Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 20, 2019

Registration No. 333-            

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM S-4

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

 

 

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   6770   61-1898603
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (Primary standard industrial
classification code number)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue

New York, New York 10174

(212) 818-8800

(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant’s principal executive offices)

Jonathan J. Ledecky

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue

New York, New York 10174

(212) 818-8800

(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)

 

 

With copies to:

 

David Alan Miller, Esq.
Jeffrey M. Gallant, Esq.
Graubard Miller
The Chrysler Building
405 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10174
Telephone: (212) 818-8800
Fax: (212) 818-8881
 

Rachel W. Sheridan, Esq.

Shagufa R. Hossain, Esq.

Latham & Watkins LLP

555 Eleventh Street, N.W.

Washington, D.C. 20004

Telephone: (202) 637-2200

Fax: (202) 637-2201

 

 

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale of the securities to the public: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective and all other conditions to the transactions contemplated by the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization described in the included proxy statement/prospectus have been satisfied or waived.

If the securities being registered on this form are to be offered in connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance with General Instruction G, check the following box:  ☐

If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  ☐

If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer

 

  

Accelerated filer

 

Non-accelerated filer

 

  

Smaller reporting company

 

    

Emerging growth company

 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act.  ☐

If applicable, place an X in the box to designate the appropriate rule provision relied upon in conducting this transaction:

Exchange Act Rule 13e-4(i) (Cross-Border Issuer Tender Offer)  ☐

Exchange Act Rule 14d-1(d) (Cross-Border Third-Party Tender Offer)  ☐

 

 

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

 

 

Title of Each Class of

Security To Be Registered

 

Amount

To Be

Registered

  Proposed
Maximum
Offering Price
Per Security (1)
  Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price (1)
  Amount of
Registration Fee

Common Stock (2)

  37,000,000   $10.25   $379,250,000   $45,965.10

Total

          $379,250,000   $45,965.10

 

 

(1)

Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee, based on the average of the high and low prices of Pivotal’s Class A common stock on June 18, 2019. This calculation is in accordance with Rule 457(f)(1) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

(2)

Represents shares of common stock to be issued by Pivotal to the holders of common stock of LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation, upon consummation of the Business Combination described herein, including upon achievement of certain earnout conditions.

 

 

The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

PRELIMINARY PROXY STATEMENT

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED JUNE 20, 2019

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor

New York, NY 10174

NOTICE OF

ANNUAL MEETING

TO BE HELD ON                 , 2019

TO THE STOCKHOLDERS OF PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.:

NOTICE IS HEREBY GIVEN that an annual meeting of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. (“ Pivotal ”), a Delaware corporation, will be held at 10:00 a.m. eastern time, on                 , 2019, at the offices of Graubard Miller, general counsel to Pivotal, at The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th  Floor, New York, New York 10174. You are cordially invited to attend the special meeting, which will be held for the following purposes:

 

  (1)

Proposal No. 1—The Business Combination Proposal— to consider and vote upon a proposal to approve and adopt the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization, dated as of May 20, 2019 (the “ Merger Agreement ”), by and among Pivotal, Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal (“ Merger Sub ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), and, solely in its capacity as representative of the stockholders of the Company, Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership (“ Carlyle ”), a copy of which is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex A , and the transactions contemplated thereby, including the merger of Merger Sub with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal (the “ Merger ”)—we refer to this proposal as the “ business combination proposal ”;

 

  (2)

Proposal No. 2—The Charter Proposals— to consider and vote upon separate proposals to approve amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to: (i) change the name of the public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”; (ii) increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock; and (iii) delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations (such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time)—we refer to these proposals collectively as the “ charter proposals ”;

 

  (3)

Proposal No. 3—The Director Election Proposal— to elect eight directors who, upon consummation of the Merger, will be the directors of Pivotal—we refer to this proposal as the “ director election proposal ”;

 

  (4)

Proposal No. 4—The Incentive Plan Proposal— to consider and vote upon a proposal to approve the 2019 Long-Term Incentive Plan, which is an incentive compensation plan for employees of Pivotal and its subsidiaries, including the Company and its subsidiaries—we refer to this proposal as the “ incentive plan proposal ”;

 

  (5)

Proposal No. 5—The Adjournment Proposal— to consider and vote upon a proposal to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date or dates if it is determined by the officer presiding over the annual meeting that more time is necessary for Pivotal to consummate the Business Combination—we refer to this proposal as the “ adjournment proposal .”


Table of Contents

These items of business are described in the attached proxy statement/prospectus. We encourage you to read the attached proxy statement/prospectus in its entirety, including the annexes and accompanying financial statements, before voting. IN PARTICULAR, WE URGE YOU TO CAREFULLY READ THE SECTION ENTITLED “ RISK FACTORS.

Only holders of record of Pivotal common stock at the close of business on                 , 2019 are entitled to notice of the annual meeting and to vote and have their votes counted at the annual meeting and any adjournments or postponements of the annual meeting.

After careful consideration, Pivotal’s board of directors has determined that each of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal is fair to and in the best interests of Pivotal and its stockholders and unanimously recommends that you vote or give instruction to vote “FOR” the business combination proposal, “FOR” each of the charter proposals, “FOR” the election of all of the persons nominated by Pivotal’s management for election as directors, “FOR” the incentive plan proposal and “FOR” the adjournment proposal, if presented. When you consider the recommendation of Pivotal’s board of directors, you should keep in mind that Pivotal’s directors and officers may have interests in the Business Combination that conflict with your interests as a stockholder. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Interests of the Founder and Pivotal’s Directors and Officers in the Business Combination .”

Consummation of the Merger is conditioned on approval of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal and the incentive plan proposal. If any of the proposals is not approved, the other proposals will not be presented to stockholders for a vote.

All Pivotal stockholders are cordially invited to attend the annual meeting in person. To ensure your representation at the annual meeting, however, you are urged to complete, sign, date and return the enclosed proxy card as soon as possible. If you are a holder of record of Pivotal common stock, you may also cast your vote in person at the annual meeting. If your common stock is held in an account at a brokerage firm or bank, you must instruct your broker or bank on how to vote your shares or, if you wish to attend the annual meeting and vote in person, obtain a proxy from your broker or bank.

A complete list of Pivotal stockholders of record entitled to vote at the annual meeting will be available for ten days before the annual meeting at the principal executive offices of Pivotal for inspection by stockholders during business hours for any purpose germane to the annual meeting.

Your vote is important regardless of the number of shares you own. Whether you plan to attend the annual meeting or not, please complete, sign, date and return the enclosed proxy card as soon as possible in the envelope provided. If your shares are held in “street name” or are in a margin or similar account, you should contact your broker to ensure that votes related to the shares you beneficially own are properly counted.

Thank you for your participation. We look forward to your continued support.

By Order of the Board of Directors

/s/ Jonathan J. Ledecky

Jonathan J. Ledecky

Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief

Executive Officer


Table of Contents

                , 2019

IF YOU RETURN YOUR PROXY CARD WITHOUT AN INDICATION OF HOW YOU WISH TO VOTE, YOUR SHARES WILL BE VOTED IN FAVOR OF EACH OF THE PROPOSALS.

ALL PIVOTAL PUBLIC STOCKHOLDERS HAVE THE RIGHT TO HAVE THEIR SHARES CONVERTED INTO CASH IN CONNECTION WITH THE PROPOSED BUSINESS COMBINATION. PUBLIC STOCKHOLDERS ARE NOT REQUIRED TO AFFIRMATIVELY VOTE FOR OR AGAINST THE BUSINESS COMBINATION PROPOSAL OR BE HOLDERS OF RECORD ON THE RECORD DATE IN ORDER TO HAVE THEIR SHARES CONVERTED INTO CASH. THIS MEANS THAT ANY PUBLIC STOCKHOLDER HOLDING SHARES OF PIVOTAL COMMON STOCK MAY EXERCISE CONVERSION RIGHTS REGARDLESS OF WHETHER THEY ARE EVEN ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE BUSINESS COMBINATION PROPOSAL.

TO EXERCISE CONVERSION RIGHTS, HOLDERS MUST TENDER THEIR STOCK TO CONTINENTAL STOCK TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY, PIVOTAL’S TRANSFER AGENT, NO LATER THAN TWO (2) BUSINESS DAYS PRIOR TO THE ANNUAL MEETING. YOU MAY TENDER YOUR STOCK BY EITHER DELIVERING YOUR STOCK CERTIFICATE TO THE TRANSFER AGENT OR BY DELIVERING YOUR SHARES ELECTRONICALLY USING THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY’S DEPOSIT WITHDRAWAL AT CUSTODIAN (“ DWAC ”) SYSTEM. IF THE BUSINESS COMBINATION IS NOT COMPLETED, THEN THESE SHARES WILL NOT BE CONVERTED INTO CASH. IF YOU HOLD THE SHARES IN STREET NAME, YOU WILL NEED TO INSTRUCT THE ACCOUNT EXECUTIVE AT YOUR BANK OR BROKER TO WITHDRAW THE SHARES FROM YOUR ACCOUNT IN ORDER TO EXERCISE YOUR CONVERSION RIGHTS. SEE “ ANNUAL MEETING OF PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS—CONVERSION RIGHTS ” FOR MORE SPECIFIC INSTRUCTIONS.


Table of Contents

The information in this proxy statement/prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not issue these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This proxy statement/prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED JUNE 20, 2019

PROXY STATEMENT FOR ANNUAL MEETING OF

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

 

 

PROSPECTUS FOR UP TO 37,000,000 SHARES OF COMMON STOCK

 

 

The board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (“ Pivotal ”), has unanimously approved the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization, dated as of May 20, 2019 (the “ Merger Agreement ”), by and among Pivotal, Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal (“ Merger Sub ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), and, solely in its capacity as representative of the stockholders of the Company, Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership (“ Carlyle ”), pursuant to which Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal (the “ Merger ”).

Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, each outstanding share of common stock of the Company will be converted into the right to receive a pro rata portion of 34,800,000 shares of common stock of Pivotal (the “ Closing Consideration ”). Stockholders of the Company will also have the right to receive 2,200,000 additional shares of common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger (the “ Contingent Consideration ” and, together with the Closing Consideration, the “ Merger Consideration ”). Accordingly, this prospectus covers up to an aggregate of 37,000,000 shares of Pivotal common stock.

Proposals to approve the Merger Agreement and the other matters discussed in this proxy statement/prospectus will be presented at the annual meeting of stockholders of Pivotal scheduled to be held on                 , 2019.

Pivotal’s units, Class A common stock and warrants are currently listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “ NYSE ”) under the symbols PVT.U, PVT and PVT WS, respectively. Upon the closing of the Merger, it is contemplated that Pivotal will have a single class of common stock. Pivotal intends to apply for listing, to be effective at the consummation of the Business Combination, of the common stock to be issued in connection with the Merger together with the common stock previously issued in its initial public offering, the warrants issued in its initial public offering and simultaneous private placement, and the common stock underlying the warrants issued in its initial public offering and simultaneous private placement, on the NYSE under the proposed symbols                 , in the case of the common stock, and                  WS, in the case of the warrants. Pivotal will not have units traded on the NYSE following consummation of the Business Combination. It is a condition of the consummation of the Business Combination that Pivotal common stock is approved for listing on the NYSE (subject only to official notice of issuance thereof and public holder requirements), but there can be no assurance such listing condition will be met. If such listing condition is not met, the Merger will not be consummated unless the listing condition set forth in the Merger Agreement is waived by the parties to that agreement.

Pivotal is an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 as amended (the “ JOBS Act ”), and has elected to comply with certain reduced public company reporting requirements.

 

 

This proxy statement/prospectus provides you with detailed information about the Merger and other matters to be considered at the annual meeting of Pivotal’s stockholders. We encourage you to carefully read this entire document. You should also carefully consider the risk factors described in “ Risk Factors beginning on page 25. These securities have not been approved or disapproved by the Securities and Exchange Commission or any state securities commission nor has the Securities and Exchange Commission or any state securities commission passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this proxy statement/prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

This proxy statement/prospectus incorporates by reference important business and financial information about Pivotal from documents that are not included in or delivered with this proxy statement/prospectus. You can obtain documents incorporated by reference in this proxy statement/prospectus and other filings of Pivotal with the Securities and Exchange Commission by visiting its website at www.sec.gov or requesting them in writing or by telephone from Pivotal at the following address:

Mr. Jonathan J. Ledecky

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor

New York, NY 10174

Tel: (212) 818-8800

You will not be charged for any of these documents that you request. Stockholders requesting documents should do so by                 , 2019 in order to receive them before the annual meeting.

This proxy statement/prospectus is dated                 , 2019, and is first being mailed to Pivotal security holders on or about                 , 2019.


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

FREQUENTLY USED TERMS

     ii  

SUMMARY OF THE MATERIAL TERMS OF THE MERGER

     1  

QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT THE PROPOSALS

     3  

SUMMARY OF THE PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

     9  

SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     20  

SELECTED UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     22  
COMPARATIVE PER SHARE DATA      24  

RISK FACTORS

     25  

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     49  

ANNUAL MEETING OF PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS

     51  

THE BUSINESS COMBINATION PROPOSAL

     57  

THE MERGER AGREEMENT

     78  

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     84  

THE CHARTER PROPOSALS

     95  

THE DIRECTOR ELECTION PROPOSAL

     97  

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     105  

THE INCENTIVE PLAN PROPOSAL

     112  

THE ADJOURNMENT PROPOSAL

     120  

OTHER INFORMATION RELATED TO PIVOTAL

     121  

BUSINESS OF THE COMPANY

     130  

THE COMPANY’S MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     144  

BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF SECURITIES

     160  

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PERSON TRANSACTIONS

     164  

DESCRIPTION OF PIVOTAL’S SECURITIES AFTER THE MERGER

     168  

INFORMATION ON PIVOTAL SECURITIES AND DIVIDENDS

     173  

APPRAISAL RIGHTS

     173  

STOCKHOLDER PROPOSALS

     173  

OTHER STOCKHOLDER COMMUNICATIONS

     174  

EXPERTS

     174  

DELIVERY OF DOCUMENTS TO STOCKHOLDERS

     174  

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     174  

Annexes

  

Annex A: Agreement and Plan of Reorganization

  

Annex B: Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation

  

Annex C: 2019 Incentive Equity Plan

  

Annex D: Opinion of Northland Securities, Inc.

  

You should rely only on the information contained in this proxy statement/prospectus in determining whether to vote in favor of the Business Combination and the other proposals. No one has been authorized to provide you with information that is different from that contained in this proxy statement/prospectus. This proxy statement/prospectus is dated                 , 2019. You should not assume that the information contained in this proxy statement/prospectus is accurate as of any date other than that date. Neither the mailing of this proxy statement/prospectus to Pivotal securityholders nor the issuance by Pivotal of common stock in connection with the Business Combination will create any implication to the contrary.

 

i


Table of Contents

Frequently Used Terms

As used in this proxy statement/prospectus:

annual meeting ” means the annual meeting of the stockholders of Pivotal that is the subject of this proxy statement/prospectus;

Business Combination ” means the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement and related agreements;

Carlyle ” means Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership;

Charter ” means the second amended and restated certificate of incorporation of Pivotal following the Merger;

Closing Consideration ” means the conversion of each outstanding share of common stock of the Company into the right to receive a pro rata portion of 34,800,000 shares of common stock of Pivotal pursuant to the Merger Agreement;

Code ” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended;

Company ” means LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation and ultimate parent company of KLDiscovery;

Contingent Consideration ” means the right Company stockholders will have to receive 2,200,000 additional shares of common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger;

DGCL ” means the Delaware General Corporation Law, as amended;

Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended;

Forward Purchase Contract ” means that certain Forward Purchase Contract, dated as of January 31, 2019, between Pivotal and Pivotal Spac Funding LLC, a managing member of the Founder and affiliate of one of Pivotal’s directors;

Founder ” means Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC, a Delaware limited liability company and an affiliate of certain of Pivotal’s officers and directors;

Founder Lock-Up Agreement ” means the lock-up agreement to be entered into at or prior to the closing of the Merger by Pivotal and the Founder;

founder shares ” means the 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock of Pivotal that were issued prior to Pivotal’s initial public offering and, unless otherwise indicated, assumes conversion of those shares upon consummation of the Merger into Pivotal’s single class of common stock on a one-for-one basis;

HSR Act ” means the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as amended;

JOBS Act ” means the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, as amended;

Marcum ” means Marcum LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, serving as Pivotal’s auditors;

Merger ” means the merger of Merger Sub with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal;

Merger Agreement ” means the Agreement and Plan of Reorganization, dated as of May 20, 2019, by and among Pivotal, Merger Sub, the Company and, solely in its capacity as a representative of the stockholders of the Company, Carlyle;

 

ii


Table of Contents

Merger Consideration ” means the Closing Consideration together with the Contingent Consideration;

Merger Sub ” means Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal;

NYSE ” means the New York Stock Exchange;

Pivotal ” means Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation, which is expected to be renamed “KLDiscovery Inc.” upon the closing of the Merger;

Pivotal common stock ” means (i) prior to the Merger, Pivotal’s Class A common stock and Class B common stock collectively, and (ii) after the Merger, Pivotal’s single class of common stock;

private warrants ” means the private placement of 6,350,000 warrants of Pivotal sold to the Founder simultaneously with Pivotal’s initial public offering;

public shares ” means the common stock included in the units issued in Pivotal’s initial public offering;

public stockholders ” means holders of public shares, including the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors to the extent they hold public shares; provided, that the holders of founder shares will be considered a “public stockholder” only with respect to any public shares held by them;

public warrants ” means the warrants exercisable for common stock included in the units issued in Pivotal’s initial public offering;

Registration Rights Agreement ” means the registration rights agreement to be entered into in connection with the consummation of the Business Combination among Pivotal, the stockholders of the Company, the holders of the founder shares and certain other securityholders of Pivotal;

Revolution ” means Revolution Growth III, LP, a Delaware limited partnership;

RG ” means Revolution;

SEC ” means the Securities and Exchange Commission;

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended;

Stockholders’ Agreement ” means the Agreement to be entered into in connection with the consummation of the Business Combination among Pivotal, affiliates of Carlyle and Revolution;

TCG ” means The Carlyle Group L.P.;

U.S. GAAP ” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States; and

2019 Plan ” means the KLDiscovery Inc. 2019 Incentive Award Plan.

 

iii


Table of Contents

SUMMARY OF THE MATERIAL TERMS OF THE MERGER

 

   

The parties to the Merger are Pivotal, Merger Sub, the Company and, solely in its capacity as a representative of the stockholders of the Company, Carlyle. Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal (the “ Merger ”). See the section entitled “ The Merger Agreement .”

 

   

KLDiscovery, a subsidiary of the Company, is one of the leading electronic discovery (“ eDiscovery ”) providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers. In 2018, KLDiscovery served over 4,300 legal technology clients, including 95% of the American Lawyer 100 (the “ AM Law 100 ”) and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. KLDiscovery has broad geographical coverage in the eDiscovery and data recovery industries with 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. Its technology and service offerings protect its clients from growing information governance challenges, litigation, compliance breaches and data loss.

 

   

Under the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of the Company will receive an aggregate of 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock at the closing of the Merger. The stockholders of the Company will also have the right to receive 2,200,000 additional shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Structure of the Transactions.

 

   

At the closing of the Merger, the Company’s stockholders will hold approximately 55% of the issued and outstanding Pivotal common stock and current stockholders of Pivotal will hold approximately 45% of the issued and outstanding Pivotal common stock (assuming no holder of Pivotal’s public shares exercises conversion rights as described in this proxy statement/prospectus). See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Structure of the Transactions.

 

   

The Merger Agreement provides that either Pivotal or the Company may terminate the Merger Agreement if the Merger is not consummated on or before October 30, 2019, provided that the failure of the Merger to be consummated by such date was not principally caused by the terminating party’s breach of the Merger Agreement. Additionally, the Merger Agreement may be terminated, among other reasons, by either Pivotal or the Company upon material breach of the other party if not cured within the time period specified within the Merger Agreement and subject to certain other conditions. See the section entitled “ The Merger Agreement—Termination .”

 

   

In addition to voting on the business combination proposal, the stockholders of Pivotal will vote on separate proposals to approve amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to: (i) change the name of the public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”; (ii) increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock; and (iii) delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations (such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time). The stockholders of Pivotal will also vote on proposals to elect eight directors who, upon consummation of the Merger, will be the directors of Pivotal, to approve the 2019 Plan and to approve, if necessary, an adjournment of the annual meeting. See the sections entitled “ The Charter Proposals, The Director Election Proposal, The Incentive Plan Proposal and The Adjournment Proposal .”

 

   

Upon completion of the Merger, if management’s nominees are elected, the directors of Pivotal will be Christopher J. Weiler (the Company’s chief executive officer), Daniel F. Akerson (the Company’s current chairman of the board of directors, who will serve as chairman of the board of directors of

 

1


Table of Contents
 

Pivotal following the Merger), Jonathan J. Ledecky (Pivotal’s current chairman of the board of directors and chief executive officer, who will serve as vice-chairman of the board of directors of Pivotal following the Merger), Kevin Griffin (a director of Pivotal and a control person of the Founder), William Darman (a managing director of The Carlyle Group L.P. (“ TCG ”)), Richard J. Williams, Donna Morea and Evan Morgan. See the section entitled “ The Director Election Proposal .”

 

   

Upon completion of the Merger, the executive officers of Pivotal will include Christopher J. Weiler as chief executive officer, Dawn Wilson as chief financial officer, and the other persons described under “ The Director Election Proposal— Information about Executive Officers, Directors and Nominees .”

 

   

Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company’s stockholders, the holders of the founder shares and certain other securityholders of Pivotal will be granted certain rights to have registered, in certain circumstances, the resale under the Securities Act of their securities of Pivotal, subject to certain conditions set forth therein.

 

   

Affiliates of Carlyle and Revolution will enter into the Stockholders’ Agreement with Pivotal, pursuant to which the holders of a majority of the shares of Pivotal common stock held by such Carlyle affiliates and Revolution will have the right to designate up to six directors for election to Pivotal’s board of directors for so long as such Carlyle affiliates and Revolution maintain collective ownership of a certain percentage interest in Pivotal.

 

   

In connection with the execution of the Merger Agreement, stockholders of the Company who hold a majority of the outstanding stock of the Company entered into agreements pursuant to which they have agreed to vote in favor of the Business Combination at a meeting called to approve the Business Combination by the Company stockholders (or to act by written consent approving the Business Combination).

 

2


Table of Contents

QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT THE PROPOSALS

The questions and answers below highlight only selected information from this proxy statement/prospectus and only briefly address some commonly asked questions about the annual meeting and the proposals to be presented at the annual meeting, including with respect to the proposed Business Combination. The following questions and answers do not include all the information that may be important to Pivotal stockholders. Stockholders are urged to carefully read this entire proxy statement/prospectus, including the annexes and the other documents referred to herein, to fully understand the proposed Business Combination and the voting procedures for the annual meeting.

 

Q.

Why am I receiving this proxy statement/prospectus?

 

A.

Pivotal and the Company have agreed to a business combination under the terms of the Merger Agreement that is described in this proxy statement/prospectus. A copy of the Merger Agreement is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex A and Pivotal encourages its stockholders to read it in its entirety. Pivotal’s stockholders are being asked to consider and vote upon a proposal to approve the Merger Agreement, which, among other things, provides for the Merger whereby Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal .”

 

Q.

Are there any other matters being presented to stockholders at the meeting?

 

A.

In addition to voting on the Business Combination, the stockholders of Pivotal will vote on the following:

 

  1.

Separate proposals to approve amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to: (i) change the name of the public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”; (ii) increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock; and (iii) delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations (such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time). See the section entitled “ The Charter Proposals .” A copy of Pivotal’s proposed second amended and restated certificate of incorporation effectuating the foregoing amendments is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex B .

 

  2.

To elect eight directors who, upon consummation of the Merger, will be the directors of Pivotal. See the section entitled “ The Director Election Proposal .”

 

  3.

To approve the 2019 Plan. See the section entitled “ The Incentive Plan Proposal .” A copy of the 2019 Plan is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex C .

 

  4.

To adjourn the meeting to a later date or dates if it is determined by the officer presiding over the annual meeting that more time is necessary for Pivotal to consummate the Merger. See the section entitled “ The Adjournment Proposal .”

Pivotal will hold the annual meeting of its stockholders to consider and vote upon these proposals. This proxy statement/prospectus contains important information about the proposed Business Combination and the other matters to be acted upon at the annual meeting. Stockholders should read it carefully.

Consummation of the Merger is conditioned on approval of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal and the incentive plan proposal. If any of the proposals is not approved, the other proposals will not be presented to stockholders for a vote.

The vote of stockholders is important. Stockholders are encouraged to vote as soon as possible after carefully reviewing this proxy statement/prospectus.

 

3


Table of Contents
Q.

I am a Pivotal warrant holder. Why am I receiving this proxy statement/prospectus?

 

A.

The holders of Pivotal warrants are entitled to purchase Pivotal common stock at a purchase price of $11.50 per share beginning 30 days after the consummation of the Merger. This proxy statement/prospectus includes important information about Pivotal and the business of Pivotal and its subsidiaries following the consummation of the Merger. Because holders of Pivotal warrants will be entitled to purchase Pivotal common stock 30 days after the consummation of the Merger, we urge you to read the information contained in this proxy statement/prospectus carefully.

 

Q.

Why is Pivotal proposing the Business Combination?

 

A.

Pivotal was organized to effect a merger, capital stock exchange, asset acquisition or other similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities.

On February 4, 2019, Pivotal completed its initial public offering of units, with each unit consisting of one share of Class A common stock and one warrant to purchase one share of Class A common stock at a price of $11.50, raising total gross proceeds of approximately $230 million. Since its initial public offering, Pivotal’s activity has been limited to the evaluation of business combination candidates.

The Company is the owner of the KLDiscovery business, one of the leading eDiscovery providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers. In 2018, KLDiscovery served over 4,300 legal technology clients, including 95% of the AM Law 100 and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. KLDiscovery has broad geographical coverage in the eDiscovery and data recovery industries with 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. Its technology and service offerings protect its clients from growing information governance challenges, litigation, compliance breaches and data loss.

Based on its due diligence investigations of the Company and the industry in which it operates, including the financial and other information provided by the Company in the course of the negotiations in connection with the Merger Agreement, Pivotal believes that the Company has a very appealing market opportunity and growth profile, strong position in its industry and a compelling valuation. As a result, Pivotal believes that a business combination with the Company will provide Pivotal stockholders with an opportunity to participate in the ownership of a company with significant growth potential. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Pivotal’s Board of Directors’ Reasons for Approval of the Business Combination.

 

Q.

Did the Pivotal board of directors obtain a third-party valuation or fairness opinion in determining whether or not to proceed with the Business Combination?

 

A.

Yes. Pivotal’s board of directors obtained an opinion from Northland Securities, Inc. as to (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal of the consideration to be paid by it pursuant to the Merger Agreement and (ii) whether the business acquired has a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in the trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of the Merger Agreement. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Pivotal’s Board of Directors’ Reasons for Approval of the Merger—Opinion of Financial Advisor.

 

 

Q.

Do I have conversion rights?

 

A.

If you are a holder of public shares, you have the right to demand that Pivotal convert such shares into a pro rata portion of the cash held in Pivotal’s trust account. We sometimes refer to these rights to demand conversion of the public shares as “conversion rights.”

Notwithstanding the foregoing, a holder of public shares, together with any affiliate of his or any other person with whom such holder is acting in concert or as a “group” (as defined in Section 13(d)(3) of the

 

4


Table of Contents

Exchange Act), will be restricted from seeking conversion rights with respect to 20% or more of the public shares. Accordingly, all public shares in excess of 20% held by a public stockholder, together with any affiliate of such holder or any other person with whom such holder is acting in concert or as a “group,” will not be converted.

Under Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation, the Business Combination may be consummated only if Pivotal has at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets after giving effect to the conversion into cash of all public shares properly demanded to be so converted by holders of public shares. This means that a substantial number of public shares may be converted and Pivotal can still consummate the Business Combination. However, the Company is not required to consummate the Merger if there is not at least $175 million available to Pivotal (consisting of the cash available in Pivotal’s trust account together with net cash proceeds received from any investment in Pivotal approved pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, including up to $50 million pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any)), after giving effect to payment of amounts that Pivotal will be required to pay to converting stockholders upon consummation of the Business Combination and certain other expenses.

 

Q.

How do I exercise my conversion rights?

 

A.

A holder of public shares may exercise conversion rights regardless of whether it votes on the business combination proposal or if it is a holder of public shares on the record date. If you are a holder of public shares and wish to exercise your redemption rights, you must demand that Pivotal redeem your public shares for cash, and deliver your public shares to Pivotal’s transfer agent physically or electronically using The Depository Trust Company’s DWAC System no later than two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting. Any holder of public shares seeking conversion will be entitled to a full pro rata portion of the amount then in the trust account (which, for illustrative purposes, was $                , or $                 per share, as of the record date), less any owed but unpaid taxes on the funds in the trust account. Such amount will be paid promptly upon consummation of the Business Combination. There are currently no owed but unpaid income taxes on the funds in the trust account.

Any request for conversion, once made by a holder of public shares, may be withdrawn at any time prior to the time the vote is taken with respect to the business combination proposal at the annual meeting. If you deliver your shares for conversion to Pivotal’s transfer agent and later decide prior to the annual meeting not to elect conversion, you may request that Pivotal’s transfer agent return the shares (physically or electronically). You may make such request by contacting Pivotal’s transfer agent at the address listed at the end of this section.

Any written demand of conversion rights must be received by Pivotal’s transfer agent at least two (2) business days prior to the vote taken on the business combination proposal at the annual meeting. No demand for conversion will be honored unless the holder’s stock has been delivered (either physically or electronically) to the transfer agent.

If you are a holder of public shares and you exercise your conversion rights, it will not result in the loss of any Pivotal warrants that you may hold. Your warrants will become exercisable to purchase one share of Pivotal common stock for a purchase price of $11.50 beginning 30 days after consummation of the Business Combination.

 

Q.

Do I have appraisal rights if I object to the proposed Business Combination?

 

A.

No. Neither Pivotal stockholders nor its unit or warrant holders have appraisal rights in connection with the Business Combination under Delaware law. See the section entitled “ Appraisal Rights.

 

Q.

What happens to the funds deposited in the trust account after consummation of the Business Combination?

 

A.

Of the net proceeds of Pivotal’s initial public offering and simultaneous private placement of warrants, $230 million was placed in the trust account immediately following the initial public offering. After

 

5


Table of Contents
 

consummation of the Business Combination, the funds in the trust account will be used to pay holders of the public shares who exercise conversion rights, to pay fees and expenses incurred in connection with the Business Combination (including aggregate fees of approximately $8.0 million to the underwriters of Pivotal’s initial public offering as deferred underwriting commissions) and for Pivotal’s working capital and general corporate purposes, including to pay down certain of the Company’s indebtedness.

 

Q.

What happens if a substantial number of public stockholders vote in favor of the business combination proposal and exercise their conversion rights?

 

A.

Pivotal’s public stockholders may vote in favor of the Business Combination and still exercise their conversion rights, although they are not required to vote in any way to exercise conversion rights. Accordingly, the Business Combination may be consummated even though the funds available from the trust account and the number of public stockholders are substantially reduced as a result of conversion by public stockholders. However, the Company is not required to consummate the Merger if there is not at least $175 million available to Pivotal in the trust account (together with net cash proceeds received from any investment in Pivotal approved pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, including up to $50 million pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any)), after giving effect to payment of amounts that Pivotal will be required to pay to converting stockholders upon consummation of the Merger and certain other expenses. Also, with fewer public shares and public stockholders, the trading markets for Pivotal common stock and warrants following the closing of the Merger may be less liquid than the market for Pivotal common stock and warrants were prior to the Merger and Pivotal may not be able to meet the listing standards of a national securities exchange. In addition, with fewer funds available from the trust account, the capital infusion from the trust account into the Company’s business will be reduced and the Company may not be able to achieve its business plans.

 

Q.

What happens if the Business Combination is not consummated?

 

A.

If Pivotal does not complete the Business Combination with the Company for whatever reason, Pivotal would search for another target business with which to complete a business combination. If Pivotal does not complete the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation), Pivotal must redeem 100% of the outstanding public shares, at a per-share price, payable in cash, equal to an amount then held in the trust account (net of taxes payable and less up to $100,000 of interest to pay dissolution expenses). The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors have waived their redemption rights with respect to their founder shares in the event a business combination is not effected in the required time period, and, accordingly, the founder shares held by them will be worthless. Additionally, in the event of such liquidation, there will be no distribution with respect to our outstanding warrants. Accordingly, the warrants will expire worthless.

 

Q.

How do the Founder and the officers and directors of Pivotal intend to vote on the proposals?

 

A.

The Founder, as well as Pivotal’s officers and directors, beneficially own and are entitled to vote an aggregate of 20% of the outstanding Pivotal common stock. These holders have agreed to vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. These holders have also indicated that they intend to vote their shares in favor of all other proposals being presented at the meeting.

 

Q.

When do you expect the Business Combination to be completed?

 

A.

It is currently anticipated that the Business Combination will be consummated promptly following the Pivotal annual meeting, which is set for                 , 2019; however, such meeting could be adjourned, as described above. For a description of the conditions for the completion of the Business Combination, see the section entitled “ The Merger Agreement—Conditions to the Closing of the Business Combination.

 

6


Table of Contents
Q.

What do I need to do now?

 

A.

Pivotal urges you to carefully read and consider the information contained in this proxy statement/prospectus, including the annexes, and to consider how the Business Combination will affect you as a stockholder and/or warrantholder of Pivotal. Stockholders should then vote as soon as possible in accordance with the instructions provided in this proxy statement/prospectus and on the enclosed proxy card.

 

Q.

How do I vote?

 

A.

If you are a holder of record of Pivotal common stock on the record date, you may vote in person at the annual meeting or by submitting a proxy for the annual meeting. You may submit your proxy by completing, signing, dating and returning the enclosed proxy card in the accompanying pre-addressed postage paid envelope. If you hold your shares in “street name,” which means your shares are held of record by a broker, bank or nominee, you should contact your broker, bank or nominee to ensure that votes related to the shares you beneficially own are properly counted. In this regard, you must provide the broker, bank or nominee with instructions on how to vote your shares or, if you wish to attend the meeting and vote in person, obtain a proxy from your broker, bank or nominee.

 

Q.

If my shares are held in “street name,” will my broker, bank or nominee automatically vote my shares for me?

 

A.

No. Your broker, bank or nominee cannot vote your shares unless you provide instructions on how to vote in accordance with the information and procedures provided to you by your broker, bank or nominee.

 

Q.

May I change my vote after I have mailed my signed proxy card?

 

A.

Yes. Stockholders may send a later-dated, signed proxy card to Pivotal’s transfer agent at the address set forth below so that it is received prior to the vote at the annual meeting or attend the annual meeting in person and vote. Stockholders also may revoke their proxy by sending a notice of revocation to Pivotal’s transfer agent, which must be received prior to the vote at the annual meeting.

 

Q.

What happens if I fail to take any action with respect to the annual meeting?

 

A.

If you fail to take any action with respect to the meeting and the Business Combination is approved by stockholders and consummated, you will continue to be a holder of Pivotal common stock or warrants, as applicable. As a corollary, failure to deliver your stock certificate(s) to Pivotal’s transfer agent (either physically or electronically) no later than two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting means you will not have any right in connection with the Merger to exchange your shares for a pro rata share of the funds held in Pivotal’s trust account. If you fail to take any action with respect to the annual meeting and the Merger is not approved, you will continue to be a stockholder and/or warrant holder of Pivotal.

 

Q.

What should I do with my share and/or warrant certificates?

 

A.

Warrant holders and those stockholders who do not elect to have their Pivotal shares converted into a pro rata share of the trust account need not submit their certificates. Pivotal stockholders who exercise their conversion rights must deliver their share certificates to Pivotal’s transfer agent (either physically or electronically) no later than two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting as described above.

 

Q.

What should I do if I receive more than one set of voting materials?

 

A.

Stockholders may receive more than one set of voting materials, including multiple copies of this proxy statement/prospectus and multiple proxy cards or voting instruction cards. For example, if you hold your

 

7


Table of Contents
 

shares in more than one brokerage account, you will receive a separate voting instruction card for each brokerage account in which you hold shares. If you are a holder of record and your shares are registered in more than one name, you will receive more than one proxy card. Please complete, sign, date and return each proxy card and voting instruction card that you receive in order to cast a vote with respect to all of your shares of Pivotal common stock.

 

Q.

Who can help answer my questions?

 

A.

If you have questions about the Merger or if you need additional copies of this proxy statement/prospectus or the enclosed proxy card, you should contact:

Mr. Jonathan J. Ledecky

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor

New York, NY 10174

Tel: (212) 818-8800

or

The proxy solicitor at:

 

You may also obtain additional information about Pivotal from documents filed with the SEC by following the instructions in the section entitled “ Where You Can Find More Information. ” If you are a holder of public shares and you intend to seek conversion of your shares, you will need to deliver your shares (either physically or electronically) to Pivotal’s transfer agent at the address below at least two (2) business days prior to the vote at the annual meeting. If you have questions regarding the certification of your position or delivery of your stock, please contact:

Mr. Mark Zimkind

Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company

1 State Street, 30th Floor

New York, New York 10004

E-mail: mzimkind@continentalstock.com

 

8


Table of Contents

SUMMARY OF THE PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS

This summary highlights selected information from this proxy statement/prospectus and does not contain all of the information that is important to you. To better understand the proposals to be submitted for a vote at the annual meeting, including the business combination proposal, you should read this entire document carefully, including the Merger Agreement attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex A. The Merger Agreement is the legal document that governs the Merger that will be undertaken in connection with the Business Combination. It is also described in detail in this proxy statement/prospectus in the section entitled “The Merger Agreement.”

The Parties

Pivotal

Pivotal Acquisition Corp. is a blank check company formed in order to effect a merger, capital stock exchange, asset acquisition or other similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities. Pivotal was incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware on August 2, 2018.

On February 4, 2019, Pivotal closed its initial public offering of 23,000,000 units, including 3,000,000 units subject to the exercise in full of the underwriters’ overallotment option, with each unit consisting of one share of Class A common stock and one warrant to purchase one share of Class A common stock at a price of $11.50 commencing 30 days after the consummation of an initial business combination. The units from Pivotal’s initial public offering (including the over-allotment option) were sold at an offering price of $10.00 per unit, generating total gross proceeds of $230 million. Simultaneously with the consummation of its initial public offering and the exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, Pivotal consummated the private sale of 6,350,000 private warrants at $1.00 per warrant generating gross proceeds of $6.35 million. A total of $230 million was deposited into the trust account and the remaining proceeds, net of underwriting discounts and commissions and other costs and expenses, became available to be used as working capital to provide for business, legal and accounting due diligence on prospective business combinations and continuing general and administrative expenses. Pivotal’s initial public offering was conducted pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-229027) that became effective on January 30, 2019. As of                 , 2019, the record date, there was approximately $                 held in the trust account.

Pivotal’s units, Class A common stock and warrants are listed on the NYSE under the symbols PVT.U, PVT and PVT WS, respectively.

The mailing address of Pivotal’s principal executive office is c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174, and its telephone number is (212) 818-8800. After the consummation of the Business Combination, Pivotal’s principal executive office will be that of the Company.

Merger Sub

Pivotal Merger Sub Corp. is a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal formed solely for the purpose of effectuating the Merger described herein. Merger Sub was incorporated under the laws of Delaware as a corporation on May 17, 2019. Merger Sub owns no material assets and does not operate any business.

The mailing address of Merger Sub’s principal executive office is c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174, and its telephone number is (212) 818-8800. After the consummation of the Business Combination, Merger Sub will cease to exist.



 

9


Table of Contents

The Company

The Company is the parent company of KLDiscovery, one of the leading eDiscovery providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers. In 2018, KLDiscovery served over 4,300 legal technology clients, including 95% of the AM Law 100 and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. KLDiscovery has broad geographical coverage in the eDiscovery and data recovery industries with 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. Its technology and service offerings protect its clients from growing information governance challenges, litigation, compliance breaches and data loss. The Company is a Delaware corporation that was incorporated on November 20, 2015.

The mailing address of the Company’s principal executive office is c/o KLDiscovery, 8201 Greensboro Dr., Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102 and its telephone number is (703) 288-3380.

Emerging Growth Company

Pivotal is an “emerging growth company,” as defined under the JOBS Act. As an emerging growth company, Pivotal is eligible to take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not emerging growth companies. These include, but are not limited to, not being required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in its periodic reports and proxy statements, and exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and the requirement to obtain stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved.

In addition, Section 107 of the JOBS Act provides that an emerging growth company can take advantage of an extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act for complying with new or revised accounting standards. Pivotal has elected to take advantage of such extended transition period.

Pivotal will remain an emerging growth company until the earlier of (1) December 31, 2024 (the last day of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering), (2) the last day of the fiscal year in which Pivotal has total annual gross revenue of at least $1.07 billion, (3) the last day of the fiscal year in which Pivotal is deemed to be a “large accelerated filer,” as defined in the Exchange Act, and (4) the date on which Pivotal has issued more than $1.0 billion in nonconvertible debt during the prior three-year period.

The Business Combination Proposal

Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, a business combination between Pivotal and the Company will be effected whereby Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal.

After consideration of the factors identified and discussed in the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Pivotal’s Board of Directors’ Reasons for Approval of the Business Combination ,” Pivotal’s board of directors concluded that the Merger met all of the requirements disclosed in the prospectus for its initial public offering, including that the Company has a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in the trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of the Merger Agreement. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Structure of the Transactions ” for more information.



 

10


Table of Contents

Consideration to Company Stockholders

Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, the Company’s stockholders will receive an aggregate of 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock and will have the right to receive an additional 2,200,000 shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger.

Pro Forma Ownership of Pivotal Upon Closing

At the closing of the Merger, the Company’s stockholders will hold approximately 55% of the issued and outstanding Pivotal common stock and current stockholders of Pivotal will hold approximately 45% of the issued and outstanding Pivotal common stock (assuming no holder of public shares exercises conversion rights).

Opinion of Financial Advisor to Pivotal’s Board of Directors

Pivotal engaged Northland Securities, Inc. (“ Northland ”) to render an opinion, as of May 17, 2019, as to (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal of the consideration to be paid by it pursuant to the Merger Agreement and (ii) whether the business acquired has a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in Pivotal’s trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of the Merger Agreement. Northland is an investment banking firm that regularly is engaged in the evaluation of businesses and their securities in connection with acquisitions, corporate restructurings, private placements and for other purposes. Pivotal’s board of directors decided to engage Northland because it is a recognized investment banking firm that has substantial experience in similar matters.

The amount of the consideration to be paid pursuant to the Merger Agreement was determined pursuant to negotiations between the parties thereto, and not pursuant to recommendations of Northland.

Northland rendered its opinion to Pivotal’s board of directors on May 17, 2019 that, as of such date, (i) the consideration to be paid pursuant to the Merger Agreement was fair, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal and (ii) the business acquired has a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in Pivotal’s trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of the Merger Agreement. The opinion was provided for the use and benefit of Pivotal’s board of directors in connection with its consideration of the Business Combination and only addressed the two above matters, in each case as of the date of the opinion, and did not address any other aspect or implication of the Business Combination. The summary of Northland’s opinion included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the written opinion, which is included as Annex D to this proxy statement/prospectus and sets forth the procedures followed, assumptions made, qualifications and limitations on the review undertaken and other matters considered by Northland in preparing its opinion. However, neither Northland’s written opinion nor the summary of its opinion and the related analyses set forth in this proxy statement/prospectus are intended to be, and do not constitute, advice or a recommendation to any stockholder as to how such stockholder should act or vote with respect to any matter relating to the proposed Business Combination.

Additional Matters Being Voted On

The Charter Proposals

In addition to voting on the business combination proposal, the stockholders of Pivotal will vote on separate proposals to approve amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to: (i) change the name of the public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”; (ii)



 

11


Table of Contents

increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock; and (iii) delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time. See the section entitled “ The Charter Proposals .” A copy of Pivotal’s proposed second amended and restated certificate of incorporation effectuating the foregoing amendments is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex B .

The Director Election Proposal

The stockholders of Pivotal will also vote to elect eight directors who, upon consummation of the Merger, will be the directors of Pivotal. If management’s nominees are elected, Richard J. Williams and Kevin Griffin will be Class A directors serving until the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 2020, Donna Morea, Jonathan J. Ledecky and Evan Morgan will be Class B directors serving until the annual meeting to be held in 2021 and Christopher J. Weiler, Daniel F. Akerson and William Darman will be Class C directors serving until the annual meeting to be held in 2022, in each case, until their successors are elected and qualified. See the section entitled “ The Director Election Proposal .”

The Incentive Plan Proposal

The proposed 2019 Plan will reserve up to                  shares of Pivotal common stock for issuance in accordance with the 2019 Plan’s terms, subject to certain adjustments. The purpose of the 2019 Plan is to provide Pivotal’s and its subsidiaries’ officers, directors, employees and consultants who, by their position, ability and diligence are able to make important contributions to Pivotal’s growth and profitability, with an incentive to assist Pivotal in achieving its long-term corporate objectives, to attract and retain executive officers and other employees of outstanding competence, and to provide such persons with an opportunity to acquire an equity interest in Pivotal. The proposed 2019 Plan is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex C . You are encouraged to read the proposed 2019 Plan in its entirety. See the section entitled “ The Incentive Plan Proposal .”

The Adjournment Proposal

If Pivotal is unable to consummate the Business Combination for any reason, Pivotal’s board of directors may submit a proposal to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date or dates, if necessary. See the section entitled “ The Adjournment Proposal .”

Pivotal Founder and Officers and Directors

As of                 , 2019, the record date for the Pivotal annual meeting, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors beneficially owned and were entitled to vote an aggregate of 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock. The founder shares currently constitute 20% of Pivotal’s outstanding common stock. The Founder also purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 private warrants simultaneously with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering.

In connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, the Founder and each of Pivotal’s officers and directors agreed to vote the founder shares, as well as any Pivotal common stock acquired in the aftermarket, in favor of the business combination proposal. The Founder and each of Pivotal’s officers and directors has also indicated that he, she or it intends to vote his, her or its shares in favor of all other proposals being presented at the meeting.



 

12


Table of Contents

In connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, the holders of Pivotal’s founder shares entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the founder shares (subject to limited exceptions) until one year after the consummation of an initial business combination or earlier if, subsequent to the consummation of an initial business combination, (i) the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the initial business combination or (ii) Pivotal (or any successor entity) consummates a subsequent liquidation, merger, stock exchange or other similar transaction which results in all of Pivotal’s (or such successor entity’s) stockholders having the right to exchange their shares of common stock for cash, securities or other property. Additionally, the holders of private warrants entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the private warrants or common stock underlying the private warrants (subject to limited exceptions) until 30 days after the consummation of an initial business combination.

In connection with the Merger, the Founder agreed to enter into the Founder Lock-Up Agreement, pursuant to which an aggregate of 1,100,000 founder shares will be subject to additional transfer restrictions until the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $15.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period. If the last reported sale price of Pivotal common stock does not equal or exceed $15.00 within five years from the consummation of the Business Combination, such founder shares will be forfeited to Pivotal for no consideration.

Date, Time and Place of Annual Meeting of Pivotal’s Stockholders

The annual meeting of stockholders of Pivotal will be held at 10:00 a.m., Eastern time, on                 , 2019, at the offices of Graubard Miller, general counsel to Pivotal, at The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, New York 10174, to consider and vote upon the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the incentive plan proposal, the director election proposal and/or if necessary, the adjournment proposal if Pivotal is not able to consummate the Merger for any reason.

Voting Power; Record Date

Stockholders will be entitled to vote or direct votes to be cast at the annual meeting if they owned Pivotal common stock at the close of business on                 , 2019, which is the record date for the annual meeting. Stockholders will have one vote for each share of Pivotal common stock owned at the close of business on the record date. If your shares are held in “street name” or are in a margin or similar account, you should contact your broker to ensure that votes related to the shares you beneficially own are properly counted. Pivotal warrants do not have voting rights. On the record date, there were 28,750,000 shares of Pivotal common stock entitled to vote at the annual meeting, of which 23,000,000 were public shares and 5,750,000 were founder shares.

Quorum and Vote of Pivotal Stockholders

A quorum of Pivotal stockholders is necessary to hold a valid meeting. A quorum will be present at the Pivotal annual meeting if a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote at the meeting are represented in person or by proxy. Abstentions and broker non-votes will count as present for the purposes of establishing a quorum. The holders of founder shares hold approximately 20% of the outstanding Pivotal common stock. Such shares will be voted in favor of the proposals presented at the annual meeting. The proposals presented at the annual meeting will require the following votes:

 

   

The approval of the business combination proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the meeting. There are



 

13


Table of Contents
 

currently 23,000,000 shares of Class A common stock outstanding and 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock outstanding; assuming all outstanding shares are present and entitled to vote at the meeting, at least 14,375,001 shares of Pivotal common stock must be voted in favor of the proposal. The holders of founder shares own an aggregate of 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock of Pivotal, representing approximately 20% of the outstanding Pivotal common stock, and have agreed to vote in favor of the proposal; as a result, only 8,625,000 public shares, or approximately 37.5% of the public shares, are required to be voted in favor of the proposal in order for it to be approved.

 

   

The approval of each of the charter proposals will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Pivotal common stock on the record date.

 

   

The election of directors requires a plurality vote of the Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the annual meeting. “Plurality” means that the individuals who receive the largest number of votes cast “FOR” are elected as directors. Consequently, any shares not voted “FOR” a particular nominee (whether as a result of an abstention, a direction to withhold authority or a broker non-vote) will not be counted in the nominee’s favor.

 

   

The approval of the incentive plan proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the meeting.

 

   

The approval of the adjournment proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the meeting.

Abstentions will have the same effect as a vote “against” the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal, if presented. Abstentions will have no effect on the director election proposal. Broker non-votes will have no effect on the business combination proposal, director election proposal, incentive plan proposal and adjournment proposal, if presented, and will have the same effect as a vote “against” the charter proposals.

Consummation of the Merger is conditioned on approval of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal and the incentive plan proposal. If any such proposal is not approved, the other proposals will not be presented to the stockholders for a vote.

Conversion Rights

Pursuant to Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation, a holder of public shares may demand that Pivotal convert such shares into cash if the Business Combination is consummated. Holders of public shares will be entitled to receive cash for these shares only if they deliver their stock to Pivotal’s transfer agent no later than two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting. Holders of public shares do not need to affirmatively vote on the business combination proposal or be a holder of such public shares as of the record date to exercise conversion rights. If the Business Combination is not completed, no shares will be converted to cash. If a holder of public shares properly demands conversion, Pivotal will convert each public share into a pro rata portion of the trust account, calculated as of two business days prior to the anticipated consummation of the Business Combination, including interest earned on the trust account and not previously released to Pivotal to pay its tax obligations. As of                 , 2019, the record date, this would amount to approximately $                 per share. If a holder of public shares exercises its conversion rights, then it will be exchanging its shares of Pivotal common stock for cash and will no longer own the shares. See the section entitled “ Annual Meeting of Pivotal Stockholders—Conversion Rights ” for a detailed description of the procedures to be followed if you wish to exercise conversion rights.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, a holder of public shares, together with any affiliate of his or any other person with whom he is acting in concert or as a “group” (as defined in Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act), will be



 

14


Table of Contents

restricted from seeking conversion rights with respect to 20% or more of the public shares. Accordingly, all public shares in excess of 20% held by a public stockholder will not be converted to cash.

The Business Combination will not be consummated if Pivotal has net tangible assets of less than $5,000,001 after taking into account the conversion into cash of all public shares properly demanded to be converted by holders of public shares. This means that a substantial number of public shares may be converted and Pivotal can still consummate the Business Combination. However, the Merger Agreement provides that the Company is not required to consummate the Merger if immediately prior to the consummation of the Merger, Pivotal does not have at least $175 million available to it in the trust account (together with net cash proceeds received from any investment in Pivotal approved pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, including up to $50 million pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any)), after giving effect to payment of amounts that Pivotal will be required to pay to converting stockholders upon consummation of the Merger and certain other fees and expenses. If the Company does not waive its termination right and Pivotal has less than the required amount in trust, the Merger will not be consummated.

Holders of Pivotal warrants will not have conversion rights with respect to such securities.

Appraisal Rights

Neither stockholders of Pivotal nor holders of units or warrants of Pivotal have appraisal rights in connection with the Merger under Delaware law.

Proxy Solicitation

Proxies may be solicited by mail, telephone or in person. Pivotal has engaged                  to assist in the solicitation of proxies. If a stockholder grants a proxy, it may still vote its shares in person if it revokes its proxy before the annual meeting. A stockholder may also change its vote by submitting a later-dated proxy as described in the section entitled “ Annual Meeting of Pivotal Stockholders—Revoking Your Proxy .”

Interests of the Founder and Pivotal’s Directors and Officers in the Business Combination

When you consider the recommendation of Pivotal’s board of directors in favor of approval of the business combination proposal, you should keep in mind that the Founder (which is affiliated with certain of Pivotal’s officers and directors) and Pivotal’s directors and officers have interests in such proposal that may be different from, or in addition to, your interests as a stockholder or warrantholder. These interests include, among other things:

 

   

If the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not consummated by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal’s stockholders), Pivotal will cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, redeeming 100% of the outstanding public shares for cash and, subject to the approval of its remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolving and liquidating. In such event, the 5,750,000 founder shares held by the Founder and Pivotal’s directors and officers, which were acquired for an aggregate purchase price of $25,000 prior to Pivotal’s initial public offering, would be worthless because the holders are not entitled to participate in any redemption or distribution with respect to such shares. Such shares had an aggregate market value of $                 based upon the closing price of $                 per share on NYSE on                 , 2019, the record date.

 

   

The Founder, which is affiliated with certain of Pivotal’s directors and officers, purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 private warrants from Pivotal for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $6.35 million (or $1.00 per warrant). These purchases took place on a private placement basis simultaneously with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering. All of the proceeds Pivotal



 

15


Table of Contents
 

received from these purchases were placed in the trust account. Such warrants had an aggregate market value of $                 based upon the closing price of $                 per unit on NYSE on                 , 2019, the record date. The private warrants will become worthless if Pivotal does not consummate a business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation).

 

   

The Stockholders’ Agreement contemplated by the Merger Agreement provides that Jonathan J. Ledecky and Kevin Griffin will be directors of Pivotal after the closing of the Merger (assuming they are elected at the annual meeting as described in this proxy statement/prospectus). As such, in the future, each will receive any cash fees, stock options or stock awards that the Pivotal board of directors determines to pay to its non-executive directors.

 

   

If Pivotal is unable to complete a business combination within the required time period, the Founder will be personally liable under certain circumstances described herein to ensure that the proceeds in the trust account are not reduced by the claims of target businesses or claims of vendors or other entities that are owed money by Pivotal for services rendered or contracted for or products sold to Pivotal. If Pivotal consummates a business combination, on the other hand, Pivotal will be liable for all such claims.

 

   

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors and their affiliates are entitled to reimbursement of out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in connection with certain activities on Pivotal’s behalf, such as identifying and investigating possible business targets and business combinations. However, if Pivotal fails to consummate a business combination within the required period, they will not have any claim against the trust account for reimbursement. Accordingly, Pivotal may not be able to reimburse these expenses if the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not completed by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation). As of                 , 2019, the record date, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors and their affiliates had incurred approximately $                 of unpaid reimbursable expenses.

 

   

The Merger Agreement provides for the continued indemnification of Pivotal’s current directors and officers and the continuation of directors and officers liability insurance covering Pivotal’s current directors and officers.

 

   

Pivotal’s officers and directors (or their affiliates) may make loans from time to time to Pivotal to fund certain capital requirements. As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, no such loans have been made, but loans may be made after the date of this proxy statement/prospectus. If the Business Combination is not consummated, the loans will not be repaid and will be forgiven except to the extent there are funds available to Pivotal outside of the trust account.

At any time prior to the annual meeting, during a period when they are not then aware of any material nonpublic information regarding Pivotal or its securities, the Founder, Pivotal’s officers and directors, the Company or the Company’s stockholders and/or their respective affiliates may purchase shares from institutional and other investors who vote, or indicate an intention to vote, against the business combination proposal, or execute agreements to purchase shares from such investors in the future, or they may enter into transactions with such investors and others to provide them with incentives to acquire shares of Pivotal common stock or vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. The purpose of such share purchases and other transactions would be to increase the likelihood of satisfaction of the requirements that the holders of a majority of the shares entitled to vote at the annual meeting to approve the business combination proposal vote in its favor and that Pivotal has in excess of the required dollar amount to consummate the Business Combination under the Merger Agreement, where it appears that such requirements would otherwise not be met. While the exact nature of any such incentives has not been determined as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, they might include,



 

16


Table of Contents

without limitation, arrangements to protect such investors or holders against potential loss in value of their shares, including the granting of put options and the transfer to such investors or holders of shares or warrants owned by the Pivotal initial stockholders for nominal value.

Entering into any such arrangements may have a depressive effect on Pivotal common stock. For example, as a result of these arrangements, an investor or holder may have the ability to effectively purchase shares at a price lower than market and may therefore be more likely to sell the shares he, she or it owns, either prior to or immediately after the annual meeting.

If such transactions are effected, the consequence could be to cause the Business Combination to be approved in circumstances where such approval could not otherwise be obtained. Purchases of shares by the persons described above would allow them to exert more influence over the approval of the business combination proposal and the other proposals to be presented at the annual meeting and would likely increase the chances that such proposals would be approved. Moreover, any such purchases may make it more likely that Pivotal will have in excess of the required amount of cash available to consummate the Business Combination as described above.

As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, no agreements dealing with the above have been entered into. Pivotal will file a Current Report on Form 8-K to disclose any arrangements entered into or significant purchases made by any of the aforementioned persons that would affect the vote on the business combination proposal or the satisfaction of any closing conditions. Any such report will include descriptions of any arrangements entered into or significant purchases by any of the aforementioned persons.

Recommendation to Stockholders

Pivotal’s board of directors believes that the business combination proposal and the other proposals to be presented at the annual meeting are fair to and in the best interest of Pivotal’s stockholders and unanimously recommends that its stockholders vote “FOR” the business combination proposal, “FOR” each of the charter proposals, “FOR” the director election proposal, “FOR” the incentive plan proposal and “FOR” the adjournment proposal, if presented.

Conditions to the Closing of the Business Combination

General Conditions

Consummation of the Merger is conditioned on the approval of the proposals by the required vote of the Pivotal stockholders, the approval of the Business Combination by the Company’s stockholders and Pivotal having at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets remaining after the closing of the Merger.

In addition, the consummation of the Merger is conditioned upon, among other things, (i) no governmental entity having enacted, issued, promulgated, enforced or entered any statute, rule, regulation, executive order, decree, injunction or other order (whether temporary, preliminary or permanent) which is in effect and which has the effect of making the Merger illegal or otherwise prohibiting consummation of the Merger, (ii) the Registration Statement on Form S-4, of which this proxy statement/prospectus forms a part, having become effective in accordance with the provisions of the Securities Act, (iii) no stop order having been issued by the SEC which remains in effect with respect to the Form S-4 and no proceeding seeking such a stop order having been threatened or initiated by the SEC which remains pending and (iv) all specified waiting periods under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 2012, as amended (the “ HSR Act ”), having expired.



 

17


Table of Contents

Company Conditions to Closing

The obligations of the Company to consummate the Merger are also conditioned upon, among other things:

 

   

the accuracy of the representations and warranties of Pivotal and Merger Sub (subject to certain bring-down standards);

 

   

performance of the covenants of Pivotal and Merger Sub required by the Merger Agreement to be performed on or prior to the closing;

 

   

Pivotal executing the Registration Rights Agreement and terminating the existing registration rights agreement among Pivotal, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors;

 

   

Pivotal executing the Stockholders’ Agreement;

 

   

Pivotal and the Founder executing the Founder Lock-Up Agreement;

 

   

Pivotal’s compliance with the Securities Act and the Exchange Act;

 

   

Pivotal having at least $175,000,000 available to it in the trust account (together with net cash proceeds received from any investment in Pivotal approved pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, including up to $50 million pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any)), after payment to holders of public shares that seek conversion in connection with the Business Combination and net of certain other expenses; and

 

   

Pivotal common stock to be issued pursuant to the Merger Agreement having been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject only to official notice of issuance thereof and public holder requirements.

Pivotal’s and Merger Sub’s Conditions to Closing

The obligations of Pivotal and Merger Sub to consummate the Merger are also conditioned upon, among other things:

 

   

the accuracy of the representations and warranties of the Company (subject to certain bring-down standards);

 

   

performance of the covenants of the Company required by the Merger Agreement to be performed on or prior to the closing; and

 

   

the termination of the Company’s existing stockholders’ agreement.

Termination

The Merger Agreement may be terminated at any time, but not later than the closing, as follows:

 

   

by mutual written consent of Pivotal and the Company;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if the Business Combination is not consummated on or before October 30, 2019; provided that the right to terminate the Merger Agreement will not be available to any party whose action or failure to act has been a principal cause of or primarily resulted in the failure of the Merger to occur on or before such date and such action or failure to act constitutes a breach of the Merger Agreement;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if a governmental entity shall have issued an order, decree or ruling or taken any other action, in any case having the effect of permanently restraining, enjoining or otherwise prohibiting the Merger, which order, decree, judgment, ruling or other action is final and non-appealable;



 

18


Table of Contents
   

by either Pivotal or the Company if, immediately following consummation of the Merger, Pivotal will have less than $5,000,001 of net tangible assets following the exercise by the holders of shares of Pivotal common stock issued in Pivotal’s initial public offering of their conversion rights;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if the other party has breached any of its covenants or representations and warranties in any material respect and has not cured its breach within 30 days of the notice of an intent to terminate; provided that the terminating party is itself not in material breach; or

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if, at the annual meeting, the business combination proposal shall fail to be approved by the required vote (subject to any adjournment or recess of the meeting).

If permitted under applicable law, Pivotal or the Company may waive any inaccuracies in the representations and warranties made to such party contained in the Merger Agreement and waive compliance with any agreements or conditions for the benefit of itself or such party contained in the Merger Agreement. However, the condition requiring that Pivotal have at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets may not be waived.

Company Support Agreement

In connection with the execution of the Merger Agreement, stockholders of the Company who hold a majority of the outstanding stock of the Company entered into agreements pursuant to which they have agreed to vote in favor of the Business Combination at a meeting called to approve the Business Combination by the Company stockholders (or to act by written consent approving the Business Combination).

Tax Consequences of the Business Combination

For a description of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Merger and the exercise of conversion rights, please see the information set forth in “ The Business Combination Proposal—Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Merger .”

Anticipated Accounting Treatment

The Merger will be accounted for as a reverse merger in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Under this method of accounting, Pivotal will be treated as the “acquired” company for financial reporting purposes. This determination was primarily based on (i) the Company being expected to have the majority interest of the combined company, (ii) the Company being represented on the board of directors of the combined company by up to three members, in addition to the chief executive officer of the Company, (iii) the Company’s senior management comprising the senior management of the combined company and (iv) the Company’s operations comprising the ongoing operations of the combined company. Accordingly, for accounting purposes, the Merger will be treated as the equivalent of the Company issuing stock for the net assets of Pivotal, accompanied by a recapitalization. The net assets of Pivotal will be stated at historical cost, with no goodwill or other intangible assets recorded. Operations prior to the Merger will be those of the Company.

Regulatory Matters

The Merger is not subject to any additional federal or state regulatory requirement or approval, except for the filings with the State of Delaware necessary to effectuate the Merger and the filing of required notifications and the expiration or termination of the required waiting periods under the HSR Act. On June 14, 2019, the parties received notice from the Federal Trade Commission (the “ FTC ”) that early termination of the waiting period under the HSR Act was granted in connection with the Merger.

Risk Factors

In evaluating the proposals to be presented at the annual meeting, a stockholder should carefully read this proxy statement/prospectus and especially consider the factors discussed in the section entitled “ Risk Factors .”



 

19


Table of Contents

SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Pivotal is providing the following selected historical financial information to assist you in your analysis of the financial aspects of the Business Combination.

Pivotal’s balance sheet data as of December 31, 2018 and statement of operations data for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018 are derived from Pivotal’s audited financial statements, audited by Marcum LLP, independent registered public accountants, included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. The selected historical interim financial information of Pivotal as of March 31, 2019 and for the three months ended March 31, 2019 was derived from the unaudited interim financial statements of Pivotal included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

The Company’s consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017 and consolidated statement of operations data for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017 are derived from the Company’s audited financial statements, audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accountants, included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. The selected historical interim financial information of the Company as of March 31, 2019 and for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 was derived from the unaudited interim financial statements of the Company included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

This information is only a summary and should be read in conjunction with each of the Company’s and Pivotal’s consolidated financial statements and related notes and “ Other Information Related to Pivotal—Pivotal’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ” and “ The Company’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ” included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. The historical results included below and elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus are not indicative of the future performance of the Company or Pivotal. All amounts are in U.S. dollars.

Pivotal’s Selected Financial Information

(dollars in thousands except per share amounts)

 

     Three Months
Ended March 31,
2019
    Period from
August 2, 2018
(inception) to
December 31, 2018
 
     (Unaudited)        

Revenue

   $ —       $ —    

Loss from Operations

     (227     (1

Interest

     792       —    

Unrealized gain on marketable securities in Trust Account

     14       —    

Net income (loss) attributable to common SH

     457       —    

Basic and diluted net income (loss) per share

     (0.02     (0.00

Weighted average shares outstanding excluding shares subject to possible redemption

     6,175,950       5,000,000  

 

Balance Sheet Data

   As of March 31,
2019
     As of December 31,
2018
 
     (Unaudited)         

Working Capital

   $ 961      $ 24  

Trust Account, restricted

     230,806        —    

Total Assets

     231,967        152  

Total Liabilities

     8,253        128  

Value of common stock redeemable for cash

     218,714        —    

Stockholders’ Equity

     5,000        24  


 

20


Table of Contents

The Company’s Selected Financial Information

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31,
    Year Ended December 31,  
     2019     2018     2018     2017  
     (Unaudited)              

Statement of Operations Data (in thousands):

        

Revenues

   $ 75,026     $ 70,211     $ 296,282     $ 281,184  

Cost of revenues

     37,455       40,350       159,617       154,082  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     37,571       29,861       136,665       127,102  

Operating expenses

     38,804       39,460       161,525       152,138  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (1,233     (9,599     (24,860     (25,036
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense

     12,066       11,085       46,591       43,109  

Other expense

     97       112       29       625  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (13,396     (20,796     (71,480     (68,770
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax (benefit) provision

     95       (2,759     (3,741     3,448  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

     (13,491     (18,037     (67,739     (72,218
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     (810     (2,101     (870     7,875  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

   $ (14,301   $ (20,138   $ (68,609   $ (64,343
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Statement of Cash Flow Data (in thousands):

        

Net cash provided by (used in):

        

Operating activities

   $ (18,340   $ (23,324   $ (11,942   $ (2,685

Investing activities

   $ (2,182   $ (1,816   $ (12,387   $ (20,600

Financing activities

   $ 1,593     $ 12,714     $ 29,030     $ 8,892  
     As of March 31,           As of December 31,  
     2019           2018     2017  
     (Unaudited)                    

Balance Sheet Data (in thousands):

        

Cash and equivalents

   $ 4,532       $ 23,439     $ 18,896  

Total assets

   $ 694,607       $ 710,380     $ 749,677  

Total liabilities

   $ 477,422       $ 481,424     $ 494,691  

Total stockholders’ equity

   $ 217,185       $ 228,956     $ 254,986  
     Three Months Ended March 31,     Year Ended December 31,  
             2019                   2018                   2018                     2017          
     (Unaudited)     (Unaudited)  

Other Financial Data (in millions):

        

EBITDA

   $ 11.2     $ 6.3     $ 29.9     $ 29.2  

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 15.1     $ 12.4     $ 54.6     $ 48.4  

Adjusted EBITDA margin

        

Cash interest expense

   $ 11.0     $ 9.8     $ 41.6     $ 35.2  

Unlevered free cash flow

   $ 12.6     $ 11.3     $ 41.0     $ 26.8  

Levered free cash flow

   $ 1.6     $ 1.4     $ (0.6   $ (8.4


 

21


Table of Contents

SELECTED UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The following selected unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of March 31, 2019 combines the unaudited historical consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of March 31, 2019 with the unaudited historical balance sheet of Pivotal as of March 31, 2019 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had been consummated as of that date.

The following selected unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 combines the audited historical consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of December 31, 2018 with the audited historical balance sheet of Pivotal as of December 31, 2018 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had been consummated as of that date.

The following selected unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the three months ended March 31, 2019 combines the unaudited historical consolidated statement of operations of the Company for the three months ended March 31, 2019 with the unaudited historical statement of operations of Pivotal for the three months ended March 31, 2019 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had occurred as of January 1, 2019.

The following selected unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2018 combines the audited historical consolidated statement of operations of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2018 with the audited historical statement of operations of Pivotal for the year ended December 31, 2018 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had occurred as of January 1, 2018.

This information should be read together with the Company’s and Pivotal’s respective audited financial statements and related notes, “ The Company’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ,” “ Other Information Related to Pivotal Pivotal’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ” and other financial information included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

The historical financial information has been adjusted to give pro forma effect to events that are related and/or directly attributable to the Business Combination, are factually supportable and, as it relates to the unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations, are expected to have a continuing impact on the results of the combined company following consummation of the Merger. The adjustments presented in the unaudited pro forma combined financial statements have been identified and presented to provide relevant information necessary for an accurate understanding of the combined company upon consummation of the Merger.

The selected unaudited pro forma combined financial information is for illustrative purposes only, and does not necessarily reflect what the combined company’s financial condition or results of operations would have been had the Business Combination occurred on the dates indicated. The selected unaudited pro forma combined financial information also may not be useful in predicting the future financial condition and results of operations of the combined company following consummation of the Merger. The actual financial position and results of operations may differ significantly from the pro forma amounts reflected herein due to a variety of factors. The Company and Pivotal have not had any historical relationship prior to the Merger except that Evan Morgan was both a director of Pivotal and a special partner at Revolution (“ RG ”), one of the Company’s shareholders, for a period of time. Accordingly, no pro forma adjustments were required to eliminate activities between the companies.

There is no historical activity with respect to Merger Sub, and accordingly, no adjustments were required with respect to this entity in the selected pro forma combined financial statements.



 

22


Table of Contents

The selected unaudited pro forma combined financial information has been prepared assuming two alternative levels of conversions of public shares:

 

   

Scenario 1—Assuming no conversions: This presentation assumes that no Pivotal shareholders exercise conversion rights with respect to their public shares upon consummation of the Merger; and

 

   

Scenario 2—Assuming conversions of 5,627,282 public shares of Pivotal for cash: This presentation assumes that Pivotal shareholders exercise their conversion rights with respect to a maximum of 5,627,282 public shares upon consummation of the Merger at a redemption price of approximately $10.07 per share. The maximum conversion amount is derived from a minimum of $175 million of cash required from Pivotal pursuant to the Merger Agreement, after giving effect to the payments to converting stockholders. Scenario 2 includes all adjustments contained in Scenario 1 and presents additional adjustments to reflect the effect of the maximum conversions.

Selected Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information

(dollars in thousands except per share amounts)

 

    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
No
Conversions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Conversions
into Cash
 

Statement of Operations Data—Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

       

Revenues

  $ 75,026     $ —       $ 75,026     $ 75,026  

Cost of revenues

  $ 37,455     $ —       $ 37,455     $ 37,455  

Operating expenses

  $ 38,804     $ 227     $ 39,906     $ 39,906  

Loss from operations

  $ (1,233   $ (227   $ (2,335   $ (2,335

Net loss

  $ (13,491   $ 457     $ (10,642   $ (10,642

Net loss per common share—basic and diluted

  $ (3.66   $ (0.02)     $ (0.17   $ (0.18

Balance Sheet Data—As of March 31, 2019

       

Total current assets

  $ 107,673     $ 1,161     $ 182,140     $ 125,455  

Total assets

  $ 694,607     $ 231,967     $ 769,074     $ 712,389  

Total current liabilities

  $ 56,814     $ 200     $ 44,764     $ 44,764  

Total liabilities

  $ 477,422     $ 8,253     $ 340,375     $ 340,375  

Total stockholders’ equity

  $ 217,185     $ 5,000     $ 428,699     $ 372,014  
    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
No
Conversions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Conversions
into Cash
 

Statement of Operations Data—Year Ended December 31, 2018

       

Revenues

  $ 296,282     $ —       $ 296,282     $ 296,282  

Cost of revenues

  $ 159,617     $ —       $ 159,617     $ 159,617  

Operating expenses

  $ 161,525     $ 1     $ 165,026     $ 165,026  

Loss from operations

  $ (24,860   $ (1   $ (28,361   $ (28,361

Net loss

  $ (67,739   $ (1   $ (55,967   $ (55,967

Net income (loss) per common share—basic and diluted

  $ (19.48   $ 0.00     $ (0.88)     $ (0.97

Balance Sheet Data—As of December 31, 2018

       

Total current assets

  $ 114,215     $ 152     $ 188,151     $ 131,466  

Total assets

  $ 710,380     $ 152     $ 784,316     $ 727,631  

Total current liabilities

  $ 57,650     $ 128     $ 45,403     $ 45,403  

Total liabilities

  $ 481,424     $ 128     $ 344,177     $ 344,177  

Total stockholders’ equity

  $ 228,956     $ 24     $ 440,139     $ 383,454  


 

23


Table of Contents

COMPARATIVE PER SHARE DATA

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming

No
Conversions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Conversions
into Cash
 

Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

       

Net income (loss)

  $ (13,491   $ 457     $ (10,642   $ (10,642

Total stockholders’ equity

  $ 217,185     $ 5,000     $ 428,699     $ 372,014  

Weighted average shares outstanding—basic and diluted

    3,683,461       6,175,950       63,550,000       57,922,718  

Basic and diluted net loss per share

  $ (3.66   $ (0.02   $ (0.17   $ (0.18

Stockholders’ equity per share—basic and diluted

  $ 58.96     $ 0.81     $ 6.75     $ 6.42  

 

    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming

No
Redemptions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Redemptions
into Cash
 

Year Ended December 31, 2018

       

Net loss

  $ (67,739   $ (1   $ (55,967   $ (55,967

Total stockholders’ equity

  $ 228,956     $ 24     $ 440,139     $ 383,454  

Weighted average shares outstanding—basic and diluted

    3,477,752       5,000,000       63,550,000       57,922,718  

Basic and diluted net loss per share

  $ (19.48   $ (0.00   $ (0.88   $ (0.97)  

Stockholders’ equity per share—basic and diluted

  $ 65.83     $ 0.00     $ 6.93     $ 6.62  


 

24


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

Stockholders should carefully consider the following risk factors, together with all of the other information included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus, before they decide whether to vote or instruct their vote to be cast to approve the proposals described in this proxy statement/prospectus.

The value of your investment in Pivotal following consummation of the Business Combination will be subject to the significant risks affecting the Company and inherent to the industry in which it operates. You should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below and other information included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. If any of the events described below occur, the post-acquisition business and financial results could be adversely affected in a material way. This could cause the trading price of its common stock to decline, perhaps significantly, and you therefore may lose all or part of your investment. As used in the risks described in this subsection, references to “we,” “us” and “our” are intended to refer to the Company unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.

We operate in highly competitive markets and may be adversely affected by this competition.

The markets for our products and services are highly competitive and are subject to rapid technological changes and evolving client demands and needs. We compete on the basis of various factors, including product functionality, product integration, platform coverage, quality of service interoperability with third-party technologies, ability to scale and price products and services, worldwide sales infrastructure, global technical support, name recognition and reputation.

Our competitors vary in size, scope and breadth of the products and services they offer. Our competitors include software vendors that offer software products that directly compete with our product offerings. In our Data & Storage Technology (“ DST ”) business, we face growing competition from network equipment, computer hardware manufacturers, large operating system providers and other technology companies. These firms are increasingly developing and incorporating into their products storage, server management software and backup that compete at some levels with our product offerings. Our competitive position could be materially adversely affected to the extent that our clients perceive the functionality incorporated into these products as replacing the need for our products. Many of our principal competitors are established companies that have substantial financial resources, recognized brands, technological expertise and market experience, and these competitors sometimes have more established positions in certain product lines and geographies than we do. We also compete with smaller and sometimes newer companies, some of which are specialized with a narrower focus than our company, and face competition from other eDiscovery and data management services providers. These companies are investing significantly in research and development as well as sales and marketing. In addition, we are facing competition from the backup services solutions offered by cloud IT providers.

Our competitors may be able to adopt new or emerging technologies or address client requirements more quickly than we can. New and emerging technologies can also have the impact of allowing startup companies to enter the market more quickly than they would have been able to in the past. We may also face increased competition from companies that could pose a threat to our business by providing more in-depth offerings, adapting their products and services to meet the demands of their clients or combining with one of their competitors to enhance their products and services. A number of our principal competitors may continue to make acquisitions as a means to improve the competitiveness of their offerings. Increased competition could harm our business by causing, among other things, price reductions of our products, reduced profitability and loss of market share. In order to better serve the needs of our existing clients and to attract new clients, we must continue to:

 

   

enhance and improve our existing products and services (such as by adding new content and functionalities);

 

   

develop new products and services;

 

25


Table of Contents
   

invest in technology; and

 

   

strategically acquire additional businesses and partner with other businesses in key sectors that will allow us to offer a broader array of products and services.

If we fail to compete effectively, our financial condition and results of operations would be adversely affected.

We may need to change our pricing models in order to compete successfully.

General economic and business conditions together with the intense competition we face in the sales of our products and services place pressure on us to reduce prices for our software and services, and we frequently encounter aggressive price competition. If our competitors offer deep discounts on certain products or services or develop products that the marketplace considers more valuable than ours, we may need to lower our prices or offer other favorable terms in order to compete successfully. Any such changes may reduce margins and could adversely affect operating results. Additionally, the increasing prevalence of cloud and Software-as-a-Service (“ SaaS ”) delivery models offered by us and our competitors may unfavorably impact pricing of both our on-site software business and our cloud business, as well as overall demand for our on-site software product and service offerings, which could reduce our revenues and profitability. Our competitors sometimes offer lower pricing on their support offerings, which places pressure on us to further discount our product or support pricing.

Industry pricing models are also evolving, and we anticipate that clients may increasingly request alternative pricing models. These pricing models may exacerbate existing pricing pressures, require investments in different product solutions or place us at a competitive disadvantage relative to our competitors. Moreover, the use of evolving technology by our clients to develop more complex pricing models may lead to additional pricing pressures. If we are unable to adapt our operations to these evolving pricing models, our results of operations may be adversely affected or we may not be able to offer pricing that is attractive relative to our competitors.

Any broad-based change to our prices and pricing policies could cause our revenues to decline or be delayed as our sales force implements, and our clients adjust to, such new pricing policies. Some of our competitors may bundle products for promotional purposes or as a long-term pricing strategy or provide guarantees of prices and product implementations. These practices could, over time, significantly constrain the prices that we can charge for certain of our products. If we do not adapt our pricing models to reflect changes in client use of our products or changes in client demand, our revenues could decrease. An increase in open source software distribution may also cause us to change our pricing models.

If we do not continue to attract, motivate and retain members of our senior management team and highly qualified employees, we may not be able to develop new and enhanced products and services or effectively manage or expand our business.

Our future success depends upon the continued service and performance of our senior management team and certain of our key technical and sales personnel. In particular, we are highly dependent on the services of Christopher J. Weiler, who currently serves as our chief executive officer. If the Merger is consummated, Mr. Weiler will serve as the chief executive officer of Pivotal. If we lose any of our senior management term or key technical and sale personnel, we may not be able to effectively manage our current and future operations, and our business, financial condition and results of operations would be adversely affected.

In addition, our business depends on our ability to continue to attract, motivate and retain highly qualified technical, managerial, and sales and marketing employees in order to implement our corporate development strategy and operations. There is a limited pool of employees who have the requisite skills, training and education. We face intense competition for qualified individuals from numerous technology, software, startup and emerging growth companies, which are active in many of the technical areas and geographic regions in which we conduct product development. Attracting and retaining highly skilled employees will be costly as we

 

26


Table of Contents

offer competitive compensation packages to prospective and current employees. If we are unable to continue to identify or be successful in attracting, motivating and retaining appropriately qualified personnel, our ability to implement our business plan and develop and maintain our software could be adversely affected. As a result, our business, financial condition and results of operations would be adversely affected.

Our ability to expand our operations and maintain or increase our revenue is dependent on the quality of our client service and support services, and our failure to perform at a high level and provide high quality service could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Our clients depend upon our client service and support staff to meet their eDiscovery needs. High-quality support services are critical for the success and sale of our services and solutions. If we fail to provide high-quality support on an ongoing basis, our clients may react negatively and our reputation in the marketplace could be materially and adversely affected, which would negatively impact our ability to secure contracts from existing and potential clients. Our failure to maintain high-quality support services could have a material and adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Further, we may be unable to respond quickly enough to accommodate short-term increases in client demand for support services. We also may be unable to modify the format of our support services to compete with changes in support services provided by competitors or successfully integrate support for our clients. Further client demand for these services could increase our costs and adversely affect our operating results.

We process, store and use personal and other special datasets on behalf of some of our clients, which subjects us to governmental regulation and other legal obligations related to privacy and information security, and our actual or perceived failure to comply with such obligations could harm our business and reputation.

We collect, store, transmit, use, disclose and process data that was collected from or about natural persons or their devices (“ personally identifiable information ” or “ PII ”) and other sensitive client data. In addition to terms in our contractual arrangements with our clients, there are numerous federal, state, local and foreign laws, regulations and directives regarding privacy and the collection, storage, transmission, use, processing, disclosure and protection of such PII and other personal or client data, the scope of which is continually evolving and subject to differing interpretations. We and our clients must comply with such laws, regulations and directives and we and our clients may be subject to significant consequences, including penalties and fines, for our failure to comply.

For example, on May 25, 2018, the General Data Protection Regulation 679/2016 (“ GDPR ”) replaced the Data Protection Directive 95/46/EC with respect to the processing of PII in the European Union. The GDPR imposes several stringent requirements for controllers and processors of PII (including non-E.U. processors who process personal data on behalf of E.U. controllers), including, for example, more robust internal accountability controls, a strengthened individual data rights regime, shortened timelines for mandatory data breach notifications, limitations on retention and secondary use of information and additional obligations when we contract with third parties in connection with the processing of the PII. Failure to comply with the requirements of GDPR and the applicable national data protection laws of the E.U. member states may result in fines of up to €20 million or up to 4% of the total worldwide annual revenue for the preceding financial year, whichever is higher, and other administrative penalties. Complying with the GDPR has required us to implement additional internal processes to ensure that we collect and process PII in a compliant way and re-draft of all our standard contracts to meet specific articles within the GDPR. As we continue to operate under the GDPR, compliance may become onerous and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

In addition, recent legal developments in Europe have created complexity and compliance uncertainty regarding certain transfers of information from Europe to the United States. For example, the E.U.-U.S. Privacy Shield Framework, of which we are accredited, is under review and there is currently litigation challenging other E.U. mechanisms for adequate data transfers (i.e., the standard contractual clauses). It is uncertain whether the Privacy

 

27


Table of Contents

Shield Framework and/or the standard contractual clauses will be invalidated by European courts or legislatures (as was the case for the earlier Safe Harbor Framework). We rely on a mixture of mechanisms to transfer our internal PII from the European Union to the United States, and we could be impacted by changes in law as a result of a future review of these transfer mechanisms by European regulators under the GDPR, as well as current challenges to these mechanisms in European courts. If one or more of the legal bases for transferring PII from Europe to the United States is invalidated, or if we are unable to transfer PII between and among countries and regions in which we operate, it could affect the manner in which we provide our services or could adversely affect our financial results.

Furthermore, any failure, or perceived failure, by us to comply with or make effective modifications to our policies, or to comply with any federal, state or international privacy, data-retention or data-protection-related laws, regulations, orders or industry self-regulatory principles could result in proceedings or actions against us by governmental entities or others (including clients), a loss of client confidence, damage to our brand and reputation or a loss of clients, any of which could have an adverse effect on our business. In addition, various federal, state and foreign legislative or regulatory bodies may enact new or additional laws and regulations concerning privacy, data-retention and data-protection issues, including laws or regulations mandating disclosure to domestic or international law enforcement bodies, which could adversely impact our business, our brand or our reputation with clients. For example, some countries have adopted laws mandating that PII regarding clients in their country be maintained solely in their country. Having to maintain local data centers and redesign product, service and business operations to limit PII processing to within individual countries could increase our operating costs significantly.

Additionally, in connection with some of our product initiatives, we expect that our clients may increasingly use our cloud services to store and process PII and other regulated data. We post, on our websites, and, where appropriate, within our products, our privacy policies and practices concerning the treatment of PII that we hold as a “controller.” While we include minimum privacy or information security commitments in our contracts, E.U. requirements may make it so that we will be unable to do business without such commitments. Any failure by us to timely amend client contracts to conform to changing data protection laws, or to comply with our posted privacy policies, other federal, state or international privacy-related or data protection laws and regulations, or the privacy or information security commitments contained in our contracts could result in proceedings against us by governmental entities or others, including individual rights of action, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, the increased attention focused upon any liability we may have as a result of lawsuits or regulatory actions could also harm our reputation or otherwise impact the growth of our business. Furthermore, although we market and sell products to our clients to help them comply with federal, state, local and foreign laws, regulations and directives, including the GDPR, our clients are responsible for ensuring they are in compliance with such laws, regulations and directives. Any failure by our clients to comply could result in significant consequences to them, including penalties and fines, and despite the existence of contractual exclusions and marketing disclaimers which make their responsibility for their own compliance clear, our clients may file claims or seek indemnification from us, which may result in reputational harm and require us to expend time, effort and costs to defend such claims or respond to indemnification requests.

In addition to government regulation, privacy advocacy and industry groups or other third parties may propose new and different self-regulatory standards that either legally or contractually apply to our clients or us. Any significant change to applicable laws, regulations, directives or industry practices regarding the collection, storage, transmission, processing, use or disclosure of our clients’ data, or regarding the manner in which the express or implied consent of clients for the collection, storage, transmission, processing, use and disclosure of such data is obtained, could require us to modify our solutions and features, possibly in a material manner, and may limit our ability to develop new services and features that make use of the data that our clients voluntarily share with us. Any failure or perceived failure by us to comply with our privacy policies, our privacy-related obligations to clients or other third parties, our privacy-related legal obligations or any compromise of security that results in the unauthorized access to, use, release or transfer of PII or other client data, may result in

 

28


Table of Contents

governmental enforcement actions, litigation, negative media attention or public statements against us by consumer advocacy groups or others and could cause our clients to lose trust in us, which would have an adverse effect on our reputation and business. Our clients may also accidentally disclose their passwords or store them on a mobile device that may be lost or stolen, resulting in unauthorized access to their data and creating the perception that our systems are not secure against third-party access. Additionally, if employees or third parties that we work with, such as contractors, vendors or developers, violate applicable laws or our policies, such violations may also put our clients’ information at risk and could in turn have an adverse effect on our business.

We have expanded our involvement in the delivery and provision of cloud computing through business alliances with various providers of cloud computing services and software and expect to continue to do so in the future. The application of U.S. and international data privacy laws to cloud computing vendors is uncertain, and our existing contractual provisions may prove to be inadequate to protect us from claims for data loss or regulatory noncompliance made against us resulting from the failures of cloud computing providers which we may partner with. While we do limit this in our contractual agreements with clients, the failure to comply with data protection laws and regulations by our clients and business partners who provide cloud computing services could have a material adverse effect on our business. Some cloud computing providers have been reluctant to provide us with information which we need in order to comply with E.U. privacy laws, and some providers refuse to offer legally compliant terms or offer terms that are commercially reasonable. We will need to modify our procurement processes in response to changing client and regulatory demands. If we fail to do so correctly, or in a timely manner, we may experience disruptions in client relationships, or receive regulatory inquiries or be the subject of government enforcement actions, which may in turn cause a material loss in revenues or damage our brand and reputation.

We have acquired businesses in the past, and we may consider opportunities in the future to acquire other companies, assets or product lines that complement or expand our business. If we are unsuccessful in integrating these companies or product lines with our existing operations, or if integration is more difficult than anticipated, we may experience disruptions to our operations. A difficult or unsuccessful integration of an acquired business could have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

Achieving the anticipated benefits of any acquisitions depends in part upon whether we can integrate new businesses in an efficient and effective manner. The integration of any acquired businesses involves a number of risks, including, but not limited to:

 

   

the complexity, time and costs associated with the integration of acquired business operations, workforce, products and technologies;

 

   

the diversion of management time and attention;

 

   

unexpected losses of key employees or clients of the acquired business, including costs associated with the termination or replacement of those employees;

 

   

failure to fully achieve expected synergies and cost savings;

 

   

difficulties in conforming standards, processes, systems, procedures and controls of the acquired business with our operations;

 

   

demands on management related to any increases in the scope, geographic diversity and complexity of our operations;

 

   

difficulties in transferring processes and know-how;

 

   

the assumption of liabilities of the acquired businesses, including litigation related to the acquired business;

 

   

the reduction of cash available for operations and other uses and resulting in potentially dilutive issuances of equity securities or the incurrence of debt; and

 

29


Table of Contents
   

the impairment of relationships with clients or business partners of the acquired business or our own clients as a result of any integration of operations;

 

   

the addition of acquisition-related debt as well as increased expenses and working capital requirements;

 

   

substantial accounting charges for restructuring and related expenses, write-off of in process research and development, impairment of goodwill, amortization of intangible assets and stock-based compensation expense;

 

   

managing tax costs and inefficiencies associated with the integration of acquired businesses; and

 

   

risks relating to the challenges and costs of closing a transaction.

Successful integration of any acquired businesses or operations will depend on our ability to manage these operations, realize opportunities for revenue growth presented by strengthened product and service offerings and expanded geographic market coverage, and eliminate redundant and excess costs to fully realize the expected synergies. Because of difficulties in combining geographically distant operations and systems which may not be fully compatible, we may not be able to achieve the financial strength and growth we anticipate from the acquisitions.

We may not realize our anticipated benefits from our acquisitions, if any, or may be unable to efficiently and effectively integrate acquired operations as planned. If we fail to integrate acquired businesses and operations efficiently and effectively or fail to realize the benefits we anticipate, we may experience material adverse effects on our business, financial condition, results of operations and future prospects.

Defects, disruptions, performance problems or risks related to the provision of our product offerings could impair our ability to deliver our services and could expose us to liability, damage our brand and reputation or otherwise negatively impact our business

Certain of our products and services utilize software solutions developed by us or third parties for our clients’ needs, and new releases of software products are issued to our clients periodically. Complex software products, such as those we offer, may contain undetected errors or defects, especially when they are first introduced or new versions are released. Despite testing, these undetected errors may be discovered only after a product has been installed and used either in our internal processing system or by our clients, and could result in unanticipated service interruptions or other performance problems and cause damage to our clients’ businesses. If that occurs, clients could elect not to renew with us, to delay or withhold payment to us, or to make warranty or other claims against us, and we could be obligated to provide service credits based on our failure to meet service level commitments, which could result in additional expense and risk of litigation.

We believe that our reputation and name recognition are critical factors in our ability to compete and generate additional sales. Promotion and enhancement of our name will depend largely on our success in continuing to provide effective products and services. The occurrence of errors in our products or services, the discovery of security vulnerabilities or the detection of bugs by our clients may damage our reputation in the market and our relationships with our existing clients, and as a result, we may be unable to attract or retain clients.

In addition, because our products and services are used to manage data that is often critical to our clients, they may have a greater sensitivity to defects in our products than to defects in other, less critical, applications. As a result, the licensing and support of our products and services involve the risk of product liability claims. Our license agreements with our clients typically contain provisions designed to limit our exposure to potential product liability claims. However, the limitation of liability provisions contained in our license agreements vary and may not be effective as a result of existing or future national, federal, state or local laws or ordinances or unfavorable judicial decisions. Although we have not experienced any material product liability claims to date, the sale and support of our products entail the risk of such claims, which could be substantial in light of the use of our products in enterprise-wide environments. In addition, our insurance against product liability may not be adequate to cover all potential claims.

 

30


Table of Contents

If we are unable to develop new and enhanced products and services that achieve widespread market acceptance, or if we are unable to continually improve the performance, features and reliability of our existing products and services or adapt our business model to keep pace with industry trends, our business and operating results could be materially adversely affected.

The markets in which we compete are characterized by rapid technological change, frequent new product introductions, evolving industry standards and changing client needs. We believe that key competitive factors in the markets we serve include the breadth and quality of professional services, system and software solution offerings, product integration, platform coverage, the stability of our information systems, the features and capabilities of our product and service offerings, the pricing of our products and services, and the potential for future product and service enhancements. Our future success depends on our ability to keep pace with technological changes and to respond to the rapidly changing needs of our clients by developing or introducing new products, product upgrades and services on a timely and cost-effective basis. We have in the past incurred, and will continue to incur, significant research and development expenses as we strive to remain competitive. Clients may require features and capabilities that our current products and services do not have, such as remote collections from mobile phones. We need to successfully respond to significant market challenges to our existing product portfolio as well as invest in new growth areas based on our core technical capabilities. Our failure to develop products and services that satisfy client preferences in a timely and cost-effective manner may harm our ability to maintain relationships with existing clients, as well as our ability to create or increase demand for our products and services, and may materially adversely affect our operating results. As competition in the information technology (“ IT ”) industry increases, it may become increasingly difficult for us to maintain a technological advantage and to leverage that advantage toward increased revenues and profits. New product development and introduction involve a significant commitment of time and resources and are subject to a number of risks and challenges including:

 

   

managing the length of the development cycle for new products and product enhancements, which can fluctuate as new features are developed;

 

   

designing and marketing products and professional services solutions that will be adopted by our client base as well as attract new clients for our technology;

 

   

managing clients’ transitions to new products and services;

 

   

adapting to emerging and evolving industry standards and to technological developments by our competitors and clients;

 

   

extending the operation of our products and services to new and evolving platforms, operating systems, operating environments and models, including support of new workloads and data management technologies, and hardware products;

 

   

clients’ ability to upgrade to the most current versions of software to take advantage of new functionalities;

 

   

reacting to trends and predicting which technologies will be successful and develop into industry standards;

 

   

tailoring our business and pricing models appropriately as we enter new markets and respond to competitive pressures and technological changes;

 

   

extending or creating technology alliances with other key technology players in our industry;

 

   

managing new product and service strategies for the markets in which we operate;

 

   

addressing trade compliance issues affecting our ability to ship our products;

 

   

developing or expanding efficient sales channels; and

 

   

obtaining sufficient licenses to technology and technical access from proprietary software providers, open source software providers and operating system software vendors on reasonable terms to enable

 

31


Table of Contents
 

the development and deployment of interoperable products, including source code licenses for certain products with deep technical integration into operating systems.

If we are not successful in managing these risks and challenges, if our new products, product upgrades and services are not technologically competitive or do not achieve market acceptance, or if our efforts are more costly or resource-intensive than anticipated or fail to achieve the expected outcomes, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

If we are unable to maintain, promote or expand our brand through effective marketing practices, our brand and business could be adversely affected.

We believe that maintaining and promoting our brand in a cost-effective manner is critical to retaining and expanding our client base. We have invested considerable money and resources in the establishment and maintenance of our brand, and we will continue to invest resources in brand marketing and other efforts to continue to preserve and enhance consumer awareness. If we fail to successfully promote and maintain our brand or if we incur excessive expenses in this effort, our business could be materially and adversely affected.

We utilize internet search engines such as Google, principally through the purchase of keywords, to generate additional traffic to our websites. The number of users we attract from search engines to our websites is due in large part on how and where information is from, and links to our websites are displayed on search engine results pages. Search engines frequently update and change the algorithm that determines the placement and display of results of a user’s search, such that the purchased or algorithmic placement of links to our websites can be negatively affected. In addition, a significant amount of traffic is directed to our websites through our participation in pay-per-click and display advertising campaigns on search engines. If a major search engine changes its algorithms or results in a manner that negatively affects the search engine ranking, paid or unpaid, of our websites, our business and financial performance would be adversely affected.

We develop products and services that interoperate with certain software, operating systems and hardware developed by others, and if the developers of such software, operating systems and hardware do not cooperate with us, if we are unable to obtain access to their new products or if we are unable to devote the necessary resources so that our applications interoperate with those third-party systems, our development efforts may be delayed or foreclosed and our business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected.

Our products and services operate primarily on the Windows, UNIX and Linux operating systems, are used in conjunction with the Microsoft SQL and Microsoft Azure platforms, and operate on hardware devices of numerous manufacturers. When new or updated versions of these operating systems, software applications and hardware devices are introduced, it is often necessary for us to develop updated versions of our software applications so that they interoperate properly with these systems and devices. We may not accomplish these development efforts quickly or cost-effectively, or at all, and it is not clear what the relative growth rates of these operating systems and hardware will be. These development efforts require the cooperation of the developers of the operating systems, software applications, and hardware, as well as substantial capital investment and the devotion of substantial employee and/or financial resources. For some operating systems, we must obtain some proprietary application program interfaces from the owner in order to develop software applications that interoperate with the operating system. Operating system and software owners have no obligation to assist in these development efforts, provide us with early access to their technology and products or share with or sell to us any application program interfaces, formats or protocols we may need. If they do not provide us with the necessary access, assistance or proprietary technology on a timely basis, or at all, we may experience product development delays or be unable to expand our software applications into other areas.

A large number of our proprietary software and applications are built on commonly used “open source” licenses. We maintain a record of all “open source” licenses used for such software and applications. Despite this, a failure

 

32


Table of Contents

to materially comply with the terms of such “open source” licenses could negatively affect our business and subject us to possible litigation.

The results of the United Kingdom’s referendum on withdrawal from the European Union may have a negative effect on global economic conditions, financial markets and our business.

We are a multinational company with worldwide operations, including significant business operations in Europe. On March 29, 2017, the Prime Minister of the United Kingdom, Theresa May, formally began the process of withdrawing the United Kingdom from the European Union, following the June 2016 referendum in which a majority of voters in the United Kingdom supported the withdrawal (the “ Brexit Referendum ”). Negotiations between the United Kingdom and the European Union remain ongoing and are complex, and there can be no assurance regarding the terms (if any) or timing of any resulting agreement or departure, or regarding the absence of any potential market or other disruptions as any deadline for a potential agreement or departure approaches. The withdrawal process has created significant uncertainty about the future relationship between the United Kingdom and the EU, and that this may have political consequences not only in the United Kingdom but in other member states. The terms of any future trading relationship between the United Kingdom and the European Union are also subject to negotiation and are currently uncertain. The Brexit Referendum and the ensuing process of the United Kingdom’s withdrawal from the European Union has created political and economic uncertainty about the future relationship between the United Kingdom and the European Union and as to whether any other European countries may similarly seek to exit the European Union.

Although we generated only approximately 9% of our revenues in the United Kingdom for the year ended December 31, 2018, these developments and the potential consequences of them, have had and may continue to have a material adverse effect upon global economic conditions and the stability of global financial markets, and could significantly reduce global market liquidity and restrict the ability of key market participants to operate in certain financial markets. Asset valuations, currency exchange rates and credit ratings have been and may continue to be subject to increased market volatility. Lack of clarity about future UK laws and regulations, including data protection and the United Kingdom’s interaction with member states applying the GDPR, financial laws and regulations, tax and free trade agreements, immigration and employment laws, could increase costs, depress economic activity, impair our ability to attract and retain qualified personnel, and have other adverse consequences. Any of these factors may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects.

The unavailability of third-party technology could adversely impact our revenue and results of operations.

We license certain eDiscovery-related software from third parties and incorporate or integrate such components into and with our services and products. For instance, we integrate third-party solutions licensed from certain providers such as Relativity, a key supplier of one of our eDiscovery platforms, with the delivery of our eDiscovery services and products. While we have developed our own proprietary platforms, certain third-party software, such as that licensed from Relativity, has become central to the operation and delivery of our eDiscovery services and products.

Certain of our third-party software license contracts expire within the next one to three years and may be renewed only by mutual consent For instance, our license contract with Relativity expires in December 31, 2020. There is no assurance that we will be able to renew these contracts as they expire or that such renewals will be on the same or substantially similar terms or on conditions that are commercially reasonable to us. If we fail to renew these contracts as they expire, we may be unable to offer certain eDiscovery-related services and products to our clients. In addition, our third-party software licenses are non-exclusive. For example, all of our primary competitors in the eDiscovery business use Relativity in connection with their eDiscovery platforms (in addition to any proprietary platforms that they may own themselves).

If certain of our third-party licensors were to change their product offerings, cease actively supporting their existing technologies, fail to update and enhance their technologies to keep pace with changing industry

 

33


Table of Contents

standards, encounter technical difficulties in the continued development of their technologies, significantly increase prices, terminate our licenses, suffer significant capacity or supply chain constraints or suffer other disruptions, we would need to identify alternative suppliers and incur additional internal and/or external development costs to ensure continued performance of our eDiscovery-related services and products. Such alternatives may not be available on attractive terms, or at all, or may not be as widely accepted or as effective as the software provided by our existing suppliers. If the cost of licensing or maintaining this third-party technology significantly increases, our revenues could significantly decrease. In addition, interruptions in the functionality of our services and products resulting from changes in or with our third party licensors could adversely affect our commitments to clients, future sales of our services and products solutions, and negatively affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We utilize various web service providers, such as Microsoft Azure, for the delivery of our cloud-based products. These services are operated by third parties that we do not control and that could require significant time to replace. We expect this dependence on third parties to continue. These systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption and have experienced interruptions in the past. A prolonged web service disruption affecting our cloud-based offerings for any of the foregoing reasons would negatively impact our ability to serve our clients and could damage our reputation with current and potential clients, expose us to liability, cause us to lose clients or otherwise harm our business. We may also incur significant costs for using alternative equipment or taking other actions in preparation for, or in reaction to, events that damage the web services we use. Interruptions in these third party-services on which we rely could affect the security or availability of our products and cloud infrastructure and could have a material adverse effect on our business. In addition, these web services providers may generally terminate our agreements for convenience upon providing some nominal period of notice and may terminate our agreements for cause if a breach by us has not been cured within a short time period. In the event that our service agreements are terminated, or there is a lapse of service, elimination of web services or features that we utilize, interruption of internet service provider connectivity or damage to such facilities, we could experience interruptions in access to our platforms as well as significant delays and additional expense in arranging or creating new facilities and services and/or re-architecting our solutions for deployment on a different cloud infrastructure service provider, which may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

If we fail to maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and internal control over financial reporting, our ability to produce timely and accurate financial statements or comply with applicable regulations could be impaired.

As a public company, we will be subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (the “ Sarbanes-Oxley Act ”), and the rules and regulations of the applicable listing standards of the NYSE. We expect that the requirements of these rules and regulations will continue to increase our legal, accounting and financial compliance costs, make some activities more difficult, time-consuming and costly and place significant strain on our personnel, systems and resources.

The Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires, among other things, that we maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting. In particular, Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (“ Section 404 ”) will require us to perform system and process evaluation and testing of our internal control over financial reporting to allow management to report on, and our independent registered public accounting firm potentially to attest to, the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. As an emerging growth company, we expect to avail ourselves of the exemption from the requirement that our independent registered public accounting firm attest to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting under Section 404. However, we may no longer avail ourselves of this exemption when we cease to be an emerging growth company. At such time, our independent registered public accounting firm may issue a report that is adverse in the event it is not satisfied with the level at which our internal control over financial reporting is documented, designed or operating. As a public company, we will be required to provide an annual management report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting commencing with our second annual

 

34


Table of Contents

report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2019. Any failure to maintain effective disclosure controls and internal control over financial reporting could have a material and adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and could cause a decline in the trading price of our common stock.

We are continuing to develop and refine our disclosure controls and other procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we will file with the SEC is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms and that information required to be disclosed in reports under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to our principal executive and financial officers. We are also continuing to improve our internal control over financial reporting. In order to develop, maintain and improve the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting, we have expended, and anticipate that we will continue to expend, significant resources, including accounting-related and audit-related costs and significant management oversight.

Our current controls and any new controls that we develop may become inadequate because of changes in conditions in our business. Further, weaknesses in our disclosure controls and internal control over financial reporting may be discovered in the future. Any failure to develop or maintain effective controls or any difficulties encountered in their implementation or improvement could harm our results of operations or cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations and may result in a restatement of our consolidated financial statements for prior periods. Any failure to implement and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting could also adversely affect the results of periodic management evaluations and annual independent registered public accounting firm attestation reports regarding the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting that we will eventually be required to include in our periodic reports that will be filed with the SEC. Ineffective disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial and other information, which would likely have a negative effect on the trading price of Pivotal shares. In addition, if we are unable to continue to meet these requirements, we may not be able to remain listed on the NYSE.

Our products, SaaS offerings, website and networks may be subject to intentional or accidental disruption that could materially adversely affect our reputation, business and future sales.

Despite our precautions and significant ongoing investments to protect against security risks such as data breaches, cyber-attacks and other intentional or accidental disruptions of our products, offerings and networks, we expect to be an ongoing target of attacks specifically designed to breach or interrupt our networks and systems, which could harm our reputation and result in litigation, fines and penalties. Experienced computer programmers may attempt to penetrate our network security or the security of our website and misappropriate proprietary information or cause interruptions to our services. Our products may come under focused threats and attacks and we or our clients may suffer data loss as a consequence of such attacks on our products. Such cyber-attacks threaten to misappropriate our proprietary information and cause interruptions of our information technology services. Because the techniques used by unauthorized persons to access or sabotage networks change frequently and may not be recognized until launched against a target, we may be unable to anticipate or detect these techniques. Further, if unauthorized access or sabotage remains undetected for an extended period of time, the effects of such breach could be exacerbated. In addition, sophisticated hardware and operating system software and applications that we produce or procure from third parties may contain defects in design or manufacture, including “bugs” and other problems that could unexpectedly interfere with the operation of our systems and networks. We have experienced and defended against threats to our systems and security including malware, phishing attacks and Distributed Denial of Service attacks, with none having had a material adverse effect on our business to date. However, we may experience more serious incidents in the future. Our exposure to cybersecurity threats and negative consequences of cybersecurity breaches will likely increase as we store increasing amounts of our clients’ data in cloud-based environments.

We outsource a number of our internal business functions to third-party contractors, and some of our client facing business operations depend, in part, on the success of our contractors’ own cybersecurity measures. We

 

35


Table of Contents

also partner with cloud service providers for some client service offerings. Similarly, particularly for the DST business, we rely upon distributors, resellers, system vendors and systems integrators to sell our products and our sales operations depend, in part, on the reliability of their cybersecurity measures. Additionally, we depend upon our employees to appropriately handle confidential information and deploy our information technology resources in a safe and secure fashion and in accordance with our policies so as not to expose our network systems to security breaches and the loss of data. Accordingly, if our cybersecurity systems, policies and procedures, and those of our contractors, partners and vendors fail to protect against unauthorized access, cyber-attacks or the mishandling of information by our employees, contractors, partners or vendors, our ability to conduct our business effectively could be damaged in a number of ways, including:

 

   

sensitive data regarding our business, including intellectual property and other proprietary data, could be stolen or mishandled;

 

   

our electronic communications systems, including email and other methods, could be disrupted, and our ability to conduct our business operations could be seriously damaged until such systems can be restored and secured;

 

   

our ability to process client orders and electronically deliver products and services could be lost or degraded, and our distribution channels could be disrupted, resulting in delays in revenue recognition;

 

   

defects and security vulnerabilities could be exploited or introduced into our products or our cloud offerings, thereby damaging the reputation and perceived reliability and security of our products and services and potentially making the data systems of our clients vulnerable to further data loss and cyber incidents; and

 

   

PII, protected health information (“ PHI ”) or other confidential data of our clients, employees and business partners could be stolen or lost.

Should any of the above events occur, we could be subject to significant claims for liability from our clients and regulatory actions from governmental agencies, our ability to protect our intellectual property rights could be compromised and our reputation and competitive position could be significantly harmed. The regulatory and contractual actions, litigations, investigations, fines, penalties and liabilities relating to data breaches that result in losses of PII, PHI or credit card information of users of our services can be significant in terms of fines and reputational impact, and necessitate changes to our business operations that may be disruptive to us. Additionally, we could incur significant costs in order to upgrade our cybersecurity systems and remediate damages. Consequently, our financial performance and results of operations would be materially adversely affected.

If we encounter difficulties as we implement our new consolidated business systems, our business may be adversely affected.

We are in the process of implementing new consolidated business systems across our global operations. We rely on our information technology to help us effectively manage our client relationships, sales information, order processing and support and marketing services, and we anticipate that the implementation of new consolidated business systems will improve our processes. However, there is a risk that implementation of these new systems will not achieve these expected benefits as quickly as anticipated or at all. In addition, there can be no assurance that there will not be errors, delays or other related issues resulting from the transition to our new business systems and adjustments to associated business processes, or that we will be able to fix any error or issue. Such errors, delays or issues may result in unanticipated costs or expenditures and divert the attention of key senior management away from other aspects of our business, which may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

 

36


Table of Contents

Our inability to successfully recover from a disaster or other business continuity event could impair our ability to deliver our products and services and harm our business.

We are heavily reliant on our technology and infrastructure to provide our products and services to our clients. For example, we provide services through computer hardware that is located in our 10 global data centers around the world as well as in cloud-based data centers offered through the Microsoft Azure Cloud. Our physical data centers are vulnerable to damage, interruption or performance problems from earthquakes, floods, fires, power loss, terrorist attacks, telecommunications failures and similar events. They are also subject to break-ins, computer viruses, sabotage, intentional acts of vandalism and similar misconduct. The occurrence of any of these events, a decision to close a data center, or other unanticipated problems could result in interruptions in the delivery of certain of our products and services.

Any errors, defects, disruptions or other performance problems with our systems, products and services could reduce our revenue, cause us to issue credits or pay penalties, cause clients to terminate their agreements with us, commence or threaten litigation against us, harm our reputation and damage our clients’ businesses. For example, we may experience disruptions, outages and other performance problems due to a variety of factors, including infrastructure changes, human or software errors, capacity constraints due to an overwhelming number of users accessing our website simultaneously, fraud or security attacks. In some instances, we may not be able to identify the cause or causes of these performance problems within an acceptable period of time. Interruptions in our products and services could impact our revenues or cause clients to cease doing business with us. In addition, our business would be harmed if any events of this nature caused our clients and potential clients to believe our services are unreliable. Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our technology infrastructure against damage from business continuity events that could have a significant disruptive effect on our operations.

We have international business operations, which subjects us to additional risks associated with these international operations.

We have significant international operations with more than 40 locations in 20 countries, including data centers in Canada, England, France, Germany, Ireland and Japan. We may expand our international operations if we identify growth opportunities. Our international operations are subject to the following risks, among others:

 

   

foreign certification, licensing and regulatory requirements, which may be substantially more complex or burdensome than our domestic requirements;

 

   

risk associated with selecting or terminating partners for foreign expansion, including marketing agents, distributors or other strategic partners for particular markets;

 

   

risk associated with local ownership and/or investment requirements, as well as difficulties in obtaining financing in foreign countries for local operations;

 

   

reduced protection of confidential consumer information in some countries

 

   

political unrest, international hostilities, military actions, terrorist or cyber-terrorist activities, natural disasters, pandemics, and infrastructure disruptions;

 

   

differing economic cycles and adverse economic conditions;

 

   

unexpected changes in and compliance with foreign regulatory requirements;

 

   

regulations or restrictions on the use, import or export of technologies that could delay or prevent the acceptance and use of our products;

 

   

differing business practices, which may require us to enter into agreements that include non-standard terms;

 

   

varying tax regimes, including with respect to the imposition of withholding taxes on remittances and other payments by our partnerships or subsidiaries;

 

37


Table of Contents
   

differing labor regulations;

 

   

foreign exchange controls and restrictions on repatriation of funds from our international subsidiaries;

 

   

fluctuations in currency exchange rates, economic instability and inflationary conditions;

 

   

inability to collect payments or seek recourse under or comply with ambiguous or vague commercial or other laws;

 

   

potential loss of proprietary information due to misappropriation or laws that may be less protective of our intellectual property rights than U.S. laws or that may not be adequately enforced;

 

   

varying attitudes towards censorship and the treatment of information service providers by foreign governments, in particular in emerging markets;

 

   

difficulties in attracting and retaining qualified management and employees, or rationalizing our workforce;

 

   

difficulties in staffing, managing and operating our international operations, including difficulties related to administering our stock plans in some foreign countries;

 

   

difficulties in coordinating the activities of our geographically dispersed and culturally diverse operations;

 

   

costs and delays associated with developing software and providing support in multiple languages; and

 

   

difficulties in penetrating new markets due to entrenched competitors, lack of recognition of our brands or lack of local acceptance of our products and services.

Our overall success as a global business depends, in part, on our ability to anticipate and effectively manage these risks, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to do so without incurring unexpected costs. If we are not able to manage the risks related to our international operations, our business, financial condition and results of operations may be materially affected.

If we do not protect our proprietary rights and information and prevent third parties from making unauthorized use of our products and technology, our financial results could be harmed.

Most of our products and underlying technology is proprietary. We seek to protect our proprietary rights through a combination of confidentiality agreements and procedures, and through copyright, patent, trademark and trade secret laws of the United States and international jurisdictions. In addition, we use licenses, non-disclosure agreements and other agreements to restrict the use of our products by our clients and other third parties. However, all of these measures afford only limited protection and may be challenged, invalidated, disregarded, declared unenforceable or circumvented by third parties, and we may not have effective remedies to protect our proprietary rights. Third parties may copy or reverse engineer all or portions of our products and underlying technology or otherwise misappropriate, use, distribute or sell our proprietary technology without authorization. Moreover, we may not be able to obtain effective protection for the technology underlying our new products and services as they are developed. For example, any of our pending or future patent applications, whether or not being currently challenged, may not be issued with the scope of the protection we seek, if at all. Furthermore, confidentiality procedures and contractual provisions can be difficult to enforce and, even if successfully enforced, may not have effective remedies available to ameliorate unauthorized disclosure of our intellectual property.

Third parties may also develop similar or superior technology by designing around our patents and the other intellectual property protections or independently developing technology that does not infringe, misappropriate or violate our intellectual property rights in the United States or elsewhere. Furthermore, the laws of some foreign countries do not offer the same level of protection of our proprietary rights as the laws of the United States, and we may not be able to prevent unauthorized use of our products in those countries. For example, for

 

38


Table of Contents

some of our products, we rely on “shrink-wrap” or “click-wrap” licenses, which may be unenforceable in whole or in part in some jurisdictions in which we operate. The unauthorized sale, distribution or use of our products or proprietary technology could result in reduced sales of our products, or diminish our brand and reputation. Any legal action to protect proprietary technology that we may bring or be engaged in with a client, strategic partner or vendor could adversely affect our ability to access software, operating systems and/or hardware platforms of such client, partner or vendor, or cause such partner or vendor to choose not to offer our products to their clients. In addition, any legal action we engage in to protect our proprietary technology could be costly, may distract management from day-to-day operations and may lead to additional claims against us, and we may not succeed; any of which could materially adversely affect.

General economic conditions and the cyclical nature of certain markets we serve may adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

Our financial performance depends on the economic conditions in the markets we serve and on the general condition of the global economy. Any sustained weakness in demand for our products and services as a result of a downturn of, or uncertainty in, the global economy or in any specific market we serve may adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. For instance, any decrease in litigation filings, class action proceedings and settlement administrations at our clients may reduce the demand for our products and services. For instance, we experienced a short-term decreased demand for our eDiscovery solutions during the U.S. federal government shutdown in January 2019 as a result of decreased litigation activity.

Exchange rate fluctuations and volatility in global currency markets may have a significant impact on our results of operations.

As a company with global operations, we face exposure to adverse movements in foreign currency exchange rates. Exchange rate movements in our currency exposures may cause fluctuations in our financial statements. Due to our global presence, a portion of our revenues, operating expense and assets and liabilities are non-U.S. dollar denominated and therefore subject to foreign currency fluctuation. We face exposure to currency exchange rates as a result of the growth in our non-U.S. dollar denominated operating expense across Europe and Asia. For example, an increase in the value of non-U.S. dollar currencies against the U.S. dollar could increase costs for delivery of products, services and also increase cost of local operating expenses and procurement of materials or services that we purchase in foreign currencies by increasing labor and other costs that are denominated in such local currencies. In addition, an increase in the value of the U.S. dollar could increase the real cost to our clients of our products in those markets outside the United States where we price our products and services in U.S. dollars. As a result of the foregoing, our results of operations may be materially adversely affected. These risks related to exchange rate fluctuations and currency volatility may increase in future periods as our operations outside of the United States continue to expand.

We may in the future hedge against currency exposure associated with anticipated foreign currency cash flows or assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currency. Such attempts to offset the impact of currency fluctuations are costly, and there can be no assurance that currency hedging activities would be successful. Losses associated with these hedging instruments may negatively affect our results of operations, and any such currency hedging activities themselves would be subject to risk, including risks related to counterparty performance.

Our substantial levels of indebtedness could adversely affect our financial condition.

On a pro forma basis after giving effect to the Business Combination and assuming no conversions of public shares, we would have had approximately $323.0 million of indebtedness as of December 31, 2018, consisting of borrowings under our First Lien Facility (as defined herein).

Our indebtedness could have important consequences to our investors, including, but not limited to:

 

   

increasing vulnerability to, and reducing our flexibility to respond to, general adverse economic and industry conditions;

 

39


Table of Contents
   

requiring the dedication of a substantial portion of cash flow from operations to the payment of principal of, and interest on, its indebtedness, thereby reducing the availability of such cash flow to fund working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, joint ventures or other general corporate purposes;

 

   

limiting flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the competitive environment; and

 

   

limiting our ability to borrow additional funds and increasing the cost of any such borrowing.

Our failure to comply with the export controls and trade and economic sanctions laws and regulations of the United States and various international jurisdictions could result in legal liability and materially adversely affect our reputation and results of operations.

Our business activities are subject to various export controls and trade and economic sanctions laws and regulations, including, without limitation, the U.S. Commerce Department’s Export Administration Regulations, the U.S. Treasury Department’s Office of Foreign Assets Control’s (“ OFAC ”) trade and economic sanctions programs, the United Nations Security Council, and other laws and regulations of a similar nature administered and enforced by relevant government authorities (collectively, “ Trade Controls ”). Such Trade Controls may prohibit or restrict our ability to, directly or indirectly, conduct activities or dealings in or with certain countries, as well as with individuals or entities that are the subject of Trade Controls-related prohibitions and restrictions. For example, our ability to procure items necessary for our business activities could be adversely impacted by the imposition of export or sanctions-related prohibitions or restrictions on our contractual counterparties. Similarly, our sales of certain commodities, software and technology, and our provision of services to persons located outside the United States may be subject to certain regulatory prohibitions, restrictions or other requirements, including certain licensing or reporting requirements. Similarly, our ability to procure such items necessary for our business activities could be adversely impacted by the imposition of export or sanctions-related prohibitions or restrictions on our contractual counterparties. Our failure to successfully comply with applicable Trade Controls may expose us to negative legal and business consequences, including civil or criminal penalties, government investigations, disgorgement of profits, injunctions and suspension or debarment from government contracts, other remedial measures, and reputational harm. Investigations of alleged violations can be expensive and disruptive. Although we have implemented internal measures reasonably designed to promote compliance with applicable Trade Controls, we cannot assure compliance by our employees or representatives for which we may be held responsible, and any such violation could materially adversely affect our reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.

Third parties claiming that we infringe their proprietary rights could cause us to incur significant legal expenses and prevent us from selling our products.

The software and internet industries are characterized by the existence of a large number of patents, trademarks and copyrights and by frequent litigation based on allegations of infringement or other violations of intellectual property rights.

We have received in the past, and may receive in the future, communications from third parties alleging infringement of their intellectual property rights, including claims regarding patents, copyrights, trade secrets and trademarks.

Because of the constant technological change in the markets in which we compete and the extensive coverage of intellectual property protection for existing technologies, including software patents, it is possible that the number of these claims may grow. In addition, former employers of our former, current or future employees may assert claims that such employees have improperly disclosed to us the confidential or proprietary information of these former employers.

 

40


Table of Contents

Any such intellectual property claim, with or without merit, could result in costly litigation and distract management from day-to-day operations, and the outcomes of such claims are uncertain. If we are not successful in defending such claims, we could be required to stop selling, delay shipments of or redesign our products, stop offering (or temporarily stop offering) our services to others, pay monetary amounts as damages, enter into royalty or licensing arrangements or satisfy indemnification obligations that we have with some of our clients, which could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition or cash flows. We cannot assure you that any royalty or licensing arrangements that we may seek in such circumstances will be available to us on commercially reasonable terms or at all. In addition, certain client agreements require us to indemnify our clients for third-party intellectual property infringement claims, which would increase the cost to us of an adverse ruling on such a claim. We have made and expect to continue making significant expenditures to preempt, investigate, defend and settle claims related to the use of technology and intellectual property rights, including trademarks, as part of our strategy to manage this risk.

Our failure to comply with the anti-corruption laws and regulations of the United States and various international jurisdictions could materially adversely affect our reputation and results of operations.

Doing business on a worldwide basis requires us to comply with anti-corruption laws and regulations imposed by governments around the world with jurisdiction over our operations, which may include the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (the “ FCPA ”) and the U.K. Bribery Act 2010 (the “ U.K. Bribery Act ”), as well as the laws of the countries where we do business. These laws and regulations apply to companies, individual directors, officers, employees and agents, and may restrict our operations, trade practices, investment decisions and partnering activities. Where they apply, the FCPA and the U.K. Bribery Act prohibit us and our officers, directors, employees and business partners acting on our behalf, including joint venture partners and agents, from corruptly offering, promising, authorizing or providing anything of value to “foreign officials” for the purposes of influencing official decisions or obtaining or retaining business or otherwise obtaining favorable treatment. The U.K. Bribery Act also prohibits non-governmental “commercial” bribery and accepting bribes. As part of our business, we may deal with governments and state-owned business enterprises, the employees and representatives of which may be considered “foreign officials” for purposes of the FCPA and the U.K. Bribery Act. We also are subject to the jurisdiction of various governments and regulatory agencies around the world, which may bring our personnel and agents into contact with “foreign officials” responsible for issuing or renewing permits, licenses or approvals or for enforcing other governmental regulations. In addition, some of the international locations in which we operate lack a developed legal system and have elevated levels of corruption.

Our global operations expose us to the risk of violating, or being accused of violating, anti-corruption laws and regulations. Our failure to successfully comply with these laws and regulations may expose us to reputational harm as well as significant sanctions, including criminal fines, imprisonment, civil penalties, disgorgement of profits, injunctions and suspension or debarment from government contracts, as well as other remedial measures. Investigations of alleged violations can be expensive and disruptive. Despite our compliance efforts and activities, we cannot assure compliance by our employees or representatives for which we may be held responsible, and any such violation could materially adversely affect our reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may need to recognize impairment charges related to goodwill, identified intangible assets and fixed assets.

We have substantial balances of goodwill and identified intangible assets. We are required to test goodwill and any other intangible assets with an indefinite life for possible impairment on an annual basis, or more frequently when circumstances indicate that impairment may have occurred. We are also required to evaluate amortizable intangible assets and fixed assets for impairment if there are indicators of a possible impairment.

Based on the results of the annual impairment test as of October 1, 2018, the fair value of our reporting unit exceeded the individual reporting unit’s carrying value, and goodwill was not impaired. There is significant

 

41


Table of Contents

judgment required in the analysis of a potential impairment of goodwill, identified intangible assets and fixed assets. If, as a result of a general economic slowdown, deterioration in one or more of the markets in which we operate or impairment in our financial performance and/or future outlook, the estimated fair value of our long-lived assets decreases, we may determine that one or more of our long-lived assets is impaired. An impairment charge would be recorded if the estimated fair value of the assets is lower than the carrying value and any such impairment charge could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial position.

Our ability to use our net operating loss carryforwards and certain other tax attributes may be limited.

Under Sections 382 and 383 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, if a corporation undergoes an “ownership change,” the corporation’s ability to use its pre-change net operating loss carryforwards and other pre-change tax attributes to offset its post-change income and taxes may be limited. In general, an “ownership change” occurs if there is a cumulative change in our ownership by “5% shareholders” (as defined under U.S. income tax laws) that exceeds 50 percentage points over a rolling three-year period. Similar rules apply under state tax laws. If we experience one or more ownership changes as a result of this Business Combination or future transactions in our stock, then we may be limited in our ability to use our net operating loss carryforwards and other tax assets to reduce taxes owed on the net taxable income that we earn. Any such limitations on the ability to use our net operating loss carryforwards and other tax assets could adversely impact our business, financial condition and operating results.

Unanticipated changes in our effective tax rate or challenges by tax authorities could harm our future results.

We are subject to income taxes in the United States and various non-U.S. jurisdictions. Our effective tax rate could be adversely affected by changes in the allocation of our pre-tax earnings and losses among countries with differing statutory tax rates, in certain non-deductible expenses as a result of acquisitions, in the valuation of our deferred tax assets and liabilities, or in federal, state, local or non-U.S. tax laws and accounting principles, including increased tax rates, new tax laws or revised interpretations of existing tax laws and precedents. Increases in our effective tax rate would adversely affect our operating results.

In addition, we may be subject to income tax audits by various tax jurisdictions throughout the world, many of which have not established clear guidance on the tax treatment of SaaS companies. The application of tax laws in such jurisdictions may be subject to diverging and sometimes conflicting interpretations by tax authorities in these jurisdictions. Although we believe our income tax liabilities are reasonably estimated and accounted for in accordance with applicable laws and principles, an adverse resolution of one or more uncertain tax positions in any period could have a material impact on the results of operations for that period.

Taxing authorities may successfully assert that we should have collected or in the future should collect additional sales and use taxes, and we could be subject to liability with respect to past or future sales, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

We have not historically filed sales and use tax returns or collected sales and use taxes in all jurisdictions in which we have sales, based on our belief that such taxes are not applicable. Taxing authorities may seek to impose such taxes on us, including for past sales, which could result in penalties and interest. Any such tax assessments may adversely affect the results of our operations.

Taxing authorities could reallocate our taxable income among our subsidiaries, which could increase our consolidated tax liability.

We conduct integrated operations internationally through subsidiaries in various tax jurisdictions pursuant to transfer pricing arrangements between our subsidiaries and between our subsidiaries and us. If two or more affiliated companies are located in different countries, the tax laws or regulations of each country generally require that transfer prices be the same as those between unrelated companies dealing at arm’s length and that

 

42


Table of Contents

contemporaneous documentation is maintained to support the transfer prices. While we believe that we operate in compliance with applicable transfer pricing laws and intend to continue to do so, our transfer pricing procedures are not binding on applicable tax authorities. If tax authorities in any of these countries were to successfully challenge our transfer prices as not reflecting arms’ length transactions, they could require us to adjust our transfer prices and thereby reallocate our income to reflect these revised transfer prices, which could result in a higher tax liability to us. Such reallocations may subject us to interest and penalties that would increase our consolidated tax liability and could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The price of Pivotal common stock may be volatile.

The price of Pivotal common stock may fluctuate due to a variety of factors, including:

 

   

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our quarterly and annual results and those of other public companies in industry;

 

   

mergers and strategic alliances in the industry in which we operate;

 

   

market prices and conditions in the industry in which we operate;

 

   

changes in government regulation;

 

   

potential or actual military conflicts or acts of terrorism;

 

   

announcements concerning us or our competitors; and

 

   

the general state of the securities markets.

These market and industry factors may materially reduce the market price of our common stock, regardless of our operating performance.

Reports published by analysts, including projections in those reports that differ from our actual results, could adversely affect the price and trading volume of our common stock.

We currently expect that securities research analysts will establish and publish their own periodic projections for our business. These projections may vary widely and may not accurately predict the results we actually achieve. Our stock price may decline if our actual results do not match the projections of these securities research analysts. Similarly, if one or more of the analysts who write reports on us downgrades our stock or publishes inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, our stock price could decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of us or fails to publish reports on us regularly, our stock price or trading volume could decline. While we expect research analyst coverage, if no analysts commence coverage of us, the trading price and volume for our common stock could be adversely affected.

Pivotal may issue additional shares of common stock or other equity securities without your approval, which would dilute your ownership interests and may depress the market price of Pivotal common stock.

Upon consummation of the Merger, Pivotal will have warrants outstanding to purchase up to an aggregate of 29,350,000 shares of common stock and may issue an aggregate of 2,200,000 shares of common stock to the Company’s stockholders if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger. Pivotal will also have the ability to issue up to                  shares under the 2019 Plan (assuming it is approved by stockholders at the meeting). Pivotal may also issue additional shares of common stock or other equity securities of equal or senior rank in the future in connection with, among other things, future acquisitions or repayment of outstanding indebtedness, without stockholder approval, in a number of circumstances.

 

43


Table of Contents

Pivotal’s issuance of additional shares of common stock or other equity securities of equal or senior rank would have the following effects:

 

   

Pivotal’s existing stockholders’ proportionate ownership interest in Pivotal will decrease;

 

   

the amount of cash available per share, including for payment of dividends in the future, may decrease;

 

   

the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding share of common stock may be diminished; and

 

   

the market price of Pivotal’s shares of common stock may decline.

Our charter will contain anti-takeover provisions that could adversely affect the rights of our stockholders.

Our second amended and restated certificate of incorporation will contain provisions to limit the ability of others to acquire control of our company or cause us to engage in change-of-control transactions, including, among other things:

 

   

provisions that authorize our board of directors, without action by our stockholders, to issue additional shares of common stock and preferred stock with preferential rights determined by our board of directors;

 

   

provisions that permit only a majority of our board of directors to call stockholder meetings and therefore do not permit stockholders to call stockholder meetings;

 

   

provisions that impose advance notice requirements, minimum shareholding periods and ownership thresholds, and other requirements and limitations on the ability of stockholders to propose matters for consideration at stockholder meetings; and

 

   

a staggered board whereby our directors are divided into three classes, with each class subject to retirement and re-election once every three years on a rotating basis.

These provisions could have the effect of depriving our stockholders of an opportunity to sell their common stock at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging third parties from seeking to obtain control of our company in a tender offer or similar transaction. With our staggered board of directors, at least two annual or special meetings of stockholders will generally be required in order to effect a change in a majority of our directors. Our staggered board of directors can discourage proxy contests for the election of our directors and purchases of substantial blocks of our shares by making it more difficult for a potential acquirer to gain control of our board of directors in a relatively short period of time.

Pivotal will not have any right to make damage claims against the Company or the Company’s stockholders for the breach of any representation, warranty or covenant made by the Company in the Merger Agreement.

The Merger Agreement provides that all of the representations, warranties and covenants of the parties contained therein shall not survive the closing of the Merger, except for those covenants that by their terms apply or are to be performed in whole or in part after the closing, and then only with respect to breaches occurring after closing. Accordingly, there are no remedies available to the parties with respect to any breach of the representations, warranties, covenants or agreements of the parties to the Merger Agreement after the closing of the Merger, except for covenants to be performed in whole or in part after the closing. As a result, Pivotal will have no remedy available to it if the Merger is consummated and it is later revealed that there was a breach of any of the representations, warranties and covenants made by the Company at the time of the Merger.

Future resales of common stock may cause the market price of Pivotal’s securities to drop significantly, even if the Company’s business is doing well.

The Founder, officers and directors of Pivotal, and the stockholders of the Company will be granted certain rights, pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, to require Pivotal to register, in certain circumstances, the

 

44


Table of Contents

resale under the Securities Act of common stock held by them, subject to certain conditions. The sale or possibility of sale of these shares could have the effect of increasing the volatility in Pivotal’s share price or putting significant downward pressure on the price of Pivotal’s stock.

If Pivotal’s stockholders fail to properly demand conversion rights, they will not be entitled to have their common stock of Pivotal converted into a pro rata portion of the trust account.

Pivotal stockholders holding public shares may demand that Pivotal convert their shares into a pro rata portion of the trust account, calculated as of two (2) business days prior to the anticipated consummation of the Business Combination, including interest earned on the trust account and not previously released to Pivotal to pay its tax obligations. Pivotal stockholders who seek to exercise this conversion right must deliver their shares (either physically or electronically) to Pivotal’s transfer agent two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting. Any Pivotal stockholder who fails to properly deliver their shares will not be entitled to have his or her shares converted. See the section entitled “ Annual Meeting of Pivotal Stockholders—Conversion Rights ” for the procedures to be followed if you wish to have your shares redeemed for cash.

Public stockholders, together with any affiliates of theirs or any other person with whom they are acting in concert or as a “group,” will be restricted from seeking conversion rights with respect to more than 20% of the public shares.

A public stockholder, together with any affiliate or any other person with whom such stockholder is acting in concert or as a “group,” will be restricted from seeking conversion rights with respect to more than 20% of the public shares. Accordingly, if you hold more than 20% of the public shares and the business combination proposal is approved, you will not be able to seek conversion rights with respect to the full amount of your shares and may be forced to hold the shares in excess of 20% or sell them in the open market. Pivotal cannot assure you that the value of such excess shares will appreciate over time following a business combination or that the market price of Pivotal common stock after the Business Combination will exceed the per-share conversion price.

Pivotal’s securities may not be listed on a national securities exchange after the Business Combination, which could limit investors’ ability to make transactions in Pivotal’s securities and subject Pivotal to additional trading restrictions.

Pivotal has applied to have its common stock and warrants listed on the NYSE after consummation of the Business Combination. Pivotal will be required to meet the initial listing requirements of the NYSE to be listed. Pivotal may not be able to meet those initial listing requirements. Even if Pivotal’s securities are so listed, Pivotal may be unable to maintain the listing of its securities in the future.

If Pivotal fails to meet the initial listing requirements and the NYSE does not list its securities and the related closing condition is waived by the parties, Pivotal could face significant material adverse consequences, including:

 

   

a limited availability of market quotations for its securities;

 

   

a limited amount of news and analyst coverage for the company; and

 

   

a decreased ability to issue additional securities or obtain additional financing in the future.

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors own common stock and warrants that will be worthless and have incurred reimbursable expenses that may not be reimbursed or repaid if the Business Combination is not approved. Such interests may have influenced their decision to approve the Business Combination with the Company.

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors and/or their affiliates beneficially own or have a pecuniary interest in founder shares and private warrants that they purchased prior to, or simultaneously with, Pivotal’s

 

45


Table of Contents

initial public offering. The holders have no redemption rights with respect to these securities in the event a business combination is not effected in the required time period. Therefore, if the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not approved within the required time period, such securities held by such persons will be worthless. Such securities had an aggregate market value of $                 based upon the closing prices of the shares and warrants on the NYSE on                 , 2019, the record date. Furthermore, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors and their affiliates are entitled to reimbursement of out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in connection with certain activities on Pivotal’s behalf, such as identifying and investigating possible business targets and business combinations. These loans and expenses will be repaid upon completion of the Business Combination with the Company. However, if Pivotal fails to consummate the Business Combination, they will not have any claim against the trust account for repayment or reimbursement. Accordingly, Pivotal may not be able to repay or reimburse these amounts if the Business Combination is not completed. See the section entitled “The Business Combination Proposal—Interests of the Founder and Pivotal’s Directors and Officers in the Business Combination .”

These financial interests may have influenced the decision of Pivotal’s directors to approve the Business Combination with the Company and to continue to pursue such Business Combination. In considering the recommendations of Pivotal’s board of directors to vote for the business combination proposal and other proposals, its stockholders should consider these interests.

The Founder, which is ultimately controlled by Jonathan J. Ledecky and Kevin Griffin, is liable under certain circumstances to ensure that proceeds of the trust are not reduced by vendor claims in the event the Business Combination is not consummated. Such liability may have influenced the decision of Messrs. Ledecky and Griffin to approve the Business Combination with the Company.

If the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not consummated by Pivotal within the required time period, the Founder will be personally liable under certain circumstances described herein to ensure that the proceeds in the trust account are not reduced by the claims of target businesses or claims of vendors or other entities that are owed money by Pivotal for services rendered or contracted for or products sold to Pivotal. If Pivotal consummates a business combination, on the other hand, Pivotal will be liable for all such claims. See the section entitled “ Other Information Related to Pivotal—Financial Condition and Liquidity ” for further information.

These personal obligations of the Founder may have influenced Pivotal’s board of director’s decision to approve the Business Combination with the Company and to continue to pursue such Business Combination. In considering the recommendations of Pivotal’s board of directors to vote for the business combination proposal and the other proposals, Pivotal’s stockholders should consider these interests.

The exercise of Pivotal’s directors’ and officers’ discretion in agreeing to changes or waivers in the terms of the Business Combination may result in a conflict of interest when determining whether such changes to the terms of the Business Combination or waivers of conditions are appropriate and in the best interests of Pivotal’s stockholders.

In the period leading up to the closing of the Business Combination, events may occur that, pursuant to the Merger Agreement, would require Pivotal to agree to amend the Merger Agreement, to consent to certain actions taken by the Company or to waive rights that Pivotal is entitled to under the Merger Agreement. Such events could arise because of changes in the course of the Company’s business, a request by the Company to undertake actions that would otherwise be prohibited by the terms of the Merger Agreement or the occurrence of other events that would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business and would entitle Pivotal to terminate the Merger Agreement. In any of such circumstances, it would be at Pivotal’s discretion, acting through its board of directors, to grant its consent or waive those rights. The existence of the financial and personal interests of the directors described in the preceding risk factors may result in a conflict of interest on the part of one or more of the directors between what he or they may believe is best for Pivotal and what he or they

 

46


Table of Contents

may believe is best for himself or themselves in determining whether or not to take the requested action. As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, Pivotal does not believe there will be any material changes or waivers that Pivotal’s directors and officers would be likely to make after the mailing of this proxy statement/prospectus. Pivotal will circulate a supplemental or amended proxy statement/prospectus if changes to the terms of the Merger that would have a material impact on its stockholders are required prior to the vote on the business combination proposal.

If Pivotal is unable to complete the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal’s stockholders), Pivotal will cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, redeeming 100% of the outstanding public shares and, subject to the approval of its remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolving and liquidating. In such event, third parties may bring claims against Pivotal and, as a result, the proceeds held in the trust account could be reduced and the per-share liquidation price received by stockholders could be less than $10.00 per share.

Under the terms of Pivotal’s amended and restated certificate of incorporation, Pivotal must complete the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation), or Pivotal must cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, redeeming 100% of the outstanding public shares and, subject to the approval of its remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolving and liquidating. In such event, third parties may bring claims against Pivotal. Although Pivotal has obtained waiver agreements from certain vendors and service providers it has engaged and owes money to, and the prospective target businesses it has negotiated with, whereby such parties have waived any right, title, interest or claim of any kind they may have in or to any monies held in the trust account, there is no guarantee that they or other vendors who did not execute such waivers will not seek recourse against the trust account notwithstanding such agreements. Furthermore, there is no guarantee that a court will uphold the validity of such agreements. Accordingly, the proceeds held in the trust account could be subject to claims which could take priority over those of Pivotal’s public stockholders. If Pivotal is unable to complete a business combination within the required time period, the Founder has agreed that it will be liable under certain circumstances described herein to ensure that the proceeds in the trust account are not reduced by the claims of target businesses or claims of vendors or other entities that are owed money by Pivotal for services rendered or contracted for or products sold to Pivotal. However, the Founder may not be able to meet such obligation as its only assets are securities of Pivotal. Therefore, the per-share distribution from the trust account in such a situation may be less than $10.00 due to such claims.

Additionally, if Pivotal is forced to file a bankruptcy case or an involuntary bankruptcy case is filed against it which is not dismissed, or if Pivotal otherwise enters compulsory or court supervised liquidation, the proceeds held in the trust account could be subject to applicable bankruptcy law, and may be included in its bankruptcy estate and subject to the claims of third parties with priority over the claims of its stockholders. To the extent any bankruptcy claims deplete the trust account, Pivotal may not be able to return to its public stockholders at least $10.00.

Pivotal’s stockholders may be held liable for claims by third parties against Pivotal to the extent of distributions received by them.

If Pivotal is unable to complete the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination within the required time period, Pivotal will (i) cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, (ii) as promptly as reasonably possible but not more than ten business days thereafter, redeem 100% of the outstanding public shares, which redemption will completely extinguish the public stockholders’ rights as stockholders (including the right to receive further liquidation distributions, if any), subject to applicable law, and (iii) as promptly as reasonably possible following such redemption, subject to the approval of its remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolve and liquidate, subject (in the case of (ii) and (iii) above) to its obligations

 

47


Table of Contents

under Delaware law to provide for claims of creditors and the requirements of other applicable law. Pivotal cannot assure you that it will properly assess all claims that may potentially be brought against Pivotal. As such, Pivotal’s stockholders could potentially be liable for any claims to the extent of distributions received by them (but no more) and any liability of its stockholders may extend well beyond the third anniversary of the date of distribution. Accordingly, Pivotal cannot assure you that third parties will not seek to recover from its stockholders amounts owed to them by Pivotal.

If Pivotal is forced to file a bankruptcy case or an involuntary bankruptcy case is filed against it which is not dismissed, any distributions received by stockholders could be viewed under applicable debtor, creditor and/or bankruptcy laws as either a “preferential transfer” or a “fraudulent conveyance.” As a result, a bankruptcy court could seek to recover all amounts received by Pivotal’s stockholders. Furthermore, because Pivotal intends to distribute the proceeds held in the trust account to its public stockholders promptly after the expiration of the time period to complete a business combination, this may be viewed or interpreted as giving preference to its public stockholders over any potential creditors with respect to access to or distributions from its assets. Furthermore, Pivotal’s board of directors may be viewed as having breached its fiduciary duties to its creditors and/or may have acted in bad faith, thereby exposing itself and the company to claims of punitive damages, by paying public stockholders from the trust account prior to addressing the claims of creditors. Pivotal cannot assure you that claims will not be brought against it for these reasons.

Activities taken by existing Pivotal stockholders to increase the likelihood of approval of the business combination proposal and the other proposals could have a depressive effect on Pivotal’s shares.

At any time prior to the annual meeting, during a period when they are not then aware of any material nonpublic information regarding Pivotal or its securities, the Founder, Pivotal’s officers, directors and stockholders from prior to Pivotal’s initial public offering, the Company or the Company’s stockholders and/or their respective affiliates may purchase shares from institutional and other investors who vote, or indicate an intention to vote, against the business combination proposal, or execute agreements to purchase such shares from such investors in the future, or they may enter into transactions with such investors and others to provide them with incentives to acquire common stock of Pivotal or vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. The purpose of such share purchases and other transactions would be to increase the likelihood of satisfaction of the requirements to consummate the Business Combination where it appears that such requirements would otherwise not be met. Entering into any such arrangements may have a depressive effect on Pivotal common stock. For example, as a result of these arrangements, an investor or holder may have the ability to effectively purchase shares at a price lower than market and may therefore be more likely to sell the shares he owns, either prior to or immediately after the annual meeting.

If the adjournment proposal is not approved, and an insufficient number of votes have been obtained to authorize the consummation of the Business Combination, Pivotal’s board of directors will not have the ability to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date in order to solicit further votes, and, therefore, the Business Combination will not be approved.

Pivotal’s board of directors is seeking approval to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date or dates if, at the annual meeting, Pivotal is unable to consummate the Business Combination. If the adjournment proposal is not approved, Pivotal’s board will not have the ability to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date and, therefore, the Business Combination would not be completed.

 

48


Table of Contents

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

Pivotal believes that some of the information in this proxy statement/prospectus constitutes forward-looking statements within the definition of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. However, because Pivotal is a “blank check” company, the safe-harbor provisions of that act do not apply to statements made in this proxy statement/prospectus. You can identify these statements by forward-looking words such as “may,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “contemplate,” “believe,” “estimate,” “intends” and “continue” or similar words. You should read statements that contain these words carefully because they:

 

   

discuss future expectations;

 

   

contain projections of future results of operations or financial condition; or

 

   

state other “forward-looking” information.

Pivotal believes it is important to communicate its expectations to its securityholders. However, there may be events in the future that Pivotal is not able to predict accurately or over which it has no control. The risk factors and cautionary language discussed in this proxy statement/prospectus provide examples of risks, uncertainties and events that may cause actual results to differ materially from the expectations described by Pivotal or the Company in such forward-looking statements, including, among other things:

 

   

the ability to complete the Merger;

 

   

the occurrence of any event, change or other circumstances that could give rise to the termination of the Merger Agreement;

 

   

the ability to maintain the listing of Pivotal’s securities on a national securities exchange following the Business Combination;

 

   

the potential liquidity and trading of Pivotal’s public securities;

 

   

the inability to recognize the anticipated benefits of the proposed Business Combination, which may be affected by, among other things, the amount of cash available following any redemption of public shares by Pivotal stockholders;

 

   

the ability to operate in highly competitive markets, and potential adverse effects of this competition;

 

   

risk of decreased revenues if the Company does not adapt its pricing models;

 

   

the ability to attract, motivate and retain qualified employees, including members of its senior management team;

 

   

the ability to maintain a high level of client service and expand operations;

 

   

potential failure to comply with privacy and information security regulations governing the client datasets the Company processes and stores;

 

   

risk that the Company is unsuccessful in integrating acquired businesses and product lines;

 

   

potential issues with the Company’s product offerings that could cause legal exposure, reputational damage and an inability to deliver services;

 

   

the ability to develop new products, improve existing products and adapt the Company’s business model to keep pace with industry trends;

 

   

the ability to maintain, promote or expand the Company’s brand through effective marketing practices;

 

   

risk that the Company’s products and services fail to interoperate with third-party systems;

 

   

results of the United Kingdom’s referendum on withdrawal from the European Union;

 

   

potential unavailability of third-party technology that the Company uses in its products and services;

 

49


Table of Contents
   

the ability to maintain effective controls over disclosure and financial reporting that enable the Company to comply with regulations and produce accurate financial statements;

 

   

potential disruption of the Company’s products, offerings, website and networks;

 

   

difficulties resulting from the Company’s implementation of new consolidated business systems;

 

   

the ability to deliver products and services following a disaster or business continuity event;

 

   

increased risks resulting from the Company’s international operations;

 

   

potential unauthorized use of the Company’s products and technology by third parties;

 

   

global economic conditions and the cyclical nature of certain markets the Company serves;

 

   

exchange rate fluctuations and volatility in global currency markets;

 

   

consequences of the Company’s substantial levels of indebtedness;

 

   

the ability to comply with various trade restrictions, such as sanctions and export controls, resulting from its international operations;

 

   

potential intellectual property infringement claims;

 

   

the ability to comply with the anti-corruption laws of the United States and various international jurisdictions;

 

   

potential impairment charges related to goodwill, identified intangible assets and fixed assets;

 

   

impacts of tax regulations and laws on the Company’s business;

 

   

a potential litigation involving Pivotal or the Company;

 

   

costs related to the Business Combination;

 

   

expectations regarding the time during which Pivotal will be an “emerging growth company” under the JOBS Act; and

 

   

other risks and uncertainties indicated in this proxy statement/prospectus, including those set forth under the section entitled “ Risk Factors.

You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus.

All forward-looking statements included herein attributable to any of Pivotal, the Company or any person acting on either party’s behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements contained or referred to in this section. Except to the extent required by applicable laws and regulations, Pivotal and the Company undertake no obligations to update these forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date of this proxy statement/prospectus or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

Before you grant your proxy or instruct your bank or broker how to vote, or vote on the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal, the incentive plan proposal or the adjournment proposal, you should be aware that the occurrence of the events described in the “ Risk Factors ” section and elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus may adversely affect Pivotal and/or the Company.

 

50


Table of Contents

ANNUAL MEETING OF PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS

General

Pivotal is furnishing this proxy statement/prospectus to Pivotal’s stockholders as part of the solicitation of proxies by Pivotal’s board of directors for use at the annual meeting of Pivotal’s stockholders. This proxy statement/prospectus provides Pivotal’s stockholders with the information they need to know to be able to vote or instruct their vote to be cast at the annual meeting.

Date, Time and Place

The annual meeting of stockholders will be held on                 , 2019, at 10:00 a.m., eastern time, at the offices of Graubard Miller, general counsel to Pivotal, at The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, New York 10174.

Purpose of the Pivotal Annual Meeting

At the annual meeting, Pivotal is asking holders of Pivotal common stock to:

 

   

consider and vote upon a proposal to adopt the Merger Agreement and approve the Business Combination contemplated thereby (the business combination proposal);

 

   

consider and vote upon separate proposals to approve amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to: (i) change the name of the public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”; (ii) increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock; and (iii) delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time (the charter proposals);

 

   

elect eight directors who, upon consummation of the Merger, will be the directors of Pivotal, in each case, until their successors are elected and qualified (the director election proposal);

 

   

consider and vote upon a proposal to approve the 2019 Plan (the incentive plan proposal); and

 

   

consider and vote upon a proposal to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date or dates, if necessary, in the event that Pivotal is unable to consummate the Business Combination for any reason (the adjournment proposal).

Recommendation of Pivotal Board of Directors

Pivotal’s board of directors has unanimously determined that the business combination proposal is fair to and in the best interests of Pivotal and its stockholders; has unanimously approved the business combination proposal; unanimously recommends that stockholders vote “FOR” the business combination proposal; unanimously recommends that stockholders vote “FOR” each of the charter proposals; unanimously recommends that stockholders vote “FOR” the election of all of the persons nominated by Pivotal’s management for election as directors; unanimously recommends that stockholders vote “FOR” the incentive plan proposal; and unanimously recommends that stockholders vote “FOR” the adjournment proposal, if presented at the meeting.

Record Date; Persons Entitled to Vote

Pivotal has fixed the close of business on                 , 2019 as the “record date” for determining Pivotal stockholders entitled to notice of, and to attend and vote at, the annual meeting. As of the close of business on

 

51


Table of Contents

                , 2019, there were 23,000,000 shares of Class A common stock outstanding and 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock outstanding and entitled to vote. Each share of Pivotal common stock is entitled to one vote at the annual meeting.

Pursuant to agreements with Pivotal, the 5,750,000 founder shares held by the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors, and any common stock acquired by them in the aftermarket, will be voted in favor of the business combination proposal. Such holders have indicated they intend to vote their shares in favor of the other proposals presented at the annual meeting.

Quorum

The presence, in person or by proxy, of a majority of all the outstanding shares of common stock entitled to vote constitutes a quorum at the annual meeting.

Abstentions and Broker Non-Votes

Abstentions are considered present for purposes of establishing a quorum but will have the same effect as a vote “against” the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal, if presented. Abstentions will have no effect on the director election proposal. Broker non-votes will have no effect on the business combination proposal, director election proposal, incentive plan proposal and adjournment proposal, if presented, and will have the same effect as a vote “against” the charter proposals.

If a stockholder does not give the broker voting instructions, under applicable self-regulatory organization rules, its broker may not vote its shares on “non-routine” proposals, such as the business combination proposal, the charter proposals and the incentive plan proposal.

Vote Required

The approval of the business combination proposal, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the meeting.

The approval of each of the charter proposals will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Pivotal common stock on the record date.

Directors are elected by a plurality. “Plurality” means that the individuals who receive the largest number of votes cast “FOR” are elected as directors. Consequently, any shares not voted “FOR” a particular nominee (whether as a result of an abstention, a direction to withhold authority or a broker non-vote) will not be counted in the nominee’s favor.

Voting Your Shares

Each share of Pivotal common stock that you own in your name entitles you to one vote. Your proxy card shows the number of shares of Pivotal common stock that you own. If your shares are held in “street name” or are in a margin or similar account, you should contact your broker to ensure that votes related to the shares you beneficially own are properly counted.

There are two ways to vote your shares of Pivotal common stock at the annual meeting:

 

   

You Can Vote By Signing and Returning the Enclosed Proxy Card . If you vote by proxy card, your “proxy,” whose name is listed on the proxy card, will vote your shares as you instruct on the proxy

 

52


Table of Contents
 

card. If you sign and return the proxy card but do not give instructions on how to vote your shares, your shares will be voted as recommended by Pivotal’s board of directors “FOR” the business combination proposal, each of the charter proposals, each director included in the director election proposal, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal, if presented. Votes received after a matter has been voted upon at the annual meeting will not be counted.

 

   

You Can Attend the Annual Meeting and Vote in Person . You will receive a ballot when you arrive. However, if your shares are held in the name of your broker, bank or another nominee, you must get a proxy from the broker, bank or other nominee. That is the only way Pivotal can be sure that the broker, bank or nominee has not already voted your shares.

Revoking Your Proxy

If you are a stockholder and you give a proxy, you may revoke it at any time before it is exercised by doing any one of the following:

 

   

you may send another proxy card with a later date;

 

   

you may notify Pivotal’s Secretary in writing before the annual meeting that you have revoked your proxy; or

 

   

you may attend the annual meeting, revoke your proxy and vote in person, as indicated above.

Who Can Answer Your Questions About Voting Your Shares

If you are a stockholder and have any questions about how to vote or direct a vote in respect of your Pivotal common stock, you may call                 , Pivotal’s proxy solicitor, at                  or Jonathan J. Ledecky, Pivotal’s chief executive officer, at (212) 818-8800.

Conversion Rights

Any holder of public shares may seek to convert their shares into cash in connection with the Business Combination. Holders of public shares are not required to affirmatively vote on the business combination proposal or be holders of public shares on the record date in order to exercise conversion rights with respect to such public shares. Any stockholder holding public shares may exercise conversion rights which will result in them converting their shares into a full pro rata portion of the trust account, including interest earned on the trust account and not previously released to Pivotal to pay its tax obligations, which, for illustrative purposes, was $                 per share as of                 , 2019, the record date, calculated as of two business days prior to the anticipated consummation of the Business Combination. If a holder seeks conversion of their shares as described in this section and the Business Combination is consummated, Pivotal will convert these shares into a pro rata portion of funds deposited in the trust account and the holder will no longer own these shares following the Business Combination.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, a holder of public shares, together with any affiliate of his or any other person with whom he is acting in concert or as a “group” (as defined in Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act), will be restricted from seeking conversion rights with respect to 20% or more of the public shares. Accordingly, all public shares in excess of 20% held by a public stockholder will not be converted.

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors will not have conversion rights with respect to any shares of Pivotal common stock owned by them, directly or indirectly.

Pivotal stockholders who seek to have their public shares converted must deliver their shares, either physically or electronically using The Depository Trust Company’s DWAC System, to Pivotal’s transfer agent no later than

 

53


Table of Contents

two (2) business days prior to the annual meeting. If you hold the shares in street name, you will have to coordinate with your broker to have your shares certificated or delivered electronically. Certificates that have not been tendered (either physically or electronically) in accordance with these procedures will not be redeemed for cash. There is a nominal cost associated with this tendering process and the act of certificating the shares or delivering them through the DWAC system. The transfer agent will typically charge the tendering broker $45 and it would be up to the broker whether or not to pass this cost on to the redeeming stockholder. In the event the proposed Business Combination is not consummated, this may result in an additional cost to stockholders for the return of their shares.

Any request to have such shares converted, once made, may be withdrawn at any time prior to the vote on the business combination proposal. Furthermore, if a holder of a public share delivered its certificate in connection with an election of its conversion and subsequently decides prior to the applicable date not to elect to exercise such rights, it may simply request that the transfer agent return the certificate (physically or electronically).

If the Business Combination is not approved or completed for any reason, then Pivotal’s public stockholders who elected to exercise their conversion rights will not be entitled to have their shares converted. In such case, Pivotal will promptly return any shares delivered by public holders.

If Pivotal would be left with less than $5,000,001 of net tangible assets as a result of the holders of public shares demanding conversion rights, Pivotal will not be able to consummate the Business Combination.

The closing price of the Pivotal Class A common stock on                 , 2019, the record date, was $                . The cash held in the trust account on such date less taxes payable was approximately $                 ($                 per public share). Prior to exercising conversion rights, stockholders should verify the market price of Pivotal Class A common stock as they may receive higher proceeds from the sale of their common stock in the public market than from exercising their conversion rights if the market price per share is higher than the redemption price. Pivotal cannot assure its stockholders that they will be able to sell their common stock in the open market, even if the market price per share is higher than the conversion price stated above, as there may not be sufficient liquidity in its securities when its stockholders wish to sell their shares.

If a holder of public shares exercises its conversion rights, then it will be exchanging its shares of Pivotal common stock for cash and will no longer own those shares.

Appraisal Rights

None of Pivotal’s stockholders, unitholders or warrant holders have appraisal rights in connection with the Business Combination under Delaware law.

Proxy Solicitation Costs

Pivotal is soliciting proxies on behalf of its board of directors. This solicitation is being made by mail but also may be made by telephone or in person. Pivotal and its directors, officers and employees may also solicit proxies in person, by telephone or by other electronic means. Pivotal will bear the cost of the solicitation.

Pivotal has hired                  to assist in the proxy solicitation process. Pivotal will pay that firm a fee of $                 plus disbursements. Such payment will be made from non-trust account funds.

Pivotal will ask banks, brokers and other institutions, nominees and fiduciaries to forward the proxy materials to their principals and to obtain their authority to execute proxies and voting instructions. Pivotal will reimburse them for their reasonable expenses.

 

54


Table of Contents

The Founder and Pivotal’s Officers and Directors

As of                 , 2019, the record date for the Pivotal annual meeting, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors beneficially owned and were entitled to vote an aggregate of 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock. These individuals and entities also purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 private warrants simultaneously with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering. The founder shares currently constitute 20% of Pivotal’s outstanding common stock.

In connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, each of the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors have agreed to vote the founder shares, as well as any common stock acquired in the aftermarket, in favor of the business combination proposal. Each has also indicated that he, she or it intends to vote his, her or its shares in favor of all the other proposals being presented at the meeting. There are no redemption rights with respect to the founder shares in the event a business combination is not effected in the required time period and Pivotal is forced to redeem all of the public shares. Accordingly, the founder shares will be worthless if no business combination is consummated by Pivotal.

In connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, the holders of Pivotal’s founder shares entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the founder shares (subject to limited exceptions) until one year after the consummation of an initial business combination or earlier if, subsequent to the consummation of an initial business combination, (i) the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the initial business combination or (ii) Pivotal (or any successor entity) consummates a subsequent liquidation, merger, stock exchange or other similar transaction which results in all of the company’s stockholders having the right to exchange their shares of common stock for cash, securities or other property. Additionally, the holders of private warrants entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the private warrants or common stock underlying the private warrants (subject to limited exceptions) until thirty (30) days after the consummation of an initial business combination.

In connection with the Merger, the Founder agreed to enter into the Founder Lock-Up Agreement, pursuant to which an aggregate of 1,100,000 founder shares will be subject to additional transfer restrictions until the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $15.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period. If the last reported sale price of Pivotal common stock does not equal or exceed $15.00 within five years from the consummation of the Business Combination, such founder shares will be forfeited to Pivotal for no consideration

At any time prior to the annual meeting, during a period when they are not then aware of any material nonpublic information regarding Pivotal or its securities, the Founder, Pivotal’s officers and directors, the Company, the Company’s stockholders and/or their respective affiliates may purchase shares from institutional and other investors who vote, or indicate an intention to vote, against the business combination proposal, or execute agreements to purchase such shares from such investors in the future, or they may enter into transactions with such investors and others to provide them with incentives to acquire Pivotal common stock or vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. The purpose of such share purchases and other transactions would be to increase the likelihood of satisfaction of the requirements to complete the Business Combination where it appears that such requirements would otherwise not be met. While the exact nature of any such incentives has not been determined as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, they might include, without limitation, arrangements to protect such investors or holders against potential loss in value of their shares, including the granting of put options and the transfer to such investors or holders of founder shares for nominal value.

Entering into any such arrangements may have a depressive effect on the shares of Pivotal common stock. For example, as a result of these arrangements, an investor or holder may have the ability to effectively purchase shares at a price lower than market and may therefore be more likely to sell the shares he owns, either prior to or immediately after the annual meeting.

 

55


Table of Contents

If such transactions are effected, the consequence could be to cause the Business Combination to be approved in circumstances where such approval could not otherwise be obtained. Purchases of shares by the persons described above would allow them to exert more influence over the approval of the business combination proposal and the other proposals and would likely increase the chances that such proposals would be approved.

No agreements dealing with the above arrangements or purchases have been entered into as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus. Pivotal will file a Current Report on Form 8-K to disclose arrangements entered into or significant purchases made by any of the aforementioned persons that would affect the vote on the business combination proposal or the net tangible asset threshold. Any such report will include descriptions of any arrangements entered into or significant purchases by any of the aforementioned persons.

 

56


Table of Contents

THE BUSINESS COMBINATION PROPOSAL

The discussion in this proxy statement/prospectus of the Business Combination and the principal terms of the Merger Agreement is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the Merger Agreement. A copy of the Merger Agreement is attached as Annex A to this proxy statement/prospectus.

Structure of the Transactions

The Merger Agreement provides, among other things, for Merger Sub to merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal. Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, each outstanding share of common stock of the Company will be converted into the right to receive a pro rata portion of (i) 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock at the closing of the Merger and (ii) 2,200,000 additional shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger.

In connection with the Merger, each outstanding share of Pivotal’s Class B common stock, by its terms, will automatically convert into one share of Pivotal’s single class of common stock upon consummation of the Business Combination. Each outstanding warrant of Pivotal entitles the holder to purchase shares of Pivotal common stock beginning 30 days after the consummation of the Business Combination.

Headquarters; Trading Symbols

After completion of the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement:

 

   

the corporate headquarters and principal executive offices of Pivotal will be located at 8201 Greensboro Dr., Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102; and

 

   

Pivotal common stock and Pivotal’s warrants are expected to be traded on the NYSE under the symbols                  and                  WS, respectively.

Sale Restrictions

The stockholders of the Company receiving shares of Pivotal common stock in the Merger will be subject to a 12-month lock-up period for all shares of Pivotal common stock held by such holders, which period may be earlier terminated if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 for a period of 20 consecutive trading days during any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the closing of the Merger. This lock-up is identical to the lock-up previously agreed to by the Founder and other holders of Pivotal’s founder shares.

Additionally, in connection with the Merger, the Founder agreed to enter into the Founder Lock-Up Agreement, pursuant to which an aggregate of 1,100,000 founder shares will be subject to transfer restrictions for the five-year period beginning upon consummation of the Business Combination until the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $15.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period. If the last reported sale price of Pivotal common stock does not equal or exceed $15.00 within the required time period, such founder shares will be forfeited to Pivotal for no consideration.

Related Agreements

Stockholders’ Agreement

Affiliates of Carlyle and Revolution have entered into the Stockholders’ Agreement with Pivotal, pursuant to which the holders of a majority of the shares of Pivotal common stock held by such Carlyle affiliates and

 

57


Table of Contents

Revolution will have the right to designate up to six directors for election to Pivotal’s board of directors for so long as such Carlyle affiliates and Revolution maintain collective ownership of a certain percentage interest in Pivotal.

Registration Rights Agreement

Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company’s stockholders, the Founder and the other holders of founder shares will be granted certain rights to have registered, in certain circumstances, the resale under the Securities Act of the securities of Pivotal held by such holders, subject to certain conditions set forth therein.

Support Agreements

In connection with the execution of the Merger Agreement, stockholders of the Company who hold a majority of the Company’s outstanding stock entered into agreements pursuant to which they agreed to vote in favor of the Business Combination at a meeting of the Company’s stockholders called to approve the Business Combination (or to act by written consent approving the Business Combination).

Background of the Merger

Pivotal is a blank check company formed in order to effect a merger, capital stock exchange, asset acquisition or other similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities. Pivotal was incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware on August 2, 2018.

The Business Combination with the Company is the result of an extensive search for a potential transaction utilizing the network and investing and transaction experience of Pivotal’s management team. The terms of the Merger Agreement are the result of arm’s-length negotiations between representatives of Pivotal and the Company. The following is a brief discussion of the background of these negotiations, the Merger Agreement and the Merger.

On February 4, 2019, Pivotal completed its initial public offering. Prior to the consummation of its initial public offering, neither Pivotal, nor anyone on its behalf, contacted any prospective target businesses or had any substantive discussions, formal or otherwise, with respect to a transaction with Pivotal.

From the date of Pivotal’s initial public offering through the signing of the Merger Agreement with the Company on May 20, 2019, representatives of Pivotal contacted and were contacted by a number of individuals and entities with respect to business combination opportunities and engaged with several possible target businesses in discussions with respect to potential transactions. During that period, Pivotal’s officers and directors identified and met with over 50 potential target businesses from a wide range of industry segments. The decision not to pursue any particular target business that Pivotal analyzed was generally the result of one or more of (i) Pivotal’s determination that such business did not represent as attractive a target as the Company due to a combination of business prospects, strategy, management teams, structure and valuation, (ii) a difference in valuation expectations between Pivotal, on the one hand, and the target and/or its owners, on the other hand, (iii) a potential target’s unwillingness to engage with Pivotal given the timing and uncertainty of closing due to the requirement for Pivotal stockholder approval or (iv) a potential target’s unwillingness to engage with Pivotal given conflicting business objectives on the target’s side.

Jonathan Ledecky and Christopher Weiler, chief executive officer of the Company, have been business acquaintances for more than 20 years. Following Pivotal’s initial public offering, Mr. Ledecky invited Mr. Weiler to lunch on February 7, 2019 so that he could update Mr. Weiler on his recent business activities, including the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering. Mr. Weiler also updated Mr. Ledecky on his current activities, including the business operations of KLDiscovery. Following this meeting, the two made arrangements to meet again to further discuss their activities and to determine whether a transaction between Pivotal and the Company could be considered.

 

58


Table of Contents

On February 18, 2019, Pivotal and the Company executed a non-disclosure agreement and on March 5, 2019, the Company began providing due diligence materials to Pivotal.

On March 25, 2019, the parties had a dinner meeting in Washington, DC to discuss the possibility of a transaction between Pivotal and the Company. Present at the meeting were Mr. Ledecky, William Darman of TCG, Evan Morgan, a former director of Pivotal and a special partner at RG, one of the Company’s stockholders, and Dan Akerson, Christopher Weiler and Dawn Wilson from KLDiscovery. At this time, Mr. Morgan was still a director of Pivotal.

On March 27, 2019, an initial draft of a letter of intent setting forth the proposed terms of a transaction between Pivotal and the Company was sent by Pivotal to the Company.

On April 3, 2019, the parties had a meeting at TCG’s offices. Present at the meeting were Mr. Darman, Mr. Ledecky, Rodney Cohen of TCG, and Kevin Griffin, a director of Pivotal. At this meeting, the parties discussed the operations of Pivotal and the Company and the terms of the letter of intent.

On April 9, 2019, Pivotal, the Company and their respective legal counsel and auditors participated in a conference call to discuss the proposed transaction. Following this call, Pivotal circulated a revised draft of the letter of intent to representatives of the Company.

On April 12, 2019, Mr. Morgan resigned from the board of directors of Pivotal in order to avoid any potential conflict of interest due to Mr. Morgan’s affiliation with both Pivotal and the Company.

On April 16, 2019, Graubard Miller, legal counsel to Pivotal, circulated an initial draft of the Merger Agreement to the Company and its legal representatives. The draft of the Merger Agreement reflected the terms of the letter of intent, which the parties determined not to execute and instead proceed straight to preparing the definitive documentation for the transaction.

On April 19, 2019, Latham & Watkins LLP, legal counsel to the Company (“ Latham  & Watkins ”), circulated a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Graubard Miller.

On April 22, 2019, the parties met at the offices of Cantor Fitzgerald & Co. (“ Cantor ”), the lead underwriter of Pivotal’s initial public offering, so that the bankers could get a better understanding of the Company’s operations and the potential economics of a transaction between Pivotal and the Company. Present at the meeting were representatives of Cantor, BTIG, LLC (“ BTIG ”), another underwriter in Pivotal’s initial public offering, Mr. Ledecky, Mr. Weiler, Ms. Wilson and Mr. Griffin.

On April 23, 2019, Graubard Miller circulated a revised draft of the Merger Agreement.

On April 24, 2019, Latham & Watkins circulated a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Graubard Miller.

On April 29, 2019, Cantor, BTIG and Pivotal had a telephone conference call to discuss, among other things, the timing of the potential transaction and a proposed requirement to have a certain minimum level of cash available to Pivotal upon the consummation of the transaction.

On April 29, 2019, Graubard Miller circulated a revised draft of the Merger Agreement.

On April 30, 2019, another meeting was held between Pivotal and its bankers to discuss the proposed transaction and various marketing aspects relating to the proposed transaction.

On May 1, 2019, Pivotal had another meeting with Cantor and BTIG to discuss the potential transaction.

 

59


Table of Contents

From May 3 to May 9, 2019, the parties had introductory conversations with a small number of existing and potential investors of Pivotal on a confidential basis to gauge their interest in connection with the potential Business Combination with the Company. During these discussions, Messrs. Ledecky and Weiler reviewed with investors certain information regarding the Company and the combined company following the Business Combination, including certain financial projections regarding the Company’s business. Each potential investor was informed in advance that the information that would be shared constituted material non-public information, and each potential investor agreed to be bound by certain confidentiality obligations as well as a prohibition on trading the securities of Pivotal and using the information for purposes other than such potential investor’s potential investment in connection with the Business Combination

On May 10, 2019, Latham & Watkins sent a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Graubard Miller. Latham & Watkins also sent drafts of various ancillary documents to the Merger Agreement to Graubard Miller.

On May 13, 2019, Graubard Miller sent a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Latham & Watkins and commented on various ancillary documents. Also on May 13, 2019, Pivotal engaged Northland to provide it with the “fairness opinion” described below.

On May 14, 2019, Latham & Watkins sent a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Graubard Miller and commented on various ancillary documents.

On May 15, 2019, Graubard Miller sent a revised draft of the Merger Agreement to Latham & Watkins.

On May 17, 2019, Pivotal’s board of directors met via teleconference. The entire board was present at the meeting. Also participating by invitation were James Brady, the chief financial officer of Pivotal, Greg Racz, an officer of the Founder, Jeffrey M. Gallant of Graubard Miller, counsel to Pivotal, and Jeff Peterson, Omar A. El-Sanjak, Matt Hansen and Kurtis Fechtmeyer of Northland (who were present only when they were making their presentation to the Pivotal board of directors). At this meeting, Messrs. Ledecky and Griffin gave an extensive presentation about the proposed Business Combination, including potential risks relevant to the Company’s business. The representatives from Northland made a presentation to the board of directors, discussed valuation methodologies and concluded by stating that they believed that the consideration to be paid by Pivotal in the Business Combination was fair to Pivotal from a financial point of view and that the value of the Company as a whole was at least equal to 80% of the amount held in the Pivotal’s trust account (excluding deferred underwriting commissions). After considerable review and discussion of the transaction, the Merger Agreement and related documents were unanimously approved, subject to final negotiations and modifications, and the board of directors determined to recommend the approval of the merger transaction to its stockholders. The Pivotal board of directors also concluded that, based on the report and presentation of Northland, the fair market value of the Company was equal to at least 80% of the funds held in Pivotal’s trust account (excluding deferred underwriting commissions).

Legal counsel to the parties continued to exchange comments to the Merger Agreement and ancillary documents until all agreements were finalized on May 20, 2019.

The Merger Agreement was signed on May 20, 2019. After market close on May 20, 2019, Pivotal and the Company jointly issued a press release announcing the signing of the Merger Agreement. Prior to the market open on May 21, 2019, Pivotal filed a Current Report on Form 8-K announcing the execution of the Merger Agreement and discussing the key terms of the Merger Agreement in detail.

Pivotal’s Board of Directors’ Reasons for Approval of the Business Combination

In evaluating the Business Combination, Pivotal’s board of directors consulted with Pivotal’s management and legal and financial advisors, including Northland. Pivotal’s board of directors reviewed various industry and financial data in order to determine that the consideration to be paid was reasonable and that the Business

 

60


Table of Contents

Combination was in the best interests of Pivotal’s stockholders. The financial data reviewed included the historical and projected consolidated financial statements of the Company, comparable publicly traded company analyses prepared by management, an analysis of pro forma capital structure and trading multiples prepared by management, and similar and other analyses provided by Northland.

Pivotal’s management conducted a due diligence review of the Company that included an industry analysis, an analysis of the existing business model of the Company and historical and projected financial results. Pivotal’s management, including its directors and advisors, has many years of experience in both operational management and investment and financial management and analysis and, in the opinion of Pivotal’s board of directors, was suitably qualified to conduct the due diligence and other investigations and analyses required in connection with the search for a business combination partner. A detailed description of the experience of Pivotal’s executive officers and directors is included in the section of this proxy statement/prospectus entitled “Other Information Related to Pivotal—Directors and Executive Officers.”

In reaching its unanimous resolution (i) that the terms and conditions of the Merger Agreement, including the proposed Business Combination, are advisable, fair to and in the best interests of Pivotal and its stockholders and (ii) to recommend that stockholders adopt and approve the Merger Agreement and approve the Merger contemplated therein, Pivotal’s board of directors considered a range of factors, including but not limited to, the factors discussed below. In light of the number and wide variety of factors, Pivotal’s board of directors did not consider it practicable to, and did not attempt to, quantify or otherwise assign relative weights to the specific factors it considered in reaching its determination. Pivotal’s board of directors viewed its position as being based on all of the information available and the factors presented to and considered by it. In addition, individual directors may have given different weight to different factors. This explanation of Pivotal’s reasons for the Business Combination and all other information presented in this section is forward-looking in nature and, therefore, should be read in light of the factors discussed under the section of this proxy statement/prospectus entitled “ Forward-Looking Statements .”

In considering the Business Combination, Pivotal’s board of directors gave considerable weight to the following factors:

 

   

Experienced Leadership Team with a Proven Track Record . The Company is led by Christopher Weiler, one of the longest tenured chief executive officers in the eDiscovery industry, with a proven track record of acquisition execution;

 

   

Commitment of Current Stockholders . The Company’s current stockholders were retaining 100% of their equity interests in the Business Combination, which the Pivotal board believed reflects their belief in and commitment to the continued growth prospects of the combined company;

 

   

Platform for Future Acquisitions . The Company provides an optimal platform for future strategic acquisitions and tuck-ins with its proven track record of M&A execution and the ample opportunity to consolidate the highly fragmented eDiscovery industry;

 

   

Top Tier Ownership from TCG and RG . TCG’s U.S. Equity Opportunity Fund is a successful middle-market private equity firm focusing on a broad range of small and middle market equity transactions. RG is a Washington D.C.-based growth stage venture capital firm which invests in and actively helps build disruptive, innovative and significant new category-defining companies;

 

   

Attractive Valuation . Pivotal’s board of directors believes the Company’s implied valuation following the Business Combination relative to the current valuations experienced by comparable publicly traded companies in the legal technology sector is favorable for Pivotal.

Pivotal’s board of directors also considered a variety of uncertainties and risks and other potentially negative factors concerning the Business Combination, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Macroeconomic Risks . Macroeconomic uncertainty and the effects it could have on the combined company’s revenues;

 

61


Table of Contents
   

Benefits Not Achieved . The risk that the potential benefits of the Merger may not be fully achieved or may not be achieved within the expected timeframe;

 

   

Competition . Competition in the Company’s industry is intense and often results in price wars, thereby potentially lowering the Company’s profits;

 

   

Indebtedness . The Company’s level of indebtedness was approximately $456.8 million as of the signing of the Merger Agreement and such debt potentially could put pressure on the Company’s operations;

 

   

Ability to Grow through Acquisitions . The Company intends to be acquisitive going forward; however, this puts pressure on management time to properly analyze and diligence potential target businesses;

 

   

Loss of Key Personnel . Key personnel in the Company’s industry is vital and competition for such personnel is intense. The loss of any key personnel could be detrimental to the Company’s operations; and

 

   

Other Risks . Various other risks associated with the Company’s business, as described in the section entitled “Risk Factors” appearing elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Pivotal’s board of directors concluded that the potential benefits that it expected Pivotal and its stockholders to achieve as a result of the Merger outweighed the potentially negative factors associated with the Merger. Accordingly, Pivotal’s board of directors unanimously determined that the Merger Agreement and the Merger contemplated therein were advisable, fair to and in the best interests of Pivotal and its stockholders.

Certain Forecasted Financial Information for the Company

The Company provided Pivotal with its internally prepared forecasts described below. These forecasts were prepared solely for internal use and capital budgeting and other management purposes, are subjective in many respects and therefore susceptible to varying interpretations and the need for periodic revision based on actual experience and business developments, and were not intended for third-party use, including by investors or holders. You are cautioned not to rely on the forecasts in making a decision regarding the Business Combination, as the forecasts may be materially different than actual results.

The forecasts are based on information as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus and reflect numerous assumptions, including assumptions with respect to general business, economic, market, regulatory and financial conditions and various other factors, all of which are difficult to predict and many of which are beyond the Company’s control, such as the risks and uncertainties described in the section entitled “Risk Factors” appearing elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Although the assumptions and estimates on which the forecasts for revenue and costs are based are believed by the Company’s management to be reasonable and based on the best then-currently available information, the financial forecasts are forward-looking statements that are based on assumptions that are inherently subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the Company’s control. While all forecasts are necessarily speculative, the Company believes that the prospective financial information covering periods beyond twelve months from its date of preparation carries increasingly higher levels of uncertainty and should be read in that context. There will be differences between actual and forecasted results, and actual results may be materially greater or materially less than those contained in the forecasts. The inclusion of the forecasted financial information in this proxy statement/prospectus should not be regarded as an indication that the Company or its representatives considered or consider the forecasts to be a reliable prediction of future events, and reliance should not be placed on the forecasts.

The forecasts were requested by, and disclosed to, Pivotal for use as a component in its overall evaluation of the Company, and are included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus on that account. The Company has not warranted the accuracy, reliability, appropriateness or completeness of the forecasts to anyone, including to

 

62


Table of Contents

Pivotal. Neither the Company’s management nor any of its representatives has made or makes any representation to any person regarding the ultimate performance of the Company compared to the information contained in the forecasts, and none of them intends to or undertakes any obligation to update or otherwise revise the forecasts to reflect circumstances existing after the date when made or to reflect the occurrence of future events in the event that any or all of the assumptions underlying the forecasts are shown to be in error. Accordingly, they should not be looked upon as “guidance” of any sort. The Company will not refer back to these forecasts in its future periodic reports filed under the Exchange Act.

The Company does not as a matter of course make public projections as to future sales, earnings or other results. However, the Company’s management has prepared the prospective financial information set forth below to present the key elements of the forecasts provided to Pivotal. The accompanying prospective financial information was not prepared with a view toward public disclosure or with a view toward complying with the guidelines established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants with respect to prospective financial information, but, in the view of the Company’s management, was prepared on a reasonable basis, reflects the best currently available estimates and judgments, and presents, to the best of management’s knowledge and belief, the expected course of action and the expected future financial performance of the Company. However, this information is not fact and should not be relied upon as being necessarily indicative of future results, and readers of this proxy statement/prospectus are cautioned not to place undue reliance on the prospective financial information. Neither the Company’s independent auditors, nor any other independent accountants, have compiled, examined or performed any procedures with respect to the prospective financial information contained herein, nor have they expressed any opinion or any other form of assurance on such information or its achievability, and assume no responsibility for, and disclaim any association with, the prospective financial information.

The key elements of the forecasts provided to Pivotal are summarized below:

 

     Fiscal Year Ended December 31,  

($ in millions)

   2019E      2020E      2021E  

Revenue

   $ 310      $ 347      $ 372  

Adjusted EBITDA (1)(2)

     75        91        98  

Gross Profit (3)

     172        202        218  

 

(1)

The Company defines Adjusted EBITDA as operating income from continued operations plus depreciation and amortization expense, stock based compensation expenses, acquisition related expenses, restructuring charges and other items not reflective of our ongoing business.

(2)

The Company is unable to predict with reasonable certainty factors such as costs and other one-time items related to this transaction, future changes in interest rates, effective income tax rate, the future impact of unusual gains and losses, restructuring, acquisition and integration-related costs and stock based compensation due to the timing of future awards, without unreasonable effort. These items are uncertain, and depend on various factors and so this reconciliation has not been provided. These items and factors could be material to the Company’s results computed in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

(3)

Gross Profit does not include amortization of acquired developed technology intangibles reflected in the U.S. GAAP financial statements.

Opinion of Financial Advisor

In making its determination with respect to the Business Combination, Pivotal’s board of directors also considered the financial analyses prepared by Northland, and the opinion of Northland as of May 17, 2019, as to (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal of the Merger Consideration to be paid pursuant to the Merger Agreement and (ii) whether the business acquired had a combined fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of funds in Pivotal’s trust account (excluding deferred underwriting commissions).

 

63


Table of Contents

Pivotal’s board of directors retained Northland to provide a fairness opinion in connection with its consideration of the Merger. On May 17, 2019, at a meeting of Pivotal’s board of directors held to evaluate the proposed transaction, Northland delivered an oral opinion, subsequently confirmed by delivery of a written opinion to Pivotal’s board of directors, to the effect that, as of that date and based upon and subject to the factors and assumptions set forth therein, (i) the Merger Consideration to be paid by Pivotal in the Business Combination pursuant to the Merger Agreement is fair, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal, and (ii) the fair market value of the Company equals or exceeds 80% of the amount held by Pivotal in trust for benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions).

The full text of the written opinion of Northland, dated May 17, 2019, which sets forth the assumptions made, procedures followed, matters considered and limitations on the review undertaken in connection with the opinion, is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex D . The following summary of Northland’s opinion in this proxy statement/prospectus is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the opinion. Northland provided its opinion for the information and assistance of Pivotal’s board of directors in connection with its consideration of the Business Combination. Northland’s opinion was not intended to and does not constitute a recommendation as to how any holder of Pivotal common stock should vote or take any action with respect to the Business Combination or any other matter.

In arriving at its opinion, Northland, among other things:

 

   

reviewed the financial terms of a draft of the Merger Agreement received on May 15, 2019;

 

   

reviewed and analyzed certain historical financial, operating and business information related to the Company;

 

   

reviewed and analyzed certain internal financial projections of the Company prepared for financial planning purposes and furnished by the management of the Company;

 

   

reviewed and analyzed certain publicly available information related to Pivotal;

 

   

reviewed and analyzed certain historical financial, operating, market and securities data of Pivotal publicly available or furnished by the management of Pivotal, as applicable;

 

   

conducted discussions with members of management of Pivotal with respect to Pivotal’s strategic reasons for pursuing the Merger and Pivotal’s valuation of the Company;

 

   

conducted discussions with members of management of Pivotal and the Company with respect to the business and prospects of Pivotal and the Company, respectively, on a stand-alone basis and on a combined basis;

 

   

reviewed and analyzed the reported prices and trading activity of shares of Pivotal common stock;

 

   

compared the financial performance of the Company with that of certain other publicly traded companies deemed by Northland to be comparable to the Company;

 

   

to the extent publicly available, reviewed and analyzed financial terms of certain acquisition transactions involving companies operating in businesses and industries deemed similar to that in which the Company operates and selected companies deemed by Northland to be comparable to the Company;

 

   

performed discounted cash flows analyses on the Company incorporating various assumptions provided to Northland by the management of each of Pivotal and the Company; and

 

   

compared the fair market value of the Company implied by the various financial analyses that Northland conducted to the amount held by Pivotal in trust for the benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions), as provided by management of the Company and Pivotal, as applicable.

In addition, Northland conducted such other analyses, examinations and inquiries and considered such other financial, economic and market criteria as Northland deemed necessary and appropriate in arriving at its opinion.

 

64


Table of Contents

Summary of Financial Analyses

In accordance with customary investment banking practice, Northland employed generally accepted valuation methods in reaching its fairness opinion. The following is a summary of the material financial analyses performed by Northland in connection with the preparation of its fairness opinion, which was reviewed with, and formally delivered to, Pivotal’s board of directors at a meeting held on May 17, 2019. The preparation of analyses and a fairness opinion is a complex analytic process involving various determinations as to the most appropriate and relevant methods of financial analysis and the application of those methods to the particular circumstances. Therefore, this summary does not purport to be a complete description of the analyses performed by Northland or of its presentation to Pivotal’s board of directors on May 17, 2019.

This summary includes information presented in tabular format, which tables must be read together with the text of each analysis summary and considered as a whole in order to fully understand the financial analyses presented by Northland. The tables alone do not constitute a complete summary of the financial analyses. The order in which these analyses are presented below, and the results of those analyses, should not be taken as an indication of the relative importance or weight given to these analyses by Northland or Pivotal’s board of directors. Except as otherwise noted, the following quantitative information, to the extent that it is based on market data, is based on market data as it existed on or before May 14, 2019 and is not necessarily indicative of current market conditions. All analyses conducted by Pivotal were going concern analyses and Northland expressed no opinion regarding the liquidation value of any entity.

The Merger Consideration was determined through arm’s-length negotiations between Pivotal and the Company and was approved by Pivotal’s board of directors. Northland did not provide advice to Pivotal’s board of directors during these negotiations nor recommend any specific consideration to Pivotal or Pivotal’s board of directors or suggest that any specific consideration constituted the only appropriate consideration for the Merger, including but not limited to the Merger Consideration. In addition, Northland’s opinion and its presentation to Pivotal’s board of directors were one of many factors taken into consideration by Pivotal’s board of directors in deciding to approve the Merger.

For purposes of its financial analyses, Northland utilized the Company’s internal financial projections for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2020, prepared by and furnished to Northland by the management of Pivotal and the Company.

Further, Northland was advised by the management of Pivotal, and Northland assumed with the consent of the management of Pivotal, that, as of the date of its opinion, the amount held by Pivotal in trust for the benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions) was equal to $223.3 million.

Comparable Public Company Analysis

Northland reviewed, among other things, selected historical financial data and estimated financial data of the Company based on projections provided by its management, and compared them to corresponding financial data, where applicable, for U.S. listed public companies that Northland deemed comparable to the Company. Northland also derived multiples for each of the comparable companies and the Company based on such financial data and market trading prices, as applicable, and compared them. Northland selected these companies based on characteristics described below using the most recently available public information obtained by searching SEC filings, public company disclosures, press releases, equity research reports, industry and popular press reports, databases and other sources.

Although Northland selected the companies reviewed in these analyses because, among other things, their businesses are reasonably similar to that of the Company, no selected company is identical to the Company. Accordingly, Northland’s comparison of selected companies to the Company and analysis of the results of such comparison was not purely quantitative, but instead necessarily involved qualitative considerations and professional judgments concerning differences in financial and operating characteristics and other factors that could affect the relative value of the Company.

 

65


Table of Contents

The comparable group consisted of sixteen (16) U.S. publicly traded companies that have financial profiles deemed comparable to the Company, divided into two sections: (1) vertically focused software companies and (2) data protection and archiving companies. Collectively, such group is referred to in this proxy statement/prospectus as the “ Comparable Group .” Based on these criteria, Northland identified and analyzed the following selected companies:

Vertically Focused Software Companies:

 

   

Benefitfocus, Inc.

 

   

Blackbaud, Inc.

 

   

BlackLine, Inc.

 

   

Bottomline Technologies (de), Inc.

 

   

Cornerstone OnDemand, Inc.

 

   

RealPage, Inc.

 

   

SPS Commerce, Inc.

 

   

SS&C Technologies Holdings, Inc.

 

   

Tyler Technologies, Inc.

 

   

Upland Software, Inc.

Data Protection and Archiving Companies:

 

   

Carbonite, Inc.

 

   

Commvault Systems, Inc.

 

   

j2 Global, Inc.

 

   

Open Text Corporation

 

   

Progress Software Corporation

 

   

Zix Corporation

In all instances, multiples were based on closing stock prices on May 14, 2019. With respect to the Comparable Group table below, the information Northland presented included the following valuation and operating data:

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to revenue for the last twelve months (“ EV  / LTM Revenue ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to gross profit for the last twelve months (“ EV  / LTM Gross Profit ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to EBITDA for the last twelve months (“ EV  / LTM EBITDA ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2019 revenue (“ EV /  2019E Revenue ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2019 gross profit (“ EV / 2019E Gross Profit ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2019 EBITDA (“ EV / 2019E EBITDA ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2020 revenue (“ EV / 2020E Revenue ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2020 gross profit (“ EV / 2020E Gross Profit ”)

 

   

multiple of enterprise value to estimated 2020 EBITDA (“ EV  /  2020E EBITDA ”)

 

66


Table of Contents
     Comparable Group  
     25 th
Percentile
     Mean      Median      75 th
Percentile
 

EV / LTM Revenue (1)

     4.8x        6.3x        5.7x        7.6x  

EV / LTM Gross Profit (1)

     8.2x        10.3x        10.0x        12.9x  

EV / LTM EBITDA (1)(2)

     15.2x        27.4x        22.8x        29.1x  

EV / 2019E Revenue (3)

     4.4x        5.4x        5.1x        6.4x  

EV / 2019E Gross Profit (3)

     5.9x        8.2x        8.2x        9.7x  

EV / 2019E EBITDA (2)(3)

     11.7x        22.9x        20.3x        25.5x  

EV / 2020E Revenue (3)

     3.9x        4.9x        4.9x        5.8x  

EV / 2020E Gross Profit (3)

     5.7x        7.3x        7.3x        9.2x  

EV / 2020E EBITDA (2)(3)

     11.0x        20.3x        17.2x        21.9x  

 

(1)

LTM period for the selected public company analysis is based on the latest publicly reported financial results for such company. For the Company, LTM financial results are as of December 31, 2018.

(2)

EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization, stock-based compensation and one-time non-recurring items.

(3)

Projected calendar year 2019 and 2020 revenue, gross profit and EBITDA, as applicable, for the Company were based on projections provided by management of Pivotal and the Company. Projected calendar year 2019 and 2020 revenue, gross profit and EBITDA, as applicable, for the selected public companies were based on equity research analyst consensus estimates.

Based on the analysis above, Northland then applied a private company discount of 30.0% to the equity values of the Comparable Group and applied the range of Comparable Group trading multiples to the applicable revenue, gross profit and EBITDA metrics of the Company. The analysis indicated the following implied enterprise value of the Company as compared to the Company’s projections:

 

           Implied Enterprise Value of the Company  

(dollars in millions)

   The Company     25 th
Percentile
     Mean      Median      75 th
Percentile
 

LTM Revenue

   $ 296.2     $ 1,015      $ 1,351      $ 1,254      $ 1,606  

LTM Gross Profit

   $ 149.9  (1)    $ 851      $ 1,222      $ 1,112      $ 1,383  

LTM EBITDA

   $ 54.6     $ 610      $ 903      $ 849      $ 1,092  

2019E Revenue

   $ 310.0     $ 1,006      $ 1,203      $ 1,206      $ 1,354  

2019E Gross Profit

   $ 172.3  (1)    $ 752      $ 1,015      $ 1,057      $ 1,244  

2019E EBITDA

   $ 74.7     $ 669      $ 1,020      $ 1,035      $ 1,395  

2020E Revenue

   $ 347.2     $ 1,038      $ 1,219      $ 1,270      $ 1,397  

2020E Gross Profit

   $ 202.2  (1)    $ 864      $ 1,072      $ 1,038      $ 1,339  

2020E EBITDA

   $ 91.3     $ 732      $ 1,067      $ 1,153      $ 1,366  

 

(1)

Gross Profit does not include amortization of acquired developed technology intangibles reflected in the U.S. GAAP financial statements.

Comparable M&A Transaction Analysis

Northland performed a comparable M&A transaction analysis, which is designed to imply a value for a company based on publicly available financial terms of the selected transactions that share some characteristics with the Merger. Northland selected these transactions based on information obtained by searching SEC filings, public company disclosures, press releases, equity research reports, industry and popular press reports, databases and other sources. Northland selected these transactions based on the following criteria:

 

   

transactions with a company operating within vertically focused software, document management, eDiscovery, data archiving, data recovery or risk mitigation services;

 

67


Table of Contents
   

transactions announced since January 1, 2015; and

 

   

transactions with publicly available information regarding terms of the transaction.

The group was comprised of the following transactions and is referred to in this proxy statement/prospectus as the “ Precedent Transaction Group ”:

 

Company

  

Buyer

Ellie Mae, Inc.    Thoma Bravo, LLC
Voalte, Inc.    Hill-Rom, Inc.
MicroPact Inc.    Tyler Technologies, Inc.
AppRiver, LLC    Zix Corporation
Visual Compliance    The Descartes Systems Group Inc.
Prescribe Wellness, LLC    Tabula Rasa HealthCare, Inc.
Datawatch Corporation    Altair Engineering Inc.
Viewpoint, Inc.    Trimble Inc.
RPX Corporation    Silver Lake Partners
CM2.Com, Inc.    Zix Corporation
Aconex Limited    Vantive Australia Pty Ltd
Barracuda Networks, Inc.    Thomas Bravo, LLC
Guidance Software, Inc.    Open Text Corporation
Kofax Limited    Thomas Bravo, LLC
Epiq Systems, Inc.    DTI
Recommind, Inc.    Open Text Corporation
Recall Holdings Limited    Iron Mountain Incorporated
SolarWinds Corporation    Silver Lake Partners
LDiscovery, LLC    The Carlyle Group
Huron Consulting Group Inc.    Consilio LLC
Daegis Inc.    Open Text Corporation
Aderant Holdings, Inc.    Roper Technologies, Inc.
Intronis, Inc.    Barracuda Networks, Inc.
Kofax Limited    Lexmark International
Iris Data Services, Inc.    Epiq Systems, Inc.

With respect to the Precedent Transaction Group, Northland calculated the ratio of implied enterprise value to historical revenue and EBITDA for the LTM period and projected revenue and EBITDA for the next twelve month period (the “ NTM period ”). Northland then compared the results of these calculations with similar calculations for the Company.

The selected transactions analysis showed that, based on the estimates and assumptions used in the analysis, the implied valuation multiples of the Company were within the range of valuation multiples of the Precedent Transaction Group when comparing the ratio of the implied enterprise value to the revenue and EBITDA for the LTM period and NTM period.

 

68


Table of Contents

Results of Northland’s analysis were presented for the Precedent Transaction Group, as shown in the following table:

 

     Precedent Transaction Group  

(dollars in millions)

   25 th
Percentile
     Mean      Median      75 th
Percentile
 

Implied EV

   $ 163.0      $ 829.7      $ 268.5      $ 1,200.3  

Implied EV to LTM Revenue (1)

     2.4x        4.2x        3.2x        5.4x  

Implied EV to LTM EBITDA (1)

     11.3x        23.2x        15.5x        33.0x  

Implied EV to NTM Revenue (1)

     2.2x        4.1x        3.1x        6.1x  

Implied EV to NTM EBITDA (1)

     13.5x        17.0x        18.7x        19.8x  

 

(1)

The LTM period and NTM period for the Precedent Transaction Group are based on latest publicly reported financial results.

Based on the analysis above, Northland then applied the range of the Precedent Transaction Group trading multiples to the applicable financial metrics of the Company. The analysis indicated the following implied enterprise value of the Company:

 

       Precedent Transaction Group  

(dollars in millions)

   The Company      25 th
Percentile
     Mean      Median      75 th
Percentile
 

LTM Revenue (1)

   $ 296.2      $ 699      $ 1,237      $ 948      $ 1,587  

LTM EBITDA (1)

   $ 54.6      $ 617      $ 1,267      $ 846      $ 1,801  

NTM Revenue (1)

   $ 310.0      $ 685      $ 1,277      $ 953      $ 1,876  

NTM EBITDA (1)

   $ 74.6      $ 1,011      $ 1,268      $ 1,394      $ 1,477  

 

(1)

LTM period for the Company is as of December 31, 2018.

No target company or transaction utilized in the comparable M&A transaction analysis is identical to the Company or the Merger. In evaluating the precedent transactions, Northland made judgments and assumptions with regard to industry performance, general business, economic, market and financial conditions and other matters, many of which are beyond the control of the Company, such as the impact of competition on the business of the Company or the industry generally, industry growth and the absence of any adverse material change in the financial condition and prospects of the Company, the industry or the financial markets in general.

Discounted Cash Flow Analysis

The discounted cash flow analysis is a widely used valuation methodology that relies upon numerous assumptions, including asset growth rates, earnings growth rates, discount rates and terminal multiples, and the results of such methodology are highly dependent on these assumptions. The analysis does not purport to be indicative of the actual or expected implied enterprise value of the Company or Pivotal on a stand-alone or a pro forma combined basis. In addition, the analysis is based on internal financial projections provided and approved for use by management of the Company and Pivotal. For its analysis, Northland did not include the value of any outstanding federal net operating losses in the implied enterprise value for the Company.

Using such discounted cash flows analysis, Northland calculated an estimated range of implied enterprise values for the Company based on the net present value of hypothetical cash flows through fiscal year 2023 utilizing financial projections for fiscal years 2019 through 2023 provided by, and approved for use by, the management of Pivotal and the Company. Northland calculated the range of net present values based on EBITDA exit multiples ranging from 8.0x to 10.0x and discount rates ranging from 12.5% to 16.5%, based on a weighted average cost of capital analysis. This analysis resulted in an implied enterprise value of the Company ranging from a low of $788 million to a high of $913 million. Northland also calculated the range of net present values

 

69


Table of Contents

based on discount rates ranging from 12.5% to 16.5%, based on a weighted average cost of capital analysis. This analysis resulted in an implied enterprise value of the Company ranging from a low of $741 million to a high of $837 million. Northland observed that the Merger Consideration (whether including or excluding the Contingent Consideration) was below the ranges of implied enterprise values of the Company derived from this analysis.

Miscellaneous

The summary set forth above does not contain a complete description of the analyses performed by Northland, but does summarize the material analyses performed by Northland in rendering its opinion. The preparation of a fairness opinion is a complex process and is not necessarily susceptible to partial analysis or summary description. Northland believes that its analyses and the summary set forth above must be considered as a whole and that selecting portions of its analyses or of the summary, without considering the analyses as a whole or all of the factors included in its analyses, would create an incomplete view of the processes underlying the analyses set forth in the Northland opinion. In arriving at its opinion, Northland considered the results of all of its analyses and did not attribute any particular weight to any factor or analysis. Instead, Northland made its determination as to fairness on the basis of its experience and financial judgment after considering the results of all of its analyses. The fact that any specific analysis has been referred to in the summary above is not meant to indicate that this analysis was given greater weight than any other analysis. In addition, the ranges of valuations resulting from any particular analysis described above should not be taken to be Northland’s view of the actual value of the Company or the combined company.

No company or transaction used in the above analyses as a comparison is directly comparable to Pivotal, the Company, the Merger or the other transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement. Accordingly, an analysis of the results of the comparisons is not mathematical; rather, it involves complex considerations and judgments about differences in the companies and transactions to which Pivotal, the Company and the Business Combination were compared and other factors that could affect the public trading value or transaction value of the companies involved, as applicable.

Northland performed its analyses solely for purposes of providing its opinion to Pivotal’s board of directors. In performing its analyses, Northland made numerous assumptions with respect to industry performance, general business and economic conditions and other matters. Certain of the analyses performed by Northland are based upon forecasts of future results furnished to Northland by outside financial advisors and confirmed by members of Pivotal’s board of directors and the management of Pivotal and the Company, which are not necessarily indicative of actual future results and may be significantly more or less favorable than actual future results. These forecasts are inherently subject to uncertainty because, among other things, they are based upon numerous factors or events beyond the control of the parties or their respective advisors. Northland does not assume responsibility if future results are materially different from forecasted results.

Northland relied upon and assumed, without assuming liability or responsibility for independent verification, the accuracy and completeness of all information that was publicly available or was furnished, or otherwise made available, to Northland or discussed with or reviewed by Northland. Northland further relied upon the assurances of the management of Pivotal and the Company that the financial information provided to Northland was prepared on a reasonable basis in accordance with industry practice, and that the management of each of Pivotal and the Company was not aware of any information or facts that would make any information provided to Northland incomplete or misleading. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, for the purpose of Northland’s opinion, Northland assumed that with respect to financial forecasts, estimates of net operating loss tax benefits or other estimates and other forward-looking information reviewed by Northland, that such information was reasonably prepared based on assumptions reflecting the best currently available estimates and judgments of the management of Pivotal and the Company as to the expected future results of operations and financial condition of Pivotal, the Company and the combined company following the consummation of the Business Combination. Northland expressed no opinion as to any such financial forecasts, net operating loss or other estimates or forward-looking information or the assumptions on which they were based. Northland relied,

 

70


Table of Contents

with Pivotal’s consent, on advice of outside counsel and Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm, and on the assumptions of the management of Pivotal and the Company, as to all accounting, legal, regulatory, tax and financial reporting matters with respect to Pivotal, the Company and the Business Combination. Northland’s opinion does not address any accounting, legal, regulatory, tax or financial reporting matters.

In arriving at its opinion, Northland assumed that the executed Merger Agreement was in all material respects identical to the last draft reviewed by Northland on May 15, 2019. Northland relied upon and assumed, without independent verification, that (i) the representations and warranties of all parties to the Merger Agreement and all other related documents and instruments that are referred to therein were true and correct, (ii) each party to such agreements would fully and timely perform all of the covenants and agreements required to be performed by such party pursuant to the Merger Agreement, (iii) the Business Combination would be consummated pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement without amendments thereto and (iv) all conditions to the consummation of the Business Combination would be satisfied without waiver by any party of any conditions or obligations thereunder. Additionally, Northland assumed that all the necessary regulatory approvals and consents required for the Business Combination would be obtained in a manner that would not adversely affect Pivotal, the Company or the contemplated benefits of the Business Combination.

In arriving at its opinion, Northland did not perform any appraisals, valuations or other independent analyses of any specific assets or liabilities (fixed, contingent or other) of Pivotal or the Company, and was not furnished or provided with any such appraisals or valuations, nor did Northland evaluate the solvency of Pivotal or the Company under any state or federal law relating to bankruptcy, insolvency or similar matters. The analyses performed by Northland in connection with its opinion were going concern analyses. Northland expressed no opinion regarding the liquidation value of Pivotal, the Company or any other entity. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, Northland undertook no independent analysis of any pending or threatened litigation, regulatory action, possible unasserted claims or other contingent liabilities to which Pivotal, the Company or any of its affiliates was a party or may be subject, and at the direction of Pivotal and with its consent, Northland’s opinion made no assumption concerning, and therefore did not consider, the possible assertion of claims, outcomes or damages arising out of any such matters. Northland also assumed that neither Pivotal nor the Company is a party to any material pending transaction, including without limitation any financing, recapitalization, acquisition or merger, other than the Business Combination.

Northland’s opinion was necessarily based upon the information available to it and facts and circumstances as they existed and were subject to evaluation on the date of its opinion. Events occurring after the date of its opinion could materially affect the assumptions used in preparing its opinion. Northland did not express any opinion as to the price at which shares of Pivotal common stock have traded or may trade following announcement of the Business Combination or at any future time. Northland did not undertake to reaffirm or revise its opinion or otherwise comment upon any events occurring after the date of its opinion and does not have any obligation to update, revise or reaffirm its opinion.

Northland’s opinion addressed solely (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal of the Merger Consideration to be paid in the Business Combination pursuant to the Merger Agreement, and (ii) whether the fair market value of the Company equals or exceeds 80% of the amount held by Pivotal in trust for benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions), and did not address any other terms or agreement relating to the Business Combination or related transactions. Northland was not requested to opine as to, and its opinion does not address, the basic business decision to proceed with or effect the Business Combination, the merits of the Business Combination relative to any alternative transaction or business strategy that may be available to Pivotal or any other terms contemplated by the Merger Agreement. Furthermore, Northland expressed no opinion with respect to the amount or nature of the compensation to any officer, director or employee, or any class of such persons, relative to the compensation to be received by the holders of any class of securities, creditors or other constituencies of Pivotal or the Company in the Business Combination, or relative to or in comparison with the Merger Consideration.

 

71


Table of Contents

Northland is a nationally recognized investment banking firm and regularly provides fairness opinion services in connection with mergers and acquisitions, underwritings, secondary distributions of listed and unlisted securities, private placements and valuations for corporate and other purposes. Pivotal’s board of directors selected Northland to render its fairness opinion in connection with the Business Combination contemplated by the Merger Agreement on the basis of its experience and reputation in providing fairness opinions in connection with mergers, acquisitions and other similar transactions.

Pursuant to the terms of the engagement letter dated May 13, 2019, Northland rendered to Pivotal’s board of directors a fairness opinion in connection with the Business Combination and will receive an aggregate fee of $250,000 from Pivotal of which $50,000 was due upon delivery of the fairness opinion with the remaining $200,000 due upon the consummation of the Merger (collectively, the “ Opinion Fee ”). The Opinion Fee was not contingent on the conclusions reached in Northland’s opinion. Additionally, Pivotal has agreed to indemnify Northland against certain liabilities and to reimburse Northland for certain expenses in connection with its services. Furthermore, Northland was not requested to, and did not, (i) participate in negotiations with respect to the Merger Agreement, (ii) solicit any expressions of interest from any other parties with respect to any business combination with Pivotal or any other alternative transaction or (iii) advise Pivotal’s board of directors or any other party with respect to alternatives to the Business Combination. In addition, Northland was not requested to and did not provide advice regarding the structure or any other aspect of the Business Combination or services other than the delivery of its opinion. Northland has not otherwise acted as financial advisor to any party to the Business Combination. In the ordinary course of its business, Northland and its affiliates may actively trade securities of Pivotal for its own account or the account of its customers and, accordingly, may at any time hold a long or short position in such securities. Northland has not received fees or other compensation from Pivotal or the Company in the past two years prior to the issuance of its opinion. Northland and its affiliates may from time to time perform various investment banking and financial advisory services for Pivotal and for other clients and customers that may have conflicting interests with Pivotal, for which Northland would expect to receive compensation.

Consistent with applicable legal and regulatory requirements, Northland has adopted policies and procedures to establish and maintain the independence of Northland’s research department and personnel. As a result, Northland’s research analysts may hold opinions, make statements or investment recommendations and/or publish research reports with respect to the Business Combination and other participants in the Business Combination that differ from the opinions of Northland’s investment banking personnel.

Satisfaction of 80% Test

It is a requirement under Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation that any business acquired by Pivotal have a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in the trust account (excluding the deferred underwriting commissions) at the time of the execution of a definitive agreement for an initial business combination. Based on the financial analyses used to approve the Business Combination described herein, Pivotal’s board of directors determined that this requirement was met. In reaching this determination, Pivotal’s board of directors concluded that it was appropriate to base such valuation on qualitative factors such as management strength and depth, competitive positioning, customer relationships and technical skills as well as quantitative factors such as the historical growth rate and potential for future growth in revenues and profits of the Company. Pivotal’s board of directors believes that the financial skills and background of its members qualify it to conclude that the acquisition met this requirement. In addition, Pivotal’s board of directors considered the financial analyses prepared by Northland, and the opinion of Northland as of May 17, 2019, as to whether the business acquired has a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in Pivotal’s trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of the Merger Agreement.

 

72


Table of Contents

Interests of the Founder and Pivotal’s Directors and Officers in the Business Combination

In considering the recommendation of Pivotal’s board of directors to vote in favor of approval of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals and the other proposals, stockholders should keep in mind that the Founder and Pivotal’s directors and executive officers have interests in such proposals that are different from, or in addition to, those of Pivotal’s stockholders generally. In particular:

 

   

If the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not consummated by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal’s stockholders), Pivotal will cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, redeeming 100% of the outstanding public shares for cash and, subject to the approval of its remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolving and liquidating. In such event, the 5,750,000 founder shares held by Founder and Pivotal’s directors and officers, which were acquired for an aggregate purchase price of $25,000 prior to Pivotal’s initial public offering, would be worthless because the holders are not entitled to participate in any redemption or distribution with respect to such shares. Such shares had an aggregate market value of $                 based upon the closing price of $                 per share on NYSE on                 , 2019, the record date.

 

   

The Founder, which is affiliated with certain of Pivotal’s directors and officers, purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 private warrants from Pivotal for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $6,350,000 (or $1.00 per warrant). These purchases took place on a private placement basis simultaneously with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering. All of the proceeds Pivotal received from these purchases were placed in the trust account. Such warrants had an aggregate market value of $                 based upon the closing price of $                 per unit on NYSE on                 , 2019, the record date. The private warrants will become worthless if Pivotal does not consummate a business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation).

 

   

The Stockholders’ Agreement contemplated by the Merger Agreement provides that Jonathan J. Ledecky and Kevin Griffin will be directors of Pivotal after the closing of the Merger (assuming they are elected at the annual meeting as described in this proxy statement/prospectus). As such, in the future each will receive any cash fees, stock options or stock awards that Pivotal’s board of directors determines to pay to its non-executive directors.

 

   

If Pivotal is unable to complete a business combination within the required time period, the Founder will be personally liable under certain circumstances described herein to ensure that the proceeds in the trust account are not reduced by the claims of target businesses or claims of vendors or other entities that are owed money by Pivotal for services rendered or contracted for or products sold to Pivotal. If Pivotal consummates a business combination, on the other hand, Pivotal will be liable for all such claims.

 

   

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers, directors and their affiliates are entitled to reimbursement of out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in connection with certain activities on Pivotal’s behalf, such as identifying and investigating possible business targets and business combinations. However, if Pivotal fails to consummate a business combination within the required period, they will not have any claim against the trust account for reimbursement. Accordingly, Pivotal may not be able to reimburse these expenses if the Business Combination with the Company or another business combination is not completed by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation). As of                 , 2019, the record date, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers, directors and their affiliates had incurred approximately $                 of unpaid reimbursable expenses.

 

   

The Merger Agreement provides for the continued indemnification of Pivotal’s current directors and officers and the continuation of directors and officers liability insurance covering Pivotal’s current directors and officers.

 

   

Pivotal’s officers and directors (or their affiliates) may make loans from time to time to Pivotal to fund certain capital requirements. As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, no such loans have been

 

73


Table of Contents
 

made; however, loans may be made after the date of this proxy statement/prospectus. If the Business Combination is not consummated, the loans will not be repaid and will be forgiven except to the extent there are funds available to Pivotal outside of the trust account.

Recommendation of Pivotal’s Board of Directors

After careful consideration of the matters described above, particularly the Company’s position in its industry, potential for growth and profitability, the experience of the Company’s management and the Company’s competitive positioning, its customer relationships and technical skills, Pivotal’s board determined unanimously that each of the business combination proposal, the charter proposals, the director election proposal, the incentive plan proposal and the adjournment proposal, if presented, is fair to and in the best interests of Pivotal and its stockholders. Pivotal’s board of directors has approved and declared advisable and unanimously recommend that you vote or give instructions to vote “FOR” each of these proposals.

The foregoing discussion of the information and factors considered by Pivotal’s board of directors is not meant to be exhaustive, but includes the material information and factors considered by Pivotal’s board of directors.

Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Merger

The following section is a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences for holders of Pivotal common stock and holders of warrants to acquire Pivotal common stock of the Business Combination. The discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences contained in this proxy statement/prospectus is intended to provide only a general discussion and is not a complete analysis or description of all potential U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Business Combination.

This discussion addresses only those holders that hold their common stock or warrants as a capital asset within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code and does not address all the U.S. federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to holders in light of their individual circumstances or to holders that are subject to special rules, such as:

 

   

financial institutions;

 

   

investors in pass-through entities;

 

   

tax-exempt organizations;

 

   

dealers in securities or currencies;

 

   

traders in securities that elect to use a mark to market method of accounting;

 

   

persons that hold Pivotal common stock as part of a straddle, hedge, constructive sale or conversion transaction;

 

   

Non-U.S. holders (as defined below, and except as otherwise discussed below);

 

   

persons that own (or are treated as owning) 5% or more of Pivotal’s common stock;

 

   

persons who exercise redemption rights but continue to own, actually or constructively, Pivotal common stock following the Merger;

 

   

persons who hold or receive Pivotal common stock as compensation; and

 

   

persons who are making charitable contributions of Pivotal common stock in connection with the Merger.

The discussion is based upon the Code, applicable Treasury regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions, all as currently in effect as of the date hereof, and all of which are subject to change, possibly with

 

74


Table of Contents

retroactive effect. Tax considerations under state, local and foreign laws, or federal laws other than those pertaining to the income tax (including the impact of the Medicare contribution tax on net investment income), are not addressed.

Neither Pivotal nor the Company intends to request any ruling from the Internal Revenue Service as to the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Merger.

For purposes of this discussion, a U.S. holder is a beneficial owner of Pivotal common stock or warrants who or which is any of the following for U.S. federal income tax purposes:

 

   

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

   

a corporation, including any entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia;

 

   

an estate if its income is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or

 

   

a trust if (a) a U.S. court can exercise primary supervision over its administration and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all of its substantial decisions, or (b) it has in effect a valid election under applicable U.S. treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

For purposes of this discussion, a “Non-U.S. holder” is a beneficial owner of Pivotal common stock or warrants who is neither a U.S. holder nor an entity that is treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Tax Consequences of the Merger

Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal.

No gain or loss is expected to be recognized for U.S. federal income tax purposes by Pivotal or by the stockholders of Pivotal (whether such holders are U.S. holders or Non-U.S. holders) if their conversion rights are not exercised. No gain or loss is expected to be recognized for U.S. federal income tax purposes by holders of warrants to acquire Pivotal common stock (whether such holders are U.S. holders or Non-U.S. holders) solely as a result of the Merger.

A stockholder of Pivotal that is a U.S. holder who exercises conversion rights and effects a complete termination of the stockholder’s interest in Pivotal is anticipated to be required to recognize gain or loss upon the exchange of that stockholder’s shares of common stock of Pivotal for cash. Such gain or loss will be measured by the difference between the amount of cash received and the tax basis of that stockholder’s shares of Pivotal common stock. This gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss if the holding period for the share of Pivotal common stock is more than one year. Gain and loss recognized on a conversion of Pivotal common stock for cash must generally be determined separately for each block of Pivotal shares (i.e., stock acquired at the same cost in a single transaction).

A stockholder of Pivotal that is a Non-U.S. holder who exercises conversion rights and effects a complete termination of the stockholder’s interest in Pivotal will generally be treated in the same manner as a U.S. stockholder for U.S. federal income tax purposes except that (subject to the discussion of FATCA below) such Non-U.S. holder generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the conversion unless (i) such holder is engaged in a trade or business within the United States and any gain recognized in the conversion is treated as effectively connected with such trade or business or (ii) such holder is an individual who is present in the United States for 183 days or more during the taxable year of the exchange and certain other requirements are met.

Gain described in clause (i) will generally be subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis at the regular graduated rates. A Non-U.S. holder that is a corporation also may be subject to a branch profits tax at a

 

75


Table of Contents

rate of 30% (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on such effectively connected gain, as adjusted for certain items. Gain described in clause (ii) will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty), which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses of the Non-U.S. holder, provided the Non-U.S. holder has timely filed U.S. federal income tax returns with respect to such losses.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

Proceeds of the sale or other taxable disposition of Pivotal common stock to Non-U.S. holders who exercise conversion rights generally will not be subject to backup withholding or information reporting, provided that the relevant holder certifies its non-U.S. status, such as by furnishing a valid IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E or W-8ECI, or otherwise establishing an exemption. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against a Non-U.S. holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the required information is timely furnished to the Internal Revenue Service.

Additional Withholding Tax on Payments Made to Foreign Accounts

Withholding taxes may be imposed under sections 1471 to 1474 of the Code (such sections commonly referred to as the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act, or “ FATCA ”) on certain types of payments made to non-U.S. financial institutions and certain other non-U.S. entities. Specifically, a 30% withholding tax may be imposed on (subject to the proposed Treasury Regulations discussed below) gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of securities paid to a “foreign financial institution” or a “non-financial foreign entity” (each as defined in the Code), unless (1) the foreign financial institution undertakes certain diligence and reporting obligations, (2) the non-financial foreign entity either certifies it does not have any “substantial United States owners” (as defined in the Code) or furnishes identifying information regarding each substantial United States owner or (3) the foreign financial institution or non-financial foreign entity otherwise qualifies for an exemption from these rules. If the payee is a foreign financial institution and is subject to the diligence and reporting requirements in (1) above, it must enter into an agreement with the U.S. Department of the Treasury requiring, among other things, that it undertake to identify accounts held by certain “specified United States persons” or “United States owned foreign entities” (each as defined in the Code), annually report certain information about such accounts, and withhold 30% on certain payments to non-compliant foreign financial institutions and certain other account holders. Foreign financial institutions located in jurisdictions that have an intergovernmental agreement with the United States governing FATCA may be subject to different rules.

Under the applicable Treasury Regulations and administrative guidance, while withholding under FATCA would have applied to payments of gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of securities on or after January 1, 2019, recently proposed Treasury Regulations eliminate FATCA withholding on payments of gross proceeds. Taxpayers generally may rely on these proposed Treasury Regulations until final Treasury Regulations are issued.

This discussion is intended to provide only a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Merger. It does not address tax consequences that may vary with, or are contingent on, your individual circumstances. In addition, the discussion does not address any non-income tax or any foreign, state or local tax consequences of the Merger or exercise of conversion rights. Accordingly, you are strongly urged to consult with your tax advisor to determine the particular U.S. federal, state, local or foreign income or other tax consequences to you of the Merger and exercise of conversion rights.

Anticipated Accounting Treatment

The Merger will be accounted for as a reverse merger in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Under this method of accounting, Pivotal will be treated as the “acquired” company for financial reporting purposes. This

 

76


Table of Contents

determination was primarily based on (i) the Company being expected to have the majority interest of the combined company, (ii) the Company being represented on the board of directors of the combined company by up to three members, in addition to the chief executive officer of the Company, (iii) the Company’s senior management comprising the senior management of the combined company and (iv) the Company’s operations comprising the ongoing operations of the combined company. Accordingly, for accounting purposes, the Merger will be treated as the equivalent of the Company issuing stock for the net assets of Pivotal, accompanied by a recapitalization. The net assets of Pivotal will be stated at historical cost, with no goodwill or other intangible assets recorded. Operations prior to the Merger will be those of the Company.

Regulatory Matters

The Merger is not subject to any federal or state regulatory requirement or approval, except for the filings with the State of Delaware necessary to effectuate the Merger, and the filing of required notifications and the expiration or termination of the required waiting periods under the HSR Act. On June 14, 2019, the parties received notice from the FTC that early termination of the waiting period under the HSR Act was granted in connection with the Merger.

Required Vote

The approval of the business combination proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Pivotal common stock present and entitled to vote at the annual meeting. Additionally, the Business Combination will not be consummated if Pivotal has less than $5,000,001 of net tangible assets in the trust account after taking into account the conversion into cash of all public shares properly demanded to be converted by holders of public shares.

The approval of the business combination proposal is a condition to the consummation of the Business Combination. If the business combination proposal is not approved, the other proposals (except an adjournment proposal, as described below) will not be presented to the stockholders for a vote.

THE PIVOTAL BOARD OF DIRECTORS UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT THE PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” THE APPROVAL OF THE BUSINESS COMBINATION PROPOSAL.

 

77


Table of Contents

THE MERGER AGREEMENT

For a discussion of the structure of the transactions and consideration, see the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal .” Such discussion and the following summary of other material provisions of the Merger Agreement is qualified by reference to the complete text of the Merger Agreement, a copy of which is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex A . All stockholders are encouraged to read the Merger Agreement in its entirety for a more complete description of the terms and conditions of the transactions.

Closing and Effective Time of the Business Combination

The closing of the Business Combination will take place no later than the fifth business day following the satisfaction or waiver of the conditions described below under the subsection entitled “ Conditions to the Closing of the Business Combination ,” unless the parties to the Merger Agreement agree in writing to another time. The Business Combination is expected to be consummated as soon as practicable after the annual meeting of Pivotal’s stockholders described in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Representations and Warranties

The Merger Agreement contains representations and warranties of the Company relating, among other things, to proper organization and qualification; subsidiaries; capitalization, the authorization, performance and enforceability against the Company of the Merger Agreement; absence of conflicts; consent, approval or authorization of governmental authorities; financial statements; absence of undisclosed liabilities; absence of certain changes or events; litigation; compliance with laws; material contracts; benefit plans; labor matters; tax matters; brokers’ fees; insurance; assets and real property; environmental matters; transactions with affiliates; internal controls; intellectual property matters; and permits.

The Merger Agreement contains representations and warranties of each of Pivotal and Merger Sub relating, among other things, to proper organization and qualification; subsidiaries; the authorization, performance and enforceability against Pivotal and Merger Sub of the Merger Agreement; absence of conflicts; litigation; consent, approval or authorization of governmental authorities; trust account; brokers’ fees; reports filed with the SEC, financial statements, Sarbanes-Oxley Act and absence of undisclosed liabilities; transactions with affiliates; board approval; fairness opinion with respect to the Merger; business activities; tax matters; capitalization; and NYSE listing.

Covenants

Pivotal and the Company have each agreed to take such actions as are necessary, proper or advisable to consummate the transactions set forth in the Merger Agreement. Each of them has also agreed to continue to operate their respective businesses in the ordinary course consistent with past practices prior to the closing and not to take the following actions, among others, except as permitted by the Merger Agreement, without the prior written consent of the other parties:

 

   

waive any stock repurchase rights, accelerate, amend or change the period of exercisability of options or restricted stock, or reprice options granted under any employee, consultant, director or other stock plans or authorize cash payments in exchange for any options granted under any of such plans;

 

   

grant any material severance or termination pay to officers or employees not in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice, except pursuant to existing agreements, policies or plans, or pursuant to applicable law;

 

   

transfer or license to any person or otherwise extend, amend or modify any material rights to intellectual property or enter into grants to transfer or license to any person future patent rights, other than in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices;

 

78


Table of Contents
   

declare, set aside or pay dividends on or make any other distributions in respect of any capital stock, or split, combine or reclassify any capital stock or issue or authorize the issuance of any other securities in respect of, in lieu of or in substitution for any capital stock;

 

   

purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, directly or indirectly, any shares of capital stock or other equity securities or ownership interests of the Company or Pivotal;

 

   

issue, deliver, sell, authorize, pledge or otherwise encumber any equity securities or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for other equity securities, or enter into other agreements obligating it to issue equity securities or convertible or exchangeable securities;

 

   

amend its certificate of incorporation or bylaws in any material respect;

 

   

acquire or agree to acquire, whether by merger, stock or asset acquisition, or other transaction any business, entity or division thereof, or otherwise acquire or agree to acquire outside the ordinary course of business any assets which are material to the business of Pivotal or the Company, as applicable, or enter into any joint ventures, strategic partnerships or alliances or other arrangements that provide for exclusivity of territory or otherwise restrict such party’s ability to compete or to offer or sell any products or services;

 

   

sell, lease, license, encumber or otherwise dispose of any material properties or assets, except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice;

 

   

except incurrences of indebtedness under the Company’s existing credit facilities and extensions of credit in the ordinary course with employees and among the Company and its subsidiaries, incur any indebtedness for borrowed money or guarantee any such indebtedness of another, issue or sell any debt securities or options, warrants, calls or other rights to acquire any debt securities of Pivotal or the Company and its subsidiaries, as applicable, enter into any “keep well” or other agreement to maintain any financial statement condition or enter into any arrangement having the economic effect of any of the foregoing;

 

   

except as otherwise required by applicable law or pursuant to an existing plan, policy or agreement, or in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice, (i) adopt or materially amend any employee benefit plan (including any plan that provides for severance), or enter into any employment contract or collective bargaining agreement, (ii) pay any special bonus or special remuneration to any director or employee or (iii) materially increase the salaries, wage rates or fringe benefits (including rights to severance or indemnification) of its directors, officers, employees or consultants;

 

   

(i) pay, discharge, settle or satisfy any material claims, liabilities or obligations (absolute, accrued, asserted or unasserted, contingent or otherwise), or litigation other than in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices or as previously disclosed in such party’s financial statements or (ii) waive the benefits of, agree to modify in any material manner, terminate, release any person from or knowingly fail to enforce any material confidentiality or similar agreement to which it is a party or beneficiary;

 

   

except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices, modify in any material respect or terminate (other than in accordance with its terms) certain material contracts, or waive, delay the exercise of, release or assign any material rights or claims thereunder;

 

   

except as required by law or U.S. GAAP, revalue any of its assets in any material manner or make any material change in accounting methods, principles or practices;

 

   

except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices, incur or enter into any agreement, contract or commitment requiring such party to pay in excess of $1,000,000 in any 12-month period;

 

   

settle any material litigation where the consideration given by the party is other than monetary or to which an officer, director or employee of such person is a party in his or her capacity as such;

 

79


Table of Contents
   

make or rescind tax elections that would be reasonably likely to adversely affect in any material respect the tax liability or attributes of such party, settle or compromise any material income tax liability outside the ordinary course of business or, except as required by applicable law, change any material method of accounting for tax purposes or prepare or file any return in a manner materially inconsistent with past practice;

 

   

form or establish a subsidiary except in the ordinary course of business consistent with prior practice;

 

   

permit any person to exercise discretionary rights under any employee benefit plan to provide for the automatic acceleration of any outstanding options, the termination of any outstanding repurchase rights or the termination of any cancellation rights issued pursuant to such plans;

 

   

make capital expenditures in excess of previously budgeted amounts;

 

   

enter into any material transaction with or distribute or advance any assets or property to any of its officers, directors, partners, stockholders, managers, members or other affiliates other than (i) the payment of salary and benefits and the advancement of expenses in the ordinary course of business consistent with prior practice, (ii) such distributions or advancements by a subsidiary of the Company to the Company or another such subsidiary or (iii) contracts entered into on an arms’-length basis and in the ordinary course of business between the Company or any subsidiary, on the one hand, and the direct or indirect portfolio companies of investment funds advised or managed by Carlyle Investment Management L.L.C. (“ CIM ”), on the other hand; or

 

   

agree in writing or otherwise commit to take any of the foregoing actions.

The Merger Agreement also contains additional covenants of the parties, including covenants providing that:

 

   

Pivotal will prepare and file the registration statement of which this proxy statement/prospectus forms a part;

 

   

the Company will give notice in accordance with Delaware Law and its charter documents seeking stockholder approval of the Merger;

 

   

Pivotal will increase the number of members of its board of directors to eight and the parties will take all necessary action so that Dan Akerson (chairman of the board), Jonathan J. Ledecky (vice chairman of the board of directors), Christopher J. Weiler, Kevin Griffin, William Darman, Richard J. Williams, Donna Morea and Evan Morgan are appointed to the board of directors;

 

   

the parties will prepare and file any required notification pursuant to the HSR Act;

 

   

the Company and its affiliates will waive their rights to make claims against Pivotal to collect from the trust account any monies that may be owed to them by Pivotal;

 

   

the parties will use reasonable best efforts to obtain the listing for trading on the NYSE of the common stock issued in connection with the Business Combination;

 

   

Pivotal will maintain tail directors’ and officers’ liability insurance policies for a period of six years following the Business Combination;

 

   

the executive officers of the Company will repay any amounts owed by them to the Company and cause any guaranty made by the Company for the benefit of them to be terminated;

 

   

Pivotal will cause the trust account to be distributed immediately upon consummation of the Business Combination and to pay all liabilities and obligations of Pivotal due or incurred at or prior to the date of closing, including (i) payment to the holders of public shares who elect to convert their shares into cash, (ii) payment of Pivotal’s income and other tax obligations, (iii) repayment of loans and reimbursement of expenses to directors and officers of Pivotal, (iv) payments of deferred underwriting commissions incurred in connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering and (v) payment of third-party transaction costs incurred by Pivotal;

 

80


Table of Contents
   

at or prior to the closing of the Business Combination, Pivotal will enter into the Stockholders’ Agreement with certain of the Company’s stockholders;

 

   

the former stockholders of the Company and the Founder will agree to the additional lock-up restrictions described herein;

 

   

at or prior to the closing of the Business Combination, Pivotal will execute and deliver the Registration Rights Agreement and use reasonable best efforts to terminate the existing registration rights agreement among Pivotal, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors;

 

   

the parties will use commercially reasonable efforts to do all things necessary, proper or advisable to consummate and make effective the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement, including obtaining all necessary approvals from governmental agencies and other third parties;

 

   

the parties will not solicit or enter into discussions or transactions with, or encourage or provide any information to any third party, and to immediately cease all existing discussions or negotiations with any third party, regarding any merger, sale of ownership interests or assets; and

 

   

the Company will provide periodic financial information to Pivotal through the closing date of the Merger.

Conditions to Closing of the Business Combination

General Conditions

Consummation of the Business Combination is conditioned on approval of the business combination proposal by Pivotal’s stockholders. In addition, the consummation of the Merger is conditioned upon, among other things:

 

   

all specified waiting periods under the HSR Act having expired;

 

   

no statute, rule, regulation, executive order, decree, injunction or other order being in effect and which has the effect of making the Merger illegal or otherwise prohibiting consummation of the Merger;

 

   

no action, suit or proceeding being pending or threatened by any governmental entity which is reasonably likely to prevent consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement or to materially and adversely affect the title of the shares of Pivotal common stock to be issued in connection with the Merger, and no order, judgment, decree, stipulation or injunction to such effect being in effect;

 

   

Pivotal having at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets remaining prior to the Merger following the exercise by holders of Pivotal’s public shares of their right to convert their public shares into their pro rata share of the trust account;

 

   

the registration statement of which this proxy statement/prospectus forms a part having become effective in accordance with the provisions of the Securities Act, no stop order having been issued by the SEC which remains in effect with respect to the registration statement, and no proceeding seeking such a stop order having been threatened or initiated by the SEC which remains pending;

 

   

no material adverse effect with respect to Pivotal or the Company having occurred between the date of the Merger Agreement and the closing of the Business Combination; and

 

   

approval of the Business Combination by the Company’s stockholders.

Conditions to Closing of the Company

The obligations of the Company to consummate the Merger are also conditioned upon, among other things:

 

   

the accuracy of the representations and warranties of Pivotal and Merger Sub (subject to certain bring-down standards);

 

81


Table of Contents
   

performance of the covenants of Pivotal and Merger Sub required by the Merger Agreement to be performed on or prior to the closing;

 

   

Pivotal executing the Registration Rights Agreement and terminating the existing registration rights agreement among Pivotal, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors;

 

   

Pivotal executing the Stockholders’ Agreement;

 

   

Pivotal and the Founder executing the Founder Lock-Up Agreement;

 

   

Pivotal’s compliance with the Securities Act and the Exchange Act;

 

   

Pivotal having at least $175 million available to it in its trust account (together with net cash proceeds received from any investment in Pivotal approved pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, including up to $50 million pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any)), after payment to holders of public shares that seek conversion in connection with the Business Combination and net of certain other expenses; and

 

   

Pivotal common stock to be issued pursuant to the Merger Agreement having been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject only to official notice of issuance thereof and public holder requirements.

Pivotal’s and Merger Sub’s Conditions to Closing

The obligations of Pivotal and Merger Sub to consummate the Merger are also conditioned upon, among other things:

 

   

the accuracy of the representations and warranties of the Company (subject to certain bring-down standards);

 

   

performance of the covenants of the Company required by the Merger Agreement to be performed on or prior to the closing; and

 

   

the termination of the Company’s existing stockholders’ agreement.

Waiver

If permitted under applicable law, Pivotal or the Company may waive any inaccuracies in the representations and warranties made to such party contained in the Merger Agreement and waive compliance with any agreements or conditions for the benefit of itself or such party contained in the Merger Agreement. However, the condition requiring that Pivotal have at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets may not be waived.

The existence of the financial and personal interests of Pivotal’s directors may result in a conflict of interest on the part of one or more of them between what he or she may believe is best for Pivotal and what he or she may believe is best for himself in determining whether or not to grant a waiver in a specific situation. See the section entitled “ Risk Factors ” for a fuller discussion of this and other risks.

Termination

The Merger Agreement may be terminated at any time, but not later than the closing, as follows:

 

   

by mutual written consent of Pivotal and the Company;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if the Business Combination is not consummated on or before October 30, 2019, provided that the right to terminate the Merger Agreement will not be available to any party whose action or failure to act has been a principal cause of or primarily resulted in the failure of the Merger to occur on or before such date and such action or failure to act constitutes a breach of the Merger Agreement;

 

82


Table of Contents
   

by either Pivotal or the Company if a governmental entity shall have issued an order, decree or ruling or taken any other action, in any case having the effect of permanently restraining, enjoining or otherwise prohibiting the Merger, which order, decree, judgment, ruling or other action is final and non-appealable;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if, immediately following consummation of the Merger, Pivotal will have less than $5,000,001 of net tangible assets following the exercise by the holders of shares of Pivotal common stock issued in Pivotal’s initial public offering of their conversion rights;

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if the other party has breached any of its covenants or representations and warranties in any material respect and has not cured its breach within 30 days of the notice of an intent to terminate, provided that the terminating party is itself not in material breach; or

 

   

by either Pivotal or the Company if, at the annual meeting, the business combination proposal shall fail to be approved by the required vote (subject to any adjournment or recess of the meeting).

Effect of Termination

In the event of proper termination by any of the parties, the Merger Agreement will be of no further force or effect (other than with respect to certain surviving obligations specified in the Merger Agreement), without any liability on the part of any party thereto or its respective affiliates, officers, directors or stockholders, other than liability of any party thereto for any intentional and willful breach of the Merger Agreement by such party occurring prior to such termination.

Fees and Expenses

Except as otherwise set forth in the Merger Agreement, all fees and expenses incurred in connection with the Merger Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereby will be paid by the party incurring such expenses whether or not the transactions are consummated.

Confidentiality; Access to Information

Each party to the Merger Agreement will afford to the other parties and their financial advisors, accountants, counsel and other representatives reasonable access during normal business hours, upon reasonable notice, to all of their respective properties, books, records and personnel during the period prior to the closing to obtain all information concerning the business, including the status of business development efforts, properties, results of operations and personnel, as each party may reasonably request. The parties agree to maintain in confidence any non-public information received from the other party, and to use such non-public information only for purposes of consummating the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement.

Amendments

The Merger Agreement may be amended by the parties thereto at any time prior to the closing of the Business Combination by execution of an instrument in writing signed on behalf of each of the parties.

Governing Law; Consent to Jurisdiction

The Merger Agreement is governed by and construed in accordance with the law of the state of Delaware, regardless of the law that might otherwise govern under applicable principles of the conflicts of laws of Delaware. With respect to disputes related to the Merger Agreement, each party irrevocably consents to the exclusive jurisdiction and venue of the courts of the State of Delaware or the federal courts located in the State of Delaware.

 

83


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Introduction

Pivotal is providing the following unaudited pro forma combined financial information to aid you in your analysis of the financial aspects of the Business Combination.

The following unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of March 31, 2019 combines the unaudited historical consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of March 31, 2019 with the unaudited historical balance sheet of Pivotal as of March 31, 2019 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had been consummated as of that date.

The following unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 combines the audited historical consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of December 31, 2018 with the audited historical balance sheet of Pivotal as of December 31, 2018 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had been consummated as of that date.

The following unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the three months ended March 31, 2019 combines the unaudited historical consolidated statement of operations of the Company for the three months ended March 31, 2019 with the unaudited historical statement of operations of Pivotal for the three months ended March 31, 2019 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had occurred as of January 1, 2019.

The following unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2018 combines the audited historical consolidated statement of operations of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2018 with the audited historical statement of operations of Pivotal for the year ended December 31, 2018 after giving effect to the Business Combination as if it had occurred as of January 1, 2018.

This information should be read together with the Company’s and Pivotal’s respective audited financial statements and related notes, “ The Company’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ,” “ Other Information Related to Pivotal Pivotal’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ” and other financial information included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Description of the Transactions

On May 20, 2019, Pivotal entered into the Merger Agreement with Merger Sub, the Company and, solely in its capacity as representative of the stockholders of the Company, Carlyle.

The Company is the owner of the KLDiscovery business, one of the leading eDiscovery providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers.

Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company, with the Company surviving the merger. As a result, the Company will become a wholly owned subsidiary of Pivotal, with the stockholders of the Company becoming securityholders of Pivotal.

Under the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of the Company will receive an aggregate of 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock. The stockholders of the Company will also have the right to receive up to 2,200,000 shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal’s common stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Business Combination.

 

84


Table of Contents

In connection with the Business Combination, the Founder will subject a certain number of its shares of Class B common to an additional lockup that will be released only if the last reported sale price of Pivotal’s common stock equals or exceeds $15.00 for a period of 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Business Combination.

The stockholders of the Company receiving shares of Pivotal common stock in connection with the Business Combination will be subject to a 12-month lockup period for all shares of Pivotal common stock held by such persons, which period may be earlier terminated if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 for a period of 20 consecutive trading days during a 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the closing of the Business Combination. This lockup is identical to the lockup previously agreed to by the Founder and other holders of its Class B common stock issued prior to Pivotal’s initial public offering.

Accounting for the Merger

The Merger will be accounted for as a reverse merger in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Under this method of accounting, Pivotal will be treated as the “acquired” company for financial reporting purposes. This determination was primarily based on (i) the Company being expected to have the majority interest of the combined company, (ii) the Company being represented on the board of directors of the combined company by up to three members, in addition to the chief executive officer of the Company, (iii) the Company’s senior management comprising the senior management of the combined company and (iv) the Company’s operations comprising the ongoing operations of the combined company. Accordingly, for accounting purposes, the Merger will be treated as the equivalent of the Company issuing stock for the net assets of Pivotal, accompanied by a recapitalization. The net assets of Pivotal will be stated at historical cost, with no goodwill or other intangible assets recorded. Operations prior to the Merger will be those of the Company.

Basis of Pro Forma Presentation

The historical financial information has been adjusted to give pro forma effect to events that are related and/or directly attributable to the Business Combination, are factually supportable and, as it relates to the unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations, are expected to have a continuing impact on the results of the combined company following consummation of the Merger. The adjustments presented in the unaudited pro forma combined financial statements have been identified and presented to provide relevant information necessary for an accurate understanding of the combined company upon consummation of the Merger.

The unaudited pro forma combined financial information is for illustrative purposes only, and does not necessarily reflect what the combined company’s financial condition or results of operations would have been had the Business Combination occurred on the dates indicated. The unaudited pro forma combined financial information also may not be useful in predicting the future financial condition and results of operations of the combined company following consummation of the Merger. The actual financial position and results of operations may differ significantly from the pro forma amounts reflected herein due to a variety of factors. The Company and Pivotal have not had any historical relationship prior to the Merger except that Evan Morgan was both a director of Pivotal and a special partner at Revolution Growth, one of the Company’s shareholders, for a period of time.

There is no historical activity with respect to Merger Sub, and accordingly, no adjustments were required with respect to this entity in the pro forma combined financial statements.

The unaudited pro forma combined financial information has been prepared assuming two alternative levels of conversions of public shares:

 

   

Scenario 1—Assuming no conversions: This presentation assumes that no Pivotal shareholders exercise conversion rights with respect to their public shares upon consummation of the Merger; and

 

85


Table of Contents
   

Scenario 2—Assuming conversions of 5,627,282 public shares of Pivotal for cash: This presentation assumes that Pivotal shareholders exercise their conversion rights with respect to a maximum of 5,627,282 public shares upon consummation of the Merger at a redemption price of approximately $10.07 per share. The maximum conversion amount is derived from a minimum of $175 million of cash required from Pivotal pursuant to the Merger Agreement, after giving effect to the payments to converting stockholders. Scenario 2 includes all adjustments contained in Scenario 1 and presents additional adjustments to reflect the effect of the maximum conversions.

Included in the shares outstanding and weighted average shares outstanding as presented in the pro forma combined financial statements are 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock to be issued to the Company’s shareholders under both Scenario 1 and 2.

As a result of the Business Combination, assuming no Pivotal shareholders elect to convert their shares for cash, the Company’s stockholders will own approximately 55% of the Pivotal shares to be outstanding immediately after the Business Combination and Pivotal stockholders will own approximately 45% of the Pivotal shares, based on the number of Pivotal shares outstanding as of March 31, 2019 (in each case, not giving effect to any shares issuable to them upon exercise of warrants). If 5,627,282 shares of Pivotal common stock are converted for cash, which assumes the maximum conversion of Pivotal’s shares and providing for a minimum of $175 million of cash after giving effect to payments to converting shareholders, the Company’s stockholders will own approximately 60% and Pivotal stockholders will own approximately 40% of the Pivotal shares to be outstanding immediately after the Business Combination (in each case, not giving effect to any shares issuable to them upon exercise of warrants).

 

86


Table of Contents

PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET

AS OF MARCH 31, 2019

(UNAUDITED)

(in thousands)

 

                Scenario 1
Assuming No
Redemptions into Cash
    Scenario 2
Assuming Maximum
Redemptions into Cash
 
    The
Company (1)
    Pivotal (2)     Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Balance
Sheet
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Balance
Sheet
 

Assets

               

Current assets

               

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 4,532     $ 1,048     $ 230,806       (a)     $ 78,886     $ (56,685     (c)     $ 22,201  
      $ (136,000     (b)          
      $ (8,050     (f)          
      $ (2,500     (g)          
      $ (10,950     (i)          

Accounts receivable, net

    83,581       —         —           83,581       —           83,581  

Prepaid expenses

    19,283       113       —           19,396       —           19,396  

Other current assets

    277       —         —           277       —           277  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current assets

    107,673       1,161       73,306         182,140       (56,685       125,455  
               

Marketable securities held in Trust Account

    —         230,806       (230,806     (a)       —             —    

Property and equipment, net

    44,949       —         —           44,949       —           44,949  

Intangible assets, net

    145,417       —         —           145,417       —           145,417  

Goodwill

    394,773       —         —           394,773       —           394,773  

Other assets

    1,795       —         —           1,795       —           1,795  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total assets

  $ 694,607     $ 231,967     $ (157,500     $ 769,074     $ (56,685     $ 712,389  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

               

Current liabilities

               

Current portion of long-term debt, net

  $ 18,268       —       $ (7,500     (b)     $ 10,768       —         $ 10,768  

Accounts payable and accrued expense

    35,160       200       (2,500     (g)       30,610       —           30,610  
        (2,250     (b)          

Deferred revenue

    3,386       —         —           3,386       —           3,386  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

    56,814       200       (12,250       44,764       —           44,764  

Long-term debt, net

    410,021       —         (125,000     (b)       285,021       —           285,021  

Deferred tax liabilities

    5,970       3       —           5,973       —           5,973  

Other liabilities

    4,617       8,050       (8,050     (f)       4,617       —           4,617  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    477,422       8,253       (145,300       340,375       —           340,375  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Commitments and Contingencies

               

Class A Common stock subject to redemption

    —         218,714       (218,714     (c)       —         —           —    

Stockholders’ equity

               

Common stock

    37       —         (37     (d)       —         —           —    

Preferred stock

    —         —         —           —         —           —    

Class A Common stock

    —         —         3       (c)       6       —           6  
        3       (d)          

Class B Common stock

    —         1       (1     (c)       —             —    

Additional paid-in capital

    373,193       4,543       218,712       (c)       594,532       (56,685     (c)       537,847  
        34       (d)          
        (2,406     (e)          
        456       (h)          

Treasury stock

    (2,406     —         2,406       (e)       —         —           —    

Accumulated deficit

    (161,445     456       (456     (h)       (173,645     —           (173,645
        (1,250     (b)          
        (10,950     (i)          

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    7,806       —             7,806       —           7,806  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

    217,185       5,000       206,514         428,699       (56,685       372,014  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

  $ 694,607     $ 231,967     $ (157,500     $ 769,074     $ (56,685     $ 712,389  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

87


Table of Contents

Pro Forma Adjustments to the Unaudited Combined Balance Sheet

As of March 31, 2019

The pro forma adjustments included in the unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of March 31, 2019 are as follows:

 

Note

  

Description

(1)

  

Derived from the Company’s unaudited consolidated balance sheet as of March 31, 2019.

(2)

  

Derived from Pivotal’s unaudited condensed balance sheet as of March 31, 2019.

(a)

  

Reflects the release of cash from marketable securities held in the trust account.

(b)

  

Reflects the repayment of prior existing short-term debt, long-term debt, accrued interest and payment of the related prepayment penalty in connection with the Business Combination.

(c)

  

In Scenario 1, which assumes no Pivotal shareholders exercise their conversion rights, shares of Class B common stock would be converted to Class A common stock and all shares of Class A common stock previously subject to conversion for cash amounting to $218.7 million would be transferred to permanent equity, with an adjustment recorded to par value and additional paid in capital. In Scenario 2, which assumes the same facts as described in the other footnotes, but also assumes the maximum number of shares of Class A common stock are redeemed for cash by Pivotal shareholders, $56.7 million would be paid out in cash. The $56.7 million, or 5,627,282 shares of Class A common stock, represents the maximum redemption amount to leave a minimum of $175.0 million of cash from Pivotal, including the cash to be released from Pivotal’s trust account, after giving effect to payments to converting shareholders based on a consummation of the Business Combination on March 31, 2019.

(d)

  

Reflects the reclassification of the Company’s outstanding common stock into additional paid in capital in connection with the Business Combination.

(e)

  

Reflects the reclassification of the Company’s outstanding treasury stock into additional paid in capital in connection with the Business Combination.

(f)

  

Reflects the payment of deferred underwriting fees in connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering.

(g)

  

Reflects the payment of accrued management fees to a related party of the Company in connection with the Business Combination.

(h)

  

Reflects the recapitalization of Pivotal and the elimination of outstanding retained deficit to additional paid in capital.

(i)

  

Reflects the payment of estimated fees and expenses related to the Business Combination, including legal, financial advisory, accounting and other professional fees.

 

88


Table of Contents

PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 2019

(UNAUDITED)

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

                Scenario 1
Assuming No
Redemptions into Cash
    Scenario 2
Assuming Maximum
Redemptions into Cash
 
    The
Company (1)
    Pivotal (2)     Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Income
Statement
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Income
Statement
 

Revenues

  $ 75,026     $ —       $ —         $ 75,026     $ —         $ 75,026  

Cost of revenues

    37,455       —         —           37,455       —           37,455  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Gross profit

    37,571       —         —           37,571       —           37,571  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Operating expenses

               

General and administrative

    14,844       227       (250     (d)       15,946       —           15,946  
        1,125       (e)          

Research and development

    1,432       —         —           1,432       —           1,432  

Sales and marketing

    12,703       —         —           12,703       —           12,703  

Depreciation and amortization

    9,825       —         —           9,825       —           9,825  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    38,804       227       875         39,906       —           39,906  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loss from operations

    (1,233     (227     (875       (2,335     —           (2,335

Other expenses

               

Other expense (income)

    97       (14     —           83       —           83  

Interest expense (income)

    12,066       (792     792       (a)       8,129       —           8,129  
        (3,937     (b)         —        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

    (13,396     579       2,270         (10,547     —           (10,547

Income tax provision

    95       122       (122     (c)       95           95  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Net loss

  $ (13,491   $ 457     $ 2,392       $ (10,642   $ —         $ (10,642
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

               

Foreign currency translation

    810       —         —           810       —           810  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

    810       —         —           810       —           810  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

  $ (12,681   $ 457     $ 2,392       $ (9,832   $ —         $ (9,832
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    3,683,461       6,175,950       57,374,050       (f)       63,550,000       (5,627,282       57,922,718  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Basic and diluted net loss per share

  $ (3.66   $ (0.02   $ (0.15     $ (0.17   $ (0.01     $ (0.18
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

89


Table of Contents

Pro Forma Adjustments to the Unaudited Combined Statement of Operations

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

The pro forma adjustments included in the unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the three months ended March 31, 2019 are as follows:

 

Note

  

Description

(1)

  

Derived from the Company’s unaudited consolidated statements of comprehensive loss as of March 31, 2019.

(2)

  

Derived from Pivotal’s unaudited condensed statements of operations as of March 31, 2019.

(a)

  

Represents an adjustment to eliminate interest income and unrealized gain on marketable securities held in the trust account as of the beginning of the period.

(b)

  

Represents an adjustment to eliminate interest expense on the Company’s Second Lien Facility (as defined herein) as of the beginning of the period as the Second Lien Facility will be repaid upon consummation of the Business Combination.

(c)

  

Represents the tax effect of the pro forma adjustments for elimination of Pivotal’s interest income.

(d)

  

Represents the elimination of the Company’s related party consulting expenses which will not continue after the consummation of the Business Combination.

(e)

  

Represents the estimate for public company costs for the three months ended March 31, 2019.

(f)

  

The calculation of weighted average shares outstanding for basic and diluted net loss per share assumes that Pivotal’s initial public offering occurred on January 1, 2019. In addition, as the Business Combination is being reflected as if it had occurred on this date, the calculation of weighted average shares outstanding for basic and diluted net loss per share assumes that the shares have been outstanding for the entire period presented. This calculation is retroactively adjusted to eliminate the number of shares redeemed in the Business Combination for the entire period.

  

The following presents the calculation of basic and diluted weighted average common shares outstanding. The computation of diluted loss per share excludes the effect of warrants to purchase 6,350,000 shares of Class A common stock because the inclusion of these securities would be anti-dilutive. The computation also excludes 2,200,000 shares that are contingently issuable to the Company.

 

     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
No
Redemptions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Redemptions
into Cash
 

Weighted average shares calculation, basic and diluted

    

Pivotal Public Shares

     23,000,000       17,372,718  

Pivotal Class B Shares

     5,750,000       5,750,000  

Pivotal shares issued in Business Combination

     34,800,000       34,800,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

     63,550,000       57,922,718  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Percent of shares owned by Pivotal shareholders

     45.2     39.9

Percent of shares owned by Company shareholders

     54.8     60.1

 

90


Table of Contents

PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET

AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2018

(UNAUDITED)

(in thousands)

 

                Scenario 1
Assuming No
Redemptions into Cash
    Scenario 2
Assuming Maximum
Redemptions into Cash
 
    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Balance
Sheet
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Balance
Sheet
 

Assets

               

Current assets

               

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 23,439     $ 19     $ 231,284       (a   $ 97,242     $ (56,685     (a   $ 40,557  
      $ (136,000     (b        
      $ (8,050     (c        
      $ (2,500     (f        
      $ (10,950     (h        

Accounts receivable, net

    80,641       —         —           80,641       —           80,641  

Prepaid expenses

    9,825       —         —           9,825       —           9,825  

Other current assets

    310       133       —           443       —           443  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current assets

    114,215       152       73,784         188,151       (56,685       131,466  

Property and equipment, net

    48,341       —         —           48,341       —           48,341  

Intangible assets, net

    151,918       —         —           151,918       —           151,918  

Goodwill

    394,167       —         —           394,167       —           394,167  

Other assets

    1,739       —         —           1,739       —           1,739  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total assets

  $ 710,380     $ 152     $ 73,784       $ 784,316     $ (56,685     $ 727,631  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

               

Current liabilities

               

Current portion of long-term debt, net

  $ 12,355     $  —       $ (7,500     $ 4,855       —         $ 4,855  

Accounts payable and accrued expense

    41,135       3       (2,500     (f     36,388       —           36,388  
        (2,250     (b        

Promissory note—related party

    —         125       (125     (a     —         —           —    

Deferred revenue

    4,160       —         —           4,160       —           4,160  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

    57,650       128       (12,375       45,403       —           45,403  

Long-term debt, net

    413,064       —         (125,000     (b     288,064       —           288,064  

Deferred tax liabilities

    6,075       —         —           6,075       —           6,075  

Other liabilities

    4,635       —         —           4,635       —           4,635  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    481,424       128       (137,375       344,177       —           344,177  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Commitments and Contingencies

               

Stockholders’ equity

               

Common stock

    37       —         (37     (d     —         —           —    

Preferred stock

    —         —         —           —         —           —    

Class A Common stock

    —         —         3       (a     6       —           6  
        3       (d        

Class B Common stock

    —         1       (1     (a     —         —           —    

Additional paid-in capital

    372,283       24       231,407       (a     593,290       (56,685     (a     536,605  
        34       (d        
        (2,406     (e        
        (8,050     (c        
        (1     (g        

Treasury stock

    (2,406     —         2,406       (e     —         —           —    

Accumulated deficit

    (147,954     (1     1       (g     (160,154     —           (160,154
        (1,250     (b        
        (10,950     (h        

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    6,996       —         —           6,996       —           6,996  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

    228,956       24       211,159         440,139       (56,685       383,454  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

  $ 710,380     $ 152     $ 73,784       $ 784,316     $ (56,685     $ 727,631  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

91


Table of Contents

Pro Forma Adjustments to the Unaudited Combined Balance Sheet

As of December 31, 2018

The pro forma adjustments included in the unaudited pro forma combined balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 are as follows:

 

Note

  

Description

(a)

  

In Scenario 1, which assumes no Pivotal shareholders exercise their conversion rights, shares of Class B common stock would be converted to Class A common stock and all shares of Class A common stock previously subject to redemption for cash amounting to $218.7 million would be transferred to permanent equity, with an adjustment recorded to par value and additional paid in capital. In Scenario 2, which assumes the same facts as described in the other footnotes, but also assumes the maximum number of shares of Class A common stock are converted for cash by Pivotal shareholders, $56.7 million would be paid out in cash. The $56.7 million, or 5,627,282 shares of Class A common stock, represents the maximum conversion amount to leave a minimum of $175.0 million of cash from Pivotal, including the cash to be released from Pivotal’s trust account, after giving effect to payments to redeeming shareholders based on a consummation of the Business Combination on December 31, 2018.

(b)

  

Reflects the repayment of a portion of existing short-term debt, long-term debt, accrued interest and payment of the related prepayment penalty in connection with the Business Combination.

(c)

  

Reflects the payment of deferred underwriting fees in connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering.

(d)

  

Reflects the reclassification of the Company’s outstanding common stock into additional paid in capital in connection with the Business Combination.

(e)

  

Reflects the reclassification of the Company’s outstanding treasury stock into additional paid in capital in connection with the Business Combination.

(f)

  

Reflects the payment of accrued management fees to a related party of the Company in connection with the Business Combination.

(g)

  

Reflects the recapitalization of Pivotal and elimination of outstanding retained deficit to additional paid in capital.

(h)

  

Reflects the payment of estimated fees and expenses related to the Business Combination, including legal, financial advisory, accounting and other professional fees.

 

92


Table of Contents

PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018

(UNAUDITED)

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

            Scenario 1
Assuming No
Redemptions into Cash
    Scenario 2
Assuming Maximum
Redemptions into Cash
 
    The
Company
    Pivotal     Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Income
Statement
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Ref     Pro Forma
Income
Statement
 

Revenues

  $ 296,282     $ —         —         $ 296,282       —         $ 296,282  

Cost of revenues

    159,617       —         —           159,617       —           159,617  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Gross profit

    136,665       —         —           136,665       —           136,665  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Operating expenses

               

General and administrative

    54,633       1       (1,000     (b)       58,134       —           58,134  
        4,500       (c)          

Research and development

    7,100       —         —           7,100       —           7,100  

Sales and marketing

    58,273       —         —           58,273       —           58,273  

Depreciation and amortization

    41,519       —         —           41,519       —           41,519  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    161,525       1       3,500         165,026       —           165,026  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loss from operations

    (24,860     (1     (3,500       (28,361     —           (28,361

Other expenses

               

Other expense

    29       —         —           29       —           29  

Interest expense

    46,591       —         (15,273     (a)       31,318       —           31,318  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

    (71,480     (1     11,773         (59,708     —           (59,708

Income tax provision

    (3,741     —         —           (3,741         (3,741
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Net loss

  $ (67,739   $ (1   $ 11,773       $ (55,967   $ —         $ (55,967
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax

               

Foreign currency translation

    (870     —         —           (870     —           (870
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive loss, net of tax

    (870     —         —           (870     —           (870
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

  $ (68,609   $ (1   $ 11,773       $ (56,837   $ —         $ (56,837
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    3,477,752       5,000,000       58,550,000       (d)       63,550,000       (5,627,282       57,922,718  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Basic and diluted net loss per share

  $ (19.48)     $ (0.00   $ (0.88     $ (0.88   $ (0.09     $ (0.97
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

93


Table of Contents

Pro Forma Adjustments to the Unaudited Combined Statements of Operations

For the Year Ended December 31, 2018

The pro forma adjustments included in the unaudited pro forma combined statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2018 are as follows:

 

Note

 

Description

(a)

 

Represents an adjustment to eliminate interest expense related to the Company’s Second Lien Facility as of the beginning of the period as the Second Lien Facility will be repaid upon consummation of the Business Combination.

(b)

 

Represents the elimination of related party consulting expenses for the year ended December 31, 2018 which will not continue after the consummation of the Business Combination.

(c)

 

Represents an estimate of public company costs for the year ended December 31, 2018.

(d)

 

The calculation of weighted average shares outstanding for basic and diluted net loss per share assumes that Pivotal’s initial public offering occurred on January 1, 2018. In addition, as the Business Combination is being reflected as if it had occurred on this date, the calculation of weighted average shares outstanding for basic and diluted net loss per share assumes that the shares have been outstanding for the entire period presented. This calculation is retroactively adjusted to eliminate the number of shares redeemed in the Business Combination for the entire period.

 

The table below presents the calculation of basic and diluted weighted average common shares outstanding. The computation of diluted loss per share excludes the effect of warrants to purchase 6,350,000 shares of Class A common stock because the inclusion of these securities would be anti-dilutive. The computation also excludes 2,200,000 shares that are contingently issuable to the Company.

 

     Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
No
Redemptions
into Cash
    Pro Forma
Combined
Assuming
Maximum
Redemptions
into Cash
 

Weighted average shares calculation, basic and diluted

    

Pivotal Class A Shares

     23,000,000       17,372,718  

Pivotal Class B Shares

     5,750,000       5,750,000  

Pivotal shares issued in Business Combination

     34,800,000       34,800,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

     63,550,000       57,922,718  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Percent of shares owned by Pivotal shareholders

     45.2     39.9

Percent of shares owned by Company shareholders

     54.8     60.1

 

94


Table of Contents

THE CHARTER PROPOSALS

The charter proposals, if approved, will approve the following amendments to Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation to:

 

   

change the name of the new public entity to “KLDiscovery Inc.” as opposed to “Pivotal Acquisition Corp.”;

 

   

increase Pivotal’s capitalization so that it will have 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock, as opposed to Pivotal having 75,000,000 authorized shares of Class A common stock, 10,000,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock, and 1,000,000 authorized preferred shares; and

 

   

delete the various provisions applicable only to special purpose acquisition corporations that Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation contains.

In the judgment of Pivotal’s board of directors, the charter proposals are desirable for the following reasons:

 

   

the name of the new public entity is desirable to reflect the Business Combination with the Company and the combined business going forward;

 

   

the greater number of authorized number of shares of capital stock is desirable for Pivotal to have sufficient shares to issue to the holders of common stock of the Company in the Merger and have enough additional authorized shares for financing its business, for acquiring other businesses, for forming strategic partnerships and alliances and for stock dividends and stock splits and to issue upon exercise of the warrants;

 

   

the single class of common stock is desirable because all shares of Class B common stock will be exchanged for Class A common stock upon consummation of the Merger, and because it will allow Pivotal to have a streamlined capital structure; and

 

   

it is desirable to delete the provisions that relate to the operation of Pivotal as a blank check company prior to the consummation of its initial business combination because they would not be applicable after the Business Combination (such as the obligation to dissolve and liquidate if a business combination is not consummated within a certain period of time).

Notwithstanding the foregoing, authorized but unissued shares of common and preferred stock may enable Pivotal’s board of directors to render it more difficult or to discourage an attempt to obtain control of Pivotal and thereby protect continuity of or entrench its management, which may adversely affect the market price of Pivotal’s securities. If, in the due exercise of its fiduciary obligations, for example, Pivotal’s board of directors were to determine that a takeover proposal were not in the best interests of Pivotal, such shares could be issued by the board of directors without stockholder approval in one or more private placements or other transactions that might prevent or render more difficult or make more costly the completion of any attempted takeover transaction by diluting voting or other rights of the proposed acquirer or insurgent stockholder group, by creating a substantial voting block in institutional or other hands that might support the position of the incumbent board of directors, by effect effecting an acquisition that might complicate or preclude the takeover, or otherwise. The authorization of additional shares will, however, enable Pivotal to have the flexibility to authorize the issuance of shares in the future for financing its business, for acquiring other businesses, for forming strategic partnerships and alliances and for stock dividends and stock splits. Pivotal currently has no such plans, proposals or arrangements, written or otherwise, to issue any of the additional authorized shares for such purposes.

Under the Merger Agreement, the approval of the charter proposals is a condition to the adoption of the business combination proposal and vice versa. Accordingly, if the business combination proposal is not approved, the charter proposals will not be presented at the annual meeting.

The approval of each charter proposal will require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Pivotal common stock on the record date.

 

95


Table of Contents

A copy of Pivotal’s proposed second amended and restated certificate of incorporation, as will be in effect assuming approval of all of the charter proposals and upon consummation of the Business Combination and filing with the Delaware Secretary of State, is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex B .

PIVOTAL’S BOARD OF DIRECTORS RECOMMENDS THAT STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” THE APPROVAL OF THE CHARTER PROPOSALS.

 

96


Table of Contents

THE DIRECTOR ELECTION PROPOSAL

Election of Directors

At the annual meeting, eight directors will be elected to be the directors of Pivotal upon consummation of the Merger. Pivotal’s board of directors will be divided into three classes with only one class of directors being elected in each year and each class (except for those directors appointed to Class A and B at the annual meeting) serving a three-year term. If management’s nominees are elected, Richard J. Williams and Kevin Griffin will be Class A directors serving until the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in 2020, Donna Morea, Jonathan J. Ledecky and Evan Morgan will be Class B directors serving until the annual meeting to be held in 2021 and Christopher J. Weiler, Daniel F. Akerson and William Darman will be Class C directors serving until the annual meeting to be held in 2022 and, in each case, until their successors are elected and qualified.

Under Delaware law, the election of directors requires a plurality vote of the common stock present in person or represented by proxy and entitled to vote at the annual meeting. “Plurality” means that the individuals who receive the largest number of votes cast “FOR” are elected as directors. Consequently, any shares not voted “FOR” a particular nominee (whether as a result of an abstention, a direction to withhold authority or a broker non-vote) will not be counted in the nominee’s favor.

Unless authority is withheld or the shares are subject to a broker non-vote, the proxies solicited by the board of directors will be voted “FOR” the election of these nominees. In case any of the nominees becomes unavailable for election to the board of directors, an event that is not anticipated, the persons named as proxies, or their substitutes, will have full discretion and authority to vote or refrain from voting for any other candidate in accordance with their judgment.

If the business combination proposal is not approved or any of the charter proposals are not approved and the applicable condition in the Merger Agreement is not waived, the director election proposal will not be presented at the meeting.

Following consummation of the Merger, the election of directors of Pivotal will be governed by its charter documents and the laws of the State of Delaware.

PIVOTAL’S BOARD OF DIRECTORS UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” EACH OF THE NOMINEES LISTED IN THIS PROXY STATEMENT/PROSPECTUS.

Information about Executive Officers, Directors and Nominees

At the effective time of the Business Combination, in accordance with the terms of the Merger Agreement and assuming the election of the nominees set forth above, the board of directors and executive officers of Pivotal will be as follows:

 

Name

   Age     

Position

Executive Officers:

     

Christopher J. Weiler

     56     

Chief Executive Officer and Director

Dawn Wilson

     53     

Chief Financial Officer

Non-Employee Directors:

     

Daniel F. Akerson

     70     

Director (Chairman)

Jonathan J. Ledecky

     61     

Director (Vice Chairman)

Kevin Griffin

     42     

Director

William Darman

     42     

Director

Richard Williams

     58     

Director

Donna Morea

     64     

Director

Evan Morgan

     34     

Director

 

97


Table of Contents

Christopher J. Weiler co-founded KLDiscovery in 2005 and has served as its Chief Executive Officer and a director since such time. Prior to co-founding KLDiscovery, Mr. Weiler co-founded On-Site Sourcing, a litigation support and electronic discovery services company, in 1993 and served as its President and Chief Executive Officer until December 2004. From 1991 to 1992, Mr. Weiler worked for Pitney Bowes Management Services as a manager, and from 1985 to 1991, he served in the U.S. Navy as a surface warfare officer and as a Navy Senate Liaison Officer in Washington, D.C. Mr. Weiler received a B.S. in Political Science and Engineering from the U.S. Naval Academy. We believe that Mr. Weiler is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his knowledge of our company and his extensive experience in the electronic discovery services industry.

Dawn Wilson has been the Chief Financial Officer of KLDiscovery since September 2017. Ms. Wilson has over 20 years of experience in finance and accounting. After starting her career at Arthur Andersen in 1992, she has primarily been with public companies in the technology and services industry. Most recently, Ms. Wilson served as Vice President of Accounting of CoStar Group, the leading provider of commercial real estate information, analytics and online marketplaces, from July 2004 to August 2016. She received a Masters in Accounting from Virginia Polytechnic Institute and State University.

Daniel F. Akerson has been the Chairman of the Board of Directors of KLDiscovery since 2015. He previously served as Vice Chairman and Special Advisor to the Board of Directors of TCG from March 2014 until December 2015, where he provided operational, investment and management guidance to TCG’s investment teams, firm management and the Board of Directors. From January 2011 to January 2014, Mr. Akerson served as the Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of General Motors Company. Prior to joining General Motors Company, Mr. Akerson served as a Managing Director of TCG including as the head of Global Buyout from July 2009 to August 2010 and the co-head of U.S. Buyout from June 2003 to June 2009. Mr. Akerson currently serves on the board of directors of Commscope Holding Company, Inc., Lockheed Martin Corporation and the U.S. Naval Academy Foundation, where he serves as chairman. He previously served on the board of directors of General Motors Company as well as a number of other private, public and nonprofit organizations. Mr. Akerson received a B.S. in Engineering from the U.S. Naval Academy and a M.Sc. in Economics from the London School of Economics. We believe that Mr. Akerson is qualified to serve as Chairman of our board of directors due to his familiarity with our business, broad knowledge of the industry, extensive directorship experience and experience in leadership positions.

Jonathan J. Ledecky  has served as the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Pivotal since its inception in 2018. Mr. Ledecky has been a co-owner of the National Hockey League’s New York Islanders franchise since October 2014. He also serves as an Alternate Governor on the Board of Governors of the NHL and as President of NY Hockey Holdings LLC. Mr. Ledecky has served as chairman of Ironbound Partners Fund LLC, a private investment management fund, since March 1999. Mr. Ledecky has also served as President and a director of Newtown Lane Holdings, Incorporated, a blank check company, since October 2015. Mr. Ledecky also served as a member of the board of directors of Propel Media, Inc., a digital media holding company, from January 2015 to January 2019, and of Kitara Media, the predecessor of Propel Media, Inc., from January 2011 to April 2015. From July 2005 to December 2007, Mr. Ledecky served as president, secretary and a director of Endeavor Acquisition Corp., a blank check company that completed its initial business combination with American Apparel, Inc. From January 2007 to May 2009, he served as president, secretary and a director of Victory Acquisition Corp., a blank check company that was unable to consummate an initial business combination. He also served as president, secretary and a director of Triplecrown Acquisition Corp., a blank check company, from June 2007 until it completed its initial business combination with Cullen Agricultural Technologies, Inc. in October 2009. During 2007, he also served as president, secretary and director of Grand Slam Acquisition Corp., Performance Acquisition Corp. and Endeavour International Acquisition Corp., three similarly structured blank check companies that never completed their initial public offerings due to market conditions at the time. Mr. Ledecky founded U.S. Office Products in October 1994 and served as its chief executive officer until November 1997 and as its chairman until its sale in 1998. U.S. Office Products was one of the fastest start-up entrants in the history of the Fortune 500 with sales in excess of $3 billion within its first three

 

98


Table of Contents

years of operation. From 1999 to 2001, Mr. Ledecky was vice chairman of Lincoln Holdings, owners of the Washington sports franchises in the NBA, NHL and WNBA. In addition to the foregoing, Mr. Ledecky served as chairman of the board and chief executive officer of Consolidation Capital Corporation from its formation in February 1997 until March 2000 when it merged with Group Maintenance America Corporation. Mr. Ledecky also has served as a trustee of George Washington University, a director of the U.S. Chamber of Commerce and a commissioner on the National Commission on Entrepreneurship and currently serves as a trustee of the U.S. Olympic Foundation and the U.S. Paralympic Foundation. In 2004, Mr. Ledecky was elected the Chief Marshal of the 2004 Harvard University Commencement, an honor bestowed by his alumni peers for a 25th reunion graduate deemed to have made exceptional contributions to Harvard and the greater society while achieving outstanding professional success. Mr. Ledecky received a B.A., cum laude, from Harvard University and a M.B.A. from the Harvard Business School. We believe that Mr. Ledecky is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his public company experience, including with other similarly structured blank check companies, business leadership, operational experience and contacts.

Kevin Griffin  has served as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal since September 2018. Mr. Griffin has been designated as a director by Pivotal Spac Funding LLC, a managing member of our sponsor, pursuant to our amended and restated certificate of incorporation. During Mr. Griffin’s 20-year career, Mr. Griffin has originated and invested over $4 billion across the capital structure of middle market businesses and has also sat on numerous boards of directors. Mr. Griffin founded MGG Investment Group in October 2014 and has served as its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Investment Officer since such time. Prior to launching MGG Investment Group, Mr. Griffin was a Managing Director with Highbridge Principal Strategies from January 2010 to June 2014, where he was a senior member of the Specialty Lending Platform and a Member of the Highbridge Credit Committee. Prior to this, Mr. Griffin was the Head of Private Investing for Octavian Funds, a hedge fund focused on global investing across debt and equity structures, from 2007 to 2009. From 2003 to 2007, Mr. Griffin was part of Fortress Investment Group in charge of originating and underwriting investment opportunities for the Drawbridge Special Opportunities Fund. Prior to Fortress, Mr. Griffin was an investor with one of the first publicly traded business development companies, American Capital, where he was involved in numerous equity buyout and subordinated debt investments. Mr. Griffin began his career with Houlihan Lokey, Howard & Zukin’s Investment Banking Division, focusing primarily on distressed M&A and financial restructurings. The M&A Advisor in May 2015 named Mr. Griffin a winner of its 40 Under 40 Emerging Leaders Award. The Hedge Fund Journal, in association with Ernst & Young, in December 2016 named Mr. Griffin one of 50 “Tomorrow’s Titans.” Mr. Griffin received a BSBA in Finance from Georgetown University. We believe that Mr. Griffin is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his extensive business and operational experience and contacts.

William Darman has been a member of the board of directors of KLDiscovery since November 2015. Mr. Darman is a Managing Director with the U.S. Equity Opportunity funds of TCG, focusing on a broad range of small and middle market equity transactions. Prior to joining TCG in 2008, Mr. Darman was a Vice President with the leveraged finance group at Goldman Sachs & Co. and a Managing Director with Fairfax Partners. Mr. Darman received an M.P.P. from the John F. Kennedy School of Government at Harvard University and an A.B from Harvard College with honors. Mr. Darman currently serves on the boards of directors of Accelerate Learning, Lift and The Great Pond Foundation. He has previously served on the boards of directors of Lakeland Holdings LLC, The National Cathedral Elementary School, Talent Partners Holdings, Inc. and Vubiquity. We believe that Mr. Darman is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his knowledge of our business and industry.

Richard J. Williams has been a member of the board of directors of KLDiscovery since February 2018. In 2004, Mr. Williams co-founded WestView Capital Partners (“ WestView ”), a private equity firm focused on growth-oriented companies, and he currently serves as its Manager Partner. WestView currently manages approximately $1.7 billion of capital. Prior to co-founding WestView, he was a Partner in Tudor Investment Corporation’s (“ Tudor ”) private equity group from 2000 to 2004. Prior to joining Tudor, Mr. Williams was a Managing Director of Triumph Capital Group (“ Triumph ”), a Boston-based private equity firm which managed more than

 

99


Table of Contents

$800 million in capital. In these positions, Mr. Williams has been responsible for investments in the technology services, software, business services and healthcare sectors. Mr. Williams currently serves on the boards of directors of Park Place Technologies, CloudWave Healthcare Solutions, Mintz Group, Collaborative Solutions, Abacus Group, AccountabilIT and Health Monitor Network. Mr. Williams previously served on the boards of directors of numerous private and public companies, including VaultLogix, Thorne Research and LDiscovery. Mr. Williams received a B.S. in Computer Science from Yale University and a MBA from the Wharton School at the University of Pennsylvania. We believe that Mr. Williams is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his extensive experience with growth-oriented companies and other public companies.

Donna S. Morea has been a member of the board of directors of KLDiscovery since March 2017. She is an Operating Advisor of TCG with over thirty years of experience in information technology professional services management, including as President of CGI Technology and Solutions, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of CGI Group (“ CGI ”), from May 2004 until her retirement at the end of 2011. Ms. Morea currently serves on the boards of directors of SunTrust Banks, Inc., Inova Health Systems, Inc. and Science Applications International Corporation. She is also the Chair of the Board of Trustees for Wesleyan University. Previously, she served as director of CGI and chair of the Northern Virginia Technology Council. Ms. Morea received a MBA, with distinction, in Finance from the Wharton School at the University of Pennsylvania. We believe that Ms. Morea is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to her broad knowledge of the information technology industry and management experience.

Evan B. Morgan  has been a member of the board of directors of KLDiscovery since December 2015. Mr. Morgan has served as Manager of The Radcliff Companies (“ Radcliff ”), a New York-based private investment partnership, since July 2016. Radcliff invests across the capital structure seeking long-term compounding at high rates of return primarily in privately held consumer and services businesses. Mr. Morgan joined RG, where he was a Partner, in 2011. In 2016, when he joined Radcliff, Mr. Morgan transitioned to Special Partner status with RG. From 2009 to 2011, Mr. Morgan worked for TCG. Mr. Morgan currently serves on the boards of directors of Shorecal Limited and JetLinx Global. Mr. Morgan previously served as a member of board of directors of Pivotal from December 2018 until April 2019. Mr. Morgan received a B.A. from the University of Pennsylvania. We believe that Mr. Morgan is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his knowledge of our business and industry.

Family Relationships

There are no family relationships between any of Pivotal’s executive officers and directors or director nominees.

Independence of Directors

As a result of its common stock being listed on the NYSE following consummation of the Business Combination, Pivotal will adhere to the rules of such exchange in determining whether a director is independent. Pivotal’s board of directors has consulted, and will consult, with its counsel to ensure that the board’s determinations are consistent with those rules and all relevant securities and other laws and regulations regarding the independence of directors. The NYSE listing standards generally define an “independent director” as a person, other than an executive officer of a company or any other individual having a relationship which, in the opinion of the issuer’s board of directors, would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director. The parties have determined that                 ,                 ,                 ,                  and                  will be considered independent directors. Pivotal’s independent directors will have regularly scheduled meetings at which only independent directors are present.

Board Leadership Structure and Role in Risk Oversight

Pivotal’s board of directors recognizes that the leadership structure and combination or separation of the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman roles is driven by the needs of Pivotal at any point in time. As a result, no policy

 

100


Table of Contents

exists requiring combination or separation of leadership roles and Pivotal’s governing documents do not mandate a particular structure. This has allowed Pivotal’s board of directors the flexibility to establish the most appropriate structure for Pivotal at any given time.

Pivotal’s board of directors will oversee the risk management activities designed and implemented by its management. Pivotal’s board of directors will execute its oversight responsibility both directly and through its committees. Pivotal’s board of directors will also consider specific risk topics, including risks associated with our strategic initiatives, business plans and capital structure. Pivotal’s management, including its executive officers, is primarily responsible for managing the risks associated with operation and business of the company and will provide appropriate updates to the board of directors and the audit committee. Pivotal’s board of directors will delegate to the audit committee oversight of its risk management process, and Pivotal’s other committees will also consider risk as they perform their respective committee responsibilities. All committees will report to the board of directors as appropriate, including when a matter rises to the level of a material or enterprise risk.

Meetings and Committees of the Board of Directors

Pivotal’s board of directors has held one meeting in 2019. Pivotal expects its directors to attend all board meetings and any meetings of committees of which they are members and to spend the time needed and meet as frequently as necessary to properly discharge their responsibilities. Each of Pivotal’s current directors attended all of the meetings of the board of directors and meetings of committees of which he was a member. Although Pivotal does not have any formal policy regarding director attendance at stockholder meetings, we attempt to schedule meetings so that all directors can attend.

Pivotal has a separately standing audit committee, compensation committee and nominating committee. The audit committee is currently composed of two independent directors, pursuant to the NYSE’s transition rules for newly listing public companies. Each of the compensation committee and nominating committee are composed solely of independent directors.

Audit Committee Information

Katrina Adams and Efrat Epstein currently serve as members of Pivotal’s audit committee. Each member of the audit committee is financially literate and Pivotal’s board of directors has determined that Ms. Adams qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” as defined in applicable SEC rules.

Upon consummation of the Merger, the audit committee will consist of                  (chairman),                  and                 . The audit committee will at all times be composed exclusively of “independent directors,” as defined for audit committee members under the NYSE listing standards and the rules and regulations of the SEC, who are “financially literate.” “Financially literate” generally means being able to read and understand fundamental financial statements, including a company’s balance sheet, income statement and cash flow statement. In addition, Pivotal will be required to certify to the exchange that the committee has, and will continue to have, at least one audit committee financial expert who has past employment experience in finance or accounting, requisite professional certification in accounting, or other comparable experience or background that results in the individual’s financial sophistication. After the Merger,                  will serve as the audit committee financial expert. The audit committee will have a written charter.

The audit committee is responsible for:

 

   

meeting with Pivotal’s independent auditor regarding, among other issues, audits and the adequacy of our accounting and control systems;

 

   

monitoring the independence of the independent auditor;

 

   

verifying the rotation of the lead (or coordinating) audit partner having primary responsibility for the audit and the audit partner responsible for reviewing the audit as required by law;

 

101


Table of Contents
   

inquiring and discussing with management our compliance with applicable laws and regulations;

 

   

pre-approving all audit services and permitted non-audit services to be performed by our independent auditor, including the fees and terms of the services to be performed;

 

   

appointing or replacing the independent auditor;

 

   

determining the compensation and oversight of the work of the independent auditor (including resolution of disagreements between management and the independent auditor regarding financial reporting) for the purpose of preparing or issuing an audit report or related work;

 

   

establishing procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment of complaints received by us regarding accounting, internal accounting controls or reports which raise material issues regarding our financial statements or accounting policies; and

 

   

reviewing and approving all payments made to our existing stockholders, executive officers or directors and their respective affiliates. Any payments made to members of our audit committee will be reviewed and approved by Pivotal’s board of directors, with the interested director or directors abstaining from such review and approval.

Pivotal’s audit committee held two meetings in 2019. Each of our audit committee members attended all of the meetings of the audit committee.

Nominating Committee Information

Pivotal’s nominating committee currently consists of Katrina Adams and Efrat Epstein, each of whom is an independent director under the NYSE’s listing standards. The nominating committee is responsible for overseeing the selection of persons to be nominated to serve on Pivotal’s board of directors. The nominating committee considers persons identified by its members, management, stockholders, investment bankers and others.

Upon consummation of the Merger, the nominating committee will consist of                  (chairman),                  and                 . Each member of the nominating committee will be independent under the NYSE listing standards. The nominating committee will have a written charter.

Guidelines for Selecting Director Nominees

The guidelines for selecting nominees, which are specified in the Nominating Committee Charter, generally provide that persons to be nominated should:

 

   

have demonstrated notable or significant achievements in business, education or public service;

 

   

possess the requisite intelligence, education and experience to make a significant contribution to the board of directors and bring a range of skills, diverse perspectives and backgrounds to its deliberations; and

 

   

have the highest ethical standards, a strong sense of professionalism and intense dedication to serving the interests of the stockholders.

The Nominating Committee will consider a number of qualifications relating to management and leadership experience, background and integrity and professionalism in evaluating a person’s candidacy for membership on the board of directors. The nominating committee may require certain skills or attributes, such as financial or accounting experience, to meet specific board needs that arise from time to time and will also consider the overall experience and makeup of its members to obtain a broad and diverse mix of board members. The nominating committee does not distinguish among nominees recommended by stockholders and other persons.

Pivotal’s nominating committee acted by unanimous written consent one time in 2019.

 

102


Table of Contents

Compensation Committee Information

Pivotal’s compensation committee currently consists of Katrina Adams and Efrat Epstein, each of whom is an independent director under the NYSE’s listing standards.

Upon consummation of the Merger, the compensation committee will consist of                  (chairman),                  and                 . Each member of the nominating committee will be independent under the NYSE listing standards. The compensation committee will have a written charter.

The compensation committee’s duties include, but are not limited to:

 

   

reviewing and approving on an annual basis the corporate goals and objectives relevant to our Chief Executive Officer’s compensation, evaluating Pivotal’s Chief Executive Officer’s performance in light of such goals and objectives and determining and approving the remuneration (if any) of Pivotal’s Chief Executive Officer based on such evaluation

 

   

reviewing and approving the compensation of all of Pivotal’s other Section 16 executive officers;

 

   

reviewing our executive compensation policies and plans;

 

   

implementing and administering Pivotal’s incentive compensation equity-based remuneration plans;

 

   

assisting management in complying with Pivotal’s proxy statement and annual report disclosure requirements;

 

   

approving all special perquisites, special cash payments and other special compensation and benefit arrangements for our executive officers and employees;

 

   

if required, producing a report on executive compensation to be included in Pivotal’s annual proxy statement; and

 

   

reviewing, evaluating and recommending changes, if appropriate, to the remuneration for directors.

The compensation committee may also, in its sole discretion, retain or obtain the advice of a compensation consultant, legal counsel or other adviser and will be directly responsible for the appointment, compensation and oversight of the work of any such adviser. However, before engaging or receiving advice from a compensation consultant, external legal counsel or any other adviser, the compensation committee will consider the independence of each such adviser, including the factors required by the NYSE and the SEC.

Pivotal’s compensation committee did not meet in 2019.

Code of Ethics

Effective January 31, 2019, Pivotal adopted a code of ethics that applies to all executive officers, directors and employees. The code of ethics codifies the business and ethical principles that govern all aspects of Pivotal’s business. Pivotal will provide, without charge, upon request, copies of our code of ethics. Requests for copies of the code of ethics should be sent in writing to Pivotal Acquisition Corp., c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

None of the members of the compensation committee is currently, or has been at any time, one of Pivotal’s officers or employees. None of Pivotal’s executive officers currently serves, or has served during the last year, as a member of the board of directors or compensation committee of any entity that has one or more executive officers serving as a member of Pivotal’s board of directors or compensation committee.

 

103


Table of Contents

Stockholder and Interested Party Communications

Prior to the Merger, Pivotal’s board of directors did not provide a process for stockholders or other interested parties to send communications to the board of directors because management believed that it was premature to develop such processes given the limited liquidity of Pivotal common stock at that time. However, Pivotal’s management following the Business Combination may establish a process for stockholder and interested party communications in the future.

 

104


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Pivotal Executive Officer and Director Compensation

Pivotal is an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act and the following is intended to comply with the scaled disclosure requirements applicable to emerging growth companies. No executive officer of Pivotal has received any cash compensation for services rendered to Pivotal although Pivotal may pay consulting, finder or success fees to its officers, directors, shareholders or their affiliates for assisting it in consummating its initial business combination. These officers, directors and shareholders will receive reimbursement for any out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in connection with activities on Pivotal’s behalf, such as identifying potential target businesses, performing business due diligence on suitable target businesses and business combinations, as well as traveling to and from the offices, plants, or similar locations of prospective target businesses to examine their operations. There is no limit on the amount of out-of-pocket expenses reimbursable by Pivotal.

After the Business Combination, members of Pivotal’s management team who remain with the combined company may be paid consulting, management, or other fees from the combined company. Such compensation will be publicly disclosed at the time of its determination in a Current Report on Form 8-K, as required by the SEC.

Since its formation, Pivotal has not granted any stock options or stock appreciation rights or any other awards under long-term incentive plans to any of its executive officers or directors.

Company Named Executive Officer and Director Compensation

Throughout this section, unless otherwise noted, “we,” “us,” “our,” “Company” and similar terms refer to LD Topco, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries. The following section provides compensation information pursuant to the scaled disclosure rules applicable to “emerging growth companies” under the rules of the SEC.

Executive Compensation

Overview

Our “Named Executive Officers” for the year ended December 31, 2018, include Christopher J. Weiler, our Chief Executive Officer, Dawn M. Wilson, our Chief Financial Officer, and Krystina L. Jones, our Executive Vice President, Global Legal Technologies Sales & Marketing (collectively, the “ Named Executive Officers or NEOs ”).

As we transition from a private company to a publicly-traded company, the combined company will evaluate its compensation program as circumstances require. This discussion may contain forward-looking statements that are based on our current plans, considerations, expectations and determinations regarding future compensation programs. The compensation reported in this discussion is not necessarily indicative of how our Named Executive Officers will be compensated in the future.

 

105


Table of Contents

2018 Summary Compensation Table

The following table presents summary information regarding the total compensation for the year ended December 31, 2018 for the Named Executive Officers.

 

Name and Principal Position

  Year     Salary ($)     Bonus
($) (1)
    Option
Awards
($) (2)
    Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
    All Other
Compensation
($)
    Total ($)  

Christopher J. Weiler

Chief Executive Officer

    2018       453,846        75,000       1,031,049       —         11,000 (5)       1,570,895  

Dawn M. Wilson

Chief Financial Officer

    2018       300,000        75,000       —         —         689 (5)       375,689  

Krystina L. Jones

EVP, Global LT Sales & Marketing

    2018       470,192  (3)      30,000       —         1,514,430  (4)      11,000 (5)       2,025,623  

 

(1)

Amounts reflect the annual discretionary cash bonuses earned in recognition of 2018 performance. For additional information, refer to the discussion in the “Narrative to 2018 Summary Compensation Table” below under the heading “—Annual Cash Bonuses.”

(2)

Amounts in this column reflect the aggregate grant date fair value of stock options granted computed in accordance with ASC Topic 718, excluding the effect of estimated forfeitures. The assumptions used by the Company in calculating these amounts for 2018 are included in Note 8 to our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. In connection with the consummation of the Business Combination, all outstanding stock options will automatically be cancelled without consideration. Consequently, it is not expected that Mr. Weiler will realize any value with respect to the stock options reported in this column.

(3)

Amounts include Ms. Jones’s base salary of $320,192 and irrecoverable draw of $150,000 earned by Ms. Jones during 2018 pursuant to the KrolLDiscovery 2018 Legal Technology Sales Commission Plan, which is described below under the heading “Executive Compensation—Sales Commission Plan.”

(4)

Amounts reflect commissions earned by Ms. Jones pursuant to the KrolLDiscovery 2018 Legal Technology Sales Commission Plan. Refer to further description of these payments under the heading “Executive Compensation—Sales Commission Plan.”

(5)

Consists of Company matching contribution payments pursuant to the Company’s 401(k) Plan.

Narrative to 2018 Summary Compensation Table

In 2018, the primary elements of compensation for the Company’s Named Executive Officers were base salary, annual cash bonuses and, for Mr. Weiler, an award of stock options. Ms. Jones was also eligible to

participate in a sales commission program. The Company’s Named Executive Officers are also eligible to participate in our employee benefit plans and programs, including medical and dental benefits, flexible spending accounts, long-term care benefits, and short- and long-term life insurance, to the same extent as our other full-time employees, subject to the terms and eligibility requirements of those plans.

 

106


Table of Contents

Base Salaries

The Company’s Named Executive Officers receive a base salary to compensate them for services rendered to our company. The base salary payable to each Named Executive Officer is intended to provide a fixed component of compensation reflecting the executive’s skill set, experience, role and responsibilities. The 2018 and 2019 annual base salaries for our Named Executive Officers are as follows:

 

Name

   2018 Annual
Base Salary
($)
    2019 Annual
Base Salary
($)
 

Christopher J. Weiler

     500,000  (1)      500,000   

Dawn M. Wilson

     300,000        350,000  (2) 

Krystina L. Jones (3)

     375,000  (4)      425,000  (5) 

 

(1)

From January 1, 2018 to March 12, 2018, Mr. Weiler’s annual base salary was $300,000.

(2)

Effective February 25, 2019.

(3)

Amounts do not include the irrecoverable draw payable to Ms. Jones pursuant to the pursuant to the KrolLDiscovery 2018 Legal Technology Sales Commission Plan. Refer to further description of these payments under the heading “ Executive Compensation—Sales Commission Plan .”

(4)

From January 1, 2018 to September 10, 2018, Ms. Jones’s annual base salary was $300,000.

(5)

Effective January 28, 2019.

Annual Cash Bonuses

In addition to base salaries, the Company’s Named Executive Officers are eligible to receive annual discretionary cash bonuses which are designed to motivate executives to achieve corporate goals and to reward our executives for their contributions towards achievement of these goals. The NEOs’ 2018 target annual cash bonuses, expressed as a percentage of base salary, were 50% for Mr. Weiler and 50% for Ms. Wilson. Ms. Jones did not have a target annual cash bonus for 2018. The Company’s board of directors annually approves the Company’s annual budget, which includes an amount for a discretionary bonus pool. After the year is completed, the senior executives review the Company’s performance and individual employee’s performance to determine the individual employee and executive bonus amounts. The actual amounts paid to the Company’s Named Executive Officers under the Company’s 2018 annual cash bonus program are set forth in the 2018 Summary Compensation Table above.

Sales Commission Plan

Ms. Jones is eligible to earn sales commissions pursuant to the KrolLDiscovery 2018 Legal Technology Sales Commission Plan (the “ 2018 Commission Plan ”). Under the 2018 Commission Plan, Ms. Jones is eligible to earn an irrecoverable draw equal to $150,000 per year, payable in equal monthly installments of $12,500. Under the 2018 Commission Plan, Ms. Jones is also eligible to earn an additional, monthly commission that is based on invoiced revenue multiplied by a specified commission rates, payable in arrears to the extent that they exceed her monthly draw.

Equity Compensation

We have granted equity awards pursuant to the LD Topco, Inc. 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (as amended, the “ Equity Plan ”), and we generally offer stock options as the long-term incentive component of our compensation program. The Company’s stock options generally allow employees, including our Named Executive Officers, to purchase shares of our common stock at a price equal to the fair market value of our common stock on the date of grant, as determined by the board of directors. Generally, stock options granted under our Equity Plan have vesting schedules that are designed to encourage continued employment. Stock options generally expire ten years

from the date of the grant. The Company’s stock options typically vest (i) as to 50%, in five equal annual installments and (ii) as to 50%, upon a liquidity event (which generally means a sale by the principal

 

107


Table of Contents

stockholders of the Company of more than 70% of the equity securities of the Company) in which certain multiple on investment hurdles are attained, subject, in each case, to the participant’s continued employment on each applicable vesting date. From time to time, our board of directors may also construct alternate vesting schedules as it determines are appropriate to motivate particular employees. In 2018, Mr. Weiler received an award of 25,000 stock options, which vest based on the Company’s standard vesting schedule described above.

Executive Employment Arrangements

The Company has entered into employment arrangements with each of the Named Executive Officers. The material terms and conditions of these arrangements are described below.

Christopher J. Weiler

LDiscovery, LLC entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Weiler, dated September 30, 2011, pursuant to which Mr. Weiler serves as the Chief Executive Officer of the Company. The current term of the employment agreement will expire on September 30, 2019, subject to automatic one-year renewals unless either party gives written notice of non-renewal at least ninety days prior to the then-scheduled expiration of the term. Pursuant to his employment agreement, Mr. Weiler is entitled to an annual base salary, currently $500,000, and is eligible to participate in an incentive program established by the Board under which Mr. Weiler may earn a bonus based on achievement of performance metrics as determined by the Board.

In the event that Mr. Weiler’s employment is terminated either by the Company without “Cause” (as defined in his employment agreement) or by Mr. Weiler for “Good Reason” (as defined in his employment agreement), subject to his execution and non-revocation of a general release of claims and continued compliance with his restrictive covenant obligations, as described below, Mr. Weiler would be entitled to an amount in cash equal to the sum of: (i) 100% of his base salary and (ii) 12 times the Company’s monthly contributions to Mr. Weiler’s health insurance, dental insurance and other employee benefit plans, payable over a twelve month period. Mr. Weiler has also agreed to refrain from disclosing our confidential information during or at any time following his employment with us and from competing with us or soliciting our employees or customers during his employment and for one year following termination of his employment.

Dawn M. Wilson

The Company entered into an offer letter agreement, dated August 25, 2017, with Ms. Wilson pursuant to which she serves as the Chief Financial Officer of the Company. Pursuant to her offer letter, Ms. Wilson is entitled to an annual base salary, currently $350,000, and is eligible to earn a discretionary bonus targeted at 50% of her annual base salary based on the achievement of key performance objectives and company performance. In the event that Ms. Wilson is terminated by the Company without “cause” (as such term is defined in her offer letter), Ms. Wilson will be entitled to receive continuation of base salary for six months.

Krystina L. Jones

Legis Discovery, LLC entered into an offer letter agreement, dated September 30, 2006, pursuant to which Ms. Jones has been employed by the Company. Pursuant to her offer letter, Ms. Jones is entitled to an annual base salary, currently $425,000, an irrevocable draw of $150,000, and is eligible to receive monthly commissions under the KrolLDiscovery 2018 Legal Technology Sales Commission Plan.

 

108


Table of Contents

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2018 Fiscal Year End

The following table summarizes the number of shares of common stock underlying outstanding equity incentive plan awards for each Named Executive Officer as of December 31, 2018.

 

          Option Awards (1)  

Name and Principal Position

  Grant Date     Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)

Exercisable
    Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)

Unexercisable
    Equity Incentive Plan
Awards: Number of
Securities Underlying
Unexercised Unearned
Options (#)
    Option
Exercise Price
    Option
Expiration
Date
 

Christopher J. Weiler

Chief Executive Officer

    4/25/2018  (2)      —         12,500       12,500     $ 100.00       4/24/2028  

Dawn M. Wilson

Chief Financial Officer

    10/17/2017  (2)      2,000       8,000  (3)      10,000     $ 100.00       10/16/2027  

Krystina L. Jones

EVP, Global LT Sales &

Marketing

    3/29/2016  (2)      1,240       1,860       3,100     $ 100.00       3/28/2026  
    3/16/2017  (2)      200       800       1,000     $ 100.00       3/15/2027  
    6/15/2017  (2)      380       1,520       1,900     $ 100.00       6/14/2027  

 

(1)

In connection with the consummation of the Business Combination, all outstanding stock options will automatically be cancelled without consideration. Consequently, it is not expected that the Named Executive Officers will realize any value with respect to the stock options reported in this table.

(2)

The option vests (a) as to 50%, in five equal annual installments beginning on the first anniversary of the vesting commencement date and (b) as to 50%, upon a liquidity event (which generally means a sale by the principal stockholders of the Company of more than 70% of the equity securities of the Company) in which certain multiple on investment hurdles are attained, subject, in each case, to the participant’s continued employment on each applicable vesting date.

(3)

The portion of the option that is time-vested will vest upon any change in control.

Retirement, Health, Welfare and Additional Benefits

The Company’s Named Executive Officers are eligible to participate in our employee benefit plans and programs, including medical, dental and vision benefits and life insurance, to the same extent as its other full-time employees, subject to the terms and eligibility requirements of those plans. The Company also sponsors a 401(k) defined contribution plan in which its Named Executive Officers may participate, subject to limits

imposed by the Code, to the same extent as all of our other full-time employees. During 2018, the Company made discretionary employer matching contributions equal to 100% of the first 3% and 50% of the next 2% of a participant’s deferral. These matching contributions are fully vested as of the date on which the contribution is made. The Company believes that providing a vehicle for tax-deferred retirement savings through our 401(k) plan adds to the overall desirability of our executive compensation package and further incentivizes our employees, including our Named Executive Officers, in accordance with our compensation policies

2018 Director Compensation Table

The table below shows all compensation to our non-employee directors for the year ended December 31, 2018.

 

Name

   Stock
Awards
($) (1)
     Total ($)  

Daniel Akerson

     500,000        500,000  

Donna Morea

     150,000        150,000  

William Darman

     —          —    

Richard Williams

     —          —    

Evan Morgan

     —          —    

 

(1)

Amounts reflect the full grant-date fair value of stock awards granted during 2018 computed in accordance with ASC Topic 718, rather than the amounts paid to or realized by the named individual. All stock awards

 

109


Table of Contents
 

granted to directors during 2018 were fully vested. We provide information regarding the assumptions used to calculate the value of all stock awards made to our directors in Note 8 to our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Pivotal Executive Officer and Director Compensation Following the Business Combination

Executive Compensation

Following the closing of the Business Combination, we intend to develop an executive compensation program that is consistent with the Company’s existing compensation policies and philosophies, which are designed to align compensation with business objectives and the creation of stockholder value, while enabling us to attract, motivate and retain individuals who contribute to long-term success.

Decisions on the executive compensation program will be made by the Compensation Committee of the board of directors, which will be established at the closing of the Business Combination. The following discussion is based on the present expectations as to the executive compensation program to be adopted by the Compensation Committee. The executive compensation program actually adopted will depend on the judgment of the members of the Compensation Committee and may differ from that set forth in the following discussion.

We anticipate that decisions regarding executive compensation will reflect our belief that the executive compensation program must be competitive in order to attract and retain our executive officers. We anticipate that the Compensation Committee will seek to implement our compensation policies and philosophies by linking a significant portion of our executive officers’ cash compensation to performance objectives and by providing a portion of their compensation as long-term incentive compensation in the form of equity awards.

We anticipate that compensation for our executive officers will have three primary components: base salary, an annual cash incentive bonus and long-term incentive based compensation in the form of stock-based awards.

Base Salary

It is expected that our Named Executive Officers’ base salaries will initially continue as described under “—Company Executive Officer and Director Compensation—Narrative to Summary Compensation Table––Annual Base Salaries,” subject to the terms of any applicable employment agreements and offer letters described under “—Company Executive Officer and Director Compensation—Executive Employment Arrangements” and will be reviewed by the Compensation Committee based upon advice and counsel of its advisors.

Annual Bonuses

We intend to use annual cash incentive bonuses for the Named Executive Officers to tie a portion of their compensation to financial and operational objectives achievable within the applicable fiscal year. We expect that, near the beginning of each year, the Compensation Committee may select performance targets, target amounts, target award opportunities and other term and conditions of the bonus opportunities for the Named Executive Officers, subject to the terms of any employment agreement. Following the end of each year, the Compensation Committee will determine the extent to which performance targets were achieved, if applicable, and the amount of the award that is payable to each of the Named Executive Officers.

Stock-Based Awards

We intend to use stock-based awards to reward long-term performance of the Named Executive Officers. We believe that providing a meaningful portion of the total compensation package in the form of stock-based awards will align the incentives of Named Executive Officers with the interests of our stockholders and serve to motivate and retain the individual executives. Stock-based awards will be awarded under the 2019 Plan, which is being submitted to our shareholders for approval at the extraordinary general meeting. For a description of the 2019 Plan, please see the section of this proxy statement/prospectus under the heading “ The Incentive Plan Proposal .”

 

110


Table of Contents

Employment Arrangements

We anticipate that the employment arrangements for the Named Executive Officers will remain in place following the consummation of the Business Combination. Any new employment agreements for Named Executive Officers following the Business Combination will be subject to Compensation Committee approval.

Other Compensation

We expect to continue to maintain various employee benefit plans, including medical and 401(k) plans, in which the Named Executive Officers will participate.

Deductibility of Executive Compensation

Section 162(m) of the Code denies a federal income tax deduction for certain compensation in excess of $1.0 million per year paid to certain executive officers of a publicly-traded corporation, including the chief executive officer, chief financial officer and the three other most highly-paid executive officers. To retain highly skilled executives and remain competitive with other employers, the Compensation Committee may authorize compensation that would not be deductible under Section 162(m) or otherwise if it determines that such compensation is in the best interests of us and our stockholders and we expressly reserve the right to do so.

Director Compensation

Following the completion of the Business Combination, our compensation committee will determine the annual compensation to be paid to the members of our board of directors.

 

111


Table of Contents

THE INCENTIVE PLAN PROPOSAL

In connection with the Merger, Pivotal intends to adopt the KLDiscovery Inc. 2019 Incentive Award Plan (the “ 2019 Plan ”). The 2019 Plan will provide for grants of stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, and other stock or cash based awards. Directors, officers and other employees of Pivotal and its subsidiaries, as well as others performing consulting or advisory services for Pivotal, are eligible for grants under the 2019 Plan. The purpose of the 2019 Plan is to enhance Pivotal’s ability to attract, retain and motivate persons who make (or are expected to make) important contributions to Pivotal by providing these individuals with equity ownership opportunities. Equity awards are intended to motivate high levels of performance and align the interests of Pivotal’s directors, employees and consultants with those of its stockholders by giving directors, employees and consultants the perspective of an owner with an equity stake in Pivotal and providing a means of recognizing their contributions to the success of Pivotal. Pivotal’s board of directors and management believe that equity awards are necessary to remain competitive in the industry and are essential to recruiting and retaining the highly qualified individuals who help Pivotal meet its goals. Set forth below is a summary of the material terms of the 2019 Plan, which is qualified in its entirety by the text of the 2019 Plan, a copy of which is attached hereto as Annex C . For further information about the 2019 Plan, we refer you to the complete copy of the 2019 Plan, which is attached to this proxy statement/prospectus as Annex C . As of                 , 2019, the latest practicable date, the closing price on the NYSE per share of Class A common stock was $                .

Administration

The 2019 Plan will be administered by Pivotal’s board of directors, which may delegate its duties and responsibilities to one or more committees of its directors and/or officers of Pivotal (referred to collectively as the plan administrator below), subject to the limitations imposed under the 2019 Plan, Section 16 of the Exchange Act, stock exchange rules and other applicable laws. The plan administrator will have the authority to take all actions and make all determinations under the 2019 Plan, to interpret the 2019 Plan and award agreements and to adopt, amend and repeal rules for the administration of the 2019 Plan as it deems advisable. The plan administrator will also have the authority to determine which eligible service providers receive awards, grant awards and set the terms and conditions of all awards under the 2019 Plan, including any vesting and vesting acceleration provisions, subject to the conditions and limitations in the 2019 Plan.

Award Limits

The maximum aggregate number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to awards granted under the 2019 Plan is                  shares, all of which may be issued upon the exercise of incentive stock options. Shares issued under the 2019 Plan may be authorized but unissued shares, shares purchased in the open market or treasury shares. The 2019 Plan also includes annual limits on awards that may be granted to non-employee directors. The maximum aggregate grant date fair value, as determined in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718 (or any successor thereto), of awards granted to a non-employee director for services as a director under the 2019 Plan during any fiscal year may not exceed $                 in the fiscal year of the non-employee director’s initial service, and $                 in any other fiscal year. The plan administrator may, however, make exceptions to such limits in extraordinary circumstances, subject to the limitations in the 2019 Plan.

Share Counting Provisions

If an award under the 2019 Plan is terminated, expires or lapses or is exchanged for cash, surrendered, repurchased, cancelled without having been fully exercised or forfeited, in any case, in a manner that results in Pivotal acquiring shares covered by the award at a price not greater than the price (as adjusted to reflect any equity restructuring) paid by the participant for the shares or not issuing any shares covered by the award, the

unused shares covered by the award will again be available for award grants under the 2019 Plan. Shares delivered by a participant to satisfy the applicable exercise or purchase price of an award granted under the 2019 Plan and/or to satisfy any applicable tax withholding obligation will again be available for award grants under the

 

112


Table of Contents

2019 Plan. Dividend equivalents paid in cash will not be counted against the number of shares reserved under the 2019 Plan.

Awards granted under the 2019 Plan in substitution for any options or other stock or stock based awards granted by an entity before the entity’s merger or consolidation with Pivotal (or any of its subsidiaries) or Pivotal’s (or any of its subsidiaries’) acquisition of the entity’s property or stock will not reduce the shares available for grant under the 2019 Plan, but will count against the maximum number of shares that may be issued upon the exercise of incentive stock options.

Eligibility

Employees, consultants and non-employee directors of Pivotal or any of its subsidiaries (as defined in the 2019 Plan) will be eligible to participate in the 2019 Plan. Following the Business Combination, Pivotal and its subsidiaries are expected to have approximately                  employees,                  consultants and                  non-employee directors who will be eligible to receive awards under the 2019 Plan.

Types of Awards

The 2019 Plan provides for the grant of stock options, including incentive stock options and nonqualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, and other stock or cash based awards. Certain awards under the 2019 Plan may constitute or provide for a deferral of compensation, subject to Section 409A of the Code, which may impose additional requirements on the terms and conditions of such awards. All awards under the 2019 Plan will be set forth in award agreements, which will detail the terms and conditions of awards, including any applicable vesting and payment terms and post-termination exercise limitations. A brief description of each award type follows.

 

   

Stock Options and Stock Appreciation Rights (SARs). Stock options provide for the purchase of shares of common stock in the future at an exercise price set on the grant date. Incentive stock options, by contrast to nonqualified stock options, may provide tax deferral beyond exercise and favorable capital gains tax treatment to their holders if certain holding periods and other requirements of the Code are satisfied. SARs entitle their holder, upon exercise, to receive an amount equal to the appreciation of the shares subject to the award between the grant date and the exercise date. The plan administrator will determine the number of shares covered by each option and SAR, the exercise price of each option and SAR and the conditions and limitations applicable to the exercise of each option and SAR. The exercise price of a stock option or SAR will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of the underlying share on the grant date (or 110% in the case of incentive stock options granted to certain significant stockholders), except with respect to certain substitute awards granted in connection with a corporate transaction. The term of a stock option or SAR may not be longer than ten years (or five years in the case of incentive stock options granted to certain significant stockholders).

 

   

Restricted Stock. Restricted stock is an award of nontransferable shares of common stock that remain forfeitable unless and until specified conditions are met and which may be subject to a purchase price. Upon issuance of restricted stock, recipients generally have the rights of a stockholder with respect to such shares, which generally include voting rights in such shares and the right to receive dividends and other distributions in relation to the award; however, dividends may be paid with respect to restricted stock only to the extent the vesting conditions have been satisfied and the restricted stock vests. The terms and conditions applicable to restricted stock will be determined by the plan administrator, subject to the conditions and limitations contained in the 2019 Plan.

 

   

Restricted Stock Units (“ RSUs ”). RSUs are contractual promises to deliver shares of common stock in the future, which may also remain forfeitable unless and until specified conditions are met and may be accompanied by the right to receive the equivalent value of dividends paid on shares of common stock prior to the delivery of the underlying shares. The plan administrator may provide that the delivery of

 

113


Table of Contents
 

the shares underlying RSUs will be deferred on a mandatory basis or at the election of the participant. The terms and conditions applicable to RSUs will be determined by the plan administrator, subject to the conditions and limitations contained in the 2019 Plan.

 

   

Other Stock or Cash Based Awards. Other stock or cash based awards are awards of cash, fully vested shares of common stock and other awards valued wholly or partially by referring to, or otherwise based on, shares of common stock or other property. Other stock or cash based awards may be granted to participants and may also be available as a payment form in the settlement of other awards, as standalone payments and as payment in lieu of compensation to which a participant is otherwise entitled. The plan administrator will determine the terms and conditions of other stock or cash based awards, which may include any purchase price, performance goal, transfer restrictions, vesting conditions and payment terms.

Performance Criteria

The plan administrator may select performance criteria for an award to establish performance goals for a performance period. Performance criteria under the 2019 Plan may include, but will not be limited to, the following: net earnings or losses (either before or after one or more of interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization, and non-cash equity-based compensation expense); gross or net sales or revenue or sales or revenue growth; net income (either before or after taxes) or adjusted net income; profits (including but not limited to gross profits, net profits, profit growth, net operation profit or economic profit), profit return ratios or operating margin; budget or operating earnings (either before or after taxes or before or after allocation of corporate overhead and bonus); cash flow (including operating cash flow and free cash flow or cash flow return on capital); return on assets; return on capital or invested capital; cost of capital; return on stockholders’ equity; total stockholder return; return on sales; costs, reductions in costs and cost control measures; expenses; working capital; earnings or loss per share; adjusted earnings or loss per share; price per share or dividends per share (or appreciation in or maintenance of such price or dividends); regulatory achievements or compliance; implementation, completion or attainment of objectives relating to research, development, regulatory, commercial, or strategic milestones or developments; market share; economic value or economic value added models; division, group or corporate financial goals; customer satisfaction/growth; customer service; employee satisfaction; recruitment and maintenance of personnel; human resources management; supervision of litigation and other legal matters; strategic partnerships and transactions; financial ratios (including those measuring liquidity, activity, profitability or leverage); debt levels or reductions; sales-related goals; financing and other capital raising transactions; cash on hand; acquisition activity; investment sourcing activity; and marketing initiatives, any of which may be measured in absolute terms or as compared to any incremental increase or decrease. Such performance goals also may be based solely by reference to the company’s performance or the performance of a subsidiary, division, business segment or business unit of the company or a subsidiary, or based upon performance relative to performance of other companies or upon comparisons of any of the indicators of performance relative to performance of other companies. When determining performance goals, the plan administrator may provide for exclusion of the impact of an event or occurrence which the plan administrator determines should appropriately be excluded, including, without limitation, non-recurring charges or events, acquisitions or divestitures, changes in the corporate or capital structure, events unrelated to the business or outside of the control of management, foreign exchange considerations, and legal, regulatory, tax or accounting changes. Change in Control and Certain Other Transactions.

In connection with certain corporate transactions and events affecting the common stock, including a change in control, or change in any applicable laws or accounting principles, the plan administrator has broad discretion to take action under the 2019 Plan to prevent the dilution or enlargement of intended benefits, facilitate the transaction or event or give effect to the change in applicable laws or accounting principles. This includes canceling awards for cash or property, accelerating the vesting of awards, providing for the assumption or substitution of awards by a successor entity, adjusting the number and type of shares subject to outstanding awards and/or with respect to which awards may be granted under the 2019 Plan and replacing or terminating

 

114


Table of Contents

awards under the 2019 Plan. In addition, in the event of certain non-reciprocal transactions with stockholders, the plan administrator will make equitable adjustments to the 2019 Plan and outstanding awards as it deems appropriate to reflect the transaction.

Amendment and Termination

The administrator may amend, suspend or terminate the 2019 Plan at any time. However, no amendment, other than an amendment that increases the number of shares available under the 2019 Plan, may materially and adversely affect an award outstanding under the 2019 Plan without the consent of the affected participant. The Board is required to obtain stockholder approval for any amendment to the 2019 Plan to the extent necessary to comply with applicable laws. Further, the plan administrator cannot, without the approval of stockholders, amend any outstanding stock option or SAR to reduce its price per share. The 2019 Plan will remain in effect until the tenth anniversary of the earlier of (i) the date the board of directors adopted the 2019 Plan and (ii) the date the stockholders approve the 2019 Plan, unless earlier terminated by the board of directors. No awards may be granted under the 2019 Plan after its termination.

Foreign Participants, Claw-back Provisions, Transferability and Participant Payments

The plan administrator may modify awards granted to participants who are foreign nationals or employed outside the United States or establish subplans or procedures to address differences in laws, rules, regulations or customs of such foreign jurisdictions. All awards will be subject to any company claw-back policy as set forth in such claw-back policy or the applicable award agreement. Except as the plan administrator may determine or provide in an award agreement, awards under the 2019 Plan are generally non-transferrable, except by will or the laws of descent and distribution, or, subject to the plan administrator’s consent, pursuant to a domestic relations order, and are generally exercisable only by the participant. With regard to tax withholding obligations arising in connection with awards under the 2019 Plan, and exercise price obligations arising in connection with the exercise of stock options under the 2019 Plan, the plan administrator may, in its discretion, accept cash, wire transfer or check, shares of common stock that meet specified conditions, a promissory note, a “market sell order,” such other consideration as the plan administrator deems suitable or any combination of the foregoing.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences

The following summary is based on an analysis of the Code as currently in effect, existing laws, judicial decisions, administrative rulings, regulations and proposed regulations, all of which are subject to change. Moreover, the following is only a summary of U.S. federal income tax consequences. Actual tax consequences to participants in the 2019 Plan may be either more or less favorable than those described below depending on the participants’ particular circumstances. State and local tax consequences may in some cases differ from the U.S. federal income tax consequences. The following summary of the income tax consequences in respect of the 2019 Plan is for general information only. Interested parties should consult their own advisors as to the specific tax consequences of their awards, including the applicability and effect of state, local and foreign laws.

Incentive Stock Options

No income will be recognized by a participant for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the grant or exercise of an incentive stock option under the 2019 Plan. The basis of shares transferred to a participant upon exercise of an incentive stock option is the price paid for the shares. If the participant holds the shares for at least one year after the transfer of the shares to the participant and two years after the grant of the option, the participant generally will recognize capital gain or loss upon sale of the shares received upon exercise equal to the difference between the amount realized on the sale and the basis of the stock. Generally, if the shares are not held for that period, the participant will recognize ordinary income upon disposition in an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of the shares on the date of exercise over the amount paid for the shares, or if less (and if the disposition is a transaction in which loss, if any, will be recognized), the gain on disposition. Any additional gain realized by

 

115


Table of Contents

the participant upon the disposition will be a capital gain. The excess of the fair market value of shares received upon the exercise of an incentive stock option over the option price for the shares is an item of adjustment for the participant for purposes of the alternative minimum tax. Therefore, although no income is recognized upon exercise of an incentive stock option, a participant may be subject to alternative minimum tax as a result of the exercise.

Non-qualified Stock Options

No income is expected to be recognized by a participant for U.S. federal income tax purposes upon the grant of a non-qualified stock option. Upon exercise of a non-qualified stock option, the participant will recognize ordinary income in an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of the shares on the date of exercise over the amount paid for the shares. Income recognized upon the exercise of a non-qualified stock option will be considered compensation subject to withholding at the time the income is recognized, and, therefore, the participant’s employer must make the necessary arrangements with the participant to ensure that the amount of the tax required to be withheld is available for payment. Non-qualified stock options are designed to provide the employer with a deduction equal to the amount of ordinary income recognized by the participant at the time of the recognition by the participant, subject to the deduction limitations described below.

Stock Appreciation Rights

There is expected to be no U.S. federal income tax consequences to either the participant or the employer upon the grant of SARs. Generally, the participant will recognize ordinary income subject to withholding upon the receipt of payment pursuant to SARs in an amount equal to the aggregate amount of cash and the fair market value of any common stock received. Subject to the deduction limitations described below, the employer generally will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction equal to the amount includible in the participant’s income.

Restricted Stock

If the restrictions on an award of shares of restricted stock are of a nature that the shares are both subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture and are not freely transferable (within the meaning of Section 83 of the Code), the participant will not recognize income for U.S. federal income tax purposes at the time of the award unless the participant affirmatively elects to include the fair market value of the shares of restricted stock on the date of the award, less any amount paid for the shares, in gross income for the year of the award pursuant to Section 83(b) of the Code. In the absence of this election, the participant will be required to include in income for United States federal income tax purposes on the date the shares either become freely transferable or are no longer subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture (within the meaning of Section 83 of the Code), the fair market value of the shares of restricted stock on such date, less any amount paid for the shares. The employer will be entitled to a deduction at the time of income recognition to the participant in an amount equal to the amount the participant is required to include in income with respect to the shares, subject to the deduction limitations described below. If a Section 83(b) election is made within 30 days after the date the restricted stock is received, the participant will recognize ordinary income at the time of the receipt of the restricted stock, and the employer will be entitled to a corresponding deduction, equal to the fair market value of the shares at the time, less the amount paid, if any, by the participant for the restricted stock. If a Section 83(b) election is made, no additional income will be recognized by the participant upon the lapse of restrictions on the restricted stock, but, if the restricted stock is subsequently forfeited, the participant may not deduct the income that was recognized pursuant to the Section 83(b) election at the time of the receipt of the restricted stock.

Dividends paid to a participant holding restricted stock before the expiration of the restriction period will be additional compensation taxable as ordinary income to the participant subject to withholding, unless the participant made an election under Section 83(b) of the Code. Subject to the deduction limitations described below, the employer generally will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction equal to the dividends includible

 

116


Table of Contents

in the participant’s income as compensation. If the participant has made a Section 83(b) election, the dividends will be dividend income, rather than additional compensation, to the participant.

If the restrictions on an award of restricted stock are not of a nature that the shares are both subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture and not freely transferable, within the meaning of Section 83 of the Code, the participant will recognize ordinary income for U.S. federal income tax purposes at the time of the transfer of the shares in an amount equal to the fair market value of the shares of restricted stock on the date of the transfer, less any amount paid therefor. The employer will be entitled to a deduction at that time in an amount equal to the amount the participant is required to include in income with respect to the restricted shares, subject to the deduction limitations described below.

Restricted Stock Units

There generally will be no U.S. federal income tax consequences to either the participant or the employer upon the grant of RSUs. Generally, the participant will recognize ordinary income subject to withholding upon the receipt of cash and/or transfer of shares of common stock in payment of the RSUs in an amount equal to the aggregate of the cash received and the fair market value of the common stock so transferred. Subject to the deduction limitations described below, the employer generally will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction equal to the amount includible in the participant’s income.

Generally, a participant will recognize ordinary income subject to withholding upon the payment of any dividend equivalents paid with respect to an award in an amount equal to the cash and the fair market value of any common stock the participant receives. Subject to the deduction limitations described below, the employer generally will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction equal to the amount includible in the participant’s income.

Stock Awards

If a participant receives a stock award in lieu of a cash payment that would otherwise have been made, the participant generally will be taxed as if the cash payment has been received, and the employer will have a deduction in the same amount.

Limitation on the Employer’s Compensation Deduction

Section 162(m) of the Code limits the deduction certain employers may take for otherwise deductible compensation payable to certain executive officers of the employer to the extent the compensation paid to such an officer for the year exceeds $1 million.

Excess Parachute Payments

Section 280G of the Code limits the deduction that the employer may take for otherwise deductible compensation payable to certain individuals if the compensation constitutes an “excess parachute payment.” Excess parachute payments arise from payments made to disqualified individuals that are in the nature of compensation and are contingent on changes in ownership or control of the employer or certain affiliates. Accelerated vesting or payment of awards under the 2019 Plan upon a change in ownership or control of the employer or its affiliates could result in excess parachute payments. In addition to the deduction limitation applicable to the employer, a disqualified individual receiving an excess parachute payment is subject to a 20% excise tax on the amount thereof.

Application of Section 409A of the Code

Section 409A of the Code imposes an additional 20% tax and interest on an individual receiving non-qualified deferred compensation under a plan that fails to satisfy certain requirements. For purposes of Section 409A,

 

117


Table of Contents

“non-qualified deferred compensation” includes equity-based incentive programs, including some stock options, stock appreciation rights and RSU programs. Generally speaking, Section 409A does not apply to incentive stock options, non-discounted non-qualified stock options and stock appreciation rights if no deferral is provided beyond exercise, or restricted stock.

The awards made pursuant to the 2019 Plan are expected to be designed in a manner intended to comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code to the extent the awards granted under the 2019 Plan are not exempt from coverage. However, if the 2019 Plan fails to comply with Section 409A in operation, a participant could be subject to the additional taxes and interest.

State, local and foreign tax consequences may in some cases differ from the U.S. federal income tax consequences described above. The foregoing summary of the United States federal income tax consequences in respect of the 2019 Plan is for general information only. Interested parties should consult their own advisors as to specific tax consequences of their awards.

The 2019 Plan is not subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, and is not intended to be qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code.

New 2019 Plan Benefits

Grants under the 2019 Plan will be made at the discretion of the plan administrator and are not currently determinable. The value of the awards granted under the 2019 Plan will depend on a number of factors, including the fair market value of the common stock on future dates, the exercise decisions made by the participants and the extent to which any applicable performance goals necessary for vesting or payment are achieved.

Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans

As of December 31, 2018, we had no equity compensation plans or outstanding equity awards. The following table is presented as of December 31, 2018 in accordance with SEC requirements:

 

Plan Category

   Number of Securities
to be Issued Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
     Weighted Average
Exercise Price of
Outstanding
Options, Warrants
and Rights
     Number of Securities
Remaining Available
for Future Issuance
Under Equity
Compensation Plans
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

     —          —          —    

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

     —          —          —    

Interests of Certain Persons in this Proposal

Pivotal’s directors and executive officers may be considered to have an interest in the approval of the 2019 Plan because they may in the future receive awards under the 2019 Plan. Nevertheless, the board of directors believes that it is important to provide incentives and rewards for superior performance and the retention of executive officers and experienced directors by adopting the 2019 Plan.

Required Vote

If the business combination proposals are not approved, the incentive plan proposal will not be presented at the annual meeting. The incentive plan proposal requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock represented in person or by proxy at the meeting and entitled to vote thereon.

 

118


Table of Contents

Board’s Recommendation

THE PIVOTAL BOARD OF DIRECTORS UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT THE PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” THE APPROVAL OF THE INCENTIVE PLAN PROPOSAL.

 

119


Table of Contents

THE ADJOURNMENT PROPOSAL

The adjournment proposal allows Pivotal’s board of directors to submit a proposal to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date or dates if Pivotal is unable to consummate the Business Combination for any reason. In no event will Pivotal solicit proxies to adjourn the annual meeting or consummate the Business Combination beyond the date by which it may properly do so under the Merger Agreement or its second amended and restated certificate of incorporation and Delaware law. The purpose of the adjournment proposal is to provide more time to consummate the Business Combination. See the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal—Interests of the Founder and Pivotal’s Directors and Officers in the Business Combination .”

In addition to an adjournment of the annual meeting upon approval of an adjournment proposal, Pivotal’s board of directors is empowered under Delaware law to postpone the meeting at any time prior to the meeting being called to order. In such event, Pivotal will issue a press release and take such other steps as it believes are necessary and practical in the circumstances to inform its stockholders of the postponement.

Consequences if the Adjournment Proposal is not Approved

If an adjournment proposal is presented to the meeting and is not approved by the stockholders, Pivotal’s board of directors may not be able to adjourn the annual meeting to a later date if Pivotal is unable to consummate the Business Combination (because either the business combination proposal is not approved or the conditions to consummating the Business Combination have not been met). In such event, the Business Combination would not be completed.

Required Vote

Adoption of the adjournment proposal requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the issued and outstanding common stock represented in person or by proxy at the meeting and entitled to vote thereon. Adoption of the adjournment proposal is not conditioned upon the adoption of any of the other proposals.

THE PIVOTAL BOARD OF DIRECTORS UNANIMOUSLY RECOMMENDS THAT PIVOTAL STOCKHOLDERS VOTE “FOR” THE APPROVAL OF THE ADJOURNMENT PROPOSAL.

 

120


Table of Contents

OTHER INFORMATION RELATED TO PIVOTAL

Introduction

Pivotal was incorporated on August 2, 2018 for the purpose of entering into a merger, share exchange, asset acquisition, stock purchase, recapitalization, reorganization or other similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities. Pivotal’s efforts to identify a prospective target business were not limited to any particular industry or geographic region. Prior to executing the Merger Agreement, Pivotal’s efforts were limited to organizational activities, completion of its initial public offering and the evaluation of possible business combinations.

Initial Public Offering and Simultaneous Private Placement

On February 4, 2019, Pivotal closed its initial public offering of 23,000,000 units, including 3,000,000 units subject to the exercise in full of the underwriters’ overallotment option, with each unit consisting of one share of Class A common stock and one warrant to purchase one share of Class A common stock at a price of $11.50 commencing 30 days after the consummation of an initial business combination. The units from Pivotal’s initial public offering (including the over-allotment option) were sold at an offering price of $10.00 per unit, generating total gross proceeds of $230,000,000. Simultaneously with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering and the exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, Pivotal consummated the private sale of 6,350,000 private warrants at $1.00 per warrant generating gross proceeds of $6,350,000. Pivotal’s initial public offering was conducted pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-1 (Reg. No. 333-229027) that became effective on January 30, 2019.

A total of $230,000,000 was deposited into a trust account at JP Morgan Chase Bank, N.A., with Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company acting as trustee. Pivotal may withdraw from the trust account interest earned on the funds held therein necessary to pay our income taxes, if any. Except as described in the prospectus for Pivotal’s initial public offering and described in the subsection below entitled “ —Pivotal’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ,” these proceeds will not be released until the earlier of the completion of an initial business combination and Pivotal’s redemption of 100% of the outstanding public shares upon its failure to consummate a business combination within the required time period.

The remaining proceeds from Pivotal’s initial public offering and simultaneous private placement, net of underwriting discounts and commissions and other costs and expenses, became available to be used as working capital to provide for business, legal and accounting due diligence on prospective business combinations and continuing general and administrative expenses.

Fair Market Value of Target Business

The target business or businesses that Pivotal acquires must collectively have a fair market value equal to at least 80% of the balance of the funds in the trust account (excluding the amount of deferred underwriting commissions held in trust) at the time of the execution of a definitive agreement for its initial business combination, although Pivotal may acquire a target business whose fair market value significantly exceeds 80% of the trust account balance. Pivotal’s board of directors determined that this test was met in connection with the proposed business combination with the Company as described in the section entitled “ The Business Combination Proposal ” above.

Stockholder Approval of Business Combination

Under Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation, in connection with any proposed business combination, Pivotal must seek stockholder approval of an initial business combination at a meeting called for such purpose at which public stockholders may seek to have their public shares converted into cash, regardless of whether they vote for or against the proposed business combination or do not vote at all, subject to

 

121


Table of Contents

the limitations described in the prospectus for Pivotal’s initial public offering. Accordingly, in connection with the Business Combination with the Company, the Pivotal public stockholders may seek to have their public shares converted to cash in accordance with the procedures set forth in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Voting Restrictions in Connection with Stockholder Meeting

In connection with any vote for a proposed business combination, including the vote with respect to the business combination proposal, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors have each agreed to vote the founder shares as well as any common stock acquired by them in the aftermarket in favor of such proposed Business Combination.

At any time prior to the annual meeting, during a period when they are not then aware of any material nonpublic information regarding Pivotal or its securities, the Founder, Pivotal’s officers and directors, the Company, the Company’s stockholders and/or their respective affiliates may purchase shares from institutional and other investors who vote, or indicate an intention to vote, against the business combination proposal, or execute agreements to purchase such shares from them in the future, or they may enter into transactions with such persons and others to provide them with incentives to acquire common stock or vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. The purpose of such share purchases and other transactions would be to increase the likelihood of satisfaction of the requirements that the Business Combination be approved where it appears that such requirements would otherwise not be met. All shares repurchased by Pivotal’s affiliates pursuant to such arrangements would be voted in favor of the proposed Business Combination. As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, no agreements dealing with the above have been entered into.

Liquidation if No Business Combination

Under Pivotal’s current amended and restated certificate of incorporation, if Pivotal does not complete the Business Combination with the Company or another initial business combination by August 4, 2020 (or such later date as may be approved by Pivotal stockholders in an amendment to its amended and restated certificate of incorporation), Pivotal will (i) cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, (ii) as promptly as reasonably possible but not more than ten business days thereafter, redeem 100% of the outstanding public shares and (iii) as promptly as reasonably possible following such redemption, subject to the approval of Pivotal’s remaining stockholders and its board of directors, dissolve and liquidate, subject (in the case of (ii) and (iii) above) to Pivotal’s obligations under Delaware law to provide for claims of creditors and the requirements of other applicable law. At such time, the warrants will expire. Holders of warrants will receive nothing upon a liquidation with respect to such rights and the warrants will be worthless.

Each of the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors has agreed to waive its rights to participate in any distribution from Pivotal’s trust account or other assets with respect to the founder shares. There will be no distribution from the trust account with respect to Pivotal’s warrants, which will expire worthless if Pivotal is liquidated.

The proceeds deposited in the trust account could, however, become subject to the claims of Pivotal’s creditors which would be prior to the claims of the Pivotal public stockholders. Although Pivotal has obtained waiver agreements from certain vendors and service providers it has engaged and owes money to, and the prospective target businesses Pivotal has negotiated with, whereby such parties have waived any right, title, interest or claim of any kind they may have in or to any monies held in the trust account, and although Pivotal will seek such waivers from vendors it engages in the future, there is no guarantee that they or other vendors who did not execute such waivers will not seek recourse against the trust account notwithstanding such agreements. The Founder has agreed that it will be liable under certain circumstances to pay debts and obligations to target businesses or vendors or other entities that are owed money by Pivotal for services rendered or contracted for or products sold to it, but Pivotal cannot ensure that the Founder will be able to satisfy its indemnification obligations if it is required to do so. Additionally there are two exceptions to the Founder’s personal indemnity:

 

122


Table of Contents

the Founder will have no personal liability (1) as to any claimed amounts owed to a target business or vendor or other entity who has executed an agreement with Pivotal waiving any right, title, interest or claim of any kind they may have in or to any monies held in the trust account, or (2) as to any claims under the indemnity with the underwriters of Pivotal’s initial public offering against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. Moreover, the Founder will not be liable to the Pivotal public stockholders and instead will only have liability to Pivotal. Furthermore, the Founder may not be able to satisfy its indemnification obligations if it is required to as the Founder’s only assets are securities of Pivotal and Pivotal has not taken any further steps to ensure that the Founder will be able to satisfy any indemnification obligations that arise. Accordingly, the actual per-share redemption price could be less than approximately $10.00, plus interest, due to claims of creditors. Additionally, if Pivotal is forced to file a bankruptcy case or an involuntary bankruptcy case is filed against it which is not dismissed, the proceeds held in the trust account could be subject to applicable bankruptcy law, and may be included in Pivotal’s bankruptcy estate and subject to the claims of third parties with priority over the claims of Pivotal’s stockholders. To the extent any bankruptcy claims deplete the trust account, Pivotal cannot assure you it will be able to return to the Pivotal public stockholders at least approximately $10.00 per share. Pivotal’s public stockholders are entitled to receive funds from the trust account only in the event of its failure to complete a business combination within the required time periods or if the stockholders properly seek to have Pivotal redeem their respective shares for cash upon a business combination which is actually completed by Pivotal. In no other circumstances does a stockholder have any right or interest of any kind to or in the trust account.

If Pivotal is forced to file a bankruptcy case or an involuntary bankruptcy case is filed against it which is not dismissed, any distributions received by stockholders could be viewed under applicable debtor, creditor and/or bankruptcy laws as either a “preferential transfer” or a “fraudulent conveyance.” As a result, a bankruptcy court could seek to recover all amounts received by Pivotal’s stockholders. Because Pivotal intends to distribute the proceeds held in the trust account to its public stockholders promptly after the expiration of the time period to complete a business combination, this may be viewed or interpreted as giving preference to its public stockholders over any potential creditors with respect to access to or distributions from its assets. Furthermore, Pivotal’s board of directors may be viewed as having breached their fiduciary duties to its creditors and/or may have acted in bad faith, and thereby exposing itself and the company to claims of punitive damages, by paying public stockholders from the trust account prior to addressing the claims of creditors. Pivotal cannot assure you that claims will not be brought against it for these reasons.

Pivotal will pay the costs of any subsequent liquidation from its remaining assets outside of the trust account plus the up to $100,000 of interest earned on the funds in the trust account that Pivotal may use for liquidation and dissolution expenses.

Employees

Pivotal has two executive officers. These individuals are not obligated to devote any specific number of hours to Pivotal’s matters and intend to devote only as much time as they deem necessary to its affairs. Pivotal does not intend to have any full time employees prior to the consummation of the Merger.

Facilities

Upon consummation of the Merger, the principal executive offices of Pivotal will be those of the Company.

 

123


Table of Contents

Directors and Executive Officers

Pivotal’s current directors and executive officers are as follows:

 

Name

   Age   

Position

Jonathan J. Ledecky

   61    Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

James H.R. Brady

   54    Chief Financial Officer

Kevin Griffin

   42    Director

Efrat Epstein

   35    Director

Katrina Adams

   50    Director

See “ The Director Election Proposal—Information about Executive Officers, Directors and Nominees ” for biographies of Messrs. Ledecky and Griffin.

James H.R. Brady  has served as Pivotal’s Chief Financial Officer since September 2018. Since 2014, Mr. Brady has been the Chief Executive Officer of Brady Enterprises, an advisory firm Mr. Brady founded that provides financial, legal and strategic services to growth companies. From 2013 to 2014, Mr. Brady was the Chief Financial Officer and General Counsel of Sweetgreen, a high-growth healthy, fast casual restaurant chain. From 2011 to 2013, Mr. Brady was Executive Vice President – Finance and Legal for Audax Health Solutions, a digital health/social media company. From 2009 to 2011, he was Executive Counsel of ODIN Technologies, a RFID software company. Mr. Brady previously served as a corporate and securities attorney with the firms of Hogan & Hartson and Hunton & Williams. Mr. Brady received a BA from the College of William and Mary, a JD from the George Washington National Law Center and a MBA from Darden Graduate School of Business at the University of Virginia.

Efrat Epstein  has served as a member of Pivotal’s board of directors since December 2018. Ms. Epstein has held leadership positions across media, tech and financial services. Since November 2016, Ms. Epstein has been the Managing Partner of Sound Ventures, an LA-based venture capital fund founded by Ashton Kutcher and Guy Oseary. In this role, Ms. Epstein leads investing, strategy and the day-to-day management of the fund. From January 2016 to November 2016, Ms. Epstein led Global Strategy at Marsh, a multi-billion dollar division of financial services firm Marsh & McLennan (NYSE: MMC). From October 2013 to January 2016, Ms. Epstein was Senior Vice President of Planning and Head of Investor Relations at iHeartMedia, a global entertainment company, and from May 2011 to September 2013, she was Head of Business Development and Strategy at CLEAR, a privately held technology company. Earlier in her career, Ms. Epstein was part of Merrill Lynch’s Global Energy and Power Investment Banking group as well as the Global Strategy team at NYSE Euronext. Ms. Epstein received a BA from the University of Texas in Austin and an MBA from Harvard Business School.

Katrina Adams  has served as a member of Pivotal’s board of directors since December 2018. Ms. Adams has served as the Immediate Past President of the U.S. Tennis Association since January 2019. She was Chairman of the Board and President of the U.S. Tennis Association from January 2015 to January 1, 2019. She also served as Chairman of the U.S. Open during this time. Ms. Adams is the first African-American, first former professional tennis player and youngest person to serve as President in the organization’s 135-year history. She is also the first individual to serve a second two-year term as Chairman of the Board and President. In 2015, Ms. Adams was elected Vice President of the International Tennis Federation and in 2016, she was appointed Chairman of the Fed Cup Committee, which governs the Fed Cup, the largest annual international team competition in women’s sport. She also serves on the board of directors for the International Tennis Hall of Fame. An accomplished tennis professional, Ms. Adams played for 12 years on the Women’s Tennis Association tour, where she ranked as high as No. 67 in the world in singles and No. 8 in doubles, winning 20 career doubles titles and reaching the quarterfinals or better in doubles at all four Grand Slam events.

While an active pro, Ms. Adams served on the board of directors of the Women’s Tennis Association as a player representative for four one-year terms and on the Women’s Tennis Association’s Players Association for five two-year terms. After leaving the tour, Ms. Adams was a USTA National Tennis Coach from 1999 to 2002.

 

124


Table of Contents

She also joined the USTA’s Board of Directors in 2005, serving as a Director at Large and as the association’s Vice President and First Vice President before assuming the presidency. She was named the Intercollegiate Tennis Association (“ ITA ”) Rookie of the Year in 1986 and an NCAA All-American in 1986 and 1987. She also became the first African-American to win the NCAA doubles title in 1987. Among her many accolades, Ms. Adams was honored with the WTA’s Player Service Award in 1989, 1996 and 1997, and she received the WTA Althea Gibson Award in 2003. In addition, she was inducted into the Northwestern Hall of Fame in 1998, the USTA Midwest Section Hall of Fame in 2005, the Chicago District Tennis Hall of Fame in 2008, the Black Tennis Hall of Fame in 2012, the ITA Women’s Tennis Hall of Fame in 2014 and the USTA Eastern Section Tennis Hall of Fame in 2015. She was also named one of the “25 Influential Black Women in Business” by The Network Journal and as one of Sports Business Daily’s “Game Changers” in 2015. In 2016, she was inducted into the Boys & Girls Clubs of America Alumni Hall of Fame. In addition to her duties with the USTA, Ms. Adams is a contributor on CBS Sports Network’s first all-female sports show, “We Need to Talk.” She also serves as a television analyst for Tennis Channel and as a contributor to Tennis magazine and tennis.com, providing instructional articles and videos. Moreover, since 2005, Ms. Adams has served as the Executive Director of the Harlem Junior Tennis and Education Program, a National Junior Tennis & Learning network chapter based in New York City. Ms. Adams attended Northwestern University, majoring in communications, before deciding to leave school and focus on her professional tennis career.

Legal Proceedings

There is no material litigation, arbitration, governmental proceeding or any other legal proceeding currently pending or known to be contemplated against Pivotal, and Pivotal has not been subject to any such proceeding in the 10 years preceding the date of this proxy statement/prospectus.

Periodic Reporting and Audited Financial Statements

Pivotal has registered its securities under the Exchange Act and has reporting obligations, including the requirement to file annual and quarterly reports with the SEC. In accordance with the requirements of the Exchange Act, Pivotal’s annual reports contain financial statements audited and reported on by Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm. Pivotal has filed with the SEC its Annual Report on Form 10-K covering the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018 and its Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2019.

Pivotal’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The following discussion of Pivotal’s financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with Pivotal’s consolidated financial statements and notes to those statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. This discussion contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Please see “ Forward-Looking Statements ” and “ Risk Factors ” in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Critical Accounting Policies

For a more detailed discussion of Pivotal’s Accounting Policies, please see Note 2 to the financial statements of Pivotal included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Common stock Subject to Possible Redemption

Pivotal accounts for its common stock subject to possible redemption in accordance with the guidance enumerated in ASC 480 “Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity.” Common stock subject to mandatory redemption (if any) is classified as a liability instrument and is measured at fair value. Conditionally convertible common stock (including common stock that features redemption rights that are either within the control of the holder or subject to redemption upon the occurrence of uncertain events not solely within Pivotal’s control) is

 

125


Table of Contents

classified as temporary equity. At all other times, common stock is classified as stockholders’ equity. Pivotal common stock features certain redemption rights that are considered by Pivotal to be outside of Pivotal’s control and subject to the occurrence of uncertain future events.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Management does not believe that any recently issued, but not yet effective, accounting standards if currently adopted would have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements of Pivotal included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

Results of Operations

Pivotal has not generated any revenues to date and will not do so until the consummation of a business combination. Since its initial public offering, Pivotal’s activity has been limited to the evaluation of business combination candidates. Pivotal expects to generate small amounts of non-operating income in the form of interest income on cash and cash equivalents. Interest income is not expected to be significant in view of current low interest rates on risk-free investments (treasury securities). Pivotal currently incurs increased expenses as a result of being a public company (for legal, financial reporting, accounting and auditing compliance), as well as for due diligence expenses.

For the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018, Pivotal had a net loss of $1,127, which consists of operating and formation costs. For the three months ended March 31, 2019, Pivotal had net income of $456,797, consisting of interest income on marketable securities held in the trust account and unrealized gain on marketable securities held in the trust account, offset by operating costs and a provision for income taxes.

Financial Condition and Liquidity

As of March 31, 2019, Pivotal had cash of $1,048,539 held outside the trust account. Until the consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering, Pivotal’s only source of liquidity was an initial purchase of common stock by the Founder and unsecured loans from the Founder.

On February 4, 2019, Pivotal consummated its initial public offering of 23,000,000 units, including 3,000,000 units subject to the underwriters’ over-allotment option. The units were sold at an offering price of $10.00 per unit, generating gross proceeds of $230,000,000. Simultaneously with the consummation of its initial public offering, Pivotal consummated the private placement of 6,350,000 private warrants at a price of $1.00 per private warrant, generating total proceeds of $6,350,000. The private warrants were purchased by the Founder.

Following Pivotal’s initial public offering and private placement of private warrants, a total of $230,000,000 was placed in the trust account.

Pivotal working capital held outside the trust account is used primarily to identify and evaluate target businesses, perform business due diligence on prospective target businesses, travel to and from the offices, plants or similar locations of prospective target businesses or their representatives or owners, review corporate documents and material agreements of prospective target businesses, and structure, negotiate and complete a business combination.

 

126


Table of Contents

Pivotal has principally financed its operations from inception using proceeds from the sale of equity securities to stockholders prior to its initial public offering and such amount of proceeds from its initial public offering that were placed in an account outside of the trust account for working capital purposes, interest that has been earned on the funds in the trust account released for working capital needs, and through loans from officers, directors and stockholders. Pivotal believes it will have sufficient cash to meet its needs through the earlier of the consummation of a business combination or August 4, 2020, the date that Pivotal will be required to cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, if a business combination is not consummated.

If Pivotal’s estimates of the costs of identifying a target business, undertaking in-depth due diligence and negotiating an initial business combination are less than the actual amount necessary to do so, it may have insufficient funds available to operate its business prior to the consummation of the initial business combination. In order to fund working capital deficiencies or finance transaction costs in connection with an intended initial Business Combination, the Founder or Pivotal’s officers and directors or their respective affiliates may, but are not obligated to, except as described above, loan Pivotal funds as may be required on a non-interest basis. If Pivotal completes its initial business combination, it would repay such loaned amounts. In the event that the initial business combination does not close, Pivotal may use a portion of the working capital held outside the trust account to repay such loaned amounts but no proceeds from the trust account would be used for such repayment. Up to $1,500,000 of such loans may be convertible into warrants of Pivotal at a price of $1.00 per warrant at the option of the lender. The warrants would be identical to the private warrants. Prior to the completion of an initial business combination, Pivotal does not expect to seek loans from parties other than from the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors or their respective affiliates as Pivotal does not believe third parties will be willing to loan such funds and provide a waiver against any and all rights to seek access to funds in the trust account.

Moreover, Pivotal may need to obtain additional financing to complete the initial business combination, either because the transaction requires more cash than is available from the proceeds held in the trust account or because Pivotal becomes obligated to convert a significant number of public shares upon completion of the business combination, in which case Pivotal may issue additional securities or incur debt in connection with such business combination. If Pivotal is unable to complete the initial business combination because it does not have sufficient funds available to it, it will be forced to cease operations and liquidate the trust account.

Contractual obligations

Pivotal does not have any long-term indebtedness, capital lease obligations, operating lease obligations or long-term liabilities.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

Pivotal did not have any off-balance sheet arrangements as of December 31, 2018.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Market risk is a broad term for the risk of economic loss due to adverse changes in the fair value of a financial instrument. These changes may be the result of various factors, including interest rates, foreign exchange rates, commodity prices and/or equity prices.

As of the period ended December 31, 2018, Pivotal was not subject to any market or interest rate risk. Net proceeds from Pivotal’s initial public offering of $230 million (which includes approximately $8 million of the proceeds attributable to the underwriters’ deferred discount from its initial public offering) have been placed in the trust account at J.P. Morgan Securities, with Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company acting as trustee. As of March 31, 2019, the balance of restricted cash and cash equivalents held in the trust account was $230,806,004 million, including $792,044 of interest earned available for tax purposes. As of March 31, 2019,

 

127


Table of Contents

the proceeds held in trust were invested in U.S. Treasury Bills with a maturity date of 180 days or less or in certain money market funds that invest solely in U.S. Treasury Bills. Due to the short-term nature of these investments and the low interest rates related to these types of investments, Pivotal believes there will be no material exposure related to interest rate risk. Pivotal does not believe that the effect of other changes, such as foreign exchange rates, commodity prices and/or equity prices, currently pose significant market risk for Pivotal.

Stock Performance Graph

The following stock performance graph compares the cumulative total return for Pivotal’s Class A common stock from March 25, 2019 (the date our warrants and Class A common stock commenced separate trading on the NYSE) through May 31, 2019 with the comparable cumulative return of two indices: the S&P SmallCap 600 and the NASDAQ US Benchmark TR. The graph assumes an initial investment of $100 on March 25, 2019 and reinvestment of dividends.

 

 

LOGO

Independent Auditors’ Fees

Marcum acts as Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm. The following is a summary of fees paid or to be paid to Marcum for services rendered.

Audit Fees . Audit fees consist of fees billed for professional services rendered for the audit of Pivotal’s year-end financial statements and services that are normally provided by Marcum in connection with regulatory filings. The aggregate fees billed by Marcum for professional services rendered in connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering and the audit of Pivotal’s financial statements for the fiscal period ended December 31, 2018 totaled $35,000. The above amount includes interim procedures and audit fees, as well as attendance at audit committee meetings.

Audit-Related Fees . During the fiscal period ended December 31, 2018, Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm did not render assurance and related services related to the performance of the audit or review of financial statements.

 

128


Table of Contents

Tax Fees . During the fiscal period ended December 31, 2018, Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm did not render services for tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.

All Other Fees . During the fiscal period ended December 31, 2018, there were no fees billed for products and services provided by Pivotal’s independent registered public accounting firm other than those set forth above.

Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures

Since Pivotal’s audit committee was not formed until January 31, 2019, the audit committee did not pre-approve any of the foregoing services that were incurred prior to such date, although any services rendered prior to the formation of the audit committee were reviewed and ratified by Pivotal’s board of directors. In accordance with Section 10A(i) of the Exchange Act, before Pivotal engages its independent accountant to render audit or non-audit services on a going-forward basis, the engagement will be approved by its audit committee.

Code of Ethics

On January 31, 2019, Pivotal’s board of directors adopted a code of ethics that applies to all of Pivotal’s executive officers, directors and employees. The code of ethics codifies the business and ethical principles that govern all aspects of Pivotal’s business. Pivotal will provide, without charge, upon request, copies of its code of ethics. Requests for copies of Pivotal’s code of ethics should be sent in writing to Pivotal Acquisition Corp., c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174.

Upon the consummation of the Business Combination, Pivotal’s code of ethics will apply to all of the executive officers, directors and employees of Pivotal and its subsidiaries, including the Company.

 

129


Table of Contents

BUSINESS OF THE COMPANY

Company Overview

In this proxy statement/prospectus, the words “we,” “our”, “us,” “KLDiscovery,” “KLD” or the “Company” refer to LD Topco Inc, a Delaware corporation, and its direct and indirect wholly owned subsidiaries. This proxy statement/prospectus also refers to our websites, but information contained on those sites is not part of this proxy statement/prospectus.

We are one of the leading eDiscovery providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers. In 2018, we served over 4,300 legal technology clients, including 95% of the AM Law 100 and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. We have broad geographical coverage in the eDiscovery and data recovery industries with 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. Our technology and service offerings protect our clients from growing information governance challenges, litigation, compliance breaches and data loss.

Our legal technology service offerings provide a wide variety of solutions for information governance and eDiscovery, including forensic collections, data processing, secure hosting, managed document review, advanced analytics and document production. eDiscovery refers to a process in which electronic data is sought, located, secured, searched and analyzed with the intent of using it as evidence in a civil, criminal or investigative legal case or regulatory action. Our data recovery service offerings allow clients to recover data in the event of physical or logical loss and provide data management tools and solutions and proprietary data erasure technologies. We differentiate ourselves through our leading integrated suite of proprietary software and services, geographic scale and award-winning corporate culture, which we believe drives our client service success.

We have longstanding relationships with our clients and a greater than 95% year-over-year retention rate. Our client retention is driven primarily by two factors: technological excellence and a culture of client service. We were ranked as a top eDiscovery provider in an aggregation of fourteen “Best Of” customer surveys from a variety of ALM online legal publications.

We offer our clients both proprietary and third-party solutions to address their legal technology requirements. Our proprietary end-to-end eDiscovery solution, Nebula, can be deployed on the cloud, on premise or behind a client’s firewall via mobile kits. This technology is a key selling point and these solutions are critical to our success. We believe that our proprietary solutions offer us a unique competitive advantage in the industry, giving us an exclusive product, which allows our clients to execute their job functions quickly and with a high degree of accuracy, thus saving them time and expense. In addition to our proprietary suite of tools, we can integrate third-party applications and tools into our workflow to create what we believe is the best possible solution for our clients. This is useful for projects where clients want to take advantage of our technology platform, but may also have a need to leverage technology that specializes in one narrow aspect. We uphold a core set of client service values including teamwork, responsiveness and sole focus on client service. As we have scaled our global operations, this set of shared beliefs has created a unique environment where employees thrive and work together to deliver our white-glove, 24/7/365 service to our clients. In an industry that is driven by long-term, repeat

relationship business, we believe our technology solutions, coupled with our dedication to excellent service, have continued to set us apart from the competition.

 

130


Table of Contents

Company History

We were founded in 2005 as a forensic and eDiscovery company. We recapitalized with an investment from Westview in September 2011, at which point we began executing a targeted acquisition strategy focused on tuck-in acquisitions of companies that would benefit from our scale and offer us advanced technology solutions and attractive client relationships. Since 2013, we acquired nine U.S. regional eDiscovery companies ranging in size and capabilities, including our 2013 acquisition of AlphaLit and our 2014 acquisition of RenewData. The RenewData acquisition facilitated our entry into the data archiving market, allowing us to increase our geographic reach, diversify our client base, grow our salesforce and further develop our technology platform.

In 2015, we recapitalized with TCG and RG. This recapitalization provided us with the resources to execute our largest acquisition to date, Kroll Ontrack, which was completed in December 2016. The Kroll Ontrack acquisition expanded our operations to 20 countries, allowing us to position ourselves as one of a small number of eDiscovery companies with cross-border capabilities. The acquisition also made us a global leader in data recovery services, via the “Ontrack” business, which has been providing data recovery services since 1985.

In 2017, we launched Nebula, a proprietary end-to-end eDiscovery solution optimized for the cloud. In 2018, in order to make further investments in sales and technology, we announced growth equity financing from our prior investor, Westview, together with Carlyle and Revolution. Coinciding with the investment, we released our mobile eDiscovery solution, Nebula Private Cloud (“ NPC ”), which allows our clients to have a small-scale private data center behind their own firewall. Also in 2018, we furthered our geographic expansion through Western Europe and Canada by opening additional data centers and managed review facilities.

In 2019, we announced our Nebula Big Data Store offering for information governance management which will include legal hold and notification services, thus expanding our proprietary technology suite into the information archiving market. We also opened a new document review facility in Sydney, Australia and re-opened our document review facility in Böblingen, Germany.

 

131


Table of Contents

Industry Overview

Legal Technology Industry

eDiscovery

eDiscovery is an essential component of litigation, government investigations and regulatory and compliance submissions, where parties exchange Electronically Stored Information (“ ESI ”) with each other. eDiscovery is subject to rules and agreed-upon processes, which often involve reviewing data for privilege and relevance before it is exchanged. eDiscovery software and services facilitate the identification, preservation, collection, review and exchange of ESI. The eDiscovery industry is highly fragmented with over 100 vendors, and in 2017, the top three pure play eDiscovery vendors accounted for less than 15% of the industry, according to IDC.

 

 

LOGO

Source: Third-party data and based on our eDiscovery revenue for the year ended December 31, 2017.

According to third-party data, the eDiscovery market is expected to grow from $10.0 billion in 2017 to $12.8 billion in 2022, representing a 5.2% compound annual growth rate (“ CAGR ”). We believe the industry is in the midst of a transformation driven by data proliferation and compounded by increasing complexity in the makeup and composition of the data we must be equipped to handle. These two factors help drive the rising increase in overall costs.

Data Proliferation . Data is growing at an exponential rate due to several factors, including the adoption of mobile devices, accessibility of hosted systems and increased reliance on electronic data storage. With ESI expected to continue growing at a significant rate, the organizations that effectively deploy advanced technologies, such as predictive coding and data analytics, and are able to help their clients work through large data sets quickly and accurately will be best positioned to earn increased market share.

 

 

LOGO

Source: IDC and EMC Corporation, The Digital Universe in 2020

 

132


Table of Contents

Market Shift to the Cloud . eDiscovery solutions are typically deployed in one of three fashions: On-premise (hosted at one of our data centers), in the public cloud (Google, Amazon Web Services, Microsoft Azure) or behind a client’s firewall. Although on-premise hosting has largely been the dominant deployment to date, cloud deployment is expected to see significant growth. Deployment in the public cloud offers many benefits, including scalability, flexibility, security and compliance, and, as a result, the adoption of cloud technology is expected to continue to increase. In particular, small and medium-sized enterprises are adopting cloud deployment mainly due to its cost-effectiveness and advanced results. According to third-party data, revenue generated by cloud-based eDiscovery solutions is expected to grow 10% during 2019.

Information Archiving

Data archiving serves a critical role in the management of organizational information resources for all businesses, regardless of size. Information archiving addresses information preservation for long-term access, enhancing access to large volumes of information in order to render it more useable and thus valuable. Information archiving also facilitates data management and disposition based on content of such data and need for preservation and/or disposition. As a result, data archiving serves as a primary source of information in legal discovery for litigious organizations. In the cloud economy, data archiving is increasingly displacing traditional backup strategies for disaster recovery purposes, since archiving provides a defense against malicious or inadvertent data loss by insiders and can be an insurance policy against ransomware. The legal hold software market overlaps with both the data archiving market and the eDiscovery software market and addresses the need for organizations to comply with legal requirements to preserve data in the face of pending litigation. Finally, the regulatory compliance software market is driven by the myriad regulatory regimes around the world that require organizations to preserve certain information, sometimes on immutable storage, for specified minimum periods. Conversely, some regulations require verifiable destruction of information when a specified time period has elapsed or certain events arise, and data archiving facilities easy execution of such requirements.

According to The Radicati Group, the information archiving market is expected to grow from $5.2 billion in 2018 to $8.5 billion in 2022, representing a 13.2% CAGR. Significant trends affecting this market include the shift to cloud computing and storage from traditional on-premises computing and storage, increased demands for storage to do more than simply preserve data and the advent of the “API economy,” in which vendors offer application programming interfaces (“ APIs ”) that enable other vendors to integrate with, extend and enhance the functionality of their core product, thereby increasing value for an end-client. These trends are driven by the widespread and general adoption of cloud services for many functions, a need for businesses or functions with variable demand to favor operational expenditures over capital expenditures, and a need for systems and data to support multiple functions, thereby driving efficiency and cost containment.

Data Recovery Industry

When consumers and businesses lose or cannot access data due to system failures, accidental deletion, physical damage, natural disasters, ransomware or user error, and no backup is available, data recovery service companies can help recover data which would have otherwise been lost. Data recovery service vendors can typically recover data from hard disk or solid state drives, flash drives and USB external drives, while some have the capability to recover data from servers, Redundant Array of Inexpensive Disks (“ RAID ”) systems, enterprise storage areas networks (“ SAN ”) and network attached storage (“ NAS ”) systems, backup tapes, optical disks, databases and virtual machines. Data recovery service companies use software tools and physical inspection to diagnose and determine the condition of the media and what data may be recovered. They then make an image of the data and perform a logical reconstruction of the data. In the case of physical damage, the device may need to be disassembled in a clean room lab and spare parts used to facilitate the recovery.

This fragmented industry is served by thousands of vendors, the majority of which are small electronics repair shops using off-the-shelf data recovery software tools. There are very few global data recovery providers that have clean room labs and physical data recovery capability with multiple labs. Factors affecting the industry

 

133


Table of Contents

include the increasing use of mobile devices, use of the cloud, streaming content, cost of storage and complexities of edge and analytics workloads and advanced data protection systems.

Products and Services

We have built an integrated suite of eDiscovery tools and services covering information governance, forensic collections, data processing, secure online hosting, document review, advanced analytics and document production. In addition, we offer data recovery solutions ranging from cleanroom facilities to proprietary data erasure, data recovery and data management tools.

 

 

LOGO

eDiscovery Solutions

We are one of the largest globally scaled eDiscovery providers in a highly-fragmented industry of over 100 vendors. With approximately 2.3% of the current eDiscovery market, based on 2017 eDiscovery revenue, we are poised to continue to gain market share via strategic acquisitions.

 

 

LOGO

Source: Third-party data and based on our eDiscovery revenue for the year ended December 31, 2017.

We offer a variety of eDiscovery solutions to our clients, including:

Nebula . Nebula is a proprietary end-to-end information governance and eDiscovery platform which helps to facilitate the identification, preservation, collection, processing, review and exchange of ESI. Nebula is powered by our in-house technology that has been developed, tested and trusted to improve the eDiscovery experience. Nebula is unique to us and contains the latest advancements in eDiscovery, while still delivering essential

 

134


Table of Contents

functionality. We offer three hosting options for Nebula: On-Premise at our data centers, in the public cloud (via Microsoft Azure cloud), and at a client’s location via NPC. NPC is particularly noteworthy as it allows for processing, filtering, analysis, review and production of ESI without the need to transfer data outside of the client’s location or across borders.

eDiscovery.com Review (“ EDR ”) . EDR is an all-encompassing, single platform used to search, review and exchange ESI. Over the past decade, our clients have produced to requesting parties over one billion documents and billions of pages using EDR.

Relativity . In 2006, we became the first vendor to license Relativity, a widely used document review tool. Shortly thereafter, we hosted the first case to reach one million records on the platform, and we have consistently worked to improve our clients’ experiences by offering a suite of proprietary enhancements exclusive to us, together with our white-glove client service. Our differentiated data hosting environment offers our clients optimal performance, reliability and redundancy. We currently host Relativity in six countries worldwide.

KLD Analytics . Developed through collaboration among our data scientists, software engineers and legal professionals, KLD Analytics offers a full range of technology-assisted review tools, supported by our team of technologists and consultants. This suite of tools offers features such as:

 

   

Predictive Coding—Leverages human expertise to automatically classify large populations of documents. Predictive coding supports entirely custom workflows and methodologies and is capable of continuous prioritization of important documents for review.

 

   

Workflow—Automates the routing and distribution of documents to streamline document review and maximize accuracy and defensibility. Workflow eliminates the need to maintain static batch sets and manually transition documents to different review teams. Workflow works hand-in-hand with Predictive Coding to make document review as efficient as possible.

 

   

Email Threading—Determines the relationship between email messages and identifies the most content-inclusive messages to avoid redundant review.

 

   

Near-Duplicate Detection—Identifies and groups similar records and highlights the subtle differences among them for a quicker review.

 

   

Language Identification—Automatically identifies the primary language on documents in a dataset.

KLD Processing . Our proprietary processing platform has been used exclusively by us for over 14 years. KLD Processing is a highly scalable platform which ingests disparate data types and sources, extracts the content of documents, removes duplicative or otherwise innocuous data, such as operating and system files, and exports data for review and production.

Document Review Services . Our document review services provide the facilities, staffing and expertise necessary to review large and complex data sets with a high degree of accuracy and efficiency. We assemble review teams of experienced legal professionals for any type of case. Each team member is a qualified attorney who has passed a selective screening process and has received training from our review managers. Review managers utilize proven methodologies to target and address quality issues early, allowing us to intelligently prioritize the documents that need to be reviewed more closely. Review managers are able to glean insights into productivity and quality using our proprietary technology to deliver a higher quality production. We have experience handling document reviews for a variety of types of matters, ranging from litigation, investigations and regulatory reviews, such as second requests, and have conducted reviews in over 30 languages. We currently maintain approximately 1,300 review seats spanning twelve facilities in six countries.

Digital Forensics Services . One of our specialties is computer forensics, including collections and analysis. Without a sound forensic collection, critical electronic evidence may be missed, inadvertently altered or otherwise rendered inadmissible. Whether it be for a small matter, such as a collection of data from a single

 

135


Table of Contents

device, or a large corporate investigation involving multiple custodians and data sources, in-person or remote, our collection analysts will determine and execute the most defensible, efficient and cost-effective strategy. Each year, we regularly collect data from many countries around the world. As a result, we possess a deep bench of talent with knowledge of country-specific discovery laws and customs. With offices across the globe, our collection team can be on the ground quickly in most regions. Our proprietary Remote Collection Manager (“ RCMgr ”) product is a suite of tools used to facilitate document collections remotely and by end-users, allowing defensibility and accuracy to be maintained without the need to deploy personnel onsite. RCMgr hard drives can arrive pre-configured to collect only the data within scope and the RCMgr tool logs the entire collection in granular detail, ensuring that we can track the process from start to finish. Upon completion of the collection, RCMgr verifies and encrypts the collected data for secure shipment back to one of our labs.

Our digital forensic services include analysis and investigative services in addition to collection services. Wherever electronic equipment is used, there is a potential source of electronic evidence and digital information, including a “bread crumb” trail to illuminate misuse or wrongdoing. Our computer forensics teams help extract critical evidence, recover any data that culprits may have sought to erase or hide, retrieve key data buried in documents and organize data contained in multiple information sources. A forensic investigation may be undertaken on a wide range of media as anything that stores data can potentially be investigated.

Information Archiving Services

Legal Hold Management . A legal hold plan that recognizes when the duty to preserve data begins, what it entails, how to implement it and when it ends is essential to any information governance or eDiscovery strategy. Our Legal Hold Management solution addresses these issues through comprehensive technology and defensible processes. With a flexible SaaS model, clients can choose to manage holds on their own using our technology or leverage our consultants to oversee and manage the process. In addition to leveraging commercially available tools, such as Relativity Legal Hold, we offer Nebula Legal Hold, which simplifies the legal hold process by managing and tracking legal hold communications and key data in a single location. Project initiation and management is efficient and flexible, whether utilizing customized communications or leveraging a full bank of legal hold templates, including initial notices, questionnaires, follow-ups and acknowledgments.

Office 365 Migration  & Management . As an inaugural Microsoft Office compliance and eDiscovery partner, we have decades of industry experience partnering with clients as they prepare for unexpected lawsuits and regulatory investigations. Our experts receive a large volume of questions from outside counsel and corporate legal departments concerning Office 365. As a Microsoft partner, we provide the expertise and services necessary to reliably and defensibly leverage the Data Governance, Search & Investigation and Advanced eDiscovery suites in Office 365. Examples of common challenges our consultants assist with include:

 

   

constructing a defensible process for Office 365 eDiscovery, including the creation and maintenance of appropriate documentation;

 

   

ensuring appropriate organizational boundaries are enforced and confidentiality is protected within Office 365;

 

   

legacy data management and remediation;

 

   

litigation readiness and data preservation and collection strategies; and

 

   

cloud migration.

Nebula Big Data Store . Nebula Big Data Store is a highly scalable, enterprise-grade storage solution with economics that rival back-up tape. Nebula Big Data Store runs on Microsoft’s Azure cloud, allowing it to be available anywhere in the world in a highly secure and resilient manner. Time- and event-based retention policies, defensible deletion and preservation controls are all built-in, offering excellent value. Nebula Big Data Store works hand-in-hand with Nebula Legal Hold for seamless preservation activities. The product eliminates costly, highly duplicative, on-premises “dumping grounds” that cannot be searched or managed effectively.

 

136


Table of Contents

Nebula Big Data Store is designed to solve enterprise problems stemming from burgeoning data volumes, fragmented application landscapes and increasing business, regulatory and legal demands, and it positions us to take advantage of evolving trends in the information archiving services industry. Nebula Big Data Store offers an API, making it simple for other products to connect to it and further extend and enhance the value of the information stored within the tool. The tool can assist with legacy application retirement, dark data remediation and information governance, among other use cases. Nebula Big Data Store works seamlessly with our eDiscovery offerings, covering the entire eDiscovery lifecycle. It is also less expensive and simpler to deploy than traditional archiving solutions. Finally, our experience and expertise in machine learning in eDiscovery positions us well to extend our archiving offering into the regulatory compliance intelligence market.

Data Recovery Services

Data Recovery . Business and private users routinely store business-critical data on servers, laptops, mobile devices and phones. As a result, data loss events can be devastating. The cost to an enterprise can amount to millions of dollars if they are unable to access important data for business operations.

To address those data loss events when they occur, we provide data recovery services worldwide. Data recovery refers to the recovery of specific information that is inaccessible due to accidental deletion, ransomware, hard drive accidental formatting, Windows reinstallation, partition loss, virtual machine deletion, system booting failure or physical damage of a storage device. The data recovery process involves a secure chain of custody and begins with a diagnosis of the media (hard disk drive, solid state drive, flash drive, RAID, database, tape or optical disk) by our data recovery engineers. The next step is to image the media, a bit by bit copy of the storage areas of the media, along with the system and hidden areas. The engineers then use proprietary tools and methods to reconstruct the data structures from the media image, which includes hidden and system areas. Physical damage may require additional clean room lab procedures, disassembly and use of new parts to access and reconstruct as much of the data as possible.

Ontrack Data Recovery performs over 50,000 data recoveries each year all over the world, and in 2018, we performed data recoveries in over 50 countries. Most of our clients believed that their data was secure, safe and backed-up although, for various reasons, it was not. When other data protection efforts fail, Ontrack can often recover our clients’ data, documents and critical systems. We believe that Ontrack is a global leader in the in-lab data recovery services industry and we have a 30-year history of developing our own recovery tools and making significant investments in automation. More than 20% of our data recovery jobs worldwide come from IT service companies or other data recovery companies who re-sell our data recovery services to their clients.

Email Extraction . We offer professional email recovery services for consumers and businesses alike. From individual files to entire databases, we maintain the expertise and technology to support practically any use case. The success of email recovery is dependent on where the email is stored. Email software, such as Microsoft Outlook, commonly stores email on hardware like a laptop, desktop, mobile phone, tablet or server. We can easily recover email from both functioning and non-functioning hardware. Additionally, our recovery engineers are experienced in recovering enterprise email no matter how it is stored on a client’s server, whether it is inside a database, a Microsoft Exchange Information Store or individual messages in separate files, such as .pst containers.

Tape Services . We provide a range of tape services to solve the problems associated with legacy backup tapes and regularly support our clients to solve the following challenges:

 

   

backup infrastructure migration and consolidation;

 

   

legacy tape and data remediation;

 

   

recovery from physically-damaged tapes; and

 

   

recovery from quickly-erased or partially-overwritten tapes.

 

137


Table of Contents

Data Destruction Services . Permanently deleting data isn’t as straightforward as pressing a delete button – it takes time and proper resources. Data that is not completely expunged before the media is disposed of is vulnerable to exposure. To increase the security of data, a secure, verified data destruction process is required. Based on their knowledge, our data experts seek to select and execute the most appropriate data destruction method for the client’s media. Once the data has been destroyed, we provide a certificate of destruction and disposal.

We support our clients throughout the whole data destruction process by offering data destruction services in our labs or onsite using Blancco Erasing Software or our Ontrack Degausser. For clients who want to handle the data destruction process themselves, we sell these products to the client and advise them how to best use them.

Mobile Phone Repair . We can repair broken screens and replace damaged batteries in many commonly-used Apple and Samsung devices at our labs around the world. Additionally, we operate a “UBreakIFix” franchise in New York City (with the option to open four more), which has more robust device repair capabilities.

Data Recovery Software

Ontrack EasyRecovery . Developed through our partnership with one of the world’s leading data recovery software manufacturers, Ontrack EasyRecovery is able to handle nearly every type of logical data loss (not physical damage) situation. Ontrack EasyRecovery allows clients to perform precise file recovery of data lost through deletion, reformatting and a number of other data loss scenarios. The product recovers data from solid-state drives (“ SSD ”) and conventional hard drives, memory cards, USB hard drives, flash drives and optical media. The product functions on both Windows and Mac operating systems and comes in several different versions, ranging from a free version ideal for small one-time recoveries to a Toolkit version which would give a professional the ability to handle complex projects. There is a “free” version that is capable of recovering up to 1 GB of data, a “Home” version for straightforward recoveries, a “Professional” version suitable for small to medium businesses and a “Technician” version that includes the tools needed to successfully perform data recoveries on all types of computer storage devices and rebuild broken RAID volumes.

Ontrack PowerControls . We believe Ontrack PowerControls is the market leading granular restore software product, developed from Ontrack’s expertise in data recovery. This product enables email and backup administrators and database administrators to restore individual mailboxes and messages, without having to restore the entire database. Ontrack PowerControls is used to find and export email, SharePoint items and structured query language (“ SQL ”) tables for eDiscovery, litigation, investigations, compliance, selective migration, develop and test and general restore use cases for IT. We believe Ontrack PowerControls provides a more powerful and faster search tool than native tools, and, most importantly for legal and compliance use cases, it does not alter the metadata, making it forensically sound. Most enterprise backup platforms do not have granular restore capabilities, so they partner with Ontrack and integrate Ontrack PowerControls with their products.

Competitive Strengths

Market Leader Across the eDiscovery Space . We are the third largest pure play electronic services discovery provider in the $10.6 billion eDiscovery industry, according to third-party data. We have established our market-leading position by leveraging our expansive sales force, national sales and service network, longstanding client relationships and operational expertise. Based on this prior experience, we believe that we will be able to further develop our market share.

Comprehensive Product Offering . We have a broad product offering of premium proprietary technology, such as eDiscovery processing, document review, data hosting, data analytics, forensic collection, data recovery, archiving, managed services, email management and information governance. We believe that our diverse and comprehensive products and offerings make us the provider of choice for our clients.

 

138


Table of Contents

Nebula Product Offering . Nebula provides us with several distinct advantages. First, the breadth of Nebula allows us to capture clients as early as the identification phase, via Nebula Big Data Store and Nebula Legal Hold, and keep them in the platform all the way through production. Second, our scale allows the platform to be deployed in many key geographic regions around the world, allowing us to penetrate underserved markets. Third, the flexibility to deploy Nebula in the cloud or at a client’s location, via NPC, removes significant geographical barriers to sales. Lastly, the platform is supported by our team of approximately 150 project managers and hosting support analysts globally.

Expansive Geographic Footprint . Our geographic presence spans the globe, with over 40 offices in 20 countries. Our broad reach provides us with a first responder-type advantage when clients have urgent work requiring immediate attention. In addition, our familiarity with local laws and regulations allows us effectively assist clients in navigating complex, cross-border situations.

Established Client Relationships and Industry Expertise . We have longstanding relationships with a large and diverse group of clients, which include 95% of the AM Law 100 and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. We provide our clients with 24/7/365, follow-the-sun service, resulting in a client retention rate of greater than 95%.

Proven and Experienced Management . We have a strong and highly experienced management team. Our chief executive officer Chris Weiler has more than 25 years of experience in the eDiscovery industry, and is one of the longest tenured CEO’s in the eDiscovery industry globally. During his tenure, Mr. Weiler and his team have identified, acquired and integrated 13 acquisitions and he has a proven track record and playbook for accretive acquisitions with the ability to target companies that meet rigorous criteria focused on people, culture, client base, geography and technology. As a result of these acquisitions, the acquired company’s client bases are efficiently onboarded onto our proprietary platforms allowing a seamless transition for our clients and full access to our global capabilities, resulting in significant cross-selling opportunities and creating increased revenues and incremental profitability. Our chief financial officer Dawn Wilson has over 20 years of experience in finance and accounting, primarily with public companies in the technology and services industry, and has successfully acquired and integrated over 40 acquisitions in her career.

Growth Strategies

Selectively Pursue Strategic Acquisitions . Due to the fragmentation in the legal technology and data recovery industries, there is substantial opportunity to continue completing strategic acquisitions of scale, as well as smaller, accretive tuck-in acquisitions. We have successfully sourced, executed and integrated ten strategic acquisitions since 2013. Acquisitions allow us to grow the company both inorganically and organically in that we can significantly increase revenue organically due to the breadth of service offerings and proprietary technology that we can provide to newly acquired customer relationships that were not available for the acquired sales people to sell before joining our company. For example, we acquired AlphaLit in 2013, and AlphaLit did not offer Managed Document Review services or Forensic Collection services. After the acquisition, the AlphaLit sales people could sell these service offerings to existing AlphaLit customers, thereby increasing revenues. We will primarily focus on small to mid-size opportunities in order to leverage our scalable platform. We are experienced in quickly integrating acquired companies into our broader business, which has allowed us to significantly increase revenue and meaningfully increase EBITDA by focusing on preserving client facing personnel, client retention, seamless transition of clients of the target business and the ability for our new salespeople to sell across a broader platform. Our past acquisitions demonstrate our management’s ability to effectively source, execute and integrate acquisitions into their existing and growing platform. We plan to continue to pursue our acquisition strategy to continue to consolidate the highly fragmented $15.8 billion eDiscovery and information governance industries, which are expected to grow to $21.2 billion in 2022 according to third-party data.

Increased Product Innovation . Adoption of cloud technology is expected to continue increasing. This shift presents market opportunities that we believe we are well positioned to capitalize upon. Our Nebula platform is a

 

139


Table of Contents

mature product, deployed globally in the cloud, in use by over 3,000 users and backed by our global client support and development teams, ensuring around-the-clock, “white glove” service and a rigorous, yet consistent, cadence for upgrades and improvements. The growth potential for this platform is further accentuated by our breadth of reach, powered largely by Nebula Big Data Store, which pushes our products’ capabilities into the information archiving market. We will also continue to advance our technology platform, both in and around Nebula, to give clients useful functionality and increased value.

Growth and Strengthening of Sales Force . We have been and will remain focused on attracting and retaining top sales professionals. We recently hired several key members of the team that will lead efforts in both established and untapped markets, which we believe will result in an acceleration of incremental revenue. We believe that certain key initiatives we are currently undertaking will ensure that accounts have proper coverage and penetration and will allow us to maximize wallet share.

Clients

Our legal technology clients include both law firms and corporations serving many industry sectors including finance and banking, pharmacuetical and biotechnology, technology, insurance, real estate and government. Our data recovery clients include individuals and corporations requiring recovery and accessing of data. For the year ended December 31, 2018, we served over 4,300 legal technology clients, including 95% of the AM Law 100 and 65% of Fortune 500 companies. We have longstanding relationships with our clients and an over 95% retention rate. For the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2018, no single client accounted for more than 5% of our revenues.

Competition

The eDiscovery market is highly fragmented, competitive and evolving. Our competitors in the eDiscovery market include Consilio, EPIQ, FTI Consulting, Inc, United Lex, E&Y, Deloitte, KPMG, Navigant, Conduent, Lighthouse, Everlaw and Transperfect. We believe the principal competitive factors in this industry include:

 

   

client service and support;

 

   

breadth of geographic coverage;

 

   

quality and depth of services offered;

 

   

pricing of service offerings;

 

   

security; and

 

   

client relationships and brand loyalty.

There are hundreds of small regional eDiscovery providers which may have a few captive relationships but lack the resources or scale to compete for meaningful work. Likewise, of the global and national providers, most lack an end-to-end proprietary platform to complement their global scale and resources. We believe we are uniquely positioned with an ideal complement of global reach, scale of resources and proprietary technology to address almost any client need.

The data recovery market is highly fragmented and generally competitive. Clients choose vendors based on brand awareness and reputation, speed, price and security. Our competitors in the data recovery market include Drivesavers, Gillware Data Recovery, Disk Doctors, Digital Data Recovery DDC and Myung Information Technologies.

Sales and Marketing

Sales

We operate with a global sales team to address the specialized needs of our client base and cultivate strategic partnerships with key clients in our industry. Our sales organization comprises over 35 professionals and is led

 

140


Table of Contents

by our sales executives and regional managers. Our business development managers have developed “first-call” relationships with several of our largest clients while providing significant expertise in the technical nature of the services.

Our global sales structure is tailored to deliver quick responses to sales executives on pricing, account ownership requests and general assistance with client requests and training. This structure is built on our foundational values of teamwork and responsiveness. Our global sales force pursues opportunities in a wide range of geographies and is not confined by the traditional territorial structure that competitors offer. This allows us to maximize relationships and revenue.

Sales leadership encourages representatives around the world to collaborate. A global sales strategy initiative has been implemented to facilitate communication between teams on shared major accounts, which includes the coordination of regular calls and information sharing on key accounts. Most law firms have multiple buyers and this model maximizes our ability to increase wallet share.

Sales executives are encouraged to act as their own entrepreneurs, backed by the support of seasoned sales leadership and a global sales operations team. The sales operations team assists the sales team with all client requests including conflict checks, SalesForce data entry, estimate creation and generation of client agreements and work orders. This global support team allows the sales representatives to focus on what they do best – generating new business and maintaining existing client relationships. Our global sales structure and sales operations teams deliver quick responses to representatives and clients, flexible pricing models and simplified matter initiation, giving us a competitive advantage in a fast-paced industry.

Marketing

We focus on connecting with our clients through our marketing team. Our marketing campaigns are home-grown and highlight the “KLD Difference. One KLD.”

We advertise in a wide variety of trade publications and at sports and entertainment events. We also sponsor a variety of events, seminars and conferences around the world. We operate approximately 35 global websites which highlight our leadership, products, services, technology, industry experience, press clippings and our community contributions. Holding true to our values, we are heavily focused on charitable donations and community work, which are highlighted on our “KLD Community” website page. We also have a number of video advertising campaigns which are shared via YouTube, Twitter and LinkedIn.

Locations

We are headquartered in McLean, VA where we house key functions including accounting, finance, human resources, legal, eDiscovery operations, eDiscovery project management, document review and data recovery. We maintain a diverse geographic footprint globally, with over 40 locations in 20 countries. In addition, we have 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs worldwide. We offer approximately 1,300 seats for contract attorney review in seven domestic and five international review facilities.

In addition to on-premise data centers, we deliver our proprietary Nebula platform via the cloud and Nebula Private Cloud, which means that a Nebula environment can be established in any Microsoft Azure location worldwide. The Nebula Private Cloud devices are custom-built hardware running the Nebula platform and, thus, can be deployed virtually anywhere.

Properties

We do not own any properties and all of our material physical properties are occupied pursuant to either the terms of a negotiated lease or another contractual arrangement for occupation of space, such as space rental in a data center facility.

 

141


Table of Contents

The table below presents summary information regarding our material properties as of June 1, 2019.

 

Location

   Legal
Technologies
Office
     Data Storage
Technologies
Office
   Managed
Review
Facility
     Data
Center
     Clean
Room
 

Fountain Valley, California, United States

      X            X  

Washington DC, United States

     X           X        

Doral, Florida, United States

     X           X        

Chicago, Illinois, United States

     X           X        

Eden Prairie, Minnesota, United States

     X      X      X           X  

Rutherford, New Jersey, United States

      X            X  

New York, New York, United States

     X           X        

New York, New York, United States

      X (Franchise)         

Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, United States

     X           X        

McLean, Virginia, United States

     X      X      X        X        X  

Brisbane, Australia

     X      X            X  

Sydney, Australia

     X           X        

Toronto, Canada

      X            X  

Toronto, Canada

     X           X        

Suzhou, China

      X            X  

Helsinki, Finland

      X            X  

Paris, France

     X      X            X  

Boblingen, Germany

     X      X      X           X  

Won Chai, Hong Kong

     X              

North Point, Hong Kong

      X            X  

Varese, Italy

      X            X  

Tokyo, Japan

     X      X            X  

Shanghai, China

      X         

Amsterdam, Netherlands

      X            X  

Kongsvinger, Norway

     X      X            X  

Katowice, Poland

     X      X      X           X  

Singapore

     X      X            X  

Madrid, Spain

      X            X  

Uppsala, Sweden

      X            X  

Wallisellen, Switzerland

      X            X  

Surrey, United Kingdom

      X            X  

London, United Kingdom

     X           X        

Toronto, Canada

              X     

Paris, France

              X     

Frankfurt, Germany

              X     

Balleycoolin, Ireland

              X     

Toyko, Japan

              X     

Brooklyn Park, Minnesota, United States

              X     

Austin, Texas, United States

     X              X     

Slough, United Kingdom

              X     

Ashburn, Virginia, United States

              X     

McLean, Virginia, United States

     X              

Chicago, Illinois, United States

     X              

Intellectual Property

We own a range of registered intellectual property rights across the world, primarily trademark registrations and patents.

We own 105 trademark registrations globally and currently have 32 trademark applications at various stages in the application process. Our material trademarks are either registered or are pending applications for registrations

 

142


Table of Contents

in the U.S. Patent and Trademark office and various non-U.S. jurisdictions (but with a focus on the European Union, the United Kingdom, Norway, Switzerland, Japan, Australia, China, Singapore and Hong Kong). We us “KLDiscovery”, “Ontrack” and “Ibas” as our primary corporate trademarks. The trademark “KLDiscovery” has proceeded to registration in Australia, China, the European Union, Hong Kong, India, Switzerland and the United Kingdom. Additionally, we have applied to register “Nebula,” the brand name for our proprietary e-discovery platform, in our key markets and, to date, applications have proceeded to registration in the United States, the European Union and the United Kingdom.

“Ontrack” and “Ontrack Data Recovery” are used in Canada by us subject to a perpetual license from Kroll, LLC who own the “Kroll Ontrack” trademark in that jurisdiction. This license was granted as part of the Kroll Ontrack acquisition in December 2016.

We are the registered proprietor of over 400 domain names including our key domains used to promote our activities, being kldiscovery.com, ontrack.com and ibas.com together with many local variants of these main domain names.

We own the copyright of many of our business software and tools as they have been created by employees in the course of their employment. These include the Nebula and EDR platforms (two proprietary eDiscovery platforms for access and review of data), the PMDB Database (internal job tracking tool), Service Cloud (data recovery portal), PowerControls (data recovery software for email) and several Relativity applications to enhance the license of standard Relativity platform services.

We have a total of 21 patents, either registered in their respective jurisdiction or at application stage, including a recent application for our Nebula offering.

Legal Proceedings

We are currently not a party to any legal proceedings that are expected to have a material adverse effect on our business or financial condition. From time-to-time, we are subject to litigation incidental to our business, as well as other litigation of a non-material nature in the ordinary course of business.

Employees

As of March 31, 2019, we had 1,981 employees. This total included 787 temporary contingent employees who are employed temporarily to work on active managed review matters. Our employees are not represented by a labor union and we have not experienced any work stoppages. We believe that our employee relations are excellent.

 

143


Table of Contents

THE COMPANY’S MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL

CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Throughout this section, unless otherwise noted “we,” “us,” “our,” “Company,” “KLDiscovery,” “KLD” or “LD Topco, Inc.” refers to LD Topco, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries. The following discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations of the Company should be read together with the financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. Such discussion and analysis reflects the historical results of operations and financial position of the Company. This discussion contains forward-looking statements based upon current expectations that involve risks and uncertainties. Actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of various factors, including those set forth under “Risk Factors,” “Forward-Looking Statements” and elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

OVERVIEW

We are one of the leading eDiscovery providers and the leading data recovery services provider to corporations, law firms, government agencies and individual consumers. We provide technology-enabled services and software to help law firms, corporations, government agencies and consumers solve complex data challenges. We have broad geographical coverage in the eDiscovery and data recovery industries with 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. Our legal technology services cover both eDiscovery and information governance services to support the litigation, regulatory compliance, and internal investigation needs of our clients. We offer data collection and forensic investigation, early case assessment, electronic discovery and data processing, application software, data hosting, and managed document review services. In addition, through our global Ontrack Data Recovery name, we deliver world-class data recovery, email extraction and restoration, data destruction and tape management services.

We classify our legal technology revenue as follows:

 

   

Collections and Processing Services: We have remote and onsite collection services. Our proprietary workflows and tools allow us to ingest, extract native file metadata and index in a normalized format. We have near duplication tools to quickly discard duplicative or irrelevant data, significantly minimizing the data that needs to be reviewed. Our analytics include predictive coding which allows us to automatically classify millions of documents in a matter of hours. We offer email threading that looks at relationships between email messages to identify the most content inclusive messages to avoid redundant review and we have language identification that can automatically identify the primary language in all documents in the data set. The collection of data is billed either by the unit or hour and the data that is processed and produced is billed by gigabyte, page or by file.

 

   

Forensics and Consulting Services : We provide the expertise and tools needed to extract and analyze digital evidence to support a client’s legal matter. Our forensics experts help extract critical evidence, recover any data that individuals may have sought to erase or hide, retrieve key data buried in documents and organize data contained in multiple information sources to give our client the insight and knowledge they need. Our forensics and consulting services are billed by either hour or unit.

 

   

Professional Services: We manage complex eDiscovery matters and partner with our clients to assist thru the lifecycle of a case. Our professional services are billed on an hourly basis.

 

   

Managed Document Review Services: We use our extensive eDiscovery project management experience, technological excellence and global presence to provide clients with a secure, seamless and cost effective document review solution. We assemble review teams of experienced legal professionals for any type of case. Each team member is a qualified attorney who has passed a selective screening process and has received training from KLDiscovery review manager to ensure the most efficient and defensible review of a client’s documents. Document review managers have extensive project managed experience to oversee the entire review process and work with the client’s legal team as an integrated

 

144


Table of Contents
 

partner. Our industry experts have developed advanced document review processes and tools and deliver services in state of the art facilities, handle subject matter versatility, are platform agnostic, possess expert working knowledge of predictive coding and technology assisted review workflows, have multilingual capabilities and focus on quality. Our managed document review services are billed on an hourly basis.

 

   

Hosting: We have flexible technology options and platforms to host our client’s data for the life of the matter. We offer secure data centers around the globe to support data across jurisdictions and privacy laws. Hosting is billed by gigabyte

 

   

Subscription: We offer subscription pricing options to provide cost predictability over time. Subscriptions cover a range of our services and are typically a fixed fee billed monthly for contract terms averaging 1 to 3 years.

We classify our data recovery revenue as follows:

 

   

Data Recovery Services : We recover lost data from devices that store digital information, including data centers, cloud, business servers, workstations, laptops and mobile devices. Pricing is per device.

 

   

PowerControls and Data Recovery Software : We enable search and recovery of data from database files and physically sound devices. Pricing is typically an annual or multi-year agreement at a fixed price.

For the years ended December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, our legal technology revenue was $250.5 million and $237.2 million, respectively, and our data recovery revenue was $45.8 million and $44.0 million, respectively.

In 2018, we meaningfully increased the quality of our sales force. We incurred approximately $15.2 million in recruiting fees, legal fees, sign on bonuses and non-recoverable draws related to the investment in some new highly skilled salespeople. The costs for these salespeople was included in our sales and marketing costs for the year ended December 31, 2018. We anticipate that revenue generated from these salespeople will increase over the next 3 years.

NON-U.S. GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES

We prepare audited financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP. We also disclose and discuss other non-U.S. GAAP financial measures such as adjusted EBITDA, unlevered free cash flow and levered free cash flow. We believe that these measures are relevant and provide useful supplemental information to investors by providing a baseline for evaluation and comparing our operating performance, and in the case of unlevered free cash flow and levered free cash flow, our liquidity results against that of other companies in our industry.

The non-U.S. GAAP financial measures that we use may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies and in the future, we may disclose different non-U.S. GAAP financial measures in order to help our investors meaningfully evaluate and compare our results of operations to our previously reported results of operations or to those of other companies in our industry. We believe these non-U.S. GAAP financial measures reflect our ongoing operating performance because the isolation of non-cash charges, such as amortization and depreciation, and other items, such as interest, income taxes, management fees and equity compensation, acquisition and transaction costs, restructuring costs, systems establishment and costs associated with strategic initiatives which are incurred outside the ordinary course of our business, and provide information about our cost structure, that helps track our operating progress. We encourage investors and potential investors to carefully review the U.S. GAAP financial information and compare them with our adjusted EBITDA, unlevered free cash flow and levered free cash flow.

 

145


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA

We view adjusted EBITDA as our operating performance measure and as such, we believe that the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP financial measure is net loss. In calculating adjusted EBITDA, we exclude from net loss certain items that we believe are not reflective of our ongoing business and exclusion of these items allows us to provide additional analysis of the financial components of the day-to-day operation of our business. We have outlined below the type and scope of these exclusions:

 

   

Acquisition, financing and transaction costs generally represented by non-ordinary course earn-out valuation changes, rating agency fees, letter of credit and revolving facility fees as well as professional service fees and direct expenses related to acquisitions. Because we do not acquire businesses on a predictable cycle, we do not consider the amount of acquisition- and integration-related costs to be a representative component of the day-to-day operating performance of our business.

 

   

Strategic initiatives expenses relate to costs resulting from pursuing strategic business opportunities. We do not consider the amounts to be representative of the day-to-day operating performance of our business.

 

   

Management fees, stock compensation and other primarily represents consulting fees and portion of compensation paid to our employees and executives through stock-based instruments. Determining the fair value of the stock-based instruments involves a high degree of judgment and estimation and the expenses recorded may not align with the actual value realized upon the future exercise or termination of the related stock-based awards. Therefore, we believe it is useful to exclude stock-based compensation to better understand the long-term performance of our core business.

 

   

Restructuring costs generally represent non-ordinary course costs incurred in connection with a change in a contract or a change in the makeup of our personnel often related to an acquisition. We do not consider the amount of restructuring costs to be a representative component of the day-to-day operating performance of our business.

 

   

Systems establishment costs relate to non-ordinary course expenses incurred to develop our IT infrastructure, including system automation and enterprise resource planning system implementation. We do not consider the amount to be representative of a component of the day-to-day operating performance of our business.

Our presentation of adjusted EBITDA should not be construed as an inference that our future results will be unaffected by any of these adjustments, or that our projections and estimates will be realized in their entirety or at all. In addition, because of these limitations, adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as a measure of liquidity or discretionary cash available to us to fund our cash needs, including investing in the growth of our business and meeting our obligations.

The use of adjusted EBITDA instead of U.S. GAAP measures has limitations as an analytical tool, and adjusted EBITDA should not be considered in isolation, or as a substitute for analysis of our results of operations and operating cash flows as reported under U.S. GAAP. For example, adjusted EBITDA does not reflect:

 

   

our cash expenditures or future requirements for capital expenditures;

 

   

changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs;

 

   

interest expense, or the cash requirements necessary to service interest or principal payments, on our indebtedness;

 

   

any cash income taxes that we may be required to pay;

 

   

any cash requirements for replacements of assets that are depreciated or amortized over their estimated useful lives and may have to be replaced in the future; or

 

   

all non-cash income or expense items that are reflected in our statements of cash flows.

 

146


Table of Contents

Unlevered Free Cash Flow and Levered Free Cash Flow

We use the non-U.S. GAAP measure of unlevered free cash flow, which we calculate as adjusted EBITDA reduced by purchases of property and equipment and any cash taxes paid. We believe unlevered free cash flow is an important liquidity measure of the cash (if any) that is available, after purchases of property and equipment and cash taxes, for investment in our business and to make acquisitions. We also present the non-U.S. GAAP measure of levered free cash flow, which we calculate by adjusting our unlevered free cash flow for cash interest expense paid during the period. We believe that levered and unlevered free cash flow are useful to investors as liquidity measures because they measure our ability to generate cash.

Our use of levered free cash flow and unlevered free cash flow have limitations as analytical tools and you should not consider them in isolation or as a substitute for an analysis of our results under U.S. GAAP. Both levered free cash flow and unlevered free cash flow are not a substitute for net cash used in operating activities. Additionally, the utility of levered free cash flow and unlevered free cash flow are further limited as they do not reflect our future contractual commitments and do not represent the total increase or decrease in our cash balance for a given period.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 Compared with the Three Months Ended March 31, 2018

The results for the periods shown below should be reviewed in conjunction with our unaudited consolidated financial statements and notes for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

 

     Three Months Ended March 31,  

(in millions)

           2019                      2018          

Revenues

   $ 75.0      $ 70.2  

Cost of revenues

     37.4        40.3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     37.6        29.9  

Operating expenses

     38.8        39.5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (1.2      (9.6
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest expense

     12.1        11.1  

Other expense

     0.1        0.1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (13.4      (20.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income tax provision (benefit)

     0.1        (2.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net loss

     (13.5      (18.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     0.8        2.1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

   $ (12.7    $ (15.9
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Revenues

Revenues increased by $4.8 million, or 6.8%, to $75.0 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to $70.2 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. This increase is primarily due to an increase of $3.0 million in legal technology revenue and an increase of $1.8 million in data recovery revenue. Legal technology revenue increased primarily due to the addition of salespeople in 2018. Data recovery revenue increased due to improvements made in our internal workflow which made it more efficient to process orders, allowing the customer to submit devices without upfront assessments.

 

147


Table of Contents

Cost of Revenues

Cost of revenues decreased by $2.9 million, or 7.2%, to $37.4 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to $40.3 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. As a percentage of revenue, our cost of revenues for the three months ended March 31, 2019 decreased to 49.9% as compared to 57.4% for the three months ended March 31, 2018. This decrease in amount and as a percentage of revenue is primarily due to increased efficiencies resulting from the synergies of the integration of Kroll Ontrack.

Gross Profit

Gross profit increased by $7.7 million, or 25.8%, to $37.6 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to $29.9 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. This increase is primarily due to the factors noted above. As a percentage of revenue, our gross profit for the three months ended March 31, 2019 increased to 50.1% as compared to 42.6% for the three months ended March 31, 2018.

Operating Expenses

Operating expenses decreased by $0.7 million, or 1.8%, to $38.8 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to $39.5 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. This decrease is primarily due to a slower rate of headcount increases and lower legal expenses, non-recoverable draws and sign on bonus amortization associated with the hiring of new salespeople of $3.2 million, partially offset by increases in other personnel expenses of $2.1 million as well as an annual stock grant of $0.5 million, which occurred in the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to 2018 when this occurred in the second quarter. As a percentage of revenue, our operating expenses for the three months ended March 31, 2019 decreased to 51.7% as compared to 56.3% for the three months ended March 31, 2018 due to the factors noted above.

Interest Expense

Interest expense increased by $1.0 million, or 9.0%, to $12.1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to $11.1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. This increase was primarily due to an increase in LIBOR rates during the three months ended March 31, 2019 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2018.

Income Tax Provision (Benefit)

A valuation allowance has been established against our net U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets, including net operating loss carryforwards. As a result, our income tax position is primarily related to foreign tax activity and U.S. deferred taxes for tax deductible goodwill and other indefinite-lived liabilities. During the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, we recorded an income tax provision (benefit) of $0.1 million and $(2.8) million, respectively, resulting in an effective tax rate of (0.7)% and 13.3%, respectively. These effective tax rates differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate primarily due to the effects of foreign tax rate differences and the valuation allowance against our domestic deferred tax assets. The effective rate for the three months ended March 31, 2019 decreased from the three months ended March 31, 2018 primarily due to the $4.3 million tax benefit that was recorded during the three months ended March 31, 2018 for changes in the realizability of our deferred tax assets due to indefinite lived domestic tax attributes.

Net Loss

Net loss for the three months ended March 31, 2019 was $13.5 million compared to $18.0 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. Net loss decreased for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to the three months ended March 31, 2018 due to the factors noted above.

 

148


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA and Leveraged Free Cash Flow Reconciliation

 

     Three Months Ended March 31,  
(in millions)            2019                      2018          

Net loss

   $ (13.5    $ (18.0

Interest expense

     12.1        11.1  

Income tax expense (benefit)

     0.1        (2.8

Depreciation and amortization expense

     12.5        16.0  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA

   $ 11.2      $ 6.3  

Acquisition, financing and transaction costs

     0.2        0.5  

Strategic Initiatives:

     

Sign-on bonus amortization

     0.1        1.4  

Non-recoverable draw

     1.1        1.5  

Recruiting and signing bonuses

     —          0.9  

Legal fees

     —          0.4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total strategic initiatives

     1.2        4.2  

Management fees, stock compensation and other

     1.2        0.6  

Restructuring costs

     0.7        0.6  

Systems establishment

     0.6        0.2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 15.1      $ 12.4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital expenditures

     (2.2      (1.8

Cash (paid) refund for taxes

     (0.3      0.7  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unlevered free cash flow (UFCF)

   $ 12.6      $ 11.3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash paid for interest

     (11.0      (9.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Levered free cash flow (LFCF)

   $ 1.6      $ 1.4  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

149


Table of Contents

For the Year Ended December 31, 2018 Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2017

The audited results for the periods shown below should be reviewed in conjunction with our audited consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes as of and for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus.

 

     Year Ended December 31,  

(in millions)

           2018                     2017          

Revenues

   $ 296.3     $ 281.2  

Cost of revenues

     159.6       154.1  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     136.7       127.1  

Operating expenses

     161.5       152.1  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (24.8     (25.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense

     46.6       43.1  

Other expense

     —         0.7  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (71.4     (68.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax (benefit) provision

     (3.7     3.4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

     (67.7     (72.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     (0.9     7.9  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

   $ (68.6   $ (64.3
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Revenues

Revenues increased by $15.1 million, or 5.4%, to $296.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to $281.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. This increase is primarily due to increases in legal technology revenue of $12.9 million and an increase in data recovery revenue of $2.2 million. The increase in legal technology revenue is primarily due to the implementation of a corporate strategy to add a team of high performing salespeople in 2018 with a goal of driving new sales and increasing sales to existing customers. Data recovery revenue increased due to improvements made in our technology to perform recoveries more efficiently.

Cost of Revenues

Cost of revenues increased by $5.5 million, or 3.6%, to $159.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to $154.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. This increase is primarily related to a higher percentage of managed document review work in 2018 as compared to 2017. As a percentage of revenue, our cost of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased slightly to 53.9% as compared to 54.8% for the year ended December 31, 2017 as certain of our costs are fixed.

Gross Profit

Gross profit increased by $9.6 million, or 7.6%, to $136.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to $127.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. This increase is primarily due to the factors discussed above.

Operating Expenses

Operating expenses increased by $9.4 million, or 6.2%, to $161.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to $152.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. This increase was primarily due to

 

150


Table of Contents

increases in legal fees, recruiting fees, non-recoverable draws and signing on bonuses of approximately $15.2 million related to the hiring of new salespeople, partially offset by lower severance, retention and consulting fees incurred in 2017 related to the Kroll Ontrack integration. As a percentage of revenue, our operating expenses for the year ended December 31, 2018 remained fairly consistent at 54.5% as compared to 54.1% for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Interest Expense

Interest expense increased by $3.5 million, or 8.1%, to $46.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to $43.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. This increase was primarily due to an increase in LIBOR rates during 2018 as compared to 2017.

Income Tax (Benefit) Provision

A valuation allowance has been established against our net U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets and certain foreign jurisdictions deferred tax assets, including net operating loss carryforwards. As a result, our income tax position is primarily related to foreign tax activity and U.S. deferred taxes for tax deductible goodwill.

During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, we recorded an income tax benefit (provision) of $3.7 million and $(3.4) million, respectively, resulting in an effective tax rate of 5.2% and (5.0)%, respectively. These effective tax rates differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate primarily due to the effects of certain permanent items, foreign tax rate differences and increases in the valuation allowance against our domestic deferred tax assets.

We reported pre-tax loss of $71.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2018 with an effective tax rate of 5.2%, resulting in a $3.7 million income tax benefit. The effective tax rate was primarily impacted by our valuation allowance, which caused a decrease in the tax benefit of $18.1 million. This was offset by a tax benefit of $7.7 million related to the tax impact of provisions of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017 (the “ TCJA ”), due to certain indefinite lived deferred tax assets that allowed for a partial release of the valuation allowance. Without these two items, our effective tax rate would have been 19.7%, which is lower than the statutory tax rate of 21.0%, primarily due to the effects of foreign tax rate differences, U.S. state taxes and certain permanent items.

We reported a pre-tax loss of $68.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2017 with an effective tax rate of negative 5.0%, resulting in a $3.4 million income tax provision. The effective tax rate was primarily impacted by our valuation allowance, which caused an increase in the tax provision of $28.2 million. This was offset by a tax benefit of $3.3 million related to the U.S. federal tax impact of certain provisions of the TCJA, due to the reduction in the corporate tax rate from 35% to 21%. Without these two items, our effective tax rate would have been 31.3%, which is lower than the statutory tax rate of 35.0%, primarily due to the effects of foreign tax rate differences, U.S. state taxes and certain permanent items.

 

151


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA and Leveraged Free Cash Flow Reconciliation

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
(in millions)            2018                      2017          

Net loss

   $ (67.7    $ (72.2

Interest expense

     46.6        43.1  

Income tax expense (benefit)

     (3.7      3.4  

Depreciation and amortization expense

     54.7        54.8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA

   $ 29.9      $ 29.1  

Acquisition, financing and transaction costs

     1.0        (0.2

Strategic Initiatives:

     

Sign-on bonus amortization

     6.2        —    

Non-recoverable draw

     5.7        —    

Recruiting and signing bonuses

     1.0        —    

Legal fees

     2.3        4.5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total strategic initiatives

     15.2        4.5  

Management fees, stock compensation and other

     3.3        3.9  

Restructuring costs

     3.2        9.7  

Systems establishment

     2.0        1.3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 54.6      $ 48.3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital expenditures

     (12.4      (20.6

Cash paid for taxes

     (1.2      (1.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unlevered free cash flow (UFCF)

   $ 41.0      $ 26.7  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash paid for interest

     (41.6      (35.2
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Levered free cash flow (LFCF)

   $ (0.6    $ (8.5
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Our primary cash needs have been to meet debt service requirements and to fund working capital and capital expenditures. We fund these requirements from cash generated by our operations, as well as funds available under our Revolving Credit Facility (our “ Revolving Credit Facility ”). As of March 31, 2019, we had $4.5 million in cash compared to $23.4 million as of December 31, 2018 and $18.9 million as of December 31, 2017. As of March 31, 2019, we had $449.8 million of outstanding borrowings under our 2016 Credit Agreement and our Revolving Credit Facility, compared to $448.0 million as of December 31, 2018 and $456.5 million as of December 31, 2017. We expect to finance our operations over the next 12 months primarily through existing cash balances and cash flow, supplemented as necessary by funds available through our Revolving Credit Facility.

2016 Credit Agreement

The Facilities

On December 9, 2016, we entered into a Credit Agreement (as amended or supplemented to date, the “ 2016 Credit Agreement ”) with a group of lenders to establish term loan facilities and a revolving line of credit for borrowings by LD Intermediate, Inc. and LD Lower Holdings, Inc. (the “ Initial Term Loans ”). The Initial Term Loan borrowings of $340.0 million (the “ First Lien Facility ”) and $125.0 million (the “ Second Lien Facility ” and, together with the First Lien Facility, the “ Facilities ”) mature on December 9, 2022 and December 9, 2023, respectively.

The First Lien Facility established a term loan principal payment schedule with payments due on the last day of each calendar quarter, beginning on March 31, 2017 with a payment of $2.1 million. Quarterly principal payments increased to $4.3 million beginning on March 31, 2019 with a balloon payment of $259.3 million due

 

152


Table of Contents

at maturity. The interest rate for the First Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by us, or to the extent consented to by all Appropriate Lenders (as defined in the 2016 Credit Agreement), 12 months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 5.875% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate (as defined in the 2016 Credit Agreement) multiplied by the greatest of (a) LIBOR, (b) 0.00% per annum and (c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. As of March 31, 2019, the balance due was $318.8 million, with an interest rate of 5.875% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.540%. At December 31, 2018, $323.0 million was outstanding under the First Lien Facility, with an interest rate of 5.875% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.61463%.

The Second Lien Facility requires a balloon payment of $125.0 million due at maturity. The interest rate for the Second Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by the Company, or to the extent consented to by all Appropriate Lenders (as defined in the 2016 Credit Agreement), 12 months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 10.0% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate multiplied by the greatest of (a) LIBOR, (b) 0.00% per annum and (c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. As of March 31, 2019, the balance due was $125.0 million with an interest rate of 10.00% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.5855%. At December 31, 2018, $125.0 million was outstanding under the Second Lien Facility with an interest rate of 10.00% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.61463%.

The Facilities are secured by substantially all of our assets and contain certain covenants. As of December 31, 2018, we were in compliance with all covenants.

The 2016 Credit Agreement includes a mandatory prepayment within ten days after delivery of the annual audited financial statements commencing with the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016, in an amount equal to the Excess Cash Flow Percentage of Excess Cash Flow for such Fiscal Year, as defined in the 2016 Credit Agreement.

Revolving Credit Facility

The 2016 Credit Agreement also provides for a Revolving Credit Facility of up to $30.0 million that matures December 9, 2021. Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facility are subject to meeting certain financial covenants set forth in the 2016 Credit Agreement, including the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio. We may draw up to $30.0 million under the Revolving Credit Facility, on a term loan basis, with either an adjustable eurocurrency loan interest rate of 5.375%, 5.625%, or 5.875% with interest rates based on the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio plus an amount equal to the LIBOR, or a base rate loan interest rate of 4.375%, 4.635%, or 4.875% plus the Base Rate. As of March 31, 2019, $6.0 million was outstanding under our Revolving Credit Facility and $1.0 million in letters of credit were issued.

As of December 31, 2018, we had no amounts outstanding under our Revolving Credit Facility and $1.2 million in letters of credit issued with approximately $28.8 million of available borrowing capacity under the Revolving Credit Facility.

The Initial Term Loan borrowings pursuant to the 2016 Credit Agreement were issued at an original issue discount of $11.9 million and $6.3 million for the First Lien Facility and Second Lien Facility, respectively. The original issue discount is amortized using the effective yield method over the respective term of each Facility.

We incurred closing fees in connection with the entry into the Facilities and the Revolving Credit Facility pursuant to the 2016 Credit Agreement of $13.6 million. These closing fees were deferred on December 9, 2016, along with fees of $0.6 million related to our prior term loan facility that we refinanced in connection with our entry into the 2016 Credit Agreement, and are amortized over their respective terms.

 

153


Table of Contents

Our net cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 and the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 were as follows:

 

     Three Months Ended March 31,      Year Ended December 31,  
             2019                      2018                      2018                     2017          

Net cash provided by (used in):

          

Operating activities

   $ (18,340    $ (23,324    $ (11,942   $ (2,685

Investing activities

   $ (2,182    $ (1,816    $ (12,387   $ (20,600

Financing activities

   $ 1,593      $ 12,714      $ 29,030     $ 8,892  

Effect of foreign exchange rates

   $ 22      $ 248      $ (158   $ 1,518  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease in cash)

   $ (18,907    $ (12,178    $ 4,543     $ (12,875
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash Flows Used in Operating Activities

Net cash used in operating activities was $18.3 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to net cash used in operating activities of $23.3 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. The decrease in net cash used is due to a $4.5 million reduction in net loss, as well as a $2.8 million decrease in non-cash expenses, offset by a $2.3 million increase in working capital. The period over period decrease in non-cash items is primarily due to a $5.5 million decrease in deferred tax benefit and an increase in stock compensation expense of $0.6 million, offset by a $3.4 million decrease in depreciation and amortization. The increase in working capital for the period is primarily due to a $8.2 million increase in prepaid expenses and other assets, offset by a $2.7 million decrease in accounts receivable, a $2.4 million increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses and a $0.8 million increase in deferred revenue. Trade accounts receivable fluctuate from period to period depending on the period to period change in revenue and the timing of collections. Accounts payable fluctuate from period to period depending on the timing of purchases and payments.

Net cash used in operating activities was $11.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to net cash used in operating activities of $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase is cash used is primarily due to a $7.4 million decrease in non-cash expenses and a $6.3 million decrease in working capital changes offset by a $4.5 million reduction in net loss from 2017 to 2018. The decrease in non-cash items is primarily due to a $9.2 million increase in deferred tax (benefit) expense from 2017 to 2018, offset by $1.6 million in fair value of contingent consideration that was recorded in 2017 but not in 2018. The decrease in working capital is primarily due to a $10.5 million decrease in accounts payable and accrued expenses, a $6.2 million increase in accounts receivable and a $1.5 million decrease in deferred revenue, offset by an $11.9 million decrease in prepaid expenses and other assets. Trade accounts receivable fluctuate from period to period depending on the period to period change in revenue and the timing of collections. Accounts payable fluctuate from period to period depending on the timing of purchases and payments.

Cash Flows Used in Investing Activities

Net cash used in investing activities was $2.2 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 as compared to net cash used in investing activities of $1.8 million for the three months ended March 31, 2018. The increase in cash used is due to increased purchases of property and equipment.

Net cash used in investing activities was $12.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to net cash used in investing activities of $20.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease is cash used is due to a decrease in purchases of property and equipment.

Cash Flows Provided by Financing Activities

For the three months ended March 31, 2019, net cash provided by financing activities of $1.6 million related to the net borrowings from our Revolving Credit Facility of $6.0 million, offset by payments of long-term debt and

 

154


Table of Contents

capital lease obligations of $4.4 million. For the three months ended March 31, 2018, net cash provided by financing activities of $12.7 million related primarily to $16.5 million from the issuance of common stock offset by payments on long-term debt of $2.1 million and payments of $1.6 million for contingent consideration.

Net cash provided by financing activities was $29.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to net cash provided by financing activities of $8.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase in cash provided is due primarily to a $20.6 million increase in issuance of common stock and a $1.2 million decrease in payments of capital lease obligations, offset by a $1.6 million increase in payments of contingent consideration related to acquisitions.

Contractual Obligations

Our operating lease obligations are disclosed below and also in Note 5 to our unaudited consolidated financial statements and our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus. Rent expense for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 was $3.0 million and $2.2 million, respectively. Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 was $13.0 million and $10.3 million, respectively.

The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of March 31, 2019:

 

     Payments due by period  
(in thousands)    Total      Less than
1 year
     1 to less
than
3 years
     3 to less
than
5 years
     More
than
5 years
 

Contractual obligations

              

Debt:

              

Principal

   $ 443,750      $ 17,000      $ 34,000      $ 392,750      $ —    

Interest on debt (1)

     167,685        42,936        81,744        43,005        —    

Purchase obligations

     15,692        6,589        7,028        2,075        —    

Capital leases

     2,346        631        1,262        453        —    

Operating leases

     46,342        10,623        15,940        15,236        4,543  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contractual obligations

   $ 675,815      $ 77,779      $ 139,974      $ 453,519      $ 4,543  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Assumed interest rates on our First Lien Facility and Second Lien Facility were 8.42% and 12.59%, respectively, as of March 31, 2019.

The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2018:

 

     Payments due by period  
(in thousands)    Total      Less than
1 year
     1 to less
than
3 years
     3 to less
than
5 years
     More
than
5 years
 

Contractual obligations

              

Debt:

              

Principal

   $ 448,000      $ 17,000      $ 34,000      $ 397,000      $ —    

Interest on debt (1)

     178,480        43,273        82,413        52,794        —    

Purchase obligations

     17,182        6,475        8,052        2,479        176  

Capital leases

     2,504        631        1,262        611        —    

Operating leases

     47,851        10,625        16,811        10,999        9,416  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contractual obligations

   $ 694,017      $ 78,004      $ 142,538      $ 463,883      $ 9,592  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Assumed interest rates on our First Lien Facility and Second Lien Facility were 8.49% and 12.61%, respectively, as of December 31, 2018.

 

155


Table of Contents

Off-balance Sheet Financing Arrangements

We have no obligations, assets or liabilities which would be considered off-balance sheet arrangements. We do not participate in transactions that create relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, often referred to as variable interest entities, which would have been established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet arrangements. We have not entered into any off-balance sheet financing arrangements, established any special purpose entities, guaranteed any debt or commitments of other entities or purchased any nonfinancial assets.

Qualitative and Quantitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Interest rate risk

We are subject to interest rate market risk in connection with our long-term indebtedness. Our principal interest rate exposure relates to outstanding amounts under the 2016 Credit Agreement, which provides for borrowings of $340.0 million under the First Lien Facility and $125.0 million under the Second Lien Facility, as well as a Revolving Credit Facility of $30.0 million. Interest rate changes generally impact the amount of our interest payments and, therefore, our future net income and cash flows, assuming other factors are held constant. Assuming the amounts outstanding under the 2016 Credit Agreement are fully drawn, each one-eighth percentage point increase or decrease in the applicable interest rates would correspondingly change our interest expense under the 2016 Credit Agreement by approximately $0.6 million per year. We do not currently hedge our interest rate exposure.

Exchange rate risk

Results of operations for our non-U.S. subsidiaries are translated from the designated functional currency to the reporting currency of the U.S. dollar. Revenues and expenses are translated at average exchange rates for each month, while assets and liabilities are translated at balance sheet date exchange rates. Resulting net translation adjustments are recorded as a component of stockholders’ equity in “Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income.”

Transaction gains and losses arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on transactions denominated in a currency other than the local functional currency are included in “Other expense” on our Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. Such transaction gains and losses may be realized or unrealized depending upon whether the transaction settled during the period or remains outstanding at the balance sheet date.

During the twelve months ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, we generated the equivalent of $62.2 million and $61.1 million, respectively, of U.S. dollar-denominated revenues in non-U.S. subsidiaries. Each 100 basis point increase or decrease in the average foreign currency rate to U.S. dollar exchange rate for the year would have correspondingly changed our revenues by approximately $0.6 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017. We do not currently hedge our exchange rate exposure.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

See Note 1 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus for a summary of accounting standards not yet adopted.

Critical Accounting Policies

We prepare our consolidated financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP. In applying accounting principles, it is often required to use estimates. These estimates consider the facts, circumstances and information available, and may be based on subjective inputs, assumptions and information known and unknown to us. Material changes in certain of the estimates that we use could potentially affect, by a material amount, our consolidated financial position and results of operations. Although results may vary, we believe our estimates are reasonable and appropriate. See Note 1 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus for a summary of our significant accounting policies. The following describes certain of our significant accounting policies that involve more subjective and complex judgments where the effect on our consolidated financial position and operating performance could be material.

 

156


Table of Contents

Use of estimates

Significant estimates include, but are not limited to, the allowance for doubtful accounts, determining the fair values of assets acquired and liabilities assumed, the recoverability and useful lives of property and equipment, intangible assets and other long-lived assets, the impairment of goodwill, the valuation and realization of deferred income taxes, the fair value of our common stock and stock option awards and acquisition-related contingent consideration.

Revenue recognition

We recognize revenue when all the following criteria are met: (1) persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists; (2) delivery has occurred; (3) the fee is fixed and determinable; and (4) collectability is probable.

Amounts billed in excess of the amounts for which the revenue recognition criteria have been satisfied are recorded as deferred revenue on our consolidated balance sheets until all revenue recognition criteria have been satisfied. Any taxes assessed on revenues relating to services provided to our clients are recorded on a net basis.

Our revenues are primarily derived from contracts to provide services each month including: collection and forensic services, processing, managed document review services and hosting fees based on the amount of data stored. We bill our customers monthly in arrears for services provided. For these contractual arrangements, we have identified each deliverable service element. Based on an evaluation of each element, we have determined that each element delivered has standalone value to its customers because we or other vendors sell such services separately from any other services/deliverables.

Accordingly, each of the service elements in our multiple element case and document management arrangements qualify as a separate unit of accounting. We allocate revenue to the various units of accounting in our arrangements based on the fair value or best estimated selling price of each unit of accounting, which is generally consistent with the stated prices in the arrangements.

We enter into arrangements that can include various combinations of software, services and hardware. Where elements are delivered over different periods of time, and when allowed under U.S. GAAP, revenue is allocated to the respective elements based on their relative selling prices at the inception of the arrangement, and revenue is recognized as each element is delivered. We use a hierarchy to determine the fair value to be used for allocating revenue to elements: (i) vendor-specific objective evidence of fair value (“ VSOE ”), (ii) third-party evidence and (iii) best estimate of selling price (“ BESP ”). For software elements, we follow the industry-specific software guidance which only allows for the use of VSOE in establishing fair value. Generally, VSOE is the price charged when the deliverable is sold separately, or the price established by management for a product that is not yet sold if it is probable that the price will not change before introduction into the marketplace. In software arrangements where we do not have VSOE for all undelivered elements, the elements are combined and the arrangement consideration is recognized for the combined element, generally ratably over the maintenance period. BESPs are established as best estimates of what the selling prices would be if the deliverables were sold regularly on a stand-alone basis. Our process for determining BESPs requires judgment and considers multiple factors that may vary over time depending upon the unique facts and circumstances related to each deliverable.

Business combinations

We recognize all of the assets acquired, liabilities assumed, contractual contingencies and contingent consideration at their fair value on the acquisition date. Acquisition-related costs are recognized separately from the acquisition and expensed as incurred. Restructuring costs incurred in periods subsequent to the acquisition date are expensed when incurred. Subsequent changes to the purchase price, such as working capital adjustments, or other fair value adjustments determined during the measurement period are recorded as an adjustment to goodwill, with the exception of contingent consideration, which is recognized in the statement of operations in

 

157


Table of Contents

the period it is modified. All subsequent changes to a valuation allowance or uncertain tax position that relate to the acquired company and existed at the acquisition date that occur both within the measurement period and as a result of facts and circumstances that existed at the acquisition date are recognized as an adjustment to goodwill. All other changes in valuation allowances are recognized as a reduction or increase to income tax expense or as a direct adjustment to additional paid-in capital as required.

Accounts receivable

Accounts receivable are recorded at original invoice amount less an estimate for doubtful accounts based on a review of outstanding amounts monthly. Management determines the allowance for doubtful accounts by regularly evaluating individual customer receivables and considering a customer’s financial condition and credit history. Accounts receivable are written off when deemed uncollectible. Recoveries of trade accounts receivable previously written off are recorded when received.

Intangible assets and other long-lived assets

We evaluate the recoverability of our long-lived assets, including finite-lived intangible assets, for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of any asset to future net undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by the asset. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured as the difference between the fair value of the asset compared to its carrying amount.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the total consideration paid over our identified intangible and tangible assets and our acquisitions. We test our goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level on an annual basis and between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying value. These events or circumstances could include a significant change in the business climate, legal factors, operating performance indicators, competition, or sale or disposition of a significant portion of a reporting unit. As of the testing date (October 1), we have determined there is one entity-wide reporting unit.

We test goodwill resulting from acquisitions for impairment annually on October 1, or more frequently, whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value of goodwill may be impaired.

In January 2017, the Financial Accounting Standard Board (“ FASB ”) issued Accounting Standard Update (“ ASU ”) 2017-04, which simplifies the subsequent measurement of goodwill to eliminate Step 2 from the goodwill impairment test, removing the need to determine the implied fair value of goodwill and comparing it to the carrying amount of that goodwill to measure the impairment loss, if any. We early adopted ASU 2017-04 during the fourth quarter of 2017.

Goodwill impairment exists when the estimated fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying value. If impairment exists, the carrying value of the goodwill is reduced by the excess through an impairment charge recorded in our statements of operations. The process of evaluating the potential impairment of goodwill is subjective and requires significant judgment at many points during the analysis.

The fair value of each reporting unit is estimated using a combination of a discounted cash flow (“ DCF ”) analysis and market-based valuation methodologies such as comparable public company trading values and values observed in recent business combinations. Determining fair value requires the exercise of significant judgments, including the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, long-term growth rates, discount rates and relevant comparable public company earnings multiples and relevant transaction multiples. The cash flows

 

158


Table of Contents

employed in the DCF analyses are based on our best estimate of future sales, earnings and cash flows after considering factors such as general market conditions, changes in working capital, long term business plans and recent operating performance. The carrying value of each reporting unit includes the assets and liabilities employed in its operations and goodwill.

Accordingly, we have not identified any indicators of impairment, nor have any impairment charges been recorded related to goodwill as a result of the annual impairment test.

Indefinite-lived intangible assets

We test indefinite-lived intangible assets annually and more frequently if events or changes in circumstances between annual tests indicate that it is more likely than not that the asset is impaired. We have the option to first assess certain qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances indicate that it is more likely than not that the fair value of an indefinite-lived intangible asset is less than its carrying amount. If, after performing a qualitative assessment, an entity determines that it is more likely than not that the carrying value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset exceeds its fair value, or we have opted not to perform a qualitative assessment, we will then estimate the fair value of the asset. If the fair value of the intangible asset is less than its carrying amount, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to the difference. The asset will then be carried at its new fair value.

We perform an impairment test of its indefinite-lived intangible assets at least annually on October 1 or more frequently whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value of its indefinite-lived intangible assets may be impaired. As discussed in Note 4 to our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus, on January 31, 2017, we announced the launch of KrolLDiscovery, a new global brand and logo for our eDiscovery and information governance offerings, combining the LDiscovery and Kroll Ontrack brands. In connection with the completion of the rebranding and launch of KrolLDiscovery, we determined that the previously identified indefinite-lived tradename now had a finite useful life. Concurrent with this change, we performed our final impairment test that indicated the fair value of its LDiscovery tradename was in excess of its carrying value.

 

159


Table of Contents

BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF SECURITIES

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management of Pivotal

The following table sets forth information regarding the beneficial ownership of Pivotal common stock as of the record date and immediately following the consummation of the Business Combination by:

 

   

each person known by Pivotal to be the beneficial owner of more than 5% of Pivotal’s outstanding shares of common stock either on the record date or after the consummation of the Business Combination;

 

   

each of Pivotal’s current executive officers and directors;

 

   

each person who will become an executive officer or a director of Pivotal upon the consummation of the Business Combination;

 

   

all of Pivotal’s current executive officers and directors as a group; and

 

   

all of Pivotal’s executive officers and directors as a group immediately following the consummation of the Business Combination.

At any time prior to the annual meeting, during any period when they are not then aware of any material nonpublic information regarding Pivotal or its securities, the Founder, Pivotal’s officers and directors, the Company and the Company’s stockholders and/or their respective affiliates may purchase shares from institutional and other investors who vote, or indicate an intention to vote, against the business combination proposal, or execute agreements to purchase such shares from them in the future, or they may enter into transactions with such persons and others to provide them with incentives to acquire common stock or vote their shares in favor of the business combination proposal. The purpose of such share purchases and other transactions would be to increase the likelihood of satisfaction of the requirements that the holders of a majority of the public shares entitled to vote at the annual meeting to approve the business combination proposal vote in favor of each business combination proposal and that Pivotal will have in excess of $5,000,001 of net tangible assets upon the closing of the Business Combination after taking into account holders of public shares that properly demanded redemption of their public shares into cash, when it appears that such requirements would otherwise not be met. While the exact nature of any such incentives has not been determined as of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, they might include, without limitation, arrangements to protect such investors or holders against potential loss in value of their shares, including the granting of put options and the transfer to such investors or holders of shares of warrants owned by the Founder for nominal value.

Entering into any such arrangements may have a depressive effect on Pivotal common stock. For example, as a result of these arrangements, an investor or holder may have the ability to effectively purchase shares at a price lower than market and may therefore be more likely to sell the shares it owns, either prior to or immediately after the annual meeting.

As of the date of this proxy statement/prospectus, no agreements dealing with the above have been entered into. Pivotal will file a Current Report on Form 8-K to disclose any arrangements entered into or significant purchases made by any of the aforementioned persons that would affect the vote on the business combination proposal and charter amendment proposals or the redemption threshold. Any such report will include descriptions of any arrangements entered into or significant purchases by any of the aforementioned persons.

Unless otherwise indicated, we believe that all persons named in the table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares of Class A common stock beneficially owned by them. The following table does not reflect (i) the record of beneficial ownership of the warrants included in the units offered in Pivotal’s initial public offering or the private warrants, as these warrants are not exercisable within 60 days of June 1, 2019, or

 

160


Table of Contents

(ii) 9,520 shares of common stock of the Company issuable upon the exercise of employee stock options exercisable within 60 days of June 1, 2019. In connection with the consummation of the Business Combination, all such outstanding stock options will automatically be canceled without consideration.

 

     Before the Business Combination (2)     After the Business Combination (3)  

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner

   Amount and
Nature of
Beneficial
Ownership
     Approximate
Percentage of
Outstanding
Shares
    Amount and
Nature of
Beneficial
Ownership
     Approximate
percentage of
Outstanding
Shares
 

Directors and Executive Officers Pre-Business Combination (1)

          

Jonathan J. Ledecky (4)(5)

     5,500,000        19.1     5,500,000        8.7

Kevin Griffin (4)(5)

     5,500,000        19.1     5,500,000        8.7

Efrat Epstein (4)

     50,000        *       50,000        *  

Katrina Adams (4)

     50,000        *       50,000        *  

James H.R. Brady (4)

     100,000        *       100,000        *  

All executive officers and directors as a group (five individuals)

     5,700,000        19.8     5,700,000        9.0

Directors and Executive Officers Post-Business Combination (6)

          

Jonathan J. Ledecky (4)(5)

     5,500,000        19.1     5,500,000        8.7

Kevin Griffin (4)(5)

     5,500,000        19.1     5,500,000        8.7

Evan Morgan (7)

     50,000        *       87,994        *  

Richard J. Williams (8)

     —          —         1,518,555        2.4

Donna Morea

     —          —         36,995        *  

Christopher J. Weiler (9)

     —          —         2,123,946        3.3

Dawn Wilson (10)

     —          —         —          —    

Krystina Jones (11)

     —          —         127,480        *  

Daniel F. Akerson

     —          —         492,907        *  

William Darman

     —          —         —          —    

All executive officers and directors as a group (ten individuals)

     5,550,000        19.3     15,387,877        24.2

Five Percent Holders

          

Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC (5)

     5,550,000        19.3     5,550,000        8.7

AQR Capital Management Holdings, LLC (12)

     1,800,000        6.3     1,800,000        2.8

RP Investment Advisors LP (13)

     1,500,000        5.2     1,500,000        2.4

TCG (14)

     —          —         20,080,527        31.6

RG (15)

     —          —         4,115,803        6.5

 

*

Less than 1%.

(1)

Unless otherwise indicated, the business address of each of the individuals is c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, New York 10174

(2)

The pre-Business Combination percentage of beneficial ownership of Pivotal in the table below is calculated based on 23,000,000 shares of Class A common stock and 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock outstanding as of the record date. The amount of beneficial ownership does not reflect the common stock issuable upon exercise of Pivotal’s warrants as such warrants may not be exercisable within 60 days, and does not include shares of common stock of the Company that may be issued upon the exercise of employee stock options as all outstanding stock options will automatically be cancelled in connection with the consummation of the Business Combination. Unless otherwise indicated, Pivotal believes that all persons named in the table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares of common stock beneficially owned by them prior to the Business Combination.

 

161


Table of Contents
(3)

The post-Business Combination percentage of beneficial ownership of Pivotal is calculated based on 63,550,000 shares of common stock outstanding. Such amount assumes that no public stockholders properly elect to redeem their shares for cash. The amount of beneficial ownership for each individual or entity post-Business Combination includes shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of Pivotal’s warrants as such warrants will become exercisable upon consummation of the Business Combination. It does not include 2,200,000 shares of common stock that may be issuable to the Company’s stockholders upon the satisfaction of certain conditions, as such conditions may not occur within 60 days. Unless otherwise indicated, Pivotal believes that all persons named in the table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all common stock beneficially owned by them upon consummation of the Business Combination.

(4)

Represents shares of Class A common stock that may be issued upon conversion of a like number of shares of Class B common stock held by each individual. Such shares of Class B common stock will automatically convert into Class A common stock at the time of our initial business combination on a one-for-one basis, subject to adjustment.

(5)

Represents shares held by our sponsor, Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC, of which each of Ironbound Partners Fund, LLC, an affiliate of Mr. Ledecky, and Pivotal Spac Funding LLC, an affiliate of Mr. Griffin, is a managing member.

(6)

Unless otherwise indicated, the business address of each of the individuals is c/o KLDiscovery, 8201 Greensboro Dr., Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102.

(7)

Before the Business Combination, represents shares of Class A common stock that may be issued upon conversion of a like number of shares of Class B common stock held by Mr. Morgan. Such shares of Class B common stock will automatically convert into Class A common stock at the time of the initial business combination on a one-for-one basis, subject to adjustment. After the Business Combination, also includes (i) 5,005 shares held by Conifer Partners and (ii) 32,989 shares held by Radcliff Principal Holdings LLC, in each case, over which Mr. Morgan has voting and dispositive control.

(8)

Includes 1,518,555 shares held by Westview. Mr. Williams is a co-managing partner of this entity and has voting and dispositive control over such shares.

(9)

Does not include 2,500 shares of common stock of the Company issuable upon the exercise of employee stock options exercisable within 60 days of June 1, 2019.

(10)

Does not include 4,000 shares of common stock of the Company issuable upon the exercise of employee stock options exercisable within 60 days of June 1, 2019.

(11)

Does not include 3,020 shares of common stock of the Company issuable upon the exercise of employee stock options exercisable within 60 days of June 1, 2019.

(12)

The business address of this entity is c/o AQR Capital Management, LLC, Two Greenwich Plaza, Greenwich, CT 06830.

(13)

The business address of this entity is c/o RP Investment Advisors LP, 39 Hazelton Avenue, Toronto, Ontario, Canada M5R 2E3.

(14)

Includes 18,337,579 shares of common stock held of record by CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P., 1,665,734 shares of common stock held of record by CEOF II Coinvestment (DE), L.P. and 77,214 shares of common stock held of record by CEOF II Coinvestment B (DE), L.P. (together with CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P. and CEOF II Coinvestment (DE), L.P., the “ CEOF Funds ”). Carlyle Group Management L.L.C. is the general partner of TCG, which is a publicly traded entity listed on NASDAQ. TCG is the sole shareholder of Carlyle Holdings I GP Inc., which is the sole member of Carlyle Holdings I GP Sub L.L.C., which is the general partner of Carlyle Holdings I L.P., which is the sole member of TC Group, L.L.C., which is the general partner of TC Group Sub L.P., which is the sole member of CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C., which is the general partner CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P., which is the general partner of each of the CEOF Funds. Accordingly, each of the foregoing entities may be deemed to share beneficial ownership of the securities held of record by the CEOF Funds. The address of each of the persons or entities named in this footnote is c/o The Carlyle Group, 1001 Pennsylvania Ave. NW, Suite 220 South, Washington, D.C. 20004-2505.

(15)

Includes 4,115,803 shares of common stock held of record by Revolution Growth III, LP. Steven J. Murray is the operating manager of Revolution Growth UGP III, LLC, the general partner of Revolution Growth GP III, LP, which is the general partner of Revolution Growth III, LP. Revolution Growth UGP III, LLC, Revolution Growth GP III, LP and Mr. Murray may be deemed to have voting and dispositive power with

 

162


Table of Contents
 

respect to these shares. The business address of these accounts is 1717 Rhode Island Avenue, NW, 10th Floor, Washington, D.C. 20036.

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors beneficially own 20% of Pivotal’s issued and outstanding common stock as of the record date. Because of this ownership block, such individuals may be able to effectively exercise control over all matters requiring approval by Pivotal’s stockholders, including the election of directors and approval of significant corporate transactions other than approval of its initial business combination.

In connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, the holders of Pivotal’s founder shares entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the founder shares (subject to limited exceptions) until one year after the consummation of an initial business combination or earlier if, subsequent to the consummation of an initial business combination, (i) the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the initial business combination or (ii) Pivotal (or any successor entity) consummates a subsequent liquidation, merger, stock exchange or other similar transaction which results in all of the company’s stockholders having the right to exchange their shares of common stock for cash, securities or other property. Additionally, the holders of private warrants entered into a lock-up agreement pursuant to which they agreed not to transfer the private warrants or common stock underlying the private warrants (subject to limited exceptions) until thirty days after the consummation of an initial business combination.

The stockholders of the Company receiving shares of Pivotal common stock will be subject to a 12-month lock-up period for all shares of Pivotal common stock held by such holders, which period may be earlier terminated if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 for a period of 20 consecutive trading days during any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after the closing of the Business Combination. This lock-up is identical to the lock-up previously agreed to by the Founder and other holders of Pivotal’s founder shares.

Additionally, in connection with the Merger, the Founder agreed to enter into the Founder Lock-Up Agreement, pursuant to which an aggregate of 1,100,000 founder shares will be subject to transfer restrictions for the five-year period beginning upon consummation of the Business Combination until the last sales price of Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $15.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations and recapitalizations) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period. If the last reported sale price of Pivotal common stock does not equal or exceed $15.00 within the required time period, such founder shares will be forfeited to Pivotal for no consideration.

 

163


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PERSON TRANSACTIONS

Related Person Policy

Pivotal’s Code of Ethics requires Pivotal to avoid, wherever possible, all related party transactions that could result in actual or potential conflicts of interests, except under guidelines approved by the board of directors (or the audit committee). Related party transactions are defined as transactions in which (1) the aggregate amount involved will or may be expected to exceed $120,000 in any calendar year, (2) Pivotal or any of its subsidiaries is a participant and (3) any (a) executive officer, director or nominee for election as a director, (b) greater than 5% beneficial owner of Pivotal common stock, or (c) immediate family member of the persons referred to in clauses (a) and (b) has or will have a direct or indirect material interest (other than solely as a result of being a director or a less than 10% beneficial owner of another entity). A conflict of interest situation can arise when a person takes actions or has interests that may make it difficult to perform his or her work objectively and effectively. Conflicts of interest may also arise if a person, or a member of his or her family, receives improper personal benefits as a result of his or her position.

Pivotal’s audit committee, pursuant to its written charter, is responsible for reviewing and approving related party transactions to the extent Pivotal enters into such transactions. The audit committee will consider all relevant factors when determining whether to approve a related party transaction, including whether the related party transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third-party under the same or similar circumstances and the extent of the related party’s interest in the transaction. No director may participate in the approval of any transaction in which he is a related party, but that director is required to provide the audit committee with all material information concerning the transaction. Additionally, Pivotal requires each of its directors and executive officers to complete an annual directors’ and officers’ questionnaire that elicits information about related party transactions.

These procedures are intended to determine whether any such related party transaction impairs the independence of a director or presents a conflict of interest on the part of a director, employee or officer.

Pivotal Related Person Transactions

In August 2018, Pivotal issued 5,570,000 shares of Class B common stock to the Founder for $25,000 in cash, at a purchase price of approximately $0.004 per share, in connection with Pivotal’s organization. The Founder transferred 50,000 founder shares to each independent director in December 2018 and transferred 100,000 founder shares to Pivotal’s chief financial officer in December 2018, in each case at the same per-share purchase price paid by the Founder.

The founder shares are designated as Class B common stock and will automatically convert into shares of Pivotal’s single class of common stock on the first business day following the consummation of our initial business combination on a one-for-one basis, subject to adjustment. In the case that additional shares of common stock, or equity-linked securities convertible or exercisable for common stock, are issued or deemed issued and related to the closing of our initial business combination, the ratio at which founder shares will convert into common stock will be adjusted so that the number of shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of all founder shares will equal, in the aggregate, 20% of the sum of the common stock outstanding upon the completion of Pivotal’s initial public offering plus the number of shares of common stock and equity-linked shares issued or deemed issued in connection with our initial business combination (net of redemptions), excluding any common stock or equity-linked securities issued, or to be issued, to any seller in our initial business combination and any private warrants issued. Any conversion of Class B common stock described herein will take effect as a redemption of Class B common stock and an issuance of Class A common stock as a matter of Delaware law.

The Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 private warrants (for a total purchase price of $6,350,000) from Pivotal on a private placement basis simultaneously with the

 

164


Table of Contents

consummation of Pivotal’s initial public offering. The private warrants are identical to the warrants included in the units sold in Pivotal’s initial public offering except that the private warrants: (i) are not redeemable by Pivotal and (ii) may be exercised for cash or on a cashless basis, as described in the prospectus for Pivotal’s initial public offering, so long as they are held by the initial purchasers or any of their permitted transferees. If the private warrants are held by holders other than the initial purchasers or any of their permitted transferees, they will be redeemable by Pivotal and exercisable by the holders on the same basis as the warrants included in the units being sold in its initial public offering. The initial purchasers of the private warrants have agreed not to transfer, assign or sell any of the warrants, including the common stock issuable upon exercise of the warrants (except to certain permitted transferees), until 30 days after the completion of Pivotal’s initial business combination.

Other than as described above, no compensation of any kind will be paid by Pivotal to its sponsor, executive officers and directors, or any of their respective affiliates, for services rendered prior to or in connection with the completion of an initial business combination. However, these individuals will be reimbursed for any out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with activities on Pivotal’s behalf such as identifying potential target businesses and performing due diligence on suitable business combinations. Pivotal’s audit committee will review on a quarterly basis all payments that were made to Pivotal’s sponsor, officers, directors or its or their affiliates.

Pivotal Spac Funding LLC, a managing member of the Founder, agreed in connection with Pivotal’s initial public offering, pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract, to purchase, in a private placement to occur concurrently with the consummation of Pivotal’s initial business combination, and under certain conditions, up to $150,000,000 of Pivotal’s securities. In connection with the signing of the Merger Agreement, Pivotal Spac Funding LLC indicated that up to $50,000,000 of the commitment could be utilized in connection with the Merger. The type of securities to be purchased by Pivotal Spac Funding LLC, if any, will be determined by Pivotal and Pivotal Spac Funding LLC prior to the closing of the proposed initial business combination. There is no binding commitment or agreement to purchase any securities and, accordingly, there can be no assurance that such purchase will occur.

An affiliate of Pivotal’s sponsor previously loaned to Pivotal $125,000. This loan was non-interest bearing, unsecured and was repaid upon the closing of Pivotal’s initial public offering.

In order to fund working capital deficiencies or finance transaction costs in connection with an intended initial business combination, the Founder and Pivotal’s officers and directors or their respective affiliates may, but are not obligated to, loan Pivotal funds as may be required on a non-interest bearing basis. If Pivotal completes its initial business combination, Pivotal would repay such loaned amounts. In the event that the initial business combination does not close, Pivotal may use a portion of the working capital held outside the trust account to repay such loaned amounts but no proceeds from the trust account would be used for such repayment. Up to $1,500,000 of such loans may be convertible into warrants of Pivotal at a price of $1.00 per warrant at the option of the lender. The warrants would be identical to the private warrants.

The holders of Pivotal’s founder shares, as well as the holders of the private warrants and any warrants the Founder or its affiliates may be issued in payment of working capital loans made to Pivotal (and all underlying securities), are entitled to registration rights pursuant to an agreement signed on the effective date of Pivotal’s initial public offering. The holders of a majority of these securities are entitled to make up to two demands that Pivotal register such securities. The holders of a majority of the private warrants or warrants issued in payment of working capital loans made to Pivotal (or underlying securities) can elect to exercise these registration rights at any time after Pivotal consummates a business combination. In addition, the holders have certain “piggy-back” registration rights with respect to registration statements filed subsequent to Pivotal’s consummation of a business combination. Pivotal will bear the expenses incurred in connection with the filing of any such registration statements. This arrangement will be terminated in connection with the consummation of the Merger and will be replaced by the Registration Rights Agreement.

 

165


Table of Contents

After the Business Combination, members of Pivotal’s management team who remain with Pivotal may be paid consulting, management or other fees from the combined company with any and all amounts being fully disclosed to stockholders, to the extent then known, in the proxy solicitation materials furnished to our stockholders. The amount of such compensation may not be known at the time of a stockholder meeting held to consider an initial business combination, as it will be up to the directors of the post-combination business to determine executive and director compensation. In this event, such compensation will be publicly disclosed at the time of its determination in a Current Report on Form 8-K, as required by the SEC.

All ongoing and future transactions between Pivotal and any of its officers and directors or their respective affiliates will be on terms believed by Pivotal to be no less favorable to it than are available from unaffiliated third parties. Such transactions will require prior approval by a majority of Pivotal’s uninterested “independent” directors or the members of Pivotal’s board who do not have an interest in the transaction, in either case who had access, at Pivotal’s expense, to Pivotal’s attorneys or independent legal counsel. Pivotal will not enter into any such transaction unless its disinterested “independent” directors determine that the terms of such transaction are no less favorable to Pivotal than those that would be available to Pivotal with respect to such a transaction from unaffiliated third parties.

Company Related Person Transactions

Consulting Services Agreement

On December 22, 2015, LDisc Holdings, LLC (“ LDisc ”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company, entered into a consulting services agreement (the “ Consulting Services Agreement ”) with CIM, an affiliate of TCG, in connection with the acquisition of LDisc by an affiliate of CIM. In exchange for providing LDisc and its subsidiaries with certain ongoing strategic and financial advisory and consulting services pursuant to the Consulting Services Agreement, CIM is entitled to a quarterly fee, determined each calendar quarter, equal in the aggregate to the greater of (i) 0.5% of the trailing 12-month consolidated EBITDA of LDisc and its subsidiaries and (ii) $250,000. For the year ended December 31, 2017, approximately $1.5 million of fees remained payable to CIM. For the year ended December 31, 2018, approximately $2.6 million of fees remained payable to CIM. As of March 31, 2019, approximately $2.947 million of fees remained payable to CIM. Further, under the Consulting Services Agreement, CIM was entitled to additional fees and compensation agreed upon by the parties for any other services provided by CIM to LDisc from time to time. CIM did not provide any additional services under the Consulting Services Agreement beyond the advisory and consulting services for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017. The Consulting Services Agreement provides that LDisc will indemnify CIM against any claims arising out of or in connection with its performance under the Consulting Services Agreement and will reimburse CIM for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with its performance of the services provided under the Consulting Services Agreement. The Consulting Services Agreement terminates automatically immediately prior to an initial public offering of LDisc or the Company or the completion of certain sale transactions involving LDisc. The Consulting Services Agreement may be terminated (i) by LDisc in the event that CIM and its affiliates collectively beneficially own less than 25% of the outstanding voting securities of LDisc or the Company or (ii) by CIM at any time. The Consulting Services Agreement will be terminated in connection with the Business Combination and all unpaid amounts thereunder as of the consummation of the Business Combination will be paid to CIM.

Stockholders’ Agreement

Affiliates of Carlyle and Revolution have entered into the Stockholders’ Agreement with Pivotal, pursuant to which the holders of a majority of the shares of Pivotal common stock held by such Carlyle affiliates and Revolution will have the right to designate up to six directors for election to Pivotal’s board of directors for so long as such Carlyle affiliates and Revolution maintain collective ownership of a certain percentage interest in Pivotal.

 

166


Table of Contents

Registration Rights Agreement

Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company’s stockholders, the Founder and the other holders of founder shares will be granted certain rights to have registered, in certain circumstances, the resale under the Securities Act of the securities of Pivotal held by such holders, subject to certain conditions set forth therein.

Support Agreements

In connection with the execution of the Merger Agreement, stockholders of the Company who hold a majority of the Company’s outstanding stock entered into agreements pursuant to which they agreed to vote in favor of the Business Combination at a meeting of the Company’s stockholders called to approve the Business Combination (or to act by written consent approving the Business Combination).

 

167


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF PIVOTAL’S SECURITIES AFTER THE MERGER

The following description of the material terms of the share capital of Pivotal following the Merger includes a summary of specified provisions of the charter documents of Pivotal that will be in effect upon completion of the Merger. This description is qualified by reference to Pivotal’s charter documents as will be in effect upon consummation of the Merger, copies of which are attached to this proxy statement/prospectus and are incorporated in this proxy statement/prospectus by reference.

General

After the Merger, Pivotal’s charter will provide for 200,000,000 authorized shares of a single class of common stock and 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock.

Common Stock

The holders of common stock will be entitled to one vote for each share held of record on all matters to be voted on by stockholders.

There is no cumulative voting with respect to the election of directors, with the result that the holders of more than 50% of the shares of common stock voted for the election of directors can elect all of the directors.

Holders of common stock will not have any conversion, preemptive or other subscription rights and there will be no sinking fund or redemption provisions applicable to the common stock.

Preferred Stock

Pivotal’s certificate of incorporation, as amended, will authorize the issuance of 1,000,000 shares of blank check preferred stock with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by Pivotal’s board of directors. Pivotal’s board of directors will be empowered, without stockholder approval, to issue the preferred stock with dividend, liquidation, conversion, voting or other rights which could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of common stock. In addition, the preferred stock could be utilized as a method of discouraging, delaying or preventing a change in control of Pivotal.

Warrants

Each outstanding warrant of Pivotal will enable the holder to purchase one share of common stock at a price of $11.50 per share, beginning 30 days from the completion of the Business Combination, subject to adjustment as discussed below. The warrants will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, five years after the completion of the Business Combination or earlier upon redemption or liquidation.

Pivotal may call the warrants for redemption (excluding the private warrants), in whole and not in part, at a price of $0.01 per warrant,

 

   

at any time while the warrants are exercisable;

 

   

upon not less than 30 days’ prior written notice of redemption to each warrant holder;

 

   

if, and only if, the reported last sale price of the Pivotal common stock equals or exceeds $18.00 per share, for any 20 trading days within a 30-day trading period ending on the third business day prior to the notice of redemption to warrant holders; and

 

   

if, and only if, there is a current registration statement in effect with respect to the shares of common stock underlying such warrants commencing five business days prior to the 30-day trading period and continuing each day thereafter until the date of redemption.

 

168


Table of Contents

The right to exercise will be forfeited unless the warrants are exercised prior to the date specified in the notice of redemption. On and after the redemption date, a record holder of a warrant will have no further rights except to receive the redemption price for such holder’s warrant upon surrender of such warrant.

If Pivotal calls the warrants for redemption as described above, its management will have the option to require all holders that wish to exercise warrants to do so on a “cashless basis.” In such event, each holder would pay the exercise price by surrendering the warrants for that number of shares of common stock equal to the quotient obtained by dividing (x) the product of the number of shares of Pivotal common stock underlying the warrants, multiplied by the difference between the exercise price of the warrants and the “fair market value” (defined below) by (y) the fair market value. In this case, the “fair market value” shall mean the average reported last sale price of the shares of Pivotal common stock for the 10 trading days ending on the third trading day prior to the date on which the notice of redemption is sent to the holders of warrants. Whether Pivotal will exercise its option to require all holders to exercise their warrants on a “cashless basis” will depend on a variety of factors including the price of shares of Pivotal common stock at the time the warrants are called for redemption, Pivotal’s cash needs at such time and concerns regarding dilutive stock issuances.

The exercise price and number of shares of common stock issuable on exercise of the warrants may be adjusted in certain circumstances including in the event of a share dividend, extraordinary dividend or Pivotal’s recapitalization, reorganization, merger or consolidation. However, the warrants will not be adjusted for issuances of shares of common stock at a price below their respective exercise prices.

The warrants may be exercised upon surrender of the warrant certificate on or prior to the expiration date at the offices of the warrant agent, with the exercise form on the reverse side of the warrant certificate completed and executed as indicated, accompanied by full payment of the exercise price, by certified or official bank check payable to us, for the number of warrants being exercised. The warrant holders do not have the rights or privileges of holders of shares of Pivotal common stock or any voting rights unless and until they exercise their warrants and receive shares of common stock. After the issuance of shares of common stock upon exercise of the warrants, each holder will be entitled to one vote for each share of common stock held of record on all matters to be voted on by stockholders.

Warrant holders may elect to be subject to a restriction on the exercise of their warrants such that an electing warrant holder would not be able to exercise their warrants to the extent that, after giving effect to such exercise, such holder would beneficially own in excess of 4.9% or 9.8% (as specified by the holder) of the shares of Pivotal common stock outstanding immediately after giving effect to such exercise.

If the number of outstanding shares of common stock is increased by a share dividend payable in shares of common stock, or by a split-up of shares of common stock or other similar event, then, on the effective date of such share dividend, split-up or similar event, the number of shares of common stock issuable on exercise of each warrant will be increased in proportion to such increase in the outstanding common stock. A rights offering to holders of common stock entitling holders to purchase shares of common stock at a price less than the fair market value will be deemed a stock dividend of a number of shares of common stock equal to the product of (i) the number of shares of common stock actually sold in such rights offering (or issuable under any other equity securities sold in such rights offering that are convertible into or exercisable for common stock) and (ii) one (1) minus the quotient of (x) the price per share of common stock paid in such rights offering divided by (y) the fair market value. For these purposes (i) if the rights offering is for securities convertible into or exercisable for common stock, in determining the price payable for common stock, there will be taken into account any consideration received for such rights, as well as any additional amount payable upon exercise or conversion and (ii) fair market value means the volume weighted average price of common stock as reported during the ten (10) trading day period ending on the trading day prior to the first date on which the shares of common stock trade on the applicable exchange or in the applicable market, regular way, without the right to receive such rights.

 

169


Table of Contents

In addition, if Pivotal, at any time while the warrants are outstanding and unexpired, pay a dividend or make a distribution in cash, securities or other assets to the holders of common stock on account of such common stock (or other securities into which the warrants are convertible), other than (a) as described above, (b) certain ordinary cash dividends, which are dividends of $0.50 or less in any fiscal year (subject to adjustments), (c) to satisfy the conversion rights of the holders of common stock in connection with a proposed initial business combination or (d) in connection with the redemption of Pivotal’s public shares upon Pivotal’s failure to complete the initial business combination, then the warrant exercise price will be decreased, effective immediately after the effective date of such event, by the amount of cash and/or the fair market value of any securities or other assets paid on each share of common stock in respect of such event.

If the number of outstanding shares of common stock is decreased by a consolidation, combination, reverse stock split or reclassification of common stock or other similar event, then, on the effective date of such consolidation, combination, reverse stock split, reclassification or similar event, the number of shares of common stock issuable on exercise of each warrant will be decreased in proportion to such decrease in outstanding shares of common stock. Pivotal will not be required to make adjustments to the exercise price for any other events including the issuance of additional shares of common stock other than dividends paid in common stock as described above.

Whenever the number of shares of common stock purchasable upon the exercise of the warrants is adjusted, as described above, the warrant exercise price will be adjusted by multiplying the warrant exercise price immediately prior to such adjustment by a fraction (x) the numerator of which will be the number of shares of common stock purchasable upon the exercise of the warrants immediately prior to such adjustment and (y) the denominator of which will be the number of shares of common stock so purchasable immediately thereafter.

In the case of any reclassification or reorganization of the outstanding common stock (other than those described above or that solely affects the par value of such common stock), or in the case of any merger or consolidation of Pivotal with or into another corporation (other than a consolidation or merger in which we are the continuing corporation and that does not result in any reclassification or reorganization of Pivotal’s outstanding common stock), or in the case of any sale or conveyance to another corporation or entity of the assets or other property of Pivotal as an entirety or substantially as an entirety in connection with which Pivotal is dissolved, the holders of the warrants will thereafter have the right to purchase and receive, upon the basis and upon the terms and conditions specified in the warrants and in lieu of the common stock immediately theretofore purchasable and receivable upon the exercise of the rights represented thereby, the kind and amount of common stock or other securities or property (including cash) receivable upon such reclassification, reorganization, merger or consolidation, or upon a dissolution following any such sale or transfer, that the holder of the warrants would have received if such holder had exercised their warrants immediately prior to such event. If less than 70% of the consideration receivable by the holders of common stock in such a transaction is payable in the form of common stock in the successor entity that is listed for trading on a national securities exchange or is quoted in an established over-the-counter market, or is to be so listed for trading or quoted immediately following such event, and if the registered holder of the warrant properly exercises the warrant within thirty days following public disclosure of such transaction, the warrant exercise price will be reduced as specified in the warrant agreement based on the Black-Scholes value (as defined in the warrant agreement) of the warrant. The purpose of such exercise price reduction is to provide additional value to holders of the warrants when an extraordinary transaction occurs during the exercise period of the warrants pursuant to which the holders of the warrants otherwise do not receive the full potential value of the warrants in order to determine and realize the option value component of the warrant. This formula is to compensate the warrantholder for the loss of the option value portion of the warrant due to the requirement that the warrantholder exercise the warrant within 30 days of the event. The Black-Scholes model is an accepted pricing model for estimating fair market value where no quoted market price for an instrument is available.

No fractional shares of common stock will be issued upon exercise of the warrants. If, upon exercise of the warrants, a holder would be entitled to receive a fractional interest in a share of common stock, Pivotal will, upon exercise, follow the requirements of the DGCL.

 

170


Table of Contents

Certain Anti-Takeover Provisions of Delaware Law and Pivotal’s Proposed Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation

Upon consummation of the Business Combination and assuming approval of the Charter Proposals, Pivotal will have certain anti-takeover provisions in place as follows:

Staggered board of directors

Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that Pivotal’s board of directors be classified into three classes of directors of approximately equal size. As a result, in most circumstances, a person can gain control of Pivotal’s board of directors only by successfully engaging in a proxy contest at two or more annual or special meetings. Furthermore, because the board of directors will be classified, directors may be removed only with cause by a majority of Pivotal’s outstanding shares.

Special meeting of stockholders

Pivotal’s bylaws will provide that special meetings of stockholders may be called only by a majority vote of Pivotal’s board of directors.

Advance notice requirements for stockholder proposals and director nominations

Pivotal’s bylaws will provide that stockholders seeking to bring business before Pivotal’s special meeting of stockholders, or to nominate candidates for election as directors at Pivotal’s special meeting of stockholders, must provide timely notice of their intent in writing. To be timely, a stockholder’s notice will need to be received by the company secretary at Pivotal’s principal executive offices not later than the close of business on the 90th day nor earlier than the open of business on the 120th day prior to the anniversary date of the immediately preceding special meeting of stockholders. Pursuant to Rule 14a-8 of the Exchange Act, proposals seeking inclusion in Pivotal’s annual proxy statement must comply with the notice periods contained therein. Pivotal’s bylaws also specify certain requirements as to the form and content of a stockholders’ meeting. These provisions may preclude Pivotal stockholders from bringing matters before the special meeting of stockholders or from making nominations for directors at Pivotal’s special meeting of stockholders.

Authorized but unissued shares

Pivotal’s authorized but unissued common stock and preferred stock will be available for future issuances without stockholder approval and could be utilized for a variety of corporate purposes, including future offerings to raise additional capital, acquisitions and employee benefit plans. The existence of authorized but unissued and unreserved common stock and preferred stock could render more difficult or discourage an attempt to obtain control of Pivotal by means of a proxy contest, tender offer, merger or otherwise.

Exclusive forum selection

Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation will require, to the fullest extent permitted by law, that derivative actions brought in Pivotal’s name, actions against directors, officers and employees for breach of fiduciary duty and other similar actions may be brought only in the Court of Chancery in the State of Delaware and, if brought outside of Delaware, the stockholder bringing the suit will be deemed to have consented to service of process on such stockholder’s counsel. This exclusive forum provision will apply to state and federal law claims brought by stockholders (including claims pursuant to the Securities Act and the Exchange Act), although stockholders will not be deemed to have waived Pivotal’s compliance with the federal securities laws and the rules and regulations thereunder. The enforceability of similar choice of forum provisions in other companies’ organizational documents has been challenged in legal proceedings, and it is possible that, in connection with claims arising under federal securities laws, a court could find the choice of forum provisions

 

171


Table of Contents

contained in Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation to be inapplicable or unenforceable. If that were the case, because stockholders will not be deemed to have waived Pivotal’s compliance with the federal securities laws and the rules and regulations thereunder, it would allow stockholders to bring claims for breach of these provisions in any appropriate forum. Although Pivotal believes this provision benefits the company by providing increased consistency in the application of Delaware law in the types of lawsuits to which it applies, the provision may have the effect of discouraging lawsuits against Pivotal’s directors and officers.

Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law

Pivotal will not be subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the DGCL regulating corporate takeovers. This statute prevents certain Delaware corporations, under certain circumstances, from engaging in a “business combination” with:

 

   

a stockholder who owns 15% or more of Pivotal’s outstanding voting stock (otherwise known as an “ interested stockholder ”);

 

   

an affiliate of an interested stockholder; or

 

   

an associate of an interested stockholder, for three years following the date that the stockholder became an interested stockholder.

A “business combination” includes a merger or sale of more than 10% of Pivotal’s assets. However, the above provisions of Section 203 will not apply to Pivotal.

Limitation on Liability and Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Pivotal’s second amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that directors and officers will be indemnified by us to the fullest extent authorized by Delaware law as it now exists or may in the future be amended.

Pivotal’s bylaws will also permit Pivotal to secure insurance on behalf of any officer, director or employee for any liability arising out of his or her actions, regardless of whether Delaware law would permit indemnification. Upon consummation of the Merger, Pivotal will have purchased a policy of directors’ and officers’ liability insurance that insures Pivotal’s directors and officers against the cost of defense, settlement or payment of a judgment in some circumstances and insures Pivotal against its obligations to indemnify the directors and officers.

These provisions may discourage stockholders from bringing a lawsuit against Pivotal’s directors for breach of their fiduciary duty. These provisions also may have the effect of reducing the likelihood of derivative litigation against directors and officers, even though such an action, if successful, might otherwise benefit us and Pivotal’s stockholders. Furthermore, a stockholder’s investment may be adversely affected to the extent Pivotal pays the costs of settlement and damage awards against directors and officers pursuant to these indemnification provisions. We believe that these provisions, the insurance and the indemnity agreements are necessary to attract and retain talented and experienced directors and officers.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to Pivotal’s directors, officers and controlling persons pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, we have been advised that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.

 

172


Table of Contents

INFORMATION ON PIVOTAL SECURITIES AND DIVIDENDS

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Market Price of Units, Common stock and Warrants

Pivotal’s units, warrants and Class A common stock are traded on the NYSE under the symbols PVT.U, PVT WS and PVT, respectively. The units commenced public trading on February 4, 2019, and the warrants and Class A common stock commenced separate trading on March 25, 2019.

Holders

As of                 , 2019, there was one holder of record of units, one holder of record of Pivotal’s Class A common stock, seven holders of record of Pivotal’s Class B common stock, and six holders of record of warrants. Management believes Pivotal has in excess of                  beneficial holders of its Class A common stock and warrants.

Company

Market Price of Common Stock

Historical market price information regarding the Company is not provided because there is no public market for its securities.

Holders

As of                 , 2019, there were                  holders of record of the Company’s common stock.

Dividends

Pivotal has not paid any cash dividends on shares of common stock to date and does not intend to pay cash dividends prior to the completion of a business combination. The payment of any dividends subsequent to the Business Combination will be within the discretion of Pivotal’s then board of directors. The payment of cash dividends in the future will be contingent upon Pivotal’s revenues and earnings, if any, capital requirements, and general financial condition subsequent to completion of the Business Combination. It is the present intention of Pivotal’s board of directors to retain all earnings, if any, for use in business operations and, accordingly, the board does not anticipate declaring any dividends in the foreseeable future.

Pivotal’s Transfer Agent and Warrant Agent

The transfer agent for Pivotal’s shares of common stock and warrant agent for its warrants upon consummation of the Merger will be Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company, 1 State Street, 30 th  Floor, New York, New York 10004.

APPRAISAL RIGHTS

Neither Pivotal stockholders, unitholders, nor warrant holders have appraisal rights under Delaware law in connection with the Merger.

STOCKHOLDER PROPOSALS

The Pivotal 2020 annual meeting of stockholders will be held on or about                 , 2020 unless the date is changed by the board of directors. If you are a stockholder of Pivotal and you want to include a proposal in the proxy

 

173


Table of Contents

statement for the 2020 annual meeting, you need to provide it to Pivotal by no later than                 . You should direct any proposals to Pivotal’s secretary at its principal office which will be located at 8201 Greensboro Drive, Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102. If you are a stockholder of Pivotal and you want to present a matter of business to be considered at the 2020 annual meeting, under Pivotal’s bylaws you must give timely notice of the matter, in writing, to Pivotal’s secretary. To be timely, the notice has to be given no later than                 .

OTHER STOCKHOLDER COMMUNICATIONS

Stockholders and interested parties may communicate with Pivotal’s board of directors, any committee chairperson or the non-management directors as a group by writing to the board or committee chairperson in care of Pivotal Acquisition Corp., c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174. Following the Business Combination, such communications should be sent in care of KLDiscovery Inc., 8201 Greensboro Drive, Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102. Each communication will be forwarded, depending on the subject matter, to the board of directors, the appropriate committee chairperson or all non-management directors.

EXPERTS

The consolidated financial statements of LD Topco, Inc. at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2018, included in the Proxy Statement of Pivotal Acquisition Corp., which is referred to and made a part of this Prospectus and Registration Statement, have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

The financial statements of Pivotal for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018 appearing in this proxy statement/prospectus have been audited by Marcum LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere in this proxy statement/prospectus, and are included in reliance on such report given on the authority of such firm as an expert in accounting and auditing.

DELIVERY OF DOCUMENTS TO STOCKHOLDERS

Pursuant to the rules of the SEC, Pivotal and services that it employs to deliver communications to its stockholders are permitted to deliver to two or more stockholders sharing the same address a single copy of each of Pivotal’s annual report to stockholders and Pivotal’s proxy statement. Upon written or oral request, Pivotal will deliver a separate copy of the annual report to stockholder and/or proxy statement to any stockholder at a shared address to which a single copy of each document was delivered and who wishes to receive separate copies of such documents. Stockholders receiving multiple copies of such documents may likewise request that Pivotal deliver single copies of such documents in the future. Stockholders receiving multiple copies of such documents may request that Pivotal deliver single copies of such documents in the future. Stockholders may notify Pivotal of their requests by calling or writing Pivotal at its principal executive offices, c/o Graubard Miller, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor, New York, NY 10174 or (212) 818-8800. Following the Business Combination, such requests should be made by calling or writing KLDiscovery Inc. at 8201 Greensboro Drive, Suite 300, McLean, VA 22102 or (703) 288-3380.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

Pivotal has filed this proxy statement/prospectus as part of a registration statement on Form S-4 with the SEC under the Securities Act. The registration statement contains exhibits and other information that are not contained

 

174


Table of Contents

in this proxy statement/prospectus. The descriptions in this proxy statement/prospectus of the provisions of documents filed as exhibits to the registration statement are only summaries of those documents’ material terms. You may read copies of such documents, along with copies of reports, proxy statements and other information filed by Pivotal with the SEC at the SEC’s website: http://www.sec.gov.

Information and statements contained in this proxy statement/prospectus or any annex to this proxy statement/prospectus are qualified in all respects by reference to the copy of the relevant contract or other annex filed as an exhibit to this proxy statement/prospectus.

All information contained in this document relating to Pivotal has been supplied by Pivotal, and all such information relating to the Company has been supplied by the Company. Information provided by one another does not constitute any representation, estimate or projection of the other.

If you would like additional copies of this document or if you have questions about the Business Combination, you should contact via phone or in writing:

Mr. Jonathan J. Ledecky

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: Jonathan J. Ledecky

Tel. (212) 818-8800

 

175


Table of Contents

INDEX TO UNAUDITED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     Page  

Condensed Balance Sheets

     F-2  

Condensed Statement of Operations

     F-3  

Condensed Statement of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

     F-4  

Condensed Statement of Cash Flows

     F-5  

Notes to Condensed Financial Statements

     F-6  

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

INDEX TO AUDITED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     Page  

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

     F-10  

Balance sheet

     F-11  

Statement of operations

     F-12  

Statement of changes in stockholder’s equity

     F-13  

Statement of cash flows

     F-14  

Notes to financial statements

     F-15  

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Condensed Balance Sheets

 

     March 31,
2019
     December 31,
2018
 
     (unaudited)         

ASSETS

     

Current Assets

     

Cash

   $ 1,048,539      $ 19,168  

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     112,863        —    

Deferred offering costs

     —          133,174  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Current Assets

     1,161,402        152,342  

Marketable securities held in Trust Account

     230,806,004        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ 231,967,406      $ 152,342  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

     

Current liabilities

     

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

   $ 81,481      $ 969  

Income taxes payable

     118,901        —    

Accrued offering costs

     —          2,500  

Promissory note – related party

     —          125,000  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     200,382        128,469  

Deferred tax liability

     2,932        —    

Deferred underwriting fee

     8,050,000        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

     8,253,314        128,469  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commitments

     

Class A Common Stock, subject to possible redemption, 21,810,992 and no shares at redemption value as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, respectively

     218,714,087        —    

Stockholders’ Equity

     

Preferred Stock, $0.0001 par value; 1,000,000 authorized; none issued and outstanding

     —          —    

Class A Common Stock, $0.0001 par value; 75,000,000 shares authorized; 1,189,008 and 0 shares issued and outstanding (excluding 21,810,992 and no shares subject to possible redemption) as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, respectively

     119        —    

Class B Common Stock, $0.0001 par value; 10,000,000 shares authorized; 5,750,000 shares issued and outstanding as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

     575        575  

Additional paid-in capital

     4,543,641        24,425  

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

     455,670        (1,127
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Stockholders’ Equity

     5,000,005        23,873  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   $ 231,967,406      $ 152,342  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited condensed financial statements.

 

F-2


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Condensed Statement of Operations

Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

 

Operating costs

   $ 227,374  
  

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (227,374

Other income:

  

Interest income

     792,044  

Unrealized gain on marketable securities held in Trust Account

     13,960  
  

 

 

 

Other income, net

     806,004  
  

 

 

 

Income before provision for income taxes

     578,630  

Provision for income taxes

     (121,833
  

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 456,797  
  

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic and diluted (1)

     6,175,950  
  

 

 

 

Basic and diluted net loss per share (2)

   $ (0.02
  

 

 

 

 

(1)

Excludes an aggregate of up to 21,810,992 shares subject to possible redemption at March 31, 2019.

(2)

Net income (loss) per share – basic and diluted excludes interest income attributable to shares subject to possible redemption of $601,384 for the three months ended March 31, 2019.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited condensed financial statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Condensed Statement of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

 

    Class A
Common Stock
    Class B
Common Stock
    Additional
Paid
in Capital
    (Accumulated
Deficit)/
Retained

Earnings
    Total
Stockholders’

Equity
 
    Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount  

Balance – January 1, 2019

    —       $ —         5,750,000     $ 575     $ 24,425     $ (1,127   $ 23,873  

Sale of 23,000,000 Units, net of underwriting discount and offering expenses

    23,000,000       2,300       —         —         216,881,122       —         216,883,422  

Sale of 6,350,000 Private Placement Warrants

    —         —         —         —         6,350,000       —         6,350,000  

Common stock subject to possible redemption

    (21,810,992     (2,181     —         —         (218,711,906     —         (218,714,087

Net income

    —         —         —         —         —         456,797       456,797  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance – March 31, 2019 (unaudited)

    1,189,008     $ 119       5,750,000     $ 575     $ 4,543,641     $ 455,670     $ 5,000,005  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited condensed financial statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Condensed Statement of Cash Flows

Three Months Ended March 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

  

Net income

   $ 456,797  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities:

  

Interest earned on marketable securities held in Trust Account

     (792,044

Unrealized gain on marketable securities held in Trust Account

     (13,960

Deferred tax provision

     2,932  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

  

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     (112,863

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

     80,512  

Income taxes payable

     118,901  
  

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (259,725
  

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:

  

Investment of cash in Trust Account

     (230,000,000
  

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (230,000,000
  

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

  

Proceeds from sale of Units, net of underwriting discounts paid

     225,400,000  

Proceeds from sale of Private Placement Warrants

     6,350,000  

Repayment of promissory note – related party

     (125,000

Payment of offering costs

     (335,904
  

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     231,289,096  
  

 

 

 

Net Change in Cash

     1,029,371  

Cash – Beginning

     19,168  
  

 

 

 

Cash – Ending

   $ 1,048,539  
  

 

 

 

Non-cash Investing and Financing Activities:

  

Deferred underwriting fee payable

   $ 8,050,000  
  

 

 

 

Initial classification of common stock subject to possible redemption

   $ 218,257,180  
  

 

 

 

Change in value of common stock subject to possible redemption

   $ 456,907  
  

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited condensed financial statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

MARCH 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

Note 1 – Organization and Plan of Business Operations

Pivotal Acquisition Corp. (the “Company”) was incorporated in Delaware on August 2, 2018 as a blank check company whose objective is to acquire, through a merger, stock exchange, asset acquisition, stock purchase, recapitalization, reorganization or other similar business combination, one or more businesses or entities (a “Business Combination”).

All activity through March 31, 2019 relates to the Company’s formation, the Company’s initial public offering of 23,000,000 units (the “Offering”), the simultaneous sale of 6,350,000 warrants (the “Private Placement Warrants”) in a private placement to Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC (the “Sponsor”), an entity affiliated with the Company’s executive officers, and the Company’s search for a target business with which to complete a Business Combination.

Liquidity

The Company has principally financed its operations from inception using proceeds from the sale of its equity securities to its stockholders prior to the Offering and such amount of proceeds from the Offering that were placed in an account outside of the Trust Account for working capital purposes. As of March 31, 2019, the Company had $1,048,539 held outside of the Trust Account.

Note 2 – Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of presentation

The accompanying unaudited condensed financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) for interim financial information and in accordance with the instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 8 of Regulation S-X of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). Certain information or footnote disclosures normally included in financial statements prepared in accordance with GAAP have been condensed or omitted, pursuant to the rules and regulations of the SEC for interim financial reporting. Accordingly, they do not include all the information and footnotes necessary for a comprehensive presentation of financial position, results of operations, or cash flows. In the opinion of management, the accompanying unaudited condensed financial statements include all adjustments, consisting of a normal recurring nature, which are necessary for a fair presentation of the financial position, operating results and cash flows for the periods presented.

The accompanying unaudited condensed financial statements should be read in conjunction with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018 as filed with the SEC on April 1, 2019, which contains the audited financial statements and notes thereto. The financial information as of December 31, 2018 is derived from the audited financial statements presented in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018. The interim results for the three months ended March 31, 2019 are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the year ending December 31, 2019 or for any future interim periods.

Use of estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

MARCH 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

Note 2 – Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Making estimates requires management to exercise significant judgment. It is at least reasonably possible that the estimate of the effect of a condition, situation or set of circumstances that existed at the date of the financial statements, which management considered in formulating its estimate, could change in the near term due to one or more future confirming events. Accordingly, the actual results could differ significantly from the Company’s estimates.

Cash and marketable securities held in Trust Account

At March 31, 2019, the assets held in the Trust Account were substantially invested in U.S. Treasury Bills.

Net loss per share

Net loss per share is computed by dividing net loss by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. The Company applies the two-class method in calculating earnings per share. Shares of common stock subject to possible redemption at March 31, 2019, which are not currently redeemable and are not redeemable at fair value, have been excluded from the calculation of basic loss per share since such shares, if redeemed, only participate in their pro rata share of the Trust Account earnings. The Company has not considered the effect of warrants to purchase 29,350,000 shares of Class A common stock that were sold in the Offering and the private placement in the calculation of diluted loss per share, since the exercise of the warrants is contingent upon the occurrence of future events. As a result, diluted loss per share is the same as basic loss per share for the period presented.

Reconciliation of net loss per share

The Company’s net income is adjusted for the portion of income that is attributable to common stock subject to possible redemption, as these shares only participate in the earnings of the Trust Account and not the income or losses of the Company. Accordingly, basic and diluted loss per share is calculated as follows:

 

     Three Months
Ended

March 31,
2019
 

Net income

   $ 456,797  

Less: Income attributable to common stock subject to possible redemption

     (601,384
  

 

 

 

Adjusted net loss

   $ (144,587
  

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic and diluted

     6,175,950  
  

 

 

 

Basic and diluted net loss per share

   $ (0.02
  

 

 

 

Recent accounting pronouncements

Management does not believe that any recently issued, but not yet effective, accounting pronouncements, if currently adopted, would have a material effect on the Company’s condensed financial statements.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

MARCH 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

 

Note 3 – Public Offering

Pursuant to the Offering, the Company sold 23,000,000 Units at a price of $10.00 per Unit, including 3,000,000 Units subject to the underwriters’ over-allotment option. Each Unit consists of one share of Class A common stock and one redeemable warrant (“Public Warrant”). Each Public Warrant entitles the holder to purchase one share of Class A common stock at a price of $11.50 per share, subject to adjustment.

Note 4 – Commitments

The underwriters of the Offering are entitled to a deferred fee of three and one-half percent (3.5%) of the gross proceeds of the Offering, or $8,050,000. The deferred fee will be paid in cash upon the closing of a Business Combination from the amounts held in the Trust Account, subject to the terms of the underwriting agreement executed in connection with the Offering.

On February 4, 2019, a managing member of the Sponsor entered into a forward purchase contract with the Company to purchase, in a private placement to occur concurrently with the consummation of the Company’s initial Business Combination, up to $150,000,000 of the Company’s securities. The type and amount of securities to be purchased by the managing member of the Sponsor will be determined by the Company and the managing member of the Sponsor at the time the Company enters into the definitive agreement for the proposed Business Combination. This agreement would be independent of the percentage of stockholders electing to convert their public shares and may provide the Company with an increased minimum funding level for the initial Business Combination. The agreement is also conditioned on the Company’s board of directors, including an affiliate of the managing member of the Sponsor, having unanimously approved the proposed initial Business Combination. Accordingly, the managing member of the Sponsor may not agree to purchase any securities, in which case the Company may need to arrange alternate financing to complete the Business Combination.

The Company’s stockholders prior to the Offering (the “Initial Stockholders”), the holders of the Private Placement Warrants (and underlying shares of Class A common stock) and the holders of any securities issued upon conversion of working capital loans made by the Company’s Sponsor, officers, directors or their affiliates or pursuant to the forward purchase contract, are entitled to registration rights with respect to their securities pursuant to an agreement dated as of January 31, 2019. The holders of the majority of the securities are entitled to demand that the Company register these securities at any time commencing after expiration of the transfer restrictions. In addition, the holders have certain “piggy-back” registration rights on registration statements filed after the Company’s consummation of a Business Combination.

Note 5 – Stockholders’ Equity

Preferred Stock

The Company is authorized to issue 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock with a par value of $0.0001 per share with such designation, rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by the Company’s board of directors. As of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, there are no shares of preferred stock issued or outstanding.

Common Stock

The Company is authorized to issue 75,000,000 shares of Class A common stock and 10,000,000 shares of Class B common stock, both with a par value of $0.0001 per share. As of March 31, 2019 and December 31,

 

F-8


Table of Contents

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

MARCH 31, 2019

(Unaudited)

Note 5 – Stockholders’ Equity (continued)

 

2018, there were 1,189,008 and no shares of Class A common stock issued and outstanding, respectively, excluding 21,810,992 and no shares subject to possible redemption, respectively, and 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock issued and outstanding.

Note 6 – Fair Value Measurements

The Company follows the guidance in ASC 820 for its financial assets and liabilities that are re-measured and reported at fair value at each reporting period, and non-financial assets and liabilities that are re-measured and reported at fair value at least annually.

The fair value of the Company’s financial assets and liabilities reflects management’s estimate of amounts that the Company would have received in connection with the sale of the assets or paid in connection with the transfer of the liabilities in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. In connection with measuring the fair value of its assets and liabilities, the Company seeks to maximize the use of observable inputs (market data obtained from independent sources) and to minimize the use of unobservable inputs (internal assumptions about how market participants would price assets and liabilities). The following fair value hierarchy is used to classify assets and liabilities based on the observable inputs and unobservable inputs used in order to value the assets and liabilities:

 

Level 1:

  

Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. An active market for an asset or liability is a market in which transactions for the asset or liability occur with sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis.

Level 2:

  

Observable inputs other than Level 1 inputs. Examples of Level 2 inputs include quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities and quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in markets that are not active.

Level 3:

  

Unobservable inputs based on our assessment of the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability.

The following table presents information about the Company’s assets that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis at March 31, 2019, and indicates the fair value hierarchy of the valuation inputs the Company utilized to determine such fair value:

 

Description

   Level      March 31, 2019  

Assets:

     

Marketable securities held in Trust Account

     1      $ 230,806,004  

Note 7 – Subsequent Events

The Company evaluates subsequent events and transactions that occur after the balance sheet date up to the date that the condensed financial statements were issued. The Company did not identify any subsequent events that would have required adjustment or disclosure in the condensed financial statements.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Shareholders and Board of Directors of

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2018 and the related statements of operations, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018 and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audit we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.

Our audit included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audit also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audit provide s a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ Marcum LLP

Marcum LLP

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2018.

New York, NY

April 1, 2019

 

F-10


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Balance sheet

December 31, 2018

 

ASSETS

  

Current asset – cash

   $ 19,168  

Deferred offering costs

     133,174  
  

 

 

 

Total Assets

     152,342  
  

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

  

Current liabilities

  

Accrued expenses

   $ 969  

Accrued offering costs

     2,500  

Promissory note – related party

     125,000  
  

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     128,469  
  

 

 

 

Commitments

  

Stockholders’ Equity

  

Preferred stock, $0.0001 par value; 1,000,000 shares authorized; none issued and outstanding

     —    

Class A Common stock, $0.0001 par value; 75,000,000 shares authorized; none issued and outstanding

     —    

Class B Common stock, $0.0001 par value; 10,000,000 shares authorized; 5,750,000 shares issued and outstanding

     575  

Additional paid-in capital

     24,425  

Accumulated deficit

     (1,127
  

 

 

 

Total Stockholders’ Equity

     23,873  
  

 

 

 

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   $ 152,342  
  

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Statement of operations

For the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) to December 31, 2018

 

Formation and operating costs

   $ 1,127  
  

 

 

 

Net Loss

   $ (1,127
  

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic and diluted (1)

     5,000,000  
  

 

 

 

Basic and diluted net loss per common share

   $ (0.00
  

 

 

 

 

(1)

Excludes an aggregate of up to 750,000 shares subject to forfeiture if the underwriters’ option to purchase additional units was not exercised in full or in part (see Note 5).

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Statement of changes in stockholder’s equity

 

                Additional
paid-in
capital
    Accumulated
deficit
    Total
stockholder’s
equity
 
    Common stock(1)  
    Shares     Amount  

Balance – August 2, 2018 (inception)

    —       $ —       $ —       $ —       $ —    

Issuance of Class B common stock to Sponsor

    5,750,000       575       24,425       —         25,000  

Net loss

    —         —         —         (1,127     ( 1,127
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance – December 31, 2018

    5,750,000     $ 575     $ 24,425     $ (1,127   $ 23,873  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-13


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Statement of cash flows

For the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) to December 31, 2018

 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

  

Net loss

   $ (1,127

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

  

Accounts payable

     969  
  

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (158
  

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

  

Proceeds from issuance of common stock to Sponsor

     25,000  

Proceeds from promissory note – related party

     125,000  

Payment of offering costs

     (130,674
  

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     19,326  
  

 

 

 

Net Change in Cash

     19,168  

Cash – Beginning

  
  

 

 

 

Cash – Ending

   $ 19,168  
  

 

 

 

Non-cash investing and financing activities:

  

Deferred offering costs included in accrued offering costs

   $ 2,500  
  

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

 

F-14


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 1 – Description of Organization and Business Operations

Pivotal Acquisition Corp. (the “Company”) was incorporated in Delaware on August 2, 2018. The Company was formed for the purpose of effecting a merger, capital stock exchange, asset acquisition, stock purchase, reorganization or similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities (the “Business Combination”).

The Company is not limited to a particular industry or sector for purposes of consummating a Business Combination. The Company is an early stage and emerging growth company and, as such, the Company is subject to all of the risks associated with early stage and emerging growth companies.

As of December 31, 2018, the Company had not commenced any operations. All activity through December 31, 2018 relates to the Company’s formation and preparation for its initial public offering (“Initial Public Offering”), which is described below.

The registration statement for the Company’s Initial Public Offering became effective under Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“Securities Act”), on January 31, 2019. On February 4, 2019, the Company consummated the Initial Public Offering of 23,000,000 units (“Units” and, with respect to the shares of Class A common stock included in the Units offered, the “Public Shares”), including 3,000,000 Units subject to the underwriters’ over-allotment option, generating total gross proceeds of $230,000,000, which is described in Note 3.

Simultaneously with the closing of the Initial Public Offering, the Company consummated the sale of an aggregate of 6,350,000 warrants (the “Private Placement Warrants”) at a price of $1.00 per Private Placement Warrant in a private placement to Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC (the “Sponsor”), generating total gross proceeds of $6,350,000, which is described in Note 4.

Following the closing of the Initial Public Offering on February 4, 2019, an amount of $230,000,000 ($10.00 per Unit) from the net proceeds of the sale of the Units in the Initial Public Offering and the sale of the Private Placement Warrants was placed in a trust account (“Trust Account”) and will be invested in U.S. government securities, within the meaning set forth in Section 2(a)(16) of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “Investment Company Act”), with a maturity of 180 days or less or in any open-ended investment company that holds itself out as a money market fund selected by the Company meeting the conditions of Rule 2a-7 of the Investment Company Act, as determined by the Company, until the earlier of: (i) the consummation of a Business Combination or (ii) the distribution of the Trust Account, as described below.

Transaction costs amounted to $13,203,283 as of March 8, 2019, consisting of $4,600,000 of underwriting fees, $8,050,000 of deferred underwriting fee and $553,283 of other costs. In addition, as of March 22, 2019, $1,058,539 of IPO proceeds was held as cash outside of the Trust Account and is available for working capital purposes as of March 22, 2019.

The Company’s management has broad discretion with respect to the specific application of the net proceeds of the Initial Public Offering and the sale of the Private Placement Warrants, although substantially all of the net proceeds are intended to be applied generally toward consummating a Business Combination. The Company must complete an initial Business Combination having an aggregate fair market value of at least 80% of the assets held in the Trust Account (net of amounts previously disbursed to management for tax obligations and excluding the amount of deferred underwriting discounts held in the Trust Account) at the time of the agreement to enter into an initial Business Combination. The Company will only complete a Business Combination if the post-transaction company owns or acquires 50% or more of the outstanding voting securities of the target or otherwise acquires a controlling interest in the target sufficient for it not to be required to register as an investment company under the Investment Company Act. There is no assurance that the Company will be able to successfully effect a Business Combination.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 1 – Description of Organization and Business Operations (continued)

 

The Company will provide its holders of the outstanding Public Shares (the “public stockholders”) with the opportunity to redeem all or a portion of their Public Shares upon the completion of a Business Combination either (i) in connection with a stockholder meeting called to approve the Business Combination or (ii) by means of a tender offer. The decision as to whether the Company will seek stockholder approval of a Business Combination or conduct a tender offer will be made by the Company, solely in its discretion. The public stockholders will be entitled to redeem their Public Shares for a pro rata portion of the amount then in the Trust Account ($10.00 per Public Share, plus any pro rata interest earned on the funds held in the Trust Account and not previously released to the Company to pay its franchise and income tax obligations). There will be no redemption rights upon the completion of a Business Combination with respect to the Company’s warrants. The Company will proceed with a Business Combination if the Company has net tangible assets of at least $5,000,001 upon such consummation of a Business Combination and, if the Company seeks stockholder approval, a majority of the shares voted are voted in favor of the Business Combination. If a stockholder vote is not required by law and the Company does not decide to hold a stockholder vote for business or other legal reasons, the Company will, pursuant to its Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the “Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation”), conduct the redemptions pursuant to the tender offer rules of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and file tender offer documents with the SEC prior to completing a Business Combination. If, however, stockholder approval of the transaction is required by law, or the Company decides to obtain stockholder approval for business or legal reasons, the Company will offer to redeem shares in conjunction with a proxy solicitation pursuant to the proxy rules and not pursuant to the tender offer rules. If the Company seeks stockholder approval in connection with a Business Combination, the holders of the Founder Shares (as defined below in Note 5) have agreed to vote such Founder Shares and any Public Shares purchased after the Initial Public Offering in favor of approving a Business Combination. Additionally, each public stockholder may elect to redeem their Public Shares irrespective of whether they vote for or against the proposed transaction.

If the Company seeks stockholder approval of a Business Combination and it does not conduct redemptions pursuant to the tender offer rules, the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides that a public stockholder, together with any affiliate of such stockholder or any other person with whom such stockholder is acting in concert or as a “group” (as defined under Section 13 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)), will be restricted from redeeming its shares with respect to more than an aggregate of 20% or more of the Public Shares, without the prior consent of the Company.

The holders of the Founder Shares have agreed (a) to waive their redemption rights with respect to their Founder Shares and any Public Shares held by them in connection with the completion of a Business Combination and (b) not to propose an amendment to the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (i) that would affect the substance or timing of the Company’s obligation to redeem 100% of its Public Shares if the Company does not complete a Business Combination or (ii) with respect to any other provision relating to stockholders’ rights or pre-business combination activity, unless the Company provides the public stockholders with the opportunity to redeem their Public Shares in conjunction with any such amendment.

The Company has until August 4, 2020 to consummate a Business Combination (the “Combination Period”). If the Company is unable to complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period, the Company will (i) cease all operations except for the purpose of winding up, (ii) as promptly as reasonably possible but not more than ten business days thereafter, redeem the Public Shares, at a per-share price, payable in cash, equal to the aggregate amount then on deposit in the Trust Account including interest earned on the funds held in the Trust Account and not previously released to the Company to pay franchise and income taxes (less up to $100,000 of interest to pay dissolution expenses), divided by the number of then outstanding Public Shares, which redemption will completely extinguish public stockholders’ rights as stockholders (including the right to receive further

 

F-16


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 1 – Description of Organization and Business Operations (continued)

 

liquidating distributions, if any), subject to applicable law, and (iii) as promptly as reasonably possible following such redemption, subject to the approval of the Company’s remaining stockholders and the Company’s board of directors, dissolve and liquidate, subject in each case to the Company’s obligations under Delaware law to provide for claims of creditors and the requirements of other applicable law. There will be no redemption rights or liquidating distributions with respect to the Company’s warrants, which will expire worthless if the Company fails to complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period.

The holders of the Founder Shares have agreed to waive their right to any distribution from the Trust Account with respect to the Founder Shares if the Company fails to complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period. However, if the holders of the Founder Shares acquires Public Shares after the Initial Public Offering, such Public Shares will be entitled to liquidating distributions from the Trust Account if the Company fails to complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period. The underwriters have agreed to waive their rights to their deferred underwriting commission (see Note 6) held in the Trust Account in the event the Company does not complete a Business Combination within in the Combination Period and, in such event, such amounts will be included with the other funds held in the Trust Account that will be available to fund the redemption of the Public Shares. In the event of such distribution, it is possible that the per share value of the assets remaining available for distribution will be less than $10.00 per share.

In order to protect the amounts held in the Trust Account, the Sponsor has agreed to be liable to the Company if and to the extent any claims by a third party for services rendered or products sold to the Company, or a prospective target business with which the Company has discussed entering into a transaction agreement, reduce the amount of funds in the Trust Account to below (i) $10.00 per share or (ii) the actual amount per public share held in the Trust Account as of the date of the liquidation of the Trust Account, if less than $10.00 per share due to reductions in the value of the trust assets. This liability will not apply with respect to any claims by a third party (including target businesses) who executed a waiver of any right, title, interest or claim of any kind in or to any monies held in the Trust Account or to any claims under the Company’s indemnity of the underwriters of the Initial Public Offering against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. Moreover, in the event that an executed waiver is deemed to be unenforceable against a third party, the Sponsor will not be responsible to the extent of any liability for such third party claims. The Company will seek to reduce the possibility that the Sponsor will have to indemnify the Trust Account due to claims of creditors by endeavoring to have all vendors, service providers, prospective target businesses or other entities with which the Company does business, execute agreements with the Company waiving any right, title, interest or claim of any kind in or to monies held in the Trust Account.

Note 2 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of Presentation

The accompanying balance sheet is presented in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) and pursuant to the rules and regulations of the SEC.

Emerging Growth Company

The Company is an “emerging growth company,” as defined in Section 2(a) of the Securities Act, as modified by the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”), and it may take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not emerging growth companies including, but not limited to, not being required to comply with the independent registered public accounting firm attestation requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, reduced

 

F-17


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 2 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in its periodic reports and proxy statements, and exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved.

Further, section 102(b)(1) of the JOBS Act exempts emerging growth companies from being required to comply with new or revised financial accounting standards until private companies (that is, those that have not had a Securities Act registration statement declared effective or do not have a class of securities registered under the Exchange Act) are required to comply with the new or revised financial accounting standards. The JOBS Act provides that a company can elect to opt out of the extended transition period and comply with the requirements that apply to non-emerging growth companies but any such election to opt out is irrevocable. The Company has elected not to opt out of such extended transition period which means that when a standard is issued or revised and it has different application dates for public or private companies, the Company, as an emerging growth company, can adopt the new or revised standard at the time private companies adopt the new or revised standard. This may make comparison of the Company’s financial statements with another public company which is neither an emerging growth company nor an emerging growth company which has opted out of using the extended transition period difficult or impossible because of the potential differences in accounting standards used.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of balance sheet in conformity with GAAP requires the Company’s management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the balance sheet and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.

Making estimates requires management to exercise significant judgment. It is at least reasonably possible that the estimate of the effect of a condition, situation or set of circumstances that existed at the date of the balance sheet, which management considered in formulating its estimate, could change in the near term due to one or more future confirming events. Accordingly, the actual results could differ significantly from those estimates.

Cash and cash equivalents

The Company considers all short-term investments with an original maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents. The Company did not have any cash equivalents as of December 31, 2018.

Income Taxes

The Company follows the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes under ASC 740, “Income Taxes.” Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the estimated future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statements carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that included the enactment date. Valuation allowances are established, when necessary, to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.

ASC 740 prescribes a recognition threshold and a measurement attribute for the financial statement recognition and measurement of tax positions taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. For those benefits to be recognized, a tax position must be more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by taxing authorities.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 2 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

The Company recognizes accrued interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as income tax expense. There were no unrecognized tax benefits and no amounts accrued for interest and penalties as of February 4, 2019. The Company is currently not aware of any issues under review that could result in significant payments, accruals or material deviation from its position. The Company is subject to income tax examinations by major taxing authorities since inception.

The Company did not have any deferred tax assets or liabilities at December 31, 2018 and the provision for income taxes was deemed to be immaterial at December 31, 2018.

Concentration of Credit Risk

Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist of a cash account in a financial institution, which, at times, may exceed the Federal Depository Insurance Coverage of $250,000. At December 31, 2018, the Company has not experienced losses on this account and management believes the Company is not exposed to significant risks on such account.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The fair value of the Company’s assets and liabilities, which qualify as financial instruments under ASC 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures,” approximates the carrying amounts represented in the accompanying balance sheet, primarily due to their short-term nature.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Management does not believe that any other recently issued, but not yet effective, accounting pronouncements, if currently adopted, would have a material effect on the Company’s financial statements.

Note 3 – Public Offering

Pursuant to the Initial Public Offering, the Company sold 23,000,000 Units at a price of $10.00 per Unit, including 3,000,000 Units subject to the underwriters’ over-allotment option. Each Unit consists of one share of Class A common stock and one redeemable warrant (“Public Warrant”). Each Public Warrant entitles the holder to purchase one share of Class A common stock at a price of $11.50 per share, subject to adjustment (see Note 7).

Note 4 – Private Placement

Simultaneously with the closing of the Initial Public Offering, the Sponsor purchased an aggregate of 6,350,000 Private Placement Warrants at a price of $1.00 per Private Placement Warrant, for an aggregate purchase price of $6,350,000. Each Private Placement Warrant is identical to the Public Warrants except that they are non-redeemable and exercisable on a cashless basis as long as they are held by the Sponsor or its permitted transferees. The proceeds from the Private Placement Warrants were added to the proceeds from the Initial Public Offering to be held in the Trust Account. If the Company does not complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period, the proceeds from the sale of the Private Placement Warrants will be used to fund the redemption of the Public Shares (subject to the requirements of applicable law), and the Private Placement Warrants will expire worthless.

 

F-19


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

 

Note 5 – Related Party Transactions

Founder Shares

On August 2, 2018, the Sponsor purchased 5,750,000 shares (the “Founder Shares”) of the Company’s Class B common stock for an aggregate price of $25,000. The 5,750,000 Founder Shares included an aggregate of 750,000 shares subject to forfeiture to the extent that the underwriters’ over-allotment option was not exercised in full or in part. The Founder Shares will automatically convert into Class A common stock upon the consummation of a Business Combination on a one-for-one basis, subject to adjustments, as described in Note 7. The Sponsor subsequently transferred certain Founder Shares to the officers and directors of the Company. In connection with the full exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option at the closing of the Initial Public Offering, the 750,000 Founder Shares are no longer subject to forfeiture.

The holders of the Founder Shares have agreed, subject to certain limited exceptions, not to transfer, assign or sell any of the Founder Shares until the earlier to occur of: (A) one year after the completion of a Business Combination or (B) subsequent to a Business Combination, (x) if the last sale price of the Class A common stock equals or exceeds $12.00 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations and the like) for any 20 trading days within any 30-trading day period commencing at least 150 days after a Business Combination, or (y) the date on which the Company completes a liquidation, merger, capital stock exchange or other similar transaction that results in all of the Company’s stockholders having the right to exchange their shares of common stock for cash, securities or other property.

Related Party Loans

On August 24, 2018, an affiliate of the Sponsor loaned the Company an aggregate of $125,000 to cover expenses related to the Initial Public Offering pursuant to a promissory note (the “Promissory Note”). The Promissory Note was non-interest bearing and payable on the earlier of September 30, 2019, the date on which the Initial Public Offering was completed or the date on which the Company determines not to proceed with the Initial Public Offering. The Promissory Note was repaid upon the consummation of the Initial Public Offering on February 4, 2019.

In addition, in order to finance transaction costs in connection with a Business Combination, the Sponsor or an affiliate of the Sponsor, or certain of the Company’s officers and directors or any of their affiliates may, but are not obligated to, loan the Company funds as may be required (“Working Capital Loans”). If the Company completes a Business Combination, the Company would repay the Working Capital Loans out of the proceeds of the Trust Account released to the Company. Otherwise, the Working Capital Loans would be repaid only out of funds held outside the Trust Account. In the event that a Business Combination does not close, the Company may use a portion of proceeds held outside the Trust Account to repay the Working Capital Loans but no proceeds held in the Trust Account would be used to repay the Working Capital Loans. Except for the foregoing, the terms of such Working Capital Loans, if any, have not been determined and no written agreements exist with respect to such loans. The Working Capital Loans would either be repaid upon consummation of a Business Combination, without interest, or, at the lender’s discretion, up to $1,500,000 of such Working Capital Loans may be convertible into units of the post Business Combination entity at a price of $1.00 per warrant. The warrants would be identical to the Private Placement Warrants.

Note 6 – Commitments

Registration Rights

Pursuant to a registration rights agreement entered into on January 31, 2019, the holders of the Founder Shares (and any shares of Class A common stock issuable upon conversion of the Founder Shares), Private Placement

 

F-20


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 6 – Commitments (continued)

 

Warrants (and any shares of Class A common stock issuable upon the exercise of the Private Placement Warrants), and securities that may be issued upon conversion of Working Capital Loans or pursuant to the Forward Purchase Agreement (described below) are entitled to registration rights requiring the Company to register such securities for resale (in the case of the Founder Shares, only after conversion to Class A common stock). The holders of the majority of these securities are entitled to make up to three demands, excluding short form demands, that the Company register such securities. In addition, the holders have certain “piggy-back” registration rights with respect to registration statements filed subsequent to the completion of a Business Combination and rights to require the Company to register for resale such securities pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act. However, the registration rights agreement provides that the Company will not permit any registration statement filed under the Securities Act to become effective until termination of the applicable lock-up period. The Company will bear the expenses incurred in connection with the filing of any such registration statements.

Underwriting Agreement

The underwriters were paid a cash underwriting discount of $4,600,000 after completion of the Initial Public Offering. In addition, the underwriters are entitled to a deferred fee of $0.35 per Unit, or $8,050,000. The deferred fee will be forfeited by the underwriters solely in the event that the Company fails to complete a Business Combination, subject to the terms of the underwriting agreement.

Forward purchase agreement

On February 4, 2019, a managing member of the Sponsor entered into a forward purchase contract with the Company to purchase, in a private placement to occur concurrently with the consummation of the Company’s initial Business Combination, up to $150,000,000 of the Company’s securities. The type and amount of securities to be purchased by the managing member of the Sponsor will be determined by the Company and the managing member of the Sponsor at the time the Company enters into the definitive agreement for the proposed Business Combination. This agreement would be independent of the percentage of stockholders electing to convert their public shares and may provide the Company with an increased minimum funding level for the initial Business Combination. The agreement is also conditioned on the Company’s board of directors, including an affiliate of the managing member of the Sponsor, having unanimously approved the proposed initial Business Combination. Accordingly, the managing member of the Sponsor may not agree to purchase any securities, in which case the Company may need to arrange alternate financing to complete the Business Combination.

Note 7 – Stockholder’s Equity

Preferred Stock  – The Company is authorized to issue 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock with a par value of $0.0001 per share with such designations, voting and other rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by the Company’s board of directors. At December 31, 2018, there were no shares of preferred stock issued or outstanding.

Common Stock

Class  A Common Stock  – The Company is authorized to issue 75,000,000 shares of Class A common stock with a par value of $0.0001 per share. Holders of Class A common stock are entitled to one vote for each share. At December 31, 2018, no shares of Class A common stock were issued or outstanding. Upon the Company’s IPO, 23,000,000 Units, each consisting of a share of Class A common stock and a redeemable warrant for Class A common stock, were issued.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 7 – Stockholder’s Equity (continued)

 

Class  B Common Stock  – The Company is authorized to issue 10,000,000 shares of Class B common stock with a par value of $0.0001 per share. Holders of Class B common stock are entitled to one vote for each share. At December 31, 2018, there were 5,750,000 shares of Class B common stock issued and outstanding.

Holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock will vote together as a single class on all other matters submitted to a vote of stockholders except as required by law.

The shares of Class B common stock will automatically convert into shares of Class A common stock at the time of a Business Combination on a one-for-one basis, subject to adjustment. In the case that additional shares of Class A common stock, or equity-linked securities, are issued or deemed issued in excess of the amounts offered in the Initial Public Offering and related to the closing of a Business Combination, the ratio at which shares of Class B common stock shall convert into shares of Class A common stock will be adjusted (unless the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Class B common stock agree to waive such adjustment with respect to any such issuance or deemed issuance) so that the number of shares of Class A common stock issuable upon conversion of all shares of Class B common stock will equal, in the aggregate, on an as-converted basis, 20% of the sum of the total number of all shares of common stock outstanding upon the completion of the Initial Public Offering (not including the shares of Class A common stock underlying the private placement units) plus all shares of Class A common stock and equity-linked securities issued or deemed issued in connection with a Business Combination (excluding any shares or equity-linked securities issued, or to be issued, to any seller in a Business Combination, any private placement-equivalent securities issued, or to be issued, to any seller in a Business Combination, any private placement equivalent securities issued to the Sponsor or its affiliates upon conversion of loans made to the Company). Holders of Founder Shares may also elect to convert their shares of Class B common stock into an equal number of shares of Class A common stock, subject to adjustment as provided above, at any time.

Warrants  – The Public Warrants will become exercisable on the later of (a) 30 days after the completion of a Business Combination or (b) 12 months from the closing of the Initial Public Offering; provided in each case that the Company has an effective registration statement under the Securities Act covering the shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the Public Warrants and a current prospectus relating to them is available. The Company has agreed that as soon as practicable, but in no event later than 15 business days after the closing of a Business

Combination, the Company will use its best efforts to file with the SEC a registration statement for the registration, under the Securities Act, of the shares of Class A common stock issuable upon exercise of the Public Warrants. The Company will use its best efforts to cause the same to become effective and to maintain a current prospectus relating to those shares of Class A common stock until the warrants expire or are redeemed, as specified in the warrant agreement. If a registration statement covering the shares of Class A common stock issuable upon exercise of the warrants is not effective by the 60 th business day after the closing of a Business Combination, warrantholders may, until such time as there is an effective registration statement and during any period when the Company will have failed to maintain an effective registration statement, exercise warrants on a “cashless basis” in accordance with Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities Act or another exemption. The Public Warrants will expire five years after the completion of a Business Combination or earlier upon redemption or liquidation.

Once the warrants become exercisable, the Company may redeem the Public Warrants:

 

   

in whole and not in part;

 

   

at a price of $0.01 per warrant;

 

   

upon not less than 30 days’ prior written notice of redemption; and

 

F-22


Table of Contents

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

Notes to financial statements

Note 7 – Stockholder’s Equity (continued)

 

   

if, and only if, the reported last sale price of the Company’s Class A common stock equals or exceeds $18.00 per share for any 20 trading days within a 30-trading day period ending three business days before the Company sends the notice of redemption to the warrantholders.

 

   

If, and only if, there is a current registration statement in effect with respect to the shares of Class A common stock underlying such warrants.

If the Company calls the Public Warrants for redemption, management will have the option to require all holders that wish to exercise the Public Warrants to do so on a “cashless basis,” as described in the warrant agreement. The exercise price and number of shares of Class A common stock issuable upon exercise of the warrants may be adjusted in certain circumstances including in the event of a stock dividend, or recapitalization, reorganization, merger or consolidation. However, the warrants will not be adjusted for issuance of Class A common stock at a price below its exercise price. Additionally, in no event will the Company be required to net cash settle the warrants. If the Company is unable to complete a Business Combination within the Combination Period and the Company liquidates the funds held in the Trust Account, holders of warrants will not receive any of such funds with respect to their warrants, nor will they receive any distribution from the Company’s assets held outside of the Trust Account with the respect to such warrants. Accordingly, the warrants may expire worthless.

The Private Placement Warrants will be identical to the Public Warrants underlying the Units sold in the Initial Offering, except that the Private Placement Warrants and the Class A common stock issuable upon the exercise of the Private Placement Warrants will not be transferable, assignable or salable until 30 days after the completion of a Business Combination, subject to certain limited exceptions. Additionally, the Private Placement Warrants will be exercisable on a cashless basis and be non-redeemable so long as they are held by the initial purchasers or their permitted transferees. If the Private Placement Warrants are held by someone other than the initial purchasers or their permitted transferees, the Private Placement Warrants will be redeemable by the Company and exercisable by such holders on the same basis as the Public Warrants.

Note 8 – Subsequent Events

On February 4, 2019, the Company completed its Initial Public Offering, discussed in Note 1.

On February 5, 2019, the Company utilized $229,999,834 of cash in the Trust Account to purchase U.S. Government Treasury Bills, due March 5, 2019. Upon maturity of such Treasury Bills, on March 5, 2019, the Company utilized $230,399,020 of cash in the Trust Account to purchase U.S. Government Treasury Bills, due April 2, 2019.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:

LD TOPCO, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

     Page  

Consolidated Financial Statements

  

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of March  31, 2019 (Unaudited) and December 31, 2018

     F-25  

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 (Unaudited)

     F-26  

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 (Unaudited)

     F-27  

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the three months ended March  31, 2019 and 2018 (Unaudited)

     F-28  

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

     F-29  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-41  

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2018 and 2017

     F-42  

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

     F-43  

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

     F-44  

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December  31, 2018 and 2017

     F-45  

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-46  

 

F-24


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     March 31,
2019
    December 31,
2018
 
     (unaudited)        

Current assets

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 4,532     $ 23,439  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $5,487 and $5,565, respectively

     83,581       80,641  

Prepaid expenses

     19,283       9,825  

Other current assets

     277       310  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     107,673       114,215  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment

    

Computer software and hardware

     70,111       68,474  

Leasehold improvements

     25,544       25,389  

Furniture, fixtures and other equipment

     4,295       4,239  

Accumulated depreciation

     (55,001     (49,761
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

     44,949       48,341  

Intangible assets, net

     145,417       151,918  

Goodwill

     394,773       394,167  

Other assets

     1,795       1,739  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 694,607     $ 710,380  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current liabilities

    

Current portion of long-term debt, net

   $ 18,268     $ 12,355  

Accounts payable and accrued expense

     35,160       41,135  

Deferred revenue

     3,386       4,160  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     56,814       57,650  

Long-term debt, net

     410,021       413,064  

Deferred tax liabilities

     5,970       6,075  

Other liabilities

     4,617       4,635  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     477,422       481,424  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

     —         —    

Stockholders’ equity

    

Common stock

    

$0.01 par value, shares authorized – 5,000,000; shares issued and outstanding – 3,687,535 and 3,681,979 as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, respectively

     37       37  

Additional paid-in capital

     373,193       372,283  

Treasury stock

     (2,406     (2,406

Accumulated deficit

     (161,445     (147,954

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     7,806       6,996  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     217,185       228,956  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 694,607     $ 710,380  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss (Unaudited)

(in thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
    Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Revenues

   $ 75,026     $ 70,211  

Cost of revenues

     37,455       40,350  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     37,571       29,861  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    

General and administrative

     14,844       12,385  

Research and development

     1,432       1,819  

Sales and marketing

     12,703       14,383  

Depreciation and amortization

     9,825       10,873  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     38,804       39,460  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (1,233     (9,599

Other expenses

    

Other expense

     97       112  

Interest expense

     12,066       11,085  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (13,396     (20,796

Income tax provision (benefit)

     95       (2,759
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (13,491   $ (18,037
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

    

Foreign currency translation

     810       2,101  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     810       2,101  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

   $ (12,681   $ (15,936
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share – basic and diluted

   $ (3.66   $ (5.35
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding – basic and diluted

     3,683,461       3,372,319  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity (Unaudited)

(in thousands, except share amounts)

 

    Common Stock
Issued
    Additional
paid-in
capital
    Treasury
Stock
    Accumulated
deficit
    Accumulated
other
comprehensive
income
       
    Shares     Amount     Total  

Balance as of December 31, 2018

    3,681,979     $  37     $  372,283     $  (2,406   $  (147,954   $  6,996     $  228,956  

Issuance of common stock

    —         —         —         —         —         —         —    

Share based compensation

    5,556       —         910       —         —         —         910  

Foreign exchange translation

    —         —         —         —         —         810       810  

Net loss

    —         —         —         —         (13,491     —         (13,491
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of March 31, 2019

    3,687,535     $ 37     $ 373,193     $  (2,406   $  (161,445   $ 7,806     $ 217,185  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

    Common Stock
Issued
    Additional
paid-in
capital
    Treasury
Stock
    Stock
subscription
receivable
    Accumulated
deficit
    Accumulated
other
comprehensive
(loss) income
       
    Shares     Amount     Total  

Balance as of December 31, 2017

    3,268,718     $ 33     $ 330,931     $  (2,319   $  (1,350   $  (80,175   $  7,866     $  254,986  

Issuance of common stock

    151,274       1       15,127       —         —         —         —         15,128  

Share based compensation

    —         —         301       —         —         —         —         301  

Foreign exchange translation

    —         —         —         —         —         —         2,101       2,101  

Stock subscription receivable

    —         (1     —         —         1,350       —         —         1,349  

Repurchases of treasury stock

    (873     —         —         (87     —         —         —         (87

Adoption of new accounting principle

    —         —         40       —         —         (40     —         —    

Net loss

    —         —         —         —         —         (18,037     —         (18,037
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of March 31, 2018

    3,419,119     $ 33     $  346,399     $  (2,406   $ —       $  (98,252   $ 9,967     $ 255,741  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (Unaudited)

(in thousands)

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
    Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Operating activities

    

Net loss

   $  (13,491   $  (18,037

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in operating activities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     12,534       15,977  

Non-cash interest

     1,167       1,106  

Stock-based compensation

     910       301  

Provision for losses on accounts receivable

     633       618  

Deferred income taxes

     (106     (5,641

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable

     (3,348     (6,007

Prepaid expenses and other assets

     (9,170     (1,004

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

     (6,686     (9,040

Deferred revenue

     (783     (1,597
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (18,340     (23,324
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

    

Purchases of property and equipment

     (2,182     (1,816
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (2,182     (1,816
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

    

Revolving credit facility – draws

     11,000       6,000  

Revolving credit facility – repayments

     (5,000     (6,000

Payments for capital lease obligations

     (157     —    

Payments on long-term debt

     (4,250     (2,125

Issuance of common stock

     —         16,476  

Payment of contingent consideration

     —         (1,550

Treasury share repurchases

     —         (87
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     1,593       12,714  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of foreign exchange rates

     22       248  

Net decrease in cash

     (18,907     (12,178

Cash at beginning of period

     23,439       18,896  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash at end of period

   $ 4,532     $ 6,718  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental disclosure:

    

Cash paid for interest

   $ 11,022     $ 9,829  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds

   $ 317     $ (711
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Significant noncash investing and financing activities

    

Purchases of property and equipment in accounts payable and accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets

   $ 112     $ 201  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-28


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

NOTE 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies

Organization

LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation organized on November 20, 2015 (“LD Topco,” d/b/a KLDiscovery), together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) provide technology-based litigation support solutions and services including computer e-discovery, data hosting, and managed document review predominantly to top law firms, corporations and government agencies. The majority of the Company’s current business is derived from these services. The Company’s headquarters is located in McLean, Virginia and has 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. The Company is majority owned by private investment funds managed by The Carlyle Group (“Carlyle”).

Principles of consolidation

Our condensed consolidated financial statements are unaudited; however, in the opinion of management, they contain all of the adjustments (consisting of those of a normal recurring nature) considered necessary to present fairly the financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the periods presented in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (U.S. GAAP) applicable to interim periods. All intercompany accounts have been eliminated in consolidation. The unaudited consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in the prospectus.

Use of estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Although actual results could differ from those estimates, management does not believe that such differences would be material.

Significant estimates include, but are not limited to, the allowance for doubtful accounts, determining the fair values of assets acquired and liabilities assumed, the recoverability and useful lives of property and equipment, intangible assets, and other long-lived assets, the impairment of goodwill, the valuation and realization of deferred income taxes, the fair value of the Company’s common stock and stock option awards, and acquisition-related contingent consideration.

Segments, concentration of credit risk and major customers

The Company operates in one business segment, providing technology-based litigation support solutions and services.

Financial instruments, which potentially expose the Company to concentrations of credit risk, consist principally of cash and accounts receivable. The Company places its cash with a banking institution where the balances, at times, exceed federally insured limits. Management believes the risks associated with these deposits are limited.

With respect to accounts receivable, the Company performs ongoing evaluations of its customers, generally grants uncollateralized credit terms to its customers, and maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical experience and management’s expectations of future losses. As of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, the Company did not have a single customer that represents more than ten percent (10%) of its accounts receivable. For the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company did not have a single customer that represents more than ten percent (10%) or more of its consolidated revenues. The Company believes that the geographic and industry diversity of the Company’s customer base throughout the U.S. and internationally minimizes the risk of incurring material losses due to concentrations of credit risk.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

NOTE 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Foreign currency

Results of operations for the Company’s non-U.S. subsidiaries are translated from the designated functional currency to the reporting currency of the U.S. dollar. Revenues and expenses are translated at average exchange rates for each month, while assets and liabilities are translated at balance sheet date exchange rates. Resulting net translation adjustments are recorded as a component of stockholders’ equity in “Accumulated other comprehensive income.”

Transaction gains and losses arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on transactions denominated in a currency other than the local functional currency are included in “Other expense” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. Such transaction gains and losses may be realized or unrealized depending upon whether the transaction settled during the period or remains outstanding at the balance sheet date.

Business combinations

The Company recognizes all of the assets acquired, liabilities assumed, contractual contingencies, and contingent consideration at their fair value on the acquisition date. Acquisition-related costs are recognized separately from the acquisition and expensed as incurred. Restructuring costs incurred in periods subsequent to the acquisition date are expensed when incurred. Subsequent changes to the purchase price (i.e. working capital adjustments) or other fair value adjustments determined during the measurement period are recorded as an adjustment to goodwill, with the exception of contingent consideration, which is recognized in the statement of operations in the period it is modified. All subsequent changes to a valuation allowance or uncertain tax position that relate to the acquired company and existed at the acquisition date that occur both within the measurement period and as a result of facts and circumstances that existed at the acquisition date are recognized as an adjustment to goodwill. All other changes in valuation allowances are recognized as a reduction or increase to income tax expense or as a direct adjustment to additional paid-in capital as required.

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash

The Company considers all highly liquid financial instruments with an original maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents.

As of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, $0.1 million of cash was pledged as collateral with Bank of America for credit cards issued to Company employees.

Accounts receivable

Accounts receivable are recorded at original invoice amount less an estimate for doubtful receivables based on a review of outstanding amounts monthly. Management determines the allowance for doubtful accounts by regularly evaluating individual customer receivables and considering a customer’s financial condition and credit history. Accounts receivable are written off when deemed uncollectible. Recoveries of trade accounts receivable previously written off are recorded when received.

Computer software, property and equipment

Computer software, property and equipment are recorded at cost. Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method over the following estimated useful lives of the assets:

 

Computer software and hardware

   3 to 5 years

Leasehold improvements

   Shorter of lease term or useful life

Furniture, fixtures and other equipment

   3 to 5 years

 

F-30


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

NOTE 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Gains or losses on disposals are included in results of operations at amounts equal to the difference between the net book value of the disposed assets and the proceeds received upon disposal. Costs for replacements and betterments are capitalized, while the costs of maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred. Property under capital leases are depreciated using the straight-line method over the lease term.

Depreciation expense totaled $5.0 million and $4.9 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively, and includes amortization of assets recorded under capital leases.

Internal-use software development costs

As required by ASC Subtopic 350-40, Internal–Use Software (ASC 350-40), the Company capitalizes certain internal computer software costs incurred during the application development stage. The application development stage generally includes software design and configuration, coding, testing and installation activities. Training and maintenance costs are expensed as incurred, while upgrades and enhancements are capitalized if it is probable that such expenditure will result in additional functionality. Capitalized software costs are depreciated over the estimated useful life of the underlying project on a straight-line basis. The Company’s estimated useful life of capitalized software costs varies between three and five years, depending on management’s expectation of the economic life of various software. Capitalized software depreciation costs are recorded as a component of depreciation and amortization expense.

Capitalized software costs are reflected as part of the “Intangible assets, net” line in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets and totaled $8.3 million and $7.6 million, net of accumulated amortization, as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the total consideration paid over identified intangible and tangible assets of the Company and its acquisitions. The Company tests its goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level on an annual basis on October 1, and between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying value. These events or circumstances could include a significant change in the business climate, legal factors, operating performance indicators, competition, or sale or disposition of a significant portion of a reporting unit. As of the October 1 testing date the Company determined there is one entity-wide reporting unit.

Accordingly, the Company has not identified any indicators of impairment, nor have any impairment charges been recorded related to goodwill resulting from the annual impairment test.

Revenue recognition

The Company recognizes revenue when all the following criteria are met: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred, the fee is fixed and determinable and collectability is reasonably assured. Deferred revenue represents revenues collected but not earned as of the financial statement date. Any taxes assessed on revenues relating to services provided to the Company’s clients are recorded on a net basis.

The Company’s revenues are primarily derived from contracts to provide services each month including; collection and forensic services, processing, document review services and hosting fees based on the amount of data stored. The Company bills its customers monthly in arrears for services provided. For these contractual arrangements, the Company has identified each deliverable service element. Based on an evaluation of each element, the Company has determined that each element delivered has standalone value to its customers because the Company or other vendors sell such services separately from any other services/deliverables.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

NOTE 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Accordingly, each of the service elements in the Company’s multiple element case and document management arrangements qualify as a separate unit of accounting. The Company allocates revenue to the various units of accounting in its arrangements based on the fair value or best estimated selling price of each unit of accounting, which is generally consistent with the stated prices in the arrangements.

The Company enters into arrangements that can include various combinations of software, services, and hardware. Where elements are delivered over different periods of time, and when allowed under U.S. GAAP, revenue is allocated to the respective elements based on their relative selling prices at the inception of the arrangement, and revenue is recognized as each element is delivered. The Company uses a hierarchy to determine the fair value to be used for allocating revenue to elements: vendor-specific objective evidence of fair value (“VSOE”), third-party evidence and best estimate of selling price (“BESP”). For software elements, the Company follows the industry specific software guidance which only allows for the use of VSOE in establishing fair value. Generally, VSOE is the price charged when the deliverable is sold separately, or the price established by management for a product that is not yet sold if it is probable that the price will not change before introduction into the marketplace. In software arrangements where the Company does not have VSOE for all undelivered elements, the elements are combined and the arrangement consideration is recognized for the combined element, generally ratably over the maintenance period. BESPs are established as best estimates of what the selling prices would be if the deliverables were sold regularly on a stand-alone basis. The Company’s process for determining BESPs requires judgment and considers multiple factors that may vary over time depending upon the unique facts and circumstances related to each deliverable.

Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted

In connection with the proposed transaction with Pivotal (see Note 16), the Company will elect to be an emerging growth company, as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the JOBS Act and take advantage of the extended transition period of delaying the adoption of new or revised accounting standards until such time as those standards apply to private companies. This may make the comparison of the Company’s consolidated financial statements to other public companies not meaningful due to the differences in accounting standards being applied.

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) , which requires lessees to recognize on the balance sheet a right-of-use asset, representing their right to use the underlying asset for the lease term, and a lease liability for all leases with terms greater than 12 months. The guidance also requires qualitative and quantitative disclosures designed to assess the amount, timing and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases. The standard requires the use of a modified retrospective transition approach, which includes a number of optional practical expedients that entities may elect to apply. This standard is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2020 and the Company is currently evaluating the impact that ASU 2016-02 will have on its consolidated financial statements.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606) . Topic 606 supersedes nearly all existing revenue recognition guidance under GAAP. The core principle of Topic 606 is to recognize revenues when promised goods or services are transferred to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration that is expected to be received for those goods or services. Topic 606 defines a five-step process to achieve this core principle and, in doing so, it is possible more judgment and estimates may be required within the revenue recognition process than are required under existing GAAP, including identifying performance obligations in the contract, estimating the amount of variable consideration to include in the transaction price and allocating the transaction price to each separate performance obligation, among others.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

NOTE 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

The Company will adopt Topic 606 (as amended) in its annual Financial Statements for the year ended December 31, 2019. The Company is using a comprehensive approach to evaluate the impact of the new standard on our accounting policies, processes, and systems to identify potential differences that would result from applying the new requirements to our revenue contracts, including evaluation of performance obligations in the contract, estimating the amount of variable consideration to include in the transaction price, allocating the transaction price to each separate performance obligation, and accounting treatment of costs to obtain and fulfill contracts.

The Company has established a cross-functional implementation team and will utilize a bottom-up approach to analyze the impact of the standard on its arrangements by reviewing the current accounting policies and practices to identify potential differences that would result from applying the requirements of the new standard to its revenue contracts.

The Company has progressed with its project plan for adopting this standard, including gathering and evaluating the inventory of its revenue streams. The Company continues to evaluate the potential impact on its accounting policies, internal control processes including system readiness and the related disclosures that will be required under the new guidance.

The update may be applied using one of two methods: retrospective application to each prior reporting period presented, or retrospective application, with the cumulative effect of initially applying the update recognized at the date of initial application. The Company is currently evaluating the transition method that will be elected and the impact of the update on its consolidated financial statements and disclosures.

In October 2016, the FASB issued ASU “Accounting for Income Taxes: Intra-Entity Transfers of Assets Other than Inventory” (Topic 740). ASU 2016-16 requires companies to recognize the income tax effects of intercompany sales of assets other than inventory when the transfer occurs. This standard was effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2019 and the adoption did not have a material impact on its consolidated financial statements.

Note 2 – Fair value measurements

The Company accounts for recurring and non-recurring fair value measurements in accordance with ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements . ASC 820 defines fair value, establishes a fair value hierarchy for assets and liabilities measured at fair value, and requires expanded disclosures about fair value measurements. The ASC 820 hierarchy ranks the quality of reliability of inputs, or assumptions, used in the determination of fair value, and requires assets and liabilities carried at fair value to be classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

Level 1 – Fair value is determined by using unadjusted quoted prices that are available in active markets for identical assets and liabilities.

Level 2 – Fair value is determined by using inputs other than Level 1 quoted prices that are directly or indirectly observable. Inputs can include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets or quoted prices for identical assets and liabilities in inactive markets. Related inputs can also include those used in valuation or other pricing models, such as interest rates and yield curves that can be corroborated by observable market data.

Level 3 – Fair value is determined by inputs that are unobservable and not corroborated by market data. Use of these inputs involves significant and subjective judgments to be made by a reporting entity – e.g., determining an appropriate adjustment to a discount factor for illiquidity associated with a given security.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

Note 2 – Fair value measurements (continued)

 

The Company evaluates financial assets and liabilities subject to fair value measurements on a recurring basis to determine the appropriate level at which to classify them each reporting period. This determination requires significant judgments to be made by the Company.

The Company believes that the fair values of its current assets and current liabilities (cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, and other current liabilities) approximate their reported carrying amounts.

The Company estimates the fair value of contingent purchase consideration based on the present value of the consideration expected to be paid during the remainder of the earn-out period, based on management’s assessment of the acquired operations’ forecasted earnings. This fair value measure is based on significant inputs not observed in the market and thus represents a Level 3 measurement. As of December 31, 2018, all acquisition related contingent consideration was fully paid.

The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurements of the Company’s contingent purchase consideration include its measures of the future profitability and related cash flows of the acquired business or assets, impacted by appropriate discount rates. Significant increases (decreases) in any of these individual inputs would result in a significantly lower (higher) fair value measurement. Generally, a change in the assumptions used for the discount rates is indirectly proportional to the fair value of contingent purchase consideration and a change in the assumptions used for the future cash flows is directly proportional to the fair value of contingent purchase consideration. The Company, using additional information as it becomes available, reassesses the fair value of the contingent purchase consideration on an annual basis.

Any change in the fair value of contingent consideration liability results in a remeasurement gain or loss that is recorded as income or expense, respectively, and is included in “Change in fair value of contingent consideration” on the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. As of December 31, 2018, all acquisition related contingent consideration was fully paid.

 

Balance at December 31, 2017

     2,380  

Payment of contingent consideration

     (1,550
  

 

 

 

Balance at March 31, 2018

   $ 830  
  

 

 

 

Management estimates the carrying amount of the Company’s long-term debt approximates its fair value because the interest rates on these instruments are subject to changes in market interest rates or are consistent with prevailing interest rates.

Note 3 – Leasing arrangements

The Company leases office space and certain equipment under operating and capital lease agreements, expiring in various years through 2027. Certain leases contain annual rent escalation clauses.

Rent expense totaled $3.0 million and $2.2 million for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

 

F-34


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

Note 3 – Leasing arrangements (continued)

 

For years subsequent to March 31, 2019, future minimum payments for all operating and capital lease obligations that have initial non-cancelable lease terms exceeding one year, net of rental income from subleases are as follows (in thousands):

 

December 31

   Capital Leases      Operating Leases  

2019 (9 Months)

   $ 473      $ 7,991  

2020

     631        9,994  

2021

     631        7,117  

2022

     542        5,859  

2023

     69        5,444  

Thereafter

     —          9,936  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $  2,346      $  46,341  
     

 

 

 

Less interest on lease obligations

     (319   
  

 

 

    
     2,027     

Less current portion

     (473   
  

 

 

    

Non-current portion

   $ 1,554     
  

 

 

    

Note 4 – Long term debt

The table below summarizes the components of the Company’s long-term debt (in thousands):

 

    March 31, 2019     December 31, 2018  

First lien facility due 2022

  $  318,750     $  323,000  

Second lien facility due 2023

    125,000       125,000  

Revolver

    6,000       —    
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt

    449,750       448,000  

Less: unamortized original issue discount

    (12,398     (13,043

Less: unamortized debt issuance costs

    (9,063     (9,538
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt, net

    428,289       425,419  

Current portion of debt

    17,000       17,000  

Revolver

    6,000       —    

Less: current portion of unamortized original issue discount

    (2,728     (2,678

Less: current portion of unamortized debt issuance costs

    (2,004     (1,967
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current portion of debt, net

    18,268       12,355  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long term debt, net

  $ 410,021     $ 413,064  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

2016 Credit Agreement

On December 9, 2016, LD Topco entered into a Credit Agreement with a group of lenders to establish term loan facilities and a revolving line of credit for borrowings by LD Intermediate, Inc. and LD Lower Holdings, Inc. (the “Initial Term Loans”). The Initial Term Loan borrowings of $340.0 million (“First Lien Facility”) and $125.0 million (“Second Lien Facility”) mature on December 9, 2022 and December 9, 2023, respectively.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

Note 4 – Long term debt (Continued)

 

The First Lien Facility established a term loan principal payment schedule with payments due on the last day of each calendar quarter beginning on March 31, 2017 of $2.1 million. Quarterly principal payments increase to $4.3 million beginning on March 31, 2019 with a balloon payment of $259.3 million due at maturity. The interest rate for the First Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by the Company, or to the extent consented to by all appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 5.875% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate multiplied by the greatest of a) LIBOR, b) 0.00% per annum and c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. At March 31, 2019, the balance due was $318.8 million with an interest rate of 5.875% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.540%.

The Second Lien Facility requires a balloon payment of $125.0 million due at maturity. The interest rate for the Second Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by the Company, or to the extent consented to by all appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 10.0% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate multiplied by the greatest of a) LIBOR, b) 0.00% per annum and c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. At March 31, 2019, the balance due was $125.0 million with an interest rate of 10.00% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.5855%.

The First and Second Lien Facilities are secured by substantially all the Company’s assets and contain financial covenants. As of March 31, 2019, the Company was in compliance with all covenants.

The 2016 Credit Agreement includes a mandatory prepayment within ten days after delivery of the annual audited financial statements commencing with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016, in an amount equal to the Excess Cash Flow Percentage of Excess Cash Flow for such Fiscal Year, as defined in the agreement. There were no mandatory prepayments with respect to the three months ended March 31, 2019 or the year ended December 31, 2018.

Revolver

The 2016 Credit Agreement also provides for unfunded revolver commitment for borrowing up to $30.0 million, maturing December 9, 2021. Borrowings under the revolver commitment are limited by certain financial covenants of the Credit Agreement including the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio. The Company may draw up to $30.0 million, on a term loan basis, with an adjustable interest rate of 5.375%, 5.625%, or 5.875% based on the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio plus an amount equal to the LIBOR. As of March 31, 2019, there were $6.0 million outstanding under the revolving loan. No amounts were outstanding under the revolving loan as of December 31, 2018.

As of March 31, 2019, there was approximately $24.0 million available capacity for borrowing under the revolving loan commitment.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

 

Note 5 – Equity incentive plan

On March 29, 2016, the Company adopted the 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (as amended, the “2016 Plan”) under which eligible employees, officers, directors and consultants of the Company may be granted incentive or non-qualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, or other stock-based awards, including shares of common stock. The 2016 Plan expires in March 2026. As of March 31, 2019, 603,829 shares of Common Stock were reserved under the 2016 Plan. As of March 31, 2019, 119,493 shares of common stock remained available for issuance.

Stock option activity

The following table summarizes the Company’s stock option activity under the 2016 Plan:

 

Description

   Options
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Exercise Price
     Weighted Average
Remaining
Contractual Term
(Years)
     Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value (1)
 

Balance at December 31, 2018

     411,480      $  100        8.3      $  —    

Granted

     67,050        90        

Forfeited

     (13,585      100        

Expired

     (4,665         
  

 

 

          

Balance at March 31, 2019

     460,280      $ 99        8.1      $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Vested and expected to vest

     230,140      $ 99        8.1      $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exercisable

     49,596      $ 100        7.5      $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Aggregate intrinsic value represents the difference between the estimated fair value of the underlying common stock and the exercise price of outstanding, in-the-money options. There were no in-the-money options as of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018.

No stock options were exercised during the three months ended March 31, 2019.

The following table summarizes additional information on stock option grants and vesting (in thousands):

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Total fair value of stock options granted

   $  2,492      $  350  

Total fair value of options vested

     815        807  

Time-based vesting stock options

Time-based vesting stock options generally vest over a five-year period, are subject to graded vesting schedules, and expire ten years from the date of grant or within 90 days of termination. The weighted-average fair value per share of time-based vesting stock options granted by us was $37.16 and $41.21 during the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

For the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company recognized $0.9 million and $0.3 million of stock-based compensation expense in connection with time-based stock options, respectively. As of March 31, 2019, there was $5.6 million of unrecognized stock-based compensation expense, respectively, related to unvested time-based stock options that is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 3.6 years.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

Note 5 – Equity incentive plan (continued)

 

Performance-based vesting stock options

Performance-based vesting stock options generally vest upon the satisfaction of performance- and market-based criteria, based on the Principal Stockholders’ (as defined in the 2016 Plan) internal rate of return on their investment in the Company as measured following their sale of at least 70% of the Principal Stockholders total holdings in the Company, and expire ten years from the date of grant. The weighted-average fair value per share of performance-based vesting stock options granted by us was $37.16 and $41.21 during the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

As of March 31, 2019, no stock-based compensation expense had been recognized for stock options with performance-based vesting conditions due to a qualifying event for the awards’ performance-based vesting component not being considered probable as of that date. The total unrecognized stock-based compensation expense relating to these awards was $8.9 million as of March 31, 2019.

Award Valuation

The Company used valuation models to value both time and performance-based vesting stock options granted during 2019 and 2018. The following table summarizes the assumptions used in the valuation models to determine the fair value of awards granted to employees and non- employees under the 2016 Plan:

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
    Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Expected volatility

     36.92     36.15

Expected term (in years)

     6.5       6.5  

Dividend yield

     0.00     0.00

Risk free interest rate

     2.42     2.78

A discussion of management’s methodology for developing each of the assumptions used in the valuation model follows:

 

   

Expected volatility – Volatility is a measure of the amount by which a financial variable such as a share price has fluctuated (historical volatility) or is expected to fluctuate (expected volatility) during a period. The Company uses an estimated volatility based on the historical and implied volatilities of comparable companies.

 

   

Expected term – This is the period that the options granted are expected to remain unexercised. For options granted during the three months ended March 31, 2019, the Company derived the expected life of the option based on the average midpoint between vesting and the contractual term as there is little exercise history.

 

   

Dividend yield – The Company has never declared or paid dividends and have no plans to do so in the foreseeable future.

 

   

Risk-free interest rate – This is the U.S. Treasury rate for securities with similar terms that most closely resembles the expected life of the option.

Stock award activity

During the three months ended March 31, 2019, the Company granted to certain non-employee directors 5,556 shares of common stock. These stock awards were issued to non-employee directors in satisfaction of their annual retainer payments and are not subject to any vesting conditions, and thus became issued and outstanding

 

F-38


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

Note 5 – Equity incentive plan (continued)

 

shares on the grant date. Accordingly, the Company recognized the grant-date fair value of the stock awards of $0.5 million as stock-based compensation expense concurrent with the grant date of the awards during the three months ended March 31, 2019. No stock awards were granted during the three months ended March 31, 2018.

Stock-based compensation expense

Stock-based compensation expense is included in the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss within the following line items (in thousands):

 

     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
     Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Cost of revenues

   $  231      $  198  

General and administrative

     619        25  

Research and development

     4        4  

Sales and marketing

     56        74  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 910      $ 301  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted stock units

Certain employees may be eligible to receive restricted stock unit awards in the event of an IPO (as defined in the respective employment agreements) with a market value equal to the greater of (1) $3.5 million or (2) an amount determined using a formula-based model (as defined in the respective employment agreements), as of the date of such grants.

Note 6 – Earnings (loss) per share

Basic earnings (loss) per common share (“EPS”) is calculated by dividing the net earnings (loss) for the fiscal year by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Due to the Company’s net loss for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, all potential common stock equivalents were anti-dilutive.

The following table summarizes the basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share for the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 (in thousands, except share and per share amounts).

 

    Three Months Ended
March 31, 2019
    Three Months Ended
March 31, 2018
 

Basic and diluted loss per share:

   

Net loss

  $ (13,491   $ (18,037
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding – basic

    3,683,461       3,372,319  

Dilutive effect of potentially issuable shares

    —         —    
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding – diluted

    3,683,461       3,372,319  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic loss per share

  $ (3.66   $ (5.35

Dilutive effect of potentially issuable shares

    —         —    
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted loss per share

  $ (3.66   $ (5.35
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common share equivalents excluded due to anti-dilutive effect

    —         —    
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-39


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

For the Three Months Ended March 31, 2019 and 2018

 

Note 7 – Income taxes

A valuation allowance has been established against our net U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets, including net operating loss carryforwards. As a result, our income tax position is primarily related to foreign tax activity and U.S. deferred taxes for tax deductible goodwill and other indefinite-lived liabilities. During the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, we recorded an income tax provision (benefit) of $0.1 million and ($2.8) million, respectively, resulting in an effective tax rate of (0.7)% and 13.3%, respectively. These effective tax rates differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate primarily due to the effects of foreign tax rate differences and the valuation allowance against our domestic deferred tax assets.

Note 8 – Commitments and contingencies

The Company is involved in various legal proceedings, which may arise occasionally in the normal course of business. While the ultimate results of such matters generally cannot be predicted with certainty, management does not expect such matters to have a material effect on the financial position and results of operations as of March 31, 2019.

The Company has four letters of credit as additional security for lease guarantees as follows; $0.3 million for the location in Eden Prairie, Minnesota, $0.3 million for the location in Rutherford, NJ, $0.3 million for the location in Austin, Texas and $0.1 million for the location in Toronto, Canada.

Note 9 – Related parties

On December 22, 2015, the Company entered into a consulting agreement with Carlyle Investment Management, LLC, an affiliate of Carlyle, for advisory, consulting and other services in relation to the strategic and financial management of the Company. For each of the three months ended March 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company recognized $0.2 million in management consulting fees, reflected within “General and administrative expenses” in the accompanying consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. As of March 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, there was approximately $2.5 and $2.3 million remained payable.

Note 10 – Subsequent events

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through June 19, 2019, the date on which these financial statements were issued, and identified the item below for discussion

On May 20, 2019, the Company entered into a merger agreement (“Merger Agreement”) with Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a publicly traded company (“Pivotal”), As a result of the merger, the Company will become a wholly-owned subsidiary of Pivotal, with the stockholders of the Company becoming securityholders of Pivotal.

Under the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of the Company will receive an aggregate of 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock. The stockholders of the Company will also have the right to receive up to 2,200,000 shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal’s common stock exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger.

The boards of directors of both the Company and Pivotal have unanimously approved the proposed transaction. Completion of the transaction, which is expected in the third quarter of 2019, is subject to approval by Pivotal stockholders and other customary closing conditions.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Shareholders and the Board of Directors of LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of LD Topco, Inc. and subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of comprehensive loss, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2018, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2018, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audits we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purposes of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2016.

Tysons, Virginia

June 19, 2019

 

F-41


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     December 31,
2018
    December 31,
2017
 

Current assets

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 23,439     $ 18,896  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $5,565 and $4,183, respectively

     80,641       71,467  

Prepaid expenses

     9,825       17,170  

Other current assets

     310       2,142  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     114,215       109,675  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment

    

Computer software and hardware

     68,474       62,875  

Leasehold improvements

     25,389       24,321  

Furniture, fixtures and other equipment

     4,239       2,942  

Accumulated depreciation

     (49,761     (30,997
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

     48,341       59,141  

Intangible assets, net

     151,918       183,819  

Goodwill

     394,167       395,062  

Other assets

     1,739       1,980  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 710,380     $ 749,677  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current liabilities

    

Current portion of long-term debt, net

   $ 12,355     $ 4,096  

Accounts payable and accrued expense

     41,135       44,002  

Current portion of contingent consideration

     —         2,380  

Deferred revenue

     4,160       4,722  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     57,650       55,200  

Long-term debt, net

     413,064       425,446  

Deferred tax liabilities

     6,075       12,761  

Other liabilities

     4,635       1,284  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     481,424       494,691  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity

    

Common stock

    

$0.01 par value, shares authorized—5,000,000; shares issued and outstanding—3,681,979 and 3,268,718 as of December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, respectively

     37       33  

Additional paid-in capital

     372,283       330,931  

Stock subscription receivable

     —         (1,350

Treasury stock

     (2,406     (2,319

Accumulated deficit

     (147,954     (80,175

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     6,996       7,866  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     228,956       254,986  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 710,380     $  749,677  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss

(in thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

    Year ended
December 31, 2018
    Year ended
December 31, 2017
 

Revenues

  $ 296,282     $ 281,184  

Cost of revenues

    159,617       154,082  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

    136,665       127,102  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

   

General and administrative

    54,633       57,698  

Research and development

    7,100       7,932  

Sales and marketing

    58,273       44,623  

Change in fair value of contingent consideration

    —         (1,640

Depreciation and amortization

    41,519       43,525  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    161,525       152,138  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

    (24,860     (25,036

Other expenses

   

Other expense

    29       625  

Interest expense

    46,591       43,109  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

    (71,480     (68,770

Income tax (benefit) provision

    (3,741     3,448  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

  $ (67,739   $ (72,218
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

   

Foreign currency translation

    (870     7,875  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    (870     7,875  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

  $ (68,609   $ (64,343
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share—basic and diluted

  $ (19.48   $ (23.51
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding—basic and diluted

    3,477,752       3,071,256  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

(in thousands, except for share amounts)

 

    Common Stock Issued     Additional
paid-in
capital
    Treasury
Stock
    Stock
subscription
receivable
    Accumulated
deficit
    Accumulated
other
comprehensive
(loss) income
    Total  
      Shares         Amount    

Balance as of December 31, 2016

    3,049,068     $ 31     $ 307,630     $ (2,319   $ —       $ (7,957   $ (9   $ 297,376  

Issuance of common stock

    199,650       2       19,963       —         —         —         —         19,965  

Share based compensation

    6,500       —         1,988       —         —         —         —         1,988  

Foreign exchange translation

    —         —         —         —         —         —         7,875       7,875  

Stock subscription receivable

    13,500       —         1,350       —         (1,350     —         —         —    

Net loss

    —         —         —         —         —         (72,218     —         (72,218
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2017

    3,268,718       33       330,931       (2,319     (1,350     (80,175     7,866       254,986  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Issuance of common stock

    407,635       4       39,187       —         —         —         —         39,191  

Share based compensation

    6,500       —         2,125       —         —         —         —         2,125  

Foreign exchange translation

    —         —         —         —         —         —         (870     (870

Stock subscription receivable

    —         —         —         —         1,350       —         —         1,350  

Repurchases of treasury stock

    (874     —         —         (87     —         —         —         (87

Adoption of new accounting principle

    —         —         40       —         —         (40     —         —    

Net loss

    —         —         —         —         —         (67,739     —         (67,739
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2018

    3,681,979     $ 37     $ 372,283     $ (2,406   $ —       $ (147,954   $ 6,996     $ 228,956  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

(in thousands)

 

     Year ended
December 31, 2018
    Year ended
December 31, 2017
 

Operating activities

    

Net loss

   $ (67,739   $ (72,218

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in operating activities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     54,749       54,801  

Non-cash interest

     4,564       4,316  

Stock-based compensation

     2,125       1,988  

Provision for losses on accounts receivable

     2,226       2,439  

Deferred income taxes

     (6,686     2,482  

Change in fair value of contingent consideration

     —         (1,640

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable

     (12,126     (5,962

Prepaid expenses and other assets

     9,864       (1,988

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

     1,540       12,063  

Deferred revenue

     (459     1,034  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (11,942     (2,685
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

    

Purchases of property and equipment

     (12,387     (20,600
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (12,387     (20,600
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

    

Revolving credit facility—draws

     21,000       22,000  

Revolving credit facility—repayments

     (21,000     (22,000

Payments for capital lease obligations

     (544     (1,743

Payments on long-term debt

     (8,500     (8,500

Issuance of common stock

     40,541       19,965  

Treasury share repurchases

     (87     —    

Payments of contingent consideration

     (2,380     (830
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     29,030       8,892  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of foreign exchange rates

     (158     1,518  

Net increase (decrease) in cash

     4,543       (12,875

Cash at beginning of period

     18,896       31,771  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash at end of period

   $ 23,439     $ 18,896  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental disclosure:

    

Cash paid for interest

   $ 41,596     $ 35,193  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds

   $ 1,229     $ 1,011  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Significant noncash investing and financing activities

    

Purchases of property and equipment in accounts payable and accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets

   $ 489     $ 240  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies

Organization

LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation organized on November 20, 2015 (“LD Topco,” d/b/a KLDiscovery), together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) provide technology-based litigation support solutions and services including computer e-discovery, data hosting, and managed document review predominantly to top law firms, corporations and government agencies. The majority of the Company’s current business is derived from these services. The Company’s headquarters is located in McLean, Virginia and has 40 locations in 20 countries, 10 data centers and 20 data recovery labs around the globe. The Company is majority owned by private investment funds managed by The Carlyle Group (“Carlyle”).

Principles of consolidation

The accompanying consolidated financial statements are prepared on the accrual basis of accounting in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“U.S. GAAP”). The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of LD Topco, Inc. and all its subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated upon consolidation.

Use of estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Although actual results could differ from those estimates, management does not believe that such differences would be material.

Significant estimates include, but are not limited to, the allowance for doubtful accounts, determining the fair values of assets acquired and liabilities assumed, the recoverability and useful lives of property and equipment, intangible assets, and other long-lived assets, the impairment of goodwill, the valuation and realization of deferred income taxes, the fair value of the Company’s common stock and stock option awards, and acquisition-related contingent consideration.

Segments, concentration of credit risk and major customers

The Company operates in one business segment, providing technology-based litigation support solutions and services.

Financial instruments, which potentially expose the Company to concentrations of credit risk, consist principally of cash and accounts receivable. The Company places its cash with a banking institution where the balances, at times, exceed federally insured limits. Management believes the risks associated with these deposits are limited.

With respect to accounts receivable, the Company performs ongoing evaluations of its customers, generally grants uncollateralized credit terms to its customers, and maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical experience and management’s expectations of future losses. As of and for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company did not have a single customer that represents more than ten percent (10%) or more of its consolidated revenues or accounts receivable. The Company believes that the geographic and industry diversity of the Company’s customer base throughout the U.S. and internationally minimizes the risk of incurring material losses due to concentrations of credit risk. Our foreign revenues, principally from businesses in the UK and Germany, totaled approximately $62.2 million in 2018 and $61.1 million in 2017. Our long-lived assets in foreign countries, principally in the UK and Germany, totaled approximately $20.6 million at December 31, 2018 and $14.6 million at December 31, 2017.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Foreign currency

Results of operations for the Company’s non-U.S. subsidiaries are translated from the designated functional currency to the reporting currency of the U.S. dollar. Revenues and expenses are translated at average exchange rates for each month, while assets and liabilities are translated at balance sheet date exchange rates. Resulting net translation adjustments are recorded as a component of stockholders’ equity in “Accumulated other comprehensive income.”

Transaction gains and losses arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on transactions denominated in a currency other than the local functional currency are included in “Other expense” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. Such transaction gains and losses may be realized or unrealized depending upon whether the transaction settled during the period or remains outstanding at the balance sheet date.

Business combinations

The Company recognizes all of the assets acquired, liabilities assumed, contractual contingencies, and contingent consideration at their fair value on the acquisition date. Acquisition-related costs are recognized separately from the acquisition and expensed as incurred. Restructuring costs incurred in periods subsequent to the acquisition date are expensed when incurred. Subsequent changes to the purchase price ( i.e. , working capital adjustments) or other fair value adjustments determined during the measurement period are recorded as an adjustment to goodwill, with the exception of contingent consideration, which is recognized in the statement of comprehensive loss in the period it is modified. All subsequent changes to a valuation allowance or uncertain tax position that relate to the acquired company and existed at the acquisition date that occur both within the measurement period and as a result of facts and circumstances that existed at the acquisition date are recognized as an adjustment to goodwill. All other changes in valuation allowances are recognized as a reduction or increase to income tax expense or as a direct adjustment to additional paid-in capital as required.

In addition, uncertain tax positions and tax related valuation allowances assumed in connection with a business combination are initially estimated as of the acquisition date. The Company re-evaluates these items based upon facts and circumstances that existed as of the acquisition date with any adjustments to its preliminary estimates being recorded to goodwill if the Company is within the measurement period. Subsequent to the measurement period, changes to these uncertain tax positions and tax related valuation allowances will affect the Company’s provision for income taxes in its Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss and could have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash

The Company considers all highly liquid financial instruments with an original maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents.

As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, $0.1 million and $0.5 million, respectively, of cash was pledged as collateral with Bank of America for credit cards issued to Company employees.

Accounts receivable

Accounts receivable are recorded at original invoice amount less an estimate for doubtful receivables based on a review of outstanding amounts monthly. Management determines the allowance for doubtful accounts by

 

F-47


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

regularly evaluating individual customer receivables and considering a customer’s financial condition and credit history. Accounts receivable are written off when deemed uncollectible. Recoveries of trade accounts receivable previously written off are recorded when received.

A rollforward of the allowance for doubtful accounts is presented below (in thousands):

 

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $  2,126  

Charged to/reversed from expense

     2,438  

Charged to/from other accounts

     —    

Deductions (write offs)

     (382
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2017

   $ 4,182  

Charged to/reversed from expense

     2,226  

Charged to/from other accounts

     —    

Deductions (write offs)

     (844
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2018

   $ 5,564  
  

 

 

 

Computer software, property and equipment

Computer software, property and equipment are recorded at cost. Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method over the following estimated useful lives of the assets:

 

Computer software and hardware

   3 to 5 years

Leasehold improvements

   Shorter of lease term or useful life

Furniture, fixtures and other equipment

   3 to 5 years

Gains or losses on disposals are included in results of operations at amounts equal to the difference between the net book value of the disposed assets and the proceeds received upon disposal. Costs for replacements and betterments are capitalized, while the costs of maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred. Property under capital leases are depreciated using the straight-line method over the lease term.

Depreciation expense totaled $24.7 million and $24.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and includes amortization of assets recorded under capital leases.

Internal-use software development costs

As required by ASC Subtopic 350-40, Internal – Use Software (ASC 350-40), the Company capitalizes certain internal computer software costs incurred during the application development stage. The application development stage generally includes software design and configuration, coding, testing and installation activities. Training and maintenance costs are expensed as incurred, while upgrades and enhancements are capitalized if it is probable that such expenditure will result in additional functionality. Capitalized software costs are depreciated over the estimated useful life of the underlying project on a straight-line basis. The Company’s estimated useful life of capitalized software costs varies between three and five years, depending on management’s expectation of the economic life of various software. Capitalized software depreciation costs are recorded as a component of depreciation and amortization expense.

Capitalized software costs are reflected as part of the “Intangible assets, net line” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets and totaled $7.6 million and $7.8 million, net of accumulated amortization, as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

 

F-48


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Intangible assets and other long-lived assets

The Company evaluates the recoverability of its long-lived assets, including finite-lived intangible assets, for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of any asset to future net undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by the asset. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured as the difference between the fair value of the asset compared to its carrying amount. No impairment losses were recognized in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

Amortization expense totaled $30.0 million and $29.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively; $13.2 million and $11.3 million of which was classified as part of the “Cost of revenues” line in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the total consideration paid over identified intangible and tangible assets of the Company and its acquisitions. The Company tests its goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level on an annual basis on October 1, and between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying value. These events or circumstances could include a significant change in the business climate, legal factors, operating performance indicators, competition, or sale or disposition of a significant portion of a reporting unit. As of the October 1 testing date the Company determined there is one entity-wide reporting unit.

In January 2017, Financial Accounting Standard Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standard Update (“ASU”) 2017-04 which simplifies the subsequent measurement of goodwill to eliminate Step 2 from the goodwill impairment test, removing the need to determine the implied fair value of goodwill and comparing it to the carrying amount of that goodwill to measure the impairment loss, if any. The Company has early adopted ASU 2017-04 during the fourth quarter of 2017.

Goodwill impairment exists when the estimated fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying value. If impairment exists, the carrying value of the goodwill is reduced by the excess through an impairment charge recorded in the Company’s statements of operations. The process of evaluating the potential impairment of goodwill is subjective and requires significant judgment at many points during the analysis.

The fair value of each reporting unit is estimated using a combination of a discounted cash flow (“DCF”) analysis and market-based valuation methodologies such as comparable public company trading values and values observed in recent business combinations. Determining fair value requires the exercise of significant judgments, including the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, long-term growth rates, discount rates and relevant comparable public company earnings multiples and relevant transaction multiples. The cash flows employed in the DCF analyses are based on the Company’s best estimate of future sales, earnings and cash flows after considering factors such as general market conditions, changes in working capital, long term business plans and recent operating performance. The carrying value of each reporting unit includes the assets and liabilities employed in its operations and goodwill.

Accordingly, the Company has not identified any indicators of impairment, nor have any impairment charges been recorded related to goodwill resulting from the annual impairment test.

 

F-49


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

The following table provides a rollforward of the carrying amount of goodwill (in thousands):

 

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $  388,353  

Measurement period adjustments

     3,497  

Foreign currency translation

     3,212  
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2017

     395,062  

Foreign currency translation

     (895
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2018

   $ 394,167  
  

 

 

 

Debt issuance costs

Debt issuance costs are stated at cost, net of accumulated amortization, and are amortized over the term of the debt using both the straight-line and the effective yield methods. U.S. GAAP requires that the effective yield method be used to amortize debt acquisition costs; however, if the effect of using the straight-line method is not materially different from the results that would have been obtained under the effective yield method, the straight-line method may be used. The amortization for funded term debt is calculated according to the effective yield method and revolving and unfunded term debt is calculated according to the straight-line method. Debt issuance costs related to funded term debt is presented in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as a direct deduction from the carrying amount of the debt liability, consistent with debt discounts or premiums. Debt issuance costs related to revolving and unfunded term debt is presented in the Consolidated Balance Sheets within “Other (current) assets.”

Revenue recognition

The Company recognizes revenue when all the following criteria are met: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred, the fee is fixed and determinable and collectability is reasonably assured. Deferred revenue represents revenues collected but not earned as of December 31st. Any taxes assessed on revenues relating to services provided to the Company’s clients are recorded on a net basis.

The Company’s revenues are primarily derived from contracts to provide services each month including; collection and forensic services, processing, document review services and hosting fees based on the amount of data stored. The Company bills its customers monthly in arrears for services provided. For these contractual arrangements, the Company has identified each deliverable service element. Based on an evaluation of each element, the Company has determined that each element delivered has standalone value to its customers because the Company or other vendors sell such services separately from any other services/deliverables.

Accordingly, each of the service elements in the Company’s multiple element case and document management arrangements qualify as a separate unit of accounting. The Company allocates revenue to the various units of accounting in its arrangements based on the fair value or best estimated selling price of each unit of accounting, which is generally consistent with the stated prices in the arrangements.

The Company enters into arrangements that can include various combinations of software, services, and hardware. Where elements are delivered over different periods of time, and when allowed under U.S. GAAP, revenue is allocated to the respective elements based on their relative selling prices at the inception of the arrangement, and revenue is recognized as each element is delivered. The Company uses a hierarchy to determine the fair value to be used for allocating revenue to elements: vendor-specific objective evidence of fair

 

F-50


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

value (“VSOE”), third-party evidence and best estimate of selling price (“BESP”). For software elements, the Company follows the industry specific software guidance which only allows for the use of VSOE in establishing fair value. Generally, VSOE is the price charged when the deliverable is sold separately, or the price established by management for a product that is not yet sold if it is probable that the price will not change before introduction into the marketplace. In software arrangements where the Company does not have VSOE for all undelivered elements, the elements are combined and the arrangement consideration is recognized for the combined element, generally ratably over the maintenance period. BESPs are established as best estimates of what the selling prices would be if the deliverables were sold regularly on a stand-alone basis. The Company’s process for determining BESPs requires judgment and considers multiple factors that may vary over time depending upon the unique facts and circumstances related to each deliverable.

Share-based compensation

The Company measures and recognizes compensation expense for all share-based awards to employees based on estimated grant date fair values on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period. The Company uses the Black-Scholes valuation model, depending on terms, facts and circumstances of each share-based award.

Advertising

Advertising costs consist of marketing, advertising through print and other media, professional event sponsorship and public relations. These costs are expensed as incurred. Advertising costs totaled $7.4 million and $7.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Advertising costs are reflected within “Sales and marketing” in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss.

Research and development expense

Costs incurred in the research and development of the Company’s technologies primarily consist of developer salaries. Research and development expenses were $7.1 million and $7.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Income taxes

Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Deferred income taxes are provided for temporary differences in recognizing certain income, expense and credit items for financial reporting purposes and tax reporting purposes. Such deferred income taxes primarily relate to the difference between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their financial reporting amounts. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured by applying enacted statutory tax rates applicable to the future years in which deferred tax assets or liabilities are expected to be settled or realized. Excess tax benefits and tax deficiencies are recognized in the income tax provision in the period in which they occur.

The Company records a valuation allowance when it determines, based on available positive and negative evidence, that it is more-likely-than-not that some portion, or all its deferred tax assets will not be realized. The Company determines the realizability of its deferred tax assets primarily based on the reversal of existing taxable temporary differences and projections of future taxable income (exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards). In evaluating such projections, the Company considers its history of profitability, the competitive environment, and general economic conditions. In addition, the Company considers the time frame over which it would take to utilize the deferred tax assets prior to their expiration.

 

F-51


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

For certain tax positions, the Company uses a more-likely-than-not threshold based on the technical merits of the tax position taken. Tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold are measured at the largest amount of tax benefits determined on a cumulative probability basis, which are more-likely-than-not to be realized upon ultimate settlement in the financial statements. The Company’s policy is to recognize interest and penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense. As of December 31, 2018, and December 31, 2017 respectively, the Company is not aware of any material uncertain tax positions requiring adjustment to or disclosure in the financial statements.

Net Income per Common Share

Basic net income per common share is determined by dividing net income by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year. Diluted net income per common share is determined by dividing net income by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year, plus the dilutive effect of common stock equivalents, including stock options and restricted shares. Common stock and common stock equivalents included in the computation represent shares issuable upon assumed exercise of outstanding stock options and release of restricted shares, except when the effect of their inclusion would be antidilutive.

Recent accounting pronouncements

The Company adopted on January 1, 2018 ASU 2016-09, Compensation – Stock Compensation (Topic 718) (ASU 2016-09). This ASU provides amended guidance which simplifies the accounting for share-based payment transactions involving multiple aspects of the accounting for share-based transactions, including income tax consequences, classification of awards as either equity or liabilities, and classification on the statement of cash flows. The Company now recognizes forfeitures of stock options as they occur. The impact of the adoption of ASU 2016-09 was $0.04 million which was not material to the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

The Company adopted ASU 2016-18,  Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash. This ASU clarifies how entities should present restricted cash and restricted cash equivalents in the statement of cash flows. ASU 2016-18 requires that a statement of cash flows explain the change during the period in the total of cash, cash equivalents, and amounts generally described as restricted cash or restricted cash equivalents. Therefore, amounts generally described as restricted cash and restricted cash equivalents should be included with cash and cash equivalents when reconciling the beginning-of-period and end-of-period total amounts shown on the statement of cash flows. ASU 2016-18 is effective for nonpublic business entities for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, and interim periods within those years, and will be applied using a retrospective transition method to each period presented. The Company adopted this standard effective January 1, 2018. Amounts described as restricted cash are included with cash and cash equivalents when reconciling the beginning-of-year and end-of-year amounts presented on the statements of cash flows. The adoption of ASU 2016-18 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted

In connection with the proposed transaction with Pivotal (see Note 16), the Company will elect to be an emerging growth company, as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the JOBS Act and take advantage of the extended transition period of delaying the adoption of new or revised accounting standards until such time as those standards apply to private companies. This may make the comparison of the Company’s consolidated financial statements to other public companies not meaningful due to the differences in accounting standards being applied.

 

F-52


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) , which requires lessees to recognize on the balance sheet a right-of-use asset, representing their right to use the underlying asset for the lease term, and a lease liability for all leases with terms greater than 12 months. The guidance also requires qualitative and quantitative disclosures designed to assess the amount, timing and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases. The standard requires the use of a modified retrospective transition approach, which includes a number of optional practical expedients that entities may elect to apply. This standard is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2020 and the Company is currently evaluating the impact that ASU 2016-02 will have on its consolidated financial statements.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606) . Topic 606 supersedes nearly all existing revenue recognition guidance under GAAP. The core principle of Topic 606 is to recognize revenues when promised goods or services are transferred to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration that is expected to be received for those goods or services. Topic 606 defines a five-step process to achieve this core principle and, in doing so, it is possible more judgment and estimates may be required within the revenue recognition process than are required under existing GAAP, including identifying performance obligations in the contract, estimating the amount of variable consideration to include in the transaction price and allocating the transaction price to each separate performance obligation, among others.

The Company will adopt Topic 606 (as amended) in its annual Financial Statements for the year ended 12/31/2019. The Company is using a comprehensive approach to evaluate the impact of the new standard on our accounting policies, processes, and systems to identify potential differences that would result from applying the new requirements to our revenue contracts, including evaluation of performance obligations in the contract, estimating the amount of variable consideration to include in the transaction price, allocating the transaction price to each separate performance obligation, and accounting treatment of costs to obtain and fulfill contracts.

The Company has established a cross-functional implementation team and will utilize a bottom-up approach to analyze the impact of the standard on its arrangements by reviewing the current accounting policies and practices to identify potential differences that would result from applying the requirements of the new standard to its revenue contracts.

The Company has progressed with its project plan for adopting this standard, including gathering and evaluating the inventory of its revenue streams. The Company continues to evaluate the potential impact on its accounting policies, internal control processes including system readiness and the related disclosures that will be required under the new guidance.

The update may be applied using one of two methods: retrospective application to each prior reporting period presented, or retrospective application, with the cumulative effect of initially applying the update recognized at the date of initial application. The Company is currently evaluating the transition method that will be elected and the impact of the update on its consolidated financial statements and disclosures.

In October 2016, the FASB issued ASU “Accounting for Income Taxes: Intra-Entity Transfers of Assets Other than Inventory” (Topic 740). ASU 2016-16 requires companies to recognize the income tax effects of intercompany sales of assets other than inventory when the transfer occurs. This standard was effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2019 and the adoption did not have a material impact on its consolidated financial statements.

In August 2018, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2018-15, Intangibles – Goodwill and Other – Internal-Use Software (Subtopic 350-40): Customer’s Accounting for Implementation Costs Incurred in a

 

F-53


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

(in thousands)

Note 1 – Organization, business and summary of significant accounting policies (continued)

 

Cloud Computing Arrangement That Is a Service Contract (“ASU 2018-15”). ASU 2018-15 requires customers in a hosting arrangement that is a service contract to follow existing internal-use software guidance to determine which implementation costs to capitalize and which costs to expense. Under this model, customers would need to determine the nature of the implementation costs and the project stage in which they are incurred to determine which costs to capitalize or expense. Customers would be required to amortize the capitalized implementation costs over the term of the hosting arrangement, which might extend beyond the noncancelable period if there are options to extend or terminate. ASU 2018-15 specifies the financial statement presentation of capitalized implementation costs and related amortization in addition to required disclosures for material capitalized implementation costs related to hosting arrangements that are service contracts. The standard is effective for interim and annual periods beginning January 1, 2020. Early adoption is permitted. Entities can choose to adopt this guidance prospectively to eligible costs incurred on or after the date the guidance is first applied, or to adopt the guidance retrospectively. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of this guidance on its consolidated financial position, results of operations, and cash flows.

Note 2 – Fair value measurements

The Company accounts for recurring and non-recurring fair value measurements in accordance with ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements . ASC 820 defines fair value, establishes a fair value hierarchy for assets and liabilities measured at fair value, and requires expanded disclosures about fair value measurements. The ASC 820 hierarchy ranks the quality of reliability of inputs, or assumptions, used in the determination of fair value, and requires assets and liabilities carried at fair value to be classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

Level 1 – Fair value is determined by using unadjusted quoted prices that are available in active markets for identical assets and liabilities.

Level 2 – Fair value is determined by using inputs other than Level 1 quoted prices that are directly or indirectly observable. Inputs can include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets or quoted prices for identical assets and liabilities in inactive markets. Related inputs can also include those used in valuation or other pricing models, such as interest rates and yield curves that can be corroborated by observable market data.

Level 3 – Fair value is determined by inputs that are unobservable and not corroborated by market data. Use of these inputs involves significant and subjective judgments to be made by a reporting entity – e.g., determining an appropriate adjustment to a discount factor for illiquidity associated with a given security.

The Company evaluates financial assets and liabilities subject to fair value measurements on a recurring basis to determine the appropriate level at which to classify them each reporting period. This determination requires significant judgments to be made by the Company.

The Company believes that the fair values of its current assets and current liabilities (cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, and other current liabilities) approximate their reported carrying amounts.

The Company estimates the fair value of contingent purchase consideration based on the present value of the consideration expected to be paid during the remainder of the earn-out period, based on management’s assessment of the acquired operations’ forecasted earnings. This fair value measure is based on significant inputs not observed in the market and thus represents a Level 3 measurement. The fair value of future expected acquisition-related contingent consideration obligations was $2.4 million at December 31, 2017. As of December 31, 2018, all acquisition related contingent consideration was fully paid.

 

F-54


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

(in thousands)

Note 2 – Fair value measurements (continued)

 

The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurements of the Company’s contingent purchase consideration include its measures of the future profitability and related cash flows of the acquired business or assets, impacted by appropriate discount rates. Significant increases (decreases) in any of these individual inputs would result in a significantly lower (higher) fair value measurement. Generally, a change in the assumptions used for the discount rates is indirectly proportional to the fair value of contingent purchase consideration and a change in the assumptions used for the future cash flows is directly proportional to the fair value of contingent purchase consideration. The Company, using additional information as it becomes available, reassesses the fair value of the contingent purchase consideration on an annual basis.

Any change in the fair value of contingent consideration liability results in a remeasurement gain or loss that is recorded as income or expense, respectively, and is included in “Change in fair value of contingent consideration” on the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss.

For the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company recorded a gain of $1.6 million related to the change in fair value of future contingent consideration payments. This change was primarily driven by business results in the current period as well as expected results during the remainder of the earn-out period.

The following table provides a reconciliation of liabilities measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 (in thousands):

 

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $ 4,850  

Payment of contingent consideration

     (830

Change in fair value of contingent consideration

     (1,640
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2017

     2,380  

Payment of contingent consideration

     (2,380

Change in fair value of contingent consideration

     —    
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2018

   $ —    
  

 

 

 

Management estimates the carrying amount of the Company’s long-term debt approximates its fair value because the interest rates on these instruments are subject to changes in market interest rates or are consistent with prevailing interest rates.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

 

Note 3 – Intangible assets

Intangible assets consist of the following (in thousands):

 

Description

   Weighted Average
Remaining Useful
Life in Years
     December 31,
2018
     December 31,
2017
 

Trademark and tradenames

     7.4      $ 66,219      $ 67,297  

Accumulated amortization

        (14,340      (7,148
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trademark and tradenames, net

        51,879        60,149  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Developed technology

     3.4        52,891        52,891  

Accumulated amortization

        (23,264      (13,497
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Developed technology, net

        29,627        39,394  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-compete agreements

     1.5        1,402        1,402  

Accumulated amortization

        (992      (820
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-compete agreements, net

        410        582  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer relationships

     7.3        94,285        94,892  

Accumulated amortization

        (31,922      (19,000
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer relationships, net

        62,363        75,892  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Intangible assets, net of amortization

      $  144,279      $  176,017  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization expense totaled $30.0 million and $29.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Future amortization of intangible assets is as follows (in thousands):

 

December 31,

   Amount  

2019

   $ 29,738  

2020

     26,812  

2021

     22,506  

2022

     18,626  

2023

     13,653  

Thereafter

     32,944  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $  144,279  
  

 

 

 

Note 4 – Accrued expenses

Accrued expenses consisted of the following (in thousands):

 

     December 31,  
     2018      2017  

Accrued expenses:

     

Accrued interest

   $ 5,783      $ 5,652  

Accrued salaries

     16,222        14,042  

Current taxes payable

     327        5,623  

Other accrued expenses

     2,109        4,284  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $  24,441      $  29,601  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-56


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

 

Note 5 – Leasing arrangements

The Company leases office space and certain equipment under operating and capital lease agreements, expiring in various years through 2027. Certain leases contain annual rent escalation clauses.

Rent expense totaled $13.0 million and $10.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

The amortization expense recorded for capital leases totaled $0.4 million and $0 for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

For years subsequent to December 31, 2018, future minimum payments for all operating and capital lease obligations that have initial non-cancelable lease terms exceeding one year, net of rental income from subleases are as follows (in thousands):

 

December 31,

   Capital Leases      Operating Leases  

2019

   $ 631      $  10,625  

2020

     631        9,841  

2021

     631        6,970  

2022

     542        5,709  

2023

     69        5,290  

Thereafter

     —          9,416  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $  2,504      $ 47,851  
     

 

 

 

Less interest on lease obligations

     (361   
  

 

 

    

Net Amount

   $ 2,143     
  

 

 

    

Note 6 – Long term debt

The table below summarizes the components of the Company’s long-term debt (in thousands):

 

     December 31,  
     2018      2017  

Term loan due 2021

   $ —        $ —    

First lien facility due 2022

     323,000        331,500  

Second lien facility due 2023

     125,000        125,000  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt

     448,000        456,500  

Less: unamortized original issue discount

     (13,043      (15,563

Less: unamortized debt issuance costs

     (9,538      (11,395
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt, net

     425,419        429,542  

Current portion of debt

     17,000        8,500  

Less: current portion of unamortized original issue discount

     (2,678      (2,536

Less: current portion of unamortized debt issuance costs

     (1,967      (1,868
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current portion of debt, net

     12,355        4,096  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total long term debt, net

   $  413,064      $  425,446  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-57


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 6 – Long term debt (continued)

 

2016 Credit Agreement

On December 9, 2016, LD Topco entered into a Credit Agreement with a group of lenders to establish term loan facilities and a revolving line of credit for borrowings by LD Intermediate, Inc. and LD Lower Holdings, Inc. (the “Initial Term Loans”). The Initial Term Loan borrowings of $340.0 million (“First Lien Facility”) and $125.0 million (“Second Lien Facility”) mature on December 9, 2022 and December 9, 2023, respectively.

The First Lien Facility established a term loan principal payment schedule with payments due on the last day of each calendar quarter beginning on March 31, 2017 of $2.1 million. Quarterly principal payments increase to $4.3 million beginning on March 31, 2019 with a balloon payment of $259.3 million due at maturity. The interest rate for the First Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by the Company, or to the extent consented to by all appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 5.875% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate multiplied by the greatest of a) LIBOR, b) 0.00% per annum and c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. At December 31, 2018, the balance due was $323.0 million with an interest rate of 5.875% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.61463%.

The Second Lien Facility requires a balloon payment of $125.0 million due at maturity. The interest rate for the Second Lien Facility adjusts every interest rate period, which can be one, two, three or six months in duration and is decided by the Company, or to the extent consented to by all appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter. Interest payment dates include the last day of each interest period and any maturity dates of the facility; however, if any interest period exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of an interest period is also an interest payment date. For each interest period, the interest rate per annum is 10.0% plus the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate which is defined as an amount equal to the Statutory Reserve Rate multiplied by the greatest of a) LIBOR, b) 0.00% per annum and c) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum. At December 31, 2018, the balance due was $125.0 million with an interest rate of 10.00% plus an Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate of 2.61463%.

The First and Second Lien Facilities are secured by substantially all the Company’s assets and contain financial covenants. As of December 31, 2018, the Company was in compliance with all covenants.

The 2016 Credit Agreement includes a mandatory prepayment within ten days after delivery of the annual audited financial statements commencing with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016, in an amount equal to the Excess Cash Flow Percentage of Excess Cash Flow for such Fiscal Year, as defined in the agreement. There were no mandatory prepayments with respect to the 2018 and 2017 fiscal years.

Revolver

The 2016 Credit Agreement also provides for unfunded revolver commitment for borrowing up to $30.0 million, maturing December 9, 2021. Borrowings under the revolver commitment are limited by certain financial covenants of the Credit Agreement including the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio. The Company may draw up to $30.0 million, on a term loan basis, with an adjustable interest rate of 5.375%, 5.625%, or 5.875% based on the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio plus an amount equal to the LIBOR. No amounts were outstanding under the revolving loan as of December 31, 2018.

 

F-58


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 6 – Long term debt (continued)

 

As of December 31, 2018, there was approximately $28.7 million available capacity for borrowing under the revolving loan commitment.

Future principal payments relating to the term loan facilities are (in thousands):

 

December 31,

   Amount  

2019

   $ 17,000  

2020

     17,000  

2021

     17,000  

2022

     272,000  

2023

     125,000  

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 

Total

   $  448,000  
  

 

 

 

The initial term loan borrowings related to the 2016 Credit Agreement were issued at an original issue discount of $11.9 million and $6.3 million for the First Lien Facility and Second Lien Facility, respectively. The original issue discount is amortized using the effective yield method over the respective term of each facility. Accretion of the original issue discount totaled $2.5 million and $2.4 million during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017. Amortization is recorded as interest expense in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss.

LD Topco incurred term loan facilities and revolver closing fees related to the 2016 Credit Agreement of $13.6 million. The term loan facilities and revolver closing fees were deferred on December 9, 2016, along with fees of $0.6 million related to the 2016 Credit Agreement and are amortized over their respective terms. Amortization of debt issuance costs totaled $1.8 million and $1.9 million during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Amortization is recorded as interest expense in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss.

The future amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue discount related to the 2016 Credit Agreement and the revolver are as follows (in thousands):

 

December 31,

   Amount  

2019

   $ 4,645  

2020

     4,953  

2021

     5,274  

2022

     5,656  

2023

     2,053  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 22,581  
  

 

 

 

Note 7 – Employee benefit plan

The Company’s 401(k) plan covers employees who are at least 21 years of age, have completed one year of employment and worked a minimum of 1,000 hours. Employees may elect to defer a percentage of their salary up to the maximum allowed under the Internal Revenue Service Code. The Company makes matching contributions to its 401(k) plan equal to 100% of the first 3% of salary deferred plus 50% of the next 2% of an employee’s contribution for a total maximum Company match of 4% of the salary deferred by the employee,

 

F-59


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 7 – Employee benefit plan (continued)

 

subject to Internal Revenue Service Code limitations. Contributions to the 401(k) plan were $2.8 million and $3.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Note 8 – Equity incentive plan

On March 29, 2016, the Company adopted the 2016 Equity Incentive Plan (as amended, the “2016 Plan”) under which eligible employees, officers, directors and consultants of the Company may be granted incentive or non-qualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, or other stock-based awards, including shares of common stock. The 2016 Plan expires in March 2026. As of December 31, 2018, 603,829 shares of Common Stock were reserved under the 2016 Plan. As of December 31, 2018, 173,849 shares of common stock remained available for issuance.

Stock option activity

The following table summarizes the Company’s stock option activity under the 2016 Plan:

 

Description

   Options
Outstanding
    Weighted Average
Exercise Price
     Weighted Average
Remaining
Contractual Term
(Years)
     Aggregate Intrinsic
Value (1)
 

Balance at December 31, 2017

     410,310     $ 100        8.8      $ —    

Granted

     84,270       100        

Forfeited

     (74,255     100        

Expired

     (8,845     100        
  

 

 

         

Balance at December 31, 2018

     411,480     $ 100        8.3      $ —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Vested and expected to vest

     205,740     $ 100        8.3      $ —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exercisable

     50,566     $ 100        7.7      $ —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Aggregate intrinsic value represents the difference between the estimated fair value of the underlying common stock and the exercise price of outstanding, in-the-money options. There were no in-the-money options as of December 31, 2018 and 2017.

No stock options were exercised during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

The following table summarizes additional information on stock option grants and vesting (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
     Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Total fair value of stock options granted

   $ 3,473      $ 13,132  

Total fair value of options vested

     1,924        1,506  

Time-based vesting stock options

Time-based vesting stock options generally vest over a five-year period, are subject to graded vesting schedules, and expire ten years from the date of grant or within 90 days of termination. The weighted-average fair value per

 

F-60


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 8 – Equity incentive plan (continued)

 

share of time-based vesting stock options granted by us was $41.20 and $40.05 during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company recognized $1.5 million and $1.3 million of stock-based compensation expense in connection with time-based stock options, respectively. As of December 31, 2018, there was $5.7 million of unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to unvested time-based stock options that is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 3.7 years.

Performance-based vesting stock options

Performance-based vesting stock options generally vest upon the satisfaction of performance- and market-based criteria, based on the Principal Stockholders’ (as defined in the 2016 Plan) internal rate of return on their investment in the Company as measured following their sale of at least 70% of the Principal Stockholders total holdings in the Company, and expire ten years from the date of grant. The weighted-average fair value per share of performance-based vesting stock options granted by us was $41.20 and $40.05 during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

As of December 31, 2018, no stock-based compensation expense had been recognized for stock options with performance-based vesting conditions due to a qualifying event for the awards’ performance-based vesting component not being considered probable as of that date. The total unrecognized stock-based compensation expense relating to these awards was $8.0 million as of December 31, 2018.

Award Valuation

The Company used valuation models to value both time and performance-based vesting stock options granted during 2018 and 2017. The following table summarizes the assumptions used in the valuation models to determine the fair value of awards granted to employees and non- employees under the 2016 Plan:

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
    Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Expected volatility

     35.51 – 36.39     35.72 – 36.31

Expected term (in years)

     6.5       6.5  

Dividend yield

     0     0

Risk free interest rate

     2.59 – 2.89     1.93 – 2.27

A discussion of management’s methodology for developing each of the assumptions used in the valuation model follows:

 

   

Expected volatility – Volatility is a measure of the amount by which a financial variable such as a share price has fluctuated (historical volatility) or is expected to fluctuate (expected volatility) during a period. The Company uses an estimated volatility based on the historical and implied volatilities of comparable companies.

 

   

Expected term – This is the period that the options granted are expected to remain unexercised. For options granted during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company derived the expected life of the option based on the average midpoint between vesting and the contractual term as there is little exercise history.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 8 – Equity incentive plan (continued)

 

   

Dividend yield – The Company has never declared or paid dividends and have no plans to do so in the foreseeable future.

 

   

Risk-free interest rate – This is the U.S. Treasury rate for securities with similar terms that most closely resembles the expected life of the option.

Stock award activity

During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company granted to certain non- employee directors 6,500 and 6,500 stock awards, respectively. These stock awards were issued to non-employee directors in satisfaction of their annual retainer payments and are not subject to any vesting conditions, and thus became issued and outstanding shares on the grant date. Accordingly, the Company recognized the grant-date fair value of the stock awards of $0.6 million and $0.7 million as stock-based compensation expense concurrent with the grant date of the awards during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Stock-based compensation expense

Stock-based compensation expense is included in the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss within the following line items (in thousands):

 

     December 31,  
     2018      2017  

Cost of revenues

   $ 869      $ 844  

General and administrative

     1,023        886  

Research and development

     14        14  

Sales and marketing

     219        244  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,125      $ 1,988  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted stock units

Certain employees may be eligible to receive restricted stock unit awards in the event of an IPO (as defined in the respective employment agreements) with a market value equal to the greater of (1) $3.5 million or (2) an amount determined using a formula-based model (as defined in the respective employment agreements), as of the date of such grants.

Note 9 – Equity

The Company is authorized to issue up to five million (5,000,000) shares of common stock, $0.01 par value per share (the “Common Stock”). Each holder of Common Stock is entitled to one vote for each share of common stock held on all matters submitted to a vote of stockholders. The holders of the Common Stock are entitled to receive dividends out of assets legally available at the time and in the amounts as the Company’s Board of Directors may from time to time determine. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of LD Topco, the assets of LD Topco shall be distributed ratably among the holders of the then outstanding Common Stock.

During 2018, the Company issued 407,635 shares of common stock in exchange for $39.2 million.

 

F-62


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 9 – Equity (continued)

 

During 2017, the Company issued 213,150 shares of common stock in exchange for $21.3 million, of which $1.3 million was received subsequent to December 31, 2017. The Company recorded a subscription stock receivable of $1.3 million as of December 31, 2017, which was paid in 2018.

Note 10 – Earnings (loss) per share

Basic earnings (loss) per common share (“EPS”) is calculated by dividing the net earnings (loss) for the fiscal year by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Due to the Company’s net loss for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, all potential common stock equivalents were anti-dilutive.

The following table summarizes basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share or the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 (in thousands, except per share amounts).

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2018
    Year Ended
December 31,
2017
 

Basic and diluted loss per share:

    

Net loss

   $ (67,739   $ (72,218
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding – basic

     3,477,752       3,071,256  

Dilutive effect of potentially issuable shares

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding – diluted

     3,477,752       3,071,256  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic loss per share

   $ (19.48   $ (23.51

Dilutive effect of potentially issuable shares

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted loss per share

   $ (19.48   $ (23.51
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common share equivalents excluded due to anti-dilutive effect

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Note 11 – Foreign currency

The Company had immaterial foreign currency losses that are reflected in “Other expense” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss for years December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Transaction gains and losses, both realized and unrealized, relate to the remeasurement or settlement of monetary assets and liabilities that are denominated in a currency other than an entity’s functional currency. These monetary assets and liabilities include cash as well as third party receivables and payables.

 

F-63


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

 

Note 12 – Income taxes

The components of income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 are presented below (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
     Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Current

     

Federal

   $ —        $ —    

State

     —          42  

Foreign

     2,808        924  

Deferred

     

Federal

     (4,049      2,555  

State

     49        1,298  

Foreign

     (2,549      (1,371
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total income tax (benefit) provision

   $ (3,741    $ 3,448  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The actual income tax expense amounts for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 differed from the expected tax amounts computed by applying the U.S. federal corporate income tax rate of 21% (35% for 2017) to the amounts of loss before income taxes as presented below (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
    Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Pre-tax book loss

   $ (71,480   $ (68,770

Tax at Federal statutory rate of 21% (2018) and 35% (2017)

     (15,011     (24,070

State taxes

     49       (150

Foreign rate differential

     (713     (429

Contingent consideration

     (255     (592

Deferred rate change

     (80     529  

TCJA impact

     (7,712     (3,321

Other adjustments

     1,833       3,258  

Valuation allowance

     18,148       28,223  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax (benefit) provision

   $ (3,741   $ 3,448  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The domestic and foreign components of loss before income taxes from continuing operations for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 are as follows (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2018
     Year Ended
December 31,
2017
 

Domestic

   $ (65,356    $ (64,890

Foreign

     (6,124      (3,880
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ (71,480    $ (68,770
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-64


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 12 – Income taxes (continued)

 

The tax effects of temporary differences at December 31, 2018 and 2017 are as follows (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
     Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Net operating losses and other carryforwards

   $ 38,010      $ 33,103  

Interest expense carryforward

     9,276        —    

Accrued expenses

     701        1,305  

Allowance for doubtful accounts

     1,194        1,039  

Stock-based compensation

     916        528  

Other

     1,028        853  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax asset

     51,125        36,828  

Valuation allowance

     (36,595      (22,513
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance

     14,530        14,315  

Property and equipment

     (510      (3,515

Intangible assets

     (19,283      (20,769

Prepaid expenses

     (812      (1,642

Other

     —          (1,150
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liability

     (20,605      (27,076
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net deferred tax liability

   $ (6,075    $ (12,761
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

On December 22, 2017, U.S. tax reform legislation known as the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the “TCJA”) was signed into law. As of December 31, 2018, the Company’s accounting for the TCJA has been completed. The Company has determined the effects of certain provisions, including but not limited to: a reduction in the corporate tax rate from 35% to 21%, a limitation on the current deductibility of net interest expense in excess of 30% of adjusted taxable income (“163j interest limitation”), a limitation of net operating losses generated after 2017 to 80% of taxable income, an incremental tax (base erosion anti-abuse or “BEAT”) on excessive amounts paid to foreign related parties, and a minimum tax on certain foreign earnings in excess of 10% of the foreign subsidiaries tangible assets (global intangible low taxed income or “GILTI”). The impact of the rate change was accounted for as of December 31, 2017, the result was the Company’s net U.S. deferred tax assets (before valuation allowance) was a decreased by $7.8 million. However, due to the Company’s valuation allowance position in the U.S., the income statement impact of the rate change was an income tax benefit of $3.3 million. In 2017, taxpayers were provided a one-year measurement period to complete their accounting for income tax effects of TCJA under SAB 118. In March 2018, the Company completed its accounting for the income tax effects within the SAB 118 measurement period and recorded an additional tax benefit of approximately $4.3 million primarily related to a valuation allowance release, due to net operating losses with unlimited carryforward periods.

During 2018, the Company considered indefinite lived assets as a source of taxable income to realize $3.4 million of the 163j deferred tax asset. Given the Company’s historic revenue position and the valuation allowance recorded against its U.S. net deferred tax assets, the Company does not believe the BEAT or GILTI provisions will have a material impact on its financial statements. As part of its GILTI review, the Company has determined that it will account for GILTI income as it is generated (i.e., treat it as a period expense).

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company had tax effected U.S. federal net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $29.0 million and $25.5 million, respectively. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company had

 

F-65


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 12 – Income taxes (continued)

 

tax effected state net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $6.6 million and $5.2 million, respectively. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company also had U.S. tax credit carryforwards of approximately $0.9 million and $0.9 million, respectively. The net operating loss and credit carryforwards, if not used, will begin to expire in 2024

The tax effected foreign net operating loss at December 31, 2018 and 2017 is approximately $1.5 million and $1.5 million, respectively, the majority of which has an unlimited carryforward period.

Under Internal Revenue Code Section 382, certain stock transactions which significantly change ownership could limit the amount of net operating loss carryforwards and credits that may be utilized on an annual basis to offset taxable income in future periods. The net operating loss carryovers earned by Renew Data Corp., prior to their acquisition by LDiscovery, LLC are subject to such limitation, which could result in the expiration of the loss carryforwards and credit carryforwards before their associated benefits are realized. In accordance with Section 382, the Company has estimated the NOL and credit carryforwards are subject to an annual limitation of approximately $1.3 million. The NOL limitation may increase approximately $13.2 million as a result of built-in gains realized during the five-year period following the ownership change.

The Company operates in multiple tax jurisdictions and, in the normal course of business, its tax returns are subject to examination by various taxing authorities. Such examinations may result in future assessments by these taxing authorities. The Company is subject to examination by U.S. tax authorities beginning with the year ended December 31, 2014. The Company is also subject to examination in various foreign jurisdictions. In material foreign jurisdictions, the statute of limitations ranges one – four years from the filing of a tax return.

No provision was made for U.S. taxes on the undistributed earnings of the foreign subsidiaries, as such earnings are considered to be permanently reinvested. Such earnings have been, and will continue to be, reinvested, but could become subject to additional tax, if they were remitted as dividends, loaned to the Company, or if the Company should sell its stock in the foreign subsidiaries. It is not practicable to determine the amount of additional tax, if any, that might be payable on the undistributed foreign earnings.

Valuation Allowance

As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company had a valuation allowance of $36.6 million and $22.5 million, respectively, against certain deferred tax assets. The valuation allowance relates to the deferred tax assets of the Company’s U.S. entities, including federal and state tax attributes and timing differences, as well as the deferred tax assets of certain foreign subsidiaries. The increase in the valuation allowance during 2018 is primarily related to operating losses incurred during the year and the limitation on deductibility of interest expense. To the extent the Company determines that, based on the weight of available evidence, all or a portion of its valuation allowance is no longer necessary, the Company will recognize an income tax benefit in the period such determination is made for the reversal of the valuation allowance. If management determines that, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more-likely-than-not that all or a portion of the net deferred tax assets will not be realized; the Company may recognize income tax expense in the period such determination is made to increase the valuation allowance. It is possible that such reduction of or addition to the Company’s valuation allowance may have a material impact on the Company’s results from operations.

 

F-66


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 12 – Income taxes (continued)

 

A summary of the deferred tax asset valuation allowance is as follows:

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
     Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Beginning Balance

   $ 22,513      $ 3,385  

Additions

   $ 22,636      $ 30,228  

Reductions

     (8,554      (11,100
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 36,595      $ 22,513  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 13 – Severance and retention

In connection with the Company’s continued integration and realignment efforts following the 2016 acquisition of Kroll Ontrack, LLC, the Company recorded severance and retention expense during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 of $1.4 and $5.1 million, respectively, comprised of employee severance and other employee-related costs associated with a reduction in workforce of 47 and 114 employees for 2018 and 2017, respectively. Severance and retention expense is included in the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss as follows:

 

     Year Ended
December 31, 2018
     Year Ended
December 31, 2017
 

Costs of revenues

   $ 8      $ 2,810  

General and administrative

     799        1,794  

Sales and marketing

     616        448  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,423      $ 5,052  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2018, approximately $0.6 million remained payable.

The activity and balance of severance-related liabilities, which are recorded within Accounts payable and accrued expense in our Consolidated Balance Sheet, are as follows (in thousands):

 

Balance at December 31, 2016

   $ 381  

Payments

     (4,362

Expense

     5,052  
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2017

   $ 1,071  

Payments

     (1,939

Expense

     1,423  
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2018

   $ 555  
  

 

 

 

Note 14 – Commitments and contingencies

The Company is involved in various legal proceedings, which may arise occasionally in the normal course of business. While the ultimate results of such matters generally cannot be predicted with certainty, management does not expect such matters to have a material effect on the financial position and results of operations as of December 31, 2018.

 

F-67


Table of Contents

LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

Note 14 – Commitments and contingencies (continued)

 

The Company has four letters of credit as additional security for lease guarantees as follows; $0.6 million for the location in Eden Prairie, Minnesota, $0.3 million for the location in Rutherford, NJ, $0.3 million for the location in Austin, Texas and $0.1 million for the location in Toronto, Canada.

Note 15 – Related parties

On December 22, 2015, the Company entered into a consulting agreement with Carlyle Investment Management, LLC, an affiliate of Carlyle, for advisory, consulting and other services in relation to the strategic and financial management of the Company. For each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company recognized $1.0 million in management consulting fees, reflected within “General and administrative expenses” in the accompanying consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss. As of December 31, 2018, approximately $2.3 million remained payable.

Note 16 – Subsequent events

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through June 19, 2019, the date on which these financial statements were issued, and identified the item below for discussion

On May 20, 2019, the Company entered into a merger agreement (“Merger Agreement”) with Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a publicly traded company (“Pivotal”), As a result of the merger, the Company will become a wholly-owned subsidiary of Pivotal, with the stockholders of the Company becoming securityholders of Pivotal.

Under the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of the Company will receive an aggregate of 34,800,000 shares of Pivotal common stock. The stockholders of the Company will also have the right to receive up to 2,200,000 shares of Pivotal common stock if the reported closing sale price of Pivotal’s common stock exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any 20 consecutive trading days during the five-year period following the closing of the Merger.

The boards of directors of both the Company and Pivotal have unanimously approved the proposed transaction. Completion of the transaction, which is expected in the third quarter of 2019, is subject to approval by Pivotal stockholders and other customary closing conditions.

 

F-68


Table of Contents

Annex A

AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF REORGANIZATION

BY AND AMONG

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.,

PIVOTAL MERGER SUB CORP.,

LD TOPCO, INC.

and

CARLYLE EQUITY OPPORTUNITY GP, L.P. (SOLELY AS REPRESENTATIVE OF

THE STOCKHOLDERS OF LD TOPCO, INC.)

DATED AS OF MAY 20, 2019

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

                     Page  

Article I THE MERGER

     1  

        

 

1.1

  

The Merger

     1  
 

1.2

  

Effective Time; Closing

     1  
 

1.3

  

Effect of the Merger

     2  
 

1.4

  

Governing Documents

     2  
 

1.5

  

Effect on Securities

     2  
 

1.6

  

Merger Consideration Exchange Procedures

     2  
 

1.7

  

Lost, Stolen or Destroyed Certificates

     3  
 

1.8

  

Tax Consequences

     4  
 

1.9

  

Taking of Necessary Action; Further Action

     4  
 

1.10

  

Representative

     4  
 

1.11

  

Outstanding Company Derivative Securities

     4  
 

1.12

  

Contingent Shares

     4  
 

1.13

  

Payment of Expenses

     5  
 

1.14

  

Support Agreements

     5  

Article II REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES REGARDING THE COMPANY

     5  
 

2.1

  

Organization and Qualification

     5  
 

2.2

  

Subsidiaries

     6  
 

2.3

  

Capitalization

     6  
 

2.4

  

Authority Relative to this Agreement

     7  
 

2.5

  

No Conflict; Required Filings and Consents

     8  
 

2.6

  

Compliance

     8  
 

2.7

  

Financial Statements

     9  
 

2.8

  

No Undisclosed Liabilities

     9  
 

2.9

  

Absence of Certain Changes or Events

     9  
 

2.10

  

Litigation

     10  
 

2.11

  

Employee Benefit Plans

     10  
 

2.12

  

Labor Matters

     11  
 

2.13

  

Restrictions on Business Activities

     11  
 

2.14

  

Title to Property

     11  
 

2.15

  

Taxes

     12  
 

2.16

  

Environmental Matters

     13  
 

2.17

  

Brokers; Third Party Expenses

     13  
 

2.18

  

Intellectual Property

     13  
 

2.19

  

Agreements, Contracts and Commitments

     14  
 

2.20

  

Insurance

     15  
 

2.21

  

Governmental Actions/Filings

     15  
 

2.22

  

Interested Party Transactions

     16  
 

2.23

  

Board Approval

     16  
 

2.24

  

Proxy Statement

     16  
 

2.25

  

No Additional Representations and Warranties

     16  

Article III REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF PARENT AND MERGER SUB

     16  
 

3.1

  

Organization and Qualification

     16  
 

3.2

  

Subsidiaries

     17  

 

i


Table of Contents
                     Page  
 

3.3

  

Capitalization

     17  
 

3.4

  

Authority Relative to this Agreement

     18  
 

3.5

  

No Conflict; Required Filings and Consents

     18  
 

3.6

  

Compliance

     19  
 

3.7

  

Parent SEC Reports and Financial Statements

     19  
 

3.8

  

No Undisclosed Liabilities

     20  
 

3.9

  

Absence of Certain Changes or Events

     20  
 

3.10

  

Litigation

     21  
 

3.11

  

Employee Benefit Plans

     21  
 

3.12

  

Labor Matters

     21  
 

3.13

  

Business Activities

     21  
 

3.14

  

Title to Property

     21  
 

3.15

  

Intellectual Property

     21  
 

3.16

  

Taxes

     21  
 

3.17

  

Environmental Matters

     22  
 

3.18

  

Brokers

     22  
 

3.19

  

Agreements, Contracts and Commitments

     22  
 

3.20

  

Insurance

     23  
 

3.21

  

Interested Party Transactions

     23  
 

3.22

  

Parent Listing

     23  
 

3.23

  

Board Approval

     23  
 

3.24

  

Trust Fund

     23  
 

3.25

  

Fairness Opinion

     24  
 

3.26

  

No Additional Representations and Warranties

     24  

Article IV CONDUCT PRIOR TO THE EFFECTIVE TIME

     24  
 

4.1

  

Conduct of Business by the Company, Parent and Merger Sub

     24  
 

4.2

  

Confidentiality; Access to Information

     27  
 

4.3

  

No Solicitation

     28  
 

4.4

  

Certain Financial Information

     28  
 

4.5

  

Access to Financial Information

     29  
 

4.6

  

Commercially Reasonable Efforts

     29  

Article V ADDITIONAL AGREEMENTS

     29  
 

5.1

  

Proxy Statement; Special Meeting

     29  
 

5.2

  

Directors and Officers of Parent and the Company After Merger

     30  
 

5.3

  

HSR Act

     31  
 

5.4

  

Public Announcements

     31  
 

5.5

  

Required Information

     31  
 

5.6

  

No Securities Transactions

     32  
 

5.7

  

No Claim Against Trust Fund

     32  
 

5.8

  

Disclosure of Certain Matters

     33  
 

5.9

  

Securities Listing

     33  
 

5.10

  

Charter Protections; Directors’ and Officers’ Liability Insurance

     33  
 

5.11

  

Insider Loans

     33  
 

5.12

  

Parent Borrowings

     34  
 

5.13

  

Trust Fund Disbursement

     34  
 

5.14

  

Parent Stockholders Agreement

     34  
 

5.15

  

Lock-Up Agreements

     34  

 

ii


Table of Contents
                     Page  
 

5.16

  

Registration Rights Agreement

     34  
 

5.17

  

Founder Common Stock Lock-Up

     34  
 

5.18

  

Intended Tax Treatment

     35  
 

5.19

  

Incentive Equity Plan

     35  
 

5.20

  

Company Stockholder Approval

     35  

Article VI CONDITIONS TO THE TRANSACTION

     35  
 

6.1

  

Conditions to Obligations of Each Party to Effect the Merger

     35  
 

6.2

  

Additional Conditions to Obligations of the Company

     36  
 

6.3

  

Additional Conditions to the Obligations of Parent and Merger Sub

     37  

Article VII TERMINATION

     38  
 

7.1

  

Termination

     38  
 

7.2

  

Notice of Termination; Effect of Termination

     38  
 

7.3

  

Fees and Expenses

     39  

Article VIII GENERAL PROVISIONS

     39  
 

8.1

  

Notices

     39  
 

8.2

  

Interpretation

     40  
 

8.3

  

Counterparts; Electronic Delivery

     44  
 

8.4

  

Entire Agreement; Third Party Beneficiaries

     44  
 

8.5

  

Severability

     44  
 

8.6

  

Other Remedies; Specific Performance

     44  
 

8.7

  

Governing Law

     44  
 

8.8

  

Consent to Jurisdiction; WAIVER OF TRIAL BY JURY

     44  
 

8.9

  

Rules of Construction

     45  
 

8.10

  

Assignment

     45  
 

8.11

  

Amendment

     45  
 

8.12

  

Extension; Waiver

     45  
 

8.13

  

Currency

     45  
 

8.14

  

Schedules

     45  
 

8.15

  

Nonsurvival of Representations, Warranties and Covenants

     45  
 

8.16

  

Non-Recourse

     46  

 

iii


Table of Contents

AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF REORGANIZATION

THIS AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF REORGANIZATION is made and entered into as of May 20, 2019, by and among Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (“ Parent ”), Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Parent (“ Merger Sub ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ Company ”), and Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership, solely in its capacity as the initial Representative hereunder. The term “ Agreement ” as used herein refers to this Agreement and Plan of Reorganization, as the same may be amended from time to time, and all schedules hereto (including the Company Schedule and the Parent Schedule, as defined in the preambles to Articles II and III hereof, respectively). Each of Parent, Merger Sub, the Company and the Representative shall be referred to herein, individually, as a “ Party ” and, collectively, as the “ Parties ”. Except as otherwise indicated, capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined shall have the meanings ascribed to them in Section  8.2 .

RECITALS

A.    Upon the terms and subject to the conditions of this Agreement and in accordance with the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “ DGCL ”), the Parties intend to enter into a business combination transaction by which Merger Sub will merge with and into the Company (with the Company being the surviving entity of the Merger (“ Surviving Corporation ”)) in exchange for the Company’s stockholders receiving shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of the Parent (“ Parent Common Stock ”) as provided by this Agreement (the “ Merger ”).

B.    The boards of directors of each of Parent, Merger Sub and the Company have determined that the Merger is fair to, and in the best interests of, their respective companies and their respective stockholders.

C.    The parties intend, by executing this Agreement, to adopt a plan of reorganization within the meaning of Section 368 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the covenants, promises and representations set forth herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

THE MERGER

1.1     The Merger . At the Effective Time and subject to and upon the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the applicable provisions of the DGCL, Merger Sub shall be merged with and into the Company, the separate corporate existence of Merger Sub shall cease and the Company shall continue as the Surviving Corporation after the Merger and as a wholly owned subsidiary of Parent.

1.2     Effective Time; Closing . Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, as soon as practicable on or after the Closing Date (defined below), the parties hereto shall cause the Merger to be consummated by filing a Certificate of Merger (the “ Certificate of Merger ”) with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware, in accordance with the applicable provisions of the DGCL (the time of such filing, or such later time as may be agreed in writing by Company and Parent and specified in the Certificate of Merger, being the “ Effective Time ”). Unless this Agreement shall have been terminated pursuant to Section  7.1 , the consummation of the Merger (the “ Closing ”), other than the filing of the Certificate of Merger, shall take place at the offices of Graubard Miller, counsel to Parent, The Chrysler Building, 405 Lexington Avenue, New York, New York 10174-1901 at a time and date to be specified by the parties, which shall be no later than the fifth (5 th ) Business Day after the

 

1


Table of Contents

satisfaction or waiver of the conditions set forth in Article VI , or at such other time, date and location as the parties hereto agree in writing (the “ Closing Date ”). Closing signatures may be transmitted by facsimile or by email pdf files.

1.3     Effect of the Merger . At the Effective Time, the effect of the Merger shall be as provided in this Agreement and the DGCL. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, and subject thereto, at the Effective Time all the property, rights, privileges, powers and franchises of each of the Company and Merger Sub shall vest in the Surviving Corporation, and all debts, liabilities and duties of each of the Company and Merger Sub shall become the debts, liabilities and duties of the Surviving Corporation.

1.4     Governing Documents . At the Effective Time,

(a)    the Certificate of Incorporation of the Surviving Corporation shall be amended and restated to be identical to the Certificate of Incorporation of Merger Sub except that the name of the Surviving Corporation shall be that of the Company; and

(b)    the Bylaws of the Surviving Corporation shall be amended and restated to be identical to the Bylaws of Merger Sub except that the name of the Surviving Corporation shall be that of the Company.

1.5     Effect on Securities . Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, at the Effective Time, by virtue of the Merger and this Agreement and without any further action on the part of Parent, Merger Sub or the Company or the holders of any of the securities of Parent or the Company, the following shall occur:

(a)     Conversion of Company Stock . Other than any shares to be canceled pursuant to Section  1.5(d) , each share of common stock, par value $0.01 per share, of the Company (“ Company Stock ”) issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Effective Time will be automatically converted, at the Effective Time, into the right to receive that number of shares of Parent Common Stock equal to the Exchange Ratio (the “ Per Share Merger Consideration ”). The aggregate Per Share Merger Consideration shall be paid to the holders of Company Stock (the “ Company Stockholders ”) in the respective amounts set forth on Schedule 1.5(a) hereto; provided that the portion of the Per Share Merger Consideration comprised of Contingent Shares shall only become issuable in accordance with Section  1.12 .

(b)     Adjustments to Merger Consideration . The Per Share Merger Consideration issuable pursuant to this Section  1.5 shall be equitably adjusted to reflect appropriately the effect of any stock split, reverse stock split, stock dividend (including any dividend or distribution of securities convertible into shares of Parent Common Stock), extraordinary cash dividends, reorganization, recapitalization, reclassification, combination, exchange of shares or other like change with respect to shares of Parent Common Stock occurring on or after the date hereof but at or prior to the Effective Time (or, as it relates to the Contingent Shares, prior to the date of issuance of such shares in accordance with Section  1.12 ).

(c)     Fractional Shares . No fraction of a share of Parent Common Stock will be issued by virtue of the Merger, and each holder of shares of Company Stock who would otherwise be entitled to a fraction of a share of Parent Common Stock any time shares of Parent Common Stock are distributed to any such Person pursuant to this Agreement (after aggregating all fractional shares of Parent Common Stock that otherwise would be received by such holder in connection with such distribution) shall, upon compliance with Section  1.6, receive from Parent, in lieu of such fractional share, one (1) share of Parent Common Stock.

(d)     Cancellation of Treasury and Parent-Owned Stock . Each share of Company Stock held by the Company or Parent or any direct or indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Parent immediately prior to the Effective Time shall be canceled and extinguished without any conversion or payment in respect thereof.

1.6     Merger Consideration Exchange Procedures .

(a)     Exchange Procedures . At the Closing, the Company Stockholders shall deliver the certificates evidencing their shares of Company Stock (the “ Company Certificates ”) to Parent for cancellation, or in the case

 

2


Table of Contents

of a lost, stolen or destroyed Company Certificate, will deliver to Parent an affidavit (and indemnity if required) in the manner provided in Section  1.7 below), together with a letter of transmittal in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit A (“ Letter of Transmittal ”), and receive in exchange therefor the Per Share Merger Consideration (other than the Contingent Shares, which shall only become issuable in accordance with Section  1.12 ) and the certificates representing the Company Stock shall forthwith be cancelled. Until so surrendered, outstanding Company Certificates will be deemed, from and after the Effective Time, to evidence only the right to receive the Per Share Merger Consideration as prescribed by this Agreement.

(b)     Distributions With Respect to Unexchanged Shares . No dividends or other distributions declared or made after the date of this Agreement with respect to Parent Common Stock with a record date after the Effective Time will be paid to the holders of any unsurrendered Company Certificates with respect to the Per Share Merger Consideration (including any Contingent Shares, if and when issued) to be issued upon surrender thereof until the holders of record of such Company Certificates shall surrender such certificates. Subject to applicable law, following surrender of any such Company Certificates, Parent shall promptly deliver to the record holders thereof, without interest, the certificates representing the Per Share Merger Consideration (including any Contingent Shares, if and when issued) issued in exchange therefor and the amount of any such dividends or other distributions with a record date after the Effective Time theretofore paid with respect to such Merger Shares (including any Contingent Shares, if and when issued).

(c)     Transfers of Ownership . If certificates representing Merger Shares are to be issued in a name other than that in which the Company Certificates surrendered in exchange therefor are registered, it will be a condition of the issuance thereof that the Company Certificates so surrendered will be properly endorsed and otherwise in proper form for transfer and that the persons requesting such exchange will have paid to Parent or any agent designated by it any transfer or other taxes required by reason of the issuance of certificates representing the Per Share Merger Consideration (including any Contingent Shares, if and when issued) in any name other than that of the registered holder of the Company Certificates surrendered, or established to the satisfaction of Parent or any agent designated by it that such tax has been paid or is not payable.

(d)     Required Withholding . Parent shall be entitled to deduct and withhold (or cause to be deducted and withheld) from any consideration payable or otherwise deliverable pursuant to this Agreement such amounts as are required to be deducted or withheld therefrom under the Code or under any provision of state, local or foreign tax law or under any other applicable legal requirement. Parent shall provide notice of any withholding that it intends to make (or cause to be made) in connection with consideration payable or otherwise deliverable pursuant to this Agreement (other than any withholding required in connection with amounts properly treated as compensation for applicable Tax purposes) at least fifteen (15) days prior to the date of the relevant payment, and the Parties shall (and shall cause their Affiliates to) cooperate to minimize or eliminate any potential withholding. To the extent such amounts are so deducted or withheld consistent with the terms of this Section  1.6(d) , such amounts shall be treated for all purposes under this Agreement as having been paid to the person to whom such amounts would otherwise have been paid.

(e)     No Further Ownership Rights in Company Stock . All shares of Parent Common Stock issued in accordance with the terms hereof shall be deemed to have been issued in full satisfaction of all rights pertaining to the Company Stock and there shall be no further registration of transfers on the records of the Surviving Corporation of the shares of Company Stock that were outstanding immediately prior to the Effective Time. If, after the Effective Time, Company Certificates are presented to the Surviving Corporation for any reason, they shall be canceled and exchanged as provided in this Article I .

1.7     Lost, Stolen or Destroyed Certificates . In the event that any Company Certificates shall have been lost, stolen or destroyed, Parent shall issue in exchange for such lost, stolen or destroyed Company Certificates, upon the making of an affidavit of that fact by the holder thereof, the aggregate Per Share Merger Consideration into which the shares of Company Stock formerly represented by such Company Certificates was converted into and any dividends or distributions payable pursuant to Section  1.6(b) ; provided, however, that, as a condition

 

3


Table of Contents

precedent to the delivery of such Per Share Merger Consideration, the owner of such lost, stolen or destroyed Company Certificates shall indemnify Parent against any claim that may be made against Parent or Surviving Corporation with respect to the Company Certificates alleged to have been lost, stolen or destroyed and deliver any Letter of Transmittal reasonably required by Parent.

1.8     Tax Consequences . It is intended by the parties hereto that the Merger shall constitute reorganization within the meaning of Section 368 of the Code. The parties hereto adopt this Agreement as a “plan of reorganization” within the meaning of Sections 1.368-2(g) and 1.368-3(a) of the United States Income Tax Regulations.

1.9     Taking of Necessary Action; Further Action . If, at any time after the Effective Time, any further action is necessary or desirable to carry out the purposes of this Agreement and to vest Surviving Corporation with full right, title and possession to all assets, property, rights, privileges, powers and franchises of the Company and Merger Sub, the officers and directors of the Company and Merger Sub will take all such lawful and necessary action.

1.10     Representative . The Company has designated Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P. as the initial representative (the “ Representative ”) to represent the interests of the Persons entitled to receive Per Share Merger Consideration as a result of the Merger, giving consents and approvals hereunder (including amendments of this Agreement) and making those determinations hereunder that are specifically reserved to the Representative by the terms hereof. If such Person ceases to serve in such capacity, for any reason, the Company (or, following the Closing, those members of the board of directors of Parent who were members of the board of directors of the Company prior to the Closing) shall appoint its successor. The Representative shall (a) have no liability to Parent, the Company, any Subsidiary or Affiliate of the foregoing or any equityholder of any of the foregoing (including any Stockholder) with respect to actions taken or omitted to be taken in its capacity as the Representative, except as agreed to by the Stockholders in the Letter of Transmittal, and (b) be entitled to indemnification by the Company against any loss, liability or expenses arising out of actions taken or omitted to be taken in its capacity as the Representative (except as agreed to by the Stockholders in the Letter of Transmittal).

1.11     Outstanding Company Derivative Securities . The holders of all outstanding options, warrants and other derivative securities of the Company have executed agreements to exercise such securities prior to the Effective Time without the payment of any consideration therefor by the Company other than the issuance of Company Stock, it being the intention of the parties that the only securities of the Company outstanding on the Closing Date shall be Company Stock. Such exercises may be made contingent upon the occurrence of the Closing. Effective as of the Effective Time, each Company Stock Option, to the extent then outstanding and unexercised will be automatically cancelled without consideration and without any liability to the Company.

1.12     Contingent Shares . The Company Stockholders shall be issued their pro rata portion of an aggregate of 2,200,000 Contingent Shares if the reported closing sale price of the Parent Common Stock equals or exceeds $13.50 per share (as adjusted for stock splits, stock dividends, reorganizations, recapitalizations or other similar actions) for any consecutive twenty (20) trading days during the five (5) year period following the Closing Date. Contingent Shares shall be issued within ten days after such condition has been satisfied with no action being required on the part of the Company Stockholders (and the Parties hereby agree that the rights to receive the Contingent Shares shall not be evidenced by negotiable certificates, and the Parties will not take any action to make such rights “readily marketable” (as such term is used in Revenue Procedure 84-42)). Any Contingent Shares payable hereunder shall be treated as comprised of two components, respectively a principal component and an interest component, the amounts of which shall be determined as provided in Treasury Regulation Section 1.483-4(b) example (2) using the 3-month test rate of interest provided for in Treasury Regulation Section 1.1274-4(a)(1)(ii) employing the semi-annual compounding period. As to any such payment of Contingent Shares to each former holder of Company stock, shares representing the principal component (with a value equal to the principal component) and shares representing the interest component (with a value equal to the interest component) shall be represented by separate share certificates.

 

4


Table of Contents

1.13     Payment of Expenses .

(a)    At least three (3) Business Days prior to the Closing Date, the Company shall provide to Parent a written report setting forth a list of all third party fees and expenses incurred by the Company or the Stockholders in connection with or in relation to the preparation, negotiation and execution of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby (together with written invoices and wire transfer instructions for the payment thereof), solely to the extent such fees and expenses will be unpaid as of the close of business on the Business Day immediately preceding the Closing Date, including, but not limited to, the: (i) fees and disbursements of outside counsel to the Company, the Representative and Company management incurred in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby and (ii) fees and expenses of any other agents, advisors, consultants, experts, financial advisors, brokers, finders or investment bankers employed by the Company or the Representative in connection with the with the transactions contemplated hereby (collectively, the “ Outstanding Company Expenses ”). On the Closing Date following the Closing, Parent shall pay or cause to be paid by wire transfer of immediately available funds the Outstanding Company Expenses.

(b)    At least three (3) Business Days prior to the Closing Date, Parent shall provide to the Company and the Representative a written report setting forth a list of all third party fees and expenses incurred by Parent and Merger Sub in connection with or in relation to the preparation, negotiation and execution of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby (together with written invoices and wire transfer instructions for the payment thereof), solely to the extent such fees and expenses will be unpaid as of the close of business on the Business Day immediately preceding the Closing Date, including, but not limited to, the: (i) fees and disbursements of outside counsel to Parent and Merger Sub incurred in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby, (ii) fees and expenses of Parent and Merger Sub for any other agents, advisors, consultants, experts, financial advisors, brokers, finders or investment bankers employed in connection with the with the transactions contemplated hereby, including any financing related to the transactions contemplated hereby, (iii) the aggregate amount of Parent Borrowings and (iv) without duplication, any other amounts described in clauses (ii) and (iii) of Section  5.13 (all of the foregoing, collectively, the “ Outstanding Parent Expenses ”). On the Closing Date, Parent shall pay or cause to be paid by wire transfer of immediately available funds the Outstanding Parent Expenses. For avoidance of doubt, such Outstanding Parent Expenses shall be payable by Parent from amounts released from the Trust Account following the Closing.

1.14     Support Agreements . Concurrently with the execution of this Agreement, the stockholders of the Company identified on Schedule 1.14 attached hereto (the “ Supporting Stockholders ”) have entered into support agreements with Parent (the “ Support Agreements ”), pursuant to which each of the Supporting Stockholders has agreed, among other things, to vote all of the shares of Company Stock beneficially owned by such Supporting Stockholder in favor of the Merger (which vote may be done by executing a written consent as provided for in Section  5.20 hereof).

ARTICLE II

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES REGARDING THE COMPANY

Subject to the exceptions set forth in Schedule 2 attached hereto (the “ Company Schedule ”), the Company hereby represents and warrants to Parent and Merger Sub as follows:

2.1     Organization and Qualification .

(a)    The Company is a corporation duly incorporated, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware and has the requisite corporate power and authority to own, lease and operate its assets and properties and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted. The Company is in possession of all franchises, grants, authorizations, licenses, permits, easements, consents, certificates, approvals and orders of

 

5


Table of Contents

or from any federal, state, municipal, foreign or other governmental, administrative or judicial body, agency or authority (“ Approvals ”) necessary to own, lease and operate the properties it purports to own, operate or lease and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted, except where the failure to have such Approvals would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Complete and correct copies of the certificate of incorporation and by-laws (or other comparable governing instruments with different names) (collectively referred to herein as “ Charter Documents ”) of the Company, as amended and currently in effect, have been heretofore made available to Parent or Parent’s counsel.

(b)    The Company is duly qualified or licensed to do business as a foreign corporation and is in good standing in each jurisdiction where the character of the properties owned, leased or operated by it or the nature of its activities makes such qualification or licensing necessary, except for such failures to be so duly qualified or licensed and in good standing that would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Each jurisdiction in which the Company is so qualified or licensed is listed in Schedule 2.1(b) .

2.2     Subsidiaries .

(a)    The Company has no direct or indirect subsidiaries other than those listed in Schedule 2.2 (the “ Subsidiaries ”). Except as set forth in Schedule 2.2 , the Company owns all of the outstanding equity securities of the Subsidiaries, free and clear of all Liens other than Permitted Liens, either directly or indirectly through one or more other Subsidiaries. Except with respect to the Subsidiaries, the Company does not own, directly or indirectly, any equity or voting interest in any Person or has any agreement or commitment to purchase any such interest, and has not agreed and is not obligated to make nor is bound by any written or oral agreement, contract, subcontract, lease, binding understanding, instrument, note, option, warranty, purchase order, license, sublicense, insurance policy, benefit plan, commitment or undertaking of any nature, as of the date hereof or as may hereafter be in effect, under which it may become obligated to make any future investment in or capital contribution to any other entity.

(b)    Each Subsidiary that is a corporation is duly incorporated, validly existing and in good standing (or the equivalent thereof) under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation (as listed in Schedule 2.2 ) and has the requisite corporate power and authority to own, lease and operate its assets and properties and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted. Each Subsidiary that is a limited liability company is duly organized or formed, validly existing and in good standing (or the equivalent thereof) under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization or formation (as listed in Schedule 2.2 ) and has the requisite limited liability company power and authority to own, lease and operate its assets and properties and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted. Each Subsidiary is in possession of all Approvals necessary to own, lease and operate the properties it purports to own, operate or lease and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted, except where the failure to have such Approvals would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Complete and correct copies of the Charter Documents of each Subsidiary, as amended and currently in effect, have been heretofore delivered to Parent or Parent’s counsel.

(c)    Each Subsidiary is duly qualified or licensed to do business as a foreign corporation or foreign limited liability company and is in good standing in each jurisdiction where the character of the properties owned, leased or operated by it or the nature of its activities makes such qualification or licensing necessary, except for such failures to be so duly qualified or licensed and in good standing that would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

2.3     Capitalization .

(a)    The authorized capital stock of the Company consists of 5,000,000 shares of Company Stock, of which 3,692,105 shares are issued and outstanding as of the date of this Agreement and all of which are validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable. Other than Company Stock, the Company has no class or series of securities

 

6


Table of Contents

authorized by its Charter Documents. Schedule 2.3(a) hereto contains a list of all of the stockholders of the Company and the number of shares of Company Stock owned by each stockholder, as of the date of this Agreement.

(b)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.3(b) hereto, as of the date of this Agreement, no shares of Company Stock are reserved for issuance upon the exercise of outstanding Company Stock Options. No shares of Company Stock are reserved for issuance upon the exercise of outstanding warrants or other rights (other than Company Stock Options) to purchase Company Stock . All shares of Company Stock subject to issuance as aforesaid, upon issuance on the terms and conditions specified in the instrument pursuant to which they are issuable, will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable. All outstanding shares of Company Stock have been issued and granted in compliance with (x) all applicable securities laws and (in all material respects) other applicable laws and regulations, and (y) all requirements set forth in any applicable Charter Documents. The Company has heretofore delivered to Parent or Parent’s counsel a true and complete list of the holders of each Company Stock Option, including their names and the numbers of shares of Company Stock underlying such holders’ Company Stock Options.

(c)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.3(b) or Schedule 2.3(c) hereto or as set forth in Section  2.3(a) hereof, as of the date of this Agreement, there are no subscriptions, options, warrants, equity securities, partnership interests or similar ownership interests, calls, rights (including preemptive rights), commitments or agreements of any character to which the Company is a party or by which it is bound obligating the Company to issue, deliver or sell, or cause to be issued, delivered or sold, or repurchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, or cause the repurchase, redemption or acquisition of, any shares of capital stock, partnership interests or similar ownership interests of the Company or obligating the Company to grant, extend, accelerate the vesting of or enter into any such subscription, option, warrant, equity security, call, right, commitment or agreement. Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary has any outstanding bonds, debentures, notes or other obligations the holders of which have the right to vote (or which are convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for securities having the right to vote) with the stockholders of the Company on any matter.

(d)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.3(d) or as contemplated by this Agreement, there are no registration rights, and there is no voting trust, proxy, rights plan, anti-takeover plan or other agreements or understandings, to which the Company is a party or by which the Company is bound with respect to any equity security of the Company.

(e)    Except as provided for in this Agreement or as set forth in Schedule  2.3(e) , as a result of the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby, no shares of capital stock, warrants, options or other securities of the Company are issuable and no rights in connection with any shares, warrants, options or other securities of the Company accelerate or otherwise become triggered (whether as to vesting, exercisability, convertibility or otherwise).

(f)    No outstanding shares of Company Stock are unvested or subjected to a repurchase option, risk of forfeiture or other condition under any applicable agreement with the Company.

2.4     Authority Relative to this Agreement . The Company has all necessary corporate power and authority to: (i) execute, deliver and perform this Agreement and each ancillary document that the Company has executed or delivered or is to execute or deliver pursuant to this Agreement, and (ii) carry out the Company’s obligations hereunder and thereunder and to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby (including the Merger). The execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Company and the consummation by the Company of the transactions contemplated hereby (including the Merger) have been, or will be, duly and validly authorized by all necessary corporate action on the part of the Company (including the approval by its board of directors and, prior to the Closing, its stockholders as required by the DGCL), and no other corporate proceedings on the part of the Company are necessary to authorize this Agreement or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby. The affirmative vote of the Supporting Stockholders to approve this Agreement, the Merger and the other

 

7


Table of Contents

transactions contemplated by this Agreement will be sufficient to obtain the Company Stockholder Approval. This Agreement has been duly and validly executed and delivered by the Company and, assuming the due authorization, execution and delivery thereof by the other parties hereto, constitutes the legal and binding obligation of the Company, enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms, except as may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity.

2.5     No Conflict; Required Filings and Consents . Except as set forth in Schedule 2.5 hereto:

(a)    The execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Company do not, and the performance of this Agreement by the Company shall not, (i) conflict with or violate the Charter Documents of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, (ii) conflict with or violate any Legal Requirements, (iii) result in any breach of or constitute a default (or an event that with notice or lapse of time or both would become a default) under, or materially impair the Company’s or any of its Subsidiaries’ rights or alter the rights or obligations of any third party under, or give to others any rights of termination, amendment, acceleration or cancellation of, or result in the creation of a lien or encumbrance on any of the properties or assets of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (other than Permitted Liens) pursuant to, any Material Company Contracts or (iv) result in the triggering, acceleration or increase of any payment to any Person pursuant to any Company Contract, including any “change in control” or similar provision of any Company Contract, except, with respect to clauses (ii), (iii) and (iv), for any such conflicts, violations, breaches, defaults, impairments, alterations, triggerings, accelerations, increases or other occurrences that would not, individually and in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

(b)    The execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Company does not, and the performance of its obligations hereunder will not, require any consent, approval, authorization or permit of, or filing with or notification to, any Governmental Entity or other third party (including, without limitation, lenders and lessors), except (i) for applicable requirements, if any, of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“ Securities Act ”), the Exchange Act or state securities laws, and the rules and regulations thereunder, and appropriate documents received from or filed with the relevant authorities of other jurisdictions in which the Company is licensed or qualified to do business, (ii) for the filing of any notifications required under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as amended (the “ HSR Act ”), and the expiration of the required waiting period thereunder, (iii) the consents, approvals, authorizations and permits described in Schedule 2.5(b) and (iv) where the failure to obtain such consents, approvals, authorizations or permits, or to make such filings or notifications, would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to (x) have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company or, after the Closing, Parent, or (y) prevent the consummation of the Merger or otherwise prevent the Company from performing its material obligations under this Agreement on a timely basis.

2.6     Compliance . During the past year and as of the date of this Agreement, the Company and each of its Subsidiaries has complied with all, and is not in violation of any, Legal Requirements with respect to the conduct of its business, or the ownership or operation of its business, except for failures to comply or violations which, individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. During the past year and as of the date of this Agreement, the businesses and activities of the Company and of each of its Subsidiaries have not been and are not being conducted in violation of any Legal Requirements, except for violations which, individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries is in default or violation in any material respect of any term, condition or provision of any applicable Charter Documents. Except as set forth in Schedule 2.6 , within the past year, no written notice of non-compliance with any Legal Requirements has been received by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (and the Company has no knowledge of any such notice delivered to any other Person).

 

8


Table of Contents

2.7     Financial Statements .

(a)    The Company has made available to Parent true and complete copies of the audited consolidated financial statements (including any related notes thereto) of the Company and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 (the “ Audited Financial Statements ”) and the unaudited consolidated financial statements (including any related notes thereto) of the Company and its Subsidiaries for the three-month periods ended March 31, 2019 and 2018 (the “ Unaudited Financial Statements ,” and together with the Audited Financial Statements, the “ Financial Statements ”).

(b)    The Financial Statements were prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“ U.S. GAAP ”) applied on a consistent basis in accordance with past practice throughout the periods involved (except as may be indicated therein or in the notes thereto), and fairly present in all material respects the financial position of the Company and its Subsidiaries at the respective dates thereof and the results of their operations and cash flows for the respective periods indicated, except, in the case of the Unaudited Financial Statements, subject to normal audit adjustments that are not expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company and the absence of footnotes.

(c)    The Company has established and maintained a system of internal accounting controls. To the Company’s knowledge, such internal controls are sufficient to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial reporting and the preparation of the Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

(d)    There are no outstanding loans or other extensions of credit made by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to any executive officer (as defined in Rule 3b-7 under the Exchange Act) or director of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries. Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has taken any action prohibited by Section 402 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.

2.8     No Undisclosed Liabilities . As of the date of this Agreement, the Company (including its Subsidiaries) has no material liabilities (absolute, accrued, contingent or otherwise) of a nature required under U.S. GAAP, applied on a consistent basis in accordance with past practice, to be disclosed on a consolidated balance sheet that are, individually or in the aggregate, material to the business, results of operations or financial condition of the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, except: (i) liabilities provided for in or otherwise disclosed in the balance sheet included in the most recent Financial Statements or in the notes to the most recent Financial Statements, (ii) such liabilities arising in the ordinary course of the Company’s business since the date of the most recent Financial Statement and (iii) liabilities disclosed in Schedule 2.8 , none of which, individually or in the aggregate, would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

2.9     Absence of Certain Changes or Events . Except as contemplated by this Agreement, since the date of the most recent Financial Statement to the date of this Agreement, there has not been: (i) any Material Adverse Effect on the Company, (ii) any declaration, setting aside or payment of any dividend on, or other distribution (whether in cash, stock or property) in respect of, any of the Company’s capital stock, or any purchase, redemption or other acquisition by the Company of any of the Company’s capital stock or any other securities of the Company or any options, warrants, calls or rights to acquire any such shares or other securities, (iii) any split, combination or reclassification of any of the Company’s capital stock, (iv) any granting by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries of any increase in compensation or fringe benefits, except for normal increases of cash compensation in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice or pursuant to any Plan, or any payment by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries of any bonus, except for bonuses made in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice or pursuant to any Plan, or any granting by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries of any increase in severance or termination pay or any entry by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries into any currently effective employment, severance, termination or indemnification agreement or any agreement the benefits of which are contingent or the terms of which are materially altered upon the occurrence of a transaction involving the Company of the nature contemplated hereby, (v) entry by the Company

 

9


Table of Contents

or any of its Subsidiaries into any licensing or other agreement with regard to the acquisition or disposition of any material Intellectual Property other than licenses and services agreements in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice or any amendment or consent with respect to any licensing or services agreement, (vi) any material change by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in its accounting methods, principles or practices, except as required by concurrent changes in U.S. GAAP, (vii) any change in the auditors of the Company, or (viii) any material revaluation by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries of any of its material assets, including, without limitation, writing down the value of capitalized inventory or writing off notes or accounts receivable or any sale of assets of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, other than in the ordinary course of business.

2.10     Litigation . Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.10 hereto, during the year prior to the date of this Agreement and as of the date of this Agreement, there have been, and are, no claims, suits, actions or proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Company, threatened against the Company or any of its Subsidiaries before any court, governmental department, commission, agency, instrumentality or authority, or any arbitrator that individually or in the aggregate, would reasonably be expected to be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

2.11     Employee Benefit Plans .

(a)     Schedule 2.11(a) lists all material Plans. “ Plan ” means any “employee benefit plan” as defined in Section 3(3) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended and any other material employee compensation, incentive, fringe or employee benefit plan, program, policy or other arrangement (whether or not set forth in a written document) covering any active or former employee, director or consultant of the Company or its Subsidiaries, in each case, with respect to which the Company or its Subsidiaries has liability, other than (i) standard employment agreements that can be terminated at any time without severance or termination pay and upon notice of not more than 60 days or such longer period as may be required by Legal Requirements, (ii) any plan, program, policy or other arrangement that is sponsored or maintained by a Governmental Entity or (iii) any plan, program, policy or other arrangement that covers only former directors, officers, employees, independent contractors and service providers and with respect to which the Company and its Subsidiaries have no remaining liabilities. Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, all Plans have been maintained and administered in all material respects in compliance with their respective terms and with the Legal Requirements which are applicable to such Plans, and all contributions required to be made with respect to the Plans as of the date hereof have been made or, if not yet due, are reflected in the financial statements and records of the Company and its Subsidiaries to the extent required by U.S. GAAP. Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (i) no suit, action or other litigation (excluding claims for benefits incurred in the ordinary course of Plan activities) has been brought, or, to the knowledge of the Company, is threatened, against or with respect to any Plan and (ii) there are no audits, inquiries or proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Company, threatened by any governmental agency with respect to any Plan. Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.11(a) , each Plan can be amended, terminated or otherwise discontinued after the Closing in accordance with its terms, without material liability to Parent or the Surviving Corporation (other than ordinary administration expenses and amounts payable for benefits accrued but not yet paid).

(b)    Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.11(b) hereto, neither the execution and delivery of this Agreement nor the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby will (i) result in any payment (including severance, bonus or otherwise) becoming due to any shareholder, director, officer or employee of the Company or its Subsidiaries under any Plan or otherwise, (ii) materially increase any benefits otherwise payable under any Plan, or (iii) result in the acceleration of the time of payment or vesting of any such benefits.

 

10


Table of Contents

2.12     Labor Matters .

(a)    Except as set forth on Schedule 2.12 , neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries is a party to any collective bargaining agreement or other labor union contract applicable to persons employed by the Company or its Subsidiaries nor does the Company have knowledge of any activities or proceedings of any labor union to organize any such employees. Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (i) there are no pending grievance or similar proceedings involving the Company or its Subsidiaries and any of its employees subject to a collective bargaining agreement or other labor union contract and (ii) there are no continuing obligations of the Company or its Subsidiaries pursuant to the resolution of any such proceeding that is no longer pending.

(b)    To the knowledge of the Company, as of the date hereof, none of the officers of the Company or its Subsidiaries presently intends to terminate his or her employment with the Company. The Company and its Subsidiaries are in compliance in all material respects and, to the Company’s knowledge, each of its employees and consultants is in compliance in all material respects, with the terms of the respective employment and consulting agreements between the Company (or one of its Subsidiaries) and such individuals.

(c)    Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (i) the Company and its Subsidiaries are in compliance with all Legal Requirements applicable to its employees, respecting employment, employment practices, terms and conditions of employment and wages and hours and is not liable for any arrears of wages or penalties with respect thereto, (ii) all amounts that the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is legally or contractually required either (x) to deduct from its employees’ salaries or to transfer to such employees’ pension or provident, life insurance, incapacity insurance, continuing education fund or other similar funds or (y) to withhold from its employees’ salaries and benefits and to pay to any Governmental Entity as required by applicable Legal Requirements have, in each case, been duly deducted, transferred, withheld and paid, and the Company and its Subsidiaries do not have any outstanding obligation to make any such deduction, transfer, withholding or payment, and (iii) there are no pending, or to the Company’s knowledge, threatened or reasonably anticipated claims or actions against the Company or any of its Subsidiaries by any employee in connection with such employee’s employment or termination of employment by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries.

(d)    Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, be material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, no employee or former employee of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is owed any wages, benefits or other compensation for past services that has not yet been paid or reimbursed (other than wages, benefits and compensation accrued in the ordinary course of business during the current pay period and any accrued benefits for services, which by their terms or under applicable law, are payable in the future, such as accrued vacation, recreation leave and severance pay).

2.13     Restrictions on Business Activities . Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.13 hereto, there is no agreement, commitment, judgment, injunction, order or decree binding upon the Company or its Subsidiaries or their respective assets or to which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is a party which has had or would reasonably be expected to have the effect of prohibiting or materially impairing any business practice of the Company or its Subsidiaries, any acquisition of property by the Company or its Subsidiaries or the conduct of business by the Company or its Subsidiaries as currently conducted other than such effects, individually or in the aggregate, which have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

2.14     Title to Property .

(a)    Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary owns any real property. Except as set forth in Schedule 2.14(a) , there are no options or other contracts under which the Company or any Subsidiary has a right or obligation to acquire any material interest in real property.

 

11


Table of Contents

(b)    All leases of material real property held by the Company and its Subsidiaries, and all material personal property and other material property and assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries owned, used or held for use in connection with the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries (the “ Personal Property ”), are shown or reflected on the balance sheet included in the most recent Financial Statements, to the extent required by U.S. GAAP applied on a consistent basis in accordance with past practice, other than those entered into or acquired on or after the date of the most recent Financial Statements in the ordinary course of business. Schedule 2.14(b) hereto contains a list of all leases of material real property and Personal Property held by the Company or its Subsidiaries. The Company and its Subsidiaries have good and marketable title to the Personal Property owned by them, and all such Personal Property is in each case held free and clear of all Liens, except for Permitted Liens or Liens disclosed in the Audited Financial Statements or in Schedule 2.14(b) hereto, none of which Liens would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on such property or on the present use of such property in the businesses of the Company and its Subsidiaries.

(c)    All material leases pursuant to which the Company and/or one of its Subsidiaries leases from others material real property or Personal Property are valid and effective in accordance with their respective terms, and there is not, under any of such leases, any existing material default or event of default of the Company or its Subsidiaries or, to the Company’s knowledge, any other party (or any event which with notice or lapse of time, or both, would constitute a material default), except where the lack of such validity and effectiveness or the existence of such default or event of default would not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

(d)    The Company or a Subsidiary is in possession of, or has valid and effective rights to, all properties, assets and rights (other than Intellectual Property, which is governed exclusively by Section  2.18 ) required, in all material respects, for the effective conduct of its business, as it is currently operated and expected to be operated in the future, in the ordinary course.

2.15     Taxes .

(a)     Tax Returns and Audits . Except as set forth in Schedule 2.15 hereto:

(i)    The Company and its Subsidiaries have timely filed all federal, state, local and foreign returns, estimates, information statements and reports relating to Taxes (“ Returns ”) required to be filed by them with any Tax authority prior to the date hereof, except such Returns that are not material to the Company and its Subsidiaries. All such Returns are true, correct and complete in all material respects. The Company and its Subsidiaries have paid all material Taxes shown to be due and payable on such Returns.

(ii)    All material Taxes that the Company and its Subsidiaries are required by law to withhold or collect have been duly withheld or collected, and have been timely paid over to the proper governmental authorities to the extent due and payable.

(iii)    The Company and its Subsidiaries have not been delinquent in the payment of any material Tax nor is there any material Tax deficiency outstanding, proposed or assessed against the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, nor has the Company or any of its Subsidiaries executed any unexpired waiver of any statute of limitations on or extending the period for the assessment or collection of any material Tax. The Company and its Subsidiaries have complied in all material respects with all Legal Requirements with respect to payments made to third parties and the withholding of any payment of withheld Taxes and has timely withheld from employee wages and other payments and timely paid over in full to the proper taxing authorities all material amounts required to be so withheld and paid over for all periods.

(iv)    To the knowledge of the Company, no audit or other examination of any Return of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries by any Tax authority is presently in progress, nor has the Company or any of its Subsidiaries been notified in writing of any request for such an audit or other examination.

 

12


Table of Contents

(v)    No material adjustment relating to any Returns filed by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries has been proposed in writing, formally or informally, by any Tax authority to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or any representative thereof.

(vi)    Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has any material liability for any unpaid Taxes which has not been accrued for or reserved on the Company’s balance sheets included in the Audited Financial Statements or the Unaudited Financial Statements, other than any liability for unpaid Taxes that may have accrued since the end of the most recent fiscal year in connection with the operation of the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business or any liability for unpaid Taxes incurred in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

(vii)    Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has taken, intends to take, or has agreed to take any action or is aware of any fact or circumstance that would prevent or impede, or would reasonably be expected to prevent or impede, the Merger from qualifying as a “reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(a) of the Code.

2.16     Environmental Matters .

(a)    Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.16 hereto, and except as would not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to result in a material liability of the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole: (i) the Company and its Subsidiaries have complied in all material respects with applicable Environmental Laws (as defined below); (ii) none of the Company or its Subsidiaries or, the knowledge of the Company, any third party has caused any properties currently owned, leased or operated by the Company or its Subsidiaries to be contaminated with any Hazardous Substances (as defined below); (iii) the properties formerly owned, leased or operated by the Company or its Subsidiaries were not contaminated with Hazardous Substances during the period of ownership, leasing or operation by the Company or its Subsidiaries; (iv) as of the date hereof, none of the Company or its Subsidiaries has received notice that it is potentially liable for any Hazardous Substance disposal or contamination on any third party or public property (whether above, on or below ground or in the atmosphere or water); (v) as of the date hereof, none of the Company or its Subsidiaries has received any written notice, demand, letter, claim or request for information alleging that the Company or any Subsidiary may be in material violation of or have material liability under any Environmental Law; and (vi) none of the Company or its Subsidiaries is subject to any orders, decrees, injunctions or other arrangements with any Governmental Entity or subject to any contractual indemnity or other agreement with any third party relating to a material liability under any Environmental Law, including in relation to Hazardous Substances.

(b)     Schedule 2.16(b) sets forth all “Phase I” or “Phase II” environmental site assessment (or equivalent) reports with respect to properties owned, leased or operated by the Company and/or its Subsidiaries as of the date hereof that are known to, and in the possession or reasonable control of, the Company. All such written reports have been made available to Parent.

2.17     Brokers; Third Party Expenses . Except as set forth in Schedule 2.17 hereto, neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has incurred, nor will it incur, directly or indirectly, any liability for brokerage, finders’ fees, agent’s commissions or any similar charges in connection with this Agreement or any transactions contemplated hereby.

2.18     Intellectual Property .

(a)     Schedule 2.18 hereto contains a description of the material Company Registered Intellectual Property, as of the date of this Agreement.

(b)    The Company owns or has enforceable rights to use all Intellectual Property required for the conduct of its business as presently conducted. Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.18 hereto, no Company Intellectual Property owned by the Company or Company Product is subject to any material proceeding or

 

13


Table of Contents

outstanding decree, order, judgment or stipulation restricting in any manner the use, transfer or licensing thereof by the Company, or which would reasonably be expected to negatively affect the validity or enforceability of such Company Intellectual Property, which in any such case would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

(c)    Except as disclosed in Schedule 2.18 hereto, the Company owns and has good and exclusive title to each material item of Company Intellectual Property owned by it free and clear of any Liens (excluding non-exclusive licenses and related restrictions granted by it in the ordinary course of business), except as would not reasonably be expected to be, individually or in the aggregate, material to the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

(d)    To the knowledge of the Company, within the year prior to the date of this Agreement, (i) the operation of the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries as such business currently is conducted, including the Company’s use of any product, device or process, has not and does not infringe or misappropriate the Intellectual Property of any third party or constitute unfair competition or trade practices under the laws of any jurisdiction, (ii) the Company has not received any claims or threats from third parties alleging any such infringement, misappropriation or unfair competition or trade practices and (iii) no third party has materially infringed or misappropriated any Company Intellectual Property.

2.19     Agreements, Contracts and Commitments .

(a)     Schedule 2.19 hereto sets forth a complete and accurate list of all Material Company Contracts (as hereinafter defined) in effect on the date of this Agreement, specifying the parties thereto. For purposes of this Agreement, (i) the term “ Company Contracts ” shall mean all legally binding contracts, agreements, leases, mortgages, indentures, notes, and bonds, whether written or oral, to which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is a party or by or to which any of the properties or assets of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries may be bound (including without limitation notes for borrowed money payable to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries) and (ii) the term “ Material Company Contracts ” shall mean (x) each Company Contract (A) providing for expected payments (present or future) to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in excess of $1,000,000 in the aggregate or (B) under or in respect of which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries presently is expected to make an expenditure in excess of $1,000,000 (other than any Company Contract of employment), and (y) the limitations of subclause (x) notwithstanding, each of the following Company Contracts:

(i)    any mortgage, indenture, note, installment obligation or other instrument or agreement for or relating to any borrowing of money or guarantee thereof by the Company or any Subsidiary to any Insider, other than in connection with the advancement of expenses to employees in the ordinary course of business;

(ii)    any mortgage, indenture, note, installment obligation or other instrument or agreement for or relating to any borrowing of money or guarantee thereof from an Insider by the Company or any Subsidiary, other than in connection with the payment of Company expenses (subject to reimbursement) in the ordinary course of business;

(iii)    any guaranty, direct or indirect, by the Company or a Subsidiary of any obligation of a third party (other than the Company or any Subsidiary) for borrowings, or otherwise, in excess of $1,000,000, excluding endorsements made for collection in the ordinary course of business;

(iv)    any Company Contract of employment (excluding customary form offer letters entered into in the ordinary course of business) with an employee of the Company or its Subsidiaries that provides for annual base cash compensation in excess of $200,000;

(v)    any Company Contract made other than in the ordinary course of business (x) providing for the grant of any preferential rights of first offer or first refusal to purchase or lease any material asset of the Company or any Subsidiary or (y) providing for any exclusive right to sell or distribute, or otherwise relating to the sale or distribution of, any product or service of the Company or any Subsidiary;

 

14


Table of Contents

(vi)    any obligation to register any shares of the capital stock or other securities of the Company with the SEC or any similar Governmental Entity;

(vii)    any obligation to make payments, contingent or otherwise, arising out of the prior acquisition of the business, all or substantially all of the assets or stock of other Persons;

(viii)    any collective bargaining agreement with any labor union;

(ix)    any lease or similar arrangement for the use by the Company or any Subsidiary of real property or Personal Property where the annual lease payments are greater than $500,000 (other than any lease of vehicles, office equipment or operating equipment made in the ordinary course of business); and

(x)    any Company Contract not terminable in connection with the Closing to which any Insider, or any entity owned or controlled by an Insider, is a party (other than (A) Company Contracts with portfolio companies and other Affiliates of an Insider that are on arms’ length terms and (B) employment agreements with employees of the Company and its Subsidiaries).

(b)    Each Material Company Contract is in full force and effect and, to the Company’s knowledge, is valid and binding upon and enforceable against each of the parties thereto, except insofar as enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by principles governing the availability of equitable remedies. To the Company’s knowledge, no other party to a Material Company Contract is the subject of a bankruptcy or insolvency proceeding. True, correct and complete copies of all Material Company Contracts have been heretofore made available to Parent or Parent’s counsel.

(c)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.19, neither the Company nor any Subsidiary party thereto nor, to the Company’s knowledge, any other party thereto is in breach of or in default under, and, to the Company’s knowledge, no event has occurred which with notice or lapse of time or both would become a breach of or default under, any Material Company Contract, and, during the year prior to the date hereof and as of the date hereof, no party to any Material Company Contract has given any written notice of any claim of any such breach, default or event, in each case, which breach, default or event, individually or in the aggregate, would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Each Material Company Contract that has not expired by its terms is in full force and effect.

2.20     Insurance . Schedule 2.20 sets forth the Company’s and its Subsidiaries’ material Insurance Policies. The coverages provided by such Insurance Policies are believed by the Company to be reasonably adequate in amount and scope for the Company’s and its Subsidiaries’ business and operations, including any insurance required to be maintained by Material Company Contracts.

2.21     Governmental Actions/Filings .

(a)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.21(a) , the Company and its Subsidiaries have been granted and hold, and have made, all Governmental Actions/Filings (including, without limitation, Governmental Actions/Filings required for emission or discharge of effluents and pollutants into the air and the water) necessary to the conduct by the Company and its Subsidiaries of their businesses (as presently conducted) or used or held for use by the Company and its Subsidiaries, except for any of the foregoing that if not granted, held or made would not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. The Company and its Subsidiaries are in substantial compliance in all material respects with all of their obligations with respect to such Governmental Actions/Filings. To the knowledge of the Company, no event has occurred and is continuing which requires or permits, or after notice or lapse of time or both would require or permit, and consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any ancillary documents will not require or permit (with or without notice or lapse of time, or both), any modification or termination of any such Governmental Actions/Filings except such events which, either individually or in the aggregate, would not have a Material Adverse Effect on the Company.

 

15


Table of Contents

(b)    Except as set forth in Schedule 2.21(b) , to the knowledge of the Company, no Governmental Action/Filing is necessary to be obtained, secured or made by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to enable any of them to continue to conduct its businesses and operations and use its properties after the Closing in a manner which is substantially consistent in all material respects with current practice.

2.22     Interested Party Transactions . Except as set forth in the Schedule 2.22 hereto, no Insider or a member of his or her immediate family is indebted to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, nor is the Company or any of its Subsidiaries indebted (or committed to make loans or extend or guarantee credit) to any of such Persons, other than (i) for payment of salary for services rendered, (ii) reimbursement for reasonable expenses incurred on behalf of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, (iii) for other employee benefits made generally available to all employees, and (iv) arms’ length relationships between the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, on the one hand, and an Affiliate of an Insider, on the other hand.

2.23     Board Approval . The board of directors of the Company (including any required committee or subgroup thereof) has, as of the date of this Agreement, duly approved this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby in accordance with the Charter Documents of the Company.

2.24     Proxy Statement . None of the information relating to the Company or its Subsidiaries supplied by the Company, or by any other Person acting on behalf of the Company at its direction, in writing specifically for inclusion in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus will, as of the date the Proxy Statement/Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) is first mailed to the Parent Stockholders, at the time of the Special Meeting or at the Effective Time, contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

2.25     No Additional Representations and Warranties . Except as provided in this Article  II , neither the Company, any Subsidiary, any of their respective Affiliates, nor any of their respective directors, officers, employees, stockholders, partners, members or representatives has made, or is making, any representation or warranty whatsoever to Parent or Merger Sub or their Affiliates, and no such party shall be liable in respect of the accuracy or completeness of any information provided to Parent or Merger Sub or their Affiliates. Each of Parent and Merger Sub acknowledges and agrees (on its own behalf and on behalf of its respective Affiliates and its and their respective Representatives) that: (i) it has conducted its own independent investigation of the financial condition, results of operations, assets, liabilities, properties and projected operations of the Company and its Subsidiaries; (ii) it has been afforded satisfactory access to the books and records, facilities and personnel of the Company and its Subsidiaries for purposes of conducting such investigation; and (iii) except for the representations and warranties set forth in this Article  II and those set forth in each Letter of Transmittal (with regard to the Stockholder delivering it), it is not relying on any representations and warranties from any Person in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby.

ARTICLE III

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF PARENT AND MERGER SUB

Subject to the exceptions set forth in Schedule 3 attached hereto (the “ Parent Schedule ”), each of Parent and Merger Sub represents and warrants to, and covenants with, the Company, as follows:

3.1     Organization and Qualification .

(a)    Each of Parent and Merger Sub is a corporation duly incorporated, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware and has the requisite corporate power and authority to own, lease and operate its assets and properties and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted. Each of Parent and Merger Sub is in possession of all Approvals necessary to own, lease and operate the properties it

 

16


Table of Contents

purports to own, operate or lease and to carry on its business as it is now being conducted, except where the failure to have such Approvals would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub. Complete and correct copies of the Charter Documents of each of Parent and Merger Sub, as amended and currently in effect, have been heretofore delivered to the Company.

(b)    Each of Parent and Merger Sub is duly qualified or licensed to do business as a foreign corporation and is in good standing in each jurisdiction where the character of the properties owned, leased or operated by it or the nature of its activities makes such qualification or licensing necessary, except for such failures to be so duly qualified or licensed and in good standing that would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub. Each jurisdiction in which Parent or Merger Sub is so qualified or licensed is listed in Schedule 3.1(b) .

3.2     Subsidiaries . Parent has no, and has never had any, direct or indirect subsidiaries or participations in joint ventures or other entities other than Merger Sub, and Merger Sub has no, and has never had any, direct or indirect subsidiaries or participations in joint ventures or other entities. Parent owns all of the outstanding equity securities of Merger Sub, free and clear of all Liens. Except for Parent’s ownership of Merger Sub, neither Parent nor Merger Sub owns, directly or indirectly, any equity or voting interest in any Person or has any agreement or commitment to purchase any such interest, and has not agreed and is not obligated to make nor is bound by any written or oral agreement, contract, subcontract, lease, binding understanding, instrument, note, option, warranty, purchase order, license, sublicense, insurance policy, benefit plan, commitment or undertaking of any nature, as of the date hereof or as may hereafter be in effect under which it may become obligated to make, any future investment in or capital contribution to any other Person. Merger Sub does not have any assets or properties of any kind, does not now conduct and has never conducted any business, and has and will have at the Closing no obligations or liabilities of any nature whatsoever, except for such obligations as are imposed under this Agreement.

3.3     Capitalization .

(a)    As of the date of this Agreement, the authorized capital stock of Parent consists of 75,000,000 shares of Parent Common Stock, 10,000,000 shares of Class B Common Stock, par value $0.0001 per share (“ Founder Common Stock ”), and 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.0001 per share (“ Parent Preferred Stock ” and together with the Parent Common Stock and Founder Common Stock, the “ Parent Stock ”), of which 23,000,000 shares of Parent Common Stock, 5,750,000 shares of Founder Common Stock and no shares of Parent Preferred Stock are issued and outstanding, all of which are validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

(b)    Except as set forth in Schedule 3.3(b) , (i) no shares of Parent Stock are reserved for issuance upon the exercise of outstanding options to purchase Parent Stock granted to employees of Parent or other parties (“ Parent Stock Options ”) and there are no outstanding Parent Stock Options; (ii) no shares of Parent Stock are reserved for issuance upon the exercise of outstanding warrants to purchase Parent Stock (“ Parent Warrants ”) and there are no outstanding Parent Warrants; and (iii) no shares of Parent Stock are reserved for issuance upon the conversion of the Parent Preferred Stock or any outstanding convertible notes, debentures or securities (“ Parent Convertible Securities ”) and there are no outstanding Parent Convertible Securities. All shares of Parent Stock subject to issuance as aforesaid, upon issuance on the terms and conditions specified in the instrument pursuant to which they are issuable, will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable. All outstanding shares of Parent Stock and all outstanding Parent Warrants have been issued and granted in compliance with (x) all applicable securities laws and (in all material respects) other applicable laws and regulations, and (y) all requirements set forth in any applicable Parent Contracts.

(c)    Except as set forth in Schedule 3.3(c) hereto, there are no subscriptions, options, warrants, equity securities, partnership interests or similar ownership interests, calls, rights (including preemptive rights), commitments or agreements of any character to which Parent or Merger Sub is a party or by which it is bound

 

17


Table of Contents

obligating Parent or Merger Sub to issue, deliver or sell, or cause to be issued, delivered or sold, or repurchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, or cause the repurchase, redemption or acquisition of, any shares of capital stock, partnership interests or similar ownership interests of Parent or Merger Sub or obligating Parent or Merger Sub to grant, extend, accelerate the vesting of or enter into any such subscription, option, warrant, equity security, call, right, commitment or agreement. Neither Parent nor Merger Sub has any outstanding bonds, debentures, notes or other obligations the holders of which have or upon the happening of certain events would have the right to vote (or which are convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for securities having the right to vote) with the stockholders of Parent or Merger Sub on any matter.

(d)    Except as set forth in Schedule 3.3(d) or as contemplated by this Agreement, there are no registration rights, and there is no voting trust, proxy, rights plan, anti-takeover plan or other agreements or understandings to which Parent or Merger Sub is a party or by which Parent or Merger Sub is bound with respect to any equity security of any class of the Parent Stock or any equity securities of Merger Sub.

(e)    Except as provided for in this Agreement or as set forth in Schedule  3.3(e) , as a result of the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby, no shares of capital stock, warrants, options or other securities of Parent or Merger Sub are issuable and no rights in connection with any shares, warrants, options or other securities of the Parent or Merger Sub accelerate or otherwise become triggered (whether as to vesting, exercisability, convertibility or otherwise).

(f)    No outstanding shares of Parent Stock or equity securities of Merger Sub are unvested or subjected to a repurchase option, risk of forfeiture or other condition under any applicable agreement with Parent or Merger Sub.

(g)    The shares of Parent Common Stock to be issued by Parent in connection with the Merger, upon issuance in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, will be duly authorized and validly issued and such shares of Parent Common Stock will be fully paid and nonassessable, free and clear of all Liens.

(h)    The authorized and outstanding share capital of Merger Sub is 100 shares of common stock, par value $0.001 per share. Parent owns all of the outstanding equity securities of Merger Sub, free and clear of all Liens.

3.4     Authority Relative to this Agreement . Each of Parent and Merger Sub has all necessary corporate power and authority to: (i) execute, deliver and perform this Agreement, and each ancillary document that Parent and Merger Sub has executed or delivered or is to execute or deliver pursuant to this Agreement, and (ii) carry out Parent’s and Merger Sub’s obligations hereunder and thereunder and, to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby (including the Merger). The execution and delivery of this Agreement by Parent and Merger Sub and the consummation by Parent and Merger Sub of the transactions contemplated hereby (including the Merger) have been duly and validly authorized by all necessary corporate action on the part of Parent and Merger Sub (including the approval by their respective boards of directors), and no other corporate proceedings on the part of Parent or Merger Sub are necessary to authorize this Agreement or to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby, other than the Parent Stockholder Approval. This Agreement has been duly and validly executed and delivered by Parent and Merger Sub and, assuming the due authorization, execution and delivery thereof by the other parties hereto, constitutes the legal and binding obligation of Parent and Merger Sub, enforceable against Parent and Merger Sub in accordance with its terms, except as may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity.

3.5     No Conflict; Required Filings and Consents .

(a)    The execution and delivery of this Agreement by each of Parent and Merger Sub do not, and the performance of this Agreement by Parent and Merger Sub shall not: (i) conflict with or violate Parent’s or

 

18


Table of Contents

Merger Sub’s Charter Documents, (ii) conflict with or violate any Legal Requirements, or (iii) result in any breach of or constitute a default (or an event that with notice or lapse of time or both would become a default) under, or materially impair Parent’s or Merger Sub’s rights or alter the rights or obligations of any third party under, or give to others any rights of termination, amendment, acceleration or cancellation of, or result in the creation of a Lien on any of the properties or assets of Parent or Merger Sub (other than Permitted Liens) pursuant to, any Parent Contracts, except, with respect to clauses (ii) and (iii), for any such conflicts, violations, breaches, defaults, impairments, alterations or other occurrences that would not, individually and in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub.

(b)    The execution and delivery of this Agreement by Parent and Merger Sub do not, and the performance of their respective obligations hereunder will not, require any consent, approval, authorization or permit of, or filing with or notification to, any Governmental Entity, except (i) for applicable requirements, if any, of the Securities Act, the Exchange Act, state securities laws, and the rules and regulations thereunder, and appropriate documents with the relevant authorities of other jurisdictions in which Parent is qualified to do business, (ii) for the filing of any notifications required under the HSR Act and the expiration of the required waiting period thereunder, (iii) the qualification of Parent as a foreign corporation in those jurisdictions in which the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries makes such qualification necessary, and (iv) where the failure to obtain such consents, approvals, authorizations or permits, or to make such filings or notifications, would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to (x) have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub, or (y) prevent the consummation of the Merger or otherwise prevent Parent or Merger Sub from performing their material obligations under this Agreement on a timely basis.

3.6     Compliance . During the past year and as of the date of this Agreement, each of Parent and Merger Sub has complied with all, and is not in violation of any, Legal Requirements with respect to the conduct of its business, or the ownership or operation of its business, except for failures to comply or violations which, individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub. During the past year and as of the date of this Agreement, the businesses and activities of Parent and Merger Sub have not been and are not being conducted in violation of any Legal Requirements, except for violations which, individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub. Neither Parent nor Merger Sub is in default or violation in any material respect of any term, condition or provision of any applicable Charter Documents. Except as set forth in Schedule 3.6 , within the past year, no written notice of non-compliance with any Legal Requirements has been received by Parent or Merger Sub (and Parent has no knowledge of any such notice delivered to any other Person).

3.7     Parent SEC Reports and Financial Statements .

(a)    The Parent has timely filed all required registration statements, reports, schedules, forms, statements and other documents filed by Parent with the SEC since its formation (collectively, as they have been amended since the time of their filing and including all exhibits thereto, the “ Parent SEC Reports ”). None of the Parent SEC Reports, as of their respective dates (or, if amended or superseded by a filing prior to the date of this Agreement or the Closing Date, then on the date of such filing), contained any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading. The audited financial statements of Parent (“ Parent Audited Financial Statements ”) and unaudited interim financial statements of Parent (“ Parent Unaudited Financial Statements ” and, together with the Parent Audited Financial Statements, the “ Parent Financial Statements ”) (including, in each case, the notes and schedules thereto) included in the Parent SEC Reports complied as to form in all material respects with the published rules and regulations of the SEC with respect thereto, were prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP applied on a consistent basis in accordance with past practice during the periods involved (except as may be indicated therein or in the notes thereto and except with respect to unaudited statements as permitted by Form 10-Q of the SEC) and fairly present (subject, in the case of the unaudited interim financial statements included therein, to normal year-end adjustments and the

 

19


Table of Contents

absence of complete footnotes) in all material respects the financial position of Parent and Merger Sub as of the respective dates thereof and the results of their operations and cash flows for the respective periods then ended.

(b)    Parent has established and maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15 under the Exchange Act). Such disclosure controls and procedures are designed to ensure that material information relating to Parent is made known to Parent’s principal executive officer and its principal financial officer, particularly during the periods in which the periodic reports required under the Exchange Act are being prepared. To Parent’s knowledge, such disclosure controls and procedures are effective in timely alerting Parent’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer to material information required to be included in Parent’s periodic reports required under the Exchange Act.

(c)    Parent has established and maintained a system of internal controls. To Parent’s knowledge, such internal controls are effective and sufficient to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of Parent’s financial reporting and the preparation of the Parent’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

(d)    There are no outstanding loans or other extensions of credit made by Parent to any executive officer (as defined in Rule 3b-7 under the Exchange Act) or director of Parent. Parent has not taken any action prohibited by Section 402 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.

(e)    Except as otherwise noted in the Parent Financial Statements, the accounts and notes receivable of Parent and Merger Sub reflected in the Parent Financial Statements: (i) arose from bona fide sales transactions in the ordinary course of business and are payable on ordinary trade terms, (ii) are legal, valid and binding obligations of the respective debtors enforceable in accordance with their terms, except as such may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally, and by general equitable principles, (iii) are not subject to any valid set-off or counterclaim to which Parent has been notified in writing as of the date hereof except to the extent set forth in such balance sheet contained therein, and (iv) are not the subject of any actions or proceedings brought by or on behalf of Parent or Merger Sub as of the date hereof.

(f)    To the knowledge of Parent, as of the date hereof, there are no outstanding SEC comments from the SEC with respect to the Parent SEC Reports. To the knowledge of Parent, none of the Parent SEC Reports filed on or prior to the date hereof is subject to ongoing SEC review or investigation as of the date hereof.

3.8     No Undisclosed Liabilities . Except as set forth in Schedule 3.8 hereto, neither Parent nor Merger Sub has any liabilities (absolute, accrued, contingent or otherwise) of a nature required to be disclosed on a balance sheet or in the related notes to Parent Financial Statements that are, individually or in the aggregate, material to the business, results of operations or financial condition of Parent or Merger Sub, except: (i) liabilities provided for in or otherwise disclosed in the balance sheet included in the most recent Parent Financial Statements or in the notes to the most recent Parent Financial Statements, and (ii) such liabilities arising in the ordinary course of Parent’s or Merger Sub’s business since the date of the most recent Parent Financial Statement, none of which, individually or in the aggregate, would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent and Merger Sub, taken as a whole.

3.9     Absence of Certain Changes or Events . Except as contemplated by this Agreement, since the date of the most recent Parent Financial Statement to the date of this Agreement, there has not been: (i) any Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub, (ii) any declaration, setting aside or payment of any dividend on, or other distribution (whether in cash, stock or property) in respect of, any of Parent’s capital stock, or any purchase, redemption or other acquisition by Parent of any of Parent’s capital stock or any other securities of Parent or any options, warrants, calls or rights to acquire any such shares or other securities, (iii) any split, combination or reclassification of any of Parent’s capital stock, (iv) any granting by Parent of any increase in compensation or fringe benefits, or any payment by Parent of any bonus, or any granting by Parent of any

 

20


Table of Contents

increase in severance or termination pay or any entry by Parent into any currently effective employment, severance, termination or indemnification agreement or any agreement the benefits of which are contingent or the terms of which are materially altered upon the occurrence of a transaction involving Parent of the nature contemplated hereby, (v) entry by Parent into any licensing or other agreement with regard to the acquisition or disposition of any material Intellectual Property other than licenses and services agreements in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice or any amendment or consent with respect to any licensing or services agreement, (vi) any material change by Parent or Merger Sub in its accounting methods, principles or practices, except as required by concurrent changes in U.S. GAAP, (vii) any change in the auditors of Parent, or (viii) any material revaluation by Parent or Merger Sub of any of its assets, including, without limitation, writing down the value of capitalized inventory or writing off notes or accounts receivable or any sale of assets of Parent or Merger Sub.

3.10     Litigation . There are no, and have never been any, claims, suits, actions or proceedings pending or to Parent’s knowledge, threatened against either Parent or Merger Sub, before any court, governmental department, commission, agency, instrumentality or authority, or any arbitrator.

3.11     Employee Benefit Plans . Neither Parent nor Merger Sub maintains, and has no liability under, any Plan, and neither the execution and delivery of this Agreement nor the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby will (i) result in any payment (including severance, unemployment compensation, golden parachute, bonus, or otherwise) becoming due to any stockholder, director, or employee of Parent or Merger Sub, or (ii) result in the acceleration of the time of payment or vesting of any such benefits.

3.12     Labor Matters . Neither Parent nor Merger Sub is a party to any collective bargaining agreement or other labor union contract applicable to persons employed by Parent or Merger Sub and neither Parent nor Merger Sub knows of any activities or proceedings of any labor union to organize any such employees.

3.13     Business Activities . Since its organization, neither Parent nor Merger Sub has conducted any business activities other than activities directed toward the accomplishment of a business combination. Merger Sub was created for the purpose of facilitating the Merger and has not conducted any prior business activities, other than any such activities incidental to consummating the Merger. Except as set forth in the Parent Charter Documents, there is no agreement, commitment, exclusive license, judgment, injunction, order, or decree binding upon Parent or Merger Sub or to which Parent or Merger Sub is a party which has or would reasonably be expected to have the effect of prohibiting or materially impairing any business practice of Parent or Merger Sub, any acquisition of property by Parent or Merger Sub, or the conduct of business by Parent or Merger Sub.

3.14     Title to Property . Neither Parent nor Merger Sub owns or leases any real property or personal property. Except as set forth in Schedule 3.14 , there are no options or other contracts under which Parent or Merger Sub has a right or obligation to acquire or lease any interest in real property or personal property.

3.15     Intellectual Property . Neither Parent nor Merger Sub owns, licenses, or otherwise has any right, title or interest in any material Intellectual Property.

3.16     Taxes . Except as set forth in Schedule 3.16 hereto:

(a)    Each of Parent and Merger Sub has timely filed all Returns required to be filed by Parent and Merger Sub with any Tax authority prior to the date hereof, except such Returns which are not material to Parent. All such Returns are true, correct, and complete in all material respects. Each of Parent and Merger Sub has paid all material Taxes shown to be due and payable on such Returns.

(b)    All material Taxes that Parent and Merger Sub are required by law to withhold or collect have been duly withheld or collected, and have been timely paid over to the proper Governmental Entity to the extent due and payable.

 

21


Table of Contents

(c)    Neither Parent nor Merger Sub has been delinquent in the payment of any material Tax, nor is there any material Tax deficiency outstanding, proposed or assessed against Parent, nor has Parent or Merger Sub executed any unexpired waiver of any statute of limitations on or extending the period for the assessment or collection of any Tax. Parent and Merger Sub have complied in all material respects with all Legal Requirements with respect to payments made to third parties and the withholding of any payment of withheld Taxes and has timely withheld from employee wages or other payments and timely paid over in full to the proper taxing authorities all material amounts required to be so withheld and paid over for all periods.

(d)    No audit or other examination of any Return of Parent or Merger Sub by any Tax authority is presently in progress, nor has Parent or Merger Sub been notified in writing of any request for such an audit or other examination.

(e)    No material adjustment relating to any Returns filed by Parent or Merger Sub has been proposed in writing, formally or informally, by any Tax authority to Parent or Merger Sub or any representative thereof.

(f)    Neither Parent nor Merger Sub has any material liability for any unpaid Taxes which have not been accrued for or reserved on Parent’s balance sheets included in the Parent Audited Financial Statements for the most recent fiscal year ended, whether asserted or unasserted, contingent or otherwise, other than any material liability for unpaid Taxes that may have accrued since the end of the most recent fiscal year in connection with the operation of the business of Parent in the ordinary course of business, none of which is material to the business, results of operations or financial condition of Parent.

(g)    Neither Parent nor Merger Sub has taken, intends to take, or has agreed to take any action or is aware of any fact or circumstance that would prevent or impede, or would reasonably be expected to prevent or impede, the Merger from qualifying as a “reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(a) of the Code.

3.17     Environmental Matters .

(a)    Except for such matters that, individually or in the aggregate, would not reasonably be expected to result in a material liability of Parent and Merger Sub, taken as a whole: (i) Parent and Merger Sub have complied in all material respects with applicable Environmental Laws; (ii) none of Parent or Merger Sub or, the knowledge of Parent, any third party, has caused any properties currently owned, leased or operated by Parent and Merger Sub to be contaminated with any Hazardous Substances; (iii) the properties formerly owned, leased or operated by Parent and Merger Sub were not contaminated with Hazardous Substances during the period of ownership, leasing or operation by Parent or Merger Sub; (iv) as of the date hereof, neither Parent nor Merger Sub has received notice that it is potentially liable for any Hazardous Substance disposal or contamination on any third party or public property (whether above, on, or below ground or in the atmosphere or water); (v) as of the date hereof, neither Parent nor Merger Sub has received any written notice, demand, letter, claim, or request for information alleging that Parent or Merger Sub may be in material violation of or have material liability under any Environmental Law; and (vii) neither Parent nor Merger Sub is subject to any orders, decrees, injunctions, or other arrangements with any Governmental Entity or subject to any contractual indemnity or other agreement with any third party relating to a material liability under any Environmental Law, including in relation to Hazardous Substances.

3.18     Brokers . Except as set forth in Schedule 3.18 , neither Parent nor Merger Sub has incurred, and neither will incur, and neither has entered into any contract, agreement, understanding, arrangement or commitment pursuant to which the Surviving Corporation or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries could incur, directly or indirectly, any liability for brokerage or finders’ fees or agent’s commissions or any similar charges in connection with this Agreement or any transaction contemplated hereby.

3.19     Agreements, Contracts and Commitments .

(a)    Except as set forth in the Parent SEC Reports filed prior to the date of this Agreement or as set forth on Schedule 3.19(a) , other than confidentiality and non-disclosure agreements, there are no contracts,

 

22


Table of Contents

agreements, leases, mortgages, indentures, notes, bonds, Liens, license, permit, franchise, purchase orders, sales orders or other understandings, commitments or obligations (including without limitation outstanding offers or proposals) of any kind, whether written or oral, to which Parent or Merger Sub is a party or by or to which any of the properties or assets of Parent or Merger Sub may be bound, subject or affected, which may not be cancelled without penalty or liability by Parent or Merger Sub on less than 30 days’ or less prior notice (“ Parent Contracts ”). All Parent Contracts are listed in Schedule 3.19 other than those that are exhibits to the Parent SEC Reports.

(b)    Except as set forth in the Parent SEC Reports filed prior to the date of this Agreement, each Parent Contract was entered into at arms’ length and in the ordinary course, is in full force and effect, and is valid and binding upon and enforceable against each of the parties thereto, except insofar as enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally or by principles governing the availability of equitable remedies. True, correct, and complete copies of all Parent Contracts (or written summaries in the case of oral Parent Contracts) have been heretofore been made available to the Company or Company counsel.

(c)    Neither Parent or Merger Sub nor, to the knowledge of Parent, any other party thereto is in breach of or in default under, and no event has occurred which with notice or lapse of time or both would become a breach of or default under, any Parent Contract, and no party to any Parent Contract has given any written notice of any claim of any such breach, default or event, which, individually or in the aggregate, are reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub. Each Parent Contract that has not expired by its terms is in full force and effect, except where such failure to be in full force and effect is not reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect on Parent or Merger Sub.

3.20     Insurance . Except for directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, neither Parent nor Merger Sub maintains any Insurance Policy.

3.21     Interested Party Transactions . (a) No employee, officer, director, or stockholder of Parent or Merger Sub or a member of his or her immediate family is indebted to Parent or Merger Sub nor is Parent or Merger Sub indebted (or committed to make loans or extend or guarantee credit) to any of them, other than reimbursement for reasonable expenses incurred on behalf of Parent or Merger Sub; and (b) to Parent’s knowledge, no employee, officer, director, or stockholder or any member of his or her immediate family is, directly or indirectly, interested in any material contract with Parent or Merger Sub (other than such contracts as relate to the acquisition of such stockholder’s ownership of capital stock or other securities of Parent).

3.22     Parent Listing . The Parent Common Stock and Parent Warrants are listed for trading on the New York Stock Exchange (the “ NYSE ”). There is no, and there has never been any, action or proceeding pending or, to the Company’s knowledge, threatened against Parent by the NYSE with respect to any intention by such entity to prohibit or terminate the listing of Parent Common Stock on the NYSE.

3.23     Board Approval . The board of directors of each of Parent and Merger Sub has, as of the date of this Agreement, unanimously (i) declared the advisability of the Merger and approved this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby in accordance with the Charter Documents of Parent and Merger Sub, (ii) determined that the Merger is in the best interests of the stockholders of Parent and Merger Sub, and (iii) determined that the fair market value of the Company is equal to at least 80% of the balance in the Trust Fund.

3.24     Trust Fund . As of the date hereof and at the Closing Date, Parent has and will have no less than $230,000,000 invested in United States Government securities or money market funds meeting the conditions under Rule 2a-7(d) promulgated under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, in a trust account administered by Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (“ Continental ”, and such trust account, the “ Trust Fund ”), less such amounts, if any, as Parent is required to pay to (i) Redeeming Stockholders and (ii) pursuant to

 

23


Table of Contents

Section  1.13(b) . Prior to the Closing, none of the funds held in the Trust Fund may be released except in accordance with that certain Investment Management Trust Agreement, dated as of January 31, 2019 (the “ Trust Agreement ”), by and between Parent and Continental, Parent’s Charter Documents and the Final Prospectus. Parent has performed all material obligations required to be performed by it to date under, and is not in material default, breach or delinquent in performance or any other respect (claimed or actual) in connection with, the Trust Agreement, and no event has occurred which, with due notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute such a default or breach thereunder. There are no claims or proceedings pending with respect to the Trust Fund. Since January 31, 2019 through the date hereof, Parent has not released any money from the Trust Fund (other than interest income earned on the principal held in the Trust Fund as permitted by the Trust Agreement). As of the Effective Time, upon approval of the Stockholder Matters, the obligations of Parent to dissolve or liquidate pursuant to Parent’s Charter Documents shall terminate, and as of the Effective Time, Parent shall have no obligation whatsoever pursuant to Parent’s Charter Documents to dissolve and liquidate the assets of Parent by reason of the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby. To Parent’s knowledge, following the Effective Time, no Parent Stockholder shall be entitled to receive any amount from the Trust Fund except to the extent such Parent Stockholder is a Redeeming Stockholder. Assuming the accuracy of the representations and warranties of the Company contained herein and the compliance by the Company with its obligations hereunder, neither Parent nor Merger Sub has any reason to believe that any of the conditions to the use of funds in the Trust Fund will not be satisfied or that funds available in the Trust Fund will not be available to Parent and Merger Sub on the Closing Date. Neither Parent nor Merger Sub has, or has any present intention, agreement, arrangement or understanding to enter into or incur, any obligations with respect to or under any indebtedness.

3.25     Fairness Opinion . Parent has received an opinion from Northland Securities, Inc. addressed to the Parent Board in connection with the Merger that the consideration to be paid by Parent for the Company is fair, from a financial point of view, to Parent.

3.26     No Additional Representations and Warranties . Except as provided in this Article  III , neither Parent nor Merger Sub, any of their respective Affiliates, nor any of their respective directors, officers, employees, shareholders, partners, members or representatives has made, or is making, any representation or warranty whatsoever to the Company, any Subsidiary, or their Affiliates, and no such party shall be liable in respect of the accuracy or completeness of any information provided to the Company, any Subsidiary or their Affiliates. The Company acknowledges and agrees (on its own behalf and on behalf of its Affiliates and its Representatives) that: (i) it has conducted its own independent investigation of the financial condition, results of operations, assets, liabilities, properties and projected operations of Parent and Merger Sub; (ii) it has been afforded satisfactory access to the books and records, facilities and personnel of Parent and Merger Sub for purposes of conducting such investigation; and (iii) except for the representations and warranties set forth in this Article  III , it is not relying on any representations and warranties from any Person in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby.

ARTICLE IV

CONDUCT PRIOR TO THE EFFECTIVE TIME

4.1     Conduct of Business by the Company, Parent and Merger Sub . During the period from the date of this Agreement and continuing until the earlier of the termination of this Agreement pursuant to its terms and the Closing, each of the Company, the Company’s Subsidiaries, Parent and Merger Sub shall, except to the extent that Parent (in the case of a request by the Company or the Company’s Subsidiaries) or the Company (in the case of a request by Parent or Merger Sub) shall otherwise consent in writing (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) or as set forth in Schedule 4.1 hereto or as contemplated by this Agreement, carry on its business in the usual, regular and ordinary course consistent with past practices, in substantially the same manner as heretofore conducted and in compliance with all applicable laws and regulations (except as expressly contemplated by Schedule 4.1 hereto) and use its commercially reasonable

 

24


Table of Contents

efforts consistent with past practices and policies to (i) preserve substantially intact its present business organization, (ii) keep available the services of its present key officers and employees and (iii) preserve its relationships with key customers, suppliers, distributors, licensors, licensees, and others with which it has significant business dealings. In addition, except as required or permitted by the terms of this Agreement or as set forth in Schedule 4.1 hereto, without the prior written consent of Parent (in the case of a request by the Company or the Company’s Subsidiaries) or the Company (in the case of a request by Parent or Merger Sub) (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed), during the period from the date of this Agreement and continuing until the earlier of the termination of this Agreement pursuant to its terms or the Closing, each of the Company (on its behalf and on behalf of its Subsidiaries), Parent and Merger Sub shall not do any of the following:

(a)    Waive any stock repurchase rights, accelerate, amend or (except as specifically provided for herein) change the period of exercisability of options or restricted stock, or reprice options granted under any employee, consultant, director or other stock plans or authorize cash payments in exchange for any options granted under any of such plans;

(b)    Grant any material severance or termination pay to (i) any officer or (ii) any employee, except pursuant to applicable law, written agreements outstanding, or Plans or policies existing on the date hereof and as previously or concurrently disclosed or made available to the other Party, or in the case of the Company and its Subsidiaries except in connection with the promotion, hiring or firing of any employee in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice;

(c)    Transfer or license to any person or otherwise extend, amend or modify any material rights to any Intellectual Property or enter into grants to transfer or license to any person future patent rights, other than in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices;

(d)    Declare, set aside or pay any dividends on or make any other distributions (whether in cash, stock, equity securities or property) in respect of any capital stock (other than any such dividend or distribution by a Subsidiary of the Company to the Company or another such Subsidiary), or split, combine or reclassify any capital stock or issue or authorize the issuance of any other securities in respect of, in lieu of or in substitution for any capital stock;

(e)    Purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, directly or indirectly, any shares of capital stock or other equity securities or ownership interests of the Company or Parent;

(f)    Issue, deliver, sell, authorize, pledge or otherwise encumber, or agree to any of the foregoing with respect to, any shares of capital stock or other equity securities or ownership interests (other than in connection with the exercise of any Company Stock Options) or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock or other equity securities or ownership interests, or subscriptions, rights, warrants or options to acquire any shares of capital stock or other equity securities or ownership interests or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock or other equity securities or other ownership interests, or enter into other agreements or commitments of any character obligating it to issue any such shares, equity securities or other ownership interests or convertible or exchangeable securities;

(g)    Amend its Charter Documents in any material respect;

(h)    Acquire or agree to acquire by merging or consolidating with, or by purchasing any equity interest in or a material portion of the assets of, or by any other manner, any business or any corporation, partnership, association or other business organization or division thereof, or otherwise acquire or agree to acquire outside the ordinary course of business any assets which are material, individually or in the aggregate, to the business of Parent or the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, as applicable, or enter into any joint ventures, strategic partnerships or alliances or other arrangements that provide for exclusivity of territory or

 

25


Table of Contents

otherwise restrict such party’s ability to compete or to offer or sell any products or services to other Persons. For purposes of this paragraph, “material” includes the requirement that, as a result of such transaction, financial statements of the acquired, merged or consolidated entity be included in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus;

(i)    Sell, lease, license, encumber or otherwise dispose of any properties or assets, except (A) sales in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice, and (B) the sale, lease or disposition of property or assets that are not material, individually or in the aggregate, to the business of such party (measured with all of its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole);

(j)    Except incurrences of indebtedness under the Company’s existing credit facilities (and, in the case of the Company and its Subsidiaries, extensions of credit in the ordinary course with employees and among the Company and its Subsidiaries), incur any indebtedness for borrowed money or guarantee any such indebtedness of another Person or Persons (other than Affiliates), issue or sell any debt securities or options, warrants, calls or other rights to acquire any debt securities of Parent or the Company and its Subsidiaries, as applicable, enter into any “keep well” or other agreement to maintain any financial statement condition or enter into any arrangement having the economic effect of any of the foregoing;

(k)    Except as otherwise required by applicable law or pursuant to an existing Plan, policy or Company Contract of the Company or its Subsidiaries, (i) adopt or materially amend any Plan (including any Plan that provides for severance), or enter into any employment contract or collective bargaining agreement (other than in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice), (ii) pay any special bonus or special remuneration to any director or employee, except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices, or (iii) materially increase the salaries or wage rates or fringe benefits (including rights to severance or indemnification) of its directors, officers, employees or consultants, except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices;

(l)    (i) Pay, discharge, settle or satisfy any material claims, liabilities or obligations (absolute, accrued, asserted or unasserted, contingent or otherwise), or litigation (whether or not commenced prior to the date of this Agreement) other than the payment, discharge, settlement or satisfaction of any claims, liabilities or obligations in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices or in accordance with their terms, or recognized or disclosed in the Company Financial Statements or in the most recent Parent SEC Reports, as applicable, or incurred since the date of such financial statements, or (ii) waive the benefits of, agree to modify in any material manner, terminate, release any person from or knowingly fail to enforce any material confidentiality or similar agreement to which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is a party or of which the Company any of its Subsidiaries is a beneficiary (other than with customers and other counterparties in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices) or to which Parent is a party or of which Parent is a beneficiary, as applicable;

(m)    Except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices, modify in any material respect or terminate (other than in accordance with its terms) any Material Company Contract or Parent Contract, as applicable, or waive, delay the exercise of, release or assign any material rights or claims thereunder;

(n)    Except as required by law or U.S. GAAP, revalue any of its assets in any material manner or make any material change in accounting methods, principles or practices;

(o)    Except in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practices, incur or enter into any agreement, contract or commitment requiring such party to pay in excess of $1,000,000 in any 12 month period;

(p)    Settle any material litigation where the consideration given by the Party is other than monetary or to which an officer, director or employee of such Person is a party in his or her capacity as such;

(q)    Make or rescind any Tax elections that, individually or in the aggregate, would be reasonably likely to adversely affect in any material respect the Tax liability or Tax attributes of such party, settle or

 

26


Table of Contents

compromise any material income tax liability outside the ordinary course of business or, except as required by applicable law, change any material method of accounting for Tax purposes or prepare or file any Return in a manner materially inconsistent with past practice;

(r)    Form or establish any subsidiary except in the ordinary course of business consistent with prior practice or as contemplated by this Agreement;

(s)    Permit any Person to exercise any of its discretionary rights under any Plan to provide for the automatic acceleration of any outstanding options, the termination of any outstanding repurchase rights or the termination of any cancellation rights issued pursuant to such Plans;

(t)    Make capital expenditures in excess of previously budgeted amounts;

(u)    Enter into any material transaction with or distribute or advance any assets or property to any of its officers, directors, partners, stockholders, managers, members or other Affiliates other than (i) the payment of salary and benefits and the advancement of expenses in the ordinary course of business consistent with prior practice, (ii) such distributions or advancements by a Subsidiary of the Company to the Company or another such Subsidiary or (iii) contracts entered into on an arms’-length basis and in the ordinary course of business between the Company or any Subsidiary, on the one hand, and the direct or indirect portfolio companies of investment funds advised or managed by Carlyle Investment Management L.L.C., on the other hand; or

(v)    Agree in writing or otherwise agree or commit to take any of the actions described in Section  4.1(a) through (u)  above.

4.2     Confidentiality; Access to Information .

(a)     Confidentiality . The parties agree that they shall be bound by that certain Non-Disclosure Agreement, dated as of February 18, 2019 (the “ Confidentiality Agreement ”), by and between KLDiscovery Ontrack, LLC and Parent, with respect to all nonpublic information exchanged in connection with this Agreement and the negotiations related thereto. The terms of the Confidentiality Agreement are hereby incorporated herein by reference and shall continue in full force and effect until the Closing, at which time the Confidentiality Agreement shall terminate. If this Agreement is, for any reason, terminated prior to the Closing, the Confidentiality Agreement shall continue in full force and effect, subject to Section  7.2(b) hereof.

(b)     Access to Information .

(i)    Subject to confidentiality obligations and similar restrictions that may be applicable to information furnished to the Company or its Subsidiaries by third parties that may be in the Company’s or its Subsidiaries’ possession from time to time, and except for any information which in the opinion of legal counsel of the Company would result in the loss of attorney-client privilege or other privilege from disclosure, the Company will afford Parent and its financial advisors, accountants, counsel and other representatives reasonable access during normal business hours, upon reasonable notice, in such manner as to not interfere with the normal operation of the Company and its Subsidiaries, to the properties, books, records and management personnel of the Company during the period prior to the Closing to obtain all information concerning the business, including the status of business development efforts, properties, results of operations and personnel of the Company, as Parent may reasonably request; provided, that such access shall not include any invasive or intrusive investigations or other testing, sampling or analysis of any properties, facilities or equipment of the Company or its Subsidiaries without the prior written consent of the Company. The parties hereto shall use commercially reasonable efforts to make alternative arrangements for such disclosure where the restrictions in the preceding sentence apply. No information or knowledge obtained by Parent in any investigation pursuant to this Section  4.2(b )( i ) will affect or be deemed to modify any representation or warranty contained herein or the conditions to the obligations of the parties to consummate the Merger.

 

27


Table of Contents

(ii)    Subject to confidentiality obligations and similar restrictions that may be applicable to information furnished to the Company or its Subsidiaries by third parties that may be in the Company’s or its Subsidiaries’ possession from time to time, and except for any information which in the opinion of legal counsel of the Company would result in the loss of attorney-client privilege or other privilege from disclosure, Parent will afford the Company and its financial advisors, underwriters, accountants, counsel and other representatives reasonable access during normal business hours, upon reasonable notice, in such manner as to not interfere with the normal operation of the Company and its Subsidiaries, to the properties, books, records and personnel of Parent and Merger Sub during the period prior to the Closing to obtain all information concerning the business, including properties, results of operations and personnel of Parent and Merger Sub, as the Company may reasonably request. The parties hereto shall use commercially reasonable efforts to make alternative arrangements for such disclosure where the restrictions in the preceding sentence apply. No information or knowledge obtained by the Company in any investigation pursuant to this Section  4.2(b )( ii) will affect or be deemed to modify any representation or warranty contained herein or the conditions to the obligations of the parties to consummate the Merger.

4.3     No Solicitation . During the period from the date of this Agreement and continuing until the earlier of the termination of this Agreement pursuant to its terms or the Closing, (a) the Company will not, and will cause its respective Affiliates, employees, agents, officers, directors and representatives not to, directly or indirectly, solicit or enter into discussions or transactions with, or encourage, or provide any information to, any corporation, partnership or other entity or group (other than Parent and its designees) concerning any merger, sale of ownership interests in the Company (other than any purchases of equity securities by the Company from employees of the Company or its Subsidiaries) and/or a material portion of the assets of the Company (other than immaterial assets or assets sold in the ordinary course of business), or a recapitalization or similar transaction involving the Company and (b) each of Parent and Merger Sub will not, and will cause its respective Affiliates, employees, agents, officers, directors and representatives not to, directly or indirectly, solicit or enter into discussions or transactions with, or encourage, or provide any information to, any corporation, partnership or other entity or group (other than the Company and its designees) concerning any merger, purchase of ownership interests and/or assets, recapitalization or similar business combination transaction. In addition, (i) the Company will, and will cause its respective Affiliates, employees, agents, officers, directors and representatives to, immediately cease any and all existing discussions or negotiations with any Person conducted heretofore with respect to any alternative merger, sale of ownership interests in and/or a material portion of the assets of the Company (other than immaterial assets or assets sold in the ordinary course of business) or recapitalization or similar transaction involving the Company and (ii) each of Parent and Merger Sub will, and will cause its respective Affiliates, employees, agents, officers, directors and representatives to, immediately cease any and all existing discussions or negotiations with any Person conducted heretofore with respect to any alternative merger, purchase of ownership interests and/or assets, recapitalization or similar business combination transaction. The Company will promptly notify Parent if it receives, or if any of its or its Affiliates’ employees, agents, officers, directors or representatives receives, any proposal, offer or submission with respect to a competing transaction after the date of this Agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company may respond to any such proposal, offer or submission by indicating only that the Company is subject to an exclusivity agreement and is unable to provide any information related to the Company and its Subsidiaries or entertain any proposals or offers or engage in any negotiations or discussions concerning a competing transaction for as long as that exclusivity agreement remains in effect. The parties agree that the rights and remedies for noncompliance with this Section  4.3 include specific performance, it being acknowledged and agreed that any breach or threatened breach will cause irreparable injury to the non-breaching party and that money damages would not provide an adequate remedy for such injury.

4.4     Certain Financial Information . Within twenty-five (25) Business Days after the end of each month between the date hereof and the earlier of the Closing Date and the date on which this Agreement is terminated, the Company shall deliver to Parent unaudited consolidated financial statements for such month, in the format provided to the lenders under the credit agreement facility of the Company.

 

28


Table of Contents

4.5     Access to Financial Information . During the period from the date of this Agreement and continuing until the earlier of the termination of this Agreement pursuant to its terms or the Closing, the Company will, and will use commercially reasonable efforts to cause its auditors (subject to any required access agreement or arrangement) to (a) continue to provide Parent and its advisors reasonable access to all of the financial information used in the preparation of Company Financial Statements and the financial information furnished pursuant to Section  4.4 hereof and (b) reasonably cooperate with any reviews performed by Parent or its advisors of any such Company Financial Statements or such information.

4.6     Commercially Reasonable Efforts . Upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement, each of the Parties agrees to use its commercially reasonable efforts to take, or cause to be taken, all actions, and to do, or cause to be done, and to assist and cooperate with the other parties in doing, all things reasonably necessary, proper or advisable to consummate and make effective, in the most expeditious manner practicable but in any event by three days prior to October 30, 2019, the Merger and the other transactions contemplated by this Agreement, including using commercially reasonable efforts to accomplish the following: (i) the taking of such reasonable acts necessary to cause the conditions precedent set forth in Article VI to be satisfied, (ii) the obtaining of such reasonably necessary actions, waivers, consents, approvals, orders and authorizations from Governmental Entities and the making of such reasonably necessary registrations, declarations and filings (including registrations, declarations and filings with Governmental Entities, if any) and the taking of such reasonable steps as may be reasonably necessary to avoid any suit, claim, action, investigation or proceeding by any Governmental Entity, (iii) the obtaining of such material consents, approvals or waivers from third parties required as a result of the transactions contemplated in this Agreement, including the consents referred to in Schedules  2.5  and  3.5 , (iv) the defending of any suits, claims, actions, investigations or proceedings, whether judicial or administrative, challenging this Agreement or the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby, including seeking to have any stay or temporary restraining order entered by any court or other Governmental Entity vacated or reversed and (v) the execution or delivery of any additional instruments reasonably necessary to consummate the transactions contemplated by, and to fully carry out the purposes of, this Agreement. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, (i) nothing in this Agreement shall be deemed to require Parent or the Company to agree to any divestiture by itself or any of its Affiliates of shares of capital stock or of any business, assets or property, or the imposition of any material limitation on the ability of any of them to conduct their business or to own or exercise control of such assets, properties and stock and (ii) in no event shall Parent, Merger Sub, the Company or its Subsidiaries be obligated to bear any expense or pay any fee or grant any concession in connection with obtaining any consents, authorizations or approvals pursuant to the terms of any Contract to which the Company or its Subsidiaries is a party in connection with the consummation of the Merger.

ARTICLE V

ADDITIONAL AGREEMENTS

5.1     Proxy Statement; Special Meeting .

(a)    As soon as is reasonably practicable after receipt by Parent from the Company of all financial and other information relating to the Company as is necessary for its preparation, Parent shall prepare and file with the SEC under the Exchange Act, and with all other applicable regulatory bodies, the Proxy Statement/Prospectus to be used for the purpose of soliciting proxies from holders of Parent Common Stock (the “ Parent Stockholders ”) to vote in favor of (i) the adoption of this Agreement and the approval of the Merger (the “ Merger Proposal ”), (ii) the election to the board of directors of Parent of the individuals identified on Schedule 5.1(a) for the class of director set forth opposite the name of such individual (the “ Director Proposal ”); (iii) the approval of certain changes to Parent’s Charter Documents, to be effective from and after the Closing, including the change of the name of Parent to a name to be mutually agreed by the parties hereto, an increase in the number of authorized shares of Parent Common Stock to 200,000,000 and amendments to Article Sixth so that the existence

 

29


Table of Contents

of Parent shall be perpetual and to remove all SPAC-related provisions that will no longer be applicable to Parent following the Closing (the “ Charter Amendments Proposals ”), (iv) the adoption of the Parent Plan and (v) approval of any other proposals reasonably agreed by Parent and the Company to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby (together with the Merger Proposal, Director Proposal, Charter Amendments Proposals and Plan Proposal, the “ Stockholder Matters ”) at a meeting of Parent Stockholders to be called and held for such purpose (the “ Special Meeting ”). Without the prior written consent of the Company, the Stockholder Matters shall be the only matters (other than procedural matters) which Parent shall propose to be acted on by the Parent Stockholders at the Special Meeting. The Parent Plan shall provide that a number of shares of Parent Common Stock in an amount to be mutually agreed by the parties hereto shall be reserved for issuance pursuant to the Parent Plan. The Company shall furnish to Parent all information concerning the Company as is necessary in connection with the preparation of the Proxy Statement/Prospectus. Parent shall also take any and all actions required to satisfy the requirements of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act.

(b)    As soon as practicable following the approval of the Proxy Statement/Prospectus by the SEC (the “ SEC Approval Date ”) (and in any event, within seven Business Days after the SEC Approval Date), Parent shall (i) distribute the Proxy Statement/Prospectus to the Parent Stockholders, (ii) having, prior to the SEC Approval Date, established the record date therefor, duly call, give notice of, convene and hold the Special Meeting in accordance with the DGCL and, subject to the other provisions of this Agreement, on a date no later than thirty (30) days following the SEC Approval Date, and (iii) subject to the other provisions of this Agreement, solicit proxies from such holders to vote in favor of the adoption of this Agreement and the approval of the Merger and the other matters presented to the Parent Stockholders for approval or adoption at the Special Meeting, including, without limitation, the Stockholder Matters . Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section  5.1(b) , if on a date for which the Special Meeting is scheduled, Parent reasonably determines that the Merger cannot be consummated for any reason, Parent shall have the right to make one or more successive postponements or adjournments of the Special Meeting, provided that (1) Parent continues to satisfy its obligations under Section  5.1(d) below and (2) the Special Meeting (x) is not postponed or adjourned to a date that is more than forty-five (45) days after the date for which the Special Meeting was originally scheduled (excluding any adjournments or postponements required by applicable Law) and (y) is held no later than three (3) Business Days prior to October 30, 2019.

(c)    Parent shall comply with all applicable provisions of and rules under the Exchange Act and all applicable provisions of the DGCL in the preparation, filing and distribution of the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, the solicitation of proxies thereunder, and the calling and holding of the Special Meeting. Without limiting the foregoing, Parent shall ensure that the Proxy Statement/Prospectus does not, as of the date on which it is first distributed to Parent Stockholders, and as of the date of the Special Meeting, contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading (provided that Parent shall not be responsible for the accuracy or completeness of any information relating to the Company or any other information furnished by the Company for inclusion in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus).

(d)    Parent, acting through its board of directors, shall include in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus the recommendation of its board of directors that the Parent Stockholders vote in favor of the adoption of this Agreement and the approval of the Merger and the other matters referred to in Section  5.1(a) , and shall otherwise use commercially reasonable best efforts to obtain approval of the matters referred to in Section  5.1(a) .

5.2     Directors and Officers of Parent and the Company After Merger . Except as otherwise agreed in writing by the Company and Parent prior to the Closing, the Parties shall take all necessary action so that (a) all of the members of the board of directors of Parent and all officers of Parent resign effective as of the Closing unless such member or officer is included on Schedule 5.2, (b) the number of directors constituting the board of directors of Parent shall be such number as is specified on Schedule 5.2 and (c) the persons listed in Schedule 5.2 are elected to the positions of officers and directors of Parent and Surviving Corporation, as set forth therein, to

 

30


Table of Contents

serve in such positions effective immediately after the Closing. If any Person listed in Schedule 5.2 is unable to serve, the Party appointing such Person shall designate a successor; provided that, if such designation is to be made after the Closing, any successor to a Person designated by Parent shall be made by the Person serving in the capacity of Chairman of Parent immediately prior to the Closing.

5.3     HSR Act . If required pursuant to the HSR Act, as promptly as practicable but in no event later than ten (10) Business Days after the date of this Agreement, Parent and the Company (i) shall each prepare and file the notification required of it thereunder in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, (ii) shall promptly and in good faith respond to all information requested of it by the Federal Trade Commission and Department of Justice in connection with such notification and otherwise cooperate in good faith with each other and such Governmental Entities and (iii) shall each request early termination of any waiting period under the HSR Act. Parent and the Company shall (a) promptly inform the other of any communication to or from the Federal Trade Commission, the Department of Justice or any other Governmental Entity regarding the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and permit counsel to the other Party an opportunity to review in advance, and each Party shall consider in good faith the views of such counsel in connection with, any proposed written communications by such party to any Governmental Entity concerning the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, (b) give the other prompt notice of the commencement of any action, suit, litigation, arbitration, proceeding or investigation by or before any Governmental Entity with respect to such transactions and (c) keep the other reasonably informed as to the status of any such action, suit, litigation, arbitration, proceeding or investigation. Each Party agrees to provide, to the extent permitted by the applicable Governmental Entity, the other Party and its counsel the opportunity, on reasonable advance notice, to participate in any substantive meetings or discussions, either in person or by telephone, between such Party and/or any of its Affiliates, agents or advisors, on the one hand, and any Governmental Entity, on the other hand, concerning or in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby; provided, neither Party shall extend any waiting period or comparable period under the HSR Act or enter into any agreement with any Governmental Entity without the written consent of the other Party. Filing fees with respect to the notifications required under the HSR Act shall be shared equally by the Parent and the Company.

5.4     Public Announcements .

(a)    As promptly as practicable after execution of this Agreement, Parent will prepare and file a Current Report on Form 8-K pursuant to the Exchange Act to report the execution of this Agreement (“ Parent Signing Form 8-K ”).

(b)    Promptly after the execution of this Agreement, Parent and the Company shall also issue a joint press release announcing the execution of this Agreement (the “ Signing Press Release ”).

(c)    At least five (5) days prior to Closing, Parent shall prepare a draft Current Report on Form 8-K announcing the Closing, together with, or incorporating by reference, the financial statements prepared by the Company and its accountant, and such other information that may be required to be disclosed with respect to the Merger in any report or form to be filed with the SEC (“ Closing Form 8-K ”), which shall be in a form reasonably acceptable to the Company. Prior to Closing, Parent and the Company shall prepare a press release announcing the consummation of the Merger hereunder (“ Closing Press Release ”). Concurrently with the Closing, Parent shall distribute the Closing Press Release. Concurrently with the Closing, or as soon as practicable thereafter, Parent shall file the Closing Form 8-K with the Commission.

5.5     Required Information .

(a)    In connection with the preparation of the Parent Signing Form 8-K, the Signing Press Release, the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, the Closing Form 8-K, the Closing Press Release or any other statement, filing, notice, or application (other than pursuant to the HSR Act, for which Section  5.3 applies) made by or on behalf of Parent or the Company to any Governmental Entity or other third party in connection with Merger and the other

 

31


Table of Contents

transactions contemplated hereby (each, a “ Reviewable Document ”), and for such other reasonable purposes, each of the Company and Parent shall, upon request by the other, use commercially reasonable efforts (subject to applicable law and contractual restrictions) to furnish the other with all information concerning themselves, their Subsidiaries, and each of their and their Subsidiaries’ respective directors, officers, and stockholders (including the directors of Parent and the Company to be elected effective as of the Closing pursuant to Section  5.2 hereof) and such other matters as may be reasonably necessary or advisable in connection with the Merger. Each Party warrants and represents to the other Party that all such information shall be true and correct in all material respects and will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements contained therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

(b)    At a reasonable time prior to the filing, issuance, or other submission or public disclosure of a Reviewable Document by Parent or the Company, the other party shall each be given a reasonable opportunity to review and comment upon such Reviewable Document and give its consent to the form thereof, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, and each party shall accept and incorporate all reasonable comments from the other party to any such Reviewable Document prior to filing, issuance, submission or disclosure thereof. Furthermore, Parent and the Company shall cooperate and mutually agree upon (such agreement not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) any response to any SEC comments on any Reviewable Document and shall otherwise use commercially reasonable efforts to cause the Proxy Statement/Prospectus to be approved by the SEC, in each case, as promptly as practicable.

(c)    Any language included in a Reviewable Document that reflects the comments of the reviewing party, as well as any text as to which the reviewing party has not commented upon after being given a reasonable opportunity to comment, shall be deemed to have been approved by the reviewing party and may henceforth be used by other party in other Reviewable Documents and in other documents distributed by the other party in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement without further review or consent of the reviewing party.

(d)    Prior to the Closing Date, the Company and Parent shall notify each other as promptly as reasonably practicable (i) upon obtaining knowledge of any event or circumstance which should be described in an amendment of, or supplement to, a Reviewable Document that has been filed with or submitted to the Governmental Authority, and (ii) after the receipt by it of any written or oral comments of the Governmental Authority on, or of any written or oral request by the Governmental Authority for amendments or supplements to, any such Reviewable Document, and shall promptly supply the other with copies of all correspondence between it or any of its representatives and the Governmental Authority with respect to any of the foregoing filings or submissions. Parent and the Company shall use their respective commercially reasonable best efforts, after consultation with each other, to resolve all such requests or comments with respect to the any Reviewable Document as promptly as reasonably practicable after receipt of any comments of the Governmental Authority. All correspondence and communications to the Governmental Authority made by Parent or the Company with respect to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any agreement ancillary hereto shall, to extent permitted by applicable law, be considered to be Reviewable Documents subject to the provisions of this Section  5.5 .

5.6     No Securities Transactions . Neither the Company nor any of its controlled Affiliates, directly or indirectly, shall engage in any purchases or sales of the securities of Parent prior to the Effective Time without the consent of Parent. The Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to require each of its Affiliates that it controls to comply with the foregoing requirement.

5.7     No Claim Against Trust Fund . Notwithstanding anything else in this Agreement, the Company acknowledges that it has read Parent’s final prospectus dated January 31, 2019 (“ Final Prospectus ”) and understands that Parent has established the Trust Fund for the benefit of Parent’s public stockholders and that Parent may disburse monies from the Trust Fund only (a) to Parent’s public stockholders in the event they elect

 

32


Table of Contents

to convert their shares into cash in accordance with Parent’s Charter Documents and/or the liquidation of Parent or (b) to Parent after, or concurrently with, the consummation of a business combination. The Company further acknowledges that, if the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, or, upon termination of this Agreement, another business combination, are not consummated by August 4, 2020, or such later date as shall be set forth in an amendment to Parent’s Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation for the purpose of extending the date by which Parent must complete a business combination, Parent will be obligated to return to its stockholders the amounts being held in the Trust Fund. Accordingly, the Company, on behalf of itself and its Affiliates, hereby waives all rights, title, interest or claim of any kind against Parent to collect from the Trust Fund any monies that may be owed to them by Parent for any reason whatsoever, including but not limited to a breach of this Agreement by Parent or any negotiations, agreements or understandings with Parent (whether in the past, present or future), and will not seek recourse against the Trust Fund at any time for any reason whatsoever. This paragraph will survive the termination of this Agreement for any reason, but notwithstanding anything set forth herein will not limit the rights of the Company or its Stockholders at or following the Closing.

5.8     Disclosure of Certain Matters . Each of Parent and the Company will provide the others with prompt written notice of any event, development or condition of which it obtains knowledge that (a) gives such Party any reason to believe that any of the conditions to the obligations of the other Party set forth in Article VI will not be satisfied, or (b) would require any amendment or supplement to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus.

5.9     Securities Listing . Parent and the Company shall use reasonable best efforts  to continue the listing for trading of the Parent Common Stock on the NYSE.

5.10      Charter Protections; Directors’ and Officers’ Liability Insurance .

(a)    All rights to indemnification for acts or omissions occurring through the Closing Date now existing in favor of the current directors and officers of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries under applicable Law or as provided in the Charter Documents of the Company and its Subsidiaries or in any indemnification agreements shall survive the Merger and shall continue in full force and effect in accordance with their terms.

(b)    For a period of six (6) years after the Closing Date, each of Parent and the Surviving Corporation shall cause to be maintained in effect the current policies of directors’ and officers’ liability insurance maintained by Parent and the Company, respectively (or policies of at least the same coverage and amounts containing terms and conditions which are no less advantageous), with respect to claims arising from facts and events that occurred prior to the Closing Date.

(c)    If the Company or any of its successors or assigns (i) consolidates with or merges into any other Person and shall not be the continuing or surviving entity of such consolidation or merger, or (ii) transfers or conveys all or substantially all of its properties and assets to any Person, then, in each such case, to the extent necessary, proper provision shall be made so that the successors and assigns of the Company assume the obligations set forth in this Section  5.10 .

(d)    The provisions of this Section  5.10 are intended to be for the benefit of, and shall be enforceable by, each Person who will have been a director or officer of the Company for all periods ending on or before the Closing Date and may not be changed without the consent of a majority of those Persons serving on Parent’s Board after the Closing Date who served on the Company’s Board immediately prior to the Closing Date.

5.11     Insider Loans . The Company shall cause each executive officer of the Company or its Subsidiaries to, at or prior to Closing (i) repay to the Company any loan by the Company to such Person and any other amount owed by such Person to the Company; and (ii) cause any guaranty or similar arrangement pursuant to which the Company has guaranteed the payment or performance of any obligations of such Person to a third party to be terminated.

 

33


Table of Contents

5.12     Parent Borrowings . Through the Closing, Parent shall be allowed to borrow funds from its directors, officers and/or stockholders to meet its reasonable capital requirements, with any such loans to be made only as reasonably required by the operation of Parent in due course on a non-interest bearing basis and repayable in cash at Closing (the “ Parent Borrowings ”).

5.13     Trust Fund Disbursement . Parent shall cause the Trust Fund to be disbursed as contemplated by this Agreement immediately upon the Closing. All liabilities and obligations of Parent due and owing or incurred at or prior to the Closing Date shall be paid as and when due, including all amounts payable (i) to stockholders who elect to have their shares of Parent Common Stock converted to cash in accordance with the provisions of Parent’s Charter Documents (“ Redeeming Stockholders ”), (ii) for income Tax or other Tax obligations of Parent prior to Closing, and (iii) subject to Section  1.13(b) , (A) as repayment of Parent Borrowings, (B) to the underwriters in Parent’s initial public offering for payment of deferred underwriting commissions and (C) to third parties (e.g., professionals, printers, etc.) who have rendered services to Parent in connection with its operations and efforts to effect the Merger.

5.14     Parent Stockholders Agreement . Prior to the Closing Date, Parent shall enter into a stockholders agreement in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit B (the “ Parent Stockholders Agreement ”).

5.15     Lock-Up Agreements . Prior to the Closing Date, the Company will use reasonable best efforts to cause the Company Stockholders to agree not to transfer the shares of Parent Common Stock to be received hereunder as Per Share Merger Consideration (including any Contingent Shares, if issued prior to the end of such period) for a period of one (1) year from the Closing, subject to certain exceptions, which provisions will be set forth in the Letter of Transmittal. The Parent Certificates evidencing shares of Parent Common Stock issued hereunder shall each include prominent disclosure or bear a prominent legend evidencing the fact that such shares are subject to such lock-up provisions described in this Section  5.15 .

5.16     Registration Rights Agreement s . Prior to the Closing Date, Parent shall enter into a registration rights agreement in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit C (the “ Registration Rights Agreement ”) pursuant to which the Company Stockholders and certain other parties thereto will be granted certain registration rights relating to the aggregate Per Share Merger Consideration to be received by them herein. Parent shall use reasonable best efforts to terminate the Parent Registration Rights Agreement prior to the Closing and shall offer the Parent Stockholders who are party to the Parent Registration Rights Agreement prior to the Closing the opportunity to enter into the Registration Rights Agreement in connection with the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby.

5.17     Founder Common Stock Lock-Up . In addition to the existing restrictions on transfer of the Founder Common Stock as described in the Final Prospectus, prior to the Closing Date:

(a)    The Founder will, and Parent will cause the Founder to, enter into a Founder Lock-Up Agreement with the Parent in the form attached hereto as Exhibit D (“ Founder Lock-Up Agreement ”) pursuant to which an aggregate of 1,100,000 shares of Founder Common Stock will be subject to restrictions on transfer which restrictions will be removed only if the last reported sale price of the Parent Common Stock equals or exceeds $15.00 for a period of 20 consecutive trading days at any time until the fifth anniversary of the Closing. If the last reported sale price of the Parent Common Stock does not equal or exceed $15.00 within the required time period, such shares of Founder Common Stock will be forfeited to Parent for no consideration.

(b)    Each of the Founder and the Founder Insiders will, and Parent will cause the Founder and Founder Insiders to, enter into an amendment (collectively, the “ Insider Letter Amendments ”) to their respective Insider Letters, dated as of January 31, 2019, by and among the Founder, the Founder Insiders and Parent, as applicable (each, an “ Insider Letter ”), pursuant to which the lock-up provisions set forth in Sections 5(a) (with respect to the Founder’s Insider Letter) and Section 6(a) (with respect to the Founder Insiders Insider Letter) will expressly survive the termination of the Insider Letters until expiration of the transfer restrictions contained in each such section. Parent hereby agrees that it will enforce the terms of the Insider Letters against the Founder and the Founder Insiders, as applicable, with the Company as a third party beneficiary thereof.

 

34


Table of Contents

5.18     Intended Tax Treatment . On or after the date hereof, none of the Parties shall take any action, or fail to take any action, which action or failure to act would reasonably be expected to prevent or impede the Merger from qualifying as a “reorganization” within the meaning of Section 368(a) of the Code. The Parties will in all Tax Returns report the Merger in a manner consistent with such tax treatment, and no Party will take a position inconsistent with that treatment, unless required to do otherwise pursuant to a final determination as defined in Section 1313(a) of the Code (or pursuant to any similar provision of applicable state, local or foreign Law).

5.19     Incentive Equity Plan . Prior to the Closing Date, Parent shall cause to be adopted the Parent Plan, the proposed form and terms of which shall be prepared and delivered by the Company and which shall be reasonably acceptable to Parent.

5.20     Company Stockholder Approval . The Company shall, as promptly as practicable after the SEC Approval Date, give notice in accordance with the DGCL and the Company’s Charter Documents to all of its stockholders calling for a special meeting of such stockholders to consider and vote upon this Agreement and the Merger and the other transactions contemplated hereby, and shall hold such meeting as promptly as practicable after such notice is given (“ Company Stockholder Meeting ”). The Company shall timely send copies of the Proxy Statement/Prospectus and all other relevant information and documentation to its stockholders in connection with the Company Stockholder Meeting. The Company and its board of directors shall cause the Company Stockholder Meeting to take place in accordance with the foregoing and in compliance with the DGCL and the Company’s Charter Documents and use commercially reasonable best efforts to secure the Company Stockholder Approval at the Company Stockholder Meeting. Notwithstanding the foregoing, at the election and option of the Company, the Company shall be permitted to obtain the Company Stockholder Approval, without a need for calling a Company Stockholder Meeting, by obtaining the written consent of holders of a majority of the issued and outstanding shares of Company Stock that is executed and delivered by such holders after the SEC Approval Date and the Proxy Statement/Prospectus is delivered to such holders; provided , that, in the event that the Company elects to obtain the Company Stockholder Approval pursuant to such written consent, consents with respect to this Agreement, the Merger and the other transactions contemplated hereby will be solicited from all holders of shares of Company Stock.

ARTICLE VI

CONDITIONS TO THE TRANSACTION

6.1     Conditions to Obligations of Each Party to Effect the Merger . The respective obligations of each party to this Agreement to effect the Merger shall be subject to the satisfaction as of the Closing Date of the following conditions, any one or more of which may be waived (if legally permitted) in writing by all of such parties:

(a)     Parent Stockholder Matters . The Stockholder Matters shall have been duly approved and adopted by the affirmative vote of the Parent Stockholders required under Parent’s Charter Documents and the DGCL.

(b)     Parent Net Tangible Assets . Parent shall have at least $5,000,001 of net tangible assets following the exercise by holders of shares of Parent Common Stock issued in Parent’s initial public offering of securities and outstanding immediately before the Closing of their right to convert their shares into a pro rata share of the Trust Fund in accordance with Parent’s Charter Documents.

(c)     HSR Act; No Order . All specified waiting periods under the HSR Act shall have expired and no Governmental Entity shall have enacted, issued, promulgated, enforced or entered any statute, rule, regulation, executive order, decree, injunction or other order (whether temporary, preliminary or permanent) which is in effect and which has the effect of making the Merger illegal or otherwise prohibiting consummation of the Merger, substantially on the terms contemplated by this Agreement.

(d)     Proxy Statement . The Proxy Statement/Prospectus (including the Form S-4) shall have become effective in accordance with the provisions of the Securities Act, no stop order shall have been issued by the SEC

 

35


Table of Contents

which remains in effect with respect to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, and no proceeding seeking such a stop order shall have been threatened or initiated by the SEC which remains pending.

(e)     Company Stockholder Approval . The Company Stockholder Approval shall have been obtained.

6.2     Additional Conditions to Obligations of the Company . The obligations of the Company to consummate and effect the Merger shall be subject to the satisfaction as of the Closing Date of each of the following conditions, any of which may be waived, in writing, exclusively by the Company:

(a)     Representations and Warranties . Each representation and warranty of Parent and Merger Sub contained in this Agreement shall be true and correct (without giving any effect to any limitation as to “materiality” or “Material Adverse Effect” or any similar limitation set forth therein) as of the Closing Date as though then made (except to the extent such representations and warranties expressly relate to an earlier date, and in such case, shall be true and correct on and as of such earlier date), except, in either case, where the failure of such representations and warranties to be so true and correct, individually or in the aggregate, has not had, and would not reasonably be expected to result in, a Material Adverse Effect with respect to Parent. The Company shall have received a certificate with respect to the foregoing signed on behalf of Parent by an authorized officer of Parent (“ Parent Closing Certificate ”).

(b)     Agreements and Covenants . Parent and Merger Sub shall have performed or complied with all agreements and covenants required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by them on or prior to the Closing Date, except (other than with respect to Section  5.15 ) to the extent that any failure to perform or comply (other than a willful failure to perform or comply or failure to perform or comply in all material respects with an agreement or covenant reasonably within the control of Parent or Merger Sub) does not, or is not reasonably expected to, constitute a Material Adverse Effect with respect to Parent (or, after the Closing, the Company and its Subsidiaries), and the Parent Closing Certificate shall include a provision to such effect.

(c)     No Litigation . No action, suit or proceeding shall be pending or threatened by any Governmental Entity which is reasonably likely to (i) prevent consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, (ii) cause any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement to be rescinded following consummation or (iii) affect materially and adversely or otherwise encumber the title of the shares of Parent Common Stock to be issued by Parent in connection with the Merger and no order, judgment, decree, stipulation or injunction to any such effect shall be in effect.

(d)     Material Adverse Effect . No Material Adverse Effect with respect to Parent shall have occurred since the date of this Agreement, and the Parent Closing Certificate shall include a provision to such effect.

(e)     SEC Compliance . Immediately prior to Closing, Parent shall be in compliance with the reporting requirements under the Securities Act and Exchange Act.

(f)     Resignations . The persons listed in Schedule 6.2(f) shall have resigned from all of their positions and offices with Parent and Merger Sub.

(g)     Registration Rights Agreement . The Registration Rights Agreement shall have been executed and delivered and shall be in full force and effect.

(h)     Available Closing Date Cash . The Available Closing Date Cash shall not be less than $175,000,000, and the Parent Closing Certificate shall include a provision to such effect.

(i)     Merger Shares . The Parent Common Stock comprising the aggregate Per Share Merger Consideration to be issued pursuant to this Agreement shall have been approved for listing on the NYSE, subject only to official notice of issuance thereof and public holder requirements.

 

36


Table of Contents

(j)     Governing Documents . The Certificate of Incorporation of Parent, in a form reasonably acceptable to Parent and the Company, shall have been filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware and Parent shall have adopted the Bylaws, in a form reasonably acceptable to Parent and the Company.

(k)     Parent Registration Rights Agreement . The Parent Registration Rights Agreement shall have been terminated.

(l)     Parent Stockholders Agreement . The Parent Stockholders Agreement shall have been executed and delivered by Parent and shall be in full force and effect.

(m)     Founder Lock-Up Agreement . The Founder Lock-Up Agreement shall have been executed and delivered by Parent and the Founder and shall be in full force and effect.

(n)     Insider Letter Amendments . The Insider Letter Amendments shall have been executed and delivered by Parent, the Founder and the Founder Insiders and shall be in full force and effect.

6.3     Additional Conditions to the Obligations of Parent and Merger Sub . The obligations of Parent and Merger Sub to consummate and effect the Merger shall be subject to the satisfaction as of the Closing Date of each of the following conditions, any of which may be waived, in writing, exclusively by Parent:

(a)     Representations and Warranties . Each representation and warranty of the Company and the Stockholders contained in this Agreement shall be true and correct (without giving any effect to any limitation as to “materiality” or “Material Adverse Effect” or any similar limitation set forth therein) as of the Closing Date as though then made (except to the extent such representations and warranties expressly relate to an earlier date, and in such case, shall be true and correct on and as of such earlier date), except, in either case, where the failure of such representations and warranties to be so true and correct, individually or in the aggregate, has not had, and would not reasonably be expected to result in, a Material Adverse Effect on the Company. Parent shall have received a certificate with respect to the foregoing signed on behalf of the Company by an authorized officer of the Company (“ Company Closing Certificate ”).

(b)     Agreements and Covenants . The Company and its Subsidiaries shall have performed or complied with all agreements and covenants required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by them at or prior to the Closing Date except to the extent that any failure to perform or comply (other than a willful failure to perform or comply or failure to perform or comply in all material respects with an agreement or covenant reasonably within the control of the Company) does not, or is not reasonably expected to constitute a Material Adverse Effect on the Company, and the Company Closing Certificate shall include a provision to such effect.

(c)     No Litigation . No action, suit or proceeding shall be pending or threatened by any Governmental Entity which is reasonably likely to (i) prevent consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, (ii) cause any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement to be rescinded following consummation or (iii) affect materially and adversely the right of the Surviving Corporation to own, operate or control any of the assets and operations of the Company following the Merger and no order, judgment, decree, stipulation or injunction to any such effect shall be in effect.

(d)     Material Adverse Effect . No Material Adverse Effect with respect to the Company shall have occurred since the date of this Agreement, and the Company Closing Certificate shall include a provision to such effect.

(g)     Company Stockholders Agreement . The Company Stockholders Agreement shall have been terminated.

 

37


Table of Contents

ARTICLE VII

TERMINATION

7.1     Termination . This Agreement may be terminated at any time prior to the Closing:

(a)    by mutual written agreement of Parent and the Company at any time;

(b)    by either Parent or the Company if the Merger shall not have been consummated by October 30, 2019; provided, however, that the right to terminate this Agreement under this Section  7.1(b) shall not be available to any Party whose action or failure to act has been a principal cause of or primarily resulted in the failure of the Merger to occur on or before such date and such action or failure to act constitutes a breach of this Agreement;

(c)    by either Parent or the Company if a Governmental Entity shall have issued an order, decree, judgment or ruling or taken any other action, in any case having the effect of permanently restraining, enjoining or otherwise prohibiting the Merger, which order, decree, ruling or other action is final and nonappealable;

(d)    by the Company, upon a material breach of any representation, warranty, covenant or agreement on the part of Parent or Merger Sub set forth in this Agreement, or if any representation or warranty of Parent or Merger Sub shall have become untrue, in either case such that the conditions set forth in Article VI would not be satisfied as of the time of such breach or as of the time such representation or warranty shall have become untrue, provided, that if such breach by Parent or Merger Sub is curable by Parent or Merger Sub prior to the Closing Date, then the Company may not terminate this Agreement under this Section  7.1(d) for thirty (30) days after delivery of written notice from the Company to Parent of such breach, provided Parent and Merger Sub continues to exercise commercially reasonable efforts to cure such breach (it being understood that the Company may not terminate this Agreement pursuant to this Section  7.1(d) if it shall have materially breached this Agreement or if such breach by Parent or Merger Sub is cured during such thirty (30)-day period);

(e)    by Parent, upon a material breach of any representation, warranty, covenant or agreement on the part of the Company or a Stockholder set forth in this Agreement, or if any representation or warranty of the Company or a Stockholder shall have become untrue, in either case such that the conditions set forth in Article VI would not be satisfied as of the time of such breach or as of the time such representation or warranty shall have become untrue, provided, that if such breach is curable by the Company or a Stockholder prior to the Closing Date, then Parent may not terminate this Agreement under this Section  7.1(e) for thirty (30) days after delivery of written notice from Parent to the Company of such breach, provided the Company and the Stockholders continue to exercise commercially reasonable efforts to cure such breach (it being understood that Parent may not terminate this Agreement pursuant to this Section  7.1(e) if it shall have materially breached this Agreement or if such breach by the Company or a Stockholder is cured during such thirty (30)-day period);

(f)    by either Parent or the Company, if, at the Special Meeting (including any adjournments thereof), the Stockholder Matters shall fail to be approved by the affirmative vote of the Parent Stockholders required under Parent’s Charter Documents and the DGCL; or

(g)    by either Parent or the Company if, immediately following consummation of the Merger, Parent will have less than $5,000,001 of net tangible assets following the exercise by the holders of shares of Parent Common Stock issued in Parent’s initial public offering of their rights to convert the shares of Parent Common Stock held by them into cash in accordance with Parent’s Charter Documents.

7.2     Notice of Termination; Effect of Terminatio n .

(a)    Any termination of this Agreement under Section  7.1 above will be effective immediately upon (or, if the termination is pursuant to Section  7.1(d) or Section  7.1(e) and the proviso therein is applicable, thirty (30) days after) the delivery of written notice of the terminating party to the other parties hereto.

 

38


Table of Contents

(b)    In the event of the termination of this Agreement as provided in Section  7.1 , this Agreement shall be of no further force or effect and the Merger shall be abandoned, except for and subject to the following: (i)  Sections 4.2(a) , 5.7 , 7.2 and 7.3 and Article VIII (General Provisions) shall survive the termination of this Agreement, and (ii) nothing herein shall relieve any party from liability for any intentional and willful breach of this Agreement by such party occurring prior to such termination.

7.3     Fees and Expenses . Except as otherwise set forth herein, all fees and expenses incurred in connection with this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby shall be paid by the party incurring such expenses whether or not the Merger is consummated.

ARTICLE VIII

GENERAL PROVISIONS

8.1     Notices . All notices and other communications among the parties hereto shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered in person, (ii) when delivered after posting in the United States mail having been sent registered or certified mail return receipt requested, postage prepaid, (iii) when delivered by FedEx or other nationally recognized overnight delivery service or (iv) when e-mailed during normal business hours (and otherwise as of the immediately following Business Day), addressed as follows:

if to Parent, to:

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: Jonathan J. Ledecky

E-mail: jledecky@hockeyny.com

with a copy to:

Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: David Alan Miller / Jeffrey M. Gallant

E-mail: dmiller@graubard.com / jgallant@graubard.com

if to the Company to:

LD Topco, Inc.

KLDiscovery

8201 Greensboro Dr.

Suite 300

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: Christopher Weiler

Email: chris.weiler@kldiscovery.com

with a copy to:

Latham & Watkins LLP

555 Eleventh Street, N.W.

Washington, DC 20004

Attention: Paul Sheridan

Email: paul.sheridan@lw.com

 

39


Table of Contents

8.2     Interpretation . The definitions of the terms herein shall apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. Whenever the context shall require, any pronoun shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms. When a reference is made in this Agreement to an Exhibit or Schedule, such reference shall be to an Exhibit or Schedule to this Agreement unless otherwise indicated. When a reference is made in this Agreement to Sections or subsections, such reference shall be to a Section or subsection of this Agreement. Unless otherwise indicated the words “include,” “includes” and “including” when used herein shall be deemed in each case to be followed by the words “without limitation.” The table of contents and headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement. Reference to the Subsidiaries of an entity shall be deemed to include all direct and indirect Subsidiaries of such entity. References to a document or item of information having been “made available” will be deemed to include the posting of such document or item of information in an electronic data room accessible by Parent or any of its representatives. For purposes of this Agreement:

(a)    the term “ Affiliate ” means, as applied to any Person, any other Person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with, such Person. For purposes of this definition, “control” (including with correlative meanings, the terms “controlling,” “controlled by” and “under common control with”), as applied to any Person, means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise;

(b)    the term “ Available Closing Date Cash ” means, as of immediately prior to the Closing, an aggregate amount equal to the result of (without duplication) (i) the cash available to be released from the Trust Account and the aggregate net cash proceeds actually received from any investment in Parent approved after the date hereof pursuant to Section  4.1(f) , including up to $50,000,000 pursuant to the Forward Purchase Contract (if any), minus (ii) the aggregate amount of all redemptions of Parent Common Stock by any Redeeming Stockholders; minus (iii) the Outstanding Parent Expenses, minus (iv) to the extent not included in the Outstanding Parent Expenses, the sum of all outstanding deferred, unpaid or contingent underwriting, broker’s or similar fees, commissions or expenses owed by Parent or any other party to the extent Parent or any of its Subsidiaries is responsible for or obligated to reimburse or repay any such amounts, minus (v) the aggregate amount outstanding under all indebtedness for borrowed money of Parent or Merger Sub (including any Parent Borrowings);

(c)    the term “ Business Day ” means a day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks in New York, New York are authorized or required by law to close;

(d)    the term “ Company Equity Plan ” shall mean the LD Topco, Inc., 2016 Equity Incentive Plan, as amended and/or restated;

(e)    the term “ Company Intellectual Property ” shall mean any Intellectual Property that is owned by the Company, including software and software programs developed by the Company;

(f)    the term “ Company Products ” means all current versions of products or service offerings of the Company;

(g)    the term “ Company Registered Intellectual Property ” means all of the Registered Intellectual Property owned by the Company;

(h)    the term “ Company Stock Option ” shall mean an option to purchase shares of Company Stock granted pursuant to the Company Equity Plan;

(i)    the term “ Company Stockholder Approval ” shall mean approval (including by written consent) of this Agreement and the Merger by holders of a majority of the issued and outstanding shares of Company Stock;

 

40


Table of Contents

(j)    the term “ Copyrights ” shall mean all copyrights, copyrights registrations and applications therefor, and all other rights corresponding thereto throughout the world;

(k)    the term “ Environmental Law ” means any federal, state, local or foreign law, regulation, order, decree, permit, authorization, opinion, common law or agency requirement relating to: (i) the protection, investigation or restoration of the environment, health and safety (in relation to exposure to Hazardous Substances), or natural resources; (ii) the handling, use, presence, disposal, release or threatened release of any Hazardous Substance or (iii) noise, odor, wetlands, pollution, contamination or any injury or threat of injury to persons or property;

(l)    the term “ Exchange Ratio ” means (i) Merger Consideration divided by (ii) the number of issued and outstanding shares of Company Stock immediately prior to the Effective Time;

(m)    the term “ Form S-4 ” shall mean the registration statement on Form S-4 of Parent with respect to registration of the Parent Common Stock to be issued in connection with the Merger;

(n)    the term “ Forward Purchase Contract ” means that certain Forward Purchase Contract, dated as of as of January 31, 2019, between Parent and Pivotal Spac Funding LLC;

(o)    the term “ Founder ” means Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC;

(p)    the term “ Founder Insiders ” means each of the individuals set forth on Schedule 8.2(p) ;

(q)    the term “ Governmental Action/Filing ” shall mean any franchise, license, certificate of compliance, authorization, consent, order, permit, approval, consent or other action of, or any filing, registration or qualification with, any federal, state, municipal, foreign or other governmental, administrative or judicial body, agency or authority;

(r)    the term “ Governmental Entity ” shall mean any court, administrative agency, commission, governmental or regulatory authority or similar body, domestic or foreign;

(s)    the term “ Hazardous Substance ” means any substance that is: (i) listed, classified or regulated pursuant to any Environmental Law; (ii) any petroleum product or by-product, asbestos-containing material, lead-containing paint or plumbing, polychlorinated biphenyls, radioactive materials or radon; or (iii) any other substance which is the subject of regulatory action by any Governmental Entity pursuant to any Environmental Law;

(t)    the term “ Insider ” shall mean any individual who is an officer, director or employee of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries;

(u)    the term “ Insurance Policies ” shall mean all material insurance policies and material fidelity and surety bonds covering the assets, business, equipment, properties, operations, employees, officers and directors;

(v)    the term “ Intellectual Property ” shall mean any or all of the following and all worldwide common law and statutory rights in, arising out of, or associated therewith: (i) Patents; (ii) inventions (whether patentable or not), invention disclosures, improvements, trade secrets, proprietary information, know how, technology, technical data and customer lists, and all documentation relating to any of the foregoing; (iii) Copyrights; (iv) software and software programs; (v) domain names, uniform resource locators and other names and locators associated with the Internet (vi) industrial designs and any registrations and applications therefor; (vii) Trademarks; (viii) all databases and data collections and all rights therein; (ix) all moral and economic rights of authors and inventors, however denominated, and (x) any similar or equivalent rights to any of the foregoing (as applicable);

 

41


Table of Contents

(w)    the term “ knowledge ” means actual knowledge or awareness as to a specified fact or event (i) in the case of the Company, of Christopher Weiler and Dawn Wilson, and (ii) in the case of Parent or Merger Sub, Jonathan Ledecky;

(x)    the term “ Legal Requirements ” means any federal, state, local, municipal, foreign or other law, statute, constitution, principle of common law, resolution, ordinance, code, edict, decree, rule, regulation, ruling or requirement issued, enacted, adopted, promulgated, implemented or otherwise put into effect by or under the authority of any Governmental Entity;

(y)    the term “ Lien ” means any mortgage, pledge, security interest, encumbrance, lien, restriction or charge of any kind (including, without limitation, any conditional sale or other title retention agreement or lease in the nature thereof, any sale with recourse against the seller or any Affiliate of the seller, or any agreement to give any security interest);

(z)    the term “ Material Adverse Effect ” when used in connection with the Company or Parent, as the case may be, means any change, event, occurrence or effect, individually or when aggregated with other changes, events, occurrences or effects, that has a materially adverse effect on the business or financial condition of the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as whole, or Parent and Merger Sub, taken together, as applicable, provided however that none of the following (or the effect of any of the following) alone or in combination shall be deemed, in and of itself, to constitute, or be taken into account in determining whether there has been or will be, a Material Adverse Effect: any changes, events, occurrences or effects arising out of, resulting from or attributable to (i) acts of war, sabotage or terrorism, or any escalation or worsening of any such acts of war, sabotage or terrorism, (ii) earthquakes, hurricanes, tornados or other natural or man-made disasters, acts of God or other force majeure events, (iii) any proposal, enactment or change in interpretation of, or other change in, applicable Legal Requirements, U.S. GAAP (or equivalent accounting practice in any other jurisdiction) or governmental policy or any development or effect of any investigation, audit or review of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries by any Governmental Entity commencing from and after the date hereof, (iv) general conditions in the industries in which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries operate, (v) the failure, in and of itself, of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to meet any internal or published projections, forecasts, estimates or predictions in respect of revenue, earnings or other financial or operating metrics before, on or after the date of this Agreement, or changes in the credit rating of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (it being understood that the underlying facts giving rise or contributing to such failure or change may be taken into account in determining whether there has been a Material Adverse Effect if otherwise contemplated by this definition), (vi) changes attributable to the public announcement or pendency of the transactions contemplated hereby or the performance of this Agreement, including the impact thereof on relationships, contractual or otherwise, with customers, suppliers, licensors, distributors, partners, providers and employees, (vii) any change in interest rates or economic, political, business, financial, commodity, currency or market conditions generally or (viii) any action taken or omitted to be taken by the Company or its Subsidiaries at Parent’s direction or written request (including any action not taken as a result of the failure of Parent to consent to any action requiring Parent’s consent) or otherwise required or permitted to be taken or omitted to be taken by this Agreement or to which Parent has consented in writing; provided, however, in the case of the foregoing clauses (i), (ii), (iii), (iv) and (vii), in the event that the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, are materially and disproportionately affected by such change, event, occurrence or effect relative to other participants in the business and industries in which the Company and its Subsidiaries operate, the extent (and only the extent) of such adverse effect, relative to such other participants, on the Company or any of its Subsidiaries may be taken into account in determining whether there has been a Material Adverse Effect;

(aa)    the term “ Merger Consideration ” shall mean an aggregate of (i) 34,800,000 shares of Parent Common Stock (“ Merger Shares ”) and (ii) 2,200,000 additional shares of Parent Common Stock (“ Contingent Shares ”) if same are issued in accordance with Section  1.12 . The Merger Shares and Contingent Shares shall be referred to herein collectively as the “ Merger Consideration ”;

 

42


Table of Contents

(bb)    the term “ Parent Plan ” shall mean a management incentive equity plan to be adopted by Parent in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby;

(cc)    the term “ Parent Registration Rights Agreement ” shall mean that certain registration rights agreement, dated as of January 31, 2019, by and among Parent and the other parties thereto.

(dd)    the term “ Patents ” shall mean all patents and applications therefor and all reissues, divisions, renewals, extensions, provisionals, continuations and continuations-in-part thereof;

(ee)    the term “ Permitted Liens ” shall mean (i) statutory Liens for Taxes, assessments or other governmental charges, in each case, not yet delinquent or the amount or validity of which is being contested in good faith, (ii) mechanics’, carriers’, workers’, repairers’ and similar Liens arising or incurred in the ordinary course of business, (iii) zoning, entitlement and other land use and environmental regulations promulgated by any Governmental Entity, (iv) Liens of public record, (v) covenants, conditions, restrictions, easements, rights of way, encumbrances, defects, imperfections, irregularities of title or other Liens, if any, that would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (vi) with respect to any leased real property, (a) the interests and rights of the respective lessors with respect thereto and (b) any Lien permitted under the applicable lease agreement and any ancillary documents thereto, (vii) Liens created by Parent or its successors and assigns, (viii) Liens disclosed in the Company Schedule or the Parent Schedule, including those listed in Schedule 8.2( ee ) , (ix) Liens (other than monetary liens) incurred in the ordinary course of business since the date of the most recent Financial Statement, (x) licenses to Intellectual Property granted in the ordinary course of business, (xi) Liens securing the Company’s and its Subsidiaries’ existing credit facilities and (xii) statutory or contractual Liens of lessors or Liens on the lessor’s or prior lessor’s interest;

(ff)    the term “ Person ” shall mean any individual, corporation (including any non-profit corporation), general partnership, limited partnership, limited liability partnership, joint venture, estate, trust, company (including any limited liability company or joint stock company), firm or other enterprise, association, organization, entity or Governmental Entity;

(gg)    the term “ Proxy Statement/Prospectus ” means the proxy statement/prospectus included in the Form S-4, including the proxy statement filed by Parent on Schedule 14A with respect to the Special Meeting to approve the Stockholder Matters, relating to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement which shall constitute a proxy statement of Parent to be used for the Special Meeting to approve the Stockholder Matters (which shall also provide the Parent Stockholders with the opportunity to redeem their shares of Parent Stock in conjunction with a stockholder vote on the Merger Proposal) and a prospectus with respect to the Parent Common Stock to be offered and issued to the Company Stockholders in all cases in accordance with and as required by the Parent’s Charter Documents, applicable Law, and the rules and regulations of the NYSE;

(hh)    the term “ Registered Intellectual Property ” means all Intellectual Property that is the subject of an application, certificate, filing, registration or other document issued, filed with, or recorded by any government or other legal authority;

(ii)    the term “ Tax ” or “ Taxes ” refers to any and all federal, state, local and foreign taxes, including, without limitation, gross receipts, income, profits, sales, use, occupation, value added, ad valorem, transfer, franchise, withholding, payroll, recapture, employment, excise and property taxes, assessments, governmental charges and duties together with all interest, penalties and additions imposed with respect to any such amounts and including any liability of a predecessor entity for any such amounts;

(jj)    the term “ Trademarks ” shall mean trade names, logos, common law trademarks and service marks, trademark and service mark registrations and applications therefor; and

(kk)    all monetary amounts set forth herein are referenced in United States dollars, unless otherwise noted.

 

43


Table of Contents

8.3     Counterparts; Electronic Delivery . This Agreement and each other document executed in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby, and the consummation thereof, may be executed in one or more counterparts, all of which shall be considered one and the same document and shall become effective when one or more counterparts have been signed by each of the parties and delivered to the other party, it being understood that all parties need not sign the same counterpart. Delivery by electronic transmission to counsel for the other party of a counterpart executed by a party shall be deemed to meet the requirements of the previous sentence.

8.4     Entire Agreement; Third Party Beneficiaries . This Agreement and the documents and instruments and other agreements among the Parties as contemplated by or referred to herein, including the Exhibits and Schedules hereto, and the Confidentiality Agreement (which will terminate at the Closing) (a) constitute the entire agreement among the Parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and supersede all prior agreements and understandings, both written and oral, among the Parties and any of their respective Affiliates with respect to the transactions contemplated hereby; and (b) are not intended to confer upon any other person any rights or remedies hereunder (except as specifically provided in this Agreement, including Sections 5.10 and 8.16 ). No representations, warranties, covenants, understandings, agreements, oral or otherwise, relating to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement exist between the parties except as expressly set forth or referenced in this Agreement and the Confidentiality Agreement.

8.5     Severability . In the event that any provision of this Agreement, or the application thereof, becomes or is declared by a court of competent jurisdiction to be illegal, void or unenforceable, the remainder of this Agreement will continue in full force and effect and the application of such provision to other persons or circumstances will be interpreted so as reasonably to effect the intent of the parties hereto. The parties further agree to replace such void or unenforceable provision of this Agreement with a valid and enforceable provision that will achieve, to the extent possible, the economic, business and other purposes of such void or unenforceable provision.

8.6     Other Remedies; Specific Performance . Except as otherwise provided herein, any and all remedies herein expressly conferred upon a party will be deemed cumulative with and not exclusive of any other remedy conferred hereby, or by law or equity upon such party, and the exercise by a party of any one remedy will not preclude the exercise of any other remedy. The parties hereto agree that irreparable damage would occur in the event that any of the provisions of this Agreement were not performed in accordance with their specific terms or were otherwise breached. It is accordingly agreed that the parties shall be entitled to an injunction or injunctions to prevent breaches of this Agreement and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions hereof in any court of the United States or any state having jurisdiction, this being in addition to any other remedy to which they are entitled at law or in equity. Each Party agrees that it will not oppose the granting of specific performance and other equitable relief on the basis that the other parties have an adequate remedy at law or that an award of specific performance is not an appropriate remedy for any reason at law or equity. The Parties acknowledge and agree that any Party seeking an injunction to prevent breaches of this Agreement and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions of this Agreement in accordance with this Section  8.6 shall not be required to provide any bond or other security in connection with any such injunction.

8.7     Governing Law . This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the internal law of the State of Delaware regardless of the law that might otherwise govern under applicable principles of conflicts of law thereof.

8.8     Consent to Jurisdiction; WAIVER OF TRIAL BY JURY . Each of the parties hereto irrevocably consents to the exclusive jurisdiction and venue of the Delaware Chancery Court (or, if the Delaware Chancery Court shall be unavailable, any other court in the State of Delaware or, in the case of claims to which the federal courts have exclusive subject matter jurisdiction, any federal courts of the United States of America sitting in the State of Delaware) in connection with any matter based upon or arising out of this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby, agrees that process may be served upon them in any manner authorized by the laws of the State of Delaware for such persons and waives and covenants not to assert or plead any objection which they

 

44


Table of Contents

might otherwise have to such jurisdiction, venue and manner of service of process. Each party hereto hereby agrees not to commence any legal proceedings relating to or arising out of this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby in any jurisdiction or courts other than as provided herein. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION BASED UPON, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATED TO THIS AGREEMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

8.9     Rules of Construction . The parties hereto agree that they have been represented by counsel during the negotiation and execution of this Agreement and, therefore, waive the application of any law, regulation, holding or rule of construction providing that ambiguities in an agreement or other document will be construed against the party drafting such agreement or document.

8.10     Assignment . No Party may assign either this Agreement or any of its rights, interests, or obligations hereunder without the prior written approval of the other parties; provided, however, that the Company and its Subsidiaries may collaterally assign any of its or their rights hereunder to any of its debt financing sources. Subject to the first sentence of this Section  8.10 , this Agreement shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and permitted assigns.

8.11     Amendment . This Agreement may be amended by the parties hereto at any time only by execution of an instrument in writing signed on behalf of each of the parties. The approval of this Agreement by the stockholders of any Party shall not restrict the ability of the board of directors of such Party to terminate this Agreement in accordance with Section  7.1 or to cause such Party to enter into an amendment to this Agreement pursuant to this Section  8.11 .

8.12     Extension; Waiver . At any time prior to the Closing, any party hereto may, to the extent legally allowed, (i) extend the time for the performance of any of the obligations or other acts of the other parties hereto, (ii) waive any inaccuracies in the representations and warranties made to such party contained herein or in any document delivered pursuant hereto and (iii) waive compliance with any of the agreements or conditions for the benefit of such party contained herein. Any agreement on the part of a Party to any such extension or waiver shall be valid only if set forth in an instrument in writing signed on behalf of such Party. Delay in exercising any right under this Agreement shall not constitute a waiver of such right.

8.13     Currency . All references to currency amounts in this Agreement shall mean United States dollars.

8.14     Schedules . The information furnished in the Schedules is arranged in sections corresponding to the Sections of this Agreement, and the disclosures in any section of the Schedules shall qualify (a) the corresponding Section of this Agreement and (b) other Sections of this Agreement to the extent (notwithstanding the absence of a specific cross-reference), that it is reasonably apparent on its face that such disclosure is also applicable to such other Sections of this Agreement. The Schedules and the information and disclosures contained in such Schedules are intended only to qualify and limit the representations and warranties of the parties contained in this Agreement and shall not be deemed to expand in any way the scope of any such representation or warranty. The inclusion of any information in the Schedules shall not be deemed to be an admission or acknowledgment that such information is material or outside the ordinary course of business. The inclusion of any fact or information in a Schedule is not intended to be construed as an admission or concession as to the legal effect of any such fact or information in any proceeding between any party and any Person who is not a party.

8.15     Nonsurvival of Representations, Warranties and Covenants . None of the representations, warranties, covenants, obligations or other agreements in this Agreement or in any certificate, statement or instrument delivered pursuant to this Agreement, including any rights arising out of any breach of such representations, warranties, covenants, obligations, agreements and other provisions, shall survive the Closing, and they shall terminate and expire upon the occurrence of the Effective Time (and there shall be no liability after the Closing

 

45


Table of Contents

in respect thereof), except for (a) those covenants and agreements contained herein (or in instruments executed pursuant to this Agreement) that by their terms expressly apply in whole or in part after the Closing and then only with respect to any breaches to the extent occurring after the Closing and (b) this Article VIII .

8.16     Non-Recourse . This Agreement may only be enforced against, and any claim or cause of action based upon, arising out of, or related to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby may only be brought against, the entities that are expressly named as parties hereto and then only with respect to the specific obligations set forth herein with respect to such party. Except to the extent a Party hereto (and then only to the extent of the specific obligations undertaken by such party hereto), no past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator, member, partner, stockholder, Affiliate, agent, attorney, advisor or representative of any Party hereto, any Affiliate of any Party hereto or any of the foregoing shall have any liability (whether in contract, tort, equity or otherwise) for any one or more of the representations, warranties, covenants, agreements or other obligations or liabilities of any one or more of the Company, Parent, Merger Sub or other party under this Agreement of or for any claim based on, arising out of, or related to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

46


Table of Contents

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be executed as of the date first written above.

 

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.

By:  

 

/s/ Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Name: Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Title: Chief Executive Officer

PIVOTAL MERGER SUB CORP.

By:

 

/s/ Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Name: Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Title: Chief Executive Officer

LD TOPCO, INC.

By:

 

/s/ Dawn Wilson

 

Name: Dawn Wilson

 

Title: CFO and Treasurer

CARLYLE EQUITY OPPORTUNITY GP, L.P.
(solely in its capacity as the initial Representative hereunder)
By: CARLYLE EQUITY OPPORTUNITY GP, L.L.C., as its general partner

By:

 

/s/ William Darman

 

Name: William Darman

 

Title: Managing Director

 

47


Table of Contents

Annex B

[TO BE FILED BY AMENDMENT]


Table of Contents

Annex C

[TO BE FILED BY AMENDMENT]


Table of Contents

Annex D

May 17, 2019

Personal and Confidential

Board of Directors of

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Members of the Board of Directors:

You have requested our opinion as to (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), of the Merger Consideration (as defined below) to be paid by the Company pursuant to that certain Agreement and Plan of Reorganization (the “ Agreement ”) by and among the Company, Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (“ Merger Sub ”), and LDTopco, Inc. (d/b/a KLDiscovery), a Delaware corporation (the “ Target ”), pursuant to which Merger Sub will merge with and into the Target, with the Target being the surviving entity of such merger and a direct wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (the “ Transaction ”), and (ii) whether the fair market value of the Target equals or exceeds 80% of the amount held by the Company in trust for benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions). The Transaction consists of (i) an aggregate of 34,800,000 1 shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.0001 per share (“ Company Common Stock ”) and the right to receive up to 2,200,000 additional shares of Company Common Stock that may be issued upon the achievement of certain targets described in the Agreement (collectively, the Merger Consideration ”), (ii) an aggregate of 23,000,000 1 shares of Company Common Stock, (iii) the assumption of $223,000,000 in net indebtedness (calculated as $359,000,000 existing net indebtedness less the repayment of $136,000,000 of indebtedness), (iv) less the net present value of tax savings of $49,000,000 (calculated as the present value of $130,000,000 in net operating losses and $350,000,000 in tax deductible goodwill and other intangible assets), and (v) an aggregate of 4,700,000 Company founder shares. The specific terms and conditions of the Transaction are more fully set forth in the Agreement. Capitalized terms used but not otherwise defined in this letter have the same meaning as in the Agreement.

We, as a customary part of our investment banking business, are continually engaged in performing financial analyses with respect to businesses and their securities in connection with mergers and acquisitions, negotiated underwritings, competitive biddings, secondary distributions of listed and unlisted securities, private placements and other transactions as well as for estate, corporate and other purposes. We have been engaged by the Company to render this opinion to its Board of Directors and we will receive a fee from the Company for providing this opinion, which is not contingent upon closing of the Transaction, and the Company has agreed to reimburse certain of our expenses arising, and indemnify us against certain liabilities that may arise, out of our engagement relating to advising the Company on the Transaction. Furthermore, we have not been requested to, and did not, (i) participate in negotiations with respect to the Agreement, (ii) solicit any expressions of interest from any other parties with respect to any business combination with the Company or any other alternative transaction or (iii) advise the Board of Directors of the Company or any other party with respect to alternatives to the Transaction. In addition, we were not requested to and did not provide advice regarding the structure or any other aspect of the Transaction, or to provide services other than the delivery of this opinion. We have not otherwise acted as financial advisor to any party to the Transaction. In the ordinary course of our business, we and our affiliates may actively trade securities of the Company for our own account or the account of our customers and, accordingly, we may at any time hold a long or short position in such securities. We may seek to be engaged for compensation in the future to perform investment banking services for the Company.

 

(1)  

Assumes a $10.00 per share price

 

D-1


Table of Contents

In connection with our review of the Transaction and in arriving at our opinion, we have made such reviews, analyses and inquiries as we have deemed necessary and appropriate under the circumstances. Among other things, we have: (i) reviewed and analyzed the financial terms of the draft of the Agreement received on May 15, 2019; (ii) reviewed and analyzed certain historical financial, operating and business information related to the Target; (iii) reviewed and analyzed certain internal financial projections of the Target prepared for financial planning purposes and furnished by the management of the Target; (iv) reviewed and analyzed certain publicly available information relative to the Company; (v) reviewed and analyzed certain historical financial, operating, market and securities data of the Company publicly available or furnished by the management of the Company, as applicable; (vi) conducted discussions with management of the Company with respect to the Company’s strategic reasons for pursuing the Transaction and the Company’s valuation of the Target; (vii) conducted discussions with members of management of the Company and the Target with respect to the business and prospects of the Company and the Target, respectively, on a stand-alone basis and on a combined basis; (viii) reviewed and analyzed the reported prices and trading activity of shares of Company Common Stock; (ix) compared the financial performance of the Target with that of certain other publicly traded companies deemed by us to be comparable to the Target; (x) to the extent publicly available, reviewed and analyzed financial terms of certain acquisition transactions involving companies operating in businesses and industries deemed similar to that in which the Target operates and selected companies deemed comparable to the Target; (xi) performed discounted cash flows analyses on the Target on a stand-alone basis incorporating various assumptions provided to us by the management of each of the Company and the Target; and (xii) compared the fair market value of the Target implied by the various financial analyses that we conducted to the amount held by the Company in trust for the benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions and taxes payable on the income earned on the trust account), as provided by management of the Target and the Company, as applicable. In addition, we have conducted such other analyses, examinations and inquiries and considered such other financial, economic and market criteria as we have deemed necessary and appropriate in arriving at our opinion.

In conducting our review of the Transaction, financial analyses and in rendering our opinion, we have relied upon and assumed, without independent verification, the accuracy and completeness of all data, material and other information furnished, or otherwise made available, to us, discussed with or reviewed by us, or publicly available, and do not assume any responsibility with respect to such data, material and other information. In addition, management of the Company has advised us, and we have assumed, that the financial projections reviewed by us have been reasonably prepared in good faith on bases reflecting the best currently available estimates and judgments of the management of the Company as to the future financial results and condition of the Company and the combined company, the best currently available estimates and judgments of the management of the Target as to the future financial results and condition of the Target, and we express no opinion with respect to such projections or the assumptions on which they are based. If any of the foregoing assumptions are not accurate, the conclusion set forth in this opinion could be materially affected. Neither the Company nor the Target publicly disclose internal financial information of the type provided to us in connection with our review of the Transaction. As a result, such information was prepared for financial planning purposes by management of the Company and the Target, as applicable, and was not prepared with the expectation of public disclosure.

We have been advised by management of the Company, and we have assumed with the consent of management of the Company, that, as of the date hereof, the amount held by the Company in trust for the benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions) is equal to $223,300,000.

As you are aware, the credit, financial and stock markets have from time to time experienced unusual volatility and we express no opinion or view as to any potential effects of such volatility on the Transaction and this opinion does not purport to address potential developments in any such markets.

We have relied upon and assumed, without independent verification, that there has been no change in the business, assets, liabilities, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows or prospects of the Company or

 

D-2


Table of Contents

the Target since the respective dates of the most recent financial statements and other information, financial or otherwise, provided to us that would be material to our analyses or this opinion, and that there is no information or any facts that would make any of the information reviewed by us incomplete or misleading.

We have assumed that the final form of the Agreement will be substantially similar to the draft, received on May 15, 2019, reviewed by us, without modification of material terms or conditions. We have assumed that the Transaction will be consummated pursuant to the terms of the Agreement without amendments thereto and without waiver by any party of any conditions or obligations thereunder. In arriving at our opinion, we have assumed that all the necessary regulatory approvals and consents required for the Transaction will be obtained in a manner that will not adversely affect the Company or the Target or alter the terms of the Transaction.

In arriving at our opinion, we have not performed any appraisals or valuations of any specific assets or liabilities (fixed, contingent or other) of the Company or the Target, including any intellectual property for which the Company or the Target may or may not currently receive royalty or licensing fees, and we have not been furnished with any such appraisals or valuations, and have made no physical inspection of the property or assets of the Company or the Target. We express no opinion regarding the liquidation value of any entity.

We were not requested to opine, and no opinion is hereby rendered, as to whether any analyses of an entity, other than as a going concern, is appropriate in the circumstances and, accordingly, we have performed no such analyses. We have undertaken no independent analysis of any pending or threatened litigation, governmental proceedings or investigations, possible unasserted claims or other contingent liabilities, to which any of the Company, the Target or their respective affiliates is a party or may be subject and at the Company’s direction and with its consent, our opinion makes no assumption concerning and therefore does not consider, the possible assertion of claims, outcomes, damages or recoveries arising out of any such matters. No company or transaction used in any analysis for purposes of comparison is identical to the Company, the Target or the Transaction. Accordingly, an analysis of the results of the comparisons is not mathematical; rather, it involves complex considerations and judgments about differences in the companies and transactions to which the Company, the Target and the Transaction were compared and other factors that could affect the public trading value or transaction value of the companies, as applicable.

This opinion is necessarily based upon the financial, market, economic and other conditions that exist on, and the information made available to us as of, the date hereof. It should be understood that subsequent developments may affect this opinion and that we disclaim any undertaking or obligation to advise any person of any change in any fact or matter affecting this opinion which may come or be brought to our attention after the date of the opinion. We are not expressing any opinion herein as to the price at which shares of Company Common Stock have traded or such stock may trade following announcement of the Transaction or at any future time. We have not undertaken to reaffirm or revise this opinion or otherwise comment upon any events occurring after the date hereof and do not have any obligation to update, revise or reaffirm this opinion.

Consistent with applicable legal and regulatory requirements, we have adopted policies and procedures to establish and maintain the independence of our research department and personnel. As a result, our research analysts may hold opinions, make statements or recommendations, and/or publish research reports with respect to the Company, the Target, the Transaction and other participants in the Transaction that differ from the views of our investment banking personnel.

This opinion is furnished pursuant to our engagement letter dated May 13, 2019 (the “ Engagement Letter ”). This opinion is directed to the Board of Directors of the Company in connection with its consideration of the Transaction. This opinion is not intended to be and does not constitute a recommendation to any stockholder of the Company as to how such stockholder should act or vote with respect to the Transaction or any other matter. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Board of Directors of the Company is authorized to rely upon this opinion. Except with respect to the use of this opinion in connection with the proxy or information statement relating to the Transaction in accordance with the Engagement Letter, this opinion shall not be published, disclosed or

 

D-3


Table of Contents

otherwise used, nor shall any public references to us be made, without our prior written approval; provided that any summary of this opinion is in form and substance reasonably acceptable to us and our counsel.

This opinion addresses solely (i) the fairness, from a financial point of view, to the Company of the Merger Consideration to be paid in the Transaction pursuant to the Agreement, and (ii) whether the fair market value of the Target equals or exceeds 80% of the amount held by the Company in trust for benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions and taxes payable on the income earned on the trust account), and does not address any other terms or agreement relating to the Transaction. We were not requested to opine as to, and this opinion does not address, the basic business decision to proceed with or effect the Transaction, or any solvency or fraudulent conveyance consideration relating to the Transaction. We express no opinion as to the relative merits of the Transaction as compared to any alternative business strategies or transactions that might exist for the Company, the Target or any other party or the effect of any other transaction in which the Company, the Target or any other party might engage. We express no opinion as to the amount, nature or fairness of the consideration or compensation to be received in or as a result of the Transaction by securityholders, officers, directors or employees of the Company, or any other class of such persons, or relative to or in comparison with the Merger Consideration. We have not been asked to consider, and this opinion does not address, the price at which the Company Common Stock will trade at any time or as to the impact of the Transaction on the solvency or viability of the Company to pay its obligations when they come due. We are not rendering any financial, legal, accounting or other advice and understand that the Company is relying on its legal counsel and accounting advisors as to legal and accounting matters in connection with the Transaction.

The preparation of a fairness opinion is a complex, analytical process involving various determinations as to the most appropriate and relevant methods of financial analysis and the application of those methods to the particular circumstances and is not necessarily susceptible to partial analysis or summary description. In arriving at this opinion, we did not attribute any particular weight to any particular analysis or factor considered by us, but rather made qualitative judgments as to the significance and relevance of each analysis and factor. Several analytical methodologies were employed by us in our analyses, and no one method of analysis should be regarded as critical to the overall conclusion reached herein. Each analytical technique has inherent strengths and weaknesses, and the nature of the available information may further affect the value of particular techniques. Accordingly, we believe that our analyses must be considered as a whole and that selecting portions of our analyses and of the factors considered by us, without considering all analyses and factors in their entirety, could create a misleading or incomplete view of the evaluation process underlying this opinion. The conclusion reached by us, therefore, is based on the application of our own experience and judgment to all analyses and factors considered by us, taken as a whole. This opinion was reviewed and approved by the Northland Fairness Opinion Committee.

Based upon and subject to the foregoing and based upon such other factors as we consider relevant, it is our opinion that, as of the date hereof, (i) the Merger Consideration to be paid by the Company in the Transaction pursuant to the Agreement is fair, from a financial point of view, to the Company, and (ii) the fair market value of the Target equals or exceeds 80% of the amount held by the Company in trust for benefit of its public stockholders (excluding any deferred underwriting commissions).

Sincerely,

Northland Securities, Inc.

 

D-4


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

PROSPECTUS FOR UP TO 37,000,000 SHARES OF COMMON STOCK

OF

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

 

 

 

DEALER PROSPECTUS DELIVERY OBLIGATION

Until                 , 2019, all dealers that effect transactions in these securities, whether or not

participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition

to the dealers’ obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with

respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

PART II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 20. Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Section 145 of the DGCL concerning indemnification of officers, directors, employees and agents is set forth below.

“Section 145. Indemnification of officers, directors, employees and agents; insurance.

 

(a)

A corporation shall have power to indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) by reason of the fact that the person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe the person’s conduct was unlawful. The termination of any action, suit or proceeding by judgment, order, settlement, conviction, or upon a plea of nolo contendere or its equivalent, shall not, of itself, create a presumption that the person did not act in good faith and in a manner which the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had reasonable cause to believe that the person’s conduct was unlawful.

 

(b)

A corporation shall have power to indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that the person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with the defense or settlement of such action or suit if the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and except that no indemnification shall be made in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the Court of Chancery or the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine upon application that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for such expenses which the Court of Chancery or such other court shall deem proper.

 

(c)

To the extent that a present or former director or officer of a corporation has been successful on the merits or otherwise in defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to in subsections (a) and (b) of this section, or in defense of any claim, issue or matter therein, such person shall be indemnified against expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection therewith.

 

(d)

Any indemnification under subsections (a) and (b) of this section (unless ordered by a court) shall be made by the corporation only as authorized in the specific case upon a determination that indemnification of the present or former director, officer, employee or agent is proper in the circumstances because the person has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in subsections (a) and (b) of this section. Such determination shall be made, with respect to a person who is a director or officer of the corporation at the time of such determination, (1) by a majority vote of the directors who are not parties to such action, suit or proceeding, even though less than a quorum, or (2) by a committee of such directors designated by majority vote of such directors, even though less than a quorum, or (3) if there are no such directors, or if such directors so direct, by independent legal counsel in a written opinion, or (4) by the stockholders.

 

II-1


Table of Contents
(e)

Expenses (including attorneys’ fees) incurred by an officer or director of the corporation in defending any civil, criminal, administrative or investigative action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the corporation in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such director or officer to repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined that such person is not entitled to be indemnified by the corporation as authorized in this section. Such expenses (including attorneys’ fees) incurred by former directors and officers or other employees and agents of the corporation or by persons serving at the request of the corporation as directors, officers, employees or agents of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise may be so paid upon such terms and conditions, if any, as the corporation deems appropriate.

 

(f)

The indemnification and advancement of expenses provided by, or granted pursuant to, the other subsections of this section shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which those seeking indemnification or advancement of expenses may be entitled under any bylaw, agreement, vote of stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise, both as to action in such person’s official capacity and as to action in another capacity while holding such office. A right to indemnification or to advancement of expenses arising under a provision of the certificate of incorporation or a bylaw shall not be eliminated or impaired by an amendment to the certificate of incorporation or the bylaws after the occurrence of the act or omission that is the subject of the civil, criminal, administrative or investigative action, suit or proceeding for which indemnification or advancement of expenses is sought, unless the provision in effect at the time of such act or omission explicitly authorizes such elimination or impairment after such action or omission has occurred.

 

(g)

A corporation shall have power to purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against any liability asserted against such person and incurred by such person in any such capacity, or arising out of such person’s status as such, whether or not the corporation would have the power to indemnify such person against such liability under this section.

 

(h)

For purposes of this section, references to “the corporation” shall include, in addition to the resulting corporation, any constituent corporation (including any constituent of a constituent) absorbed in a consolidation or merger which, if its separate existence had continued, would have had power and authority to indemnify its directors, officers, and employees or agents, so that any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of such constituent corporation, or is or was serving at the request of such constituent corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, shall stand in the same position under this section with respect to the resulting or surviving corporation as such person would have with respect to such constituent corporation if its separate existence had continued.

 

(i)

For purposes of this section, references to “other enterprises” shall include employee benefit plans; references to “fines” shall include any excise taxes assessed on a person with respect to any employee benefit plan; and references to “serving at the request of the corporation” shall include any service as a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation which imposes duties on, or involves services by, such director, officer, employee or agent with respect to an employee benefit plan, its participants or beneficiaries; and a person who acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably believed to be in the interest of the participants and beneficiaries of an employee benefit plan shall be deemed to have acted in a manner “not opposed to the best interests of the corporation” as referred to in this section.

 

(j)

The indemnification and advancement of expenses provided by, or granted pursuant to, this section shall, unless otherwise provided when authorized or ratified, continue as to a person who has ceased to be a director, officer, employee or agent and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and administrators of such a person.

 

(k)

The Court of Chancery is hereby vested with exclusive jurisdiction to hear and determine all actions for advancement of expenses or indemnification brought under this section or under any bylaw, agreement, vote

 

II-2


Table of Contents
 

of stockholders or disinterested directors, or otherwise. The Court of Chancery may summarily determine a corporation’s obligation to advance expenses (including attorneys’ fees).”

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to our directors, officers, and controlling persons pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, we have been advised that, in the opinion of the SEC, such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person in a successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, we will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to the court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

Article Eighth of Pivotal’s certificate of incorporation will provide:

“The personal liability of the directors of the Corporation to the Corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of his or her fiduciary duty as director is hereby eliminated to the fullest extent permitted by the DGCL. Any amendment, repeal or modification of this Article Eighth, or the adoption of any provision of the Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation inconsistent with this Article Eighth, shall not adversely affect any right or protection of a director of the Corporation existing immediately prior to such amendment, repeal or modification. If the DGCL is amended after approval by the stockholders of this Article Eighth to authorize corporate action further eliminating or limiting the personal liability of directors, then the liability of a director of the Corporation shall be eliminated or limited to the fullest extent permitted by the DGCL as so amended.”

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling us pursuant to the foregoing provisions, we have been informed that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is theretofore unenforceable.

 

Item 21.

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

Exhibit
No.

  

Description

  

Included

  

Form

  

Filing Date

    2.1*    Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of May  20, 2019, by and among Pivotal Acquisition Corp., Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., LD Topco, Inc., and Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, LP (solely as representative of the stockholders of LD Topco, Inc.)   

Annex A

  

—  

  

—  

    3.1    Form of Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation   

Annex B

  

—  

  

—  

    3.2    Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws   

Annex B

     
    3.3    Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Pivotal Acquisition Corp.   

By Reference

  

8-K

  

February 1, 2019

    3.4    Bylaws of Pivotal Acquisition Corp.   

By Reference

  

S-1

  

December 26, 2018

    4.1    Specimen Unit Certificate   

By Reference

  

S-1/A

  

January 11, 2019

    4.2    Specimen Common Stock Certificate   

By Reference

  

S-1/A

  

January 11, 2019

    4.3    Specimen Warrant Certificate   

By Reference

  

S-1/A

  

January 11, 2019

 

II-3


Table of Contents

Exhibit
No.

  

Description

  

Included

  

Form

  

Filing Date

    4.4    Warrant Agreement between Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company and Pivotal Acquisition Corp.   

By Reference

  

8-K

  

February 1, 2019

    4.5    Form of Registration Rights Agreement   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

    5.1**    Opinion of Graubard Miller   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.1    Form of Letter Agreement from each of the initial stockholders, officers, and directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp.   

By Reference

  

S-1/A

  

January 11, 2019

  10.2**    Form of Amended Letter Agreement from certain of Pivotal’s initial stockholders, officers and directors   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.4    Investment Management Trust Agreement between Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company and Pivotal Acquisition Corp.   

By Reference

  

8-K

  

February 1, 2019

  10.5    Registration Rights Agreement among Pivotal Acquisition Corp. and each of Pivotal’s initial stockholders, officers and directors   

By Reference

  

8-K

  

February 1, 2019

  10.6    Forward Purchase Contract between Pivotal Acquisition Corp. and Pivotal Spac Funding LLC   

By Reference

  

8-K

  

February 1, 2019

  10.7    Form of Stockholders’ Agreement   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.8    Form of 2019 Long Term Incentive Plan   

Annex C

  

—  

  

—  

  10.9    Employment Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2011, between LDiscovery, LLC and Christopher Weiler   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.10    Offer Letter, dated as of September 30, 2006, between LegisDiscovery, LLC and Krystina Jones   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.11    Offer Letter, dated as of August 25, 2017, between KrolLDiscovery and Dawn Wilson   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  10.12    First Lien Credit Agreement, dated as of December  9, 2016, among LD Intermediate Holdings, Inc. and LD Lower Holdings, Inc., as co-borrowers, LD Topco, Inc., as Holdings, Royal Bank of Canada, as administrative agent, collateral agent, swing line lender and L/C issuer, the other lenders party thereto, and RBC Capital Markets and TD Securities (USA) LLC, as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

 

II-4


Table of Contents

Exhibit
No.

  

Description

  

Included

  

Form

  

Filing Date

  10.13    Second Lien Credit Agreement, dated as of December  9, 2016, among LD Intermediate Holdings, Inc. and LD Lower Holdings Inc., as co-borrowers, LD Topco, Inc., as Holdings, Royal Bank of Canada, as administrative agent and collateral agent, the other lenders party thereto, and RBC Capital Markets, Northwestern Mutual Investment Management Company, LLC and TD Securities (USA) LLC, as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  23.1    Consent of Ernst & Young LLP   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  23.2    Consent of Marcum LLP   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  23.3**    Consent of Graubard Miller    Included within exhibit 5.1   

—  

  

—  

  99.1**    Form of Proxy Card         
  99.2    Consent of Daniel F. Akerson to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  99.3    Consent of William Darman to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  99.4    Consent of Donna Morea to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  99.5    Consent of Evan Morgan to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  99.6    Consent of Christopher J. Weiler to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

  99.7    Consent of Richard J. Williams to be named as a Director   

Herewith

  

—  

  

—  

 

*

Schedule and exhibits to this Exhibit omitted pursuant to Regulation S-K Item 601(b)(2). The Company agrees to furnish supplementally a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit to the SEC upon request.

**

To be filed by amendment.

 

Item 22.

Undertakings

 

(a)

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes:

 

  (1)

To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:

 

  i.

To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1933;

 

  ii.

To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the

 

II-5


Table of Contents
 

changes in volume and price represent no more than 20 percent change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the “Calculation of Registration Fee” table in the effective registration statement.

 

  iii.

To include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any material change to such information in the registration statement.

 

  (2)

That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

  (3)

To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such Director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes as follows: that prior to any public reoffering of the securities registered hereunder through use of a prospectus which is a part of this registration statement, by any person or party who is deemed to be an underwriter within the meaning of Rule 145(c), the issuer undertakes that such reoffering prospectus will contain the information called for by the applicable registration form with respect to reofferings by persons who may be deemed underwriters, in addition to the information called for by the other items of the applicable form.

The registrant undertakes that every prospectus: (1) that is filed pursuant to the immediately preceding paragraph, or (2) that purports to meet the requirements of Section 10(a)(3) of the Act and is used in connection with an offering of securities subject to Rule 415, will be filed as a part of an amendment to the registration statement and will not be used until such amendment is effective, and that, for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

(b) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to respond to requests for information that is incorporated by reference into the prospectus pursuant to Item 4, 10(b), 11, or 13 of this form, within one business day of receipt of such request, and to send the incorporated documents by first class mail or other equally prompt means. This includes information contained in documents filed subsequent to the effective date of the registration statement through the date of responding to the request.

(c) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to supply by means of a post-effective amendment all information concerning a transaction, and the company being acquired involved therein, that was not the subject of and included in the registration statement when it became effective.

 

II-6


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in New York, NY, on the 20 th day of June, 2019.

 

By:

 

/s/ Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Jonathan J. Ledecky

 

Chief Executive Officer

KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Jonathan J. Ledecky his true and lawful attorney-in-fact, with full power of substitution and resubstitution for him and in his name, place and stead, in any and all capacities to sign any and all amendments including post-effective amendments to this proxy statement/prospectus and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorney-in-fact or his substitute, each acting alone, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue thereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Name

  

Title

 

Date

/s/ Jonathan J. Ledecky

   Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer   June 20, 2019
Jonathan J. Ledecky    (Principal Executive Officer)  

/s/ James Brady

   Chief Financial Officer   June 20, 2019
James Brady    (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)  

/s/ Kevin Griffin

   Director   June 20, 2019
Kevin Griffin     

/s/ Katrina Adams

   Director   June 20, 2019
Katrina Adams     

/s/ Efrat Epstein

   Director   June 20, 2019
Efrat Epstein     

Exhibit 4.5

REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT

This REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”) is made as of [●], 2019 by and among Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), each of the Controlling Holders (as defined below), and each other Person identified on Schedule A attached hereto (the “ Schedule of Investors ”) as of the date hereof.

R ECITALS

WHEREAS, the Company is party to that certain Agreement and Plan of Reorganization, dated as of May 20, 2019 (the “ Merger Agreement ”), by and among the Company, Pivotal Merger Sub Corp., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (“ Merger Sub ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ LD Topco ”), and Carlyle Equity Opportunity GP, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership, solely in its capacity as the initial Representative (as defined therein) thereunder, pursuant to which Merger Sub will merge with and into LD Topco (with LD Topco being the surviving entity) (the “ Merger ”) in exchange for LD Topco’s stockholders receiving shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of the Company (the “ Common Stock ” and, such shares, the “ Shares ”) as provided by the Merger Agreement; and

WHEREAS, in connection with the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement, the Company has agreed to grant to the Holders (as defined below) certain rights with respect to the registration of the Registrable Securities (as defined below) on the terms and conditions set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants contained herein and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties to this Agreement hereby agree as follows:

Section 1.     Definitions . For purposes of this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings specified in this Section  1 :

Acquired Common ” has the meaning set forth in Section  9 .

Additional Investor ” has the meaning set forth in Section  9 , and shall be deemed to include each such Person’s Affiliates, immediate family members, heirs, successors and assigns who may succeed to such Person as a Holder hereunder.

Affiliate ” of any Person means any other Person controlled by, controlling or under common control with such Person; provided that the Company and its Subsidiaries shall not be deemed to be Affiliates of any Holder. As used in this definition, “control” (including, with its correlative meanings, “controlling,” “controlled by” and “under common control with”) shall mean possession, directly or indirectly, of power to direct or cause the direction of management or policies (whether through ownership of securities, by contract or otherwise).

Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Automatic Shelf Registration Statement ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(a) .


Business Combination ” means the acquisition of direct or indirect ownership through a merger, share exchange, asset acquisition, share purchase, recapitalization, reorganization or other similar type of transaction, of one or more businesses or entities.

Business Day ” means any day of the year on which national banking institutions in New York are open to the public for conducting business and are not required or authorized to close.

Capital Stock ” means (i) with respect to any Person that is a corporation, any and all shares, interests or equivalents in capital stock of such corporation (whether voting or nonvoting and whether common or preferred), (ii) with respect to any Person that is not a corporation, individual or governmental entity, any and all partnership, membership, limited liability company or other equity interests of such Person that confer on the holder thereof the right to receive a share of the profits and losses of, or the distribution of assets of, the issuing Person, and (iii) any and all warrants, rights (including conversion and exchange rights) and options to purchase any security described in the clause (i)  or (ii) above.

Company ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Controlling Holder ” means each of CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P. and any of its investment vehicle Affiliates, so long as such Holder continues to hold Registrable Securities.

Demand Registrations ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(a) .

End of Suspension Notice ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(e)(ii) .

Exchange Act ” means the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, or any successor federal law then in force, together with all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

FINRA ” means the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

Forward Purchase Agreement ” means the agreement pursuant to which one of the Holders has committed to purchase up to $150,000,000 of Forward Purchase Securities upon consummation of a Business Combination.

[“ Forward Purchase Securities ” means the securities that may be sold to pursuant to the Forward Purchase Agreement.]

Founder Shares ” means all of the outstanding shares of Common Stock of the Company issued prior to the consummation of its initial public offering.

Free Writing Prospectus ” means a free-writing prospectus, as defined in Rule 405.

Holder ” means any Person who is the registered holder of Registrable Securities.

Holder Indemnified Parties ” has the meaning set forth in Section  7(a) .

Joinder ” has the meaning set forth in Section  9 .

 

2


LD Topco ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

Long-Form Registrations ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(a) .

Merger ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

Merger Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

Merger Sub ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

MNPI ” means material non-public information within the meaning of Regulation FD promulgated under the Exchange Act, which shall in any case include the receipt of the notice of a Demand Registration or Shelf Offering Notice pursuant to Section  2(a) or Section  2(d) and the information contained in such notice.

Person ” means an individual, a partnership, a corporation, a limited liability company, an association, a joint stock company, a trust, a joint venture, an unincorporated organization and a governmental entity or any department, agency or political subdivision thereof.

Piggyback Registrations ” has the meaning set forth in Section  3(a) .

Private Warrants ” means the Warrants certain Holders privately purchased simultaneously with the consummation of the Company’s initial public offering.

Public Offering ” means any sale or distribution to the public of Capital Stock of the Company pursuant to an offering registered under the Securities Act, whether by the Company, by Holders and/or by any other holders of the Company’s Capital Stock.

Registrable Securities ” means (i) any Common Stock issued by the Company in connection with the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any Contingent Shares (as defined in the Merger Agreement), if and to the extent issued in accordance with Section 1.13 of the Merger Agreement), (ii) the Founder Shares, (iii) the Private Warrants (and underlying securities), [(iv) the Working Capital Warrants (and underlying securities), if any, (v) the Forward Purchase Securities, if any,] 1 (vi) any Capital Stock of the Company or of any Subsidiary of the Company issued or issuable with respect to the securities referred to in clauses (i) (v) above by way of dividend, distribution, split or combination of securities, or any recapitalization, merger, consolidation or other reorganization, and (vii) any other Shares owned or acquired after the date hereof by Persons that are the registered holders of securities described in clauses (i)  through (vi) above. As to any particular Registrable Securities owned by any Person, such securities shall cease to be Registrable Securities on the date such securities have been (a) sold or distributed pursuant to a Public Offering, (b) sold in compliance with Rule 144 or (c) repurchased by the Company or a Subsidiary of the Company. For purposes of this Agreement, a Person shall be deemed to be a Holder, and the Registrable Securities shall be deemed to be in existence, whenever such Person has the right to acquire, directly or indirectly, such Registrable Securities (upon conversion or

 

1  

NTD: To be deleted if not applicable.

 

3


exercise in connection with a transfer of securities or otherwise, but disregarding any restrictions or limitations upon the exercise of such right), whether or not such acquisition has actually been effected, and such Person shall be entitled to exercise the rights of a Holder hereunder; provided a Holder may only request that Registrable Securities in the form of Capital Stock of the Company that is registered or to be registered as a class under Section 12 of the Exchange Act be registered pursuant to this Agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with the consent of the Company and the Controlling Holders, any Registrable Securities held by any Person that may be sold under Rule 144 shall not be deemed to be Registrable Securities upon notice from the Company to such Person.

Registration Expenses ” has the meaning set forth in Section  6(a) .

Rule 144 ,” “ Rule 158 ,” “ Rule 405 ” and “ Rule 415 ” mean, in each case, such rule promulgated under the Securities Act (or any successor provision) by the Securities and Exchange Commission, as the same shall be amended from time to time, or any successor rule then in force.

Schedule of Investors ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Securities Act ” means the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended from time to time, or any successor federal law then in force, together with all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

Shares ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

Shelf Offering ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) .

Shelf Offering Notice ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) .

Shelf Offering Request ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) .

Shelf Registrable Securities ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) .

Shelf Registration ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(a) .

Shelf Registration Notice ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(i) .

“Shelf Registration Participation Deadline” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(i) .

Shelf Registration Request ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(i) .

Shelf Registration Statement ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(i) .

Short-Form Registrations ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(a) .

Subsidiary ” means, with respect to the Company, any corporation, limited liability company, partnership, association or other business entity of which (i) if a corporation, a majority of the total voting power of Capital Stock of such Person entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors or managers is at the time

 

4


owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by the Company, or (ii) if a limited liability company, partnership, association or other business entity, either (x) a majority of the Capital Stock of such Person entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers, general partners or other oversight board vested with the authority to direct management of such Person is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by the Company or (y) the Company or one of its Subsidiaries is the sole manager or general partner of such Person.

Suspension Event ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(e)(ii) .

Suspension Notice ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(e)(ii) .

Suspension Period ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(e)(i) .

Underwritten Takedown ” has the meaning set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) .

Violation ” has the meaning set forth in Section  7(a) .

WKSI ” means a “well-known seasoned issuer” as defined under Rule 405.

[“ Working Capital Warrants ” means any Warrants held by Holders, officers or directors of the Company or their affiliates which may have been issued in payment of working capital loans made to the Company.]

Section 2.     Demand Registrations .

(a)     Requests for Registration . Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, commencing on the date that is one (1) year following the date hereof (or earlier if authorized by a decision of the Company’s board of directors (without any dissenting vote from any member of the Company’s board of directors)), each Controlling Holder may request registration under the Securities Act of all or any portion of their Registrable Securities on Form S-1 or any similar long-form registration (“ Long-Form Registrations ”), and each Controlling Holder may request registration under the Securities Act of all or any portion of their Registrable Securities on Form S-3 or any similar short-form registration (“ Short-Form Registrations ”), if available. All registrations requested pursuant to this Section  2(a) are referred to herein as “ Demand Registrations .” The Controlling Holder making a Demand Registration may request that the registration be made pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act (a “ Shelf Registration ”) and, if the Company is a WKSI at the time any request for a Demand Registration is submitted to the Company, that such Shelf Registration be an automatic shelf registration statement (as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act) (an “ Automatic Shelf Registration Statement ”). Except to the extent that Section  2(c) applies, promptly upon receipt of a request for a Demand Registration (but in no event more than five (5) Business Days thereafter (or such shorter period as may be reasonably requested in connection with a Shelf Offering)), the Company shall give written notice of the Demand Registration to all other Holders and, subject to the terms of Section  2(d) , shall include in such Demand Registration (and in all related registrations and qualifications under state blue sky laws and in any related underwriting) all Registrable Securities of each Holder with respect to which the Company has received a written request for inclusion therein within five (5) Business Days after the date the Company’s notice was

 

5


delivered. Notwithstanding the foregoing, other than delivery to each Holder of the written notice in accordance with this Section  2(a) , the Company shall not be required to take any action that would otherwise be required under this Section  2 if such action would violate Section  4(a) hereof or any similar provision contained in the underwriting agreement entered into in connection with any underwritten Public Offering.

(b)     Demand Registrations . The Controlling Holders shall be entitled to request no more than six (6) Demand Registrations in which the Company shall pay all Registration Expenses, regardless of whether any registration statement is filed or any such Demand Registration is consummated. Demand Registrations shall be Short-Form Registrations whenever the Company is permitted to use any applicable short form and the managing underwriters (if any) agree to the use of a Short-Form Registration. After the Company has become subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, the Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to make Short-Form Registrations available for the sale of Registrable Securities. All Long-Form Registrations shall be underwritten registrations unless otherwise approved by the applicable Controlling Holder.

(c)     Shelf Registrations .

(i)    Subject to the availability of required financial information, as promptly as practicable after the Company receives written notice of a request for a Shelf Registration (a “ Shelf Registration Request ”) and the expiration of the Shelf Registration Participation Deadline (as defined below), the Company shall file with the Securities and Exchange Commission a registration statement under the Securities Act for the Shelf Registration (a “ Shelf Registration Statement ”). As promptly as practicable, but no later than three (3) Business Days after receipt of a Shelf Registration Request, the Company shall give written notice (the “ Shelf Registration Notice ”) of such Shelf Registration Request to all other Holders. The Company, subject to Sections 2(d) and 8 hereof, shall include in such Shelf Registration (and in all related registrations and qualifications under state blue sky laws) all Registrable Securities of each Holder with respect to which the Company has received a written request for inclusion therein within two (2) Business Days after the Shelf Registration Notice was delivered (such deadline, the “ Shelf Registration Participation Deadline ”). The Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to cause any Shelf Registration Statement to be declared effective under the Securities Act as soon as practicable after the initial filing of such Shelf Registration Statement and, once effective, the Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to cause such Shelf Registration Statement to remain continuously effective for such time period as is specified in the request by the Holders, but for no time period longer than the period ending on the earliest of (A) the date on which all Registrable Securities covered by such Shelf Registration Statement have been sold pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement and (B) the date as of which there are no longer any Registrable Securities covered by such Shelf Registration Statement in existence. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in Section  2(c)(ii) , any Holder that is named as a selling securityholder in such Shelf Registration Statement may make a secondary resale under such Shelf Registration Statement without the consent of the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities or any other Holder if such resale does not require a supplement to the Shelf Registration Statement.

 

6


(ii)    In the event that a Shelf Registration Statement is effective, the Controlling Holders shall have the right at any time or from time to time to elect to offer and sell (including pursuant to an underwritten offering (an “ Underwritten Takedown ”)) Registrable Securities available for sale pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement (“ Shelf Registrable Securities ”), so long as the Shelf Registration Statement remains effective, and the Company shall pay all Registration Expenses in connection therewith. The applicable Holders shall make such election by delivering to the Company a written request (a “ Shelf Offering Request ”) for such offering specifying the number of Shelf Registrable Securities that such Holders desire to sell pursuant to such offering (the “ Shelf Offering ”). As promptly as practicable, but no later than three (3) Business Days after receipt of a Shelf Offering Request, the Company shall give written notice (the “ Shelf Offering Notice ”) of such Shelf Offering Request to all other holders of Shelf Registrable Securities. The Company, subject to Sections 2(d) and 8 hereof, shall include in such Shelf Offering (and in all related registrations and qualifications under state blue sky laws and in any related underwriting) the Shelf Registrable Securities of any other Holder that shall have made a written request to the Company for inclusion in such Shelf Offering (which request shall specify the maximum number of Shelf Registrable Securities intended to be sold by such Holder) within two (2) Business Days after the receipt of the Shelf Offering Notice. The Company shall, as expeditiously as possible (and in any event within ten (10) days after the receipt of a Shelf Offering Request, unless a longer period is agreed to by the Controlling Holders that made the Shelf Offering Request), use its reasonable best efforts to facilitate such Shelf Offering.

(iii)    If the Controlling Holders wish to engage in an underwritten block trade, variable price reoffer or overnight underwritten offering, in each case, off of a Shelf Registration Statement (either through filing an Automatic Shelf Registration Statement or through a take-down from an already existing Shelf Registration Statement), then, notwithstanding the time periods set forth in Section  2(c)(ii) , such holders shall notify the Company not less than two (2) Business Days prior to the day such offering is to commence. The Company shall promptly notify other Holders of such offering, and such other Holders must elect whether or not to participate by the next Business Day ( i.e. , one (1) Business Day prior to the day such offering is to commence) (unless a longer period is agreed to by the holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities wishing to engage in the underwritten block trade), and the Company shall as expeditiously as possible use its reasonable best efforts to facilitate such offering (which may close as early as two (2) Business Days after the date it commences); provided that the Controlling Holders shall use commercially reasonable efforts to work with the Company and the underwriters prior to making such request in order to facilitate preparation of the registration statement, prospectus and other offering documentation related to the transaction.

(iv)    The Company shall, at the request of Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities covered by a Shelf Registration Statement, file any prospectus supplement or, if the applicable Shelf Registration Statement is an Automatic Shelf Registration Statement, any post-effective amendments and otherwise take any action necessary to include therein all disclosure and language deemed necessary or advisable by such Holders to effect such Shelf Offering.

 

7


(d)     Priority on Demand Registrations and Shelf Offerings . The Company shall not include in any Demand Registration or Shelf Offering any securities that are not Registrable Securities without the prior written consent of Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in such registration or offering. If a Demand Registration or a Shelf Offering is an underwritten offering and the managing underwriters advise the Company in writing that in their opinion the number of securities requested to be included in such offering exceeds the number of securities that can be sold in such offering without adversely affecting the marketability, proposed offering price, timing or method of distribution of the offering, the Company shall include in such registration or offering, as applicable, prior to the inclusion of any securities which are not Registrable Securities, the number of Registrable Securities requested by Holders to be included that, in the opinion of such underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect, pro rata among the respective Holders thereof on the basis of the amount of Registrable Securities then owned by each such Holder that such Holder of Registrable Securities shall have requested to be included therein. Alternatively, if the number of Registrable Securities which can be included on a Shelf Registration Statement is otherwise limited by Instruction I.B.6 to Form S-3 (or any successor provision thereto), the Company shall include in such registration or offering, prior to the inclusion of any securities which are not Registrable Securities, the number of Registrable Securities requested to be included which can be included on such Shelf Registration Statement in accordance with the requirements of Form S-3, pro rata among the respective Holders thereof on the basis of the amount of Registrable Securities owned by each such Holder that such Holder of Registrable Securities shall have requested to be included therein.

(e)     Restrictions on Demand Registration and Shelf Offerings .

(i)    The Company shall not be obligated to effect more than four (4) Demand Registrations in any calendar year, nor shall the Company be obligated to effect a Demand Registration within thirty (30) days of a previous Demand Registration or a previous registration statement in which Registrable Securities were included and in which there was no reduction in the number of Registrable securities requested to be included. The Company may postpone, for up to sixty (60) days from the date of the request, the filing or the effectiveness of a registration statement for a Demand Registration or suspend the use of a prospectus that is part of a Shelf Registration Statement for up to sixty (60) days from the date of the Suspension Notice (as defined below) and therefore suspend sales of the Shelf Registrable Securities (such period, the “ Suspension Period ”) by providing written notice to the Holders if (A) the Company’s board of directors determines in its reasonable good faith judgment that the offer or sale of Registrable Securities would reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on any proposal or plan by the Company or any Subsidiary to engage in any material acquisition of assets or stock (other than in the ordinary course of business) or any material merger, consolidation, tender offer, recapitalization, reorganization or other transaction involving the Company or any Subsidiary, or (B) upon advice of counsel, the sale of Registrable Securities pursuant to the registration statement would require disclosure of MNPI not otherwise required to be disclosed under applicable law, and either (x) the Company has a bona fide business purpose for preserving the confidentiality of such transaction or (y) disclosure of such MNPI would have a material adverse effect on the Company or the Company’s ability to consummate such transaction;

 

8


provided that in such event, the Holders shall be entitled to withdraw such request for a Demand Registration or underwritten Shelf Offering and the Company shall pay all Registration Expenses in connection with such Demand Registration or Shelf Offering. The Company may delay a Demand Registration hereunder only once in any twelve (12)-month period, except with the consent of the applicable Controlling Holder.

(ii)    In the case of an event that causes the Company to suspend the use of a Shelf Registration Statement as set forth in paragraph (e)(i) above or pursuant to applicable subsections of Section  5(a)(vi) (a “ Suspension Event ”), the Company shall give a notice to the Holders of Registrable Securities registered pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement (a “ Suspension Notice ”) to suspend sales of the Registrable Securities and such notice shall state generally the basis for the notice and that such suspension shall continue only for so long as the Suspension Event or its effect is continuing. If the basis of such suspension is nondisclosure of MNPI, the Company shall not be required to disclose the subject matter of such MNPI to Holders. A Holder shall not effect any sales of the Registrable Securities pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement (or such filings) at any time after it has received a Suspension Notice from the Company and prior to receipt of an End of Suspension Notice (as defined below). Each Holder agrees that it shall treat as confidential the receipt of the Suspension Notice and shall not disclose or use the information contained in such Suspension Notice without the prior consent of the Company until such time as the information contained therein is or becomes available to the public generally, other than as a result of disclosure by a Holder in breach of the terms of this Agreement. Holders may recommence effecting sales of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement (or such filings) following written notice to such effect (an “ End of Suspension Notice ”) from the Company, which End of Suspension Notice shall be given by the Company to the Holders promptly following the conclusion of any Suspension Event.

(iii)    Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, if the Company gives a Suspension Notice with respect to any Shelf Registration Statement pursuant to this Section  2(e) , the Company agrees that it shall extend the period of time during which such Shelf Registration Statement shall be maintained effective pursuant to this Agreement by the number of days during the period from the date of receipt by the holders of the Suspension Notice to and including the date of receipt by the holders of the End of Suspension Notice and provide copies of any supplemented or amended prospectus necessary to resume sales, with respect to each Suspension Event.

(f)     Selection of Underwriters . Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in any Demand Registration or Underwritten Takedown shall have the right to select the investment banker(s) and manager(s) to administer such offering (including assignment of titles). If any Shelf Offering is an underwritten offering, the Holders holding a majority of the Registrable Securities participating in such underwritten offering shall have the right to select the investment banker(s) and manager(s) to administer the offering relating to such Shelf Offering (including assignment of titles). The Company represents and warrants that no investment bankers are entitled to any rights that would conflict with the rights of the Holders under this Section  2 .

 

9


(g)     Other Registration Rights . The Company represents and warrants that it is not a party to, or otherwise subject to, any other agreement granting registration rights to any other Person with respect to any securities of the Company. Except as provided in this Agreement, the Company shall not grant to any Persons the right to request the Company or any Subsidiary to register any Capital Stock of the Company or of any Subsidiary, or any securities convertible or exchangeable into or exercisable for such securities, without the prior written consent of the Controlling Holders; provided that the Company may grant rights to other Persons to participate in Piggyback Registrations so long as such rights are subordinate to the rights of the Holders with respect to such Piggyback Registrations as set forth below.

(h)    Revocation of Demand Notice or Shelf Offering Notice. At any time prior to the effective date of the registration statement relating to a Demand Registration or the “pricing” of any offering relating to a Shelf Offering Notice, the Holders that provided such Demand Registration or Shelf Offering Notice may revoke such Demand Registration or Shelf Offering Notice on behalf of all Holders participating in such Demand Registration or Shelf Offering without liability to such Holders, in each case by providing written notice to the Company.

Section 3.     Piggyback Registrations .

(a)     Right to Piggyback . Commencing on the date that is one (1) year following the date hereof (or earlier if authorized by a decision of the Company’s board of directors (without any dissenting vote from any member of the Company’s board of directors)), whenever the Company proposes to register any of its securities under the Securities Act (other than (i) pursuant to a Demand Registration, (ii) in connection with registrations on Form S-4 or S-8 promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor or similar forms or (iii) a registration on any form that does not include substantially the same information as would be required to be included in a registration statement covering the sale of Registrable Securities) and the registration form to be used may be used for the registration of Registrable Securities (a “ Piggyback Registration ”), the Company shall give prompt written notice (in any event within two (2) Business Days after its receipt of notice of any request for registration on behalf of holders of the Company’s securities (other than under this Agreement)) to all Holders of its intention to effect such Piggyback Registration and, subject to the terms of Section  3(c) and Section  3(d) , shall include in such Piggyback Registration (and in all related registrations or qualifications under blue sky laws and in any related underwriting) all Registrable Securities of each Holder with respect to which the Company has received a written request for inclusion therein within ten (10) days after delivery of the Company’s notice.

(b)     Piggyback Expenses . The Registration Expenses of the Holders shall be paid by the Company in all Piggyback Registrations, whether or not any such registration became effective.

(c)     Priority on Primary Registrations . If a Piggyback Registration is an underwritten primary registration on behalf of the Company, and the managing underwriters advise the Company in writing that in their opinion the number of securities requested to be included in such registration exceeds the number which can be sold in such offering without adversely affecting the marketability, proposed offering price, timing or method of distribution of the offering, the Company shall include in such registration (i) first, the securities the Company

 

10


proposes to sell, (ii) second, the Registrable Securities requested to be included in such registration which, in the opinion of the underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect, pro rata among the Holders on the basis of the number of Registrable Securities then owned by each such Holder that such Holder of Registrable Securities shall have requested to be included therein, and (iii) third, other securities requested to be included in such registration which, in the opinion of the underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect.

(d)     Priority on Secondary Registrations . If a Piggyback Registration is an underwritten secondary registration on behalf of holders of the Company’s securities, and the managing underwriters advise the Company in writing that in their opinion the number of securities requested to be included in such registration exceeds the number which can be sold in such offering without adversely affecting the marketability, proposed offering price, timing or method of distribution of the offering, the Company shall include in such registration (i) first, the Registrable Securities of Holders requested to be included in such registration which, in the opinion of the underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect, pro rata among the Holders on the basis of the number of Registrable Securities then owned by each such Holder that such Holder of Registrable Securities shall have requested to be included therein, (ii) second, the securities requested to be included therein by the initial holders requesting such registration which, in the opinion of the underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect and (iii) third, other securities requested to be included in such registration which, in the opinion of the underwriters, can be sold without any such adverse effect.

(e)     Selection of Underwriters . If any Piggyback Registration is an underwritten offering, the selection of investment banker(s) and manager(s) for the offering must be approved by the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in such Piggyback Registration, such approval not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed.

(f)     Right to Terminate Registration . The Company shall have the right to terminate or withdraw any registration initiated by it under this Section  3 whether or not any Holder has elected to include securities in such registration. The Registration Expenses of such withdrawn registration shall be borne by the Company in accordance with Section  6 .

Section 4.     Holdback Agreements .

(a)     Holders of Registrable Securities . Each and every Holder shall enter into lock-up agreements with the managing underwriter(s) of an underwritten Public Offering providing that, unless the underwriters managing such underwritten Public Offering otherwise agree in writing, subject to customary exceptions such Holder shall not (i) offer, sell, contract to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of (including sales pursuant to Rule 144), directly or indirectly, any Capital Stock of the Company (including Capital Stock of the Company that may be deemed to be owned beneficially by such holder in accordance with the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission) (collectively, “ Securities ”), (ii) enter into a transaction which would have the same effect as described in clause (i)  above, (iii) enter into any swap, hedge or other arrangement that transfers, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences or ownership of any Securities, whether such transaction is to be settled by delivery of such Securities, in cash or otherwise (each of (i) , (ii) and (iii)  above, a “ Sale Transaction ”), or (iv) publicly disclose the intention to enter into any Sale Transaction, commencing on the earlier of the date on which the

 

11


Company gives notice to the Holders that a preliminary prospectus has been circulated for such Public Offering or the “pricing” of such offering and continuing to the date that is ninety (90) days following the date of the final prospectus for such Public Offering (or such shorter period that is required by the managing underwriter(s)) (the “ Holdback Period ”).

(b)     Exceptions . The foregoing holdback agreements in Section  4(a) shall not apply to a registration on Form S-8 or any successor or similar form or otherwise in connection with an employee benefit plan or in connection with any registration on Form S-4 or any successor or similar form in connection with any type of acquisition transaction or exchange offer.

(c)     The Company . The Company (i) shall not file any registration statement for a Public Offering or cause any such registration statement to become effective, or effect any public sale or distribution of its equity securities, or any securities, options or rights convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for such securities, during any Holdback Period without the consent of the Controlling Holders and (ii) shall use its reasonable best efforts to cause (A) each holder of at least five percent (5%) (on a fully-diluted basis) of its shares of Common Stock, or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for shares of Common Stock, and (B) each of its directors and executive officers, to agree not to effect any Sale Transaction during any Holdback Period, except as part of such underwritten registration, if otherwise permitted, unless the underwriters managing the Public Offering otherwise agree in writing.

Section 5.     Registration Procedures .

(a)    Whenever the Holders have requested that any Registrable Securities be registered pursuant to this Agreement or have initiated a Shelf Offering, the Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to effect the registration and the sale of such Registrable Securities in accordance with the intended method of disposition thereof, and pursuant thereto the Company shall as expeditiously as possible:

(i)    in accordance with the Securities Act and all applicable rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, prepare and file with the Securities and Exchange Commission a registration statement, and all amendments and supplements thereto and related prospectuses with respect to such Registrable Securities and use its reasonable best efforts to cause such registration statement to become effective (provided that before filing a registration statement or prospectus or any amendments or supplements thereto, the Company shall furnish to the counsel selected by the Controlling Holders and the counsel selected by the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement copies of all such documents proposed to be filed, which documents shall be subject to the review and comment of such counsel);

(ii)    notify each Holder of (A) the issuance by the Securities and Exchange Commission of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of any registration statement or the initiation of any proceedings for that purpose, (B) the receipt by the Company or its counsel of any notification with respect to the suspension of the qualification of the Registrable Securities for sale in any jurisdiction or the initiation or threatening of any proceeding for such purpose and (C) the effectiveness of each registration statement filed hereunder;

 

12


(iii)    prepare and file with the Securities and Exchange Commission such amendments and supplements to such registration statement and the prospectus used in connection therewith as may be necessary to keep such registration statement effective for a period ending when all of the securities covered by such registration statement have been disposed of in accordance with the intended methods of distribution by the sellers thereof set forth in such registration statement (but in any event not before the expiration of any longer period required under the Securities Act or, if such registration statement relates to an underwritten Public Offering, such longer period as in the opinion of counsel for the underwriters a prospectus is required by law to be delivered in connection with sale of Registrable Securities by an underwriter or dealer) and comply with the provisions of the Securities Act with respect to the disposition of all securities covered by such registration statement during such period in accordance with the intended methods of disposition by the sellers thereof set forth in such registration statement;

(iv)    furnish to each seller of Registrable Securities thereunder such number of copies of such registration statement, each amendment and supplement thereto, the prospectus included in such registration statement (including each preliminary prospectus), each Free Writing Prospectus and such other documents as such seller may reasonably request in order to facilitate the disposition of the Registrable Securities owned by such seller;

(v)    use reasonable best efforts to register or qualify such Registrable Securities under such other securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdictions as any seller reasonably requests and do any and all other acts and things which may be reasonably necessary or advisable to enable such seller to consummate the disposition in such jurisdictions of the Registrable Securities owned by such seller (provided that the Company shall not be required to (A) qualify generally to do business in any jurisdiction where it would not otherwise be required to qualify but for this subparagraph or (B) subject itself to taxation in any such jurisdiction);

(vi)    notify each seller of such Registrable Securities (A) promptly after it receives notice thereof, of the date and time when such registration statement and each post-effective amendment thereto has become effective or a prospectus or supplement to any prospectus relating to a registration statement has been filed and when any registration or qualification has become effective under a state securities or blue sky law or any exemption thereunder has been obtained, (B) promptly after receipt thereof, of any written comments by the Securities and Exchange Commission, or any request by the Securities and Exchange Commission or other federal or state governmental authority for amendments or supplements to such registration statement or such prospectus, or for additional information (whether before or after the effective date of the registration statement) or any other correspondence with the Securities and Exchange Commission relating to, or which may affect, the registration and (C) at any time when a prospectus relating thereto is required to be delivered under the Securities Act, of the happening of any event as a result of which the prospectus included in such registration statement contains an untrue statement of a material fact or omits any fact necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, and, subject to Section  2(e) , at the request of any such seller, the Company shall use its best efforts to prepare a supplement or amendment to

 

13


such prospectus so that, as thereafter delivered to the purchasers of such Registrable Securities, such prospectus shall not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state any fact necessary to make the statements therein not misleading;

(vii)    use reasonable best efforts to cause all such Registrable Securities to be listed on each securities exchange on which similar securities issued by the Company are then listed and, if not so listed, to be listed on a securities exchange and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, to arrange for at least two (2) market makers to register as such with respect to such Registrable Securities with FINRA;

(viii)    use reasonable best efforts to provide a transfer agent, registrar and CUSIP number for all such Registrable Securities not later than the effective date of such registration statement;

(ix)    enter into and perform such customary agreements (including underwriting agreements in customary form), which may include indemnification provisions in favor of underwriters and other Persons in addition to the provisions of Section  7 hereof, make such representations and warranties to the Holders registering securities and the underwriters or agents, if any, in form, substance and scope as are customarily made by issuers in public offerings similar to the offering then being undertaken, and take all such other actions as the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities being sold or the underwriters, if any, reasonably request in order to expedite or facilitate the disposition of such Registrable Securities (including, without limitation, effecting a stock split, combination of shares, recapitalization or reorganization);

(x)    make available for inspection by any seller of Registrable Securities, any underwriter participating in any disposition pursuant to such registration statement and any attorney, accountant or other agent retained by any such seller or underwriter, all financial and other records, pertinent corporate and business documents and properties of the Company as shall be necessary to enable them to exercise their due diligence responsibility, and cause the Company’s officers, directors, employees, agents, representatives and independent accountants to make themselves available to discuss the business of the Company and to supply all information reasonably requested by any such seller, underwriter, attorney, accountant or agent in connection with such registration statement;

(xi)    use reasonable best efforts to ensure that any Free Writing Prospectus utilized in connection with any Demand Registration or Piggyback Registration hereunder complies in all material respects with the Securities Act, is filed in accordance with the Securities Act to the extent required thereby, is retained in accordance with the Securities Act to the extent required thereby and, when taken together with the related prospectus, shall not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading;

 

14


(xii)    otherwise use reasonable best efforts to comply with all applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission, and make available to its security holders, as soon as reasonably practicable, an earnings statement covering the period of at least twelve months beginning with the first day of the Company’s first full calendar quarter after the effective date of the registration statement, which earnings statement shall satisfy the provisions of Section 11(a) of the Securities Act and Rule 158;

(xiii)    to the extent that a Holder, in its sole and exclusive judgment, might be deemed to be an underwriter of any Registrable Securities or a controlling person of the Company, permit such Holder to participate in the preparation of such registration or comparable statement and allow such Holder to provide language for insertion therein, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Company, which in the reasonable judgment of such Holder and its counsel should be included;

(xiv)    in the event of the issuance of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of a registration statement, or the issuance of any order suspending or preventing the use of any related prospectus or suspending the qualification of any Common Stock included in such registration statement for sale in any jurisdiction, use reasonable best efforts promptly to obtain the withdrawal of such order;

(xv)    use reasonable best efforts to cause such Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement to be registered with or approved by such other governmental agencies or authorities as may be necessary to enable the sellers thereof to consummate the disposition of such Registrable Securities;

(xvi)    cooperate with the Holders of Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement and the managing underwriter or agent, if any, to facilitate the timely preparation and delivery of certificates (not bearing any restrictive legends) representing the Registrable Securities to be sold under the registration statement and enable such Registrable Securities to be in such denominations and registered in such names as the managing underwriter, or agent, if any, or such Holders may request;

(xvii)    cooperate with each Holder of Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement and each underwriter or agent participating in the disposition of such Registrable Securities and their respective counsel in connection with any filings required to be made with FINRA;

(xviii)    use reasonable best efforts to make available the executive officers of the Company to participate with the Holders of Registrable Securities covered by such registration statement and any underwriters in any “road shows” or other selling efforts that may be reasonably requested by the Holders in connection with the methods of distribution for the Registrable Securities;

(xix)    in the case of any underwritten Public Offering, use its reasonable best efforts to obtain one or more comfort letters from the Company’s independent certified public accountants (and, if necessary, any other independent certified public accountants or independent auditors of any Subsidiary of the Company or any business acquired by

 

15


the Company for which financial statements and financial data are, or are required to be, included in the registration statement) in customary form and covering such matters of the type customarily covered by comfort letters as the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities being sold reasonably request;

(xx)    in the case of any underwritten Public Offering, use its reasonable best efforts to provide (i) a legal opinion of the Company’s outside counsel, dated the date of the closing under the underwriting agreement, the registration statement, each amendment and supplement thereto, the prospectus included therein (including the preliminary prospectus) and such other documents relating thereto in customary form and covering such matters of the type customarily covered by legal opinions of such nature, which opinion shall be addressed to the underwriters and the Holders of such Registrable Securities being sold and (ii) a legal opinion of the Company’s general counsel, dated the date of the closing under the underwriting agreement, the registration statement, each amendment and supplement thereto, the prospectus included therein (including the preliminary prospectus) and such other documents relating thereto in customary form and covering such matters of the type customarily covered by legal opinions of such nature, which opinion shall be addressed to the underwriters and the Holders of such Registrable Securities being sold;

(xxi)    if the Company files an Automatic Shelf Registration Statement covering any Registrable Securities, use its reasonable best efforts to remain a WKSI (and not become an ineligible issuer (as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act)) during the period during which such Automatic Shelf Registration Statement is required to remain effective and, if WKSI status is lost, to file an amendment to the Automatic Shelf Registration Statement to convert it into a Shelf Registration Statement as promptly as practicable;

(xxii)    if the Company does not pay the filing fee covering the Registrable Securities at the time an Automatic Shelf Registration Statement is filed, pay such fee at such time or times as the Registrable Securities are to be sold;

(xxiii)    if an Automatic Shelf Registration Statement has been outstanding for at least three (3) years, at the end of the third year, file a new Automatic Shelf Registration Statement covering the Registrable Securities, and, if at any time when the Company is required to re-evaluate its WKSI status the Company determines that it is not a WKSI, use its reasonable best efforts to refile the Shelf Registration Statement on Form S-3 and, if such form is not available, Form S-1 and keep such registration statement effective during the period during which such registration statement is required to be kept effective;

(xxiv)    provide all such other certificates, letters, opinions and other requested documents customarily provided in public offerings similar to the offering then being undertaken; and

 

16


(xxv)    take all such other reasonable actions as are necessary or advisable in order to expedite or facilitate the disposition of such Registrable Securities in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

(b)    If the Company files any Automatic Shelf Registration Statement for the benefit of the holders of any of its securities other than the Holders, and the Holders do not request that their Registrable Securities be included in such Shelf Registration Statement, the Company agrees that, once it is eligible to rely on Rule 430B, at the request of the Holders holding a majority of the Registrable Securities, it shall include in such Automatic Shelf Registration Statement such disclosures as may be required by Rule 430B in order to ensure that the Holders may be added to such Shelf Registration Statement at a later time through the filing of a prospectus supplement rather than a posteffective amendment.

(c)    Any officer of the Company who is a Holder agrees that if and for so long as he or she is employed by the Company or any Subsidiary thereof, he or she shall participate fully in the sale process in a manner customary and reasonable for persons in like positions and consistent with his or her other duties with the Company and in accordance with applicable law, including the preparation of the registration statement and the preparation and presentation of any road shows.

(d)    The Company may require each Holder requesting, or electing to participate in, any registration to furnish the Company such information regarding such Holder and the distribution of such Registrable Securities as the Company may from time to time reasonably request in writing.

(e)    If the Controlling Holders or any of their respective Affiliates seek to effectuate an in-kind distribution of all or part of their respective Registrable Securities to their respective direct or indirect equityholders, the Company shall, subject to any applicable lock-ups, use reasonable best efforts to facilitate such in-kind distribution in the manner reasonably requested.

Section 6.     Registration Expenses .

(a)     The Company’s Obligation . All expenses incident to the Company’s performance of or compliance with this Agreement (including, without limitation, (i) all registration, qualification and filing fees (including filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission and FINRA and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the underwriters in connection with FINRA qualification of the Registrable Securities), (ii) fees and expenses of compliance with securities or blue sky laws (including reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the underwriters in connection with blue sky qualification of the Registrable Securities), (iii) printing expenses (including expenses of printing certificates for Registrable Securities in a form eligible for deposit with The Depositary Trust Company and of printing prospectuses if the printing of prospectuses is requested by the managing underwriters or by the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in such registration), (iv) messenger, telephone and delivery expenses, (v) fees and disbursements of custodians, (vi) any other reasonable fees and disbursements of underwriters customarily paid by issuers or sellers of securities (excluding underwriting discounts and commissions), (vii) all expenses related to the “road show” for any underwritten Public Offering, including the cost of any aircraft chartered for such purpose, (viii)

 

17


fees and expenses of the transfer agent and registrar of the Company’s Common Stock and (ix) fees and disbursements of counsel for the Company and all independent certified public accountants (including the expenses of any special audit and comfort letters required by or incident to such performance) and other Persons retained by the Company) (all such expenses being herein called “ Registration Expenses ”), shall be borne by the Company, and the Company shall, in any event, pay its internal expenses (including, without limitation, all salaries and expenses of its officers and employees performing legal or accounting duties), the expense of any annual audit or quarterly review, the expense of any liability insurance and the expenses and fees for listing the securities to be registered on each securities exchange on which similar securities issued by the Company are then listed or quotation of the Registrable Securities on any inter-dealer quotation system. Each Person that sells securities pursuant to a Demand Registration or Piggyback Registration hereunder shall bear and pay all underwriting discounts and commissions applicable to the securities sold for such Person’s account.

(b)     Counsel Fees and Disbursements . In connection with each Demand Registration, each Piggyback Registration and each Shelf Offering that is an underwritten Public Offering, the Company shall reimburse the Holders of Registrable Securities included in such registration for the reasonable fees and disbursements of (i) one counsel chosen by the Controlling Holders and (ii) each additional counsel retained by any Holder for the purpose of rendering an opinion on behalf of such Holder in connection with any Demand Registration, Piggyback Registration or Shelf Offering that is an underwritten Public Offering, where the counsel referred to in clause (i) is unable or unwilling to render an opinion on behalf of such Holder.

(c)     Security Holders . To the extent any expenses are not required to be paid by the Company, each holder of securities included in any registration hereunder shall pay those expenses allocable to the registration of such holder’s securities so included in proportion to the aggregate selling price of the securities to be so registered.

Section 7.     Indemnification and Contribution .

(a)     By the Company . The Company shall indemnify and hold harmless, to the extent permitted by law, each Holder, such Holder’s officers, directors, managers, employees, agents, brokers, dealers and representatives, and each Person who controls such Holder (within the meaning of the Securities Act) (the “ Holder Indemnified Parties ”) against all losses, claims, actions, damages, liabilities and expenses (including with respect to actions or proceedings, whether commenced or threatened, and including reasonable attorney fees and expenses) caused by, resulting from, arising out of, based upon or related to any of the following statements, omissions or violations (each a “ Violation ”) by the Company: (i) any untrue or alleged untrue statement of material fact contained in (A) any registration statement, prospectus, preliminary prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus, or any amendment thereof or supplement thereto or (B) any application or other document or communication (in this Section  7 , collectively called an “ application ”) executed by or on behalf of the Company or based upon written information furnished by or on behalf of the Company filed in any jurisdiction in order to qualify any securities covered by such registration under the securities laws thereof, (ii) any omission or alleged omission of a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or (iii) any violation or alleged violation by the Company of the Securities Act or any other similar federal or state securities laws or any rule or regulation

 

18


promulgated thereunder applicable to the Company and relating to action or inaction required of the Company in connection with any such registration, qualification or compliance. In addition, the Company will reimburse such Holder Indemnified Party for any legal or any other expenses reasonably incurred by them in connection with investigating or defending any such losses. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company shall not be liable in any such case to the extent that any such losses result from, arise out of, are based upon, or relate to an untrue statement or alleged untrue statement, or omission or alleged omission, made in such registration statement, any such prospectus, preliminary prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus or any amendment or supplement thereto, or in any application, in reliance upon, and in conformity with, written information prepared and furnished in writing to the Company by such Holder Indemnified Party expressly for use therein or by such Holder Indemnified Party’s failure to deliver a copy of the registration statement or prospectus or any amendments or supplements thereto after the Company has furnished such Holder Indemnified Party with a sufficient number of copies of the same. In connection with an underwritten offering, the Company shall indemnify such underwriters, their officers and directors, and each Person who controls such underwriters (within the meaning of the Securities Act) to the same extent as provided above with respect to the indemnification of the Holder Indemnified Parties.

(b)     By Each Holder . In connection with any registration statement in which a Holder is participating, each such Holder shall furnish to the Company in writing such information and affidavits as the Company reasonably requests for use in connection with any such registration statement or prospectus and, to the extent permitted by law, shall indemnify the Company, its officers, directors, managers, employees, agents and representatives, and each Person who controls the Company (within the meaning of the Securities Act) against any losses, claims, damages, liabilities and expenses resulting from any untrue or alleged untrue statement of material fact contained in the registration statement, prospectus or preliminary prospectus or any amendment thereof or supplement thereto or any omission or alleged omission of a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, but only to the extent that such untrue statement or omission is contained in any information or affidavit so furnished in writing by such Holder expressly for use in such registration statement; provided that the obligation to indemnify shall be individual, not joint and several, for each Holder and shall be limited to the net amount of proceeds received by such Holder from the sale of Registrable Securities pursuant to such registration statement.

(c)     Claim Procedure . Any Person entitled to indemnification hereunder shall (i) give prompt written notice to the indemnifying party of any claim with respect to which it seeks indemnification (provided that the failure to give prompt notice shall impair any Person’s right to indemnification hereunder only to the extent such failure has prejudiced the indemnifying party) and (ii) unless in such indemnified party’s reasonable judgment a conflict of interest between such indemnified and indemnifying parties may exist with respect to such claim, permit such indemnifying party to assume the defense of such claim with counsel reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party. If such defense is assumed, the indemnifying party shall not be subject to any liability for any settlement made by the indemnified party without its consent (but such consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed). An indemnifying party who is not entitled to, or elects not to, assume the defense of a claim shall not be obligated to pay the fees and expenses of more than one counsel for all parties indemnified by such indemnifying party with respect to such claim, unless in the reasonable judgment of any indemnified party a

 

19


conflict of interest may exist between such indemnified party and any other of such indemnified parties with respect to such claim. In such instance, the conflicted indemnified parties shall have a right to retain one separate counsel, chosen by the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in the registration if such Holders are indemnified parties, at the expense of the indemnifying party.

(d)     Contribution . If the indemnification provided for in this Section  7 is held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be unavailable to, or is insufficient to hold harmless, an indemnified party or is otherwise unenforceable with respect to any loss, claim, damage, liability or action referred to herein, then the indemnifying party shall contribute to the amounts paid or payable by such indemnified party as a result of such loss, claim, damage, liability or action in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the indemnifying party on the one hand and of the indemnified party on the other hand in connection with the statements or omissions which resulted in such loss, claim, damage, liability or action as well as any other relevant equitable considerations; provided that the maximum amount of liability in respect of such contribution shall be limited, in the case of each seller of Registrable Securities, to an amount equal to the net proceeds actually received by such seller from the sale of Registrable Securities effected pursuant to such registration. The relative fault of the indemnifying party and of the indemnified party shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the indemnifying party or by the indemnified party and the parties’ relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission. The parties hereto agree that it would not be just or equitable if the contribution pursuant to this Section  7(d) were to be determined by pro rata allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take into account such equitable considerations. The amount paid or payable by an indemnified party as a result of the losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses referred to herein shall be deemed to include any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in connection with investigating or defending against any action or claim which is the subject hereof. No Person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any Person who is not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

(e)     Release . No indemnifying party shall, except with the consent of the indemnified party, consent to the entry of any judgment or enter into any settlement that does not include as an unconditional term thereof giving by the claimant or plaintiff to such indemnified party of a release from all liability in respect to such claim or litigation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Section  7 , an indemnifying party shall not be liable for any amounts paid in settlement of any loss, claim, damage, liability, or action if such settlement is effected without the consent of the indemnifying party, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed.

(f)     Non-exclusive Remedy; Survival . The indemnification and contribution provided for under this Agreement shall be in addition to any other rights to indemnification or contribution that any indemnified party may have pursuant to law or contract and shall remain in full force and effect regardless of any investigation made by or on behalf of the indemnified party or any officer, director or controlling Person of such indemnified party and shall survive the transfer of Registrable Securities and the termination or expiration of this Agreement.

 

20


Section 8.     Underwritten Registrations .

(a)     Participation . No Person may participate in any Public Offering hereunder which is underwritten unless such Person (i) agrees to sell such Person’s securities on the basis provided in any underwriting arrangements approved by the Person or Persons entitled hereunder to approve such arrangements (including, without limitation, pursuant to any over-allotment or “green shoe” option requested by the underwriters; provided that no Holder shall be required to sell more than the number of Registrable Securities such Holder has requested to include) and (ii) completes and executes all questionnaires, powers of attorney, indemnities, underwriting agreements and other documents required under the terms of such underwriting arrangements and that are consistent in all material respects with the documents to be completed and executed by the Controlling Holders; provided that no Holder included in any underwritten registration shall be required to make any representations or warranties to the Company or the underwriters (other than representations and warranties regarding such holder and such holder’s intended method of distribution) or to undertake any indemnification obligations to the Company or the underwriters with respect thereto that are materially more burdensome than those provided in Section 7 or those provided by the other Holders participating in such underwritten registration. Each Holder shall execute and deliver such other agreements as may be reasonably requested by the Company and the lead managing underwriter(s) that are consistent with such Holder’s obligations under Section  4 , Section  5 and this Section  8(a) or that are necessary to give further effect thereto and that are consistent in all material respects with the documents to be completed and executed by the Controlling Holders. To the extent that any such agreement is entered into pursuant to, and consistent with, Section  4 and this Section  8(a) , the respective rights and obligations created under such agreement shall supersede the respective rights and obligations of the Holders, the Company and the underwriters created pursuant to this Section  8(a) .

(b)     Price and Underwriting Discounts . In the case of an underwritten Demand Registration or Underwritten Takedown requested by Holders pursuant to this Agreement, the price, underwriting discount and other financial terms of the related underwriting agreement for the Registrable Securities shall be determined by the Holders representing a majority of the Registrable Securities included in such underwritten offering.

(c)     Suspended Distributions . Each Person that is participating in any registration under this Agreement, upon receipt of any notice from the Company of the happening of any event of the kind described in Section  5(a)(vi)(B) or (C) , shall immediately discontinue the disposition of its Registrable Securities pursuant to the registration statement until such Person’s receipt of the copies of a supplemented or amended prospectus as contemplated by Section  5(a)(vi) .

Section 9.     Additional Parties; Joinder . Subject to the prior written consent of each Controlling Holder, the Company may make any Person who acquires Common Stock or rights to acquire Common Stock from the Company after the date hereof a party to this Agreement (each such Person, an “ Additional Investor ”) and to succeed to all of the rights and obligations of a Holder under this Agreement by obtaining an executed joinder to this Agreement from such Additional Investor in the form of Exhibit A attached hereto (a “ Joinder ”). Upon the execution and delivery of a Joinder by such Additional Investor, the Common Stock of the Company acquired by such Additional Investor or to which such Additional Investor has the right to

 

21


acquire (the “ Acquired Common ”) shall be Registrable Securities to the extent provided herein, such Additional Investor shall be a Holder under this Agreement with respect to the Acquired Common, and the Company shall add such Additional Investor’s name and address to the Schedule of Investors and circulate such information to the parties to this Agreement.

Section 10.     Current Public Information . At all times after the Company has filed a registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the requirements of either the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, the Company shall file all reports required to be filed by it under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act and shall take such further action as any Holder may reasonably request, all to the extent required to enable such Holders to sell Registrable Securities pursuant to Rule 144. Upon request, the Company shall deliver to any Holder a written statement as to whether it has complied with such requirements.

Section 11.     Subsidiary Public Offering . If, after an initial Public Offering of the Capital Stock of one of its Subsidiaries (including the Company), the Company distributes securities of such Subsidiary to its equityholders, then the rights and obligations of the Company pursuant to this Agreement shall apply, mutatis mutandis , to such Subsidiary, and the Company shall cause such Subsidiary to comply with such Subsidiary’s obligations under this Agreement.

Section 12.     MNPI Provisions .

(a)    Each Holder acknowledges that (i) the provisions of this Agreement that require communications by the Company or other Holders to such Holder may result in such Holder and its Representatives (as defined below) acquiring MNPI (which may include, solely by way of illustration, the fact that an offering of the Company’s securities is pending or the number of Company securities or the identity of the selling Holders), and (ii) there is no limitation on the duration of time that such Holder and its Representatives may be in possession of MNPI and no requirement that the Company or other Holders make any public disclosure to cause such information to cease to be MNPI; provided that the Company will use reasonable best efforts to promptly notify each Holder if any proposed registration or offering for which a notice has been delivered pursuant to this Agreement has been terminated or aborted.

(b)    Each Holder agrees that it will maintain the confidentiality of such MNPI and, to the extent such Holder is not a natural person, such confidential treatment shall be in accordance with procedures adopted by it in good faith to protect confidential information of third parties delivered to such Holder (“ Policies ”); provided that a Holder may deliver or disclose MNPI to (i) its directors, officers, employees, agents, attorneys, affiliates and financial and other advisors (collectively, the “ Representatives ”), but solely to the extent such disclosure reasonably relates to its evaluation of exercise of its rights under this Agreement and the sale of any Registrable Securities in connection with the subject of the notice, (ii) any federal or state regulatory authority having jurisdiction over such Holder, (iii) any Person if necessary to effect compliance with any law, rule, regulation or order applicable to such Holder, (iv) in response to any subpoena or other legal process, or (v) in connection with any litigation to which such Holder is a party; provided , further , that in the case of clause (i) , the recipients of such MNPI are subject to the Policies or agree to hold confidential the MNPI in a manner substantially consistent with the terms of this Section  12 and that in the case of clauses (ii)  through (v) , such disclosure is required by law and such Holder promptly notifies the Company of such disclosure to the extent such Holder is legally permitted to give such notice.

 

22


(c)    Each Holder, by its execution of a counterpart to this Agreement or of a Joinder, hereby acknowledges that it is aware that the U.S. securities laws prohibit any Person who has MNPI about a company from purchasing or selling, directly or indirectly, securities of such company (including entering into hedge transactions involving such securities), or from communicating such information to any other Person under circumstances in which it is reasonably foreseeable that such Person is likely to purchase or sell such securities.

(d)    Each Holder shall have the right, at any time and from time to time (including after receiving information regarding any potential Public Offering), to elect not to receive any notice that the Company or any other Holders otherwise are required to deliver pursuant to this Agreement by delivering to the Company a written statement signed by such Holder that it does not want to receive any notices hereunder (an “ Opt-Out Request ”); in which case and notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement the Company and other Holders shall not be required to, and shall not, deliver any notice or other information required to be provided to Holders hereunder to the extent that the Company or such other Holders reasonably expect would result in a Holder acquiring MNPI. An Opt-Out Request may state a date on which it expires or, if no such date is specified, shall remain in effect indefinitely. A Holder who previously has given the Company an Opt-Out Request may revoke such request at any time, and there shall be no limit on the ability of a Holder to issue and revoke subsequent Opt-Out Requests; provided that each Holder shall use commercially reasonable efforts to minimize the administrative burden on the Company arising in connection with any such Opt-Out Requests.

Section 13.     General Provisions .

(a)     Amendments and Waivers . Except as otherwise provided herein, the provisions of this Agreement may be amended, modified or waived only with the prior written consent of the Company and each Controlling Holder; provided that no such amendment, modification or waiver that would adversely affect a Holder in a manner that is different from any other Holder ( provided that the accession by any Additional Investor to this Agreement pursuant to Section  9 shall not be deemed to adversely affect any Holder), shall be effective against such Holder without the prior written consent of such Holder. The failure or delay of any Person to enforce any of the provisions of this Agreement shall in no way be construed as a waiver of such provisions and shall not affect the right of such Person thereafter to enforce each and every provision of this Agreement in accordance with its terms. A waiver or consent to or of any breach or default by any Person in the performance by that Person of his, her or its obligations under this Agreement shall not be deemed to be a consent or waiver to or of any other breach or default in the performance by that Person of the same or any other obligations of that Person under this Agreement.

(b)     Remedies . The parties to this Agreement and their successors and assigns shall be entitled to enforce their rights under this Agreement specifically (without posting a bond or other security), to recover damages caused by reason of any breach of any provision of this Agreement and to exercise all other rights existing in their favor. The parties hereto and their successors and assigns agree and acknowledge that a breach of this Agreement would cause irreparable harm

 

23


and money damages would not be an adequate remedy for any such breach and that, in addition to any other rights and remedies existing hereunder, any party shall be entitled to specific performance and/or other injunctive relief from any court of law or equity of competent jurisdiction (without posting any bond or other security) in order to enforce or prevent violation of the provisions of this Agreement.

(c)     Severability . Whenever possible, each provision of this Agreement shall be interpreted in such manner as to be effective and valid under applicable law, but if any provision of this Agreement is held to be prohibited, invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect under any applicable law or regulation in any jurisdiction, such prohibition, invalidity, illegality or unenforceability shall not affect the validity, legality or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement in such jurisdiction or in any other jurisdiction, but this Agreement shall be reformed, construed and enforced in such jurisdiction as if such prohibited, invalid, illegal or unenforceable provision had never been contained herein.

(d)     Entire Agreement . Except as otherwise provided herein, this Agreement contains the complete agreement and understanding among the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and supersedes and preempts any prior understandings, agreements or representations by or among the parties hereto, written or oral, which may have related to the subject matter hereof in any way.

(e)     Successors and Assigns . The rights to cause the Company to register Registrable Securities under this Agreement may be transferred or assigned by each Holder to one or more transferees or assignees of Registrable Securities; provided, that any such transferee or assignee is an Affiliate of, and after such transfer or assignment continues to be an Affiliate of, such Holder and that each such transferee or assignee assumes in writing responsibility for its portion of the obligations of such transferring Holder under this Agreement. This Agreement shall bind and inure to the benefit and be enforceable by the Company and its successors and assigns and the Holders and their respective successors and assigns (whether so expressed or not). In addition, whether or not any express assignment has been made, the provisions of this Agreement which are for the benefit Holders are also for the benefit of, and enforceable by, any subsequent or successor Holder.

(f)     Notices . Any notice, demand or other communication to be given under or by reason of the provisions of this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been given or delivered (i) when delivered personally to the recipient, (ii) when sent by confirmed electronic mail if sent during normal business hours of the recipient but, if not, then on the next Business Day, (iii) one Business Day after it is sent to the recipient by reputable overnight courier service (charges prepaid) or (iv) three Business Days after it is mailed to the recipient by first class mail, return receipt requested. Such notices, demands and other communications shall be sent to the Company and the Controlling Holders at the addresses specified below and to any other party subject to this Agreement at such address as indicated on the Schedule of Investors, or at such address or to the attention of such other Person as the recipient party has specified by prior written notice to the sending party or as is on file for such Person at the Company. Any party may change such party’s address for receipt of notice by providing prior written notice of the change to the sending party as provided herein. The Company’s address is:

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: Jonathan J. Ledecky

E-mail: jledecky@hockeyny.com

 

24


With a copy to:

Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: David Alan Miller / Jeffrey M. Gallant

E-mail: dmiller@graubard.com / jgallant@graubard.com

or to such other address or to the attention of such other Person as the Company has specified by prior written notice to the sending party.

The Controlling Holders’ address is:

c/o The Carlyle Group

520 Madison Avenue

New York, New York 10022

Attention: William Darman

Email: william.darman@carlyle.com

With a copy to:

Latham & Watkins LLP

555 Eleventh Street, N.W.

Washington, DC 20004

Attention: Paul Sheridan

Email: paul.sheridan@lw.com

or to such other address or to the attention of such other Person as the Controlling Holders have specified by prior written notice to the sending party.

(g)     Business Days . If any time period for giving notice or taking action hereunder expires on a day that is not a Business Day, the time period shall automatically be extended to the immediately following Business Day.

(h)     Governing Law . All issues and questions concerning the construction, validity, interpretation and enforcement of this Agreement and the exhibits and schedules hereto, and the relative rights of the Company and its stockholders hereunder, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Delaware, without giving effect to any

 

25


choice of law or conflict of law rules or provisions (whether of the State of Delaware or any other jurisdiction) that would cause the application of the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of Delaware.

(i)     MUTUAL WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL . AS A SPECIFICALLY BARGAINED FOR INDUCEMENT FOR EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT (AFTER HAVING THE OPPORTUNITY TO CONSULT WITH COUNSEL), EACH PARTY HERETO EXPRESSLY WAIVES THE RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LAWSUIT OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO OR ARISING IN ANY WAY FROM THIS AGREEMENT OR THE MATTERS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

(j)     CONSENT TO JURISDICTION AND SERVICE OF PROCESS . EACH OF THE PARTIES, AND EACH OF THEIR SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS, IRREVOCABLY SUBMITS TO THE NON-EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION OF THE FEDERAL COURTS OF THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA LOCATED IN THE STATE OF DELAWARE, FOR THE PURPOSES OF ANY SUIT, ACTION OR OTHER PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF THIS AGREEMENT, ANY RELATED AGREEMENT OR ANY TRANSACTION CONTEMPLATED HEREBY OR THEREBY. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO, AND EACH OF THEIR SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS, FURTHER AGREES THAT SERVICE OF ANY PROCESS, SUMMONS, NOTICE OR DOCUMENT BY U.S. REGISTERED MAIL TO SUCH PARTY’S RESPECTIVE ADDRESS SET FORTH ABOVE SHALL BE EFFECTIVE SERVICE OF PROCESS FOR ANY ACTION, SUIT OR PROCEEDING WITH RESPECT TO ANY MATTERS TO WHICH IT HAS SUBMITTED TO JURISDICTION IN THIS PARAGRAPH. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO, AND EACH OF THEIR SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS, IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION TO THE LAYING OF VENUE OF ANY ACTION, SUIT OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF THIS AGREEMENT, ANY RELATED DOCUMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY AND THEREBY IN THE UNITED STATES DISTRICT COURT FOR THE DISTRICT OF DELAWARE, AND HEREBY AND THEREBY FURTHER IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES AND AGREES NOT TO PLEAD OR CLAIM IN ANY SUCH COURT THAT ANY SUCH ACTION, SUIT OR PROCEEDING BROUGHT IN ANY SUCH COURT HAS BEEN BROUGHT IN AN INCONVENIENT FORUM.

(k)     No Recourse . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the Company and each Holder agrees and acknowledges that no recourse under this Agreement or any documents or instruments delivered in connection with this Agreement, shall be had against any current or future director, officer, employee, general or limited partner or member of any Holder or of any Affiliate or assignee thereof, whether by the enforcement of any assessment or by any legal or equitable proceeding, or by virtue of any statute, regulation or other applicable law, it being expressly agreed and acknowledged that no personal liability whatsoever shall attach to, be imposed on or otherwise be incurred by any current or future officer, agent or employee of any Holder or any current or future member of any Holder or any current or future director, officer, employee, partner or member of any Holder or of any Affiliate or assignee thereof, as such for any obligation of any Holder under this Agreement or any documents or instruments delivered in connection with this Agreement for any claim based on, in respect of or by reason of such obligations or their creation.

 

26


(l)     Descriptive Headings; Interpretation . The descriptive headings of this Agreement are inserted for convenience only and do not constitute a part of this Agreement. The use of the word “including” in this Agreement shall be by way of example rather than by limitation.

(m)     No Strict Construction . The language used in this Agreement shall be deemed to be the language chosen by the parties hereto to express their mutual intent, and no rule of strict construction shall be applied against any party.

(n)     Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in multiple counterparts, any one of which need not contain the signature of more than one party, but all such counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.

(o)     Electronic Delivery . This Agreement, the agreements referred to herein, and each other agreement or instrument entered into in connection herewith or therewith or contemplated hereby or thereby, and any amendments hereto or thereto, to the extent executed and delivered by means of a photographic, photostatic, facsimile or similar reproduction of such signed writing using a facsimile machine or electronic mail shall be treated in all manner and respects as an original agreement or instrument and shall be considered to have the same binding legal effect as if it were the original signed version thereof delivered in person. At the request of any party hereto or to any such agreement or instrument, each other party hereto or thereto shall re-execute original forms thereof and deliver them to all other parties. No party hereto or to any such agreement or instrument shall raise the use of a facsimile machine or electronic mail to deliver a signature or the fact that any signature or agreement or instrument was transmitted or communicated through the use of a facsimile machine or electronic mail as a defense to the formation or enforceability of a contract and each such party forever waives any such defense.

(p)     Further Assurances . In connection with this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby, each Holder shall execute and deliver any additional documents and instruments and perform any additional acts that may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate and perform the provisions of this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby.

(q)     No Inconsistent Agreements . The Company shall not hereafter enter into any agreement with respect to its securities which is inconsistent with or violates the rights granted to the Holders in this Agreement.

(r)     Dilution . If, from time to time, there is any change in the capital structure of the Company by way of a stock split, stock dividend, combination or reclassification, or through a merger, consolidation, reorganization or recapitalization, or by any other means, appropriate adjustment shall be made in the provisions hereof so that the rights and privileges granted hereby shall continue.

* * * * *

 

27


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Registration Rights Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.
By:  

 

Name:
Its:

 

[ Signature Page to Registration Rights Agreement ]


CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P., its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C., its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director
CEOF II Coinvestment (DE), L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P.; its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C.; its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director
CEOF II Coinvestment B (DE), L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P.; its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C.; its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director

 

[ Signature Page to Registration Rights Agreement ]


[ADDITIONAL INVESTORS]
By:  

 

Name:
Title:

 

[ Signature Page to Registration Rights Agreement ]


SCHEDULE A

Schedule of Investors

 

1.

CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P.

2.

CEOF II Coinvestment (DE), L.P.

3.

CEOF II Coinvestment B (DE), L.P.

4.

Revolution Growth III, LP

5.

Abramson Investment Management

6.

ACE Buyout II SPC on behalf of LD S.P.

7.

Antares Holdings LP

8.

Anthony J. DeJohn

9.

Atlantic Neptune Investment Holdings, LLC

10.

Brian J. Morley

11.

Brickman Partners, LP

12.

Christopher J. Weiler

13.

Conifer Partners LLC

14.

Dale Drury

15.

Daniel Akerson

16.

Daniel A. Zambito

17.

Daniel B. Balthaser

18.

Daniel Cilman

19.

Dennis Hall

20.

Dennis Liberson

21.

Donna S. Morea

22.

Douglas S. Strahan, transfer on death to Douglas S. Strahan Trust dated October 29, 1999, and amended by complete restatement on August 1, 2016, as it may be amended from time to time

23.

Edgar B. Harris

24.

Ferdinand Cami

25.

James Hallmark & Song H Pak JTWROS

26.

Jennifer Swensson

27.

John Krutsick

28.

Joseph K. Palosky

29.

KLD Investors LLC

30.

Krystina L. Jones

31.

Liberty Mutual Investment Holdings LLC

32.

Long Grove Capital, LLC

33.

Mitchell Schear

34.

Northwestern Mutual Capital Strategic Equity Fund IV, LP

35.

Northwestern Mutual Life Insurance Company


36.

Northwestern Mutual Life Insurance Company for its Group Annuity Separate Account

37.

Oleg Linnik

38.

Radcliff Principal Holdings LLC

39.

Robert P. Hunter

40.

Scott A. Somer

41.

Taffita M. Schurz

42.

The Europe Trust

43.

Thomas C. Hughes

44.

Westview Capital Partners III, L.P.

45.

Yengiang D. Tran

46.

Pivotal Acquisition Holdings LLC

47.

Pivotal SPAC Funding LLC

48.

James H.R. Brady

49.

Evan B. Morgan

50.

Efrat Epstein

51.

Katrina Adams


EXHIBIT A

REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT JOINDER

The undersigned is executing and delivering this Joinder pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of [●], 2019 (as the same may hereafter be amended, the “ Registration Rights Agreement ”), among Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), and the other person named as parties therein.

By executing and delivering this Joinder to the Company, and upon acceptance hereof by the Company upon the execution of a counterpart hereof, the undersigned hereby agrees to become a party to, to be bound by, and to comply with the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement as a Holder of Registrable Securities in the same manner as if the undersigned were an original signatory to the Registration Rights Agreement, and the undersigned’s shares of Common Stock shall be included as Registrable Securities under the Registration Rights Agreement to the extent provided therein. The Company is directed to add the address below the undersigned’s signature on this Joinder to the Schedule of Investors attached to the Registration Rights Agreement.

Accordingly, the undersigned has executed and delivered this Joinder as of the              day of              , 20      .

 

 

Signature of Stockholder

 

Print Name of Stockholder

Its:
Address:                                                                                       

 

 

Agreed and Accepted as of

             , 20     

 

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.
By:                                                                       
Name:
Its:

Exhibit 10.7

STOCKHOLDERS’ AGREEMENT

This Stockholders’ Agreement (this “ Agreement ”), dated as of [______], 2019 (the “ Effective Time ”), is entered into by and among (i) Pivotal Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”) and (ii) the Persons included on the signature pages hereto as “LD Topco Holders” (collectively, the “ LD Topco Holders ”). Each of the Company and the LD Topco Holders may be referred to herein as a “ Party ” and collectively as the “ Parties ”. Except as otherwise indicated, capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings set forth in Section  5 of this Agreement.

WHEREAS, the Company has agreed to permit the LD Topco Holders, in connection with the Effective Time, to designate up to six persons for nomination for election to the board of directors of the Company (the “ Board ”) and to provide certain ongoing rights with respect to the nomination of directors on the terms and conditions set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants contained herein and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Parties hereby agree as follows:

Section 1.     Board of Directors .

(a)    Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, from and after the Effective Time and until a Termination Event (as defined below) shall have occurred, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall have the right to designate up to six persons to be appointed or nominated, as the case may be, for election to the Board (including any successor, each, a “ Nominee ”) by giving written notice to the Company not later than ten days after receiving notice of the date of the applicable meeting of shareholders provided to the LD Topco Holders; provided , however , the initial Nominees shall be appointed as set forth in Section  1(b) .

(b)    The Company shall take all necessary and desirable actions within its control such that, as of the Effective Time: (i) the size of the Board shall be set at eight members; and (ii) the following persons shall form the composition of the Board: (A) Richard J. Williams and Kevin Griffin shall be appointed as Class A Directors with terms ending at the Company’s 2020 Annual Meeting; (B) Donna Morea, Jonathan J. Ledecky and Evan Morgan shall be appointed as Class B Directors with terms ending at the Company’s 2021 Annual Meeting; and (C) Christopher J. Weiler, Daniel F. Akerson and William Darman shall be appointed as Class C Directors with terms ending at the Company’s 2022 Annual Meeting.

(c)    Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, from and after the Effective Time and until a Termination Event shall have occurred, the Company shall, as promptly as practicable, take all necessary and desirable actions within its control (including, without limitation, calling special meetings of the Board and the shareholders and recommending, supporting and soliciting proxies), so that:

(i)    for so long as the LD Topco Holders (together with their Affiliates) Beneficially Own a number of shares of Common Stock equal to or greater than 65% of the total number of shares of Common Stock acquired by the LD Topco Holders on the


date hereof, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall have the right to nominate, in the aggregate, a number of Nominees equal to six (less the number of LD Topco Directors who are not up for election), and the size of the Board shall be set at eight members;

(ii)    for so long as the LD Topco Holders (together with their Affiliates) Beneficially Own a number of shares of Common Stock equal to or greater than 35% of the total number of shares of Common Stock acquired by the LD Topco Holders on the date hereof, but less than 65% of the total number of shares of Common Stock acquired by the LD Topco Holders on the date hereof, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall have the right to nominate, in the aggregate, a number of Nominees equal to three (less the number of LD Topco Directors who are then serving but not up for election), and the size of the Board shall be set at eight members; and

(iii)    for so long as the LD Topco Holders (together with their Affiliates) Beneficially Own a number of shares of Common Stock equal to or greater than 10% of the total number of shares of Common Stock acquired by the LD Topco Holders on the date hereof but less than 35% of the total number of shares of Common Stock acquired by the LD Topco Holders on the date hereof, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall have the right to nominate, in the aggregate, a number of Nominees equal to one (less the number of LD Topco Directors who are then serving but not up for election), and the size of the Board shall be set at eight members;

provided , that, no reduction in the number of shares of Common Stock over which the LD Topco Holders and their Affiliates retain voting control shall shorten the term of any incumbent Director.

(d)    The Company shall take all actions necessary to ensure that: (i) the applicable Nominees are included in the Board’s slate of nominees to the shareholders of the Company for each election of Directors and recommended by the Board at any meeting of shareholders called for the purpose of electing directors; and (ii) each applicable Nominee up for election is included in the proxy statement prepared by management of the Company in connection with the Company’s soliciting proxies or consents in favor of the foregoing for every meeting of the shareholders of the Company called with respect to the election of members of the Board, and at every adjournment or postponement thereof, and on every action or approval by written resolution of the shareholders of the Company or the Board with respect to the election of members of the Board. In addition, each Shareholder agrees with the Company that such Shareholder shall vote in favor of each person to be appointed or nominated, as the case may be, for election to the Board and who has been recommended by the Board for such appointment or nomination at every meeting of the shareholders of the Company called with respect to the election of members of the Board, and at every adjournment or postponement thereof, and on every action or approval by written resolution of the shareholders of the Company or the Board with respect to the election of members of the Board.

(e)    If a vacancy occurs because of the death, disability, disqualification, resignation or removal of a LD Topco Director or for any other reason, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall be entitled to designate such person’s successor,

 

2


and the Company shall, within ten days of such designation, take all necessary actions within its control such that such vacancy shall be filled with such successor Nominee, it being understood that any such successor designee shall serve the remainder of the term of the Director whom such designee replaces. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary, the director position for such LD Topco Director shall not be filled pending such designation and appointment, unless the LD Topco Holders fail to designate such Nominee for more than 15 days, after which the Company may appoint an interim successor Director until the LD Topco Holders make such designation.

(f)    If a Nominee is not elected because of such Nominee’s death, disability, disqualification, withdrawal as a nominee or for any other reason, the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares shall be entitled to designate promptly another Nominee and the Shareholders and the Company shall take all necessary and desirable actions within its control such that the director position for which such Nominee was nominated shall not be filled pending such designation or the size of the Board shall be increased by one and such vacancy shall be filled with such successor Nominee within ten days of such designation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary, the director position for which such Nominee was nominated shall not be filled pending such designation and appointment, unless the LD Topco Holders fail to designate such Nominee for more than 30 days, after which the Company may appoint an interim successor nominee who may serve as a director if duly elected until the LD Topco Holders make such designation. The LD Topco Holders shall not be obligated to designate all (or any) of the directors they are entitled to designate pursuant to this Agreement but the failure to do so shall not constitute a waiver of their rights hereunder.

(g)    The Company shall pay the reasonable, documented out-of-pocket expenses incurred by each LD Topco Director in connection with his or her services provided to or on behalf of the Company, including attending meetings (including committee meetings) or events attended on behalf of the Company at the Company’s request.

(h)    In accordance with the Company’s Organizational Documents, the Board may from time to time by resolution establish and maintain one or more committees of the Board, each committee to consist of one or more Directors. The Company shall notify the LD Topco Holders in writing of any new committee of the Board to be established at least 15 days prior to the effective establishment of such committee. If requested by the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares, the Shareholders and the Company shall take all necessary steps within its control to cause at least two LD Topco Directors (selected by such LD Topco Holders) to be appointed as a member of each such committee of the Board unless such designation would violate any legal restriction on such committee’s composition or the rules and regulations of any applicable exchange on which the Company’s securities may be listed (subject in each case to any applicable exceptions, including those for “controlled companies” and any applicable phase-in periods).

(i)    The Company shall (i) purchase directors’ and officers’ liability insurance in an amount and pursuant to terms determined by the Board to be reasonable and customary and (ii) for so long as any Director to the Board nominated pursuant to the terms of this Agreement serves as a Director of the Company, maintain such coverage with respect to such Directors; provided , that upon removal or resignation of such Director for any reason, the Company shall take all actions reasonably necessary to extend such directors’ and officers’ liability insurance coverage for a period of not less than six years from any such event in respect of any act or omission occurring at or prior to such event.

 

3


(j)    For so long as any LD Topco Director serves as a Director of the Company, the Company shall not amend, alter or repeal any right to indemnification or exculpation covering or benefiting any Director nominated pursuant to this Agreement as and to the extent consistent with applicable Law, including but not limited to any such rights to indemnification or exculpation in the Company’s Organizational Documents (except to the extent such amendment or alteration permits the Company to provide broader indemnification or exculpation rights, in the aggregate and on an individual basis, on a retroactive basis, than permitted prior thereto).

(k)    Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, if the LD Topco Holders have the right to designate one or more Nominees and either have not exercised such right with respect to any Nominee or no such Nominee has not been elected as a LD Topco Director (such that there are no LD Topco Directors on the Board), then the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares may elect at such time in their sole discretion to designate one Board observer (regardless of how many rights to designate Designees such LD Topco Holders have) (each, a “ Board Observer ”) to attend and participate in all meetings of the Board or any committees thereof in a non-voting capacity by the giving of written notice to the Company of such election (“ Observation Election ”). In connection therewith, the Company shall simultaneously give such Board Observer copies of all notices, consents, minutes and other materials, financial or otherwise, which the Company provides to the Board; provided , however , that if the Board Observer does not, upon the written request of the Company, before attending any meetings of the Board, execute and deliver to the Company an agreement to abide by all Company policies applicable to members of the Board and a confidentiality agreement reasonably acceptable to the Company, the Board Observer may be excluded from access to any material or meeting or portion thereof if the Board determines in good faith, upon advice of counsel, that such exclusion is reasonably necessary to protect highly confidential proprietary information of the Company or confidential proprietary information of third parties that the Company is required to hold in confidence, or for other similar reasons. The LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares may revoke any such Observation Election at any time upon written notice to the Company after which the LD Topco Holders shall be entitled to designate a replacement Board Observer.

(l)    The Nominees may, but do not need to, qualify as “independent” pursuant to listing standards of the Approved Stock Exchange, except that, if the LD Topco Holders have the right to designate three Nominees, then at least one Nominee shall qualify as “independent” pursuant to listing standards of the Approved Stock Exchange. All other Directors of the Board other than the Chief Executive Officer of the Company shall qualify as “independent” pursuant to listing standards of the Approved Stock Exchange.

(m)    For the avoidance of doubt, a reduction in the percentage of Common Stock Beneficially Owned by the LD Topco Holders shall not impact the LD Topco Holders’ right to fill a vacancy resulting from any Nominee ceasing to serve as a Director for any reason.

 

4


(n)    Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, from and after the Effective Time and at any time prior to a Termination Event, the Shareholders shall not knowingly take or agree to take, directly or indirectly, any action to frustrate, obstruct or otherwise prevent, the Company from performing its obligations to nominate the Nominees under Section  1(c) .

Section 2.     Actions Requiring Special Approval . Without the prior approval of the LD Topco Holders, from and after the Effective Time and at any time prior to a Termination Event, the Company shall not take or omit to take, as applicable, or agree to take or omit to take, as applicable, directly or indirectly, any action to increase or decrease the size of the Board or to make a change to the classes on which the Directors serve.

Section 3.     Definitions .

Affiliate ” means, with respect to any specified Person, any Person that, directly or indirectly, controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with, such specified Person, through one or more intermediaries or otherwise.

Agreement ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Annual Meeting ” means any meeting of the stockholders of the Company held for the purpose of electing the Directors of the Company.

Approved Stock Exchange ” means the Nasdaq, the New York Stock Exchange or any other national securities exchange on which any of the Common Stock of the Company is listed.

Beneficially Own ” has the meaning ascribed to it in Section 13(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

Board ” has the meaning set forth in the recitals.

Board Observer ” has the meaning set forth in Section  1(k) .

Business Day ” means a day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks in New York, New York, are authorized or required by Law to close.

Common Stock ” means the issued and outstanding Class A common stock of the Company, par value $0.0001 per share.

Company ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Director ” means a member of the Board until such individual’s death, disability, disqualification, resignation or removal.

Effective Time ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

 

5


LD Topco Director ” means an individual elected to the Board that has been nominated by the LD Topco Holders pursuant to this Agreement.

LD Topco Holders ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

LD Topco Shares ” means any shares of Common Stock held by the LD Topco Holders.

Nominee ” has the meaning set forth in Section  1(a) .

Observation Election ” has the meaning set forth in Section  1(k) .

Organizational Documents ” means the Company’s certificate of incorporation and bylaws, as in effect at the Effective Time, as the same may be amended from time to time.

Party ” has the meaning set forth in the preamble.

Person ” means any individual, firm, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, incorporated or unincorporated association, joint venture, joint stock company, governmental agency or instrumentality or other entity of any kind.

Shareholder ” means any holder of Common Stock that is or becomes a party to this Agreement from time to time in accordance with the provisions hereof.

Termination Event ” has the meaning set forth in Section  17 .

Transfer ” means any sale, transfer, assignment or other disposition of (whether with or without consideration and whether voluntary or involuntary or by operation of Law) of Common Stock. “ Transferable ” and “ Transferee ” shall each have a correlative meaning.

Section 4.     Assignment; Benefit of Parties . This Agreement shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors, legal representatives and assignees for the uses and purposes set forth and referred to herein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company may not assign any of its rights or obligations hereunder without the prior written consent of the LD Topco Holders holding a majority of the LD Topco Shares. Nothing herein contained shall confer or is intended to confer on any third party or entity that is not a party to this Agreement any rights under this Agreement.

Section 5.     Remedies . The Parties shall be entitled to enforce their rights under this Agreement specifically, to recover damages by reason of any breach of any provision of this Agreement and to exercise all other rights existing in their favor. The Parties agree and acknowledge that a breach of this Agreement would cause irreparable harm and money damages would not be an adequate remedy for any such breach and that, in addition to other rights and remedies hereunder, the Parties shall be entitled to specific performance and/or injunctive or other equitable relief (without posting a bond or other security) from any court of Law or equity of competent jurisdiction in order to enforce or prevent any violation of the provisions of this Agreement.

 

6


Section 6.     Notices . All notices and other communications among the Parties shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered in person, (ii) when delivered after posting in the United States mail having been sent registered or certified mail return receipt requested, postage prepaid, (iii) when delivered by FedEx or other nationally recognized overnight delivery service or (iv) when e-mailed during normal business hours (and otherwise as of the immediately following Business Day), addressed as follows:

 

  (a)    If

to the Company:

Pivotal Acquisition Corp.

c/o Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: Jonathan J. Ledecky

E-mail: jledecky@hockeyny.com

With a copy to:

Graubard Miller

The Chrysler Building

405 Lexington Avenue, 11 th Floor

New York, New York 10174

Attention: David Alan Miller / Jeffrey M. Gallant

E-mail: dmiller@graubard.com / jgallant@graubard.com

(b)    If to an LD Topco Holder, in accordance with such LD Topco Holder’s signature page hereto, with copies (which shall not constitute notice), to:

Latham & Watkins LLP

555 Eleventh Street, N.W.

Washington, DC 20004

Attention: Paul Sheridan

Email: paul.sheridan@lw.com

Section 7.     Adjustments . If, and as often as, there are any changes in the Common Stock by way of stock split, stock dividend, combination or reclassification, or through merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization or sale, or by any other means, appropriate adjustment shall be made in the provisions of this Agreement, as may be required, so that the rights, privileges, duties and obligations hereunder shall continue with respect to the Common Stock as so changed.

Section 8.     No Strict Construction . The language used in this Agreement shall be deemed to be the language chosen by the Parties to express their mutual intent, and no rule of strict construction shall be applied against any Party.

 

7


Section 9.     No Third-Party Beneficiaries . Nothing in this Agreement, express or implied, is intended or shall be construed to confer upon, or give to, any person or entity other than the Parties and their respective successors and assigns any remedy or claim under or by reason of this Agreement or any terms, covenants or conditions hereof, and all of the terms, covenants, conditions, promises and agreements contained in this Agreement shall be for the sole and exclusive benefit of the Parties and their respective successors and assigns.

Section 10.     Further Assurances . Each of the Parties hereby agrees that it will hereafter execute and deliver any further document, agreement, instruments of assignment, transfer or conveyance as may be necessary or desirable to effectuate the purposes hereof.

Section 11.     Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, and may be delivered by means of facsimile or electronic transmission in portable document format, each of which shall be deemed to be an original and shall be binding upon the Party who executed the same, but all of such counterparts shall constitute the same agreement.

Section 12.     Governing Law . This Agreement, and all claims or causes of action based upon, arising out of, or related to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby, shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the Laws of the State of Delaware, without giving effect to principles or rules of conflict of Laws to the extent such principles or rules would require or permit the application of Laws of another jurisdiction.

Section 13.     Jurisdiction; WAIVER OF TRIAL BY JURY . Any action based upon, arising out of or related to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby may be brought in federal and state courts located in the State of Delaware, and each of the Parties irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of each such court in any such action, waives any objection it may now or hereafter have to personal jurisdiction, venue or to convenience of forum, agrees that all claims in respect of the action shall be heard and determined only in any such court, and agrees not to bring any action arising out of or relating to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby in any other court. Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to affect the right of any Party to serve process in any manner permitted by Law or to commence legal proceedings or otherwise proceed against any other Party in any other jurisdiction, in each case, to enforce judgments obtained in any action brought pursuant to this Section  13 . EACH OF THE PARTIES HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION BASED UPON, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATED TO THIS AGREEMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

Section 14.     Entire Agreement . This Agreement, together with the Merger Agreement, the agreements referenced herein and the other agreements entered into in connection with the consummation of the Transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement, constitute the entire agreement among the Parties relating to the transactions contemplated hereby and supersede any other agreements, whether written or oral, that may have been made or entered into by or among any of the Parties or any of their respective subsidiaries relating to the transactions contemplated hereby.

Section 15.     Severability . If any provision of this Agreement is held invalid or unenforceable by any court of competent jurisdiction, the other provisions of this Agreement

 

8


shall remain in full force and effect. The Parties further agree that if any provision contained herein is, to any extent, held invalid or unenforceable in any respect under the Laws governing this Agreement, the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall be reformed, construed and enforced to the fullest extent permitted by Law and to the extent necessary to give effect to the intent of the Parties.

Section 16.     Amendment and Waiver . Except as otherwise provided herein, no modification, amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be effective against the Parties unless such modification is approved in writing by the Parties. The failure of any Party to enforce any of the provisions of this Agreement shall in no way be construed as a waiver of such provisions and shall not affect the right of such Party thereafter to enforce each and every provision of this Agreement in accordance with its terms.

Section 17.     Termination . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, if the LD Topco Holders (together with their Affiliates and permitted assignees) cease to Beneficially Own a number of shares of Common Stock equal to or greater than 5% of the total number of shares of Common Stock issued and outstanding (on a non-fully diluted basis) (“ Termination Event ”), then this Agreement shall expire and terminate automatically; provided, however, that Section  1(g) , (i) , (j) and (k) , Sections 5 through 6 , Sections 7 through 11 , Sections 12 through 18 , this Section  17 and Section  18 shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

Section 18.     Enforcement . Each of the Parties covenant and agree that the disinterested Directors of the Board have the right to enforce, waive or take any other action with respect to this Agreement on behalf of the Company.

[THE REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY BLANK]

 

9


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement as of the Effective Time.

 

Company:

PIVOTAL ACQUISITION CORP.
By:                                                                           
Name:
Title:

 

[Signature page to Stockholders’ Agreement]


LD Topco Holder:

CEOF II DE I AIV, L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P., its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C., its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director
CEOF II Coinvestment (DE), L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P.; its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C.; its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director
CEOF II Coinvestment B (DE), L.P.
By: CEOF II DE AIV GP, L.P.; its general partner
By: CEOF II DE GP AIV, L.L.C.; its general partner
By:  

 

Name:   William Darman
Title:   Managing Director

Address for notice purposes:

                                                                 

                                                                 

                                                                 

Attention:                                                 

Telephone:                                               

Facsimile:                                                 

E-mail:                                                     

 

[Signature page to Stockholders’ Agreement]


REVOLUTION GROWTH III, LP

By: Revolution Grown GP III, L.P, its general partner
By: Revolution Growth UGP III, LLC, its general partner
By:  

 

Name:

Title:

Address for notice purposes:

                                                                 

                                                                 

                                                                 

Attention:                                                 

Telephone:                                               

Facsimile:                                                 

E-mail:                                                     

 

[Signature page to Stockholders’ Agreement]

Exhibit 10.9

Execution Version

Employment Agreement

This Employment Agreement (the “ Agreement ”), dated as of September 30, 2011, is made by and between LDiscovery, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ Company ”), and Christopher Weiler (the “ Employee ”) (collectively referred to herein as the “ Parties ”).

RECITALS

 

A.

It is the desire of the Company to assure itself of the services of the Employee to the Company beginning upon the Effective Date by entering into this Agreement.

 

B.

Employee and the Company mutually desire that Employee provide services to the Company on the terms herein provided.

AGREEMENT

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and of the respective covenants and agreements set forth below, the Parties hereto agree as follows:

 

1.

Employment .

(a)     General . The Company shall employ Employee pursuant to the terms of this Agreement effective on September 30, 2011 (the “ Effective Date ”) and Employee shall be employed by the Company from and after the Effective Date, for the period and in the position set forth in this Section 1 , and upon the other terms and conditions herein provided.

(b)     Employment Term . Employee and the Company agree that Employee’s employment pursuant to this Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date and end on September 30, 2015, unless earlier terminated in accordance with Section  3 ; provided that commencing on the 4th anniversary of the Effective Date, and on each succeeding anniversary thereafter, the Term (as defined below) shall automatically be extended for one (1) year unless either Party has given written notice of non-renewal to the other Party at least ninety (90) days prior to the then-scheduled expiration of the Term (as defined below). The period from the Effective Date through the termination of Employee’s employment pursuant to this Agreement, regardless of the time or reason for such termination, shall be referred to herein as the “ Term .”

(c)     Position and Duties . Employee shall serve as the Chief Executive Officer of the Company, with the responsibilities, duties and authority customarily associated with such position in a company the size and nature of the Company and such other responsibilities, duties and authority commensurate with such position, as may from time to time be assigned to Employee by the Board of Directors (the “ Board ”). Employee shall report to the Board or any committee of the Board. Employee shall devote substantially all of Employee’s working time and efforts to the business and affairs of the Company (which shall include service to its affiliates, if applicable) and shall perform the duties and responsibilities normally associated with such role. Employee agrees to observe and comply with the rules and policies of the Company as adopted by the Company from time to time. Notwithstanding anything set forth in this Agreement or otherwise, the Company acknowledges and agrees that, to the extent that performance of such activities does not interfere with the performance of his duties for the Company in any substantial manner, the Employee may continue to serve as a coach or other advisor (volunteer or otherwise) for local high school football teams in a manner consistent with the past practices of Employee with respect to such activities.


2.

Compensation and Related Matters .

(a)     Annual Base Salary . During the Term, Employee shall receive a base salary at a rate of $280,000.00 per annum (the “ Annual Base Salary ”), which shall be paid in accordance with the customary payroll practices of the Company. Such Annual Base Salary shall be reviewed from time to time by the Board or an authorized committee of the Board, and may be increased (but shall not be decreased), in the sole discretion of the Board or such authorized committee of the Board.

(b)     Bonus . During the Term, the Employee will be eligible to participate in an incentive program established by the Board. The bonus awards payable under the incentive program shall be based on continued employment with the Company through the end of the applicable bonus period and the achievement of performance goals to be determined by the Board or its designee for such period. The bonus, if any, will be paid within 2 1/2 months after the end of the applicable fiscal year.

(c)     Benefits . During the Term, Employee may participate in such employee benefit plans and programs as the Company may from time to time offer to provide to its senior executives, pursuant to the terms and eligibility requirements of those plans.

(d)     Vacation; Holidays . During the Term, Employee shall accrue paid vacation in accordance with the Company’s vacation policies applicable to senior executives of the Company, as they may be amended from time to time; provided, however, that, in no event shall Employee be entitled to fewer than four (4) weeks of paid vacation annually. At the end of each calendar year, any accrued but unused vacation time shall be forfeited. Any vacation shall be taken at the reasonable and mutual convenience of the Company and Employee. In addition, the Company offers employees time off for standard Company holidays.

(e)     Expenses . During the Term, the Company shall reimburse Employee for all reasonable travel and other business expenses incurred by Employee in the performance of Employee’s duties to the Company in accordance with the Company’s expense reimbursement policy.

(f)     Key Person Insurance . At any time during the Term, the Company shall have the right (but not the obligation) to insure the life of Employee for the Company’s sole benefit. The Company shall have the right to determine the amount of insurance and the type of policy. Employee shall reasonably cooperate with the Company in obtaining such insurance by submitting to physical examinations, by supplying all information reasonably required by any insurance carrier, and by executing all necessary documents reasonably required by any insurance carrier.

 

3.

Termination .

(a)     Reason for Termination . Notwithstanding the Term set forth in Section 1(b), Employee’s employment hereunder may be terminated by the Company or Employee, as applicable, without any breach of this Agreement for any reason or no reason, with or without cause.

(b)     Notice of Termination . Any termination of Employee’s employment by the Company or by Employee under this Section  3 (other than termination due to Employee’s death) shall be communicated by a written notice to the other party hereto, which shall indicate the specific basis for the termination and which if by the Company without Cause or the Employee without Good Reason shall specify a date of termination which, if submitted by Employee, shall be at least thirty (30) days following the date of such notice (such notice, a “ Notice of Termination ”); provided, however, that in the event that Employee delivers a Notice of Termination to the Company, the Company may, in its sole discretion, change the Date of Termination to any date that occurs following the date of Company’s receipt of such

 

2


Notice of Termination and is prior to the date specified in such Notice of Termination. A Notice of Termination submitted by the Company may provide for a Date of Termination on the date Employee receives the Notice of Termination, or any date thereafter elected by the Company in its sole discretion.

(c)     Company Obligations upon Termination . Upon termination of Employee’s employment, Employee (or Employee’s estate) shall be entitled to receive the sum of: (i) the portion of Employee’s Annual Base Salary earned through the Date of Termination, but not yet paid to Employee; (ii) any expenses incurred by Employee prior to the Date of Termination and owed to Employee pursuant to this Agreement; (iii) any amount accrued and arising from Employee’s participation in, or benefits accrued under any employee benefit plans, programs or arrangements, which amounts shall be payable in accordance with the terms and conditions of such employee benefit plans, programs or arrangements (collectively, the “Company Arrangements ”); (iv) payment for any accrued but unused vacation time for the current year as of the Date of Termination; and (v) any earned but unpaid bonus with respect to bonus periods ending prior to the Date of Termination (collectively. “ Accrued Benefits ”). Except as otherwise expressly required by law ( e.g ., COBRA) or as specifically provided herein, all of Employee’s rights to salary, severance, benefits, bonuses and other amounts hereunder (if any) shall cease upon the termination of Employee’s employment hereunder.

(d)     Severance . If Employee’s employment is terminated by the Company without Cause (other than due to death or Disability), due to Employee’s resignation for Good Reason, then, subject to Employee’s continued compliance with Sections 4 and 5, and Employee signing a release of current and future claims in the form attached as Exhibit A to this Agreement (the “ Release ”) with such Release not being revoked as allowed by law, such that the Release becomes fully effective and irrevocable within 30 days after Employee’s termination of employment, Employee shall receive, in addition to the Accrued Benefits, an amount in cash equal to (i) 100% of the Annual Base Salary of Employee as of the Date of Termination, in the form of salary continuation and payable in regular installments over the one year period beginning within 30 days after Employee’s termination of employment in accordance with the Company’s regular payroll policies, plus (ii) twelve times the Company’s monthly contributions to Employee’s health insurance, dental insurance and other employee benefit plans, in regular installments over the one year period beginning within 30 days after Employee’s termination of employment, in each case subject to all applicable withholding. If the foregoing severance is deferred compensation subject to Section 409A and if the period of time that the Employee may consider and revoke the Release spans two calendar years, then the severance payments described herein will begin in the second calendar year regardless of when the Employee returns the signed Release to the Company.

(e)     Deemed Resignation . Upon termination of Employee’s employment for any reason, Employee shall be deemed to have resigned from all offices and directorships, if any, then held with the Company or any of its affiliates, other than Employee’s position as a member of the Board of Managers of the Company, to the extent Employee retains the right to such a position in accordance with the Operating Agreement of the Company.

(f)     Survival . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the provisions of Sections 3 through 8 and 10 will survive the termination of Employee’s employment and the expiration or termination of the Term

4.     Competition . Employee acknowledges that the Company will provide Employee with Confidential Information (as defined below), including confidential information of third parties such as customers, suppliers, and business affiliates; specialized training and knowledge regarding the Company’s methodologies and business strategies; and/or support in the development of goodwill such as introductions and customer relationship information. Ancillary to the rights provided to Employee as set forth in this Agreement, the Company’s provision of Confidential Information, specialized training,

 

3


and/or goodwill support to Employee, and Employee’s agreements regarding the use of same, in order to protect the value of any training, goodwill support and/or the Confidential Information described above and in consideration for good and valuable consideration received by Employee in connection with the transactions contemplated by the Contribution Agreement, the Company and Employee agree to the following provisions against unfair competition, which Employee acknowledges represent a fair balance of the Company’s rights to protect its business and Employee’s right to pursue employment:

(a)    Employee shall not, at any time during the Restriction Period, directly or indirectly engage in, have any equity interest in, interview for a potential employment or consulting relationship with or manage or operate any person, firm, corporation, partnership or business (whether as director, officer, employee, agent, representative, partner, security holder, consultant or otherwise) that engages in any business which competes with any portion of the Business (as defined below) of the Company in the United States. Nothing herein shall prohibit Employee from (i) being a passive owner of not more than 5% of the outstanding equity interest in any entity that is publicly traded, so long as Employee has no active participation in the business of such entity or (ii) providing services to any entity where such services are not substantially similar to and otherwise competitive with those previously provided by the Employee to the Company.

(b)    Employee shall not, at any time during the Restriction Period, directly or indirectly, otherwise solicit or induce any customer, subscriber or supplier of the Company (i) to terminate its existing arrangements with the Company, or (ii) to otherwise change its relationship with the Company. Employee shall not, at any time during the Restriction Period, directly or indirectly, either for Employee or for any other person or entity, hire, or recruit or attempt to hire, or engage or attempt to engage as an independent contractor, employee or consultant, any person who was employed or otherwise engaged by the Company at any time during the one (1) year period prior to the any Termination Date.

(c)    In the event the terms of this Section  4 shall be determined by any court of competent jurisdiction to be unenforceable by reason of its extending for too great a period of time or over too great a geographical area or by reason of its being too extensive in any other respect, it will be interpreted to extend only over the maximum period of time for which it may be enforceable, over the maximum geographical area as to which it may be enforceable, or to the maximum extent in all other respects as to which it may be enforceable, all as determined by such court in such action.

(d)    As used in this Section 4 , (i) the term “ Company ” shall include the Company and its direct and indirect subsidiaries, (ii) the term “ Business ” shall mean the business of the Company, as such business may be expanded or altered by the Company during the Term; and (iii) the term “Restriction Period” shall mean the period beginning on the Effective Date and ending on the date one (1) year following the Date of Termination.

(e)    Employee and the Company agree, during the Term and following the Date of Termination, to refrain from disparaging the Employee on the one hand and the Company and its affiliates on the other hand, including any of the Company’s services, technologies or practices, or any of its directors, officers, agents, representatives or stockholders, either orally or in writing. Nothing in this paragraph shall preclude Employee or the Company from making truthful statements, including but not limited to statements made in writing, that are reasonably necessary to comply with applicable law, regulation or legal process or to enforce the terms of this Agreement or any other agreement between the parties.

(f)    Employee represents that Employee’s employment by the Company does not and will not breach any agreement with any former employer, including any non-compete agreement or any agreement to keep in confidence or refrain from using information acquired by Employee prior to Employee’s

 

4


employment by the Company. During Employee’s employment by the Company, Employee agrees that Employee will not violate any non-solicitation agreements Employee entered into with any former employer or improperly make use of, or disclose, any information or trade secrets of any former employer or other third party, nor will Employee bring onto the premises of the Company or use any unpublished documents or any property belonging to any former employer or other third party, in violation of any lawful agreements with that former employer or third party.

 

5.

Nondisclosure of Proprietary Information .

(a)    Except in connection with the faithful performance of Employee’s duties hereunder or pursuant to Section 5(c) and (e) , Employee shall, in perpetuity, maintain in confidence and shall not directly, indirectly or otherwise, use, disseminate, disclose or publish, or use for Employee’s benefit or the benefit of any person, firm, corporation or other entity any confidential or proprietary information or trade secrets of or relating to the Company (including, without limitation, business plans, business strategies and methods, acquisition targets, intellectual property in the form of patents, trademarks and copyrights and applications therefor, ideas, inventions, works, discoveries, improvements, information, documents, formulae, practices, processes, methods, developments, source code, modifications, technology, techniques, data, programs, other know-how or materials, owned, developed or possessed by the Company, whether in tangible or intangible form, information with respect to the Company’s operations, processes, products, inventions, business practices, finances, principals, vendors, suppliers, customers, potential customers, marketing methods, costs, prices, contractual relationships, regulatory status, prospects and compensation paid to employees or other terms of employment) (collectively, the “ Confidential Information ”), or deliver to any person, firm, corporation or other entity any document, record, notebook, computer program or similar repository of or containing any such Confidential Information. The Parties hereby stipulate and agree that, as between them, any item of Confidential Information is important, material and confidential and affects the successful conduct of the businesses of the Company (and any successor or assignee of the Company). Notwithstanding the foregoing, Confidential Information shall not include any information that has been published in a form generally available to the public prior to the date Employee proposes to disclose or use such information, provided, that such publishing of the Confidential Information shall not have resulted from Employee directly or indirectly breaching Employee’s obligations under this Section 5(a) or any other similar provision by which Employee is bound, or from any third-party breaching a provision similar to that found under this Section  5(a) . For the purposes of the previous sentence, Confidential Information will not be deemed to have been published or otherwise disclosed merely because individual portions of the information have been separately published, but only if all material features comprising such information have been published in combination.

(b)    Upon termination of Employee’s employment with the Company for any reason, Employee will promptly deliver to the Company all correspondence, drawings, manuals, letters, notes, notebooks, reports, programs, plans, proposals, financial documents, or any other documents or property concerning the Company’s customers, business plans, marketing strategies, products, property or processes.

(c)    Employee may respond to a lawful and valid subpoena or other legal process but shall give the Company the earliest possible notice thereof, shall, as much in advance of the return date as possible, make available to the Company and its counsel the documents and other information sought and shall assist such counsel at Company’s expense in resisting or otherwise responding to such process.

(d)    As used in this Section  5 and Section 6 , the term “ Company ” shall include the Company and its direct and indirect parents and subsidiaries.

 

5


(e)    Nothing in this Agreement shall prohibit Employee from (i) disclosing information and documents when required by law, subpoena or court order (subject to the requirements of Section 5(c) above), (ii) disclosing information and documents to Employee’s attorney or tax adviser for the purpose of securing legal or tax advice, (iii) disclosing Employee’s post-employment restrictions in this Agreement in confidence to any potential new employer, or (iv) retaining, at any time, Employee’s personal correspondence, Employee’s personal contacts and documents related to Employee’s own personal benefits, entitlements and obligations.

 

6.

Inventions ,

All rights to discoveries, inventions, improvements, works of authorship, software, and innovations (including all data and records pertaining thereto), in any form or medium whatsoever, related to the business of the Company, whether or not patentable, copyrightable, registrable as a trademark, or reduced to writing, that Employee may discover, invent, conceive, author or originate during the Term, or may have discovered, invented, conceived, authored, or originated prior to the Effective Date since the first date of his employment with the Company or any of its affiliates or predecessors, either alone or with others and whether or not during working hours or by the use of the facilities of the Company, and any patents, copyrights, trademark rights, trade secrets rights and other intellectual property rights therein (collectively, “ Inventions ”), shall be the exclusive property of the Company. Employee shall promptly disclose all Inventions to the Company, and hereby assigns and agrees to assign all such Inventions to the Company. Employee shall execute at the request of the Company any assignments or other documents the Company may deem reasonably necessary to protect or perfect its rights therein, and shall assist the Company, upon reasonable request and at the Company’s expense, in obtaining, defending and enforcing the Company’s rights therein. Employee hereby appoints the Company as Employee’s attorney-in-fact to execute on Employee’s behalf any assignments or other documents reasonably deemed necessary by the Company to protect or perfect its rights to any Inventions.

 

7.

Injunctive Relief .

It is recognized and acknowledged by Employee that a breach of the covenants contained in Sections 4, 5 and 6 will cause irreparable damage to Company and its goodwill, the exact amount of which will be difficult or impossible to ascertain, and that the remedies at law for any such breach will be inadequate. Accordingly, Employee agrees that in the event of a breach of any of the covenants contained in Sections 4, 5 and 6 , in addition to any other remedy which may be available at law or in equity, the Company will be entitled to specific performance and injunctive relief without the need to post bond.

 

8.

Assignment and Successors .

The Company may assign its rights and obligations under this Agreement to any successor to all or substantially all of the business or the assets of the Company (by merger or otherwise), and may assign or encumber this Agreement and its rights hereunder as security for indebtedness of the Company and its affiliates. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Company, Employee and their respective successors, assigns, personnel and legal representatives, executors, administrators, heirs, distributees, devisees, and legatees, as applicable. None of Employee’s rights or obligations may be assigned or transferred by Employee, other than Employee’s rights to payments hereunder, which may be transferred only by will or operation of law. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Employee shall be entitled, to the extent permitted under applicable law and applicable Company Arrangements, to select and change a beneficiary or beneficiaries to receive compensation hereunder following Employee’s death by giving written notice thereof to the Company.

 

6


9.

Certain Definitions .

(a)     Cause . “Cause” shall mean:

(i) Employee’s continued failure to (A) substantially perform any of his material duties with the Company (other than any such failure resulting from his incapacity due to physical or mental impairment) or (B) comply with, in any material respect, any of the Company’s policies with respect to employee conduct, after receiving written notice from the Board specifically identifying Employee’s failure and being given thirty (30) days to cure such failure, if curable;

(ii) the Board’s reasonable determination that Employee failed in any material respect to carry out or comply with any lawful and reasonable directive of the Board, after receiving written notice from the Board specifically identifying Employee’s failure and being given thirty (30) days to cure such failure, if curable;

(iii) Employee’s breach of a material provision of this Agreement, after receiving written notice from the Board specifically identifying Employee’s breach and being given thirty (30) days to cure such breach, if curable;

(iv) Employee’s conviction, plea of no contest, plea of nolo contendere, or imposition of unadjudicated probation for any felony or crime involving moral turpitude;

(v) Employee’s unlawful use (including being under the influence) or possession of illegal drugs on the Company’s (or any of its affiliate’s) premises or while performing Employee’s duties and responsibilities under this Agreement; or

(vi) Employee’s commission of an act of fraud, embezzlement or misappropriation against the Company or any of its affiliates.

(b)     Date of Termination . “ Date of Termination ” shall mean (i) if Employee’s employment is terminated by Employee’s death, the date of Employee’s death, (ii) if Employee’s employment terminates because of non-renewal pursuant to Section 1(b) , the last day of the Employment Period, or (iii) if Employee’s employment is terminated for any other reason the date indicated in the Notice of Termination or the date specified by the Company pursuant to Section 3(b), whichever is earlier.

(c)     Disability . “Disability” shall mean Employee’s inability to perform, with or without reasonable accommodation, the essential functions of Employee’s position hereunder for a total of three months during any six-month period as a result of incapacity due to mental or physical illness as determined by a physician selected by the Company or its insurers. Any unreasonable refusal by Employee to submit to a medical examination for the purpose of determining Disability shall be deemed to constitute conclusive evidence of Employee’s Disability.

(d)     Good Reason . For the sole purpose of determining Employee’s right to severance payments as described above, the Employee’s resignation will be for “Good Reason” if the Employee resigns within ninety days after either (i) a decrease in Employee’s annual base salary without Employee’s written consent or (ii) a material and adverse reduction in the Employee’s position, authority, duties or responsibilities (other than in connection with a corporate transaction where the Employee continues to hold the position referenced in Section 1(c) above with respect to the Company’s business, substantially as such business exists prior to the date of consummation of such corporate transaction, but does not hold such position with respect to the successor entity to such transaction; provided , that the Employee has given Company detailed written notice of the change or event constituting “Good Reason” and the Company has failed to remedy such change or event within thirty (30) days after receiving such notice.

 

7


10.

Miscellaneous Provisions .

(a)     Governing Law . This Agreement shall be governed, construed, interpreted and enforced in accordance with its express terms, and otherwise in accordance with the substantive laws of the Commonwealth of Virginia without reference to the principles of conflicts of law of the Commonwealth of Virginia or any other jurisdiction, and where applicable, the laws of the United States.

(b)     Validity . The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision or provisions of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement, which shall remain in full force and effect.

(c)     Notices . Any notice, request, claim, demand, document and other communication hereunder to any Party shall be effective upon receipt (or refusal of receipt) and shall be in writing and delivered personally or sent by facsimile or certified or registered mail, postage prepaid, as follows:

(i)    If to the Company:

LDiscovery, LLC

8201 Greensboro Drive

Suite 717

McLean, VA 22102-3810

Attention: Richard Williams

Facsimile: 617-261-2060

(ii)    If to Employee, at the last address that the Company has in its personnel records for Employee.

or at any other address as any Party shall have specified by notice in writing to the other Party.

(d)     Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in several counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which together will constitute one and the same Agreement. Signatures delivered by facsimile shall be deemed effective for all purposes.

(e)     Entire Agreement . The terms of this Agreement are intended by the Parties to be the final expression of their agreement with respect to the employment of Employee by the Company and supersede all prior understandings and agreements, whether written or oral. The Parties further intend that this Agreement shall constitute the complete and exclusive statement of their terms and that no extrinsic evidence whatsoever may be introduced in any judicial, administrative, or other legal proceeding to vary the terms of this Agreement.

(f)     Amendments: Waivers . This Agreement may not be modified, amended, or terminated except by an instrument in writing, signed by Employee and a duly authorized officer of Company. By an instrument in writing similarly executed, Employee or a duly authorized officer of the Company may waive compliance by the other Party with any specifically identified provision of this Agreement that such other Party was or is obligated to comply with or perform; provided, however, that such waiver shall not operate as a waiver of, or estoppel with respect to, any other or subsequent failure. No failure to exercise and no delay in exercising any right, remedy, or power hereunder preclude any other or further exercise of any other right, remedy, or power provided herein or by law or in equity.

 

8


(g)     No Inconsistent Actions . The Parties hereto shall not voluntarily undertake or fail to undertake any action or course of action inconsistent with the provisions or essential intent of this Agreement. Furthermore, it is the intent of the Parties hereto to act in a fair and reasonable manner with respect to the interpretation and application of the provisions of this Agreement.

(h)     Construction . This Agreement shall be deemed drafted equally by both the Parties. Its language shall be construed as a whole and according to its fair meaning. Any presumption or principle that the language is to be construed against any Party shall not apply. The headings in this Agreement are only for convenience and are not intended to affect construction or interpretation. Any references to paragraphs, subparagraphs, sections or subsections are to those parts of this Agreement, unless the context clearly indicates to the contrary. Also, unless the context clearly indicates to the contrary, (a) the plural includes the singular and the singular includes the plural; (b) “and” and “or” are each used both conjunctively and disjunctively; (c) “any,” “all,” “each,” or “every” means “any and all,” and “each and every”; (d) “includes” and “including” are each “without limitation”; (e) “herein,” “hereof,” “hereunder” and other similar compounds of the word “here” refer to the entire Agreement and not to any particular paragraph, subparagraph, section or subsection; and (f) all pronouns and any variations thereof shall be deemed to refer to the masculine, feminine, neuter, singular or plural as the identity of the entities or persons referred to may require.

(i)     Arbitration . Any controversy, claim or dispute arising out of or relating to this Agreement, shall be settled solely and exclusively by a binding arbitration process administered by the American Arbitration Association (“ AAA ’) in the city of Washington, D.C. Such arbitration shall be conducted in accordance with the then-existing rules, with the following exceptions if in conflict: (a) one arbitrator shall be chosen by AAA and such arbitrator shall be a retired judge if a retired judge is reasonably available; (b) each Party to the arbitration will pay its pro rata share of the expenses and fees of the arbitrator, together with other expenses of the arbitration incurred or approved by the arbitrator; and (c) arbitration may proceed in. the absence of any Party if written notice (pursuant to AAA rules and regulations) of the proceedings has been given to such Party. Each Party shall bear its own attorneys fees and expenses. The Parties agree to abide by all decisions and awards rendered in such proceedings. Such decisions and awards rendered by the arbitrator shall be final and conclusive. All such controversies, claims or disputes shall be settled in this manner in lieu of any action at law or equity; provided, however, that nothing in this subsection shall be construed as precluding the bringing an action for injunctive relief or specific performance as provided in this Agreement. This dispute resolution process and any arbitration hereunder shall be confidential and neither any Party nor the neutral arbitrator shall disclose the existence, contents or results of such process without the prior written consent of all Parties. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Employee and the Company each have the right to resolve any issue or dispute over intellectual property rights by Court action instead of arbitration.

(j)     Enforcement . If any provision of this Agreement is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable under present or future laws effective during the term of this Agreement, such provision shall be fully severable; this Agreement shall be construed and enforced as if such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision had never comprised a portion of this Agreement; and the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect and shall not be affected by the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision or by its severance from this Agreement. Furthermore, in lieu of such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision there shall be added automatically as part of this Agreement a provision as similar in terms to such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision as may be possible and be legal, valid and enforceable.

(k)     Withholding . The Company shall be entitled to withhold from any amounts payable under this Agreement any federal, state, local or foreign withholding or other taxes or charges which the Company is required to withhold. The Company shall be entitled to rely on an opinion of counsel if any questions as to the amount or requirement of withholding shall arise.

 

9


(l)     Section 409A .

(i)     General. The intent of the Parties is that the payments and benefits under this Agreement comply with or be exempt from Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations and guidance promulgated thereunder (collectively, “ Section 409A ”) and, accordingly, to the maximum extent permitted, this Agreement shall be interpreted to be in compliance therewith.

(ii)     Separation from Service. Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, any compensation or benefits payable under this Agreement that is designated under this Agreement as payable upon Employee’s termination of employment shall be payable only upon Employee’s “separation from service” with the Company within the meaning of Section 409A (a “ Separation from Service ”).

(iii)     Specified Employee. Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, if Employee is deemed by the Company at the time of Employee’s Separation from Service to be a “specified employee” for purposes of Section 409A, to the extent delayed commencement of any portion of the benefits to which Employee is entitled under this Agreement is required in order to avoid a prohibited distribution under Section 409A, such portion of Employee’s benefits shall not be provided to Employee prior to the earlier of (i) the expiration of the six-month period measured from the date of Employee’s Separation from Service with the Company or (ii) the date of Employee’s death. Upon the first business day following the expiration of the applicable Section 409A period, all payments deferred pursuant to the preceding sentence shall be paid in a lump sum to Employee (or Employee’s estate or beneficiaries), and any remaining payments due to Employee under this Agreement shall be paid as otherwise provided herein.

(iv)     Expense Reimbursements. To the extent that any reimbursements under this Agreement are subject to Section 409A, any such reimbursements payable to Employee shall be paid to Employee no later than December 31 of the year following the year in which the expense was incurred; provided, that Employee submits Employee’s reimbursement request promptly following the date the expense is incurred, the amount of expenses reimbursed in one year shall not affect the amount eligible for reimbursement in any subsequent year, other than medical expenses referred to in Section 105(b) of the Code, and Employee’s right to reimbursement under this Agreement will not be subject to liquidation or exchange for another benefit.

(v)     Installments. Employee’s right to receive any installment payments under this Agreement, including without limitation any continuation salary payments that are payable on Company payroll dates, shall be treated as a right to receive a series of separate payments and, accordingly, each such installment payment shall at all times be considered a separate and distinct payment as permitted under Section 409A. Except as otherwise permitted under Section 409A, and subject to Employee’s consent, no payment hereunder shall be accelerated or deferred unless such acceleration or deferral would not result in additional tax or interest pursuant to Section 409A.

 

10


11.

Employee Acknowledgement .

Employee acknowledges that Employee has read and understands this Agreement, is fully aware of its legal effect, has not acted in reliance upon any representations or promises made by the Company other than those contained in writing herein, and has entered into this Agreement freely based on Employee’s own judgment.

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

11


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement on the date and year first above written.

 

COMPANY

By:

 

/s/ Richard J. Williams

  Name:    Richard J. Williams
  Title:      Vice President
EMPLOYEE

By:

 

/s/ Christopher Weiler

  Name:    Christopher Weiler

[S IGNATURE P AGE TO E MPLOYMENT A GREEMENT ]


EXHIBIT A

Form of Release

This Agreement and Release (“Agreement”) is made by and among between LDiscovery, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ Company ”), and Christopher Weiler (the “ Employee ”) (collectively referred to herein as the “ Parties ” and each a “ Party ”). Capitalized terms used but not defined in this Agreement shall have the meanings set forth in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).

WHEREAS, the Parties have previously entered into that certain Employment Agreement, dated as of                , 2011 (the “Employment Agreement”); and

WHEREAS, in connection with Employee’s termination of employment with the Company or a subsidiary or affiliate of the Company effective                , 20    , the Parties wish to resolve any and all disputes, claims, complaints, grievances, charges, actions, petitions, and demands that Employee may have against the Company, and any of the Releasees as defined below, including, but not limited to, any and all claims arising out of or in any way related to Employee’s employment with or separation from the Company or its subsidiaries or affiliates.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the Severance Payments described in Section  3 of the Employment Agreement, which, pursuant to the Employment Agreement, are conditioned on Employee’s execution and non-revocation of this Agreement, and in consideration of the mutual promises made herein, the Company and Employee hereby agree as follows:

1. Severance Payments; Salary and Benefits . The Company agrees to provide Employee with the severance payments and benefits described in Section  3 of the Employment Agreement, payable at the times set forth in, and subject to the terms and conditions of, the Employment Agreement. In addition, to the extent not already paid, and subject to the terms and conditions of the Employment Agreement, the Company shall pay or provide to Employee all other payments or benefits described in Section  3 of the Employment Agreement, subject to and in accordance with the terms thereof.

2. Release of Claims . Employee agrees that the foregoing consideration represents settlement in full of all outstanding obligations owed to Employee by the Company, any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries and affiliates, and, in their capacities related to the foregoing, any of their current and former officers, directors, equity holders, managers, employees, agents, investors, attorneys, shareholders, administrators, affiliates, benefit plans, plan administrators, insurers, trustees, divisions, and subsidiaries and predecessor and successor corporations and assigns (collectively, the “Releasees”). Employee, on his own behalf and on behalf of any of Employee’s affiliated companies or entities and any of their respective heirs, family members, executors, agents, and assigns, hereby and forever releases the Releasees from, and agrees not to sue concerning, or in any manner to institute, prosecute, or pursue, any claim, complaint, charge, duty, obligation, or cause of action relating to any matters of any kind, whether presently known or unknown, suspected or unsuspected, that Employee may possess against any of the Releasees arising from any omissions, acts, facts, or damages that have occurred up until and including the Effective Date of this Agreement (as defined in Section  7 below), including, without limitation:

(a) any and all claims relating to or arising from Employee’s employment or service relationship with the Company or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries or affiliates and the termination of that relationship;

(b) any and all claims relating to, or arising from, Employee’s right to purchase, or actual purchase of any shares of stock or other equity interests of the Company or any of its affiliates, including, without limitation, any claims for fraud, misrepresentation, breach of fiduciary duty, breach of duty under applicable state law, and securities fraud under any state or federal law;


(c) any and all claims for wrongful discharge of employment; termination in violation of public policy; discrimination; harassment; retaliation; breach of contract, both express and implied; breach of covenant of good faith and fair dealing, both express and implied; promissory estoppel; negligent or intentional infliction of emotional distress; fraud; negligent or intentional misrepresentation; negligent or intentional interference with contract or prospective economic advantage; unfair business practices; defamation; libel; slander; negligence; personal injury; assault; battery; invasion of privacy; false imprisonment; conversion; and disability benefits;

(d) any and all claims for violation of any federal, state, or municipal statute, including, but not limited to, Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964; the Civil Rights Act of 1991; the Rehabilitation Act of 1973; the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990; the Equal Pay Act; the Fair Labor Standards Act; the Fair Credit Reporting Act; the Age Discrimination in Employment Act of 1967; the Older Workers Benefit Protection Act; the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974; the Worker Adjustment and Retraining Notification Act; the Family and Medical Leave Act; the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002; the New York City Human Rights Law;

(e) any and all claims for violation of the federal or any state constitution;

(f) any and all claims arising out of any other laws and regulation relating to employment or employment discrimination;

(g) any claim for any loss, cost, damage, or expense arising out of any dispute over the non-withholding or other tax treatment of any of the proceeds received by Employee as a result of this Agreement; and

(h) any and all claims for attorneys’ fees and costs.

Employee agrees that the release set forth in this section shall be and remain in effect in all respects as a complete general release as to the matters released. This release does not release claims that cannot be released as a matter of law, including, but not limited to, Employee’s right to file a charge with or participate in a charge by the Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, or any other local, state, or federal administrative body or government agency that is authorized to enforce or administer laws related to employment, against the Company (with the understanding that Employee’s release of claims herein bars Employee from recovering such monetary relief from the Company or any Releasee), claims for unemployment compensation or any state disability insurance benefits pursuant to the terms of applicable state law, claims to continued participation in certain of the Company’s group benefit plans pursuant to the terms and conditions of COBRA, claims to any benefit entitlements vested as the date of separation of Employee’s employment, rights with regard to any vested equity (including under any stockholders agreement governing such equity and any side letter relating thereto), any rights to indemnity and coverage under the Company’s directors and officers insurance policies, and Employee’s rights to severance pay and benefits pursuant to the Employment Agreement.

3. Acknowledgment of Waiver of Claims under ADEA . Employee understands and acknowledges that he is waiving and releasing any rights he may under the Age Discrimination in Employment Act of 1967 (“ADEA”), and that this waiver and release is knowing and voluntary. Employee understands and agrees that this waiver and release does not apply to any rights or claims that may arise under the ADEA after the Effective Date of this Agreement. Employee understands and acknowledges that the consideration given for this waiver and release is in addition to anything of value

 

14


to which Employee was already entitled. Employee further understands and acknowledges that he has been advised by this writing that: (a) he should consult with an attorney prior to executing this Agreement; (b) he has at least 21 days within which to consider this Agreement; (c) he has 7 days following his execution of this Agreement to revoke this Agreement; (d) this Agreement shall not be effective until after the revocation period has expired; and (e) nothing in this Agreement prevents or precludes Employee from challenging or seeking a determination in good faith of the validity of this waiver under the ADEA, nor does it impose any condition precedent, penalties, or costs for doing so, unless specifically authorized by federal law. In the event Employee signs this Agreement and returns it to the Company in less than the 21-day period identified above, Employee hereby acknowledges that he has freely and voluntarily chosen to waive the time period allotted for considering this Agreement.

4. Severability . In the event that any provision or any portion of any provision hereof or any surviving agreement made a part hereof becomes or is declared by a court of competent jurisdiction or arbitrator to be illegal, unenforceable, or void, this Agreement shall continue in full force and effect without said provision or portion of provision.

5. No Oral Modification . This Agreement may only be amended in a writing signed by Employee, a duly authorized officer of the Company and a duly authorized officer of Parent.

6. Governing Law; Dispute Resolution . This Agreement shall be subject to the provisions of Sections 10(a) and 10(i) of the Employment Agreement.

7. Effective Date . If Employee has attained or is over the age of 40 as the date of Employee’s termination of employment, then the Employee has seven days after he signs this Agreement to revoke it and this Agreement will become effective on the eighth day after Employee signed this Agreement, so long as it has been signed by the Parties and has not been revoked by the Employee before that date (the “Effective Date”).

8. Voluntary Execution of Agreement . Employee understands and agrees that he executed this Agreement voluntarily, without any duress or undue influence on the part or behalf of the Company, Parent or any third party, with the full intent of releasing all of his claims against the Company, Parent and any of the other Releasees. Employee acknowledges that: (a) he has read this Agreement; (b) he has not relied upon any representations or statements made by the Company or Parent that are not specifically set forth in this Agreement; (c) he has been represented in the preparation, negotiation, and execution of this Agreement by legal counsel of his own choice or has elected not to retain legal counsel; (d) he understands the terms and consequences of this Agreement and of the releases it contains; and (e) he is fully aware of the legal and binding effect of this Agreement.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement on the respective dates set forth below.

 

Dated:                                         COMPANY (or any successor thereto)
   By:                                                               
   Name:                                                          
   Title:                                                            

 

Dated:                                         EMPLOYEE
   By:                                                               
   Name:

 

15

Exhibit 10.10

 

LOGO

September 30, 2006

Krystina

Dear Krystina:

On behalf of LegisDiscovery, LLC. (LegisDiscovery), I am pleased to offer you the opportunity to become a member of Legis Discovery. We feel confident that your decision to join our company will prove to be a dynamic step forward in realizing your career goals. Please accept this letter as a formal offer of employment with LegisDiscovery. The following outlines the basic parameters of our mutually agreed upon terms and conditions.

You will join LegisDiscovery as Senior Account Executive, Mclean, Virginia office with your effective employment start date to be October 16, 2006. You will report to our Tyson’s Corner office. As Senior Account Executive, your compensation will be $4166.66 monthly draw versus commissions for one year. Your commissions will be paid on the 7 th and 22 th of the following month after the company receives payment from your clients. Your commission will be calculated using the attached commission table. The compensation committee will evaluate your compensation annually in December. The granting and amount of any raises and bonuses rests solely with the Company. In addition, should legal action be taken against you by your former company, Legis Discovery agrees to indemnify and provide and pay for your legal counsel as it relates to your non-compete covenants.

As an exempt employee, you will be paid semi-monthly, on the 7th and the 22nd of each month beginning the next pay period. You will be eligible to participate in our health benefits program the first day of the month following the completion of your 90 introductory period.

This offer of employment is contingent upon the satisfactory completion of a background check. If your position requires you to drive a motor vehicle as a part of your job duties, the offer is further conditioned upon a satisfactory motor vehicle records check and your providing us with a valid driver’s license. You will be required to sign an employment agreement and/or non-compete agreement and/or confidentiality agreement.

In addition, it is necessary for you to complete an I-9 Form the first day of employment which verifies your eligibility to work in the United States. On your start date, please bring the required documents, which may include, U.S. Passport, certificate of U.S., citizenship, naturalization certificate, resident alien card with photo identification, social security or birth certificate with photo identification. In conjunction with any laws of this state, your employment with us will be “at-will”. This means that either party, company or LegisDiscovery Team member, may terminate the employment relationship at any time for any reason—with or without notice, with or without cause.

Your agreement of these terms and conditions is required in writing prior to the start date of your employment with LegisDiscovery.

 

8201 Greensboro Drive    Suite 803    McLean, VA 22102    Tel:     703.288.3380    Fax:     703-288-3801    www.legisdiscovery.com


LOGO

Once again, we look forward to working with you. I believe that we will have a mutually rewarding relationship and you will be presented with tremendous professional challenges and career opportunities. Please signify below your acceptance of this offer of employment and return to me with your original signature.

If we can be of further assistance, please feel free to contact me with questions at 703-288-3380.

Sincerely,

/s/ Arne Christensen

Arne Christensen

Director of Sales

LegisDiscovery

Krystina Jones

I accept the terms and conditions of LegisDiscovery employment below.

 

Accepted:   

/s/ Krystina Jones

   Date:   

10/19/06

 

8201 Greensboro Drive    Suite 803    McLean, VA 22102    Tel:     703.288.3380    Fax:     703-288-3801    www.legisdiscovery.com

Exhibit 10.11

 

LOGO

8201 Greensboro Drive

Suite 717

McLean, VA 22102

Tel 703-288-3380

Fax 703-288-3801

August 25, 2017

Dawn M. Wilson

Dear Dawn:

On behalf of KrolLDiscovery, I am pleased to offer you the opportunity to become a team member. Please accept this letter as a formal offer of fulltime employment with KrolLDiscovery. The following outlines the basic parameters of our mutually agreed upon terms and conditions.

You will become a team member at KrolLDiscovery as Chief Financial Officer. You will report to Chris Weiler, CEO. You will report physically to our McLean, VA headquarters, and will also be expected to travel as projects may require.

DATE OF HIRE AND BACKGROUND INVESTIGATION

Your start date will be September 5, 2017. This offer of employment is contingent upon the satisfactory completion of a background check and verification of information stated in your application. If your position requires you to drive a motor vehicle as a part of your job duties, the offer is further conditioned upon a satisfactory motor vehicle records check and your providing us with a valid driver’s license.

In addition, it is necessary for you to complete an I-9 Form within three days of employment which verifies your eligibility to work in the United States. Please review the enclosed I-9 List of Acceptable Documents and bring the appropriate documents on your first day.

COMPENSATION

You will receive an annualized salary of $300,000.00 paid on a per-pay-period basis of $11,538.46, less appropriate tax and benefit withholdings and deductions. As an exempt employee, you will be paid biweekly, with pay periods ending on Sunday and paychecks issued or direct deposits released on Friday.

You will be eligible for a 50% annual bonus, paid at the Company’s discretion based on factors including, but not limited to, your individual Key Performance Objectives and company performance. The bonus plan is currently paid at 50% for your KPOs and 50% for company performance.

In addition, you will receive a Stock Option grant to purchase an amount equal to 0.5% of available Common Stock shares, 20,000 options, on a fully diluted basis. Your stock options which are time vested will vest upon any change of control.

SEVERANCE

You will receive 6 months of salary as severance if terminated without cause. And this severance will be paid on a monthly basis over the 6 month period after termination.


LOGO

BENEFITS

You will be eligible to participate in our employee benefit insurance plans on the first of the month following your date of hire, in accordance with company policy. Specific plan information is included with this offer letter and you will receive electronic enrollment upon your start. You will have 31 days from the date of hire to complete the enrollment process.

PAID TIME OFF (PTO)

You will be eligible to accrue PTO according to policy.

AT-WILL EMPLOYMENT

In conjunction with any laws of this state, your employment with us will be “at-will,” meaning that you or KrolLDiscovery may terminate your position at any time for any reason - with or without notice, with or without cause.

ACCEPTANCE OF OFFER AND AGREEMENTS

This offer is contingent upon you reviewing, freely agreeing to and signing the attachments to this letter, captioned, “Employee Proprietary Information and Inventions Assignment Agreement,” “Employment Policies and Release Form,” “Harassment-Free Workplace Policy,” “Application for Employment,” “Privacy Policy,” “Social Media Policy,” and “Employee Handbook.” Please review and sign all.

You warrant that you are not party to any non-competitive agreements or any confidentiality agreements which would restrict you from working with KrolLDiscovery. If you are party to any said agreements, you agree to indemnify KrolLDiscovery from any loss, damage or claims with respect thereto.

Your agreement of these terms and conditions is required in writing prior to the start date of your employment with KrolLDiscovery.

Once again, we look forward to your taking the offered position. I believe that we will have a mutually rewarding relationship and you will be presented with tremendous professional challenges and career opportunities. Please signify below your acceptance of this offer of employment and return to me with your original signature.

If we can be of further assistance, please feel free to contact me with questions at 703-288-3380.

 

Sincerely,

/s/ Christopher Weiler

Christopher Weiler

Chief Executive Officer

KrolLDiscovery

I accept the terms and conditions of KrolLDiscovery employment below.

 

Accepted:

     

Date:

  

/s/ Dawn M. Wilson

  

8. 29. 17

  

Dawn M. Wilson

  

Exhibit 10.12

Execution Version

 

 

 

FIRST LIEN CREDIT AGREEMENT

D ATED AS OF

D ECEMBER  9, 2016

AMONG

LD INTERMEDIATE HOLDINGS, INC.,

AND

LD LOWER HOLDINGS, INC.,

AS C O -B ORROWERS ,

LD TOPCO, INC.,

AS H OLDINGS ,

ROYAL BANK OF CANADA,

AS A DMINISTRATIVE A GENT , C OLLATERAL A GENT , S WING L INE L ENDER AND L/C I SSUER ,

T HE O THER L ENDERS P ARTY H ERETO ,

RBC CAPITAL MARKETS 1 ,

AND

TD SECURITIES (USA) LLC,

AS J OINT L EAD A RRANGERS AND J OINT B OOKRUNNERS

AND

TD SECURITIES (USA) LLC,

AS S YNDICATION A GENT

 

 

 

 

1  

RBC Capital Markets is a brand name for the capital markets businesses of Royal Bank of Canada and its affiliates.


T ABLE OF C ONTENTS

 

          Page  

ARTICLE I

  

DEFINITIONS AND ACCOUNTING TERMS

  

Section 1.01

   Defined Terms      1  

Section 1.02

   Other Interpretive Provisions      64  

Section 1.03

   Accounting Terms      66  

Section 1.04

   Rounding      67  

Section 1.05

   References to Agreements and Laws      67  

Section 1.06

   Timing of Payment or Performance      67  

Section 1.07

   Currency Equivalents Generally      67  

Section 1.08

   Letter of Credit Amounts      67  

Section 1.09

   Pro Forma Calculations      68  

Section 1.10

   Calculation of Baskets      69  

Section 1.11

   Treatment of Subsidiaries Prior to Joinder      69  

ARTICLE II

  

THE COMMITMENTS AND CREDIT EXTENSIONS

  

Section 2.01

   The Loans      69  

Section 2.02

   Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans      69  

Section 2.03

   Letters of Credit      71  

Section 2.04

   Swingline Loans      80  

Section 2.05

   Prepayments      82  

Section 2.06

   Termination or Reduction of Commitments      87  

Section 2.07

   Repayment of Loans      88  

Section 2.08

   Interest      89  

Section 2.09

   Fees      90  

Section 2.10

   Computation of Interest and Fees; Retroactive Adjustments of Applicable Rate      90  

Section 2.11

   Evidence of Indebtedness      91  

Section 2.12

   Payments Generally; Administrative Agent’s Clawback      91  

Section 2.13

   Sharing of Payments      93  

Section 2.14

   Incremental Facilities      94  

Section 2.15

   New Incremental Notes      98  

Section 2.16

   Cash Collateral      99  

Section 2.17

   Defaulting Lenders      100  

Section 2.18

   Specified Refinancing Debt      102  

ARTICLE III

  

TAXES, INCREASED COSTS PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

  

Section 3.01

   Taxes      104  

Section 3.02

   Illegality      108  

Section 3.03

   Inability to Determine Rates      108  

Section 3.04

   Increased Cost and Reduced Return; Capital Adequacy      109  

Section 3.05

   Funding Losses      110  

Section 3.06

   Matters Applicable to All Requests for Compensation      110  

Section 3.07

   Replacement of Lenders Under Certain Circumstances      111  

 

-i-


Section 3.08

   Currency Equivalents      113  

ARTICLE IV

  

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

  

Section 4.01

   Conditions to Credit Extensions on the Closing Date      113  

Section 4.02

   Conditions to All Credit Extensions      117  

ARTICLE V

  

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

  

Section 5.01

   Existence, Qualification and Power; Compliance with Laws      117  

Section 5.02

   Authorization; No Contravention      118  

Section 5.03

   Governmental Authorization      118  

Section 5.04

   Binding Effect      118  

Section 5.05

   Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect      119  

Section 5.06

   Litigation      119  

Section 5.07

   Use of Proceeds      119  

Section 5.08

   Ownership of Property; Liens      119  

Section 5.09

   Environmental Compliance      120  

Section 5.10

   Taxes      120  

Section 5.11

   Employee Benefits Plans      120  

Section 5.12

   Subsidiaries; Equity Interests      120  

Section 5.13

   Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act      121  

Section 5.14

   Disclosure      121  

Section 5.15

   Compliance with Laws      121  

Section 5.16

   Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc.      121  

Section 5.17

   Solvency      122  

Section 5.18

   Perfection, Etc.      122  

Section 5.19

   Anti-Terrorism Laws; OFAC; FCPA      122  

ARTICLE VI

  

AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

  

Section 6.01

   Financial Statements      123  

Section 6.02

   Certificates; Other Information      125  

Section 6.03

   Notices      127  

Section 6.04

   Payment of Taxes      127  

Section 6.05

   Preservation of Existence, Etc.      127  

Section 6.06

   Maintenance of Properties      127  

Section 6.07

   Maintenance of Insurance      128  

Section 6.08

   Compliance with Laws      128  

Section 6.09

   Books and Records      128  

Section 6.10

   Inspection Rights      129  

Section 6.11

   Use of Proceeds      129  

Section 6.12

   Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security      129  

Section 6.13

   Compliance with Environmental Laws      131  

Section 6.14

   Further Assurances      131  

Section 6.15

   Maintenance of Ratings      131  

Section 6.16

   Post-Closing Undertakings      131  

 

-ii-


ARTICLE VII

  

NEGATIVE COVENANTS

  

Section 7.01

   Liens      133  

Section 7.02

   Investments      137  

Section 7.03

   Indebtedness      141  

Section 7.04

   Fundamental Changes      145  

Section 7.05

   Dispositions      147  

Section 7.06

   Restricted Payments      150  

Section 7.07

   Change in Nature of Business      154  

Section 7.08

   Transactions with Affiliates      154  

Section 7.09

   Burdensome Agreements      156  

Section 7.10

   Financial Covenant      158  

Section 7.11

   Accounting Changes      159  

Section 7.12

   Prepayments, Etc. of Indebtedness; Amendments      159  

Section 7.13

   Holding Company      160  

ARTICLE VIII

  

EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

  

Section 8.01

   Events of Default      160  

Section 8.02

   Remedies upon Event of Default      163  

Section 8.03

   Right to Cure      164  

Section 8.04

   Application of Funds      165  

ARTICLE IX

  

ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT AND OTHER AGENTS

  

Section 9.01

   Appointment and Authorization of Agents      167  

Section 9.02

   Delegation of Duties      168  

Section 9.03

   Liability of Agents      168  

Section 9.04

   Reliance by Agents      169  

Section 9.05

   Notice of Default      169  

Section 9.06

   Credit Decision; Disclosure of Information by Agents      170  

Section 9.07

   Indemnification of Agents      170  

Section 9.08

   Agents in Their Individual Capacities      171  

Section 9.09

   Successor Agents      171  

Section 9.10

   Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim      172  

Section 9.11

   Collateral and Guaranty Matters      173  

Section 9.12

   Certain Rights of the Administrative Agent      174  

Section 9.13

   Holders      174  

Section 9.14

   Other Agents; Arranger and Managers      174  

Section 9.15

   Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements      175  

Section 9.16

   Appointment of Supplemental Agents      175  

Section 9.17

   Intercreditor Agreement      176  

Section 9.18

   Withholding Tax      176  

Section 9.19

   Appointment of Incremental Arrangers and Specified Refinancing Agents      177  

 

-iii-


ARTICLE X

  

MISCELLANEOUS

  

Section 10.01

   Amendments, Etc.      177  

Section 10.02

   Notices; Electronic Communications      181  

Section 10.03

   No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies; Enforcement      183  

Section 10.04

   Expenses and Taxes      184  

Section 10.05

   Indemnification by the Borrower      185  

Section 10.06

   Payments Set Aside      186  

Section 10.07

   Successors and Assigns      186  

Section 10.08

   Confidentiality      193  

Section 10.09

   Setoff      194  

Section 10.10

   Interest Rate Limitation      195  

Section 10.11

   Counterparts      195  

Section 10.12

   Integration; Effectiveness      195  

Section 10.13

   Survival of Representations and Warranties      196  

Section 10.14

   Severability      196  

Section 10.15

   Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Etc.      196  

Section 10.16

   SERVICE OF PROCESS      197  

Section 10.17

   WAIVER OF RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY      197  

Section 10.18

   Binding Effect      197  

Section 10.19

   No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility      197  

Section 10.20

   Affiliate Activities      198  

Section 10.21

   Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents      198  

Section 10.22

   USA PATRIOT ACT      199  

Section 10.23

   Acknowledgement and Consent to Bail-In of EEA Financial Institutions      199  

Section 10.24

   Judgment Currency      199  

SCHEDULES

 

A    Cash Management Obligations
1    Subsidiary Guarantors
1.01(e)    Contracts Prohibiting Subsidiary Guarantees
1.01(f)    Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information
2.01    Commitments and Pro Rata Shares
5.08(b)    Owned Real Property
5.12    Restricted Subsidiaries
5.16    Intellectual Property Matters
6.16    Post-Closing Undertakings
7.01    Existing Liens
7.02    Existing Investments
7.03    Permitted Surviving Debt
7.08    Transactions with Affiliates
7.09    Burdensome Agreements
10.02    Administrative Agent’s Office, Certain Addresses for Notices

EXHIBITS

Form of

 

-iv-


A-1    Committed Loan Notice
A-2    Request for L/C Credit Extension
A-3    Swing Line Loan Notice
B-1    Revolving Credit Note
B-2    Term Note
B-3    Swing Line Note
C    Closing Certificate
D    Compliance Certificate
E-1    Assignment and Assumption
E-2    Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption
F-1    Holdings Guaranty
F-2    Subsidiary Guaranty
G    Security Agreement
H    Intercompany Subordination Agreement
I-1    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-2    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-3    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-4    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
J    Solvency Certificate
K-1    Optional Prepayment of Loans
K-2    Optional Prepayment of Swing Line Loans
L    Perfection Certificate
M    Intercreditor Agreement

 

-v-


This FIRST LIEN CREDIT AGREEMENT dated as of December 9, 2016, among LD Lower Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ LD Lower ”) and LD Intermediate Holdings, Inc. (“ LD Intermediate ”), a Delaware corporation (and, together with LD Lower, each a “ Borrower ” and collectively, the “ Borrowers ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ Holdings ”), each lender from time to time party hereto (collectively, the “ Lenders ” and individually, a “ Lender ”) and Royal Bank of Canada (“ Royal Bank ”), as Administrative Agent, Collateral Agent, Swing Line Lender and L/C Issuer.

PRELIMINARY STATEMENTS

WHEREAS, pursuant to that certain Unit Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 21, 2016 (as amended and restated on December 8, 2016 and together with all exhibits and schedules thereto, collectively, the “ Acquisition Agreement ”) by and among, inter alios , LD Lower, as buyer, and Corporate Risk Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as the seller, LD Lower will indirectly acquire certain foreign subsidiaries of Kroll Ontrack, LLC, a Minnesota limited liability company, and directly acquire the Company Units (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement) (the “ Acquisition ”); and

WHEREAS, in connection with the Transaction, the Borrowers have requested that, upon the satisfaction (or waiver) in full of the conditions precedent set forth in Section  4.01 , the applicable Lenders (a) make term loans to the Borrowers in an aggregate principal amount of $340,000,000 and (b) make available to the Borrowers a $30,000,000 revolving credit facility for the making, from time to time, of revolving loans and swing line loans and the issuance, from time to time, of letters of credit, in each case on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement.

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

Definitions and Accounting Terms

Section 1.01 Defined Terms . As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

Acquisition ” has the meaning specified in the preliminary statements to this Agreement.

Acquisition Agreement ” has the meaning specified in the preliminary statements to this Agreement.

Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate ” means, with respect to any Eurocurrency Rate Loan for any Interest Period, an interest rate per annum equal to (a) the Statutory Reserve Rate (which shall not be less than zero) multiplied by (b) the greatest of (i) LIBOR, (ii) 0.00% per annum and (iii) solely with respect to the Initial Term Loans, 1.00% per annum.

Administrative Agent ” means Royal Bank, acting through such of its Affiliates or branches as it may designate, in its capacity as administrative agent under any of the Loan Documents, or any successor administrative agent permitted by the terms hereof.

Administrative Agent’s Office ” means the Administrative Agent’s address and, as appropriate, account as set forth on Schedule 10.02 , or in each case, such other address or account as the Administrative Agent may from time to time notify the Borrower Representative and the Lenders.


Administrative Questionnaire ” means an Administrative Questionnaire supplied by the Administrative Agent.

Affiliate ” means, with respect to any Person, another Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, Controls or is Controlled by or is under common Control with the Person specified.

Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(i)(i) .

Affiliate Lenders ” means, collectively, the Sponsor and its Affiliates (other than Holdings, a Borrower and any of their respective Subsidiaries).

Agency Matters ” means any matters relating to the Facilities (including, without limitation, those relating to the Term Facility, any Revolving Tranche and Letters of Credit issued under any Revolving Tranche).

Agent-Related Distress Event ” means, with respect to the Administrative Agent or any Person that directly or indirectly Controls the Administrative Agent (each, a “ Distressed Agent-Related Person ”), a voluntary or involuntary case with respect to such Distressed Agent-Related Person under any Debtor Relief Law, or a custodian, conservator, receiver or similar official is appointed for such Distressed Agent-Related Person or any substantial part of such Distressed Agent-Related Person’s assets, or such Distressed Agent-Related Person makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors or is otherwise adjudicated as, or determined by any Governmental Authority having regulatory authority over such Distressed Agent-Related Person to be, insolvent or bankrupt; provided that an Agent-Related Distress Event shall not be deemed to have occurred solely by virtue of the ownership or acquisition of any Equity Interests in the Administrative Agent or any Person that directly or indirectly Controls the Administrative Agent by a Governmental Authority or an instrumentality thereof.

Agent-Related Persons ” means each Agent, together with its Related Parties.

Agents ” means, collectively, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, the Arrangers and the Syndication Agent.

Agreement ” means this First Lien Credit Agreement.

Agreement Currency ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.24 .

Aggregate Commitments ” means the Commitments of all the Lenders.

All-In Yield ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(f) .

Anticipated Cure Deadline ” has the meaning specified in Section  8.03(a) .

Applicable Commitment Fee ” means a percentage per annum equal to (a) from the Closing Date until the first Business Day that immediately follows the date on which a Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) in respect of the first full fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date, 0.50% per annum, and (b) thereafter, the applicable percentage per annum set forth below, as determined by reference to First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, as set forth in the most recent Compliance Certificate received by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  6.02(b) :

 

-2-


Applicable Commitment Fee

 

Pricing Level

  

First Lien Net Leverage Ratio

   Applicable Commitment Fee  

1

   £ 3.25 to 1.00      0.375

2

   > 3.25 to 1.00      0.50

Any increase or decrease in the Applicable Commitment Fee resulting from a change in the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio shall become effective as of the first Business Day immediately following the date the applicable Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) ; provided , however , that “Pricing Level 2” shall apply without regard to the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (x) at any time after the date on which any annual or quarterly financial statement was required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) but was not delivered (or the Compliance Certificate related to such financial statements was required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) but was not delivered), commencing with the first Business Day immediately following such date and continuing until the first Business Day immediately following the date on which such financial statements (or, if later, the Compliance Certificate related to such financial statements) are delivered or (y) at all times if any Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements ” means customary intercreditor arrangements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent; provided that in the case of Indebtedness secured by Liens ranking junior to the Obligations, the Intercreditor Agreement shall be deemed satisfactory.

Applicable Rate means a percentage per annum equal to:

(a) with respect to the Initial Term Loans, (i) 5.875% per annum for Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (ii) 4.875% per annum for Base Rate Loans; and

(b) with respect to the Revolving Tranche, (i) from the Closing Date until the first Business Day that immediately follows the date on which a Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) in respect of the first full fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date, (A) 5.875% per annum for Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (B) 4.875% per annum for Base Rate Loans and (ii) thereafter, for any day the applicable percentage per annum set forth below, as determined by reference to the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, as set forth in the then most recent Compliance Certificate received by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  6.02(b) prior to such day:

 

Applicable Rate

 

Pricing Level

  

First Lien Net Leverage Ratio

   Eurocurrency Rate Loans     Base Rate Loans  

1

   £ 2.75 to 1.00      5.375     4.375

2

   > 2.75 to 1.00 and £ 3.25 to 1.00      5.625     4.625

3

   > 3.25 to 1.00      5.875     4.875

In clause (b) above, any increase or decrease in the Applicable Rate resulting from a change in the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio shall become effective as of the first Business Day immediately following the date a Compliance Certificate is delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) ; provided , however , that “Pricing Level 3” shall apply without regard to the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (x) at any time after the date on which any annual or quarterly financial statement was required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) but was not delivered (or the Compliance Certificate related to such

 

-3-


financial statements was required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) but was not delivered), commencing with the first Business Day immediately following such date and continuing until the first Business Day immediately following the date on which such financial statements (or, if later, the Compliance Certificate related to such financial statements) are delivered or (y) at all times if an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this definition, the determination of the Applicable Rate for any period shall be subject to the provisions of Section  2.10(b) .

Appropriate Lender ” means, at any time, (a) with respect to the Term Facility or any Revolving Tranche, a Lender that has a Commitment with respect to such Facility or Tranche or holds a Term Loan or a Revolving Credit Loan under such Revolving Tranche, respectively, at such time, (b) with respect to the Letter of Credit Sublimit for any Revolving Tranche, (i) each L/C Issuer under such Tranche and (ii) if any Letter of Credit has been issued pursuant to Section  2.03(a) , the Revolving Credit Lenders under such Tranche, (c) with respect to the Swing Line Facility, (i) the Swing Line Lender and (ii) if any Swing Line Loans are outstanding pursuant to Section  2.04(a) , the Revolving Credit Lenders, (d) with respect to any New Term Facility, a Lender that holds a New Term Loan at such time, and (e) with respect to any Specified Refinancing Debt, a Lender that holds Specified Refinancing Term Loans or Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans, as applicable.

Approved Bank ” has the meaning specified in clause (c) of the definition of “ Cash Equivalents .”

Approved Fund ” means with respect to any Lender any Fund that is administered, advised or managed by (a) such Lender, (b) an Affiliate of such Lender or (c) an entity or an Affiliate of an entity that administers, advises or manages such Lender.

Arrangers ” means each of RBC Capital Markets and TD Securities (USA) LLC, in their respective capacities as exclusive joint lead arrangers and bookrunners, as applicable.

Assignee Group ” means two or more Eligible Assignees that are Affiliates of one another or two or more Approved Funds managed, advised or administered by the same investment advisor/manager or affiliated investment advisors/managers.

Assignment and Assumption ” means an Assignment and Assumption substantially in the form of Exhibit E-1 , or otherwise in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

Attributable Indebtedness ” means, on any date, (a) in respect of any Capitalized Lease of any Person, the capitalized amount thereof that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP, and (b) in respect of any Synthetic Lease Obligation, the capitalized amount of the remaining lease payments under the relevant lease that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP if such lease were accounted for as a capital lease.

Audited Financial Statements ” means, collectively, (a) the audited financial statements for LDisc Holdings, LLC and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2014 and the fiscal period ending December 22, 2015and (b) the audited financial statements for Holdings and its Subsidiaries for the 10-day accounting period ending December 31, 2015.

Auto-Renewal Letter of Credit ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.03(b)(iii) .

 

-4-


Bail-In Action ” means the exercise of any Write-Down and Conversion Powers by the applicable EEA Resolution Authority in respect of any liability of an EEA Financial Institution.

Bail-In Legislation ” means, with respect to any EEA Member Country implementing Article 55 of Directive 2014/59/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of the European Union, the implementing law for such EEA Member Country from time to time which is described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule.

Base Rate ” means, for any day, a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the Federal Funds Rate in effect on such day plus 0.50%, (b) the prime commercial lending rate determined by Royal Bank as the “prime rate” and (c) the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate determined on such date (or if such day is not a Business Day, the immediately preceding Business Day) for a deposit in Dollars with a maturity of one month plus 1.00% (or, if such day is not a Business Day, the immediately preceding Business Day, subject to the interest rate floors set forth therein); provided that in no event shall the Base Rate be less than, in the case of Initial Term Loans, 2.00%; provided , further , that if any of the rates set forth above shall be less than zero percent per annum, such rate shall be deemed to be zero percent per annum for purposes of this Agreement.

Base Rate Loan ” means a Loan denominated in Dollars that bears interest based on the Base Rate.

Basel III ” means (a) the agreements on capital requirements, a leverage ratio and liquidity standards contained in “Basel III: A global regulatory framework for more resilient banks and banking systems”, “Basel III: International framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring” and “Guidance for national authorities operating the countercyclical capital buffer” published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in December 2010, each as amended, supplemented or restated; (b) the rules for global systemically important banks contained in “Global systemically important banks: assessment methodology and the additional loss absorbency requirement – Rules text” published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in November 2011, as amended, supplemented or restated; and (c) any further guidance or standards published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision relating to “Basel III”.

Borrower ” and “ Borrowers ” have the meanings specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Borrower Materials ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

Borrower Parties ” means the collective reference to Holdings, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, and “ Borrower Party ” means any one of them.

Borrower Representative ” means LD Intermediate.

Borrowing ” means a Revolving Credit Borrowing, a Swing Line Borrowing or a Term Borrowing, as the context may require.

Business Day ” means:

(a) any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks are authorized to close under the Laws of, or are in fact closed in New York City;

 

-5-


(b) if such day relates to any interest rate settings as to a Eurocurrency Rate Loan denominated in Dollars or Pounds Sterling, any such day described in clause (a) above which is also a day on which dealings in deposits in Dollars are conducted by and between banks in the London interbank market; and

(c) if such day relates to any interest rate settings as to a Eurocurrency Rate Loans denominated in Euros, any day that is not a TARGET Day.

Capital Expenditures ” means, as of any date for the applicable period then ended, all capital expenditures of the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis for such period (whether paid in cash or accrued as liabilities), that are required to be capitalized in accordance with GAAP (including acquisitions of IP Rights made in cash during such period to the extent the cost thereof is treated as a capitalized expense in accordance with GAAP); provided , however , that Capital Expenditures shall not include any such expenditures which constitute (a) an Investment permitted under Section  7.02 (but shall include all Capital Expenditures made with the proceeds of such Investment by a Borrower Party that is the recipient thereof), (b) to the extent permitted by this Agreement, (i) a reinvestment of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Disposition or Casualty Event in accordance with Section  2.05(b)(ii) or (ii) the purchase of property, plant or equipment or software to the extent financed with the proceeds of Dispositions or Casualty Events that are not required pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) to be applied to prepay Loans or to be reinvested, (c) capitalized interest in respect of operating or capital leases, (d) the book value of any asset owned to the extent such book value is included as a capital expenditure as a result of reusing or beginning to reuse such asset during such period without a corresponding expenditure actually having been made in such period, (e) any non-cash amounts reflected as additions to property, plant or equipment on the Borrowers’ consolidated balance sheet and (f) expenditures that are accounted for as capital expenditures by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and that actually are paid for or reimbursed (including by means of the issuance of Equity Interests by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) by a Person other than a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and for which neither of the Borrowers nor any Restricted Subsidiary has provided or is required to provide or incur, directly or indirectly, any consideration or obligation to such Person or any other Person (whether before, during or after such period).

Capitalized Leases ” means all leases that have been or are required to be, in accordance with GAAP, recorded as capitalized leases; provided that obligations or liabilities of any Person to pay rent or other amounts under any lease of (or other arrangement conveying the right to use) real or personal property, or a combination thereof, which obligations would be required to be classified and accounted for as an operating lease under GAAP as existing on the Closing Date that are recharacterized as Capitalized Leases due to a change in GAAP after the Closing Date shall not be treated as Capitalized Leases for any purpose under this Agreement, but instead shall be accounted for as if they were operating leases for all purposes under this Agreement as determined under GAAP as in effect on the Closing Date.

Capitalized Software Expenditures ” means, for any period, the aggregate of all expenditures (whether paid in cash or accrued as liabilities) by the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries during such period in respect of purchased software or internally developed software and software enhancements that, in conformity with GAAP, are or are required to be reflected as capitalized costs on the consolidated balance sheet of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries.

Cash-Capped Incremental Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Cash Collateralize ” means to pledge and deposit with or deliver to the Administrative Agent, for the benefit of the Administrative Agent, L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender (as applicable) and the Lenders, as collateral for L/C Obligations, Obligations in respect of Swing Line Loans, or obligations of Lenders to fund participations in respect of either thereof (as the context may require), cash, Cash Equivalents (if

 

-6-


reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and the applicable L/C Issuer) or deposit account balances (in the case of L/C Obligations in the respective currency or currencies in which the applicable L/C Obligations are denominated) or, if the Administrative Agent, L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender benefiting from such collateral shall agree in its sole discretion, other credit support (including by backstop with a letter of credit satisfactory to the applicable L/C Issuer or by being deemed reissued under another agreement acceptable to the applicable L/C Issuer), in each case pursuant to documentation in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to (a) the Administrative Agent and (b) the applicable L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender, as applicable (which documents are hereby consented to by the Lenders). “ Cash Collateral ” shall have a meaning correlative to the foregoing and shall include the proceeds of such cash collateral and other credit support. “Cash Collateralization” shall have a meaning correlative to the foregoing.

Cash Equivalents ” means any of the following types of Investments, to the extent owned by a Borrower or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries:

(a) Dollars;

(b) readily marketable obligations issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof having maturities of not more than 24 months from the date of acquisition thereof; provided that the full faith and credit of the United States is pledged in support thereof;

(c) time deposits or eurodollar time deposits with, insured certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances or overnight bank deposits of, or letters of credit issued by, any domestic or foreign commercial bank that (i) issues (or the parent of which issues) commercial paper rated at least P-2 (or the then equivalent grade) by Moody’s or at least A-2 (or the then equivalent grade) by S&P and (ii) has combined capital and surplus of at least $250,000,000 (or the Dollar Equivalent thereof in a currency other than Dollars as of the date of determination in the case of any non-U.S. banks) (any such bank being an “ Approved Bank ”), in each case with maturities of not more than 360 days from the date of acquisition thereof;

(d) commercial paper and variable or fixed rate notes issued by an Approved Bank (or by the parent company thereof) or any variable or fixed rate note issued by, or guaranteed by a domestic corporation rated A-2 (or the equivalent thereof) or better by S&P or P-2 (or the equivalent thereof) or better by Moody’s, in each case with maturities of not more than 24 months from the date of acquisition thereof;

(e) marketable short-term money market and similar funds (including such funds investing a portion of their assets in municipal securities) having a rating of at least P-2 or A-2 from either Moody’s or S&P, respectively (or, if at any time neither Moody’s nor S&P shall be rating such obligations, an equivalent rating from another nationally recognized statistical rating agency selected by the Borrowers);

(f) repurchase agreements entered into by any Person with a bank or trust company (including any of the Lenders) or recognized securities dealer having capital and surplus in excess of $250,000,000 (or the Dollar Equivalent thereof in a currency other than Dollars as of the date of determination in the case of any non-U.S. banks) for direct obligations issued by or fully guaranteed or insured by the United States government or any agency or instrumentality of the United States in which such Person shall have a perfected first priority security interest (subject to no other Liens) and having, on the date of purchase thereof, a fair market value of at least 100% of the amount of the repurchase obligations;

 

-7-


(g) Investments, classified in accordance with GAAP as Consolidated Current Assets of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary, in money market investment programs registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, which are administered by financial institutions having capital of at least $250,000,000 (or the Dollar Equivalent thereof in a currency other than Dollars as of the date of determination in the case of any non-U.S. banks), and the portfolios of which are limited such that substantially all of such investments are of the character, quality and maturity described in clauses (b) through (f) and (j) of this definition;

(h) investment funds investing at least 95% of their assets in securities of the types (including as to credit quality and maturity) described in clauses (b) through (g) above;

(i) solely with respect to any Restricted Subsidiary that is a Foreign Subsidiary, (x) such local currencies in those countries in which such Foreign Subsidiary transacts business from time to time in the ordinary course of business and (y) investments of comparable tenor and credit quality to those described in the foregoing clauses (b) through (h) customarily utilized in countries in which such Foreign Subsidiary operates for short term cash management purposes; and

(j) securities with average maturities of 24 months or less from the date of acquisition issued or fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth or territory of the United States, by any political subdivision or taxing authority of any such state, commonwealth or territory or by any foreign government having a rating of at least P-2 or A-2 from either Moody’s or S&P, respectively (or the equivalent thereof).

Notwithstanding the foregoing, Cash Equivalents shall include amounts denominated in currencies other than those set forth in clauses (a) and (i) above; provided that such amounts are converted into any currency listed in clause (a) or (i) as promptly as practicable and in any event within ten Business Days following the receipt of such amounts.

Cash Management Agreement ” means any agreement to provide cash management services, including treasury, depository, overdraft, credit, purchasing or debit card, electronic funds transfer and other cash management arrangements to any Loan Party.

Cash Management Bank ” means any Person that (i) at the time it enters into a Cash Management Agreement, is a Lender or an Agent or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent, (ii) in the case of any Cash Management Agreement in effect on or prior to the Closing Date, is, as of the Closing Date or within 30 days thereafter, a Lender or an Agent or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent and a party to a Cash Management Agreement or (iii) within 30 days after the time it enters into the applicable Cash Management Agreement, becomes a Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent, in each case, in its capacity as a party to such Cash Management Agreement.

Casualty Event ” means any event that gives rise to the receipt by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any casualty insurance proceeds or condemnation awards or that gives rise to a taking by a Governmental Authority in respect of any equipment, fixed assets or real property (including any improvements thereon) to replace, restore or repair, or compensate for the loss of, such equipment, fixed assets or real property.

Change of Control ” means: (a) for any reason whatsoever Holdings shall cease to own, directly or indirectly, 100% of the Equity Interests of each Borrower; (b) at any time prior to a Qualified IPO and for any reason whatsoever, the Permitted Holders shall cease to own, directly or indirectly, at least 50.1% of the Equity Interests of Holdings having the power, directly or indirectly, to designate (and do so

 

-8-


designate) a majority of the board of directors of Holdings; (c) at any time after a Qualified IPO and for any reason whatsoever, any “person” or “group” (within the meaning of Rule 13d-5 of the Exchange Act as in effect on the Closing Date, but excluding any employee benefits plan of any Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries) other than the Permitted Holders shall beneficially own a percentage of the then outstanding Voting Equity Interests of Holdings that is more than the greater of (A) 35% of the outstanding Voting Equity Interests of Holdings and (B) the percentage of such Voting Equity Interests owned, directly or indirectly, beneficially by the Permitted Holders, or (d) at any time, a Change of Control (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement) shall have occurred.

Class ” means (i) with respect to Commitments or Loans, those of such Commitments or Loans that have the same terms and conditions (without regard to differences in the Type of Loan or Interest Period or, unless such differences result in such Loans not being fungible for U.S. federal tax purposes, upfront fees or original issue discount or similar fees paid or payable in connection with such Commitments or Loans), and (ii) with respect to Lenders, those of such Lenders that have Commitments or Loans of a particular Class.

Closing Date ” means December 9, 2016.

Code ” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

Collateral ” means all of the “Collateral” referred to in the Collateral Documents and all of the other property and assets that are or are required under the terms of the Collateral Documents to be subject to Liens in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Collateral Agent ” means Royal Bank, acting through such of its Affiliates or branches as it may designate, in its capacity as collateral agent under any of the Loan Documents, or any successor collateral agent permitted by the terms hereof.

Collateral Documents ” means, collectively, the Security Agreement, the Intellectual Property Security Agreements, the Mortgages (if any), the Intercreditor Agreement, any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to this Agreement, each of the mortgages, collateral assignments, Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements, security agreements, pledge agreements or other similar agreements delivered to the Collateral Agent pursuant to Sections  6.12 , 6.14 or 6.16 , and each of the other agreements, instruments or documents that creates or purports to create a Lien in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Commitment ” means a Term Commitment and/or a Revolving Credit Commitment, as the context may require.

Committed Loan Notice ” means a notice of (a) a Term Borrowing, (b) a Revolving Credit Borrowing, (c) a conversion of Loans from one Type to the other or (d) a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case, pursuant to Section  2.02(a) , which, if in writing, shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A-1 .

Commodity Exchange Act ” means the Commodity Exchange Act (7 U.S.C. § 1 et seq .), as amended from time to time, and any successor statute.

Company Competitor ” means any Person that competes with the business of Holdings, the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries from time to time.

 

-9-


Compliance Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit  D or such other form as may be agreed between the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent.

Consolidated Cash Taxes ” means, for an applicable period with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the aggregate of all taxes based on income, profits or capital of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including (i) federal, state, franchise, excise and similar taxes and foreign withholding taxes, (ii) penalties and interest related to such taxes or arising from any tax examinations and (iii) taxes in respect of repatriated funds), paid in cash during such period, to the extent they exceed the amount of taxes deducted in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period.

Consolidated Current Assets ” means, with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, all assets of such Person that, in accordance with GAAP, would be classified as current assets on the balance sheet of a company conducting a business the same as or similar to that of such Person, after deducting appropriate and adequate reserves therefrom in each case in which a reserve is proper in accordance with GAAP, but excluding (i) cash, (ii) Cash Equivalents, (iii) Swap Contracts to the extent that the mark-to-market Swap Termination Value would be reflected as an asset on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, (iv) deferred financing fees and (v) amounts related to current or deferred Taxes (but excluding assets held for sale, loans (permitted) to third parties, pension assets, deferred bank fees and derivative financial instruments) (so long as the items described in clauses (iv) and (v) are non-cash items.

Consolidated Current Liabilities ” means, with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, all liabilities in accordance with GAAP that would be classified as current liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, but excluding (a) the current portion of Indebtedness (including the Swap Termination Value of any Swap Contracts) to the extent reflected as a liability on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, (b) the current portion of interest, (c) accruals for current or deferred taxes based on income or profits, (d) accruals of any costs or expenses related to restructuring reserves or severance, (e) deferred revenue, (f) escrow account balances, (g) any L/C Obligations, Swing Line Loans or Revolving Credit Loans and any letter of credit obligations, swing line loans or revolving loans under any other revolving credit facility, (h) the current portion of pension liabilities, (i) liabilities in respect of unpaid earn outs and (j) amounts related to derivative financial instruments and assets held for sale.

Consolidated EBITDA ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the sum of:

(a) Consolidated Net Income; plus

(b) an amount which, in the determination of Consolidated Net Income for such period, has been deducted (and not added back) (or, in the case of amounts pursuant to clauses (vi), (x) or (xi) below, not already included in Consolidated Net Income) for, without duplication,

(i) total interest expense determined in accordance with GAAP (including, to the extent deducted and not added back in computing Consolidated Net Income, (A) amortization of original issue discount resulting from the issuance of Indebtedness at less than par, (B) all commissions, discounts and other fees and charges owed with respect to letters of credit or bankers’ acceptances, (C) non-cash interest payments, (D) the interest component of Capitalized Leases, (E) net payments, if any, made (less net amounts, if any, received) pursuant to interest rate Swap Contracts with respect to Indebtedness, (F) amortization or write-off of deferred financing fees, debt issuance costs, commissions,

 

-10-


fees and expenses, including commitment, letter of credit and administrative fees and charges with respect to the Facilities, the Second Lien Facility and with respect to other Indebtedness permitted to be incurred hereunder and (G) any expensing of bridge, commitment and other financing fees, but excluding total interest expense associated with Synthetic Lease Obligations) and, to the extent not reflected in such total interest expense, any losses on hedging obligations or other derivative instruments entered into for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk, net of interest income or gains on such hedging obligations, and costs of surety bonds in connection with financing activities (whether amortized or immediately expensed),

(ii) provision for taxes based on income, profits or capital of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, including corporate income tax, federal, state, franchise, excise and similar taxes and foreign withholding taxes paid or accrued during such period including (A) penalties and interest related to such taxes or arising from any tax examinations and (B) in respect of repatriated funds,

(iii) depreciation and amortization expense and impairment charges (including amortization of intangible assets (including goodwill), deferred financing fees or costs, capitalized software expenditures (including capitalized software development expenditures), customer acquisition costs and incentive payments, conversion costs, and contract acquisition costs),

(iv) other non-cash charges, expenses or losses (excluding any such non-cash charge, expense or loss to the extent that it represents an accrual of or reserve for cash expenses in any future period, an amortization of a prepaid cash expense that was paid in a prior period, or write-off or write-down or reserves with respect to current assets but including (A) any non-cash increase in expenses resulting from the revaluation of inventory (including any impact of changes to inventory valuation policy methods including changes in capitalization and variances), (B) charges recognized in relation to post-retirement benefits or other charges necessary to adjust the defined benefit pension expense to reflect service cost only, (C) losses on minority interests owned by such Person, (D) the non-cash impact of accounting changes or restatements, (E) non-cash fair value adjustments in Investments, (F) the non-cash portion of “straight line” rent expense and (G) any other non-cash losses and expenses resulting from fair value accounting required by the applicable standard under GAAP and related interpretations) all as determined on a consolidated basis,

(v) restructuring charges, accruals or reserves and business optimization expense, including any restructuring costs and integration costs incurred in connection with the Transactions, Permitted Acquisitions and other acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02 after the Closing Date, project start-up costs, losses, charges and expenses relating to any strategic initiatives (including any multi-year strategic initiatives), costs related to the closure, relocation, reconfiguration and/or consolidation of facilities, reconfiguration of fixed assets for alternative uses and costs to relocate employees, integration and transaction costs, retention charges, severance, contract termination costs, recruiting and signing bonuses and expenses, future lease commitments, systems establishment costs, conversion costs, excess pension charges (including curtailments and modifications to pensions and post retirement employee benefit plans), and consulting fees, expenses attributable to the implementation of costs savings initiatives, costs associated with tax projects/audits and costs consisting of professional consulting or other fees relating to any of the foregoing,

 

-11-


(vi) the amount of “run rate” net cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and acquisition synergies, in each case, projected by the Borrowers in good faith to be realized (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis as though such items had been realized on the first day of such period) as a result of specified actions taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (in the good faith determination of the Borrowers), net of the amount of actual benefits realized during such period that are otherwise included in the calculation of Consolidated EBITDA from such actions; provided that (A) the Compliance Certificate required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.02 for the applicable period shall include a certification that such cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements, synergies are, in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers, (1) factually supportable and (2) reasonably anticipated to be realized within 18 months after the consummation of any operational change or the acquisition or disposition or the entry into any new agreements or amendments to existing agreements with customers or joint ventures, in each case, which is expected to result in such cost savings, expense reductions, operating improvements or synergies, as the case may be, (B) no cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies shall be added pursuant to this clause (vi) to the extent duplicative of any expenses or charges otherwise added to Consolidated Net Income, whether through a pro forma adjustment or otherwise, for such period and (C) projected amounts (that are not yet realized) may no longer be added in calculating Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (vi) to the extent occurring more than six full fiscal quarters after the specified action taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken in order to realize such projected cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies; provided that, amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (vi), other than to the extent in connection with the Transactions or the LDiscovery Transactions, shall not, when combined with amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to Section  1.09(b) , in the aggregate exceed 25% of Consolidated EBITDA (determined prior to giving effect to such amounts) in any four consecutive fiscal quarter period,

(vii) non-cash expenses resulting from any employee benefit or management compensation plan or the grant of stock and stock options and other equity and equity-based interests to employees or other service providers of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a written plan or agreement (including expenses arising from the grant of stock and stock options and other equity and equity-based interests prior to the Closing Date) or the treatment of such options and other equity and equity-based interests under variable plan accounting,

(viii) (A) management, consulting and advisory fees, termination payments, transaction fees, indemnities and expenses permitted under Section  7.08(c) and (B) the amount of expenses, if any relating to payments made to holders of stock options or other compensatory equity-based awards in Holdings or any Parent Holding Company in connection with, or as a result of, any distribution being made to equity holders or unit holders of such Person or its direct or indirect parent companies, which payments are being made to compensate such holders of compensatory equity-based awards as though they were shareholders or unit holders at the time entitled to share in such distribution, in each case to the extent permitted by this Agreement,

 

-12-


(ix) any costs or expenses incurred pursuant to any management equity plan or share or unit option plan or any other management, director or employee benefit plan or agreement or share or unit subscription or shareholder or similar agreement, to the extent such costs or expenses are funded with cash proceeds contributed to the capital of a Borrower or the Net Cash Proceeds of any issuance of Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of a Borrower (or any Parent Holding Company thereof),

(x) proceeds from business interruption insurance (to the extent not reflected as revenue or income in Consolidated Net Income and to the extent that the related loss was deducted in the determination of Consolidated Net Income),

(xi) charges, losses, lost profits, expenses or write-offs to the extent indemnified or insured by a third party, including expenses covered by indemnification provisions in connection with the Transaction, a Permitted Acquisition or any other acquisition permitted by Section  7.02 or any transaction permitted by Section  7.04 , in each case, to the extent that coverage has not been denied and so long as such amounts are actually reimbursed to a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary in cash within one year after the related amount is first added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (xi) (and if not so reimbursed within one year, such amount shall be deducted from Consolidated EBITDA during the next measurement period),

(xii) Synthetic Lease Obligations, to the extent deducted as an expense in such period,

(xiii) any losses realized upon a Disposition of property (including abandoned or discontinued operations or product lines) outside of the ordinary course of business,

(xiv) cash receipts (or any netting arrangements resulting in reduced cash expenses) not included in Consolidated EBITDA in any period to the extent non-cash gains relating to such receipts were deducted in the calculation of Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to clause (c) below for any previous period and not added back,

(xv) net realized losses relating to amounts denominated in foreign currencies resulting from the application of FASB ASC 830 (or any similar pronouncement) (including net realized losses from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items, net of realized gains from related Swap Contracts) (entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice),

(xvi) cash expenses relating to earn outs and similar obligations including the LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment and any other earn-out obligations incurred prior to the date thereof or in connection with any acquisition, buyout or other investment paid or accrued during the applicable period, including any mark-to-market adjustments,

(xvii) Initial Public Company Costs,

(xviii) any loss relating to Swap Contracts (excluding Swap Contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice),

(xix) the amount of any non-controlling interest expense consisting of Subsidiary income attributable to minority equity interests of third parties in any non-wholly owned Subsidiary deducted (and not added back) in such period in calculating Consolidated Net Income, excluding cash distributions in respect thereof, and

 

-13-


(xx) compensation and reimbursement of expenses of non-management members of the board of directors (or similar body) of such Person (other than employees of the Sponsor);

minus

(c) an amount which, in the determination of Consolidated Net Income, has been included for:

(i) other non-cash income or gains, including (A) any non-cash portion of “straight line” rent expense, (B) credits recognized in relation to post-retirement benefits or other credits necessary to adjust the defined benefit pension income to reflect service cost only, (C) gains on minority interests owned by any Person, (D) the non-cash impact of accounting changes or restatements and (E) non-cash fair value adjustments in Investments but excluding (x) accrual of revenue in the ordinary course, (y) any such items in respect of which cash was received in a prior period or will be received in a future period (and, in the case of cash that was received in a prior period, such amounts previously reduced Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be added back pursuant to clause (b) of this definition)) or (z) any such items which represent the reversal in such period of any accrual of, or reserve for, anticipated cash charges in any prior period where such accrual or reserve is no longer required (and where such accrual or reserve previously reduced Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be added back pursuant to clause (b) of this definition)) and (F) any other non-cash gains and income resulting from fair value accounting required by the applicable standard under GAAP and related interpretations, all as determined on a consolidated basis,

(ii) any gains realized upon the Disposition of property (including abandoned or discontinued operations or product lines) outside of the ordinary course of business,

(iii) the amount of cash received in such period in respect of any non-cash income or gain in a prior period (and such non-cash income or gain previously increased Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be deducted pursuant to clause (c)(i) of this definition)),

(iv) net realized gains relating to amounts denominated in foreign currencies resulting from the application of FASB ASC 830 (or any similar pronouncement) (including net realized gains from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items, net of realized losses from related Swap Contracts) (entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice), and

(v) any gain related to Swap Contracts (excluding Swap Contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice).

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary and without duplication of any adjustment provided for in clauses (a) to (c) above, Consolidated EBITDA shall be deemed to be $21,300,000 for the fiscal quarter ended September 30, 2016, $20,900,000 for the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2016, $21,100,000 for the fiscal quarter ended March 31, 2016 and $21,900,000 for the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2015.

 

-14-


Consolidated Net Income ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, net income, excluding, without duplication:

(i) extraordinary, unusual or non-recurring charges, expenses, losses or gains (including (A) accruals for amounts payable and payments under executive employment agreements, severance costs, relocation costs, signing, retention and completion bonuses and (B) gains and losses realized on disposition of property outside of the ordinary course of business);

(ii) any amounts attributable to Investments in any non-wholly owned Restricted Subsidiary, Unrestricted Subsidiary or Joint Venture (other than a Guarantor or any Person at the Closing Date accounted for by the equity method of accounting; provided that to the extent not already excluded or deducted as minority interest expense, payments made in respect of interests of third parties shall be excluded) to the extent that such amounts have not been distributed in cash or Cash Equivalents to such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such applicable period;

(iii) (x) any net unrealized gains and losses resulting from fair value accounting (including as a result of the mark-to-market of obligations of Swap Contracts and other derivative instruments) and (y) any net unrealized gains and losses relating to mark-to-market of amounts denominated in foreign currencies (including net unrealized gain and losses from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items), in each case, to the extent included in Consolidated Net Income;

(iv) the income (or loss) of any Person accrued prior to the date it becomes a Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower or is merged into or consolidated with a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries (except to the extent required for any calculation of Consolidated EBITDA on a Pro Forma Basis);

(v) [reserved];

(vi) the net income for such period shall not include the cumulative effect of a change in or the adoption, application or modification of accounting principles or policies during such period, whether effected through a cumulative effect adjustment or a retroactive application;

(vii) effects of adjustments (including the effects of such adjustments pushed down to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries) in any line item in such Person’s consolidated financial statements resulting from the application of purchase accounting (including any step-ups with respect to re-valuing assets and liabilities) in relation to the Transactions and any investment, acquisition, merger or consolidation (or resulting from any reorganization or restructuring) that is consummated after the Closing Date or the depreciation, amortization or write-off of any amounts thereof shall be excluded;

(viii) Transaction Costs; and

(ix) transaction fees and expenses incurred, or amortization thereof, in connection with, to the extent permitted hereunder, any Investment, any Debt Issuance, any Equity Issuance, any Disposition, any Casualty Event, recapitalization or any amendments or waivers of the Loan Documents the Second Lien Facility Documentation, documentation governing other securities, credit facilities or debt instruments (including, in each case listed above, any amendments or other modifications thereto) and Permitted Refinancings in connection therewith, in each case, whether or not consummated.

 

-15-


There shall be excluded from Consolidated Net Income for any period (A) the accounting effects of adjustments to inventory, property and equipment, software and other intangible assets and deferred revenue required or permitted by GAAP and related authoritative pronouncements (including the effects of such adjustments pushed down to the Borrowers and/or the Restricted Subsidiaries), as a result of any acquisition consummated prior to the Closing Date, the Transactions and any Permitted Acquisitions (or Investments similar to those made for Permitted Acquisitions) or any Investment permitted under Section  7.02 or the amortization or write-off of any amounts thereof and (B) any income (loss) for such period attributable to the early extinguishment of (i) Indebtedness, (ii) obligations under any Swap Contracts and (iii) other derivative instruments.

Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the sum of all scheduled payments of principal made in cash during such period on Funded Indebtedness that constitutes Funded Debt (including the implied principal component of payments due on Capitalized Leases during such period to the extent not deducted in the calculation of Consolidated Net Income), less the reduction in such scheduled payments resulting from voluntary prepayments pursuant to Section  2.05(a) or mandatory prepayments required pursuant to Section  2.05(b) , in each case as applied pursuant to Section  2.05 , as determined in accordance with GAAP.

Consolidated Total Assets ” means, the consolidated total assets of the Borrowers and their respective Restricted Subsidiaries as set forth on the consolidated balance sheet of the Borrowers as of the most recent period for which financial statements were required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) (and, in the case of any determination relating to any incurrence of Indebtedness or any Investment, Restricted Payment, Permitted Acquisition or other acquisition, on a Pro Forma Basis including any property or asset being acquired or disposed of in connection therewith); provided that, at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma consolidated financial information of the Borrowers and their respective Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule  1.01(f) hereto.

Consulting Services Agreement ” means those certain Consulting Services Agreements in the form made available to the Arrangers on or around the Closing Date, between Holdings, on the one hand, and the Sponsor, on the other hand, dated as of December 22, 2015, as such consulting services agreement may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent that such amendments, supplements or modifications (i) do not increase the obligation of Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries to make payments thereunder and (ii) are otherwise permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

Contract Consideration ” has the meaning given it in clause (b)(xv) of the definition of “Excess Cash Flow.”

Contractual Obligation ” means, as to any Person, any provision of any security issued by such Person or of any agreement, loan agreement, indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, lease, instrument or other undertaking to which such Person is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound.

Control ” means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise, and “ Controlling ” and “ Controlled ” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

-16-


Control Investment Affiliate ” means, as to any Person, any other Person that (a) directly or indirectly, is in Control of, is Controlled by, or is under common Control with, such Person and (b) is organized by such Person primarily for the purpose of making equity investments in one or more companies.

Controlled Foreign Subsidiary ” means any Foreign Subsidiary that is a “controlled foreign corporation” within the meaning of Section 957 of the Code.

Credit Extension ” means each of the following: (a) a Borrowing and (b) an L/C Credit Extension.

Cumulative Credit ” means, at any date, an amount, not less than zero in the aggregate, determined on a cumulative basis equal to the sum of (without duplication):

(a) $12,500,000, plus

(b) the percentage of Excess Cash Flow (if any) not required to be applied towards repayment of the Term Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(b) (with such amount determined without giving effect to the minimum threshold set forth in Section  2.05(b)(i)(A) ), determined for the period (taken as one accounting period) commencing with the fiscal year of the Borrowers ending December 31, 2017 to the end of the fiscal year most recently ended in respect of which a Compliance Certificate has been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) , plus

(c) the Net Cash Proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance after the Closing Date (other than Cure Amounts, but including the Net Cash Proceeds of issuances or incurrences of Indebtedness or Disqualified Equity Interests by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries owed or issued, as applicable, to a Person other than a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary after the Closing Date which shall have been subsequently exchanged for or converted into Permitted Equity Issuances of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) at such time and any direct contribution to the common capital of a Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, plus

(d) in the event that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit has been applied to make an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(s) in connection with the designation of a Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary, the acquisition of Equity Interests of an Unrestricted Subsidiary or the acquisition of any Investment, an amount equal to the aggregate amount received by a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in cash and Cash Equivalents from: (i) the sale (other than to any of the Restricted Subsidiaries of a Borrower) of any such Equity Interests of any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or any such Investment less any amounts that would be deducted pursuant to clause (a)(ii) of the definition of “Net Cash Proceeds” if such sale constituted a Disposition, (ii) any dividend or other distribution by any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or received in respect of any such Investment or (iii) interest, returns of principal, repayments and similar payments by any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or received in respect of any such Investment, plus

(e) in the event that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit has been applied to make an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(s) in connection with the designation of a Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary and such Unrestricted Subsidiary is thereafter redesignated as a Restricted Subsidiary or is merged, consolidated or amalgamated with or into, or transfers or conveys its assets to, or is liquidated into, a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, an amount equal to the fair market value of the Investments of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries in such Unrestricted Subsidiary at the time of such redesignation, combination or transfer (or of the assets transferred or conveyed, as applicable), plus

 

-17-


(f) any Declined Amounts (other than any Declined Amounts attributable to a prepayment that is declined by an Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate)), plus

(g) an amount equal to any returns in cash and Cash Equivalents (including dividends, interest, distributions, returns of principal, sale proceeds, repayments, income and similar amounts) actually received by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of any Investments pursuant to Section  7.02(s) ; provided that in no case shall such amount exceed the amount of such Investment made using the Cumulative Credit pursuant to Section  7.02(s) , plus

(h) the proceeds and the fair market value (as reasonably determined by the Borrowers) of marketable securities or other property contributed to a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary since Closing Date from any Person (other than Holdings, a Borrower or its Subsidiaries);

as such amount shall be reduced dollar for dollar from time to time to the extent that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit is applied prior to such date to make Investments, Restricted Payments or prepayments of Junior Financing to the extent permitted hereunder.

Cure Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  8.03 .

Cure Right ” has the meaning specified in Section  8.03 .

Debt Fund Affiliate ” means any Affiliate of the Sponsor (other than Holdings and its Subsidiaries or a natural person) that is primarily engaged in, or advises funds or other investment vehicles that are engaged in, making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans, bonds and similar extensions of credit or securities in the ordinary course and with respect to which the Sponsor does not, directly or indirectly, possess the power to direct or cause the direction of the investment policies of any such Affiliate.

Debt Issuance ” means the issuance by any Person of any Indebtedness for borrowed money.

Debtor Relief Laws ” means the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, or similar debtor relief Laws of the United States or other applicable jurisdictions from time to time in effect and affecting the rights of creditors generally.

Declined Amounts ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Declining Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Default ” means any event or condition that constitutes an Event of Default or that, with the giving of any notice, the passage of time, or both, would be an Event of Default.

Default Rate ” means an interest rate equal to (after as well as before judgment), (a) with respect to any overdue principal for any Loan, the applicable interest rate for such Loan plus 2.00% per annum ( provided that with respect to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the determination of the applicable interest rate is subject to Section  2.02(c) to the extent that Eurocurrency Rate Loans may not be converted to, or continued as, Eurocurrency Rate Loans, pursuant thereto) and (b) with respect to any other overdue amount, including overdue interest, the Base Rate plus the Applicable Rate with respect to the Initial Term Loans plus 2.00% per annum, in each case, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

 

-18-


Defaulting Lender ” means, subject to Section  2.17(b) , any Lender that (a) has failed to perform any of its funding obligations hereunder, including in respect of its Loans or participations in respect of Letters of Credit or Swing Line Loans within three Business Days of the date required to be funded by it hereunder, (b) has notified the Borrower Representative or the Administrative Agent that it does not intend to comply with its funding obligations or has made a public statement to that effect with respect to its funding obligations hereunder, under the Second Lien Credit Agreement, or, solely with respect to a Revolving Credit Lender, under other agreements generally in which it commits to extend credit, (c) has failed, within three Business Days after reasonable request by the Administrative Agent, to confirm in a manner satisfactory to the Administrative Agent that it will comply with its funding obligations ( provided that such Lender shall cease to be a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this clause (c) upon receipt of such confirmation by the Administrative Agent) or (d) has, or has a direct or indirect parent company that has, (i) become the subject of a proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, (ii) had a receiver, conservator, trustee, administrator, assignee for the benefit of creditors or similar Person charged with reorganization or liquidation of its business or a custodian appointed for it, (iii) taken any action in furtherance of, or indicated its consent to, approval of or acquiescence in any such proceeding or appointment; or (iv) become subject to a Bail-In Action; provided that no Lender shall be a Defaulting Lender solely by virtue of (x) the ownership or acquisition by a Governmental Authority of any Equity Interest in that Lender or any direct or indirect parent company thereof so long as such ownership interest does not result in or provide such Lender with immunity from the jurisdiction of courts within the United States or from the enforcement of judgments or writs of attachment on its assets or permit such Lender (or such Governmental Authority) to reject, repudiate, disavow or disaffirm any contracts or agreements made with such Lender, (y) the occurrence of any of the events described in clause (d)(i), (d)(ii), (d)(iii) or (d)(iv) of this definition which in each case has been dismissed or terminated prior to the date of this Agreement or (z) the occurrence of an Undisclosed Administration. Any determination by the Administrative Agent that a Lender is a Defaulting Lender under any one or more of clauses (a) through (d) above shall be conclusive and binding absent manifest error, and such Lender shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender (subject to Section  2.17(b) ) upon delivery of written notice of such determination to the Borrower Representative, each L/C Issuer, each Swing Line Lender and each Lender.

Designated Foreign Currency ” means Euro and Pounds Sterling (GBP).

Designated Foreign Currency Sublimit ” means $10,000,000.

Designated Non-Cash Consideration ” means the fair market value of non-cash consideration received by a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with a Disposition made pursuant to Section  7.05(s) that is designated as “ Designated Non-Cash Consideration ” on the date received pursuant to a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers setting forth the basis of such fair market value (with the amount of Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of any Disposition being reduced for purposes of Section  7.05(s) to the extent a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries converts the same to cash or Cash Equivalents within 180 days following the closing of the applicable Disposition).

Disposition ” or “ Dispose ” means the sale, transfer, license, lease or other disposition of any property by any Person (including any sale and leaseback transaction and any issuance of Equity Interests by a Restricted Subsidiary of such Person), including any sale, assignment, transfer or other disposal, with or without recourse, of any notes or accounts receivable or any rights and claims associated therewith; provided , however , that “Disposition” and “Dispose” shall not be deemed to include any issuance by Holdings of any of its Equity Interests to another Person.

 

-19-


Disqualified Equity Interests ” means any Equity Interest which, by its terms (or by the terms of any security or other Equity Interests into which it is convertible or for which it is exchangeable), or upon the happening of any event or condition (a) matures or is mandatorily redeemable (other than solely for Equity Interests that are not Disqualified Equity Interests), pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise (except as a result of a change of control or asset sale so long as any rights of the holders thereof upon the occurrence of a change of control or asset sale event shall be subject to the prior repayment in full of the Loans and all other Obligations that are accrued and payable and the termination of the Commitments), (b) is redeemable at the option of the holder thereof (except as a result of a change of control or asset sale so long as any rights of the holders thereof upon the occurrence of a change of control or asset sale event shall be subject to the prior repayment in full of the Loans and all other Obligations that are accrued and payable), in whole or in part, (c) provides for the scheduled payments of dividends in cash or (d) is or becomes convertible into or exchangeable for Indebtedness or any other Equity Interests that would constitute Disqualified Equity Interests, in each case, prior to the date that is 91 days after the Latest Maturity Date of the Facilities at the time of issuance of the respective Disqualified Equity Interests; provided that if such Equity Interests are issued pursuant to a plan for the benefit of employees or other service providers of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company), a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries or by any such plan to such employees, such Equity Interests shall not constitute Disqualified Equity Interests solely because they may be required to be repurchased by Holdings or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in order to satisfy applicable statutory or regulatory obligations or in connection with such employee’s or other service provider’s termination, death or disability.

Disqualified Institution ” means (a) each bank, financial institution or other institutional lender or investor identified on a written list (if any) made available to the Administrative Agent on or prior to October 21, 2016, (b) any Company Competitor specified by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent in writing from time to time and (c) known Affiliates of any such Persons described in clauses (a) and (b) that are readily identifiable as Affiliates of such Persons solely based on the similarity of such Affiliate’s name (in each case, other than a bona fide debt fund or an investment vehicle that is engaged in the making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans, bonds and similar extensions of credit or securities in the ordinary course and with respect to which the lender or investor described in clause (a) or (b), as applicable, does not, directly or indirectly, possess the power to direct or cause the direction of the investment policies of such entity), which designations shall not apply retroactively to disqualify any Persons that have previously acquired an assignment or participation interest in the Loans or the Commitments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, (i) the assignment by any Lender of its Loans and/or Commitments to a Disqualified Institution shall be prohibited only to the extent the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to any requesting Lender (or potential Lender) and (ii) any Disqualified Institution shall be prohibited from being a Participant only to the extent the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to the Lenders.

Dollar ” or “ $ ” means lawful money of the United States.

Dollar Equivalent ” shall mean, at any time of determination, (a) if such amount is expressed in Dollars, such amount, (b) if such amount is expressed in any lawful currency other than Dollars that is freely transferable into Dollars, the equivalent of such amount in Dollars, as determined by the Administrative Agent based on the rate of exchange quoted by Royal Bank in New York, New York at 11:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the date of such determination (or, if such date is not a Business Day, the last Business Day prior thereto) to prime banks in New York for the spot purchase in the New York foreign exchange market of such amount of Dollars with such applicable currency and (c) if such amount is denominated in any other currency, the equivalent of such amount in Dollars as reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent; provided that any determination pursuant to this clause (c)  by the Administrative Agent shall be presumptively correct absent manifest error.

 

-20-


Dutch Auction ” means an auction (an “ Auction ”) conducted by any Borrower or one of its Subsidiaries in order to purchase any Term Loans under a Tranche (the “ Purchase ”) in accordance with the following procedures or such other procedures as may be agreed to between the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers:

(a) Notice Procedures . In connection with any Auction, the Borrower Representative shall provide notification to the Administrative Agent (for distribution to the Appropriate Lenders) of the Term Loans under such Tranche that will be the subject of the Auction (an “ Auction Notice ”). Each Auction Notice shall be in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and shall specify (i) the total cash value of the bid, in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount (the “ Auction Amount ”) and (ii) the discounts to par, which shall be expressed as a range of percentages of the par principal amount of the Term Loans under such Tranche at issue (the “ Discount Range ”), representing the range of purchase prices that could be paid in the Auction.

(b) Reply Procedures . In connection with any Auction, each applicable Lender may, in its sole discretion, participate in such Auction by providing the Administrative Agent with a notice of participation (the “ Return Bid ”) which shall be in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and shall specify (i) a discount to par that must be expressed as a price (the “ Reply Discount ”), which must be within the Discount Range, and (ii) a principal amount of the applicable Loans such Lender is willing to sell in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount (the “ Reply Amount ”). Lenders may only submit one Return Bid per Auction. In addition to the Return Bid, each Lender wishing to participate in such Auction must execute and deliver, to be held in escrow by the Administrative Agent, an assignment and acceptance agreement in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

(c) Acceptance Procedures . Based on the Reply Discounts and Reply Amounts received by the Administrative Agent, the Administrative Agent, in consultation with the Borrowers, will determine the applicable discount (the “ Applicable Discount ”) for the Auction, which shall be the lowest Reply Discount for which any Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, can complete the Auction at the Auction Amount; provided that, in the event that the Reply Amounts are insufficient to allow any Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, to complete a purchase of the entire Auction Amount (any such Auction, a “ Failed Auction ”), such Borrower or such Subsidiary shall either, at its election, (i) withdraw the Auction or (ii) complete the Auction at an Applicable Discount equal to the highest Reply Discount. A Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall purchase the applicable Loans (or the respective portions thereof) from each applicable Lender with a Reply Discount that is equal to or greater than the Applicable Discount (“ Qualifying Bids ”) at the Applicable Discount; provided that if the aggregate proceeds required to purchase all applicable Loans subject to Qualifying Bids would exceed the Auction Amount for such Auction, a Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall purchase such Loans at the Applicable Discount ratably based on the principal amounts of such Qualifying Bids (subject to adjustment for rounding as specified by the Administrative Agent). Each participating Lender will receive notice of a Qualifying Bid as soon as reasonably practicable but in no case later than five Business Days from the date the Return Bid was due.

(d) Additional Procedures . Once initiated by an Auction Notice, a Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, as applicable, may not withdraw an Auction other than a Failed Auction. Furthermore, in connection with any Auction, upon submission by a Lender of a Qualifying Bid, such Lender will be obligated to sell the entirety or its allocable portion of the Reply Amount, as the case may be, at the Applicable Discount. The Purchase shall be consummated pursuant to and in accordance with Section  10.07 and, to the extent not otherwise provided herein, shall otherwise be consummated pursuant to procedures (including as to timing, rounding and minimum amounts, Interest Periods, and other notices by such Borrower or such Subsidiaries, as applicable) reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers.

 

-21-


EEA Financial Institution ” means (a) any credit institution or investment firm established in any EEA Member Country which is subject to the supervision of an EEA Resolution Authority, (b) any entity established in an EEA Member Country which is a parent of an institution described in clause (a) of this definition, or (c) any financial institution established in an EEA Member Country which is a subsidiary of an institution described in clauses (a) or (b) of this definition and is subject to consolidated supervision with its parent.

EEA Member Country ” means any of the member states of the European Union, Iceland, Liechtenstein, and Norway.

EEA Resolution Authority ” means any public administrative authority or any person entrusted with public administrative authority of any EEA Member Country (including any delegee) having responsibility for the resolution of any EEA Financial Institution.

Eligible Assignee ” means any Person that meets the requirements to be an assignee under Section  10.07(b) (subject to receipt of such consents, if any, as may be required for the assignment of the applicable Loan and/or Commitments to such Person under Section  10.07(b)(iii) ).

Environmental Laws ” means any and all applicable federal, state, local and foreign statutes, laws, including common law, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgments, orders, decrees, permits, concessions, grants, franchises, licenses or governmental restrictions relating to pollution, the protection of the environment, human health (to the extent relating to exposure to Hazardous Materials) or safety, including those related to Hazardous Materials, air emissions and discharges to public pollution control systems.

Environmental Liability ” means any liability, contingent or otherwise (including any liability for damages, costs of environmental remediation, monitoring or oversight by a Governmental Authority, fines, penalties or indemnities), of the Borrowers, any other Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries directly or indirectly resulting from or based upon (a) any actual or alleged violation of any Environmental Law, (b) the generation, use, handling, transportation, storage, treatment or disposal of any Hazardous Materials, (c) human exposure to any Hazardous Materials, (d) the release or threatened release of any Hazardous Materials into the environment or (e) any contract, agreement or other binding consensual arrangement pursuant to which liability is assumed or imposed with respect to any of the foregoing.

Environmental Permit ” means any permit, approval, identification number, license or other authorization required under any Environmental Law.

Equity Contribution ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions”.

Equity Interests ” means, with respect to any Person, all of the shares, interests, rights, participations or other equivalents (however designated) of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests or units in) such Person and all of the warrants, options or other rights for the purchase, acquisition or exchange from such Person of any of the foregoing (including through convertible securities); provided that any instrument evidencing Indebtedness convertible or exchangeable for Equity Interests shall not be deemed to be Equity Interests unless and until such instrument is so converted or exchanged, except, solely for purposes of a pledge of Equity Interests in connection with this Agreement, to the extent such instrument could be treated as “stock” of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary for purposes of Treasury Regulation Section 1.956-2(c)(2).

 

-22-


Equity Issuance ” means any issuance by any Person to any other Person of (a) its Equity Interests for cash, (b) any of its Equity Interests pursuant to the exercise of options or warrants, (c) any of its Equity Interests pursuant to the conversion of any debt securities to equity or (d) any options or warrants relating to its Equity Interests.

ERISA ” means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, and the rules and regulations thereunder, each as amended or modified from time to time.

ERISA Affiliate ” means any Person who together with any Loan Party is treated as a single employer within the meaning of Section 414(b) or (c) of the Code (and Sections 414(m) and (o) of the Code for purposes of provisions relating to Section 412 of the Code) or Section 4001 of ERISA.

ERISA Event ” means (a) a Reportable Event with respect to a Plan; (b) the withdrawal of any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate from a Plan subject to Section 4063 of ERISA during a plan year in which such entity was a “substantial employer” (as defined in Section 4001(a)(2) of ERISA) or a cessation of operations that is treated as such a withdrawal under Section 4062(e) of ERISA; (c) a complete or partial withdrawal by any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate from a Multiemployer Plan or written notification that a Multiemployer Plan is “in reorganization” (within the meaning of Section 4241 of ERISA) or “insolvent” (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA); (d) the filing of a written notice of intent to terminate or the treatment of a Plan amendment as a termination under Section 4041 or 4041A of ERISA, respectively, (e) the institution by the PBGC of proceedings to terminate a Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (f) an event or condition which constitutes grounds under Section 4042 of ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee to administer, any Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (g) the determination that any Plan is considered an at-risk plan within the meaning of Section 430 of the Code or Section 303 of ERISA; (h) the determination that any Multiemployer Plan is considered a plan in “endangered status” or “critical status” within the meaning of Section 432 of the Code or Section 305 of ERISA; (i) the imposition of any liability under Title IV of ERISA, other than for PBGC premiums due but not delinquent under Section 4007 of ERISA, upon any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate; (j) the conditions for the imposition of a lien under Section 430(k) of the Code or Section 303(k) of ERISA shall have been met with respect to any Plan; or (k) Foreign Benefit Event.

EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule ” means the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule published by the Loan Market Association (or any successor person), as in effect from time to time.

Euro ” or “ ” means the single currency of the European Union as constituted by the Treaty on European Union as referred to in the legislative measures of the European Union for the introduction of, changeover to or operation of the Euro in one or more member states.

Eurocurrency Rate ” means, with respect to any Credit Extension, LIBOR.

Eurocurrency Rate Loan ” means a Loan which bears interest at a rate based on the applicable Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate.

Event of Default ” has the meaning specified in Section  8.01 .

 

-23-


Excess Cash Flow ” means, with respect to any Excess Cash Flow Period, an amount, not less than zero, equal to:

(a) the sum, without duplication, of (i) Consolidated Net Income of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such Excess Cash Flow Period, plus (ii) the amount of all non-cash charges (including depreciation, amortization and deferred tax expense) deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iii) the aggregate net amount of non-cash loss on Dispositions by the Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such Excess Cash Flow Period (other than sales of inventory in the ordinary course of business), to the extent deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iv) to the extent not otherwise included in determining Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of cash receipts for such period attributable to Swap Contracts or other derivative instruments (other than commodity Swap Contracts); minus

(b) the sum, without duplication (in each case, for Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis), of:

(i) without duplication of amounts deducted pursuant to clause (xv) below in prior fiscal years, the amount of Capital Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property to the extent not expensed or accrued during such period and Capitalized Software Expenditures made in cash or accrued during such period, except to the extent that such Capital Expenditures and acquisitions were financed by the issuance or incurrence of Indebtedness (other than revolving Indebtedness) by, or the issuance of Equity Interests by, or the making of capital contributions to, the Borrowers or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries or using the proceeds of any Disposition outside the ordinary course of business or other proceeds not included in Consolidated Net Income;

(ii) the amount of Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments (except to the extent financed with the proceeds of Funded Debt other than the Loans) and, to the extent not otherwise deducted from Consolidated Net Income, Consolidated Cash Taxes, in each case, actually made during such period;

(iii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, Restricted Payments made in cash during such period by the Borrowers to the extent that such Restricted Payments are made under Sections 7.06(e) , (h) , (j)(i) , (k) and (l) , solely to the extent made, directly or indirectly, with the net cash proceeds from events or circumstances that were included in the calculation of Consolidated Net Income;

(iv) the aggregate amount of voluntary or mandatory permanent principal payments or mandatory repurchases of (A) Indebtedness for borrowed money and (B) the principal component of payments in respect of Capitalized Leases of the Borrower Parties (in each case, excluding the Obligations and the Revolving Credit Commitments) made by the Borrower Parties during such period; provided that (A) such prepayments or repurchases are otherwise permitted hereunder, (B) if such Indebtedness consists of a revolving line of credit, the commitments under such line of credit are permanently reduced by the amount of such prepayment or repurchase, and (C) such prepayments or repurchases are not made, directly or indirectly, using (1) proceeds, payments or any other amounts available from events or circumstances that were not included in determining Consolidated Net Income during such period (including any proceeds from Indebtedness) or (2) the Cumulative Credit;

 

-24-


(v) (A) the aggregate amount of any premium, make-whole or penalty payments actually paid in cash by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries during such period that are required to be made in connection with any prepayment or satisfaction and discharge of Indebtedness of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries (except to the extent financed with the proceeds of Funded Debt other than the Loans) to the extent that the amount so prepaid, satisfied or discharged is not deducted from Consolidated Net Income for purposes of calculating Excess Cash Flow and (B) to the extent included in determining Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of any income (or loss) for such period attributable to the early extinguishment of Indebtedness, Swap Contracts or other derivative instruments (other than commodity Swap Contracts);

(vi) cash payments made by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries during such period (to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income) in satisfaction of non-current liabilities (excluding payments of Indebtedness for borrowed money) not made directly or indirectly using (1) proceeds, payments or any other amounts available from events or circumstances that were not included in determining Consolidated Net Income during such period (including any proceeds from Indebtedness) or (2) the Cumulative Credit;

(vii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, fees, expenses and purchase price adjustments paid in cash during such period by the Borrower Parties in connection with the Transactions (other than any LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment) or, to the extent permitted hereunder, any Investment permitted under Section  7.02 , any Disposition permitted by Section  7.05 , Equity Issuance or Debt Issuance (whether or not consummated) and any Restricted Payment made in cash by any Borrower Party pursuant to Section  7.06(g) to pay any of the foregoing;

(viii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of expenditures actually made in cash by the Borrower Parties during such period (including expenditures for payment of financing fees) to the extent such expenditures are (1) not expensed during such period and (2) made with cash from operations;

(ix) without duplication of amounts deducted pursuant to clause (xv) below in prior fiscal years, cash from operations used by the Borrower Parties or committed to be used by the Borrower Parties to consummate a Permitted Acquisition or acquisition, in each case, as permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(x) the amount of cash payments made in respect of pensions and other postemployment benefits in such period to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income;

(xi) the amount of cash expenditures in respect of Swap Contracts during such fiscal year to the extent they exceed the amount of expenditures expensed in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period;

(xii) the aggregate principal amount of all mandatory prepayments of the Term Facilities made during such Excess Cash Flow Period pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) or any amounts offered pursuant to Section  2.05(c) and constituting Declined Amounts, or reinvestments of Net Cash Proceeds in lieu thereof, to the extent that the applicable Net Cash Proceeds resulted in an increase of Consolidated Net Income (and are not in excess of such increase) for such Excess Cash Flow Period;

 

-25-


(xiii) the amount representing accrued expenses for cash payments (including with respect to retirement plan obligations) that are not paid in cash during such Excess Cash Flow Period; provided that such amounts will be added to Excess Cash Flow for the following Excess Cash Flow Period to the extent not paid in cash within six months after the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period (and no future deduction shall be made for purposes of this definition when such amounts are paid in cash in any future period);

(xiv) the aggregate net amount of any non-cash gains and credits to the extent included in arriving at Consolidated Net Income;

(xv) without duplication of amounts deducted from Excess Cash Flow in other periods, the aggregate consideration required to be paid in cash by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries pursuant to binding contracts (the “ Contract Consideration ”) entered into prior to or during such period relating to Permitted Acquisitions (or similar acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02) , Capital Expenditures, Capitalized Software Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property (to the extent not expensed) to be consummated or made during the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters of the Borrowers following the end of such period; provided that to the extent that the aggregate amount of cash actually utilized to finance such Permitted Acquisitions (or similar acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02) , Capital Expenditures, Capitalized Software Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property during such period of four consecutive fiscal quarters (A) is financed by the issuance or incurrence of Indebtedness by, or the issuance of Equity Interests by, or the making of capital contributions to, a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries or using the proceeds of any Disposition outside the ordinary course of business or other proceeds not included in Consolidated Net Income or (B) if not so financed, is less than the Contract Consideration, then the portion so financed in clause (A) or the amount of such shortfall in clause (B) shall be added to the calculation of Excess Cash Flow, at the end of such period of four consecutive fiscal quarters;

(xvi) at the option of the Borrowers, any amounts in respect of Investments and acquisitions (including related earnouts and similar payments) which could have been deducted pursuant to clauses (vii) or (ix) above if made in such period, but which are made after the end of such period and prior to the date upon which a mandatory prepayment for such period would be required under Section  2.05(b) (it being understood that such amounts shall not reduce Excess Cash Flow in such subsequent period);

(xvii) reimbursable or insured expenses incurred during such fiscal year to the extent that such reimbursement has not yet been received and to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income;

(xviii) amounts received from customers in the ordinary course of business representing an overfunding or overpayment of amounts owed to the Borrower Parties; and

(xix) the amount of Tax distributions actually distributed for such period pursuant to Section  7.06(e)(ii) ;

minus

 

-26-


(c) any increase in Net Working Capital during such Excess Cash Flow Period (measured as the excess, if any, of Net Working Capital at the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period minus Net Working Capital at the beginning of such Excess Cash Flow Period) or increases in long-term accounts receivable and decreases in the long term portion of deferred revenue for such period, except as a result of the reclassification of items from short-term to long-term or vice versa; plus

(d) any decrease in Net Working Capital during such Excess Cash Flow Period (measured as the excess, if any, of Net Working Capital at the beginning of such Excess Cash Flow Period minus Net Working Capital at the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period) or decreases in long-term accounts receivable and increases in the long-term portion of deferred revenue for such period, except as a result of the reclassification of items from short-term to long-term or vice versa;

provided that for purposes of calculating any increase or decrease in Net Working Capital, long-term accounts receivables or long-term portion of deferred revenue for such period pursuant to clauses (c) and (d) above, (1) any such increase or decrease shall be disregarded if attributable to property Disposed by Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such period and (2) the Net Working Capital, long-term accounts receivables or long-term portion of deferred revenue at the beginning of such period shall include such amounts as set forth on the opening balance sheet of any entity acquired (or combined into) Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries at the time of any Permitted Acquisition or similar acquisition consummated during such period.

Excess Cash Flow Period ” means any fiscal year of the Borrowers, commencing with the fiscal year ending on December 31, 2017.

Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

Exchange Rate ” means, on any applicable date, (a) with respect to any Designated Foreign Currency, the rate at which such currency may be exchanged into Dollars, as set forth at approximately 11:00 a.m. London time, on such day on the Reuters World Currency Page for such currency and (b) otherwise, the currency exchange rates selected in good faith by the Borrowers and used in preparing the Borrowers’ financial statements most recently delivered prior to such date.

Excluded Information ” has the meaning set forth in Section  10.07(i) .

Excluded Property ” means, (a) any fee-owned real property not constituting Material Real Property and any leased real property, (b) motor vehicles and other assets subject to certificates of title, to the extent a Lien thereon cannot be perfected by filing a UCC financing statement, (c) assets to the extent a security interest in such assets would result in material adverse Tax consequences (including, without limitation, as a result of the operation of Section 956 of the Code or any similar law or regulation in any applicable jurisdiction), (d) pledges of, and security interests in, certain assets, in favor of the Collateral Agent that are prohibited by applicable Law; provided that (i) any such limitation described in this clause (d) on the security interests granted hereunder shall only apply to the extent that any such prohibition could not be rendered ineffective pursuant to the UCC or any other applicable Law or principles of equity and shall not apply to any proceeds or receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC notwithstanding such prohibition and (ii) in the event of the termination or elimination of any such prohibition contained in any applicable Law (and the absence of any other applicable limitation), a security interest in such assets shall be automatically and simultaneously granted under the applicable Collateral Documents and shall be included as Collateral, (e) any governmental licenses (but not the proceeds thereof) or state or local franchises, charters and authorizations or any other

 

-27-


property or assets, to the extent security interests in favor of the Collateral Agent in such licenses, franchises, charters, authorizations or other property or assets are prohibited or restricted thereby after giving effect to the applicable anti-assignment provisions of the UCC other than proceeds and receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC notwithstanding such prohibition; provided that (i) any such limitation described in this clause (e) on the security interests granted hereunder shall only apply to the extent that any such prohibition or restriction could not be rendered ineffective pursuant to the UCC or any other applicable Law or principles of equity and (ii) in the event of the termination or elimination of any such prohibition or restriction contained in any applicable license, franchise, charter or authorization (and the absence of any other applicable limitation), a security interest in such licenses, franchises, charters or authorizations shall be automatically and simultaneously granted under the applicable Collateral Documents and shall be included as Collateral, (f) Equity Interests in (A) any Person other than wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiaries of any Borrower to the extent the terms of such Person’s Organization Documents, joint venture agreement, shareholder agreement or other similar agreements with equity holders of such Person do not permit the pledge of such Equity Interests without the consent of one or more third parties other than Holdings, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (unless such consent has been received) for so long as such prohibition exists; provided that such prohibition exists on the Closing Date or at the time such Equity Interests are acquired (so long as such prohibition did not arise in contemplation of such acquisition), (B) any not-for-profit Subsidiary, (C) any captive insurance Subsidiary, (D) any special purpose securitization vehicle (or similar entity) formed pursuant to a transaction permitted hereunder, (E) any Unrestricted Subsidiary and (F) (I) any indirect Subsidiary (not directly owned by a Borrower or a Guarantor), or (II) any direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO; (g) any lease, license or other agreement or any property subject to a purchase money security interest, capital lease obligation or similar arrangement in each case permitted to be incurred under this Agreement, to the extent that a grant of a security interest therein would violate or invalidate such lease, license or agreement or purchase money arrangement or create a right of termination in favor of any other party thereto (other than a Loan Party or their wholly-owned Subsidiaries) after giving effect to the applicable anti-assignment provisions of the UCC of any applicable jurisdiction, other than proceeds and receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC of any applicable jurisdiction notwithstanding such prohibition, (h) U.S. “intent-to-use” trademark applications to the extent that a verified statement of use or an amendment to allege use has not been filed and accepted by the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office with respect thereto, (i) Voting Equity Interests in excess of 65% of the Voting Equity Interests of (A) any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or (B) any FSHCO and (j) Margin Stock. Other assets shall be deemed to be “Excluded Property” if the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers reasonably agree in writing that the cost of obtaining or perfecting a security interest in such assets is excessive in relation to the value of such assets as Collateral. Notwithstanding anything herein or the Collateral Documents to the contrary, Excluded Property shall not include any Proceeds (as defined in the UCC), substitutions or replacements of any Excluded Property (unless such Proceeds, substitutions or replacements would otherwise constitute Excluded Property referred to above).

Excluded Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary that is (a) an Unrestricted Subsidiary, (b) not wholly-owned directly by a Borrower or one or more of its Restricted Subsidiaries, (c) an Immaterial Subsidiary that is designated in writing to the Administrative Agent as such by the Borrower Representative, (d) a FSHCO or Foreign Subsidiary or a direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO, (e) established or created pursuant to Section  7.02(x) and meeting the requirements of the proviso thereto; provided that such Subsidiary shall only be an Excluded Subsidiary for the period immediately prior to such acquisition, (f) a Subsidiary that is prohibited by applicable Law from guaranteeing the Facilities, or which would require governmental (including regulatory) consent, approval, license or authorization to provide a guarantee unless, such consent, approval, license or authorization has been received, in each case so long as the Administrative Agent shall have received a certification from a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers as to the existence of such prohibition or

 

-28-


consent, approval, license or authorization requirement, (h) a Subsidiary that is prohibited from guaranteeing the Facilities by any Contractual Obligation in existence on the Closing Date and is listed on Schedule  1.01(e) hereto (or, in the case of any newly-acquired Subsidiary, in existence at the time of acquisition thereof but not entered into in contemplation thereof), (h) a Subsidiary with respect to which a guarantee by it of the Facilities would result in material adverse Tax consequences to Holdings or one or more of its Restricted Subsidiaries, as reasonably determined by the Borrowers, (i) not-for-profit subsidiaries, (j) Subsidiaries that are special purpose entities, and (k) any other Subsidiary with respect to which, in the reasonable judgment of the Administrative Agent (confirmed in writing by notice to the Borrower Representative), the cost or other consequences (including any adverse tax consequences) of guaranteeing the Facilities shall be excessive in view of the benefits to be obtained by the Lenders therefrom; provided that if a Subsidiary executes the Subsidiary Guaranty as a “Subsidiary Guarantor,” then it shall not constitute an “Excluded Subsidiary” (unless released from its obligations under the Subsidiary Guaranty as a “Subsidiary Guarantor” in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof).

Excluded Swap Obligation ” means, with respect to any Guarantor, any Swap Obligation if, and to the extent that, all or a portion of the Guarantee of such Guarantor of, or the grant by such Guarantor of a security interest to secure, such Swap Obligation (or any Guarantee thereof) is or becomes illegal under the Commodity Exchange Act or any rule, regulation or order of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (or the application or official interpretation of any thereof) by virtue of such Guarantor’s failure for any reason to constitute an “eligible contract participant” as defined in the Commodity Exchange Act and the regulations thereunder at the time the Guarantee of such Guarantor or the grant of such security interest becomes effective with respect to such Swap Obligation. If a Swap Obligation arises under a master agreement governing more than one swap, such exclusion shall apply only to the portion of such Swap Obligation that is attributable to swaps for which such Guarantee or security interest is or becomes illegal.

Excluded Taxes ” means any of the following Taxes imposed on or with respect to a Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to a Recipient: (a) Taxes imposed on or measured by such Recipient’s net income (however denominated), franchise Taxes, and branch profits Taxes, in each case, (i) imposed as a result of such Recipient being organized under the laws of, or having its principal office or, in the case of any Lender, its applicable lending office located in, the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (or any political subdivision thereof) or (ii) any Taxes that are imposed as a result of any other present or former connection between such Recipient and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than connections arising from such recipient having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to and/or enforced any Loan Document), (b) in the case of a Lender (other than any Lender becoming a party hereto pursuant to a request by any Loan Party under Section  3.07 ), any U.S. federal withholding Taxes imposed pursuant to a Law in effect on the date on which such Lender becomes a party hereto or changes its lending office, except in each case to the extent that, pursuant to Section  3.01 , additional amounts with respect to such Taxes were payable either to such Lender’s assignor immediately before such Lender became a party hereto or to such Lender immediately before it changed its lending office, (c) Taxes attributable to such Recipient’s failure to comply with Section  3.01(g) , and (d) any Taxes imposed pursuant to FATCA.

Executive Order ” means Executive Order No. 13224 of September 23, 2001, entitled Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten to Commit, or Support Terrorism (66 Fed. Reg. 49079 (2001)).

Existing Credit Agreement ” means that certain Credit Agreement, dated as of December 22, 2015(as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time prior to the Closing Date), among Holdings, LD Intermediate, the financial institutions party thereto as lenders and Antares Capital LP, as administrative agent.

 

-29-


Facility ” means the Term Facilities, the Revolving Credit Facility, the Swing Line Sublimit or the Letter of Credit Sublimit, as the context may require.

FATCA ” means Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, as of the date of this Agreement (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with), any current or future Treasury regulations or official administrative interpretations thereof, any agreements entered into pursuant to current Section 1471(b)(1) of the Code (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with), any intergovernmental agreements implementing the foregoing and any legislation or official guidance or other official requirements adopted in accordance with any such intergovernmental agreements.

Federal Funds Rate ” means, for any day, the rate per annum equal to the weighted average of the rates on overnight federal funds transactions with members of the Federal Reserve System arranged by federal funds brokers on such day, as published by the Federal Reserve Bank on the Business Day next succeeding such day; provided, that (a), if such day is not a Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be such rate on such transactions on the immediately preceding Business Day as so published on the next succeeding Business Day and (b) if no such rate is so published on such next succeeding Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be the average rate charged to the Administrative Agent on such day on such transactions as determined by the Administrative Agent.

Fee Letter ” means that certain Amended and Restated Fee Letter, dated as of November 11, 2016, by and among the Arrangers, the Borrowers and the other persons party thereto.

Financial Covenant ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.10 .

First Lien Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded First Lien Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for the four fiscal quarter period most recently then ended.

Flood Insurance Laws means, collectively, (i) the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (ii) the Flood Disaster Protection Act of 1973 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (iii) the National Flood Insurance Reform Act of 1994 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (iv) the Flood Insurance Reform Act of 2004 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto and (v) the Biggert-Waters Flood Insurance Reform Act of 2012 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto.

Foreign Benefit Event ” means, with respect to any Foreign Plan and as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (a) the existence of unfunded liabilities in excess of the amount that would be permitted absent a waiver from a Governmental Authority, (b) the failure to make the required contributions, under any applicable Law, on or before the due date for such contributions, (c) the receipt of a notice by a Governmental Authority relating to the intention to terminate any such Foreign Plan or to appoint a trustee or similar official to administer any such Foreign Plan, (d) the incurrence of any liability by Holdings or any its Subsidiaries under applicable Law on account of the complete or partial termination of such Foreign Plan or the complete or partial withdrawal of any participating employer therein or (e) the occurrence of any transaction that is prohibited under any applicable Law and that could reasonably be expected to result in the incurrence of any liability by Holdings and any of its Subsidiaries, or the imposition on Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries of, any fine, excise tax or penalty resulting from any noncompliance with any applicable Law.

 

-30-


Foreign Casualty Event ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Disposition ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Excess Cash Flow ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Plan ” means any pension plan, benefit plan, fund (including any superannuation fund) or other similar program that, under the applicable Law of any jurisdiction other than the United States, is required to be funded through a trust or other funding vehicle (other than a trust or funding vehicle maintained exclusively by a Governmental Authority) by a Loan Party primarily for the benefit of employees employed and residing outside the United States.

Foreign Subsidiary ” means any direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Borrower that is not a U.S. Person.

FRB ” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System of the United States.

Fronting Exposure ” means, at any time there is a Defaulting Lender under any Tranche of the Revolving Credit Facility, (a) with respect to an L/C Issuer under such Tranche, such Defaulting Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the outstanding L/C Obligations under such Tranche (other than L/C Obligations as to which such Defaulting Lender’s participation obligation has been reallocated to other Non-Defaulting Lenders under such Tranche or Cash Collateralized in accordance with the terms hereof) and (b) with respect to the Swing Line Lender under such Tranche, such Defaulting Lender’s Pro Rata Share of Swing Line Loans under such Tranche (other than Swing Line Loans as to which such Defaulting Lender’s participation obligation has been reallocated to other Non-Defaulting Lenders under such Tranche or Cash Collateralized in accordance with the terms hereof).

FSHCO ” means any direct or indirect Subsidiary that owns no material assets other than Equity Interests and/or Indebtedness of one or more Controlled Foreign Subsidiaries and/or other FSHCOs (it being understood that Ontrack Data Recovery, LLC satisfies the foregoing requirement as of the Closing Date).

Fund ” means any Person (other than a natural person) that is engaged in making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans and similar extensions of credit in the ordinary course of its business.

Funded Debt ” of any Person means Indebtedness for borrowed money of such Person that (x) by its terms matures more than one year after the date of its creation or (y) matures within one year from any date of determination but (in the case of this clause (y)) is renewable or extendable, at the option of such Person, to a date more than one year after such date or arises under a revolving credit or similar agreement that obligates the lender or lenders to extend credit during a period of more than one year after such date, including Indebtedness in respect of the Loans and the Second Lien Loans.

Funded First Lien Indebtedness ” means Funded Indebtedness that is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary; provided that such Funded Indebtedness (i) is not expressly subordinated pursuant to a written agreement in right of payment to the Obligations or (ii) is not secured by Liens on the Collateral that are expressly junior to the Liens securing the Obligations.

 

-31-


Funded Indebtedness ” means all Indebtedness of the type described in clauses (a), (b)(i), (f) and, without duplication, (h) of the definition of “Indebtedness” (to the extent relating to Indebtedness of the type described in clauses (a), (b)(i) or (f) of the definition thereof), of a Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, in an amount that would be reflected on a balance sheet (in the case of such clause (h), of the Person whose Indebtedness is guaranteed) prepared as of such date on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP (but (x) subject to Section  1.03(c) and (y) any Indebtedness that is issued at a discount to its initial principal amount shall be calculated based on the entire stated principal amount thereof, without giving effect to any discounts or upfront payments), excluding (i) obligations in respect of letters of credit (including Letters of Credit), except to the extent of unreimbursed amounts thereunder that are not reimbursed within two Business Days after such amount is drawn, (ii) Attributable Indebtedness of the type described in clause (b) of the definition of Attributable Indebtedness and (iii) any Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness. For the avoidance of doubt, it is understood that obligations (i) under Swap Contracts and Cash Management Agreements, and (ii) owed by Unrestricted Subsidiaries, do not constitute Funded Indebtedness.

Funded Senior Secured Indebtedness ” means Funded Indebtedness that is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary.

GAAP ” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States as in effect from time to time.

Governmental Authority ” means any nation or government, any state or other political subdivision thereof, any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, administrative tribunal, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.

Granting Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(g) .

Guarantee ” means, as to any Person, without duplication, (a) any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person guaranteeing or having the economic effect of guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other monetary obligation payable or performable by another Person (the “ primary obligor ”) in any manner, whether directly or indirectly, and including any obligation of such Person, direct or indirect, (i) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation, (ii) to purchase or lease property, securities or services for the purpose of assuring the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of the payment or performance of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation, (iii) to maintain working capital, equity capital or any other financial statement condition or liquidity or level of income or cash flow of the primary obligor so as to enable the primary obligor to pay such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation or (iv) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any other manner the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of the payment or performance thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part) or (b) any Lien on any assets of such Person securing any Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of any other Person, whether or not such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation is assumed by such Person (or any right, contingent or otherwise, of any holder of such Indebtedness to obtain any such Lien); provided that the term “Guarantee” shall not include endorsements for collection or deposit, in either case in the ordinary course of business, or customary or reasonable indemnity obligations in effect on the Closing Date, or entered into in connection with any acquisition or Disposition of assets permitted under this Agreement (other than such obligations with respect to Indebtedness). The amount of any Guarantee shall be deemed to be an amount equal to the stated or determinable amount of the related primary obligation, or portion thereof, in respect of which such Guarantee is made or, if not stated or determinable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof as determined by the guaranteeing Person in good faith. The term “ Guarantee ” as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

 

-32-


Guarantors ” means, collectively, Holdings and the Subsidiaries of the Borrowers listed on Schedule  1 and each other Subsidiary of a Borrower (such Subsidiaries not to include any Excluded Subsidiary) that shall be required to execute and deliver a guaranty or guaranty supplement pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Guaranty ” means, collectively, the Holdings Guaranty and the Subsidiary Guaranty, together with each other guaranty and guaranty supplement delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Hazardous Materials ” means all explosive or radioactive substances or wastes and all hazardous or toxic substances, materials or wastes, including petroleum or petroleum distillates, asbestos or asbestos-containing materials, toxic mold, polychlorinated biphenyls, radon gas, infectious or medical wastes and all other substances or wastes of any nature regulated pursuant to any Environmental Law.

Hedge Bank ” means any Person that (i) at the time it enters into a Swap Contract, is a Lender or an Agent or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent, (ii) within 30 days after the time it enters into a Swap Contract, becomes a Lender or an Agent or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent, or (iii) with respect to Swap Contracts in effect as of the Closing Date, is, as of the Closing Date or within 30 days after the Closing Date, a Lender or an Agent or an Affiliate of a Lender or an Agent and a party to a Swap Contract, in each case, in its capacity as a party to such Swap Contract.

Holdings ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Holdings Guaranty ” means the Holdings Guaranty made by Holdings in favor of the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Secured Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit  F -1 .

Honor Date ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.03(c)(i) .

Immaterial Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of a Borrower that, as of the date of the most recent financial statements required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , (x) does not have (a) assets (when combined with the assets of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) in excess of 5.0% of Consolidated Total Assets or (b) revenues (when combined with the revenues of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such date in excess of 5.0% of the consolidated revenues of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period or (y) whose contribution to Consolidated EBITDA (when combined with the contribution to Consolidated EBITDA of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such date does not exceed 5.0% of the Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period; provided that, at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma consolidated financial information of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule  1.01(f) hereto.

Increase Effective Date ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(c) .

Incremental Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Incremental Arranger ” means the Person that is a financial institution engaged in arranging similar financings in the ordinary course of its business appointed by the Borrowers to arrange New Loan Commitments, who (i) may be the Administrative Agent, if it so agrees, or (ii) any other Person appointed by the Borrowers; provided that such Person may not be an Affiliate of a Borrower.

 

-33-


Indebtedness ” means, as to any Person at a particular time, without duplication, all of the following, whether or not included as indebtedness or liabilities in accordance with GAAP:

(a) all obligations of such Person for borrowed money and all obligations of such Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments;

(b) the maximum amount of (i) all letters of credit (including standby and commercial), bankers’ acceptances, bank guaranties, and (ii) surety bonds, performance bonds and similar instruments issued or created by or for the account of such Person;

(c) net obligations of such Person under any Swap Contract;

(d) all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than (w) trade accounts payable in the ordinary course of business, (x) any earn-out obligation until such obligation becomes a liability on the balance sheet of such Person in accordance with GAAP and is not yet paid after becoming due and payable, (y) expenses accrued in the ordinary course of business and (z) purchase price holdbacks in respect of a portion of the purchase price of an asset to satisfy warranty or other unperformed obligations of the respective seller);

(e) indebtedness (excluding prepaid interest thereon) secured by a Lien on property owned or being purchased by such Person (including indebtedness arising under conditional sales or other title retention agreements and mortgage, industrial revenue bond, industrial development bond and similar financings), whether or not such indebtedness shall have been assumed by such Person or is limited in recourse;

(f) all Attributable Indebtedness;

(g) all obligations of such Person in respect of Disqualified Equity Interests; and

(h) all Guarantees of such Person in respect of any of the foregoing.

For all purposes hereof, the Indebtedness of any Person shall (A) include the Indebtedness of any partnership or Joint Venture (other than a joint venture that is itself a corporation or limited liability company or the foreign equivalent thereof) in which such Person is a general partner or a joint venturer, (i) unless such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to such Person or (ii) except to the extent such Person’s liability for such Indebtedness is otherwise limited in recourse or amount, but only up to the amount of the value of the assets to which recourse is limited or the amount of such limit and (B) in the case of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries, exclude all intercompany Indebtedness having a term not exceeding 364 days (inclusive of roll over or extensions of term). The amount of any net obligation under any Swap Contract on any date shall be deemed to be the Swap Termination Value thereof as of such date. The amount of Indebtedness of any Person for purposes of clause (e) shall be deemed to be equal to the lesser of (i) the aggregate unpaid amount of such Indebtedness and (ii) the fair market value of the property encumbered thereby as determined by such Person in good faith.

Indemnified Liabilities ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.05 .

 

-34-


Indemnified Taxes ” means (a) all Taxes, other than Excluded Taxes, imposed on or with respect to any payment made by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party under any Loan Document and (b) to the extent not otherwise described in (a), all Other Taxes.

Indemnitees ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.05 .

Independent Financial Advisor ” means an accounting, appraisal, investment banking firm or consultant of nationally recognized standing that is, in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers, qualified to perform the task for which it has been engaged and that is independent of Holdings and its Affiliates.

Information ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.08 .

Initial Lenders ” means each of the Lenders party to this Agreement on the Closing Date.

Initial Public Company Costs ” means, as to any Person, costs associated with, or in anticipation of, or preparation for, compliance with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules and regulations promulgated in connection therewith and costs relating to compliance with the provisions of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, as applicable to companies with equity securities held by the public, the rules of national securities exchange companies with listed equity, directors’ compensation, fees and expense reimbursement, costs relating to investor relations, shareholder meetings and reports to shareholders, directors’ and officers’ insurance and other executive costs, legal and other professional fees, and listing fees, in each case to the extent arising solely by virtue of the initial listing of such Person’s equity securities on a national securities exchange; provided that any such costs arising from the costs described above in respect of the ongoing operation of such Person as a listed equity or its listed debt securities following the initial listing of such Person’s equity securities or debt securities, respectively, on a national securities exchange shall not constitute Initial Public Company Costs.

Initial Term Borrowing ” means a borrowing consisting of simultaneous Initial Term Loans having the same Interest Period made by each of the Initial Term Lenders pursuant to Section  2.01(a) on the Closing Date.

Initial Term Commitment ” means, as to each Term Lender, its obligation, as of the Closing Date, to make Initial Term Loans to the Borrowers pursuant to Section  2.01(a) in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed such Term Lender’s “Initial Term Commitment” set forth on Schedule 2.01 , which such commitments in the aggregate equal $340,000,000.

Initial Term Lenders ” means each of the Lenders party to this Agreement and holding an Initial Term Commitment on the Closing Date.

Initial Term Loans ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.01(a) .

Intellectual Property Security Agreement ” means, collectively, the intellectual property security agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B to the Security Agreement, entered into by and among the Collateral Agent and the applicable Loan Parties dated the date of this Agreement, together with each other intellectual property security agreement or intellectual property security agreement supplement executed and delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 or 6.14 .

Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplement ” means, collectively, any intellectual property security agreement supplement entered into in connection with, and pursuant to the terms of, any Intellectual Property Security Agreement.

 

-35-


Intercompany Subordination Agreement ” means an intercompany subordination agreement, in substantially the form of Exhibit H hereto, or otherwise in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

Intercreditor Agreement ” means the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, among the Administrative Agent, the Second Lien Administrative Agent and the Loan Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit M .

Interest Payment Date ” means (a) as to any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan, the last day of each Interest Period applicable to such Loan and the Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made; provided , however , that if any Interest Period for a Eurocurrency Rate Loan exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of such Interest Period shall also be Interest Payment Dates and (b) as to any Base Rate Loan (including a Swing Line Loan), the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December and the Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made.

Interest Period ” means, as to each Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the period commencing on the date any Eurocurrency Rate Loan is disbursed or converted to or continued as a Eurocurrency Rate Loan and ending on the date (x) one, two, three or six months thereafter, or to the extent consented to by all Appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter or (y) if agreed by the Administrative Agent in its sole discretion, such other period not to exceed one-month, each as selected by the Borrower Representative in a Committed Loan Notice; provided that:

(a) any Interest Period that would otherwise end on a day that is not a Business Day shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless such Business Day falls in another calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the next preceding Business Day;

(b) any Interest Period that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and

(c) no Interest Period shall extend beyond the scheduled Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made.

Interpolated Screen Rate ” means, in relation to LIBOR for any Loan, the rate (rounded to the same number of decimal places as the two relevant Screen Rates) which results from interpolating on a linear basis between:

(a) the applicable Screen Rate for the longest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which is less than the Interest Period of that Loan; and

(b) the applicable Screen Rate for the shortest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which exceeds the Interest Period of that Loan;

provided that if any Interpolated Screen Rate shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement.

Investment ” means, as to any Person, any direct or indirect acquisition or investment by such Person, whether by means of (a) the purchase or other acquisition of Equity Interests or debt or other securities of another Person, (b) a loan, advance or capital contribution (excluding accounts receivable,

 

-36-


credit card and debit card receivables, trade credit, and advances to customers, in each case made in the ordinary course of business) to, Guarantee or assumption of debt of, or purchase or other acquisition of any other debt or equity participation or interest in, another Person, including any partnership or joint venture interest in such other Person and any arrangement pursuant to which the investor incurs debt of the type referred to in clause (h) of the definition of “Indebtedness” in respect of such Person or (c) the purchase or other acquisition (in one transaction or a series of transactions) of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of another Person or assets constituting a business unit, line of business or division of such Person. For purposes of covenant compliance, the amount of any Investment shall be the amount actually invested (measured at the time made), without adjustment for subsequent increases or decreases in the value of such Investment but, giving effect to any returns or distributions of capital or repayment of principal actually received in cash by such Person with respect thereto (but only to the extent that the aggregate amount of all such returns, distributions and repayments with respect to such Investment does not exceed the principal amount of such Investment and less any such amounts which increase the Cumulative Credit).

IP Rights ” has the meaning specified in Section  5.16 .

IRS ” means the United States Internal Revenue Service.

ISP ” means, with respect to any Letter of Credit, the “International Standby Practices 1998” published by the Institute of International Banking Law & Practice, Inc. (or such later version thereof as may be in effect at the time of issuance).

Issuer Documents ” means with respect to any Letter of Credit, the Letter of Credit Application, and any other document, agreement and instrument entered into by the applicable L/C Issuer and the applicable Borrower (or, if applicable, a Borrower and a Restricted Subsidiary) or in favor of such L/C Issuer and relating to such Letter of Credit.

Joint Venture ” means (a) any Person that is not a Subsidiary of a Borrower that would constitute an “equity method investee” of a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries and (b) any Person other than an individual or a Subsidiary of a Borrower (i) in which a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary holds or acquires a beneficial ownership interest (by way of ownership of Equity Interests or other evidence of ownership) in such Person and (ii) which is engaged in a business not prohibited by Section  7.07 .

Judgment Currency ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.24 .

Junior Financing ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.12 .

Junior Financing Documentation ” means any documentation governing any Junior Financing.

Latest Maturity Date ” means, at any date of determination, the latest maturity or expiration date applicable to any Term Loan Tranche or Revolving Tranche at such time under this Agreement, in each case as extended in accordance with this Agreement from time to time.

Laws ” means, collectively, all applicable international, foreign, federal, state and local statutes, treaties, rules, guidelines, regulations, ordinances, codes and administrative or judicial precedents or authorities, including the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Authority charged with the enforcement, interpretation or administration thereof, and all applicable administrative orders, directed duties, requests, licenses, authorizations and permits of, and agreements with, any Governmental Authority.

 

-37-


L/C Advance ” means, with respect to each Revolving Credit Lender under any Revolving Tranche, such Lender’s funding of its participation in any L/C Borrowing under such Revolving Tranche in accordance with its Pro Rata Share.

L/C Borrowing ” means an extension of credit resulting from a drawing under any Letter of Credit under any Revolving Tranche which has not been reimbursed by the Borrowers on the date required under Section  2.03(d)(i) or refinanced as a Revolving Credit Borrowing under such Revolving Tranche.

L/C Credit Extension ” means, with respect to any Letter of Credit, the issuance thereof or extension of the expiry date thereof, or the renewal or increase of the amount thereof.

L/C Issuer ” means (a) Royal Bank, in its capacity as an issuer of Letters of Credit hereunder and (b) any other Revolving Lender reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent that agrees to issue Letters of Credit pursuant hereto, in each case in its capacity as an issuer of Letters of Credit hereunder, or any successor issuer of Letters of Credit hereunder.

L/C Obligations ” means, as at any date of determination under any Revolving Tranche, the aggregate amount available to be drawn under all outstanding Letters of Credit under such Revolving Tranche plus the aggregate of all Unreimbursed Amounts, including all L/C Borrowings. For purposes of computing the amount available to be drawn under any Letter of Credit, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be determined in accordance with Section  1.08 . For all purposes of this Agreement, if on any date of determination a Letter of Credit has expired by its terms under such Revolving Tranche but any amount may still be drawn thereunder by reason of the operation of Rule 3.14 of the ISP, such Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be “outstanding” in the amount so remaining available to be drawn.

LDisc Acquisition Agreement ” has the meaning specified in the definition of LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment.

LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment ” means those certain earn-out payments for up to $12,500,000 due in each of 2017 and 2018 which may be required pursuant to that certain Equity Purchase Agreement (the “ LDisc Acquisition Agreement ”), dated as of November 23, 2015, by and among the LD Intermediate, LDisc Holdings, LLC, WVLD Acquisition Corp. Westview Capital Partners II, L.P. and the Selling Members (as defined therein). The amount of such earn-out payments shall be calculated (and for the avoidance of doubt, reduced in whole or in part) in a manner as set forth in the LDisc Acquisition Agreement and as agreed to between the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent.

LDiscovery Transactions ” means those transactions as contemplated by the LDisc Acquisition Agreement.

LD Intermediate ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

LD Lower ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Lender ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement and, as the context requires, includes each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender.

Lending Office ” means, as to any Lender, the office or offices of such Lender described as such in such Lender’s Administrative Questionnaire, or such other office or offices as a Lender may from time to time notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent.

 

-38-


Letter of Credit ” means any letter of credit issued hereunder. A Letter of Credit may be a commercial letter of credit or a standby letter of credit and may be issued on a sight basis only; provided that Royal Bank shall not, in any event, be obligated to issue commercial letters of credit.

Letter of Credit Application ” means an application and agreement for the issuance or amendment of a Letter of Credit in the form from time to time in use by the applicable L/C Issuer, together with a request for L/C Credit Extension, substantially in the form of Exhibit A-2 hereto.

Letter of Credit Expiration Date ” means, subject to Section  2.03(a)(ii)(C) , the day that is five Business Days prior to the scheduled Maturity Date then in effect for the applicable Revolving Tranche (or, if such day is not a Business Day, the next preceding Business Day).

Letter of Credit Individual Sublimit ” means $5,000,000 with respect to Royal Bank and with respect to any other L/C Issuer, such sublimit as agreed among such L/C Issuer, the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent.

Letter of Credit Sublimit ” means $5,000,000. The Letter of Credit Sublimit under any Revolving Tranche is part of, and not in addition to, the applicable Revolving Tranche.

LIBOR ” means, in relation to any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan:

(a) the applicable Screen Rate; or

(b) (if no Screen Rate is available for the Interest Period of that Loan) the Interpolated Screen Rate for that Loan; or

(c) if no Screen Rate is available for the Interest Period of that Loan and it is not possible to calculate an Interpolated Screen Rate for that Loan, the rate determined in accordance with Section  3.03 ,

As of, in the case of clauses (a) and (c) above, the 11:00 a.m. London time on the date that is two Business Days before the first day of such period, for deposits in the applicable currency with a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan.

Lien ” means any mortgage, pledge, hypothecation, collateral assignment, deposit arrangement, encumbrance having the effect of security, lien (statutory or other), charge, or preference, priority or other security interest or preferential arrangement of any kind or nature whatsoever (including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any Capitalized Lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing).

Limited Condition Acquisition ” means any acquisition, including by way of merger, amalgamation or consolidation, by one or more of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries of any assets, business or Person permitted by this Agreement whose consummation is not conditioned on the availability of, or on obtaining, third party acquisition financing and which is designated as a Limited Condition Acquisition by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in writing to the Administrative Agent and Lenders.

Loan ” means an extension of credit by a Lender to one or more of the Borrowers under Article II in the form of a Term Loan Tranche, a Revolving Credit Loan, a Specified Refinancing Revolving Loan or a Swing Line Loan.

 

-39-


Loan Documents ” means, collectively, (i) this Agreement, (ii) the Notes, (iii) the Guaranty, (iv) the Collateral Documents, (v) [reserved], (vi) the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, (vii) the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, (viii) any agreement creating or perfecting rights in Cash Collateral pursuant to the provisions of Section  2.16 of this Agreement, (ix) any Refinancing Amendment and (x) any joinder or amendment to any of the foregoing that is designated as a “Loan Document.”

Loan Parties ” means, collectively, the Borrowers and each Guarantor.

Majority Lenders ” means those Non-Defaulting Lenders that would constitute the Required Lenders under, and as defined in, this Agreement if all outstanding Obligations of the other Tranches under this Agreement were repaid in full and all Commitments with respect thereto were terminated.

Margin Stock ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the United States Federal Reserve System, or any successor thereto.

Material Adverse Effect ” means (a) a material adverse effect on the business, assets, property, liabilities (actual or contingent), financial condition or results of operations of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (b) a material adverse effect on the ability of the Loan Parties (taken as a whole) to perform their respective obligations under the Loan Documents, (c) a material adverse effect on the legality, validity or enforceability of the Loan Documents or (d) a material adverse effect on the rights and remedies of the Agents or the Lenders under the Loan Documents.

Material Real Property ” means any parcel of real property (other than a parcel with a fair market value of less than $5,000,000 at the Closing Date or, with respect to real property acquired after the Closing Date, at the time of acquisition, in each case, as reasonably estimated by the Borrowers in good faith) owned in fee by a Loan Party and located in the United States; provided , however , that one or more parcels owned in fee by a Loan Party and located adjacent to, contiguous with, or in close proximity to, and comprising one property with a common street address, may, in the reasonable discretion of the Administrative Agent, be deemed to be one parcel for the purposes of this definition.

Maturity Date ” means (a) with respect to the Revolving Tranche, the earlier of (i) the fifth anniversary of the Closing Date and (ii) the date of termination in whole of the Revolving Credit Commitments, the Letter of Credit Commitments and the Swing Line Loans pursuant to Section  2.06(a) or 8.02 and (b) with respect to the Initial Term Loans, the earliest of (i) the sixth anniversary of the Closing Date, (ii) the date of termination in whole of the applicable Initial Term Commitments pursuant to Section  2.06(a) prior to any Initial Term Borrowing and (iii) the date that the Initial Term Loans are declared due and payable pursuant to Section  8.02 ; provided that the reference to Maturity Date with respect to (i) Term Loans and Revolving Credit Commitments that are the subject of a loan modification offer pursuant to Section  10.01 and (ii) Term Loans and Revolving Credit Commitments that are incurred pursuant to Section  2.14 or 2.18 shall, in each case, be the final maturity date as specified in the loan modification documentation, incremental documentation, or specified refinancing documentation, as applicable thereto.

Maximum First Lien Net Leverage Requirement ” means, with respect to any request made in reliance on this definition under Article II for an increase in any Revolving Tranche or any Term Loan Tranche, for a New Term Facility or for the issuance of New Incremental Notes, the requirement that, on a Pro Forma Basis, after giving effect to such increase, such new Facility (assuming all commitments thereunder are fully drawn) or such New Incremental Notes (including, in each case, any acquisition consummated concurrently therewith), the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio as of the date of the most recent financial statements required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b)  does not exceed 3.75 to

 

-40-


1.00; provided that solely for the purpose of calculating the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio pursuant to this definition, any (i) Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.15 , and any Refinancing Notes (in the case of Refinancing Notes, to the extent that such Refinancing Notes refinance Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.15 ) and, in each case, whether or not such Indebtedness is unsecured or is secured by Liens that rank junior in priority to the Liens securing the Obligations, shall be deemed to constitute Funded First Lien Indebtedness and (ii) any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections  2.14 and 2.15 shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of this definition (however, to the extent the proceeds thereof are used to repay Indebtedness, Pro Forma Effect shall be given to such repayment of Indebtedness).

Maximum Rate ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.10 .

Moody’s ” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. and any successor thereto.

Mortgage ” means, collectively, the deeds of trust, trust deeds and mortgages in respect of Mortgaged Properties in the U.S. made by the Loan Parties in favor or for the benefit of the Collateral Agent on behalf of the Lenders in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, in each case as the same may be amended, amended and restated, extended, supplemented, substituted or otherwise modified from time to time.

Mortgage Policies ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.16(a)(ii) .

Mortgaged Properties ” means the parcels of real property identified on Schedule 5.08(b) and any other Material Real Property with respect to which a Mortgage is required pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Multiemployer Plan ” means a “multiemployer plan” as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA and subject to Title IV of ERISA, to which any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate makes or is obligated to make contributions.

Net Cash Proceeds ” means:

(a) with respect to the Disposition of any asset by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries or any Casualty Event, the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of cash and Cash Equivalents received in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (including any cash or Cash Equivalents received by way of deferred payment pursuant to, or by monetization of, a note receivable or otherwise, but only as and when so received and, with respect to any Casualty Event, any insurance proceeds or condemnation awards in respect of such Casualty Event received by or paid to or for the account of a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries and including any proceeds received as a result of unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection with such related transaction) over (ii) the sum of (A) the principal amount of any Indebtedness that is secured by the asset subject to such Disposition or Casualty Event and that is required to be repaid in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (other than (x) Indebtedness under the Loan Documents and, if such asset constitutes Collateral, any Indebtedness secured by such asset with a Lien ranking junior to the Liens securing the Obligations and (y) in the case of any New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes that are secured by Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with Liens securing the Obligations, if such asset constitutes Collateral any amounts in excess of the ratable portion (based on any then outstanding Term Loan Tranches and any then outstanding New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes that are secured by Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations) attributable to such New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes, as applicable), (B) the out-of-pocket

 

-41-


expenses incurred by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (including attorneys’ fees, accountants’ fees, investment banking fees, survey costs, title insurance premiums, and related search and recording charges, transfer Taxes, deed or mortgage recording Taxes, other customary expenses and brokerage, consultant and other customary fees actually incurred in connection therewith), (C) income Taxes reasonably estimated to be payable in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (or any Tax distribution the Borrowers make as a result of such Disposition or Casualty Event) and any repatriation costs associated with receipt or distribution by the applicable taxpayer of such proceeds, (D) any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection with such transaction, (E) any reserve for adjustment in respect of (x) the sale price of the property that is the subject of such Disposition established in accordance with GAAP and (y) any liabilities associated with such property and retained by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries after such Disposition, including pension and other post-employment benefit liabilities and liabilities related to environmental matters or against any indemnification obligations associated with such transaction, and (F) any customer deposits required to be returned as a result of such Disposition, and it being understood that “Net Cash Proceeds” shall include, without limitation, any cash or Cash Equivalents (i) received upon the Disposition of any non-cash consideration received by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries in any such Disposition and (ii) upon the reversal (without the satisfaction of any applicable liabilities in cash in a corresponding amount) of any reserve described in clause (E) above;

(b) with respect to the issuance of any Equity Interest by Holdings (or Parent Holding Company) or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, the excess of (i) the sum of the cash and Cash Equivalents received in connection with such issuance and in connection with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith over (ii) the investment banking fees, underwriting discounts, premiums, commissions, Taxes, other out-of-pocket expenses and other customary expenses and fees related thereto, incurred by Holdings (or Parent Holding Company) or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such issuance and any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith; and

(c) with respect to the incurrence or issuance of any Indebtedness by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of the cash received in connection with such incurrence or issuance and in connection with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith over (ii) the investment banking fees, underwriting discounts and commissions, premiums, expenses, accrued interest and fees related thereto, Taxes reasonably estimated to be payable and other out-of-pocket expenses and other customary expenses, incurred by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such incurrence or issuance and any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith and, in the case of Indebtedness of any Foreign Subsidiary, deductions in respect of withholding Taxes that are or would otherwise be payable in cash if such funds were repatriated to the United States.

Net Working Capital ” means, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, Consolidated Current Assets minus Consolidated Current Liabilities; provided that increases or decreases in Net Working Capital shall be calculated without regard to any changes in Consolidated Current Assets or Consolidated Current Liabilities as a result of (a) any reclassification in accordance with GAAP of assets or liabilities, as applicable, between current and noncurrent, (b) the effects of purchase accounting or (c) the effect of fluctuations in the amount of accrued or contingent obligations, assets or liabilities under Swap Contracts.

New Incremental Notes ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.15(a) .

 

-42-


New Incremental Notes Indentures ” means, collectively, the indentures or other similar agreements pursuant to which any New Incremental Notes are issued, together with all instruments and other agreements in connection therewith, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

New Loan Commitments ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

New Term Commitment ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

New Term Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

New Term Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

New York Time ” means with respect to any matters, including Agency Matters, the local time in New York City.

No Undisclosed Information Statement ” means, with respect to any Person, (i) a representation that such Person is not in possession of any material non-public information with respect to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries that has not been disclosed to the Lenders generally (other than those Lenders who have elected to not receive any non-public information with respect to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries), and if so disclosed could reasonably be expected to have a material effect upon, or otherwise be material to, the market price of the applicable Loan, or the decision of an assigning Lender to sell, or of an assignee to purchase, such Loan or, alternatively, (ii) a statement that such representation cannot be made.

Non-Consenting Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  3.07(c) .

Non-Defaulting Lender ” means any Lender other than a Defaulting Lender.

Non-U.S. Lender ” means a Lender that is not a U.S. Person.

Not Otherwise Applied ” means, with reference to any proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance or equity contribution that is proposed to be applied to a particular use or transaction (including incurring Indebtedness in reliance on Section  7.03(xix) ), that such amount has not previously been (and is not simultaneously being) applied to anything other than such particular use or transaction (including any application thereof as a Cure Right pursuant to Section  8.03 ).

Note ” means a Term Note, a Revolving Credit Note or the Swing Line Note, as the context may require.

NYFRB ” means the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

NYFRB Rate ” means, for any day, the greater of (a) the Federal Funds Rate in effect on such day and (b) the Overnight Bank Funding Rate in effect on such day (or for any day that is not a Business Day, for the immediately preceding Business Day); provided that if none of such rates are published for any day that is a Business Day, the term “NYFRB Rate” means the rate for a federal funds transaction quoted at 11:00 a.m. (New York City time) on such day received to the Administrative Agent from a Federal funds broker of recognized standing selected by it; provided, further , that if any of the aforesaid rates shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement.

 

-43-


Obligations ” means all advances to, and debts, liabilities, obligations, covenants and duties of, any Loan Party arising under any Loan Document or otherwise with respect to any Loan, Letter of Credit, Secured Cash Management Agreement or Secured Hedge Agreement, in each case whether direct or indirect (including those acquired by assumption), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising and including interest and fees that accrue after the commencement by or against any Loan Party of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Laws naming such Person as the debtor in such proceeding, regardless of whether such interest and fees are allowed claims in such proceeding; provided that (a) obligations of any Loan Party under any Secured Cash Management Agreement or Secured Hedge Agreement shall be secured and guaranteed pursuant to the Collateral Documents only to the extent that, and for so long as, the other Obligations are so secured and guaranteed and (b) any release of Collateral or Guarantors effected in the manner permitted by this Agreement shall not require the consent of holders of obligations under Secured Hedge Agreements or Secured Cash Management Agreements; provided , further , that the Obligations of any Loan Party shall not include any Excluded Swap Obligations of such Loan Party. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Obligations of the Loan Parties under the Loan Documents include (a) the obligation to pay principal, interest, Letter of Credit commissions, charges, expenses, fees, indemnities and other amounts payable by any Loan Party under any Loan Document and (b) the obligation of any Loan Party to reimburse any amount in respect of any of the foregoing pursuant to Section  10.04 .

Organization Documents ” means (a) with respect to any corporation, the certificate or articles of incorporation and the bylaws (or equivalent or comparable constitutive documents with respect to any non-U.S. jurisdiction), (b) with respect to any limited liability company, the certificate or articles of formation or organization and operating or limited liability company agreement (or equivalent or comparable constitutive documents with respect to any non-U.S. jurisdiction) and (c) with respect to any partnership, joint venture, trust or other form of business entity, the partnership, joint venture, trust or other applicable agreement of formation or organization and any agreement, instrument, filing or notice with respect thereto filed in connection with its formation or organization with the applicable Governmental Authority in the jurisdiction of its formation or organization and, if applicable, any certificate or articles of formation or organization of such entity.

Other Affiliate ” means the Sponsor and any Affiliate of the Sponsor, other than Holdings, any Subsidiary of Holdings and any natural person.

Other Taxes ” means all present or future stamp, court or documentary, intangible, recording, filing or similar Taxes that arise from any payment made under, from the execution, delivery, performance, enforcement or registration of, from the receipt or perfection of a security interest under, or otherwise with respect to, any Loan Document, except any such Taxes that are imposed with respect to an assignment or transfer of any Recipient’s rights (other than an assignment made pursuant to Section  3.07 ) (an “ Assignment Tax ”), but only to the extent such Assignment Taxes are imposed as a result of a present or former connection between the assignor or assignee and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than a connection arising from such assignor or assignee having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to and/or enforced any Loan Document).

Outstanding Amount ” means (a) with respect to the Term Loans, Revolving Credit Loans and Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans and Swing Line Loans on any date, the aggregate outstanding principal Dollar Equivalent thereof after giving effect to any borrowings and prepayments or repayments of the Term Loans, Revolving Credit Loans (including any refinancing of outstanding unpaid drawings under Letters of Credit or L/C Credit Extensions as a Revolving Credit Borrowing), Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans and Swing Line Loans, as the case may be, occurring on such date; and (b) with respect to any L/C Obligations with respect to any Tranche on any date, the Dollar Equivalent of

 

-44-


such L/C Obligations on such date after giving effect to any L/C Credit Extension with respect to such Tranche occurring on such date and any other changes in the aggregate amount of the L/C Obligations with respect to such Tranche as of such date, including as a result of any reimbursements of outstanding unpaid drawings under any Letters of Credit (including any refinancing of outstanding unpaid drawings under Letters of Credit or L/C Credit Extensions as a Revolving Credit Borrowing under such Tranche) or any reductions in the maximum amount available for drawing under Letters of Credit taking effect on such date.

Overnight Bank Funding Rate ” means, for any day, the rate comprised of both overnight federal funds and overnight eurodollar borrowings by U.S.-managed banking offices of depository institutions (as such composite rate shall be determined by the NYFRB as set forth on its public website from time to time) and published on the next succeeding Business Day by the NYFRB as an overnight bank funding rate (from and after such date as the NYFRB shall commence to publish such composite rate).

Parent Holding Company ” means any direct or indirect parent entity of Holdings that does not hold Equity Interests in any other Person (except for any other Parent Holding Company).

Participant ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(d) .

Participant Register ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(m) .

Party ” means a party to this Agreement.

PATRIOT Act ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.22 .

PBGC ” means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation.

Pension Funding Rules ” means the rules of the Code and ERISA regarding minimum required contributions (including any installment payment thereof) to Plans and set forth in, with respect to plan years ending prior to the effective date of the Pension Protection Act of 2006, Section 412 of the Code and Section 302 of ERISA, each as in effect prior to the Pension Protection Act of 2006 and, thereafter, Section 412, 430, 431, 432 and 436 of the Code and Sections 302, 303, 304 and 305 of ERISA.

Perfection Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit L , as may be amended or supplemented from time to time by a Perfection Certificate Supplement (as defined in the Security Agreement) or otherwise.

Perfection Exceptions ” means that no Loan Party shall be required to (i) enter into control agreements with respect to, or otherwise perfect any security interest by “control” (or similar arrangements) over securities accounts, deposit accounts, other bank accounts, cash and cash equivalents and accounts related to the clearing, payment processing and similar operations of such Loan Party, (ii) perfect the security interest in the following other than by the filing of a UCC financing statement: (1) letter-of-credit rights (as defined in the UCC), (2) commercial tort claims (as defined in the UCC) and (3) Fixtures (as defined in the UCC), except to the extent that the same are Equipment (as defined in the UCC) or are related to real property covered or intended by the Loan Documents to be covered by a Mortgage, (iii) so long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, send notices to account debtors or other contractual third-parties, (iv) enter into any security documents to be governed by the law of any jurisdiction in which assets are located (other than the United States or any state thereof), or (v) deliver landlord waivers, estoppels or collateral access letters.

 

-45-


Perfection Requirements ” means the making of appropriate registrations, filings, endorsements, notarizations, stamping and/or notifications of the Collateral Documents and/or the Collateral created under any other document required by the Collateral Documents.

Permitted Acquisition ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.02(i) .

Permitted Acquisition Provisions ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(d) .

Permitted Encumbrances ” has the meaning specified in the Mortgages.

Permitted Equity Issuance ” means any sale or issuance of any Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of Holdings, the proceeds of which are contributed to the ordinary equity of a Borrower.

Permitted Holders ” means the collective reference to (a) Permitted Transferees and (b) the Sponsor and their respective Control Investment Affiliates (but excluding any operating portfolio companies of the foregoing), managers and members of management of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) and its Subsidiaries that have ownership interests in Holdings (or such Parent Holding Company), and one or more third-party co-investors identified to the Arrangers by the Sponsor prior to the Closing Date (it being understood any such managers or members of management and third-party co-investors shall only constitute “Permitted Holders” to the extent that the ownership interests held by any such managers or members of management and third-party co-investors collectively are less than the ownership interests held by the Sponsor, with any excess ownership interests being excluded from the ownership deemed held by Permitted Holders for purposes of determining whether a Change of Control has occurred).

Permitted Ratio Debt ” means (i) unsecured Indebtedness, (ii) secured Indebtedness secured by a Lien ranking pari passu to the Liens securing the Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary, (iii) secured Indebtedness secured by a Lien junior to the Liens securing the Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and either junior to or pari passu with the Liens securing the obligations under the Second Lien Facility or (iv) Indebtedness of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary that is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations; provided , in each case, that immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect thereto and to the use of the proceeds thereof, (i) (A) in the case of Permitted Ratio Debt incurred to finance a Permitted Acquisition, other permitted Investment or other acquisition, no Event of Default shall exist on the date that the applicable Borrower or the applicable Restricted Subsidiary enters into a binding agreement with respect to such transaction and no Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , 8.01(f) or 8.01(g) shall be continuing or result therefrom or (B) in all other cases, no Event of Default shall be continuing or result therefrom, (ii) the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries will be in Pro Forma Compliance with the Financial Covenant (whether or not then in effect) and (iii) (A) in the case of unsecured Permitted Ratio Debt, the Total Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00 or (B), in the case of secured Permitted Ratio Debt, (x) the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 3.75 to 1.00 if such secured Permitted Ratio Debt is ranked pari passu to the Obligations or (y) the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) no greater than 5.25 to 1.00 for all other secured Permitted Ratio Debt and (iv) with respect to any incurrence of Permitted Ratio Debt, any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xx) shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of such incurrence. Additionally, any Permitted Ratio Debt that is secured by a Lien ranking pari passu to the Liens securing the Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) if such Indebtedness is in the form of loans, shall be subject to the “MFN” requirements in Section  2.14(f)(iii)

 

-46-


( mutatis mutandis ) and (y) shall be subject ( mutatis mutandis ) to the applicable limitations on terms applicable to New Term Facilities in Section  2.14 (if such Permitted Ratio Debt is in the form of loans) or shall be subject ( mutatis mutandis ) to the applicable limitations on terms applicable to New Incremental Notes in Section  2.15 (if such Permitted Ratio Debt is in the form of bonds or other securities).

Permitted Refinancing ” means, with respect to any Person, any modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension of any Indebtedness of such Person; provided that (a) the principal amount (or accreted value, if applicable) thereof does not exceed the principal amount (or accreted value, if applicable) of the Indebtedness so modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended except by an amount equal to accrued and unpaid interest and a reasonable premium thereon plus other reasonable amounts paid, and fees and expenses reasonably incurred (including original issue discount and upfront fees), in connection with such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension and by an amount equal to any existing commitments unutilized thereunder; (b) other than with respect to Section  7.03(b)(v) , such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension has a final maturity date equal to or later than the final maturity date of, and has a Weighted Average Life to Maturity equal to or greater than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended; (c) if the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations, such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations on terms, taken as a whole, as favorable in all material respects to the Lenders (including, if applicable, as to Collateral) as those contained in the documentation governing the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended or otherwise acceptable to the Administrative Agent; (d) if the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended is (i) unsecured, such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is unsecured, or (ii) if secured by Liens on the Collateral, such modification, refinancing, refunding, replacement, renewal or extension is secured to the same extent, including with respect to any subordination provisions, and in each case, subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements; (e) the terms and conditions (including, if applicable, as to collateral) of any such modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended (other than to the extent permitted by any other clause of this definition or with respect to interest rate, optional prepayment premiums and optional redemption provisions) Indebtedness are, either (i) substantially identical to or less favorable to the investors providing such Permitted Refinancing, taken as a whole, than the terms and conditions of the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended, (ii) when taken as a whole (other than interest rate, prepayment premiums and redemption premiums), not more restrictive to Holdings, the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries than those set forth in this Agreement or are customary for similar indebtedness in light of current market conditions ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such Indebtedness, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Indebtedness or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set out in this clause (e), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)), in each case, except for terms and conditions only applicable to periods after the Latest Maturity Date; (f) such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is incurred by the Person who is or would have been permitted to be the obligor or guarantor (or any successor thereto) on the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced or extended (it being understood that the roles of such obligors as a borrower or a guarantor with respect to such obligations may be interchanged); and (g) at the time thereof, other than with respect to a Permitted Refinancing in respect of Indebtedness pursuant to Sections  7.03(b)(v) and (b)(vii) , no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

 

-47-


Permitted Surviving Debt ” means certain Indebtedness set forth on Schedule 7.03 that the Arrangers and the Borrowers have agreed may remain outstanding as of the Closing Date with respect to the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries.

Permitted Transferee ” means, in the case of any member of management, (i) his or her executor, administrator, testamentary trustee, legatee or beneficiaries, (ii) his or her spouse, parents, siblings, members of his or her immediate family (including adopted children and step children) and/or direct lineal descendants or (iii) a trust, the beneficiaries of which, or a corporation or partnership, the stockholders or partners of which, include only a member of management and his or her spouse, parents, siblings, members of his or her immediate family (including adopted children) and/or direct lineal descendants (in each case, for so long as the ownership interests held by such persons are less than the ownership interests held by Sponsor).

Person ” means any natural person, corporation, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, partnership, Governmental Authority or other entity.

Plan ” means any “employee benefit plan” (other than a Multiemployer Plan) within the meaning of Section 3(3) of ERISA that is maintained or is contributed to by a Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate and is subject to Title IV of ERISA or the minimum funding standards under Sections 412 or 430 of the Code or Sections 302 or 303 of ERISA.

Platform ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

Pledged Debt ” means “Pledged Debt” (or equivalent term) as defined in each applicable Collateral Document.

Pledged Interests ” means “Pledged Interests” or “Pledged Equity” (or equivalent term) as defined in each applicable Collateral Document.

Pounds Sterling ” or “ £ ” means British Pounds Sterling (GBP) or any successor currency in the United Kingdom.

Prepayment Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Prepayment Date ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Prepay Incremental Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Prime Rate ” means the rate of interest per annum determined by Royal Bank from time to time as its prime commercial lending rate for United States Dollar loans in the United States for such day. The Prime Rate is not necessarily the lowest rate that Royal Bank is charging any corporate customer.

Pro Forma Basis ,” “ Pro Forma Compliance ” and “ Pro Forma Effect ” means, in respect of a Specified Transaction, that such Specified Transaction and the following transactions in connection therewith (to the extent applicable) shall be deemed to have occurred as of the first day of the applicable period of measurement for the applicable covenant or requirement on the basis of the financial information most recently delivered to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) : (a) historical income statement items (whether positive or negative) attributable to

 

-48-


the property or Person, if any, subject to such Specified Transaction shall be (i) excluded (in the case of a Disposition of all or substantially all Equity Interests in any Restricted Subsidiary or any division, product line or facility used for operations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary or a designation of a Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary) and (ii) included (in the case of a purchase or other acquisition of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of any Person, or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or of all or substantially all of the Equity Interests in a Person or a designation of a Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary), (b) in the event that a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary incurs (including by assumption or guarantees) or repays (including by redemption, repayment, retirement, discharge, defeasance or extinguishment) any Indebtedness included in the calculations of any financial ratio or test (in each case, other than Indebtedness incurred or repaid under any revolving credit facility in the ordinary course of business for working capital purposes), (i) during the applicable measurement period or (ii) subsequent to the end of the applicable measurement period and prior to or simultaneously with the event for which the calculation of any such ratio is made, then such financial ratio or test shall be calculated giving pro forma effect to such incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness, to the extent required, as if the same had occurred on the last day of the applicable measurement period; provided that (A) Pro Forma Basis, Pro Forma Compliance and Pro Forma Effect in respect of any Specified Transaction shall be calculated in a reasonable and factually supportable manner and certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers and (B) any such calculation shall be subject to the applicable limitations set forth in Section  1.09 ; provided , further , that at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma financial information of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule 1.01(f) hereto.

Pro Rata Share ” means, with respect to each Lender and any Facility or all the Facilities or any Tranche or all the Tranches (as the case may be) at any time, a fraction (expressed as a percentage, carried out to the ninth decimal place, and subject to adjustment as provided in Section  2.17 ), the numerator of which is the amount of the Commitments of such Lender under the applicable Facility or the Facilities or Tranche or Tranches (and, in the case of any Term Loan Tranche after the applicable borrowing date and without duplication, the outstanding principal amount of Term Loans under such Tranche, of such Lender, at such time) at such time and the denominator of which is the amount of the Aggregate Commitments under the applicable Facility or the Facilities or Tranche or Tranches at such time (and, in the case of any Term Loan Tranche and without duplication, the outstanding principal amount of Term Loans under such Tranche, at such time); provided that if the commitment of each Lender to make Loans and the obligation of each L/C Issuer to make L/C Credit Extensions have been terminated pursuant to Section  8.02 , then the Pro Rata Share of each Lender shall be determined based on the Pro Rata Share of such Lender immediately prior to such termination and after giving effect to any subsequent assignments made pursuant to the terms hereof. The initial Pro Rata Share of each Lender is set forth opposite the name of such Lender on Schedule 2.01 or in the Assignment and Assumption pursuant to which such Lender became a party hereto, as applicable.

Public Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness ” means unsecured Indebtedness of Holdings (A) that is not subject to any Guarantee by any Subsidiary of Holdings, (B) that will not mature prior to the date that is 91 days after the Latest Maturity Date of any Term Loan Tranche in effect on the date of issuance or incurrence thereof, (C) that has no scheduled amortization or scheduled payments of principal and is not subject to mandatory redemption, repurchase, prepayment or sinking fund obligation (it being understood that such Indebtedness may have mandatory prepayment, repurchase or redemption provisions satisfying the requirements of clause (D) below) and (D) that has mandatory prepayment, repurchase or redemption, covenant, default and remedy provisions customary for senior notes (or no more restrictive than is customary) of an issuer that is the parent of a borrower under senior secured credit facilities, and in

 

-49-


any event, with respect to covenant, default and remedy provisions, no more restrictive (taken as a whole) than those set forth in this Agreement (other than provisions customary for senior notes of a holding company, including (x) customary assets sale, change of control provisions and customary acceleration rights after an event of default and (y) customary “AHYDO” payments); provided that the Borrowers shall have delivered a certificate of a Responsible Officer to the Administrative Agent at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such Indebtedness, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Indebtedness or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have reasonably determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the foregoing requirement (and such certificate shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy the foregoing requirement unless the Administrative Agent notifies the Borrower Representative within such five Business Day period that it disagrees with such determination (including a reasonably detailed description of the basis upon which it disagrees)); provided , further , that any such Indebtedness shall constitute Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness only if immediately after giving effect to the issuance or incurrence thereof and the use of proceeds thereof, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Qualified IPO ” means the issuance by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company of its common Equity Interests in an underwritten primary public offering (other than a public offering pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-8), resulting in such Equity Interests being listed on a nationally recognized stock exchange in the applicable jurisdiction.

Ratio-Based Incremental Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Recipient ” means the Administrative Agent, any Lender, any L/C Issuer, and any Swing Line Lender, or any other recipient of any payment to be made by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document, as applicable.

Refinancing ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions”.

Refinancing Amendment ” means an amendment to this Agreement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent, among the Borrowers, the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Lenders providing Specified Refinancing Debt, effecting the incurrence of such Specified Refinancing Debt in accordance with Section  2.18 .

Refinancing Notes ” means one or more series of senior unsecured notes, or senior secured notes secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations, or on a junior basis to the Facilities (and on a pari passu or junior Lien basis to the Second Lien Facility), in each case issued by one or more Borrower in respect of a refinancing of outstanding Indebtedness of such Borrower or Borrowers under any one or more Term Loan Tranches; provided that (a) if such Refinancing Notes shall be secured, (i) then such Refinancing Notes shall only be secured by a security interest in the Collateral that secured the Term Loan Tranche being refinanced, and (ii) then such Refinancing Notes shall be issued subject to the Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements; (b) no Refinancing Notes shall (i) mature prior to the Latest Maturity Date with respect to Term Loans then in effect immediately after giving effect to such refinancing or (ii) be subject to any amortization prior to the final maturity thereof, or be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except (x) customary assets sale, change of control or event of loss or similar event provisions and a customary acceleration right after an event of default or (y) “AHYDO” payments); (c) the covenants, events of default, guarantees, collateral and other terms of such Refinancing Notes are customary for similar debt securities in light of then-prevailing market conditions at the time of issuance (it being understood that no Refinancing Notes shall include any financial maintenance covenants (including indirectly by way of a cross-default to this Agreement), but that customary cross-acceleration provisions

 

-50-


may be included and that any negative covenants with respect to indebtedness, investments, liens or restricted payments shall be incurrence-based) and in any event are not more favorable to the investors providing such Refinancing Notes, when taken as a whole, than the terms of the Indebtedness being refinanced by such Refinancing Notes (other than with respect to interest rate, prepayment premiums and optional redemption provisions), except for covenants or other provisions (x) applicable only to periods after the Latest Maturity Date then in effect immediately after giving effect to such refinancing or (y) otherwise acceptable to the Administrative Agent ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such Refinancing Notes, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Refinancing Notes or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set forth in this clause (c), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)); (d) such Refinancing Notes may not have obligors and Liens that are more extensive than those which apply to the Term Loans under this Agreement (it being understood that the roles of such obligors as a borrower or a guarantor with respect to such obligations may be interchanged); and (e) the Net Cash Proceeds of such Refinancing Notes shall be applied, substantially concurrently with the incurrence thereof, to the pro rata prepayment of outstanding Term Loans under the applicable Term Loan Tranche being so refinanced and the payment of fees, expenses and premiums, if any, payable in connection therewith.

Refinancing Notes Indentures ” means, collectively, the indentures or other similar agreements pursuant to which any Refinancing Notes are issued, together with all instruments and other agreements in connection therewith, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

Register ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(c) .

Regulation S-X ” means Regulation S-X under the Securities Act.

Related Parties ” means, with respect to any Person, such Person’s Affiliates and the partners, members, directors, managers, officers, employees, agents, attorneys-in-fact, trustees and advisors of such Person and of such Person’s Affiliates.

Relevant Transaction ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b)(ii) .

Replaceable Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  3.07(a) .

Reportable Event ” means any of the events set forth in Section 4043(c) of ERISA, other than events for which the 30-day notice period has been waived.

Repricing Event ” means (i) any prepayment or repayment of the Initial Term Loans, in whole or in part, with the proceeds of, or conversion of any portion of such Initial Term Loans into, any new or replacement tranche of syndicated term loans bearing interest with an All-In Yield less than the All-In Yield applicable to such portion of the Initial Term Loans (as such comparative yields are determined in the reasonable judgment of the Administrative Agent consistent with generally accepted financial practices) and (ii) any amendment to the Facility with respect to the Initial Term Loans that reduces the All-In Yield applicable to the Initial Term Loans, but in either such case, excluding any event described in clauses (i) and (ii) that is not consummated for the primary purpose of lowering the effective interest cost or weighted average yield applicable to the Initial Term Loans, including, without limitation, any new or replacement loans incurred in connection with a Change of Control, a Qualified IPO, or a Transformative Acquisition.

 

-51-


Request for Credit Extension ” means (a) with respect to a Borrowing, conversion or continuation of Loans, a Committed Loan Notice, (b) with respect to an L/C Credit Extension, a Letter of Credit Application and (c) with respect to a Swing Line Loan, a Swing Line Loan Notice.

Required Lenders ” means, as of any date of determination, Lenders having more than 50% of the sum of the (a) Total Outstandings (with the aggregate amount of each Lender’s risk participation and funded participation in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans being deemed “held” by such Lender for purposes of this definition), (b) aggregate unused Term Commitments and (c) aggregate unused Revolving Credit Commitments; provided that the unused Term Commitments of, unused Revolving Credit Commitment of, and the portion of the Total Outstandings held or deemed held by, (x) any Defaulting Lender shall be excluded for purposes of making a determination of Required Lenders and (y) any Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall be deemed to have voted in the same proportion as Lenders that are not Affiliate Lenders vote on such matter.

Required Revolving Lenders ” means, as of any date of determination, Revolving Credit Lenders holding more than 50% of the sum of the (a) Total Revolving Credit Outstandings (with the aggregate amount of each Revolving Credit Lender’s risk participation and funded participation in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans being deemed “held” by such Revolving Credit Lender for purposes of this definition) and (b) aggregate unused Revolving Credit Commitments; provided that the unused Revolving Credit Commitment of, and the portion of the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings held or deemed held by, any Defaulting Lender shall be excluded for purposes of making a determination of Required Revolving Lenders.

Responsible Officer ” means the chief executive officer, representative, director, manager, president, vice president, executive vice president, chief financial officer, treasurer or assistant treasurer, secretary or assistant secretary, an authorized signatory, an attorney-in-fact (to the extent empowered by the board of directors/managers of Holdings or the Borrowers), or other similar officer of a Loan Party. Any document delivered hereunder that is signed by a Responsible Officer of a Loan Party shall be conclusively presumed to have been authorized by all necessary corporate, partnership and/or other action on the part of such Loan Party and such Responsible Officer shall be conclusively presumed to have acted on behalf of such Loan Party.

Restricted Payment ” means any dividend or other distribution (whether in cash, securities or other property) with respect to any Equity Interest of any Person, or any payment (whether in cash, securities or other property), including any sinking fund or similar deposit, on account of the purchase, redemption, retirement, defeasance, acquisition, cancellation or termination of any such Equity Interest, or on account of any return of capital to such Person’s stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent Persons thereof).

Restricted Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of Holdings that is not an Unrestricted Subsidiary, which for the avoidance of doubt shall include the Borrowers.

Revolving Commitment Increase Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(e) .

Revolving Credit Borrowing ” means a borrowing of any Revolving Tranche consisting of simultaneous Revolving Credit Loans of the same Type and, in the case of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, having the same Interest Period made by each of the Revolving Credit Lenders under such Revolving Tranche pursuant to Section  2.01(b) .

 

-52-


Revolving Credit Commitment ” means, as to any Revolving Credit Lender, its obligation, if any, to (a) make Revolving Credit Loans to one or more Borrower pursuant to Section  2.01(b) and (b) purchase participations in L/C Obligations of the Revolving Tranche, in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the amount set forth under the heading “Revolving Credit Commitment” opposite such Lender’s name on Schedule 2.01 , or in the Assignment and Assumption pursuant to which such Lender became a party hereto, as applicable, as the same may be adjusted from time to time in accordance with this Agreement. The Revolving Credit Commitments shall include all Revolving Credit Commitment Increases and Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments. The aggregate Revolving Credit Commitment is $30,000,000 on the Closing Date, as such amount may be adjusted from time to time in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

Revolving Credit Commitment Increase ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Revolving Credit Facility ” means the aggregate amount of the Revolving Credit Lenders’ Revolving Credit Commitments at such time.

Revolving Credit Lender ” means, at any time, any Lender that has a Revolving Credit Commitment at such time (and after the termination of all Revolving Credit Commitments, any Lender that holds any Outstanding Amount in respect of Revolving Credit Loans, Swing Line Loans and/or L/C Obligations).

Revolving Credit Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.01(b) .

Revolving Credit Note ” means a promissory note of the Borrowers payable to any Revolving Credit Lender or its registered assigns, in substantially the form of Exhibit B-1 hereto, evidencing the aggregate indebtedness of the Borrowers to such Revolving Credit Lender resulting from the Revolving Credit Loans made by such Revolving Credit Lender.

Revolving Tranche ” means (a) means the Tranche of the Revolving Credit Facility pursuant to which Revolving Credit Loans or Letters of Credit are made under the Revolving Credit Commitments and (b) any Specified Refinancing Debt constituting revolving credit facility commitments, in each case, including the extensions of credit made thereunder.

Royal Bank ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Same Day Funds ” means disbursements and payments in immediately available funds.

Sanctions Laws and Regulations ” means (i) any sanctions or requirements imposed by, or based upon the obligations or authorities set forth in, the PATRIOT Act, the Executive Order No. 13224 of September 23, 2001, entitled Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten to Commit, or Support Terrorism (66 Fed. Reg. 49079 (2001)), the U.S. International Emergency Economic Powers Act (50 U.S.C. §§ 1701 et seq.), the U.S. Trading with the Enemy Act (50 U.S.C. App. §§ 1 et seq.), the U.S. Syria Accountability and Lebanese Sovereignty Act, the U.S. Comprehensive Iran Sanctions, Accountability, and Divestment Act of 2010 or the Iran Sanctions Act, Section 1245 of the National Defense Authorization Act of 2012, all as amended, or any of the foreign assets control regulations (including but not limited to 31 C.F.R., Subtitle B, Chapter V, as amended) or any other law or executive order relating thereto administered by the U.S. Department of the Treasury Office of Foreign Assets Control, and any similar law, regulation, or executive order enacted in the

 

-53-


United States after the date of this Agreement and (ii) any sanctions or requirements imposed under similar laws or regulations enacted by the European Union, any member state thereof or the United Kingdom (including, without limitation, by Her Majesty’s Treasury) that apply to a Borrower or the Restricted Subsidiaries.

S&P ” means Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and any successor thereto.

Screen Rate ” means in relation to LIBOR, the London interbank offered rate administered by the ICE Benchmark Administration Limited (or any other person which takes over the administration of that rate) for the relevant currency and period displayed on pages LIBOR1 or LIBOR02 of the Reuters screen (or any replacement Reuters page which displays that rate) or, in each case, on the appropriate page of such other information service which publishes that rate from time to time in place of Reuters; provided that, if the Screen Rate shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement. If such page or service ceases to be available, the Administrative Agent may specify another page or service displaying the relevant rate after consultation with the Borrowers.

SEC ” means the Securities and Exchange Commission, or any Governmental Authority succeeding to any of its principal functions.

Second Lien Additional Indebtedness ” shall mean, collectively, any Second Lien Incremental Loans and any Second Lien Incremental Notes.

Second Lien Administrative Agent ” shall mean Royal Bank in its capacity as administrative agent and collateral agent under the Second Lien Facility Documentation, or any successor administrative agent and collateral agent under the Second Lien Credit Agreement.

Second Lien Credit Agreement ” shall mean that certain second lien credit agreement, dated as of the date hereof, among Holdings, the Borrowers, the lenders party thereto from time to time and the Second Lien Administrative Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, modified, supplemented, extended, increased, or refinanced or replaced pursuant to a Permitted Refinancing from time to time in one or more agreements (in each case with the same or new lenders, investors or agents), in each case as and to the extent permitted by this Agreement and the Intercreditor Agreement.

Second Lien Credit Agreement Refinancing Indebtedness ” shall mean “Specified Refinancing Debt” (including Specified Refinancing Term Loans) and “Refinancing Notes” (or any comparable term), each as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement (as in effect on the Closing Date, as the same may be subsequently amended or restated in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement).

Second Lien Facility ” shall mean the second lien term loan facility under the Second Lien Credit Agreement.

Second Lien Facility Documentation ” shall mean the Second Lien Credit Agreement and all security agreements, guarantees, pledge agreements, notes and other agreements or instruments executed in connection therewith, including all “Loan Documents” (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement).

Second Lien Incremental Notes ” shall mean the “New Incremental Notes” as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement.

 

-54-


Second Lien Incremental Loans ” shall mean the “New Term Loans” or any “Term Commitment Increase”, each as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement.

Second Lien Loans ” shall have the meaning provided to the term “Loans” (or any equivalent thereto) in the Second Lien Credit Agreement.

Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness ” shall mean the Second Lien Loans, any Second Lien Additional Indebtedness, any Second Lien Credit Agreement Refinancing Indebtedness and any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof.

Secured Cash Management Agreement ” means any Cash Management Agreement that is entered into by and between any Loan Party and any Cash Management Bank, except for any such Cash Management Agreement designated by the Borrower Representative and such Cash Management Bank in writing to the Administrative Agent as an “unsecured cash management agreement” as of the Closing Date or, if later, as of the time of entering into such Cash Management Agreement.

Secured Hedge Agreement ” means any Swap Contract permitted under Article VII that is entered into by and between any Loan Party and any Hedge Bank, except for any such Swap Contract designated by the Borrower Representative and such Hedge Bank in writing to the Administrative Agent as an “unsecured hedge agreement” as of the Closing Date or, if later, as of the time of entering into such Swap Contract.

Secured Obligations ” has the meaning specified in the applicable Collateral Document.

Secured Parties ” means, collectively, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, the Lenders, the Hedge Banks to the extent they are party to one or more Secured Hedge Agreements, the Cash Management Banks to the extent they are party to one or more Secured Cash Management Agreements and each co-agent or subagent appointed by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent from time to time pursuant to Article IX .

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Security Agreement ” means, collectively, the Security Agreement dated as of the Closing Date executed by the Loan Parties party thereto, substantially in the form of Exhibit G , together with each other security agreement and security agreement supplement executed and delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 , 6.14 or 6.16 .

Security Agreement Supplement ” has the meaning specified in the Security Agreement.

Seller ” has the meaning specified in the Acquisition Agreement.

Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded Senior Secured Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries.

Shared Debt Cap ” means, at any time, (a) the greater of (i) $30,000,000 and (ii) 35% of Consolidated EBITDA, less (b) the amount of any Indebtedness then outstanding and incurred in reliance on the Shared Debt Cap.

 

-55-


Solvent ” and “ Solvency ” mean, with respect to any Person on any date of determination, that on such date (i) the sum of the debt (including contingent liabilities) of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, does not exceed the present fair value of the assets of the Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (ii) the sum of the debt (including contingent liabilities) of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, does not exceed the present fair saleable value (on a going concern basis) of the assets of the Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole; (iii) the capital of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, is not unreasonably small in relation to the business of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, contemplated as of such date; and (iv) such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, do not intend to incur, or believe that they will incur, debts including current obligations beyond their ability to pay such debt as they mature in the ordinary course of business. For the purposes hereof, the amount of any contingent liability at any time shall be computed as the amount that, in light of all of the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured liability (irrespective of whether such contingent liabilities meet the criteria for accrual under Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 5).

SPC ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(g) .

Specified Acquisition Agreement Representations ” means the representations in the Acquisition Agreement made with respect to the Company and its Subsidiaries that are material to the interests of the Lenders, but only to the extent that Holdings, a Borrower or any Affiliate thereof has the right to terminate its obligations under the Acquisition Agreement, or the right to decline to consummate the Acquisition, as a result of a breach of such representations in the Acquisition Agreement.

Specified Refinancing Agent ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Debt ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitment ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans ” means Specified Refinancing Debt constituting revolving loans.

Specified Refinancing Term Commitment ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Term Loans ” means Specified Refinancing Debt constituting term loans.

Specified Representations ” means those representations and warranties of the Borrowers and Holdings and of the other Guarantors (solely with respect to the Subsidiary Guarantee) set forth in Sections 5.01 , 5.02(a) , 5.04 , 5.13 , 5.17 , 5.18 and 5.19 (limited, in the case of clauses (b) and (c) of such Section  5.19 to the provisions thereof relating to the use of proceeds of the Loans).

Specified Transaction ” means any incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness (excluding Indebtedness incurred for working capital purposes other than pursuant to this Agreement) or Investment that results in a Person becoming a Subsidiary, any designation of a Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary or as an Unrestricted Subsidiary, any Permitted Acquisition or any Disposition that results in a Restricted Subsidiary ceasing to be a Subsidiary of a Borrower, any Investment constituting an acquisition of assets constituting a business unit, line of business or division of another Person or any Disposition of a business unit, line of business or division of a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case whether by merger, consolidation, amalgamation or otherwise or any material restructuring of the Borrowers or implementation of any initiative (including cost saving, operating expense reduction not in the ordinary course of business.

 

-56-


Sponsor ” means CEOF II DE AIV, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership or each of its Control Investment Affiliates (but excluding any operating portfolio companies of the foregoing).

Sponsor Model ” means the model delivered to each of the Arrangers on or about October 6, 2016 (together with any updates or modifications thereto reasonably agreed between the Sponsor and the Arrangers or as necessary to reflect an exercise of “market flex” pursuant to the Fee Letter and, to the extent not reflected in the Sponsor Model, any original issue discount).

Statutory Reserve Rate ” means a fraction (expressed as a decimal), the numerator of which is the number one and the denominator of which is the number one minus the aggregate of the maximum reserve percentage (including any marginal, special, emergency or supplemental reserves) expressed as a decimal established by the FRB to which the Administrative Agent is subject with respect to the Eurodollar Rate, for eurocurrency funding (currently referred to as “Eurocurrency Liabilities” in Regulation D of the FRB). Such reserve percentage shall include those imposed pursuant to such Regulation D. Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be deemed to constitute eurocurrency funding and to be subject to such reserve requirements without benefit of or credit for proration, exemptions or offsets that may be available from time to time to any Lender under such Regulation D or any comparable regulation. The Statutory Reserve Rate shall be adjusted automatically on and as of the effective date of any change in any reserve percentage.

Subsidiary ” of a Person means a corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other business entity (a) of which a majority of the shares of securities or other Equity Interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors, managers or other governing body (other than securities or interests having such power only by reason of the happening of a contingency) are at the time beneficially owned, or (b) the management of which is otherwise controlled, directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, or both, by such Person and, in the case of this clause (b), which is treated as a consolidated subsidiary for accounting purposes. Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to a “Subsidiary” or to “Subsidiaries” shall refer to a Subsidiary or Subsidiaries of a Borrower.

Subsidiary Guarantor ” means, collectively, the Restricted Subsidiaries of Holdings that are Guarantors.

Subsidiary Guaranty ” means, collectively, the Subsidiary Guaranty made by the Subsidiary Guarantors in favor of the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Secured Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit F-2 , together with each other guaranty and guaranty supplement delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Successor Company ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.04(h) .

Swap Contract ” means (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, and

 

-57-


(b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement, including any obligations or liabilities under any such master agreement.

Swap Obligation ” means, with respect to any Guarantor, any obligation to pay or perform under any agreement, contract or transaction that constitutes a “swap” within the meaning of section 1a(47) of the Commodity Exchange Act.

Swap Termination Value ” means, in respect of any one or more Swap Contracts, after taking into account the effect of any legally enforceable netting agreement relating to such Swap Contracts, (a) for any date on or after the date such Swap Contracts have been closed out and termination value(s) determined in accordance therewith, such termination value(s), and (b) for any date prior to the date referenced in clause (a), the amount(s) determined as the mark-to-market value(s) for such Swap Contracts, as determined based upon one or more mid-market or other readily available quotations provided by any recognized dealer in such Swap Contracts (which may include a Lender or any Affiliate of a Lender).

Swing Line Borrowing ” means a borrowing of a Swing Line Loan pursuant to Section  2.04 .

Swing Line Facility ” means the revolving credit facility made available by the Swing Line Lender pursuant to Section  2.04 .

Swing Line Lender ” means Royal Bank in its capacity as provider of Swing Line Loans, or any successor swing line lender hereunder.

Swing Line Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.04(a) .

Swing Line Loan Notice ” means a notice of a Swing Line Borrowing pursuant to Section  2.04(b) , which, if in writing, shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A-3 .

Swing Line Note ” means a promissory note of the Borrower payable to the Swing Line Lender or its registered assigns, in substantially the form of Exhibit C-3 hereto, evidencing the aggregate indebtedness of the Borrower to the Swing Line Lender resulting from the Swing Line Loans made by the Swing Line Lender.

Swing Line Sublimit ” means an amount equal to the lesser of (a) $5,000,000 and (b) the Revolving Credit Facility. The Swing Line Sublimit is part of, and not in addition to, the Revolving Credit Facility.

Syndication Agent ” means TD Securities (USA) LLC, in its capacity as syndication agent.

Synthetic Lease Obligation ” means the monetary obligation of a Person under a so-called synthetic, off-balance sheet or tax retention lease as determined pursuant GAAP.

Target Companies ” means each of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries, as defined in the Acquisition Agreement.

Target Company Material Adverse Effect ” means any event, change, occurrence, circumstance or effect that has had or would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a material adverse change in, or effect on, the business, assets, properties, financial condition or results of operations

 

-58-


of the Company Entities, taken as a whole; provided that any such change or effect to the extent resulting from any of the following, individually or in the aggregate, shall not be considered when determining whether a Material Adverse Effect has occurred: (i) any change in economic conditions generally or capital and financial markets generally, including changes in interest or exchange rates, (ii) any industry wide change in the industry in which the Business operates or in which products of the Business are used or distributed, (iii) any change in Laws or GAAP, or the enforcement or interpretation thereof, applicable to the Business after the date hereof, (iv) political conditions in jurisdictions in which the Business operates, including hostilities, acts of war, sabotage, terrorism or military actions, or any escalation or worsening of any of the foregoing, (v) any change resulting from the execution, announcement or consummation of the transactions contemplated by, or the performance of express obligations under, this Agreement or the Ancillary Agreements, including any such change resulting from the identity of, or facts and circumstances relating to, Buyer; provided that this clause (v) does not apply to any representation or warranty made in Section 2.2, Section 2.3, Section 2.15(c)(ii) or Section 2.15(c)(iii) (in each case, of the Acquisition Agreement) (or any condition to Closing as it relates to either such representation or warranty), (vi) any action taken by Buyer and any of its Affiliates, agents or representatives, (vii) any hurricane, flood, tornado, earthquake or other natural disaster or any other force majeure event, (viii) any actions required to be taken or omitted pursuant to this Agreement or the Ancillary Agreements, (ix) the failure of the Business to achieve any financial projections or forecasts (provided that the cause or basis for the Company Entities failing to meet such projections or forecasts may be considered in determining the existence of a Material Adverse Effect unless such cause or basis is otherwise excluded by this definition) or (x) any matter set forth in the Seller Disclosure Letter, other than, in each case, to the extent any such change or item has a disproportionate effect on the Company Entities relative to other participants in the same business as the Company Entities. Capitalized terms used in the definition of Target Company Material Adverse Effect (other than the terms “Acquisition Agreement” and “Target Company Material Adverse Effect”) shall have the meaning given to them in the Acquisition Agreement.

TARGET Day ” means any day on which the Trans-European Automated Real-time Gross Settlement Express Transfer (TARGET2) payment system which utilizes a single shared platform and which was launched on 19 November 2007 (or, if such payment system ceases to be operative, such other payment system (if any) reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent to be a suitable replacement) is open for the settlement of payments in Euro.

Tax Group ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.06(e)(ii) .

Taxes ” means all present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, deductions, withholdings (including backup withholding), assessments, fees or other similar charges imposed by any Governmental Authority, including any interest, additions to tax or penalties applicable thereto.

Term Borrowing ” means a borrowing of the same Type of Term Loan of a single Tranche from all the Lenders having Term Commitments of the respective Tranche on a given date (or resulting from a conversion or conversions on such date) having, in the case of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the same Interest Period.

Term Commitment ” means, as to each Term Lender, (i) the Initial Term Commitments, (ii) a Term Commitment Increase, (iii) a New Term Commitment or (iv) a Specified Refinancing Term Commitment. The amount of each Lender’s Initial Term Commitment is as set forth in the definition thereof and the amount of each Lender’s other Term Commitments shall be as set forth in the Assignment and Assumption, or in the amendment or agreement relating to the respective Term Commitment Increase, New Term Commitment or Specified Refinancing Term Commitment pursuant to which such Lender shall have assumed its Term Commitment, as the case may be, as such amounts may be adjusted from time to time in accordance with this Agreement.

 

-59-


Term Commitment Increase ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Term Facility ” means Term Commitments, Term Loans and any Specified Refinancing Debt related thereto.

Term Lender ” means (a) at any time on or prior to the Closing Date, any Lender that has an Initial Term Commitment at such time and (b) at any time after the Closing Date, any Lender that holds Term Loans and/or Term Commitments at such time.

Term Loan ” means an advance made by any Term Lender under any Term Facility.

Term Loan Tranche ” means the respective facility and commitments utilized in making Term Loans hereunder, including (i) the Term Facility and (ii) additional Tranches that may be added after the Closing Date, i.e., New Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Term Loans, New Term Commitments and Specified Refinancing Term Commitments.

Term Notes ” means a promissory note of the Borrowers, payable to any Term Lender or its registered assigns, in substantially the form of Exhibit  B-2 hereto, evidencing the indebtedness of the Borrowers, to such Term Lender resulting from the Term Loans under the Term Facility.

Threshold Amount ” means, with respect to each category set forth below, an amount equal to the “Minimum Threshold Amount” set forth opposite such category or a whole multiple in excess thereof of the amount set forth opposite such category under the heading “Incremental Multiples in Excess Thereof.”

 

Category

   Minimum Threshold
Amount
     Incremental Multiples
in Excess Thereof
 
Auction Amount for Term Loans    $ 5,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Reply Amount for Term Loans    $ 1,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Borrowing/Conversion of Base Rate Loans    $ 1,000,000      $ 250,000  
Borrowing/Continuation/Conversion of Eurocurrency Rate Loans ($)    $ 1,000,000      $ 250,000  
Borrowing/Continuation/Conversion of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (€)    1,000,000      250,000  
Borrowing/Continuation/Conversion of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (£)    £ 1,000,000      £ 250,000  
Optional Prepayment of Term Loans    $ 3,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Specified Refinancing Debt Threshold    $ 8,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Incremental Amount    $ 5,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Incremental Notes Amount    $ 8,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Assignments of Revolving Tranche    $ 5,000,000      $ 1,000,000  
Assignment of Term Loan Tranche    $ 1,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

 

-60-


Total Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for the four fiscal quarter period most recently then ended for which financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) .

Total Outstandings ” means the aggregate Outstanding Amount of all Loans and all L/C Obligations.

Total Revolving Credit Outstandings ” means the aggregate Outstanding Amount of all Revolving Credit Loans, Swing Line Loans and L/C Obligations.

Tranche ” means any Term Loan Tranche or any Revolving Tranche.

Transaction s” means the acquisition of the Equity Interests of the Target Companies by LD Lower pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement, together with each of the following transactions consummated or to be consummated in connection therewith:

(a) the contribution (the “ Equity Contribution ”) of cash or rollover equity to the Borrowers (including for these purposes equity of Holdings contributed to the Borrowers to facilitate the Acquisition) in an aggregate amount not less than 35% of the total pro forma consolidated gross debt and equity capitalization of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries on the Closing Date after giving effect to the Transactions (excluding any Letters of Credit issued on the Closing Date and amounts funded hereunder to fund upfront fees or original issue discount in respect of the Facilities) from, directly or indirectly, Holdings, the Sponsor, certain of the Sponsor’s Affiliates, members of management of the Target Companies, the Seller and other Permitted Holders. Any investments made by the Persons described in the preceding sentence in Holdings shall be in the form of (i) common equity and/or (ii) preferred equity with terms reasonably acceptable to the Arrangers; provided that (x) not less than 50.1% of the total Equity Contribution shall be attributable to contributions by the Sponsor; and (y) the contribution by Holdings to the Borrowers of the Equity Contribution shall be in the form of common equity;

(b) the Acquisition;

(c) the execution and delivery of Loan Documents to be entered into on the Closing Date and the funding of the Loans on the Closing Date;

(d) the execution and delivery of Second Lien Facility Documentation to be entered into on the Closing Date and the funding of the Second Lien Loans on the Closing Date;

(e) (x) the repayment of all Indebtedness and the termination of any financing commitments under the Existing Credit Agreement and (y) the refinancing or repayment of all existing third party Indebtedness for borrowed money of the Target Companies and their Subsidiaries, other than (i) ordinary course capital leases, purchase money indebtedness, equipment financings, customer financings and related guarantees, hedging obligations and related guarantees and other ordinary short term working capital facilities, (ii) indebtedness permitted to remain outstanding or be incurred prior to the Closing Date under the Acquisition Agreement, (iii) intercompany indebtedness and (iv) Indebtedness described on Schedule  7.03 , including certain Indebtedness that the Arrangers and Borrowers agree may remain outstanding on the Closing Date (the “ Refinancing ”); and

 

-61-


(f) the payment of all fees, costs and expenses incurred in connection with the transactions described in the foregoing provisions of this definition (the “ Transaction Costs ”).

Transaction Costs ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions.”

Transformative Acquisition ” means any acquisition (including by merger or consolidation) or similar Investment by a Borrower or any other Restricted Subsidiary that (i) is not permitted by the terms of the Loan Documents immediately prior to the consummation of such transaction or (ii) if permitted by the terms of the Loan Documents immediately prior to the consummation of such transaction, would not provide the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries with adequate flexibility under the Loan Documents for the continuation and/or expansion of their combined operations following such consummation, as reasonably determined by the Borrowers acting in good faith.

Type ” means, with respect to a Loan, its character as a Base Rate Loan or a Eurocurrency Rate Loan.

Unaudited Financial Information ” means, collectively (a) the unaudited financial statements of LD Intermediate and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarters ending March 31, 2016, June 30, 2016 and September 30, 2016 and (b) the unaudited financial statements of the Target Companies for the nine month period ending June 30, 2016.

Undisclosed Administration ” means the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official by a supervisory authority or regulator with respect to a Lender under or pursuant to the law in the country where such Lender is subject to home jurisdiction supervision, if applicable law requires that such appointment is not to be publicly disclosed.

Unfunded Advances/Participations ” means (a) with respect to the Administrative Agent, the aggregate amount, if any (i) made available to the Borrowers on the assumption that each Lender has made available to the Administrative Agent such Lender’s share of the applicable Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent as contemplated by Section  2.12(b) and (ii) with respect to which a corresponding amount shall not in fact have been returned to the Administrative Agent by the Borrowers or made available to the Administrative Agent by any such Lender, (b) with respect to the Swing Line Lender, the aggregate amount, if any, of outstanding Swing Line Loans in respect of which any Revolving Credit Lender fails to make available to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Swing Line Lender any amount required to be paid by such Lender pursuant to Section  2.04(c) and (c) with respect to any L/C Issuer, the aggregate amount, if any, of amounts drawn under Letters of Credit in respect of which a Revolving Credit Lender shall have failed to make Revolving Credit Loans or L/C Advances to reimburse such L/C Issuer pursuant to Section  2.03(c) .

Unfunded Pension Liability ” means the excess of a Plan’s benefit liabilities under Section 4001(a)(16) of ERISA over the current value of such Plan’s assets, determined in accordance with assumptions used for funding the Plan pursuant to Section 412 of the Code for the applicable plan year.

Uniform Commercial Code ” or “ UCC ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as the same may from time to time be in effect in the State of New York or the Uniform Commercial Code (or similar code or statute) of another jurisdiction, to the extent it may be required to apply to any item or items of Collateral.

United Kingdom ” and “ U.K. ” mean the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland.

United States ” and “ U.S. ” mean the United States of America.

 

-62-


Unreimbursed Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.03(c)(i) .

Unrestricted Cash ” means, as of any date of determination, the aggregate amount of all cash and Cash Equivalents on the consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries that is not restricted for purposes of GAAP, in each case, in excess of (a) $25,000,000 less (b) the aggregate amount of LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payments (not to exceed $25,000,000) that (i) have been made in cash by Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on or prior to such date of determination or (ii) reduced in whole or in part in accordance with the definition thereof.

Unrestricted Subsidiary ” means (a) any Subsidiary of Holdings designated by the Borrower Representative as an Unrestricted Subsidiary hereunder by written notice to the Administrative Agent; provided that the Borrower Representative shall only be permitted to so designate an Unrestricted Subsidiary so long as (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, (ii) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such designation, the Borrowers would be in Pro Forma Compliance with the Financial Covenant (whether or not then in effect), (iii) no such Subsidiary or any of its Subsidiaries owns any Equity Interests, or owns or holds any Lien on any property of, a Borrower or any other Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower that is not a Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so designated, (iv) such Unrestricted Subsidiary shall be capitalized (to the extent capitalized by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary) through Investments as permitted by, and in compliance with, Section  7.02 and valued at its fair market value (as determined by the Borrowers in good faith) at the time of such designation, (v) without duplication of clause (iv), any assets owned by such Unrestricted Subsidiary at the time of the initial designation thereof shall be treated as Investments pursuant to Section  7.02 and valued at their fair market value (as determined by the Borrowers in good faith) at the time of such designation, (vi) such Subsidiary shall have been or will promptly be designated an “unrestricted subsidiary” (or otherwise not be subject to the covenants) under the Second Lien Credit Agreement, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes and all Permitted Refinancings in respect thereof, and any Permitted Ratio Debt in each case (other than the Second Lien Credit Agreement) with an aggregate outstanding principal amount in excess of $20,000,000 and (vii) the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate executed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying compliance with the requirements of preceding clauses (i) through (vi) and (b) any Subsidiary of an Unrestricted Subsidiary. The Borrower Representative may designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary for purposes of this Agreement (each, a “ Subsidiary Redesignation ”); provided that (A) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, (B) any Indebtedness of the applicable Subsidiary and any Liens encumbering its property existing as of the time of such Subsidiary Redesignation shall be deemed newly incurred or established, as applicable, at such time, (C) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such designation, the Borrowers would be in Pro Forma Compliance with the Financial Covenant (whether or not then in effect) and (D) the Borrower Representative shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate executed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying compliance with the requirements of the preceding clauses (A) and (C); provided , further , that no Unrestricted Subsidiary that has been designated as a Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a Subsidiary Redesignation may again be designated as an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

U.S. Person ” means any Person that is a “United States person” as defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code.

U.S. Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of a Borrower that (i) is organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia, (ii) is not a Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary and (iii) is not a FSHCO.

U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section  3.01(g)(ii)(B)(III) .

 

-63-


Voting Equity Interests ” means, with respect to any Person, the outstanding Equity Interests of a Person having the power, directly or indirectly, to designate the board of directors (or equivalent governing body) of such Person.

Weighted Average Life to Maturity ” means, when applied to any Indebtedness at any date, the number of years (and/or portion thereof) obtained by dividing: (a) the sum of the products obtained by multiplying (i) the amount of each then remaining installment, sinking fund, serial maturity or other required payments of principal, including payment at final maturity, in respect thereof, by (ii) the number of years (calculated to the nearest one-twelfth) that will elapse between such date and the making of such payment; by (b) the then outstanding principal amount of such Indebtedness; provided that the effects of any prepayments or amortization made on such Indebtedness shall be disregarded in making such calculation.

wholly-owned ” means, with respect to a Subsidiary of a Person, a Subsidiary of such Person all of the outstanding Equity Interests of which (other than (x) director’s qualifying shares and (y) shares issued to foreign nationals to the extent required by applicable Law) are owned by such Person and/or by one or more wholly-owned Subsidiaries of such Person.

Withholding Agent ” means any Loan Party and the Administrative Agent.

Write-Down and Conversion Powers ” means, with respect to any EEA Resolution Authority, the write-down and conversion powers of such EEA Resolution Authority from time to time under the Bail-In Legislation for the applicable EEA Member Country, which write-down and conversion powers are described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule.

Section 1.02 Other Interpretive Provisions . With reference to this Agreement and each other Loan Document, unless otherwise specified herein or in such other Loan Document:

(a) The meanings of defined terms are equally applicable to the singular and plural forms of the defined terms.

(b) The words “herein,” “hereto,” “hereof” and “hereunder” and words of similar import when used in any Loan Document shall refer to such Loan Document as a whole and not to any particular provision thereof.

(c) References in this Agreement to an Exhibit, Schedule, Article, Section, clause or subclause refer (A) to the appropriate Exhibit or Schedule to, or Article, Section, clause or subclause in this Agreement or (B) to the extent such references are not present in this Agreement, to the Loan Document in which such reference appears.

(d) The term “including” is by way of example and not limitation.

(e) The term “documents” includes any and all instruments, documents, agreements, certificates, notices, reports, financial statements and other writings, however evidenced, whether in physical or electronic form.

(f) Any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns.

 

-64-


(g) In the computation of periods of time from a specified date to a later specified date, the word “from” means “from and including”; the words “to” and “until” each mean “to but excluding;”; and the word “through” means “to and including.”

(h) Section headings herein and in the other Loan Documents are included for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

(i) In connection with any action being taken in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition, except to the extent expressly set forth herein, for purposes of determining compliance with any provision of this Agreement which requires that no Default, Event of Default or specified Event of Default, as applicable, has occurred, is continuing or would result from any such action, as applicable, such condition shall be deemed satisfied, so long as no Default, Event of Default or specified Event of Default, as applicable, exists on the date the definitive agreements for such Limited Condition Acquisition are entered into after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Limited Condition Acquisition and the actions to be taken in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) as if such Limited Condition Acquisition and other actions had occurred on such date. For the avoidance of doubt, if the Borrowers have exercised their option under the first sentence of this clause (i), and any Default or Event of Default occurs following the date the definitive agreements for the applicable Limited Condition Acquisition were entered into and prior to the consummation of such Limited Condition Acquisition, any such Default or Event of Default shall be deemed to not have occurred or be continuing solely for purposes of determining whether any action being taken in connection with such Limited Condition Acquisition is permitted hereunder.

(j) In connection with any action being taken solely in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition, for purposes of:

(i) determining compliance with any provision of this Agreement which requires the calculation of the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio, or the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, including the Financial Covenant if compliance with the Financial Covenant is a required test, or

(ii) testing availability under baskets set forth in this Agreement (including baskets measured as a percentage of Consolidated EBITDA),

in each case, at the option of the Borrowers (the Borrowers’ election to exercise such option in connection with any Limited Condition Acquisition, an “ LCA Election ”), the date of determination of whether any such action is permitted hereunder, shall be deemed to be the date the definitive agreements for such Limited Condition Acquisition are entered into (the “ LCA Test Date ”), and if, after giving pro forma effect to the Limited Condition Acquisition and the other transactions to be entered into in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) as if they had occurred at the beginning of the most recent four consecutive fiscal quarters ending prior to the LCA Test Date for which consolidated financial statements of the Borrowers are available, the Borrowers could have taken such action on the relevant LCA Test Date in compliance with such ratio or basket, such ratio or basket shall be deemed to have been complied with. For the avoidance of doubt, if the Borrowers have made an LCA Election and any of the ratios or baskets for which compliance was determined or tested as of the LCA Test Date are exceeded as a result of fluctuations in any such ratio or basket, including due to fluctuations in Consolidated EBITDA of the Borrowers or the Person subject to such Limited Condition Acquisition, at or prior to the consummation of the relevant transaction

 

-65-


or action, such baskets or ratios will not be deemed to have been exceeded as a result of such fluctuations. If the Borrowers have made an LCA Election for any Limited Condition Acquisition, then in connection with any subsequent calculation of any ratio or basket availability with respect to the incurrence of Indebtedness or Liens, or the making of Investments or Restricted Payments, mergers, the conveyance, lease or other transfer of all or substantially all of the assets of the Borrowers, the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasance or other satisfaction of Indebtedness, or the designation of an Unrestricted Subsidiary on or following the relevant LCA Test Date and prior to the earlier of the date on which such Limited Condition Acquisition is consummated or the definitive agreement for such Limited Condition Acquisition is terminated or expires without consummation of such Limited Condition Acquisition, any such ratio or basket shall be calculated on a pro forma basis assuming such Limited Condition Acquisition and other transactions in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) have been consummated; provided that the calculation of Consolidated Net Income (and any defined term a component of which is Consolidated Net Income) shall not include the Consolidated Net Income of the Person or assets to be acquired in any Limited Condition Acquisition until such time as such Limited Condition Acquisition is actually consummated.

Section 1.03 Accounting Terms .

(a) All accounting terms not specifically or completely defined herein shall be construed in conformity with, and all financial data (including financial ratios and other financial calculations) required to be submitted pursuant to this Agreement shall be prepared in conformity with, GAAP, as in effect from time to time.

(b) If at any time any change in GAAP or the application thereof would affect the computation or interpretation of any financial ratio, basket, requirement or other provision set forth in any Loan Document, and either the Borrower Representative or the Required Lenders shall so request, the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall negotiate in good faith to amend such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision to preserve the original intent thereof in light of such change in GAAP or the application thereof (subject to the approval of the Required Lenders not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) ( provided that any change affecting the computation of the ratio set forth in Section  7.10 shall be subject solely to the approval of the Required Revolving Lenders (not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) and the Borrowers); provided that, until so amended, (i) (A) such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision shall continue to be computed or interpreted in accordance with GAAP or the application thereof prior to such change therein and (B) the Borrowers shall provide to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders a written reconciliation in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, between calculations of such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision made before and after giving effect to such change in GAAP or the application thereof or (ii) the Borrowers may elect to fix GAAP (for purposes of such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision) as of another later date notified in writing to the Administrative Agent from time to time.

(c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, all such financial statements shall be prepared, and all financial covenants contained herein or in any other Loan Document shall be calculated, in each case, without giving effect to any election under FASB ASC 825 (or any similar accounting principle) permitting a Person to value its financial liabilities at the fair value thereof.

(d) Any reference to any specific pronouncement or principle herein not otherwise operative under GAAP shall be deemed to refer to any such similar pronouncement or principle as may be operative under GAAP.

 

-66-


Section 1.04 Rounding . Any financial ratios required to be maintained by Holdings, or satisfied in order for a specific action to be permitted, under this Agreement shall be calculated by dividing the appropriate component by the other component, carrying the result to one place more than the number of places by which such ratio is expressed herein and rounding the result up or down to the nearest number (with a rounding-up if there is no nearest number).

Section 1.05 References to Agreements and Laws . Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, (a) references to Organization Documents, agreements (including the Loan Documents) and other contractual instruments shall be deemed to include all subsequent amendments, restatements, extensions, supplements and other modifications thereto, but only to the extent that such amendments, restatements, extensions, supplements and other modifications are permitted by any Loan Document and (b) references to any Law shall include all statutory and regulatory provisions consolidating, amending, replacing, supplementing or interpreting such Law. Unless otherwise expressly set forth herein, references to specific provisions (or defined terms) in the Second Lien Facility Documentation shall be to such provisions (or defined terms) as amended or replaced (to the extent such amendment or replacement is permitted by the Loan Documents), and cross-references shall be deemed amended as necessary to refer to the same provisions that are referenced in the Second Lien Facility Documentation as in effect on the Closing Date.

Section 1.06 Timing of Payment or Performance . When the payment of any obligation or the performance of any covenant, duty or obligation is stated to be due or performance required on a day which is not a Business Day, the date of such payment (other than as specifically provided in Section  2.12 or as described in the definition of Interest Period) or performance shall extend to the immediately succeeding Business Day.

Section 1.07 Currency Equivalents Generally .

(a) Any amount specified in this Agreement (other than in Articles II , IX and X or as set forth in clause (b) of this Section) or any of the other Loan Documents to be in Dollars shall also include the equivalent of such amount in any currency other than Dollars, such equivalent amount to be determined at the Exchange Rate; provided that if any basket is exceeded solely as a result of fluctuations in applicable currency exchange rates after the last time such basket was utilized (including in connection with any Permitted Refinancing), such basket will not be deemed to have been exceeded solely as a result of such fluctuations in currency exchange rates.

(b) For purposes of determining the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio and the Total Net Leverage Ratio, amounts denominated in a currency other than Dollars will be converted to Dollars for the purposes of (A) testing the Financial Covenant, at the Exchange Rate as of the last day of the fiscal quarter for which such measurement is being made, and (B) calculating the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio and the Total Net Leverage Ratio (other than for the purposes of determining compliance with the Financial Covenant), at the Exchange Rate as of the date of calculation, and will, in the case of Indebtedness, reflect the currency translation effects, determined in accordance with GAAP, of Swap Contracts permitted hereunder for currency exchange risks with respect to the applicable currency in effect on the date of determination of the Dollar equivalent of such Indebtedness.

Section 1.08 Letter of Credit Amounts . Unless otherwise specified herein, the amount of a Letter of Credit at any time shall be deemed to be the stated amount of such Letter of Credit in effect at such time after giving effect to any expiration periods applicable thereto; provided , however , that with respect to any Letter of Credit that, by its terms or the terms of any Issuer Document related thereto, provides for one or more automatic increases in the stated amount thereof, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be the maximum stated amount of such Letter of Credit after giving effect to all such increases, whether or not such maximum stated amount is in effect at such time.

 

-67-


Section 1.09 Pro Forma Calculations .

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio and Consolidated EBITDA shall be calculated (including for purposes of Sections 2.14 and 2.15 ) on a Pro Forma Basis with respect to each Specified Transaction occurring during the applicable four quarter period to which such calculation relates, and/or subsequent to the end of such four-quarter period but not later than the date of such calculation; provided that notwithstanding the foregoing, when calculating the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio for purposes of determining (x) the applicable percentage of Excess Cash Flow for purposes of Section  2.05(b) , (y) the Applicable Rate and (z) actual compliance (and not Pro Forma Compliance or compliance on a Pro Forma Basis) with the Financial Covenant (whether or not then in effect), any Specified Transaction and any related adjustment contemplated in the definition of Pro Forma Basis (and corresponding provisions of the definition of “Consolidated EBITDA”) that occurred subsequent to the end of the applicable four quarter period shall not be given Pro Forma Effect. The calculation of the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio and Consolidated EBITDA on a Pro Forma Basis for the purpose of determining if any action is permitted under an incurrence test hereunder shall be based on the financial statements that have been most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) (or prior to such initial delivery thereunder, the most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Section  4.01(l) ).

(b) Whenever Pro Forma Effect is to be given to a Specified Transaction, the amount of “run-rate” cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and acquisition synergies projected by the Borrowers in good faith to be realized (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis as though such items had been realized on the first day of such period and as if such items were realized during the entirety of such period) as a result of specified actions taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (in the good faith determination of the Borrowers), with “run-rate” meaning the full recurring benefit for a period that is associated with any action taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (including any savings expected to result from the elimination of a public target’s compliance costs with public company requirements) net of the amount of actual benefits realized during such period from such actions, such adjustments shall be included in the initial pro forma calculations of such financial ratios or tests and during any subsequent measurement period in which the effects thereof are expected to be realized relating to such Specified Transaction; provided that (A) such cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and synergies are factually supportable in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers and as determined in good faith by the Borrowers and are reasonably anticipated to be realized within 18 months after the consummation of any operational change or the acquisition or disposition which is expected to result in such cost savings, expense reductions, operating improvements or synergies, (B) no cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies shall be added pursuant to this clause (b) to the extent duplicative of any expenses or charges otherwise added to Consolidated Net Income or Consolidated EBITDA, whether through a pro forma adjustment or otherwise, with respect to such period, (C) projected amounts (that are not yet realized) may no longer be added in calculating Consolidated EBITDA to the extent occurring more than six full fiscal quarters after the specified action taken in order to realize such projected cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies and (D) amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this Section  1.09(b) shall not, when combined with amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to clause (b)(vi) of the definition thereof (other than to the extent in connection with the Transactions or the LDiscovery Transactions), in the aggregate exceed 25% of Consolidated EBITDA (determined prior to giving effect to such amounts) in any four consecutive fiscal quarter period.

 

-68-


Section 1.10 Calculation of Baskets . If any of the baskets set forth in Article  VII of this Agreement are exceeded solely as a result of fluctuations to Consolidated EBITDA for the most recently completed fiscal quarter after the last time such baskets were calculated for any purpose under Article  VII , such baskets will not be deemed to have been exceeded solely as a result of such fluctuations.

Section 1.11 Treatment of Subsidiaries Prior to Joinder . Each Subsidiary of Holdings that is required to be joined as a Loan Party pursuant to Section  6.12 shall, until the completion of such joinder, be deemed for the purposes of Article  VII of this Agreement to be a Loan Party from and after the Closing Date (or the date of formation or acquisition of such subsidiary).

ARTICLE II

The Commitments and Credit Extensions

Section 2.01 The Loans .

(a) The Initial Term Borrowing . Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, each Initial Lender severally agrees to make a single loan denominated in Dollars (the “ Initial Term Loans ”) to the Borrowers (on a joint and several basis) on the Closing Date in an amount equal to such Initial Lender’s Initial Term Commitment. The Initial Term Borrowing shall consist of Initial Term Loans made simultaneously by the Initial Lenders in accordance with their respective Initial Term Commitments. Amounts borrowed under this Section  2.01(a) and subsequently repaid or prepaid may not be reborrowed. Initial Term Loans may be Base Rate Loans or Eurocurrency Rate Loans as provided herein.

(b) The Revolving Credit Borrowings . Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, each Revolving Credit Lender severally agrees to make loans denominated in Dollars or in any Designated Foreign Currency (each such loan, a “ Revolving Credit Loan ”) to the Borrowers (on a joint and several basis) from time to time on and after the Closing Date, on any Business Day until and excluding the Business Day preceding the Maturity Date for the Revolving Tranche, in an aggregate amount not to exceed at any time outstanding the amount of such Revolving Credit Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment; provided , however , that after giving effect to any Revolving Credit Borrowing under the Revolving Tranche, (x) the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings under such Tranche shall not exceed the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments, (y) the Dollar Equivalent of the Outstanding Amount of the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency shall not exceed the Designated Foreign Currency Sublimit and (z) the aggregate Outstanding Amount of the Revolving Credit Loans of any Lender, plus such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all L/C Obligations, plus such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all Swing Line Loans shall not exceed such Revolving Credit Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment. Within the limits of each Revolving Credit Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment, and subject to the other terms and conditions hereof, the Borrowers may borrow under this Section  2.01(b) , prepay under Section  2.05 , and reborrow under this Section  2.01(b) . Revolving Credit Loans may be Base Rate Loans or Eurocurrency Rate Loans, as further provided herein.

Section 2.02 Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans .

(a) Each Term Borrowing, each Revolving Credit Borrowing, each conversion of Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans or Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other, and each continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be made upon irrevocable notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent; provided that Revolving Credit Loans denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency may not be converted into Base Rate Loans.

 

-69-


(i) With respect to such Borrowings, conversions or continuations with respect to Term Loans and Revolving Credit Loans, each such notice must be in writing and must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (New York Time) (x) in the case of a Borrowing, conversion or continuation relating to Dollars, three Business Days prior to the requested date of any Borrowing, conversion to or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or such shorter period as the Administrative Agent shall agree in its sole discretion), (y) in the case of a Borrowing, conversion or continuation relating to a Designated Foreign Currency, four Business Days prior to the requested date of any Borrowing, conversion to or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or such shorter period as the Administrative Agent shall agree in its sole discretion) or (z) on the Business Day immediately preceding the requested date of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans); provided , however , that if the Borrowers wishes to request Eurocurrency Rate Loans having an Interest Period other than one, two, three or six months in duration as provided in the definition of Interest Period, the applicable notice from the Borrower Representative must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York Time) five Business Days prior to the requested date of such Borrowing or continuation, whereupon the Administrative Agent shall give prompt notice to the Appropriate Lenders of such request and determine whether the requested Interest Period is acceptable to all of them. Not later than 10:00 a.m. (New York Time) three Business Days before the requested date of such Borrowing or continuation, the Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrower Representative whether or not the requested Interest Period has been consented to by all the Appropriate Lenders.

(ii) Each notice by the Borrower Representative pursuant to Section  2.02(a)(i) shall be delivered to the Administrative Agent in the form of a written Committed Loan Notice, appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers. Each Borrowing, conversion or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount for a Term Borrowing or a Revolving Credit Borrowing. Each Committed Loan Notice shall specify (i) whether the Borrowers are requesting a Term Borrowing, a Revolving Credit Borrowing (and the requested currency of such Borrowing of Revolving Credit Loans), a conversion of a Tranche of Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans or Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other, or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, (ii) the requested date of the Borrowing, conversion or continuation, as the case may be (which shall be a Business Day), (iii) the principal amount of Loans to be borrowed, converted or continued, (iv) the Type of Loans to be borrowed or to which existing Tranche of Loans are to be converted, (v) if applicable, the duration of the Interest Period with respect thereto and (vi) wire instructions of the account(s) to which funds are to be disbursed (it being understood, for the avoidance of doubt, that the amount to be disbursed to any particular account may be less than the Threshold Amount set forth above so long as the aggregate amount to be disbursed to all such accounts pursuant to such Borrowing meets such Threshold Amount). If with respect to any Eurocurrency Rate Loans denominated in Dollars, the Borrowers fail to specify a Type of Loan in a Committed Loan Notice or if the Borrowers fail to give a timely notice requesting a conversion or continuation of such Loans, then the applicable Tranche of Loans shall be made as or converted to, Base Rate Loans. Any such automatic conversion to Base Rate Loans shall be effective as of the last day of the Interest Period then in effect with respect to the applicable Eurocurrency Rate Loans. If with respect to any Revolving Credit Loan that is a Eurocurrency Rate Loan denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency, the Borrower fails to specify a Type of Loan in a Committed Loan Notice or if the Borrower fails to give a timely notice requesting a continuation of such Loans, then the applicable Tranche of Revolving Credit Loans shall be made or continued as a Eurocurrency Rate Loan with an Interest Period of

 

-70-


one month. Any such automatic conversion or continuation pursuant ot the immediately preceding two sentences shall be effective as of the last day of the Interest Period then in effect with respect to the applicable Eurocurrency Rate Loans. If the Borrower requests a Borrowing of, conversion to, or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans in any such Committed Loan Notice, but fails to specify an Interest Period, it will be deemed to have specified an Interest Period of one month. If no currency is specified, the requested Borrowing shall be in Dollars. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, a Swing Line Loan may not be converted to a Eurocurrency Rate Loan.

(b) Following receipt of a Committed Loan Notice, the Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each applicable Lender of the amount of its ratable share of the applicable Tranche of Loans, and if no timely notice of a conversion or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loan is provided by the Borrower Representative, the Administrative Agent shall notify each Lender of the details of any automatic continuation or conversion to Eurocurrency Rate Loans with an Interest Period of one month or Base Rate Loans, as applicable, as described in Section  2.02(a) . Each Appropriate Lender shall make the amount of its Loan available to the Administrative Agent in immediately available funds at the Administrative Agent’s Office not later than 12:00 noon (New York Time), in each case, on the Business Day specified in the applicable Committed Loan Notice. Upon satisfaction of the applicable conditions set forth in Section  4.02 (and, if such Borrowing is the initial Credit Extension, Section  4.01 ), the Administrative Agent shall make all funds so received available to the Borrowers in like funds as received by the Administrative Agent either by (i) crediting the account of the applicable Borrower on the books of the Administrative Agent with the amount of such funds or (ii) wire transfer of such funds, in each case in accordance with instructions provided to (and reasonably acceptable to) the Administrative Agent by the Borrower Representative; provided , however , that if, on the date the Committed Loan Notice with respect to such Borrowing under any Revolving Tranche is given by the Borrower Representative, there are Swing Line Loans or L/C Borrowings outstanding under such Tranche, then the proceeds of such Borrowing shall be applied, first , to the payment in full of any such L/C Borrowings, second , to the payment in full of any such Swing Line Loans, and third , to the Borrowers as provided above.

(c) Except as otherwise provided herein, a Eurocurrency Rate Loan may be continued or converted only on the last day of an Interest Period for such Eurocurrency Rate Loan unless the Borrowers pay the amount due under Section  3.05 in connection therewith.

(d) The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower Representative and the Lenders of the interest rate applicable to any Interest Period for Eurocurrency Rate Loans upon determination of such interest rate. The determination of the Eurocurrency Rate by the Administrative Agent shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error.

(e) After giving effect to all Borrowings, all conversions of Term Loans or Revolving Credit Loans from one Type to the other and all continuations of Term Loans or Revolving Credit Loans of the same Type, there shall not be more than fifteen Interest Periods in effect.

(f) The failure of any Lender to make the Loan to be made by it as part of any Borrowing shall not relieve any other Lender of its obligation, if any, hereunder to make its Loan on the date of such Borrowing, but no Lender shall be responsible for the failure of any other Lender to make the Loan to be made by such other Lender on the date of any Borrowing.

Section 2.03 Letters of Credit .

(a) The Letter of Credit Commitment .

 

-71-


(i) Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, (A) each L/C Issuer under the Revolving Tranche agrees, in reliance upon the agreements of the other Revolving Credit Lenders of such Tranche set forth in this Section  2.03 , (1) from time to time on any Business Day during the period from the Closing Date until the applicable Letter of Credit Expiration Date, to issue Letters of Credit denominated in Dollars under such Revolving Tranche for the account of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary ( provided that the Borrowers hereby irrevocably agrees to reimburse the applicable L/C Issuer for amounts drawn on any Letters of Credit issued for the account of any Restricted Subsidiary on a joint and several basis with such Restricted Subsidiary) and to amend or renew Letters of Credit previously issued by it, in accordance with Section  2.03(b) , and (2) to honor drafts under such Letters of Credit and (B) the Revolving Credit Lenders under the Revolving Tranche severally agree to participate in such Letters of Credit; provided that no L/C Issuer shall be obligated to make any L/C Credit Extension applicable to such Tranche with respect to any Letter of Credit, and no Lender under such Tranche shall be obligated to participate in any such Letter of Credit applicable to such Tranche, if as of the date of such L/C Credit Extension (w) the Outstanding Amount of the L/C Obligations under such Tranche issued by such L/C Issuer would exceed the Letter of Credit Individual Sublimit applicable to such L/C Issuer under such Tranche, (x) the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings under such Tranche would exceed the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitment, (y) the aggregate Outstanding Amount of the Revolving Credit Loans of any Lender outstanding under the Revolving Tranche, plus such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all L/C Obligations under such Tranche, plus such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all Swing Line Loans under such Tranche would exceed such Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment or (z) the Outstanding Amount of the L/C Obligations under such Tranche would exceed the Letter of Credit Sublimit applicable to such Tranche.

Within the foregoing limits, and subject to the terms and conditions hereof, the Borrowers’ ability to obtain Letters of Credit shall be fully revolving, and accordingly the Borrowers may, during the foregoing period, obtain Letters of Credit to replace Letters of Credit that have expired or that have been drawn upon and reimbursed.

(ii) No L/C Issuer under any Revolving Tranche shall be under any obligation to issue any Letter of Credit if:

(A) any order, judgment or decree of any Governmental Authority or arbitrator shall by its terms purport to enjoin or restrain such L/C Issuer from issuing such Letter of Credit, or any Law applicable to such L/C Issuer or any request or directive (whether or not having the force of Law) from any Governmental Authority with jurisdiction over such L/C Issuer shall prohibit, or request that such L/C Issuer refrain from, the issuance of letters of credit generally or such Letter of Credit in particular or shall impose upon such L/C Issuer with respect to such Letter of Credit any restriction, reserve or capital requirement (for which such L/C Issuer is not otherwise compensated hereunder) not in effect on the Closing Date, or shall impose upon such L/C Issuer any unreimbursed loss, cost or expense which was not applicable on the Closing Date and which, in each case, such L/C Issuer in good faith deems material to it;

(B) subject to Section  2.03(b)(ii) , the expiry date of such requested Letter of Credit would occur more than 12 months after the date of issuance or last renewal (or more than 180 days thereafter in the case of trade Letters of Credit), unless (1) the Required Revolving Lenders under such Tranche and the L/C Issuer, in their sole discretion, have approved such expiry date or (2) the Outstanding Amount of L/C Obligations, as applicable, in respect of such requested Letter of Credit has been Cash Collateralized or backstopped in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the L/C Issuer;

 

-72-


(C) the expiry date of such requested Letter of Credit would occur after the applicable Letter of Credit Expiration Date, unless (i) all the Revolving Credit Lenders under such Tranche and the L/C Issuer have approved such expiry date and/or (ii) the L/C Issuer has approved such expiry date and such requested Letter of Credit has been Cash Collateralized by the applicant requesting such Letter of Credit in accordance with Section  2.16 at least three Business Days prior to the applicable Letter of Credit Expiration Date;

(D) the issuance of such Letter of Credit would violate one or more generally applicable policies of such L/C Issuer in place at the time of such request;

(E) such Letter of Credit requested under the Revolving Tranche is in an initial stated amount of less than an amount equal to $10,000 or such lesser amount as is acceptable to the applicable L/C Issuer in its sole discretion; or

(F) any Revolving Credit Lender under such Tranche is at that time a Defaulting Lender, unless the applicable L/C Issuer has entered into arrangements, including reallocation of the Defaulting Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the outstanding L/C Obligations under such Tranche pursuant to Section  2.17(a)(iv) or the delivery of Cash Collateral in accordance with Section  2.16 with the Borrowers or such Lender to eliminate such L/C Issuer’s actual or potential Fronting Exposure under such Tranche (after giving effect to Section  2.17(a)(iv) ) with respect to the Defaulting Lender arising from either the Letter of Credit then proposed to be issued or that Letter of Credit and all other L/C Obligations as to which such L/C Issuer has actual or potential Fronting Exposure under such Tranche.

(iii) No L/C Issuer shall be under any obligation to amend any Letter of Credit if (A) such L/C Issuer would have no obligation at such time to issue such Letter of Credit in its amended form under the terms hereof or (B) the beneficiary of such Letter of Credit does not accept the proposed amendment to such Letter of Credit.

(iv) Each L/C Issuer shall act on behalf of the Revolving Credit Lenders under the applicable Tranche with respect to any Letters of Credit issued by it and the documents associated therewith, and each L/C Issuer shall have all of the benefits and immunities (A) provided to the Administrative Agent in Article IX with respect to any acts taken or omissions suffered by such L/C Issuer in connection with Letters of Credit issued by it or proposed to be issued by it and Issuer Documents pertaining to such Letters of Credit as fully as if the term “Administrative Agent” as used in Article IX included each L/C Issuer with respect to such acts or omissions, and (B) as additionally provided herein with respect to each L/C Issuer;

provided that the foregoing shall not excuse the L/C Issuer from liability to the Borrowers to the extent of any direct damages (as opposed to consequential damages claims in respect of which are waived by the Borrowers to the extent permitted by applicable law) suffered by the Borrowers that are caused by the L/C Issuer’s gross negligence or willful misconduct as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and nonappealable judgment.

(b) Procedures for Issuance and Amendment of Letters of Credit ; Auto-Renewal Letters of Credit .

(i) Each Letter of Credit shall be issued or amended, as the case may be, upon the request of the Borrower Representative delivered to the applicable L/C Issuer (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) in the form of a Letter of Credit Application, including agreed-upon draft language for such Letter of Credit reasonably acceptable to the applicable L/C Issuer (it being understood that such draft language

 

-73-


for each such Letter of Credit must be in English or, if agreed to in the sole discretion of the applicable L/C issuer, accompanied by an English translation certified by the Borrowers to be a true and correct English translation), appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers. Such Letter of Credit Application must be received by the applicable L/C Issuer and the Administrative Agent not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York time) at least two Business Days (or such shorter period as such L/C Issuer may agree in a particular instance in its sole discretion) prior to the proposed issuance date or date of amendment, as the case may be. In the case of a request for an initial issuance of a Letter of Credit, such Letter of Credit Application shall specify in form and detail reasonably satisfactory to the applicable L/C Issuer: (A) the proposed issuance date of the requested Letter of Credit (which shall be a Business Day not later than 30 days prior to the Maturity Date of the applicable Revolving Tranche, unless the Administrative Agent and the L/C Issuer otherwise agree); (B) the amount thereof; (C) the expiry date thereof; (D) the name and address of the beneficiary thereof; (E) the documents to be presented by such beneficiary in case of any drawing thereunder; (F) the full text of any certificate to be presented by such beneficiary in case of any drawing thereunder; (G) the currency in which the requested Letter of Credit will be denominated; (H) the Person for whose account the requested Letter of Credit is to be issued (which must be a Borrower Party); (I) the Tranche of Revolving Credit Facility that the Letter of Credit is to be issued under and (J) such other matters as the applicable L/C Issuer may reasonably request. In the case of a request for an amendment of any outstanding Letter of Credit, such Letter of Credit Application shall specify in form and detail reasonably satisfactory to the applicable L/C Issuer: (1) the Letter of Credit to be amended; (2) the proposed date of amendment thereof (which shall be a Business Day); (3) the nature of the proposed amendment and (4) such other matters as the applicable L/C Issuer may reasonably request.

(ii) Promptly after receipt of any Letter of Credit Application, the applicable L/C Issuer will confirm with the Administrative Agent that the Administrative Agent has received a copy of such Letter of Credit Application from the Borrower Representative and, if not, such L/C Issuer will provide the Administrative Agent with a copy thereof. Upon receipt by such L/C Issuer of confirmation from the Administrative Agent that the requested issuance or amendment is permitted in accordance with the terms hereof, then, subject to the terms and conditions hereof, such L/C Issuer shall, on the requested date, issue a Letter of Credit under the applicable Tranche for the account of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary (as designated in the Letter of Credit Application) or enter into the applicable amendment, as the case may be. Immediately upon the issuance of such Letter of Credit, each Revolving Credit Lender under such Tranche shall be deemed to, and hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees to, purchase from the applicable L/C Issuer a risk participation in such Letter of Credit in an amount equal to such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of such Tranche multiplied by the amount of such Letter of Credit.

(iii) If a Borrower on behalf of the applicable Borrower Party so requests in any applicable Letter of Credit Application, the applicable L/C Issuer may, in its sole and absolute discretion, agree to issue a Letter of Credit that has automatic renewal provisions (each, an “ Auto-Renewal Letter of Credit ”); provided that any such Auto-Renewal Letter of Credit must permit such L/C Issuer to prevent any such renewal at least once in each twelve-month period (commencing with the date of issuance of such Letter of Credit) by giving prior notice to the beneficiary thereof not later than a day in each such twelve-month period to be agreed upon at the time such Letter of Credit is issued. Unless otherwise directed by the applicable L/C Issuer, the Borrowers shall not be required to make a specific request to such L/C Issuer for any such renewal. Once an Auto-Renewal Letter of Credit has been issued, the Lenders under the applicable Tranche shall be deemed to have authorized (but may not require) the applicable L/C Issuer to permit the renewal of such Letter of Credit at any time to an expiry date not later than the applicable Letter of Credit Expiration Date; provided , however , that such L/C Issuer shall not permit any such renewal if such L/C Issuer has determined that it would have no obligation at such time to issue such Letter of Credit in its renewed form under the terms hereof (by reason of the provisions of Section  2.03(a)(iii) or otherwise).

 

-74-


(iv) Promptly after its delivery of any Letter of Credit or any amendment to a Letter of Credit to an advising bank with respect thereto or to the beneficiary thereof, the applicable L/C Issuer will also (A) deliver to the Borrower Representative, the applicable Borrower Party and the Administrative Agent a true and complete copy of such Letter of Credit or amendment and (B) notify each Revolving Credit Lender of the applicable Tranche of such issuance or amendment and the amount of such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share therein.

(c) Drawings and Reimbursements; Funding of Participations .

(i) Upon receipt from the beneficiary of any Letter of Credit of any notice of a drawing under such Letter of Credit, the applicable L/C Issuer shall notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent thereof. Each L/C Issuer shall notify the Borrower Representative on the date of any payment by such L/C Issuer under a Letter of Credit (each such date, an “ Honor Date ”), and the Borrowers shall reimburse such L/C Issuer directly in an amount in Dollars equal to the amount of such drawing no later than on the next succeeding Business Day (and any reimbursement made on such next Business Day shall be taken into account in computing interest and fees in respect of any such Letter of Credit) after the Borrower Representative shall have received notice of such payment with interest on the amount so paid or disbursed by such L/C Issuer, to the extent not reimbursed, prior to 1:00 p.m. (New York time), in each case, on the respective Honor Date, from and including the date paid or disbursed to but excluding the date such L/C Issuer was reimbursed by the Borrowers therefor at a rate per annum equal to the Eurocurrency Rate (for an Interest Period of one month) as in effect from time to time plus the Applicable Rate as in effect from time to time for Revolving Credit Loans in in Dollars). If the Borrowers fail to so reimburse such L/C Issuer on such next Business Day, the Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each Revolving Credit Lender under the applicable Tranche of the Honor Date, the amount of the unreimbursed drawing (expressed in Dollars) (the “ Unreimbursed Amount ”), and the amount of such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share thereof. In such event, in the case of an Unreimbursed Amount under the Revolving Credit Facility, the Borrowers shall be deemed to have requested a Revolving Credit Borrowing of Base Rate Loans under the applicable Tranche to be disbursed on such date in an amount equal to the Unreimbursed Amount, without regard to the Threshold Amount specified in Section  2.02 for the principal amount of Base Rate Loans but subject to the amount of the unutilized portion of the Revolving Credit Commitments under the applicable Tranche and the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 (other than the delivery of a Committed Loan Notice).

(ii) Each Revolving Credit Lender under the applicable Tranche (including each Lender acting as an L/C Issuer) shall upon any notice pursuant to Section  2.03(d)(i) make funds available (and the Administrative Agent may apply Cash Collateral provided for this purpose) to the applicable L/C Issuer in Dollars in an amount equal to its Pro Rata Share of the Unreimbursed Amount not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York time), in each case, on the Business Day specified in such notice by the Administrative Agent, whereupon, subject to the provisions of Section  2.03(c)(iii) , each Revolving Credit Lender that so makes funds available shall be deemed to have made a Revolving Credit Loan in the form of a Base Rate Loan to the Borrowers in such amount.

(iii) With respect to any Unreimbursed Amount that is not fully refinanced by a Revolving Credit Borrowing under the applicable Tranche, because the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 cannot be satisfied or for any other reason, the Borrowers shall be deemed to have incurred from the applicable L/C Issuer an L/C Borrowing in the amount of the Unreimbursed Amount that is not so refinanced, which L/C Borrowing shall be due and payable on demand (together with interest) and shall bear interest at the Default Rate then applicable to Revolving Credit Loans under such Tranche. In such event, each Revolving Credit Lender’s payment to the applicable L/C Issuer pursuant to Section  2.03(d)(ii) shall be deemed payment in respect of its participation in such L/C Borrowing and shall constitute an L/C Advance from such Lender in satisfaction of its participation obligation under this Section  2.03 .

 

-75-


(iv) Until each Revolving Credit Lender under the applicable Tranche funds its Revolving Credit Loan or L/C Advance pursuant to this Section  2.03(c) to reimburse the applicable L/C Issuer for any amount drawn under any Letter of Credit, interest in respect of such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of such amount shall be solely for the account of such L/C Issuer.

(v) Each Revolving Credit Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans or L/C Advances under any Revolving Tranche to reimburse the applicable L/C Issuer for amounts drawn under Letters of Credit issued under such Tranche, as contemplated by this Section  2.03(c) , shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be affected by any circumstance, including (A) any setoff, counterclaim, recoupment, defense or other right which such Lender may have against such L/C Issuer, the Borrowers or any other Person for any reason whatsoever, (B) the occurrence or continuance of a Default or (C) any other occurrence, event or condition, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing; provided , however , that each Revolving Credit Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans pursuant to this Section  2.03(c) is subject to the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 (other than delivery by the Borrower Representative of a Committed Loan Notice). No such making of an L/C Advance shall relieve or otherwise impair the obligation of the Borrowers to reimburse the applicable L/C Issuer for the amount of any payment made by the applicable L/C Issuer under any Letter of Credit, together with interest as provided herein.

(vi) If any Revolving Credit Lender under any Revolving Tranche fails to make available to the applicable L/C Issuer any amount required to be paid by such Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section  2.03(c) by the time specified in Section  2.03(c)(ii) , then, without limiting the other provisions of this Agreement, such L/C Issuer shall be entitled to recover from such Lender (acting through the Administrative Agent), on demand, such amount with interest thereon for the period from the date such payment is required to the date on which such payment is immediately available to such L/C Issuer at a rate per annum equal to the greater of the Federal Funds Rate from time to time in effect and a rate reasonably determined by such L/C Issuer in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by such L/C Issuer in connection with the foregoing. If such Lender pays such principal amount, the amount so paid (less interest and fees) shall constitute such Lender’s Loan included in the relevant Borrowing or L/C Advance in respect of the relevant L/C Borrowing, as the case may be. A certificate of the applicable L/C Issuer submitted to any Revolving Credit Lender under such Revolving Tranche (through the Administrative Agent) with respect to any amounts owing under this Section  2.03(c)(vi) shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

(d) Repayment of Participations .

(i) If, at any time after an L/C Issuer under any Revolving Tranche has made a payment under any Letter of Credit issued by it and has received from any Revolving Credit Lender under such Tranche such Lender’s L/C Advance in respect of such payment in accordance with Section  2.03(c) , the Administrative Agent receives for the account of such L/C Issuer any payment in respect of the related Unreimbursed Amount or interest thereon (whether directly from the Borrowers or otherwise, including proceeds of Cash Collateral applied thereto by the Administrative Agent), the Administrative Agent will distribute to such Lender its Pro Rata Share thereof (appropriately adjusted, in the case of interest payments, to reflect the period of time during which such Lender’s L/C Advance was outstanding) in the same funds as those received by the Administrative Agent.

(ii) If any payment received by the Administrative Agent for the account of an L/C Issuer pursuant to Section  2.03(d)(i) is required to be returned under any of the circumstances described in Section  10.06 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by such L/C Issuer in its discretion), each Revolving Credit Lender under the applicable Tranche shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the

 

-76-


account of such L/C Issuer its Pro Rata Share thereof on demand of the Administrative Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such amount is returned by such Lender, at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate or the relevant Eurocurrency Rate, as the case may be, from time to time in effect. The obligations of the Lenders under this clause shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

(e) Obligations Absolute . The obligation of the Borrowers to reimburse the applicable L/C Issuer for each drawing under each Letter of Credit issued for its account or for the account of its Restricted Subsidiaries and to repay each L/C Borrowing shall be joint and several, absolute, unconditional and irrevocable, and shall be paid strictly in accordance with the terms of this Agreement under all circumstances, including the following:

(i) any lack of validity or enforceability of such Letter of Credit, this Agreement, any other agreement or instrument relating thereto or any term or provision therein;

(ii) the existence of any claim, counterclaim, setoff, defense or other right that the Borrowers may have at any time against any beneficiary or any transferee of such Letter of Credit (or any Person for whom any such beneficiary or any such transferee may be acting), the applicable L/C Issuer or any other Person, whether in connection with this Agreement, the transactions contemplated hereby or by such Letter of Credit or any agreement or instrument relating thereto, or any unrelated transaction;

(iii) any draft, demand, certificate or other document presented under such Letter of Credit proving to be forged, fraudulent, invalid or insufficient in any respect or any statement therein being untrue or inaccurate in any respect; or any loss or delay in the transmission or otherwise of any document required in order to make a drawing under such Letter of Credit;

(iv) any payment by the applicable L/C Issuer under such Letter of Credit against presentation of a draft or certificate that does not strictly comply with the terms of such Letter of Credit; or any payment made by the applicable L/C Issuer under such Letter of Credit to any Person purporting to be a trustee in bankruptcy, debtor-in-possession, assignee for the benefit of creditors, administrator, administrative receiver, judicial manager, liquidator, receiver or other representative of or successor to any beneficiary or any transferee of such Letter of Credit, including any arising in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law;

(v) any exchange, release or non-perfection of any Collateral, or any release or amendment or waiver of or consent to departure from the Guaranty or any other guarantee, for all or any of the Obligations of the Borrowers in respect of such Letter of Credit; or

(vi) any other circumstance or happening whatsoever, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing, including any other circumstance that might otherwise constitute a defense available to, a discharge of, or provide a right of setoff against the Borrowers.

The Borrowers shall promptly examine a copy of each Letter of Credit and each amendment thereto that is delivered to it and, in the event of any claim of noncompliance with the instructions of the Borrower Representative or other irregularity, the Borrowers will promptly notify the applicable L/C Issuer. The Borrowers shall be conclusively deemed to have waived any such claim against any L/C Issuer and its correspondents unless such notice is given as aforesaid.

 

-77-


(f) Role of L/C Issuer . Each Lender and the Borrowers agree that, in paying any drawing under a Letter of Credit, the applicable L/C Issuer shall not have any responsibility to obtain any document (other than any sight draft, certificates and documents expressly required by the Letter of Credit) or to ascertain or inquire as to the validity or accuracy of any such document or the authority of the Person executing or delivering any such document. None of the applicable L/C Issuer, any Agent-Related Person nor any of the respective correspondents, participants or assignees of the applicable L/C Issuer shall be liable to any Lender for (i) any action taken or omitted in connection herewith at the request or with the approval of the Revolving Credit Lenders under the applicable Tranche or the Required Revolving Lenders of such Tranche, as applicable; (ii) any action taken or omitted in the absence of gross negligence or willful misconduct or (iii) the due execution, effectiveness, validity or enforceability of any document or instrument related to any Letter of Credit or Letter of Credit Application. The Borrowers hereby assume all risks of the acts or omissions of any beneficiary or transferee with respect to its use of any Letter of Credit; provided , however , that this assumption is not intended to, and shall not, preclude the Borrowers from pursuing such rights and remedies as they may have against the beneficiary or transferee at Law or under any other agreement. None of the applicable L/C Issuer, any Agent-Related Person, nor any of the respective correspondents, participants or assignees of such L/C Issuer, shall be liable or responsible for any of the matters described in clauses (i) through (v) of Section  2.03(e) ; provided , however , that anything in such clauses to the contrary notwithstanding, the Borrowers may have a claim against such L/C Issuer, and such L/C Issuer may be liable to the Borrowers, to the extent, but only to the extent, of any direct, as opposed to indirect, special, punitive, consequential or exemplary, damages suffered by the Borrowers which a court of competent jurisdiction determines in a final non-appealable judgment were caused by such L/C Issuer’s willful misconduct or gross negligence. In furtherance and not in limitation of the foregoing, the applicable L/C Issuer may, in its sole discretion, either accept documents that appear on their face to be in order, without responsibility for further investigation, regardless of any notice or information to the contrary, or refuse to accept and make payment upon such documents if such documents are not in strict compliance with the terms of such Letter of Credit and such L/C Issuer shall not be responsible for the validity or sufficiency of any instrument transferring or assigning or purporting to transfer or assign a Letter of Credit or the rights or benefits thereunder or proceeds thereof, in whole or in part, which may prove to be invalid or ineffective for any reason.

(g) Letter of Credit Fees . The Borrowers shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of each Revolving Credit Lender under any Revolving Tranche in accordance with its Pro Rata Share, a Letter of Credit fee which shall accrue for each Letter of Credit issued under such Revolving Tranche in an amount equal to the Applicable Rate then in effect for Eurocurrency Rate Loans with respect to such Tranche multiplied by the daily maximum amount then available to be drawn under such Letter of Credit (whether or not such maximum amount is then in effect under such Letter of Credit if such maximum amount increases periodically pursuant to the terms of such Letter of Credit); provided , however , that any Letter of Credit fees otherwise payable for the account of a Defaulting Lender with respect to any Letter of Credit as to which such Defaulting Lender has not provided Cash Collateral satisfactory to the applicable L/C Issuer pursuant to this Section  2.03 shall be payable, to the maximum extent permitted by applicable Law, to the other Lenders under the applicable Tranche in accordance with the upward adjustments in their respective Pro Rata Shares allocable to such Letter of Credit pursuant to Section  2.17(a)(iv) , with the balance of such fee, if any, payable to the applicable L/C Issuer for its own account. Such Letter of Credit fees shall be computed on a quarterly basis in arrears and shall be due and payable on the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December, in respect of the quarterly period then ending (or portion thereof, in the case of the first payment), commencing with the first such date to occur after the issuance of such Letter of Credit, on the Letter of Credit Expiration Date and thereafter on demand. If there is any change in the Applicable Rate during any quarter, the daily maximum amount of each Letter of Credit shall be computed and multiplied by the Applicable Rate separately for each period during such quarter that such Applicable Rate was in effect. Each payment of fees under this clause (g) on any Letters of Credit shall be made in Dollars.

 

-78-


(h) Fronting Fee and Documentary and Processing Charges Payable to an L/C Issuer . The Borrowers shall pay directly to the applicable L/C Issuer for its own account a fronting fee at a rate equal to the greater of (i) 0.125% per annum computed on the maximum daily amount available to be drawn under such Letter of Credit on a quarterly basis in arrears and (ii) $500 per annum. Such fronting fee shall be due and payable on the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December in respect of the quarterly period then ending (or portion thereof, in the case of the first payment), commencing with the first such date to occur after the issuance of such Letter of Credit, on the Letter of Credit Expiration Date and thereafter on demand. For purposes of computing the maximum daily amount available to be drawn under any Letter of Credit, the amount of such Letter of Credit shall be determined in accordance with Section  1.08 . Each payment of fees required above under this clause (h) on any Letters of Credit shall be made in Dollars. In addition, the Borrowers shall pay directly to the applicable L/C Issuer for its own account the customary issuance, presentation, administration, amendment and other processing fees, and other standard costs and charges, of such L/C Issuer relating to letters of credit as from time to time in effect. Such customary fees and standard costs and charges are due and payable within five Business Days of demand and are non-refundable.

(i) Conflict with Letter of Credit Application . In the event of any conflict between the terms hereof and the terms of any Letter of Credit Application, the terms hereof shall control.

(j) Reporting . To the extent that any Letters of Credit are issued by an L/C Issuer other than the Administrative Agent, each such L/C Issuer shall furnish to the Administrative Agent a report detailing the daily L/C Obligations outstanding under all Letters of Credit issued by it under any Tranche of the Revolving Credit Facility, such report to be in a form and at reporting intervals as shall be agreed between the Administrative Agent and such L/C Issuer; provided that in no event shall such reports be furnished at intervals greater than 31 days.

(k) Provisions Related to Extended Revolving Credit Commitments . If the Maturity Date in respect of any Revolving Tranche occurs prior to the expiration of any Letter of Credit, then (i) if one or more Revolving Tranches in respect of which the Maturity Date shall not have occurred are then in effect and permit issuance of Letters of Credit in like currency, such Letters of Credit shall automatically be deemed to have been issued (including for purposes of the obligations of the Revolving Credit Lenders to purchase participations therein and to make Revolving Credit Loans and payments in respect thereof pursuant to this Section  2.03 ) under (and ratably participated in by Lenders pursuant to) the Revolving Credit Commitments in respect of such non-terminating Tranches up to an aggregate amount not to exceed the aggregate principal amount of the unutilized Revolving Credit Commitments thereunder at such time (it being understood that no partial face amount of any Letter of Credit may be so reallocated) and to the extent any Letters of Credit are not able to be reallocated pursuant to this clause (i) and there are outstanding Revolving Credit Loans under the non-terminating Tranches, the Borrowers agree, jointly and severally, to repay all such Revolving Credit Loans (or such lesser amount as is necessary to reallocate all Letters of Credit pursuant to this clause (i)) or (ii) to the extent not reallocated pursuant to immediately preceding clause (i), the Borrowers shall Cash Collateralize any such Letter of Credit in accordance with Section  2.16 but only up to the amount of such Letter of Credit not so reallocated. Except to the extent of reallocations of participations pursuant to clause (i) of the immediately preceding sentence, the occurrence of a Maturity Date with respect to a given tranche of Revolving Credit Commitments shall have no effect upon (and shall not diminish) the percentage participations of the Revolving Credit Lenders in any Letter of Credit issued before such Maturity Date.

 

-79-


Section 2.04 Swingline Loans .

(a) The Swing Line . Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, the Swing Line Lender, in reliance upon the agreements of the other Lenders set forth in this Section  2.04 , shall make loans in Dollars (each such loan, a “ Swing Line Loan ”) to the Borrowers from time to time on any Business Day until the Maturity Date in an aggregate amount not to exceed at any time outstanding the Swing Line Sublimit, notwithstanding the fact that such Swing Line Loans, when aggregated with the Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of Loans and L/C Obligations of the Lender acting as Swing Line Lender, may exceed the amount of such Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment; provided , however , that after giving effect to any Swing Line Loan, (i) the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings shall not exceed the Revolving Credit Facility and (ii) the aggregate Outstanding Amount of the Revolving Credit Loans of any Revolving Credit Lender, plus such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all L/C Obligations at such time, plus such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Outstanding Amount of all Swing Line Loans at such time shall not exceed such Revolving Credit Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment; provided , further , that the Borrowers shall not use the proceeds of any Swing Line Loan to refinance any outstanding Swing Line Loan. Within the foregoing limits, and subject to the other terms and conditions hereof, the Borrowers may borrow, on a joint and several basis, under this Section  2.04 , prepay under Section  2.05 , and reborrow under this Section  2.04 . Each Swing Line Loan shall bear interest only at a rate based on the Base Rate. Immediately upon the making of a Swing Line Loan, each Revolving Credit Lender shall be deemed to, and hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees to, purchase from the Swing Line Lender a risk participation in such Swing Line Loan in an amount in Dollars equal to such Revolving Credit Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the Revolving Credit Facility multiplied by the amount of such Swing Line Loan.

(b) Borrowing Procedures . Each Swing Line Borrowing shall be made upon the irrevocable notice by the Borrower Representative to the Swing Line Lender. Each such notice must be received by the Swing Line Lender and the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (New York City time) on the requested borrowing date, and shall specify (i) the amount to be borrowed, which shall be a minimum of $100,000 and (ii) the requested borrowing date, which shall be a Business Day. The Borrower Representative shall deliver to the Swing Line Lender a written Swing Line Loan Notice, appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers. Promptly after receipt by the Swing Line Lender of any Swing Line Loan Notice, the Swing Line Lender will confirm with the Administrative Agent that the Administrative Agent has also received such Swing Line Loan Notice and, if not, the Swing Line Lender will notify the Administrative Agent of the contents thereof. Unless the Swing Line Lender has received notice from the Administrative Agent (including at the request of any Revolving Credit Lender) prior to 2:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the date of the proposed Swing Line Borrowing (A) directing the Swing Line Lender not to make such Swing Line Loan as a result of the limitations set forth in the first proviso to the first sentence of Section  2.04(a) or (B) that one or more of the applicable conditions specified in Article IV is not then satisfied, then, subject to the terms and conditions hereof, the Swing Line Lender will, not later than 3:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the borrowing date specified in such Swing Line Loan Notice, make the amount of its Swing Line Loan available to the applicable Borrower.

(c) Refinancing of Swing Line Loans . (i) The Swing Line Lender at any time in its sole and absolute discretion may request, on behalf of the Borrowers (and the Borrowers hereby irrevocably authorize the Swing Line Lender to so request on their behalf), that each Revolving Credit Lender make a Base Rate Loan in an amount in Dollars equal to such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of the amount of Swing Line Loans then outstanding. Such request shall be made in writing (which written request shall be deemed to be a Committed Loan Notice for purposes hereof) and in accordance with the requirements of Section  2.02 , without regard to the minimum and multiples specified therein for the principal amount of Base Rate Loans, but subject to the unutilized portion of the Revolving Credit Facility and the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 . The Swing Line Lender shall furnish the Borrower Representative with a copy of the applicable Committed Loan Notice promptly after delivering such notice to the Administrative Agent. Each Revolving Credit Lender shall make an amount equal to its Pro Rata Share of the amount specified in such Committed Loan Notice available in Dollars to the Administrative Agent in immediately

 

-80-


available funds (and the Administrative Agent may apply Cash Collateral available with respect to the applicable Swing Line Loan) for the account of the Swing Line Lender at the Administrative Agent’s Office not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the day specified in such Committed Loan Notice, whereupon, subject to Section  2.04(c)(ii) , each Revolving Credit Lender that so makes funds available shall be deemed to have made a Base Rate Loan to the Borrowers in such amount. The Administrative Agent shall remit the funds so received to the Swing Line Lender.

(ii) If for any reason any Swing Line Loan cannot be refinanced by such a Revolving Credit Borrowing in accordance with Section  2.04(c)(i) , the request for Base Rate Loans submitted by the Swing Line Lender as set forth herein shall be deemed to be a request by the Swing Line Lender that each of the Revolving Credit Lenders fund its risk participation in the relevant Swing Line Loan and each Revolving Credit Lender’s payment to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Swing Line Lender pursuant to Section  2.04(c)(i) shall be deemed payment in respect of such participation.

(iii) If any Revolving Credit Lender fails to make available to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Swing Line Lender any amount required to be paid by such Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section  2.04(c) by the time specified in Section  2.04(c)(i) , the Swing Line Lender shall be entitled to recover from such Lender (acting through the Administrative Agent), on demand, such amount with interest thereon for the period from the date such payment is required to the date on which such payment is immediately available to the Swing Line Lender at a rate per annum equal to the greater of the applicable Overnight Bank Funding Rate from time to time in effect and a rate reasonably determined by the Swing Line Lender in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Swing Line Lender in connection with the foregoing. If such Lender pays such amount (with interest and fees as aforesaid) the amount so paid shall constitute such Lender’s committed Loan included in the relevant committed Borrowing or funded participation in the relevant Swing Line Loan, as the case may be. A certificate of the Swing Line Lender submitted to any Lender (through the Administrative Agent) with respect to any amounts owing under this clause (iii) shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

(iv) Each Revolving Credit Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans or to purchase and fund risk participations in Swing Line Loans pursuant to this Section  2.04(c) shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be affected by any circumstance, including (A) any setoff, counterclaim, recoupment, defense or other right which such Lender may have against the Swing Line Lender, the Borrowers or any other Person for any reason whatsoever, (B) the occurrence or continuance of a Default or (C) any other occurrence, event or condition, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing; provided , however , that each Revolving Credit Lender’s obligation to make Revolving Credit Loans pursuant to this Section  2.04(c) is subject to the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 . No such funding of risk participations shall relieve or otherwise impair the obligation of the Borrowers to repay Swing Line Loans, together with interest as provided herein.

(d) Repayment of Participations . (i) At any time after any Revolving Credit Lender has purchased and funded a risk participation in a Swing Line Loan, if the Swing Line Lender receives any payment on account of such Swing Line Loan, the Swing Line Lender will distribute to such Lender its Pro Rata Share of such payment (appropriately adjusted, in the case of interest payments, to reflect the period of time during which such Lender’s risk participation was funded) in the same funds as those received by the Swing Line Lender.

(ii) If any payment received by the Swing Line Lender in respect of principal or interest on any Swing Line Loan is required to be returned by the Swing Line Lender under any of the circumstances described in Section  10.06 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the Swing Line Lender in its discretion), each Revolving Credit Lender shall pay to the Swing Line Lender its Pro Rata Share

 

-81-


thereof on demand of the Administrative Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such amount is returned, at a rate per annum equal to the applicable Overnight Bank Funding Rate. The Administrative Agent will make such demand upon the request of the Swing Line Lender. The obligations of the Lenders under this clause shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

(e) Interest for Account of Swing Line Lender . The Swing Line Lender shall be responsible for invoicing the Borrowers for interest on the Swing Line Loans. Until each Revolving Credit Lender funds its Base Rate Loan or risk participation pursuant to this Section  2.04 to refinance such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of any Swing Line Loan made, interest in respect of such Pro Rata Share shall be solely for the account of the Swing Line Lender.

(f) Payments Directly to Swing Line Lender . The Borrowers shall make all payments of principal and interest in respect of the Swing Line Loans directly to the Swing Line Lender.

(g) Extended Revolving Credit Commitments . If the Maturity Date shall have occurred in respect of any Tranche of Revolving Credit Commitments at a time when another tranche or tranches of Revolving Credit Commitments is or are in effect with a longer Maturity Date, then on the earliest occurring Maturity Date all then outstanding Swing Line Loans shall be repaid in full on such date (and there shall be no adjustment to the participations in such Swing Line Loans as a result of the occurrence of such Maturity Date); provided , however , that if on the occurrence of such earliest Maturity Date (after giving effect to any repayments of Revolving Credit Loans and any reallocation of Letter of Credit participations as contemplated in Section  2.03(k) ), no Default then exists or would result therefrom and there shall exist sufficient unutilized Revolving Credit Commitments in effect with a longer Maturity Date so that the respective outstanding Swing Line Loans could be incurred pursuant the such Revolving Credit Commitments which will remain in effect after the occurrence of such Maturity Date, then there shall be an automatic adjustment on such date of the participations in such Swing Line Loans and same shall be deemed to have been incurred solely pursuant to the relevant Revolving Credit Commitments in effect with a longer Maturity Date, and such Swing Line Loans shall not be so required to be repaid in full on such earliest Maturity Date.

Section 2.05 Prepayments .

(a) Optional . (i) The Borrowers may, upon notice by the Borrower Representative substantially in the form of Exhibit  K-1 to the Administrative Agent, at any time or from time to time voluntarily prepay Loans in whole or in part without premium or penalty except as set forth in Section  2.05(a)(iv) , as applicable, below; provided that (1) such notice must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than, 1:00 p.m. (New York Time), in each case, (x) in the case of any prepayment of a Borrowing of Eurocurrency Rate Loans denominated in Dollars, three Business Days prior to any date of prepayment of such Eurocurrency Rate Loans, (y) in the case of any prepayment of a Borrowing of Eurocurrency Rate Loans denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency, four Business Days prior to any date of prepayment of such Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (z) one Business Day prior to any date of prepayment of Base Rate Loans; (2) any prepayment of Loans shall be in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount or, if less, the entire principal amount thereof then outstanding. Each such notice shall specify the date and amount of such prepayment, the Tranche of Loans to be prepaid, the Type(s) of Loans to be prepaid and, if Eurocurrency Rate Loans are to be prepaid, the Interest Period(s) of such Loans (except that if the class of Loans to be prepaid includes both Base Rate Loans and Eurocurrency Rate Loans, absent direction by the Borrower Representative, the applicable prepayment shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans to the full extent thereof before application to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case in a manner that minimizes the amount payable by the Borrowers in respect of such prepayment pursuant to Section  3.05) . The Administrative Agent will promptly notify each Lender of its

 

-82-


receipt of each such notice, and of the amount of such Lender’s ratable portion of such prepayment (based on such Lender’s ratable share of the relevant Facility or, in the case of the Revolving Credit Facility, Tranche of Loans). If such notice is given by the Borrower Representative, subject to clause (iii) below, the Borrowers shall make such prepayment and the payment amount specified in such notice shall be due and payable on the date specified therein. Any prepayment of a Eurocurrency Rate Loan shall be accompanied by all accrued interest thereon, together with any additional amounts required pursuant to Section  2.05(a)(iv) , as applicable, and Section  3.05 . Each prepayment of the principal of, and interest on, any Revolving Credit Loans shall be made in the currency in which such Revolving Credit Loans were made. Subject to Section  2.17 , each prepayment of outstanding Term Loan Tranches pursuant to this Section  2.05(a) shall be applied to such Term Loan Tranche on a pro rata basis. All voluntary prepayments of a Term Loan Tranche in accordance with this Section  2.05(a) shall be applied to the remaining amortization payments of the respective Term Loan Tranche as directed by the Borrower Representative (or, if the Borrower Representative has not made such designation, in direct order of maturity); and each such prepayment shall be paid to the Appropriate Lenders on a pro rata basis, except as set forth above.

(ii) The Borrower may, upon notice by the Borrower Representative to the Swing Line Lender substantially in the form of Exhibit  K-2 (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), at any time or from time to time, voluntarily prepay Swing Line Loans in whole or in part without premium or penalty; provided  that (A) such notice must be received by the Swing Line Lender and the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (New York City time) on the date of the prepayment and (B) any such prepayment shall be in a minimum principal amount of $100,000 or, if less, the entire principal amount thereof then outstanding. Each such notice shall specify the date and amount of such prepayment. If such notice is given subject to clause (iii) below, the Borrower shall make such prepayment and the payment amount specified in such notice shall be due and payable on the date specified therein.

(iii) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, any notice of prepayment under Section  2.05(a)(i) or (a)(ii) may state that it is conditioned upon the occurrence or non-occurrence of any event specified therein (including the effectiveness of other credit facilities), in which case such notice may be revoked by the Borrower Representative (by written notice to the Administrative Agent on or prior to the specified effective date) if such condition is not satisfied.

(iv) If the Borrowers, in connection with, or resulting in, any Repricing Event (A) makes a voluntary prepayment of any Initial Term Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(a) , (B) makes a repayment of any Initial Term Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(iii) or (C) effects any amendment with respect to the Initial Term Loans, in each case, on or prior to the one-year anniversary of the Closing Date, the Borrowers shall pay to the Administrative Agent, for the ratable account of the applicable Term Lenders (x) with respect to clauses (A) and (B), a prepayment premium in an amount equal to 1.00% of the principal amount of such Term Loans prepaid or repaid and (y) with respect to clause (C), a prepayment premium in an amount equal to 1.00% of the principal amount of the Term Loans subject to such amendment.

(b) Mandatory . (i) Within ten Business Days after financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) and the related Compliance Certificate has been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) (or, if later, the date on which such financial statements and such Compliance Certificate are required to be delivered), the Borrowers shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of Term Loans in an amount equal to (A) 75% (as may be adjusted pursuant to the proviso below) of Excess Cash Flow in excess of $5,000,000 for the fiscal year covered by such financial statements commencing with the fiscal year ending on December 31, 2017, minus (B) the sum of (1) the aggregate amount of voluntary principal prepayments of the Loans (except prepayments of (x) Swing Line Loans and (y) Loans under any Revolving Tranche that are not accompanied by a corresponding permanent commitment reduction of the

 

-83-


Revolving Tranche) and Loans repurchased pursuant to Dutch Auctions or open market purchases (in each case, to the extent offered to all Lenders on a pro rata basis) in an amount equal to the discounted purchase price of such Loans paid in respect of such Loans pursuant to such Dutch Auctions or through open market purchases) in each case other than to the extent that any such prepayment is funded with the proceeds of Specified Refinancing Debt, Refinancing Notes or any other long-term Indebtedness, in each case, occurring during the applicable Excess Cash Flow Period and (2) any amount not required to be applied pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(viii) ; provided that such percentage in respect of any Excess Cash Flow Period shall be reduced to 50%, 25% or 0% if the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio as of the last day of the fiscal year to which such Excess Cash Flow Period relates was equal to or less than 3.75 to 1.00, 3.25 to 1.00 or 2.75 to 1.00, respectively.

(ii) (A) If (x) a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary Disposes of any property or assets pursuant to Section  7.05(e) , (m) , (n) , (p) or (s)  or (y) any Casualty Event occurs, and any transaction or series of related transactions described in the foregoing clauses (x) and (y) results in the receipt by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary of aggregate Net Cash Proceeds such that proceeds realized in any fiscal year exceed $5,000,000 (such annual amount, the “ Annual Net Cash Proceeds Threshold ”) (any such transaction or series of related transactions resulting in Net Cash Proceeds being a “ Relevant Transaction ”), (1) the Borrower Representative shall give written notice to the Administrative Agent thereof promptly after the date of receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds and (2) except to the extent the Borrowers elect in such notice to reinvest all or a portion of such Net Cash Proceeds in accordance with Section  2.05(b)(ii)(B) , the Borrowers shall prepay, subject to Section  2.05(b)(viii) an aggregate principal amount of Term Loans in an amount equal to 100% (as may be adjusted pursuant to the second proviso below) of all Net Cash Proceeds in excess of the Annual Net Cash Proceeds Threshold received from such Relevant Transaction within fifteen Business Days of receipt thereof by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary; provided that the Borrowers may use a portion of the Net Cash Proceeds received from such Relevant Transaction to prepay or repurchase any other Indebtedness that is secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with Liens securing the Obligations to the extent such other Indebtedness and the Liens securing the same are permitted hereunder and the documentation governing such other Indebtedness requires such a prepayment or repurchase thereof with the proceeds of such Relevant Transaction, to the extent not deducted in the calculation of Net Cash Proceeds, in each case in an amount not to exceed the product of (1) the amount of such Net Cash Proceeds and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the outstanding principal amount of such other Indebtedness (or to the extent such amount is not in Dollars, such equivalent amount of such Indebtedness converted into Dollars as determined in accordance with Section  1.07 ) and the denominator of which is the aggregate outstanding principal amount of Term Loans and such other Indebtedness (or to the extent such amount is not in Dollars, such equivalent amount of such Indebtedness converted into Dollars as determined in accordance with Article I ).

(B) With respect to any Net Cash Proceeds realized or received with respect to any Relevant Transaction at the option of the Borrowers, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary may reinvest all or any portion of such Net Cash Proceeds in the business within 365 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds (or, if the Borrowers or the relevant Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, has contractually committed within 365 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds to reinvest such Net Cash Proceeds, then within 545 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds); provided , however , that if any of such Net Cash Proceeds are no longer intended to be so reinvested at any time after the occurrence of the Relevant Transaction (or are not reinvested within such 365 days or 545 days, as applicable), an amount equal to any such Net Cash Proceeds shall be promptly applied to the prepayment of Term Loans (subject to the proviso set forth in clause (A) above) as set forth in this Section  2.05 .

 

-84-


(iii) Upon the incurrence or issuance by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any Refinancing Notes, any Specified Refinancing Term Loans or any Indebtedness not expressly permitted to be incurred or issued pursuant to Section  7.03 , the Borrowers shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of Term Loan Tranches in an amount equal to 100% of all Net Cash Proceeds received therefrom immediately upon receipt thereof by the applicable Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary.

(iv) Upon the incurrence by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any Specified Refinancing Debt constituting revolving credit facilities, the Borrowers shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of the Tranche of Revolving Credit Loans in an amount equal to 100% of all Net Cash Proceeds received therefrom immediately upon receipt thereof by the applicable Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary.

(v) If for any reason the sum of the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings under any Tranche and the outstanding Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans at any time exceed the sum of the Revolving Tranches then in effect (including after giving effect to any reduction in the Revolving Credit Commitments pursuant to Section  2.06 ), the Borrowers shall immediately prepay Revolving Tranches and/or Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations in an aggregate amount equal to such excess; provided , however , that the Borrowers shall not be required to Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations pursuant to this Section  2.05(b)(v) unless after the prepayment in full of the Revolving Tranches and Swing Line Loans the sum of the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings and the outstanding Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans exceed the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments under such Tranche and commitments to make Specified Refinancing Revolving Loans then in effect.

(vi) Subject to Section  2.17 , each prepayment of Term Loans pursuant to this Section  2.05(b) shall be applied to each Term Loan Tranche on a pro rata basis (or, if agreed to in writing by the Majority Lenders of a Term Loan Tranche, in a manner that provides for more favorable prepayment treatment of other Term Loan Tranches, so long as each other such Term Loan Tranche receives its Pro Rata Share of any amount to be applied more favorably, except to the extent otherwise agreed by the Majority Lenders of each Term Loan Tranche receiving less than such Pro Rata Share) (other than a prepayment of (x) Term Loans or Revolving Credit Loans, as applicable, with the proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section  2.18 , which shall be applied to the Term Loan Tranche or Revolving Tranche, as applicable, being refinanced pursuant thereto or (y) Term Loans with the proceeds of any Refinancing Notes issued to the extent permitted under Section  7.03(b)(i) , which shall be applied to the Term Loan Tranche being refinanced pursuant thereto). Amounts to be applied to a Term Loan Tranche in connection with prepayments made pursuant to this Section  2.05(b) shall be applied to the remaining scheduled installments with respect to such Term Loan Tranche in direct order of maturity. Each prepayment of Term Loans under a Facility pursuant to this Section  2.05(b) shall be applied on a pro rata basis to the then outstanding Base Rate Loans and Eurocurrency Rate Loans under such Facility; provided that, with respect to such prepayment, then the amount thereof shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans under such Facility to the full extent thereof before application to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case in a manner that minimizes the amount payable by the Borrowers in respect of such prepayment pursuant to Section  3.05 , subject to the rights of the Declining Lenders to not be paid.

(vii) All prepayments under this Section  2.05 shall be made together with, in the case of any such prepayment of a Eurocurrency Rate Loan on a date other than the last day of an Interest Period therefor, any amounts owing in respect of such Eurocurrency Rate Loan pursuant to Section  3.05 and, to the extent applicable, any additional amounts required pursuant to Section  2.05(a)(iv) . Notwithstanding any of the other provisions of this Section  2.05(b) , so long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, if any prepayment of Eurocurrency Rate Loans is required to be made under this Section  2.05(b) , other than on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, the Borrowers may, in their sole discretion, deposit the amount of any such prepayment otherwise required to be made thereunder into a Cash Collateral account until the last day of such Interest Period, at which time the Administrative Agent shall be authorized (without any further action by or notice to or from the Borrowers or any other Loan

 

-85-


Party) to apply such amount to the prepayment of such Loans in accordance with this Section  2.05(b) . Upon the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, the Administrative Agent shall also be authorized (without any further action by or notice to or from the Borrowers or any other Loan Party) to apply such amount to the prepayment of the outstanding Loans in accordance with this Section  2.05(b) .

(viii) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section  2.05 , (A) to the extent that any or all of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Disposition by a Borrower Party (a “ Foreign Disposition ”) or the Net Cash Proceeds of any Casualty Event from a Borrower Party (a “ Foreign Casualty Event ”), in each case giving rise to a prepayment event pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) , or Excess Cash Flow attributable to a Borrower Party (“ Foreign Excess Cash Flow ”) giving rise to a prepayment event pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(i) are or is prohibited, restricted or delayed by applicable local law from being repatriated to the Borrowers that would be required to make such a prepayment, an amount equal to the portion of such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow so affected will not be required to be applied to repay Term Loans at the times provided in this Section  2.05 but may be retained by the applicable Borrower Party so long, but only so long, as the applicable local law will not permit repatriation to the Borrowers (the Borrowers hereby agreeing to use commercially reasonable efforts to cause the applicable Borrower Party to promptly take all actions reasonably required by the applicable local law to permit such repatriation), and once such repatriation of any of such affected Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow is permitted under the applicable local law, such repatriation will be immediately effected and an amount equal to such repatriated Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow will be promptly (and in any event not later than two Business Days after such repatriation) applied (net of additional Taxes payable or reserved against as a result thereof) to the repayment of the Loans pursuant to this Section  2.05 to the extent provided herein and (B) to the extent that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that repatriation of any or all of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Foreign Disposition, any Foreign Casualty Event or Foreign Excess Cash Flow would have a material adverse Tax consequence (taking into account any foreign tax credit or benefit actually realized in connection with such repatriation) with respect to such Net Cash Proceeds or Foreign Excess Cash Flow, the Net Cash Proceeds or Foreign Excess Cash Flow so affected may be retained by the applicable Borrower Party; provided , that no amounts retained by a Borrower Party pursuant to this Section  2.05(b)(viii) shall, in any event, increase the Cumulative Credit pursuant to clause (b) of the definition thereof; provided , further , that, in the case of this clause (B), on or before the date on which an amount equal to any Net Cash Proceeds so retained would otherwise have been required to be applied to reinvestments or prepayments pursuant to this Section  2.05 (or twelve months after the date such Excess Cash Flow would have been so required to be applied if it were Net Cash Proceeds), (x) the Borrowers shall apply an amount equal to such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow to such reinvestments or prepayments as if such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow had been received by the Borrowers rather than such Borrower Party, less the amount of additional Taxes that would have been payable or reserved against if such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow had been repatriated (or, if less, the Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow that would be calculated if received by such Borrower Party) or (y) such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow are applied to the repayment of Indebtedness of the applicable Borrower Party.

(c) Term Lender Opt-Out . With respect to any prepayment of Initial Term Loans and, unless otherwise specified in the documents therefor, other Term Loan Tranches pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) or (iii), any Appropriate Lender, at its option (but solely to the extent the Borrowers elect for this clause (c) to be applicable to a given prepayment), may elect not to accept such prepayment as provided below. The Borrower Representative may notify the Administrative Agent of any event giving rise to a prepayment under Section  2.05(b)(ii) or (iii)  at least ten Business Days prior to the date of such prepayment. Each such notice shall specify the date of such prepayment and provide a reasonably detailed calculation of the amount of such prepayment that is required to be made under Section  2.05(b)(ii) or (iii) (the “ Prepayment Amount ”). The Administrative Agent will promptly notify

 

-86-


each Appropriate Lender of the contents of any such prepayment notice so received from the Borrower Representative, including the date on which such prepayment is to be made (the “ Prepayment Date ”). Any Appropriate Lender may (but solely to the extent the Borrowers elect for this clause (c) to be applicable to a given prepayment) decline to accept all (but not less than all) of its share of any such prepayment (any such Lender, a “ Initial Declining Lender ”) by providing written notice to the Administrative Agent no later than 5:00 p.m. (New York Time) one Business Day after the date of such Appropriate Lender’s receipt of notice from the Administrative Agent regarding such prepayment. If any Appropriate Lender does not give a notice to the Administrative Agent on or prior to such fifth Business Day informing the Administrative Agent that it declines to accept the applicable prepayment, then such Lender will be deemed to have accepted such prepayment (all such Lenders, together with all other Lenders who are not an Initial Declining Lenders, the “ Initial Accepting Lenders ”). The Administrative Agent shall give notice to the Initial Accepting Lenders of the aggregate amount declined by the Initial Declining Lenders (the “ Reoffered Amount ”). Any Initial Accepting Lender may decline to accept all (but not less than all) of its share of any Reoffered Amount (any such Lender, a “ Secondary Declining Lender ”) by providing written notice to the Administrative Agent no later than 5:00 p.m. (New York Time) one Business Day after the date of such notice from the Administrative Agent regarding the Reoffered Amount. If any Initial Accepting Lender does not give a notice to the Administrative Agent prior to such time informing the Administrative Agent that it declines to accept the Reoffered Amount, then such Initial Accepting Lender will be deemed to have accepted the Reoffered Amount (all such Lenders, the “ Secondary Accepting Lenders ”). On any Prepayment Date, an amount equal to the Prepayment Amount minus the portion of the Reoffered Amount that is declined shall be paid to the Administrative Agent by the Borrowers and applied by the Administrative Agent ratably to prepay Term Loans under the Term Loan Tranches owing to Initial Accepting Lenders in the manner described in Section  2.05(b) for such prepayment ( provided that if there are no Initial Accepting Lenders, no such prepayments shall be required). Any amounts declined from the Reoffered Amount (or if there are no Initial Accepting Lenders, the Prepayment Amount) shall be applied in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement and the Second Lien Facility Documentation and, to the extent required by the terms thereof, shall be applied to the repayment of Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness under the Second Lien Credit Agreement, and any amounts not required to be applied to repay such Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness shall be retained by the Borrowers (such amounts, “ Declined Amounts ”).

(d) All Loans shall be repaid, whether pursuant to this Section  2.05 or otherwise, in the currency in which they were made.

Section 2.06 Termination or Reduction of Commitments .

(a) Optional . The Borrowers may, upon not less than three Business Days’ written notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent, terminate the unused portions of the Commitments under any Term Loan Tranche, any Letter of Credit Sublimit, or the unused Revolving Credit Commitments under any Revolving Tranche, or from time to time permanently reduce the unused portions of the Commitments under any Term Loan Tranche, the Letter of Credit Sublimit, or the unused Revolving Credit Commitments under any Revolving Tranche; provided that (i) any such notice shall be received by the Administrative Agent five Business Days (or such shorter period as the Administrative Agent shall agree) prior to the date of termination or reduction, (ii) any such partial reduction shall be in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount and (iii) the Borrowers shall not terminate or reduce (A) the Commitments under any Tranche of the Revolving Credit Facility if, after giving effect thereto and to any concurrent prepayments hereunder, (x) the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings would exceed the Revolving Credit Facility or (y) the Total Revolving Credit Outstandings with respect to such Tranche would exceed the Revolving Credit Commitments under such Tranche, (B) the Letter of Credit Sublimit if, after giving effect thereto, the Outstanding Amount of L/C Obligations not fully Cash Collateralized hereunder would exceed the Letter of Credit Sublimit or (C) the Swing Line Sublimit if, after giving

 

-87-


effect thereto and to any concurrent prepayments hereunder, the Outstanding Amount of any Swing Line Loans would exceed the Swing Line Sublimit. Any such notice of termination or reduction of commitments pursuant to this Section  2.06(a) may state that it is conditioned upon the occurrence or non-occurrence of any event specified therein (including the effectiveness of other credit facilities), in which case such notice may be revoked by the Borrowers (by written notice from the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent on or prior to the specified effective date) if such condition is not satisfied.

(b) Mandatory . (i) The Aggregate Commitments under a Term Loan Tranche shall be automatically and permanently reduced to zero on the date of the initial incurrence of Term Loans under such Term Loan Tranche.

(ii) Upon the incurrence by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any Specified Refinancing Debt constituting revolving credit facilities, the Revolving Credit Commitments of the Lenders of the Tranche of Revolving Credit Loans being refinanced shall be automatically and permanently reduced on a ratable basis by an amount equal to 100% of the Commitments under such revolving credit facilities.

(iii) If after giving effect to any reduction or termination of Revolving Credit Commitments with respect to any Revolving Tranche under this Section  2.06 , the Letter of Credit Sublimit or the Swing Line Sublimit under such Tranche exceeds the aggregate amount of such Revolving Credit Commitments at such time, such Letter of Credit Sublimit or such Swing Line Sublimit, as the case may be, shall be automatically reduced by the amount of such excess (ratably among any L/C Issuers based on their Letter of Credit Individual Sublimits).

(iv) The aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments with respect to any Revolving Tranche shall automatically and permanently be reduced to zero on the Maturity Date with respect to such Revolving Tranche.

(c) Application of Commitment Reductions ; Payment of Fees . The Administrative Agent will promptly notify the Lenders of the applicable Tranche of any termination or reduction of the Commitments under any Term Loan Tranche, the Letter of Credit Sublimit or the Revolving Credit Commitment under any Revolving Tranche under this Section  2.06 . Upon any reduction of Commitments under a Facility or Tranche thereof, the Commitment of each Lender under such Facility or Tranche thereof shall be reduced by such Lender’s ratable share of the amount by which such Facility or Tranche thereof is reduced (other than the termination of the Commitment of any Lender as provided in Section  3.06 ). All commitment fees accrued until the effective date of any termination of the Aggregate Commitments and unpaid, shall be paid on the effective date of such termination.

Section 2.07 Repayment of Loans .

(a) Initial Term Loans . The Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, repay to the Administrative Agent for the ratable account of the Term Lenders holding Initial Term Loans, the aggregate principal amount of all Initial Term Loans outstanding in consecutive quarterly installments as follows (which installments shall, to the extent applicable, be reduced as a result of the application of prepayments in accordance with the order of priority set forth in Sections 2.05 and 2.06 , or be increased as a result of any increase in the amount of Initial Term Loans pursuant to Section  2.14 :

 

-88-


Date

   Amount  

March 31, 2017 – December 31, 2018

   $ 2,125,000  

March 31, 2019 and each quarter thereafter ending prior to the Maturity Date for the Term Facilities

   $ 4,250,000  

provided , however , that the final principal repayment installment of the Initial Term Loans shall be repaid on the applicable Maturity Date for the Initial Term Loans and in any event shall be in an amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of all Initial Term Loans outstanding on such date.

(b) Revolving Credit Loans . The Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, repay to the Administrative Agent for the ratable account of the Appropriate Lenders on the applicable Maturity Date for each Revolving Tranche the aggregate principal amount of all Revolving Credit Loans under such Tranche outstanding on such date.

(c) Swing Line Loans . The Borrower shall, jointly and severally, repay each Swing Line Loan on the earlier to occur of (i) the date that is five Business Days after such Loan is made and (ii) the Maturity Date for the Revolving Credit Facility. At any time there shall exist a Default Lender, immediately upon the request of the Swing Line Lender, the Borrower shall repay Swing Line Loans in an amount sufficient to eliminate any Fronting Exposure in respect of the Swing Line Loans.

(d) All Loans shall be repaid, whether pursuant to this Section  2.07 or otherwise, in Dollars.

Section 2.08 Interest .

(a) Subject to the provisions of Section  2.08(b) , (i) each Eurocurrency Rate Loan under a Facility shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof for each Interest Period at a rate per annum equal to the sum of (A) the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate for such Interest Period plus (B) the Applicable Rate for Eurocurrency Rate Loans under such Facility; (ii) each Base Rate Loan under a Facility shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from the applicable borrowing date or conversion date, as the case may be, at a rate per annum equal to the sum of (A) the Base Rate plus (B) the Applicable Rate for Base Rate Loans under such Facility; and (iii) each Swing Line Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from the applicable borrowing date at a rate per annum equal to the sum of (A) the Base Rate plus (B) the Applicable Rate for Base Rate Loans under the Revolving Credit Facility. The Borrowers shall pay interest on all overdue Obligations hereunder, which shall include all Obligations following an acceleration pursuant to Section  8.02 (including an automatic acceleration) at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws. Accrued and unpaid interest on past due amounts (including interest on past due interest) shall be due and payable upon demand.

(b) Accrued interest on each Loan shall be due and payable in arrears on each Interest Payment Date applicable thereto and at such other times as may be specified herein; provided that in the event of any repayment or prepayment of any Loan (other than Revolving Credit Loans bearing interest based on the Base Rate that are repaid or prepaid without any corresponding termination or reduction of the Revolving Credit Commitments other than as set forth in Section  2.14(e) ), accrued interest on the principal amount repaid or prepaid shall be payable on the date of such repayment or prepayment. Interest hereunder shall be due and payable in accordance with the terms hereof before and after judgment, and before and after the commencement of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law.

(c) Interest on each Loan shall be payable in Dollars.

 

-89-


(d) All computations of interest hereunder shall be made in accordance with Section  2.10 of this Agreement.

Section 2.09 Fees . In addition to certain fees described in Sections 2.03(g) and (h) :

(a) Commitment Fee . The Borrowers shall pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of each Revolving Credit Lender in accordance with its Pro Rata Share of the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments, a commitment fee in Dollars equal to the Applicable Commitment Fee with respect to the Revolving Tranche (as in effect from time to time) multiplied by the actual daily amount by which the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments exceed the sum of (A) the Outstanding Amount of Revolving Credit Loans outstanding (which, for the avoidance of doubt, shall not include the Outstanding Amount of any Swing Line Loans) and (B) the Outstanding Amount of L/C Obligations, subject to adjustment as provided in Section  2.17 . The commitment fee shall accrue at all times from the Closing Date until the Maturity Date for the Revolving Tranche, and shall be due and payable quarterly in arrears on the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December, commencing with the last Business Day of the first full fiscal quarter to end following the Closing Date, and on the Maturity Date for the Revolving Tranche.

(b) Other Fees . The Borrowers shall pay to the Arrangers and the Administrative Agent for their own respective accounts fees in the amounts and at the times specified in the Fee Letter or other agreements between one or more Borrower and any of the Arrangers or the Administrative Agent in connection with this Agreement.

(c) The Borrowers shall pay to the Lenders such fees as shall have been separately agreed upon in writing in the amounts and at the times so specified.

Section 2.10 Computation of Interest and Fees ; Retroactive Adjustments of Applicable Rate .

(a) All computations of interest for (i) Base Rate Loans based on clause (b) of the definition thereof and (ii) Eurocurrency Rate Loans denominated in Pounds Sterling shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days, as the case may be, and actual days elapsed. All other computations of fees and interest shall be made on the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed (which results in more fees or interest, as applicable, being paid than if computed on the basis of a 365-day year). Interest shall accrue on each Loan for the day on which the Loan is made, and shall not accrue on a Loan, or any portion thereof, for the day on which the Loan or such portion is paid; provided that any Loan that is repaid on the same day on which it is made shall, subject to Section  2.12(a) , bear interest for one day. Each determination by the Administrative Agent of an interest rate or fee hereunder shall be conclusive and binding for all purposes, absent manifest error.

(b) If, as a result of any restatement of or other adjustment to the financial statements of the Borrowers or for any other reason, the Borrowers or the Lenders determine that (i) the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio as calculated by the Borrowers as of any applicable date was inaccurate and (ii) a proper calculation of such ratio would have resulted in higher interest or fees for any period, the Borrowers shall be obligated to pay to the Administrative Agent for the account of the applicable Lenders or the applicable L/C Issuer, as the case may be, promptly on demand by the Administrative Agent (or, after the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to the Borrowers under the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, automatically and with any such demand by the Administrative Agent being excused), an amount equal to the excess of the amount of interest or fees that should have been paid for such period over the amount of interest actually paid for such period. This clause (b) shall

 

-90-


not limit the rights of the Administrative Agent, any Lender or the applicable L/C Issuer, as the case may be, under Section  2.03(c)(iii) , Section  2.03(g) or (h) , Section  2.08(b) or under Article VIII . The Borrowers’ obligations under this Section  2.10(b) shall survive the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and acceleration of the Loans pursuant to Section  8.02 and the repayment of all other Obligations after an acceleration of the Loans pursuant to Sections 8.02 . Except in any case where a demand is excused as provided above, any additional interest or fees under this Section  2.10(b) shall not be due and payable until a demand is made for such payment by the Administrative Agent and accordingly, any non-payment of such interest or fees as result of any such inaccuracy shall not constitute a Default (whether retroactively or otherwise), and none of such additional amounts shall be deemed overdue or accrue interest at the Default Rate, in each case at any time prior to the date that is five Business Days following such demand.

Section 2.11 Evidence of Indebtedness .

(a) The Credit Extensions made by each Lender and the interest thereon shall be evidenced by one or more accounts or records maintained by such Lender and evidenced by one or more entries in the Register. The accounts or records maintained by the Administrative Agent and each Lender shall be prima facie evidence absent manifest error of the amount of the Credit Extensions made by the Lenders to the Borrowers and the interest and payments thereon. Any failure to so record or any error in doing so shall not, however, limit the obligation of the Borrowers hereunder to pay any amount owing with respect to the Obligations. In the event of any conflict between the accounts and records maintained by any Lender and the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent in respect of such matters, the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent shall control in the absence of manifest error. Upon the request of any Lender made through the Administrative Agent, the Borrowers shall execute and deliver to such Lender (through the Administrative Agent) a Note payable to such Lender, which shall evidence such Lender’s Loans in addition to such accounts or records. Each Lender may attach schedules to its Note and endorse thereon the date, Type (if applicable), amount and maturity of its Loans and payments with respect thereto.

(b) In addition to the accounts and records referred to in Section  2.11(a) , each Lender and the Administrative Agent shall maintain in accordance with its usual practice accounts or records and, in the case of the Administrative Agent, entries in the Register, evidencing the purchases and sales by such Lender of participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans. In the event of any conflict between the accounts and records maintained by the Administrative Agent and the accounts and records of any Lender in respect of such matters, the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent shall control in the absence of manifest error.

(c) Entries made in good faith by the Administrative Agent in the Register pursuant to Sections 2.11(a) and (b) , and by each Lender in its accounts or records pursuant to Sections 2.11(a) and (b) , shall be prima facie evidence of the amount of principal and interest due and payable or to become due and payable from the Borrowers to, in the case of the Register, each Lender and, in the case of such accounts or records, such Lender, under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, absent manifest error; provided that the failure of the Administrative Agent or such Lender to make an entry, or any finding that an entry is incorrect, in the Register or such accounts or records shall not limit the obligations of the Borrowers under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 2.12 Payments Generally; Administrative Agent s Clawback .

(a) General . All payments to be made by the Borrowers shall be joint and several and shall be made without condition or deduction for any counterclaim, defense, recoupment or setoff. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, all payments by the Borrowers hereunder shall be made to the

 

-91-


Administrative Agent, for the account of the respective Lenders to which such payment is owed, at the applicable Administrative Agent’s Office in Dollars and in Same Day Funds not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York Time) on the dates specified herein. If, for any reason, the Borrower is prohibited by any Law from making any required payment hereunder in a Designated Foreign Currency, the Borrower shall make such payment in Dollars in the Dollar Equivalent of the Designated Foreign Currency payment amount. The Administrative Agent will promptly distribute to each Lender its ratable share in respect of the relevant Facility or Tranche thereof (or other applicable share as provided herein) of such payment in like funds as received by wire transfer to such Lender’s Lending Office. All payments received by the Administrative Agent after 1:00 p.m. (New York Time), shall, in each case, be deemed received on the next succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue. If any payment to be made by the Borrowers shall come due on a day other than a Business Day, payment shall be made on the next following Business Day, and such extension of time shall be reflected in computing interest or fees, as the case may be; provided , however , that, if such extension would cause payment of interest on or principal of Eurocurrency Rate Loans to be made in the next succeeding calendar month, such payment shall be made on the immediately preceding Business Day.

(b) Funding by Lenders ; Presumption by Administrative Agent . Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from a Lender prior to the proposed date of any Borrowing of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or, in the case of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans, prior to 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on the date of such Borrowing) that such Lender will not make available to the Administrative Agent such Lender’s share of such Borrowing, the Administrative Agent may assume that such Lender has made such share available on such date in accordance with and at the time required by Section  2.02(b) and may, in reliance upon such assumption, make available to the Borrowers a corresponding amount. In such event, if any Lender does not in fact make its share of the applicable Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent, then such Lender, on the one hand, and the Borrowers, on the other hand, severally agree to pay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand an amount equal to such applicable share in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such amount is made available to the Borrowers by the Administrative Agent to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at (A) in the case of a payment to be made by such Lender, the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Administrative Agent in connection with the foregoing and (B) in the case of a payment to be made by the Borrowers, the interest rate applicable to Base Rate Loans. If both the Borrowers and such Lender pay such interest to the Administrative Agent for the same or an overlapping period, the Administrative Agent shall promptly remit to the Borrowers the amount of such interest paid by the Borrowers for such period. If such Lender pays its share of the applicable Borrowing to the Administrative Agent, then the amount so paid (less interest and fees) shall constitute such Lender’s Loan included in such Borrowing. Any payment by the Borrowers shall be without prejudice to any claim the Borrowers may have against a Lender that shall have failed to make its share of any Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent.

(c) Payments by the Borrowers; Presumptions by Administrative Agent . Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from the Borrower Representative prior to the date on which any payment is due to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Lenders or an L/C Issuer hereunder that the Borrowers will not make such payment, the Administrative Agent may assume that the Borrowers have made such payment on such date in accordance herewith and may, in reliance upon such assumption, distribute to the Appropriate Lenders or the applicable L/C Issuer, as the case may be, the amount due. In such event, if the Borrowers do not in fact make such payment, then each of the Appropriate Lenders or the applicable L/C Issuer, as the case may be, severally agrees to repay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand the amount so distributed to such Lender or such L/C Issuer, in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such

 

-92-


amount is distributed by the Administrative Agent to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Administrative Agent in connection with the foregoing.

A notice of the Administrative Agent to any Lender or the Borrowers with respect to any amount owing under this Section  2.12(c) shall be conclusive, absent manifest error.

(d) Failure to Satisfy Conditions Precedent . If any Lender makes available to the Administrative Agent funds for any Loan to be made by such Lender as provided in the foregoing provisions of this Article II , and such funds are not made available to the Borrowers by the Administrative Agent because the conditions to the applicable Credit Extension set forth in Article IV are not satisfied or waived in accordance with the terms hereof, the Administrative Agent shall return such funds (in like funds as received from such Lender) to such Lender on demand, without interest.

(e) Obligations of the Lenders Several . The obligations of the Lenders hereunder to make Loans, to fund participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans and to make payments pursuant to Section  9.07 are several and not joint. The failure of any Lender to make any Loan or to fund any such participation or to make any payment under Section  9.07 on any date required hereunder shall not relieve any other Lender of its corresponding obligation to do so on such date, and no Lender shall be responsible for the failure of any other Lender to so make its Loan or, to fund its participation or to make its payment under Section  9.07 .

(f) Funding Source . Nothing herein shall be deemed to obligate any Lender to obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner or to constitute a representation by any Lender that it has obtained or will obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner.

(g) Insufficient Funds . If at any time insufficient funds are received by and available to the Administrative Agent to pay fully all amounts of principal, L/C Borrowings, interest and fees then due hereunder, such funds shall be applied (i) first, toward payment of interest and fees then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of interest and fees then due to such parties, and (ii) second, toward payment of principal and L/C Borrowings then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of principal and L/C Borrowings then due to such parties.

(h) Unallocated Funds . If the Administrative Agent receives funds for application to the Obligations of the Loan Parties under or in respect of the Loan Documents under circumstances for which the Loan Documents do not specify the manner in which such funds are to be applied, the Administrative Agent may, but shall not be obligated to, elect to distribute such funds to each of the Lenders in accordance with such Lender’s ratable share of the sum of (a) the Outstanding Amount of all Loans outstanding at such time and (b) the Outstanding Amount of all L/C Obligations outstanding at such time, in repayment or prepayment of such of the outstanding Loans or other Obligations then owing to such Lender.

Section 2.13 Sharing of Payments . If, other than as expressly provided elsewhere herein (including the application of funds arising from the existence of a Defaulting Lender), any Lender shall obtain, either directly or indirectly, on account of the Loans made by it, or the participations in L/C Obligations or Swing Line Loans held by it, any payment (whether voluntary, involuntary, through the exercise of any right of setoff, or otherwise) in excess of its ratable share (or other share contemplated hereunder) thereof, such Lender shall immediately (a) notify the Administrative Agent of such fact and

 

-93-


(b) purchase from the other Lenders such participations in the Loans made by them and/or such subparticipations in the participations in L/C Obligations or Swing Line Loans held by them, as the case may be, as shall be necessary to cause such purchasing Lender to share the excess payment in respect of such Loans or such participations, as the case may be, pro rata with each of them; provided , however , that if all or any portion of such excess payment is thereafter recovered from the purchasing Lender under any of the circumstances described in Section  10.06 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the purchasing Lender in its discretion), such purchase shall to that extent be rescinded and each other Lender shall repay to the purchasing Lender the purchase price paid therefor, together with an amount equal to such paying Lender’s ratable share (according to the proportion of (i) the amount of such paying Lender’s required repayment to (ii) the total amount so recovered from the purchasing Lender) of any interest or other amount paid or payable by the purchasing Lender in respect of the total amount so recovered, without further interest thereon. The Borrowers agree that any Lender so purchasing a participation from another Lender may, to the fullest extent permitted by Law, exercise all its rights of payment (including the right of setoff, but subject to Section  10.09 ) with respect to such participation as fully as if such Lender were the direct creditor of the Borrowers in the amount of such participation. The Administrative Agent will keep records (which shall be conclusive and binding in the absence of manifest error) of participations purchased under this Section  2.13 and will in each case notify the Lenders following any such purchases or repayments. Each Lender that purchases a participation pursuant to this Section  2.13 shall from and after such purchase have the right to give all notices, requests, demands, directions and other communications under this Agreement with respect to the portion of the Obligations purchased to the same extent as though the purchasing Lender were the original owner of the Obligations purchased. For the avoidance of doubt, the provisions of this Section  2.13 shall not be construed to apply to (A) the application of Cash Collateral provided for in Section  2.16 , (B) the assignments and participations (including by means of a Dutch Auction and open market debt repurchases) described in Section  10.07 , (C) (i) the incurrence of any New Term Loans in accordance with Section  2.14 , (ii) the prepayment of Revolving Credit Loans in accordance with Section  2.14(e) in connection with a Revolving Credit Commitment Increase or (iii) any Specified Refinancing Debt in accordance with Section  2.18 , (D) any loan modification offer described in Section  10.01 , or (E) any applicable circumstances contemplated by Section  2.05(b) , 2.14 , 2.17 or 3.07 .

Section 2.14 Incremental Facilities .

(a) The Borrowers may, from time to time after the Closing Date, upon notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent (who shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders) specifying the proposed amount thereof, request (i) an increase in the Commitments under any Revolving Tranche (which shall be on the same terms as, and become part of, the Revolving Tranche proposed to be increased) (a “ Revolving Credit Commitment Increase ”), (ii) an increase in any Term Loan Tranche then outstanding (which shall be on the same terms as, and become part of, the Term Loan Tranche proposed to be increased hereunder (except as otherwise provided in clause (d) below with respect to amortization)) (each, a “ Term Commitment Increase ”) and (iii) the addition of one or more new term loan facilities to the Facilities (each, a “ New Term Facility ”; and any advance made by a Lender thereunder, a “ New Term Loan ”; and the commitments thereof, the “ New Term Commitment ” and together with the Revolving Credit Commitment Increase and the Term Commitment Increase, the “ New Loan Commitments ”) by an amount not to exceed (after giving effect to any applicable usage of such amount under this Agreement) the sum of (x) $45,000,000, minus the aggregate principal amount of (1) Incremental Notes incurred pursuant to Section  2.15 in reliance on the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, (2) Second Lien Additional Indebtedness utilizing Section  2.14(a)(x) of the Second Lien Credit Agreement and (3) Incremental Notes (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement) incurred pursuant to Section  2.15 of the Second Lien Credit Agreement in reliance on the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement) (such aggregate amount, the “ Cash-Capped Incremental Facility ”) plus (y) an unlimited amount (the “ Ratio-Based Incremental Facility ”) so long as the Maximum First Lien Net

 

-94-


Leverage Requirement is satisfied plus (z) an amount equal to all (i) voluntary prepayments of Term Loans made pursuant to Section  2.05(a) or Section  10.07(j)(i)(A) and (ii) voluntary prepayments of Revolving Credit Loans and Revolving Credit Commitment Increases to the extent the Revolving Credit Commitments with respect thereto are permanently reduced by the amount of such payments, other than in the case of clauses (i) and (ii), such voluntary prepayments financed with the proceeds of other Indebtedness (the “ Prepay Incremental Amount ”) (such sum, at any such time, the “ Incremental Amount ”); provided that any such request for an increase shall be in a minimum amount equal to the lesser of (x) the applicable Threshold Amount and (y) the entire amount of any increase that may be requested under this Section  2.14 ; provided , further , that (1) if at the time of any such incurrence or issuance, there is capacity under the foregoing clause (z), such capacity must be utilized before utilizing any available capacity under the foregoing clauses (x) and (y), (2) any capacity available under the foregoing clause (y) shall be deemed to be utilized prior to utilizing any capacity available under the foregoing clause (x) and (3) loans may be incurred under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and the Prepay Incremental Amount, and proceeds from any such incurrence under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and the Prepay Incremental Amount may be utilized in a single transaction by first, calculating the incurrence of the Prepay Incremental Amount, if any, second calculating the incurrence under the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and third calculating the incurrence under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility; provided , further , that solely for the purpose of calculating the Maximum First Lien Net Leverage Requirement to determine the availability under the New Loan Commitments at the time of incurrence, (a) any New Loan Commitments that are unsecured or secured on a junior basis shall nevertheless be deemed to be secured on a pari passu basis to the Obligations and (b) any cash proceeds from any Revolving Credit Commitment Increase, Term Commitment Increase or addition of New Term Facility pursuant to this Section  2.14 at such test date in calculating such Maximum First Lien Net Leverage Requirement shall be excluded for purposes of cash netting (however, to the extent the proceeds thereof are used to repay Indebtedness, pro forma effect shall be given to such repayment of Indebtedness). At the time of sending such notice to the applicable Lenders, the Borrower Representative shall specify the time period within which each applicable Lender is requested to respond (which, unless the Incremental Arranger otherwise agrees, shall in no event be less than ten Business Days from the date of delivery of such notice).

(b) The Borrowers may appoint an Incremental Arranger in connection with a New Loan Commitment. Each applicable Lender shall notify the Incremental Arranger within such time period whether or not it agrees to participate in such new facility or increase of the existing Tranche and, if so, whether by a percentage of the requested increase equal to, greater than, or less than its Pro Rata Share of any then-existing Tranche. Any Lender approached may elect or decline, in its sole discretion, to provide such increase or new facility. Any Lender not responding within such time period shall be deemed to have declined to increase its Commitment with respect to such Tranche or to provide a new Tranche. The Incremental Arranger shall notify the Borrower Representative of the Lenders’ responses to each request made under this Section  2.14 . To achieve the full amount of a requested increase or issuance of New Term Facility, as applicable, the Borrowers may also invite additional Eligible Assignees reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender (to the extent the consent of any of the foregoing would be required to assign Revolving Credit Loans to such Eligible Assignee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed) to become Lenders pursuant to a joinder agreement to this Agreement in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger and, to the extent required by clause (iii) in the first proviso after 10.01(i), the Administrative Agent.

(c) If (i) a Revolving Tranche or a Term Loan Tranche is increased in accordance with this Section  2.14 or (ii) a New Term Loan Facility is added in accordance with this Section  2.14 , the Incremental Arranger and the Borrowers shall determine the effective date (the “ Increase Effective Date ”)

 

-95-


and the final allocation of such increase or New Term Facility among the applicable Lenders. The Incremental Arranger shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders of the final allocation of such increase or New Term Facility and the Increase Effective Date. In connection with (i) any increase in a Term Loan Tranche or Revolving Tranche or (ii) any addition of a New Term Facility, in each case, pursuant to this Section  2.14 , this Agreement and the other Loan Documents may be amended in a writing (which may be executed and delivered by the Borrowers and the Incremental Arranger (and the Lenders hereby authorize such Incremental Arranger to execute and deliver any such documentation)) in order to establish the New Term Facility or to effectuate the increases to the Term Loan Tranche or Revolving Tranche and to reflect any technical changes necessary or appropriate to give effect to such increase or new facility in accordance with its terms as set forth herein. As of the Increase Effective Date, the amortization schedule for the Term Loan Tranche then increased set forth in Section  2.07(a) (or any other applicable amortization schedule for New Term Loans or Specified Refinancing Term Loans) shall be amended in a writing (which may be executed and delivered by the Borrowers and the Incremental Arranger (and the Lenders hereby authorize such Incremental Arranger to execute and deliver any such documentation)) to increase the then-remaining unpaid installments of principal by an aggregate amount equal to the additional Loans under such Term Loan Tranche being made on such date, such aggregate amount to be applied to increase such installments ratably in accordance with the amounts in effect immediately prior to the Increase Effective Date. If the Incremental Arranger is not the Administrative Agent, the actions authorized to be taken by the Incremental Arranger herein shall be done in consultation with the Administrative Agent and, with respect to the preparation of any documentation necessary or appropriate to carry out the provisions of this Section  2.14 (including amendments to this Agreement), any comments to such documentation reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent shall be reflected therein. The Borrowers, L/C Issuers and Lenders agree that the Administrative Agent shall have no liability for the actions of any Incremental Arranger (if other than the Administrative Agent) and this sentence shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

(d) With respect to any Revolving Credit Commitment Increase, Term Commitment Increase or addition of New Term Facility pursuant to this Section  2.14 , (i) except as set forth below, no Event of Default would exist after giving effect to such increase, (ii) (A) in the case of any increase of the Revolving Tranche, (1) the final maturity shall be the same as the Maturity Date applicable to the Revolving Credit Facility, (2) no amortization or mandatory commitment reduction prior to the Maturity Date applicable to the Revolving Credit Facility shall be required and (3) the terms and documentation applicable to the Revolving Credit Facility shall apply, (B) in the case of any increase of a Term Loan Tranche, the final maturity of the Term Loans, New Term Loans or Specified Refinancing Term Loans increased pursuant to this Section  2.14 shall be no earlier than the Latest Maturity Date for, and such additional Loans shall not have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity shorter than the longest remaining weighted average life of, any other outstanding Term Loans, New Term Loans or Specified Refinancing Term Loans, as applicable, and (C) in the case of any New Term Facility, such New Term Facility shall have a final maturity no earlier than the then Latest Maturity Date of any Term Loan Tranche and the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of such New Term Facility shall be no shorter than that of any existing Term Loan Tranche, (iii) except with respect to all-in yield and as set forth in subclause (C) above with respect to final maturity and Weighted Average Life to Maturity, or otherwise as shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, any such New Term Facility shall have the same terms as the Term Facility; provided that (x) to the extent such terms and documentation are not consistent with the existing Term Facility (except to the extent permitted above), such terms (if favorable to the existing Lenders) shall be incorporated into this Agreement for the benefit of all existing Lenders without further amendment requirements other than consultation with the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  2.14(c) , including, for the avoidance of doubt, at the option of the Borrowers, any increase in the Applicable Rate relating to the existing Term Facility to bring such Applicable Rate in line with the New Term Facility to achieve fungibility with such existing Term Facility and (y) otherwise, may be incorporated if reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger and the Administrative Agent and

 

-96-


(iv) to the extent reasonably requested by the Incremental Arranger, the Incremental Arranger shall have received legal opinions, resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 with respect to Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor (in a manner generally consistent with those delivered at the Closing Date, as modified to reflect changes subsequent thereto) (other than changes to such legal opinions resulting from a change in Law, change in fact or change to counsel’s form of opinion reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the conditions precedent to each such increase or New Term Facility shall be agreed to by the Lenders providing such increase or New Term Facility, as applicable, and the Borrowers; provided , further , in connection with the incurrence of any New Term Loans, if the proceeds of such New Term Loans are, substantially concurrently with the receipt thereof, to be used, in whole or in part, by the Borrowers or any other Loan Party to finance, in whole or in part, a Permitted Acquisition, then (A) the only representations and warranties hereunder that will be required to be true and correct in all material respects as of the applicable Increase Effective Date shall be (x) the Specified Representations (conformed as necessary for such Permitted Acquisition) and (B) the only Events of Default, the absence of which shall be a condition to such incurrence, shall be those under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g) (“ Permitted Acquisition Provisions ”).

(e) On the Increase Effective Date with respect to a Revolving Tranche, (x) each Revolving Credit Lender immediately prior to such increase or incurrence will automatically and without further act be deemed to have assigned to each Lender providing a portion of the increase to the Revolving Credit Commitments (each, a “ Revolving Commitment Increase Lender ”), and each such Revolving Commitment Increase Lender will automatically and without further act be deemed to have assumed, a portion of such Revolving Credit Lender’s participations hereunder in outstanding L/C Advances and Swing Line Loans such that, after giving effect to each such deemed assignment and assumption of participations, the percentage of the aggregate outstanding (i) participations hereunder in L/C Advances and (ii) participations hereunder in Swing Line Loans held by each Revolving Credit Lender (including each such Revolving Commitment Increase Lender) will equal the percentage of the aggregate Revolving Credit Commitments of all Revolving Credit Lenders represented by such Revolving Credit Lender’s Revolving Credit Commitment and (y) if, on the date of such increase, there are any Revolving Credit Loans outstanding, such Revolving Credit Loans shall on or prior to the Increase Effective Date be prepaid from the proceeds of Revolving Credit Loans made hereunder (reflecting such increase in Revolving Credit Commitments), which prepayment shall be accompanied by accrued interest on the Revolving Credit Loans being prepaid and any costs incurred by any Lender in accordance with Section  3.05 . The Administrative Agent and the Lenders hereby agree that the minimum borrowing, pro rata borrowing and pro rata payment requirements contained elsewhere in this Agreement shall not apply to the transactions effected pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence. The additional Term Loans made under the Term Loan Tranche subject to the increases shall be made by the applicable Lenders participating therein pursuant to the procedures set forth in Sections  2.01 and 2.02 and on the date of the making of such new Term Loans, and notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in Sections 2.01 and  2.02 , such new Loans shall be added to (and form part of) each Borrowing of outstanding Term Loans under such Term Loan Tranche on a pro rata basis (based on the relative sizes of the various outstanding Borrowings), so that each Lender under such Term Loan Tranche will participate proportionately in each then outstanding Borrowing of Term Loans under the Term Loan Tranche.

(f) (i) Any New Term Facility shall rank pari passu in right of payment, have the same guarantees as, and be unsecured, secured either on an “equal and ratable” basis with the other Facilities or on a junior lien basis to the Facilities (and on a pari passu or junior basis to the Second Lien Facility), in each case over the same Collateral that secures the Facilities (or less Collateral as may be agreed by the Lenders providing such New Term Facility), and in each case, the application of any proceeds of the Collateral securing such New Term Facility shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements,

 

-97-


(ii) the New Term Facility shall share ratably in any prepayments of the Term Loans pursuant to Section  2.05 (or otherwise provide for more favorable prepayment treatment for the then outstanding Term Loan Tranches than the Term Loans under such New Term Facility) and (iii) the all-in yield (whether in the form of interest rate margins, original issue discount, upfront fees, or Eurocurrency Rate or Base Rate floors paid by either Borrower (but not arrangement or underwriting fees paid to arrangers for their own account, structuring fees, ticking fees, commitment fees, unused line fees, any amendment and similar fees (regardless of whether paid in whole or in part to any or all lenders) and any fees not paid generally to all lenders to such applicable Facility) and equating original issue discount and upfront fees paid by either Borrower to interest rate for purposes of this calculation, assuming a four-year life to maturity) (such yield, “ All-In Yield ”) applicable to such New Term Facility shall be determined by the Borrowers and the Lenders providing such New Term Facility and, for any New Term Facility secured on a pari passu basis, shall not be more than 50 basis points higher than the corresponding All-In Yield for the applicable Term Loan Tranches of the same currency unless the All-In Yield with respect to such applicable Term Loan Tranches is increased to the amount necessary so that the difference between the All-In Yield with respect to such New Term Facility and the corresponding All-In Yield on such applicable Term Loan Tranches is equal to 50 basis points.

Section 2.15 New Incremental Notes .

(a) The Borrowers may from time to time after the Closing Date, upon notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent, specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof, request to issue one or more series of senior secured, senior unsecured, senior subordinated or subordinated notes (which notes, if secured by the Collateral, are secured on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations or on a junior lien basis to the Facilities (and pari passu or junior to the Liens securing the Second Lien Facility), and guaranteed only by the entities which are or who become Loan Parties (such notes, collectively, “ New Incremental Notes ”) in an amount not to exceed the Incremental Amount (at the time of issuance); provided that (i) no Event of Default would exist after giving Pro Forma Effect to any such request, subject to the Permitted Acquisition Provisions, and (ii) any such issuance of New Incremental Notes shall be in a minimum amount equal to the lesser of (x) the applicable Threshold Amount and (y) the entire amount that may be requested under this Section  2.15 ; provided , further , that any New Loan Commitments established pursuant to Section  2.14 and New Incremental Notes issued pursuant to this Section  2.15 , will count towards the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility, Cash-Capped Incremental Facilities and Prepay Incremental Amount as set forth in Section  2.14 .

(b) As a condition precedent to the issuance of any New Incremental Notes pursuant to this Section  2.15 , (i) the Borrowers shall deliver to the Administrative Agent a certificate dated as of the date of issuance of the New Incremental Notes signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying and attaching the resolutions adopted by each Borrower approving or consenting to the issuance of such New Incremental Notes, and certifying that the conditions precedent set forth in the following subclauses (ii) through (ix) have been satisfied (which certificate shall include supporting calculations demonstrating compliance, if applicable, with the Maximum First Lien Net Leverage Requirement), (ii) such New Incremental Notes shall not be Guaranteed by any Person that is not a Loan Party, (iii) to the extent guaranteed by any Loan Party or secured by any Collateral, such New Incremental Notes shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements); (iv) such New Incremental Notes shall have a final maturity no earlier than the then Latest Maturity Date, (v) the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of such New Incremental Notes shall not (A) be shorter than that of any then-existing Term Loan Tranche, or (B) to the extent unsecured, be subject to any amortization prior to the final maturity thereof, or be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except (x) customary assets sale, change of control or event of loss or similar event provisions and a customary acceleration right after an event of default or (y) AHYDO payments), (vi) such New Incremental Notes shall not be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except to the extent any such mandatory redemption or

 

-98-


prepayment is required to be applied pro rata to the Term Loans and other Indebtedness that is secured on a pari passu basis with the Obligations), (vii) the covenants and events of default (excluding pricing and optional prepayment and redemption terms) of such New Incremental Notes, when taken as a whole, are no more restrictive than those under any then outstanding Term Facility (except for covenants or other provisions (x) applicable only to periods after the Latest Maturity Date of the then outstanding Term Facility or (y) as are incorporated into the Loan Documents for the benefit of all existing Lenders (which may be accomplished without further amendment voting requirements) (it being understood that no New Incremental Notes shall include any financial maintenance covenants (including indirectly by way of a cross-default to this Agreement), but that customary cross-acceleration provisions may be included)), (viii) if secured, such New Incremental Notes shall only be secured by Collateral, and (ix) guarantees, collateral and other terms of such New Incremental Notes are (A) customary for similar debt securities in light of then-prevailing market conditions at the time of issuance) and (B) otherwise reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such New Incremental Notes, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such New Incremental Notes or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set forth in this clause (b), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the conditions precedent to each such increase shall be agreed to by the Lenders providing such increase and the Borrowers.

(c) The issuance of any New Incremental Notes shall also be subject, to the extent reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, to receipt by the Administrative Agent of legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements, including any supplements or amendments to the Collateral Documents to account for such New Incremental Notes. The Lenders hereby authorize the Administrative Agent to enter into amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents with the Borrowers as may be necessary or appropriate in order to secure any New Incremental Notes with the Collateral and/or to make such technical amendments as may be necessary or appropriate in the reasonable opinion of the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers in connection with the issuance of such New Incremental Notes, in each case on terms consistent with this Section  2.15 .

Section 2.16 Cash Collateral .

(a) Upon the request of the Administrative Agent or the applicable L/C Issuer under any Revolving Tranche (i) if the applicable L/C Issuer has honored any full or partial drawing request under any Letter of Credit issued under such Tranche and such drawing has resulted in an L/C Borrowing or (ii) if, as of the Letter of Credit Expiration Date, any L/C Obligation for any reason remains outstanding under such Tranche, the Borrower or Borrowers under such Tranche shall, in each case, immediately Cash Collateralize the then Outstanding Amount of all such L/C Obligations, as applicable. At any time that there shall exist a Defaulting Lender, immediately upon the request of the Administrative Agent, the applicable L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender, the Borrowers shall deliver to the Administrative Agent Cash Collateral in an amount sufficient to cover 103% of all Fronting Exposure of such Defaulting Lender after giving effect to Section  2.17(a)(iv) and any Cash Collateral provided by such Defaulting Lender.

(b) All Cash Collateral (other than credit support not constituting funds subject to deposit) shall be maintained in blocked non-interest bearing deposit accounts at the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent. The Borrowers, and to the extent provided by any Lender, such Lender, hereby grants

 

-99-


to (and subjects to the control of) the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent, for the benefit of the Administrative Agent, the applicable L/C Issuer and the Lenders (including the Swing Line Lender), and agrees to maintain, a first priority security interest in all such cash, deposit accounts and all balances therein, and all other property so provided as collateral pursuant hereto, and in all proceeds of the foregoing, all as security for the obligations to which such Cash Collateral may be applied pursuant to Section  2.16(c) . If at any time the Administrative Agent determines that Cash Collateral is subject to any right or claim of any Person other than the Administrative Agent as herein provided or that the total amount of such Cash Collateral is less than the applicable Fronting Exposure and other obligations secured thereby, the Borrowers and the relevant Defaulting Lender shall, promptly upon demand by the Administrative Agent, pay or provide to the Administrative Agent additional Cash Collateral in an amount sufficient to eliminate such deficiency.

(c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, Cash Collateral provided under any of this Section  2.16 or Sections 2.03 , 2.05 , 2.06 , 2.17 , 8.02 or 8.04 in respect of Letters of Credit or Swing Line Loans shall be held and applied to the satisfaction of the specific L/C Obligations, Swing Line Loans, obligations to fund participations therein (including, as to Cash Collateral provided by a Defaulting Lender, any interest accrued on such obligation) and other obligations for which the Cash Collateral was so provided prior to any other application of such property as may be provided for herein.

(d) Cash Collateral (or the appropriate portion thereof) provided to reduce Fronting Exposure or other obligations shall be released promptly following (i) the elimination of the applicable Fronting Exposure (after giving effect to such release) or other obligations giving rise thereto (including by the termination of Defaulting Lender status of the applicable Lender (or, as appropriate, its assignee following compliance with Section  10.07(b)(viii) )) or (ii) the Administrative Agent’s good faith determination that there exists excess Cash Collateral; provided , however , (x) that Cash Collateral furnished by or on behalf of a Loan Party shall not be released during the continuance of a Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  or an Event of Default (and following application as provided in this Section  2.16 may be otherwise applied in accordance with Section  8.04 ) and (y) the Person providing Cash Collateral and the applicable L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as applicable, may agree that Cash Collateral shall not be released but instead held to support future anticipated Fronting Exposure or other obligations.

Section 2.17 Defaulting Lenders .

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, if any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, then, until such time as that Lender is no longer a Defaulting Lender, to the extent permitted by applicable Law:

(i) That Defaulting Lender’s right to approve or disapprove any amendment, waiver or consent with respect to this Agreement shall be restricted as set forth in Section  10.01 .

(ii) Any payment of principal, interest, fees or other amounts received by the Administrative Agent for the account of that Defaulting Lender (under any Revolving Tranche whether voluntary or mandatory, at maturity, pursuant to Article VIII or otherwise, and including any amounts made available to the Administrative Agent by that Defaulting Lender pursuant to Section  10.09 ), shall be applied at such time or times as may be determined by the Administrative Agent as follows: first , to the payment of any amounts owing by that Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent hereunder; second , to the payment on a pro rata basis of any amounts owing by that Defaulting Lender to the applicable L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender under such Tranche hereunder; third , if so reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent or reasonably

 

-100-


requested by the applicable L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, to be held as Cash Collateral for future funding obligations of that Defaulting Lender of any participation in any Swing Line Loan or Letter of Credit issued under such Tranche; fourth , as the Borrowers may request (so long as no Default or Event of Default exists), to the funding of any applicable Loan in respect of which that Defaulting Lender has failed to fund its portion thereof as required by this Agreement, as determined by the Administrative Agent; fifth , if so determined by the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers, to be held in a non-interest bearing deposit account and released in order to satisfy obligations of that Defaulting Lender to fund Loans under this Agreement; sixth , to the payment of any amounts owing to the Lenders, the applicable L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender as a result of any non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by any Lender, the applicable L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender against that Defaulting Lender as a result of that Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; seventh , so long as no Default or Event of Default pursuant to Sections  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  exists, to the payment of any amounts owing to the Borrowers as a result of any non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by the Borrowers against that Defaulting Lender as a result of that Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; and eighth , to that Defaulting Lender or as otherwise directed by a court of competent jurisdiction; provided that if (x) under any such Tranche such payment is a payment of the principal amount of any Loans or L/C Borrowings in respect of which that Defaulting Lender has not fully funded its appropriate share and (y) such Loans or L/C Borrowings were made at a time when the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 were satisfied or waived, such payment shall be applied solely to pay the Loans of, and L/C Borrowings owed to, all non-Defaulting Lenders under such Tranche on a pro rata basis prior to being applied to the payment of any Loans of, or L/C Borrowings owed to, that Defaulting Lender. Any payments, prepayments or other amounts paid or payable to a Defaulting Lender that are applied (or held) to pay amounts owed by a Defaulting Lender or to post Cash Collateral pursuant to this Section  2.17(a)(ii) shall be deemed paid to and redirected by that Defaulting Lender, and each Lender irrevocably consents hereto.

(iii) That Defaulting Lender (x) shall not be entitled to receive any commitment fee pursuant to Section  2.09(a) for any period during which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender (and the Borrowers shall not be required to pay any such fee that otherwise would have been required to have been paid to that Defaulting Lender) and (y) shall be limited in its right to receive Letter of Credit fees as provided in Section  2.03(h) .

(iv) During any period in which there is a Defaulting Lender, for purposes of computing the amount of the obligation of each non-Defaulting Lender under such Tranche to acquire, refinance or fund participations in Letters of Credit or Swing Line Loans under such Tranche pursuant to Sections  2.03 and 2.04 , the “Pro Rata Share” of each non-Defaulting Lender under such Tranche shall be determined without giving effect to the Commitment under such Tranche of that Defaulting Lender; provided that (i) each such reallocation shall be given effect unless an Event of Default exists; and (ii) the aggregate obligation of each non-Defaulting Lender under a such Tranche to acquire, refinance or fund participations in Letters of Credit issued, and Swing Line Loans incurred, under such Tranche shall not exceed the positive difference, if any, of (1) the Commitment under such Tranche of that non-Defaulting Lender minus (2) the aggregate Outstanding Amount of the Loans, as applicable, under such Revolving Tranche of that Revolving Credit Lender.

(b) If the Borrowers, the Administrative Agent, the Swing Line Lender and each L/C Issuer agree in writing in their sole discretion that a Defaulting Lender should no longer be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender, the Administrative Agent will so notify the parties hereto, whereupon as of the effective date specified in such notice and subject to any conditions set forth therein (which may include

 

-101-


arrangements with respect to any Cash Collateral), that Lender will, to the extent applicable, purchase that portion of outstanding Loans of the other Lenders or take such other actions as the Administrative Agent may reasonably determine to be necessary to cause the Loans and funded and unfunded participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans to be held on a pro rata basis by the Lenders in accordance with their ratable shares (without giving effect to the application of Section  2.17(a)(iv) ) in respect of that Lender, whereupon that Lender will cease to be a Defaulting Lender; provided that no adjustments will be made retroactively with respect to fees accrued or payments made by or on behalf of the Borrowers while that Lender was a Defaulting Lender; provided , further , that except to the extent otherwise expressly agreed by the affected parties, no change hereunder from Defaulting Lender to Lender will constitute a waiver or release of any claim of any party hereunder arising from that Lender having been a Defaulting Lender.

Section 2.18 Specified Refinancing Debt .

(a) The Borrowers may, from time to time after the Closing Date, add one or more new term loan facilities and new revolving credit facilities to the Facilities (“ Specified Refinancing Debt ”; and the commitments in respect of such new term facilities, the “ Specified Refinancing Term Commitment ” and the commitments in respect of such new revolving credit facilities, the “ Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitment ”) pursuant to procedures reasonably specified by any Person that is a financial institution engaged in arranging similar financings in the ordinary course of its business (that is not an Affiliate of a Borrower) appointed by the Borrowers, after consultation with the Administrative Agent, as agent under such Specified Refinancing Debt (such Person (who may be the Administrative Agent, if it so agrees), the “ Specified Refinancing Agent ”) and reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers, to refinance (I) all or any portion of any Term Loan Tranches then outstanding under this Agreement and (II) all or any portion of any Revolving Tranche then in effect under this Agreement, in each case pursuant to a Refinancing Amendment; provided that such Specified Refinancing Debt (i) will rank pari passu in right of payment as the other Loans and Commitments hereunder; (ii) will not have obligors other than the Loan Parties; (iii) will be either (x) unsecured or (y) secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations or on a “junior” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations (in each case pursuant to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements); (iv) will have such pricing and optional prepayment terms as may be agreed by the Borrowers and the applicable Lenders thereof; (v) (x) to the extent constituting revolving credit facilities, will not have a maturity date (or have mandatory commitment reductions or amortization) that is prior to the scheduled Maturity Date of the Revolving Tranche being refinanced and (y) to the extent constituting term loan facilities, will have a maturity date that is not prior to the date that is after the scheduled Maturity Date of, and will have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity that is not shorter than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, the Term Loans being refinanced; (vi) in the case of any voluntary or mandatory prepayment of any Specified Refinancing Term Loan, such prepayments may be made on a pro rata basis or a less than pro rata basis (but not a greater than pro rata basis, except (I) in connection with Specified Refinancing Debt with respect thereto or (II) as requested by the Borrower Representative by written notice, to any Class or Class of Term Loans with an earlier Maturity Date as compared with the remaining Classes of Term Loans then outstanding) with all other Term Loans (vii) the borrowing and repayment (except for (A) payments of interest and fees at different rates on Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments (and related outstandings), (B) repayments required upon the maturity date of the Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments and (C) repayment made in connection with a permanent repayment and termination of commitments) of Loans with respect to Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments after the date of obtaining any Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments may be made on a pro rata basis or less than pro rata basis with all other Specified Refinancing Revolving Credit Commitments (except that the Borrowers shall be permitted to permanently repay and terminate commitments of any such Class on a better than a pro rata basis as compared to any other Class with a later maturity date than such Class); and (viii) subject to clauses (iv), (v), (vi) and (vii) above, will have terms and conditions

 

-102-


(other than pricing and optional prepayment and redemption terms) that are substantially identical to, or less favorable, when taken as a whole, to the lenders providing such Specified Refinancing Debt than, the terms and conditions of the Facilities and Loans being refinanced (as reasonably determined by the Borrowers in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of an objection (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects) within five Business Days after being notified of such determination by the Borrowers); and the Net Cash Proceeds of such Specified Refinancing Debt shall be applied, substantially concurrently with the incurrence thereof, to the pro rata prepayment of outstanding Loans being so refinanced (and, in the case of Revolving Credit Loans, a corresponding amount of Revolving Credit Commitments shall be permanently reduced), in each case pursuant to Sections  2.05 and 2.06 , as applicable; provided , however , that such Specified Refinancing Debt (x) may provide for any additional or different financial or other covenants or other provisions that are agreed among the Borrowers and the Lenders thereof and applicable only during periods after the then Latest Maturity Date in effect or, if favorable to the existing Lenders, as are incorporated into the Loan Documents for the benefit of all existing Lenders (which may be accomplished without further amendment requirements) and (y) shall not have a principal or commitment amount (or accreted value) greater than the Loans (or commitments as applicable) being refinanced (excluding accrued interest, fees, discounts, premiums or expenses).

(b) The Borrowers shall make any request for Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to a written notice to the Administrative Agent specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof. Any Lender approached to provide all or a portion of any Specified Refinancing Debt may elect or decline, in its sole discretion, to provide such Specified Refinancing Debt. Any Lender not responding within such time period shall be deemed to have declined to participate in providing such Specified Refinancing Debt. The Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrowers and each applicable Lender of the Lenders’ responses to each request made hereunder. To achieve the full amount of a requested issuance of Specified Refinancing Debt, and subject to the approval of the Administrative Agent, each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender, if applicable (in each case, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed), the Borrowers may also invite additional Eligible Assignees to become Lenders in respect of such Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to a joinder agreement to this Agreement in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent.

(c) The effectiveness of any Refinancing Amendment shall be subject to the satisfaction on the date thereof of each of the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 and, to the extent reasonably requested by the Specified Refinancing Agent, receipt by the Specified Refinancing Agent of legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements with respect to the Borrowers, including any supplements or amendments to the Collateral Documents providing for such Specified Refinancing Debt to be secured thereby, consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 (other than changes to such legal opinions resulting from a change in Law, change in fact or change to counsel’s form of opinion reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent). The Lenders hereby authorize the Specified Refinancing Agent to enter into amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents with the Borrowers as may be necessary in order to establish new Tranches of Specified Refinancing Debt and to make such technical amendments as may be necessary or appropriate in the reasonable opinion of the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Borrowers in connection with the establishment of such new Tranches, in each case on terms consistent with and/or to effect the provisions of this Section  2.18 .

(d) Each class of Specified Refinancing Debt incurred under this Section  2.18 shall be in an aggregate principal amount that is not less than the Threshold Amount. Any Refinancing Amendment may provide for the issuance of Letters of Credit for the account of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary (on a joint and several basis) in respect of a Revolving Tranche, or the provisions to the Borrower of Swing Line Loans, pursuant to any revolving credit facility established thereby, in each case, on terms substantially equivalent to the terms applicable to Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans under the Revolving Credit Commitments.

 

-103-


(e) The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each Lender as to the effectiveness of each Refinancing Amendment (if applicable, after the Specified Refinancing Agent has notified the Administrative Agent thereof). Each of the parties hereto hereby agrees that, upon the effectiveness of any Refinancing Amendment, this Agreement shall be deemed amended to the extent (but only to the extent) necessary to reflect the existence and terms of the Specified Refinancing Debt incurred pursuant thereto (including the addition of such Specified Refinancing Debt as separate “Facilities” hereunder and treated in a manner consistent with the Facilities being refinanced, including for purposes of prepayments and voting). Any Refinancing Amendment may, without the consent of any Person other than the Borrowers, the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Lenders providing such Specified Refinancing Debt, effect such amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents as may be necessary or appropriate, in the reasonable opinion of the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Borrowers, to effect the provisions of or consistent with this Section  2.18 ; provided that if the Specified Refinancing Agent is not the Administrative Agent, any amendment to any Loan Document other than this Agreement shall require the consent of the Administrative Agent). In addition, if so provided in the relevant Refinancing Amendment and with the consent of each L/C Issuer, participations in Letters of Credit expiring on or after the scheduled Maturity Date in respect of the Revolving Tranche shall be reallocated from Lenders holding Revolving Credit Commitments to Lenders holding extended revolving commitments in accordance with the terms of such Refinancing Amendment; provided , however , that such participation interests shall, upon receipt thereof by the relevant Lenders holding extended revolving commitments, be deemed to be participation interests in respect of such extended revolving commitments and the terms of such participation interests (including the commission applicable thereto) shall be adjusted accordingly. If the Specified Refinancing Agent is not the Administrative Agent, the actions authorized to be taken by the Specified Refinancing Agent herein shall be done in consultation with the Administrative Agent and, with respect to the preparation of any documentation necessary or appropriate to carry out the provisions of this Section  2.18 (including amendments to this Agreement), any comments to such documentation reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent shall be reflected therein. The Borrowers, L/C Issuers and Lenders agree that the Administrative Agent shall have no liability for the actions of any Specified Refinancing Agent (if other than the Administrative Agent) and this sentence shall survive the termination of this agreement.

ARTICLE III

Taxes, Increased Costs Protection and Illegality

Section 3.01 Taxes .

(a) Any and all payments by or on account of any obligation of the Borrowers or any other Loan Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document shall be made without deduction or withholding for any Taxes, except as required by applicable Law. If any applicable Law (as determined in the good faith discretion of an applicable Withholding Agent) requires the deduction or withholding of any Tax from or in respect of any such payment, then the applicable Withholding Agent shall be entitled to make such deduction or withholding and shall timely pay the full amount deducted or withheld to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law and, if such Tax is an Indemnified Tax, the sum payable by the Borrowers or other applicable Loan Party shall be increased as necessary so that after all such deductions or withholdings of Indemnified Taxes have been made (including such deductions and withholdings applicable to additional sums payable under this Section  3.01 ) the applicable Recipient receives an amount equal to the sum it would have received had no such deduction or withholding been made.

 

-104-


(b) In addition but without duplication, the Loan Parties shall timely pay to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law, or at the option of the Administrative Agent timely reimburse it for the payment of, any Other Taxes.

(c) The Loan Parties shall jointly and severally indemnify each Recipient, within 30 days after demand therefor, for the full amount of any Indemnified Taxes (including Indemnified Taxes imposed or asserted on or attributable to amounts payable under this Section  3.01 , but excluding Indemnified Taxes compensated under Section  3.01(a) ) payable or paid by such Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to such Recipient and any reasonable out-of-pocket expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Indemnified Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Authority. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to the Borrower Representative by a Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), or by the Administrative Agent on its own behalf or on behalf of a Lender, shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

(d) Within 30 days after any payment of Taxes by any Loan Party to a Governmental Authority pursuant to this Section  3.01 , such Loan Party shall deliver to the Administrative Agent the original or a certified copy of a receipt issued by such Governmental Authority evidencing such payment, a copy of the return reporting such payment or other evidence of such payment reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

(e) If any Recipient determines, in its sole discretion exercised in good faith, that it has received a refund (for this purpose, including credits that a Recipient receives in lieu of a cash refund) of any Indemnified Taxes as to which it has been indemnified pursuant to this Section  3.01 (including by the payment of additional amounts pursuant to this Section  3.01 ), it shall pay to the indemnifying party an amount equal to such refund (but only to the extent of indemnity payments made under this Section  3.01 with respect to the Indemnified Taxes giving rise to such refund), net of all out-of-pocket expenses (including Taxes) of such indemnified party and without interest (other than any interest paid by the relevant Governmental Authority with respect to such refund). Such indemnifying party, upon the request of such indemnified party, shall promptly repay to such indemnified party the amount paid over pursuant to this clause (e) (plus any penalties, interest or other charges imposed by the relevant Governmental Authority) in the event that such indemnified party is required to repay such refund to such Governmental Authority. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this clause (e), in no event will the indemnified party be required to pay any amount to an indemnifying party pursuant to this clause (e) the payment of which would place the indemnified party in a less favorable net after-Tax position than the indemnified party would have been in if the Tax subject to indemnification and giving rise to such refund had not been deducted, withheld or otherwise imposed and the indemnification payments or additional amounts with respect to such Tax had never been paid. This clause (e) shall not be construed to require any indemnified party to make available its Tax returns (or any other information relating to its Taxes that it deems confidential) to the indemnifying party or any other Person.

(f) Each Lender agrees that, upon the occurrence of any event giving rise to the operation of Section  3.01(a) or (c)  with respect to such Lender, it will, if requested by the Borrowers, use commercially reasonable efforts (subject to such Lender’s overall internal policies of general application and legal and regulatory restrictions) to avoid or reduce to the greatest extent possible any indemnification or additional amounts being due under this Section  3.01 , including to designate another Lending Office or account for any Loan or Letter of Credit affected by such event; provided that such efforts are made on terms that, in the reasonable judgment of such Lender, cause such Lender and its Lending Office(s) to suffer no material economic, legal or regulatory disadvantage; provided , further , that nothing in this Section  3.01(f) shall affect or postpone any of the Obligations of the Borrowers or the rights of such Lender pursuant to Sections 3.01(a) and (c) . The Borrowers hereby agree, jointly and severally, to pay all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by any Lender as a result of a request by the Borrowers under this Section  3.01(f) .

 

-105-


(g) (i) Any Lender that is entitled to an exemption from or reduction of withholding Tax with respect to any payments made under any Loan Document shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent, at the time or times reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent, such properly completed and executed documentation reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as will permit such payments to be made without withholding or at a reduced rate of withholding. In addition, (1) on or before the date that any such previously provided documentation, certificate or other evidence expires or becomes obsolete, (2) after the occurrence of any event requiring a change in the most recent documentation, certificate or evidence previously delivered by it to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent, and (3) if reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent, each Lender and Agent shall deliver such other documentation prescribed by applicable Law or reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as will enable the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent to determine whether or not such Person is subject to backup withholding or information reporting requirements. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the preceding two sentences, the completion, execution and submission of such documentation (other than such documentation set forth in Sections  3.01(g)(ii)(A) , (ii)(B), (ii)(D), (iii) and (iv)  below) shall not be required if in the Lender’s reasonable judgment such completion, execution or submission would subject such Lender to any material unreimbursed cost or expense or would materially prejudice the legal or commercial position of such Lender.

(ii) Without limiting the generality of Section  3.01(g)(i) :

(A) any Lender that is a U.S. Person shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent on or prior to the date on which such Person becomes a party to this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent), executed copies of IRS Form W-9 (or any successor form) certifying that such Lender is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding;

(B) any Non-U.S. Lender shall, to the extent it is legally eligible to do so, deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent (in such number of copies as shall be requested by the recipient) on or prior to the date on which such Non-U.S. Lender becomes a Lender under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent), whichever of the following is applicable:

(I) in the case of a Non-U.S. Lender claiming the benefits of an income tax treaty to which the United States is a party, executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (or any successor forms) establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax;

(II) executed copies of IRS Form W-8ECI (or any successor form);

(III) in the case of a Non-U.S. Lender claiming the benefits of the exemption for portfolio interest under Section 871(h) or Section 881(c) of the Code, (x) a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-1 to the effect that such Non-U.S. Lender is not a “bank” within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, a “10 percent shareholder” of a Borrower within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(B) of the Code or a “controlled foreign corporation” described in Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code (a “ U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ”) and (y) executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (or any successor forms); or

 

-106-


(IV) to the extent a Non-U.S. Lender is not the beneficial owner ( e.g ., where the Non-U.S. Lender is a partnership or a participating Lender), executed copies of IRS Form W-8IMY, accompanied by IRS Form W-8ECI, IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E, a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-2 or I-3 , IRS Form W-9, and/or other certification documents from each beneficial owner, as applicable; provided that if the Non-U.S. Lender is a partnership (and not a participating Lender) and one or more direct or indirect partners of such Non-U.S. Lender are claiming the portfolio interest exemption, such Non-U.S. Lender may provide a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-4 on behalf of each such direct and indirect partner;

(C) any Non-U.S. Lender shall, to the extent it is legally eligible to do so, deliver to the Borrower Representative or the Administrative Agent, executed copies of any other form prescribed by applicable Law as a basis for claiming exemption from or a reduction in U.S. federal withholding Tax, duly completed, together with such supplementary documentation as may be prescribed by applicable Law to permit the Loan Parties or the Administrative Agent to determine the withholding or deduction required to be made; and

(D) if a payment made to a Lender under any Loan Document would be subject to Tax imposed by FATCA if such Person were to fail to comply with the applicable reporting requirements of FATCA (including those contained in Section 1471(b) or 1472(b) of the Code, as applicable), such Person shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent at the time or times prescribed by Law and at such time or times reasonably requested by Borrowers or the Administrative Agent such documentation prescribed by applicable Law (including as prescribed by Section 1471(b)(3)(C)(i) of the Code) and such additional documentation reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as may be necessary for the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent to comply with their obligations under FATCA to determine whether such Person has complied with such Person’s obligations under FATCA and, if necessary, to determine the amount to deduct and withhold from such payment. Solely for purposes of this clause (D), “FATCA” shall include any amendments made to FATCA after the date of this Agreement.

(iii) Each Lender agrees that if any documentation it previously delivered expires or becomes obsolete or inaccurate in any respect, it shall promptly update and deliver such form or certification to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent or promptly notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent in writing of its legal ineligibility to do so.

(iv) On or before the date any Person becomes the Administrative Agent hereunder, (i) if such Person is a U.S. Person, it shall deliver to the Borrower Representative duly completed copies of IRS Form W-9 certifying that it is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding; or (ii) if such Person is not a U.S. Person, it shall deliver to the Borrower Representative a duly executed original U.S. branch withholding certificate on IRS Form W-8IMY evidencing its agreement with the Borrowers to be treated as a U.S. Person, with the effect that the Loan Parties will be entitled to make payments hereunder to the Administrative Agent without withholding or deduction on account of U.S. federal withholding Tax.

(v) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section  3.01(g) , a Lender shall not be required to deliver any documentation that such Lender is not legally eligible to deliver.

(h) For the avoidance of doubt, the term “ Lender ” shall, for purposes of this Section  3.01 , include any L/C Issuer and any Swing Line Lender.

 

-107-


Section 3.02 Illegality . If any Lender reasonably determines that any Law has made it unlawful, or that any Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful, for any Lender or its applicable Lending Office to make, maintain or fund Loans whose interest is determined by reference to the Eurocurrency Rate, or to determine or charge interest rates based upon the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate, or any Governmental Authority has imposed material restrictions on the authority of such Lender to purchase or sell, or to take deposits of, Dollars or any Designated Foreign Currency in the applicable interbank market then, on notice thereof by such Lender to the Borrower Representative through the Administrative Agent, (i) any obligation of such Lender to make or continue Eurocurrency Rate Loans in the affected currency or currencies or to convert Base Rate Loans to Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be suspended and (ii) if such notice asserts the illegality of such Lender making or maintaining Base Rate Loans the interest rate on which is determined by reference to the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender, shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference to the Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, in each case until such Lender notifies the Administrative Agent and the Borrower Representative that the circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist. Upon receipt of such notice the Borrowers shall, upon demand from such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), prepay or, (I) if applicable and such Loans are denominated in Dollars, convert all of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans to Base Rate Loans (the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference to the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate) or (II) if applicable and such Loans are denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency, the interest rate with respect to such Loans shall be determined by an alternative rate mutually acceptable to the Borrowers and the Lenders, either on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, if such Lender may lawfully continue to maintain such Eurocurrency Rate Loans to such day, or immediately, if such Lender may not lawfully continue to maintain such Eurocurrency Rate Loans. Upon any such prepayment or conversion, the Borrowers shall also pay accrued interest on the amount so prepaid or converted and all amounts due, if any, in connection with such prepayment or conversion under Section  3.05 . Each Lender agrees to designate a different Lending Office if such designation will avoid the need for such notice and will not, in the good faith judgment of such Lender, otherwise be materially disadvantageous to such Lender.

Section 3.03 Inability to Determine Rates . If the Administrative Agent or the Required Lenders reasonably determine that for any reason, adequate and reasonable means do not exist for determining the Eurocurrency Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurocurrency Rate Loan (including by means of an Interpolated Screen Rate), or that the Eurocurrency Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurocurrency Rate Loan does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to such Lenders of funding such Loan, or that deposits are not being offered to banks in the relevant interbank market for the applicable amount and the Interest Period of such Eurocurrency Rate Loan, the Administrative Agent will promptly so notify the Borrower Representative and each Lender. Thereafter, (x) the obligation of the Lenders to make or maintain Eurocurrency Rate Loans in the affected currency or currencies shall be suspended and (y) in the event of a determination described in the preceding sentence with respect to the Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, the utilization of the Eurocurrency Rate component in determining the Base Rate shall be suspended, in each case until the Administrative Agent (upon the instruction of the Required Lenders) revokes such notice. Upon receipt of such notice, the Borrowers may revoke any pending request for a Borrowing of, conversion of or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans or, failing that, will be deemed to have converted such request into a request for a Borrowing of Base Rate Loans in the amount specified therein (or, in the case of a pending request for a Loan denominated in a Designated Foreign Currency, the Borrowers and the Lenders may establish a mutually acceptable alternative rate).

 

-108-


Section 3.04 Increased Cost and Reduced Return; Capital Adequacy .

(a) If any Lender reasonably determines that as a result of the introduction of or any change in or in the interpretation of any Law, in each case after the Closing Date, or such Lender’s compliance therewith, there shall be any material increase in the cost to such Lender of agreeing to make or making, funding or maintaining any Loan the interest on which is determined by reference to the Eurocurrency Rate or (as the case may be) issuing or participating in Letters of Credit, or a material reduction in the amount received or receivable by such Lender in connection with any of the foregoing (including Taxes on or in respect of its loans, letters of credit, commitments, or other obligations, or its deposits, reserves, other liabilities or capital attributable thereto, but excluding for purposes of this Section  3.04(a) any such increased costs or reduction in amount resulting from (i) Indemnified Taxes indemnifiable under Section  3.01 , (ii) Excluded Taxes, and (iii) reserve requirements reflected in the Eurocurrency Rate), then within 15 days after demand of such Lender setting forth in reasonable detail such increased costs (with a copy of such demand to the Administrative Agent given in accordance with Section  3.05 ), the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such additional amounts as will compensate such Lender for such increased cost or reduction.

(b) If any Lender reasonably determines that the introduction of any Law regarding capital adequacy or liquidity requirements or any change therein or in the interpretation thereof, in each case after the Closing Date, or compliance by such Lender (or its Lending Office) therewith, has the effect of materially reducing the rate of return on the capital of such Lender or any corporation controlling such Lender as a consequence of such Lender’s obligations hereunder (taking into consideration its policies with respect to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements and such Lender’s desired return on capital), then within 15 days after demand of such Lender setting forth in reasonable detail the charge and the calculation of such reduced rate of return (with a copy of such demand to the Administrative Agent given in accordance with Section  3.05 ), the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such additional amounts as will compensate such Lender for such reduction.

(c) The Borrowers shall pay to each Lender, (i) as long as such Lender shall be required to maintain reserves or liquidity with respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or including Eurocurrency Rate funds or deposits, additional interest on the unpaid principal amount of each Eurocurrency Rate Loan equal to the actual costs of such reserves or liquidity allocated to such Loan by such Lender (as determined by such Lender in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error), and (ii) as long as such Lender shall be required to comply with any liquidity requirement, reserve ratio requirement or analogous requirement of any other central banking or financial regulatory authority imposed in respect of the maintenance of the Commitments or the funding of the Eurocurrency Rate Loans, such additional costs (expressed as a percentage per annum and rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) equal to the actual costs allocated to such Commitment or Loan by such Lender (as determined by such Lender in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive absent manifest error) which in each case shall be due and payable on each date on which interest is payable on such Loan; provided that the Borrowers shall have received at least 15 days’ prior notice (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) of such additional interest or cost from such Lender. If a Lender fails to give notice 15 days prior to the relevant Interest Payment Date, such additional interest or cost shall be due and payable 15 days from receipt of such notice.

(d) For purposes of this Section  3.04 , (i) the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and all requests, rules, regulations, guidelines or directives thereunder or issued in connection therewith and (ii) all requests, rules, guidelines, requirements, agreements, standards and directives promulgated by the Bank for International Settlements, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (or any successor or similar authority) or the United States or foreign regulatory authorities (other than foreign regulatory authorities in Switzerland), in each case pursuant to Basel III, shall, in each case, be deemed to have gone into effect after the Closing Date, regardless of the date enacted, adopted or issued.

 

-109-


Section 3.05 Funding Losses . Upon written demand of any Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) from time to time, setting forth in reasonable detail the basis for calculating such compensation, the Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, promptly compensate such Lender for and hold such Lender harmless from any loss, cost or expense incurred by it as a result of:

(a) any continuation, conversion, payment or prepayment of any Eurocurrency Rate Loan on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loan (whether voluntary, mandatory, automatic, by reason of acceleration, or otherwise);

(b) any failure by the Borrowers (for a reason other than the failure of such Lender to make a Loan or pursuant to a conditional notice) to prepay, borrow, continue or convert any Eurocurrency Rate Loan on the date or in the amount notified by the Borrowers;

(c) any failure by the Borrowers to make payment of any Loan or drawing under any Letter of Credit (or interest due thereon) on its scheduled due date or any payment of any Loan or drawing under any Letter of Credit (or interest due thereon) in a different currency from such Loan or Letter of Credit drawing; or

(d) any mandatory assignment of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans pursuant to Section  3.06 on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loans,

including foreign exchange losses and any loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment of funds obtained by it to maintain such Loan or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds were obtained, or from the performance of any foreign exchange contract (but excluding anticipated profits). For the purposes of calculating the amounts payable under this Section  3.05 , any “floor” requirement reflected in the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate shall be disregarded. The Borrowers shall also pay any customary administrative fees charged by such Lender in connection with the foregoing.

Section 3.06 Matters Applicable to All Requests for Compensation .

(a) A certificate of any Agent or any Lender claiming compensation under this Article  III and setting forth in reasonable detail a calculation of the additional amount or amounts to be paid to it hereunder shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error. In determining such amount, such Agent or such Lender may use any reasonable averaging and attribution methods. With respect to any Lender’s claim for compensation under Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 , the Loan Parties shall not be required to compensate such Lender for any amount incurred more than 180 days prior to the date that such Lender notifies the Borrower Representative of the event that gives rise to such claim; provided that if the circumstance giving rise to such claim is retroactive, then such 180-day period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof.

(b) If any Lender requests compensation under Section  3.04 , or a Borrower is required to pay any additional amount to any Lender, the L/C Issuer, or any Governmental Authority for the account of any Lender or the L/C Issuer pursuant to Section  3.01 , or if any Lender gives a notice pursuant to Section  3.02 , then such Lender or the L/C Issuer, as applicable, will, if requested by the Borrowers and at the Borrowers’ expense, use commercially reasonable efforts to designate another Lending Office for any Loan or Letter of Credit affected by such event; provided that such efforts (i) would eliminate or reduce amounts payable pursuant to Section  3.01 or 3.03 , as applicable, in the future and (ii) would not, in the judgment of such Lender or such L/C Issuer, as applicable, be inconsistent with the internal policies of, or otherwise be disadvantageous in any material legal, economic or regulatory respect to such Lender or its Lending Office or such L/C Issuer. The provisions of this clause (b) shall not affect or postpone any Obligations of the Borrowers or rights of such Lender pursuant to Section  3.04 .

 

-110-


(c) If any Lender requests compensation by the Borrowers under Section  3.04 , the Borrowers may, by notice to such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), suspend the obligation of such Lender to make or continue from one Interest Period to another Eurocurrency Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans into Eurocurrency Rate Loans (in the case of Term Loans and Revolving Credit Loans denominated in Dollars), until the event or condition giving rise to such request ceases to be in effect (in which case the provisions of Section  3.05(e) shall be applicable); provided that such suspension shall not affect the right of such Lender to receive the compensation so requested.

(d) In the case of Term Loans and Revolving Credit Loans denominated in Dollars, if the obligation of any Lender to make or continue from one Interest Period to another any Eurocurrency Rate Loan, or to convert Base Rate Loans into Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be suspended pursuant to Section  3.06(c) hereof, such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be automatically converted into Base Rate Loans on the last day(s) of the then current Interest Period(s) for such Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or, in the case of an immediate conversion required by Section  3.02 , on such earlier date as required by Law) and, unless and until such Lender gives notice as provided below that the circumstances specified in Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 hereof that gave rise to such conversion no longer exist:

(i) to the extent that such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans have been so converted, all payments and prepayments of principal that would otherwise be applied to such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be applied instead to its Base Rate Loans; and

(ii) all Loans that would otherwise be made or continued from one Interest Period to another by such Lender as Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be made or continued instead as Base Rate Loans, and all Base Rate Loans of such Lender that would otherwise be converted into Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall remain as Base Rate Loans.

(e) If any Lender gives notice to the Borrower Representative (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) that the circumstances specified in Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 hereof that gave rise to the conversion of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans pursuant to Section  3.06(d) no longer exist (which such Lender agrees to do promptly upon such circumstances ceasing to exist) at a time when Eurocurrency Rate Loans made by other Lenders are outstanding, such Lender’s Base Rate Loans shall be automatically converted, on the first day(s) of the next succeeding Interest Period(s) for such outstanding Eurocurrency Rate Loans, to the extent necessary so that, after giving effect thereto, all Loans held by the Lenders holding Eurocurrency Rate Loans and by such Lender are held pro rata (as to principal amounts, interest rate basis, and Interest Periods) in accordance with their respective Commitments.

(f) A Lender shall not be entitled to any compensation pursuant to the foregoing sections to the extent such Lender is not imposing such charges or requesting such compensation from borrowers (similarly situated to the Borrowers hereunder) under comparable syndicated credit facilities.

Section 3.07 Replacement of Lenders Under Certain Circumstances .

(a) If at any time (i) the Borrowers become obligated to pay additional amounts or indemnity payments described in Section  3.01 or 3.04 (other than with respect to Other Taxes) as a result of any condition described in such Sections or any Lender ceases to make Eurocurrency Rate Loans as a result of any condition described in Section  3.02 or 3.03 , (ii) any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender or (iii) any Lender becomes a Non-Consenting Lender (as defined below in this Section  3.07 ) (collectively, a “ Replaceable Lender ”), then the Borrowers may, on three Business Days’ prior written notice (or such

 

-111-


shorter time as the Administrative Agent may determine) from the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent and such Lender, either (i) replace such Lender by causing such Lender to (and such Lender shall be obligated to) assign pursuant to Section  10.07(b) (with the assignment fee to be paid by the Borrowers in such instance unless waived by the Administrative Agent) all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement (or, in the case of a Non-Consenting Lender, all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement with respect to the Facility or Facilities for which its consent is required) to one or more Eligible Assignees; provided that neither the Administrative Agent nor any Lender shall have any obligation to the Borrowers to find a replacement Lender or other such Person or (ii) so long as no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, terminate the Commitment of such Lender or L/C Issuer, as the case may be, and (1) in the case of a Lender (other than an L/C Issuer), repay all Obligations of the Borrowers owing (and the amount of all accrued interest and fees in respect thereof) to such Lender relating to the Loans and participations held by such Lender as of such termination date and (2) in the case of an L/C Issuer, repay all obligations of the Borrowers owing to such L/C Issuer relating to the Loans and participations held by such L/C Issuer as of such termination date and cancel or backstop on terms satisfactory to such L/C Issuer any Letters of Credit issued by it; provided that (i) in the case of any such replacement of, or termination of Commitments with respect to a Non-Consenting Lender such replacement or termination shall be sufficient (together with all other consenting Lenders including any other Replacement Lender) to cause the adoption of the applicable modification, waiver or amendment of the Loan Documents and (ii) in the case of any such replacement as a result of Borrowers having become obligated to pay amounts described in Section  3.01 or 3.03 , such replacement would eliminate or reduce payments pursuant to Section  3.01 or 3.03 , as applicable, in the future. Any Lender being replaced pursuant to this Section  3.07(a) shall (i) execute and deliver an Assignment and Assumption with respect to such Lender’s Commitment and outstanding Loans and participations in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans and (ii) deliver any Notes evidencing such Loans to the Borrowers (for return to the Borrowers) or the Administrative Agent. Pursuant to such Assignment and Assumption, (A) the assignee Lender shall acquire all or a portion, as the case may be, of the assigning Lender’s Commitment and outstanding Loans and participations in L/C Obligations and Swing Line Loans, (B) all Obligations relating to the Loans and participations (and the amount of all accrued interest, fees and premiums in respect thereof) so assigned shall be paid in full by the assignee Lender to such assigning Lender concurrently with such assignment and assumption and (C) upon such payment and, if so requested by the assignee Lender, the assigning Lender shall deliver to the assignee Lender the applicable Note or Notes executed by the Borrowers, the assignee Lender shall become a Lender hereunder and the assigning Lender shall cease to constitute a Lender hereunder with respect to such assigned Loans, Commitments and participations, except with respect to indemnification provisions under this Agreement, which shall survive as to such assigning Lender. In connection with any such replacement, if any such Replaceable Lender does not execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent a duly executed Assignment and Assumption reflecting such replacement within five Business Days of the date on which the assignee Lender executes and delivers such Assignment and Assumption to such Replaceable Lender, then such Replaceable Lender shall be deemed to have executed and delivered such Assignment and Assumption without any action on the part of the Replaceable Lender. In connection with the replacement of any Lender pursuant to this Section  3.07(a) , the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such amounts as may be required pursuant to Section  3.05 .

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained above, (i) any Lender that acts as an L/C Issuer may not be replaced hereunder at any time that it has any Letter of Credit outstanding hereunder unless arrangements satisfactory to such L/C Issuer (including the furnishing of a back-up standby letter of credit in form and substance, and issued by an issuer reasonably satisfactory to such L/C Issuer or the depositing of Cash Collateral into a cash collateral account in amounts and pursuant to arrangements consistent with the requirements of Section  2.16 ) have been made with respect to such outstanding Letter of Credit and (ii) the Lender that acts as the Administrative Agent may not be replaced hereunder except in accordance with the terms of Section  9.09 .

 

-112-


(c) In the event that (i) a Borrower or the Administrative Agent has requested the Lenders to consent to a waiver of any provisions of the Loan Documents or to agree to any amendment or other modification thereto, (ii) the waiver, amendment or modification in question requires the agreement of all affected Lenders in accordance with the terms of Section  10.01 or all the Lenders with respect to a certain class of the Loans and (iii) the Required Lenders have agreed to such waiver, amendment or modification, then any Lender who does not agree to such waiver, amendment or modification, in each case, shall be deemed a “ Non-Consenting Lender ”; provided that the term “Non-Consenting Lender” shall also include (x) any Lender that rejects (or is deemed to reject) a loan modification offer under Section  10.01 , which loan modification has been accepted by at least the Majority Lenders of the respective Tranche of Loans whose Loans and/or Commitments are to be extended pursuant to such loan modification and (y) any Lender that does not elect to become a lender in respect of any Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to Section  2.18 . If any applicable Lender shall be deemed a Non-Consenting Lender and is required to assign all or any portion of its Initial Term Loans pursuant to Section  3.07(a) prior to the one-year anniversary of the Closing Date, in connection with any such waiver, amendment or modification constituting a Repricing Event, the Borrowers shall pay such Non-Consenting Lender a fee equal to 1.00% of the principal amount of the Initial Term Loans so assigned by such Non-Consenting Lender.

(d) All of the Loan Parties’ obligations under this Article III shall survive termination of the Aggregate Commitments and repayment of all other Obligations hereunder, any assignment by or replacement of a Lender and any resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent.

Section 3.08 Currency Equivalents .

(a) The Administrative Agent shall determine the Dollar Equivalent of each Revolving Credit Loan under such Tranche in Designated Foreign Currencies (i) as of the first day of each Interest Period applicable thereto and (ii) as of the end of each fiscal quarter of a Borrower, and shall promptly notify the Borrower Representative and the Lenders under such tranche of each Dollar Equivalent so determined by it. Each such determination shall be based on the Exchange Rate (x) on the date of the related Borrowing request for purposes of the initial such determination for any Revolving Credit Loan and (y) on the fourth Business Day prior to the date as of which such Dollar Amount is to be determined, for purposes of any subsequent determination.

(b) If after giving effect to any such determination of a Dollar Equivalent, the sum of the aggregate Outstanding Amount of the Revolving Credit Loans and the L/C Obligations under any Revolving Tranche exceeds the aggregate amount of Revolving Credit Commitments under such Tranche then in effect, the Borrower shall, within five Business Days of receipt of notice thereof from the Administrative Agent setting forth such calculation in reasonable detail, prepay the applicable outstanding Revolving Credit Loans or take other action as the Administrative Agent, in its discretion, may direct (including Cash Collateralization of the applicable L/C Obligations in amounts from time to time equal to such excess) to the extent necessary to eliminate any such excess.

ARTICLE IV

Conditions Precedent

Section 4.01 Conditions to Credit Extensions on the Closing Date . The obligation of each Lender and L/C Issuer, as applicable, to make its initial Credit Extension hereunder on the Closing Date is subject to the satisfaction as to form and substance in the opinion of the Administrative Agent (acting reasonably) or due waiver in accordance with Section  10.01 of each of the following conditions precedent on or prior to the Closing Date:

 

-113-


(a) Credit Agreement; Other Loan Documents . The Administrative Agent shall have received all of the following, each of which shall be originals or facsimiles or “pdf” files (followed promptly by originals) unless otherwise specified, each properly executed by a Responsible Officer of the signing Loan Party, each dated on or prior to the Closing Date, each in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, and each accompanied by their respective required schedules and other attachments:

(i) (A) this Agreement from Holdings and the Borrowers, (B) the Guaranty from Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor, (C) the Intercompany Subordination Agreement from Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor, and (D) the Perfection Certificate from each Loan Party;

(ii) [reserved];

(iii) the Security Agreement, duly executed by the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties party thereto, together with copies of proper financing statements, filed or duly prepared for filing under the Uniform Commercial Code in all jurisdictions that the Administrative Agent may deem reasonably necessary in order to perfect and protect the Liens on assets of the Borrowers and such other Loan Parties created under the Security Agreement, covering the Collateral described in the Security Agreement; and

(iv) certified copies of UCC, United States Patent and Trademark Office and United States Copyright Office, tax and judgment lien searches, bankruptcy and pending lawsuit searches or equivalent reports or searches, each of a recent date listing all effective financing statements, lien notices or comparable documents that name any Loan Party as debtor and that are filed in those state and county jurisdictions in which any Loan Party is organized or maintains its principal place of business and such other searches that are required by the Perfection Certificate or that the Collateral Agent deems necessary or appropriate, none of which encumber the Collateral covered or intended to be covered by the Collateral Documents (other than Liens permitted under Section  7.01 );.

(b) Committed Loan Notice . The Administrative Agent shall have received a Committed Loan Notice relating to the initial Credit Extensions to be made on the Closing Date, to be provided at least (A) three Business Days prior to the Closing Date for any Borrowings of Eurocurrency Rate Loans or (B) one Business Day prior to the Closing Date for any Borrowings of Base Rate Loans;

(c) Representations and Warranties . All Specified Acquisition Agreement Representations shall be true and correct in all material respects on the Closing Date, and all Specified Representations made by any Loan Party shall be true and correct in all material respects on the Closing Date;

(d) Legal Opinions . The Administrative Agent shall have received executed legal opinions of (i) Latham & Watkins LLP, special New York counsel to the Loan Parties, and (ii) Robins Kaplan LLP, special Minnesota counsel to the Loan Parties, in each case in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(e) Pledged Interests, Pledged Debt; Pledged Instruments of Transfer . Subject to the last paragraph of this Section  4.01 , the Collateral Agent shall have received the certificates, if any, representing Pledged Equity and instruments evidencing the Pledged Debt, in each case, together with an undated stock power or other appropriate instrument of transfer for each such certificate or instrument executed in blank by a duly authorized officer of the pledgor thereof;

 

-114-


(f) Solvency Certificate . The Administrative Agent shall have received a solvency certificate signed by a senior financial officer on behalf of the Borrowers, substantially in the form of Exhibit  J , after giving effect to the Transactions;

(g) Refinancing . The Refinancing shall have been, or shall substantially concurrently with the initial borrowings under the Facilities be, consummated, and all security interests in respect of, and Liens securing, the Indebtedness and other obligations thereunder created pursuant to the security documentation relating thereto shall have been terminated and released (or arrangements therefor reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent shall have been made), and the Administrative Agent shall have received all such releases as may have been reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, which releases shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(h) Target Company Material Adverse Effect . Since the last Balance Sheet Date (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement on the date hereof), there has not occurred a Target Company Material Adverse Effect, and this condition shall not be qualified by any disclosure set forth in the Disclosure Letter (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement on the date hereof);

(i) Acquisition . The Acquisition shall have been consummated, or substantially simultaneously with the initial borrowing under the Facilities shall be consummated, in all material respects in accordance with the terms of the Acquisitions Agreement, without giving effect to any modifications, amendments, consents or waivers thereto or thereunder that are material and adverse to the Lenders or the Arrangers without the prior consent of the Arrangers (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned), it being hereby understood and agreed that (A) any change to the definition of “Material Adverse Effect” contained in the Acquisition Agreement shall be deemed to be material and adverse to the Lenders and Arrangers and (B) any change in the purchase price payable in connection with the Acquisition shall not be deemed to be material and adverse to the interests of the Lenders and the Arrangers; provided , that (x) any increase in the purchase price so payable is funded solely by an increase in the aggregate amount of the Equity Contribution and (y) any reduction in the purchase price so payable is allocated (I)  first , to reduce the Equity Contribution to an amount that is equal to 35% of the total pro forma consolidated gross debt and equity capitalization of the Borrowers and its Subsidiaries on the Closing Date (excluding any Letters of Credit issued on the Closing Date and amounts funded under the Revolving Credit Facility to fund upfront fees or original issue discount pursuant to the “market flex” provisions in the Fee Letter in respect of the Facilities or Second Lien Facility) after giving effect to the Transactions and (II)  second , (a) 65% to pro rata reductions in the aggregate principal amounts of the Initial Term Loans and the Second Lien Loans funded on the Closing Date and (b) 35% to a reduction to the Equity Contribution;

(j) Second Lien Term Facility . The Second Lien Facility Documentation required by the terms of the Second Lien Credit Agreement shall have been duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party thereto to the Second Lien Administrative Agent and shall be in full force and effect, and substantially contemporaneously with the funding of the Facilities, the Second Lien Facility shall be funded;

(k) Intercreditor Agreement . On the Closing Date, the Intercreditor Agreement shall have been duly executed and delivered by each party thereto and shall be in full force and effect;

(l) Financial Statements . The Arrangers shall have received the Audited Financial Statements and the Unaudited Financial Information;

 

-115-


(m) Pro Forma Financial Statements . The Arrangers shall have received a pro forma consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries based on the historical balance sheet of the Company as of the last day of the most recently completed fiscal quarter ended at least 45 days prior to the Closing Date, prepared so as to give effect to the Transactions as if the Transactions had occurred as of such date, which need not be prepared in compliance with Regulation S-X of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or include adjustments for purchase accounting;

(n) Closing Certificate . The Administrative Agent shall have received a certificate of each Loan Party, dated as of the Closing Date, each substantially in the form of Exhibit C , with appropriate insertions and attachments;

(o) USA PATRIOT Act . No later than at least three Business Days prior to the Closing Date, the Borrowers shall have provided the documentation and other information about the Borrowers and the Guarantors as has been reasonably requested in writing at least ten days prior to the Closing Date by the Arrangers as they reasonably determine is required by regulatory authorities under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money-laundering rules and regulations, including, without limitation, the PATRIOT Act;

(p) Filings . Subject to the last paragraph of this Section  4.01 , each intellectual property security agreement and each other action required by the Collateral Documents to be filed or taken in order to create in favor of the Collateral Agent, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a first priority perfected Lien (subject to Liens permitted under Section  7.01 ) on the Collateral described therein shall have been delivered to the Collateral Agent in proper form for filing or shall have been taken;

(q) Equity Contribution . The Equity Contribution shall have been or, substantially concurrently with the funding of the Facilities shall be, made in at least the amount not less than that contemplated by the definition of “Transactions” (or such lesser amount permitted by clause (y) of the proviso to Section  4.01(i) ) and not less than 50.1% of such proceeds shall have been attributable to contributions by the Sponsor); and

(r) Fees . All fees required to be paid on the Closing Date pursuant to this Agreement and the Fee Letter and reasonable out-of-pocket expenses required to be paid on the Closing Date pursuant to this Agreement and the Fee Letter, to the extent invoiced at least three Business Days prior to the Closing Date (or such later date as the Borrowers may reasonably agree) shall, upon the initial Borrowing under the Facilities, have been paid (which amounts may be offset against the proceeds of the Initial Term Loan).

Without limiting the generality of the provisions of Section  9.03 , for purposes of determining compliance with the conditions specified in this Section  4.01 , each Lender as of the Closing Date shall be deemed to have consented to, approved or accepted or to be satisfied with, each document or other matter required hereunder to be consented to or approved by or acceptable or satisfactory to a Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received written notice from such Lender prior to the Closing Date specifying its objection thereto.

Each of the requirements set forth in clauses (e) and (p) above (except (a) to the extent that a Lien on such Collateral may under applicable law be perfected on the Closing Date by the filing of financing statements under the Uniform Commercial Code of any applicable jurisdiction, (b) pledge and perfection of the Equity Interests of the Borrowers and their respective material, wholly-owned U.S. Subsidiaries and (c) the delivery of stock certificates of the Borrowers and the wholly-owned U.S. Subsidiaries of each Borrower (other than (x) Immaterial Subsidiaries and (y) Subsidiaries of a Borrower to the extent stock certificates issued by such entities are not delivered to the Borrowers on the Closing Date) ( provided , however , that the Borrowers shall use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain such certificates from the Seller on or prior to the Closing Date to the extent in existence prior to the Closing Date) to the extent

 

-116-


included in the Collateral, with respect to which a Lien may be perfected on the Closing Date by the delivery of a stock certificate) shall not constitute conditions precedent under this Section  4.01 after the Borrowers’ use of commercially reasonable efforts to satisfy such requirements without undue burden or expense; provided that the Borrowers hereby agree to deliver, or cause to be delivered, such documents and instruments, or take or cause to be taken such other actions, in each case, as may be required to perfect such security interests within the time specified on Schedule  6.16.

Section 4.02 Conditions to All Credit Extensions . The obligation of each Lender or L/C Issuer, as applicable, to honor any Request for Credit Extension after the Closing Date (other than as contemplated by Section  2.14 or 2.15 , and other than a Committed Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Loans to the other Type or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans) is subject to the following conditions precedent:

(a) Subject in the case of any Borrowing in connection with a New Loan Commitment to the limitations in Section  2.14(d) and in the case of Borrowings (other than a Revolving Credit Borrowing) in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition to the limitations in Section  1.02(i) , the representations and warranties of the Borrowers and each other Loan Party contained in Article V or any other Loan Document shall be true and correct in all material respects (and in all respects if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) on and as of the date of such Credit Extension, except to the extent that such representations and warranties specifically refer to an earlier date, in which case they shall be true and correct in all material respects (and in all respects if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) as of such earlier date, and except that for purposes of this Section  4.02 , the representations and warranties contained in Sections 5.05(a) and 5.05(b) shall be deemed to refer to the most recent financial statements furnished pursuant to Section  6.01(a) and (b) , respectively, prior to such proposed Credit Extension.

(b) Subject in the case of any Borrowing in connection with a New Loan Commitment to the limitations in Section  2.14(d) and in the case of Borrowings (other than a Revolving Credit Borrowing) in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition to the limitations in Section  1.02(i) , no Default or Event of Default shall exist, or would result from such proposed Credit Extension or from the application of the proceeds therefrom.

(c) The Administrative Agent and, if applicable, the applicable L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender shall have received a Request for Credit Extension in accordance with the requirements hereof.

Each Request for Credit Extension (other than a Committed Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Loans to the other Type or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans) submitted by the Borrowers shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty that the conditions specified in Sections 4.02(a) and (b)  have been satisfied (unless waived) on and as of the date of the applicable Credit Extension.

ARTICLE V

Representations and Warranties

Each of Holdings and the Borrowers, on the Closing Date and at the time of each Credit Extension, represents and warrants to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders (after giving effect to the Transaction) that:

Section 5.01 Existence, Qualification and Power; Compliance with Laws . Each Loan Party and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries (a) is a Person duly organized, formed or incorporated, validly existing and in good standing (or its equivalent, to the extent such concept is applicable in the relevant

 

-117-


jurisdiction) under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organization, (b) has all requisite power and authority to (i) own or lease its assets and carry on its business and (ii) execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is a party, (c) is duly qualified and is authorized to do business and in good standing (to the extent such concept is applicable in the relevant jurisdiction) under the Laws of each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification and (d) has all requisite governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals to operate its business as currently conducted; except in each case referred to in clauses (a) (other than with respect to the Borrowers), (b)(i), (b)(ii) (other than with respect to the Borrowers), (c) and (d), to the extent that any failure to be so or to have such could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.02 Authorization; No Contravention . The execution, delivery and performance by each Loan Party of each Loan Document to which such Person is or is to be a party, are within such Loan Party’s corporate or other powers, have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other organizational action and do not (a) contravene the terms of any of such Person’s Organization Documents, (b) violate any Law or (c) conflict with or result in any breach or contravention of, or the creation of any Lien under (other than as permitted by Section  7.01 ), or require any payment (other than for Indebtedness to be repaid on the Closing Date in connection with the Transaction) to be made under any Contractual Obligation to which such Person is a party, except, in the case of subclauses (b) and (c) to the extent that such violation, conflict, breach or contravention could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.03 Governmental Authorization . No approval, consent, exemption, authorization or other action by, or notice to, or filing with, any Governmental Authority is necessary or required and no stamp, registration, notarial or similar Taxes or fees are payable in connection with (a) the execution, delivery, performance by, or enforcement against, any Loan Party of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or for the consummation of the Transaction, (b) the grant by any Loan Party of the Liens granted by it pursuant to the Collateral Documents, (c) the perfection or maintenance of the Liens created under the Collateral Documents or (d) the exercise by the Administrative Agent or any Lender of its rights under the Loan Documents or the remedies in respect of the Collateral pursuant to the Collateral Documents, except for (w) filings, registrations and taxes and fees necessary to perfect the Liens on the Collateral granted by the Loan Parties or any Restricted Subsidiary in favor of the Secured Parties consisting of UCC financing statements, filings in the United States Patent and Trademark Office and the United States Copyright Office and Mortgages and all other Perfection Requirements, (x) the approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations, actions, notices and filings which have been duly obtained, taken, given or made and are in full force and effect, (y) those approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations or other actions, notices, filings and payments set out in the Collateral Documents and (z) those approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations or other actions, notices, filings and payments, the failure of which to obtain or make could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.04 Binding Effect . This Agreement and each other Loan Document has been duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party that is party thereto. This Agreement and each other Loan Document constitutes, a legal, valid and binding obligation of such Loan Party, enforceable against each Loan Party that is party thereto in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by any applicable bankruptcy, administration, administrative receivership, winding-up, insolvency, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), receivership, moratorium or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity.

 

-118-


Section 5.05 Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect .

(a) The Audited Financial Statements and Unaudited Financial Information fairly present in all material respects the combined financial condition of the Target Companies as of the dates thereof and its results of operations for the period covered thereby in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein.

(b) The unaudited consolidated financial statements of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(b)(i) were prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein, and (ii) fairly present in all material respects the consolidated financial condition of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries as of the date thereof and their results of operations for the period covered thereby, subject to the absence of footnotes and to normal and recurring year-end audit adjustments.

(c) Since the Closing Date, there has been no event or circumstance, either individually or in the aggregate, that has had or would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

(d) The consolidated forecasted balance sheets, statements of income and statements of cash flows of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(c) were prepared in good faith on the basis of the assumptions stated therein, which assumptions were reasonable in light of the conditions existing at the time of delivery of such forecasts; it being understood that no assurance can be given that any particular projections will be realized, that actual results may vary from such forecasts and that such variations may be material.

Section 5.06 Litigation . There are no actions, suits, proceedings, claims or disputes pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers threatened in writing, at law, in equity, in arbitration or before any Governmental Authority, against the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, or against any of their properties or revenues that would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.07 Use of Proceeds . The Borrowers (a) will only use the proceeds of the Initial Term Loans to finance a portion of the Transactions (including paying any fees, commissions and expenses associated therewith and, if applicable, to be retained on the Borrowers’ balance sheet); (b) will only use the proceeds of the Revolving Credit Loans incurred on the Closing Date to finance (i) any upfront fees or original issue discount required to be funded on the Closing Date with respect to the Facilities and imposed pursuant to the market flex provisions of the Fee Letter, (ii) the issuance of Letters of Credit as required to backstop letters of credit and similar obligations of the Company existing on the Closing Date and (iii) any other Transaction Costs to be paid on the Closing Date, in an amount not to exceed, in the case of clauses (ii) and (iii), $5,000,000; and (c) will use the proceeds of all other Borrowings to finance the working capital needs of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries and for general corporate purposes of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including Permitted Acquisitions and other acquisitions permitted hereunder).

Section 5.08 Ownership of Property; Liens .

(a) Each Loan Party and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries has fee simple or other comparable valid title to, or leasehold interests in, all real property necessary in the ordinary conduct of its business, free and clear of all Liens except for defects in title that do not materially interfere with its ability to conduct its business or to utilize such assets for their intended purposes and Liens permitted by Section  7.01 , except where the failure to have such title or interests could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on the use or operation of any Material Real Property or any real property necessary for the ordinary conduct of the Borrowers’ business, taken as a whole.

 

-119-


(b) Set forth on Schedule 5.08(b) hereto is a complete and accurate list, in all material respects, of all Material Real Property owned by any Loan Party as of the Closing Date (after giving effect to the Transaction), showing as of the Closing Date, the street address (to the extent available), county or other relevant jurisdiction, state and record owner; and as of the Closing Date (after giving effect to the Transaction) no Loan Party owns any Material Real Property except as listed on Schedule  5.08(b) .

Section 5.09 Environmental Compliance . Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect:

(a) The Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries and their respective operations and properties, are in compliance with all applicable Environmental Laws and Environmental Permits and no Borrower nor any of the Restricted Subsidiaries are subject to or aware of any basis for any Environmental Liability.

(b) Hazardous Materials have not been released, discharged or disposed of on or from any property currently or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, formerly owned, leased or operated by the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, except for such releases, discharges and disposals that were in compliance with, or would not reasonably be expected to give rise to liability under, Environmental Laws.

(c) None of the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries has received notice of or is subject to any claim, action, proceeding or suit alleging liability pursuant to any Environmental Law.

Section 5.10 Taxes . Holdings, the Borrowers and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries have filed or have caused to be filed all Tax returns and reports required to be filed, and have paid all Taxes (including in its capacity as a withholding agent) levied or imposed upon them or their properties, income or assets otherwise due and payable, except those (a) which are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and for which adequate reserves have been provided in accordance with GAAP or (b) with respect to which the failure to make such filing or payment would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.11 Employee Benefits Plans .

(a) To the knowledge of any Loan Party, no ERISA Event has occurred and neither any Loan Party nor any ERISA Affiliate is aware of any fact, event or circumstance that could reasonably be expected to constitute or result in an ERISA Event, (b) each Loan Party and each ERISA Affiliate has met all applicable requirements under the Pension Funding Rules in respect of each Plan, and no waiver of the minimum funding standards under such Pension Funding Rules has been applied for or obtained, (c) there exists no Unfunded Pension Liability and (d) neither any Loan Party nor any ERISA Affiliate has engaged in a transaction that would reasonably be expected to be subject to Sections 4069 or 4212(c) of ERISA, except with respect to each of the foregoing clauses (a) through (d) of this Section  5.11 , as would not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.12 Subsidiaries; Equity Interests . As of the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction, there are no Restricted Subsidiaries other than those specifically disclosed in Schedule  5.12 , and all of the outstanding Equity Interests in such Restricted Subsidiaries that are owned by a Loan Party have been validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable (other than for those Restricted Subsidiaries that are limited liability companies and to the extent such concepts are not

 

-120-


applicable in the relevant jurisdiction) and are owned free and clear of all Liens except (i) those created under the Collateral Documents, (ii) those created under the Second Lien Facility Documentation ranking junior to the Liens securing the Obligations, (iii) any nonconsensual Lien that is permitted under Section  7.01 and (iv) if such representation is made after the Closing Date, Liens related to New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes and Permitted Ratio Debt secured by Liens ranking junior to the Liens securing the Obligations.

Section 5.13 Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act .

(a) None of the Loan Parties is engaged nor will engage, principally or as one of its important activities, in the business of purchasing or carrying Margin Stock, or extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying Margin Stock, and no proceeds of any Borrowings or drawings under any Letter of Credit will be used to purchase or carry any Margin Stock or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying any Margin Stock. Neither the making of any Credit Extension hereunder nor the use of proceeds thereof will violate any Regulations of the FRB, including the provisions of Regulations T, U or X of the FRB.

(b) None of the Loan Parties is or is required to be registered as an “investment company” under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Section 5.14 Disclosure . As of the Closing Date, no report, financial statement, certificate or other written information furnished by or on behalf of any Loan Party (other than projected financial information, pro forma financial information and information of a general economic or industry nature) to any Agent or any Lender in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby and the negotiation of this Agreement or delivered hereunder or any other Loan Document (as modified or supplemented by other information so furnished), when taken as a whole, contains any material misstatement of fact or omits to state any material fact necessary to make the statements therein (when taken as a whole), in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not materially misleading; provided that with respect to projected and pro forma financial information, Holdings and the Borrowers represent only that such information was prepared in good faith based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time of preparation and delivery; it being understood that actual results may vary from such forecasts and that such variances may be material.

Section 5.15 Compliance with Laws . Holdings, the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary is in compliance in all material respects with the requirements of all Laws and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees applicable to it or to its properties, except in such instances in which (a) such requirement of Law or order, writ, injunction or decree is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted or (b) the failure to comply therewith, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.16 Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc . The Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor owns, licenses or possesses the right to use, all of the trademarks, service marks, trade names, copyrights, patents, licenses and other intellectual property rights (collectively, “ IP Rights ”) that are necessary for the operation of its respective businesses, as currently conducted, except to the extent such failure to own, license or possess such IP Rights, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; provided that the foregoing shall not deem to constitute a representation that the Borrowers and the Subsidiary Guarantors do not infringe or violate the IP Rights held by any other Person. Set forth on Schedule  5.16 is a complete and accurate list of all material U.S. registrations or applications for registration of patents, trademarks, and copyrights owned or, in the case of copyrights, exclusively licensed by the Borrowers and Subsidiary Guarantors as of the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction. To the knowledge of the Borrowers, the conduct of

 

-121-


the business of the Borrowers and the Subsidiary Guarantors as currently conducted does not infringe upon or violate any IP Rights held by any other Person, except for such infringements and violations that, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. No material claim or litigation regarding any of the foregoing is pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, threatened in writing that, either individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.17 Solvency . On the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction, Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basis, are Solvent.

Section 5.18 Perfection, Etc . Each Collateral Document delivered pursuant to this Agreement will, upon execution and delivery thereof, be effective to create (to the extent described therein) in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, legal, valid and enforceable Liens on, and security interests in, the Collateral described therein to the extent intended to be created thereby, except as to enforcement, as may be limited by applicable domestic or foreign bankruptcy, winding-up, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangements or otherwise), moratorium and other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally, general equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law) and (a) when financing statements and other filings in appropriate form are filed or registered, as applicable, in the offices of the Secretary of State of each Loan Party’s jurisdiction of organization or formation and applicable documents are filed and recorded as applicable in the United States Copyright Office or the United States Patent and Trademark Office and all other Perfection Requirements have been taken and (b) upon the taking of possession or control by the Collateral Agent of such Collateral with respect to which a security interest may be perfected only by possession or control (which possession or control shall be given to the Collateral Agent to the extent possession or control by the Collateral Agent is required by the applicable Collateral Document) the Liens created by the Collateral Documents shall constitute fully perfected first priority Liens so far as possible under relevant law on, and security interests in (to the extent intended to be created thereby and required to be perfected under the Loan Documents), all right, title and interest of the grantors in such Collateral in each case free and clear of any Liens other than Liens permitted hereunder.

Section 5.19 Anti-Terrorism Laws; OFAC; FCPA .

(a) Anti-Terrorism Laws . The Borrowers have implemented and maintain in effect policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance by Holdings, the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents with applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations and Laws related to bribery or anti-corruption. Each of Holdings, the Borrowers and each of their respective Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents is in compliance with the Sanctions Laws and Regulations and with all applicable Laws concerning bribery or anti-corruption. No Borrowing or Letter of Credit, or use of proceeds, will violate or result in the violation of any Sanctions Laws and Regulations or bribery or anti-corruption Laws applicable to any party hereto.

(b) OFAC . None of (I) Holdings, the Borrowers or any other Loan Party and (II) their respective Subsidiaries or, to the knowledge of Holdings and the Borrowers, any director, manager, officer, agent or employee of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case, is a person on the list of “Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons” or any other Sanctions Laws and Regulations-related list of designated persons maintained by the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control. To the knowledge of Holdings and the Borrowers, Holdings, the Borrowers, all other Loan Parties and their respective Subsidiaries, and all directors, managers, officers, agents and employees of Holdings, the Borrowers and all of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case, are in compliance with Sanctions Laws and Regulations. The Borrowers will not directly or indirectly use the proceeds of the Loans or otherwise make available such proceeds to any person, for the purpose of financing the activities of any Person in violation of applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations.

 

-122-


(c) FCPA . No part of the proceeds of any Loan will be used for any improper payments, directly or indirectly, to any governmental official or employee, political party, official of a political party, candidate for political office, or anyone else acting in an official capacity, or any other party (if applicable) in order to obtain, retain or direct business or obtain any improper advantage in violation of the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, the United Kingdom Bribery Act of 2010, as amended and any similar laws, rules or regulations issued, administered or enforced by any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Borrower (collectively, the “ Anti-Corruption Laws ”). The Borrowers have implemented and maintain in effect policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance by the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents with Anti-Corruption Laws, and the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective officers and employees and, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, their directors and agents, are in compliance with Anti-Corruption Laws.

ARTICLE VI

Affirmative Covenants

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder, any Loan or other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted and obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied, or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding (other than Letters of Credit which have been Cash Collateralized), the Borrowers shall, and shall (except in the case of the covenants set forth in Sections 6.01 , 6.02 and 6.03 ) cause each Restricted Subsidiary to:

Section 6.01 Financial Statements . Deliver to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender:

(a) as soon as available, but in any event within 90 days (or 150 days with respect to the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016) after the end of each fiscal year of the Holdings, a consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal year, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for such fiscal year, and, commencing with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and prepared in accordance with GAAP, audited and accompanied by a report and opinion of CohnReznick LLP, a “Big Four” accounting firm or any other independent certified public accountant of nationally recognized standing, which report and opinion shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and shall not be subject to any “going concern” or like qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph or any qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph as to the scope of such audit (other than any such qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph that is expressly solely with respect to, or expressly resulting solely from, (i) an upcoming maturity date under the Facilities or the Second Lien Facility that is scheduled to occur within one year from the time such report and opinion are delivered or (ii) any potential inability to satisfy the Financial Covenant on a future date or in a future period), together with a customary management’s discussion and analysis of financial information in a form provided to the Sponsor;

 

-123-


(b) as soon as available, but in any event within 45 days (or 90 days with respect to the first fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date and 75 days with respect to the next two fiscal quarters ending after the Closing Date (in each case, other than the last fiscal quarter of a year)) after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year of Holdings, a consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal quarter, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for such fiscal quarter and for the portion of the fiscal year then ended, and, commencing with the fiscal quarter ending one year after the first full fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the corresponding fiscal quarter of the previous fiscal year and the corresponding portion of the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower Representative as fairly presenting in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows of Holdings and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP, subject only to normal year-end audit adjustments and the absence of footnotes, together with a customary management’s discussion and analysis of financial information;

(c) prior to the occurrence of a Qualified IPO, as soon as available, but in any event no later than 90 days after the end of each fiscal year (or 150 days with respect to the fiscal year beginning January 1, 2017), reasonably detailed consolidated forecasts along with written assumptions prepared by management of the Borrowers (including projected consolidated balance sheets, income statements, Consolidated EBITDA and cash flow statements of Holdings and its Subsidiaries) on a quarterly basis for the fiscal year following such fiscal year then ended, which forecasts shall be prepared in good faith on the basis of assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time of preparation thereof; and

(d) concurrently with the delivery of any financial statements pursuant to Sections  6.01(a) and (b)  above, the related consolidating financial statements reflecting the adjustments necessary to eliminate the accounts of Unrestricted Subsidiaries (if any) from such consolidated financial statements.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, (A) the obligations in clauses (a), (b) and (c) of this Section  6.01 may be satisfied by furnishing, at the option of the Borrowers, the applicable financial statements or, as applicable, forecasts of any Parent Holding Company and its Subsidiaries; provided that to the extent such information relates to a Parent Holding Company, such information is accompanied by consolidating information that explains in reasonable detail the differences between the information relating to such Parent Holding Company, on the one hand, and the information relating to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a standalone basis, on the other hand, and (B) (i) in the event that the Borrowers deliver to the Administrative Agent an annual report on Form 10-K for any fiscal year, as filed with the SEC or in such form as would have been suitable for filing with the SEC, within 90 days after the end of such fiscal year, such Form 10-K shall satisfy all requirements of clause (a) of this Section  6.01 with respect to such fiscal year to the extent that it contains the information and report and opinion required by such clause (a) and such report and opinion does not contain any “going concern” or like qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph or any qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph as to the scope of audit (other than any such exception or explanatory paragraph, but not a qualification, expressly permitted to be contained therein under clause (a) of this Section  6.01 ) and (ii) in the event that the Borrowers deliver to the Administrative Agent a quarterly report on Form 10-Q for any fiscal quarter, as filed with the SEC or in such form as would have been suitable for filing with the SEC, within 45 days after the end of such fiscal quarter, such Form 10-Q shall satisfy all requirements of clause (b) of this Section  6.01 with respect to such fiscal quarter to the extent that it contains the information required by such clause (b); in each case to the extent that information contained in such Form 10-K or Form 10-Q satisfies the requirements of clause s (a) or (b) of this Section  6.01 , as the case may be.

 

-124-


Section 6.02 Certificates; Other Information . Deliver to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender:

(a) no later than five days after the delivery of (i) the financial statements referred to in Section  6.01(a) or (ii) an annual report on Form 10-K (delivered pursuant to the last paragraph of Section  6.01 ), but only to the extent permitted by accounting industry policies generally followed by independent certified public accountants, a certificate of Holdings’ independent certified public accountants certifying such financial statements and stating that in making the examination necessary therefor no knowledge was obtained of any Event of Default arising from a breach of Section  7.10 (to the extent applicable) or, if any such Event of Default shall exist, stating the nature and status of such event;

(b) no later than five days after the delivery of (i) the financial statements referred to in Sections 6.01(a) and (b)  for any fiscal period ending after the Closing Date or (ii) an annual report on Form 10-K or a quarterly report on Form 10-Q for any fiscal period ending after the Closing Date (in either case, delivered pursuant to the last paragraph of Section  6.01 ), a duly completed Compliance Certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower Representative (which delivery may, unless the Administrative Agent or a Lender requests executed originals, be by electronic communication including fax or email and shall be deemed to be an original authentic counterpart thereof for all purposes);

(c) promptly after the same are available, copies of all annual, regular, periodic and special reports and registration statements which Holdings or the Borrowers may file or be required to file, copies of any report, filing or communication with the SEC under Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, or with any Governmental Authority that may be substituted therefor, or with any national securities exchange, and in any case not otherwise required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent pursuant hereto;

(d) promptly after the furnishing thereof, copies of any notices received by any Loan Party (other than in the ordinary course of business) and copies of any statement or report furnished to any holder of debt securities or loans of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, in each case pursuant to the terms of the Second Lien Credit Agreement or any other Junior Financing in a principal amount greater than $20,000,000 (other than any immaterial correspondence in the ordinary course of business or any regularly required quarterly or annual certificates) and not otherwise required to be furnished to the Lenders pursuant to any other clause of this Section  6.02 ;

(e) promptly after the receipt thereof by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, copies of each notice or other correspondence received from the SEC (or comparable agency in any applicable non-U.S. jurisdiction) concerning any material investigation or other material inquiry by such agency regarding financial or other operational results of any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries;

(f) promptly after the assertion or occurrence thereof, notice of any action arising under any Environmental Law against or of any noncompliance by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries with any Environmental Law or Environmental Permit that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

 

-125-


(g) together with the delivery of each Compliance Certificate pursuant to Section  6.02(b) , a report supplementing Schedule 5.12 hereto to the extent necessary so that the related representation and warranty would be true and correct if made as of the date of such Compliance Certificate; and

(h) promptly, such additional information regarding the business, legal, financial or corporate affairs of any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof as the Administrative Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent may from time to time reasonably request.

Documents required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) , (b) , (c) or (d)  or Section  6.02(c) or (d) (or to the extent any such documents are included in materials otherwise filed with the SEC) may be delivered electronically and if so delivered, shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date on which such documents are posted on the Borrowers’ behalf on the Platform or another relevant internet or intranet website, if any, to which each Lender and the Administrative Agent have access (whether a commercial, third-party website or whether sponsored by the Administrative Agent); provided that: (i) upon written request by the Administrative Agent, the Borrowers shall deliver paper copies of such documents to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender until a written request to cease delivering paper copies is given by the Administrative Agent or such Lender and (ii) the Borrowers shall notify (which may be by facsimile or electronic mail) the Administrative Agent of the posting of any such documents and provide to the Administrative Agent by electronic mail electronic versions (i.e., soft copies) of such documents. The Administrative Agent shall have no obligation to request the delivery of or to maintain or deliver to Lenders paper copies of the documents referred to above, and in any event shall have no responsibility to monitor compliance by the Borrowers with any such request for delivery, and each Lender shall be solely responsible for timely accessing posted documents or requesting delivery of paper copies of such documents from the Administrative Agent and maintaining its copies of such documents.

The Borrowers hereby acknowledge that (a) the Administrative Agent and/or the Arrangers will make available to the Lenders and the L/C Issuers materials and/or information provided by or on behalf of the Borrowers hereunder (collectively, “ Borrower Materials ”) by posting the Borrower Materials on IntraLinks/IntraAgency, Syndtrak or another similar electronic system (the “ Platform ”) and (b) certain of the Lenders (each, a “ Public Lender ”) may have personnel who do not wish to receive material non-public information (within the meaning of United States federal and state securities laws or any other applicable jurisdiction’s securities laws) with respect to the Borrowers or their Affiliates, or the respective securities of any of the foregoing, and who may be engaged in investment and other market-related activities with respect to such Persons’ securities. The Borrowers hereby agree that it will use commercially reasonable efforts to identify that portion of the Borrower Materials that may be distributed to the Public Lenders and that (w) all such Borrower Materials shall be clearly and conspicuously marked “PUBLIC SIDE” which, at a minimum, shall mean that the word “PUBLIC SIDE” shall appear prominently on the first page thereof; (x) by marking Borrower Materials “PUBLIC SIDE,” the Borrowers shall be deemed to have authorized the Administrative Agent, the Arrangers, the L/C Issuers and the Lenders to treat such Borrower Materials as not containing any material non-public information (although it may be sensitive and proprietary) with respect to the Borrowers or their Affiliates, or their respective securities for purposes of United States federal and state securities laws ( provided , however , that to the extent such Borrower Materials constitute Information, they shall be treated as set forth in Section  10.08 ); (y) all Borrower Materials marked “PUBLIC SIDE” are permitted to be made available through a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information” and (z) any Borrower Materials that are not marked “PUBLIC SIDE” shall be deemed to contain material non-public information (within the meaning of United States federal and state securities laws) and shall not be suitable for posting on a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information”. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, financial statements delivered pursuant to Sections 6.01(a) and (b)  and Compliance Certificates delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(a) shall be deemed to be suitable for posting on a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information.”

 

-126-


Section 6.03 Notices . Promptly, after a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers or any Guarantor has obtained knowledge thereof, notify the Administrative Agent:

(a) of the occurrence of any Default;

(b) of any matter that has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect;

(c) of the institution of any material litigation not previously disclosed by the Borrowers to the Administrative Agent, or any material development in any material litigation that is reasonably likely to be adversely determined, and would, in either case, if adversely determined be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and

(d) of the occurrence of any ERISA Event, where there is any reasonable likelihood of the imposition of liability on any Loan Party as a result thereof that could be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

Each notice pursuant to this Section  6.03 shall be accompanied by a statement of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers setting forth details of the occurrence referred to therein and stating what action the Borrowers have taken and proposes to take with respect thereto.

Section 6.04 Payment of Taxes . Pay, discharge or otherwise satisfy as the same shall become due and payable, all Taxes (including in its capacity as withholding agent) imposed upon it or its income, profits, properties or other assets, unless the same are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and adequate reserves in accordance with GAAP (or, with respect to any Foreign Subsidiaries, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization) are being maintained by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary; except to the extent the failure to pay, discharge or satisfy the same could not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 6.05 Preservation of Existence, Etc . (a) Preserve, renew and maintain in full force and effect its legal existence under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its organization except in a transaction permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 , (b) take all reasonable action to maintain all rights, privileges (including its good standing, if such concept is applicable in its jurisdiction of organization), permits, licenses and franchises necessary or desirable in the normal conduct of its business, except to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or as otherwise permitted hereunder, and (c) use commercially reasonable efforts to preserve or renew all of its registered copyrights, patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks, the non-preservation of which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or as otherwise permitted hereunder; provided that nothing in this Section  6.05 shall require the preservation, renewal or maintenance of, or prevent the abandonment by, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of, any registered copyrights, patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks that the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary reasonably determines is not useful to its business or no longer commercially desirable.

Section 6.06 Maintenance of Properties . Except if the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect, maintain, preserve and protect all of its tangible properties and equipment that are necessary in the operation of its business in good working order, repair and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted and casualty or condemnation excepted.

 

-127-


Section 6.07 Maintenance of Insurance .

(a) Except if the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, maintain in full force and effect, with insurance companies that the Borrowers believe (in the good faith judgment of the management of the Borrowers) are financially sound and responsible at the time the relevant coverage is placed or renewed, insurance in at least such amounts (after giving effect to any self-insurance which the Borrowers believe (in the good faith judgment of management of the Borrowers) is reasonable and prudent in light of the size and nature of its business) and against at least such risks (and with such risk retentions) as are usually insured against in the same general area by companies engaged in businesses similar to those engaged by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries. The Borrowers shall use commercially reasonable efforts to ensure that at all times the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, shall be named as an additional insured with respect to liability policies (other than directors and officers policies and workers compensation) maintained by the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor and the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, shall be named as loss payee with respect to the property insurance maintained by the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor; provided that, unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, (A) all proceeds from insurance policies shall be paid to the Borrowers, or the applicable Subsidiary Guarantor, (B) to the extent the Collateral Agent receives any proceeds, the Collateral Agent shall turn over to the Borrowers any amounts received by it as an additional insured or loss payee under any property insurance maintained by the Borrowers and its Subsidiaries, and (C) the Collateral Agent agrees that the Borrowers and/or their applicable Subsidiary shall have the sole right to adjust or settle any claims under such insurance.

(b) If (x) any improved portion of any Mortgaged Property located in the United States is at any time located in an area identified by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (or any successor agency) as a special flood hazard area with respect to which flood insurance has been made available under the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968 (as now or hereafter in effect or successor act thereto) and (y) the Collateral Agent shall have delivered notice(s) to the relevant Borrower Party pursuant to Section 208.25(i) of Regulation H of the FRB stating that such mortgaged property is located in the United States and in such special flood hazard area with respect to which such flood insurance has been made available, then the Borrowers shall, or shall cause each Loan Party to (i) maintain, or cause to be maintained, with a financially sound and reputable insurer, flood insurance in an amount and otherwise sufficient to comply with all applicable rules and regulations promulgated pursuant to the Flood Insurance Laws and (ii) deliver to the Administrative Agent evidence of such compliance in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

Section 6.08 Compliance with Laws . Comply with the requirements of all applicable Laws (including, without limitation, ERISA, Sanctions Laws and Regulations and Environmental Laws) and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees of any Governmental Authority applicable to it or to its business or property, except if the failure to comply therewith, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. The Borrowers will maintain in effect and enforce policies and procedures reasonably designed to ensure compliance by the Borrowers with applicable bribery or anti-corruption Laws and Sanctions Laws and Regulations.

Section 6.09 Books and Records . Maintain proper books of record and account, in a manner to allow financial statements to be prepared in all material respects in conformity with GAAP consistently applied in respect of all financial transactions and matters involving the assets and business of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be (it being understood and agreed that Foreign Subsidiaries may maintain individual books and records in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization).

 

-128-


Section 6.10 Inspection Rights . Permit representatives of the Administrative Agent and, during the continuance of any Event of Default, of each Lender to visit and inspect any of its properties (subject to the rights of lessees or sublessees thereof and subject to any restrictions or limitations in the applicable lease, sublease or other written occupancy arrangement pursuant to a Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary is a party), to examine its corporate, financial and operating records, and make copies thereof or abstracts therefrom, and to discuss its affairs, finances and accounts with its directors, managers, officers, and independent public accountants (subject to such accountants’ customary policies and procedures), all at the reasonable expense of the Borrowers and at such reasonable times during normal business hours and as often as may be reasonably desired, upon reasonable advance written notice to the Borrowers; provided that, excluding any such visits and inspections during the continuation of an Event of Default, (i) only the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Lenders may exercise rights under this Section  6.10 , (ii) the Administrative Agent shall not exercise such rights more often than one time during any calendar year and (iii) such exercise shall be at the Borrowers’ expense; provided , further , that when an Event of Default exists the Administrative Agent (or any of its respective representatives) may do any of the foregoing at the expense of the Borrowers at any time during normal business hours and upon reasonable advance written notice. The Administrative Agent and the Lenders shall give the Borrowers the opportunity to participate in any discussions with the Borrowers’ accountants. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Section  6.10 , none of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary will be required to disclose or permit the inspection or discussion of, any document, information or other matter (i) that constitutes non-financial trade secrets or non-financial proprietary information, (ii) in respect of which disclosure to the Administrative Agent or any Lender (or their respective representatives or contractors) is prohibited by Law or any binding agreement ( provided that any such confidentiality obligations pursuant to a binding agreement were not entered into in contemplation of the requirements of this Section  6.10 ) or (iii) that is subject to attorney client or similar privilege or constitutes attorney work product.

Section 6.11 Use of Proceeds . The Borrowers will use the proceeds of the Loans only as provided in Section  5.07 . The Borrowers will not request, and the Borrowers shall not use, and shall procure that its Subsidiaries and its or their respective directors, officers, employees and agents shall not use, any part of the proceeds of any Loan (i) for any improper payments, directly or indirectly, to any governmental official or employee, political party, official of a political party, candidate for political office, or anyone else acting in an official capacity, or any other party (if applicable) in order to obtain, retain or direct business or obtain any improper advantage, in violation of the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, the United Kingdom Bribery Act of 2010, as amended or any similar laws, rules or regulations issued, administered or enforced by any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Borrowers; (ii) for the purpose of funding, financing or facilitating any activities, business or transaction in violation of applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations; or (iii) in any manner that would result in the violation of any Sanctions Laws and Regulations applicable to any party hereto.

Section 6.12 Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security .

(a) Upon the acquisition of any property (other than Excluded Property and real property that is not Material Real Property) by any Loan Party, which property, in the reasonable judgment of the Administrative Agent, is not already subject to a perfected (or the equivalent under applicable foreign Law) Lien in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties (and where such a perfected (or the equivalent under applicable foreign Law) Lien would be required in accordance with the terms of the Collateral Documents) or in connection with the formation or acquisition of a Subsidiary, in each case, within 60 days (or such longer period as the Collateral Agent may agree in its sole discretion) after such formation or acquisition, cause each applicable Subsidiary (as applicable that is not an Excluded Subsidiary) and applicable Loan Party:

(i) to duly execute and deliver to the Collateral Agent a guaranty or guaranty supplement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent, guaranteeing the Obligations and a joinder or supplement to the applicable Collateral Documents, this Agreement and the Intercompany Subordination Agreement,

 

-129-


(ii) (if not already so delivered) to deliver certificates (or the foreign equivalent thereof, as applicable) representing the Pledged Interests of each such Subsidiary (if any) (other than any Unrestricted Subsidiary) held by the applicable Loan Party accompanied by undated stock powers or other appropriate instruments of transfer executed in blank and instruments evidencing the Pledged Debt owing by such Subsidiary to any Loan Party indorsed in blank to the Collateral Agent, together with, if requested by the Collateral Agent, supplements to the Security Agreement or other pledge or other security agreements with respect to the pledge of any Equity Interests or Indebtedness; provided that any Excluded Property shall not be required to be pledged as Collateral,

(iii) to duly execute and deliver, to the Collateral Agent one or more Mortgages (and other documentation and instruments referred to in Section  6.14 ) (with respect to Material Real Properties only), Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements and other security agreements (relating to each relevant type of assets), as specified by and in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent (consistent, to the extent applicable, with the Security Agreement, the Intellectual Property Security Agreement, the Mortgages and the other Collateral Documents (and Section  6.14 )), securing payment of all the Obligations of the applicable Loan Party or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, under the Loan Documents and establishing Liens on all such properties or property; provided that such properties or property shall not be required to be pledged as Collateral, and no Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements and other security agreements or pledge agreements shall be required to be delivered in respect thereof, to the extent that any such properties or property constitute Excluded Property,

(iv) to take, whatever action (including the recording of Mortgages (with respect to Material Real Properties only), the filing of UCC financing statements, the giving of notices and delivery of stock and membership interest certificates or foreign equivalents representing the applicable Equity Interests) or take other perfection or customary steps as may be necessary or advisable in the reasonable opinion of the Collateral Agent to vest in the Collateral Agent (or in any representative of the Collateral Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the Collateral purported to be subject to the Mortgages, Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements, supplements to other Collateral Documents and other security agreements delivered pursuant to this Section  6.12 , in each case subject to the Perfection Exceptions enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, and

(v) deliver to the Collateral Agent Organization Documents, resolutions and a signed copy of one or more opinions, addressed to the Collateral Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent as to such matters as the Collateral Agent may reasonably request (limited, in the case of any opinions of local counsel to the Loan Parties relating to Mortgaged Properties in jurisdictions in which such Mortgaged Property is located, to opinions relating to the Mortgage with respect to such Material Real Property (and any other Mortgaged Properties located in the same jurisdiction as any such Material Real Property)).

 

-130-


Section 6.13 Compliance with Environmental Laws . Except, in each case, to the extent that the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, comply, and make all reasonable efforts to cause all lessees and other Persons operating or occupying its properties to comply, with all Environmental Laws and Environmental Permits; obtain, maintain and renew all Environmental Permits necessary for its operations and properties; and, to the extent required under Environmental Laws, conduct any investigation, mitigation, study, sampling and testing, and undertake any cleanup, removal or remedial, corrective or other action necessary to respond to and remove and clean up all Hazardous Materials from any of its properties, in accordance with the requirements of all Environmental Laws.

Section 6.14 Further Assurances . Promptly upon request by the Administrative Agent, or the Collateral Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, and subject to the limitations described in Section  6.12 , (i) correct any material defect or error that may be discovered in any Loan Document or other document or instrument relating to any Collateral or in the execution, acknowledgment, filing or recordation thereof and (ii) do, execute, acknowledge, deliver, record, re-record, file, re-file, register and re-register any and all such further acts, deeds, certificates, assurances and other instruments as the Administrative Agent, or the Collateral Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, may reasonably require from time to time in order to grant, preserve, protect and continue the validity, perfection and priority of the security interests created or intended to be created by the Collateral Documents.

Section 6.15 Maintenance of Ratings . Use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain and maintain (but not obtain or maintain a specific rating) (i) a public corporate family rating of the Borrowers and a rating of the Facilities, in each case from Moody’s and (ii) a public corporate credit rating of the Borrowers and a rating of the Facilities, in each case from S&P (it being understood and agreed that “commercially reasonable efforts” shall in any event include the payment by the Borrowers of customary rating agency fees and cooperation with information and data requests by Moody’s and S&P in connection with their ratings process).

Section 6.16 Post-Closing Undertakings .

(a) By the date that is 90 days after the Closing Date, as such time period may be extended in the Collateral Agent’s reasonable discretion, the Borrowers shall, and shall cause each applicable Loan Party to, deliver to the Collateral Agent:

(i) a Mortgage with respect to each Mortgaged Property, together with evidence each such Mortgage has been duly executed, acknowledged and delivered by a duly authorized officer of each party thereto on or before such date in a form suitable for filing and recording in all appropriate local filing or recording offices that the Collateral Agent may deem reasonably necessary or desirable in order to create a valid and subsisting perfected Lien on the property described therein in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties and that all filing and recording taxes and fees have been paid or otherwise provided for in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent;

(ii) with respect to each Mortgaged Property, fully paid American Land Title Association Lender’s title insurance policies or marked up unconditional binder for such insurance (the “ Mortgage Policies ”) in form and substance reasonably requested by Collateral Agent, with endorsements reasonably requested by Collateral Agent, in amounts reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent (not to exceed the value of the Mortgaged Properties covered thereby and subject to any tie-in coverage available), issued, coinsured and reinsured by title insurers reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent in connection with any Material Real Property located in the United States;

 

-131-


(iii) American Land Title Association/American Congress on Surveying and Mapping form surveys, for which all necessary fees (where applicable) have been paid, certified to the Collateral Agent and the issuer of the Mortgage Policies in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent by a land surveyor duly registered and licensed in the States in which the property described in such surveys is located and reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent; provided that new or updated surveys will not be required if an existing survey, ExpressMap or other similar documentation is available and survey coverage is available for the Mortgage Policies without the need for such new or updated surveys; provided , further , the foregoing requirement shall only be in connection with any Material Real Property located in the United States;

(iv) in each case with respect to any Mortgaged Properties, customary opinions of local counsel to the Loan Parties in jurisdictions in which the Mortgaged Property is located, with respect to the enforceability and perfection of the Mortgages and, if applicable any related fixture filings, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent;

(v) customary opinions of counsel to the Loan Parties in the states in which the Loan Parties party to the Mortgages are organized or formed, with respect to the validly existence, corporate power and authority of such Loan Parties in the granting of the Mortgages, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(vi) with respect to each improved Mortgaged Property, a “Life-of Loan” Federal Emergency Management Agency Standard Flood Hazard Determination and, if the area in which any improvements located on any Mortgaged Property is designated a “special flood hazard area” by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (or any successor agency), evidence of flood insurance satisfying the requirements of Section  6.07(b) hereof;

(vii) evidence that all other actions reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, that are necessary in order to create valid and subsisting Liens on the property described in the Mortgage, have been taken; and

(viii) evidence that all fees, costs and expenses have been paid in connection with the preparation, execution, filing and recordation of the Mortgages, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, filing and recording fees, title insurance company coordination fees, documentary stamp, mortgage and intangible taxes and title search charges and other charges incurred in connection with the recordation of the Mortgages and the other matters described in this Section  6.16 and as otherwise required to be paid in connection therewith under Section  10.04.

(b) Within the time periods specified on Schedule 6.16 hereto (as each may be extended by the Administrative Agent in its reasonable discretion), provide such Collateral Documents and complete such undertakings as are set forth on Schedule 6.16 hereto.

ARTICLE VII

Negative Covenants

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder, any Loan or other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted and obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied, or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding (other than Letters of Credit which have been Cash Collateralized), the Borrowers shall not and shall not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to (and with respect to Section  7.13 , Holdings shall not), directly or indirectly:

 

-132-


Section 7.01 Liens . Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien upon any of its property, assets or revenues, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, or sign or file or authorize the filing under the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction a financing statement that names the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary as debtor, or sign any security agreement authorizing any secured party thereunder to file any such financing statement, other than the following:

(a) (i) Liens pursuant to any Loan Document, and (ii) Liens securing Indebtedness and other obligations permitted under Section  7.03(a) (so long as such Liens are secured on a junior basis to the Liens securing the Obligations and are subject to the Intercreditor Agreement);

(b) Liens existing on the Closing Date and listed on Schedule 7.01 hereto (or to the extent not listed on such Schedule 7.01 , where the fair market value of all property to which such Liens under this clause (b) attach is less than $2,500,000 in the aggregate), and, in each case, any modifications, replacements, renewals, refinancings or extensions thereof; provided that (i) the Lien does not encumber any property other than (A) property encumbered on the Closing Date, (B) after-acquired property that is affixed or incorporated into the property encumbered by such Lien on the Closing Date and (C) proceeds and products thereof and (ii) the modification, replacement, renewal, extension or refinancing of the obligations secured or benefited by such Liens, to the extent constituting Indebtedness, is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(c) Liens for Taxes, assessments or governmental charges which are not overdue for more than thirty days or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings, if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained on the books of the applicable Person in accordance with GAAP (or, with respect any Foreign Subsidiaries, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization);

(d) statutory or common law Liens of landlords, carriers, warehousemen, mechanics, materialmen, repairmen, construction contractors or other like Liens arising in the ordinary course of business and could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect;

(e) Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business (i) in connection with workers’ compensation, unemployment insurance and other social security legislation, (ii) securing liability for reimbursement or indemnification obligations of insurance carriers providing property, casualty or liability insurance to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or under self-insurance arrangements in respect of such obligations or (iii) securing obligations in respect of letters of credit that have been posted by the Borrowers or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to support the payment of items set forth in clauses (i) and (ii);

(f) Liens to secure the performance of tenders, bids, trade contracts, utilities, governmental contracts, leases and other contracts (other than Indebtedness for borrowed money), statutory obligations, surety, stay, customs and appeal bonds, performance bonds, customer guarantees, performance and completion guarantees and other obligations of a like nature (including (i) those to secure health, safety and environmental obligations, (ii) those required or requested by any Governmental Authority and (iii) letters of credit or bank guarantees issued in lieu of any such bonds or guarantees to support the issuance thereof), in each case, incurred in the ordinary course of business;

(g) easements, covenants, rights-of-way, restrictions (including zoning restrictions), encroachments, protrusions and other similar encumbrances and minor title defects affecting real property which, in the aggregate, do not in any case materially and adversely interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, and any exceptions on the Mortgage Policies issued in connection with the Mortgaged Properties;

 

-133-


(h) Liens (i) securing judgments for the payment of money not constituting an Event of Default under Section  8.01(h) , (ii) arising out of judgments or awards against the Borrowers or any of their Restricted Subsidiaries with respect to which an appeal or other proceeding for review is then being pursued and (iii) notices of lis pendens and associated rights related to litigation being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings for which adequate reserves have been made;

(i) Liens securing Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(v) ; provided that (i) such Liens (other than any Liens securing any Permitted Refinancing of the Indebtedness secured by such Liens) attach concurrently with or within 270 days after the acquisition, repair, replacement, construction or improvement (as applicable) of the property subject to such Liens, (ii) such Liens do not at any time encumber any property (except for replacements, additions and accessions to such property) other than the property financed by such Indebtedness and the proceeds and the products thereof and customary security deposits and (iii) with respect to Capitalized Leases, such Liens do not at any time extend to or cover any assets other than the assets subject to such Capitalized Leases and the proceeds and products thereof and customary security deposits; provided that individual financings of equipment provided by one lender may be cross-collateralized to other financings of equipment provided by such lender on customary terms;

(j) leases, licenses, subleases, sublicenses or other occupancy arrangements and terminations thereof granted to others in respect of real property in the ordinary course of business on which facilities owned or leased by the Borrowers or any of their Restricted Subsidiaries are located;

(k) Liens (i) in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of Law to secure payment of customs duties in connection with the importation of goods in the ordinary course of business or (ii) on specific items of inventory or other goods and proceeds of any Person securing such Person’s obligations in respect of bankers’ acceptances or letters of credit issued or created for the account of such Person to facilitate the purchase, shipment or storage of such inventory or other goods in the ordinary course of business;

(l) Liens (i) of a collection bank arising under Section 4-208 of the Uniform Commercial Code on items in the course of collection, (ii) attaching to commodity trading accounts or other commodities brokerage accounts incurred in the ordinary course of business; and (iii) in favor of a banking or other financial institution arising as a matter of Law or under customary general terms and conditions encumbering deposits or other funds maintained with a financial institution (including the right of set-off) and which are within the general parameters customary in the banking industry;

(m) Liens (i) on cash or Cash Equivalents advances in favor of the seller of any property to be acquired in an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(f) , (i) , (o) , (q) , (s) , or (hh) to be applied against the purchase price for such Investment or (ii) consisting of an agreement to Dispose of any property in a Disposition permitted under Section  7.05 , in each case solely to the extent such Investment or Disposition, as the case may be, would have been permitted on the date of the creation of such Lien;

 

-134-


(n) Liens on property of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party securing Indebtedness and other obligations in respect of Indebtedness of a non-Loan Party ;

(o) Liens in favor of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary securing Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(iv) ; provided that any such Lien on any Collateral securing such Indebtedness shall be expressly junior in priority to the Liens on the Collateral securing the Obligations pursuant to one or more agreements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(p) Liens (A) existing on property at the time of its acquisition or existing on the property of any Person that becomes a Subsidiary after the Closing Date and any modifications, replacements, renewals and extensions thereof (including Liens securing Permitted Refinancings of Indebtedness secured by such Liens) but, in each case, other than Liens on the Equity Interests of any Person that becomes a Subsidiary (that is not an Excluded Subsidiary); provided that (i) such Lien was not created in contemplation of such acquisition or such Person becoming a Subsidiary, (ii) such Lien does not encumber any property other than property encumbered at the time of such acquisition or such Person becoming a Subsidiary and the proceeds and products thereof and (iii) the Indebtedness secured thereby is permitted under Section  7.03(b)(v) , Section  7.03(b)(vi) , Section  7.03(b)(xiii)(x) or Section  7.03(b)(xv) ; and (B) securing Indebtedness incurred under Section  7.03(b)(xiii)(y) ; provided that any Indebtedness secured by Liens on the Collateral shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements;

(q) Liens arising from (i) any Uniform Commercial Code financing statement or filing filed against the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary not authorized by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary ( provided that such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary will promptly upon obtaining knowledge thereof use commercially reasonable efforts to have such financing statement terminated or corrected to the extent permitted by the UCC) and (ii) precautionary UCC financing statement filings (or other similar filings in non-U.S. jurisdictions) regarding leases, subleases, licenses or consignments entered into by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary;

(r) any interest or title, and all encumbrances and other matters affecting such interest or title, of a lessor, sublessor, licensee, sublicensee, licensor or sublicensor under any lease, sublease, license or sublicense agreement (including software and other technology licenses) in the ordinary course of business;

(s) Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, consignment or similar arrangements for sale of goods entered into by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(t) Liens deemed to exist in connection with Investments in repurchase agreements permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(u) Liens encumbering reasonable customary initial deposits and margin deposits and similar Liens attaching to commodity trading accounts or other brokerage accounts incurred in the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes;

(v) Permitted Encumbrances;

(w) Liens on Cash Collateral granted in favor of any Lenders and/or L/C Issuers created as a result of any requirement or option to Cash Collateralize pursuant to this Agreement;

 

-135-


(x) Liens that are customary contractual rights of setoff or rights of pledge (i) relating to the establishment of depository relations with banks or other financial institutions not given in connection with the incurrence of Indebtedness, (ii) relating to pooled deposit or sweep accounts of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary to permit satisfaction of overdraft or similar obligations incurred in the ordinary course of business of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or (iii) relating to purchase orders and other agreements entered into with customers of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(y) (i) zoning, building, entitlement and other land use regulations by Governmental Authorities with which the normal operation of the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries complies, and (ii) any zoning or similar Law or right reserved to or vested in any Governmental Authority to control or regulate the use of any real property that does not materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary taken as a whole;

(z) Liens solely on any cash earnest money deposits made by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in connection with any letter of intent or purchase agreement permitted hereunder;

(aa) Liens on Equity Interests of Joint Ventures securing obligations of such Joint Venture;

(bb) (i) deposits made in the ordinary course of business to secure liability to insurance carriers and (ii) Liens on insurance policies and the proceeds thereof securing the financing of insurance premiums with respect thereto;

(cc) receipt of progress payments and advances from customers in the ordinary course of business to the extent the same creates a Lien on the related inventory and proceeds thereof;

(dd) so long as no Default has occurred and is continuing at the time of granting such Liens, Liens on cash deposits securing any Swap Contract permitted hereunder in an aggregate amount not to exceed the greater of the greater of (i) $10,000,000 and (ii) 12.5% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(ee) Liens on cash or Cash Equivalents used to defease or to satisfy and discharge Indebtedness; provided that such defeasance or satisfaction and discharge is permitted hereunder;

(ff) [Reserved];

(gg) (A) Liens on property constituting Collateral securing obligations issued or incurred under (i) any Refinancing Notes and the Refinancing Notes Indentures related thereto, (ii) any New Incremental Notes and the New Incremental Notes Indentures related thereto or (iii) any Permitted Ratio Debt secured on a basis ranking pari passu or junior to the Liens securing the Obligations and any documentation related thereto and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancings thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof); provided that such Indebtedness is subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements and (B) Liens on any property of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor securing obligations of non-Loan Parties in respect of Permitted Ratio Debt and any documentation related thereto and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

 

-136-


(hh) Liens on cash or Cash Equivalents (and the related escrow accounts) in connection with the issuance into (and pending the release from) escrow of any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes, any Permitted Ratio Debt and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing thereof;

(ii) other Liens securing Indebtedness outstanding in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the greater of the greater of (i) $25,000,000 and (ii) 30% of Consolidated EBITDA, which Liens, if on the Collateral, shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements;

(jj) Liens arising out of any license, sublicense or cross license of, or other contractual obligation with respect to, intellectual property to or from the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary permitted under Section  7.05 ;

(kk) Liens in respect of sale-leasebacks permitted under Section  7.05(e) and general intangibles relevant thereto so long as such Liens attach only to the property sold and being leased in such transaction and related property;

(ll) [Reserved];

(mm) [Reserved];

(nn) [Reserved];

(oo) [Reserved];

(pp) in the case of any non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary, any put and call arrangements or restrictions on disposition related to its Equity Interests set forth in its organizational documents or any related joint venture or similar agreement; and

(qq) Liens consisting of contractual restrictions permitted under Section  7.09 .

Section 7.02 Investments .

Make or hold any Investments, except:

(a) Investments held by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the form of Cash Equivalents or that were Cash Equivalents when made;

(b) loans or advances to officers, managers, directors and employees of Holdings, any Parent Holding Company, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (i) for travel, entertainment, relocation and analogous ordinary business purposes, in an aggregate amount not to exceed, other than for travel, relocation, entertainment, each in the ordinary course of business, and analogous ordinary business purposes, $10,000,000 at any time outstanding and (ii) in connection with such Person’s purchase of Equity Interests of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company; provided that no cash is actually advanced pursuant to this clause (ii) unless immediately repaid;

(c) Investments (i) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in any Loan Party (or any Person that becomes a Loan Party in connection with such Investment) other than Holdings, (ii) by any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party in any other Restricted Subsidiary that is also not a Loan Party, (iii) by Loan Parties in any Restricted Subsidiary that is

 

-137-


not a Loan Party so long as such Investment is part of a series of Investments by Restricted Subsidiaries in other Restricted Subsidiaries that result in the proceeds of the initial Investment being invested in one or more Restricted Subsidiaries that are Loan Parties and (iv) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary made for tax planning reorganization purposes, so long as the Borrowers provide to the Administrative Agent evidence reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent that, after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Investments, the granting, perfection, validity and priority of the security interest of the Secured Parties in the Collateral, taken as a whole, is not impaired in any material respect by such Investment;

(d) Investments consisting of extensions of credit in the nature of accounts receivable or notes receivable arising from the grant of trade credit in the ordinary course of business (including advances made to distributors), Investments received in satisfaction or partial satisfaction thereof from financially troubled account debtors, and Investments consisting of prepayments to suppliers in the ordinary course of business;

(e) to the extent constituting Investments, transactions expressly permitted (other than by reference to this Section  7.02 or any clause thereof) under Sections 7.01 , 7.03 , 7.04 , 7.05 (including the receipt of non-cash consideration for the Dispositions of assets permitted thereunder), 7.06 and 7.12 ;

(f) Investments in existence on, or that are made pursuant to legally binding written commitments that are in existence on, the Closing Date and are set forth on Schedule 7.02 , and any modification, replacement, renewal or extension thereof; provided that no such modification, replacement, renewal or extension shall increase the amount of Investments then permitted under this Section  7.02(f) except pursuant to the terms of such Investment in existence on the Closing Date or as otherwise permitted by this Section  7.02 ;

(g) Investments in Swap Contracts permitted under Section  7.03 ;

(h) promissory notes and other non-cash consideration received in connection with Dispositions permitted by Section  7.05 ;

(i) (i) any acquisition or other Investment made solely with the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of Holdings, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied or (ii) the purchase or other acquisition of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of, any Person or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or of all of the Equity Interests in a Person (or all of the remaining Equity Interests of a non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary) that, upon the consummation thereof, will be a Restricted Subsidiary that is wholly-owned directly by the Borrowers and/or one or more other wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiaries (including as a result of a merger or consolidation) (each, a “ Permitted Acquisition ”); provided that, with respect to each purchase or other acquisition made pursuant to this Section  7.02(i) :

(i) each applicable Loan Party and any such newly created or acquired Restricted Subsidiary shall have complied with the requirements of Section  6.12 or made arrangements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent for compliance after the effectiveness of such Permitted Acquisition, as applicable;

 

-138-


(ii) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to any such purchase or other acquisition and any incurrence of Indebtedness in connection therewith, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing;

(iii) any Person or assets or division as acquired in accordance herewith shall be in the same business or lines of business or reasonably related, ancillary or complementary businesses in which the Borrowers and/or their Subsidiaries are then engaged; and

(iv) the aggregate amount of consideration paid or provided by a Borrower or another Loan Party (including the aggregate principal amount of all Indebtedness assumed in connection with such Permitted Acquisition and the fair market value of any non-cash consideration provided in connection therewith) under this clause (i) with respect to (x) any Person or Persons that shall not be or, after giving effect to such Permitted Acquisition, shall not become a Guarantor or shall not transfer all or substantially all of its assets to a Borrower or another Loan Party and/or (y) in the case of an asset acquisition, assets that shall not be, or after giving effect to such Permitted Acquisition, shall not become Collateral, shall not exceed in the aggregate, when combined with Investments made pursuant to clause (j)(iii) below, the greater of (x) $30,000,000 and (y) 35% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(j) (i) Investments by any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party in any Joint Venture or Unrestricted Subsidiary, (ii) Investments by a Loan Party in any Joint Venture, as long as such Investments do not exceed in the aggregate the greater of (x) $20,000,000 and (y) 25% of Consolidated EBITDA, and (iii) Investments by Loan Parties in any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party, to the extent that the aggregate amount of all Investments made pursuant to this Section  7.02(j)(iii) shall not exceed in the aggregate, when combined with Permitted Acquisitions made pursuant to clause (i)(iv) above, the greater of (x) $30,000,000 and (y) 35% of Consolidated EBITDA ( provided that, in each case, intercompany current liabilities incurred in the ordinary course of business and consistent with past practice in connection with the cash management operations of Holdings, the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries shall not be included in calculating such limitation) plus any amounts of Investments then permitted to be made under Section  7.02(s) ( provided , that any usage of such amounts hereunder shall reduce the Cumulative Credit by a corresponding amount);

(k) Investments in the ordinary course of business consisting of (i) endorsements for collection or deposit and (ii) customary trade arrangements with customers;

(l) Investments (including debt obligations and Equity Interests) received in connection with the bankruptcy or reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise) of suppliers and customers and in settlement of delinquent obligations of, and other disputes with, customers and suppliers arising in the ordinary course of business and upon the foreclosure with respect to any secured Investment or other transfer of title with respect to any secured Investment;

(m) the licensing, sublicensing or contribution of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business;

 

-139-


(n) loans and advances to Holdings in lieu of, and not in excess of the amount of (after giving effect to any other loans, advances or Restricted Payments made to Holdings), Restricted Payments permitted to be made to Holdings in accordance with Section  7.06 ; provided that any such loan or advance shall reduce the amount of such applicable Restricted Payment thereafter permitted under Section  7.06 by a corresponding amount (if such applicable subsection of Section  7.06 contains a maximum amount);

(o) other Investments not exceeding the greater of (i) $30,000,000 and (ii) 35% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(p) Investments made in the ordinary course of business in connection with obtaining, maintaining or renewing client contracts and loans or advances made to distributors and suppliers in the ordinary course of business;

(q) Investments to the extent that payment for such Investments is made solely by the issuance of Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) to the seller of such Investments;

(r) Investments of a Person that is acquired and becomes a Restricted Subsidiary or of a company merged or amalgamated or consolidated into the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, in each case after the Closing Date and in accordance with this Section  7.02 and/or Section  7.04 , as applicable, to the extent that such Investments were not made in contemplation of or in connection with such acquisition, merger, amalgamation or consolidation and were in existence on the date of such acquisition, merger, amalgamation or consolidation;

(s) Investments made with the portion, if any, of the Cumulative Credit on the date that the Borrowers elect to apply all or a portion thereof to this Section  7.02(s) , and, upon the request of the Administrative Agent, such election to be specified in a written notice of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers calculating in reasonable detail the amount of Cumulative Credit immediately prior to such election and the amount thereof elected to be so applied; provided that with respect to any Investment made pursuant to this clause (s), immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Investment, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom;

(t) any Investments in a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party or in a Joint Venture, in each case, to the extent such Investment is substantially contemporaneously repaid with a dividend or other distribution from such Restricted Subsidiary or Joint Venture;

(u) the forgiveness or conversion to equity of any Indebtedness owed to a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary and permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(v) Investments made on or prior to the Closing Date to consummate the Transaction;

(w) advances of payroll payments and business expenses to employees in the ordinary course of business;

(x) additional Restricted Subsidiaries of the Borrowers may be established or created if the Borrowers and such Subsidiary comply with the requirements of Section  6.12 , if applicable; provided that to the extent any such new Subsidiary is created solely for the purpose of consummating a transaction pursuant to an acquisition permitted by this Section  7.02 , and such new Subsidiary at no time holds any assets or liabilities other than any merger consideration contributed to it contemporaneously with the closing of such transaction, such new Subsidiary

 

-140-


shall not be required to take the actions set forth in Section  6.12 , as applicable, until the respective acquisition is consummated (at which time the surviving or transferee entity of the respective transaction and its Subsidiaries shall be required to so comply in accordance with the provisions thereof);

(y) [Reserved];

(z) to the extent that they constitute Investments, purchases and acquisitions of inventory, supplies, materials and equipment, maintenance, filing and renewal fees or purchases of contract rights or licenses or leases of intellectual property, in each case in the ordinary course of business;

(aa) Guarantees of Holdings, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of leases entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(bb) Guarantees of Indebtedness incurred by customers in connection with the purchase or other acquisition of equipment or supplies in the ordinary course of business;

(cc) Investments arising as a result of sale-leasebacks permitted by Section  7.05(e) ;

(dd) [Reserved];

(ee) [Reserved];

(ff) prepaid expenses or lease, utility and other similar deposits, in each case made in the ordinary course of business;

(gg) Investments made by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party to the extent such Investments are financed with the proceeds received by such Restricted Subsidiary from an Investment in such Restricted Subsidiary by a Loan Party permitted under this Section  7.02 ; and

(hh) in addition to the foregoing Investments, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries may make additional Investments; provided that (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (ii) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 4.25 to 1.00.

Section 7.03 Indebtedness . Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Indebtedness, except:

(a) Indebtedness under the Second Lien Credit Agreement of the Borrowers or any Guarantor in an aggregate outstanding principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $125,000,000, plus the aggregate principal amount of any Second Lien Incremental Loans or Second Lien Incremental Notes incurred after the Closing Date and permitted to be incurred under the Second Lien Credit Agreement, in each case as in effect on the Closing Date, and any Permitted Refinancing thereof;

 

-141-


(b) in the case of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries:

(i) (x) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties under or pursuant to the Loan Documents including any refinancing thereof in accordance with Section  2.18 , (y) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties evidenced by Refinancing Notes and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof) and (z) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties evidenced by New Incremental Notes and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

(ii) Permitted Surviving Debt and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

(iii) Guarantees (i) incurred by the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any other Restricted Subsidiary that is permitted to be incurred under this Agreement; provided that in the case of any Guarantees by a Loan Party of the obligations of a non-Loan Party, the related Investment is permitted under Section  7.02 and (ii) of any Loan Party in respect of Indebtedness of the Borrowers (including any Permitted Refinancing thereof) or any other Loan Party otherwise permitted hereunder;

(iv) Indebtedness of (A) any Loan Party owing to any other Loan Party, (B) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party owed to (1) any other Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party or (2) any Loan Party in respect of an Investment permitted under Section  7.02 and (C) any Loan Party to any Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party; provided that all such Indebtedness of any Loan Party in clauses (iv)(C) must be expressly subordinated to the Obligations on the terms of the Intercompany Subordination Agreement;

(v) (i) (A) Attributable Indebtedness (including Capitalized Leases) and purchase money obligations (including obligations in respect of mortgage, industrial revenue bond, industrial development bond and similar financings) to finance the purchase or other acquisition, repair or improvement of fixed or capital assets within the limitations set forth in Section  7.01(i) and (B) any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof; provided , however , that the aggregate amount of all such Indebtedness at any one time outstanding shall not exceed the greater of (x) $15,000,000 and (y) 17.5% of Consolidated EBITDA, and (ii) Attributable Indebtedness arising out of sale-leaseback transactions permitted by Section  7.05(e) and any Permitted Refinancing of such Attributable Indebtedness;

(vi) [Reserved];

(vii) Indebtedness in respect of Swap Contracts incurred in the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes and Guarantees thereof;

(viii) [Reserved];

(ix) Indebtedness representing deferred compensation or stock-based compensation to employees of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

(x) Indebtedness consisting of promissory notes issued by any Loan Party to current or former officers, managers, consultants, directors and employees, their respective estates, spouses or former spouses to finance the purchase or redemption of Equity Interests of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company permitted by Section  7.06 ;

 

-142-


(xi) Indebtedness in respect of indemnification, purchase price adjustments or other similar adjustments incurred by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in a Permitted Acquisition, any other Investments or other acquisition permitted hereunder or Disposition under agreements that provide for the adjustment of the indemnification, purchase price or for similar adjustments;

(xii) Indebtedness consisting of obligations of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary under deferred consideration ( e.g ., earn-outs, indemnifications, incentive non-competes and other contingent obligations) or other similar arrangements incurred by such Person in connection with the Transactions or any Permitted Acquisition or other acquisition permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(xiii) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) assumed in connection with any Permitted Acquisition ( provided that such Indebtedness is not incurred in contemplation of such Permitted Acquisition or any Permitted Refinancing thereof) or (y) incurred to finance any Permitted Acquisition; provided that after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Permitted Acquisition and the assumption or incurrence of such Indebtedness, as applicable, (A) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00, (B) if such Indebtedness is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary on a pari passu basis with the Obligations, the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 3.75 to 1.00 and (C) if such Indebtedness is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00; provided that any such Indebtedness assumed or incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party, together with any Indebtedness incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xx) , does not exceed in the aggregate at any time outstanding the Shared Debt Cap, in each case determined at the time of assumption or incurrence; provided , further , that in the case of clause (y), (A) such Indebtedness does not mature prior to the date that is the Latest Maturity Date of, or have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity less than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, any Term Loan outstanding at the time such Indebtedness is incurred or issued, and does not require any scheduled amortization or other scheduled payments of principal prior to, the final Maturity Date with respect to the Term Loans, (B) no Event of Default shall exist or result therefrom (other than a Permitted Acquisition, a permitted Investment or other acquisition permitted pursuant to this Agreement and made pursuant to a legally binding commitment entered into at a time when no Event of Default exists or would result therefrom) and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing of such Indebtedness, (C) with respect to any incurrence of Indebtedness under this clause (xiii), any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to this clause (xiii) shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of such incurrence and (D) such indebtedness, if secured on a pari passu basis with the Obligations, is subject to the restrictions for loans or securities (as applicable) set forth in the last sentence of the definition of “Permitted Ratio Debt”;

 

-143-


(xiv) Indebtedness in respect of netting services, overdraft protections, employee credit card programs, automatic clearinghouse arrangements, other cash management arrangements and similar arrangements in each case in connection with deposit accounts and Indebtedness arising from the honoring of a bank or other financial institution of a check, draft or similar instrument drawn against insufficient funds in the ordinary course of business; provided that any such Indebtedness is extinguished within 30 days;

(xv) Indebtedness in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the greater of (x) $25,000,000 and (y) 30% of Consolidated EBITDA, at any time outstanding;

(xvi) Indebtedness incurred by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of bank guarantees, letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances, warehouse receipts or similar instruments issued or created in the ordinary course of business, including in respect of workers compensation claims, health, disability or other employee benefits or property, casualty or liability insurance or self-insurance, or other Indebtedness with respect to reimbursement type obligations regarding workers compensation claims;

(xvii) Obligations (including bank guarantees, letters of credit issued or similar investments) in respect of performance, bid, appeal and surety bonds, customer guarantees and performance and completion guarantees and similar obligations provided by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(xviii) Indebtedness consisting of (a) the financing of insurance premiums or (b) take-or-pay obligations contained in supply arrangements, in each case, in the ordinary course of business;

(xix) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the amount of cash that is contributed to the common equity of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) after the Closing Date (other than (x) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary and (y) any Cure Amount); provided that the cash so contributed to Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) is promptly further contributed to the common equity of one or more Borrowers;

(xx) Indebtedness incurred by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries constituting Permitted Ratio Debt and any Permitted Refinancings thereof; provided that the amount of Indebtedness that may be incurred pursuant to this Section  7.03(b)(xx) in each case by Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties shall not exceed the Shared Debt Cap, at any time outstanding;

(xxi) [Reserved];

(xxii) Indebtedness supported by a Letter of Credit, in a principal amount not in excess of the stated amount of such Letter of Credit;

(xxiii) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary as an account party in respect of trade letters of credit issued in the ordinary course of business;

(xxiv) [Reserved];

(xxv) Guarantees incurred in the ordinary course of business in respect of obligations of or to suppliers, customers, franchisees, lessors, licensees and sublicensees;

 

-144-


(xxvi) unsecured Indebtedness in respect of intercompany obligations of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of accounts payable incurred in connection with goods sold or services rendered in the ordinary course of business and not in connection with the borrowing of money;

(xxvii) (i) Indebtedness incurred in connection with any sale leaseback permitted pursuant to Section  7.05(e) and (ii) any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof;

(xxviii) [Reserved];

(xxix) [Reserved];

(xxx) Indebtedness incurred as a result of the cancellation of Loans in accordance with Section  10.07(j)(i) ;

(xxxi) to the extent constituting Indebtedness, customer deposits and advance payments (including progress payments) received in the ordinary course of business from customers for goods and services purchased in the ordinary course of business; and

(xxxii) all premiums (if any), interest (including post-petition interest), fees, expenses, charges and additional or contingent interest on obligations described in clauses (i) through (xxxi) above.

The accrual of interest, the accretion of accreted value and the payment of interest in the form of additional Indebtedness shall not be deemed to be an incurrence of Indebtedness for purposes of this Section  7.03 . The principal amount of any non-interest bearing Indebtedness or other discount security constituting Indebtedness at any date shall be the principal amount thereof that would be shown on a balance sheet of the Borrowers dated such date prepared in accordance with GAAP.

For purposes of determining compliance with this Section  7.03 , in the event that an item of Indebtedness meets the criteria of more than one of the categories of Indebtedness described in Sections  7.03(b)(iii) through 7.03(b)(xxxi) , the Borrowers shall, in their sole discretion, classify and reclassify or later divide, classify or reclassify such item of Indebtedness (or any portion thereof) and will only be required to include the amount and type of such Indebtedness in one or more of the above clauses; provided that all Indebtedness outstanding under the Loan Documents will at all times be deemed to be outstanding in reliance only on the exception in Section  7.03(b)(i) and for the avoidance of doubt, Indebtedness under Section  7.03(a) may not be reclassified under such other clauses; provided , further , that, for the avoidance of doubt, Indebtedness incurred pursuant to one or more prongs of the Incremental Amount shall not be permitted to be reclassified.

Section 7.04 Fundamental Changes . Merge, dissolve, liquidate, amalgamate, consolidate with or into another Person, or Dispose of (whether in one transaction or in a series of transactions) all or substantially all of its assets (whether now owned or hereafter acquired) to or in favor of any Person, except that:

(a) any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with (i) so long as no Event of Default would result therefrom, the Borrowers (including a merger, the purpose of which is to reorganize a Borrower into a new jurisdiction in any State of the United States); provided that a Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving Person or the surviving Person shall expressly assume the obligations of the applicable Borrower pursuant to documents reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent or (ii) any one or more other Restricted Subsidiaries;

 

-145-


provided that (x) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or a FSHCO may not merge with any Restricted Subsidiary that is a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or a FSHCO if such Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or such FSHCO shall be the continuing or surviving Person and (y) when any Guarantor is merging with another Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party (A) the Guarantor shall be the continuing or surviving Person, (B) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in or Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party in accordance with Sections 7.02 and 7.03 , respectively and (C) to the extent constituting a Disposition, such Disposition must be permitted hereunder;

(b) (i) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with or into any other Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party and (ii) any Restricted Subsidiary may liquidate or dissolve, or the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary may change its legal form if the Borrowers determine in good faith that such action is in the best interest of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries and is not disadvantageous to the Lenders in any material respect (it being understood that in the case of any dissolution of a Restricted Subsidiary that is a Guarantor, such Subsidiary shall at or before the time of such dissolution transfer its assets to another Restricted Subsidiary that is a Borrower or a Guarantor unless such Disposition of assets is permitted hereunder; and in the case of any change in legal form, a Restricted Subsidiary that is a Guarantor will remain a Guarantor unless such Guarantor is otherwise permitted to cease being a Guarantor hereunder);

(c) any Restricted Subsidiary may Dispose of all or substantially all of its assets (upon voluntary liquidation or otherwise) to the Borrowers or to any Restricted Subsidiary; provided that if the transferor in such a transaction is a Guarantor, then (i) the transferee must either be the Borrowers or a Guarantor and (ii) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in or Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party in accordance with Sections 7.02 and 7.03 , respectively;

(d) any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with, or dissolve into, any other Person in order to effect an Investment permitted pursuant to Section  7.02 ; provided that (i) the continuing or surviving Person shall, to the extent subject to the terms hereof, have complied with the requirements of Section  6.12 and (ii) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in accordance with Section  7.02 and (iii) to the extent constituting a Disposition, such Disposition must be permitted hereunder;

(e) the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries may consummate the Transaction;

(f) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, dissolve, liquidate, amalgamate, consolidate with or into another Person in order to effect a Disposition permitted pursuant to Section  7.05 (other than Section  7.05(d)(A) );

(g) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, any Investment permitted by Section  7.02 may be structured as a merger, consolidation or amalgamation; and

 

-146-


(h) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, the Borrowers may merge or consolidate with any other Person; provided that (i) a Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving corporation or (ii) if the Person formed by or surviving any such merger or consolidation is not a Borrower (any such Person, the “ Successor Company ”), (A) the Successor Company shall be an entity organized or existing under the Laws of any state of the United States or the District of Columbia, (B) the Successor Company shall expressly assume all the obligations of the applicable Borrower or Borrowers under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which each applicable Borrower is a party pursuant to a supplement hereto or thereto in form reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, (C) each Guarantor, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have confirmed that its Guarantee shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, (D) each Guarantor, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have by a Security Agreement Supplement and other applicable Collateral Documents confirmed that its obligations thereunder shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, (E) if reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, each mortgagor of a Mortgaged Property, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have by an amendment to or restatement of the applicable Mortgage (or other instrument reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent) confirmed that its obligations thereunder shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, and (F) the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that such merger or consolidation and such supplement to this Agreement or any Collateral Document comply with this Agreement; provided , further , that if the foregoing are satisfied, the Successor Company will succeed to, and be substituted for, the applicable Borrower under this Agreement.

Section 7.05 Dispositions . Make any Disposition, except:

(a) Dispositions of obsolete, surplus, used or worn out property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in the ordinary course of business and Dispositions of property no longer used or useful or economically practicable to maintain in the conduct of the business of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries (including allowing any registrations or applications for registration of any intellectual property to lapse or go abandoned);

(b) Dispositions of inventory, goods held for sale and immaterial assets in the ordinary course of business (including allowing any registrations or applications for registration of any intellectual property to lapse or go abandoned in the ordinary course of business) and termination of leases and licenses in the ordinary course of business, including but not limited to a voluntary or mandatory recall of any product;

(c) Dispositions of property to the extent that (i) such property is exchanged for credit against the purchase price of similar replacement property or (ii) the net proceeds of such Disposition are promptly applied to the purchase price of such replacement property;

(d) (A) Dispositions permitted by Section  7.04 , (B) Investments permitted by Section  7.02 , (C) Restricted Payments permitted by Section  7.06 and (D) Liens permitted by Section  7.01 (in each case, other than by reference to this Section  7.05 (or any clause under this Section  7.05 ));

(e) Dispositions by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of property pursuant to sale-leaseback transactions; provided that (i) the fair market value of all property so Disposed of shall not exceed $25,000,000 from and after the Closing Date and (ii) the purchase price for such property shall be paid to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, for not less than 75% cash consideration;

 

-147-


(f) Dispositions of cash and Cash Equivalents in the ordinary course of business;

(g) [Reserved];

(h) licensing or sublicensing of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business on customary terms;

(i) sales, Dispositions or contributions of property (A) between Loan Parties (other than Holdings), (B) between Restricted Subsidiaries (other than Loan Parties), (C) by Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties to the Loan Parties (other than Holdings) or (D) by Loan Parties to any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party; provided that (1) the portion (if any) of any such Disposition made for less than fair market value and (2) any non-cash consideration received in exchange for any such Disposition, shall in each case constitute an Investment in such Restricted Subsidiary and, if the transferor of such property is a Loan Party and the transferee thereof is a non-Loan Party, such sale, Disposition or contribution of property shall otherwise comply with Section  7.02 ;

(j) leases, subleases, licenses, sublicenses or other occupancy arrangements of property (other than IP Rights) in the ordinary course of business and which do not materially interfere with the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

(k) transfers of property subject to Casualty Events upon receipt of the Net Cash Proceeds of such Casualty Event;

(l) Dispositions made (i) on the Closing Date to consummate the Transactions and (ii) as contemplated pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement as in effect on the Closing Date;

(m) Dispositions of Investments (including Equity Interests) in Joint Ventures to the extent required by, or made pursuant to customary buy/sell arrangements between, the joint venture parties set forth in joint venture arrangements and similar binding arrangements;

(n) the transfer for fair value of property (including Equity Interests of Subsidiaries) to another Person in connection with a joint venture arrangement with respect to the transferred property; provided that such transfer is permitted under Section  7.02(j) , (o) , (s), (t) or (hh) ;

(o) the unwinding of Swap Contracts permitted hereunder pursuant to their terms;

(p) transfers of condemned property as a result of the exercise of “eminent domain” or other similar powers to the respective Governmental Authority or agency that has condemned the same (whether by deed in lieu of condemnation or otherwise), and transfers of property that have been subject to a casualty to the respective insurer of such real property as part of an insurance settlement;

(q) any Disposition of any asset between or among the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries as a substantially concurrent interim Disposition in connection with a Disposition otherwise permitted pursuant to this Section  7.05 ;

(r) [Reserved];

 

-148-


(s) Dispositions by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary not otherwise permitted under this Section  7.05 ; provided that (i) at the time of such Disposition (other than any such Disposition made pursuant to a legally binding commitment entered into at a time when no Event of Default exists), no Event of Default shall exist or would result from such Disposition and (ii) the purchase price for such property in excess of $7,500,000 shall be paid to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, for not less than 75% cash consideration or Cash Equivalents; provided , however , that for the purposes of this clause (s)(ii), the following shall be deemed to be cash: (A) any liabilities (as shown on the Borrowers’ or such Restricted Subsidiary’s most recent balance sheet provided hereunder or in the footnotes thereto) of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary (other than liabilities that are by their terms subordinated to the Obligations) that are (x) assumed by the transferee with respect to the applicable Disposition or (y) are otherwise unconditionally cancelled or terminated (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of cancelled or terminated liabilities in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) in connection with the transaction with such transferee (other than intercompany debt owed to the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries) and, in the case of clause (x), for which the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries shall have been validly released (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of released liabilities in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) by all applicable creditors in writing, (B) any securities, notes or other obligations or assets received by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary from such transferee that are converted by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary into cash or Cash Equivalents (to the extent of the cash or Cash Equivalents received in the conversion) within 180 days following the closing of the applicable Disposition; (C) any Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of such Disposition having an aggregate fair market value, taken together with the Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of all other Dispositions, not in excess of the greater of $15,000,000 (with the fair market value of each item of Designated Non-Cash Consideration being measured as of the time received) and 17.5% of Consolidated EBITDA and (D) Indebtedness of any Restricted Subsidiary that ceases to be a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such Disposition (other than intercompany debt owed to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary), to the extent that the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary are unconditionally released from all obligations (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of released obligations in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) with respect to such Indebtedness in connection with such Disposition;

(t) the Disposition of any Unrestricted Subsidiary;

(u) the Disposition of assets acquired pursuant to or in order to effectuate a Permitted Acquisition or any other acquisition permitted under Section  7.02 which assets are (i) obsolete or (ii) not used or useful to the core or principal business of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(v) [Reserved];

(w) [Reserved];

(x) [Reserved];

(y) any Subsidiary may issue Equity Interests to qualified directors where required by applicable law or to satisfy other requirements of applicable law with respect to ownership of Equity Interests in Foreign Subsidiaries; and

 

-149-


(z) the sale or issuance of the Equity Interests of any Foreign Subsidiary or any Subsidiary of the type described in clause (d) or (e) of the definition of Excluded Subsidiary to any other Foreign Subsidiary or any Subsidiary of the type described in clause (d) or (e) of the definition of Excluded Subsidiary, including, without limitation, in connection with any tax restructuring activities not otherwise prohibited hereunder;

provided , however , that any Disposition of any property pursuant to Section  7.05(b) (other than with respect to immaterial assets Disposed of in the ordinary course of business), (c) , (e) , (n) , (s) or (t)  shall be for no less than the fair market value of such property at the time of such Disposition. To the extent any Collateral is Disposed of as expressly permitted by this Section  7.05 to any Person other than a Loan Party, such Collateral shall be sold free and clear of the Liens created by the Loan Documents, and the Administrative Agent is authorized to and shall take any actions deemed appropriate in order to effect the foregoing.

Section 7.06 Restricted Payments . Declare or make, directly or indirectly, any Restricted Payment, except:

(a) each Restricted Subsidiary may make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers and to other Restricted Subsidiaries that directly or indirectly own Equity Interests of such Restricted Subsidiary (and, in the case of a Restricted Payment by a non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary, to the Borrowers and any such other Restricted Subsidiary and to each other owner of Equity Interests of such Restricted Subsidiary based on their relative ownership interests);

(b) the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary may declare and make dividend payments or other distributions payable solely in the Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests not otherwise permitted by Section  7.03 ) of such Person (and in the case that one or more Borrower receives Equity Interests of any of its direct or indirect parent company as a result of foreclosing on such Equity Interests pledged to secure loans or advances as described in Section  7.02(b) , any dividends or distributions of such Equity Interests);

(c) the Borrowers may make Restricted Payments with the cash proceeds contributed to its ordinary equity from the Net Cash Proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of the applicable Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, so long as, with respect to any such Restricted Payments, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing or would result therefrom;

(d) to the extent constituting Restricted Payments, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries may take actions expressly permitted by Section  7.02 (other than Sections 7.02(e) and (n) ), 7.04 , 7.05 , 7.08(b) , (c) , (d) , (e) , (h) , (i) , (j) , (o) or (q)  or 7.12 (in each case, other than by reference to this Section  7.06 (or any clause under this Section  7.06 ));

(e) any Restricted Subsidiary may make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers, and the Borrowers may make Restricted Payments, in each case:

(i) the proceeds of which shall be used by the Borrowers to pay (or to make a Restricted Payment to or Investment in Holdings or a Parent Holding Company to enable it to pay) (a) its, Holdings’ or such Parent Holding Company’s operating expenses incurred in the ordinary course of business and other corporate overhead costs and expenses (including administrative, legal, accounting and similar expenses provided by third parties), that are reasonable and customary and incurred in the ordinary course of business, plus any reasonable and customary indemnification claims made by directors,

 

-150-


managers or officers of the Borrowers or Holdings not to exceed the ratable share of the amount to which such Restricted Payment relates that is related to the ownership or operations of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries or (b) the fees and other amounts described in Sections 7.08(c) , (d) , (e) , (i) and (j)  to the extent that the Borrowers would be then permitted under such Sections 7.08(c) , (d) , (e) , (i) , (j) , (o) and (q)  to pay such fees and other amounts directly;

(ii) for any taxable period for which the Borrowers and/or any of its Subsidiaries are members of a consolidated, combined, unitary, affiliated or similar income, franchise or other tax (imposed in lieu of income tax) group of which the Borrowers or a direct or indirect parent of Borrowers is the common parent (a “ Tax Group ”), the portion of any income taxes (and any consolidated, combined, unitary, affiliated or similar franchise or similar taxes imposed in lieu of such income taxes of such Tax Group) due by the parent company of the relevant Tax Group for such taxable period, that is attributable to the Borrowers and/or their Subsidiaries; provided that (A) Restricted Payments under this Section  7.06(e)(ii) for any taxable period shall not exceed the amount of such Taxes that the Borrowers and/or such Subsidiaries, as applicable, would have paid had the Borrowers and/or such Subsidiaries, as applicable, been a stand-alone taxpayer (or a stand-alone group), taking into account any prior use by the Tax Group of any operating losses of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries and (B) Restricted Payments under this Section  7.06(e)(ii) in respect of an Unrestricted Subsidiary shall be permitted only to the extent that cash distributions were made by such Unrestricted Subsidiary to Holdings or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries for such purpose;

(iii) the proceeds of which will be used to repurchase, retire or otherwise acquire the Equity Interests of the Borrowers (or to make a Restricted Payment to or an Investment in Holdings or a Parent Holding Company or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof to enable it to repurchase, retire or otherwise acquire its Equity Interest) from future, former or present directors, managers, consultants, employees or members of management of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary (or their estate, family members, spouse and/or former spouse or successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees or distributees of the foregoing), in an aggregate amount not in excess of (A) at any time prior to a Qualified IPO, $5,000,000 in any calendar year plus any unutilized portion of such amount in any preceding fiscal years (with such sum, however, not exceeding $15,000,000 at any time) and (B) at any time after a Qualified IPO, $10,000,000 in any calendar year plus any unutilized portion of such amount in any preceding fiscal years (with such sum, however, not exceeding $25,000,000 at any time); provided , further , that the amounts set forth in this clause (e)(iii) may be further increased by (A) the proceeds of any key-man life insurance received by Holdings (or a Parent Holding Company), the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary less the amount of Restricted Payments previously made with the cash proceeds of such key man life insurance policies plus (B) the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of the Borrowers, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied ( provided that in no event shall any such contributed amounts increase the Cumulative Credit) plus (C) amounts that would otherwise increase the Cumulative Credit pursuant to clause (c) of the definition of “Cumulative Credit” as a result of proceeds received from the sale of applicable equity to the Persons set forth in this clause (iii) above; provided that for the avoidance of doubt, any amounts included in this clause (C) may not also increase the Cumulative Credit plus (D) the amount of any cash bonuses or other cash compensation otherwise payable to any

 

-151-


future, present or former director, manager, employee, member of management or consultant of Holdings or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary that are foregone in return for the receipt of Equity Interests of the Borrowers or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof, or the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a deferred compensation plan of such equity; provided that cancellation of Indebtedness owing to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary from members of management of Holdings, any of Holdings’ direct or indirect parent companies or any of Holdings’ Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with a repurchase of Equity Interests of any of the Borrowers’ direct or indirect parent companies will not be deemed to constitute a Restricted Payment for purposes of this covenant or any other provision of this Agreement;

(iv) the proceeds of which are applied to the purchase or other acquisition by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of any Person, or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or more than 50% of the Equity Interests in a Person; provided that, if such purchase or other acquisition had been made by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, it would have constituted a Permitted Acquisition permitted to be made pursuant to Section  7.02(i) ; provided , further , that (A) such Restricted Payment shall be made concurrently with the closing of such purchase or other acquisition and (B) Holdings, the Borrowers or any Parent Holding Company shall, immediately following the closing thereof, cause (1) all property acquired (whether assets or Equity Interests) and any liabilities assumed to be contributed to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than (i) with respect to such assets, to any Foreign Subsidiaries of the Borrowers and (ii) to the extent such Equity Interests constitute Foreign Subsidiaries, to the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries) or (2) the merger (to the extent permitted in Section  7.04 ) into the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than any of its Subsidiaries to the extent constituting a Foreign Subsidiary) of the Person formed or acquired in order to consummate such purchaser or other acquisition;

(v) repurchases of Equity Interests of one or more Borrower deemed to occur upon the non-cash exercise of stock options and warrants or similar equity incentive awards;

(vi) the proceeds of which shall be used by the Borrowers to pay, or to make Restricted Payments to allow Holdings or any Parent Holding Company to pay, other than to Affiliates of a Borrower, a portion of any customary fees and expenses related to any unsuccessful equity offering by the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company or offering or debt issuance, incurrence or offering, Disposition or acquisition or investment transaction permitted by this Agreement, in each case not to exceed the ratable share of the amount to which such Restricted Payment relates that is directly related to the operations of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries; and

(vii) the proceeds of which shall be used to pay customary salary, bonus and other benefits payable to officers, employees, consultants and independent contractors of the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company to the extent such salaries, bonuses and other benefits are attributable to the ownership or operation of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

 

-152-


(f) the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments in an aggregate amount not to exceed the Cumulative Credit at such time; provided that with respect to any such Restricted Payment, (x) immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Restricted Payment, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (y) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Restricted Payment, the Borrowers could incur $1.00 of additional unsecured Permitted Ratio Debt;

(g) Restricted Payments made (i) on or after the Closing Date to consummate the Transactions, (ii) in order to satisfy indemnity and other similar obligations under the Acquisition Agreement, any Permitted Acquisition or other permitted Investment or other acquisition permitted pursuant to this Agreement and (iii) to the extent constituting a Restricted Payment, in respect of the LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment;

(h) the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiary may (i) pay cash in lieu of fractional shares in connection with any dividend, split or combination of its Equity Interests or any Permitted Acquisition (or similar Investment) and (ii) honor any conversion request by a holder of convertible Indebtedness and make cash payments in lieu of fractional shares in connection with any such conversion;

(i) the payment of dividends and distributions within 60 days after the date of declaration thereof, if at the date of declaration of such payment, such payment would have complied with the other provisions of this Section  7.06 ;

(j) after a Qualified IPO, (i) any Restricted Payment by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or any direct or indirect parent of the Borrowers to pay listing fees and other costs and expenses attributable to being a publicly traded company which are reasonable and customary and (ii) Restricted Payments by the Borrowers to Holdings so that Holdings may make Restricted Payments to its equity holders or the equity holders of any Parent Holding Company in an aggregate amount not exceeding 6.0% per annum of the Net Cash Proceeds received by the Borrowers from such Qualified IPO;

(k) Restricted Payments in an amount equal to any Taxes payable, including, but not limited to, withholding or similar taxes payable or expected to be payable in connection with any payments to any future, present or former employee, director, officer, manager, consultant or independent contractor (or their respective Affiliates, estates, immediate family members, spouses, former spouses, successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees or distributees of any of the foregoing) or in connection with any repurchases of Equity Interests in consideration of such payments including deemed repurchases in connection with the exercise of stock options or grant, vesting or delivery of any Equity Interests;

(l) Restricted Payments made in respect of working capital adjustments, purchase price adjustments or earn out payments pursuant to the Acquisition, any Permitted Acquisition or other permitted Investments or other acquisitions permitted pursuant to this Agreement;

(m) the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments in an aggregate amount not to exceed, when aggregated with the amount of prepayments, redemptions, purchases, defeasement or other satisfaction prior to the scheduled maturity thereof of any Junior Financing pursuant to Section  7.12(a)(iv)(x) , $12,500,000; and

(n) in addition to the foregoing Restricted Payments, the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments; provided that (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (ii) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 3.75 to 1.00.

 

-153-


Section 7.07 Change in Nature of Business . Engage in any material line of business substantially different from those lines of business conducted by the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries on the Closing Date or any business reasonably related, complementary, synergistic or ancillary thereto or reasonable extensions thereof.

Section 7.08 Transactions with Affiliates . Make any payment to, or sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its properties or assets to, or purchase any property or assets from, or enter into or make or amend any transaction or series of transactions, contract, agreement, understanding, loan, advance or guarantee with, or for the benefit of, any Affiliate of a Borrower involving aggregate consideration in excess of $10,000,000 (each of the foregoing, an “ Affiliate Transaction ”), unless (i) such Affiliate Transaction is on terms that are not materially less favorable to the relevant Borrower Party than those that could have been obtained in a comparable transaction with an unrelated Person on an arm’s length basis and (ii) with respect to any Affiliate Transaction or series of related Affiliate Transactions involving aggregate consideration in excess of $30,000,000, each Borrower delivers to the Administrative Agent a resolution adopted in good faith by the majority of the board of directors of Holdings, each such Borrower or any Parent Holding Company, approving such Affiliate Transaction, together with a certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers certifying that the board of directors of Holdings, the Borrowers or any Parent Holding Company determined or resolved that such Affiliate Transaction complies with clause (i). This provision shall not apply to:

(a) transactions among Loan Parties (other than Holdings) and their Restricted Subsidiaries (or any entity that becomes a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such transaction);

(b) the Transactions and the payment of fees and expenses in connection with the consummation of the Transactions (in the case of any deferred fees payable to the Sponsor, only so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing);

(c) so long as no Event of Default under Section  8.01(f) or (g)  shall have occurred and be continuing, the payments pursuant to Consulting Services Agreements (including upon the termination thereof) to the Sponsor plus related indemnities and reasonable expenses; provided that during the period that an Event of Default under Section  8.01(f) or (g)  shall have occurred or be continuing, such payments may accrue, but not be paid, and following cure of such Event of Default to the satisfaction of the Administrative Agent, such accrued payments may be paid to the Sponsor;

(d) customary fees and indemnities may be paid to any directors or managers of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company), the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries (and, to the extent attributable to the operations or ownership of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries, of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) and reasonable out-of-pocket costs of such Persons may be reimbursed;

(e) the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries may enter into employment and severance or other compensation arrangements with officers, directors, consultants and employees of the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries (or any direct or indirect parent company of the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries) in the ordinary course of business or as otherwise approved by the board of directors, board of managers or other equivalent governing body of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary and transactions pursuant to stock option plans and employee benefit plans and arrangements in the ordinary course of business or as otherwise approved by the board of directors, board of managers or other equivalent governing body of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary;

 

-154-


(f) Restricted Payments permitted under Section  7.06 (other than Section  7.06(d) );

(g) Investments to the extent permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(h) payments required to be made pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement (as in effect on the Closing Date);

(i) transactions pursuant to agreements in existence on the Closing Date and set forth on Schedule 7.08 or any amendment thereto to the extent such an amendment is not materially adverse, taken as a whole, to the Lenders in any material respect;

(j) transactions between a Borrower Party and any Person that is an Affiliate solely due to the fact that a director or manager of such Person is also a director or manager of the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company; provided , however , that such director or manager abstains from voting as a director of the Borrowers, Holdings or such Parent Holding Company, as the case may be, on any matter involving such other Person;

(k) the issuance of Equity Interests to any Permitted Holder, the Sponsor, any Parent Holding Company, Holdings, or to any former, current or future director, manager, officer, employee or consultant (or any spouses, former spouses, successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees, distributes or Affiliate of any of the foregoing) of Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries or any direct or indirect parent thereof;

(l) any issuance of Equity Interests, or other payments, awards or grants in cash, securities, Equity Interests or otherwise pursuant to, or the funding of, employment arrangements, stock options and stock ownership plans approved by the board of directors or board of managers of Holdings (or any direct Parent Holding Company) or the Borrowers, as the case may be;

(m) transactions with wholly-owned Subsidiaries for the purchase or sale of goods, products, parts and services entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(n) Investments by Affiliates in Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries (and/or such Affiliate’s exercise of any permitted rights with respect thereto), so long as non-Affiliates were also offered the opportunity to invest in such Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests, and transactions with Affiliates solely in their capacity as holders of Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries, so long as such transaction is with all holders of such class (and there are such non-Affiliate holders) and such Affiliates are treated no more favorably than all other holders of such class generally;

(o) reimbursement of reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses of the Sponsor by the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiaries incurred in connection with financial advisory, financing, underwriting or placement services or in respect of other investment banking activities (including in connection with acquisitions or divestitures, whether or not consummated) so long as such costs and expenses are approved by a majority of the members of the board of directors or a majority of the disinterested members of the board of directors, in each case, of the Borrowers in good faith;

 

-155-


(p) loans and other transactions among the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries (to the extent any such Subsidiary that is not a Restricted Subsidiary is only an Affiliate as a result of Investments by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries in such Subsidiary) to the extent otherwise permitted under this Article  VII ;

(q) the payment of reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses and indemnities pursuant to the stockholders agreement or the registration and participation rights agreement (or amendments to such agreements) entered into on or after the Closing Date in connection therewith or similar equity holder’s agreements or limited liability company agreements;

(r) transactions in which the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, as the case may be, deliver to the Administrative Agent a letter from an Independent Financial Advisor stating that such transaction is fair to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary from a financial point of view or meets the requirements of Section  7.08(b) ; and

(s) payments to or from, and other transactions with, a Joint Venture (to the extent any such Joint Venture is only an Affiliate as a result of Investments by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries in such Joint Venture) in the ordinary course of business and to the extent otherwise permitted under Section  7.02 .

Section 7.09 Burdensome Agreements . Enter into or permit to exist any Contractual Obligation (other than this Agreement or any other Loan Document) that limits the ability of

(a) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Guarantor to make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers or any Guarantor or to otherwise transfer property to or invest in the Borrowers or any Guarantor, except for:

(i) any agreement in effect on the Closing Date and described on Schedule  7.09 ;

(ii) any agreement in effect at the time any Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrowers or any agreement assumed in connection with the acquisition of assets from any Person, so long as such agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of a Borrower or the acquisition of assets from such Person;

(iii) any agreement representing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary of the Borrowers which is not a Loan Party which is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(iv) any agreement in connection with a Disposition permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 and relate solely to the assets of any Person subject to such Disposition;

(v) customary provisions in joint venture agreements or other similar agreements applicable to Joint Ventures permitted under Section  7.02 and applicable solely to the assets and Equity Interests of such Joint Venture entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(vi) customary provisions restricting assignment of any agreement; provided that if such agreement is not entered into in the ordinary course of business, the granting, perfection, validity and priority of the security interests of the Secured Parties is not impaired in any material respect by such restriction;

 

-156-


(vii) restrictions contained in any Permitted Surviving Debt documents (as amended, so long as such restrictions are not expanded in scope);

(viii) customary net worth provisions contained in real property leases entered into by the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business, so long as the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such net worth provisions would not reasonably be expected to impair the ability of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries to meet their ongoing obligations;

(ix) any restrictions regarding licenses or sublicenses by the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business (in which case such restriction shall relate only to such IP Rights);

(x) restrictions contained in the Second Lien Facility Documentation and the Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness;

(xi) customary restrictions contained in (A) any Permitted Ratio Debt (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof), (B) any Refinancing Notes (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof), (C) New Incremental Notes and (D) Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Sections 7.03(b)(i) , (ii) , (v) , (vi) , (xiii) , (xiv) , (xv) , (xviii)(a) , (xix ) and ( xx ) and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing thereof; provided that with respect to Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Sections 7.03(b)(vi) , (xiii) , (xv) , (xix) and (xx) , solely to the extent applicable only to the Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Guarantors obligated with respect to such Indebtedness;

(xii) restrictions contained in Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xxvii) to the extent no more restrictive, taken as a whole, to the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries than the covenants contained in this Agreement;

(xiii) solely to the extent that such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries (other than otherwise permitted under this Agreement), restrictions contained in Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Section  7.03(b) and (xxx) ;

(xiv) restrictions imposed by reason of applicable Law; or

(b) the Borrowers or any Loan Party to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist Liens on property of such Person for the benefit of the Lenders with respect to the Facilities and the Obligations or under the Loan Documents except for:

(i) restrictions contained in the Second Lien Facility Documentation and the Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness and any other agreement in effect on the Closing Date and described on Schedule 7.09 ;

(ii) any agreement in effect at any time any Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of a Borrower, or any agreement assumed in connection with the acquisition of assets from any Person, so long as such agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of a Borrower or of the acquisition of assets from such Person;

 

-157-


(iii) any agreement representing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower which is not a Loan Party which is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(iv) any agreement in connection with a Disposition permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 and relate solely to the assets of Person subject to such Disposition;

(v) customary provisions in joint venture agreements or other similar agreements applicable to Joint Ventures permitted under Section  7.02 and applicable solely to the assets and Equity Interests of such Joint Venture entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(vi) restrictions contained in any Permitted Surviving Debt documents (as amended, so long as such restrictions are not expanded in scope);

(vii) negative pledges and restrictions on Liens in favor of any holder of Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(i) , (ii) , (v) , (vi) , (vii) , (xiii) , (xiv) , (xv) , (xix) , (xx) or (xxvii)  but, in each case solely to the extent such negative pledge and restrictions on Liens relate to the property financed by, or the subject of which is, such Indebtedness;

(viii) customary restrictions in leases, subleases, licenses or asset sale agreements otherwise permitted hereby so long as such restrictions relate to the assets subject thereto;

(ix) customary restrictions contained in any (A) Permitted Ratio Debt (solely to the extent any negative pledge relates to the property financed by or the subject of such Indebtedness), (B) Refinancing Notes (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof) and (C) New Incremental Notes; provided , in each case that such restrictions do not restrict the Liens securing the Obligations or the senior priority status thereof (it being understood that any such Indebtedness shall be permitted to be secured on a pari passu basis or junior with the Obligations to the extent permitted hereunder);

(x) restrictions arising in connection with cash or other deposits entered into in the ordinary course of business and restrictions on cash earnest money deposits in favor of sellers in connection with acquisitions not prohibited hereunder;

(xi) customary provisions restricting assignment of any agreement entered into in the ordinary course of business; and

(xii) restrictions imposed by applicable Law.

Section 7.10 Financial Covenant . As of the end of each fiscal quarter of the Borrowers (commencing with the first full fiscal quarter after the Closing Date) and so long as the aggregate amount of L/C Obligations, Revolving Credit Loans and Swing Line Loans outstanding as of the end of such fiscal quarter (with respect to L/C Obligations, to the extent such L/C Obligations are in the aggregate greater than $3,500,000 and not otherwise Cash Collateralized by the Borrowers to at least 101% of their maximum stated amount) exceeds 30% of the aggregate amount of all Revolving Credit Commitments then in effect, permit the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio as of the end of such fiscal quarter of the Borrowers to exceed (a) for the period commencing with the fiscal quarter of the Borrowers ending on March 31, 2017 through and including the fiscal quarter of the Borrowers ending on September 30, 2018, 5.75 to 1.00 and (b) for the period commencing with the fiscal quarter of the Borrowers ending on December 31, 2018 and for each fiscal quarter thereafter, 5.50 to 1.00 (the “ Financial Covenant ”).

 

-158-


Section 7.11 Accounting Changes . Make any change in fiscal year; provided , however , that the Borrowers may, upon written notice to the Administrative Agent, change its fiscal year to any other fiscal year reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent, in which case, the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent will, and are hereby authorized by the Lenders to, make any amendments to this Agreement that are necessary, in the judgment of the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers to reflect such change in fiscal year.

Section 7.12 Prepayments, Etc. of Indebtedness ; Amendments . (a) Prepay, redeem, purchase, defease or otherwise satisfy prior to the scheduled maturity thereof in any manner the Second Lien Loan, any other Indebtedness that is expressly subordinated by contract in right of payment to the Obligations (other than intercompany Indebtedness so long as no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing) or any other Indebtedness that is secured by a second-priority (or other junior priority) security interest in the Collateral, including, without limitation, the Second Lien Facility (collectively, together with any Permitted Refinancing of the foregoing, “ Junior Financing ”) that has an aggregate principal amount in excess of $20,000,000 (it being understood that payments of regularly scheduled principal, interest and AHYDO payments and, in connection with the amendment of any Junior Financing, the payment of fees (other than in connection with any amendment that reduces or forgives the commitments, outstanding principal amount or effective yield of such Junior Financing) shall be permitted), or make any payment in violation of any subordination terms of any Junior Financing Documentation, except (i) a prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction of Junior Financing made using the portion, if any, of the Cumulative Credit on the date of such election that the Borrowers elect to apply to this Section  7.12(a)(i) , and, upon the request of the Administrative Agent, such election to be specified in a written notice of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers calculating in reasonable detail the amount of Cumulative Credit immediately prior to such election and the amount thereof elected to be so applied; provided that (A) immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such prepayment, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (B) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such prepayment, the Borrowers could incur $1.00 of additional unsecured Permitted Ratio Debt, (ii) the conversion of any Junior Financing to Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) or the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction of Junior Financing with the proceeds of Permitted Equity Issuances (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary capital of a Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, (iii) the refinancing of any Junior Financing with any Permitted Refinancing thereof; (iv) the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction prior to the scheduled maturity of any Junior Financing in an aggregate amount not to exceed, the greater of $20,000,000 and 25% of Consolidated EBITDA (less the amount of any Restricted Payments made pursuant to Section  7.06(m) ), plus (y) the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of Holdings plus (z) an unlimited amount so long as (A) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (B) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 3.75 to 1.00, (b) amend, modify or change any term or condition of any Junior Financing Documentation (including by way of refinancing or otherwise replacing the Indebtedness thereunder), that has an aggregate principal amount in excess of $20,000,000 or the Second Lien Facility Documentation or any of its Organization Documents in any manner that is materially adverse to the interests of the Administrative Agent or the Lenders; provided that an amendment of the Second Lien Facility Documentation solely to incorporate the incurrence of Second Lien Incremental Loans, Second Lien Incremental Notes, Specified Refinancing Debt (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement) or Refinancing Notes (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Agreement) pursuant to the provisions of the Second Lien Credit Agreement as in effect on the Closing Date shall not be deemed materially adverse to the interests of the Administrative Agent or the Lenders.

 

-159-


Section 7.13 Holding Company . Conduct, transact or otherwise engage in any material business or operations; provided that the following shall be permitted in any event: (i) Holdings’ ownership of the Equity Interests of the Borrowers, and any Subsidiary of Holdings (that is not a Borrower) which is formed solely for purposes of acting as a co-obligor with respect to any Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness and which does not conduct, transact or otherwise engage in any material business or operation, and, in each case, and activities incidental thereto; (ii) the entry into, and the performance of its obligations with respect to the Loan Documents (including any Specified Refinancing Debt or any New Term Facility), the Second Lien Facility Documentation, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes, the Junior Financing Documentation, any Permitted Ratio Debt documentation, any documentation relating to any Permitted Refinancing of the foregoing or documentation relating to the Indebtedness otherwise permitted by the last sentence in this Section  7.13 and the Guarantees permitted by clause (iv) below; (iii) the consummation of the Transaction; (iv) performing of activities (including, without limitation, cash management activities) and the entry into documentation with respect thereto, in each case, permitted by this Agreement for Holdings to enter into and perform; (v) the payment of dividends and distributions (and other activities in lieu thereof permitted by this Agreement), the making of contributions to the capital of its Subsidiaries and Guarantees of Indebtedness and other obligations permitted to be incurred hereunder by the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries; (vi) the maintenance of its legal existence (including the ability to incur fees, costs and expenses relating to such maintenance and performance of activities relating to its officers, directors, managers and employees and those of its Subsidiaries); (vii) the performing of its obligations with respect to the Acquisition Agreement and the other agreements contemplated thereby and the performance of its obligations with respect thereto; (viii) the performing of activities in preparation for and consummating any public offering of its common stock or any other issuance or sale of its Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) including converting into another type of legal entity; (ix) the participation in tax, accounting and other administrative matters as a member of any applicable consolidated group, including compliance with applicable Laws and legal, tax and accounting matters related thereto and activities relating to its officers, directors, managers and employees; (x) the holding of any cash and Cash Equivalents (but not operating any property); (xi) the entry into and performance of its obligations with respect to contracts and other arrangements, including the providing of indemnification to officers, managers, directors and employees; (xii) the performance of management and administrative services on behalf of, or for the benefit of, its Subsidiaries; and (xiii) any activities incidental to the foregoing. Holdings shall not create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien on any Equity Interests of the Borrowers (other than Liens pursuant to any Loan Document, the Second Lien Facility Documentation, non-consensual Liens arising solely by operation of Law and Liens pursuant to documentation relating to other secured indebtedness permitted to be incurred hereunder) and shall not incur any Indebtedness (other than in respect of Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.02(n) , Disqualified Equity Interests, Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness, or Guarantees permitted by clauses (ii) and (v) above and liabilities imposed by Law, including Tax liabilities).

ARTICLE VIII

Events of Default and Remedies

Section 8.01 Events of Default . Any of the following shall constitute an “Event of Default”:

(a) Non-Payment . A Borrower or any other Loan Party fails to pay in the currency required hereunder (i) when due and as required to be paid herein, any amount of principal of any Loan, or (ii) within five Business Days after the same becomes due and payable, any interest on any Loan or on any L/C Obligation, any L/C Obligation or any fee due hereunder, or any other amount payable hereunder or with respect to any other Loan Document; or

 

-160-


(b) Specific Covenants . A Borrower or any of the Subsidiary Guarantors fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in any of Section  6.03(a) , 6.05(a) (solely with respect to one or more of the Borrowers) or 6.11 or in any Section of Article VII (subject to, in the case of the Financial Covenant, the cure rights contained in Section  8.03 and the proviso at the end of this clause (b)), or Holdings fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in Section  7.13 ; provided that an Event of Default under the Financial Covenant shall not constitute an Event of Default with respect to the Term Facility, any New Term Facility or any Specified Refinancing Debt (unless consisting of revolving credit facilities) unless and until the Required Revolving Lenders shall have terminated their Revolving Credit Commitments and declared all amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit Facility to be due and payable; or

(c) Other Defaults . Any Loan Party fails to perform or observe any covenant or agreement (other than those specified in Section  8.01(a) or (b)  above) contained in any Loan Document on its part to be performed or observed and such failure continues for 30 days after notice thereof by the Administrative Agent to the Borrower Representative; or

(d) Representations and Warranties . Any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of a Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document required to be delivered in connection herewith or therewith shall be incorrect or misleading in any material respect (or in any respect if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) when made or deemed made; or

(e) Cross-Default . (i) Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (A) fails to make any payment beyond the applicable grace period with respect thereto, if any (whether by scheduled maturity, required prepayment, acceleration, demand, or otherwise) in respect of any Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness hereunder and intercompany Indebtedness) having an aggregate outstanding principal amount of more than $20,000,000 or (B) fails to observe or perform any other agreement or condition relating to any such Indebtedness, or any other event occurs, the effect of which default or other event is to cause, or to permit the holder or holders of such Indebtedness (or a trustee or agent on behalf of such holder or holders or beneficiary or beneficiaries) after the expiration of any applicable grace or cure period therefor to cause, with the giving of notice if required, such Indebtedness to become due or to be repurchased, prepaid, defeased or redeemed (automatically or otherwise), or an offer to repurchase, prepay, defease or redeem such Indebtedness to be made, in each case, prior to its stated maturity; provided that this clause (e)(B) shall not apply to (x) secured Indebtedness that becomes due as a result of the sale or transfer or other Disposition (including a Casualty Event) of the property or assets securing such Indebtedness permitted hereunder and under the documents providing for such Indebtedness and such Indebtedness is repaid when required under the documents providing for such Indebtedness (y) events of default, termination events or any other similar event under the documents governing Swap Contracts for so long as such event of default, termination event or other similar event does not result in the occurrence of an early termination date or any acceleration or prepayment of any amounts or other Indebtedness payable thereunder or (z) Indebtedness that upon the happening of any such default or event automatically converts into Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interest or, in the case of the Borrowers or a Restricted Subsidiary, Disqualified Equity Interest or preferred stock) in accordance with its terms; provided , further , that such failure is unremedied and is not validly waived by the holders of such Indebtedness in accordance with the terms of the documents governing such Indebtedness prior to any termination of the Revolving Credit Commitments or acceleration of the Loans pursuant to Section  8.02 ; or

 

-161-


(f) Insolvency Proceedings, Etc . Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than Immaterial Subsidiaries) institutes or consents to the institution of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, a winding-up, an administration, a dissolution, or a composition or makes an assignment for the benefit of creditors or any other action is commenced (by way of voluntary arrangement, scheme of arrangement or otherwise); or appoints, applies for or consents to the appointment of any receiver, administrator, administrative receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator, judicial manager, provisional liquidator, administrator, receiver and manager, controller, monitor or similar officer for it or for all or any material part of its property; or any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator, judicial manager, provisional liquidator, administrator, administrative receiver, receiver and manager, controller, monitor or similar officer is appointed without the application or consent of such Person and the appointment continues undischarged or unstayed for 60 days or any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law relating to any such Person or to all or substantially all of its property is instituted without the consent of such Person and continues undismissed or unstayed for 60 days, or an order for relief is entered in any such proceeding; or

(g) Inability to Pay Debts ; Attachment . (i) Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than any Immaterial Subsidiary) becomes unable or admits in writing its inability or fails generally to pay its debts as they become due or suspends making payments or enters into a moratorium or standstill arrangement in relation to its Indebtedness or is taken to have failed to comply with a statutory demand (or otherwise be presumed to be insolvent by applicable Law) or (ii) any writ or warrant of attachment or execution or similar process is issued, commenced or levied against all or substantially all of the property of any such Person and is not released, vacated or fully bonded within 60 days after its issue, commencement or levy, or any analogous procedure or step is taken in any jurisdiction); or

(h) Judgments . There is entered against any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary a final judgment or order for the payment of money in an aggregate amount (as to all such judgments and orders) exceeding $20,000,000 (to the extent not paid and not covered by (i) independent third-party insurance as to which the insurer has been notified of such judgment or order and does not deny coverage or (ii) an enforceable indemnity to the extent that such Loan Party or Restricted Subsidiary shall have made a claim for indemnification and the applicable indemnifying party shall not have disputed such claim) and there is a period of 60 consecutive days during which a stay of enforcement of such judgment, by reason of a pending appeal or otherwise, is not in effect; or

(i) ERISA . One or more ERISA Events occur or there is or arises an Unfunded Pension Liability (taking into account only Plans with positive Unfunded Pension Liability) which ERISA Event or Events or Unfunded Pension Liability or Liabilities results or would reasonably be expected to result in liability of any Loan Party in an aggregate amount (determined as of the date of occurrence of such ERISA Event) which would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect; or

(j) Invalidity of Loan Documents . Any material provision of any Collateral Document, any Guaranty, the Intercreditor Agreement and/or the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, or any intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, at any time after its execution and delivery and for any reason other than as

 

-162-


expressly permitted hereunder or thereunder (including as a result of a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05) or satisfaction in full of all the Obligations (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted and obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements as to which arrangements satisfactory to the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank shall have been made) ceases to be in full force and effect (except that any such failure to be in full force and effect with respect to the documents referred to in clause (viii) of the definition of “Loan Documents” shall constitute an Event of Default only if the Borrower Representative receives notice thereof and the Borrowers fail to remedy the relevant failure in all material respects within ten Business Days of receiving said notice); or any Loan Party contests in writing the validity or enforceability of any provision of any Collateral Document, any Guaranty, the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, the Intercreditor Agreement or any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement; or any Loan Party denies in writing that it has any or further liability or obligation under any Loan Document (other than as a result of repayment in full of the Obligations (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted and obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements as to which arrangements satisfactory to the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank shall have been made) and termination of the Aggregate Commitments), or purports in writing to revoke or rescind any Loan Document or the perfected first priority Liens created thereby (except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement or the Collateral Documents); or

(k) Change of Control . There occurs any Change of Control.

Section 8.02 Remedies upon Event of Default . If (i) any Event of Default occurs and is continuing (other than an Event of Default under Section  8.01(b) due solely to the Borrowers’ failure to observe the Financial Covenant) the Administrative Agent shall, at the request of, or may, with the consent of, the Required Lenders and (ii) solely with respect to an Event of Default that has occurred and is continuing under Section  8.01(b) due solely to the Borrowers’ failure to observe the Financial Covenant, the Administrative Agent shall, at the request of, or may, with the consent of, the Required Revolving Lenders, take any or all of the following actions:

(a) declare the commitment of each Lender to make Loans and any obligation of the L/C Issuers to make L/C Credit Extensions to be terminated, whereupon such commitments and obligation shall be terminated;

(b) declare the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans, all interest accrued and unpaid thereon, and all other amounts owing or payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document to be immediately due and payable, without presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Borrowers;

(c) require that the Borrowers Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations (in an amount equal to the then Outstanding Amount thereof); and

(d) exercise on behalf of itself, the L/C Issuers and the Lenders all rights and remedies available to it, the L/C Issuers and the Lenders under the Loan Documents, under any document evidencing Indebtedness in respect of which the Facilities have been designated as “Designated Senior Debt” (or any comparable term) and/or under applicable Law;

 

-163-


provided , however , that upon the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to any Loan Party under any Debtor Relief Law, the obligation of each Lender to make Loans and any obligation of the L/C Issuers to make L/C Credit Extensions shall automatically terminate, the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid shall automatically become due and payable, and the obligation of the Borrowers to Cash Collateralize the L/C Obligations as aforesaid shall automatically become effective, in each case without further act of the Administrative Agent or any Lender.

Section 8.03 Right to Cure .

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Section  8.01 or 8.02 , in the event that the Borrowers fail to comply with the Financial Covenant as of the end of any fiscal quarter, at any time when the Borrowers are required to comply with such Financial Covenant, pursuant to the terms thereof, then (A) after the end of such fiscal quarter of the Borrowers until the expiration of the tenth Business Day subsequent to the date the relevant financial statements for such fiscal quarter are required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) (the last day of such period being the “ Anticipated Cure Deadline ”), Holdings shall have the right to issue common Equity Interests, preferred equity certificates and/or convertible preferred equity certificates (so long as such preferred equity certificates and convertible preferred equity certificates do not constitute Disqualified Equity Interests) or in another form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent for cash and contribute the proceeds therefrom in the form of common Equity Interests, to a Borrower or obtain a contribution to Holdings’ equity (which shall be in the form of common Equity Interests, preferred equity certificates and/or convertible preferred equity certificates (so long as such preferred equity certificates and convertible preferred equity certificates do not constitute Disqualified Equity Interests) or otherwise in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and contribute the proceeds therefrom in the form of common Equity Interests to a Borrower) (the “ Cure Right ”), and upon the receipt by a Borrower of such cash (the “ Cure Amount ”), pursuant to the exercise by the Borrowers of such Cure Right, the calculation of Consolidated EBITDA as used in the Financial Covenant as of the end of such fiscal quarter shall be recalculated giving effect to the following pro forma adjustments:

(i) Consolidated EBITDA shall be increased, solely for the purpose of measuring the Financial Covenant for the applicable period and each subsequent period containing such fiscal quarter and not for any other purpose under this Agreement (including but not limited to determining the availability or amount of any covenant baskets or carve-outs (including the determination of Cumulative Credit) or determining the Applicable Rate), by an amount equal to the Cure Amount; provided that (1) the receipt by a Borrower of the Cure Amount pursuant to the Cure Right shall be deemed to have no other effect whatsoever under this Agreement (including but not limited to determining the availability or amount of any covenant baskets or carve-outs or determining the Applicable Rate) and (2) no Cure Amount shall reduce Indebtedness on a Pro Forma Basis for the applicable period for purposes of calculating the Financial Covenant or calculating the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio or the Total Net Leverage Ratio, nor shall any Cure Amount held by any Borrower Party qualify as Unrestricted Cash for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities under the terms of this Agreement;

(ii) if, after giving effect to the foregoing recalculations, the Borrowers shall then be in compliance with the requirements of the Financial Covenant, the Borrowers shall be deemed to have satisfied the requirements of the Financial Covenant as of the relevant date of determination with the same effect as though there had been no failure to comply therewith at such date, and the applicable breach or default of the Financial Covenant that had occurred (and any other Default as a result thereof, including the failure to meet any condition requiring no Default or Event of Default based solely on the basis of any actual or purported Event of Default under the Financial Covenant) shall be deemed cured for the purposes of this Agreement; and

 

-164-


(iii) upon receipt by the Administrative Agent of written notice from the Borrower Representative, on or prior to the Anticipated Cure Deadline, that the Borrowers intend to exercise the Cure Right in respect of a fiscal quarter, the Lenders shall not be permitted to accelerate the Loans held by them, to terminate the Revolving Credit Commitments held by them or to exercise remedies against the Collateral on the basis of a failure to comply with the Financial Covenant (but such failure shall not be disregarded in determining whether conditions to borrowing are satisfied), unless such failure is not cured pursuant to the exercise of the Cure Right on or prior to the Anticipated Cure Deadline.

(b) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, (i) in each four consecutive fiscal-quarter period there shall be at least two fiscal quarters in respect of which the Cure Right is not exercised, (ii) there can be no more than five fiscal quarters in respect of which the Cure Right is exercised during the term of the Facilities and (iii) for purposes of this Section  8.03 , the Cure Amount utilized shall be no greater than the minimum amount required to remedy the applicable failure to comply with the Financial Covenant.

Section 8.04 Application of Funds . After the exercise of remedies provided for in Section  8.02 (or after an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to one or more of the Borrowers under any Debtor Relief Law), any amounts received on account of the Obligations shall, subject to the provisions of Sections 2.16 and 2.17 be applied by the Administrative Agent in the following order:

(a) first , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities, expenses and other amounts (including fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel payable under Section  10.04 and amounts payable under Article III and amounts owing in respect of (x) the preservation of Collateral or the Collateral Agent’s security interest in the Collateral or (y) with respect to enforcing the rights of the Secured Parties under the Loan Documents) payable to the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent in their respective capacity as such;

(b) second , to payment in full of Unfunded Advances/Participations (the amounts so applied to be distributed between or among, as applicable, the Administrative Agent, the Swing Line Lender and the L/C Issuers pro rata in accordance with the amounts of Unfunded Advances/Participations owed to them on the date of any such distribution);

(c) third , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities, expenses and other amounts (other than principal, interest and Letter of Credit fees) payable to the Lenders and the L/C Issuers (including fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel payable under Sections 10.04 and 10.05 ) arising under the Loan Documents and amounts payable under Article III , ratably among them in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (c) held by them;

(d) fourth , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting accrued and unpaid Letter of Credit fees and interest on the Loans and L/C Borrowings, ratably among the Lenders and the L/C Issuers in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (d) held by them;

(e) fifth , (i) to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting unpaid principal of the Loans, the L/C Borrowings and obligations of the Loan Parties then owing under Secured Hedge Agreements and the Secured Cash Management Agreements and (ii) to Cash Collateralize that portion of L/C Obligations comprising the aggregate undrawn amount of Letters of Credit to the extent not otherwise Cash Collateralized by the Borrowers pursuant to

 

-165-


Sections  2.03 and 2.16 , ratably among the Lenders, the L/C Issuers, the Hedge Banks party to such Secured Hedge Agreements and the Cash Management Banks party to such Secured Cash Management Agreements in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (e) held by them; provided that (x) any such amounts applied pursuant to the foregoing subclause (ii) shall be paid to the Administrative Agent for the ratable account of the applicable L/C Issuers to Cash Collateralize such L/C Obligations, (y) subject to Sections 2.03(d) and 2.16 , amounts used to Cash Collateralize the aggregate undrawn amount of Letters of Credit pursuant to this clause (e) shall be applied to satisfy drawings under such Letters of Credit as they occur and (z) upon the expiration of any Letter of Credit, the pro rata share of Cash Collateral attributable to such expired Letter of Credit shall be applied by the Administrative Agent in accordance with the priority of payments set forth in this Section  8.04 ;

(f) sixth , to the payment of all other Obligations of the Loan Parties owing under or in respect of the Loan Documents that are then due and payable to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, ratably based upon the respective aggregate amounts of all such Obligations then owing to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties; and

(g) last , after all of the Obligations have been paid in full (other than contingent indemnification obligations not yet due and owing), to the Borrowers or as otherwise required by Law.

If any amount remains on deposit as Cash Collateral after all Letters of Credit have either been fully drawn or expired, such remaining amount shall be applied to the other Obligations, if any, in accordance with the priority of payments set forth above. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Obligations arising under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements shall be excluded from the application of payments described above if the Administrative Agent has not received written notice thereof, together with such supporting documentation as the Administrative Agent may reasonably request, from the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank, as the case may be. Each Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank not a party to this Agreement that has given the notice contemplated by the preceding sentence shall, by such notice, be deemed to have acknowledged and accepted the appointment of the Administrative Agent pursuant to the terms of Article IX for itself and its Affiliates as if a “Lender” party hereto.

It is understood and agreed by each Loan Party and each Secured Party that the Administrative Agent and Collateral Agent shall have no liability for any determinations made by it in this Section  8.04 , in each case except to the extent resulting from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent, as applicable (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision). Each Loan Party and each Secured Party also agrees that the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent may (but shall not be required to), at any time and in its sole discretion, and with no liability resulting therefrom, petition a court of competent jurisdiction regarding any application of Collateral in accordance with the requirements hereof, and the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent shall be entitled to wait for, and may conclusively rely on, any such determination.

 

-166-


ARTICLE IX

Administrative Agent and Other Agents

Section 9.01 Appointment and Authorization of Agents .

(a) Each Lender, L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender hereby irrevocably appoints Royal Bank to act on its behalf as Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, and designates and authorizes the Administrative Agent to take such actions on its behalf under the provisions of this Agreement and each other Loan Document and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to the Administrative Agent by the terms of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, together with such actions and powers as are reasonably incidental thereto. Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary contained elsewhere herein or in any other Loan Document no Agent shall have any duties or responsibilities, except those expressly set forth herein, nor shall any Agent have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with any Lender or participant, and no implied covenants, functions, responsibilities, duties, obligations or liabilities shall be read into this Agreement or any other Loan Document or otherwise exist against any Agent. Regardless of whether a Default has occurred and is continuing and without limiting the generality of the foregoing sentence, the use of the term “agent” herein and in the other Loan Documents with reference to any Agent is not intended to connote any fiduciary or other implied (or express) obligations arising under agency doctrine of any applicable Law. Instead, such term is used merely as a matter of market custom, and is intended to create or reflect only an administrative relationship between independent contracting parties.

(b) Each L/C Issuer shall act on behalf of the Lenders with respect to any Letters of Credit issued by it and the documents associated therewith, and such L/C Issuer shall have all of the benefits and immunities (i) provided to the Agents in this Article IX with respect to any acts taken or omissions suffered by such L/C Issuer in connection with Letters of Credit issued by it or proposed to be issued by it and the applications and agreements for letters of credit pertaining to such Letters of Credit as fully as if the term “Agent” as used in this Article IX and in the definition of “Agent-Related Person” included such L/C Issuer with respect to such acts or omissions, and (ii) as additionally provided herein with respect to such L/C Issuer.

(c) The Administrative Agent shall also act as the Collateral Agent under the Loan Documents, and each of the Secured Parties, the L/C Issuer (if applicable) and the Swing Line Lender (if applicable) hereby irrevocably appoints and authorizes the Administrative Agent to act as the agent of (and in its capacity as Collateral Agent to hold the benefit of any security interest created by the Collateral Documents and/or any asset and proceeds of any asset paid to, held by or received or recovered by it under or in connection with the Loan Documents on trust for itself and the other Secured Parties and the L/C Issuer (if applicable) according to its and their respective interests and upon the terms and conditions set out in the relevant Loan Documents) such Secured Party and L/C Issuer (if applicable) for purposes of acquiring, holding and enforcing any and all Liens on Collateral granted by any of the Loan Parties to secure any of the Secured Obligations, together with such powers and discretion as are reasonably incidental thereto. In this connection, the Administrative Agent as Collateral Agent (and any co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact appointed by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  9.02 for purposes of holding or enforcing any Lien on the Collateral (or any portion thereof) granted under the Collateral Documents, or for exercising any rights and remedies thereunder at the direction of the Administrative Agent), shall be entitled to the benefits of all provisions of this Article IX (including Section  9.07 , as though such co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact were the Collateral Agent under the Loan Documents) and Section  10.04 as if set forth in full herein with respect thereto and all references to Administrative Agent in this Article IX shall, where applicable, be read as including a reference to the Collateral Agent. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Lenders hereby expressly authorize the Administrative Agent as Collateral Agent to execute any and all documents (including releases) with respect to the Collateral and the rights of the Secured Parties with respect thereto, as contemplated by and in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and the Collateral Documents and acknowledge and agree that any such action by any Agent shall bind the Secured Parties, the L/C Issuer (if applicable) and the Swing Line Lender (if applicable).

 

-167-


Section 9.02 Delegation of Duties . The Administrative Agent may execute any of its duties and exercise its rights and powers under this Agreement or any other Loan Document (including for purposes of holding or enforcing any Lien on the Collateral (or any portion thereof) granted under the Collateral Documents or of exercising any rights and remedies thereunder) by or through agents, employees or attorneys-in-fact and shall be entitled to advice of counsel and other consultants or experts concerning all matters pertaining to such duties. The Administrative Agent and any such sub agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers by or through their respective Agent-Related Persons. The Administrative Agent shall not be responsible for the negligence or misconduct of any agent or attorney-in-fact that it selects in the absence of gross negligence or willful misconduct by the Administrative Agent, as determined by a final non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction. The exculpatory provisions of this Article IX shall apply to any such sub agent and to the Agent-Related Persons of the Administrative Agent and any such sub agent, and shall apply to their respective activities in connection with the syndication of the credit facilities provided for herein as well as activities as Administrative Agent.

Section 9.03 Liability of Agents .

(a) No Agent-Related Person shall be (i) liable for any action taken or omitted to be taken by any of them under or in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan Document or the transactions contemplated hereby (except for its own gross negligence or willful misconduct in connection with its duties expressly set forth herein, to the extent determined in a final, non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction), (ii) liable for any action taken or not taken by it (A) with the consent or at the request of the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be necessary, or as the Administrative Agent shall believe in good faith shall be necessary, under the circumstances as provided in Sections 10.01 and 8.02 ) or (B) in the absence of its own gross negligence or willful misconduct as determined by the final, non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction, in connection with its duties expressly set forth herein, (iii) responsible in any manner to any Lender or participant for any recital, statement, representation or warranty made by any Loan Party or any officer thereof, contained herein or in any other Loan Document, or in any certificate, report, statement or other document referred to or provided for in, or received by the Administrative Agent under or in connection with, this Agreement or any other Loan Document, (iv) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the validity, effectiveness, genuineness, enforceability or sufficiency of this Agreement or any other Loan Document or any other agreement, instrument or document, or the creation, perfection or priority of any Lien, or security interest created or purported to be created under the Collateral Documents, or for any failure of any Loan Party or any other party to any Loan Document to perform its obligations hereunder, (v) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the value or the sufficiency of any Collateral or (vi) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the satisfaction of any condition set forth in Article IV or elsewhere herein, other than to confirm receipt of items expressly required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent. No Agent-Related Person shall be under any obligation to any Lender or participant to ascertain or to inquire as to the observance or performance of any of the agreements contained in, or conditions of, this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or to inspect the properties, books or records of any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof.

(b) The Administrative Agent shall not have any duty to (i) take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated hereby or by the other Loan Documents that such Agent is required to exercise as directed in writing by the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be expressly provided for herein or in the other Loan Documents); provided that no Agent shall be required to take any action that, in its opinion or the opinion of its counsel, may expose such Agent to liability or that is contrary to any Loan Document or applicable Law; and (ii) to disclose, except as expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents, and shall not be liable for the failure to disclose, any information relating to the Borrowers or any of their Affiliates that is communicated to or obtained by any Person serving as an Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity.

 

-168-


(c) Any assignor of a Loan or seller of a participation hereunder shall be entitled to rely conclusively on a representation of the assignee Lender or Participant in the relevant Assignment and Assumption or participation agreement, as applicable, that such assignee or purchaser is not a Disqualified Institution. No Agent shall have any responsibility or liability for monitoring the list or identities of, or enforcing provisions relating to, Disqualified Institutions.

Section 9.04 Reliance by Agents .

(a) Each Agent shall be entitled to rely, and shall be fully protected in relying, upon any writing, communication, signature, resolution, representation, notice, request, consent, certificate, instrument, affidavit, letter, telegram, facsimile, telex or telephone message, electronic mail message, Internet or intranet website posting or other distribution statement or other document or conversation believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed, sent or made by the proper Person or Persons. Each Agent also may rely upon any statement made to it orally or by telephone and believed by it to have been made by the proper Person, and shall not incur any liability for relying thereon. In determining compliance with any condition hereunder to the making of a Loan that by its terms must be fulfilled to the satisfaction of a Lender, the Administrative Agent may presume that such condition is satisfactory to such Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice to the contrary from such Lender prior to the making of such Loan. Each Agent may consult with, and rely upon (and be fully protected in relying upon), advice and statements of legal counsel (including counsel to any Loan Party), independent accountants and other experts selected by such Agent. Each Agent shall be fully justified in failing or refusing to take any action under any Loan Document unless it shall first receive such advice or concurrence of the Required Lenders (or such greater number of Lenders as may be expressly required hereby in any instance) as it deems appropriate and, if it so requests, it shall first be indemnified to its satisfaction by the Lenders against any and all liability and expense that may be incurred by it by reason of taking or continuing to take any such action. Each Agent shall in all cases be fully protected in acting, or in refraining from acting, under this Agreement or any other Loan Document in accordance with a request or consent of the Required Lenders (or such greater number of Lenders as may be expressly required hereby in any instance) and such request and any action taken or failure to act pursuant thereto shall be binding upon all the Lenders.

(b) For purposes of determining compliance with the conditions specified in Sections 4.01 , each Lender that has signed this Agreement shall be deemed to have consented to, approved or accepted or to be satisfied with, each document or other matter required thereunder to be consented to or approved by or acceptable or satisfactory to a Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from such Lender prior to the proposed Closing Date, specifying its objection thereto.

Section 9.05 Notice of Default . The Administrative Agent shall not be deemed to have knowledge or notice of the occurrence of any Default, except with respect to defaults in the payment of principal, interest and fees required to be paid to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Lenders, unless the Administrative Agent shall have received written notice from a Lender or the Borrowers referring to this Agreement, describing such Default and stating that such notice is a “notice of default.” The Administrative Agent will notify the Lenders of its receipt of any such notice. The Administrative Agent shall take such action with respect to any Event of Default as may be directed by the Required Lenders or the Required Revolving Lenders, as applicable, in accordance with Article VIII ; provided , however , that unless and until the Administrative Agent has received any such direction, the Administrative Agent may (but shall not be obligated to) take such action, or refrain from taking such action, with respect to such Event of Default as it shall deem advisable or in the best interest of the Lenders.

 

-169-


Section 9.06 Credit Decision ; Disclosure of Information by Agents . Each Lender acknowledges that no Agent-Related Person has made any representation or warranty to it, and that no act by any Agent hereafter taken, including any consent to and acceptance of any assignment or review of the affairs of any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof, shall be deemed to constitute any representation or warranty by any Agent-Related Person to any Lender as to any matter, including whether Agent-Related Persons have disclosed material information in their possession. Each Lender represents to each Agent that it has, independently and without reliance upon any Agent-Related Person and based on such documents and information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own appraisal of, and investigation into, the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition and creditworthiness of the Loan Parties and their respective Subsidiaries, and all applicable bank or other regulatory Laws relating to the transactions contemplated hereby, and made its own decision to enter into this Agreement and to extend credit to the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties hereunder. Each Lender also represents that it will, independently and without reliance upon any Agent-Related Person and based on such documents and information as it shall deem appropriate at the time, continue to make its own credit analysis, appraisals and decisions in taking or not taking action under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and to make such investigations as it deems necessary to inform itself as to the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition and creditworthiness of the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties. Except for notices, reports and other documents expressly required to be furnished to the Lenders by any Agent herein, such Agent shall not have any duty or responsibility to provide any Lender with any credit or other information concerning the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition or creditworthiness of any of the Loan Parties or any of their respective Affiliates which may come into the possession of any Agent-Related Person.

Section 9.07 Indemnification of Agents . Whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby are consummated, each Lender shall, on a ratable basis based on such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of all the Facilities, indemnify upon demand each Agent-Related Person (to the extent not reimbursed by or on behalf of any Loan Party and without limiting the obligation of any Loan Party to do so), and hold harmless each Agent-Related Person in each case from and against any and all Indemnified Liabilities incurred by such Agent-Related Person; provided , however , that no Lender shall be liable for any Indemnified Liabilities incurred by an Agent-Related Person to the extent such Indemnified Liabilities are determined in a final, non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction to have resulted from such Agent-Related Person’s own gross negligence or willful misconduct; provided , however , that no action taken in accordance with the directions of the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be required by the Loan Documents) shall be deemed to constitute gross negligence or willful misconduct for purposes of this Section  9.07 ; provided , further , that to the extent any L/C Issuer is entitled to indemnification under this Section  9.07 solely in its capacity and role as an L/C Issuer, only the Revolving Credit Lenders shall be required to indemnify such L/C Issuer under this Section  9.07 (which indemnity shall be provided by such Lenders based upon their respective Pro Rata Share of the Revolving Credit Facility). In the case of any investigation, litigation or proceeding giving rise to any Indemnified Liabilities, this Section  9.07 shall apply whether or not any such investigation, litigation or proceeding is brought by any Lender or any other Person. Without limiting the foregoing, each Lender shall reimburse the Administrative Agent upon demand for its Pro Rata Share of any costs or out-of-pocket expenses (including the fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel) incurred by the Administrative Agent in connection with the preparation, execution, delivery, administration, modification, amendment or enforcement (whether through negotiations, legal proceedings or otherwise) of, or legal advice in respect of rights or responsibilities under, this Agreement, any other Loan Document, or any document contemplated by or referred to herein, to the extent that the Administrative Agent is not reimbursed for such expenses by or on behalf of the Borrowers; provided that such reimbursement by the Lenders shall not affect the Borrowers’ continuing reimbursement obligations with respect thereto; provided , further , that failure of any Lender to indemnify or reimburse the Administrative Agent shall not relieve any other Lender of its obligation in respect thereof. The undertaking in this Section  9.07 shall survive termination of the Aggregate Commitments, the payment of all other Obligations and the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent.

 

-170-


Section 9.08 Agents in Their Individual Capacities . Any Agent and its Affiliates may make loans to, issue letters of credit for the account of, accept deposits from, acquire Equity Interests in and generally engage in any kind of banking, trust, financial advisory, underwriting or other business with each of the Loan Parties and their respective Affiliates as though it were not an Agent or an L/C Issuer hereunder and without notice to or consent of the Lenders. The Lenders acknowledge that, pursuant to such activities, an Agent or its Affiliates may receive information regarding any Loan Party or its Affiliates (including information that may be subject to confidentiality obligations in favor of such Loan Party or such Affiliate) and acknowledge that such Agent shall be under no obligation to provide such information to them. With respect to its Loans, such Agent shall have the same rights and powers under this Agreement as any other Lender and may exercise such rights and powers as though it were not an Agent or an L/C Issuer, and the terms “Lender” and “Lenders” include such Agent in its individual capacity (unless otherwise expressly indicated or unless the context otherwise requires).

Section 9.09 Successor Agents .

(a) The Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent may resign as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, upon 30 days’ written notice to the Borrowers and the Lenders. If the Administrative Agent or a Controlling Affiliate of the Administrative Agent is subject to an Agent-Related Distress Event, the Borrowers may remove the Administrative Agent from such role upon ten (10) days’ written notice to the Lenders. Upon receipt of any such notice of resignation or removal, the Required Lenders shall appoint from among the Lenders a successor agent for the Lenders, which successor agent shall be consented to by the Borrowers at all times other than during the existence of an Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) , or (g) (which consent of the Borrowers shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed). If no successor agent is appointed prior to the effective date of the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, may appoint, after consulting with the Lenders and the Borrowers, a successor agent from among the Lenders, which shall not be incorporated or acting through an office situated in a Non-Cooperative Jurisdiction. Upon the acceptance of its appointment as successor agent hereunder, the Person acting as such successor agent shall succeed to all the rights, powers and duties of the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, and the term “Administrative Agent” or “Collateral Agent,” as applicable, shall mean such successor administrative agent or such successor collateral agent, as applicable, and the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s appointment, powers and duties as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be terminated. After the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s resignation or removal hereunder as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, the provisions of this Article  IX and Sections 10.04 and 10.05 shall continue in effect for its benefit as to any actions taken or omitted to be taken by it while it was the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under this Agreement. If no successor agent has accepted appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent by the date which is 30 days following the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s removal or notice of resignation, the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s resignation or removal shall nevertheless thereupon become effective and (i) the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder and under the other Loan Documents (except that in the case of any collateral security held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent on behalf of the Lenders under any of the Loan Documents, the retiring Agent shall continue to hold such collateral security as bailee, trustee or other applicable capacity until such time as a successor of such Agent is appointed), (ii) all payments, communications and determinations provided to or be made by, to or through the Administrative Agent shall instead be made by or to each Lender directly, until such time as the Required Lenders appoint a successor Administrative Agent as provided

 

-171-


for above in this Section  9.09 and (iii) the Lenders shall perform all of the duties of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, hereunder until such time, if any, as the Required Lenders appoint a successor agent as provided for above. Upon the acceptance of any appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder by a successor and upon the execution and filing or recording of such financing statements, or amendments thereto, and such amendments or supplements to the Mortgages, and such other instruments or notices, as may be necessary or desirable, or as the Required Lenders may request, in order to continue the perfection of the Liens granted or purported to be granted by the Collateral Documents, the successor Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall thereupon succeed to and become vested with all the rights, powers, discretion, privileges, and duties of the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent. Upon the acceptance of any appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder by a successor or upon the expiration of the 30-day period following the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s removal or notice of resignation without a successor agent having been appointed, the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder and under the other Loan Documents but the provisions of this Article IX and Sections 10.04 and 10.05 shall continue in effect for the benefit of such retiring Agent, its sub-agents and their respective Agent-Related Persons in respect of any actions taken or omitted to be taken by any of them solely in respect of the Loan Documents or Obligations, as applicable, while the retiring Agent was acting as Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable. At any time the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent is a Defaulting Lender pursuant to clause (d) of the definition thereof, the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent may be removed as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder at the request of the Borrowers and the Required Lenders.

(b) Any resignation by or removal of Royal Bank as Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent pursuant to this Section  9.09 shall also constitute its resignation or removal as an L/C Issuer and as Swing Line Lender, in which case the resigning or removed Administrative Agent (x) shall not be required to issue any further Letters of Credit or make any additional Swing Line Loans hereunder and (y) shall maintain all of its rights as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be, with respect to any Letters of Credit issued by it, or Swing Line Loans made by it, prior to the date of such resignation or removal. Upon the acceptance of a successor’s appointment as Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder or upon the expiration of the 30-day period following the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent’s removal or notice of resignation without a successor agent having been appointed, (i) such successor (if any) shall succeed to and become vested with all of the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the retiring L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender, (ii) the retiring L/C Issuer and Swing Line Lender shall be discharged from all of their respective duties and obligations hereunder or under the other Loan Documents and (iii) the successor L/C Issuer (if any) shall issue letters of credit in substitution for the Letters of Credit issued by such retiring L/C Issuer, if any, outstanding at the time of such succession or make (or the Borrowers shall enter into) other arrangements satisfactory to the retiring L/C Issuer to effectively assume the obligations of the retiring L/C Issuer with respect to such Letters of Credit.

Section 9.10 Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim . In case of the pendency of any receivership, administrative receivership, judicial management, insolvency, liquidation, bankruptcy, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), arrangement, adjustment, composition or other judicial proceeding relative to any Loan Party, the Administrative Agent (irrespective of whether the principal of any Loan or L/C Obligation shall then be due and payable as herein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and irrespective of whether the Administrative Agent shall have made any demand on the Borrowers) shall be entitled and empowered, by intervention in such proceeding or otherwise:

(a) to file and prove a claim for the whole amount of the principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the Loans, L/C Obligations and all other Obligations that are owing and

 

-172-


unpaid and to file such other documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Lenders and the Administrative Agent (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Lenders and the Administrative Agent and their respective agents and counsel and all other amounts due the Lenders and the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.03(g) and (h) , 2.09 and 10.04 ) allowed in such judicial proceeding; and

(b) to collect and receive any monies or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute the same;

and any administrator, administrative receiver, custodian, receiver, assignee, trustee, judicial manager, liquidator, sequestrator or other similar official in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Lender to make such payments to the Administrative Agent and, in the event that the Administrative Agent shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Lenders, to pay to the Administrative Agent any amount due for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Agents and their respective agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.09 and 10.04 .

Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to authorize the Administrative Agent to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Lender any plan of reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Obligations or the rights of any Lender or to authorize the Administrative Agent to vote in respect of the claim of any Lender in any such proceeding.

Section 9.11 Collateral and Guaranty Matters . Each of the Lenders (including in their capacities as potential Hedge Banks party to a Secured Hedge Agreement and potential Cash Management Banks party to a Secured Cash Management Agreement) and each L/C Issuer irrevocably authorize the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent, and each of the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent shall to the extent requested by the Borrowers or, solely in the case of clause (d) below, to the extent provided for under this Agreement,

(a) release any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under any Loan Document (i) upon termination of the Aggregate Commitments and payment in full of all Obligations (other than (A) contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted and (B) obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements) and the expiration or termination of all Letters of Credit (other than Letters of Credit which have been Cash Collateralized), (ii) that is sold, disposed of or distributed or to be sold, disposed of or distributed as part of or in connection with any transaction permitted hereunder or under any other Loan Document, in each case to a Person that is not a Loan Party, (iii) subject to Section  10.01 , if approved, authorized or ratified in writing by the Required Lenders, (iv) that constitutes Excluded Property as a result of an occurrence not prohibited hereunder or (v) owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor upon release of such Subsidiary Guarantor from its obligations under its Guaranty pursuant to clause (c) below;

(b) release or subordinate any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under any Loan Document to the holder of any Lien on such property that is permitted by Section  7.01(e) (other than with respect to self-insurance arrangements), (f) , (i) , (m) , (p)(A) , (s) , (u) , (w) , (z) , (aa) , (bb) , (dd) , (ee) , (hh) , (kk) and (pp) ;

 

-173-


(c) release any Guarantor from its obligations under the applicable Guaranty if in the case of any Subsidiary, such Person ceases to be a Restricted Subsidiary or otherwise becomes an Excluded Subsidiary as a result of a transaction or designation permitted hereunder; provided that no such release shall occur if such Guarantor continues to be a guarantor in respect of the Second Lien Term Facility Indebtedness, any Specified Refinancing Debt, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes and, to the extent incurred by a Loan Party, any Permitted Ratio Debt of any Loan Party or any Permitted Refinancing of any of the foregoing (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof), in each case, with an aggregate outstanding principal amount in excess of the Threshold Amount; and

(d) to enter into the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor arrangements as contemplated by this Agreement, including pursuant to Section  7.01(ii) .

Upon request by the Administrative Agent at any time, the Required Lenders will confirm in writing the Collateral Agent’s authority to release or subordinate its interest in particular types or items of property, or to release any Guarantor from its obligations under the Guaranty pursuant to this Section  9.11 . In each case as specified in this Section  9.11 , the applicable Agent will (and each Lender irrevocably authorizes the applicable Agent to), at the Borrowers’ expense, execute and deliver to the applicable Loan Party such documents as such Loan Party may reasonably request to evidence the release or subordination of such item of Collateral from the assignment and security interest granted under the Collateral Documents, or to evidence the release of such Guarantor from its obligations under the Guaranty, in each case in accordance with the terms of the Loan Documents and this Section  9.11 ; provided that the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers certifying that any such transaction has been consummated in compliance with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 9.12 Certain Rights of the Administrative Agent . If the Administrative Agent requests instructions from the Required Lenders with respect to any act or action (including failure to act) in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan Document, the Administrative Agent shall be entitled to refrain from such act or taking such action unless and until the Administrative Agent shall have received instructions from the Required Lenders; and the Administrative Agent shall not incur liability to any Lender by reason of so refraining. Without limiting the foregoing, neither any Lender nor the holder of any Note shall have any right of action whatsoever against the Administrative Agent as a result of the Administrative Agent acting or refraining from acting hereunder or under any other Loan Document in accordance with the instructions of the Required Lenders.

Section 9.13 Holders . The Administrative Agent may deem and treat the payee of any Note as the owner thereof for all purposes hereof unless and until a written notice of the assignment, transfer or endorsement thereof, as the case may be, shall have been filed with the Administrative Agent and recorded in the Register in accordance with Section  10.07(c) . Any request, authority or consent of any Person who, at the time of making such request or giving such authority or consent, is the holder of any Note shall be conclusive and binding on any subsequent holder, transferee, assignee or endorsee, as the case may be, of such Note or of any Note or Notes issued in exchange therefor.

Section 9.14 Other Agents; Arranger and Managers . None of the Lenders or other Persons identified on the facing page or signature pages of this Agreement as a “syndication agent,” “co-documentation agent,” “joint lead arranger,” “joint bookrunner” or “co-manager” shall have any right, power, obligation, liability, responsibility or duty under this Agreement other than those applicable to all Lenders as such. Without limiting the foregoing, none of the Lenders or other Persons so identified shall have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with any Lender. Each Lender acknowledges that it has not relied, and will not rely, on any of the Lenders or other Persons so identified in deciding to enter into this Agreement or in taking or not taking action hereunder.

 

-174-


Section 9.15 Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements .

(a) No Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank that obtains the benefits of Section  8.04 , any Guaranty or any Collateral by virtue of the provisions hereof or of any Guaranty or any Collateral Document shall have any right to notice of any action or to consent to, direct or object to any action hereunder or under any other Loan Document or otherwise in respect of the Collateral (including the release or impairment of any Collateral) other than in its capacity as a Lender and, in such case, only to the extent expressly provided in the Loan Documents.

(b) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article IX to the contrary, the Administrative Agent shall not be required to verify the payment of, or that other satisfactory arrangements have been made with respect to, Obligations arising under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements unless the Administrative Agent has received written notice of such Obligations, together with such supporting documentation as the Administrative Agent may request, from the applicable Cash Management Bank or Hedge Bank, as the case may be.

Section 9.16 Appointment of Supplemental Agents .

(a) It is the purpose of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents that there shall be no violation of any Law of any jurisdiction denying or restricting the right of banking corporations or associations to transact business as agent or trustee in such jurisdiction. It is recognized that in case of litigation under this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents, and in particular in case of the enforcement of any of the Loan Documents, or in case the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent deems that by reason of any present or future Law of any jurisdiction it may not exercise any of the rights, powers or remedies granted herein or in any of the other Loan Documents or take any other action that may be desirable or necessary in connection therewith, the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent are hereby authorized to appoint an additional individual or institution selected by them in their sole discretion as a separate trustee, co-trustee, administrative agent, collateral agent, administrative sub-agent or administrative co-agent, as applicable (any such additional individual or institution being referred to herein individually as a “ Supplemental Agent ” and collectively as “ Supplemental Agents ”).

(b) In the event that the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent appoints a Supplemental Agent with respect to any Collateral, (i) each and every right, power, privilege or duty expressed or intended by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents to be exercised by or vested in or conveyed to the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent with respect to such Collateral shall be exercisable by and vest in such Supplemental Agent to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to enable such Supplemental Agent to exercise such rights, powers and privileges with respect to such Collateral and to perform such duties with respect to such Collateral, and every covenant and obligation contained in the Loan Documents and necessary to the exercise or performance thereof by such Supplemental Agent shall run to and be enforceable by either the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent or such Supplemental Agent, and (ii) the provisions of this Article IX and of Sections 10.04 and 10.05 (obligating the Borrowers to pay the Administrative Agent’s and the Collateral Agent’s expenses and to indemnify the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent) that refer to the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent shall inure to the benefit of such Supplemental Agent and all references therein to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent shall be deemed to be references to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent and/or such Supplemental Agent, as the context may require.

 

-175-


(c) Should any instrument in writing from a Borrower, Holdings or any other Loan Party be required by any Supplemental Agent so appointed by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent for more fully and certainly vesting in and confirming to him or it such rights, powers, privileges and duties, the Borrowers or Holdings, as applicable, shall, or shall cause such Loan Party to, execute, acknowledge and deliver any and all such instruments promptly upon request by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent. In case any Supplemental Agent, or a successor thereto, shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all the rights, powers, privileges and duties of such Supplemental Agent, to the extent permitted by Law, shall vest in and be exercised by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent, as applicable, until the appointment of a new Supplemental Agent.

Section 9.17 Intercreditor Agreement . The Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent are authorized by the Lenders and other Secured Parties to, to the extent required by the terms of the Loan Documents, enter into (i) the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement, (ii) any Collateral Document, (iii) or make or consent to any filings or take any other actions in connection therewith (and any amendments, amendments and restatements, restatements or waivers of or supplements to or other modifications to, such agreements in connection with the incurrence by any Loan Party of any Indebtedness of such Loan Party that is permitted to be secured pursuant to Sections  7.01 and 7.03 of this Agreement, in order to permit such Indebtedness to be secured by a valid, perfected lien on the Collateral (with such priority as may be designated by such Loan Party, to the extent such priority is permitted by the Loan Documents)), and the parties hereto acknowledge that any intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement, Collateral Document, consent, filing or other action will be binding upon them. Each Lender and each other Secured Party (a) understands, acknowledges and agrees that Liens will be created on the Collateral pursuant to the Second Lien Facility Documentation, which Liens shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Intercreditor Agreement hereby agrees that it will be bound by and will take no actions contrary to the provisions of any intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement (if entered into) and (b) hereby authorizes and instructs the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent to enter into the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement or Collateral Document (and any amendments, amendments and restatements, restatements or waivers of or supplements to or other modifications to, such agreements in connection with the incurrence by any Loan Party of any Indebtedness of such Loan Party that is permitted to be secured pursuant to Sections  7.01 and 7.03 of this Agreement, in order to permit such Indebtedness to be secured by a valid, perfected lien on the Collateral (with such priority as may be designated by such Loan Party, to the extent such priority is permitted by the Loan Documents)), and to subject the Liens on the Collateral securing the Obligations to the provisions thereof.

Section 9.18 Withholding Tax . To the extent required by any applicable Laws, the Administrative Agent may withhold from any payment to any Lender an amount equivalent to any withholding tax applicable to such payment. If the IRS or any other Governmental Authority asserts a claim that the Administrative Agent did not properly withhold tax from amounts paid to or for the account of any Lender for any reason, or the Administrative Agent has paid over to the IRS or other Governmental Authority applicable withholding tax relating to a payment to a Lender but no deduction has been made from such payment, such Lender shall indemnify the Administrative Agent fully for all amounts paid, directly or indirectly, by the Administrative Agent as Tax or otherwise, including any penalties, additions to tax or interest and together with any and all expenses incurred, unless such amounts have been indemnified by the Borrowers or other Loan Party. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to any Lender by the Administrative Agent shall be conclusive absent manifest error. Each Lender hereby authorizes the Administrative Agent to set off and apply any and all amounts at any time owing to such Lender under this Agreement or any other Loan Document against any amount due the Administrative Agent under this Section  9.18 . The agreements in this Section  9.18 shall survive the resignation and/or replacement of the Administrative Agent, any assignment of rights by, or the replacement of, a Lender, the termination of the Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all other Obligations.

 

-176-


Section 9.19 Appointment of Incremental Arrangers and Specified Refinancing Agents . In the event that the Borrowers appoint or designate any Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent pursuant to Section  2.14 or Section 2.18 , as applicable, (i) each and every right, power, privilege or duty expressed or intended by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents to be exercised by or vested in or conveyed to an agent or arranger with respect to the establishment of New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing Debt, as applicable shall be exercisable by and vest in such Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to enable such Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent to establish the New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing Debt, as applicable, and to perform such duties with respect to such New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing debt, and every covenant and obligation contained in the Loan Documents and necessary to the establishment thereof by such Incremental Arranger shall run to and be enforceable by either the Administrative Agent , such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent and (ii) the provisions of this Article IX and of Sections 10.04 and 10.05 (obligating the Borrowers to pay the Administrative Agent’s and the Collateral Agent’s expenses and to indemnify the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent) that refer to the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent shall also inure to the benefit of such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent and all references therein to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent shall be deemed to be references to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent and/or such Incremental Arranger and/or such Specified Refinancing Agent, as the context may require. Each Lender and L/C Issuer hereby irrevocably appoints any Incremental Arranger and/or such Specified Refinancing Agent to act on its behalf hereunder pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.18 and designates and authorizes such Incremental Arranger to take such actions on its behalf under the provisions of this Agreement and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent by the terms of this Agreement, together with such actions and powers as are reasonably incidental thereto.

ARTICLE X

Miscellaneous

Section 10.01 Amendments, Etc . Except as otherwise expressly set forth in this Agreement, no amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, and no consent to any departure by the Borrowers or any other Loan Party therefrom, shall be effective unless in writing signed by the Required Lenders and the Borrowers or the applicable Loan Party, as the case may be, and acknowledged by the Administrative Agent to the extent the Administrative Agent is not a Defaulting Lender (other than with respect to any amendment or waiver contemplated in clause (h) below, which shall only require the consent of the Required Revolving Lenders), and each such amendment, waiver or consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the specific purpose for which given; provided , however , that no such amendment, waiver or consent shall:

(a) extend or increase the Commitment of any Lender, or reinstate the Commitment of any Lender after the termination of such Commitment pursuant to Section  8.02 , in each case without the written consent of such Lender (it being understood that a waiver of any condition precedent set forth in Section  4.02 or the waiver of (or amendment to the terms of) any Default or Event of Default, mandatory prepayment or mandatory reduction of the Commitments shall not constitute an extension or increase of any Commitment of any Lender);

 

-177-


(b) postpone any date scheduled for, or reduce the amount of, any payment of principal of, or interest on, any Loan or L/C Borrowing or any fees or other amounts payable hereunder, without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby (and subject to such further requirements as may be applicable thereto under the last paragraph of this Section  10.01 ), it being understood that the waiver of any obligation to pay interest at the Default Rate, the amendment or waiver and any mandatory prepayment of Loans under the Term Facilities shall not constitute a postponement of any date scheduled for the payment of principal, interest or fees;

(c) reduce the principal of, or the rate of interest specified herein on, any Loan or L/C Borrowing (it being understood that a waiver of any Default or Event of Default or mandatory prepayment shall not constitute a reduction or forgiveness of principal), or (subject to clause (iii) of the proviso following clause (i) below) any fees or other amounts payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby, it being understood that any change to the definitions of First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, Total Net Leverage Ratio or, in each case, in the component definitions thereof shall not constitute a reduction in any rate of interest or any fees based thereon; provided , however , that only the consent of the Required Lenders shall be necessary to amend the definition of “Default Rate” or to waive any obligation of the Borrowers to pay interest at the Default Rate;

(d) modify Section  2.06(c) , 2.13 or 8.04 without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby;

(e) change (i) any provision of this Section  10.01 (other than the last paragraph of this Section  10.01 ), or the definition of “Required Lenders”, or any other provision hereof specifying the number or percentage of Lenders or portion of the Loans or Commitments required to amend, waive or otherwise modify any rights hereunder or make any determination or grant any consent hereunder (other than the definition specified in clause (ii) of this Section  10.01(e) and other than modifications in connection with repurchases of Term Loans, amendments with respect to New Loan Commitments and amendments with respect to extensions of maturity), without the written consent of each Lender, or (ii) the definition of “Required Revolving Lenders,” without the written consent of each Lender under the Revolving Credit Facility;

(f) other than in a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05 , release all or substantially all of the Collateral in any transaction or series of related transactions, without the written consent of each Lender;

(g) other than in a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05 , release all or substantially all of the aggregate value of the Guaranty, or all or substantially all of the Guarantors, without the written consent of each Lender;

(h) (i) amend or otherwise modify Section  7.10 (or for the purposes of determining compliance with the Financial Covenant, any defined terms used therein) or Section  4.02 with respect to the Revolving Credit Facility, (ii) waive or consent to any Default or Event of Default resulting from a breach of the Financial Covenant, (iii) alter the rights or remedies of the Required Revolving Lenders arising pursuant to Article VIII or (iv) increase, reduce or otherwise modify the Designated Foreign Currency Sublimit, in each case, without the written consent of the Required Revolving Lenders; provided , however , that the amendments, modifications, waivers and consents described in this clause (h) shall not require the consent of any Lenders other than the Required Revolving Lenders; or

 

-178-


(i) change the currency in which any Loan or Commitment is denominated or required to be made without the written consent of the Lender holding such Loans or Commitment, as applicable;

provided , further , that (i) no amendment, waiver or consent shall, unless in writing and signed by an L/C Issuer in addition to the Borrowers and the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of such L/C Issuer, in its capacity as such, under this Agreement or any Letter of Credit Application relating to any Letter of Credit issued or to be issued by it; (ii) no amendment, waiver or consent shall, unless in writing and signed by the Swing Line Lender in addition to the Borrowers and the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of the Swing Line Lender, in its capacity as such, under this Agreement; (iii) unless in writing and signed by the Administrative Agent, in its capacity as such, in addition to the Borrowers and the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; (iv)  Section  10.07(g) may not be amended, waived or otherwise modified without the consent of each Granting Lender all or any part of whose Loans are being funded by an SPC at the time of such amendment, waiver or other modification; and (v) the Fee Letter may be amended, or rights or privileges thereunder waived, in a writing executed only by the parties thereto. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any amendment, modification, waiver or other action which by its terms requires the consent of all Lenders or each affected Lender may be effected with the consent of the applicable Lenders other than Defaulting Lenders or Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates), except that (x) no amendment, waiver or consent relating to Section  10.01(a) , (b) or (c)  may be effected, in each case without the consent of such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender and (y) any amendment, modification, waiver or other action that by its terms adversely affects any Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender in its capacity as a Lender in a manner that differs in any material respect from, and is more adverse to such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender than it is to, other affected Lenders shall require the consent of such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any waiver, amendment, modification or consent in respect of this Agreement or any other Loan Document that by its terms affects the rights or duties under this Agreement or any other Loan Document of Lenders holding Loans or Commitments of a particular Tranche (but not the Lenders holding Loans or Commitments of any other Tranche) may be effected by an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by the Borrowers and the requisite percentage in interest of the Lenders with respect to such Tranche that would be required to consent thereto under this Section  10.01 if such Lenders were the only Lenders hereunder at the time.

Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement or the other Loan Documents to the contrary, each Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate) hereby agrees that, if a proceeding under the United States Bankruptcy Code or any other Federal, state or foreign bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or similar law shall be commenced by or against the Borrowers or any other Loan Party at a time when such Lender is an Affiliate Lender, such Affiliate Lender irrevocably authorizes and empowers the Administrative Agent to vote on behalf of such Affiliate Lender with respect to the Loans held by such Affiliate Lender in any manner in the Administrative Agent’s sole discretion, unless the Administrative Agent instructs such Affiliate Lender to vote, in which case such Affiliate Lender shall vote with respect to the Loans held by it as the Administrative Agent directs; provided that such Affiliate Lender shall be entitled to vote in accordance with its sole discretion (and not in accordance with the direction of the Administrative Agent) in connection with any plan of reorganization to the extent any such plan of reorganization proposes to treat any such Affiliate Lender or the Obligations held by it in a manner that is less favorable in any material respect to such Affiliate Lender than the proposed treatment of similar Lenders and the Obligations held by them that are not Affiliates of a Borrower.

 

-179-


This Section  10.01 shall be subject to any contrary provision of Sections 2.14 or 2.18 ; provided that in no event shall any amendment pursuant to Section  2.14 or 2.18 affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent, the Swing Line Lender or an L/C Issuer without the written consent of the Administrative Agent, the Swing Line Lender or such L/C Issuer, as the case may be. In addition, notwithstanding anything else to the contrary contained in this Section  10.01 , (a) if the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall have jointly identified an obvious error or any error or omission of a technical nature, in each case, in any provision of the Loan Documents, then the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend such provision without any further action or consent of any other party if the same is not objected to in writing by the Required Lenders to the Administrative Agent within 5 Business Days following receipt of notice thereof, (b) the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend any provision of any Collateral Document or the Guaranty, or enter into any new agreement or instrument, to better implement the intentions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents or as required by local law to give effect to any guaranty, or to give effect to or to protect any security interest for the benefit of the Secured Parties, in any property so that the security interests comply with applicable Law, (c) the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend the schedules to this Agreement and any Collateral Document prior to the Closing Date and (d) to the extent the Borrowers elect to change accounting standards from GAAP to IFRS, the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend the Loan Documents to effectuate such changes, and in each case, such amendments, documents and agreements shall become effective without any further action or consent of any other party to any Loan Document and if, in the case of amendments contemplated by clause (a), the same is not objected to in writing by the Required Lenders within 5 Business Days following receipt of notice thereof.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, in connection with any amendment, modification, waiver or other action requiring the consent or approval of Required Lenders, Lenders that are Debt Fund Affiliates shall not be permitted, in the aggregate, to account for more than 49.9% of the amounts actually included in determining whether the threshold in the definition of “ Required Lenders ” has been satisfied. The voting power of each Lender that is a Debt Fund Affiliate shall be reduced, pro rata, to the extent necessary in order to comply with the immediately preceding sentence.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, at any time and from time to time, upon notice to the Administrative Agent (who shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders) specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof, the Borrowers may make one or more loan modification offers to all the Lenders of any Facility that would, if and to the extent accepted by any such Lender, (a) extend the scheduled Maturity Date and any amortization of the Loans and Commitments under such Facility and/or change the Applicable Rate and/or fees payable with respect to the Loans and Commitments under such Facility (in each case solely with respect to the Loans and Commitments of accepting Lenders in respect of which an acceptance is delivered) and (b) treat the Loans and Commitments so modified as a new “Facility” for all purposes under this Agreement; provided that (i) such loan modification offer is made to each Lender under the applicable Facility on the same terms and subject to the same procedures as are applicable to all other Lenders under such Facility (which procedures in any case shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent) and (ii) no loan modification shall affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent, the Swing Line Lender or any L/C Issuer, without its prior written consent.

In connection with any such loan modification offer, the Borrowers and each accepting Lender shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent such agreements and other documentation as the Administrative Agent shall reasonably specify to evidence the acceptance of the applicable loan modification offer and the terms and conditions thereof, and this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall be amended in a writing (which may be executed and delivered by the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent and shall be effective only with respect to the applicable Loans and Commitments of Lenders that shall have accepted the relevant loan modification offer (and only with respect to Loans and Commitments as to which any such Lender has accepted the loan modification offer)) to the extent necessary or appropriate, in the judgment of the Administrative Agent, to reflect the

 

-180-


existence of, and to give effect to the terms and conditions of, the applicable loan modification (including the addition of such modified Loans and/or Commitments as a “Facility” hereunder). No Lender shall have any obligation whatsoever to accept any loan modification offer, and may reject any such offer in its sole discretion. On the effective date of any loan modification applicable to the Revolving Credit Facility, the Borrowers shall prepay any Revolving Credit Loans, L/C Advances or Swing Line Loans (to the extent participated to Revolving Credit Lenders) outstanding on such effective date (and pay any additional amounts required pursuant to Section  3.05 ) to the extent necessary to keep the outstanding Revolving Credit Loans, L/C Advances or Swing Line Loans (to the extent participated to Revolving Credit Lenders), as the case may be, ratable with any revised Pro Rata Share of a Revolving Credit Lender in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility arising from any non-ratable loan modification to the Revolving Credit Commitments under this Section  10.01 . Notwithstanding the foregoing, no modification referred to above shall become effective unless the Administrative Agent, to the extent reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, shall have received legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 with respect to Holdings, the Borrowers and each other Subsidiary Guarantor.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Section  10.01 , (i) the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent may, without the input or consent of the Lenders, effect amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents as may be necessary or appropriate in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to effect the provisions of Sections 2.14 or 2.18 ; (ii) the Fee Letter may be amended, or rights or privileges thereunder waived, in a writing executed only by the parties thereto; (iii) the Administrative Agent is hereby authorized by the Lenders to approve the forms of Collateral Documents as contemplated herein, and to enter into any Loan Documents in such forms as approved by it on or prior to the Closing Date (and thereafter as contemplated by the provisions of this Agreement); (iv) the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent may, without the input or consent of the Lenders, effect amendments to the Collateral Documents to effect such customary changes as may be requested by any Person acting as trustee or collateral trustee in respect of any Permitted Refinancing thereof in the form of debt securities and (v) guarantees, collateral security documents and related documents executed by any Person in connection with this Agreement may be in a form reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent and may be, together with this Agreement, amended, supplemented and waived with the consent of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, at the request of the Borrowers without the need to obtain the consent of any other Lender if such amendment, supplement or waiver is delivered in order (a) to comply with or reflect customary practices under local Law or advice of local counsel, (b) to cure ambiguities, omissions, mistakes or defects or (c) to cause such guarantee, collateral security document or other document to be consistent with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 10.02 Notices; Electronic Communications .

(a) General . Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, all notices and other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed by certified or registered mail or sent by telecopier as follows, and all notices and other communications expressly permitted hereunder to be given by telephone shall be made to the applicable telephone number, as follows:

(i) if to Holdings, the Borrowers, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, an L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender, to the address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified for such Person on Schedule 10.02 or to such other address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number as shall be designated by such party in a notice to the other parties hereto, as provided in Section  10.02(d) ; and

 

-181-


(ii) if to any other Lender, to the address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified in its Administrative Questionnaire.

Notices and other communications sent by hand or overnight courier service, or mailed by certified or registered mail, shall be deemed to have been given when received; notices and other communications sent by telecopier shall be deemed to have been given when sent (except that, if not given during normal business hours for the recipient, shall be deemed to have been given at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient). Notices and other communications delivered through electronic communications to the extent provided in clause (b) below shall be effective as provided in such clause (b).

(b) Electronic Communications . Notices and other communications to the Lenders and the L/C Issuers hereunder may be delivered or furnished by electronic communication (including e-mail and Internet or intranet websites) pursuant to procedures approved by the Administrative Agent; provided that the foregoing shall not apply to notices to any Lender or any L/C Issuer pursuant to Article  II if such Lender or such L/C Issuer, as applicable, has notified the Administrative Agent that it is incapable of receiving, or is unwilling to receive, notices under Article  II by electronic communication. The Administrative Agent or the Borrowers may, in its discretion, agree to accept notices and other communications to it hereunder by electronic communications pursuant to procedures approved by it; provided that approval of such procedures may be limited to particular notices or communications.

Unless the Administrative Agent otherwise prescribes (with the Borrowers’ consent), (i) notices and other communications sent to an e-mail address shall be deemed received upon the sender’s receipt of an acknowledgment from the intended recipient (such as by the “return receipt requested” function, as available, return e-mail or other written acknowledgement); provided that if such notice or other communication is not sent during the normal business hours of the recipient, such notice or communication shall be deemed to have been sent at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient, and (ii) notices or communications posted to an Internet or intranet website shall be deemed received upon the deemed receipt by the intended recipient at its e-mail address as described in the foregoing clause (i) of notification that such notice or communication is available and identifying the website address therefor.

(c) The Platform . THE PLATFORM IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE.” THE AGENT-RELATED PERSONS DO NOT WARRANT THE ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE ADEQUACY OF THE PLATFORM, AND EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM LIABILITY FOR ERRORS IN OR OMISSIONS FROM THE BORROWER MATERIALS. NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR FREEDOM FROM VIRUSES OR OTHER CODE DEFECTS, IS MADE BY ANY AGENT-RELATED PERSON IN CONNECTION WITH THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE PLATFORM. In no event shall any Agent-Related Person have any liability to any Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries, any Lender, any L/C Issuer or any other Person for losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses of any kind (whether in tort, contract or otherwise) arising out of the Borrowers’ or the Administrative Agent’s transmission of Borrower Materials through the Internet, except to the extent that such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction by a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Agent-Related Person; provided , however , that in no event shall any Agent-Related Person have any liability to any Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries, any Lender, any L/C Issuer or any other Person for indirect, special, incidental, consequential or punitive damages (as opposed to direct or actual damages).

 

-182-


(d) Change of Address, Etc . Each of Holdings, the Borrowers, the Guarantors, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender may change its address, telecopier, telephone number or electronic mail address for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the other parties hereto. Each other Lender may change its address, telecopier, telephone number or electronic mail address for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the Borrower Representative, the Administrative Agent, each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender. In addition, each Lender agrees to notify the Administrative Agent from time to time to ensure that the Administrative Agent has on record (i) an effective address, contact name, telephone number, telecopier number and electronic mail address to which notices and other communications may be sent and (ii) accurate wire instructions for such Lender. Furthermore, each Public Lender agrees to cause at least one individual at or on behalf of such Public Lender to at all times have selected the “Private Side Information” or similar designation on the content declaration screen of the Platform in order to enable such Public Lender or its delegate, in accordance with such Public Lender’s compliance procedures and applicable Law, including United States federal and state securities Laws, to make reference to Borrower Materials that are not made available through the “Public Side Information” portion of the Platform and that may contain material non-public information with respect to the Borrowers or their securities for purposes of United States federal or state securities laws.

(e) Reliance by Administrative Agent, Collateral Agent, L/C Issuer and Lenders . The Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, the L/C Issuers and the Lenders shall be entitled to rely and act upon any notices (including telephonic Committed Loan Notices and Swing Line Loan Notices) purportedly given by or on behalf of a Borrower even if (i) such notices were not made in a manner specified herein, were incomplete or were not preceded or followed by any other form of notice specified herein, or (ii) the terms thereof, as understood by the recipient, varied from any confirmation thereof. The Borrowers shall indemnify the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, each L/C Issuer, each Lender and the Related Parties of each of them from all losses, costs, expenses and liabilities resulting from the reliance by such Person on each notice purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrowers to the extent required by Section  10.05 . All telephonic notices to and other telephonic communications with the Administrative Agent may be recorded by the Administrative Agent, and each of the parties hereto hereby consents to such recording.

Section 10.03 No Waiver ; Cumulative Remedies ; Enforcement .

(a) No failure by any Lender, any L/C Issuer, the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent to exercise, and no delay by any such Person in exercising, any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder or under any other Loan Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or privilege. The rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided hereunder and under each other Loan Document, are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided by Law.

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein or in any other Loan Document, the authority to enforce rights and remedies hereunder and under the other Loan Documents against the Loan Parties or any of them shall be vested exclusively in, and all actions and proceedings at law in connection with such enforcement shall be instituted and maintained exclusively by, the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent in accordance with Section  8.02 and the other Loan Documents for the benefit of all the Lenders and the L/C Issuers; provided , however , that the foregoing shall not prohibit (a) the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent from exercising on its own behalf the rights and remedies that inure to its benefit (solely in its capacity as Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent) hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, (b) each L/C Issuer or the Swing Line Lender from exercising the rights and remedies that inure to its benefit (solely in its capacity

 

-183-


as an L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be) hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, (c) any Lender from exercising setoff rights in accordance with Section  10.09 (subject to the terms of Section  2.13 ), or (d) any Lender from filing proofs of claim or appearing and filing pleadings on its own behalf during the pendency of a proceeding relative to any Loan Party under any Debtor Relief Law; provided , further , that if at any time there is no Person acting as Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, then (i) the Required Lenders shall have the rights otherwise ascribed to the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  8.02 and (ii) in addition to the matters set forth in clauses (b), (c) and (d) of the preceding proviso and subject to Section  2.13 , any Lender may, with the consent of the Required Lenders, enforce any rights and remedies available to it and as authorized by the Required Lenders. In the event of a foreclosure by the Collateral Agent on any of the Collateral pursuant to a public or private sale, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent or any Lender (or any person nominated by them) may be the purchaser of any or all of such Collateral at any such sale and the Administrative Agent, as agent for and representative of the Lenders (but not any Lender or Lenders in its or their respective individual capacities unless the Required Lenders shall otherwise agree in writing), shall be entitled, for the purpose of bidding and making settlement or payment of the purchase price for all or any portion of the Collateral sold in any such public sale, to use and apply any of the Obligations as a credit on account of the purchase price for any Collateral payable by the Administrative Agent at such sale.

Section 10.04 Expenses and Taxes . The Borrowers jointly and severally agree (a) if the Closing Date occurs, to pay or reimburse the Administrative Agent and the other Agents for all reasonable and out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred in connection with the preparation, negotiation, syndication and execution of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents (including reasonable expenses incurred in connection with due diligence and travel, courier, reproduction, printing and delivery expenses), and any amendment, waiver, consent or other modification of the provisions hereof and thereof (whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby are consummated), and the consummation and administration of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, including the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel (limited to the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of one primary counsel to the Agents and, if necessary, one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions) and special counsel for each relevant specialty, and (b) from and after the Closing Date, to pay or reimburse the Administrative Agent, the other Agents and each Lender for all reasonable documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred in connection with the enforcement of any rights or remedies under this Agreement or the other Loan Documents (including all such costs and expenses incurred during any legal proceeding, including, without duplication of Indemnified Taxes or Other Taxes paid or indemnified pursuant to Sections 3.01 and 3.03 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, not including any Taxes that are Excluded Taxes under this Agreement or under any other Loan Document), any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or in connection with any workout or restructuring and all documentary taxes associated with the Facilities), including the fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel (limited to the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of one counsel to the Administrative Agent, the other Agents and the Lenders taken as a whole, and, if necessary, of one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions) and of special counsel for each relevant specialty and, in the event of any actual or potential conflict of interest, one additional counsel in each relevant jurisdiction for each Lender or group of Lenders or Agents subject to such conflict), in each case without duplication for any amounts paid (or indemnified) under Section  3.01 . The foregoing costs and expenses shall include, without duplication of Indemnified Taxes or Other Taxes paid or indemnified pursuant to Sections 3.01 and 3.03 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, not including any Taxes that are Excluded Taxes under this Agreement or under any other Loan Document), all reasonable search, filing, recording, title insurance and appraisal charges and fees and taxes related thereto, and other out-of-pocket expenses incurred by any Agent. All amounts due under this Section  10.04 shall be paid within 30 days after invoiced or demand therefor (with a reasonably detailed invoice with respect thereto)

 

-184-


(except for any such costs and expenses incurred prior to the Closing Date, which shall be paid on the Closing Date to the extent invoiced at least 3 Business Days prior to the Closing Date). The agreements in this Section  10.04 shall survive the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and repayment of all other Obligations. If any Loan Party fails to pay when due any costs, expenses or other amounts payable by it hereunder or under any Loan Document, such amount may be paid on behalf of such Loan Party by the Administrative Agent after any applicable grace periods have expired, in its sole discretion and the Borrowers shall immediately reimburse the Administrative Agent, as applicable.

Section 10.05 Indemnification by the Borrower s. The Borrowers shall indemnify and hold harmless each Arranger, each Agent-Related Person, each Lender, each L/C Issuer, each of their respective Affiliates and each partner, controlling person, director, officer, employee, counsel, agent and representative of the foregoing and, in the case of any funds, trustees and advisors and attorneys-in-fact (collectively, the “ Indemnitees ”) from and against (and will reimburse each Indemnitee, as and when incurred, for) any and all liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, claims, demands, actions, judgments, suits, costs (including settlement costs), disbursements, and reasonable and documented or invoiced out-of-pocket fees and expenses (including the fees, disbursements and other charges of (i) one counsel to the Indemnitees taken as a whole, (ii) in the case of an actual or perceived conflict of interest, where the Indemnitee affected by such conflict informs the Borrower Representative of such conflict and thereafter retains its own counsel, of another firm of counsel for each such affected Indemnitee in each relevant jurisdiction material to the interests of the Indemnitees, and (iii) if necessary, one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions and, solely in the event of an actual or perceived conflict of interest, one additional counsel in each applicable jurisdiction material to the interests of the affected Persons (or each group of affected Persons) taken as a whole) and special counsel for each relevant specialty) of any kind or nature whatsoever which may at any time be imposed on, incurred by or asserted or awarded against any such Indemnitee in any way relating to or arising out of or in connection with or by reason of (x) any actual or prospective claim, litigation, investigation or proceeding in any way relating to, arising out of, in connection with or by reason of any of the following, whether based on contract, tort or any other theory (including any investigation of, preparation for, or defense of any pending or threatened claim, investigation, litigation or proceeding): (a) the execution, delivery, enforcement, performance or administration of any Loan Document or any other agreement, letter or instrument delivered in connection with the transactions contemplated thereby or the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby or (b) any Commitment, Loan or Letter of Credit or the use or proposed use of the proceeds therefrom (including any refusal by any L/C Issuer to honor a demand for payment under a Letter of Credit if the documents presented in connection with such demand do not strictly comply with the terms of such Letter of Credit); provided that such indemnity shall not, as to any Indemnitee, be available to the extent that such liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, claims, demands, actions, judgments, suits, costs, disbursements, fees or expenses are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from (A) the bad faith, gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee or any of its Affiliates or controlling persons or any of the officers, directors, employees, agents, advisors, or members of any of the foregoing or (B) any dispute that is among Indemnitees (other than any dispute involving claims against the Administrative Agent, any Arranger or any other Agent, the Swing Line Lender or any L/C Issuer, in each case in their respective capacities as such, or any Initial Lender solely in connection with its syndication activities as contemplated under the Commitment Letter) that a court of competent jurisdiction has determined in a final and non-appealable judgment did not involve actions or omissions of any direct or indirect parent or controlling person of a Borrower or its Subsidiaries; or (y) any actual or alleged presence or release of Hazardous Materials on or from any property currently or formerly owned or operated by Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Environmental Liability related in any way to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, ((x) and (y), collectively, the “ Indemnified Liabilities ”) in all cases, whether or not caused by or arising, in whole or in part, out of the negligence of the Indemnitee and regardless of whether such Indemnitee is a party thereto,

 

-185-


and whether or not such proceedings are brought by a Borrower, its equity holders, its Affiliates, creditors or any other third person. No Indemnitee shall be liable for any damages arising from the use by others of any information or other materials obtained through the Platform or other information transmission systems (including electronic telecommunications) in connection with this Agreement unless determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee, nor shall any Indemnitee or any Loan Party have any liability for any special, punitive, indirect or consequential damages relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document or arising out of its activities in connection herewith or therewith (whether before or after the Closing Date); provided that such waiver of special, punitive, indirect or consequential damages shall not limit the indemnification obligations of the Loan Parties under this Section  10.05 . In the case of an investigation, litigation or other proceeding to which the indemnity in this Section  10.05 applies, such indemnity shall be effective whether or not such investigation, litigation or proceeding is brought by any Loan Party, its directors, shareholders or creditors or an Indemnitee or any other Person, and whether or not any Indemnitee is otherwise a party thereto. Should any investigation, litigation or proceeding be settled, or if there is a judgment against an Indemnitee in any such investigation, litigation or proceeding, the Borrowers shall indemnify and hold harmless each Indemnitee in the manner set forth above; provided that the Borrowers shall not be liable for any settlement effected without the Borrowers’ prior written consent (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned). All amounts due under this Section  10.05 shall be payable within 30 days after demand therefor. The agreements in this Section  10.05 shall survive the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent, the replacement of any Lender, the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all the other Obligations. This Section  10.05 shall not apply to any claims with respect to Taxes (other than any Taxes imposed on payments received pursuant to this Section  10.05 ).

Section 10.06 Payments Set Aside . To the extent that any payment by or on behalf of the Borrowers is made to any Agent, to any L/C Issuer or any Lender, or any Agent, any L/C Issuer or any Lender exercises its right of setoff, and such payment or the proceeds of such setoff or any part thereof is subsequently invalidated, declared to be fraudulent or preferential, set aside or required (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by such Agent, such L/C Issuer or such Lender in its discretion) to be repaid to a trustee, receiver or any other party, in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or otherwise, then (a) to the extent of such recovery, the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall be revived and continued in full force and effect as if such payment had not been made or such setoff had not occurred, and (b) each Lender and each L/C Issuer severally agrees to pay to the Administrative Agent upon demand its applicable share (without duplication) of any amount so recovered from or repaid by any Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such payment is made at a rate per annum equal to the relevant Eurocurrency Rate from time to time in effect in the applicable currency of such recovery or payment. The obligations of the Lenders and the L/C Issuers under clause (b) of the preceding sentence shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

Section 10.07 Successors and Assigns .

(a) The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, except that the Borrowers may not assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder without the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent and each Lender (and any other attempted assignment or transfer by any party hereto shall be null and void) and no Lender may assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder except (i) to an Eligible Assignee (other than to any Disqualified Institution, to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available (and is permitted to be shared) as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions) in accordance with the provisions of Section

 

-186-


10.07(b) , (ii) by way of participation in accordance with the provisions of Section  10.07(d) , (iii) by way of pledge or assignment of a security interest subject to the restrictions of Section  10.07(f) or (iv) to an SPC in accordance with the provisions of Section  10.07(g) . Nothing in this Agreement, expressed or implied, shall be construed to confer upon any Person (other than the parties hereto, their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, Participants to the extent provided in Section  10.07(d) and, to the extent expressly contemplated hereby, the Indemnitees) any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or by reason of this Agreement.

(b) Any Lender may at any time assign to one or more assignees all or a portion of its rights and obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment(s) and the Loans (including for purposes of this Section  10.07(b) , participations in L/C Obligations and in Swing Line Loans) at the time owing to it); provided that:

(i) (A) in the case of an assignment of the entire remaining amount of the assigning Lender’s Commitment under any Facility and the Loans at the time owing to it under such Facility, no minimum amount shall need be assigned, and (B) in any case not described in clause (b)(i)(A) of this Section  10.07 , the aggregate amount of the Commitment (which for this purpose includes Loans outstanding thereunder) or, if the applicable Commitment is not then in effect, the outstanding principal balance of the Loans of the assigning Lender subject to each such assignment, determined as of the date the Assignment and Assumption with respect to such assignment is delivered to the Administrative Agent or, if “Trade Date” is specified in the Assignment and Assumption, as of the Trade Date, shall not be less than the applicable Threshold Amount (or such lesser amount as is acceptable to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers), in each case unless each of the Administrative Agent and, so long as no Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  has occurred and is continuing, the Borrowers otherwise consent (each such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed; provided , however , that concurrent assignments to members of an Assignee Group and concurrent assignments from members of an Assignee Group to a single Eligible Assignee (or to an Eligible Assignee and members of its Assignee Group)) will be treated as a single assignment for purposes of determining whether such minimum amount has been met;

(ii) each partial assignment shall be made as an assignment of a proportionate part of all the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement with respect to the Loans or the Commitment assigned, except that this clause (ii) shall not (x) apply to the Swing Line Lender’s rights and obligations in respect of Swing Line Loans or (y) prohibit any Lender from assigning all or a portion of its rights and obligations among separate Facilities on a non-pro rata basis;

(iii) no consent shall be required for any assignment except to the extent required by clause (b)(i)(B) of this Section  10.07 and, in addition (A) the consent of the Borrowers (from and after the Closing Date, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) shall be required for any assignment unless (1) an Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  has occurred and is continuing at the time of such assignment, (2) such assignment is in respect of a Term Facility and is to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund (other than any Disqualified Institution) or (3) such assignment is in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and is to a Revolving Credit Lender, an Affiliate of a Revolving Credit Lender or an Approved Fund related thereto (other than any Disqualified Institution); provided that (1) the Borrowers shall be deemed to have consented to any assignment unless they object thereto by written notice to the Administrative Agent within ten Business Days after having received notice thereof and (2) during the forty-five (45) day period (or such longer period reasonably acceptable to the Arrangers and the Borrowers) following the Closing Date, the Borrowers shall be deemed

 

-187-


to have consented to an assignment to any Lender if such Lender was previously identified and approved in the initial allocations of the Loans provided by the Arrangers to the Borrowers, (B) the consent of the Administrative Agent (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) shall be required for any assignment unless (1) such assignment is in respect of a Term Facility and to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund or (2) such assignment is in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and is to a Revolving Credit Lender, an Affiliate of a Revolving Credit Lender or an Approved Fund related thereto (other than any Disqualified Institution) and (C) the consent of each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender (each such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) shall be required for any assignment in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility; provided , however , that the consent of each L/C Issuer and the Swing Line Lender shall not be required for any assignment of a Term Loan;

(iv) the parties to each assignment shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent an Assignment and Assumption manually, together with a processing and recordation fee of $3,500 (except, (x) in the case of assignments by any of the Initial Lenders or any of their Affiliates, only a single processing and recording fee shall be payable for assignments as a part of the primary syndication of the Initial Term Loans and (y) the Administrative Agent, in its sole discretion, may elect to waive such processing and recording fee in the case of any assignment). Each Eligible Assignee that is not an existing Lender shall deliver to the Administrative Agent an Administrative Questionnaire;

(v) no such assignment shall be made (A) to any Defaulting Lender or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Person who, upon becoming a Lender hereunder, would constitute any of the foregoing Persons described in this clause (A), (B) to any natural person, (C) to any Disqualified Institution (to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available (and is permitted to be shared) as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions), (D) to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries except as permitted under clause (j) below or (E) to any Affiliate Lender except as permitted under Section  10.07(i) ;

(vi) no Revolving Credit Commitments or Revolving Credit Loans may be assigned to any Affiliate Lender;

(vii) the assigning Lender shall deliver any Notes or, in lieu thereof, a lost note affidavit and indemnity reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers evidencing such Loans to the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent;

(viii) in connection with any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder, no such assignment shall be effective unless and until, in addition to the other conditions thereto set forth herein, the parties to the assignment shall make such additional payments to the Administrative Agent in an aggregate amount sufficient, upon distribution thereof as appropriate (which may be outright payment, purchases by the assignee of participations or subparticipations, or other compensating actions, including funding, with the consent of the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent, the applicable Pro Rata Share of Loans previously requested but not funded by the Defaulting Lender, to each of which the applicable assignee and assignor hereby irrevocably consent), to (x) pay and satisfy in full all payment liabilities then owed by such Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent or any Lender hereunder (and interest accrued thereon) and (y) acquire (and fund as appropriate) its full Pro Rata Share of all Loans and participations in Letters of Credit and Swing Line Loans in accordance with its Pro Rata Share; provided that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder shall become effective under applicable Law without compliance with the provisions of this paragraph, then the assignee of such interest shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender for all purposes of this Agreement until such compliance occurs.

 

-188-


Subject to acceptance and recording thereof by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  10.07(c) , from and after the effective date specified in each Assignment and Assumption, the Eligible Assignee thereunder shall be a party to this Agreement and, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, have the rights and obligations of a Lender under this Agreement, and the assigning Lender thereunder shall, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, be released from its obligations under this Agreement (and, in the case of an Assignment and Assumption covering all of the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement, such Lender shall cease to be a party hereto but shall continue to be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 , 3.04 , 10.04 and 10.05 with respect to facts and circumstances occurring prior to the effective date of such assignment, and subject to the obligations set forth in Section  10.08 ). Upon request, and the surrender by the assigning Lender of its Note, the Borrowers (at their expense) shall execute and deliver a Note to the assignee Lender. Any assignment or transfer by a Lender of rights or obligations under this Agreement (other than any purported assignment or transfer to a Disqualified Institution) that does not comply with this clause (b) shall be treated for purposes of this Agreement as a sale by such Lender of a participation in such rights and obligations in accordance with Section  10.07(d) .

(c) The Administrative Agent, acting solely for this purpose as an agent of the Borrowers (and such agency being solely for tax purposes), shall maintain at the Administrative Agent’s Office a copy of each Assignment and Assumption delivered to it and a register for the recordation of the names and addresses of the Lenders, and the Commitments of, and principal amounts (and related interest amounts) of the Loans, L/C Obligations (specifying the Unreimbursed Amounts), L/C Borrowings and amounts due under Section  2.03 , owing to, each Lender pursuant to the terms hereof from time to time (the “ Register ”). Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Documents, the entries in the Register shall be conclusive, absent manifest error, and the Borrowers, the Agents and the Lenders shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Register pursuant to the terms hereof as a Lender hereunder for all purposes of this Agreement, notwithstanding notice to the contrary. In addition, the Administrative Agent shall maintain on the Register information regarding the designation, and revocation of designation, of any Lender as Defaulting Lender. The Register shall be available for inspection by the Borrowers, any Agent and any Lender (with respect to itself), at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice. This Section  10.07(c) and Section  2.11 shall be construed so that all Loans are at all times maintained in “registered form” within the meaning of Sections 163(f), 871(h)(2) and 881(c)(2) of the Code and any related Treasury regulations (or any other relevant or successor provisions of the Code or of such Treasury regulations). Upon receipt of a duly completed Assignment and Assumption executed by the assigning Lender and the assignee Lender, the processing fee referred to in clause (b)(iv) of this Section  10.07 , if applicable, and any written consent to such assignment required by clause (b) of this Section  10.07 , the Administrative Agent shall accept such Assignment and Assumption and record the information contained therein in the Register. No assignment shall be effective for purposes of this Section  10.07 unless it has been recorded in the Register as provided in this Section  10.07(c).

(d) Any Lender may at any time, without the consent of, or notice to, the Borrowers, the Administrative Agent, the L/C Issuers or Swing Line Lender, sell participations to any Person (other than a natural person, an Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate), a Person that the Administrative Agent has identified in a notice to the Lenders as a Defaulting Lender or a Disqualified Institution (to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to all Lenders as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions) (each, a “ Participant ”) in all or a portion of such Lender’s rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment and/or the Loans (including such Lender’s participations in L/C Obligations and/or Swing Line Loans) owing to it);

 

-189-


provided that (i) such Lender’s obligations under this Agreement shall remain unchanged, (ii) such Lender shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the performance of such obligations and (iii) the Borrowers, the Agents and the other Lenders shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Lender in connection with such Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement. Any agreement or instrument pursuant to which a Lender sells such a participation shall provide that such Lender shall retain the sole right to enforce this Agreement and the other Loan Documents and to approve any amendment, modification or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document; provided that such agreement or instrument may provide that such Lender will not, without the consent of the Participant, agree to any amendment, waiver or other modification described in the first proviso to Section  10.01 that directly affects such Participant. Subject to Section  10.07(e) , the Borrowers agree that each Participant shall be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 and 3.04 (subject to the requirements and the limitations of such Sections and Section  3.07 ) to the same extent as if it were a Lender and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to Section  10.07(b) . To the extent permitted by law, each Participant also shall be entitled to the benefits of Section  10.09 as though it were a Lender; provided , such Participant agrees to be subject to Section  2.13 as though it were a Lender.

(e) A Participant shall not be entitled to receive any greater payment under Section  3.01 , 3.03 or 3.04 than the applicable Lender would have been entitled to receive with respect to the participation sold to such Participant, except to the extent that a Participant’s right to a greater payment results from a change in any Law after the Participant becomes a Participant.

(f) Any Lender may at any time pledge or assign a security interest in all or any portion of its rights under this Agreement (including under its Note, if any) (other than to a Disqualified Institution or a natural person) to secure obligations of such Lender, including any pledge or assignment to secure obligations to a Federal Reserve Bank or any central bank having jurisdiction over such Lender; provided that no such pledge or assignment, and no foreclosure or other enforcement action in respect thereof, shall release such Lender from any of its obligations hereunder or substitute any such pledgee or assignee for such Lender as a party hereto.

(g) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender (a “ Granting Lender ”) may grant to a special purpose funding vehicle identified as such in writing from time to time by the Granting Lender to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers (an “ SPC ”) the option to provide all or any part of any Loan that such Granting Lender would otherwise be obligated to make pursuant to this Agreement; provided that (i) nothing herein shall constitute a commitment by any SPC to fund any Loan, and (ii) if an SPC elects not to exercise such option or otherwise fails to make all or any part of such Loan, the Granting Lender shall be obligated to make such Loan pursuant to the terms hereof or, if it fails to do so, to make such payment to the Administrative Agent as is required under Section  2.12(b) . Each party hereto hereby agrees that an SPC shall be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 and 3.04 (subject to the requirements and the limitations of such Sections and Section  3.07 ); provided that neither the grant to any SPC nor the exercise by any SPC of such option shall increase the costs or expenses or otherwise increase or change the obligations of the Borrowers under this Agreement (including under Section  3.01 , 3.03 or 3.04 ), except to the extent that the SPC’s right to a greater payment results from a change in any Law after the grant to the SPC takes place. Each party hereto further agrees that (i) no SPC shall be liable for any indemnity or similar payment obligation under this Agreement for which a Lender would be liable, and (ii) the Granting Lender shall for all purposes, including the approval of any amendment, waiver or other modification of any provision of any Loan Document, remain the Lender of record hereunder. Other than as expressly provided in this Section  10.07(g) , (A) such Granting Lender’s obligations under this Agreement shall remain unchanged, (B) such Granting Lender shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the performance of such obligations and (C) the Borrowers, the Agents and the other Lenders shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Granting Lender in connection with such Granting Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement. The making of a

 

-190-


Loan by an SPC hereunder shall utilize the Commitment of the Granting Lender to the same extent, and as if, such Loan were made by such Granting Lender. In furtherance of the foregoing, each party hereto hereby agrees (which agreement shall survive the termination of this Agreement) that, prior to the date that is one year and one day after the payment in full of all outstanding commercial paper or other senior debt of any SPC, it will not, other than in respect of matters unrelated to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby, institute against, or join any other Person in instituting against, such SPC any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency, or liquidation proceeding under the laws of the United States or any State thereof. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, any SPC may (i) with notice to, but without prior consent of the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent and with the payment of a processing fee of $3,500 assign all or any portion of its rights hereunder with respect to any Loan to the Granting Lender and (ii) subject to Section  10.08 , disclose on a confidential basis any non-public information relating to its funding of Loans to any rating agency, commercial paper dealer or provider of any surety or Guarantee or credit or liquidity enhancement to such SPC.

(h) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender that is a Fund may create a security interest in all or any portion of the Loans owing to it and the Note, if any, held by it to the trustee for holders of obligations owed, or securities issued, by such Fund as security for such obligations or securities; provided that unless and until such trustee actually becomes a Lender in compliance with the other provisions of this Section  10.07 , (i) no such pledge shall release the pledging Lender from any of its obligations under the Loan Documents, and (ii) such trustee shall not be entitled to exercise any of the rights of a Lender under the Loan Documents even though such trustee may have acquired ownership rights with respect to the pledged interest through foreclosure or otherwise.

(i) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender may assign all or any portion of its Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Term Loans and New Term Loans hereunder to any Other Affiliate (including any Debt Fund Affiliate), but only if:

(i) the assigning Lender and Other Affiliate purchasing such Lender’s Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Term Loans or New Term Loans, as applicable, shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent an assignment agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit  E-2 hereto (an “ Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption ”) in lieu of an Assignment and Assumption;

(ii) after giving effect to such assignment, Other Affiliates (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not, in the aggregate, own or hold Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Term Loans and New Term Loans with an aggregate principal amount in excess of 25% of the principal amount of all Term Loans then outstanding (calculated as of the date of such purchase); and

(iii) such Other Affiliate (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall (A) at the time of such assignment affirm the No Undisclosed Information Statement and (B) all times thereafter be subject to the voting restrictions specified in Section  10.01 .

In connection with each assignment pursuant to this Section  10.07(i) , each Lender acknowledges and agrees that in connection therewith, if the representation set forth in the definition of “No Undisclosed Information Statement” cannot be made pursuant to clause (ii) thereof (1) the Other Affiliates may have, and later may come into possession of, information regarding the Borrowers, the Sponsor, their respective affiliates not known to such Lender and that may be material to a decision by such Lender to participate in such prepayment (including material non-public information) (“ Excluded Information ”), (2) such Lender, independently and, without reliance on the Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates, has made its own analysis and determination to participate in such prepayment notwithstanding such Lender’s lack of knowledge of the Excluded

 

-191-


Information and (3) none of the Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates shall have any liability to such Lender, and such Lender hereby waives and releases, to the extent permitted by law, any claims such Lender may have against Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates, under applicable laws or otherwise, with respect to the nondisclosure of the Excluded Information.

(j) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender may assign all or any portion of its Term Loans, Specified Refinancing Term Loans and New Term Loans hereunder to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, but only if:

(i) (A) such assignment is made pursuant to a Dutch Auction open to all Term Lenders, Specified Refinancing Term Loan lenders or New Term Loan lenders on a pro rata basis or (B) such assignment is made as an open market purchase;

(ii) Holdings or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall at the time of such assignment affirm the No Undisclosed Information Statement;

(iii) any such Term Loans shall be automatically and permanently cancelled immediately upon acquisition thereof by Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries; and

(iv) Holdings and its Subsidiaries do not use the proceeds of the Revolving Credit Facility (whether or not the Revolving Credit Facility has been increased pursuant to Section  2.14 or refinanced pursuant to Section  2.18 ) to acquire such Term Loans.

(k) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, (i) Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not have any right to attend (including by telephone) any meeting or discussions (or portion thereof) among the Administrative Agent or any other Lender to which representatives of the Borrowers are not then present, (ii) Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not have any right to receive any information or material prepared by the Administrative Agent or any other Lender or any communication by or among the Administrative Agent and one or more other Lenders, except to the extent such information or materials have been made available to the Borrowers or their representatives, (iii) no assignments in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility may be made to the Sponsor or any Affiliate of the Sponsor and (iv) neither the Sponsor nor any Affiliate of the Sponsor (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) may be entitled to receive advice of counsel to the Agents or other Lenders and none of them shall challenge any assertion of attorney-client privilege by any Agent or other Lender.

(l) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, Royal Bank may, (i) upon 30 days’ notice to the Borrower Representative and the Lenders, resign as L/C Issuer and/or (ii) upon 30 days’ notice to the Borrower Representative, resign as Swing Line Lender; provided that on or prior to the expiration of such 30-day period with respect to such resignation, the relevant L/C Issuer shall have identified a successor L/C Issuer willing to accept its appointment as successor L/C Issuer, and the effectiveness of such resignation shall be conditioned upon such successor assuming the rights and duties of the L/C Issuer. In the event of any such resignation as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, the Borrowers shall be entitled to appoint from among the Lenders a successor L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender hereunder; provided , however , that no failure by the Borrowers to appoint any such successor shall affect the resignation of Royal Bank as L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be. If Royal Bank resigns as L/C Issuer, it shall retain all the rights and obligations of an L/C Issuer hereunder with respect to all Letters of Credit outstanding as of the effective date of its resignation as L/C Issuer and all L/C Obligations with respect thereto (including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in Unreimbursed Amounts pursuant to Section  2.03(d) ). If Royal Bank resigns as Swing Line Lender, it shall retain all rights of the Swing Line Lender provided for hereunder with respect

 

-192-


to Swing Line Loans made by it and outstanding as of the effective date of such resignation, including the right to require the Lenders to make Base Rate Loans or fund risk participations in outstanding Swing Line Loans pursuant to Section  2.04(c) . Upon the appointment of a successor L/C Issuer and/or Swing Line Lender, (A) such successor shall succeed to and become vested with all of the rights, powers, privileges and duties of the retiring L/C Issuer or Swing Line Lender, as the case may be, and (B) the successor L/C Issuer shall issue letters of credit in substitution for the Letters of Credit, if any, outstanding at the time of such succession or make other arrangements satisfactory to Royal Bank to effectively assume the obligations of Royal Bank with respect to such Letters of Credit.

(m) The applicable Lender, acting solely for this purpose as a non-fiduciary agent of the Borrowers (solely for tax purposes), shall maintain a register on which it enters the name and address of (i) each SPC (other than any SPC that is treated as a disregarded entity of the Granting Lender for U.S. federal income tax purposes) that has exercised its option pursuant to Section  10.07(g) and (ii) each Participant, and the amount of (including the principal amount and stated interest of) each such SPC’s and Participant’s interest in such Lender’s rights and/or obligations under this Agreement for purposes of complying with the requirements of Sections 163(f), 871(h) and 881(c)(2) of the Code and the United States Treasury Regulations (the “ Participant Register ”); provided that no Lender shall have any obligation to disclose all or any portion of the Participant Register (including the identity of any Participant or any information relating to a Participant’s interest in any commitments, loans, letters of credit or its other obligations under any Loan Document) to any Person except to the extent that such disclosure is necessary to establish that such commitment, loan, letter of credit or other obligation is in registered form under Section 5f.103-1(c) of the United States Treasury Regulations. The entries in the Participant Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and the Borrowers and such Lender shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Participant Register as the owner of the applicable rights and/or obligations of such Lender under this Agreement, notwithstanding notice to the contrary.

(n) In the event that a transfer by any of the Secured Parties of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (and/or any relevant Loan Document) occurred or was deemed to occur by way of novation, the Borrowers and any other Loan Parties explicitly agree that all securities and guarantees created under any Loan Documents shall be preserved for the benefit of the new Lender and the other Secured Parties.

Section 10.08 Confidentiality . Each of the Agents and the Lenders agrees to maintain the confidentiality of the Information, except that Information may be disclosed (a) to its Affiliates and to its and its Affiliate’s respective partners, directors, officers, employees, trustees, representatives and agents, including accountants, legal counsel and other advisors and numbering administration and settlement service providers on a need to know basis, it being understood that the Persons to whom such disclosure is made will be informed of the confidential nature of such Information and instructed to keep such Information confidential in accordance with customary practices; (b) to the extent requested by any regulatory authority having jurisdiction over such Agent, Lender or its respective Affiliates or in connection with any pledge or assignment permitted under Section  10.07(f) ; (c) in any legal, judicial, administrative proceeding or other compulsory process or otherwise as required by applicable Laws or regulations or by any subpoena or similar legal process, in each case based upon the reasonable advice of the disclosing Agent’s or Lender’s legal counsel (in which case the disclosing Agent or Lender, as applicable, agrees (except with respect to any audit or examination conducted by bank accountants or any governmental bank regulatory authority exercising examination or regulatory authority), to the extent practicable and not prohibited by applicable Law, to promptly notify the Borrower Representative after disclosure); (d) to any other party to this Agreement; (e) in connection with the exercise of any remedies hereunder or under any other Loan Document or any action or proceeding relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document or the enforcement of rights hereunder or thereunder; (f) subject to an agreement containing provisions substantially the same (or at least as restrictive) as those of this Section

 

-193-


10.08 (or as may otherwise be reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers), to any Eligible Assignee of or Participant in, or any prospective Eligible Assignee of or Participant in, any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement; provided that no such disclosure shall be made by such Lender or such Agent or any of their respective Affiliates to any such Person that is a Disqualified Institution (to the extent the list thereof has been provided to all Lenders); (g) with the written consent of Holdings; (h) to the extent such Information becomes publicly available other than as a result of a breach of this Section  10.08 ; (i) to any state, federal or foreign authority or examiner (including the National Association of Insurance Commissioners or any other similar organization) regulating any Lender; (j) to any rating agency when required by it (it being understood that, prior to any such disclosure, such rating agency shall undertake to preserve the confidentiality of any Information relating to the Loan Parties received by it from such Lender); or (k) to any national or international numbering service provider appointed by such Agent or Lender to provide identification numbering services in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Loan Parties. In addition, the Agents and the Lenders may disclose the existence of this Agreement and information about this Agreement to market data collectors, similar service providers to the lending industry, and service providers to the Agents and the Lenders in connection with the administration and management of this Agreement, the other Loan Documents, the Commitments, and the Credit Extensions; provided that such Person is advised and agrees to be bound by the provisions of this Section  10.08 .

For the purposes of this Section  10.08 , “ Information ” means all information received from any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof relating to any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof or their respective businesses, other than any such information that is publicly available to any Agent or any Lender prior to disclosure by any Loan Party other than as a result of a breach of this Section  10.08 by such Lender or Agent. Any Person required to maintain the confidentiality of Information as provided in this Section  10.08 shall be considered to have complied with its obligation to do so if such Person has exercised the same degree of care to maintain the confidentiality of such Information as such Person would accord to its own confidential information.

Each of the Administrative Agent, the Lenders and each L/C Issuer acknowledges that (i) the Information may include material non-public information concerning Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, (ii) it has developed compliance procedures regarding the use of material non-public information and (iii) it will handle such material non-public information in accordance with applicable Law, including United States federal and state securities Laws.

Section 10.09 Setoff . In addition to any rights and remedies of the Lenders provided by Law, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, each Secured Party is authorized at any time and from time to time, after obtaining the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent, without prior notice to any Borrower or any other Loan Party, any such notice being waived by the Borrowers (each, on its own behalf and on behalf of each Loan Party) to the fullest extent permitted by Law, to set off and apply any and all deposits (general or special, time or demand, provisional or final, in any currency), other than deposits in fiduciary accounts as to which a Loan Party is acting as fiduciary for another Person who is not a Loan Party, at any time held by, and other Indebtedness (in any currency) at any time owing by, such Lender to or for the credit or the account of the respective Loan Parties against any and all Obligations owing to such Secured Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document (or other Secured Agreement (as defined in the Security Agreement)), now or hereafter existing, irrespective of whether or not such Agent or such Lender shall have made demand under this Agreement or any other Loan Document (or other Secured Agreement (as defined in the Security Agreement)) and although such Obligations may be contingent or unmatured or denominated in a currency different from that of the applicable deposit or Indebtedness or are owed to a branch or office of such Lender different from the branch or office holding such deposit or obligated on such Indebtedness; provided that in the event that any Defaulting Lender shall exercise any such right of setoff,

 

-194-


(x) all amounts so set off shall be paid over immediately to the Administrative Agent for further application in accordance with the provisions of Section  2.17 and, pending such payment, shall be segregated by such Defaulting Lender from its other funds and deemed held in trust for the benefit of the Administrative Agent and the Lenders, and (y) the Defaulting Lender shall provide promptly to the Administrative Agent a statement describing in reasonable detail the Obligations owing to such Defaulting Lender as to which it exercised such right of setoff. Each Secured Party agrees promptly to notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent after any such set-off and application made by such Secured Party; provided , however , that the failure to give such notice shall not affect the validity of such setoff and application. The rights of the Administrative Agent and each Secured Party under this Section  10.09 are in addition to other rights and remedies (including other rights of setoff) that the Administrative Agent and such Secured Party may have. Notwithstanding anything herein or in any other Loan Document to the contrary, in no event shall the assets of any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO constitute security, or shall the proceeds of such assets be available for, payment of the Obligations, it being understood that (a) the Equity Interests of any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO that are directly owned by any U.S. Loan Party may be pledged, to the extent set forth in Section  6.12 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, only to the extent not constituting Excluded Property) and (b) the provisions hereof shall not limit, reduce or otherwise diminish in any respect the Borrowers’ obligations to make any mandatory prepayment pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) .

Section 10.10 Interest Rate Limitation . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Document, the interest paid or agreed to be paid under the Loan Documents shall not exceed the maximum rate of non-usurious interest permitted by applicable Law (the “ Maximum Rate ”). If any Agent or any Lender shall receive interest in an amount that exceeds the Maximum Rate, the excess interest shall be applied to the principal of the Loans or, if it exceeds such unpaid principal, refunded to the Borrowers. In determining whether the interest contracted for, charged, or received by an Agent or a Lender exceeds the Maximum Rate, such Person may, to the extent permitted by applicable Law, (a) characterize any payment that is not principal as an expense, fee, or premium rather than interest, (b) exclude voluntary prepayments and the effects thereof and (c) amortize, prorate, allocate, and spread in equal or unequal parts the total amount of interest throughout the contemplated term of the Obligations hereunder.

Section 10.11 Counterparts . This Agreement and each other Loan Document may be executed in one or more counterparts (and by different parties hereto in different counterparts), each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument. Delivery by telecopier or other electronic transmission of an executed counterpart of a signature page to this Agreement and each other Loan Document shall be effective as delivery of an original executed counterpart of this Agreement and such other Loan Document. The Agents may also require that any such documents and signatures delivered by telecopier or other electronic transmission be confirmed by a manually-signed original thereof; provided that the failure to request or deliver the same shall not limit the effectiveness of any document or signature delivered by telecopier or other electronic transmission.

Section 10.12 Integration ; Effectiveness . This Agreement and the other Loan Documents (in addition to the Fee Letter) constitute the entire contract among the parties relating to the subject matter hereof and supersede any and all previous agreements and understandings, oral or written, relating to the subject matter hereof. It is expressly agreed and confirmed by the parties hereto that the provisions of the Fee Letter shall survive the execution and delivery of this Agreement, the occurrence of the Closing Date, and shall continue in effect thereafter in accordance with their terms. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and those of any other Loan Document, the provisions of this Agreement shall control; provided that the inclusion of supplemental rights or remedies in favor of the Agents or the Lenders in any other Loan Document shall not be deemed a conflict with this Agreement. Each Loan Document was drafted with the joint participation of the respective parties thereto and shall be construed neither against nor in favor of any party, but rather in accordance with the fair meaning thereof. This Agreement shall become effective in accordance with Section  4.01 .

 

-195-


Section 10.13 Survival of Representations and Warranties . All representations and warranties made hereunder and in any other Loan Document or other document delivered pursuant hereto or thereto or in connection herewith or therewith shall survive the execution and delivery hereof and thereof. Such representations and warranties have been or will be relied upon by each Agent and each Lender, regardless of any investigation made by any Agent or any Lender or on their behalf and notwithstanding that any Agent or any Lender may have had notice or knowledge of any Default at the time of any Credit Extension, and shall continue in full force and effect as long as any Loan or any other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification or other obligations and obligations and liabilities under Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied or any Letter of Credit shall remain outstanding (other than Letters of Credit which have been Cash Collateralized).

Section 10.14 Severability . If any provision of this Agreement or the other Loan Documents is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable, (a) the legality, validity and enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall not be affected or impaired thereby and (b) the parties shall endeavor in good faith negotiations to replace the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions. The invalidity of a provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction. Without limiting the foregoing provisions of this Section  10.14 , if and to the extent that the enforceability of any provisions in this Agreement relating to Defaulting Lenders shall be limited by Debtor Relief Laws then such provisions shall be deemed to be in effect only to the extent not so limited.

Section 10.15 Governing Law ; Jurisdiction ; Etc .

(a) GOVERNING LAW . THIS AGREEMENT AND EACH OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (OTHER THAN WITH RESPECT TO ANY COLLATERAL DOCUMENTS TO THE EXTENT EXPRESSLY PROVIDED OTHERWISE THEREIN) SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

(b) SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY SUBMITS, FOR ITSELF AND ITS PROPERTY, TO THE EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION OF THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SITTING IN NEW YORK CITY IN THE BOROUGH OF MANHATTAN AND OF THE UNITED STATES DISTRICT COURT FOR THE SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK SITTING IN THE BOROUGH OF MANHATTAN, AND ANY APPELLATE COURT FROM ANY THEREOF, IN ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (OTHER THAN WITH RESPECT TO ANY COLLATERAL DOCUMENT TO THE EXTENT EXPRESSLY PROVIDED OTHERWISE THEREIN), OR FOR RECOGNITION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY JUDGMENT, AND EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY AGREES THAT ALL CLAIMS IN RESPECT OF ANY SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING MAY BE HEARD AND DETERMINED IN SUCH NEW YORK STATE COURT OR, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN SUCH FEDERAL COURT. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT A FINAL JUDGMENT IN ANY SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING SHALL BE CONCLUSIVE AND MAY BE ENFORCED IN OTHER JURISDICTIONS BY SUIT ON THE JUDGMENT OR IN ANY OTHER MANNER PROVIDED BY LAW. NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT OR IN ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT SHALL AFFECT ANY RIGHT WITH RESPECT TO THE COLLATERAL THAT THE

 

-196-


ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, THE COLLATERAL AGENT, ANY LENDER OR ANY L/C ISSUER MAY OTHERWISE HAVE TO BRING ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE RECOGNITION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY JUDGMENT AGAINST ANY LOAN PARTY OR ITS PROPERTIES IN THE COURTS OF ANY JURISDICTION.

(c) WAIVER OF VENUE . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY OBJECTION THAT IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE TO THE LAYING OF VENUE OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT IN ANY COURT REFERRED TO IN CLAUSE (b) OF THIS SECTION  10.15 . EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, THE DEFENSE OF AN INCONVENIENT FORUM TO THE MAINTENANCE OF SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN ANY SUCH COURT.

Section 10.16 SERVICE OF PROCESS . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY CONSENTS TO SERVICE OF PROCESS IN THE MANNER PROVIDED FOR NOTICES IN SECTION  10.02 . NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT WILL AFFECT THE RIGHT OF ANY PARTY HERETO TO SERVE PROCESS IN ANY OTHER MANNER PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.

Section 10.17 WAIVER OF RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY . EACH PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT HEREBY EXPRESSLY WAIVES ANY RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY OF ANY CLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION ARISING UNDER ANY LOAN DOCUMENT OR IN ANY WAY CONNECTED WITH OR RELATED OR INCIDENTAL TO THE DEALINGS OF THE PARTIES HERETO OR ANY OF THEM WITH RESPECT TO ANY LOAN DOCUMENT, OR THE TRANSACTIONS RELATED THERETO, IN EACH CASE WHETHER NOW EXISTING OR HEREAFTER ARISING, AND WHETHER FOUNDED IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR OTHERWISE; AND EACH PARTY HEREBY AGREES AND CONSENTS THAT ANY SUCH CLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION SHALL BE DECIDED BY COURT TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY, AND THAT ANY PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY FILE AN ORIGINAL COUNTERPART OR A COPY OF THIS SECTION 10.17 WITH ANY COURT AS WRITTEN EVIDENCE OF THE CONSENT OF THE SIGNATORIES HERETO TO THE WAIVER OF THEIR RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY.

Section 10.18 Binding Effect . When this Agreement shall have become effective in accordance with Section  10.12 , it shall thereafter shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Borrowers, each Agent and each Lender and their respective successors and permitted assigns, except that the Borrowers shall not have the right to assign its rights hereunder or any interest herein without the prior written consent of the Lenders except as permitted by Section  7.04 .

Section 10.19 No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility . In connection with all aspects of each transaction contemplated hereby (including in connection with any amendment, waiver or other modification hereof or of any other Loan Document), the Borrowers and Holdings acknowledge and agree, and each of them acknowledges and agrees that it has informed its other Affiliates, that: (i) (A) no fiduciary, advisory or agency relationship between any of Holdings and its Subsidiaries and any Agent or any Arranger is intended to be or has been created in respect of any of the transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents, irrespective of whether any Agent or any Arranger has advised or is advising Holdings and its Subsidiaries on other matters, (B) the arranging and other services regarding this Agreement provided by the Agents and the Arrangers are arm’s-length commercial transactions between Holdings and its Subsidiaries, on the one hand, and the Agents and the Arrangers,

 

-197-


on the other hand, (C) the Borrowers and Holdings have consulted their own legal, accounting, regulatory and tax advisors to the extent it has deemed appropriate, and (D) the Borrowers and Holdings are capable of evaluating, and understands and accepts, the terms, risks and conditions of the transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents; (ii) (A) each Agent and Arranger is and has been acting solely as a principal and, except as may otherwise be expressly agreed in writing by the relevant parties, has not been, is not, and will not be acting as an advisor, agent or fiduciary for Holdings or any of its Affiliates, or any other Person and (B) neither any Agent nor any Arranger has any obligation to Holdings or any of its Affiliates with respect to the transactions contemplated hereby except those obligations expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents; and (iii) the Agents and the Arrangers and their respective Affiliates may be engaged in a broad range of transactions that involve interests that differ from those of Holdings, the Borrowers and their respective Affiliates, and neither any Agent nor any Arranger has any obligation to disclose any of such interests and transactions to Holdings, the Borrowers or their respective Affiliates. To the fullest extent permitted by law, Holdings and the Borrowers hereby (i) agree not to assert any claims that they may have against the Agents, the Arrangers, and the Lenders with respect to any breach or alleged breach of agency and (ii) agree not to assert that any fiduciary or similar duty is owed by the Agents, the Arrangers or the Lenders, in each case, in connection with any aspect of any transaction contemplated hereby.

Section 10.20 Affiliate Activities . The Borrowers and Holdings acknowledge that each Agent and each Arranger (and their respective Affiliates) is a full service securities firm engaged, either directly or through affiliates, in various activities, including securities trading, investment banking and financial advisory, investment management, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities and financial planning and benefits counseling for both companies and individuals. In the ordinary course of these activities, any of them may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and/or financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of customers and may at any time hold long and short positions in such securities and/or instruments. Such investment and other activities may involve securities and instruments of Holdings and its Affiliates, as well as of other entities and persons and their Affiliates which may (i) be involved in transactions arising from or relating to the engagement contemplated hereby and by the other Loan documents, (ii) be customers or competitors of Holdings and its Affiliates or (iii) have other relationships with Holdings and its Affiliates. In addition, it may provide investment banking, underwriting and financial advisory services to such other entities and persons. It may also co-invest with, make direct investments in, and invest or co-invest client monies in or with funds or other investment vehicles managed by other parties, and such funds or other investment vehicles may trade or make investments in securities of Holdings and its Affiliates or such other entities. The transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents may have a direct or indirect impact on the investments, securities or instruments referred to in this Section  10.20 .

Section 10.21 Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents . The words “execution,” “signed,” “signature,” and words of like import in any Assignment and Assumption or in any amendment or other modification hereof (including waivers and consents) shall be deemed to include electronic signatures or the keeping of records in electronic form, each of which shall be of the same legal effect, validity or enforceability as a manually executed signature or the use of a paper-based recordkeeping system, as the case may be, to the extent and as provided for in any applicable Law, including the Federal Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce Act, the New York State Electronic Signatures and Records Act, or any other similar state laws based on the Uniform Electronic Transactions Act.

 

-198-


Section 10.22 USA PATRIOT ACT . Each Lender that is subject to the PATRIOT Act and the Administrative Agent (for itself and not on behalf of any Lender) hereby notifies each Borrower that pursuant to the requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act (Title III of Pub. L. 107-56 (signed into law October 26, 2001, as amended from time to time)) (the “ PATRIOT Act ”), it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies each Loan Party, which information includes the name and address of each Loan Party and other information that will allow such Lender or the Administrative Agent, as applicable, to identify each Loan Party in accordance with the PATRIOT Act. The Borrowers shall, promptly following a request by the Administrative Agent or any Lender, provide all documentation and other information that the Administrative Agent or such Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the PATRIOT Act.

Section 10.23 Acknowledgement and Consent to Bail-In of EEA Financial Institutions . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Document or in any other agreement, arrangement or understanding among any such parties, each party hereto acknowledges that any liability of any EEA Financial Institution arising under any Loan Document, to the extent such liability is unsecured, may be subject to the write-down and conversion powers of an EEA Resolution Authority and agrees and consents to, and acknowledges and agrees to be bound by: (a) the application of any Write-Down and Conversion Powers by an EEA Resolution Authority to any such liabilities arising hereunder which may be payable to it by any party hereto that is an EEA Financial Institution; and (b) the effects of any Bail-In Action on any such liability, including, if applicable: (i) a reduction in full or in part or cancellation of any such liability; (ii) a conversion of all, or a portion of, such liability into shares or other instruments of ownership in such EEA Financial Institution, its parent entity, or a bridge institution that may be issued to it or otherwise conferred on it, and that such shares or other instruments of ownership will be accepted by it in lieu of any rights with respect to any such liability under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; or (iii) the variation of the terms of such liability in connection with the exercise of the write-down and conversion powers of any EEA Resolution Authority.

Section 10.24 Judgment Currency . If, for the purposes of obtaining judgment in any court, it is necessary to convert a sum due hereunder or any other Loan Document in one currency into another currency, the rate of exchange used shall be that at which in accordance with normal banking procedures the Administrative Agent could purchase the first currency with such other currency on the Business Day preceding that on which final judgment is given. The obligation of the Borrowers in respect of any such sum due from it to the Administrative Agent or the Lenders hereunder or under the Loan Documents shall, notwithstanding any judgment in a currency (the “ Judgment Currency ”) other than that in which such sub is denominated in accordance with applicable provisions of this Agreement (the “ Agreement Currency ”), be discharged only to the extent that on the Business Day following receipt by the Administrative Agent of any sum adjudged to be so due in the Judgment Currency, the Administrative Agent may in accordance with normal banking procedures purchase the Agreement Currency with the Judgment Currency. If the amount of the Agreement Currency so purchased is less than the sum originally due to the Administrative Agent from the Borrowers in the Agreement Currency, the Borrowers agree, as a separate obligation and notwithstanding any such judgment, to indemnify the Administrative Agent or the Person to whom such obligation was owing against such loss. If the amount of the Agreement Currency so purchased is greater than the sum originally due to the Administrative Agent in such currency, the Administrative Agent or the applicable person to whom such payment was made agrees to return the amount of any excess to the Borrowers (or to any other Person who may be entitled thereto under applicable Law).

[REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

-199-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Credit Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first written above.

 

LD INTERMEDIATE HOLDINGS, INC., as a
Borrower
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer

 

LD LOWER HOLDINGS, INC., as a Borrower
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer

 

LD TOPCO, INC., as Holdings
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer

 

[Signature Page to Second Lien Credit Agreement]


ROYAL BANK OF CANADA, as Administrative
Agent
By:  

/s/ Rodica Dutka

Name:   Rodica Dutka
Title:   Manager, Agency

 

[Signature Page to Second Credit Agreement]


ROYAL BANK OF CANADA, as Lender
By:  

/s/ Kamran Khan

Name:   Kamran Khan
Title:   Authorized Signatory

 

[Signature Page to Second Credit Agreement]


THE NORTHWESTERN MUTUAL LIFE
INSURANCE COMPANY, as Lender
By:  

Northwestern Mutual Investment

Management Company, LLC

Its: Investment Adviser

  By:  

/s/ Daniel J. Julka

  Name:  

Daniel J. Julka

  Its:   Managing Director

 

THE NORTHWESTERN MUTUAL LIFE
INSURANCE COMPANY

for its Group Annuity Separate Account, as Lender

By:  

/s/ Daniel J. Julka

Name:  

Daniel J. Julka

  Its:   Authorized Representative

 

NORTHWESTERN MUTUAL CAPITAL

MEZZANINE FUND IV, LP, as Lender

By:   Northwestern Mutual Capital GP IV, LLC
  Its: General Partner
By:  

Northwestern Mutual Investment

Management Company, LLC

Its: Manager

By:  

/s/ Daniel J. Julka

Name:  

Daniel J. Julka

  Its: Managing Director

 

[Signature Page to Second Credit Agreement]

Exhibit 10.13

Execution Version

 

 

 

SECOND LIEN CREDIT AGREEMENT

D ATED AS OF

D ECEMBER  9, 2016

AMONG

LD INTERMEDIATE HOLDINGS, INC.,

AND

LD LOWER HOLDINGS, INC.,

AS C O -B ORROWERS ,

LD TOPCO, I NC .,

AS H OLDINGS ,

ROYAL BANK OF CANADA,

AS A DMINISTRATIVE A GENT AND C OLLATERAL A GENT ,

T HE O THER L ENDERS P ARTY H ERETO ,

RBC CAPITAL MARKETS 1 ,

NORTHWESTERN MUTUAL INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT COMPANY, LLC

AND

TD SECURITIES (USA) LLC,

AS J OINT L EAD A RRANGERS AND J OINT B OOKRUNNERS

 

 

 

 

1  

RBC Capital Markets is a brand name for the capital markets businesses of Royal Bank of Canada and its affiliates.


T ABLE OF C ONTENTS

 

          Page  

ARTICLE I

 

DEFINITIONS AND ACCOUNTING TERMS

 

Section 1.01

   Defined Terms      1  

Section 1.02

   Other Interpretive Provisions      56  

Section 1.03

   Accounting Terms      58  

Section 1.04

   Rounding      58  

Section 1.05

   References to Agreements and Laws      58  

Section 1.06

   Timing of Payment or Performance      59  

Section 1.07

   Currency Equivalents Generally      59  

Section 1.08

   [Reserved]      59  

Section 1.09

   Pro Forma Calculations      59  

Section 1.10

   Calculation of Baskets      60  

Section 1.11

   Treatment of Subsidiaries Prior to Joinder      60  

ARTICLE II

  

THE COMMITMENTS AND CREDIT EXTENSIONS

  

Section 2.01

   The Loans      60  

Section 2.02

   Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans      61  

Section 2.03

   [Reserved]      62  

Section 2.04

   [Reserved]      62  

Section 2.05

   Prepayments      62  

Section 2.06

   Termination or Reduction of Commitments      67  

Section 2.07

   Repayment of Loans      67  

Section 2.08

   Interest      67  

Section 2.09

   Fees      67  

Section 2.10

   Computation of Interest and Fees      68  

Section 2.11

   Evidence of Indebtedness      68  

Section 2.12

   Payments Generally; Administrative Agent’s Clawback      68  

Section 2.13

   Sharing of Payments      70  

Section 2.14

   Incremental Facilities      71  

Section 2.15

   New Incremental Notes      74  

Section 2.16

   [Reserved]      75  

Section 2.17

   Defaulting Lenders      75  

Section 2.18

   Specified Refinancing Debt      76  

ARTICLE III

  

TAXES, INCREASED COSTS PROTECTION AND ILLEGALITY

  

Section 3.01

   Taxes      78  

Section 3.02

   Illegality      81  

Section 3.03

   Inability to Determine Rates      82  

Section 3.04

   Increased Cost and Reduced Return; Capital Adequacy      82  

Section 3.05

   Funding Losses      83  

Section 3.06

   Matters Applicable to All Requests for Compensation      84  

Section 3.07

   Replacement of Lenders Under Certain Circumstances      85  

 

-i-


ARTICLE IV

  

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

  

Section 4.01

   Conditions to Credit Extensions on the Closing Date      86  

Section 4.02

   Conditions to All Credit Extensions      90  

ARTICLE V

  

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

  

Section 5.01

   Existence, Qualification and Power; Compliance with Laws      90  

Section 5.02

   Authorization; No Contravention      91  

Section 5.03

   Governmental Authorization      91  

Section 5.04

   Binding Effect      91  

Section 5.05

   Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect      91  

Section 5.06

   Litigation      92  

Section 5.07

   Use of Proceeds      92  

Section 5.08

   Ownership of Property; Liens      92  

Section 5.09

   Environmental Compliance      93  

Section 5.10

   Taxes      93  

Section 5.11

   Employee Benefits Plans      93  

Section 5.12

   Subsidiaries; Equity Interests      93  

Section 5.13

   Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act      93  

Section 5.14

   Disclosure      94  

Section 5.15

   Compliance with Laws      94  

Section 5.16

   Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc.      94  

Section 5.17

   Solvency      94  

Section 5.18

   Perfection, Etc.      95  

Section 5.19

   Anti-Terrorism Laws; OFAC; FCPA      95  

ARTICLE VI

  

AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

  

Section 6.01

   Financial Statements      96  

Section 6.02

   Certificates; Other Information      97  

Section 6.03

   Notices      99  

Section 6.04

   Payment of Taxes      100  

Section 6.05

   Preservation of Existence, Etc.      100  

Section 6.06

   Maintenance of Properties      100  

Section 6.07

   Maintenance of Insurance      100  

Section 6.08

   Compliance with Laws      101  

Section 6.09

   Books and Records      101  

Section 6.10

   Inspection Rights      101  

Section 6.11

   Use of Proceeds      102  

Section 6.12

   Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security      102  

Section 6.13

   Compliance with Environmental Laws      103  

Section 6.14

   Further Assurances      103  

Section 6.15

   Maintenance of Ratings      104  

Section 6.16

   Post-Closing Undertakings      104  

 

-ii-


ARTICLE VII

  

NEGATIVE COVENANTS

  

Section 7.01

   Liens      105  

Section 7.02

   Investments      110  

Section 7.03

   Indebtedness      114  

Section 7.04

   Fundamental Changes      118  

Section 7.05

   Dispositions      120  

Section 7.06

   Restricted Payments      123  

Section 7.07

   Change in Nature of Business      126  

Section 7.08

   Transactions with Affiliates      127  

Section 7.09

   Burdensome Agreements      129  

Section 7.10

   [Reserved]      131  

Section 7.11

   Accounting Changes      131  

Section 7.12

   Prepayments, Etc. of Indebtedness; Amendments      131  

Section 7.13

   Holding Company      132  

ARTICLE VIII

  

EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

  

Section 8.01

   Events of Default      133  

Section 8.02

   Remedies upon Event of Default      135  

Section 8.03

   [Reserved]      136  

Section 8.04

   Application of Funds      136  

ARTICLE IX

  

ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT AND OTHER AGENTS

  

Section 9.01

   Appointment and Authorization of Agents      137  

Section 9.02

   Delegation of Duties      138  

Section 9.03

   Liability of Agents      138  

Section 9.04

   Reliance by Agents      139  

Section 9.05

   Notice of Default      140  

Section 9.06

   Credit Decision; Disclosure of Information by Agents      140  

Section 9.07

   Indemnification of Agents      140  

Section 9.08

   Agents in Their Individual Capacities      141  

Section 9.09

   Successor Agents      141  

Section 9.10

   Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim      142  

Section 9.11

   Collateral and Guaranty Matters      143  

Section 9.12

   Certain Rights of the Administrative Agent      144  

Section 9.13

   Holders      144  

Section 9.14

   Other Agents; Arranger and Managers      144  

Section 9.15

   [Reserved]      144  

Section 9.16

   Appointment of Supplemental Agents      144  

Section 9.17

   Intercreditor Agreement      145  

Section 9.18

   Withholding Tax      146  

Section 9.19

   Appointment of Incremental Arrangers and Specified Refinancing Agents      146  

 

-iii-


ARTICLE X

  

MISCELLANEOUS

  

Section 10.01

   Amendments, Etc.      147  

Section 10.02

   Notices; Electronic Communications      150  

Section 10.03

   No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies; Enforcement      152  

Section 10.04

   Expenses and Taxes      153  

Section 10.05

   Indemnification by the Borrower      154  

Section 10.06

   Payments Set Aside      155  

Section 10.07

   Successors and Assigns      155  

Section 10.08

   Confidentiality      161  

Section 10.09

   Setoff      162  

Section 10.10

   Interest Rate Limitation      163  

Section 10.11

   Counterparts      163  

Section 10.12

   Integration; Effectiveness      163  

Section 10.13

   Survival of Representations and Warranties      164  

Section 10.14

   Severability      164  

Section 10.15

   Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Etc.      164  

Section 10.16

   SERVICE OF PROCESS      165  

Section 10.17

   WAIVER OF RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY      165  

Section 10.18

   Binding Effect      165  

Section 10.19

   No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility      165  

Section 10.20

   Affiliate Activities      166  

Section 10.21

   Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents      166  

Section 10.22

   USA PATRIOT ACT      166  

Section 10.23

   Acknowledgement and Consent to Bail-In of EEA Financial Institutions      167  

SCHEDULES

 

A    Cash Management Obligations
1    Subsidiary Guarantors
1.01(e)    Contracts Prohibiting Subsidiary Guarantees
1.01(f)    Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information
2.01    Commitments and Pro Rata Shares
5.08(b)    Owned Real Property
5.12    Restricted Subsidiaries
5.16    Intellectual Property Matters
6.16    Post-Closing Undertakings
7.01    Existing Liens
7.02    Existing Investments
7.03    Permitted Surviving Debt
7.08    Transactions with Affiliates
7.09    Burdensome Agreements
10.02    Administrative Agent’s Office, Certain Addresses for Notices
EXHIBITS
Form of
A    Committed Loan Notice

 

-iv-


B    Note
C    Closing Certificate
D    Compliance Certificate
E-1    Assignment and Assumption
E-2    Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption
F-1    Holdings Guaranty
F-2    Subsidiary Guaranty
G    Security Agreement
H    Intercompany Subordination Agreement
I-1    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-2    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-3    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
I-4    U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate
J    Solvency Certificate
K    Optional Prepayment of Loans
L    Perfection Certificate
M    Intercreditor Agreement

 

-v-


This SECOND LIEN CREDIT AGREEMENT dated as of December 9, 2016, among LD Lower Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ LD Lower ”) and LD Intermediate Holdings, Inc. (“ LD Intermediate ”), a Delaware corporation (and, together with LD Lower, each a “ Borrower ” and collectively, the “ Borrowers ”), LD Topco, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“ Holdings ”), each lender from time to time party hereto (collectively, the “ Lenders ” and individually, a “ Lender ”) and Royal Bank of Canada (“ Royal Bank ”), as Administrative Agent and Collateral Agent.

PRELIMINARY STATEMENTS

WHEREAS, pursuant to that certain Unit Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 21, 2016 (as amended and restated on December 8, 2016 and together with all exhibits and schedules thereto, collectively, the “ Acquisition Agreement ”) by and among, inter alios, LD Lower, as buyer, and Corporate Risk Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as the seller, LD Lower will indirectly acquire certain foreign subsidiaries of Kroll Ontrack, LLC, a Minnesota limited liability company, and directly acquire the Company Units (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement) (the “ Acquisition ”); and

WHEREAS, in connection with the Transaction, the Borrowers have requested that, upon the satisfaction (or waiver) in full of the conditions precedent set forth in Section  4.01 , the applicable Lenders make second lien term loans to the Borrowers in an aggregate principal amount of $125,000,000 on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement.

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

Definitions and Accounting Terms

Section 1.01 Defined Terms . As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

Acquisition ” has the meaning specified in the preliminary statements to this Agreement.

Acquisition Agreement ” has the meaning specified in the preliminary statements to this Agreement.

Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate ” means, with respect to any Eurocurrency Rate Loan for any Interest Period, an interest rate per annum equal to (a) the Statutory Reserve Rate (which shall not be less than zero) multiplied by (b) the greatest of (i) LIBOR, (ii) 0.00% per annum and (iii) solely with respect to the Initial Loans, 1.00% per annum.

Administrative Agent ” means Royal Bank, acting through such of its Affiliates or branches as it may designate, in its capacity as administrative agent under any of the Loan Documents, or any successor administrative agent permitted by the terms hereof.

Administrative Agent’s Office ” means the Administrative Agent’s address and, as appropriate, account as set forth on Schedule 10.02 , or in each case, such other address or account as the Administrative Agent may from time to time notify the Borrower Representative and the Lenders.

Administrative Questionnaire ” means an Administrative Questionnaire supplied by the Administrative Agent.


Affiliate ” means, with respect to any Person, another Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, Controls or is Controlled by or is under common Control with the Person specified.

Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(i)(i) .

Affiliate Lenders ” means, collectively, the Sponsor and its Affiliates (other than Holdings, a Borrower and any of their respective Subsidiaries).

Agency Matters ” means any matters relating to the Facility.

Agent-Related Distress Event ” means, with respect to the Administrative Agent or any Person that directly or indirectly Controls the Administrative Agent (each, a “ Distressed Agent-Related Person ”), a voluntary or involuntary case with respect to such Distressed Agent-Related Person under any Debtor Relief Law, or a custodian, conservator, receiver or similar official is appointed for such Distressed Agent-Related Person or any substantial part of such Distressed Agent-Related Person’s assets, or such Distressed Agent-Related Person makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors or is otherwise adjudicated as, or determined by any Governmental Authority having regulatory authority over such Distressed Agent-Related Person to be, insolvent or bankrupt; provided that an Agent-Related Distress Event shall not be deemed to have occurred solely by virtue of the ownership or acquisition of any Equity Interests in the Administrative Agent or any Person that directly or indirectly Controls the Administrative Agent by a Governmental Authority or an instrumentality thereof.

Agent-Related Persons ” means each Agent, together with its Related Parties.

Agents ” means, collectively, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, the Arrangers and the Syndication Agent.

Agreement ” means this Second Lien Credit Agreement.

Aggregate Commitments ” means the Commitments of all the Lenders.

All-In Yield ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(f) .

Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements ” means customary intercreditor arrangements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent; provided that (i) in the case of Indebtedness secured by Liens ranking pari passu with the First Lien Obligations, the Intercreditor Agreement shall be deemed satisfactory and (ii) in the case of Indebtedness secured by Liens ranking pari passu with the Obligations, such arrangements shall include a customary pari passu intercreditor agreement reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

Applicable Rate means a percentage per annum equal to (A) 10.00% per annum for Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (B) 9.00% per annum for Base Rate Loans.

Appropriate Lender ” means, at any time, (a) with respect to the Initial Facility, a Lender that has an Initial Commitment with respect to such Facility or Tranche thereunder or holds an Initial Loan at such time, (b) with respect to any New Facility, a Lender that holds a New Commitment or a New Loan at such time, and (c) with respect to any Specified Refinancing Debt, a Lender that holds a Specified Refinancing Commitment or Specified Refinancing Loans.

Approved Bank ” has the meaning specified in clause (c) of the definition of “ Cash Equivalents .”

 

-2-


Approved Fund ” means with respect to any Lender any Fund that is administered, advised or managed by (a) such Lender, (b) an Affiliate of such Lender or (c) an entity or an Affiliate of an entity that administers, advises or manages such Lender.

Arrangers ” means each of RBC Capital Markets, Northwestern and TD Securities (USA) LLC, in their respective capacities as exclusive joint lead arrangers and bookrunners, as applicable.

Assignee Group ” means two or more Eligible Assignees that are Affiliates of one another or two or more Approved Funds managed, advised or administered by the same investment advisor/manager or affiliated investment advisors/managers.

Assignment and Assumption ” means an Assignment and Assumption substantially in the form of Exhibit E-1 , or otherwise in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

Attributable Indebtedness ” means, on any date, (a) in respect of any Capitalized Lease of any Person, the capitalized amount thereof that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP, and (b) in respect of any Synthetic Lease Obligation, the capitalized amount of the remaining lease payments under the relevant lease that would appear on a balance sheet of such Person prepared as of such date in accordance with GAAP if such lease were accounted for as a capital lease.

Audited Financial Statements ” means, collectively, (a) the audited financial statements for LDisc Holdings, LLC and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2014 and the fiscal period ending December 22, 2015 and (b) the audited financial statements for Holdings and its Subsidiaries for the 10-day accounting period ending December 31, 2015.

Bail-In Action ” means the exercise of any Write-Down and Conversion Powers by the applicable EEA Resolution Authority in respect of any liability of an EEA Financial Institution.

Bail-In Legislation ” means, with respect to any EEA Member Country implementing Article 55 of Directive 2014/59/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of the European Union, the implementing law for such EEA Member Country from time to time which is described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule.

Base Rate ” means, for any day, a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the Federal Funds Rate in effect on such day plus 0.50%, (b) the prime commercial lending determined by Royal Bank as the “prime rate” and (c) the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate determined on such date (or if such day is not a Business Day, the immediately preceding Business Day) for a deposit in Dollars with a maturity of one month plus 1.00% (or, if such day is not a Business Day, the immediately preceding Business Day, subject to the interest rate floors set forth therein); provided that in no event shall the Base Rate be less than, in the case of Initial Loans, 2.00%; provided , further , that if any of the rates set forth above shall be less than zero percent per annum, such rate shall be deemed to be zero percent per annum for purposes of this Agreement.

Base Rate Loan ” means a Loan denominated in Dollars that bears interest based on the Base Rate.

Basel III ” means (a) the agreements on capital requirements, a leverage ratio and liquidity standards contained in “Basel III: A global regulatory framework for more resilient banks and banking systems”, “Basel III: International framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring” and “Guidance for national authorities operating the countercyclical capital buffer” published by the

 

-3-


Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in December 2010, each as amended, supplemented or restated; (b) the rules for global systemically important banks contained in “Global systemically important banks: assessment methodology and the additional loss absorbency requirement – Rules text” published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in November 2011, as amended, supplemented or restated; and (c) any further guidance or standards published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision relating to “Basel III”.

Borrower ” and “ Borrowers ” have the meanings specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Borrower Materials ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

Borrower Parties ” means the collective reference to Holdings, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, and “ Borrower Party ” means any one of them.

Borrower Representative ” means LD Intermediate.

Borrowing ” means a borrowing of the same Type of Loan of a single Tranche from all the Lenders having Commitments of the respective Tranche on a given date (or resulting from a conversion or conversions on such date) having, in the case of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the same Interest Period.

Business Day ” means:

(a) any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks are authorized to close under the Laws of, or are in fact closed in New York City; and

(b) if such day relates to any interest rate settings as to a Eurocurrency Rate Loan, any such day described in clause (a) above which is also a day on which dealings in deposits in Dollars are conducted by and between banks in the London interbank market.

Capital Expenditures ” means, as of any date for the applicable period then ended, all capital expenditures of the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis for such period (whether paid in cash or accrued as liabilities), that are required to be capitalized in accordance with GAAP (including acquisitions of IP Rights made in cash during such period to the extent the cost thereof is treated as a capitalized expense in accordance with GAAP); provided , however , that Capital Expenditures shall not include any such expenditures which constitute (a) an Investment permitted under Section  7.02 (but shall include all Capital Expenditures made with the proceeds of such Investment by a Borrower Party that is the recipient thereof), (b) to the extent permitted by this Agreement, (i) a reinvestment of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Disposition or Casualty Event in accordance with Section  2.05(b)(ii) or (ii) the purchase of property, plant or equipment or software to the extent financed with the proceeds of Dispositions or Casualty Events that are not required pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) to be applied to prepay Loans or to be reinvested, (c) capitalized interest in respect of operating or capital leases, (d) the book value of any asset owned to the extent such book value is included as a capital expenditure as a result of reusing or beginning to reuse such asset during such period without a corresponding expenditure actually having been made in such period, (e) any non-cash amounts reflected as additions to property, plant or equipment on the Borrowers’ consolidated balance sheet and (f) expenditures that are accounted for as capital expenditures by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and that actually are paid for or reimbursed (including by means of the issuance of Equity Interests by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) by a Person other than a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and for which neither of the Borrowers nor any Restricted Subsidiary has provided or is required to provide or incur, directly or indirectly, any consideration or obligation to such Person or any other Person (whether before, during or after such period).

 

-4-


Capitalized Leases ” means all leases that have been or are required to be, in accordance with GAAP, recorded as capitalized leases; provided that obligations or liabilities of any Person to pay rent or other amounts under any lease of (or other arrangement conveying the right to use) real or personal property, or a combination thereof, which obligations would be required to be classified and accounted for as an operating lease under GAAP as existing on the Closing Date that are recharacterized as Capitalized Leases due to a change in GAAP after the Closing Date shall not be treated as Capitalized Leases for any purpose under this Agreement, but instead shall be accounted for as if they were operating leases for all purposes under this Agreement as determined under GAAP as in effect on the Closing Date.

Capitalized Software Expenditures ” means, for any period, the aggregate of all expenditures (whether paid in cash or accrued as liabilities) by the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries during such period in respect of purchased software or internally developed software and software enhancements that, in conformity with GAAP, are or are required to be reflected as capitalized costs on the consolidated balance sheet of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries.

Cash-Capped Incremental Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Cash Equivalents ” means any of the following types of Investments, to the extent owned by a Borrower or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries:

(a) Dollars;

(b) readily marketable obligations issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof having maturities of not more than 24 months from the date of acquisition thereof; provided that the full faith and credit of the United States is pledged in support thereof;

(c) time deposits or eurodollar time deposits with, insured certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances or overnight bank deposits of, or letters of credit issued by, any domestic or foreign commercial bank that (i) issues (or the parent of which issues) commercial paper rated at least P-2 (or the then equivalent grade) by Moody’s or at least A-2 (or the then equivalent grade) by S&P and (ii) has combined capital and surplus of at least $250,000,000 (or, in the case of any non-U.S. banks, the equivalent amount thereof in a currency other than Dollars determined in accordance with Section 1.07 of this Agreement) (any such bank being an “ Approved Bank ”), in each case with maturities of not more than 360 days from the date of acquisition thereof;

(d) commercial paper and variable or fixed rate notes issued by an Approved Bank (or by the parent company thereof) or any variable or fixed rate notes issued by, or guaranteed by a domestic corporation rated A-2 (or the equivalent thereof) or better by S&P or P-2 (or the equivalent thereof) or better by Moody’s, in each case with maturities of not more than 24 months from the date of acquisition thereof;

(e) marketable short-term money market and similar funds (including such funds investing a portion of their assets in municipal securities) having a rating of at least P-2 or A-2 from either Moody’s or S&P, respectively (or, if at any time neither Moody’s nor S&P shall be rating such obligations, an equivalent rating from another nationally recognized statistical rating agency selected by the Borrowers);

(f) repurchase agreements entered into by any Person with a bank or trust company (including any of the Lenders) or recognized securities dealer having capital and surplus in excess of $250,000,000 (or, in the case of any non-U.S. banks, the equivalent amount thereof in a

 

-5-


currency other than Dollars determined in accordance with Section 1.07 of this Agreement) for direct obligations issued by or fully guaranteed or insured by the United States government or any agency or instrumentality of the United States in which such Person shall have a perfected first priority security interest (subject to no other Liens) and having, on the date of purchase thereof, a fair market value of at least 100% of the amount of the repurchase obligations;

(g) Investments, classified in accordance with GAAP as Consolidated Current Assets of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary, in money market investment programs registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, which are administered by financial institutions having capital of at least $250,000,000 (or, in the case of any non-U.S. banks, the equivalent amount thereof in a currency other than Dollars determined in accordance with Section 1.07 of this Agreement), and the portfolios of which are limited such that substantially all of such investments are of the character, quality and maturity described in clauses (b) through (f) and (j) of this definition;

(h) investment funds investing at least 95% of their assets in securities of the types (including as to credit quality and maturity) described in clauses (b) through (g) above;

(i) solely with respect to any Restricted Subsidiary that is a Foreign Subsidiary, (x) such local currencies in those countries in which such Foreign Subsidiary transacts business from time to time in the ordinary course of business and (y) investments of comparable tenor and credit quality to those described in the foregoing clauses (b) through (h) customarily utilized in countries in which such Foreign Subsidiary operates for short term cash management purposes; and

(j) securities with average maturities of 24 months or less from the date of acquisition issued or fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth or territory of the United States, by any political subdivision or taxing authority of any such state, commonwealth or territory or by any foreign government having a rating of at least P-2 or A-2 from either Moody’s or S&P, respectively (or the equivalent thereof).

Notwithstanding the foregoing, Cash Equivalents shall include amounts denominated in currencies other than those set forth in clauses (a) and (i) above; provided that such amounts are converted into any currency listed in clause (a) or (i) as promptly as practicable and in any event within ten Business Days following the receipt of such amounts.

Cash Management Agreement ” means any agreement to provide cash management services, including treasury, depository, overdraft, credit, purchasing or debit card, electronic funds transfer and other cash management arrangements to any Loan Party.

Casualty Event ” means any event that gives rise to the receipt by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any casualty insurance proceeds or condemnation awards or that gives rise to a taking by a Governmental Authority in respect of any equipment, fixed assets or real property (including any improvements thereon) to replace, restore or repair, or compensate for the loss of, such equipment, fixed assets or real property.

Change of Control ” means: (a) for any reason whatsoever Holdings shall cease to own, directly or indirectly, 100% of the Equity Interests of each Borrower; (b) at any time prior to a Qualified IPO and for any reason whatsoever, the Permitted Holders shall cease to own, directly or indirectly, at least 50.1% of the Equity Interests of Holdings having the power, directly or indirectly, to designate (and do so designate) a majority of the board of directors of Holdings; (c) at any time after a Qualified IPO and for

 

-6-


any reason whatsoever, any “person” or “group” (within the meaning of Rule 13d-5 of the Exchange Act as in effect on the Closing Date, but excluding any employee benefits plan of any Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries) other than the Permitted Holders shall beneficially own a percentage of the then outstanding Voting Equity Interests of Holdings that is more than the greater of (A) 35% of the outstanding Voting Equity Interests of Holdings and (B) the percentage of such Voting Equity Interests owned, directly or indirectly, beneficially by the Permitted Holders, or (d) at any time, a Change of Control (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) shall have occurred.

Class ” means (i) with respect to Commitments or Loans, those of such Commitments or Loans that have the same terms and conditions (without regard to differences in the Type of Loan or Interest Period or, unless such differences result in such Loans not being fungible for U.S. federal tax purposes, upfront fees or original issue discount or similar fees paid or payable in connection with such Commitments or Loans), and (ii) with respect to Lenders, those of such Lenders that have Commitments or Loans of a particular Class.

Closing Date ” means December 9, 2016.

Code ” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

Collateral ” means all of the “Collateral” referred to in the Collateral Documents and all of the other property and assets that are or are required under the terms of the Collateral Documents to be subject to Liens in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Collateral Agent ” means Royal Bank, acting through such of its Affiliates or branches as it may designate, in its capacity as collateral agent under any of the Loan Documents, or any successor collateral agent permitted by the terms hereof.

Collateral Documents ” means, collectively, the Security Agreement, the Intellectual Property Security Agreements, the Mortgages (if any), the Intercreditor Agreement, any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to this Agreement, each of the mortgages, collateral assignments, Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements, security agreements, pledge agreements or other similar agreements delivered to the Collateral Agent pursuant to Sections  6.12 , 6.14 or 6.16 , and each of the other agreements, instruments or documents that creates or purports to create a Lien in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties.

Commitment ” means, with respect to each Lender, such Lender’s Initial Commitment, Commitment Increase, New Commitment or Specified Refinancing Commitment.

Commitment Increase ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.14(a).

Committed Loan Notice ” means a notice of (a) a Borrowing, (b) a conversion of Loans from one Type to the other or (c) a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case, pursuant to Section  2.02(a) , which, if in writing, shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A .

Company Competitor ” means any Person that competes with the business of Holdings, the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries from time to time.

Compliance Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit  D or such other form as may be agreed between the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent.

 

-7-


Consolidated Cash Taxes ” means, for an applicable period with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the aggregate of all taxes based on income, profits or capital of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including (i) federal, state, franchise, excise and similar taxes and foreign withholding taxes, (ii) penalties and interest related to such taxes or arising from any tax examinations and (iii) taxes in respect of repatriated funds), paid in cash during such period, to the extent they exceed the amount of taxes deducted in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period.

Consolidated Current Assets ” means, with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, all assets of such Person that, in accordance with GAAP, would be classified as current assets on the balance sheet of a company conducting a business the same as or similar to that of such Person, after deducting appropriate and adequate reserves therefrom in each case in which a reserve is proper in accordance with GAAP, but excluding (i) cash, (ii) Cash Equivalents, (iii) Swap Contracts to the extent that the mark-to-market Swap Termination Value would be reflected as an asset on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, (iv) deferred financing fees and (v) amounts related to current or deferred Taxes (but excluding assets held for sale, loans (permitted) to third parties, pension assets, deferred bank fees and derivative financial instruments) (so long as the items described in clauses (iv) and (v) are non-cash items.

Consolidated Current Liabilities ” means, with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, all liabilities in accordance with GAAP that would be classified as current liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, but excluding (a) the current portion of Indebtedness (including the Swap Termination Value of any Swap Contracts) to the extent reflected as a liability on the consolidated balance sheet of such Person, (b) the current portion of interest, (c) accruals for current or deferred taxes based on income or profits, (d) accruals of any costs or expenses related to restructuring reserves or severance, (e) deferred revenue, (f) escrow account balances, (g) any letter of credit obligations, swing line loans or revolving loans under any revolving credit facility (including in respect of the First Lien Credit Agreement), (h) the current portion of pension liabilities, (i) liabilities in respect of unpaid earn outs and (j) amounts related to derivative financial instruments and assets held for sale.

Consolidated EBITDA ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the sum of:

(a) Consolidated Net Income; plus

(b) an amount which, in the determination of Consolidated Net Income for such period, has been deducted (and not added back) (or, in the case of amounts pursuant to clauses (vi), (x) or (xi) below, not already included in Consolidated Net Income) for, without duplication,

(i) total interest expense determined in accordance with GAAP (including, to the extent deducted and not added back in computing Consolidated Net Income, (A) amortization of original issue discount resulting from the issuance of Indebtedness at less than par, (B) all commissions, discounts and other fees and charges owed with respect to letters of credit or bankers’ acceptances, (C) non-cash interest payments, (D) the interest component of Capitalized Leases, (E) net payments, if any, made (less net amounts, if any, received) pursuant to interest rate Swap Contracts with respect to Indebtedness, (F) amortization or write-off of deferred financing fees, debt issuance costs, commissions, fees and expenses, including commitment, letter of credit and administrative fees and charges with respect to the Facility, the First Lien Facilities and with respect to other Indebtedness permitted to be incurred hereunder and (G) any expensing of bridge,

 

-8-


commitment and other financing fees, but excluding total interest expense associated with Synthetic Lease Obligations) and, to the extent not reflected in such total interest expense, any losses on hedging obligations or other derivative instruments entered into for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk, net of interest income or gains on such hedging obligations, and costs of surety bonds in connection with financing activities (whether amortized or immediately expensed),

(ii) provision for taxes based on income, profits or capital of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, including corporate income tax, federal, state, franchise, excise and similar taxes and foreign withholding taxes paid or accrued during such period including (A) penalties and interest related to such taxes or arising from any tax examinations and (B) in respect of repatriated funds,

(iii) depreciation and amortization expense and impairment charges (including amortization of intangible assets (including goodwill), deferred financing fees or costs, capitalized software expenditures (including capitalized software development expenditures), customer acquisition costs and incentive payments, conversion costs, and contract acquisition costs),

(iv) other non-cash charges, expenses or losses (excluding any such non-cash charge, expense or loss to the extent that it represents an accrual of or reserve for cash expenses in any future period, an amortization of a prepaid cash expense that was paid in a prior period, or write-off or write-down or reserves with respect to current assets but including (A) any non-cash increase in expenses resulting from the revaluation of inventory (including any impact of changes to inventory valuation policy methods including changes in capitalization and variances), (B) charges recognized in relation to post-retirement benefits or other charges necessary to adjust the defined benefit pension expense to reflect service cost only, (C) losses on minority interests owned by such Person, (D) the non-cash impact of accounting changes or restatements, (E) non-cash fair value adjustments in Investments, (F) the non-cash portion of “straight line” rent expense and (G) any other non-cash losses and expenses resulting from fair value accounting required by the applicable standard under GAAP and related interpretations) all as determined on a consolidated basis,

(v) restructuring charges, accruals or reserves and business optimization expense, including any restructuring costs and integration costs incurred in connection with the Transactions, Permitted Acquisitions and other acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02 after the Closing Date, project start-up costs, losses, charges and expenses relating to any strategic initiatives (including any multi-year strategic initiatives), costs related to the closure, relocation, reconfiguration and/or consolidation of facilities, reconfiguration of fixed assets for alternative uses and costs to relocate employees, integration and transaction costs, retention charges, severance, contract termination costs, recruiting and signing bonuses and expenses, future lease commitments, systems establishment costs, conversion costs, excess pension charges (including curtailments and modifications to pensions and post retirement employee benefit plans), and consulting fees, expenses attributable to the implementation of costs savings initiatives, costs associated with tax projects/audits and costs consisting of professional consulting or other fees relating to any of the foregoing,

 

-9-


(vi) the amount of “run rate” net cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and acquisition synergies, in each case, projected by the Borrowers in good faith to be realized (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis as though such items had been realized on the first day of such period) as a result of specified actions taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (in the good faith determination of the Borrowers), net of the amount of actual benefits realized during such period that are otherwise included in the calculation of Consolidated EBITDA from such actions; provided that (A) the Compliance Certificate required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.02 for the applicable period shall include a certification that such cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements, synergies are, in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers, (1) factually supportable and (2) reasonably anticipated to be realized within 18 months after the consummation of any operational change or the acquisition or disposition or the entry into any new agreements or amendments to existing agreements with customers or joint ventures, in each case, which is expected to result in such cost savings, expense reductions, operating improvements or synergies, as the case may be, (B) no cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies shall be added pursuant to this clause (vi) to the extent duplicative of any expenses or charges otherwise added to Consolidated Net Income, whether through a pro forma adjustment or otherwise, for such period and (C) projected amounts (that are not yet realized) may no longer be added in calculating Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (vi) to the extent occurring more than six full fiscal quarters after the specified action taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken in order to realize such projected cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies; provided that, amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (vi), other than to the extent in connection with the Transactions or the LDiscovery Transactions, shall not, when combined with amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to Section  1.09(b) , in the aggregate exceed 25% of Consolidated EBITDA (determined prior to giving effect to such amounts) in any four consecutive fiscal quarter period,

(vii) non-cash expenses resulting from any employee benefit or management compensation plan or the grant of stock and stock options and other equity and equity-based interests to employees or other service providers of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a written plan or agreement (including expenses arising from the grant of stock and stock options and other equity and equity-based interests prior to the Closing Date) or the treatment of such options and other equity and equity-based interests under variable plan accounting,

(viii) (A) management, consulting and advisory fees, termination payments, transaction fees, indemnities and expenses permitted under Section  7.08(c) and (B) the amount of expenses, if any relating to payments made to holders of stock options or other compensatory equity-based awards in Holdings or any Parent Holding Company in connection with, or as a result of, any distribution being made to equity holders or unit holders of such Person or its direct or indirect parent companies, which payments are being made to compensate such holders of compensatory equity-based awards as though they were shareholders or unit holders at the time entitled to share in such distribution, in each case to the extent permitted by this Agreement,

(ix) any costs or expenses incurred pursuant to any management equity plan or share or unit option plan or any other management, director or employee benefit plan or agreement or share or unit subscription or shareholder or similar agreement, to the extent such costs or expenses are funded with cash proceeds contributed to the capital of a Borrower or the Net Cash Proceeds of any issuance of Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of a Borrower (or any Parent Holding Company thereof),

 

-10-


(x) proceeds from business interruption insurance (to the extent not reflected as revenue or income in Consolidated Net Income and to the extent that the related loss was deducted in the determination of Consolidated Net Income),

(xi) charges, losses, lost profits, expenses or write-offs to the extent indemnified or insured by a third party, including expenses covered by indemnification provisions in connection with the Transaction, a Permitted Acquisition or any other acquisition permitted by Section  7.02 or any transaction permitted by Section  7.04 , in each case, to the extent that coverage has not been denied and so long as such amounts are actually reimbursed to a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary in cash within one year after the related amount is first added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this clause (xi) (and if not so reimbursed within one year, such amount shall be deducted from Consolidated EBITDA during the next measurement period),

(xii) Synthetic Lease Obligations, to the extent deducted as an expense in such period,

(xiii) any losses realized upon a Disposition of property (including abandoned or discontinued operations or product lines) outside of the ordinary course of business,

(xiv) cash receipts (or any netting arrangements resulting in reduced cash expenses) not included in Consolidated EBITDA in any period to the extent non-cash gains relating to such receipts were deducted in the calculation of Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to clause (c) below for any previous period and not added back,

(xv) net realized losses relating to amounts denominated in foreign currencies resulting from the application of FASB ASC 830 (or any similar pronouncement) (including net realized losses from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items, net of realized gains from related Swap Contracts) (entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice),

(xvi) cash expenses relating to earn outs and similar obligations including the LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment and any other earn-out obligations incurred prior to the date thereof or in connection with any acquisition, buyout or other investment paid or accrued during the applicable period, including any mark-to-market adjustments,

(xvii) Initial Public Company Costs,

(xviii) any loss relating to Swap Contracts (excluding Swap Contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice),

(xix) the amount of any non-controlling interest expense consisting of Subsidiary income attributable to minority equity interests of third parties in any non-wholly owned Subsidiary deducted (and not added back) in such period in calculating Consolidated Net Income, excluding cash distributions in respect thereof, and

 

-11-


(xx) compensation and reimbursement of expenses of non-management members of the board of directors (or similar body) of such Person (other than employees of the Sponsor);

minus

(c) an amount which, in the determination of Consolidated Net Income, has been included for:

(i) other non-cash income or gains, including (A) any non-cash portion of “straight line” rent expense, (B) credits recognized in relation to post-retirement benefits or other credits necessary to adjust the defined benefit pension income to reflect service cost only, (C) gains on minority interests owned by any Person, (D) the non-cash impact of accounting changes or restatements and (E) non-cash fair value adjustments in Investments but excluding (x) accrual of revenue in the ordinary course, (y) any such items in respect of which cash was received in a prior period or will be received in a future period (and, in the case of cash that was received in a prior period, such amounts previously reduced Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be added back pursuant to clause (b) of this definition)) or (z) any such items which represent the reversal in such period of any accrual of, or reserve for, anticipated cash charges in any prior period where such accrual or reserve is no longer required (and where such accrual or reserve previously reduced Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be added back pursuant to clause (b) of this definition)) and (F) any other non-cash gains and income resulting from fair value accounting required by the applicable standard under GAAP and related interpretations, all as determined on a consolidated basis,

(ii) any gains realized upon the Disposition of property (including abandoned or discontinued operations or product lines) outside of the ordinary course of business,

(iii) the amount of cash received in such period in respect of any non-cash income or gain in a prior period (and such non-cash income or gain previously increased Consolidated Net Income in a prior period (and would not have been required to be deducted pursuant to clause (c)(i) of this definition)),

(iv) net realized gains relating to amounts denominated in foreign currencies resulting from the application of FASB ASC 830 (or any similar pronouncement) (including net realized gains from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items, net of realized losses from related Swap Contracts) (entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice), and

(v) any gain related to Swap Contracts (excluding Swap Contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business or consistent with past practice).

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary and without duplication of any adjustment provided for in clauses (a) to (c) above, Consolidated EBITDA shall be deemed to be $21,300,000 for the fiscal quarter ended September 30, 2016, $20,900,000 for the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2016, $21,100,000 for the fiscal quarter ended March 31, 2016 and $21,900,000 for the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2015.

 

-12-


Consolidated Net Income ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to any Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, net income, excluding, without duplication:

(i) extraordinary, unusual or non-recurring charges, expenses, losses or gains (including (A) accruals for amounts payable and payments under executive employment agreements, severance costs, relocation costs, signing, retention and completion bonuses and (B) gains and losses realized on disposition of property outside of the ordinary course of business);

(ii) any amounts attributable to Investments in any non-wholly owned Restricted Subsidiary, Unrestricted Subsidiary or Joint Venture (other than a Guarantor or any Person at the Closing Date accounted for by the equity method of accounting; provided that to the extent not already excluded or deducted as minority interest expense, payments made in respect of interests of third parties shall be excluded) to the extent that such amounts have not been distributed in cash or Cash Equivalents to such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such applicable period;

(iii) (x) any net unrealized gains and losses resulting from fair value accounting (including as a result of the mark-to-market of obligations of Swap Contracts and other derivative instruments) and (y) any net unrealized gains and losses relating to mark-to-market of amounts denominated in foreign currencies (including net unrealized gain and losses from exchange rate fluctuations on intercompany balances and balance sheet items), in each case, to the extent included in Consolidated Net Income;

(iv) the income (or loss) of any Person accrued prior to the date it becomes a Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower or is merged into or consolidated with a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries (except to the extent required for any calculation of Consolidated EBITDA on a Pro Forma Basis);

(v) [reserved];

(vi) the net income for such period shall not include the cumulative effect of a change in or the adoption, application or modification of accounting principles or policies during such period, whether effected through a cumulative effect adjustment or a retroactive application;

(vii) effects of adjustments (including the effects of such adjustments pushed down to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries) in any line item in such Person’s consolidated financial statements resulting from the application of purchase accounting (including any step-ups with respect to re-valuing assets and liabilities) in relation to the Transactions and any investment, acquisition, merger or consolidation (or resulting from any reorganization or restructuring) that is consummated after the Closing Date or the depreciation, amortization or write-off of any amounts thereof shall be excluded;

(viii) Transaction Costs; and

(ix) transaction fees and expenses incurred, or amortization thereof, in connection with, to the extent permitted hereunder, any Investment, any Debt Issuance, any Equity Issuance, any Disposition, any Casualty Event, recapitalization or any amendments or waivers of the Loan Documents the First Lien Facility Documentation, documentation governing other securities, credit facilities or debt instruments (including, in each case listed above, any amendments or other modifications thereto) and Permitted Refinancings in connection therewith, in each case, whether or not consummated.

 

-13-


There shall be excluded from Consolidated Net Income for any period (A) the accounting effects of adjustments to inventory, property and equipment, software and other intangible assets and deferred revenue required or permitted by GAAP and related authoritative pronouncements (including the effects of such adjustments pushed down to the Borrowers and/or the Restricted Subsidiaries), as a result of any acquisition consummated prior to the Closing Date, the Transactions and any Permitted Acquisitions (or Investments similar to those made for Permitted Acquisitions) or any Investment permitted under Section  7.02 or the amortization or write-off of any amounts thereof and (B) any income (loss) for such period attributable to the early extinguishment of (i) Indebtedness, (ii) obligations under any Swap Contracts and (iii) other derivative instruments.

Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments ” means, as of any date for the applicable period ending on such date with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the sum of all scheduled payments of principal made in cash during such period on Funded Indebtedness that constitutes Funded Debt (including the implied principal component of payments due on Capitalized Leases during such period to the extent not deducted in the calculation of Consolidated Net Income), less the reduction in such scheduled payments resulting from voluntary prepayments pursuant to Section  2.05(a) or mandatory prepayments required pursuant to Section  2.05(b) , in each case as applied pursuant to Section  2.05 , as determined in accordance with GAAP.

Consolidated Total Assets ” means, the consolidated total assets of the Borrowers and their respective Restricted Subsidiaries as set forth on the consolidated balance sheet of the Borrowers as of the most recent period for which financial statements were required to have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) (and, in the case of any determination relating to any incurrence of Indebtedness or any Investment, Restricted Payment, Permitted Acquisition or other acquisition, on a Pro Forma Basis including any property or asset being acquired or disposed of in connection therewith); provided that, at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma consolidated financial information of the Borrowers and their respective Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule  1.01(f) hereto.

Consulting Services Agreement ” means those certain Consulting Services Agreements in the form made available to the Arrangers on or around the Closing Date, between Holdings, on the one hand, and the Sponsor, on the other hand, dated as of December 22, 2015, as such consulting services agreement may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent that such amendments, supplements or modifications (i) do not increase the obligation of Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries to make payments thereunder and (ii) are otherwise permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

Contract Consideration ” has the meaning given it in clause (b)(xv) of the definition of “Excess Cash Flow.”

Contractual Obligation ” means, as to any Person, any provision of any security issued by such Person or of any agreement, loan agreement, indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, lease, instrument or other undertaking to which such Person is a party or by which it or any of its property is bound.

Control ” means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise, and “ Controlling ” and “ Controlled ” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

-14-


Control Investment Affiliate ” means, as to any Person, any other Person that (a) directly or indirectly, is in Control of, is Controlled by, or is under common Control with, such Person and (b) is organized by such Person primarily for the purpose of making equity investments in one or more companies.

Controlled Foreign Subsidiary ” means any Foreign Subsidiary that is a “controlled foreign corporation” within the meaning of Section 957 of the Code.

Credit Extension ” means a Borrowing.

Cumulative Credit ” means, at any date, an amount, not less than zero in the aggregate, determined on a cumulative basis equal to the sum of (without duplication):

(a) $15,000,000, plus

(b) the percentage of Excess Cash Flow (if any) not required to be applied towards repayment of the Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(b) (with such amount determined without giving effect to the minimum threshold set forth in Section  2.05(b)(i)(A) ), determined for the period (taken as one accounting period) commencing with the fiscal year of the Borrowers ending December 31, 2017 to the end of the fiscal year most recently ended in respect of which a Compliance Certificate has been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) , plus

(c) the Net Cash Proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance after the Closing Date (other than Cure Amounts, but including the Net Cash Proceeds of issuances or incurrences of Indebtedness or Disqualified Equity Interests by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries owed or issued, as applicable, to a Person other than a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary after the Closing Date which shall have been subsequently exchanged for or converted into Permitted Equity Issuances of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) at such time and any direct contribution to the common capital of a Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, plus

(d) in the event that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit has been applied to make an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(s) in connection with the designation of a Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary, the acquisition of Equity Interests of an Unrestricted Subsidiary or the acquisition of any Investment, an amount equal to the aggregate amount received by a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in cash and Cash Equivalents from: (i) the sale (other than to any of the Restricted Subsidiaries of a Borrower) of any such Equity Interests of any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or any such Investment less any amounts that would be deducted pursuant to clause (a)(ii) of the definition of “Net Cash Proceeds” if such sale constituted a Disposition, (ii) any dividend or other distribution by any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or received in respect of any such Investment or (iii) interest, returns of principal, repayments and similar payments by any such Unrestricted Subsidiary or received in respect of any such Investment, plus

(e) in the event that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit has been applied to make an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(s) in connection with the designation of a Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary and such Unrestricted Subsidiary is thereafter redesignated as a Restricted Subsidiary or is merged, consolidated or amalgamated with or into, or transfers or conveys its assets to, or is liquidated into, a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, an amount equal to the fair market value of the Investments of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries in such Unrestricted Subsidiary at the time of such redesignation, combination or transfer (or of the assets transferred or conveyed, as applicable), plus

 

-15-


(f) any Declined Amounts (other than any Declined Amounts attributable to a prepayment that is declined by an Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate)), plus

(g) an amount equal to any returns in cash and Cash Equivalents (including dividends, interest, distributions, returns of principal, sale proceeds, repayments, income and similar amounts) actually received by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of any Investments pursuant to Section  7.02(s) ; provided that in no case shall such amount exceed the amount of such Investment made using the Cumulative Credit pursuant to Section  7.02(s) , plus

(h) the proceeds and the fair market value (as reasonably determined by the Borrowers) of marketable securities or other property contributed to a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary since Closing Date from any Person (other than Holdings, a Borrower or its Subsidiaries);

as such amount shall be reduced dollar for dollar from time to time to the extent that all or a portion of the Cumulative Credit is applied prior to such date to make Investments, Restricted Payments or prepayments of Junior Financing to the extent permitted hereunder.

Cure Amount ” has the meaning given to such term in the First Lien Credit Agreement.

Debt Fund Affiliate ” means any Affiliate of the Sponsor (other than Holdings and its Subsidiaries or a natural person) that is primarily engaged in, or advises funds or other investment vehicles that are engaged in, making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans, bonds and similar extensions of credit or securities in the ordinary course and with respect to which the Sponsor does not, directly or indirectly, possess the power to direct or cause the direction of the investment policies of any such Affiliate.

Debt Issuance ” means the issuance by any Person of any Indebtedness for borrowed money.

Debtor Relief Laws ” means the Bankruptcy Code of the United States, and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, or similar debtor relief Laws of the United States or other applicable jurisdictions from time to time in effect and affecting the rights of creditors generally.

Declined Amounts ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Declining Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Default ” means any event or condition that constitutes an Event of Default or that, with the giving of any notice, the passage of time, or both, would be an Event of Default.

Default Rate ” means an interest rate equal to (after as well as before judgment), (a) with respect to any overdue principal for any Loan, the applicable interest rate for such Loan plus 2.00% per annum ( provided that with respect to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the determination of the applicable interest rate is subject to Section  2.02(c) to the extent that Eurocurrency Rate Loans may not be converted to, or continued as, Eurocurrency Rate Loans, pursuant thereto) and (b) with respect to any other overdue amount, including overdue interest, the Base Rate plus the Applicable Rate with respect to the Initial Loans plus 2.00% per annum, in each case, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws.

 

-16-


Defaulting Lender ” means, subject to Section  2.17(b) , any Lender that (a) has failed to perform any of its funding obligations hereunder, including in respect of its Loans within three Business Days of the date required to be funded by it hereunder, (b) has notified the Borrower Representative or the Administrative Agent that it does not intend to comply with its funding obligations or has made a public statement to that effect with respect to its funding obligations hereunder or under the First Lien Credit Agreement, (c) has failed, within three Business Days after reasonable request by the Administrative Agent, to confirm in a manner satisfactory to the Administrative Agent that it will comply with its funding obligations ( provided that such Lender shall cease to be a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this clause (c) upon receipt of such confirmation by the Administrative Agent) or (d) has, or has a direct or indirect parent company that has, (i) become the subject of a proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, (ii) had a receiver, conservator, trustee, administrator, assignee for the benefit of creditors or similar Person charged with reorganization or liquidation of its business or a custodian appointed for it, (iii) taken any action in furtherance of, or indicated its consent to, approval of or acquiescence in any such proceeding or appointment; or (iv) become subject to a Bail-In Action; provided that no Lender shall be a Defaulting Lender solely by virtue of (x) the ownership or acquisition by a Governmental Authority of any Equity Interest in that Lender or any direct or indirect parent company thereof so long as such ownership interest does not result in or provide such Lender with immunity from the jurisdiction of courts within the United States or from the enforcement of judgments or writs of attachment on its assets or permit such Lender (or such Governmental Authority) to reject, repudiate, disavow or disaffirm any contracts or agreements made with such Lender, (y) the occurrence of any of the events described in clause (d)(i), (d)(ii), (d)(iii) or (d)(iv) of this definition which in each case has been dismissed or terminated prior to the date of this Agreement or (z) the occurrence of an Undisclosed Administration. Any determination by the Administrative Agent that a Lender is a Defaulting Lender under any one or more of clauses (a) through (d) above shall be conclusive and binding absent manifest error, and such Lender shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender (subject to Section  2.17(b) ) upon delivery of written notice of such determination to the Borrower Representative and each Lender.

Designated Non-Cash Consideration ” means the fair market value of non-cash consideration received by a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with a Disposition made pursuant to Section  7.05(s) that is designated as “ Designated Non-Cash Consideration ” on the date received pursuant to a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers setting forth the basis of such fair market value (with the amount of Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of any Disposition being reduced for purposes of Section  7.05(s) to the extent a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries converts the same to cash or Cash Equivalents within 180 days following the closing of the applicable Disposition).

Disposition ” or “ Dispose ” means the sale, transfer, license, lease or other disposition of any property by any Person (including any sale and leaseback transaction and any issuance of Equity Interests by a Restricted Subsidiary of such Person), including any sale, assignment, transfer or other disposal, with or without recourse, of any notes or accounts receivable or any rights and claims associated therewith; provided , however , that “Disposition” and “Dispose” shall not be deemed to include any issuance by Holdings of any of its Equity Interests to another Person.

Disqualified Equity Interests ” means any Equity Interest which, by its terms (or by the terms of any security or other Equity Interests into which it is convertible or for which it is exchangeable), or upon the happening of any event or condition (a) matures or is mandatorily redeemable (other than solely for Equity Interests that are not Disqualified Equity Interests), pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise (except as a result of a change of control or asset sale so long as any rights of the holders thereof upon the occurrence of a change of control or asset sale event shall be subject to the prior repayment in full of the Loans and all other Obligations that are accrued and payable and the termination of the Commitments), (b) is redeemable at the option of the holder thereof (except as a result of a change

 

-17-


of control or asset sale so long as any rights of the holders thereof upon the occurrence of a change of control or asset sale event shall be subject to the prior repayment in full of the Loans and all other Obligations that are accrued and payable), in whole or in part, (c) provides for the scheduled payments of dividends in cash or (d) is or becomes convertible into or exchangeable for Indebtedness or any other Equity Interests that would constitute Disqualified Equity Interests, in each case, prior to the date that is 91 days after the Latest Maturity Date of the Facility at the time of issuance of the respective Disqualified Equity Interests; provided that if such Equity Interests are issued pursuant to a plan for the benefit of employees or other service providers of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company), a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries or by any such plan to such employees, such Equity Interests shall not constitute Disqualified Equity Interests solely because they may be required to be repurchased by Holdings or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries in order to satisfy applicable statutory or regulatory obligations or in connection with such employee’s or other service provider’s termination, death or disability.

Disqualified Institution ” means (a) each bank, financial institution or other institutional lender or investor identified on a written list (if any) made available to the Administrative Agent on or prior to October 21, 2016, (b) any Company Competitor specified by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent in writing from time to time and (c) known Affiliates of any such Persons described in clauses (a) and (b) that are readily identifiable as Affiliates of such Persons solely based on the similarity of such Affiliate’s name (in each case, other than a bona fide debt fund or an investment vehicle that is engaged in the making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans, bonds and similar extensions of credit or securities in the ordinary course and with respect to which the lender or investor described in clause (a) or (b), as applicable, does not, directly or indirectly, possess the power to direct or cause the direction of the investment policies of such entity), which designations shall not apply retroactively to disqualify any Persons that have previously acquired an assignment or participation interest in the Loans or the Commitments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, (i) the assignment by any Lender of its Loans and/or Commitments to a Disqualified Institution shall be prohibited only to the extent the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to any requesting Lender (or potential Lender) and (ii) any Disqualified Institution shall be prohibited from being a Participant only to the extent the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to the Lenders.

Dollar ” or “ $ ” means lawful money of the United States.

Dutch Auction ” means an auction (an “ Auction ”) conducted by any Borrower or one of its Subsidiaries in order to purchase any Loans under a Tranche (the “ Purchase ”) in accordance with the following procedures or such other procedures as may be agreed to between the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers:

(a) Notice Procedures . In connection with any Auction, the Borrower Representative shall provide notification to the Administrative Agent (for distribution to the Appropriate Lenders) of the Loans under such Tranche that will be the subject of the Auction (an “ Auction Notice ”). Each Auction Notice shall be in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and shall specify (i) the total cash value of the bid, in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount (the “ Auction Amount ”) and (ii) the discounts to par, which shall be expressed as a range of percentages of the par principal amount of the Loans under such Tranche at issue (the “ Discount Range ”), representing the range of purchase prices that could be paid in the Auction.

(b) Reply Procedures . In connection with any Auction, each applicable Lender may, in its sole discretion, participate in such Auction by providing the Administrative Agent with a notice of participation (the “ Return Bid ”) which shall be in a form reasonably acceptable to the

 

-18-


Administrative Agent and shall specify (i) a discount to par that must be expressed as a price (the “ Reply Discount ”), which must be within the Discount Range, and (ii) a principal amount of the applicable Loans such Lender is willing to sell in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount (the “ Reply Amount ”). Lenders may only submit one Return Bid per Auction. In addition to the Return Bid, each Lender wishing to participate in such Auction must execute and deliver, to be held in escrow by the Administrative Agent, an assignment and acceptance agreement in a form reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

(c) Acceptance Procedures . Based on the Reply Discounts and Reply Amounts received by the Administrative Agent, the Administrative Agent, in consultation with the Borrowers, will determine the applicable discount (the “ Applicable Discount ”) for the Auction, which shall be the lowest Reply Discount for which any Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, can complete the Auction at the Auction Amount; provided that, in the event that the Reply Amounts are insufficient to allow any Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, to complete a purchase of the entire Auction Amount (any such Auction, a “ Failed Auction ”), such Borrower or such Subsidiary shall either, at its election, (i) withdraw the Auction or (ii) complete the Auction at an Applicable Discount equal to the highest Reply Discount. A Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall purchase the applicable Loans (or the respective portions thereof) from each applicable Lender with a Reply Discount that is equal to or greater than the Applicable Discount (“ Qualifying Bids ”) at the Applicable Discount; provided that if the aggregate proceeds required to purchase all applicable Loans subject to Qualifying Bids would exceed the Auction Amount for such Auction, a Borrower or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall purchase such Loans at the Applicable Discount ratably based on the principal amounts of such Qualifying Bids (subject to adjustment for rounding as specified by the Administrative Agent). Each participating Lender will receive notice of a Qualifying Bid as soon as reasonably practicable but in no case later than five Business Days from the date the Return Bid was due.

(d) Additional Procedures . Once initiated by an Auction Notice, a Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries, as applicable, may not withdraw an Auction other than a Failed Auction. Furthermore, in connection with any Auction, upon submission by a Lender of a Qualifying Bid, such Lender will be obligated to sell the entirety or its allocable portion of the Reply Amount, as the case may be, at the Applicable Discount. The Purchase shall be consummated pursuant to and in accordance with Section  10.07 and, to the extent not otherwise provided herein, shall otherwise be consummated pursuant to procedures (including as to timing, rounding and minimum amounts, Interest Periods, and other notices by such Borrower or such Subsidiaries, as applicable) reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers.

EEA Financial Institution ” means (a) any credit institution or investment firm established in any EEA Member Country which is subject to the supervision of an EEA Resolution Authority, (b) any entity established in an EEA Member Country which is a parent of an institution described in clause (a) of this definition, or (c) any financial institution established in an EEA Member Country which is a subsidiary of an institution described in clauses (a) or (b) of this definition and is subject to consolidated supervision with its parent.

EEA Member Country ” means any of the member states of the European Union, Iceland, Liechtenstein, and Norway.

EEA Resolution Authority ” means any public administrative authority or any person entrusted with public administrative authority of any EEA Member Country (including any delegee) having responsibility for the resolution of any EEA Financial Institution.

 

-19-


Eligible Assignee ” means any Person that meets the requirements to be an assignee under Section  10.07(b) (subject to receipt of such consents, if any, as may be required for the assignment of the applicable Loan and/or Commitments to such Person under Section  10.07(b)(iii) ).

Environmental Laws ” means any and all applicable federal, state, local and foreign statutes, laws, including common law, regulations, ordinances, rules, judgments, orders, decrees, permits, concessions, grants, franchises, licenses or governmental restrictions relating to pollution, the protection of the environment, human health (to the extent relating to exposure to Hazardous Materials) or safety, including those related to Hazardous Materials, air emissions and discharges to public pollution control systems.

Environmental Liability ” means any liability, contingent or otherwise (including any liability for damages, costs of environmental remediation, monitoring or oversight by a Governmental Authority, fines, penalties or indemnities), of the Borrowers, any other Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries directly or indirectly resulting from or based upon (a) any actual or alleged violation of any Environmental Law, (b) the generation, use, handling, transportation, storage, treatment or disposal of any Hazardous Materials, (c) human exposure to any Hazardous Materials, (d) the release or threatened release of any Hazardous Materials into the environment or (e) any contract, agreement or other binding consensual arrangement pursuant to which liability is assumed or imposed with respect to any of the foregoing.

Environmental Permit ” means any permit, approval, identification number, license or other authorization required under any Environmental Law.

Equity Contribution ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions”.

Equity Interests ” means, with respect to any Person, all of the shares, interests, rights, participations or other equivalents (however designated) of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests or units in) such Person and all of the warrants, options or other rights for the purchase, acquisition or exchange from such Person of any of the foregoing (including through convertible securities); provided that any instrument evidencing Indebtedness convertible or exchangeable for Equity Interests shall not be deemed to be Equity Interests unless and until such instrument is so converted or exchanged, except, solely for purposes of a pledge of Equity Interests in connection with this Agreement, to the extent such instrument could be treated as “stock” of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary for purposes of Treasury Regulation Section 1.956-2(c)(2).

Equity Issuance ” means any issuance by any Person to any other Person of (a) its Equity Interests for cash, (b) any of its Equity Interests pursuant to the exercise of options or warrants, (c) any of its Equity Interests pursuant to the conversion of any debt securities to equity or (d) any options or warrants relating to its Equity Interests.

ERISA ” means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, and the rules and regulations thereunder, each as amended or modified from time to time.

ERISA Affiliate ” means any Person who together with any Loan Party is treated as a single employer within the meaning of Section 414(b) or (c) of the Code (and Sections 414(m) and (o) of the Code for purposes of provisions relating to Section 412 of the Code) or Section 4001 of ERISA.

ERISA Event ” means (a) a Reportable Event with respect to a Plan; (b) the withdrawal of any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate from a Plan subject to Section 4063 of ERISA during a plan year in which such entity was a “substantial employer” (as defined in Section 4001(a)(2) of ERISA) or a

 

-20-


cessation of operations that is treated as such a withdrawal under Section 4062(e) of ERISA; (c) a complete or partial withdrawal by any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate from a Multiemployer Plan or written notification that a Multiemployer Plan is “in reorganization” (within the meaning of Section 4241 of ERISA) or “insolvent” (within the meaning of Section 4245 of ERISA); (d) the filing of a written notice of intent to terminate or the treatment of a Plan amendment as a termination under Section 4041 or 4041A of ERISA, respectively, (e) the institution by the PBGC of proceedings to terminate a Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (f) an event or condition which constitutes grounds under Section 4042 of ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee to administer, any Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (g) the determination that any Plan is considered an at-risk plan within the meaning of Section 430 of the Code or Section 303 of ERISA; (h) the determination that any Multiemployer Plan is considered a plan in “endangered status” or “critical status” within the meaning of Section 432 of the Code or Section 305 of ERISA; (i) the imposition of any liability under Title IV of ERISA, other than for PBGC premiums due but not delinquent under Section 4007 of ERISA, upon any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate; (j) the conditions for the imposition of a lien under Section 430(k) of the Code or Section 303(k) of ERISA shall have been met with respect to any Plan; or (k) Foreign Benefit Event.

EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule ” means the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule published by the Loan Market Association (or any successor person), as in effect from time to time.

Eurocurrency Rate ” means, with respect to any Credit Extension, LIBOR.

Eurocurrency Rate Loan ” means a Loan which bears interest at a rate based on the applicable Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate.

Event of Default ” has the meaning specified in Section  8.01 .

Excess Cash Flow ” means, with respect to any Excess Cash Flow Period, an amount, not less than zero, equal to:

(a) the sum, without duplication, of (i) Consolidated Net Income of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such Excess Cash Flow Period, plus (ii) the amount of all non-cash charges (including depreciation, amortization and deferred tax expense) deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iii) the aggregate net amount of non-cash loss on Dispositions by the Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such Excess Cash Flow Period (other than sales of inventory in the ordinary course of business), to the extent deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iv) to the extent not otherwise included in determining Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of cash receipts for such period attributable to Swap Contracts or other derivative instruments (other than commodity Swap Contracts); minus

(b) the sum, without duplication (in each case, for Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis), of:

(i) without duplication of amounts deducted pursuant to clause (xv) below in prior fiscal years, the amount of Capital Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property to the extent not expensed or accrued during such period and Capitalized Software Expenditures made in cash or accrued during such period, except to the extent that such Capital Expenditures and acquisitions were financed by the issuance or incurrence of Indebtedness (other than revolving Indebtedness) by, or the issuance of Equity Interests by, or the making of capital contributions to, the Borrowers or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries or using the proceeds of any Disposition outside the ordinary course of business or other proceeds not included in Consolidated Net Income;

 

-21-


(ii) the amount of Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments (except to the extent financed with the proceeds of Funded Debt other than any revolving loans under the First Lien Credit Agreement) and, to the extent not otherwise deducted from Consolidated Net Income, Consolidated Cash Taxes, in each case, actually made during such period;

(iii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, Restricted Payments made in cash during such period by the Borrowers to the extent that such Restricted Payments are made under Sections 7.06(e) , (h) , (j)(i), (k) and (l) , solely to the extent made, directly or indirectly, with the net cash proceeds from events or circumstances that were included in the calculation of Consolidated Net Income;

(iv) the aggregate amount of voluntary or mandatory permanent principal payments or mandatory repurchases of (A) Indebtedness for borrowed money and (B) the principal component of payments in respect of Capitalized Leases of the Borrower Parties (in each case, excluding the Obligations and the First Lien Loans) made by the Borrower Parties during such period; provided that (A) such prepayments or repurchases are otherwise permitted hereunder, (B) if such Indebtedness consists of a revolving line of credit, the commitments under such line of credit are permanently reduced by the amount of such prepayment or repurchase, and (C) such prepayments or repurchases are not made, directly or indirectly, using (1) proceeds, payments or any other amounts available from events or circumstances that were not included in determining Consolidated Net Income during such period (including any proceeds from Indebtedness) or (2) the Cumulative Credit;

(v) (A) the aggregate amount of any premium, make-whole or penalty payments actually paid in cash by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries during such period that are required to be made in connection with any prepayment or satisfaction and discharge of Indebtedness of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries (except to the extent financed with the proceeds of Funded Debt other than any revolving loans under the First Lien Credit Agreement) to the extent that the amount so prepaid, satisfied or discharged is not deducted from Consolidated Net Income for purposes of calculating Excess Cash Flow and (B) to the extent included in determining Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of any income (or loss) for such period attributable to the early extinguishment of Indebtedness, Swap Contracts or other derivative instruments (other than commodity Swap Contracts);

(vi) cash payments made by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiaries during such period (to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income) in satisfaction of non-current liabilities (excluding payments of Indebtedness for borrowed money) not made directly or indirectly using (1) proceeds, payments or any other amounts available from events or circumstances that were not included in determining Consolidated Net Income during such period (including any proceeds from Indebtedness) or (2) the Cumulative Credit;

(vii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, fees, expenses and purchase price adjustments paid in cash during such period by the Borrower Parties in connection with the Transactions (other than any LDiscovery Acquisition

 

-22-


Earnout Payment) or, to the extent permitted hereunder, any Investment permitted under Section  7.02 , any Disposition permitted by Section  7.05 , Equity Issuance or Debt Issuance (whether or not consummated) and any Restricted Payment made in cash by any Borrower Party pursuant to Section  7.06(g) to pay any of the foregoing;

(viii) to the extent not deducted in arriving at Consolidated Net Income, the aggregate amount of expenditures actually made in cash by the Borrower Parties during such period (including expenditures for payment of financing fees) to the extent such expenditures are (1) not expensed during such period and (2) made with cash from operations;

(ix) without duplication of amounts deducted pursuant to clause (xv) below in prior fiscal years, cash from operations used by the Borrower Parties or committed to be used by the Borrower Parties to consummate a Permitted Acquisition or acquisition, in each case, as permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(x) the amount of cash payments made in respect of pensions and other postemployment benefits in such period to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income;

(xi) the amount of cash expenditures in respect of Swap Contracts during such fiscal year to the extent they exceed the amount of expenditures expensed in determining Consolidated Net Income for such period;

(xii) the aggregate principal amount of all mandatory prepayments of the Facility made during such Excess Cash Flow Period pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) or any amounts offered pursuant to Section  2.05(c) and constituting Declined Amounts, or reinvestments of Net Cash Proceeds in lieu thereof, to the extent that the applicable Net Cash Proceeds resulted in an increase of Consolidated Net Income (and are not in excess of such increase) for such Excess Cash Flow Period;

(xiii) the amount representing accrued expenses for cash payments (including with respect to retirement plan obligations) that are not paid in cash during such Excess Cash Flow Period; provided that such amounts will be added to Excess Cash Flow for the following Excess Cash Flow Period to the extent not paid in cash within six months after the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period (and no future deduction shall be made for purposes of this definition when such amounts are paid in cash in any future period);

(xiv) the aggregate net amount of any non-cash gains and credits to the extent included in arriving at Consolidated Net Income;

(xv) without duplication of amounts deducted from Excess Cash Flow in other periods, the aggregate consideration required to be paid in cash by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries pursuant to binding contracts (the “ Contract Consideration ”) entered into prior to or during such period relating to Permitted Acquisitions (or similar acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02) , Capital Expenditures, Capitalized Software Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property (to the extent not expensed) to be consummated or made during the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters of the Borrowers following the end of such period; provided that to the extent that the aggregate amount of cash actually utilized to finance such Permitted Acquisitions (or similar acquisitions permitted under Section  7.02) , Capital Expenditures, Capitalized

 

-23-


Software Expenditures or acquisitions of intellectual property during such period of four consecutive fiscal quarters (A) is financed by the issuance or incurrence of Indebtedness by, or the issuance of Equity Interests by, or the making of capital contributions to, a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries or using the proceeds of any Disposition outside the ordinary course of business or other proceeds not included in Consolidated Net Income or (B) if not so financed, is less than the Contract Consideration, then the portion so financed in clause (A) or the amount of such shortfall in clause (B) shall be added to the calculation of Excess Cash Flow, at the end of such period of four consecutive fiscal quarters;

(xvi) at the option of the Borrowers, any amounts in respect of Investments and acquisitions (including related earnouts and similar payments) which could have been deducted pursuant to clauses (vii) or (ix) above if made in such period, but which are made after the end of such period and prior to the date upon which a mandatory prepayment for such period would be required under Section  2.05(b) (it being understood that such amounts shall not reduce Excess Cash Flow in such subsequent period);

(xvii) reimbursable or insured expenses incurred during such fiscal year to the extent that such reimbursement has not yet been received and to the extent not deducted in arriving at such Consolidated Net Income;

(xviii) amounts received from customers in the ordinary course of business representing an overfunding or overpayment of amounts owed to the Borrower Parties; and

(xix) the amount of Tax distributions actually distributed for such period pursuant to Section  7.06(e)(ii) ;

minus

(c) any increase in Net Working Capital during such Excess Cash Flow Period (measured as the excess, if any, of Net Working Capital at the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period minus Net Working Capital at the beginning of such Excess Cash Flow Period) or increases in long-term accounts receivable and decreases in the long term portion of deferred revenue for such period, except as a result of the reclassification of items from short-term to long-term or vice versa; plus

(d) any decrease in Net Working Capital during such Excess Cash Flow Period (measured as the excess, if any, of Net Working Capital at the beginning of such Excess Cash Flow Period minus Net Working Capital at the end of such Excess Cash Flow Period) or decreases in long-term accounts receivable and increases in the long-term portion of deferred revenue for such period, except as a result of the reclassification of items from short-term to long-term or vice versa;

provided that for purposes of calculating any increase or decrease in Net Working Capital, long-term accounts receivables or long-term portion of deferred revenue for such period pursuant to clauses (c) and (d) above, (1) any such increase or decrease shall be disregarded if attributable to property Disposed by Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries during such period and (2) the Net Working Capital, long-term accounts receivables or long-term portion of deferred revenue at the beginning of such period shall include such amounts as set forth on the opening balance sheet of any entity acquired (or combined into) Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries at the time of any Permitted Acquisition or similar acquisition consummated during such period.

 

-24-


Excess Cash Flow Period ” means any fiscal year of the Borrowers, commencing with the fiscal year ending on December 31, 2017.

Exchange Act ” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

Exchange Rate ” means, on any applicable date, the currency exchange rates selected in good faith by the Borrowers and used in preparing the Borrowers’ financial statements most recently delivered prior to such date.

Excluded Information ” has the meaning set forth in Section  10.07(i) .

Excluded Property ” means, (a) any fee-owned real property not constituting Material Real Property and any leased real property, (b) motor vehicles and other assets subject to certificates of title, to the extent a Lien thereon cannot be perfected by filing a UCC financing statement, (c) assets to the extent a security interest in such assets would result in material adverse Tax consequences (including, without limitation, as a result of the operation of Section 956 of the Code or any similar law or regulation in any applicable jurisdiction), (d) pledges of, and security interests in, certain assets, in favor of the Collateral Agent that are prohibited by applicable Law; provided that (i) any such limitation described in this clause (d) on the security interests granted hereunder shall only apply to the extent that any such prohibition could not be rendered ineffective pursuant to the UCC or any other applicable Law or principles of equity and shall not apply to any proceeds or receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC notwithstanding such prohibition and (ii) in the event of the termination or elimination of any such prohibition contained in any applicable Law (and the absence of any other applicable limitation), a security interest in such assets shall be automatically and simultaneously granted under the applicable Collateral Documents and shall be included as Collateral, (e) any governmental licenses (but not the proceeds thereof) or state or local franchises, charters and authorizations or any other property or assets, to the extent security interests in favor of the Collateral Agent in such licenses, franchises, charters, authorizations or other property or assets are prohibited or restricted thereby after giving effect to the applicable anti-assignment provisions of the UCC other than proceeds and receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC notwithstanding such prohibition; provided that (i) any such limitation described in this clause (e) on the security interests granted hereunder shall only apply to the extent that any such prohibition or restriction could not be rendered ineffective pursuant to the UCC or any other applicable Law or principles of equity and (ii) in the event of the termination or elimination of any such prohibition or restriction contained in any applicable license, franchise, charter or authorization (and the absence of any other applicable limitation), a security interest in such licenses, franchises, charters or authorizations shall be automatically and simultaneously granted under the applicable Collateral Documents and shall be included as Collateral, (f) Equity Interests in (A) any Person other than wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiaries of any Borrower to the extent the terms of such Person’s Organization Documents, joint venture agreement, shareholder agreement or other similar agreements with equity holders of such Person do not permit the pledge of such Equity Interests without the consent of one or more third parties other than Holdings, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (unless such consent has been received) for so long as such prohibition exists; provided that such prohibition exists on the Closing Date or at the time such Equity Interests are acquired (so long as such prohibition did not arise in contemplation of such acquisition), (B) any not-for-profit Subsidiary, (C) any captive insurance Subsidiary, (D) any special purpose securitization vehicle (or similar entity) formed pursuant to a transaction permitted hereunder, (E) any Unrestricted Subsidiary and (F) (I) any indirect Subsidiary (not directly owned by a Borrower or a Guarantor), or (II) any direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO; (g) any lease, license or other

 

-25-


agreement or any property subject to a purchase money security interest, capital lease obligation or similar arrangement in each case permitted to be incurred under this Agreement, to the extent that a grant of a security interest therein would violate or invalidate such lease, license or agreement or purchase money arrangement or create a right of termination in favor of any other party thereto (other than a Loan Party or their wholly-owned Subsidiaries) after giving effect to the applicable anti-assignment provisions of the UCC of any applicable jurisdiction, other than proceeds and receivables thereof, the assignment of which is expressly deemed effective under the UCC of any applicable jurisdiction notwithstanding such prohibition, (h) U.S. “intent-to-use” trademark applications to the extent that a verified statement of use or an amendment to allege use has not been filed and accepted by the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office with respect thereto, (i) Voting Equity Interests in excess of 65% of the Voting Equity Interests of (A) any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or (B) any FSHCO and (j) Margin Stock. Other assets shall be deemed to be “Excluded Property” if the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers reasonably agree in writing that the cost of obtaining or perfecting a security interest in such assets is excessive in relation to the value of such assets as Collateral. Notwithstanding anything herein or the Collateral Documents to the contrary, Excluded Property shall not include any Proceeds (as defined in the UCC), substitutions or replacements of any Excluded Property (unless such Proceeds, substitutions or replacements would otherwise constitute Excluded Property referred to above).

Excluded Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary that is (a) an Unrestricted Subsidiary, (b) not wholly-owned directly by a Borrower or one or more of its Restricted Subsidiaries, (c) an Immaterial Subsidiary that is designated in writing to the Administrative Agent as such by the Borrower Representative, (d) a FSHCO or Foreign Subsidiary or a direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO, (e) established or created pursuant to Section  7.02(x) and meeting the requirements of the proviso thereto; provided that such Subsidiary shall only be an Excluded Subsidiary for the period immediately prior to such acquisition, (f) a Subsidiary that is prohibited by applicable Law from guaranteeing the Facility, or which would require governmental (including regulatory) consent, approval, license or authorization to provide a guarantee unless, such consent, approval, license or authorization has been received, in each case so long as the Administrative Agent shall have received a certification from a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers as to the existence of such prohibition or consent, approval, license or authorization requirement, (h) a Subsidiary that is prohibited from guaranteeing the Facility by any Contractual Obligation in existence on the Closing Date and is listed on Schedule  1.01(e) hereto (or, in the case of any newly-acquired Subsidiary, in existence at the time of acquisition thereof but not entered into in contemplation thereof), (h) a Subsidiary with respect to which a guarantee by it of the Facility would result in material adverse Tax consequences to Holdings or one or more of its Restricted Subsidiaries, as reasonably determined by the Borrowers, (i) not-for-profit subsidiaries, (j) Subsidiaries that are special purpose entities, and (k) any other Subsidiary with respect to which, in the reasonable judgment of the Administrative Agent (confirmed in writing by notice to the Borrower Representative), the cost or other consequences (including any adverse tax consequences) of guaranteeing the Facility shall be excessive in view of the benefits to be obtained by the Lenders therefrom; provided that if a Subsidiary executes the Subsidiary Guaranty as a “Subsidiary Guarantor,” then it shall not constitute an “Excluded Subsidiary” (unless released from its obligations under the Subsidiary Guaranty as a “Subsidiary Guarantor” in accordance with the terms hereof and thereof).

Excluded Taxes ” means any of the following Taxes imposed on or with respect to a Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to a Recipient: (a) Taxes imposed on or measured by such Recipient’s net income (however denominated), franchise Taxes, and branch profits Taxes, in each case, (i) imposed as a result of such Recipient being organized under the laws of, or having its principal office or, in the case of any Lender, its applicable lending office located in, the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (or any political subdivision thereof) or (ii) any Taxes that are imposed as a result of any other present or former connection between such Recipient and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than connections arising from such recipient having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its

 

-26-


obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to and/or enforced any Loan Document), (b) in the case of a Lender (other than any Lender becoming a party hereto pursuant to a request by any Loan Party under Section  3.07 ), any U.S. federal withholding Taxes imposed pursuant to a Law in effect on the date on which such Lender becomes a party hereto or changes its lending office, except in each case to the extent that, pursuant to Section  3.01 , additional amounts with respect to such Taxes were payable either to such Lender’s assignor immediately before such Lender became a party hereto or to such Lender immediately before it changed its lending office, (c) Taxes attributable to such Recipient’s failure to comply with Section  3.01(g) , and (d) any Taxes imposed pursuant to FATCA.

Executive Order ” means Executive Order No. 13224 of September 23, 2001, entitled Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten to Commit, or Support Terrorism (66 Fed. Reg. 49079 (2001)).

Existing Credit Agreement ” means that certain Credit Agreement, dated as of December 22, 2015(as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time prior to the Closing Date), among Holdings, LD Intermediate, the financial institutions party thereto as lenders and Antares Capital LP, as administrative agent.

Facility ” means the Commitments and Loans and any Specified Refinancing Debt related thereto.

FATCA ” means Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, as of the date of this Agreement (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with), any current or future Treasury regulations or official administrative interpretations thereof, any agreements entered into pursuant to current Section 1471(b)(1) of the Code (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with), any intergovernmental agreements implementing the foregoing and any legislation or official guidance or other official requirements adopted in accordance with any such intergovernmental agreements.

Federal Funds Rate ” means, for any day, the rate per annum equal to the weighted average of the rates on overnight federal funds transactions with members of the Federal Reserve System arranged by federal funds brokers on such day, as published by the Federal Reserve Bank on the Business Day next succeeding such day; provided , that (a) if such day is not a Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be such rate on such transactions on the immediately preceding Business Day as so published on the next succeeding Business Day and (b) if no such rate is so published on such next succeeding Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall be the average rate charged to the Administrative Agent on such day on such transactions as determined by the Administrative Agent.

Fee Letter ” means that certain Amended and Restated Fee Letter, dated as of November 11, 2016, by and among the Arrangers, the Borrowers and the other persons party thereto.

First Lien Additional Indebtedness ” shall mean, collectively, any First Lien Incremental Loans and any First Lien Incremental Notes.

First Lien Administrative Agent ” shall mean Royal Bank of Canada in its capacity as administrative agent and collateral agent under the First Lien Facility Documentation, or any successor administrative agent and collateral agent under the First Lien Credit Agreement.

 

-27-


First Lien Credit Agreement ” shall mean that certain first lien credit agreement, dated as of the date hereof, among Holdings, the Borrower, the lenders and other persons party thereto from time to time and the First Lien Administrative Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, modified, supplemented, extended, increased, renewed, refunded, replaced, restructured or refinanced from time to time in one or more agreements (in each case with the same or new lenders, investors or agents), including any agreement extending the maturity thereof or otherwise restructuring all or any portion of the Indebtedness thereunder or increasing the amount loaned or issued thereunder or altering the maturity thereof with new lenders or a different agent, in each case as and to the extent permitted by this Agreement and the Intercreditor Agreement.

First Lien Credit Agreement Refinancing Indebtedness ” shall mean “Specified Refinancing Debt” (including Specified Refinancing Loans) and “Refinancing Notes”, each as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement (as in effect on the Closing Date, as the same may be subsequently amended or restated in accordance with the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement).

First Lien Facility ” shall mean (a) the first lien term loan facility and (b) the revolving credit facility, each under the First Lien Credit Agreement.

First Lien Facility Documentation ” shall mean the First Lien Credit Agreement and all security agreements, guarantees, pledge agreements, notes and other agreements or instruments executed in connection therewith, including all “Loan Documents” (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement).

First Lien Facility Indebtedness ” shall mean the First Lien Loans, any First Lien Additional Indebtedness, any First Lien Credit Agreement Refinancing Indebtedness and any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof.

First Lien Incremental Loans ” shall mean the “New Term Loans”, any “Term Commitment Increase” or “Revolving Credit Commitment Increase”, each as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement.

First Lien Incremental Notes ” shall mean the “New Incremental Notes” as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement.

First Lien Loans ” shall have the meaning provided to the terms “Term Loans” and “Revolving Credit Loans”, collectively, in the First Lien Credit Agreement and any modification, replacement, refinancing, refunding, renewal, or extension thereof.

First Lien Obligations ” shall mean the “Obligations” as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement.

First Lien Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to the Borrower Parties on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded First Lien Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for the four fiscal quarter period most recently then ended.

Flood Insurance Laws means, collectively, (i) the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (ii) the Flood Disaster Protection Act of 1973 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (iii) the National Flood Insurance Reform Act of 1994 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto, (iv) the Flood Insurance Reform Act of 2004 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto and (v) the Biggert-Waters Flood Insurance Reform Act of 2012 as now or hereafter in effect or any successor statute thereto.

 

-28-


Foreign Benefit Event ” means, with respect to any Foreign Plan and as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (a) the existence of unfunded liabilities in excess of the amount that would be permitted absent a waiver from a Governmental Authority, (b) the failure to make the required contributions, under any applicable Law, on or before the due date for such contributions, (c) the receipt of a notice by a Governmental Authority relating to the intention to terminate any such Foreign Plan or to appoint a trustee or similar official to administer any such Foreign Plan, (d) the incurrence of any liability by Holdings or any its Subsidiaries under applicable Law on account of the complete or partial termination of such Foreign Plan or the complete or partial withdrawal of any participating employer therein or (e) the occurrence of any transaction that is prohibited under any applicable Law and that could reasonably be expected to result in the incurrence of any liability by Holdings and any of its Subsidiaries, or the imposition on Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries of, any fine, excise tax or penalty resulting from any noncompliance with any applicable Law.

Foreign Casualty Event ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Disposition ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Excess Cash Flow ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b) .

Foreign Plan ” means any pension plan, benefit plan, fund (including any superannuation fund) or other similar program that, under the applicable Law of any jurisdiction other than the United States, is required to be funded through a trust or other funding vehicle (other than a trust or funding vehicle maintained exclusively by a Governmental Authority) by a Loan Party primarily for the benefit of employees employed and residing outside the United States.

Foreign Subsidiary ” means any direct or indirect Subsidiary of a Borrower that is not a U.S. Person.

FRB ” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System of the United States.

FSHCO ” means any direct or indirect Subsidiary that owns no material assets other than Equity Interests and/or Indebtedness of one or more Controlled Foreign Subsidiaries and/or other FSHCOs (it being understood that Ontrack Data Recovery, LLC satisfies the foregoing requirement as of the Closing Date).

Fund ” means any Person (other than a natural person) that is engaged in making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in commercial loans and similar extensions of credit in the ordinary course of its business.

Funded Debt ” of any Person means Indebtedness for borrowed money of such Person that (x) by its terms matures more than one year after the date of its creation or (y) matures within one year from any date of determination but (in the case of this clause (y)) is renewable or extendable, at the option of such Person, to a date more than one year after such date or arises under a revolving credit or similar agreement that obligates the lender or lenders to extend credit during a period of more than one year after such date, including Indebtedness in respect of the Loans and the First Lien Loans.

Funded First Lien Indebtedness ” means Funded Indebtedness that is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary; provided that such Funded Indebtedness (i) is not expressly subordinated pursuant to a written agreement in right of payment to the First Lien Obligations or (ii) is not secured by Liens on the Collateral that are expressly junior to the Liens securing the First Lien Obligations.

 

-29-


Funded Indebtedness ” means all Indebtedness of the type described in clauses (a), (b)(i), (f) and, without duplication, (h) of the definition of “Indebtedness” (to the extent relating to Indebtedness of the type described in clauses (a), (b)(i) or (f) of the definition thereof), of a Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, in an amount that would be reflected on a balance sheet (in the case of such clause (h), of the Person whose Indebtedness is guaranteed) prepared as of such date on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP (but (x) subject to Section  1.03(c) and (y) any Indebtedness that is issued at a discount to its initial principal amount shall be calculated based on the entire stated principal amount thereof, without giving effect to any discounts or upfront payments), excluding (i) obligations in respect of letters of credit, except to the extent of unreimbursed amounts thereunder that are not reimbursed within two Business Days after such amount is drawn, (ii) Attributable Indebtedness of the type described in clause (b) of the definition of Attributable Indebtedness and (iii) any Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness. For the avoidance of doubt, it is understood that obligations (i) under Swap Contracts and Cash Management Agreements, and (ii) owed by Unrestricted Subsidiaries, do not constitute Funded Indebtedness.

Funded Senior Secured Indebtedness ” means Funded Indebtedness that is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary.

GAAP ” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States as in effect from time to time.

Governmental Authority ” means any nation or government, any state or other political subdivision thereof, any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, administrative tribunal, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.

Granting Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(g) .

Guarantee ” means, as to any Person, without duplication, (a) any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person guaranteeing or having the economic effect of guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other monetary obligation payable or performable by another Person (the “ primary obligor ”) in any manner, whether directly or indirectly, and including any obligation of such Person, direct or indirect, (i) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation, (ii) to purchase or lease property, securities or services for the purpose of assuring the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of the payment or performance of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation, (iii) to maintain working capital, equity capital or any other financial statement condition or liquidity or level of income or cash flow of the primary obligor so as to enable the primary obligor to pay such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation or (iv) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any other manner the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of the payment or performance thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part) or (b) any Lien on any assets of such Person securing any Indebtedness or other monetary obligation of any other Person, whether or not such Indebtedness or other monetary obligation is assumed by such Person (or any right, contingent or otherwise, of any holder of such Indebtedness to obtain any such Lien); provided that the term “Guarantee” shall not include endorsements for collection or deposit, in either case in the ordinary course of business, or customary or reasonable indemnity obligations in effect on the Closing Date, or entered into in connection with any acquisition or Disposition of assets permitted under this Agreement (other than such obligations with respect to Indebtedness). The amount of any Guarantee shall be deemed to be an amount equal to the stated or determinable amount of the related primary obligation, or portion thereof, in respect of which such Guarantee is made or, if not stated or determinable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof as determined by the guaranteeing Person in good faith. The term “ Guarantee ” as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

 

-30-


Guarantors ” means, collectively, Holdings and the Subsidiaries of the Borrowers listed on Schedule  1 and each other Subsidiary of a Borrower (such Subsidiaries not to include any Excluded Subsidiary) that shall be required to execute and deliver a guaranty or guaranty supplement pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Guaranty ” means, collectively, the Holdings Guaranty and the Subsidiary Guaranty, together with each other guaranty and guaranty supplement delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Hazardous Materials ” means all explosive or radioactive substances or wastes and all hazardous or toxic substances, materials or wastes, including petroleum or petroleum distillates, asbestos or asbestos-containing materials, toxic mold, polychlorinated biphenyls, radon gas, infectious or medical wastes and all other substances or wastes of any nature regulated pursuant to any Environmental Law.

Holdings ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Holdings Guaranty ” means the Holdings Guaranty made by Holdings in favor of the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Secured Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit  F -1 .

Immaterial Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of a Borrower that, as of the date of the most recent financial statements required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , (x) does not have (a) assets (when combined with the assets of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) in excess of 5.0% of Consolidated Total Assets or (b) revenues (when combined with the revenues of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such date in excess of 5.0% of the consolidated revenues of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period or (y) whose contribution to Consolidated EBITDA (when combined with the contribution to Consolidated EBITDA of all other Immaterial Subsidiaries, after eliminating intercompany obligations) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such date does not exceed 5.0% of the Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period; provided that, at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma consolidated financial information of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule  1.01(f) hereto.

Increase Effective Date ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.14(c) .

Incremental Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Incremental Arranger ” means the Person that is a financial institution engaged in arranging similar financings in the ordinary course of its business appointed by the Borrowers to arrange New Loan Commitments, who (i) may be the Administrative Agent, if it so agrees, or (ii) any other Person appointed by the Borrowers; provided that such Person may not be an Affiliate of a Borrower.

Indebtedness ” means, as to any Person at a particular time, without duplication, all of the following, whether or not included as indebtedness or liabilities in accordance with GAAP:

(a) all obligations of such Person for borrowed money and all obligations of such Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments;

 

-31-


(b) the maximum amount of (i) all letters of credit (including standby and commercial), bankers’ acceptances, bank guaranties, and (ii) surety bonds, performance bonds and similar instruments issued or created by or for the account of such Person;

(c) net obligations of such Person under any Swap Contract;

(d) all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than (w) trade accounts payable in the ordinary course of business, (x) any earn-out obligation until such obligation becomes a liability on the balance sheet of such Person in accordance with GAAP and is not yet paid after becoming due and payable, (y) expenses accrued in the ordinary course of business and (z) purchase price holdbacks in respect of a portion of the purchase price of an asset to satisfy warranty or other unperformed obligations of the respective seller);

(e) indebtedness (excluding prepaid interest thereon) secured by a Lien on property owned or being purchased by such Person (including indebtedness arising under conditional sales or other title retention agreements and mortgage, industrial revenue bond, industrial development bond and similar financings), whether or not such indebtedness shall have been assumed by such Person or is limited in recourse;

(f) all Attributable Indebtedness;

(g) all obligations of such Person in respect of Disqualified Equity Interests; and

(h) all Guarantees of such Person in respect of any of the foregoing.

For all purposes hereof, the Indebtedness of any Person shall (A) include the Indebtedness of any partnership or Joint Venture (other than a joint venture that is itself a corporation or limited liability company or the foreign equivalent thereof) in which such Person is a general partner or a joint venturer, (i) unless such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to such Person or (ii) except to the extent such Person’s liability for such Indebtedness is otherwise limited in recourse or amount, but only up to the amount of the value of the assets to which recourse is limited or the amount of such limit and (B) in the case of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries, exclude all intercompany Indebtedness having a term not exceeding 364 days (inclusive of roll over or extensions of term). The amount of any net obligation under any Swap Contract on any date shall be deemed to be the Swap Termination Value thereof as of such date. The amount of Indebtedness of any Person for purposes of clause (e) shall be deemed to be equal to the lesser of (i) the aggregate unpaid amount of such Indebtedness and (ii) the fair market value of the property encumbered thereby as determined by such Person in good faith.

Indemnified Liabilities ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.05 .

Indemnified Taxes ” means (a) all Taxes, other than Excluded Taxes, imposed on or with respect to any payment made by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party under any Loan Document and (b) to the extent not otherwise described in (a), all Other Taxes.

Indemnitees ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.05 .

Independent Financial Advisor ” means an accounting, appraisal, investment banking firm or consultant of nationally recognized standing that is, in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers, qualified to perform the task for which it has been engaged and that is independent of Holdings and its Affiliates.

 

-32-


Information ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.08 .

Initial Borrowing ” means a borrowing consisting of simultaneous Initial Loans having the same Interest Period made by each of the Initial Lenders pursuant to Section  2.01 on the Closing Date.

Initial Facility ” means the Initial Commitments and Initial Loans.

Initial Commitment ” means, as to each Lender, its obligation, as of the Closing Date, to make Initial Loans to the Borrower pursuant to Section  2.01(a) in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $125,000,000.

Initial Lenders ” means each of the Lenders party to this Agreement on the Closing Date.

Initial Loans ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.01.

Initial Public Company Costs ” means, as to any Person, costs associated with, or in anticipation of, or preparation for, compliance with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules and regulations promulgated in connection therewith and costs relating to compliance with the provisions of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, as applicable to companies with equity securities held by the public, the rules of national securities exchange companies with listed equity, directors’ compensation, fees and expense reimbursement, costs relating to investor relations, shareholder meetings and reports to shareholders, directors’ and officers’ insurance and other executive costs, legal and other professional fees, and listing fees, in each case to the extent arising solely by virtue of the initial listing of such Person’s equity securities on a national securities exchange; provided that any such costs arising from the costs described above in respect of the ongoing operation of such Person as a listed equity or its listed debt securities following the initial listing of such Person’s equity securities or debt securities, respectively, on a national securities exchange shall not constitute Initial Public Company Costs.

Intellectual Property Security Agreement ” means, collectively, the intellectual property security agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit B to the Security Agreement, entered into by and among the Collateral Agent and the applicable Loan Parties dated the date of this Agreement, together with each other intellectual property security agreement or intellectual property security agreement supplement executed and delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 or 6.14 .

Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplement ” means, collectively, any intellectual property security agreement supplement entered into in connection with, and pursuant to the terms of, any Intellectual Property Security Agreement.

Intercompany Subordination Agreement ” means an intercompany subordination agreement, in substantially the form of Exhibit H hereto, or otherwise in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

Intercreditor Agreement ” means the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, among the Administrative Agent, the First Lien Administrative Agent and the Loan Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit M .

Interest Payment Date ” means (a) as to any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan, the last day of each Interest Period applicable to such Loan and the Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made; provided , however , that if any Interest Period for a Eurocurrency Rate Loan exceeds three months, the respective dates that fall every three months after the beginning of such Interest Period shall also be Interest Payment Dates and (b) as to any Base Rate Loan, the last Business Day of each March, June, September and December and the Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made.

 

-33-


Interest Period ” means, as to each Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the period commencing on the date any Eurocurrency Rate Loan is disbursed or converted to or continued as a Eurocurrency Rate Loan and ending on the date (x) one, two, three or six months thereafter, or to the extent consented to by all Appropriate Lenders, twelve months thereafter or (y) if agreed by the Administrative Agent in its sole discretion, such other period not to exceed one-month, each as selected by the Borrower Representative in a Committed Loan Notice; provided that:

(a) any Interest Period that would otherwise end on a day that is not a Business Day shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless such Business Day falls in another calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the next preceding Business Day;

(b) any Interest Period that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period) shall end on the last Business Day of the calendar month at the end of such Interest Period; and

(c) no Interest Period shall extend beyond the scheduled Maturity Date of the Facility under which such Loan was made.

Interpolated Screen Rate ” means, in relation to LIBOR for any Loan, the rate (rounded to the same number of decimal places as the two relevant Screen Rates) which results from interpolating on a linear basis between:

(a) the applicable Screen Rate for the longest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which is less than the Interest Period of that Loan; and

(b) the applicable Screen Rate for the shortest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which exceeds the Interest Period of that Loan;

provided that if any Interpolated Screen Rate shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement.

Investment ” means, as to any Person, any direct or indirect acquisition or investment by such Person, whether by means of (a) the purchase or other acquisition of Equity Interests or debt or other securities of another Person, (b) a loan, advance or capital contribution (excluding accounts receivable, credit card and debit card receivables, trade credit, and advances to customers, in each case made in the ordinary course of business) to, Guarantee or assumption of debt of, or purchase or other acquisition of any other debt or equity participation or interest in, another Person, including any partnership or joint venture interest in such other Person and any arrangement pursuant to which the investor incurs debt of the type referred to in clause (h) of the definition of “Indebtedness” in respect of such Person or (c) the purchase or other acquisition (in one transaction or a series of transactions) of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of another Person or assets constituting a business unit, line of business or division of such Person. For purposes of covenant compliance, the amount of any Investment shall be the amount actually invested (measured at the time made), without adjustment for subsequent increases or decreases in the value of such Investment but, giving effect to any returns or distributions of capital or repayment of principal actually received in cash by such Person with respect thereto (but only to the extent that the aggregate amount of all such returns, distributions and repayments with respect to such Investment does not exceed the principal amount of such Investment and less any such amounts which increase the Cumulative Credit).

 

-34-


IP Rights ” has the meaning specified in Section  5.16 .

IRS ” means the United States Internal Revenue Service.

Joint Venture ” means (a) any Person that is not a Subsidiary of a Borrower that would constitute an “equity method investee” of a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries and (b) any Person other than an individual or a Subsidiary of a Borrower (i) in which a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary holds or acquires a beneficial ownership interest (by way of ownership of Equity Interests or other evidence of ownership) in such Person and (ii) which is engaged in a business not prohibited by Section  7.07 .

Junior Financing ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.12 .

Junior Financing Documentation ” means any documentation governing any Junior Financing.

Latest Maturity Date ” means, at any date of determination, the latest maturity or expiration date applicable to any Tranche at such time under this Agreement, in each case as extended in accordance with this Agreement from time to time.

Laws ” means, collectively, all applicable international, foreign, federal, state and local statutes, treaties, rules, guidelines, regulations, ordinances, codes and administrative or judicial precedents or authorities, including the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Authority charged with the enforcement, interpretation or administration thereof, and all applicable administrative orders, directed duties, requests, licenses, authorizations and permits of, and agreements with, any Governmental Authority.

LDisc Acquisition Agreement ” has the meaning specified in the definition of LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment.

LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment ” means those certain earn-out payments for up to $12,500,000 due in each of 2017 and 2018 which may be required pursuant to that certain Equity Purchase Agreement (the “ LDisc Acquisition Agreement ”), dated as of November 23, 2015, by and among the LD Intermediate, LDisc Holdings, LLC, WVLD Acquisition Corp. Westview Capital Partners II, L.P. and the Selling Members (as defined therein). The amount of such earn-out payments shall be calculated (and for the avoidance of doubt, reduced in whole or in part) in a manner as set forth in the LDisc Acquisition Agreement and as agreed to between the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent.

LDiscovery Transactions ” means those transactions as contemplated by the LDisc Acquisition Agreement.

LD Intermediate ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

LD Lower ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Lender ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

 

-35-


Lending Office ” means, as to any Lender, the office or offices of such Lender described as such in such Lender’s Administrative Questionnaire, or such other office or offices as a Lender may from time to time notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent.

LIBOR ” means, in relation to any Loan other than a Base Rate Loan:

(a) the applicable Screen Rate; or

(b) (if no Screen Rate is available for the Interest Period of that Loan) the Interpolated Screen Rate for that Loan; or

(c) if no Screen Rate is available for the Interest Period of that Loan and it is not possible to calculate an Interpolated Screen Rate for that Loan, the rate determined in accordance with Section  3.03 ,

As of, in the case of clauses (a) and (c) above, the 11:00 a.m. London time on the date that is two Business Days before the first day of such period, for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan.

Lien ” means any mortgage, pledge, hypothecation, collateral assignment, deposit arrangement, encumbrance having the effect of security, lien (statutory or other), charge, or preference, priority or other security interest or preferential arrangement of any kind or nature whatsoever (including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any Capitalized Lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing).

Limited Condition Acquisition ” means any acquisition, including by way of merger, amalgamation or consolidation, by one or more of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries of any assets, business or Person permitted by this Agreement whose consummation is not conditioned on the availability of, or on obtaining, third party acquisition financing and which is designated as a Limited Condition Acquisition by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in writing to the Administrative Agent and Lenders.

Loan ” means an extension of credit by a Lender to one or more of the Borrowers under Article II .

Loan Documents ” means, collectively, (i) this Agreement, (ii) the Notes, (iii) the Guaranty, (iv) the Collateral Documents, (v) [reserved], (vi) the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, (vii) the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, (viii) any Refinancing Amendment and (ix) any joinder or amendment to any of the foregoing that is designated as a “Loan Document.”

Loan Parties ” means, collectively, the Borrowers and each Guarantor.

Majority Lenders ” means those Non-Defaulting Lenders that would constitute the Required Lenders under, and as defined in, this Agreement if all outstanding Obligations of the other Tranches under this Agreement were repaid in full and all Commitments with respect thereto were terminated.

Margin Stock ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the United States Federal Reserve System, or any successor thereto.

 

-36-


Material Adverse Effect ” means (a) a material adverse effect on the business, assets, property, liabilities (actual or contingent), financial condition or results of operations of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (b) a material adverse effect on the ability of the Loan Parties (taken as a whole) to perform their respective obligations under the Loan Documents, (c) a material adverse effect on the legality, validity or enforceability of the Loan Documents or (d) a material adverse effect on the rights and remedies of the Agents or the Lenders under the Loan Documents.

Material Real Property ” means any parcel of real property (other than a parcel with a fair market value of less than $5,000,000 at the Closing Date or, with respect to real property acquired after the Closing Date, at the time of acquisition, in each case, as reasonably estimated by the Borrowers in good faith) owned in fee by a Loan Party and located in the United States; provided , however , that one or more parcels owned in fee by a Loan Party and located adjacent to, contiguous with, or in close proximity to, and comprising one property with a common street address, may, in the reasonable discretion of the Administrative Agent, be deemed to be one parcel for the purposes of this definition.

Maturity Date ” means with respect to the Initial Loans, the earlier of (i) the seventh anniversary of the Closing Date and (ii) the date that the Initial Loans are declared due and payable pursuant to Section  8.02 ; provided that the reference to Maturity Date with respect to (i) Loans that are the subject of a loan modification offer pursuant to Section  10.01 and (ii) Loans that are incurred pursuant to Section  2.14 or 2.18 shall, in each case, be the final maturity date as specified in the loan modification documentation, incremental documentation, or specified refinancing documentation, as applicable thereto.

Maximum Senior Secured Net Leverage Requirement ” means, with respect to any request made in reliance on this definition under Article II for an increase in any Tranche, for a New Facility or for the issuance of New Incremental Notes, the requirement that, on a Pro Forma Basis, after giving effect to such increase, such new Facility (assuming all commitments thereunder are fully drawn) or such New Incremental Notes (including, in each case, any acquisition consummated concurrently therewith), the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio as of the date of the most recent financial statements required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b)  does not exceed 5.25:1.00; provided that solely for the purpose of calculating the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio pursuant to this definition, any (i) Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.15 , and any Refinancing Notes (in the case of Refinancing Notes, to the extent that such Refinancing Notes refinance Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.15 ) and, in each case, whether or not such Indebtedness is unsecured or is secured (it being understood that if any portion of such Indebtedness is reclassified pursuant to the last paragraph of Section  7.03 to any other exception to Section  7.03 , following its initial date of incurrence, such portion of such Indebtedness shall no longer be deemed secured if unsecured), such indebtedness shall be deemed to constitute Funded Senior Secured Indebtedness and (ii) any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.15 shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of the Borrower and its Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of this definition (however, to the extent the proceeds thereof are used to repay Indebtedness, Pro Forma Effect shall be given to such repayment of Indebtedness).

Maximum Rate ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.10 .

Moody’s ” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. and any successor thereto.

Mortgage ” means, collectively, the deeds of trust, trust deeds and mortgages in respect of Mortgaged Properties in the U.S. made by the Loan Parties in favor or for the benefit of the Collateral Agent on behalf of the Lenders in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, in each case as the same may be amended, amended and restated, extended, supplemented, substituted or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

-37-


Mortgage Policies ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.16(a)(ii) .

Mortgaged Properties ” means the parcels of real property identified on Schedule 5.08(b) and any other Material Real Property with respect to which a Mortgage is required pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Multiemployer Plan ” means a “multiemployer plan” as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA and subject to Title IV of ERISA, to which any Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate makes or is obligated to make contributions.

Net Cash Proceeds ” means:

(a) with respect to the Disposition of any asset by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries or any Casualty Event, the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of cash and Cash Equivalents received in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (including any cash or Cash Equivalents received by way of deferred payment pursuant to, or by monetization of, a note receivable or otherwise, but only as and when so received and, with respect to any Casualty Event, any insurance proceeds or condemnation awards in respect of such Casualty Event received by or paid to or for the account of a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries and including any proceeds received as a result of unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection with such related transaction) over (ii) the sum of (A) the principal amount of any Indebtedness that is secured by the asset subject to such Disposition or Casualty Event and that is required to be repaid in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (other than (x) Indebtedness under the Loan Documents and, if such asset constitutes Collateral, any Indebtedness secured by such asset with a Lien ranking junior to the Liens securing the Obligations and (y) in the case of any New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes that are secured by Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with Liens securing the Obligations, if such asset constitutes Collateral any amounts in excess of the ratable portion (based on any then outstanding Tranches and any then outstanding New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes that are secured by Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations) attributable to such New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes, as applicable), (B) the out-of-pocket expenses incurred by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (including attorneys’ fees, accountants’ fees, investment banking fees, survey costs, title insurance premiums, and related search and recording charges, transfer Taxes, deed or mortgage recording Taxes, other customary expenses and brokerage, consultant and other customary fees actually incurred in connection therewith), (C) income Taxes reasonably estimated to be payable in connection with such Disposition or Casualty Event (or any Tax distribution the Borrowers make as a result of such Disposition or Casualty Event) and any repatriation costs associated with receipt or distribution by the applicable taxpayer of such proceeds, (D) any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection with such transaction, (E) any reserve for adjustment in respect of (x) the sale price of the property that is the subject of such Disposition established in accordance with GAAP and (y) any liabilities associated with such property and retained by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries after such Disposition, including pension and other post-employment benefit liabilities and liabilities related to environmental matters or against any indemnification obligations associated with such transaction, and (F) any customer deposits required to be returned as a result of such Disposition, and it being understood that “Net Cash Proceeds” shall include, without limitation, any cash or Cash Equivalents (i) received upon the Disposition of any non-cash consideration received by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries in any such Disposition and (ii) upon the reversal (without the satisfaction of any applicable liabilities in cash in a corresponding amount) of any reserve described in clause (E) above;

 

-38-


(b) with respect to the issuance of any Equity Interest by Holdings (or Parent Holding Company) or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, the excess of (i) the sum of the cash and Cash Equivalents received in connection with such issuance and in connection with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith over (ii) the investment banking fees, underwriting discounts, premiums, commissions, Taxes, other out-of-pocket expenses and other customary expenses and fees related thereto, incurred by Holdings (or Parent Holding Company) or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such issuance and any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith; and

(c) with respect to the incurrence or issuance of any Indebtedness by a Borrower or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of the cash received in connection with such incurrence or issuance and in connection with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith over (ii) the investment banking fees, underwriting discounts and commissions, premiums, expenses, accrued interest and fees related thereto, Taxes reasonably estimated to be payable and other out-of-pocket expenses and other customary expenses, incurred by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such incurrence or issuance and any costs associated with unwinding any related Swap Contract in connection therewith and, in the case of Indebtedness of any Foreign Subsidiary, deductions in respect of withholding Taxes that are or would otherwise be payable in cash if such funds were repatriated to the United States.

Net Working Capital ” means, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, Consolidated Current Assets minus Consolidated Current Liabilities; provided that increases or decreases in Net Working Capital shall be calculated without regard to any changes in Consolidated Current Assets or Consolidated Current Liabilities as a result of (a) any reclassification in accordance with GAAP of assets or liabilities, as applicable, between current and noncurrent, (b) the effects of purchase accounting or (c) the effect of fluctuations in the amount of accrued or contingent obligations, assets or liabilities under Swap Contracts.

New Commitment ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.14(a).

New Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section 2.14(a).

New Incremental Notes ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.15(a) .

New Incremental Notes Indentures ” means, collectively, the indentures or other similar agreements pursuant to which any New Incremental Notes are issued, together with all instruments and other agreements in connection therewith, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

New Loan ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

New York Time ” means with respect to any matters, including Agency Matters, the local time in New York City.

No Undisclosed Information Statement ” means, with respect to any Person, (i) a representation that such Person is not in possession of any material non-public information with respect to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries that has not been disclosed to the Lenders generally (other than those Lenders who have elected to not receive any non-public information with respect to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries), and if so disclosed could reasonably be expected to have a material effect upon, or otherwise be material to, the market price of the applicable Loan, or the decision of an assigning Lender to sell, or of an assignee to purchase, such Loan or, alternatively, (ii) a statement that such representation cannot be made.

 

-39-


Non-Consenting Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  3.07(c) .

Non-Defaulting Lender ” means any Lender other than a Defaulting Lender.

Non-U.S. Lender ” means a Lender that is not a U.S. Person.

Northwestern ” means Northwestern Mutual Investment Management Company, LLC.

Not Otherwise Applied ” means, with reference to any proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance or equity contribution that is proposed to be applied to a particular use or transaction (including incurring Indebtedness in reliance on Section  7.03(xix) ), that such amount has not previously been (and is not simultaneously being) applied to anything other than such particular use or transaction (including any application thereof as a Cure Right (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement).

Note ” means any promissory note of the Borrower payable to any Lender or its registered assigns, in substantially the form of Exhibit B hereto, evidencing the indebtedness of the Borrower to such Lender resulting from the Loans under the Facility.

NYFRB ” means the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

NYFRB Rate ” means, for any day, the greater of (a) the Federal Funds Rate in effect on such day and (b) the Overnight Bank Funding Rate in effect on such day (or for any day that is not a Business Day, for the immediately preceding Business Day); provided that if none of such rates are published for any day that is a Business Day, the term “NYFRB Rate” means the rate for a federal funds transaction quoted at 11:00 a.m. (New York City time) on such day received to the Administrative Agent from a Federal funds broker of recognized standing selected by it; provided, further , that if any of the aforesaid rates shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement.

Obligations ” means all advances to, and debts, liabilities, obligations, covenants and duties of, any Loan Party arising under any Loan Document or otherwise with respect to any Loan, whether direct or indirect (including those acquired by assumption), absolute or contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising and including interest and fees that accrue after the commencement by or against any Loan Party of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Laws naming such Person as the debtor in such proceeding, regardless of whether such interest and fees are allowed claims in such proceeding. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Obligations of the Loan Parties under the Loan Documents include (a) the obligation to pay principal, interest, charges, expenses, fees, indemnities and other amounts payable by any Loan Party under any Loan Document and (b) the obligation of any Loan Party to reimburse any amount in respect of any of the foregoing pursuant to Section  10.04 .

Organization Documents ” means (a) with respect to any corporation, the certificate or articles of incorporation and the bylaws (or equivalent or comparable constitutive documents with respect to any non-U.S. jurisdiction), (b) with respect to any limited liability company, the certificate or articles of formation or organization and operating or limited liability company agreement (or equivalent or comparable constitutive documents with respect to any non-U.S. jurisdiction) and (c) with respect to any partnership, joint venture, trust or other form of business entity, the partnership, joint venture, trust or other applicable agreement of formation or organization and any agreement, instrument, filing or notice with respect thereto filed in connection with its formation or organization with the applicable Governmental Authority in the jurisdiction of its formation or organization and, if applicable, any certificate or articles of formation or organization of such entity.

 

-40-


Other Affiliate ” means the Sponsor and any Affiliate of the Sponsor, other than Holdings, any Subsidiary of Holdings and any natural person.

Other Taxes ” means all present or future stamp, court or documentary, intangible, recording, filing or similar Taxes that arise from any payment made under, from the execution, delivery, performance, enforcement or registration of, from the receipt or perfection of a security interest under, or otherwise with respect to, any Loan Document, except any such Taxes that are imposed with respect to an assignment or transfer of any Recipient’s rights (other than an assignment made pursuant to Section  3.07 ) (an “ Assignment Tax ”), but only to the extent such Assignment Taxes are imposed as a result of a present or former connection between the assignor or assignee and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than a connection arising from such assignor or assignee having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to and/or enforced any Loan Document).

Outstanding Amount ” means with respect to the Loans on any date, the aggregate outstanding principal amount thereof after giving effect to any borrowings and prepayments or repayments of the Loans occurring on such date.

Overnight Bank Funding Rate ” means, for any day, the rate comprised of both overnight federal funds and overnight eurodollar borrowings by U.S.-managed banking offices of depository institutions (as such composite rate shall be determined by the NYFRB as set forth on its public website from time to time) and published on the next succeeding Business Day by the NYFRB as an overnight bank funding rate (from and after such date as the NYFRB shall commence to publish such composite rate).

Parent Holding Company ” means any direct or indirect parent entity of Holdings that does not hold Equity Interests in any other Person (except for any other Parent Holding Company).

Participant ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(d) .

Participant Register ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(m) .

Party ” means a party to this Agreement.

PATRIOT Act ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.22 .

PBGC ” means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation.

Pension Funding Rules ” means the rules of the Code and ERISA regarding minimum required contributions (including any installment payment thereof) to Plans and set forth in, with respect to plan years ending prior to the effective date of the Pension Protection Act of 2006, Section 412 of the Code and Section 302 of ERISA, each as in effect prior to the Pension Protection Act of 2006 and, thereafter, Section 412, 430, 431, 432 and 436 of the Code and Sections 302, 303, 304 and 305 of ERISA.

Perfection Certificate ” means a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit L , as may be amended or supplemented from time to time by a Perfection Certificate Supplement (as defined in the Security Agreement) or otherwise.

 

-41-


Perfection Exceptions ” means that no Loan Party shall be required to (i) enter into control agreements with respect to, or otherwise perfect any security interest by “control” (or similar arrangements) over securities accounts, deposit accounts, other bank accounts, cash and cash equivalents and accounts related to the clearing, payment processing and similar operations of such Loan Party, (ii) perfect the security interest in the following other than by the filing of a UCC financing statement: (1) letter-of-credit rights (as defined in the UCC), (2) commercial tort claims (as defined in the UCC) and (3) Fixtures (as defined in the UCC), except to the extent that the same are Equipment (as defined in the UCC) or are related to real property covered or intended by the Loan Documents to be covered by a Mortgage, (iii) so long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, send notices to account debtors or other contractual third-parties, (iv) enter into any security documents to be governed by the law of any jurisdiction in which assets are located (other than the United States or any state thereof), or (v) deliver landlord waivers, estoppels or collateral access letters.

Perfection Requirements ” means the making of appropriate registrations, filings, endorsements, notarizations, stamping and/or notifications of the Collateral Documents and/or the Collateral created under any other document required by the Collateral Documents.

Permitted Acquisition ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.02(i) .

Permitted Acquisition Provisions ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(d) .

Permitted Encumbrances ” has the meaning specified in the Mortgages.

Permitted Equity Issuance ” means any sale or issuance of any Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of Holdings, the proceeds of which are contributed to the ordinary equity of a Borrower.

Permitted Holders ” means the collective reference to (a) Permitted Transferees and (b) the Sponsor and their respective Control Investment Affiliates (but excluding any operating portfolio companies of the foregoing), managers and members of management of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) and its Subsidiaries that have ownership interests in Holdings (or such Parent Holding Company), and one or more third-party co-investors identified to the Arrangers by the Sponsor prior to the Closing Date (it being understood any such managers or members of management and third-party co-investors shall only constitute “Permitted Holders” to the extent that the ownership interests held by any such managers or members of management and third-party co-investors collectively are less than the ownership interests held by the Sponsor, with any excess ownership interests being excluded from the ownership deemed held by Permitted Holders for purposes of determining whether a Change of Control has occurred).

Permitted Ratio Debt ” means (i) unsecured Indebtedness, (ii) secured Indebtedness secured by a Lien ranking pari passu to the Liens securing the First Lien Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary, (iii) secured Indebtedness secured by a Lien junior to the Liens securing the First Lien Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary and either junior to or pari passu with the Liens securing the Obligations or (iv) Indebtedness of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary that is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations; provided , in each case, that immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect thereto and to the use of the proceeds thereof, (i) (A) in the case of Permitted Ratio Debt incurred to finance a Permitted Acquisition, other permitted Investment or other acquisition, no Event of Default shall exist on the date that the applicable Borrower or the applicable Restricted Subsidiary enters into a binding agreement with respect to such transaction and no Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , 8.01(f) or 8.01(g) shall be continuing or result therefrom or (B) in all other cases, no Event of Default shall be continuing or result therefrom and (ii) (A) in the case of unsecured Permitted

 

-42-


Ratio Debt, the Total Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00 or (B), in the case of secured Permitted Ratio Debt, (x) the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 3.75 to 1.00 if such secured Permitted Ratio Debt is not ranked pari passu with or junior to the Obligations or (y) the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) no greater than 5.25 to 1.00 for all other secured Permitted Ratio Debt and (iv) with respect to any incurrence of Permitted Ratio Debt, any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xx) shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of such incurrence. Additionally, any Permitted Ratio Debt that is secured by a Lien ranking pari passu to the Liens securing the Obligations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) if such Indebtedness is in the form of loans, shall be subject to the “MFN” requirements in Section  2.14(f)(iii) ( mutatis mutandis ) and (y) shall be subject ( mutatis mutandis ) to the applicable limitations on terms applicable to New Facilities in Section  2.14 (if such Permitted Ratio Debt is in the form of loans) or shall be subject ( mutatis mutandis ) to the applicable limitations on terms applicable to New Incremental Notes in Section  2.15 (if such Permitted Ratio Debt is in the form of bonds or other securities).

Permitted Refinancing ” means, with respect to any Person, any modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension of any Indebtedness of such Person; provided that (a) the principal amount (or accreted value, if applicable) thereof does not exceed the principal amount (or accreted value, if applicable) of the Indebtedness so modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended except by an amount equal to accrued and unpaid interest and a reasonable premium thereon plus other reasonable amounts paid, and fees and expenses reasonably incurred (including original issue discount and upfront fees), in connection with such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension and by an amount equal to any existing commitments unutilized thereunder; (b) other than with respect to Section  7.03(b)(v) , such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension has a final maturity date equal to or later than the final maturity date of, and has a Weighted Average Life to Maturity equal to or greater than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended; (c) if the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations, such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations on terms, taken as a whole, as favorable in all material respects to the Lenders (including, if applicable, as to Collateral) as those contained in the documentation governing the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended or otherwise acceptable to the Administrative Agent; (d) if the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended is (i) unsecured, such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is unsecured, or (ii) if secured by Liens on the Collateral, such modification, refinancing, refunding, replacement, renewal or extension is secured to the same extent, including with respect to any subordination provisions, and in each case, subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements; (e) the terms and conditions (including, if applicable, as to collateral) of any such modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended (other than to the extent permitted by any other clause of this definition or with respect to interest rate, optional prepayment premiums and optional redemption provisions) Indebtedness are, either (i) substantially identical to or less favorable to the investors providing such Permitted Refinancing, taken as a whole, than the terms and conditions of the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced, exchanged or extended, (ii) when taken as a whole (other than interest rate, prepayment premiums and redemption premiums), not more restrictive to Holdings, the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries than those set forth in this Agreement or are customary for similar indebtedness in light of current market conditions ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the

 

-43-


incurrence of such Indebtedness, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Indebtedness or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set out in this clause (e), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)), in each case, except for terms and conditions only applicable to periods after the Latest Maturity Date; (f) such modification, refinancing, refunding, renewal, replacement, exchange or extension is incurred by the Person who is or would have been permitted to be the obligor or guarantor (or any successor thereto) on the Indebtedness being modified, refinanced, refunded, renewed, replaced or extended (it being understood that the roles of such obligors as a borrower or a guarantor with respect to such obligations may be interchanged); and (g) at the time thereof, other than with respect to a Permitted Refinancing in respect of Indebtedness pursuant to Sections  7.03(b)(v) and (b)(vii) , no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Permitted Surviving Debt ” means certain Indebtedness set forth on Schedule 7.03 that the Arrangers and the Borrowers have agreed may remain outstanding as of the Closing Date with respect to the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries.

Permitted Transferee ” means, in the case of any member of management, (i) his or her executor, administrator, testamentary trustee, legatee or beneficiaries, (ii) his or her spouse, parents, siblings, members of his or her immediate family (including adopted children and step children) and/or direct lineal descendants or (iii) a trust, the beneficiaries of which, or a corporation or partnership, the stockholders or partners of which, include only a member of management and his or her spouse, parents, siblings, members of his or her immediate family (including adopted children) and/or direct lineal descendants (in each case, for so long as the ownership interests held by such persons are less than the ownership interests held by Sponsor).

Person ” means any natural person, corporation, limited liability company, trust, joint venture, association, company, partnership, Governmental Authority or other entity.

Plan ” means any “employee benefit plan” (other than a Multiemployer Plan) within the meaning of Section 3(3) of ERISA that is maintained or is contributed to by a Loan Party or any ERISA Affiliate and is subject to Title IV of ERISA or the minimum funding standards under Sections 412 or 430 of the Code or Sections 302 or 303 of ERISA.

Platform ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

Pledged Debt ” means “Pledged Debt” (or equivalent term) as defined in each applicable Collateral Document.

Pledged Interests ” means “Pledged Interests” or “Pledged Equity” (or equivalent term) as defined in each applicable Collateral Document.

Prepayment Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Prepayment Date ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(c) .

Prepay Incremental Amount ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

 

-44-


Prime Rate ” means the rate of interest per annum determined by Royal Bank from time to time as its prime commercial lending rate for United States Dollar loans in the United States for such day. The Prime Rate is not necessarily the lowest rate that Royal Bank is charging any corporate customer.

Pro Forma Basis ,” “ Pro Forma Compliance ” and “ Pro Forma Effect ” means, in respect of a Specified Transaction, that such Specified Transaction and the following transactions in connection therewith (to the extent applicable) shall be deemed to have occurred as of the first day of the applicable period of measurement for the applicable covenant or requirement on the basis of the financial information most recently delivered to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) : (a) historical income statement items (whether positive or negative) attributable to the property or Person, if any, subject to such Specified Transaction shall be (i) excluded (in the case of a Disposition of all or substantially all Equity Interests in any Restricted Subsidiary or any division, product line or facility used for operations of a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary or a designation of a Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary) and (ii) included (in the case of a purchase or other acquisition of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of any Person, or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or of all or substantially all of the Equity Interests in a Person or a designation of a Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary), (b) in the event that a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary incurs (including by assumption or guarantees) or repays (including by redemption, repayment, retirement, discharge, defeasance or extinguishment) any Indebtedness included in the calculations of any financial ratio or test (in each case, other than Indebtedness incurred or repaid under any revolving credit facility in the ordinary course of business for working capital purposes), (i) during the applicable measurement period or (ii) subsequent to the end of the applicable measurement period and prior to or simultaneously with the event for which the calculation of any such ratio is made, then such financial ratio or test shall be calculated giving pro forma effect to such incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness, to the extent required, as if the same had occurred on the last day of the applicable measurement period; provided that (A) Pro Forma Basis, Pro Forma Compliance and Pro Forma Effect in respect of any Specified Transaction shall be calculated in a reasonable and factually supportable manner and certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers and (B) any such calculation shall be subject to the applicable limitations set forth in Section  1.09 ; provided , further , that at all times prior to the first delivery of financial statements pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or (b) , this definition shall be applied based on the pro forma financial information of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries set forth on Schedule 1.01(f) hereto.

Pro Rata Share ” means, with respect to each Lender and any Facility or all the Facilities or any Tranche or all the Tranches (as the case may be) at any time, a fraction (expressed as a percentage, carried out to the ninth decimal place, and subject to adjustment as provided in Section  2.17 ), the numerator of which is the amount of the Commitments of such Lender under the applicable Facility or the Facilities or Tranche or Tranches (and, in the case of any Tranche after the applicable borrowing date and without duplication, the outstanding principal amount of Loans under such Tranche, of such Lender, at such time) at such time and the denominator of which is the amount of the Aggregate Commitments under the applicable Facility or the Facilities or Tranche or Tranches at such time (and, in the case of any Tranche and without duplication, the outstanding principal amount of Loans under such Tranche, at such time); provided that if the commitment of each Lender to make Loans has been terminated pursuant to Section  8.02 , then the Pro Rata Share of each Lender shall be determined based on the Pro Rata Share of such Lender immediately prior to such termination and after giving effect to any subsequent assignments made pursuant to the terms hereof. The initial Pro Rata Share of each Lender is set forth opposite the name of such Lender on Schedule 2.01 or in the Assignment and Assumption pursuant to which such Lender became a party hereto, as applicable.

Public Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  6.02 .

 

-45-


Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness ” means unsecured Indebtedness of Holdings (A) that is not subject to any Guarantee by any Subsidiary of Holdings, (B) that will not mature prior to the date that is 91 days after the Latest Maturity Date of any Tranche in effect on the date of issuance or incurrence thereof, (C) that has no scheduled amortization or scheduled payments of principal and is not subject to mandatory redemption, repurchase, prepayment or sinking fund obligation (it being understood that such Indebtedness may have mandatory prepayment, repurchase or redemption provisions satisfying the requirements of clause (D) below) and (D) that has mandatory prepayment, repurchase or redemption, covenant, default and remedy provisions customary for senior notes (or no more restrictive than is customary) of an issuer that is the parent of a borrower under senior secured credit facilities, and in any event, with respect to covenant, default and remedy provisions, no more restrictive (taken as a whole) than those set forth in this Agreement (other than provisions customary for senior notes of a holding company, including (x) customary assets sale, change of control provisions and customary acceleration rights after an event of default and (y) customary “AHYDO” payments); provided that the Borrowers shall have delivered a certificate of a Responsible Officer to the Administrative Agent at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such Indebtedness, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Indebtedness or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have reasonably determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the foregoing requirement (and such certificate shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy the foregoing requirement unless the Administrative Agent notifies the Borrower Representative within such five Business Day period that it disagrees with such determination (including a reasonably detailed description of the basis upon which it disagrees)); provided , further , that any such Indebtedness shall constitute Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness only if immediately after giving effect to the issuance or incurrence thereof and the use of proceeds thereof, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

Qualified IPO ” means the issuance by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company of its common Equity Interests in an underwritten primary public offering (other than a public offering pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-8), resulting in such Equity Interests being listed on a nationally recognized stock exchange in the applicable jurisdiction.

Ratio-Based Incremental Facility ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.14(a) .

Recipient ” means the Administrative Agent and any Lender, or any other recipient of any payment to be made by or on account of any obligation of any Loan Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document, as applicable.

Refinancing ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions”.

Refinancing Amendment ” means an amendment to this Agreement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent, among the Borrowers, the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Lenders providing Specified Refinancing Debt, effecting the incurrence of such Specified Refinancing Debt in accordance with Section  2.18 .

Refinancing Notes ” means one or more series of senior unsecured notes, or senior secured notes secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations, or on a junior basis to the Obligations, in each case issued by one or more Borrower in respect of a refinancing of outstanding Indebtedness of such Borrower or Borrowers under any one or more Tranches; provided that (a) if such Refinancing Notes shall be secured, (i) then such Refinancing Notes shall only be secured by a security interest in the Collateral that secured the Tranche being refinanced, and (ii) then such Refinancing Notes shall be issued subject to the Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements; (b) no Refinancing Notes shall (i) mature prior to the Latest Maturity Date with respect to Loans then in effect

 

-46-


immediately after giving effect to such refinancing or (ii) be subject to any amortization prior to the final maturity thereof, or be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except (x) customary assets sale, change of control or event of loss or similar event provisions and a customary acceleration right after an event of default or (y) “AHYDO” payments); (c) the covenants, events of default, guarantees, collateral and other terms of such Refinancing Notes are customary for similar debt securities in light of then-prevailing market conditions at the time of issuance (it being understood that no Refinancing Notes shall include any financial maintenance covenants (including indirectly by way of a cross-default to this Agreement), but that customary cross-acceleration provisions may be included and that any negative covenants with respect to indebtedness, investments, liens or restricted payments shall be incurrence-based) and in any event are not more favorable to the investors providing such Refinancing Notes, when taken as a whole, than the terms of the Indebtedness being refinanced by such Refinancing Notes (other than with respect to interest rate, prepayment premiums and optional redemption provisions), except for covenants or other provisions (x) applicable only to periods after the Latest Maturity Date then in effect immediately after giving effect to such refinancing or (y) otherwise acceptable to the Administrative Agent ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such Refinancing Notes, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such Refinancing Notes or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set forth in this clause (c), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)); (d) such Refinancing Notes may not have obligors and Liens that are more extensive than those which apply to the Loans under this Agreement (it being understood that the roles of such obligors as a borrower or a guarantor with respect to such obligations may be interchanged); and (e) the Net Cash Proceeds of such Refinancing Notes shall be applied, substantially concurrently with the incurrence thereof, to the pro rata prepayment of outstanding Loans under the applicable Tranche being so refinanced and the payment of fees, expenses and premiums, if any, payable in connection therewith.

Refinancing Notes Indentures ” means, collectively, the indentures or other similar agreements pursuant to which any Refinancing Notes are issued, together with all instruments and other agreements in connection therewith, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof, but only to the extent permitted under the terms of the Loan Documents.

Register ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(c) .

Regulation S-X ” means Regulation S-X under the Securities Act.

Related Parties ” means, with respect to any Person, such Person’s Affiliates and the partners, members, directors, managers, officers, employees, agents, attorneys-in-fact, trustees and advisors of such Person and of such Person’s Affiliates.

Relevant Transaction ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.05(b)(ii) .

Replaceable Lender ” has the meaning specified in Section  3.07(a) .

Reportable Event ” means any of the events set forth in Section 4043(c) of ERISA, other than events for which the 30-day notice period has been waived.

 

-47-


Request for Credit Extension ” means with respect to a Borrowing, conversion or continuation of Loans, a Committed Loan Notice.

Required Lenders ” means, as of any date of determination, Lenders having more than 50% of the sum of the (a) Total Outstandings and (b) aggregate unused Commitments; provided that the unused Commitments of, and the portion of the Total Outstandings held or deemed held by, (x) any Defaulting Lender shall be excluded for purposes of making a determination of Required Lenders and (y) any Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall be deemed to have voted in the same proportion as Lenders that are not Affiliate Lenders vote on such matter.

Responsible Officer ” means the chief executive officer, representative, director, manager, president, vice president, executive vice president, chief financial officer, treasurer or assistant treasurer, secretary or assistant secretary, an authorized signatory, an attorney-in-fact (to the extent empowered by the board of directors/managers of Holdings or the Borrowers), or other similar officer of a Loan Party. Any document delivered hereunder that is signed by a Responsible Officer of a Loan Party shall be conclusively presumed to have been authorized by all necessary corporate, partnership and/or other action on the part of such Loan Party and such Responsible Officer shall be conclusively presumed to have acted on behalf of such Loan Party.

Restricted Payment ” means any dividend or other distribution (whether in cash, securities or other property) with respect to any Equity Interest of any Person, or any payment (whether in cash, securities or other property), including any sinking fund or similar deposit, on account of the purchase, redemption, retirement, defeasance, acquisition, cancellation or termination of any such Equity Interest, or on account of any return of capital to such Person’s stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent Persons thereof).

Restricted Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of Holdings that is not an Unrestricted Subsidiary, which for the avoidance of doubt shall include the Borrowers.

Royal Bank ” has the meaning specified in the introductory paragraph to this Agreement.

Same Day Funds ” means disbursements and payments in immediately available funds.

Sanctions Laws and Regulations ” means (i) any sanctions or requirements imposed by, or based upon the obligations or authorities set forth in, the PATRIOT Act, the Executive Order No. 13224 of September 23, 2001, entitled Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten to Commit, or Support Terrorism (66 Fed. Reg. 49079 (2001)), the U.S. International Emergency Economic Powers Act (50 U.S.C. §§ 1701 et seq.), the U.S. Trading with the Enemy Act (50 U.S.C. App. §§ 1 et seq.), the U.S. Syria Accountability and Lebanese Sovereignty Act, the U.S. Comprehensive Iran Sanctions, Accountability, and Divestment Act of 2010 or the Iran Sanctions Act, Section 1245 of the National Defense Authorization Act of 2012, all as amended, or any of the foreign assets control regulations (including but not limited to 31 C.F.R., Subtitle B, Chapter V, as amended) or any other law or executive order relating thereto administered by the U.S. Department of the Treasury Office of Foreign Assets Control, and any similar law, regulation, or executive order enacted in the United States after the date of this Agreement and (ii) any sanctions or requirements imposed under similar laws or regulations enacted by the European Union, any member state thereof or the United Kingdom (including, without limitation, by Her Majesty’s Treasury) that apply to a Borrower or the Restricted Subsidiaries.

S&P ” means Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and any successor thereto.

 

-48-


Screen Rate ” means in relation to LIBOR, the London interbank offered rate administered by the ICE Benchmark Administration Limited (or any other person which takes over the administration of that rate) for the relevant currency and period displayed on pages LIBOR1 or LIBOR02 of the Reuters screen (or any replacement Reuters page which displays that rate) or, in each case, on the appropriate page of such other information service which publishes that rate from time to time in place of Reuters; provided that, if the Screen Rate shall be less than zero, such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement. If such page or service ceases to be available, the Administrative Agent may specify another page or service displaying the relevant rate after consultation with the Borrowers.

SEC ” means the Securities and Exchange Commission, or any Governmental Authority succeeding to any of its principal functions.

Secured Obligations ” has the meaning specified in the applicable Collateral Document.

Secured Parties ” means, collectively, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, the Lenders, and each co-agent or subagent appointed by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent from time to time pursuant to Article IX .

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Security Agreement ” means, collectively, the Security Agreement dated as of the Closing Date executed by the Loan Parties party thereto, substantially in the form of Exhibit G , together with each other security agreement and security agreement supplement executed and delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 , 6.14 or 6.16 .

Security Agreement Supplement ” has the meaning specified in the Security Agreement.

Seller ” has the meaning specified in the Acquisition Agreement.

Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded Senior Secured Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries.

Shared Debt Cap ” means, at any time, (a) the greater of (i) $36,000,000 and (ii) 42% of Consolidated EBITDA, less (b) the amount of any Indebtedness then outstanding and incurred in reliance on the Shared Debt Cap.

Solvent ” and “ Solvency ” mean, with respect to any Person on any date of determination, that on such date (i) the sum of the debt (including contingent liabilities) of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, does not exceed the present fair value of the assets of the Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, (ii) the sum of the debt (including contingent liabilities) of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, does not exceed the present fair saleable value (on a going concern basis) of the assets of the Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole; (iii) the capital of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, is not unreasonably small in relation to the business of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, contemplated as of such date; and (iv) such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, do not intend to incur, or believe that they will incur, debts including current obligations beyond their ability to pay such debt as they mature in the ordinary course of business. For the purposes hereof, the amount of any contingent liability at any time shall be computed as the amount that, in light of all of the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured liability (irrespective of whether such contingent liabilities meet the criteria for accrual under Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 5).

 

-49-


SPC ” has the meaning specified in Section  10.07(g) .

Specified Acquisition Agreement Representations ” means the representations in the Acquisition Agreement made with respect to the Company and its Subsidiaries that are material to the interests of the Lenders, but only to the extent that Holdings, a Borrower or any Affiliate thereof has the right to terminate its obligations under the Acquisition Agreement, or the right to decline to consummate the Acquisition, as a result of a breach of such representations in the Acquisition Agreement.

Specified Refinancing Agent ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Debt ” has the meaning specified in Section  2.18(a) .

Specified Refinancing Loans ” means Specified Refinancing Debt constituting term loans.

Specified Representations ” means those representations and warranties of the Borrowers and Holdings and of the other Guarantors (solely with respect to the Subsidiary Guarantee) set forth in Sections 5.01 , 5.02(a) , 5.04 , 5.13 , 5.17 , 5.18 and 5.19 (limited, in the case of clauses (b) and (c) of such Section  5.19 to the provisions thereof relating to the use of proceeds of the Loans).

Specified Transaction ” means any incurrence or repayment of Indebtedness (excluding Indebtedness incurred for working capital purposes other than pursuant to this Agreement) or Investment that results in a Person becoming a Subsidiary, any designation of a Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary or as an Unrestricted Subsidiary, any Permitted Acquisition or any Disposition that results in a Restricted Subsidiary ceasing to be a Subsidiary of a Borrower, any Investment constituting an acquisition of assets constituting a business unit, line of business or division of another Person or any Disposition of a business unit, line of business or division of a Borrower or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case whether by merger, consolidation, amalgamation or otherwise or any material restructuring of the Borrowers or implementation of any initiative (including cost saving, operating expense reduction not in the ordinary course of business.

Sponsor ” means CEOF II DE AIV, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership or each of its Control Investment Affiliates (but excluding any operating portfolio companies of the foregoing).

Sponsor Model ” means the model delivered to each of the Arrangers on or about October 6, 2016 (together with any updates or modifications thereto reasonably agreed between the Sponsor and the Arrangers or as necessary to reflect an exercise of “market flex” pursuant to the Fee Letter and, to the extent not reflected in the Sponsor Model, any original issue discount).

Statutory Reserve Rate ” means a fraction (expressed as a decimal), the numerator of which is the number one and the denominator of which is the number one minus the aggregate of the maximum reserve percentage (including any marginal, special, emergency or supplemental reserves) expressed as a decimal established by the FRB to which the Administrative Agent is subject with respect to the Eurodollar Rate, for eurocurrency funding (currently referred to as “Eurocurrency Liabilities” in Regulation D of the FRB). Such reserve percentage shall include those imposed pursuant to such Regulation D. Eurodollar Rate Loans shall be deemed to constitute eurocurrency funding and to be subject to such reserve requirements without benefit of or credit for proration, exemptions or offsets that may be available from time to time to any Lender under such Regulation D or any comparable regulation. The Statutory Reserve Rate shall be adjusted automatically on and as of the effective date of any change in any reserve percentage.

 

-50-


Subsidiary ” of a Person means a corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other business entity (a) of which a majority of the shares of securities or other Equity Interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors, managers or other governing body (other than securities or interests having such power only by reason of the happening of a contingency) are at the time beneficially owned, or (b) the management of which is otherwise controlled, directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, or both, by such Person and, in the case of this clause (b), which is treated as a consolidated subsidiary for accounting purposes. Unless otherwise specified, all references herein to a “Subsidiary” or to “Subsidiaries” shall refer to a Subsidiary or Subsidiaries of a Borrower.

Subsidiary Guarantor ” means, collectively, the Restricted Subsidiaries of Holdings that are Guarantors.

Subsidiary Guaranty ” means, collectively, the Subsidiary Guaranty made by the Subsidiary Guarantors in favor of the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Secured Parties, substantially in the form of Exhibit F-2 , together with each other guaranty and guaranty supplement delivered pursuant to Section  6.12 .

Successor Company ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.04(h) .

Swap Contract ” means (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, and (b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement, including any obligations or liabilities under any such master agreement.

Swap Termination Value ” means, in respect of any one or more Swap Contracts, after taking into account the effect of any legally enforceable netting agreement relating to such Swap Contracts, (a) for any date on or after the date such Swap Contracts have been closed out and termination value(s) determined in accordance therewith, such termination value(s), and (b) for any date prior to the date referenced in clause (a), the amount(s) determined as the mark-to-market value(s) for such Swap Contracts, as determined based upon one or more mid-market or other readily available quotations provided by any recognized dealer in such Swap Contracts (which may include a Lender or any Affiliate of a Lender).

Synthetic Lease Obligation ” means the monetary obligation of a Person under a so-called synthetic, off-balance sheet or tax retention lease as determined pursuant GAAP.

Target Companies ” means each of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries, as defined in the Acquisition Agreement.

 

-51-


Target Company Material Adverse Effect ” means any event, change, occurrence, circumstance or effect that has had or would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a material adverse change in, or effect on, the business, assets, properties, financial condition or results of operations of the Company Entities, taken as a whole; provided that any such change or effect to the extent resulting from any of the following, individually or in the aggregate, shall not be considered when determining whether a Material Adverse Effect has occurred: (i) any change in economic conditions generally or capital and financial markets generally, including changes in interest or exchange rates, (ii) any industry wide change in the industry in which the Business operates or in which products of the Business are used or distributed, (iii) any change in Laws or GAAP, or the enforcement or interpretation thereof, applicable to the Business after the date hereof, (iv) political conditions in jurisdictions in which the Business operates, including hostilities, acts of war, sabotage, terrorism or military actions, or any escalation or worsening of any of the foregoing, (v) any change resulting from the execution, announcement or consummation of the transactions contemplated by, or the performance of express obligations under, this Agreement or the Ancillary Agreements, including any such change resulting from the identity of, or facts and circumstances relating to, Buyer; provided that this clause (v) does not apply to any representation or warranty made in Section 2.2, Section 2.3, Section 2.15(c)(ii) or Section 2.15(c)(iii) (in each case, of the Acquisition Agreement) (or any condition to Closing as it relates to either such representation or warranty), (vi) any action taken by Buyer and any of its Affiliates, agents or representatives, (vii) any hurricane, flood, tornado, earthquake or other natural disaster or any other force majeure event, (viii) any actions required to be taken or omitted pursuant to this Agreement or the Ancillary Agreements, (ix) the failure of the Business to achieve any financial projections or forecasts (provided that the cause or basis for the Company Entities failing to meet such projections or forecasts may be considered in determining the existence of a Material Adverse Effect unless such cause or basis is otherwise excluded by this definition) or (x) any matter set forth in the Seller Disclosure Letter, other than, in each case, to the extent any such change or item has a disproportionate effect on the Company Entities relative to other participants in the same business as the Company Entities. Capitalized terms used in the definition of Target Company Material Adverse Effect (other than the terms “Acquisition Agreement” and “Target Company Material Adverse Effect”) shall have the meaning given to them in the Acquisition Agreement.

Tax Group ” has the meaning specified in Section  7.06(e)(ii) .

Taxes ” means all present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, deductions, withholdings (including backup withholding), assessments, fees or other similar charges imposed by any Governmental Authority, including any interest, additions to tax or penalties applicable thereto.

Threshold Amount ” means, with respect to each category set forth below, an amount equal to the “Minimum Threshold Amount” set forth opposite such category or a whole multiple in excess thereof of the amount set forth opposite such category under the heading “Incremental Multiples in Excess Thereof.”

 

Category

   Minimum Threshold
Amount
     Incremental Multiples
in Excess Thereof
 

Auction Amount for Loans

   $ 5,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Reply Amount for Loans

   $ 1,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Borrowing/Conversion of Base Rate Loans

   $ 1,000,000      $ 250,000  

Borrowing/Continuation/Conversion of Eurocurrency Rate Loans

   $ 1,000,000      $ 250,000  

Optional Prepayment of Loans

   $ 3,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

 

-52-


Category

   Minimum Threshold
Amount
     Incremental Multiples
in Excess Thereof
 

Specified Refinancing Debt Threshold

   $ 8,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Incremental Amount

   $ 5,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Incremental Notes Amount

   $ 8,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Assignment of Tranche

   $ 1,000,000      $ 1,000,000  

Total Net Leverage Ratio ” means, on any date of determination, with respect to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, the ratio of (a) Funded Indebtedness (less the Unrestricted Cash of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date) of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on such date to (b) Consolidated EBITDA of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries for the four fiscal quarter period most recently then ended for which financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) .

Total Outstandings ” means the aggregate Outstanding Amount of all Loans.

Tranche ” means the respective facility and commitments utilized in making Loans hereunder, including (i) the Initial Facility and (ii) additional Tranches that may be added after the Closing Date, i.e., New Loans, Specified Refinancing Loans, New Commitments and Specified Refinancing Commitments.

Transaction s” means the acquisition of the Equity Interests of the Target Companies by LD Lower pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement, together with each of the following transactions consummated or to be consummated in connection therewith:

(a) the contribution (the “ Equity Contribution ”) of cash or rollover equity to the Borrowers (including for these purposes equity of Holdings contributed to the Borrowers to facilitate the Acquisition) in an aggregate amount not less than 35% of the total pro forma consolidated gross debt and equity capitalization of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries on the Closing Date after giving effect to the Transactions (excluding any letters of credit issued on the Closing Date under the First Lien Facilities and amounts funded hereunder or under the First Lien Facility to fund upfront fees or original issue discount in respect of the Facility or the First Lien Facilities) from, directly or indirectly, Holdings, the Sponsor, certain of the Sponsor’s Affiliates, members of management of the Target Companies, the Seller and other Permitted Holders. Any investments made by the Persons described in the preceding sentence in Holdings shall be in the form of (i) common equity and/or (ii) preferred equity with terms reasonably acceptable to the Arrangers; provided that (x) not less than 50.1% of the total Equity Contribution shall be attributable to contributions by the Sponsor; and (y) the contribution by Holdings to the Borrowers of the Equity Contribution shall be in the form of common equity;

(b) the Acquisition;

(c) the execution and delivery of Loan Documents to be entered into on the Closing Date and the funding of the Loans on the Closing Date;

(d) the execution and delivery of First Lien Facility Documentation to be entered into on the Closing Date and the funding of the First Lien Loans, to the extent funded, on the Closing Date;

 

-53-


(e) (x) the repayment of all Indebtedness and the termination of any financing commitments under the Existing Credit Agreement and (y) the refinancing or repayment of all existing third party Indebtedness for borrowed money of the Target Companies and their Subsidiaries, other than (i) ordinary course capital leases, purchase money indebtedness, equipment financings, customer financings and related guarantees, hedging obligations and related guarantees and other ordinary short term working capital facilities, (ii) indebtedness permitted to remain outstanding or be incurred prior to the Closing Date under the Acquisition Agreement, (iii) intercompany indebtedness and (iv) Indebtedness described on Schedule  7.03 , including certain Indebtedness that the Arrangers and Borrowers agree may remain outstanding on the Closing Date (the “ Refinancing ”); and

(f) the payment of all fees, costs and expenses incurred in connection with the transactions described in the foregoing provisions of this definition (the “ Transaction Costs ”).

Transaction Costs ” has the meaning given to such term in the definition of “Transactions.”

Type ” means, with respect to a Loan, its character as a Base Rate Loan or a Eurocurrency Rate Loan.

Unaudited Financial Information ” means, collectively (a) the unaudited financial statements of LD Intermediate and its Subsidiaries for the fiscal quarters ending March 31, 2016, June 30, 2016 and September 30, 2016 and (b) the unaudited financial statements of the Target Companies for the nine month period ending June 30, 2016.

Undisclosed Administration ” means the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official by a supervisory authority or regulator with respect to a Lender under or pursuant to the law in the country where such Lender is subject to home jurisdiction supervision, if applicable law requires that such appointment is not to be publicly disclosed.

Unfunded Advances/Participations ” means with respect to the Administrative Agent, the aggregate amount, if any (i) made available to the Borrowers on the assumption that each Lender has made available to the Administrative Agent such Lender’s share of the applicable Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent as contemplated by Section  2.12(b) and (ii) with respect to which a corresponding amount shall not in fact have been returned to the Administrative Agent by the Borrowers or made available to the Administrative Agent by any such Lender.

Unfunded Pension Liability ” means the excess of a Plan’s benefit liabilities under Section 4001(a)(16) of ERISA over the current value of such Plan’s assets, determined in accordance with assumptions used for funding the Plan pursuant to Section 412 of the Code for the applicable plan year.

Uniform Commercial Code ” or “ UCC ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as the same may from time to time be in effect in the State of New York or the Uniform Commercial Code (or similar code or statute) of another jurisdiction, to the extent it may be required to apply to any item or items of Collateral.

United Kingdom ” and “ U.K. ” mean the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland.

United States ” and “ U.S. ” mean the United States of America.

Unrestricted Cash ” means, as of any date of determination, the aggregate amount of all cash and Cash Equivalents on the consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries that is not

 

-54-


restricted for purposes of GAAP, in each case, in excess of (a) $25,000,000 less (b) the aggregate amount of LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payments (not to exceed $25,000,000) that (i) have been made in cash by Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on or prior to such date of determination or (ii) reduced in whole or in part in accordance with the definition thereof.

Unrestricted Subsidiary ” means (a) any Subsidiary of Holdings designated by the Borrower Representative as an Unrestricted Subsidiary hereunder by written notice to the Administrative Agent; provided that the Borrower Representative shall only be permitted to so designate an Unrestricted Subsidiary so long as (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, (ii) no such Subsidiary or any of its Subsidiaries owns any Equity Interests, or owns or holds any Lien on any property of, a Borrower or any other Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower that is not a Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so designated, (iii) such Unrestricted Subsidiary shall be capitalized (to the extent capitalized by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary) through Investments as permitted by, and in compliance with, Section  7.02 and valued at its fair market value (as determined by the Borrowers in good faith) at the time of such designation, (iv) without duplication of clause (iii), any assets owned by such Unrestricted Subsidiary at the time of the initial designation thereof shall be treated as Investments pursuant to Section  7.02 and valued at their fair market value (as determined by the Borrowers in good faith) at the time of such designation, (v) such Subsidiary shall have been or will promptly be designated an “unrestricted subsidiary” (or otherwise not be subject to the covenants) under the First Lien Credit Agreement, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes and all Permitted Refinancings in respect thereof, and any Permitted Ratio Debt in each case (other than the First Lien Credit Agreement) with an aggregate outstanding principal amount in excess of $24,000,000 and (vi) the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate executed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying compliance with the requirements of preceding clauses (i) through (v) and (b) any Subsidiary of an Unrestricted Subsidiary. The Borrower Representative may designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary for purposes of this Agreement (each, a “ Subsidiary Redesignation ”); provided that (A) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, (B) any Indebtedness of the applicable Subsidiary and any Liens encumbering its property existing as of the time of such Subsidiary Redesignation shall be deemed newly incurred or established, as applicable, at such time and (C) the Borrower Representative shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate executed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying compliance with the requirements of the preceding clause (A); provided , further , that no Unrestricted Subsidiary that has been designated as a Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a Subsidiary Redesignation may again be designated as an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

U.S. Person ” means any Person that is a “United States person” as defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code.

U.S. Subsidiary ” means any Subsidiary of a Borrower that (i) is organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia, (ii) is not a Subsidiary of a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary and (iii) is not a FSHCO.

U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 3.01(g)(ii)(B)(III) .

Voting Equity Interests ” means, with respect to any Person, the outstanding Equity Interests of a Person having the power, directly or indirectly, to designate the board of directors (or equivalent governing body) of such Person.

 

-55-


Weighted Average Life to Maturity ” means, when applied to any Indebtedness at any date, the number of years (and/or portion thereof) obtained by dividing: (a) the sum of the products obtained by multiplying (i) the amount of each then remaining installment, sinking fund, serial maturity or other required payments of principal, including payment at final maturity, in respect thereof, by (ii) the number of years (calculated to the nearest one-twelfth) that will elapse between such date and the making of such payment; by (b) the then outstanding principal amount of such Indebtedness; provided that the effects of any prepayments or amortization made on such Indebtedness shall be disregarded in making such calculation.

wholly-owned ” means, with respect to a Subsidiary of a Person, a Subsidiary of such Person all of the outstanding Equity Interests of which (other than (x) director’s qualifying shares and (y) shares issued to foreign nationals to the extent required by applicable Law) are owned by such Person and/or by one or more wholly-owned Subsidiaries of such Person.

Withholding Agent ” means any Loan Party and the Administrative Agent.

Write-Down and Conversion Powers ” means, with respect to any EEA Resolution Authority, the write-down and conversion powers of such EEA Resolution Authority from time to time under the Bail-In Legislation for the applicable EEA Member Country, which write-down and conversion powers are described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule.

Section 1.02 Other Interpretive Provisions . With reference to this Agreement and each other Loan Document, unless otherwise specified herein or in such other Loan Document:

(a) The meanings of defined terms are equally applicable to the singular and plural forms of the defined terms.

(b) The words “herein,” “hereto,” “hereof” and “hereunder” and words of similar import when used in any Loan Document shall refer to such Loan Document as a whole and not to any particular provision thereof.

(c) References in this Agreement to an Exhibit, Schedule, Article, Section, clause or subclause refer (A) to the appropriate Exhibit or Schedule to, or Article, Section, clause or subclause in this Agreement or (B) to the extent such references are not present in this Agreement, to the Loan Document in which such reference appears.

(d) The term “including” is by way of example and not limitation.

(e) The term “documents” includes any and all instruments, documents, agreements, certificates, notices, reports, financial statements and other writings, however evidenced, whether in physical or electronic form.

(f) Any reference herein to any Person shall be construed to include such Person’s successors and assigns.

(g) In the computation of periods of time from a specified date to a later specified date, the word “from” means “from and including”; the words “to” and “until” each mean “to but excluding;”; and the word “through” means “to and including.”

(h) Section headings herein and in the other Loan Documents are included for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

 

-56-


(i) In connection with any action being taken in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition, except to the extent expressly set forth herein, for purposes of determining compliance with any provision of this Agreement which requires that no Default, Event of Default or specified Event of Default, as applicable, has occurred, is continuing or would result from any such action, as applicable, such condition shall be deemed satisfied, so long as no Default, Event of Default or specified Event of Default, as applicable, exists on the date the definitive agreements for such Limited Condition Acquisition are entered into after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Limited Condition Acquisition and the actions to be taken in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) as if such Limited Condition Acquisition and other actions had occurred on such date. For the avoidance of doubt, if the Borrowers have exercised their option under the first sentence of this clause (i), and any Default or Event of Default occurs following the date the definitive agreements for the applicable Limited Condition Acquisition were entered into and prior to the consummation of such Limited Condition Acquisition, any such Default or Event of Default shall be deemed to not have occurred or be continuing solely for purposes of determining whether any action being taken in connection with such Limited Condition Acquisition is permitted hereunder.

(j) In connection with any action being taken solely in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition, for purposes of:

(i) determining compliance with any provision of this Agreement which requires the calculation of the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio, or the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, or

(ii) testing availability under baskets set forth in this Agreement (including baskets measured as a percentage of Consolidated EBITDA),

in each case, at the option of the Borrowers (the Borrowers’ election to exercise such option in connection with any Limited Condition Acquisition, an “ LCA Election ”), the date of determination of whether any such action is permitted hereunder, shall be deemed to be the date the definitive agreements for such Limited Condition Acquisition are entered into (the “ LCA Test Date ”), and if, after giving Pro Forma Effect to the Limited Condition Acquisition and the other transactions to be entered into in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) as if they had occurred at the beginning of the most recent four consecutive fiscal quarters ending prior to the LCA Test Date for which consolidated financial statements of the Borrowers are available, the Borrowers could have taken such action on the relevant LCA Test Date in compliance with such ratio or basket, such ratio or basket shall be deemed to have been complied with. For the avoidance of doubt, if the Borrowers have made an LCA Election and any of the ratios or baskets for which compliance was determined or tested as of the LCA Test Date are exceeded as a result of fluctuations in any such ratio or basket, including due to fluctuations in Consolidated EBITDA of the Borrowers or the Person subject to such Limited Condition Acquisition, at or prior to the consummation of the relevant transaction or action, such baskets or ratios will not be deemed to have been exceeded as a result of such fluctuations. If the Borrowers have made an LCA Election for any Limited Condition Acquisition, then in connection with any subsequent calculation of any ratio or basket availability with respect to the incurrence of Indebtedness or Liens, or the making of Investments or Restricted Payments, mergers, the conveyance, lease or other transfer of all or substantially all of the assets of the Borrowers, the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasance or other satisfaction of Indebtedness, or the designation of an Unrestricted Subsidiary on or following the relevant LCA Test Date and prior to the earlier of the date on which such Limited Condition Acquisition is consummated or the definitive agreement for such Limited Condition Acquisition

 

-57-


is terminated or expires without consummation of such Limited Condition Acquisition, any such ratio or basket shall be calculated on a pro forma basis assuming such Limited Condition Acquisition and other transactions in connection therewith (including any incurrence of Indebtedness and the use of proceeds thereof) have been consummated; provided that the calculation of Consolidated Net Income (and any defined term a component of which is Consolidated Net Income) shall not include the Consolidated Net Income of the Person or assets to be acquired in any Limited Condition Acquisition until such time as such Limited Condition Acquisition is actually consummated.

Section 1.03 Accounting Terms .

(a) All accounting terms not specifically or completely defined herein shall be construed in conformity with, and all financial data (including financial ratios and other financial calculations) required to be submitted pursuant to this Agreement shall be prepared in conformity with, GAAP, as in effect from time to time.

(b) If at any time any change in GAAP or the application thereof would affect the computation or interpretation of any financial ratio, basket, requirement or other provision set forth in any Loan Document, and either the Borrower Representative or the Required Lenders shall so request, the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall negotiate in good faith to amend such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision to preserve the original intent thereof in light of such change in GAAP or the application thereof (subject to the approval of the Required Lenders not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed); provided that, until so amended, (i) (A) such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision shall continue to be computed or interpreted in accordance with GAAP or the application thereof prior to such change therein and (B) the Borrowers shall provide to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders a written reconciliation in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, between calculations of such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision made before and after giving effect to such change in GAAP or the application thereof or (ii) the Borrowers may elect to fix GAAP (for purposes of such ratio, basket, requirement or other provision) as of another later date notified in writing to the Administrative Agent from time to time.

(c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, all such financial statements shall be prepared, and all financial covenants contained herein or in any other Loan Document shall be calculated, in each case, without giving effect to any election under FASB ASC 825 (or any similar accounting principle) permitting a Person to value its financial liabilities at the fair value thereof.

(d) Any reference to any specific pronouncement or principle herein not otherwise operative under GAAP shall be deemed to refer to any such similar pronouncement or principle as may be operative under GAAP.

Section 1.04 Rounding . Any financial ratios required to be maintained by Holdings, or satisfied in order for a specific action to be permitted, under this Agreement shall be calculated by dividing the appropriate component by the other component, carrying the result to one place more than the number of places by which such ratio is expressed herein and rounding the result up or down to the nearest number (with a rounding-up if there is no nearest number).

Section 1.05 References to Agreements and Laws . Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, (a) references to Organization Documents, agreements (including the Loan Documents) and other contractual instruments shall be deemed to include all subsequent amendments, restatements, extensions, supplements and other modifications thereto, but only to the extent that such amendments, restatements, extensions, supplements and other modifications are permitted by any Loan Document and (b) references

 

-58-


to any Law shall include all statutory and regulatory provisions consolidating, amending, replacing, supplementing or interpreting such Law. Unless otherwise expressly set forth herein, references to specific provisions (or defined terms) in the First Lien Facility Documentation shall be to such provisions (or defined terms) as amended or replaced (to the extent such amendment or replacement is permitted by the Loan Documents), and cross-references shall be deemed amended as necessary to refer to the same provisions that are referenced in the First Lien Facility Documentation as in effect on the Closing Date.

Section 1.06 Timing of Payment or Performance . When the payment of any obligation or the performance of any covenant, duty or obligation is stated to be due or performance required on a day which is not a Business Day, the date of such payment (other than as specifically provided in Section  2.12 or as described in the definition of Interest Period) or performance shall extend to the immediately succeeding Business Day.

Section 1.07 Currency Equivalents Generally .

(a) Any amount specified in this Agreement (other than in Articles II , IX and X or as set forth in clause (b) of this Section) or any of the other Loan Documents to be in Dollars shall also include the equivalent of such amount in any currency other than Dollars, such equivalent amount to be determined at the Exchange Rate; provided that if any basket is exceeded solely as a result of fluctuations in applicable currency exchange rates after the last time such basket was utilized (including in connection with any Permitted Refinancing), such basket will not be deemed to have been exceeded solely as a result of such fluctuations in currency exchange rates.

(b) For purposes of determining the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio and the Total Net Leverage Ratio, amounts denominated in a currency other than Dollars will be converted to Dollars, at the Exchange Rate as of the date of calculation, and will, in the case of Indebtedness, reflect the currency translation effects, determined in accordance with GAAP, of Swap Contracts permitted hereunder for currency exchange risks with respect to the applicable currency in effect on the date of determination of the Dollar equivalent of such Indebtedness.

Section 1.08 [Reserved] .

Section 1.09 Pro Forma Calculations .

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio and Consolidated EBITDA shall be calculated (including for purposes of Sections 2.14 and 2.15 ) on a Pro Forma Basis with respect to each Specified Transaction occurring during the applicable four quarter period to which such calculation relates, and/or subsequent to the end of such four-quarter period but not later than the date of such calculation; provided that notwithstanding the foregoing, when calculating the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio for purposes of determining the applicable percentage of Excess Cash Flow for purposes of Section  2.05(b) , any Specified Transaction and any related adjustment contemplated in the definition of Pro Forma Basis (and corresponding provisions of the definition of “Consolidated EBITDA”) that occurred subsequent to the end of the applicable four quarter period shall not be given Pro Forma Effect. The calculation of the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio, the Total Net Leverage Ratio and Consolidated EBITDA on a Pro Forma Basis for the purpose of determining if any action is permitted under an incurrence test hereunder shall be based on the financial statements that have been most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) or Section  6.01(b) (or prior to such initial delivery thereunder, the most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Section  4.01(l) ).

 

-59-


(b) Whenever Pro Forma Effect is to be given to a Specified Transaction, the amount of “run-rate” cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and acquisition synergies projected by the Borrowers in good faith to be realized (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis as though such items had been realized on the first day of such period and as if such items were realized during the entirety of such period) as a result of specified actions taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (in the good faith determination of the Borrowers), with “run-rate” meaning the full recurring benefit for a period that is associated with any action taken, committed to be taken or with respect to which substantial steps have been taken or are expected to be taken (including any savings expected to result from the elimination of a public target’s compliance costs with public company requirements) net of the amount of actual benefits realized during such period from such actions, such adjustments shall be included in the initial pro forma calculations of such financial ratios or tests and during any subsequent measurement period in which the effects thereof are expected to be realized relating to such Specified Transaction; provided that (A) such cost savings, operating expense reductions, other operating improvements and synergies are factually supportable in the good faith judgment of the Borrowers and as determined in good faith by the Borrowers and are reasonably anticipated to be realized within 18 months after the consummation of any operational change or the acquisition or disposition which is expected to result in such cost savings, expense reductions, operating improvements or synergies, (B) no cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies shall be added pursuant to this clause (b) to the extent duplicative of any expenses or charges otherwise added to Consolidated Net Income or Consolidated EBITDA, whether through a pro forma adjustment or otherwise, with respect to such period, (C) projected amounts (that are not yet realized) may no longer be added in calculating Consolidated EBITDA to the extent occurring more than six full fiscal quarters after the specified action taken in order to realize such projected cost savings, operating expense reductions, operating improvements and synergies and (D) amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to this Section  1.09(b) shall not, when combined with amounts added to Consolidated EBITDA pursuant to clause (b)(vi) of the definition thereof (other than to the extent in connection with the Transactions or the LDiscovery Transactions), in the aggregate exceed 25% of Consolidated EBITDA (determined prior to giving effect to such amounts) in any four consecutive fiscal quarter period.

Section 1.10 Calculation of Baskets . If any of the baskets set forth in Article  VII of this Agreement are exceeded solely as a result of fluctuations to Consolidated EBITDA for the most recently completed fiscal quarter after the last time such baskets were calculated for any purpose under Article  VII , such baskets will not be deemed to have been exceeded solely as a result of such fluctuations.

Section 1.11 Treatment of Subsidiaries Prior to Joinder . Each Subsidiary of Holdings that is required to be joined as a Loan Party pursuant to Section  6.12 shall, until the completion of such joinder, be deemed for the purposes of Article  VII of this Agreement to be a Loan Party from and after the Closing Date (or the date of formation or acquisition of such subsidiary).

ARTICLE II

The Commitments and Credit Extensions

Section 2.01 The Loans . Subject to the terms and conditions set forth herein, each Initial Lender severally agrees to make a single loan denominated in Dollars (the “ Initial Loans ”) to the Borrowers (on a joint and several basis) on the Closing Date in an amount equal to such Initial Lender’s Initial Commitment. The Initial Borrowing shall consist of Initial Loans made simultaneously by the Initial Lenders in accordance with their respective Initial Commitments. Amounts borrowed under this Section  2.01(a) and subsequently repaid or prepaid may not be reborrowed. Initial Loans may be Base Rate Loans or Eurocurrency Rate Loans as provided herein.

 

-60-


Section 2.02 Borrowings, Conversions and Continuations of Loans .

(a) Each Borrowing, each conversion of Loans from one Type to the other, and each continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be made upon irrevocable notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent.

(i) With respect to such Borrowings, conversions or continuations, each such notice must be in writing and must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 12:00 noon (New York Time) three Business Days prior to the requested date of any Borrowing, conversion to or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or such shorter period as the Administrative Agent shall agree in its sole discretion) or by 12:00 noon (New York Time) on the Business Day immediately preceding the requested date of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans); provided , however , that if the Borrowers wishes to request Eurocurrency Rate Loans having an Interest Period other than one, two, three or six months in duration as provided in the definition of Interest Period, the applicable notice from the Borrower Representative must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York Time) five Business Days prior to the requested date of such Borrowing or continuation, whereupon the Administrative Agent shall give prompt notice to the Appropriate Lenders of such request and determine whether the requested Interest Period is acceptable to all of them. Not later than 10:00 a.m. (New York Time) three Business Days before the requested date of such Borrowing or continuation, the Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrower Representative whether or not the requested Interest Period has been consented to by all the Appropriate Lenders.

(ii) Each notice by the Borrower Representative pursuant to Section  2.02(a)(i) shall be delivered to the Administrative Agent in the form of a written Committed Loan Notice, appropriately completed and signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers. Each Borrowing, conversion or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount for a Borrowing. Each Committed Loan Notice shall specify (i) whether the Borrowers are requesting a Borrowing, a conversion of a Tranche Loans from one Type to the other, or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans, (ii) the requested date of the Borrowing, conversion or continuation, as the case may be (which shall be a Business Day), (iii) the principal amount of Loans to be borrowed, converted or continued, (iv) the Type of Loans to be borrowed or to which existing Tranche of Loans are to be converted, (v) if applicable, the duration of the Interest Period with respect thereto and (vi) wire instructions of the account(s) to which funds are to be disbursed (it being understood, for the avoidance of doubt, that the amount to be disbursed to any particular account may be less than the Threshold Amount set forth above so long as the aggregate amount to be disbursed to all such accounts pursuant to such Borrowing meets such Threshold Amount). If with respect to any Eurocurrency Rate Loans, the Borrowers fail to specify a Type of Loan in a Committed Loan Notice or if the Borrowers fail to give a timely notice requesting a conversion or continuation of such Loans, then the applicable Tranche of Loans shall be made as or converted to, Base Rate Loans. Any such automatic conversion to Base Rate Loans shall be effective as of the last day of the Interest Period then in effect with respect to the applicable Eurocurrency Rate Loans.

(b) Following receipt of a Committed Loan Notice, the Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each applicable Lender of the amount of its ratable share of the applicable Tranche of Loans, and if no timely notice of a conversion or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loan is provided by the Borrower Representative, the Administrative Agent shall notify each Lender of the details of any automatic continuation or conversion to Eurocurrency Rate Loans with an Interest Period of one month or Base Rate Loans, as applicable, as described in Section  2.02(a) . Each Appropriate Lender shall make the amount of its Loan available to the Administrative Agent in immediately available funds at the Administrative

 

-61-


Agent’s Office not later than 12:00 noon (New York Time), in each case, on the Business Day specified in the applicable Committed Loan Notice. Upon satisfaction of the applicable conditions set forth in Section  4.02 (and, if such Borrowing is the initial Credit Extension, Section  4.01 ), the Administrative Agent shall make all funds so received available to the Borrowers in like funds as received by the Administrative Agent either by (i) crediting the account of the applicable Borrower on the books of the Administrative Agent with the amount of such funds or (ii) wire transfer of such funds, in each case in accordance with instructions provided to (and reasonably acceptable to) the Administrative Agent by the Borrower Representative.

(c) Except as otherwise provided herein, a Eurocurrency Rate Loan may be continued or converted only on the last day of an Interest Period for such Eurocurrency Rate Loan unless the Borrowers pay the amount due under Section  3.05 in connection therewith.

(d) The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower Representative and the Lenders of the interest rate applicable to any Interest Period for Eurocurrency Rate Loans upon determination of such interest rate. The determination of the Eurocurrency Rate by the Administrative Agent shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error.

(e) After giving effect to all Borrowings, all conversions of Loans from one Type to the other and all continuations of Loans of the same Type, there shall not be more than fifteen Interest Periods in effect.

(f) The failure of any Lender to make the Loan to be made by it as part of any Borrowing shall not relieve any other Lender of its obligation, if any, hereunder to make its Loan on the date of such Borrowing, but no Lender shall be responsible for the failure of any other Lender to make the Loan to be made by such other Lender on the date of any Borrowing.

Section 2.03 [Reserved] .

Section 2.04 [Reserved] .

Section 2.05 Prepayments .

(a) Optional . (i) The Borrowers may, upon notice by the Borrower Representative substantially in the form of Exhibit  K-1 to the Administrative Agent, at any time or from time to time voluntarily prepay Loans in whole or in part without premium or penalty except as set forth in Section  2.05(a)(iv) , as applicable, below; provided that (1) such notice must be received by the Administrative Agent not later than, 1:00 p.m. (New York Time), in each case, (x) three Business Days prior to any date of prepayment of such Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (y) one Business Day prior to any date of prepayment of Base Rate Loans; (2) any prepayment of Loans shall be in an amount equal to the applicable Threshold Amount or, if less, the entire principal amount thereof then outstanding. Each such notice shall specify the date and amount of such prepayment, the Tranche of Loans to be prepaid, the Type(s) of Loans to be prepaid and, if Eurocurrency Rate Loans are to be prepaid, the Interest Period(s) of such Loans (except that if the class of Loans to be prepaid includes both Base Rate Loans and Eurocurrency Rate Loans, absent direction by the Borrower Representative, the applicable prepayment shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans to the full extent thereof before application to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case in a manner that minimizes the amount payable by the Borrowers in respect of such prepayment pursuant to Section  3.05) . The Administrative Agent will promptly notify each Lender of its receipt of each such notice, and of the amount of such Lender’s ratable portion of such prepayment (based on such Lender’s ratable share of the relevant Tranche). If such notice is given by the Borrower Representative, subject to clause (iii) below, the Borrowers shall make such prepayment and the payment

 

-62-


amount specified in such notice shall be due and payable on the date specified therein. Any prepayment of a Eurocurrency Rate Loan shall be accompanied by all accrued interest thereon, together with any additional amounts required pursuant to Section  2.05(a)(iv) , as applicable, and Section  3.05 . Subject to Section  2.17 , each prepayment of outstanding Tranches pursuant to this Section  2.05(a) shall be applied to such Tranche on a pro rata basis. All voluntary prepayments of a Tranche in accordance with this Section 2.05(a) shall be paid to the Appropriate Lenders on a pro rata basis, except as set forth above.

(ii) [Reserved].

(iii) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, any notice of prepayment under Section  2.05(a)(i) or (a)(ii) may state that it is conditioned upon the occurrence or non-occurrence of any event specified therein (including the effectiveness of other credit facilities), in which case such notice may be revoked by the Borrower Representative (by written notice to the Administrative Agent on or prior to the specified effective date) if such condition is not satisfied.

(iv) If the Borrowers, (A) make a voluntary prepayment of any Initial Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(a) , (B) make a repayment of any Initial Loans pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(iii) or (C) repays such Initial Loans at acceleration pursuant to Section  8.02(b) , in each case, on or prior to the second anniversary of the Closing Date, the Borrower shall pay to the Administrative Agent, for the ratable account of the applicable Lenders, a prepayment premium in an amount equal to (1) 3.00% of the principal amount of such Loans prepaid or repaid if such prepayment occurs on or prior to the first anniversary of the Closing Date, (2) 2.00% of the principal amount of such Loans prepaid or repaid if such prepayment occurs after the first anniversary of the Closing Date but on or prior to the second anniversary of the Closing Date and (3) 1.00% of the principal amount of such Loans prepaid or repaid if such prepayment occurs after the second anniversary of the Closing Date but on or prior to the third anniversary of the Closing Date.

(b) Mandatory . (i) Within ten Business Days after financial statements have been delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) and the related Compliance Certificate has been delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(b) (or, if later, the date on which such financial statements and such Compliance Certificate are required to be delivered), the Borrowers shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of Loans in an amount equal to (A) 75% (as may be adjusted pursuant to the proviso below) of Excess Cash Flow in excess of $5,000,000 for the fiscal year covered by such financial statements commencing with the fiscal year ending on December 31, 2017, minus (B) the sum of (1) the aggregate amount of voluntary principal prepayments of the Loans and First Lien Loans (solely, with respect to First Lien Loans under any Revolving Tranche (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement), to the extent accompanied by a corresponding permanent commitment reduction thereof and Loans and First Lien Loans repurchased pursuant to Dutch Auctions or dutch auctions in respect of the First Lien Loans or open market purchases (in the case of Loans, to the extent offered to all Lenders on a pro rata basis) in an amount equal to the discounted purchase price of such Loans or First Lien Loans paid in respect of such Loans or First Lien Loans pursuant to such Dutch Auctions or through open market purchases) in each case other than to the extent that any such prepayment is funded with the proceeds of Specified Refinancing Debt, Refinancing Notes or any other long-term Indebtedness, in each case, occurring during the applicable Excess Cash Flow Period and (2) any amount not required to be applied pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(viii) ; provided that such percentage in respect of any Excess Cash Flow Period shall be reduced to 50%, 25% or 0% if the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio as of the last day of the fiscal year to which such Excess Cash Flow Period relates was equal to or less than 5.25 to 1.00, 4.75 to 1.00 or 4.25 to 1.00, respectively; provided, further, that until the Discharge of First Lien Credit Agreement Obligations (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement), no mandatory prepayments of Loans shall be required under this Section 2.05(b)(i) except to the extent of mandatory prepayments pursuant to Section 2.05(b)(i) of the First Lien Credit Agreement declined by the lenders thereunder in accordance with Section 2.05(c) of the First Lien Credit Agreement.

 

-63-


(ii) (A) If (x) a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary Disposes of any property or assets pursuant to Section  7.05(e) , (m) , (n) , (p) or (s)  or (y) any Casualty Event occurs, and any transaction or series of related transactions described in the foregoing clauses (x) and (y) results in the receipt by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary of aggregate Net Cash Proceeds such that proceeds realized in any fiscal year exceed $5,000,000 (such annual amount, the “ Annual Net Cash Proceeds Threshold ”) (any such transaction or series of related transactions resulting in Net Cash Proceeds being a “ Relevant Transaction ”), (1) the Borrower Representative shall give written notice to the Administrative Agent thereof promptly after the date of receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds and (2) except to the extent the Borrowers elect in such notice to reinvest all or a portion of such Net Cash Proceeds in accordance with Section  2.05(b)(ii)(B) , the Borrowers shall prepay, subject to Section  2.05(b)(viii) an aggregate principal amount of Loans in an amount equal to 100% (as may be adjusted pursuant to the second proviso below) of all Net Cash Proceeds in excess of the Annual Net Cash Proceeds Threshold received from such Relevant Transaction within fifteen Business Days of receipt thereof by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary; provided that the Borrowers may use a portion of the Net Cash Proceeds received from such Relevant Transaction to prepay or repurchase any other Indebtedness that is secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with Liens securing the Obligations to the extent such other Indebtedness and the Liens securing the same are permitted hereunder and the documentation governing such other Indebtedness requires such a prepayment or repurchase thereof with the proceeds of such Relevant Transaction, to the extent not deducted in the calculation of Net Cash Proceeds, in each case in an amount not to exceed the product of (1) the amount of such Net Cash Proceeds and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the outstanding principal amount of such other Indebtedness (or to the extent such amount is not in Dollars, such equivalent amount of such Indebtedness converted into Dollars as determined in accordance with Section  1.07 ) and the denominator of which is the aggregate outstanding principal amount of Loans and such other Indebtedness (or to the extent such amount is not in Dollars, such equivalent amount of such Indebtedness converted into Dollars as determined in accordance with Article  I ); provided , further , that prepayments of First Lien Term Loans pursuant to Section 2.05(b)(ii) of the First Lien Credit Agreement (to the extent then outstanding) shall reduce the prepayment requirements under this Section 2.05(b)(ii) on a dollar-for-dollar basis.

(B) With respect to any Net Cash Proceeds realized or received with respect to any Relevant Transaction at the option of the Borrowers, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary may reinvest all or any portion of such Net Cash Proceeds in the business within 365 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds (or, if the Borrowers or the relevant Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, has contractually committed within 365 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds to reinvest such Net Cash Proceeds, then within 545 days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds); provided , however , that if any of such Net Cash Proceeds are no longer intended to be so reinvested at any time after the occurrence of the Relevant Transaction (or are not reinvested within such 365 days or 545 days, as applicable), an amount equal to any such Net Cash Proceeds shall be promptly applied to the prepayment of Loans (subject to the proviso set forth in clause (A) above) as set forth in this Section  2.05 .

(iii) Upon the incurrence or issuance by a Borrower or any Restricted Subsidiary of any Refinancing Notes, any Specified Refinancing Loans or any Indebtedness not expressly permitted to be incurred or issued pursuant to Section  7.03 , the Borrowers shall prepay an aggregate principal amount of Tranches in an amount equal to 100% of all Net Cash Proceeds received therefrom immediately upon receipt thereof by the applicable Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary.

(iv) [Reserved].

 

-64-


(v) [Reserved].

(vi) Subject to Section  2.17 , each prepayment of Loans pursuant to this Section  2.05(b) shall be applied to each Tranche on a pro rata basis (or, if agreed to in writing by the Majority Lenders of a Tranche, in a manner that provides for more favorable prepayment treatment of other Tranches, so long as each other such Tranche receives its Pro Rata Share of any amount to be applied more favorably, except to the extent otherwise agreed by the Majority Lenders of each Tranche receiving less than such Pro Rata Share) (other than a prepayment of (x) Loans with the proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section  2.18 , which shall be applied to the Tranche being refinanced pursuant thereto or (y) Loans with the proceeds of any Refinancing Notes issued to the extent permitted under Section  7.03(b)(i) , which shall be applied to the Tranche being refinanced pursuant thereto). Each prepayment of Loans under a Facility pursuant to this Section  2.05(b) shall be applied on a pro rata basis to the then outstanding Base Rate Loans and Eurocurrency Rate Loans under such Facility; provided that, with respect to such prepayment, then the amount thereof shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans under such Facility to the full extent thereof before application to Eurocurrency Rate Loans, in each case in a manner that minimizes the amount payable by the Borrowers in respect of such prepayment pursuant to Section  3.05 , subject to the rights of the Declining Lenders to not be paid.

(vii) All prepayments under this Section  2.05 shall be made together with, in the case of any such prepayment of a Eurocurrency Rate Loan on a date other than the last day of an Interest Period therefor, any amounts owing in respect of such Eurocurrency Rate Loan pursuant to Section  3.05 and, to the extent applicable, any additional amounts required pursuant to Section  2.05(a)(iv) . Notwithstanding any of the other provisions of this Section  2.05(b) , so long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, if any prepayment of Eurocurrency Rate Loans is required to be made under this Section  2.05(b) , other than on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, the Borrowers may, in their sole discretion, deposit the amount of any such prepayment otherwise required to be made thereunder into a cash collateral account until the last day of such Interest Period, at which time the Administrative Agent shall be authorized (without any further action by or notice to or from the Borrowers or any other Loan Party) to apply such amount to the prepayment of such Loans in accordance with this Section  2.05(b) . Upon the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, the Administrative Agent shall also be authorized (without any further action by or notice to or from the Borrowers or any other Loan Party) to apply such amount to the prepayment of the outstanding Loans in accordance with this Section  2.05(b) .

(viii) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section  2.05 , (A) to the extent that any or all of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Disposition by a Borrower Party (a “ Foreign Disposition ”) or the Net Cash Proceeds of any Casualty Event from a Borrower Party (a “ Foreign Casualty Event ”), in each case giving rise to a prepayment event pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(ii) , or Excess Cash Flow attributable to a Borrower Party (“ Foreign Excess Cash Flow ”) giving rise to a prepayment event pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(i) are or is prohibited, restricted or delayed by applicable local law from being repatriated to the Borrowers that would be required to make such a prepayment, an amount equal to the portion of such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow so affected will not be required to be applied to repay Loans at the times provided in this Section  2.05 but may be retained by the applicable Borrower Party so long, but only so long, as the applicable local law will not permit repatriation to the Borrowers (the Borrowers hereby agreeing to use commercially reasonable efforts to cause the applicable Borrower Party to promptly take all actions reasonably required by the applicable local law to permit such repatriation), and once such repatriation of any of such affected Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow is permitted under the applicable local law, such repatriation will be immediately effected and an amount equal to such repatriated Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow will be promptly (and in any event not later than two Business Days after such repatriation) applied (net of additional Taxes payable or reserved against as a result thereof) to the repayment of the Loans pursuant to this Section  2.05 to the extent provided herein

 

-65-


and (B) to the extent that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that repatriation of any or all of the Net Cash Proceeds of any Foreign Disposition, any Foreign Casualty Event or Foreign Excess Cash Flow would have a material adverse Tax consequence (taking into account any foreign tax credit or benefit actually realized in connection with such repatriation) with respect to such Net Cash Proceeds or Foreign Excess Cash Flow, the Net Cash Proceeds or Foreign Excess Cash Flow so affected may be retained by the applicable Borrower Party; provided that no amounts retained by a Borrower Party pursuant to this Section  2.05(b)(viii) shall, in any event, increase the Cumulative Credit pursuant to clause (b) of the definition thereof; provided , further , that, in the case of this clause (B), on or before the date on which an amount equal to any Net Cash Proceeds so retained would otherwise have been required to be applied to reinvestments or prepayments pursuant to this Section  2.05 (or twelve months after the date such Excess Cash Flow would have been so required to be applied if it were Net Cash Proceeds), (x) the Borrowers shall apply an amount equal to such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow to such reinvestments or prepayments as if such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow had been received by the Borrowers rather than such Borrower Party, less the amount of additional Taxes that would have been payable or reserved against if such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow had been repatriated (or, if less, the Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow that would be calculated if received by such Borrower Party) or (y) such Net Cash Proceeds or Excess Cash Flow are applied to the repayment of Indebtedness of the applicable Borrower Party.

(c) Lender Opt-Out . With respect to any prepayment of Initial Loans and, unless otherwise specified in the documents therefor, other Tranches pursuant to Section  2.05(b)(i) or (ii), any Appropriate Lender, at its option (but solely to the extent the Borrowers elect for this clause (c) to be applicable to a given prepayment), may elect not to accept such prepayment as provided below. The Borrower Representative may notify the Administrative Agent of any event giving rise to a prepayment under Section  2.05(b)(i) or (ii)  at least ten Business Days prior to the date of such prepayment. Each such notice shall specify the date of such prepayment and provide a reasonably detailed calculation of the amount of such prepayment that is required to be made under Section  2.05(b)(i) or (ii) (the “ Prepayment Amount ”). The Administrative Agent will promptly notify each Appropriate Lender of the contents of any such prepayment notice so received from the Borrower Representative, including the date on which such prepayment is to be made (the “ Prepayment Date ”). Any Appropriate Lender may (but solely to the extent the Borrowers elect for this clause (c) to be applicable to a given prepayment) decline to accept all (but not less than all) of its share of any such prepayment (any such Lender, a “ Declining Lender ”) by providing written notice to the Administrative Agent no later than 5:00 p.m. (New York Time) one Business Day after the date of such Appropriate Lender’s receipt of notice from the Administrative Agent regarding such prepayment. If any Appropriate Lender does not give a notice to the Administrative Agent on or prior to such fifth Business Day informing the Administrative Agent that it declines to accept the applicable prepayment, then such Lender will be deemed to have accepted such prepayment (all such Lenders, together with all other Lenders who are not an Declining Lenders, the “ Accepting Lenders ”). The Administrative Agent shall give notice to the Accepting Lenders of the aggregate amount declined by the Declining Lenders (the “ Reoffered Amount ”). Any Accepting Lender may decline to accept all (but not less than all) of its share of any Reoffered Amount (any such Lender, a “ Secondary Declining Lender ”) by providing written notice to the Administrative Agent no later than 5:00 p.m. (New York Time) one Business Day after the date of such notice from the Administrative Agent regarding the Reoffered Amount. If any Accepting Lender does not give a notice to the Administrative Agent prior to such time informing the Administrative Agent that it declines to accept the Reoffered Amount, then such Accepting Lender will be deemed to have accepted the Reoffered Amount (all such Lenders, the “ Secondary Accepting Lenders ”). On any Prepayment Date, an amount equal to the Prepayment Amount minus the portion of the Reoffered Amount that is declined shall be paid to the Administrative Agent by the Borrowers and applied by the Administrative Agent ratably to prepay Loans under the Tranches owing to Accepting Lenders in the manner described in Section  2.05(b) for such prepayment ( provided that if there are no Accepting Lenders, no such prepayments shall be required). Any amounts declined from the Reoffered Amount (or if there are no Accepting Lenders, the Prepayment Amount) shall be retained by the Borrowers (such amounts, “ Declined Amounts ”).

 

-66-


(d) All Loans shall be repaid, whether pursuant to this Section  2.05 or otherwise, in Dollars.

Section 2.06 Termination or Reduction of Commitments .

The Aggregate Commitments under a Tranche of Loans shall be automatically and permanently reduced to zero on the date of the initial incurrence of Loans under such Tranche.

Section 2.07 Repayment of Loans .

(a) Initial Loans . The Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, repay to the Administrative Agent for the ratable account of the Appropriate Lenders holding Initial Loans on the applicable Maturity Date for the Initial Loans the aggregate principal amount of all Initial Loans outstanding on such date.

(b) [Reserved] .

(c) All Loans shall be repaid, whether pursuant to this Section  2.07 or otherwise, in Dollars.

Section 2.08 Interest .

(a) Subject to the provisions of Section  2.08(b) , (i) each Eurocurrency Rate Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof for each Interest Period at a rate per annum equal to the sum of (A) the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate for such Interest Period plus (B) the Applicable Rate for Eurocurrency Rate Loans and (ii) each Base Rate Loan shall bear interest on the outstanding principal amount thereof from the applicable borrowing date or conversion date, as the case may be, at a rate per annum equal to the sum of (A) the Base Rate plus (B) the Applicable Rate for Base Rate Loans. The Borrowers shall pay interest on all overdue Obligations hereunder, which shall include all Obligations following an acceleration pursuant to Section  8.02 (including an automatic acceleration) at a fluctuating interest rate per annum at all times equal to the Default Rate to the fullest extent permitted by applicable Laws. Accrued and unpaid interest on past due amounts (including interest on past due interest) shall be due and payable upon demand.

(b) Accrued interest on each Loan shall be due and payable in arrears on each Interest Payment Date applicable thereto and at such other times as may be specified herein; provided that in the event of any repayment or prepayment of any Loan, accrued interest on the principal amount repaid or prepaid shall be payable on the date of such repayment or prepayment. Interest hereunder shall be due and payable in accordance with the terms hereof before and after judgment, and before and after the commencement of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law.

(c) Interest on each Loan shall be payable in Dollars.

(d) All computations of interest hereunder shall be made in accordance with Section  2.10 of this Agreement.

Section 2.09 Fees .

(a) The Borrowers shall pay to the Arrangers and the Administrative Agent for their own respective accounts fees in the amounts and at the times specified in the Fee Letter or other agreements between one or more Borrower and any of the Arrangers or the Administrative Agent in connection with this Agreement.

 

-67-


(b) The Borrowers shall pay to the Lenders such fees as shall have been separately agreed upon in writing in the amounts and at the times so specified.

Section 2.10 Computation of Interest and Fees .

All computations of interest for Base Rate Loans based on clause (b) of the definition thereof shall be made on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days, as the case may be, and actual days elapsed. All other computations of fees and interest shall be made on the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed (which results in more fees or interest, as applicable, being paid than if computed on the basis of a 365-day year). Interest shall accrue on each Loan for the day on which the Loan is made, and shall not accrue on a Loan, or any portion thereof, for the day on which the Loan or such portion is paid; provided that any Loan that is repaid on the same day on which it is made shall, subject to Section  2.12(a) , bear interest for one day. Each determination by the Administrative Agent of an interest rate or fee hereunder shall be conclusive and binding for all purposes, absent manifest error.

Section 2.11 Evidence of Indebtedness .

(a) The Credit Extensions made by each Lender and the interest thereon shall be evidenced by one or more accounts or records maintained by such Lender and evidenced by one or more entries in the Register. The accounts or records maintained by the Administrative Agent and each Lender shall be prima facie evidence absent manifest error of the amount of the Credit Extensions made by the Lenders to the Borrowers and the interest and payments thereon. Any failure to so record or any error in doing so shall not, however, limit the obligation of the Borrowers hereunder to pay any amount owing with respect to the Obligations. In the event of any conflict between the accounts and records maintained by any Lender and the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent in respect of such matters, the accounts and records of the Administrative Agent shall control in the absence of manifest error. Upon the request of any Lender made through the Administrative Agent, the Borrowers shall execute and deliver to such Lender (through the Administrative Agent) a Note payable to such Lender, which shall evidence such Lender’s Loans in addition to such accounts or records. Each Lender may attach schedules to its Note and endorse thereon the date, Type (if applicable), amount and maturity of its Loans and payments with respect thereto.

(b) Entries made in good faith by the Administrative Agent in the Register pursuant to Sections 2.11(a) , and by each Lender in its accounts or records pursuant to Sections 2.11(a) , shall be prima facie evidence of the amount of principal and interest due and payable or to become due and payable from the Borrowers to, in the case of the Register, each Lender and, in the case of such accounts or records, such Lender, under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, absent manifest error; provided that the failure of the Administrative Agent or such Lender to make an entry, or any finding that an entry is incorrect, in the Register or such accounts or records shall not limit the obligations of the Borrowers under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 2.12 Payments Generally; Administrative Agent s Clawback .

(a) General . All payments to be made by the Borrowers shall be joint and several and shall be made without condition or deduction for any counterclaim, defense, recoupment or setoff. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, all payments by the Borrowers hereunder shall be made to the Administrative Agent, for the account of the respective Lenders to which such payment is owed, at the applicable Administrative Agent’s Office in Dollars and in Same Day Funds not later than 1:00 p.m.

 

-68-


(New York Time) on the dates specified herein. The Administrative Agent will promptly distribute to each Lender its ratable share in respect of the relevant Tranche (or other applicable share as provided herein) of such payment in like funds as received by wire transfer to such Lender’s Lending Office. All payments received by the Administrative Agent after 1:00 p.m. (New York Time), shall, in each case, be deemed received on the next succeeding Business Day and any applicable interest or fee shall continue to accrue. If any payment to be made by the Borrowers shall come due on a day other than a Business Day, payment shall be made on the next following Business Day, and such extension of time shall be reflected in computing interest or fees, as the case may be; provided , however , that, if such extension would cause payment of interest on or principal of Eurocurrency Rate Loans to be made in the next succeeding calendar month, such payment shall be made on the immediately preceding Business Day.

(b) Funding by Lenders ; Presumption by Administrative Agent . Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from a Lender prior to the proposed date of any Borrowing of Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or, in the case of any Borrowing of Base Rate Loans, prior to 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on the date of such Borrowing) that such Lender will not make available to the Administrative Agent such Lender’s share of such Borrowing, the Administrative Agent may assume that such Lender has made such share available on such date in accordance with and at the time required by Section  2.02(b) and may, in reliance upon such assumption, make available to the Borrowers a corresponding amount. In such event, if any Lender does not in fact make its share of the applicable Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent, then such Lender, on the one hand, and the Borrowers, on the other hand, severally agree to pay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand an amount equal to such applicable share in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such amount is made available to the Borrowers by the Administrative Agent to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at (A) in the case of a payment to be made by such Lender, the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Administrative Agent in connection with the foregoing and (B) in the case of a payment to be made by the Borrowers, the interest rate applicable to Base Rate Loans. If both the Borrowers and such Lender pay such interest to the Administrative Agent for the same or an overlapping period, the Administrative Agent shall promptly remit to the Borrowers the amount of such interest paid by the Borrowers for such period. If such Lender pays its share of the applicable Borrowing to the Administrative Agent, then the amount so paid (less interest and fees) shall constitute such Lender’s Loan included in such Borrowing. Any payment by the Borrowers shall be without prejudice to any claim the Borrowers may have against a Lender that shall have failed to make its share of any Borrowing available to the Administrative Agent.

(c) Payments by the Borrowers; Presumptions by Administrative Agent . Unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from the Borrower Representative prior to the date on which any payment is due to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Lenders hereunder that the Borrowers will not make such payment, the Administrative Agent may assume that the Borrowers have made such payment on such date in accordance herewith and may, in reliance upon such assumption, distribute to the Appropriate Lenders the amount due. In such event, if the Borrowers do not in fact make such payment, then each of the Appropriate Lenders severally agrees to repay to the Administrative Agent forthwith on demand the amount so distributed to such Lender, in immediately available funds with interest thereon, for each day from and including the date such amount is distributed by the Administrative Agent to but excluding the date of payment to the Administrative Agent, at the greater of the Federal Funds Rate and a rate reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation, plus any reasonable administrative, processing or similar fees customarily charged by the Administrative Agent in connection with the foregoing.

 

-69-


A notice of the Administrative Agent to any Lender or the Borrowers with respect to any amount owing under this Section  2.12(c) shall be conclusive, absent manifest error.

(d) Failure to Satisfy Conditions Precedent . If any Lender makes available to the Administrative Agent funds for any Loan to be made by such Lender as provided in the foregoing provisions of this Article II , and such funds are not made available to the Borrowers by the Administrative Agent because the conditions to the applicable Credit Extension set forth in Article IV are not satisfied or waived in accordance with the terms hereof, the Administrative Agent shall return such funds (in like funds as received from such Lender) to such Lender on demand, without interest.

(e) Obligations of the Lenders Several . The obligations of the Lenders hereunder to make Loans and to make payments pursuant to Section  9.07 are several and not joint. The failure of any Lender to make any Loan or to make any payment under Section  9.07 on any date required hereunder shall not relieve any other Lender of its corresponding obligation to do so on such date, and no Lender shall be responsible for the failure of any other Lender to so make its Loan or, or to make its payment under Section  9.07 .

(f) Funding Source . Nothing herein shall be deemed to obligate any Lender to obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner or to constitute a representation by any Lender that it has obtained or will obtain the funds for any Loan in any particular place or manner.

(g) Insufficient Funds . If at any time insufficient funds are received by and available to the Administrative Agent to pay fully all amounts of principal, interest and fees then due hereunder, such funds shall be applied (i) first, toward payment of interest and fees then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of interest and fees then due to such parties, and (ii) second, toward payment of principal then due hereunder, ratably among the parties entitled thereto in accordance with the amounts of principal then due to such parties.

(h) Unallocated Funds . If the Administrative Agent receives funds for application to the Obligations of the Loan Parties under or in respect of the Loan Documents under circumstances for which the Loan Documents do not specify the manner in which such funds are to be applied, the Administrative Agent may, but shall not be obligated to, elect to distribute such funds to each of the Lenders in accordance with such Lender’s ratable share of the sum of the Outstanding Amount of all Loans outstanding at such time, in repayment or prepayment of such of the outstanding Loans then owing to such Lender.

Section 2.13 Sharing of Payments . If, other than as expressly provided elsewhere herein (including the application of funds arising from the existence of a Defaulting Lender), any Lender shall obtain, either directly or indirectly, on account of the Loans made by it, any payment (whether voluntary, involuntary, through the exercise of any right of setoff, or otherwise) in excess of its ratable share (or other share contemplated hereunder) thereof, such Lender shall immediately (a) notify the Administrative Agent of such fact and (b) purchase from the other Lenders such participations in the Loans made by them as shall be necessary to cause such purchasing Lender to share the excess payment in respect of such Loans or such participations, as the case may be, pro rata with each of them; provided , however , that if all or any portion of such excess payment is thereafter recovered from the purchasing Lender under any of the circumstances described in Section  10.06 (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by the purchasing Lender in its discretion), such purchase shall to that extent be rescinded and each other Lender shall repay to the purchasing Lender the purchase price paid therefor, together with an amount equal to such paying Lender’s ratable share (according to the proportion of (i) the amount of such paying Lender’s required repayment to (ii) the total amount so recovered from the purchasing Lender) of any interest or other amount paid or payable by the purchasing Lender in respect of the total amount so recovered,

 

-70-


without further interest thereon. The Borrowers agree that any Lender so purchasing a participation from another Lender may, to the fullest extent permitted by Law, exercise all its rights of payment (including the right of setoff, but subject to Section  10.09 ) with respect to such participation as fully as if such Lender were the direct creditor of the Borrowers in the amount of such participation. The Administrative Agent will keep records (which shall be conclusive and binding in the absence of manifest error) of participations purchased under this Section  2.13 and will in each case notify the Lenders following any such purchases or repayments. Each Lender that purchases a participation pursuant to this Section  2.13 shall from and after such purchase have the right to give all notices, requests, demands, directions and other communications under this Agreement with respect to the portion of the Obligations purchased to the same extent as though the purchasing Lender were the original owner of the Obligations purchased. For the avoidance of doubt, the provisions of this Section  2.13 shall not be construed to apply to (A) the assignments and participations (including by means of a Dutch Auction and open market debt repurchases) described in Section  10.07 , (B) (i) the incurrence of any New Loans in accordance with Section  2.14 or (ii) any Specified Refinancing Debt in accordance with Section  2.18 , (C) any loan modification offer described in Section  10.01 , or (D) any applicable circumstances contemplated by Section  2.05(b) , 2.14 , 2.17 or 3.07 .

Section 2.14 Incremental Facilities .

(a) The Borrowers may, from time to time after the Closing Date, upon notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent (who shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders) specifying the proposed amount thereof, request (i) an increase in any Tranche then outstanding (which shall be on the same terms as, and become part of, the Tranche proposed to be increased hereunder) (each, a “ Commitment Increase ”) and (ii) the addition of one or more new term loan facilities to the Facility (each, a “ New Facility ”; and any advance made by a Lender thereunder, a “ New Loan ”; and the commitments thereof, the “ New Commitment ”) by an amount not to exceed (after giving effect to any applicable usage of such amount under this Agreement) the sum of (x) $45,000,000, minus the aggregate principal amount of (1) Incremental Notes incurred pursuant to Section  2.15 in reliance on the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, (2) First Lien Additional Indebtedness utilizing Section  2.14(a)(x) of the First Lien Credit Agreement and (3) Incremental Notes (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) incurred pursuant to Section  2.15 of the First Lien Credit Agreement in reliance on the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) (such aggregate amount, the “ Cash-Capped Incremental Facility ”) plus (y) an unlimited amount (the “ Ratio-Based Incremental Facility ”) so long as the Maximum Senior Secured Net Leverage Requirement is satisfied plus (z) an amount equal to all voluntary prepayments of Loans made pursuant to Section  2.05(a) or Section  10.07(j)(i)(A) other than such voluntary prepayments financed with the proceeds of other Indebtedness (the “ Prepay Incremental Amount ”) (such sum, at any such time, the “ Incremental Amount ”); provided that any such request for an increase shall be in a minimum amount equal to the lesser of (x) the applicable Threshold Amount and (y) the entire amount of any increase that may be requested under this Section  2.14 ; provided , further , that (1) if at the time of any such incurrence or issuance, there is capacity under the foregoing clause (z), such capacity must be utilized before utilizing any available capacity under the foregoing clauses (x) and (y), (2) any capacity available under the foregoing clause (y) shall be deemed to be utilized prior to utilizing any capacity available under the foregoing clause (x) and (3) loans may be incurred under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and the Prepay Incremental Amount, and proceeds from any such incurrence under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility, the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and the Prepay Incremental Amount may be utilized in a single transaction by first, calculating the incurrence of the Prepay Incremental Amount, if any, second calculating the incurrence under the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility and third calculating the incurrence under the Cash-Capped Incremental Facility; provided , further , that solely for the purpose of calculating the Maximum Senior Secured Net Leverage Requirement to determine the availability under the New Commitments at the time of incurrence, (a) any New Commitments that are unsecured or secured on a junior basis shall

 

-71-


nevertheless be deemed to be secured on a pari passu basis to the Obligations and (b) any cash proceeds from any Commitment Increase or addition of a New Facility pursuant to this Section  2.14 at such test date in calculating such Maximum Senior Secured Net Leverage Requirement shall be excluded for purposes of cash netting (however, to the extent the proceeds thereof are used to repay Indebtedness, Pro Forma Effect shall be given to such repayment of Indebtedness). At the time of sending such notice to the applicable Lenders, the Borrower Representative shall specify the time period within which each applicable Lender is requested to respond (which, unless the Incremental Arranger otherwise agrees, shall in no event be less than ten Business Days from the date of delivery of such notice).

(b) The Borrowers may appoint an Incremental Arranger in connection with a New Commitment. Each applicable Lender shall notify the Incremental Arranger within such time period whether or not it agrees to participate in such new facility or increase of the existing Tranche and, if so, whether by a percentage of the requested increase equal to, greater than, or less than its Pro Rata Share of any then-existing Tranche. Any Lender approached may elect or decline, in its sole discretion, to provide such increase or new facility. Any Lender not responding within such time period shall be deemed to have declined to increase its Commitment with respect to such Tranche or to provide a new Tranche. The Incremental Arranger shall notify the Borrower Representative of the Lenders’ responses to each request made under this Section  2.14 . To achieve the full amount of a requested increase or issuance of a New Facility, as applicable, the Borrowers may also invite additional Eligible Assignees reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent to become Lenders pursuant to a joinder agreement to this Agreement in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger and, to the extent required by clause (iii) in the first proviso after 10.01(i), the Administrative Agent.

(c) If (i) a Tranche is increased in accordance with this Section  2.14 or (ii) a New Facility is added in accordance with this Section  2.14 , the Incremental Arranger and the Borrowers shall determine the effective date (the “ Increase Effective Date ”) and the final allocation of such increase or New Facility among the applicable Lenders. The Incremental Arranger shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders of the final allocation of such increase or New Facility and the Increase Effective Date. In connection with (i) any increase in a Tranche or (ii) any addition of a New Facility, in each case, pursuant to this Section  2.14 , this Agreement and the other Loan Documents may be amended in a writing (which may be executed and delivered by the Borrowers and the Incremental Arranger (and the Lenders hereby authorize such Incremental Arranger to execute and deliver any such documentation)) in order to establish the New Facility or to effectuate the increases to a Tranche and to reflect any technical changes necessary or appropriate to give effect to such increase or new facility in accordance with its terms as set forth herein. If the Incremental Arranger is not the Administrative Agent, the actions authorized to be taken by the Incremental Arranger herein shall be done in consultation with the Administrative Agent and, with respect to the preparation of any documentation necessary or appropriate to carry out the provisions of this Section  2.14 (including amendments to this Agreement), any comments to such documentation reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent shall be reflected therein. The Borrowers and Lenders agree that the Administrative Agent shall have no liability for the actions of any Incremental Arranger (if other than the Administrative Agent) and this sentence shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

(d) With respect to any Commitment Increase or addition of a New Facility pursuant to this Section  2.14 , (i) except as set forth below, no Event of Default would exist after giving effect to such increase, (ii) (A) in the case of any increase or addition of a Tranche, the final maturity of the Loans, New Loans or Specified Refinancing Loans increased or added pursuant to this Section  2.14 shall be no earlier than the Latest Maturity Date for, and such additional Loans shall not have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity shorter than the longest remaining weighted average life of, any other outstanding Loans, New Loans or Specified Refinancing Loans, as applicable, and (B) in the case of any New Facility, such New Facility shall have a final maturity no earlier than the then Latest Maturity Date of any Tranche and the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of such New Facility shall be no shorter than that of any existing

 

-72-


Tranche, (iii) except with respect to all-in yield and as set forth in subclause (B) above with respect to final maturity and Weighted Average Life to Maturity, or otherwise as shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, any such New Facility shall have the same terms as the Facility; provided that (x) to the extent such terms and documentation are not consistent with the existing Facility (except to the extent permitted above), such terms (if favorable to the existing Lenders) shall be incorporated into this Agreement for the benefit of all existing Lenders without further amendment requirements other than consultation with the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  2.14(c) , including, for the avoidance of doubt, at the option of the Borrowers, any increase in the Applicable Rate relating to the existing Facility to bring such Applicable Rate in line with the New Facility to achieve fungibility with such existing Facility and (y) otherwise, may be incorporated if reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger and the Administrative Agent and (iv) to the extent reasonably requested by the Incremental Arranger, the Incremental Arranger shall have received legal opinions, resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 with respect to Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor (in a manner generally consistent with those delivered at the Closing Date, as modified to reflect changes subsequent thereto) (other than changes to such legal opinions resulting from a change in Law, change in fact or change to counsel’s form of opinion reasonably satisfactory to the Incremental Arranger). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the conditions precedent to each such increase or New Facility shall be agreed to by the Lenders providing such increase or New Facility, as applicable, and the Borrowers; provided , further , in connection with the incurrence of any New Loans, if the proceeds of such New Loans are, substantially concurrently with the receipt thereof, to be used, in whole or in part, by the Borrowers or any other Loan Party to finance, in whole or in part, a Permitted Acquisition, then (A) the only representations and warranties hereunder that will be required to be true and correct in all material respects as of the applicable Increase Effective Date shall be (x) the Specified Representations (conformed as necessary for such Permitted Acquisition) and (B) the only Events of Default, the absence of which shall be a condition to such incurrence, shall be those under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g) (“ Permitted Acquisition Provisions ”).

(e) The additional Loans made under the Tranche subject to the increases shall be made by the applicable Lenders participating therein pursuant to the procedures set forth in Sections  2.01 and 2.02 and on the date of the making of such new Loans, and notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in Sections 2.01 and  2.02 , such new Loans shall be added to (and form part of) each Borrowing of outstanding Loans under such Tranche on a pro rata basis (based on the relative sizes of the various outstanding Borrowings), so that each Lender under such Tranche will participate proportionately in each then outstanding Borrowing of Loans under the Tranche.

(f) (i) Any New Facility shall rank pari passu in right of payment, have the same guarantees as, and be unsecured, secured either on an “equal and ratable” basis with the other Facilities or on a junior lien basis to the Facility, in each case over the same Collateral that secures the Facilities (or less Collateral as may be agreed by the Lenders providing such New Facility), and in each case, the application of any proceeds of the Collateral securing such New Facility shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements, (ii) the New Facility shall share ratably in any prepayments of the Loans pursuant to Section  2.05 (or otherwise provide for more favorable prepayment treatment for the then outstanding Tranches than the Loans under such New Facility) and (iii) the all-in yield (whether in the form of interest rate margins, original issue discount, upfront fees, or Eurocurrency Rate or Base Rate floors paid by either Borrower (but not arrangement or underwriting fees paid to arrangers for their own account, structuring fees, ticking fees, commitment fees, unused line fees, any amendment and similar fees (regardless of whether paid in whole or in part to any or all lenders) and any fees not paid generally to all lenders to such applicable Facility) and equating original issue discount and upfront fees paid by either Borrower to interest rate for purposes of this calculation, assuming a four-year life to maturity) (such yield, “ All-In Yield ”) applicable to such New Facility shall be determined by the Borrowers and the

 

-73-


Lenders providing such New Facility and, for any New Facility secured on a pari passu basis, shall not be more than 50 basis points higher than the corresponding All-In Yield for the applicable Tranches of the same currency unless the All-In Yield with respect to such applicable Tranches is increased to the amount necessary so that the difference between the All-In Yield with respect to such New Facility and the corresponding All-In Yield on such applicable Tranches is equal to 50 basis points.

Section 2.15 New Incremental Notes .

(a) The Borrowers may from time to time after the Closing Date, upon notice by the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent, specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof, request to issue one or more series of senior secured, senior unsecured, senior subordinated or subordinated notes (which notes, if secured by the Collateral, are secured on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations or on a junior lien basis to the Facility, and guaranteed only by the entities which are or who become Loan Parties (such notes, collectively, “ New Incremental Notes ”) in an amount not to exceed the Incremental Amount (at the time of issuance); provided that (i) no Event of Default would exist after giving Pro Forma Effect to any such request, subject to the Permitted Acquisition Provisions, and (ii) any such issuance of New Incremental Notes shall be in a minimum amount equal to the lesser of (x) the applicable Threshold Amount and (y) the entire amount that may be requested under this Section  2.15 ; provided , further , that any New Loan Commitments established pursuant to Section  2.14 and New Incremental Notes issued pursuant to this Section  2.15 , will count towards the Ratio-Based Incremental Facility, Cash-Capped Incremental Facilities and Prepay Incremental Amount as set forth in Section  2.14 .

(b) As a condition precedent to the issuance of any New Incremental Notes pursuant to this Section  2.15 , (i) the Borrowers shall deliver to the Administrative Agent a certificate dated as of the date of issuance of the New Incremental Notes signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers, certifying and attaching the resolutions adopted by each Borrower approving or consenting to the issuance of such New Incremental Notes, and certifying that the conditions precedent set forth in the following subclauses (ii) through (ix) have been satisfied (which certificate shall include supporting calculations demonstrating compliance, if applicable, with the Maximum Senior Secured Net Leverage Requirement), (ii) such New Incremental Notes shall not be Guaranteed by any Person that is not a Loan Party, (iii) to the extent guaranteed by any Loan Party or secured by any Collateral, such New Incremental Notes shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements); (iv) such New Incremental Notes shall have a final maturity no earlier than the then Latest Maturity Date, (v) the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of such New Incremental Notes shall not (A) be shorter than that of any then-existing Tranche, or (B) to the extent unsecured, be subject to any amortization prior to the final maturity thereof, or be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except (x) customary assets sale, change of control or event of loss or similar event provisions and a customary acceleration right after an event of default or (y) AHYDO payments), (vi) such New Incremental Notes shall not be subject to any mandatory redemption or prepayment provisions or rights (except to the extent any such mandatory redemption or prepayment is required to be applied pro rata to the Loans and other Indebtedness that is secured on a pari passu basis with the Obligations), (vii) the covenants and events of default (excluding pricing and optional prepayment and redemption terms) of such New Incremental Notes, when taken as a whole, are no more restrictive than those under the Facility (except for covenants or other provisions (x) applicable only to periods after the Latest Maturity Date of the then outstanding Facility or (y) as are incorporated into the Loan Documents for the benefit of all existing Lenders (which may be accomplished without further amendment voting requirements) (it being understood that no New Incremental Notes shall include any financial maintenance covenants (including indirectly by way of a cross-default to this Agreement), but that customary cross-acceleration provisions may be included)), (viii) if secured, such New Incremental Notes shall only be secured by Collateral, and (ix) guarantees, collateral and other terms of such New Incremental Notes are (A) customary for similar debt securities in light of then-prevailing

 

-74-


market conditions at the time of issuance) and (B) otherwise reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent ( provided that a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers delivered to the Administrative Agent in good faith at least five Business Days prior to the incurrence of such New Incremental Notes, together with a reasonably detailed description of the material terms and conditions of such New Incremental Notes or drafts of the documentation relating thereto, stating that the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such terms and conditions satisfy the requirement set forth in this clause (b), shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of its objection during such five Business Day period (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects)). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the conditions precedent to each such increase shall be agreed to by the Lenders providing such increase and the Borrowers.

(c) The issuance of any New Incremental Notes shall also be subject, to the extent reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, to receipt by the Administrative Agent of legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements, including any supplements or amendments to the Collateral Documents to account for such New Incremental Notes. The Lenders hereby authorize the Administrative Agent to enter into amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents with the Borrowers as may be necessary or appropriate in order to secure any New Incremental Notes with the Collateral and/or to make such technical amendments as may be necessary or appropriate in the reasonable opinion of the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers in connection with the issuance of such New Incremental Notes, in each case on terms consistent with this Section  2.15 .

Section 2.16 [Reserved] .

Section 2.17 Defaulting Lenders .

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, if any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, then, until such time as that Lender is no longer a Defaulting Lender, to the extent permitted by applicable Law:

(i) That Defaulting Lender’s right to approve or disapprove any amendment, waiver or consent with respect to this Agreement shall be restricted as set forth in Section  10.01 .

(ii) Any payment of principal, interest, fees or other amounts received by the Administrative Agent for the account of that Defaulting Lender (at maturity, pursuant to Article VIII or otherwise, and including any amounts made available to the Administrative Agent by that Defaulting Lender pursuant to Section  10.09 ), shall be applied at such time or times as may be determined by the Administrative Agent as follows: first , to the payment of any amounts owing by that Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent hereunder; second , , as the Borrowers may request (so long as no Default or Event of Default exists), to the funding of any applicable Loan in respect of which that Defaulting Lender has failed to fund its portion thereof as required by this Agreement, as determined by the Administrative Agent; third , if so determined by the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers, to be held in a non-interest bearing deposit account and released in order to satisfy obligations of that Defaulting Lender to fund Loans under this Agreement; fourth , to the payment of any amounts owing to the Lenders as a result of any non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by any Lender against that Defaulting Lender as a result of that Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; fifth , so long as no Default or Event of Default pursuant to Sections  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  exists, to the payment of any amounts owing to the Borrowers as a result of any non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction obtained by the Borrowers against that Defaulting

 

-75-


Lender as a result of that Defaulting Lender’s breach of its obligations under this Agreement; and sixth , to that Defaulting Lender or as otherwise directed by a court of competent jurisdiction; provided that if (x) under any such Tranche such payment is a payment of the principal amount of any Loans in respect of which that Defaulting Lender has not fully funded its appropriate share and (y) such Loans were made at a time when the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 were satisfied or waived, such payment shall be applied solely to pay the Loans of all Non-Defaulting Lenders under such Tranche on a pro rata basis prior to being applied to the payment of any Loans of that Defaulting Lender. Any payments, prepayments or other amounts paid or payable to a Defaulting Lender that are applied (or held) to pay amounts owed by a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this Section  2.17(a)(ii) shall be deemed paid to and redirected by that Defaulting Lender, and each Lender irrevocably consents hereto.

(b) If the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent agree in writing in their sole discretion that a Defaulting Lender should no longer be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender, the Administrative Agent will so notify the parties hereto, whereupon as of the effective date specified in such notice and subject to any conditions set forth therein, that Lender will, to the extent applicable, purchase that portion of outstanding Loans of the other Lenders or take such other actions as the Administrative Agent may reasonably determine to be necessary to cause the Loans to be held on a pro rata basis by the Lenders in accordance with their ratable shares in respect of that Lender, whereupon that Lender will cease to be a Defaulting Lender; provided that no adjustments will be made retroactively with respect to fees accrued or payments made by or on behalf of the Borrowers while that Lender was a Defaulting Lender; provided , further , that except to the extent otherwise expressly agreed by the affected parties, no change hereunder from Defaulting Lender to Lender will constitute a waiver or release of any claim of any party hereunder arising from that Lender having been a Defaulting Lender.

Section 2.18 Specified Refinancing Debt .

(a) The Borrowers may, from time to time after the Closing Date, add one or more new term loan facilities to the Facility (“ Specified Refinancing Debt ”; and the commitments in respect of such new facilities, the “ Specified Refinancing Commitment ”) pursuant to procedures reasonably specified by any Person that is a financial institution engaged in arranging similar financings in the ordinary course of its business (that is not an Affiliate of a Borrower) appointed by the Borrowers, after consultation with the Administrative Agent, as agent under such Specified Refinancing Debt (such Person (who may be the Administrative Agent, if it so agrees), the “ Specified Refinancing Agent ”) and reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers, to refinance all or any portion of any Tranches then outstanding under this Agreement pursuant to a Refinancing Amendment; provided that such Specified Refinancing Debt (i) will rank pari passu in right of payment as the other Loans and Commitments hereunder; (ii) will not have obligors other than the Loan Parties; (iii) will be either (x) unsecured or (y) secured by the Collateral on an “equal and ratable” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations or on a “junior” basis with the Liens securing the Obligations (in each case pursuant to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements); (iv) will have such pricing and optional prepayment terms as may be agreed by the Borrowers and the applicable Lenders thereof; (v) will have a maturity date that is not prior to the date that is after the scheduled Maturity Date of, and will have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity that is not shorter than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, the Loans being refinanced; (vi) in the case of any voluntary or mandatory prepayment of any Specified Refinancing Loan, such prepayments may be made on a pro rata basis or a less than pro rata basis (but not a greater than pro rata basis, except (I) in connection with Specified Refinancing Debt with respect thereto or (II) as requested by the Borrower Representative by written notice, to any Class or Class of Loans with an earlier Maturity Date as compared with the remaining Classes of Loans then outstanding) with all other Loans; and (vii) subject to clauses (iv), (v) and (vi) above, will have terms and conditions (other than pricing and optional prepayment and redemption terms) that are substantially identical to, or less favorable, when taken as a whole, to the lenders providing such Specified Refinancing

 

-76-


Debt than, the terms and conditions of the Facility and Loans being refinanced (as reasonably determined by the Borrowers in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive evidence that such terms and conditions satisfy such requirement unless the Administrative Agent provides notice to the Borrower Representative of an objection (including a reasonable description of the basis upon which it objects) within five Business Days after being notified of such determination by the Borrowers); and the Net Cash Proceeds of such Specified Refinancing Debt shall be applied, substantially concurrently with the incurrence thereof, to the pro rata prepayment of outstanding Loans being so refinanced, in each case pursuant to Sections  2.05 and 2.06 , as applicable; provided , however , that such Specified Refinancing Debt (x) may provide for any additional or different financial or other covenants or other provisions that are agreed among the Borrowers and the Lenders thereof and applicable only during periods after the then Latest Maturity Date in effect or, if favorable to the existing Lenders, as are incorporated into the Loan Documents for the benefit of all existing Lenders (which may be accomplished without further amendment requirements) and (y) shall not have a principal or commitment amount (or accreted value) greater than the Loans (or commitments as applicable) being refinanced (excluding accrued interest, fees, discounts, premiums or expenses).

(b) The Borrowers shall make any request for Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to a written notice to the Administrative Agent specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof. Any Lender approached to provide all or a portion of any Specified Refinancing Debt may elect or decline, in its sole discretion, to provide such Specified Refinancing Debt. Any Lender not responding within such time period shall be deemed to have declined to participate in providing such Specified Refinancing Debt. The Administrative Agent shall notify the Borrowers and each applicable Lender of the Lenders’ responses to each request made hereunder. To achieve the full amount of a requested issuance of Specified Refinancing Debt, and subject to the approval of the Administrative Agent (which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed), the Borrowers may also invite additional Eligible Assignees to become Lenders in respect of such Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to a joinder agreement to this Agreement in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent.

(c) The effectiveness of any Refinancing Amendment shall be subject to the satisfaction on the date thereof of each of the conditions set forth in Section  4.02 and, to the extent reasonably requested by the Specified Refinancing Agent, receipt by the Specified Refinancing Agent of legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements with respect to the Borrowers, including any supplements or amendments to the Collateral Documents providing for such Specified Refinancing Debt to be secured thereby, consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 (other than changes to such legal opinions resulting from a change in Law, change in fact or change to counsel’s form of opinion reasonably satisfactory to the Specified Refinancing Agent). The Lenders hereby authorize the Specified Refinancing Agent to enter into amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents with the Borrowers as may be necessary in order to establish new Tranches of Specified Refinancing Debt and to make such technical amendments as may be necessary or appropriate in the reasonable opinion of the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Borrowers in connection with the establishment of such new Tranches, in each case on terms consistent with and/or to effect the provisions of this Section  2.18 .

(d) Each class of Specified Refinancing Debt incurred under this Section  2.18 shall be in an aggregate principal amount that is not less than the Threshold Amount.

(e) The Administrative Agent shall promptly notify each Lender as to the effectiveness of each Refinancing Amendment (if applicable, after the Specified Refinancing Agent has notified the Administrative Agent thereof). Each of the parties hereto hereby agrees that, upon the effectiveness of any Refinancing Amendment, this Agreement shall be deemed amended to the extent (but only to the extent) necessary to reflect the existence and terms of the Specified Refinancing Debt incurred pursuant thereto (including the addition of such Specified Refinancing Debt as separate “Facilities” hereunder and

 

-77-


treated in a manner consistent with the Facilities being refinanced, including for purposes of prepayments and voting). Any Refinancing Amendment may, without the consent of any Person other than the Borrowers, the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Lenders providing such Specified Refinancing Debt, effect such amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents as may be necessary or appropriate, in the reasonable opinion of the Specified Refinancing Agent and the Borrowers, to effect the provisions of or consistent with this Section  2.18 ; provided that if the Specified Refinancing Agent is not the Administrative Agent, any amendment to any Loan Document other than this Agreement shall require the consent of the Administrative Agent). If the Specified Refinancing Agent is not the Administrative Agent, the actions authorized to be taken by the Specified Refinancing Agent herein shall be done in consultation with the Administrative Agent and, with respect to the preparation of any documentation necessary or appropriate to carry out the provisions of this Section  2.18 (including amendments to this Agreement), any comments to such documentation reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent shall be reflected therein. The Borrowers and Lenders agree that the Administrative Agent shall have no liability for the actions of any Specified Refinancing Agent (if other than the Administrative Agent) and this sentence shall survive the termination of this agreement.

ARTICLE III

Taxes, Increased Costs Protection and Illegality

Section 3.01 Taxes .

(a) Any and all payments by or on account of any obligation of the Borrowers or any other Loan Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document shall be made without deduction or withholding for any Taxes, except as required by applicable Law. If any applicable Law (as determined in the good faith discretion of an applicable Withholding Agent) requires the deduction or withholding of any Tax from or in respect of any such payment, then the applicable Withholding Agent shall be entitled to make such deduction or withholding and shall timely pay the full amount deducted or withheld to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law and, if such Tax is an Indemnified Tax, the sum payable by the Borrowers or other applicable Loan Party shall be increased as necessary so that after all such deductions or withholdings of Indemnified Taxes have been made (including such deductions and withholdings applicable to additional sums payable under this Section  3.01 ) the applicable Recipient receives an amount equal to the sum it would have received had no such deduction or withholding been made.

(b) In addition but without duplication, the Loan Parties shall timely pay to the relevant Governmental Authority in accordance with applicable Law, or at the option of the Administrative Agent timely reimburse it for the payment of, any Other Taxes.

(c) The Loan Parties shall jointly and severally indemnify each Recipient, within 30 days after demand therefor, for the full amount of any Indemnified Taxes (including Indemnified Taxes imposed or asserted on or attributable to amounts payable under this Section  3.01 , but excluding Indemnified Taxes compensated under Section  3.01(a) ) payable or paid by such Recipient or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to such Recipient and any reasonable out-of-pocket expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Indemnified Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Authority. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to the Borrower Representative by a Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), or by the Administrative Agent on its own behalf or on behalf of a Lender, shall be conclusive absent manifest error.

 

-78-


(d) Within 30 days after any payment of Taxes by any Loan Party to a Governmental Authority pursuant to this Section  3.01 , such Loan Party shall deliver to the Administrative Agent the original or a certified copy of a receipt issued by such Governmental Authority evidencing such payment, a copy of the return reporting such payment or other evidence of such payment reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent.

(e) If any Recipient determines, in its sole discretion exercised in good faith, that it has received a refund (for this purpose, including credits that a Recipient receives in lieu of a cash refund) of any Indemnified Taxes as to which it has been indemnified pursuant to this Section  3.01 (including by the payment of additional amounts pursuant to this Section  3.01 ), it shall pay to the indemnifying party an amount equal to such refund (but only to the extent of indemnity payments made under this Section  3.01 with respect to the Indemnified Taxes giving rise to such refund), net of all out-of-pocket expenses (including Taxes) of such indemnified party and without interest (other than any interest paid by the relevant Governmental Authority with respect to such refund). Such indemnifying party, upon the request of such indemnified party, shall promptly repay to such indemnified party the amount paid over pursuant to this clause (e) (plus any penalties, interest or other charges imposed by the relevant Governmental Authority) in the event that such indemnified party is required to repay such refund to such Governmental Authority. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this clause (e), in no event will the indemnified party be required to pay any amount to an indemnifying party pursuant to this clause (e) the payment of which would place the indemnified party in a less favorable net after-Tax position than the indemnified party would have been in if the Tax subject to indemnification and giving rise to such refund had not been deducted, withheld or otherwise imposed and the indemnification payments or additional amounts with respect to such Tax had never been paid. This clause (e) shall not be construed to require any indemnified party to make available its Tax returns (or any other information relating to its Taxes that it deems confidential) to the indemnifying party or any other Person.

(f) Each Lender agrees that, upon the occurrence of any event giving rise to the operation of Section  3.01(a) or (c)  with respect to such Lender, it will, if requested by the Borrowers, use commercially reasonable efforts (subject to such Lender’s overall internal policies of general application and legal and regulatory restrictions) to avoid or reduce to the greatest extent possible any indemnification or additional amounts being due under this Section  3.01 , including to designate another Lending Office or account for any Loan affected by such event; provided that such efforts are made on terms that, in the reasonable judgment of such Lender, cause such Lender and its Lending Office(s) to suffer no material economic, legal or regulatory disadvantage; provided , further , that nothing in this Section  3.01(f) shall affect or postpone any of the Obligations of the Borrowers or the rights of such Lender pursuant to Sections 3.01(a) and (c) . The Borrowers hereby agree, jointly and severally, to pay all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by any Lender as a result of a request by the Borrowers under this Section  3.01(f) .

(g) (i) Any Lender that is entitled to an exemption from or reduction of withholding Tax with respect to any payments made under any Loan Document shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent, at the time or times reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent, such properly completed and executed documentation reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as will permit such payments to be made without withholding or at a reduced rate of withholding. In addition, (1) on or before the date that any such previously provided documentation, certificate or other evidence expires or becomes obsolete, (2) after the occurrence of any event requiring a change in the most recent documentation, certificate or evidence previously delivered by it to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent, and (3) if reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent, each Lender and Agent shall deliver such other documentation prescribed by applicable Law or reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as will enable the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent to determine whether or not such Person is subject to backup withholding or information reporting requirements. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the preceding two sentences, the completion, execution and submission of such documentation (other

 

-79-


than such documentation set forth in Sections  3.01(g)(ii)(A) , (ii)(B), (ii)(D), (iii) and (iv)  below) shall not be required if in the Lender’s reasonable judgment such completion, execution or submission would subject such Lender to any material unreimbursed cost or expense or would materially prejudice the legal or commercial position of such Lender.

(ii) Without limiting the generality of Section  3.01(g)(i) :

(A) any Lender that is a U.S. Person shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent on or prior to the date on which such Person becomes a party to this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent), executed copies of IRS Form W-9 (or any successor form) certifying that such Lender is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding;

(B) any Non-U.S. Lender shall, to the extent it is legally eligible to do so, deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent (in such number of copies as shall be requested by the recipient) on or prior to the date on which such Non-U.S. Lender becomes a Lender under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent), whichever of the following is applicable:

(I) in the case of a Non-U.S. Lender claiming the benefits of an income tax treaty to which the United States is a party, executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (or any successor forms) establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax;

(II) executed copies of IRS Form W-8ECI (or any successor form);

(III) in the case of a Non-U.S. Lender claiming the benefits of the exemption for portfolio interest under Section 871(h) or Section 881(c) of the Code, (x) a certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-1 to the effect that such Non-U.S. Lender is not a “bank” within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, a “10 percent shareholder” of a Borrower within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(B) of the Code or a “controlled foreign corporation” described in Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code (a “ U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate ”) and (y) executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (or any successor forms); or

(IV) to the extent a Non-U.S. Lender is not the beneficial owner ( e.g ., where the Non-U.S. Lender is a partnership or a participating Lender), executed copies of IRS Form W-8IMY, accompanied by IRS Form W-8ECI, IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E, a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-2 or I-3 , IRS Form W-9, and/or other certification documents from each beneficial owner, as applicable; provided that if the Non-U.S. Lender is a partnership (and not a participating Lender) and one or more direct or indirect partners of such Non-U.S. Lender are claiming the portfolio interest exemption, such Non-U.S. Lender may provide a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate substantially in the form of Exhibit I-4 on behalf of each such direct and indirect partner;

(C) any Non-U.S. Lender shall, to the extent it is legally eligible to do so, deliver to the Borrower Representative or the Administrative Agent, executed copies of any other form prescribed by applicable Law as a basis for claiming exemption from or a reduction in U.S. federal withholding Tax, duly completed, together with such supplementary documentation as may be prescribed by applicable Law to permit the Loan Parties or the Administrative Agent to determine the withholding or deduction required to be made; and

 

-80-


(D) if a payment made to a Lender under any Loan Document would be subject to Tax imposed by FATCA if such Person were to fail to comply with the applicable reporting requirements of FATCA (including those contained in Section 1471(b) or 1472(b) of the Code, as applicable), such Person shall deliver to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent at the time or times prescribed by Law and at such time or times reasonably requested by Borrowers or the Administrative Agent such documentation prescribed by applicable Law (including as prescribed by Section 1471(b)(3)(C)(i) of the Code) and such additional documentation reasonably requested by the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent as may be necessary for the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent to comply with their obligations under FATCA to determine whether such Person has complied with such Person’s obligations under FATCA and, if necessary, to determine the amount to deduct and withhold from such payment. Solely for purposes of this clause (D), “FATCA” shall include any amendments made to FATCA after the date of this Agreement.

(iii) Each Lender agrees that if any documentation it previously delivered expires or becomes obsolete or inaccurate in any respect, it shall promptly update and deliver such form or certification to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent or promptly notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent in writing of its legal ineligibility to do so.

(iv) On or before the date any Person becomes the Administrative Agent hereunder, (i) if such Person is a U.S. Person, it shall deliver to the Borrower Representative duly completed copies of IRS Form W-9 certifying that it is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding; or (ii) if such Person is not a U.S. Person, it shall deliver to the Borrower Representative a duly executed original U.S. branch withholding certificate on IRS Form W-8IMY evidencing its agreement with the Borrowers to be treated as a U.S. Person, with the effect that the Loan Parties will be entitled to make payments hereunder to the Administrative Agent without withholding or deduction on account of U.S. federal withholding Tax.

(v) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section  3.01(g) , a Lender shall not be required to deliver any documentation that such Lender is not legally eligible to deliver.

Section 3.02 Illegality . If any Lender reasonably determines that any Law has made it unlawful, or that any Governmental Authority has asserted that it is unlawful, for any Lender or its applicable Lending Office to make, maintain or fund Loans whose interest is determined by reference to the Eurocurrency Rate, or to determine or charge interest rates based upon the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate, or any Governmental Authority has imposed material restrictions on the authority of such Lender to purchase or sell, or to take deposits of, Dollars in the applicable interbank market then, on notice thereof by such Lender to the Borrower Representative through the Administrative Agent, (i) any obligation of such Lender to make of continue Eurocurrency Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans to Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be suspended and (ii) if such notice asserts the illegality of such Lender making or maintaining Base Rate Loans the interest rate on which is determined by reference to the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender, shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference to the Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, in each case until such Lender notifies the Administrative Agent and the Borrower Representative that the circumstances giving rise to such determination no longer exist. Upon receipt of such notice the Borrowers shall, upon demand from such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), prepay or, convert all of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans to Base Rate Loans (the interest rate on which Base Rate Loans of such Lender shall, if necessary to avoid such illegality, be determined by the Administrative Agent without reference

 

-81-


to the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate), either on the last day of the Interest Period therefor, if such Lender may lawfully continue to maintain such Eurocurrency Rate Loans to such day, or immediately, if such Lender may not lawfully continue to maintain such Eurocurrency Rate Loans. Upon any such prepayment or conversion, the Borrowers shall also pay accrued interest on the amount so prepaid or converted and all amounts due, if any, in connection with such prepayment or conversion under Section  3.05 . Each Lender agrees to designate a different Lending Office if such designation will avoid the need for such notice and will not, in the good faith judgment of such Lender, otherwise be materially disadvantageous to such Lender.

Section 3.03 Inability to Determine Rates . If the Administrative Agent or the Required Lenders reasonably determine that for any reason, adequate and reasonable means do not exist for determining the Eurocurrency Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurocurrency Rate Loan (including by means of an Interpolated Screen Rate), or that the Eurocurrency Rate for any requested Interest Period with respect to a proposed Eurocurrency Rate Loan does not adequately and fairly reflect the cost to such Lenders of funding such Loan, or that deposits are not being offered to banks in the relevant interbank market for the applicable amount and the Interest Period of such Eurocurrency Rate Loan, the Administrative Agent will promptly so notify the Borrower Representative and each Lender. Thereafter, (x) the obligation of the Lenders to make or maintain Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be suspended and (y) in the event of a determination described in the preceding sentence with respect to the Eurocurrency Rate component of the Base Rate, the utilization of the Eurocurrency Rate component in determining the Base Rate shall be suspended, in each case until the Administrative Agent (upon the instruction of the Required Lenders) revokes such notice. Upon receipt of such notice, the Borrowers may revoke any pending request for a Borrowing of, conversion of or continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans or, failing that, will be deemed to have converted such request into a request for a Borrowing of Base Rate Loans in the amount specified therein.

Section 3.04 Increased Cost and Reduced Return; Capital Adequacy .

(a) If any Lender reasonably determines that as a result of the introduction of or any change in or in the interpretation of any Law, in each case after the Closing Date, or such Lender’s compliance therewith, there shall be any material increase in the cost to such Lender of agreeing to make or making, funding or maintaining any Loan the interest on which is determined by reference to the Eurocurrency Rate or a material reduction in the amount received or receivable by such Lender in connection with any of the foregoing (including Taxes on or in respect of its loans, commitments, or other obligations, or its deposits, reserves, other liabilities or capital attributable thereto, but excluding for purposes of this Section  3.04(a) any such increased costs or reduction in amount resulting from (i) Indemnified Taxes indemnifiable under Section  3.01 , (ii) Excluded Taxes, and (iii) reserve requirements reflected in the Eurocurrency Rate), then within 15 days after demand of such Lender setting forth in reasonable detail such increased costs (with a copy of such demand to the Administrative Agent given in accordance with Section  3.05 ), the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such additional amounts as will compensate such Lender for such increased cost or reduction.

(b) If any Lender reasonably determines that the introduction of any Law regarding capital adequacy or liquidity requirements or any change therein or in the interpretation thereof, in each case after the Closing Date, or compliance by such Lender (or its Lending Office) therewith, has the effect of materially reducing the rate of return on the capital of such Lender or any corporation controlling such Lender as a consequence of such Lender’s obligations hereunder (taking into consideration its policies with respect to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements and such Lender’s desired return on capital), then within 15 days after demand of such Lender setting forth in reasonable detail the charge and the calculation of such reduced rate of return (with a copy of such demand to the Administrative Agent given in accordance with Section  3.05 ), the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such additional amounts as will compensate such Lender for such reduction.

 

-82-


(c) The Borrowers shall pay to each Lender, (i) as long as such Lender shall be required to maintain reserves or liquidity with respect to liabilities or assets consisting of or including Eurocurrency Rate funds or deposits, additional interest on the unpaid principal amount of each Eurocurrency Rate Loan equal to the actual costs of such reserves or liquidity allocated to such Loan by such Lender (as determined by such Lender in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error), and (ii) as long as such Lender shall be required to comply with any liquidity requirement, reserve ratio requirement or analogous requirement of any other central banking or financial regulatory authority imposed in respect of the maintenance of the Commitments or the funding of the Eurocurrency Rate Loans, such additional costs (expressed as a percentage per annum and rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) equal to the actual costs allocated to such Commitment or Loan by such Lender (as determined by such Lender in good faith, which determination shall be conclusive absent manifest error) which in each case shall be due and payable on each date on which interest is payable on such Loan; provided that the Borrowers shall have received at least 15 days’ prior notice (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) of such additional interest or cost from such Lender. If a Lender fails to give notice 15 days prior to the relevant Interest Payment Date, such additional interest or cost shall be due and payable 15 days from receipt of such notice.

(d) For purposes of this Section  3.04 , (i) the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and all requests, rules, regulations, guidelines or directives thereunder or issued in connection therewith and (ii) all requests, rules, guidelines, requirements, agreements, standards and directives promulgated by the Bank for International Settlements, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (or any successor or similar authority) or the United States or foreign regulatory authorities (other than foreign regulatory authorities in Switzerland), in each case pursuant to Basel III, shall, in each case, be deemed to have gone into effect after the Closing Date, regardless of the date enacted, adopted or issued.

Section 3.05 Funding Losses . Upon written demand of any Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) from time to time, setting forth in reasonable detail the basis for calculating such compensation, the Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, promptly compensate such Lender for and hold such Lender harmless from any loss, cost or expense incurred by it as a result of:

(a) any continuation, conversion, payment or prepayment of any Eurocurrency Rate Loan on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loan (whether voluntary, mandatory, automatic, by reason of acceleration, or otherwise);

(b) any failure by the Borrowers (for a reason other than the failure of such Lender to make a Loan or pursuant to a conditional notice) to prepay, borrow, continue or convert any Eurocurrency Rate Loan on the date or in the amount notified by the Borrowers;

(c) any failure by the Borrowers to make payment of any Loan (or interest due thereon) on its scheduled due date or any payment of any Loan (or interest due thereon) in a different currency from such Loan; or

(d) any mandatory assignment of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans pursuant to Section  3.06 on a day other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loans,

 

-83-


including foreign exchange losses and any loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment of funds obtained by it to maintain such Loan or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds were obtained, or from the performance of any foreign exchange contract (but excluding anticipated profits). For the purposes of calculating the amounts payable under this Section  3.05 , any “floor” requirement reflected in the Adjusted Eurocurrency Rate shall be disregarded. The Borrowers shall also pay any customary administrative fees charged by such Lender in connection with the foregoing.

Section 3.06 Matters Applicable to All Requests for Compensation .

(a) A certificate of any Agent or any Lender claiming compensation under this Article  III and setting forth in reasonable detail a calculation of the additional amount or amounts to be paid to it hereunder shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error. In determining such amount, such Agent or such Lender may use any reasonable averaging and attribution methods. With respect to any Lender’s claim for compensation under Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 , the Loan Parties shall not be required to compensate such Lender for any amount incurred more than 180 days prior to the date that such Lender notifies the Borrower Representative of the event that gives rise to such claim; provided that if the circumstance giving rise to such claim is retroactive, then such 180-day period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof.

(b) If any Lender requests compensation under Section  3.04 , or a Borrower is required to pay any additional amount to any Lender, or any Governmental Authority for the account of any Lender pursuant to Section  3.01 , or if any Lender gives a notice pursuant to Section  3.02 , then such Lender will, if requested by the Borrowers and at the Borrowers’ expense, use commercially reasonable efforts to designate another Lending Office for any Loan affected by such event; provided that such efforts (i) would eliminate or reduce amounts payable pursuant to Section  3.01 or 3.03 , as applicable, in the future and (ii) would not, in the judgment of such Lender be inconsistent with the internal policies of, or otherwise be disadvantageous in any material legal, economic or regulatory respect to such Lender or its Lending Office. The provisions of this clause (b) shall not affect or postpone any Obligations of the Borrowers or rights of such Lender pursuant to Section  3.04 .

(c) If any Lender requests compensation by the Borrowers under Section  3.04 , the Borrowers may, by notice to such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative Agent), suspend the obligation of such Lender to make or continue from one Interest Period to another Eurocurrency Rate Loans or to convert Base Rate Loans into Eurocurrency Rate Loans, until the event or condition giving rise to such request ceases to be in effect (in which case the provisions of Section  3.05(e) shall be applicable); provided that such suspension shall not affect the right of such Lender to receive the compensation so requested.

(d) If the obligation of any Lender to make or continue from one Interest Period to another any Eurocurrency Rate Loan, or to convert Base Rate Loans into Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be suspended pursuant to Section  3.06(c) hereof, such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be automatically converted into Base Rate Loans on the last day(s) of the then current Interest Period(s) for such Eurocurrency Rate Loans (or, in the case of an immediate conversion required by Section  3.02 , on such earlier date as required by Law) and, unless and until such Lender gives notice as provided below that the circumstances specified in Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 hereof that gave rise to such conversion no longer exist:

(i) to the extent that such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans have been so converted, all payments and prepayments of principal that would otherwise be applied to such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be applied instead to its Base Rate Loans; and

(ii) all Loans that would otherwise be made or continued from one Interest Period to another by such Lender as Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall be made or continued instead as Base Rate Loans, and all Base Rate Loans of such Lender that would otherwise be converted into Eurocurrency Rate Loans shall remain as Base Rate Loans.

 

-84-


(e) If any Lender gives notice to the Borrower Representative (with a copy to the Administrative Agent) that the circumstances specified in Section  3.02 , 3.03 or 3.04 hereof that gave rise to the conversion of such Lender’s Eurocurrency Rate Loans pursuant to Section  3.06(d) no longer exist (which such Lender agrees to do promptly upon such circumstances ceasing to exist) at a time when Eurocurrency Rate Loans made by other Lenders are outstanding, such Lender’s Base Rate Loans shall be automatically converted, on the first day(s) of the next succeeding Interest Period(s) for such outstanding Eurocurrency Rate Loans, to the extent necessary so that, after giving effect thereto, all Loans held by the Lenders holding Eurocurrency Rate Loans and by such Lender are held pro rata (as to principal amounts, interest rate basis, and Interest Periods) in accordance with their respective Commitments.

(f) A Lender shall not be entitled to any compensation pursuant to the foregoing sections to the extent such Lender is not imposing such charges or requesting such compensation from borrowers (similarly situated to the Borrowers hereunder) under comparable syndicated credit facilities.

Section 3.07 Replacement of Lenders Under Certain Circumstances .

(a) If at any time (i) the Borrowers become obligated to pay additional amounts or indemnity payments described in Section  3.01 or 3.04 (other than with respect to Other Taxes) as a result of any condition described in such Sections or any Lender ceases to make Eurocurrency Rate Loans as a result of any condition described in Section  3.02 or 3.03 , (ii) any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender or (iii) any Lender becomes a Non-Consenting Lender (as defined below in this Section  3.07 ) (collectively, a “ Replaceable Lender ”), then the Borrowers may, on three Business Days’ prior written notice (or such shorter time as the Administrative Agent may determine) from the Borrower Representative to the Administrative Agent and such Lender, either (i) replace such Lender by causing such Lender to (and such Lender shall be obligated to) assign pursuant to Section  10.07(b) (with the assignment fee to be paid by the Borrowers in such instance unless waived by the Administrative Agent) all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement (or, in the case of a Non-Consenting Lender, all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement with respect to the Facility or Facilities for which its consent is required) to one or more Eligible Assignees; provided that neither the Administrative Agent nor any Lender shall have any obligation to the Borrowers to find a replacement Lender or other such Person or (ii) so long as no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, terminate the Commitment of such Lender and repay all Obligations of the Borrowers owing (and the amount of all accrued interest and fees in respect thereof) to such Lender relating to the Loans held by such Lender as of such termination date; provided that (i) in the case of any such replacement of, or termination of Commitments with respect to a Non-Consenting Lender such replacement or termination shall be sufficient (together with all other consenting Lenders including any other Replacement Lender) to cause the adoption of the applicable modification, waiver or amendment of the Loan Documents and (ii) in the case of any such replacement as a result of Borrowers having become obligated to pay amounts described in Section  3.01 or 3.03 , such replacement would eliminate or reduce payments pursuant to Section  3.01 or 3.03 , as applicable, in the future. Any Lender being replaced pursuant to this Section  3.07(a) shall (i) execute and deliver an Assignment and Assumption with respect to such Lender’s Commitment and outstanding Loans and (ii) deliver any Notes evidencing such Loans to the Borrowers (for return to the Borrowers) or the Administrative Agent. Pursuant to such Assignment and Assumption, (A) the assignee Lender shall acquire all or a portion, as the case may be, of the assigning Lender’s Commitment and outstanding Loans, (B) all Obligations relating to the Loans (and the amount of all accrued interest, fees and premiums in respect thereof) so assigned shall be paid in full by the assignee Lender to such assigning Lender concurrently with such assignment and assumption and (C) upon such payment and, if so requested by the assignee Lender, the assigning Lender shall deliver to the assignee Lender the

 

-85-


applicable Note or Notes executed by the Borrowers, the assignee Lender shall become a Lender hereunder and the assigning Lender shall cease to constitute a Lender hereunder with respect to such assigned Loans, Commitments and participations, except with respect to indemnification provisions under this Agreement, which shall survive as to such assigning Lender. In connection with any such replacement, if any such Replaceable Lender does not execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent a duly executed Assignment and Assumption reflecting such replacement within five Business Days of the date on which the assignee Lender executes and delivers such Assignment and Assumption to such Replaceable Lender, then such Replaceable Lender shall be deemed to have executed and delivered such Assignment and Assumption without any action on the part of the Replaceable Lender. In connection with the replacement of any Lender pursuant to this Section  3.07(a) , the Borrowers shall pay to such Lender such amounts as may be required pursuant to Section  3.05 .

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained above, the Lender that acts as the Administrative Agent may not be replaced hereunder except in accordance with the terms of Section  9.09 .

(c) In the event that (i) a Borrower or the Administrative Agent has requested the Lenders to consent to a waiver of any provisions of the Loan Documents or to agree to any amendment or other modification thereto, (ii) the waiver, amendment or modification in question requires the agreement of all affected Lenders in accordance with the terms of Section  10.01 or all the Lenders with respect to a certain class of the Loans and (iii) the Required Lenders have agreed to such waiver, amendment or modification, then any Lender who does not agree to such waiver, amendment or modification, in each case, shall be deemed a “ Non-Consenting Lender ”; provided that the term “Non-Consenting Lender” shall also include (x) any Lender that rejects (or is deemed to reject) a loan modification offer under Section  10.01 , which loan modification has been accepted by at least the Majority Lenders of the respective Tranche of Loans whose Loans and/or Commitments are to be extended pursuant to such loan modification and (y) any Lender that does not elect to become a lender in respect of any Specified Refinancing Debt pursuant to Section  2.18 . If any applicable Lender shall be deemed a Non-Consenting Lender and is required to assign or have prepaid all or any portion of its Initial Loans pursuant to Section  3.07(a) , (x) if such assignment or prepayment occurs on or after the Closing Date but on or prior to the one-year anniversary of the Closing Date (including, for the avoidance of doubt, on or prior to the first anniversary of the Closing Date), an amount equal to 2.00% of the principal amount of the Initial Loans so assigned by such Non-Consenting Lender or prepaid, and (y) if such assignment or prepayment occurs after the one-year anniversary of the Closing Date but on or prior to the two-year anniversary of the Closing Date, an amount equal to 1.00% of the principal amount of the Initial Loans so assigned by such Non-Consenting Lender or prepaid.

(d) All of the Loan Parties’ obligations under this Article III shall survive termination of the Aggregate Commitments and repayment of all other Obligations hereunder, any assignment by or replacement of a Lender and any resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent.

ARTICLE IV

Conditions Precedent

Section 4.01 Conditions to Credit Extensions on the Closing Date . The obligation of each Lender to make its initial Credit Extension hereunder on the Closing Date is subject to the satisfaction as to form and substance in the opinion of the Administrative Agent (acting reasonably) or due waiver in accordance with Section  10.01 of each of the following conditions precedent on or prior to the Closing Date:

(a) Credit Agreement; Other Loan Documents . The Administrative Agent shall have received all of the following, each of which shall be originals or facsimiles or “pdf” files (followed

 

-86-


promptly by originals) unless otherwise specified, each properly executed by a Responsible Officer of the signing Loan Party, each dated on or prior to the Closing Date, each in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, and each accompanied by their respective required schedules and other attachments:

(i) (A) this Agreement from Holdings and the Borrowers, (B) the Guaranty from Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor, (C) the Intercompany Subordination Agreement from Holdings, the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor, and (D) the Perfection Certificate from each Loan Party;

(ii) [reserved];

(iii) the Security Agreement, duly executed by the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties party thereto, together with copies of proper financing statements, filed or duly prepared for filing under the Uniform Commercial Code in all jurisdictions that the Administrative Agent may deem reasonably necessary in order to perfect and protect the Liens on assets of the Borrowers and such other Loan Parties created under the Security Agreement, covering the Collateral described in the Security Agreement; and

(iv) certified copies of UCC, United States Patent and Trademark Office and United States Copyright Office, tax and judgment lien searches, bankruptcy and pending lawsuit searches or equivalent reports or searches, each of a recent date listing all effective financing statements, lien notices or comparable documents that name any Loan Party as debtor and that are filed in those state and county jurisdictions in which any Loan Party is organized or maintains its principal place of business and such other searches that are required by the Perfection Certificate or that the Collateral Agent deems necessary or appropriate, none of which encumber the Collateral covered or intended to be covered by the Collateral Documents (other than Liens permitted under Section  7.01 );.

(b) Committed Loan Notice . The Administrative Agent shall have received a Committed Loan Notice relating to the initial Credit Extensions to be made on the Closing Date, to be provided at least (A) three Business Days prior to the Closing Date for any Borrowings of Eurocurrency Rate Loans or (B) one Business Day prior to the Closing Date for any Borrowings of Base Rate Loans;

(c) Representations and Warranties . All Specified Acquisition Agreement Representations shall be true and correct in all material respects on the Closing Date, and all Specified Representations made by any Loan Party shall be true and correct in all material respects on the Closing Date;

(d) Legal Opinions . The Administrative Agent shall have received executed legal opinions of (i) Latham & Watkins LLP, special New York counsel to the Loan Parties, and (ii) Robins Kaplan LLP, special Minnesota counsel to the Loan Parties, in each case in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(e) Pledged Interests, Pledged Debt; Pledged Instruments of Transfer . Subject to the last paragraph of this Section  4.01 , the Collateral Agent shall have received evidence that the First Lien Administrative Agent has received the certificates, if any, representing Pledged Equity and instruments evidencing the Pledged Debt, in each case, together with an undated stock power or other appropriate instrument of transfer for each such certificate or instrument executed in blank by a duly authorized officer of the pledgor thereof;

 

-87-


(f) Solvency Certificate . The Administrative Agent shall have received a solvency certificate signed by a senior financial officer on behalf of the Borrowers, substantially in the form of Exhibit  J , after giving effect to the Transactions;

(g) Refinancing . The Refinancing shall have been, or shall substantially concurrently with the initial borrowings under the Initial Facility be, consummated, and all security interests in respect of, and Liens securing, the Indebtedness and other obligations thereunder created pursuant to the security documentation relating thereto shall have been terminated and released (or arrangements therefor reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent shall have been made), and the Administrative Agent shall have received all such releases as may have been reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, which releases shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(h) Target Company Material Adverse Effect . Since the last Balance Sheet Date (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement on the date hereof), there has not occurred a Target Company Material Adverse Effect, and this condition shall not be qualified by any disclosure set forth in the Disclosure Letter (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement on the date hereof);

(i) Acquisition . The Acquisition shall have been consummated, or substantially simultaneously with the initial borrowing under the Initial Facility shall be consummated, in all material respects in accordance with the terms of the Acquisitions Agreement, without giving effect to any modifications, amendments, consents or waivers thereto or thereunder that are material and adverse to the Lenders or the Arrangers without the prior consent of the Arrangers (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned), it being hereby understood and agreed that (A) any change to the definition of “Material Adverse Effect” contained in the Acquisition Agreement shall be deemed to be material and adverse to the Lenders and Arrangers and (B) any change in the purchase price payable in connection with the Acquisition shall not be deemed to be material and adverse to the interests of the Lenders and the Arrangers; provided , that (x) any increase in the purchase price so payable is funded solely by an increase in the aggregate amount of the Equity Contribution and (y) any reduction in the purchase price so payable is allocated (I)  first , to reduce the Equity Contribution to an amount that is equal to 35% of the total pro forma consolidated gross debt and equity capitalization of the Borrowers and its Subsidiaries on the Closing Date (excluding any letters of credit issued under the First Lien Credit Agreement on the Closing Date and amounts funded under the Revolving Credit Facility (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) to fund upfront fees or original issue discount pursuant to the “market flex” provisions in the Fee Letter in respect of the Facility or the First Lien Facilities) after giving effect to the Transactions and (II)  second , (a) 65% to pro rata reductions in the aggregate principal amounts of the Initial Loans and the First Lien Loans funded on the Closing Date and (b) 35% to a reduction to the Equity Contribution;

(j) First Lien Facility . The First Lien Facility Documentation required by the terms of the First Lien Credit Agreement shall have been duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party thereto to the First Lien Administrative Agent and shall be in full force and effect, and substantially contemporaneously with the funding of the Facility, the First Lien Facility (as applicable) shall be funded;

(k) Intercreditor Agreement . On the Closing Date, the Intercreditor Agreement shall have been duly executed and delivered by each party thereto and shall be in full force and effect;

(l) Financial Statements . The Arrangers shall have received the Audited Financial Statements and the Unaudited Financial Information;

 

-88-


(m) Pro Forma Financial Statements . The Arrangers shall have received a pro forma consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries based on the historical balance sheet of the Company as of the last day of the most recently completed fiscal quarter ended at least 45 days prior to the Closing Date, prepared so as to give effect to the Transactions as if the Transactions had occurred as of such date, which need not be prepared in compliance with Regulation S-X of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or include adjustments for purchase accounting;

(n) Closing Certificate . The Administrative Agent shall have received a certificate of each Loan Party, dated as of the Closing Date, each substantially in the form of Exhibit C , with appropriate insertions and attachments;

(o) USA PATRIOT Act . No later than at least three Business Days prior to the Closing Date, the Borrowers shall have provided the documentation and other information about the Borrowers and the Guarantors as has been reasonably requested in writing at least ten days prior to the Closing Date by the Arrangers as they reasonably determine is required by regulatory authorities under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money-laundering rules and regulations, including, without limitation, the PATRIOT Act;

(p) Filings . Subject to the last paragraph of this Section  4.01 , each intellectual property security agreement and each other action required by the Collateral Documents to be filed or taken in order to create in favor of the Collateral Agent, for the benefit of the Secured Parties, a second priority perfected Lien (subject to Liens permitted under Section  7.01 ) on the Collateral described therein shall have been delivered to the Collateral Agent in proper form for filing or shall have been taken;

(q) Equity Contribution . The Equity Contribution shall have been or, substantially concurrently with the funding of the Facility shall be, made in at least the amount not less than that contemplated by the definition of “Transactions” (or such lesser amount permitted by clause (y) of the proviso to Section  4.01(i) ) and not less than 50.1% of such proceeds shall have been attributable to contributions by the Sponsor); and

(r) Fees . All fees required to be paid on the Closing Date pursuant to this Agreement and the Fee Letter and reasonable out-of-pocket expenses required to be paid on the Closing Date pursuant to this Agreement and the Fee Letter, to the extent invoiced at least three Business Days prior to the Closing Date (or such later date as the Borrowers may reasonably agree) shall, upon the initial Borrowing under the Facility, have been paid (which amounts may be offset against the proceeds of the Initial Loan).

Without limiting the generality of the provisions of Section  9.03 , for purposes of determining compliance with the conditions specified in this Section  4.01 , each Lender as of the Closing Date shall be deemed to have consented to, approved or accepted or to be satisfied with, each document or other matter required hereunder to be consented to or approved by or acceptable or satisfactory to a Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received written notice from such Lender prior to the Closing Date specifying its objection thereto.

Each of the requirements set forth in clauses (e) and (p) above (except (a) to the extent that a Lien on such Collateral may under applicable law be perfected on the Closing Date by the filing of financing statements under the Uniform Commercial Code of any applicable jurisdiction, (b) pledge and perfection of the Equity Interests of the Borrowers and their respective material, wholly-owned U.S. Subsidiaries and (c) the delivery of stock certificates of the Borrowers and the wholly-owned U.S. Subsidiaries of each Borrower (other than (x) Immaterial Subsidiaries and (y) Subsidiaries of a Borrower to the extent stock certificates issued by such entities are not delivered to the Borrowers on the Closing Date) ( provided , however , that the Borrowers shall use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain such certificates from the Seller on or prior to the Closing Date to the extent in existence prior to the Closing Date) to the extent included in the Collateral, with respect to which a Lien may be perfected on the Closing Date by the

 

-89-


delivery of a stock certificate) shall not constitute conditions precedent under this Section  4.01 after the Borrowers’ use of commercially reasonable efforts to satisfy such requirements without undue burden or expense; provided that the Borrowers hereby agree to deliver, or cause to be delivered, such documents and instruments, or take or cause to be taken such other actions, in each case, as may be required to perfect such security interests within the time specified on Schedule  6.16.

Section 4.02 Conditions to All Credit Extensions . The obligation of each Lender to honor any Request for Credit Extension after the Closing Date (other than as contemplated by Section  2.14 or 2.15 , and other than a Committed Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Loans to the other Type or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans) is subject to the following conditions precedent:

(a) Subject in the case of any Borrowing in connection with a New Loan Commitment to the limitations in Section  2.14(d) and in the case of Borrowings in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition to the limitations in Section  1.02(i) , the representations and warranties of the Borrowers and each other Loan Party contained in Article V or any other Loan Document shall be true and correct in all material respects (and in all respects if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) on and as of the date of such Credit Extension, except to the extent that such representations and warranties specifically refer to an earlier date, in which case they shall be true and correct in all material respects (and in all respects if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) as of such earlier date, and except that for purposes of this Section  4.02 , the representations and warranties contained in Sections 5.05(a) and 5.05(b) shall be deemed to refer to the most recent financial statements furnished pursuant to Section  6.01(a) and (b) , respectively, prior to such proposed Credit Extension.

(b) Subject in the case of any Borrowing in connection with a New Loan Commitment to the limitations in Section  2.14(d) and in the case of Borrowings in connection with a Limited Condition Acquisition to the limitations in Section  1.02(i) , no Default or Event of Default shall exist, or would result from such proposed Credit Extension or from the application of the proceeds therefrom.

(c) The Administrative Agent shall have received a Request for Credit Extension in accordance with the requirements hereof.

Each Request for Credit Extension (other than a Committed Loan Notice requesting only a conversion of Loans to the other Type or a continuation of Eurocurrency Rate Loans) submitted by the Borrowers shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty that the conditions specified in Sections 4.02(a) and (b)  have been satisfied (unless waived) on and as of the date of the applicable Credit Extension.

ARTICLE V

Representations and Warranties

Each of Holdings and the Borrowers, on the Closing Date and at the time of each Credit Extension, represents and warrants to the Administrative Agent and the Lenders (after giving effect to the Transaction) that:

Section 5.01 Existence, Qualification and Power; Compliance with Laws . Each Loan Party and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries (a) is a Person duly organized, formed or incorporated, validly existing and in good standing (or its equivalent, to the extent such concept is applicable in the relevant jurisdiction) under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organization, (b) has all requisite power and authority to (i) own or lease its assets and carry on its business and (ii) execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is a party, (c) is duly qualified and is

 

-90-


authorized to do business and in good standing (to the extent such concept is applicable in the relevant jurisdiction) under the Laws of each jurisdiction where its ownership, lease or operation of properties or the conduct of its business requires such qualification and (d) has all requisite governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals to operate its business as currently conducted; except in each case referred to in clauses (a) (other than with respect to the Borrowers), (b)(i), (b)(ii) (other than with respect to the Borrowers), (c) and (d), to the extent that any failure to be so or to have such could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.02 Authorization; No Contravention . The execution, delivery and performance by each Loan Party of each Loan Document to which such Person is or is to be a party, are within such Loan Party’s corporate or other powers, have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate or other organizational action and do not (a) contravene the terms of any of such Person’s Organization Documents, (b) violate any Law or (c) conflict with or result in any breach or contravention of, or the creation of any Lien under (other than as permitted by Section  7.01 ), or require any payment (other than for Indebtedness to be repaid on the Closing Date in connection with the Transaction) to be made under any Contractual Obligation to which such Person is a party, except, in the case of subclauses (b) and (c) to the extent that such violation, conflict, breach or contravention could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.03 Governmental Authorization . No approval, consent, exemption, authorization or other action by, or notice to, or filing with, any Governmental Authority is necessary or required and no stamp, registration, notarial or similar Taxes or fees are payable in connection with (a) the execution, delivery, performance by, or enforcement against, any Loan Party of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or for the consummation of the Transaction, (b) the grant by any Loan Party of the Liens granted by it pursuant to the Collateral Documents, (c) the perfection or maintenance of the Liens created under the Collateral Documents or (d) the exercise by the Administrative Agent or any Lender of its rights under the Loan Documents or the remedies in respect of the Collateral pursuant to the Collateral Documents, except for (w) filings, registrations and taxes and fees necessary to perfect the Liens on the Collateral granted by the Loan Parties or any Restricted Subsidiary in favor of the Secured Parties consisting of UCC financing statements, filings in the United States Patent and Trademark Office and the United States Copyright Office and Mortgages and all other Perfection Requirements, (x) the approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations, actions, notices and filings which have been duly obtained, taken, given or made and are in full force and effect, (y) those approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations or other actions, notices, filings and payments set out in the Collateral Documents and (z) those approvals, consents, exemptions, authorizations or other actions, notices, filings and payments, the failure of which to obtain or make could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.04 Binding Effect . This Agreement and each other Loan Document has been duly executed and delivered by each Loan Party that is party thereto. This Agreement and each other Loan Document constitutes, a legal, valid and binding obligation of such Loan Party, enforceable against each Loan Party that is party thereto in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by any applicable bankruptcy, administration, administrative receivership, winding-up, insolvency, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), receivership, moratorium or other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and by general principles of equity.

Section 5.05 Financial Statements; No Material Adverse Effect .

(a) The Audited Financial Statements and Unaudited Financial Information fairly present in all material respects the combined financial condition of the Target Companies as of the dates thereof and its results of operations for the period covered thereby in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein.

 

-91-


(b) The unaudited consolidated financial statements of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(b)(i) were prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein, and (ii) fairly present in all material respects the consolidated financial condition of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries as of the date thereof and their results of operations for the period covered thereby, subject to the absence of footnotes and to normal and recurring year-end audit adjustments.

(c) Since the Closing Date, there has been no event or circumstance, either individually or in the aggregate, that has had or would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

(d) The consolidated forecasted balance sheets, statements of income and statements of cash flows of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries most recently delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(c) were prepared in good faith on the basis of the assumptions stated therein, which assumptions were reasonable in light of the conditions existing at the time of delivery of such forecasts; it being understood that no assurance can be given that any particular projections will be realized, that actual results may vary from such forecasts and that such variations may be material.

Section 5.06 Litigation . There are no actions, suits, proceedings, claims or disputes pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers threatened in writing, at law, in equity, in arbitration or before any Governmental Authority, against the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, or against any of their properties or revenues that would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.07 Use of Proceeds . The Borrowers (a) will only use the proceeds of the Initial Loans to finance a portion of the Transactions (including paying any fees, commissions and expenses associated therewith and, if applicable, to be retained on the Borrowers’ balance sheet) and (b) will use the proceeds of all other Borrowings to finance the working capital needs of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries and for general corporate purposes of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries (including Permitted Acquisitions and other acquisitions permitted hereunder).

Section 5.08 Ownership of Property; Liens .

(a) Each Loan Party and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries has fee simple or other comparable valid title to, or leasehold interests in, all real property necessary in the ordinary conduct of its business, free and clear of all Liens except for defects in title that do not materially interfere with its ability to conduct its business or to utilize such assets for their intended purposes and Liens permitted by Section  7.01 , except where the failure to have such title or interests could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on the use or operation of any Material Real Property or any real property necessary for the ordinary conduct of the Borrowers’ business, taken as a whole.

(b) Set forth on Schedule 5.08(b) hereto is a complete and accurate list, in all material respects, of all Material Real Property owned by any Loan Party as of the Closing Date (after giving effect to the Transaction), showing as of the Closing Date, the street address (to the extent available), county or other relevant jurisdiction, state and record owner; and as of the Closing Date (after giving effect to the Transaction) no Loan Party owns any Material Real Property except as listed on Schedule  5.08(b) .

 

-92-


Section 5.09 Environmental Compliance . Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect:

(a) The Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries and their respective operations and properties, are in compliance with all applicable Environmental Laws and Environmental Permits and no Borrower nor any of the Restricted Subsidiaries are subject to or aware of any basis for any Environmental Liability.

(b) Hazardous Materials have not been released, discharged or disposed of on or from any property currently or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, formerly owned, leased or operated by the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, except for such releases, discharges and disposals that were in compliance with, or would not reasonably be expected to give rise to liability under, Environmental Laws.

(c) None of the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries has received notice of or is subject to any claim, action, proceeding or suit alleging liability pursuant to any Environmental Law.

Section 5.10 Taxes . Holdings, the Borrowers and each of the Restricted Subsidiaries have filed or have caused to be filed all Tax returns and reports required to be filed, and have paid all Taxes (including in its capacity as a withholding agent) levied or imposed upon them or their properties, income or assets otherwise due and payable, except those (a) which are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and for which adequate reserves have been provided in accordance with GAAP or (b) with respect to which the failure to make such filing or payment would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.11 Employee Benefits Plans .

(a) To the knowledge of any Loan Party, no ERISA Event has occurred and neither any Loan Party nor any ERISA Affiliate is aware of any fact, event or circumstance that could reasonably be expected to constitute or result in an ERISA Event, (b) each Loan Party and each ERISA Affiliate has met all applicable requirements under the Pension Funding Rules in respect of each Plan, and no waiver of the minimum funding standards under such Pension Funding Rules has been applied for or obtained, (c) there exists no Unfunded Pension Liability and (d) neither any Loan Party nor any ERISA Affiliate has engaged in a transaction that would reasonably be expected to be subject to Sections 4069 or 4212(c) of ERISA, except with respect to each of the foregoing clauses (a) through (d) of this Section  5.11 , as would not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.12 Subsidiaries; Equity Interests . As of the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction, there are no Restricted Subsidiaries other than those specifically disclosed in Schedule  5.12 , and all of the outstanding Equity Interests in such Restricted Subsidiaries that are owned by a Loan Party have been validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable (other than for those Restricted Subsidiaries that are limited liability companies and to the extent such concepts are not applicable in the relevant jurisdiction) and are owned free and clear of all Liens except (i) those created under the Collateral Documents, (ii) those created under the First Lien Facility Documentation, (iii) any nonconsensual Lien that is permitted under Section  7.01 and (iv) if such representation is made after the Closing Date, Liens related to New Incremental Notes and Refinancing Notes and Permitted Ratio Debt secured by Liens permitted hereunder.

Section 5.13 Margin Regulations; Investment Company Act .

 

-93-


(a) None of the Loan Parties is engaged nor will engage, principally or as one of its important activities, in the business of purchasing or carrying Margin Stock, or extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying Margin Stock, and no proceeds of any Borrowings will be used to purchase or carry any Margin Stock or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying any Margin Stock. Neither the making of any Credit Extension hereunder nor the use of proceeds thereof will violate any Regulations of the FRB, including the provisions of Regulations T, U or X of the FRB.

(b) None of the Loan Parties is or is required to be registered as an “investment company” under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Section 5.14 Disclosure . As of the Closing Date, no report, financial statement, certificate or other written information furnished by or on behalf of any Loan Party (other than projected financial information, pro forma financial information and information of a general economic or industry nature) to any Agent or any Lender in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby and the negotiation of this Agreement or delivered hereunder or any other Loan Document (as modified or supplemented by other information so furnished), when taken as a whole, contains any material misstatement of fact or omits to state any material fact necessary to make the statements therein (when taken as a whole), in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not materially misleading; provided that with respect to projected and pro forma financial information, Holdings and the Borrowers represent only that such information was prepared in good faith based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time of preparation and delivery; it being understood that actual results may vary from such forecasts and that such variances may be material.

Section 5.15 Compliance with Laws . Holdings, the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary is in compliance in all material respects with the requirements of all Laws and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees applicable to it or to its properties, except in such instances in which (a) such requirement of Law or order, writ, injunction or decree is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted or (b) the failure to comply therewith, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.16 Intellectual Property; Licenses, Etc . The Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor owns, licenses or possesses the right to use, all of the trademarks, service marks, trade names, copyrights, patents, licenses and other intellectual property rights (collectively, “ IP Rights ”) that are necessary for the operation of its respective businesses, as currently conducted, except to the extent such failure to own, license or possess such IP Rights, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; provided that the foregoing shall not deem to constitute a representation that the Borrowers and the Subsidiary Guarantors do not infringe or violate the IP Rights held by any other Person. Set forth on Schedule  5.16 is a complete and accurate list of all material U.S. registrations or applications for registration of patents, trademarks, and copyrights owned or, in the case of copyrights, exclusively licensed by the Borrowers and Subsidiary Guarantors as of the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction. To the knowledge of the Borrowers, the conduct of the business of the Borrowers and the Subsidiary Guarantors as currently conducted does not infringe upon or violate any IP Rights held by any other Person, except for such infringements and violations that, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. No material claim or litigation regarding any of the foregoing is pending or, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, threatened in writing that, either individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 5.17 Solvency . On the Closing Date, after giving effect to the Transaction, Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basis, are Solvent.

 

-94-


Section 5.18 Perfection, Etc . Each Collateral Document delivered pursuant to this Agreement will, upon execution and delivery thereof, be effective to create (to the extent described therein) in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, legal, valid and enforceable Liens on, and security interests in, the Collateral described therein to the extent intended to be created thereby, except as to enforcement, as may be limited by applicable domestic or foreign bankruptcy, winding-up, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangements or otherwise), moratorium and other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally, general equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law) and (a) when financing statements and other filings in appropriate form are filed or registered, as applicable, in the offices of the Secretary of State of each Loan Party’s jurisdiction of organization or formation and applicable documents are filed and recorded as applicable in the United States Copyright Office or the United States Patent and Trademark Office and all other Perfection Requirements have been taken and (b) upon the taking of possession or control by the Collateral Agent (or, if applicable, the First Lien Administrative Agent in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement) of such Collateral with respect to which a security interest may be perfected only by possession or control (which possession or control shall, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, be given to the Collateral Agent to the extent possession or control by the Collateral Agent is required by the applicable Collateral Document) the Liens created by the Collateral Documents shall constitute fully perfected second priority Liens so far as possible under relevant law on, and security interests in (to the extent intended to be created thereby and required to be perfected under the Loan Documents), all right, title and interest of the grantors in such Collateral in each case free and clear of any Liens other than Liens permitted hereunder.

Section 5.19 Anti-Terrorism Laws; OFAC; FCPA .

(a) Anti-Terrorism Laws . The Borrowers have implemented and maintain in effect policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance by Holdings, the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents with applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations and Laws related to bribery or anti-corruption. Each of Holdings, the Borrowers and each of their respective Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents is in compliance with the Sanctions Laws and Regulations and with all applicable Laws concerning bribery or anti-corruption. No Borrowing, or use of proceeds, will violate or result in the violation of any Sanctions Laws and Regulations or bribery or anti-corruption Laws applicable to any party hereto.

(b) OFAC . None of (I) Holdings, the Borrowers or any other Loan Party and (II) their respective Subsidiaries or, to the knowledge of Holdings and the Borrowers, any director, manager, officer, agent or employee of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case, is a person on the list of “Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons” or any other Sanctions Laws and Regulations-related list of designated persons maintained by the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control. To the knowledge of Holdings and the Borrowers, Holdings, the Borrowers, all other Loan Parties and their respective Subsidiaries, and all directors, managers, officers, agents and employees of Holdings, the Borrowers and all of their respective Restricted Subsidiaries, in each case, are in compliance with Sanctions Laws and Regulations. The Borrowers will not directly or indirectly use the proceeds of the Loans or otherwise make available such proceeds to any person, for the purpose of financing the activities of any Person in violation of applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations.

(c) FCPA . No part of the proceeds of any Loan will be used for any improper payments, directly or indirectly, to any governmental official or employee, political party, official of a political party, candidate for political office, or anyone else acting in an official capacity, or any other party (if applicable) in order to obtain, retain or direct business or obtain any improper advantage in violation of the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, the United Kingdom Bribery Act of

 

-95-


2010, as amended and any similar laws, rules or regulations issued, administered or enforced by any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Borrower (collectively, the “ Anti-Corruption Laws ”). The Borrowers have implemented and maintain in effect policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance by the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective directors, officers, employees and agents with Anti-Corruption Laws, and the Borrowers, their Subsidiaries and their respective officers and employees and, to the knowledge of the Borrowers, their directors and agents, are in compliance with Anti-Corruption Laws.

ARTICLE VI

Affirmative Covenants

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder or any Loan or other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied), the Borrowers shall, and shall (except in the case of the covenants set forth in Sections 6.01 , 6.02 and 6.03 ) cause each Restricted Subsidiary to:

Section 6.01 Financial Statements . Deliver to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender:

(a) as soon as available, but in any event within 90 days (or 150 days with respect to the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016) after the end of each fiscal year of the Holdings, a consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal year, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for such fiscal year, and, commencing with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2016, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and prepared in accordance with GAAP, audited and accompanied by a report and opinion of CohnReznick LLP, a “Big Four” accounting firm or any other independent certified public accountant of nationally recognized standing, which report and opinion shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and shall not be subject to any “going concern” or like qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph or any qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph as to the scope of such audit (other than any such qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph that is expressly solely with respect to, or expressly resulting solely from, (i) an upcoming maturity date under the Facility or the First Lien Facility that is scheduled to occur within one year from the time such report and opinion are delivered or (ii) any potential inability to satisfy any financial maintenance covenant under the First Lien Credit Agreement or (to the extent applicable) this Agreement on a future date or in a future period), together with a customary management’s discussion and analysis of financial information in a form provided to the Sponsor;

(b) as soon as available, but in any event within 45 days (or 90 days with respect to the first fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date and 75 days with respect to the next two fiscal quarters ending after the Closing Date (in each case, other than the last fiscal quarter of a year)) after the end of each of the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year of Holdings, a consolidated balance sheet of Holdings and its Subsidiaries as at the end of such fiscal quarter, and the related consolidated statements of income or operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for such fiscal quarter and for the portion of the fiscal year then ended, and, commencing with the fiscal quarter ending one year after the first full fiscal quarter ending after the Closing Date, setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the corresponding fiscal quarter of the previous fiscal year and the corresponding portion of the previous fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and certified by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower Representative as fairly presenting in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows of Holdings and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP, subject only to normal year-end audit adjustments and the absence of footnotes, together with a customary management’s discussion and analysis of financial information;

 

-96-


(c) prior to the occurrence of a Qualified IPO, as soon as available, but in any event no later than 90 days after the end of each fiscal year (or 150 days with respect to the fiscal year beginning January 1, 2017), reasonably detailed consolidated forecasts along with written assumptions prepared by management of the Borrowers (including projected consolidated balance sheets, income statements, Consolidated EBITDA and cash flow statements of Holdings and its Subsidiaries) on a quarterly basis for the fiscal year following such fiscal year then ended, which forecasts shall be prepared in good faith on the basis of assumptions believed to be reasonable at the time of preparation thereof; and

(d) concurrently with the delivery of any financial statements pursuant to Sections  6.01(a) and (b)  above, the related consolidating financial statements reflecting the adjustments necessary to eliminate the accounts of Unrestricted Subsidiaries (if any) from such consolidated financial statements.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, (A) the obligations in clauses (a), (b) and (c) of this Section  6.01 may be satisfied by furnishing, at the option of the Borrowers, the applicable financial statements or, as applicable, forecasts of any Parent Holding Company and its Subsidiaries; provided that to the extent such information relates to a Parent Holding Company, such information is accompanied by consolidating information that explains in reasonable detail the differences between the information relating to such Parent Holding Company, on the one hand, and the information relating to Holdings and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a standalone basis, on the other hand, and (B) (i) in the event that the Borrowers deliver to the Administrative Agent an annual report on Form 10-K for any fiscal year, as filed with the SEC or in such form as would have been suitable for filing with the SEC, within 90 days after the end of such fiscal year, such Form 10-K shall satisfy all requirements of clause (a) of this Section  6.01 with respect to such fiscal year to the extent that it contains the information and report and opinion required by such clause (a) and such report and opinion does not contain any “going concern” or like qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph or any qualification, exception or explanatory paragraph as to the scope of audit (other than any such exception or explanatory paragraph, but not a qualification, expressly permitted to be contained therein under clause (a) of this Section  6.01 ) and (ii) in the event that the Borrowers deliver to the Administrative Agent a quarterly report on Form 10-Q for any fiscal quarter, as filed with the SEC or in such form as would have been suitable for filing with the SEC, within 45 days after the end of such fiscal quarter, such Form 10-Q shall satisfy all requirements of clause (b) of this Section  6.01 with respect to such fiscal quarter to the extent that it contains the information required by such clause (b); in each case to the extent that information contained in such Form 10-K or Form 10-Q satisfies the requirements of clause s (a) or (b) of this Section  6.01 , as the case may be.

Section 6.02 Certificates; Other Information . Deliver to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender:

(a) no later than five days after the delivery of (i) the financial statements referred to in Section  6.01(a) or (ii) an annual report on Form 10-K (delivered pursuant to the last paragraph of Section  6.01 ), but only to the extent permitted by accounting industry policies generally followed by independent certified public accountants, a certificate of Holdings’ independent certified public accountants certifying such financial statements;

 

-97-


(b) no later than five days after the delivery of (i) the financial statements referred to in Sections 6.01(a) and (b)  for any fiscal period ending after the Closing Date or (ii) an annual report on Form 10-K or a quarterly report on Form 10-Q for any fiscal period ending after the Closing Date (in either case, delivered pursuant to the last paragraph of Section  6.01 ), a duly completed Compliance Certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrower Representative (which delivery may, unless the Administrative Agent or a Lender requests executed originals, be by electronic communication including fax or email and shall be deemed to be an original authentic counterpart thereof for all purposes);

(c) promptly after the same are available, copies of all annual, regular, periodic and special reports and registration statements which Holdings or the Borrowers may file or be required to file, copies of any report, filing or communication with the SEC under Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, or with any Governmental Authority that may be substituted therefor, or with any national securities exchange, and in any case not otherwise required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent pursuant hereto;

(d) promptly after the furnishing thereof, copies of any notices received by any Loan Party (other than in the ordinary course of business) and copies of any statement or report furnished to any holder of debt securities or loans of any Loan Party or of any of its Subsidiaries, in each case pursuant to the terms of the First Lien Credit Agreement or any Junior Financing in a principal amount greater than $24,000,000 (other than any immaterial correspondence in the ordinary course of business or any regularly required quarterly or annual certificates) and not otherwise required to be furnished to the Lenders pursuant to any other clause of this Section  6.02 ;

(e) promptly after the receipt thereof by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries, copies of each notice or other correspondence received from the SEC (or comparable agency in any applicable non-U.S. jurisdiction) concerning any material investigation or other material inquiry by such agency regarding financial or other operational results of any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries;

(f) promptly after the assertion or occurrence thereof, notice of any action arising under any Environmental Law against or of any noncompliance by any Loan Party or any of its Subsidiaries with any Environmental Law or Environmental Permit that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

(g) together with the delivery of each Compliance Certificate pursuant to Section  6.02(b) , a report supplementing Schedule 5.12 hereto to the extent necessary so that the related representation and warranty would be true and correct if made as of the date of such Compliance Certificate; and

(h) promptly, such additional information regarding the business, legal, financial or corporate affairs of any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof as the Administrative Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent may from time to time reasonably request.

Documents required to be delivered pursuant to Section  6.01(a) , (b) , (c) or (d)  or Section  6.02(c) or (d) (or to the extent any such documents are included in materials otherwise filed with the SEC) may be delivered electronically and if so delivered, shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date on which such documents are posted on the Borrowers’ behalf on the Platform or another relevant internet or intranet website, if any, to which each Lender and the Administrative Agent have access (whether a commercial, third-party website or whether sponsored by the Administrative Agent); provided that: (i) upon written request by the Administrative Agent, the Borrowers shall deliver paper copies of such documents to the Administrative Agent for further distribution to each Lender until a written request to

 

-98-


cease delivering paper copies is given by the Administrative Agent or such Lender and (ii) the Borrowers shall notify (which may be by facsimile or electronic mail) the Administrative Agent of the posting of any such documents and provide to the Administrative Agent by electronic mail electronic versions (i.e., soft copies) of such documents. The Administrative Agent shall have no obligation to request the delivery of or to maintain or deliver to Lenders paper copies of the documents referred to above, and in any event shall have no responsibility to monitor compliance by the Borrowers with any such request for delivery, and each Lender shall be solely responsible for timely accessing posted documents or requesting delivery of paper copies of such documents from the Administrative Agent and maintaining its copies of such documents.

The Borrowers hereby acknowledge that (a) the Administrative Agent and/or the Arrangers will make available to the Lenders materials and/or information provided by or on behalf of the Borrowers hereunder (collectively, “ Borrower Materials ”) by posting the Borrower Materials on IntraLinks/IntraAgency, Syndtrak or another similar electronic system (the “ Platform ”) and (b) certain of the Lenders (each, a “ Public Lender ”) may have personnel who do not wish to receive material non-public information (within the meaning of United States federal and state securities laws or any other applicable jurisdiction’s securities laws) with respect to the Borrowers or their Affiliates, or the respective securities of any of the foregoing, and who may be engaged in investment and other market-related activities with respect to such Persons’ securities. The Borrowers hereby agree that it will use commercially reasonable efforts to identify that portion of the Borrower Materials that may be distributed to the Public Lenders and that (w) all such Borrower Materials shall be clearly and conspicuously marked “PUBLIC SIDE” which, at a minimum, shall mean that the word “PUBLIC SIDE” shall appear prominently on the first page thereof; (x) by marking Borrower Materials “PUBLIC SIDE,” the Borrowers shall be deemed to have authorized the Administrative Agent, the Arrangers and the Lenders to treat such Borrower Materials as not containing any material non-public information (although it may be sensitive and proprietary) with respect to the Borrowers or their Affiliates, or their respective securities for purposes of United States federal and state securities laws ( provided , however , that to the extent such Borrower Materials constitute Information, they shall be treated as set forth in Section  10.08 ); (y) all Borrower Materials marked “PUBLIC SIDE” are permitted to be made available through a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information” and (z) any Borrower Materials that are not marked “PUBLIC SIDE” shall be deemed to contain material non-public information (within the meaning of United States federal and state securities laws) and shall not be suitable for posting on a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information”. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, financial statements delivered pursuant to Sections 6.01(a) and (b)  and Compliance Certificates delivered pursuant to Section  6.02(a) shall be deemed to be suitable for posting on a portion of the Platform designated “Public Side Information.”

Section 6.03 Notices . Promptly, after a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers or any Guarantor has obtained knowledge thereof, notify the Administrative Agent:

(a) of the occurrence of any Default;

(b) of any matter that has resulted or could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect;

(c) of the institution of any material litigation not previously disclosed by the Borrowers to the Administrative Agent, or any material development in any material litigation that is reasonably likely to be adversely determined, and would, in either case, if adversely determined be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and

 

-99-


(d) of the occurrence of any ERISA Event, where there is any reasonable likelihood of the imposition of liability on any Loan Party as a result thereof that could be reasonably expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

Each notice pursuant to this Section  6.03 shall be accompanied by a statement of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers setting forth details of the occurrence referred to therein and stating what action the Borrowers have taken and proposes to take with respect thereto.

Section 6.04 Payment of Taxes . Pay, discharge or otherwise satisfy as the same shall become due and payable, all Taxes (including in its capacity as withholding agent) imposed upon it or its income, profits, properties or other assets, unless the same are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently conducted and adequate reserves in accordance with GAAP (or, with respect to any Foreign Subsidiaries, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization) are being maintained by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary; except to the extent the failure to pay, discharge or satisfy the same could not reasonably be expected, individually or in the aggregate, to have a Material Adverse Effect.

Section 6.05 Preservation of Existence, Etc . (a) Preserve, renew and maintain in full force and effect its legal existence under the Laws of the jurisdiction of its organization except in a transaction permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 , (b) take all reasonable action to maintain all rights, privileges (including its good standing, if such concept is applicable in its jurisdiction of organization), permits, licenses and franchises necessary or desirable in the normal conduct of its business, except to the extent that failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or as otherwise permitted hereunder, and (c) use commercially reasonable efforts to preserve or renew all of its registered copyrights, patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks, the non-preservation of which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or as otherwise permitted hereunder; provided that nothing in this Section  6.05 shall require the preservation, renewal or maintenance of, or prevent the abandonment by, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of, any registered copyrights, patents, trademarks, trade names and service marks that the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary reasonably determines is not useful to its business or no longer commercially desirable.

Section 6.06 Maintenance of Properties . Except if the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect, maintain, preserve and protect all of its tangible properties and equipment that are necessary in the operation of its business in good working order, repair and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted and casualty or condemnation excepted.

Section 6.07 Maintenance of Insurance .

(a) Except if the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, maintain in full force and effect, with insurance companies that the Borrowers believe (in the good faith judgment of the management of the Borrowers) are financially sound and responsible at the time the relevant coverage is placed or renewed, insurance in at least such amounts (after giving effect to any self-insurance which the Borrowers believe (in the good faith judgment of management of the Borrowers) is reasonable and prudent in light of the size and nature of its business) and against at least such risks (and with such risk retentions) as are usually insured against in the same general area by companies engaged in businesses similar to those engaged by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries. Subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, the Borrowers shall use commercially reasonable efforts to ensure that at all times the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, shall be named as an additional insured with respect to liability policies (other than directors and officers policies and workers compensation) maintained by the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor and the

 

-100-


Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties, shall be named as loss payee with respect to the property insurance maintained by the Borrowers and each Subsidiary Guarantor; provided that, unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, (A) all proceeds from insurance policies shall be paid to the Borrowers, or the applicable Subsidiary Guarantor, (B) to the extent the Collateral Agent receives any proceeds, the Collateral Agent shall turn over to the Borrowers any amounts received by it as an additional insured or loss payee under any property insurance maintained by the Borrowers and its Subsidiaries, and (C) the Collateral Agent agrees that the Borrowers and/or their applicable Subsidiary shall have the sole right to adjust or settle any claims under such insurance.

(b) If (x) any improved portion of any Mortgaged Property located in the United States is at any time located in an area identified by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (or any successor agency) as a special flood hazard area with respect to which flood insurance has been made available under the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968 (as now or hereafter in effect or successor act thereto) and (y) the Collateral Agent shall have delivered notice(s) to the relevant Borrower Party pursuant to Section 208.25(i) of Regulation H of the FRB stating that such mortgaged property is located in the United States and in such special flood hazard area with respect to which such flood insurance has been made available, then the Borrowers shall, or shall cause each Loan Party to (i) maintain, or cause to be maintained, with a financially sound and reputable insurer, flood insurance in an amount and otherwise sufficient to comply with all applicable rules and regulations promulgated pursuant to the Flood Insurance Laws and (ii) deliver to the Administrative Agent evidence of such compliance in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent.

Section 6.08 Compliance with Laws . Comply with the requirements of all applicable Laws (including, without limitation, ERISA, Sanctions Laws and Regulations and Environmental Laws) and all orders, writs, injunctions and decrees of any Governmental Authority applicable to it or to its business or property, except if the failure to comply therewith, either individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. The Borrowers will maintain in effect and enforce policies and procedures reasonably designed to ensure compliance by the Borrowers with applicable bribery or anti-corruption Laws and Sanctions Laws and Regulations.

Section 6.09 Books and Records . Maintain proper books of record and account, in a manner to allow financial statements to be prepared in all material respects in conformity with GAAP consistently applied in respect of all financial transactions and matters involving the assets and business of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be (it being understood and agreed that Foreign Subsidiaries may maintain individual books and records in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization).

Section 6.10 Inspection Rights . Permit representatives of the Administrative Agent and, during the continuance of any Event of Default, of each Lender to visit and inspect any of its properties (subject to the rights of lessees or sublessees thereof and subject to any restrictions or limitations in the applicable lease, sublease or other written occupancy arrangement pursuant to a Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary is a party), to examine its corporate, financial and operating records, and make copies thereof or abstracts therefrom, and to discuss its affairs, finances and accounts with its directors, managers, officers, and independent public accountants (subject to such accountants’ customary policies and procedures), all at the reasonable expense of the Borrowers and at such reasonable times during normal business hours and as often as may be reasonably desired, upon reasonable advance written notice to the Borrowers; provided that, excluding any such visits and inspections during the continuation of an Event of Default, (i) only the Administrative Agent on behalf of the Lenders may exercise rights under this Section  6.10 , (ii) the Administrative Agent shall not exercise such rights more often than one time during any calendar year and (iii) such exercise shall be at the Borrowers’ expense; provided , further , that when an Event of Default exists the Administrative Agent (or any of its respective representatives) may

 

-101-


do any of the foregoing at the expense of the Borrowers at any time during normal business hours and upon reasonable advance written notice. The Administrative Agent and the Lenders shall give the Borrowers the opportunity to participate in any discussions with the Borrowers’ accountants. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Section  6.10 , none of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary will be required to disclose or permit the inspection or discussion of, any document, information or other matter (i) that constitutes non-financial trade secrets or non-financial proprietary information, (ii) in respect of which disclosure to the Administrative Agent or any Lender (or their respective representatives or contractors) is prohibited by Law or any binding agreement ( provided that any such confidentiality obligations pursuant to a binding agreement were not entered into in contemplation of the requirements of this Section  6.10 ) or (iii) that is subject to attorney client or similar privilege or constitutes attorney work product.

Section 6.11 Use of Proceeds . The Borrowers will use the proceeds of the Loans only as provided in Section  5.07 . The Borrowers will not request, and the Borrowers shall not use, and shall procure that its Subsidiaries and its or their respective directors, officers, employees and agents shall not use, any part of the proceeds of any Loan (i) for any improper payments, directly or indirectly, to any governmental official or employee, political party, official of a political party, candidate for political office, or anyone else acting in an official capacity, or any other party (if applicable) in order to obtain, retain or direct business or obtain any improper advantage, in violation of the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, the United Kingdom Bribery Act of 2010, as amended or any similar laws, rules or regulations issued, administered or enforced by any Governmental Authority having jurisdiction over the Borrowers; (ii) for the purpose of funding, financing or facilitating any activities, business or transaction in violation of applicable Sanctions Laws and Regulations; or (iii) in any manner that would result in the violation of any Sanctions Laws and Regulations applicable to any party hereto.

Section 6.12 Covenant to Guarantee Obligations and Give Security .

(a) Upon the acquisition of any property (other than Excluded Property and real property that is not Material Real Property) by any Loan Party, which property, in the reasonable judgment of the Administrative Agent, is not already subject to a perfected (or the equivalent under applicable foreign Law) Lien in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties (and where such a perfected (or the equivalent under applicable foreign Law) Lien would be required in accordance with the terms of the Collateral Documents) or in connection with the formation or acquisition of a Subsidiary, in each case, within 60 days (or such longer period as the Collateral Agent may agree in its sole discretion) after such formation or acquisition, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, cause each applicable Subsidiary (as applicable that is not an Excluded Subsidiary) and applicable Loan Party:

(i) to duly execute and deliver to the Collateral Agent a guaranty or guaranty supplement, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent, guaranteeing the Obligations and a joinder or supplement to the applicable Collateral Documents, this Agreement and the Intercompany Subordination Agreement,

(ii) (if not already so delivered) to deliver certificates (or the foreign equivalent thereof, as applicable) representing the Pledged Interests of each such Subsidiary (if any) (other than any Unrestricted Subsidiary) held by the applicable Loan Party accompanied by undated stock powers or other appropriate instruments of transfer executed in blank and instruments evidencing the Pledged Debt owing by such Subsidiary to any Loan Party indorsed in blank to the Collateral Agent, together with, if requested by the Collateral Agent, supplements to the Security Agreement or other pledge or other security agreements with respect to the pledge of any Equity Interests or Indebtedness; provided that any Excluded Property shall not be required to be pledged as Collateral,

 

-102-


(iii) to duly execute and deliver, to the Collateral Agent one or more Mortgages (and other documentation and instruments referred to in Section  6.14 ) (with respect to Material Real Properties only), Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements and other security agreements (relating to each relevant type of assets), as specified by and in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent (consistent, to the extent applicable, with the Security Agreement, the Intellectual Property Security Agreement, the Mortgages and the other Collateral Documents (and Section  6.14 )), securing payment of all the Obligations of the applicable Loan Party or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, under the Loan Documents and establishing Liens on all such properties or property; provided that such properties or property shall not be required to be pledged as Collateral, and no Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements and other security agreements or pledge agreements shall be required to be delivered in respect thereof, to the extent that any such properties or property constitute Excluded Property,

(iv) to take, whatever action (including the recording of Mortgages (with respect to Material Real Properties only), the filing of UCC financing statements, the giving of notices and delivery of stock and membership interest certificates or foreign equivalents representing the applicable Equity Interests) or take other perfection or customary steps as may be necessary or advisable in the reasonable opinion of the Collateral Agent to vest in the Collateral Agent (or in any representative of the Collateral Agent designated by it) valid and subsisting Liens on the Collateral purported to be subject to the Mortgages, Security Agreement Supplements, Intellectual Property Security Agreement Supplements, supplements to other Collateral Documents and other security agreements delivered pursuant to this Section  6.12 , in each case subject to the Perfection Exceptions enforceable against all third parties in accordance with their terms, and

(v) deliver to the Collateral Agent Organization Documents, resolutions and a signed copy of one or more opinions, addressed to the Collateral Agent and the other Secured Parties, of counsel for the Loan Parties reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent as to such matters as the Collateral Agent may reasonably request (limited, in the case of any opinions of local counsel to the Loan Parties relating to Mortgaged Properties in jurisdictions in which such Mortgaged Property is located, to opinions relating to the Mortgage with respect to such Material Real Property (and any other Mortgaged Properties located in the same jurisdiction as any such Material Real Property)).

Section 6.13 Compliance with Environmental Laws . Except, in each case, to the extent that the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, comply, and make all reasonable efforts to cause all lessees and other Persons operating or occupying its properties to comply, with all Environmental Laws and Environmental Permits; obtain, maintain and renew all Environmental Permits necessary for its operations and properties; and, to the extent required under Environmental Laws, conduct any investigation, mitigation, study, sampling and testing, and undertake any cleanup, removal or remedial, corrective or other action necessary to respond to and remove and clean up all Hazardous Materials from any of its properties, in accordance with the requirements of all Environmental Laws.

Section 6.14 Further Assurances . Promptly upon request by the Administrative Agent, or the Collateral Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, and subject to the limitations described in Section  6.12 (and subject to the Intercreditor Agreement), (i) correct any material defect or error that may be discovered in any Loan Document or other document or instrument relating to any Collateral or in the execution, acknowledgment, filing or recordation thereof and (ii) do, execute, acknowledge, deliver, record, re-record, file, re-file, register and re-register any and all such further acts,

 

-103-


deeds, certificates, assurances and other instruments as the Administrative Agent, or the Collateral Agent or any Lender through the Administrative Agent, may reasonably require from time to time in order to grant, preserve, protect and continue the validity, perfection and priority of the security interests created or intended to be created by the Collateral Documents.

Section 6.15 Maintenance of Ratings . Use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain and maintain (but not obtain or maintain a specific rating) (i) a public corporate family rating of the Borrowers and a rating of the Facility, in each case from Moody’s and (ii) a public corporate credit rating of the Borrowers and a rating of the Facility, in each case from S&P (it being understood and agreed that “commercially reasonable efforts” shall in any event include the payment by the Borrowers of customary rating agency fees and cooperation with information and data requests by Moody’s and S&P in connection with their ratings process).

Section 6.16 Post-Closing Undertakings .

(a) By the date that is 90 days after the Closing Date, as such time period may be extended in the Collateral Agent’s reasonable discretion, the Borrowers shall, and shall cause each applicable Loan Party to, deliver to the Collateral Agent (subject to the Intercreditor Agreement):

(i) a Mortgage with respect to each Mortgaged Property, together with evidence each such Mortgage has been duly executed, acknowledged and delivered by a duly authorized officer of each party thereto on or before such date in a form suitable for filing and recording in all appropriate local filing or recording offices that the Collateral Agent may deem reasonably necessary or desirable in order to create a valid and subsisting perfected Lien on the property described therein in favor of the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Secured Parties and that all filing and recording taxes and fees have been paid or otherwise provided for in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent;

(ii) with respect to each Mortgaged Property, fully paid American Land Title Association Lender’s title insurance policies or marked up unconditional binder for such insurance (the “ Mortgage Policies ”) in form and substance reasonably requested by Collateral Agent, with endorsements reasonably requested by Collateral Agent, in amounts reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent (not to exceed the value of the Mortgaged Properties covered thereby and subject to any tie-in coverage available), issued, coinsured and reinsured by title insurers reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent in connection with any Material Real Property located in the United States;

(iii) American Land Title Association/American Congress on Surveying and Mapping form surveys, for which all necessary fees (where applicable) have been paid, certified to the Collateral Agent and the issuer of the Mortgage Policies in a manner reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent by a land surveyor duly registered and licensed in the States in which the property described in such surveys is located and reasonably acceptable to the Collateral Agent; provided that new or updated surveys will not be required if an existing survey, ExpressMap or other similar documentation is available and survey coverage is available for the Mortgage Policies without the need for such new or updated surveys; provided , further , the foregoing requirement shall only be in connection with any Material Real Property located in the United States;

 

-104-


(iv) in each case with respect to any Mortgaged Properties, customary opinions of local counsel to the Loan Parties in jurisdictions in which the Mortgaged Property is located, with respect to the enforceability and perfection of the Mortgages and, if applicable any related fixture filings, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Collateral Agent;

(v) customary opinions of counsel to the Loan Parties in the states in which the Loan Parties party to the Mortgages are organized or formed, with respect to the validly existence, corporate power and authority of such Loan Parties in the granting of the Mortgages, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(vi) with respect to each improved Mortgaged Property, a “Life-of Loan” Federal Emergency Management Agency Standard Flood Hazard Determination and, if the area in which any improvements located on any Mortgaged Property is designated a “special flood hazard area” by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (or any successor agency), evidence of flood insurance satisfying the requirements of Section  6.07(b) hereof;

(vii) evidence that all other actions reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, that are necessary in order to create valid and subsisting Liens on the property described in the Mortgage, have been taken; and

(viii) evidence that all fees, costs and expenses have been paid in connection with the preparation, execution, filing and recordation of the Mortgages, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, filing and recording fees, title insurance company coordination fees, documentary stamp, mortgage and intangible taxes and title search charges and other charges incurred in connection with the recordation of the Mortgages and the other matters described in this Section  6.16 and as otherwise required to be paid in connection therewith under Section  10.04.

(b) Within the time periods specified on Schedule 6.16 hereto (as each may be extended by the Administrative Agent in its reasonable discretion), provide such Collateral Documents and complete such undertakings as are set forth on Schedule 6.16 hereto.

ARTICLE VII

Negative Covenants

So long as any Lender shall have any Commitment hereunder, any Loan or other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied, the Borrowers shall not and shall not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to (and with respect to Section  7.13 , Holdings shall not), directly or indirectly:

Section 7.01 Liens . Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien upon any of its property, assets or revenues, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, or sign or file or authorize the filing under the Uniform Commercial Code of any jurisdiction a financing statement that names the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary as debtor, or sign any security agreement authorizing any secured party thereunder to file any such financing statement, other than the following:

(a) (i) Liens pursuant to any Loan Document, and (ii) Liens securing Indebtedness and other obligations permitted under Section  7.03(a) , including cash management obligations and hedging obligations secured ratably pursuant to the First Lien Facility Documentation;

(b) Liens existing on the Closing Date and listed on Schedule 7.01 hereto (or to the extent not listed on such Schedule 7.01 , where the fair market value of all property to which such Liens under this clause (b) attach is less than $3,000,000 in the aggregate), and, in each case, any modifications, replacements, renewals, refinancings or extensions thereof; provided that (i) the

 

-105-


Lien does not encumber any property other than (A) property encumbered on the Closing Date, (B) after-acquired property that is affixed or incorporated into the property encumbered by such Lien on the Closing Date and (C) proceeds and products thereof and (ii) the modification, replacement, renewal, extension or refinancing of the obligations secured or benefited by such Liens, to the extent constituting Indebtedness, is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(c) Liens for Taxes, assessments or governmental charges which are not overdue for more than thirty days or which are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings, if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained on the books of the applicable Person in accordance with GAAP (or, with respect any Foreign Subsidiaries, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles that are applicable in their respective jurisdiction of organization);

(d) statutory or common law Liens of landlords, carriers, warehousemen, mechanics, materialmen, repairmen, construction contractors or other like Liens arising in the ordinary course of business and could not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect;

(e) Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business (i) in connection with workers’ compensation, unemployment insurance and other social security legislation, (ii) securing liability for reimbursement or indemnification obligations of insurance carriers providing property, casualty or liability insurance to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or under self-insurance arrangements in respect of such obligations or (iii) securing obligations in respect of letters of credit that have been posted by the Borrowers or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to support the payment of items set forth in clauses (i) and (ii);

(f) Liens to secure the performance of tenders, bids, trade contracts, utilities, governmental contracts, leases and other contracts (other than Indebtedness for borrowed money), statutory obligations, surety, stay, customs and appeal bonds, performance bonds, customer guarantees, performance and completion guarantees and other obligations of a like nature (including (i) those to secure health, safety and environmental obligations, (ii) those required or requested by any Governmental Authority and (iii) letters of credit or bank guarantees issued in lieu of any such bonds or guarantees to support the issuance thereof), in each case, incurred in the ordinary course of business;

(g) easements, covenants, rights-of-way, restrictions (including zoning restrictions), encroachments, protrusions and other similar encumbrances and minor title defects affecting real property which, in the aggregate, do not in any case materially and adversely interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, and any exceptions on the Mortgage Policies issued in connection with the Mortgaged Properties;

(h) Liens (i) securing judgments for the payment of money not constituting an Event of Default under Section  8.01(h) , (ii) arising out of judgments or awards against the Borrowers or any of their Restricted Subsidiaries with respect to which an appeal or other proceeding for review is then being pursued and (iii) notices of lis pendens and associated rights related to litigation being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings for which adequate reserves have been made;

 

-106-


(i) Liens securing Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(v) ; provided that (i) such Liens (other than any Liens securing any Permitted Refinancing of the Indebtedness secured by such Liens) attach concurrently with or within 270 days after the acquisition, repair, replacement, construction or improvement (as applicable) of the property subject to such Liens, (ii) such Liens do not at any time encumber any property (except for replacements, additions and accessions to such property) other than the property financed by such Indebtedness and the proceeds and the products thereof and customary security deposits and (iii) with respect to Capitalized Leases, such Liens do not at any time extend to or cover any assets other than the assets subject to such Capitalized Leases and the proceeds and products thereof and customary security deposits; provided that individual financings of equipment provided by one lender may be cross-collateralized to other financings of equipment provided by such lender on customary terms;

(j) leases, licenses, subleases, sublicenses or other occupancy arrangements and terminations thereof granted to others in respect of real property in the ordinary course of business on which facilities owned or leased by the Borrowers or any of their Restricted Subsidiaries are located;

(k) Liens (i) in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of Law to secure payment of customs duties in connection with the importation of goods in the ordinary course of business or (ii) on specific items of inventory or other goods and proceeds of any Person securing such Person’s obligations in respect of bankers’ acceptances or letters of credit issued or created for the account of such Person to facilitate the purchase, shipment or storage of such inventory or other goods in the ordinary course of business;

(l) Liens (i) of a collection bank arising under Section 4-208 of the Uniform Commercial Code on items in the course of collection, (ii) attaching to commodity trading accounts or other commodities brokerage accounts incurred in the ordinary course of business; and (iii) in favor of a banking or other financial institution arising as a matter of Law or under customary general terms and conditions encumbering deposits or other funds maintained with a financial institution (including the right of set-off) and which are within the general parameters customary in the banking industry;

(m) Liens (i) on cash or Cash Equivalents advances in favor of the seller of any property to be acquired in an Investment pursuant to Section  7.02(f) , (i) , (o) , (q) , (s) , or (hh) to be applied against the purchase price for such Investment or (ii) consisting of an agreement to Dispose of any property in a Disposition permitted under Section  7.05 , in each case solely to the extent such Investment or Disposition, as the case may be, would have been permitted on the date of the creation of such Lien;

(n) Liens on property of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party securing Indebtedness and other obligations in respect of Indebtedness of a non-Loan Party ;

(o) Liens in favor of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary securing Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(iv) ; provided that any such Lien on any Collateral securing such Indebtedness shall be expressly junior in priority to the Liens on the Collateral securing the Obligations pursuant to one or more agreements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent;

(p) Liens (A) existing on property at the time of its acquisition or existing on the property of any Person that becomes a Subsidiary after the Closing Date and any modifications, replacements, renewals and extensions thereof (including Liens securing Permitted Refinancings of Indebtedness secured by such Liens) but, in each case, other than Liens on the Equity Interests of any Person that becomes a Subsidiary (that is not an Excluded Subsidiary); provided that (i)

 

-107-


such Lien was not created in contemplation of such acquisition or such Person becoming a Subsidiary, (ii) such Lien does not encumber any property other than property encumbered at the time of such acquisition or such Person becoming a Subsidiary and the proceeds and products thereof and (iii) the Indebtedness secured thereby is permitted under Section  7.03(b)(v) , Section  7.03(b)(vi) , Section  7.03(b)(xiii)(x) or Section  7.03(b)(xv) ; and (B) securing Indebtedness incurred under Section  7.03(b)(xiii)(y) ; provided that any Indebtedness secured by Liens on the Collateral shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements;

(q) Liens arising from (i) any Uniform Commercial Code financing statement or filing filed against the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary not authorized by such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary ( provided that such Borrower or such Restricted Subsidiary will promptly upon obtaining knowledge thereof use commercially reasonable efforts to have such financing statement terminated or corrected to the extent permitted by the UCC) and (ii) precautionary UCC financing statement filings (or other similar filings in non-U.S. jurisdictions) regarding leases, subleases, licenses or consignments entered into by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary;

(r) any interest or title, and all encumbrances and other matters affecting such interest or title, of a lessor, sublessor, licensee, sublicensee, licensor or sublicensor under any lease, sublease, license or sublicense agreement (including software and other technology licenses) in the ordinary course of business;

(s) Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, consignment or similar arrangements for sale of goods entered into by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(t) Liens deemed to exist in connection with Investments in repurchase agreements permitted under Section  7.02 ;

(u) Liens encumbering reasonable customary initial deposits and margin deposits and similar Liens attaching to commodity trading accounts or other brokerage accounts incurred in the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes;

(v) Permitted Encumbrances;

(w) Liens on cash collateral granted in favor of any lenders and/or issuers of letters of credit created in accordance with the terms of the First Lien Facility Documentation;

(x) Liens that are customary contractual rights of setoff or rights of pledge (i) relating to the establishment of depository relations with banks or other financial institutions not given in connection with the incurrence of Indebtedness, (ii) relating to pooled deposit or sweep accounts of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary to permit satisfaction of overdraft or similar obligations incurred in the ordinary course of business of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or (iii) relating to purchase orders and other agreements entered into with customers of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(y) (i) zoning, building, entitlement and other land use regulations by Governmental Authorities with which the normal operation of the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries complies, and (ii) any zoning or similar Law or right reserved to or vested in any Governmental Authority to control or regulate the use of any real property that does not materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary taken as a whole;

 

-108-


(z) Liens solely on any cash earnest money deposits made by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in connection with any letter of intent or purchase agreement permitted hereunder;

(aa) Liens on Equity Interests of Joint Ventures securing obligations of such Joint Venture;

(bb) (i) deposits made in the ordinary course of business to secure liability to insurance carriers and (ii) Liens on insurance policies and the proceeds thereof securing the financing of insurance premiums with respect thereto;

(cc) receipt of progress payments and advances from customers in the ordinary course of business to the extent the same creates a Lien on the related inventory and proceeds thereof;

(dd) so long as no Default has occurred and is continuing at the time of granting such Liens, Liens on cash deposits securing any Swap Contract permitted hereunder in an aggregate amount not to exceed the greater of the greater of (i) $12,000,000 and (ii) 15% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(ee) Liens on cash or Cash Equivalents used to defease or to satisfy and discharge Indebtedness; provided that such defeasance or satisfaction and discharge is permitted hereunder;

(ff) [Reserved];

(gg) (A) Liens on property constituting Collateral securing obligations issued or incurred under (i) any Refinancing Notes and the Refinancing Notes Indentures related thereto, (ii) any New Incremental Notes and the New Incremental Notes Indentures related thereto or (iii) any Permitted Ratio Debt secured on a basis ranking pari passu or junior to the Liens securing the Obligations and any documentation related thereto and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancings thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof); provided that such Indebtedness is subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements and (B) Liens on any property of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary Guarantor securing obligations of non-Loan Parties in respect of Permitted Ratio Debt and any documentation related thereto and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

(hh) Liens on cash or Cash Equivalents (and the related escrow accounts) in connection with the issuance into (and pending the release from) escrow of any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes, any Permitted Ratio Debt and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing thereof;

(ii) other Liens securing Indebtedness outstanding in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the greater of the greater of (i) $30,000,000 and (ii) 36% of Consolidated EBITDA, which Liens, if on the Collateral, shall be subject to Applicable Intercreditor Arrangements;

(jj) Liens arising out of any license, sublicense or cross license of, or other contractual obligation with respect to, intellectual property to or from the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary permitted under Section  7.05 ;

 

-109-


(kk) Liens in respect of sale-leasebacks permitted under Section  7.05(e) and general intangibles relevant thereto so long as such Liens attach only to the property sold and being leased in such transaction and related property;

(ll) [Reserved];

(mm) [Reserved];

(nn) [Reserved];

(oo) [Reserved];

(pp) in the case of any non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary, any put and call arrangements or restrictions on disposition related to its Equity Interests set forth in its organizational documents or any related joint venture or similar agreement; and

(qq) Liens consisting of contractual restrictions permitted under Section  7.09 .

Section 7.02 Investments .

Make or hold any Investments, except:

(a) Investments held by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the form of Cash Equivalents or that were Cash Equivalents when made;

(b) loans or advances to officers, managers, directors and employees of Holdings, any Parent Holding Company, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (i) for travel, entertainment, relocation and analogous ordinary business purposes, in an aggregate amount not to exceed, other than for travel, relocation, entertainment, each in the ordinary course of business, and analogous ordinary business purposes, $12,000,000 at any time outstanding and (ii) in connection with such Person’s purchase of Equity Interests of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company; provided that no cash is actually advanced pursuant to this clause (ii) unless immediately repaid;

(c) Investments (i) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in any Loan Party (or any Person that becomes a Loan Party in connection with such Investment) other than Holdings, (ii) by any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party in any other Restricted Subsidiary that is also not a Loan Party, (iii) by Loan Parties in any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party so long as such Investment is part of a series of Investments by Restricted Subsidiaries in other Restricted Subsidiaries that result in the proceeds of the initial Investment being invested in one or more Restricted Subsidiaries that are Loan Parties and (iv) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary made for tax planning reorganization purposes, so long as the Borrowers provide to the Administrative Agent evidence reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent that, after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Investments, the granting, perfection, validity and priority of the security interest of the Secured Parties in the Collateral, taken as a whole, is not impaired in any material respect by such Investment;

(d) Investments consisting of extensions of credit in the nature of accounts receivable or notes receivable arising from the grant of trade credit in the ordinary course of business (including advances made to distributors), Investments received in satisfaction or partial satisfaction thereof from financially troubled account debtors, and Investments consisting of prepayments to suppliers in the ordinary course of business;

 

-110-


(e) to the extent constituting Investments, transactions expressly permitted (other than by reference to this Section  7.02 or any clause thereof) under Sections 7.01 , 7.03 , 7.04 , 7.05 (including the receipt of non-cash consideration for the Dispositions of assets permitted thereunder), 7.06 and 7.12 ;

(f) Investments in existence on, or that are made pursuant to legally binding written commitments that are in existence on, the Closing Date and are set forth on Schedule 7.02 , and any modification, replacement, renewal or extension thereof; provided that no such modification, replacement, renewal or extension shall increase the amount of Investments then permitted under this Section  7.02(f) except pursuant to the terms of such Investment in existence on the Closing Date or as otherwise permitted by this Section  7.02 ;

(g) Investments in Swap Contracts permitted under Section  7.03 ;

(h) promissory notes and other non-cash consideration received in connection with Dispositions permitted by Section  7.05 ;

(i) (i) any acquisition or other Investment made solely with the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of Holdings, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied or (ii) the purchase or other acquisition of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of, any Person or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or of all of the Equity Interests in a Person (or all of the remaining Equity Interests of a non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary) that, upon the consummation thereof, will be a Restricted Subsidiary that is wholly-owned directly by the Borrowers and/or one or more other wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiaries (including as a result of a merger or consolidation) (each, a “ Permitted Acquisition ”); provided that, with respect to each purchase or other acquisition made pursuant to this Section  7.02(i) :

(i) each applicable Loan Party and any such newly created or acquired Restricted Subsidiary shall have complied with the requirements of Section  6.12 or made arrangements reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent for compliance after the effectiveness of such Permitted Acquisition, as applicable;

(ii) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to any such purchase or other acquisition and any incurrence of Indebtedness in connection therewith, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing;

(iii) any Person or assets or division as acquired in accordance herewith shall be in the same business or lines of business or reasonably related, ancillary or complementary businesses in which the Borrowers and/or their Subsidiaries are then engaged; and

(iv) the aggregate amount of consideration paid or provided by a Borrower or another Loan Party (including the aggregate principal amount of all Indebtedness assumed in connection with such Permitted Acquisition and the fair market value of any non-cash consideration provided in connection therewith) under this clause (i) with respect to (x) any Person or Persons that shall not be or, after

 

-111-


giving effect to such Permitted Acquisition, shall not become a Guarantor or shall not transfer all or substantially all of its assets to a Borrower or another Loan Party and/or (y) in the case of an asset acquisition, assets that shall not be, or after giving effect to such Permitted Acquisition, shall not become Collateral, shall not exceed in the aggregate, when combined with Investments made pursuant to clause (j)(iii) below, the greater of (x) $36,000,000 and (y) 42% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(j) (i) Investments by any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party in any Joint Venture or Unrestricted Subsidiary, (ii) Investments by a Loan Party in any Joint Venture, as long as such Investments do not exceed in the aggregate the greater of (x) $24,000,000 and (y) 30% of Consolidated EBITDA, and (iii) Investments by Loan Parties in any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party, to the extent that the aggregate amount of all Investments made pursuant to this Section  7.02(j)(iii) shall not exceed in the aggregate, when combined with Permitted Acquisitions made pursuant to clause (i)(iv) above, the greater of (x) $36,000,000 and (y) 42% of Consolidated EBITDA ( provided that, in each case, intercompany current liabilities incurred in the ordinary course of business and consistent with past practice in connection with the cash management operations of Holdings, the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries shall not be included in calculating such limitation) plus any amounts of Investments then permitted to be made under Section  7.02(s) ( provided , that any usage of such amounts hereunder shall reduce the Cumulative Credit by a corresponding amount);

(k) Investments in the ordinary course of business consisting of (i) endorsements for collection or deposit and (ii) customary trade arrangements with customers;

(l) Investments (including debt obligations and Equity Interests) received in connection with the bankruptcy or reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise) of suppliers and customers and in settlement of delinquent obligations of, and other disputes with, customers and suppliers arising in the ordinary course of business and upon the foreclosure with respect to any secured Investment or other transfer of title with respect to any secured Investment;

(m) the licensing, sublicensing or contribution of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business;

(n) loans and advances to Holdings in lieu of, and not in excess of the amount of (after giving effect to any other loans, advances or Restricted Payments made to Holdings), Restricted Payments permitted to be made to Holdings in accordance with Section  7.06 ; provided that any such loan or advance shall reduce the amount of such applicable Restricted Payment thereafter permitted under Section  7.06 by a corresponding amount (if such applicable subsection of Section  7.06 contains a maximum amount);

(o) other Investments not exceeding the greater of (i) $36,000,000 and (ii) 42% of Consolidated EBITDA;

(p) Investments made in the ordinary course of business in connection with obtaining, maintaining or renewing client contracts and loans or advances made to distributors and suppliers in the ordinary course of business;

 

-112-


(q) Investments to the extent that payment for such Investments is made solely by the issuance of Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) to the seller of such Investments;

(r) Investments of a Person that is acquired and becomes a Restricted Subsidiary or of a company merged or amalgamated or consolidated into the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, in each case after the Closing Date and in accordance with this Section  7.02 and/or Section  7.04 , as applicable, to the extent that such Investments were not made in contemplation of or in connection with such acquisition, merger, amalgamation or consolidation and were in existence on the date of such acquisition, merger, amalgamation or consolidation;

(s) Investments made with the portion, if any, of the Cumulative Credit on the date that the Borrowers elect to apply all or a portion thereof to this Section  7.02(s) , and, upon the request of the Administrative Agent, such election to be specified in a written notice of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers calculating in reasonable detail the amount of Cumulative Credit immediately prior to such election and the amount thereof elected to be so applied; provided that with respect to any Investment made pursuant to this clause (s), immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Investment, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom;

(t) any Investments in a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party or in a Joint Venture, in each case, to the extent such Investment is substantially contemporaneously repaid with a dividend or other distribution from such Restricted Subsidiary or Joint Venture;

(u) the forgiveness or conversion to equity of any Indebtedness owed to a Borrower or a Restricted Subsidiary and permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(v) Investments made on or prior to the Closing Date to consummate the Transaction;

(w) advances of payroll payments and business expenses to employees in the ordinary course of business;

(x) additional Restricted Subsidiaries of the Borrowers may be established or created if the Borrowers and such Subsidiary comply with the requirements of Section  6.12 , if applicable; provided that to the extent any such new Subsidiary is created solely for the purpose of consummating a transaction pursuant to an acquisition permitted by this Section  7.02 , and such new Subsidiary at no time holds any assets or liabilities other than any merger consideration contributed to it contemporaneously with the closing of such transaction, such new Subsidiary shall not be required to take the actions set forth in Section  6.12 , as applicable, until the respective acquisition is consummated (at which time the surviving or transferee entity of the respective transaction and its Subsidiaries shall be required to so comply in accordance with the provisions thereof);

(y) [Reserved];

(z) to the extent that they constitute Investments, purchases and acquisitions of inventory, supplies, materials and equipment, maintenance, filing and renewal fees or purchases of contract rights or licenses or leases of intellectual property, in each case in the ordinary course of business;

 

-113-


(aa) Guarantees of Holdings, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of leases entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(bb) Guarantees of Indebtedness incurred by customers in connection with the purchase or other acquisition of equipment or supplies in the ordinary course of business;

(cc) Investments arising as a result of sale-leasebacks permitted by Section  7.05(e) ;

(dd) [Reserved];

(ee) [Reserved];

(ff) prepaid expenses or lease, utility and other similar deposits, in each case made in the ordinary course of business;

(gg) Investments made by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party to the extent such Investments are financed with the proceeds received by such Restricted Subsidiary from an Investment in such Restricted Subsidiary by a Loan Party permitted under this Section  7.02 ; and

(hh) in addition to the foregoing Investments, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries may make additional Investments; provided that (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (ii) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 4.25 to 1.00.

Section 7.03 Indebtedness . Create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Indebtedness, except:

(a) Indebtedness under the First Lien Credit Agreement of the Borrowers or any Guarantor (i) in an aggregate outstanding principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $370,000,000, plus the aggregate principal amount of any First Lien Incremental Loans or First Lien Incremental Notes incurred after the Closing Date and permitted to be incurred under the First Lien Credit Agreement (as in effect on the date hereof), in each case as in effect on the Closing Date, and any Permitted Refinancing thereof and (ii) in respect of Secured Cash Management Agreements and Secured Hedge Agreements (each as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) incurred in accordance with the terms of the First Lien Credit Agreement (as in effect on the date hereof);

(b) in the case of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries:

(i) (x) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties under or pursuant to the Loan Documents including any refinancing thereof in accordance with Section  2.18 , (y) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties evidenced by Refinancing Notes and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof) and (z) Indebtedness of the Loan Parties evidenced by New Incremental Notes and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

(ii) Permitted Surviving Debt and any Permitted Refinancing thereof (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof);

 

-114-


(iii) Guarantees (i) incurred by the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any other Restricted Subsidiary that is permitted to be incurred under this Agreement; provided that in the case of any Guarantees by a Loan Party of the obligations of a non-Loan Party, the related Investment is permitted under Section  7.02 and (ii) of any Loan Party in respect of Indebtedness of the Borrowers (including any Permitted Refinancing thereof) or any other Loan Party otherwise permitted hereunder;

(iv) Indebtedness of (A) any Loan Party owing to any other Loan Party, (B) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party owed to (1) any other Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party or (2) any Loan Party in respect of an Investment permitted under Section  7.02 and (C) any Loan Party to any Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party; provided that all such Indebtedness of any Loan Party in clauses (iv)(C) must be expressly subordinated to the Obligations on the terms of the Intercompany Subordination Agreement;

(v) (i) (A) Attributable Indebtedness (including Capitalized Leases) and purchase money obligations (including obligations in respect of mortgage, industrial revenue bond, industrial development bond and similar financings) to finance the purchase or other acquisition, repair or improvement of fixed or capital assets within the limitations set forth in Section  7.01(i) and (B) any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof; provided , however , that the aggregate amount of all such Indebtedness at any one time outstanding shall not exceed the greater of (x) $18,000,000 and (y) 21% of Consolidated EBITDA, and (ii) Attributable Indebtedness arising out of sale-leaseback transactions permitted by Section  7.05(e) and any Permitted Refinancing of such Attributable Indebtedness;

(vi) [Reserved];

(vii) Indebtedness in respect of Swap Contracts incurred in the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes and Guarantees thereof;

(viii) [Reserved];

(ix) Indebtedness representing deferred compensation or stock-based compensation to employees of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

(x) Indebtedness consisting of promissory notes issued by any Loan Party to current or former officers, managers, consultants, directors and employees, their respective estates, spouses or former spouses to finance the purchase or redemption of Equity Interests of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company permitted by Section  7.06 ;

(xi) Indebtedness in respect of indemnification, purchase price adjustments or other similar adjustments incurred by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in a Permitted Acquisition, any other Investments or other acquisition permitted hereunder or Disposition under agreements that provide for the adjustment of the indemnification, purchase price or for similar adjustments;

(xii) Indebtedness consisting of obligations of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary under deferred consideration ( e.g ., earn-outs, indemnifications, incentive non-competes and other contingent obligations) or other similar arrangements incurred by such Person in connection with the Transactions or any Permitted Acquisition or other acquisition permitted under Section  7.02 ;

 

-115-


(xiii) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) assumed in connection with any Permitted Acquisition ( provided that such Indebtedness is not incurred in contemplation of such Permitted Acquisition or any Permitted Refinancing thereof) or (y) incurred to finance any Permitted Acquisition; provided that after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Permitted Acquisition and the assumption or incurrence of such Indebtedness, as applicable, (A) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00, (B) if such Indebtedness is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary on a pari passu basis with the obligations under the First Lien Facility Documentation, the First Lien Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 3.75 to 1.00 and (C) if such Indebtedness is secured by a Lien on any asset or property of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, the Senior Secured Net Leverage Ratio (determined on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is no greater than 5.25 to 1.00; provided that any such Indebtedness assumed or incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party, together with any Indebtedness incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xx) , does not exceed in the aggregate at any time outstanding the Shared Debt Cap, in each case determined at the time of assumption or incurrence; provided , further , that in the case of clause (y), (A) such Indebtedness does not mature prior to the date that is the Latest Maturity Date of, or have a Weighted Average Life to Maturity less than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, any Loan outstanding at the time such Indebtedness is incurred or issued, and does not require any scheduled amortization or other scheduled payments of principal prior to, the final Maturity Date with respect to the Loans, (B) no Event of Default shall exist or result therefrom (other than a Permitted Acquisition, a permitted Investment or other acquisition permitted pursuant to this Agreement and made pursuant to a legally binding commitment entered into at a time when no Event of Default exists or would result therefrom) and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing of such Indebtedness, (C) with respect to any incurrence of Indebtedness under this clause (xiii), any identifiable proceeds of Indebtedness incurred pursuant to this clause (xiii) shall not qualify as “cash or Cash Equivalents of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries” for the purposes of calculating any net obligations or liabilities for purposes of such incurrence and (D) such indebtedness, if secured on a pari passu basis with the Obligations, is subject to the restrictions for loans or securities (as applicable) set forth in the last sentence of the definition of “Permitted Ratio Debt”;

(xiv) Indebtedness in respect of netting services, overdraft protections, employee credit card programs, automatic clearinghouse arrangements, other cash management arrangements and similar arrangements in each case in connection with deposit accounts and Indebtedness arising from the honoring of a bank or other financial institution of a check, draft or similar instrument drawn against insufficient funds in the ordinary course of business; provided that any such Indebtedness is extinguished within 30 days;

(xv) Indebtedness in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the greater of (x) $30,000,000 and (y) 36% of Consolidated EBITDA, at any time outstanding;

 

-116-


(xvi) Indebtedness incurred by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of bank guarantees, letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances, warehouse receipts or similar instruments issued or created in the ordinary course of business, including in respect of workers compensation claims, health, disability or other employee benefits or property, casualty or liability insurance or self-insurance, or other Indebtedness with respect to reimbursement type obligations regarding workers compensation claims;

(xvii) Obligations (including bank guarantees, letters of credit issued or similar investments) in respect of performance, bid, appeal and surety bonds, customer guarantees and performance and completion guarantees and similar obligations provided by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business;

(xviii) Indebtedness consisting of (a) the financing of insurance premiums or (b) take-or-pay obligations contained in supply arrangements, in each case, in the ordinary course of business;

(xix) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed the amount of cash that is contributed to the common equity of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) after the Closing Date (other than (x) by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary and (y) any Cure Amount); provided that the cash so contributed to Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company) is promptly further contributed to the common equity of one or more Borrowers;

(xx) Indebtedness incurred by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries constituting Permitted Ratio Debt and any Permitted Refinancings thereof; provided that the amount of Indebtedness that may be incurred pursuant to this Section  7.03(b)(xx) in each case by Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties shall not exceed the Shared Debt Cap, at any time outstanding;

(xxi) [Reserved];

(xxii) Indebtedness supported by a letter of credit issued under the First Lien Credit Agreement, in a principal amount not in excess of the stated amount of such letter of credit;

(xxiii) Indebtedness of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary as an account party in respect of trade letters of credit issued in the ordinary course of business;

(xxiv) [Reserved];

(xxv) Guarantees incurred in the ordinary course of business in respect of obligations of or to suppliers, customers, franchisees, lessors, licensees and sublicensees;

(xxvi) unsecured Indebtedness in respect of intercompany obligations of the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary in respect of accounts payable incurred in connection with goods sold or services rendered in the ordinary course of business and not in connection with the borrowing of money;

(xxvii) (i) Indebtedness incurred in connection with any sale leaseback permitted pursuant to Section  7.05(e) and (ii) any Permitted Refinancing in respect thereof;

 

-117-


(xxviii) [Reserved];

(xxix) [Reserved];

(xxx) Indebtedness incurred as a result of the cancellation of Loans in accordance with Section  10.07(j)(i) ;

(xxxi) to the extent constituting Indebtedness, customer deposits and advance payments (including progress payments) received in the ordinary course of business from customers for goods and services purchased in the ordinary course of business; and

(xxxii) all premiums (if any), interest (including post-petition interest), fees, expenses, charges and additional or contingent interest on obligations described in clauses (i) through (xxxi) above.

The accrual of interest, the accretion of accreted value and the payment of interest in the form of additional Indebtedness shall not be deemed to be an incurrence of Indebtedness for purposes of this Section  7.03 . The principal amount of any non-interest bearing Indebtedness or other discount security constituting Indebtedness at any date shall be the principal amount thereof that would be shown on a balance sheet of the Borrowers dated such date prepared in accordance with GAAP.

For purposes of determining compliance with this Section  7.03 , in the event that an item of Indebtedness meets the criteria of more than one of the categories of Indebtedness described in Sections  7.03(b)(iii) through 7.03(b)(xxxi) , the Borrowers shall, in their sole discretion, classify and reclassify or later divide, classify or reclassify such item of Indebtedness (or any portion thereof) and will only be required to include the amount and type of such Indebtedness in one or more of the above clauses; provided that all Indebtedness outstanding under the Loan Documents will at all times be deemed to be outstanding in reliance only on the exception in Section  7.03(b)(i) and for the avoidance of doubt, Indebtedness under Section  7.03(a) may not be reclassified under such other clauses; provided , further , that, for the avoidance of doubt, Indebtedness incurred pursuant to one or more prongs of the Incremental Amount shall not be permitted to be reclassified.

Section 7.04 Fundamental Changes . Merge, dissolve, liquidate, amalgamate, consolidate with or into another Person, or Dispose of (whether in one transaction or in a series of transactions) all or substantially all of its assets (whether now owned or hereafter acquired) to or in favor of any Person, except that:

(a) any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with (i) so long as no Event of Default would result therefrom, the Borrowers (including a merger, the purpose of which is to reorganize a Borrower into a new jurisdiction in any State of the United States); provided that a Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving Person or the surviving Person shall expressly assume the obligations of the applicable Borrower pursuant to documents reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent or (ii) any one or more other Restricted Subsidiaries; provided that (x) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or a FSHCO may not merge with any Restricted Subsidiary that is a Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or a FSHCO if such Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or such FSHCO shall be the continuing or surviving Person and (y) when any Guarantor is merging with another Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party (A) the Guarantor shall be the continuing or surviving Person, (B) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in or Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party in accordance with Sections 7.02 and 7.03 , respectively and (C) to the extent constituting a Disposition, such Disposition must be permitted hereunder;

 

-118-


(b) (i) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with or into any other Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party and (ii) any Restricted Subsidiary may liquidate or dissolve, or the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary may change its legal form if the Borrowers determine in good faith that such action is in the best interest of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries and is not disadvantageous to the Lenders in any material respect (it being understood that in the case of any dissolution of a Restricted Subsidiary that is a Guarantor, such Subsidiary shall at or before the time of such dissolution transfer its assets to another Restricted Subsidiary that is a Borrower or a Guarantor unless such Disposition of assets is permitted hereunder; and in the case of any change in legal form, a Restricted Subsidiary that is a Guarantor will remain a Guarantor unless such Guarantor is otherwise permitted to cease being a Guarantor hereunder);

(c) any Restricted Subsidiary may Dispose of all or substantially all of its assets (upon voluntary liquidation or otherwise) to the Borrowers or to any Restricted Subsidiary; provided that if the transferor in such a transaction is a Guarantor, then (i) the transferee must either be the Borrowers or a Guarantor and (ii) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in or Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Loan Party in accordance with Sections 7.02 and 7.03 , respectively;

(d) any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, amalgamate or consolidate with, or dissolve into, any other Person in order to effect an Investment permitted pursuant to Section  7.02 ; provided that (i) the continuing or surviving Person shall, to the extent subject to the terms hereof, have complied with the requirements of Section  6.12 and (ii) to the extent constituting an Investment, such Investment must be a permitted Investment in accordance with Section  7.02 and (iii) to the extent constituting a Disposition, such Disposition must be permitted hereunder;

(e) the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries may consummate the Transaction;

(f) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, any Restricted Subsidiary may merge, dissolve, liquidate, amalgamate, consolidate with or into another Person in order to effect a Disposition permitted pursuant to Section  7.05 (other than Section  7.05(d)(A) );

(g) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, any Investment permitted by Section  7.02 may be structured as a merger, consolidation or amalgamation; and

(h) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, the Borrowers may merge or consolidate with any other Person; provided that (i) a Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving corporation or (ii) if the Person formed by or surviving any such merger or consolidation is not a Borrower (any such Person, the “ Successor Company ”), (A) the Successor Company shall be an entity organized or existing under the Laws of any state of the United States or the District of Columbia, (B) the Successor Company shall expressly assume all the obligations of the applicable Borrower or Borrowers under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which each applicable Borrower is a party pursuant to a supplement hereto or thereto in form reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent,

 

-119-


(C) each Guarantor, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have confirmed that its Guarantee shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, (D) each Guarantor, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have by a Security Agreement Supplement and other applicable Collateral Documents confirmed that its obligations thereunder shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, (E) if reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, each mortgagor of a Mortgaged Property, unless it is the other party to such merger or consolidation, shall have by an amendment to or restatement of the applicable Mortgage (or other instrument reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent) confirmed that its obligations thereunder shall apply to the Successor Company’s obligations under the Loan Documents, and (F) the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that such merger or consolidation and such supplement to this Agreement or any Collateral Document comply with this Agreement; provided , further , that if the foregoing are satisfied, the Successor Company will succeed to, and be substituted for, the applicable Borrower under this Agreement.

Section 7.05 Dispositions . Make any Disposition, except:

(a) Dispositions of obsolete, surplus, used or worn out property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in the ordinary course of business and Dispositions of property no longer used or useful or economically practicable to maintain in the conduct of the business of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries (including allowing any registrations or applications for registration of any intellectual property to lapse or go abandoned);

(b) Dispositions of inventory, goods held for sale and immaterial assets in the ordinary course of business (including allowing any registrations or applications for registration of any intellectual property to lapse or go abandoned in the ordinary course of business) and termination of leases and licenses in the ordinary course of business, including but not limited to a voluntary or mandatory recall of any product;

(c) Dispositions of property to the extent that (i) such property is exchanged for credit against the purchase price of similar replacement property or (ii) the net proceeds of such Disposition are promptly applied to the purchase price of such replacement property;

(d) (A) Dispositions permitted by Section  7.04 , (B) Investments permitted by Section  7.02 , (C) Restricted Payments permitted by Section  7.06 and (D) Liens permitted by Section  7.01 (in each case, other than by reference to this Section  7.05 (or any clause under this Section  7.05 ));

(e) Dispositions by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary of property pursuant to sale-leaseback transactions; provided that (i) the fair market value of all property so Disposed of shall not exceed $30,000,000 from and after the Closing Date and (ii) the purchase price for such property shall be paid to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, for not less than 75% cash consideration;

(f) Dispositions of cash and Cash Equivalents in the ordinary course of business;

(g) [Reserved];

(h) licensing or sublicensing of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business on customary terms;

 

-120-


(i) sales, Dispositions or contributions of property (A) between Loan Parties (other than Holdings), (B) between Restricted Subsidiaries (other than Loan Parties), (C) by Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Loan Parties to the Loan Parties (other than Holdings) or (D) by Loan Parties to any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Loan Party; provided that (1) the portion (if any) of any such Disposition made for less than fair market value and (2) any non-cash consideration received in exchange for any such Disposition, shall in each case constitute an Investment in such Restricted Subsidiary and, if the transferor of such property is a Loan Party and the transferee thereof is a non-Loan Party, such sale, Disposition or contribution of property shall otherwise comply with Section  7.02 ;

(j) leases, subleases, licenses, sublicenses or other occupancy arrangements of property (other than IP Rights) in the ordinary course of business and which do not materially interfere with the business of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

(k) transfers of property subject to Casualty Events upon receipt of the Net Cash Proceeds of such Casualty Event;

(l) Dispositions made (i) on the Closing Date to consummate the Transactions and (ii) as contemplated pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement as in effect on the Closing Date;

(m) Dispositions of Investments (including Equity Interests) in Joint Ventures to the extent required by, or made pursuant to customary buy/sell arrangements between, the joint venture parties set forth in joint venture arrangements and similar binding arrangements;

(n) the transfer for fair value of property (including Equity Interests of Subsidiaries) to another Person in connection with a joint venture arrangement with respect to the transferred property; provided that such transfer is permitted under Section  7.02(j) , (o) , (s), (t) or (hh) ;

(o) the unwinding of Swap Contracts permitted hereunder pursuant to their terms;

(p) transfers of condemned property as a result of the exercise of “eminent domain” or other similar powers to the respective Governmental Authority or agency that has condemned the same (whether by deed in lieu of condemnation or otherwise), and transfers of property that have been subject to a casualty to the respective insurer of such real property as part of an insurance settlement;

(q) any Disposition of any asset between or among the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries as a substantially concurrent interim Disposition in connection with a Disposition otherwise permitted pursuant to this Section  7.05 ;

(r) [Reserved];

(s) Dispositions by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary not otherwise permitted under this Section  7.05 ; provided that (i) at the time of such Disposition (other than any such Disposition made pursuant to a legally binding commitment entered into at a time when no Event of Default exists), no Event of Default shall exist or would result from such Disposition and (ii) the purchase price for such property in excess of $9,000,000 shall be paid to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary, as applicable, for not less than 75% cash consideration or Cash Equivalents; provided , however , that for the purposes of this clause (s)(ii), the following shall be deemed to be cash: (A) any liabilities (as shown on the Borrowers’ or such Restricted Subsidiary’s most recent balance sheet provided hereunder or in the footnotes thereto) of the

 

-121-


Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary (other than liabilities that are by their terms subordinated to the Obligations) that are (x) assumed by the transferee with respect to the applicable Disposition or (y) are otherwise unconditionally cancelled or terminated (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of cancelled or terminated liabilities in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) in connection with the transaction with such transferee (other than intercompany debt owed to the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries) and, in the case of clause (x), for which the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries shall have been validly released (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of released liabilities in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) by all applicable creditors in writing, (B) any securities, notes or other obligations or assets received by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary from such transferee that are converted by the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary into cash or Cash Equivalents (to the extent of the cash or Cash Equivalents received in the conversion) within 180 days following the closing of the applicable Disposition; (C) any Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of such Disposition having an aggregate fair market value, taken together with the Designated Non-Cash Consideration in respect of all other Dispositions, not in excess of the greater of $18,000,000 (with the fair market value of each item of Designated Non-Cash Consideration being measured as of the time received) and 21% of Consolidated EBITDA and (D) Indebtedness of any Restricted Subsidiary that ceases to be a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such Disposition (other than intercompany debt owed to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary), to the extent that the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary are unconditionally released from all obligations (other than customary indemnity, reimbursement, and similar obligations and subject to customary statutory provisions related to reinstatement of released obligations in the event of bankruptcy or insolvency) with respect to such Indebtedness in connection with such Disposition;

(t) the Disposition of any Unrestricted Subsidiary;

(u) the Disposition of assets acquired pursuant to or in order to effectuate a Permitted Acquisition or any other acquisition permitted under Section  7.02 which assets are (i) obsolete or (ii) not used or useful to the core or principal business of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries;

(v) [Reserved];

(w) [Reserved];

(x) [Reserved];

(y) any Subsidiary may issue Equity Interests to qualified directors where required by applicable law or to satisfy other requirements of applicable law with respect to ownership of Equity Interests in Foreign Subsidiaries; and

(z) the sale or issuance of the Equity Interests of any Foreign Subsidiary or any Subsidiary of the type described in clause (d) or (e) of the definition of Excluded Subsidiary to any other Foreign Subsidiary or any Subsidiary of the type described in clause (d) or (e) of the definition of Excluded Subsidiary, including, without limitation, in connection with any tax restructuring activities not otherwise prohibited hereunder;

 

-122-


provided , however , that any Disposition of any property pursuant to Section  7.05(b) (other than with respect to immaterial assets Disposed of in the ordinary course of business), (c) , (e) , (n) , (s) or (t)  shall be for no less than the fair market value of such property at the time of such Disposition. To the extent any Collateral is Disposed of as expressly permitted by this Section  7.05 to any Person other than a Loan Party, such Collateral shall be sold free and clear of the Liens created by the Loan Documents, and the Administrative Agent is authorized to and shall take any actions deemed appropriate in order to effect the foregoing.

Section 7.06 Restricted Payments . Declare or make, directly or indirectly, any Restricted Payment, except:

(a) each Restricted Subsidiary may make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers and to other Restricted Subsidiaries that directly or indirectly own Equity Interests of such Restricted Subsidiary (and, in the case of a Restricted Payment by a non-wholly-owned Restricted Subsidiary, to the Borrowers and any such other Restricted Subsidiary and to each other owner of Equity Interests of such Restricted Subsidiary based on their relative ownership interests);

(b) the Borrowers and each Restricted Subsidiary may declare and make dividend payments or other distributions payable solely in the Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests not otherwise permitted by Section  7.03 ) of such Person (and in the case that one or more Borrower receives Equity Interests of any of its direct or indirect parent company as a result of foreclosing on such Equity Interests pledged to secure loans or advances as described in Section  7.02(b) , any dividends or distributions of such Equity Interests);

(c) the Borrowers may make Restricted Payments with the cash proceeds contributed to its ordinary equity from the Net Cash Proceeds of any Permitted Equity Issuance or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of the applicable Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, so long as, with respect to any such Restricted Payments, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing or would result therefrom;

(d) to the extent constituting Restricted Payments, the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries may take actions expressly permitted by Section  7.02 (other than Sections 7.02(e) and (n) ), 7.04 , 7.05 , 7.08(b) , (c) , (d) , (e) , (h) , (i) , (j) , (o) or (q)  or 7.12 (in each case, other than by reference to this Section  7.06 (or any clause under this Section  7.06 ));

(e) any Restricted Subsidiary may make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers, and the Borrowers may make Restricted Payments, in each case:

(i) the proceeds of which shall be used by the Borrowers to pay (or to make a Restricted Payment to or Investment in Holdings or a Parent Holding Company to enable it to pay) (a) its, Holdings’ or such Parent Holding Company’s operating expenses incurred in the ordinary course of business and other corporate overhead costs and expenses (including administrative, legal, accounting and similar expenses provided by third parties), that are reasonable and customary and incurred in the ordinary course of business, plus any reasonable and customary indemnification claims made by directors, managers or officers of the Borrowers or Holdings not to exceed the ratable share of the amount to which such Restricted Payment relates that is related to the ownership or operations of the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries or (b) the fees and other amounts described in Sections 7.08(c) , (d) , (e) , (i) and (j)  to the extent that the Borrowers would be then permitted under such Sections 7.08(c) , (d) , (e) , (i) , (j) , (o) and (q)  to pay such fees and other amounts directly;

 

-123-


(ii) for any taxable period for which the Borrowers and/or any of its Subsidiaries are members of a consolidated, combined, unitary, affiliated or similar income, franchise or other tax (imposed in lieu of income tax) group of which the Borrowers or a direct or indirect parent of Borrowers is the common parent (a “ Tax Group ”), the portion of any income taxes (and any consolidated, combined, unitary, affiliated or similar franchise or similar taxes imposed in lieu of such income taxes of such Tax Group) due by the parent company of the relevant Tax Group for such taxable period, that is attributable to the Borrowers and/or their Subsidiaries; provided that (A) Restricted Payments under this Section  7.06(e)(ii) for any taxable period shall not exceed the amount of such Taxes that the Borrowers and/or such Subsidiaries, as applicable, would have paid had the Borrowers and/or such Subsidiaries, as applicable, been a stand-alone taxpayer (or a stand-alone group), taking into account any prior use by the Tax Group of any operating losses of the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries and (B) Restricted Payments under this Section  7.06(e)(ii) in respect of an Unrestricted Subsidiary shall be permitted only to the extent that cash distributions were made by such Unrestricted Subsidiary to Holdings or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries for such purpose;

(iii) the proceeds of which will be used to repurchase, retire or otherwise acquire the Equity Interests of the Borrowers (or to make a Restricted Payment to or an Investment in Holdings or a Parent Holding Company or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof to enable it to repurchase, retire or otherwise acquire its Equity Interest) from future, former or present directors, managers, consultants, employees or members of management of Holdings or any Restricted Subsidiary (or their estate, family members, spouse and/or former spouse or successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees or distributees of the foregoing), in an aggregate amount not in excess of (A) at any time prior to a Qualified IPO, $6,000,000 in any calendar year plus any unutilized portion of such amount in any preceding fiscal years (with such sum, however, not exceeding $18,000,000 at any time) and (B) at any time after a Qualified IPO, $12,000,000 in any calendar year plus any unutilized portion of such amount in any preceding fiscal years (with such sum, however, not exceeding $30,000,000 at any time); provided , further , that the amounts set forth in this clause (e)(iii) may be further increased by (A) the proceeds of any key-man life insurance received by Holdings (or a Parent Holding Company), the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary less the amount of Restricted Payments previously made with the cash proceeds of such key man life insurance policies plus (B) the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of the Borrowers, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied ( provided that in no event shall any such contributed amounts increase the Cumulative Credit) plus (C) amounts that would otherwise increase the Cumulative Credit pursuant to clause (c) of the definition of “Cumulative Credit” as a result of proceeds received from the sale of applicable equity to the Persons set forth in this clause (iii) above; provided that for the avoidance of doubt, any amounts included in this clause (C) may not also increase the Cumulative Credit plus (D) the amount of any cash bonuses or other cash compensation otherwise payable to any future, present or former director, manager, employee, member of management or consultant of Holdings or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof, the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary that are foregone in return for the receipt of Equity Interests of the Borrowers or a direct or indirect equity holder thereof, or the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to a deferred compensation plan of such equity; provided that cancellation of Indebtedness owing to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary from members of management of Holdings, any of Holdings’ direct or indirect parent

 

-124-


companies or any of Holdings’ Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with a repurchase of Equity Interests of any of the Borrowers’ direct or indirect parent companies will not be deemed to constitute a Restricted Payment for purposes of this covenant or any other provision of this Agreement;

(iv) the proceeds of which are applied to the purchase or other acquisition by Holdings or any Parent Holding Company of all or substantially all of the property and assets or business of any Person, or of assets constituting a business unit, a line of business or division of such Person, or more than 50% of the Equity Interests in a Person; provided that, if such purchase or other acquisition had been made by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary, it would have constituted a Permitted Acquisition permitted to be made pursuant to Section  7.02(i) ; provided , further , that (A) such Restricted Payment shall be made concurrently with the closing of such purchase or other acquisition and (B) Holdings, the Borrowers or any Parent Holding Company shall, immediately following the closing thereof, cause (1) all property acquired (whether assets or Equity Interests) and any liabilities assumed to be contributed to the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than (i) with respect to such assets, to any Foreign Subsidiaries of the Borrowers and (ii) to the extent such Equity Interests constitute Foreign Subsidiaries, to the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries) or (2) the merger (to the extent permitted in Section  7.04 ) into the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than any of its Subsidiaries to the extent constituting a Foreign Subsidiary) of the Person formed or acquired in order to consummate such purchaser or other acquisition;

(v) repurchases of Equity Interests of one or more Borrower deemed to occur upon the non-cash exercise of stock options and warrants or similar equity incentive awards;

(vi) the proceeds of which shall be used by the Borrowers to pay, or to make Restricted Payments to allow Holdings or any Parent Holding Company to pay, other than to Affiliates of a Borrower, a portion of any customary fees and expenses related to any unsuccessful equity offering by the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company or offering or debt issuance, incurrence or offering, Disposition or acquisition or investment transaction permitted by this Agreement, in each case not to exceed the ratable share of the amount to which such Restricted Payment relates that is directly related to the operations of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries; and

(vii) the proceeds of which shall be used to pay customary salary, bonus and other benefits payable to officers, employees, consultants and independent contractors of the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company to the extent such salaries, bonuses and other benefits are attributable to the ownership or operation of the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries;

(f) the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments in an aggregate amount not to exceed the Cumulative Credit at such time; provided that with respect to any such Restricted Payment, (x) immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Restricted Payment, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (y) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such Restricted Payment, the Borrowers could incur $1.00 of additional unsecured Permitted Ratio Debt;

 

-125-


(g) Restricted Payments made (i) on or after the Closing Date to consummate the Transactions, (ii) in order to satisfy indemnity and other similar obligations under the Acquisition Agreement, any Permitted Acquisition or other permitted Investment or other acquisition permitted pursuant to this Agreement and (iii) to the extent constituting a Restricted Payment, in respect of the LDiscovery Acquisition Earnout Payment;

(h) the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiary may (i) pay cash in lieu of fractional shares in connection with any dividend, split or combination of its Equity Interests or any Permitted Acquisition (or similar Investment) and (ii) honor any conversion request by a holder of convertible Indebtedness and make cash payments in lieu of fractional shares in connection with any such conversion;

(i) the payment of dividends and distributions within 60 days after the date of declaration thereof, if at the date of declaration of such payment, such payment would have complied with the other provisions of this Section  7.06 ;

(j) after a Qualified IPO, (i) any Restricted Payment by the Borrowers or any Restricted Subsidiary or any direct or indirect parent of the Borrowers to pay listing fees and other costs and expenses attributable to being a publicly traded company which are reasonable and customary and (ii) Restricted Payments by the Borrowers to Holdings so that Holdings may make Restricted Payments to its equity holders or the equity holders of any Parent Holding Company in an aggregate amount not exceeding 6.0% per annum of the Net Cash Proceeds received by the Borrowers from such Qualified IPO;

(k) Restricted Payments in an amount equal to any Taxes payable, including, but not limited to, withholding or similar taxes payable or expected to be payable in connection with any payments to any future, present or former employee, director, officer, manager, consultant or independent contractor (or their respective Affiliates, estates, immediate family members, spouses, former spouses, successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees or distributees of any of the foregoing) or in connection with any repurchases of Equity Interests in consideration of such payments including deemed repurchases in connection with the exercise of stock options or grant, vesting or delivery of any Equity Interests;

(l) Restricted Payments made in respect of working capital adjustments, purchase price adjustments or earn out payments pursuant to the Acquisition, any Permitted Acquisition or other permitted Investments or other acquisitions permitted pursuant to this Agreement;

(m) the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments in an aggregate amount not to exceed, when aggregated with the amount of prepayments, redemptions, purchases, defeasement or other satisfaction prior to the scheduled maturity thereof of any Junior Financing pursuant to Section  7.12(a)(iv)(x) , $15,000,000; and

(n) in addition to the foregoing Restricted Payments, the Borrowers may make additional Restricted Payments; provided that (i) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (ii) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 3.75 to 1.00.

Section 7.07 Change in Nature of Business . Engage in any material line of business substantially different from those lines of business conducted by the Borrowers and the Restricted Subsidiaries on the Closing Date or any business reasonably related, complementary, synergistic or ancillary thereto or reasonable extensions thereof.

 

-126-


Section 7.08 Transactions with Affiliates . Make any payment to, or sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its properties or assets to, or purchase any property or assets from, or enter into or make or amend any transaction or series of transactions, contract, agreement, understanding, loan, advance or guarantee with, or for the benefit of, any Affiliate of a Borrower involving aggregate consideration in excess of $12,000,000 (each of the foregoing, an “ Affiliate Transaction ”), unless (i) such Affiliate Transaction is on terms that are not materially less favorable to the relevant Borrower Party than those that could have been obtained in a comparable transaction with an unrelated Person on an arm’s length basis and (ii) with respect to any Affiliate Transaction or series of related Affiliate Transactions involving aggregate consideration in excess of $36,000,000, each Borrower delivers to the Administrative Agent a resolution adopted in good faith by the majority of the board of directors of Holdings, each such Borrower or any Parent Holding Company, approving such Affiliate Transaction, together with a certificate signed by a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers certifying that the board of directors of Holdings, the Borrowers or any Parent Holding Company determined or resolved that such Affiliate Transaction complies with clause (i). This provision shall not apply to:

(a) transactions among Loan Parties (other than Holdings) and their Restricted Subsidiaries (or any entity that becomes a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such transaction);

(b) the Transactions and the payment of fees and expenses in connection with the consummation of the Transactions (in the case of any deferred fees payable to the Sponsor, only so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing);

(c) so long as no Event of Default under Section  8.01(f) or (g)  shall have occurred and be continuing, the payments pursuant to Consulting Services Agreements (including upon the termination thereof) to the Sponsor plus related indemnities and reasonable expenses; provided that during the period that an Event of Default under Section  8.01(f) or (g)  shall have occurred or be continuing, such payments may accrue, but not be paid, and following cure of such Event of Default to the satisfaction of the Administrative Agent, such accrued payments may be paid to the Sponsor;

(d) customary fees and indemnities may be paid to any directors or managers of Holdings (or any Parent Holding Company), the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries (and, to the extent attributable to the operations or ownership of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries, of Holdings or any Parent Holding Company) and reasonable out-of-pocket costs of such Persons may be reimbursed;

(e) the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries may enter into employment and severance or other compensation arrangements with officers, directors, consultants and employees of the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries (or any direct or indirect parent company of the Borrowers or their Restricted Subsidiaries) in the ordinary course of business or as otherwise approved by the board of directors, board of managers or other equivalent governing body of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary and transactions pursuant to stock option plans and employee benefit plans and arrangements in the ordinary course of business or as otherwise approved by the board of directors, board of managers or other equivalent governing body of the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary;

(f) Restricted Payments permitted under Section  7.06 (other than Section  7.06(d) );

(g) Investments to the extent permitted under Section  7.02 ;

 

-127-


(h) payments required to be made pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement (as in effect on the Closing Date);

(i) transactions pursuant to agreements in existence on the Closing Date and set forth on Schedule 7.08 or any amendment thereto to the extent such an amendment is not materially adverse, taken as a whole, to the Lenders in any material respect;

(j) transactions between a Borrower Party and any Person that is an Affiliate solely due to the fact that a director or manager of such Person is also a director or manager of the Borrowers, Holdings or any Parent Holding Company; provided , however , that such director or manager abstains from voting as a director of the Borrowers, Holdings or such Parent Holding Company, as the case may be, on any matter involving such other Person;

(k) the issuance of Equity Interests to any Permitted Holder, the Sponsor, any Parent Holding Company, Holdings, or to any former, current or future director, manager, officer, employee or consultant (or any spouses, former spouses, successors, executors, administrators, heirs, legatees, distributes or Affiliate of any of the foregoing) of Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries or any direct or indirect parent thereof;

(l) any issuance of Equity Interests, or other payments, awards or grants in cash, securities, Equity Interests or otherwise pursuant to, or the funding of, employment arrangements, stock options and stock ownership plans approved by the board of directors or board of managers of Holdings (or any direct Parent Holding Company) or the Borrowers, as the case may be;

(m) transactions with wholly-owned Subsidiaries for the purchase or sale of goods, products, parts and services entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(n) Investments by Affiliates in Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries (and/or such Affiliate’s exercise of any permitted rights with respect thereto), so long as non-Affiliates were also offered the opportunity to invest in such Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests, and transactions with Affiliates solely in their capacity as holders of Indebtedness or preferred Equity Interests of Holdings, the Borrowers or any of their Subsidiaries, so long as such transaction is with all holders of such class (and there are such non-Affiliate holders) and such Affiliates are treated no more favorably than all other holders of such class generally;

(o) reimbursement of reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses of the Sponsor by the Borrowers and any Restricted Subsidiaries incurred in connection with financial advisory, financing, underwriting or placement services or in respect of other investment banking activities (including in connection with acquisitions or divestitures, whether or not consummated) so long as such costs and expenses are approved by a majority of the members of the board of directors or a majority of the disinterested members of the board of directors, in each case, of the Borrowers in good faith;

(p) loans and other transactions among the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries (to the extent any such Subsidiary that is not a Restricted Subsidiary is only an Affiliate as a result of Investments by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries in such Subsidiary) to the extent otherwise permitted under this Article  VII ;

(q) the payment of reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses and indemnities pursuant to the stockholders agreement or the registration and participation rights agreement (or amendments to such agreements) entered into on or after the Closing Date in connection therewith or similar equity holder’s agreements or limited liability company agreements;

 

-128-


(r) transactions in which the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, as the case may be, deliver to the Administrative Agent a letter from an Independent Financial Advisor stating that such transaction is fair to the Borrowers or such Restricted Subsidiary from a financial point of view or meets the requirements of Section  7.08(b) ; and

(s) payments to or from, and other transactions with, a Joint Venture (to the extent any such Joint Venture is only an Affiliate as a result of Investments by the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries in such Joint Venture) in the ordinary course of business and to the extent otherwise permitted under Section  7.02 .

Section 7.09 Burdensome Agreements . Enter into or permit to exist any Contractual Obligation (other than this Agreement or any other Loan Document) that limits the ability of

(a) any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Guarantor to make Restricted Payments to the Borrowers or any Guarantor or to otherwise transfer property to or invest in the Borrowers or any Guarantor, except for:

(i) any agreement in effect on the Closing Date and described on Schedule  7.09 ;

(ii) any agreement in effect at the time any Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of the Borrowers or any agreement assumed in connection with the acquisition of assets from any Person, so long as such agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of a Borrower or the acquisition of assets from such Person;

(iii) any agreement representing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary of the Borrowers which is not a Loan Party which is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(iv) any agreement in connection with a Disposition permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 and relate solely to the assets of any Person subject to such Disposition;

(v) customary provisions in joint venture agreements or other similar agreements applicable to Joint Ventures permitted under Section  7.02 and applicable solely to the assets and Equity Interests of such Joint Venture entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(vi) customary provisions restricting assignment of any agreement; provided that if such agreement is not entered into in the ordinary course of business, the granting, perfection, validity and priority of the security interests of the Secured Parties is not impaired in any material respect by such restriction;

(vii) restrictions contained in any Permitted Surviving Debt documents (as amended, so long as such restrictions are not expanded in scope);

 

-129-


(viii) customary net worth provisions contained in real property leases entered into by the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business, so long as the Borrowers have determined in good faith that such net worth provisions would not reasonably be expected to impair the ability of the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries to meet their ongoing obligations;

(ix) any restrictions regarding licenses or sublicenses by the Borrowers and the other Restricted Subsidiaries of IP Rights in the ordinary course of business (in which case such restriction shall relate only to such IP Rights);

(x) restrictions contained in the First Lien Facility Documentation and the First Lien Facility Indebtedness;

(xi) customary restrictions contained in (A) any Permitted Ratio Debt (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof), (B) any Refinancing Notes (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof), (C) New Incremental Notes and (D) Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Sections 7.03(b)(i) , (ii) , (v) , (vi) , (xiii) , (xiv) , (xv) , (xviii)(a) , (xix ) and ( xx ) and, in each case, any Permitted Refinancing thereof; provided that with respect to Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Sections 7.03(b)(vi) , (xiii) , (xv) , (xix) and (xx) , solely to the extent applicable only to the Restricted Subsidiaries that are not Guarantors obligated with respect to such Indebtedness;

(xii) restrictions contained in Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Section  7.03(b)(xxvii) to the extent no more restrictive, taken as a whole, to the Borrowers and their Subsidiaries than the covenants contained in this Agreement;

(xiii) solely to the extent that such Indebtedness is expressly made non-recourse to the Borrowers and their Restricted Subsidiaries (other than otherwise permitted under this Agreement), restrictions contained in Indebtedness permitted pursuant to Section  7.03(b) and (xxx) ;

(xiv) restrictions imposed by reason of applicable Law; or

(b) the Borrowers or any Loan Party to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist Liens on property of such Person for the benefit of the Lenders with respect to the Facilities and the Obligations or under the Loan Documents except for:

(i) restrictions contained in the First Lien Facility Documentation and the First Lien Facility Indebtedness and any other agreement in effect on the Closing Date and described on Schedule 7.09 ;

(ii) any agreement in effect at any time any Restricted Subsidiary becomes a Subsidiary of a Borrower, or any agreement assumed in connection with the acquisition of assets from any Person, so long as such agreement was not entered into solely in contemplation of such Person becoming a Subsidiary of a Borrower or of the acquisition of assets from such Person;

(iii) any agreement representing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary of a Borrower which is not a Loan Party which is permitted by Section  7.03 ;

(iv) any agreement in connection with a Disposition permitted by Section  7.04 or 7.05 and relate solely to the assets of Person subject to such Disposition;

 

-130-


(v) customary provisions in joint venture agreements or other similar agreements applicable to Joint Ventures permitted under Section  7.02 and applicable solely to the assets and Equity Interests of such Joint Venture entered into in the ordinary course of business;

(vi) restrictions contained in any Permitted Surviving Debt documents (as amended, so long as such restrictions are not expanded in scope);

(vii) negative pledges and restrictions on Liens in favor of any holder of Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.03(b)(i) , (ii) , (v) , (vi) , (vii) , (xiii) , (xiv) , (xv) , (xix) , (xx) or (xxvii)  but, in each case solely to the extent such negative pledge and restrictions on Liens relate to the property financed by, or the subject of which is, such Indebtedness;

(viii) customary restrictions in leases, subleases, licenses or asset sale agreements otherwise permitted hereby so long as such restrictions relate to the assets subject thereto;

(ix) customary restrictions contained in any (A) Permitted Ratio Debt (solely to the extent any negative pledge relates to the property financed by or the subject of such Indebtedness), (B) Refinancing Notes (and any Permitted Refinancing thereof) and (C) New Incremental Notes; provided , in each case that such restrictions do not restrict the Liens securing the Obligations or the senior priority status thereof (it being understood that any such Indebtedness shall be permitted to be secured on a pari passu basis or junior with the Obligations to the extent permitted hereunder);

(x) restrictions arising in connection with cash or other deposits entered into in the ordinary course of business and restrictions on cash earnest money deposits in favor of sellers in connection with acquisitions not prohibited hereunder;

(xi) customary provisions restricting assignment of any agreement entered into in the ordinary course of business; and

(xii) restrictions imposed by applicable Law.

Section 7.10 [Reserved] .

Section 7.11 Accounting Changes . Make any change in fiscal year; provided , however , that the Borrowers may, upon written notice to the Administrative Agent, change its fiscal year to any other fiscal year reasonably acceptable to the Administrative Agent, in which case, the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent will, and are hereby authorized by the Lenders to, make any amendments to this Agreement that are necessary, in the judgment of the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers to reflect such change in fiscal year.

Section 7.12 Prepayments, Etc. of Indebtedness ; Amendments . (a) Prepay, redeem, purchase, defease or otherwise satisfy prior to the scheduled maturity thereof in any manner any Indebtedness that is expressly subordinated by contract in right of payment to the Obligations (other than intercompany Indebtedness so long as no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing) or any other Indebtedness that is secured by a junior priority security interest in the Collateral, including, without limitation, the Second Lien Facility (collectively, together with any Permitted Refinancing of the foregoing, “ Junior Financing ”) that has an aggregate principal amount in excess of

 

-131-


$24,000,000 (it being understood that payments of regularly scheduled principal, interest and AHYDO payments and, in connection with the amendment of any Junior Financing, the payment of fees (other than in connection with any amendment that reduces or forgives the commitments, outstanding principal amount or effective yield of such Junior Financing) shall be permitted), or make any payment in violation of any subordination terms of any Junior Financing Documentation, except (i) a prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction of Junior Financing made using the portion, if any, of the Cumulative Credit on the date of such election that the Borrowers elect to apply to this Section  7.12(a)(i) , and, upon the request of the Administrative Agent, such election to be specified in a written notice of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers calculating in reasonable detail the amount of Cumulative Credit immediately prior to such election and the amount thereof elected to be so applied; provided that (A) immediately before and immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such prepayment, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (B) immediately after giving Pro Forma Effect to such prepayment, the Borrowers could incur $1.00 of additional unsecured Permitted Ratio Debt, (ii) the conversion of any Junior Financing to Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) or the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction of Junior Financing with the proceeds of Permitted Equity Issuances (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary capital of a Borrower, in each case, that is Not Otherwise Applied, (iii) the refinancing of any Junior Financing with any Permitted Refinancing thereof; (iv) the prepayment, redemption, purchase, defeasement or other satisfaction prior to the scheduled maturity of any Junior Financing in an aggregate amount not to exceed the greater of $24,000,000 and 30% of Consolidated EBITDA (less the amount of any Restricted Payments made pursuant to Section  7.06(m) ), plus (y) the Net Cash Proceeds of any substantially concurrent Permitted Equity Issuance (other than Cure Amounts) or any direct contribution to the ordinary equity of Holdings plus (z) an unlimited amount so long as (A) no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom and (B) the Total Net Leverage Ratio (calculated on a Pro Forma Basis in accordance with Section  1.09 ) is less than or equal to 3.75 to 1.00, (b) amend, modify or change any term or condition of any Junior Financing Documentation (including by way of refinancing or otherwise replacing the Indebtedness thereunder), that has an aggregate principal amount in excess of $24,000,000 or any of its Organization Documents in any manner that is materially adverse to the interests of the Administrative Agent or the Lenders.

Section 7.13 Holding Company . Conduct, transact or otherwise engage in any material business or operations; provided that the following shall be permitted in any event: (i) Holdings’ ownership of the Equity Interests of the Borrowers, and any Subsidiary of Holdings (that is not a Borrower) which is formed solely for purposes of acting as a co-obligor with respect to any Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness and which does not conduct, transact or otherwise engage in any material business or operation, and, in each case, and activities incidental thereto; (ii) the entry into, and the performance of its obligations with respect to the Loan Documents (including any Specified Refinancing Debt or any New Facility), the First Lien Facility Documentation, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes, the Junior Financing Documentation, any Permitted Ratio Debt documentation, any documentation relating to any Permitted Refinancing of the foregoing or documentation relating to the Indebtedness otherwise permitted by the last sentence in this Section  7.13 and the Guarantees permitted by clause (iv) below; (iii) the consummation of the Transaction; (iv) performing of activities (including, without limitation, cash management activities) and the entry into documentation with respect thereto, in each case, permitted by this Agreement for Holdings to enter into and perform; (v) the payment of dividends and distributions (and other activities in lieu thereof permitted by this Agreement), the making of contributions to the capital of its Subsidiaries and Guarantees of Indebtedness and other obligations permitted to be incurred hereunder by the Borrowers or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries; (vi) the maintenance of its legal existence (including the ability to incur fees, costs and expenses relating to such maintenance and performance of activities relating to its officers, directors, managers and employees and those of its Subsidiaries); (vii) the performing of its obligations with respect to the Acquisition Agreement and the other agreements contemplated thereby and the performance of its obligations with respect

 

-132-


thereto; (viii) the performing of activities in preparation for and consummating any public offering of its common stock or any other issuance or sale of its Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interests) including converting into another type of legal entity; (ix) the participation in tax, accounting and other administrative matters as a member of any applicable consolidated group, including compliance with applicable Laws and legal, tax and accounting matters related thereto and activities relating to its officers, directors, managers and employees; (x) the holding of any cash and Cash Equivalents (but not operating any property); (xi) the entry into and performance of its obligations with respect to contracts and other arrangements, including the providing of indemnification to officers, managers, directors and employees; (xii) the performance of management and administrative services on behalf of, or for the benefit of, its Subsidiaries; and (xiii) any activities incidental to the foregoing. Holdings shall not create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien on any Equity Interests of the Borrowers (other than Liens pursuant to any Loan Document, the First Lien Facility Documentation, non-consensual Liens arising solely by operation of Law and Liens pursuant to documentation relating to other secured indebtedness permitted to be incurred hereunder) and shall not incur any Indebtedness (other than in respect of Indebtedness permitted under Section  7.02(n) , Disqualified Equity Interests, Qualified Holding Company Indebtedness, or Guarantees permitted by clauses (ii) and (v) above and liabilities imposed by Law, including Tax liabilities).

ARTICLE VIII

Events of Default and Remedies

Section 8.01 Events of Default . Any of the following shall constitute an “Event of Default”:

(a) Non-Payment . A Borrower or any other Loan Party fails to pay in the currency required hereunder (i) when due and as required to be paid herein, any amount of principal of any Loan, or (ii) within five Business Days after the same becomes due and payable, any interest on any Loan or any fee due hereunder, or any other amount payable hereunder or with respect to any other Loan Document; or

(b) Specific Covenants . A Borrower or any of the Subsidiary Guarantors fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in any of Section  6.03(a) , 6.05(a) (solely with respect to one or more of the Borrowers) or 6.11 or in any Section of Article VII , or Holdings fails to perform or observe any term, covenant or agreement contained in Section  7.13 ; or

(c) Other Defaults . Any Loan Party fails to perform or observe any covenant or agreement (other than those specified in Section  8.01(a) or (b)  above) contained in any Loan Document on its part to be performed or observed and such failure continues for 30 days after notice thereof by the Administrative Agent to the Borrower Representative; or

(d) Representations and Warranties . Any representation, warranty, certification or statement of fact made or deemed made by or on behalf of a Borrower or any other Loan Party herein, in any other Loan Document, or in any document required to be delivered in connection herewith or therewith shall be incorrect or misleading in any material respect (or in any respect if any such representation or warranty is already qualified by materiality) when made or deemed made; or

(e) Cross-Default . (i) Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (A) fails to make any payment beyond the applicable grace period with respect thereto, if any (whether by scheduled maturity, required prepayment, acceleration, demand, or otherwise) in respect of any

 

-133-


Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness hereunder and intercompany Indebtedness) having an aggregate outstanding principal amount of more than $24,000,000 or (B) fails to observe or perform any other agreement or condition relating to any such Indebtedness, or any other event occurs, the effect of which default or other event is to cause, or to permit the holder or holders of such Indebtedness (or a trustee or agent on behalf of such holder or holders or beneficiary or beneficiaries) after the expiration of any applicable grace or cure period therefor to cause, with the giving of notice if required, such Indebtedness to become due or to be repurchased, prepaid, defeased or redeemed (automatically or otherwise), or an offer to repurchase, prepay, defease or redeem such Indebtedness to be made, in each case, prior to its stated maturity; provided that this clause (e)(B) shall not apply to (x) secured Indebtedness that becomes due as a result of the sale or transfer or other Disposition (including a Casualty Event) of the property or assets securing such Indebtedness permitted hereunder and under the documents providing for such Indebtedness and such Indebtedness is repaid when required under the documents providing for such Indebtedness (y) events of default, termination events or any other similar event under the documents governing Swap Contracts for so long as such event of default, termination event or other similar event does not result in the occurrence of an early termination date or any acceleration or prepayment of any amounts or other Indebtedness payable thereunder or (z) Indebtedness that upon the happening of any such default or event automatically converts into Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Equity Interest or, in the case of the Borrowers or a Restricted Subsidiary, Disqualified Equity Interest or preferred stock) in accordance with its terms; provided , further , that such failure is unremedied and is not validly waived by the holders of such Indebtedness in accordance with the terms of the documents governing such Indebtedness prior to any acceleration of the Loans pursuant to Section  8.02 ; provided , further , that with respect to the First Lien Facility or any other senior lien indebtedness permitted to be incurred hereunder in accordance with and as required by any similar provision of the First Lien Credit Agreement, in each case, that is secured by a Lien on the Collateral on a senior basis to the Obligations, such failure shall constitute an Event of Default hereunder only if the holders of such Indebtedness have caused the same to become due and payable prior to the scheduled maturity date or if such Indebtedness is not paid at final maturity; or

(f) Insolvency Proceedings, Etc . Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than Immaterial Subsidiaries) institutes or consents to the institution of any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law, a winding-up, an administration, a dissolution, or a composition or makes an assignment for the benefit of creditors or any other action is commenced (by way of voluntary arrangement, scheme of arrangement or otherwise); or appoints, applies for or consents to the appointment of any receiver, administrator, administrative receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator, judicial manager, provisional liquidator, administrator, receiver and manager, controller, monitor or similar officer for it or for all or any material part of its property; or any receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator, liquidator, rehabilitator, judicial manager, provisional liquidator, administrator, administrative receiver, receiver and manager, controller, monitor or similar officer is appointed without the application or consent of such Person and the appointment continues undischarged or unstayed for 60 days or any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law relating to any such Person or to all or substantially all of its property is instituted without the consent of such Person and continues undismissed or unstayed for 60 days, or an order for relief is entered in any such proceeding; or

(g) Inability to Pay Debts ; Attachment . (i) Any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than any Immaterial Subsidiary) becomes unable or admits in writing its inability or fails generally to pay its debts as they become due or suspends making payments or enters into a moratorium or standstill arrangement in relation to its Indebtedness or is taken to have failed to comply with a statutory demand (or otherwise be presumed to be insolvent by

 

-134-


applicable Law) or (ii) any writ or warrant of attachment or execution or similar process is issued, commenced or levied against all or substantially all of the property of any such Person and is not released, vacated or fully bonded within 60 days after its issue, commencement or levy, or any analogous procedure or step is taken in any jurisdiction); or

(h) Judgments . There is entered against any Loan Party or any Restricted Subsidiary a final judgment or order for the payment of money in an aggregate amount (as to all such judgments and orders) exceeding $24,000,000 (to the extent not paid and not covered by (i) independent third-party insurance as to which the insurer has been notified of such judgment or order and does not deny coverage or (ii) an enforceable indemnity to the extent that such Loan Party or Restricted Subsidiary shall have made a claim for indemnification and the applicable indemnifying party shall not have disputed such claim) and there is a period of 60 consecutive days during which a stay of enforcement of such judgment, by reason of a pending appeal or otherwise, is not in effect; or

(i) ERISA . One or more ERISA Events occur or there is or arises an Unfunded Pension Liability (taking into account only Plans with positive Unfunded Pension Liability) which ERISA Event or Events or Unfunded Pension Liability or Liabilities results or would reasonably be expected to result in liability of any Loan Party in an aggregate amount (determined as of the date of occurrence of such ERISA Event) which would reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect; or

(j) Invalidity of Loan Documents . Any material provision of any Collateral Document, any Guaranty, the Intercreditor Agreement and/or the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, or any intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, at any time after its execution and delivery and for any reason other than as expressly permitted hereunder or thereunder (including as a result of a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05) or satisfaction in full of all the Obligations (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) ceases to be in full force and effect (except that any such failure to be in full force and effect with respect to the documents referred to in clause (viii) of the definition of “Loan Documents” shall constitute an Event of Default only if the Borrower Representative receives notice thereof and the Borrowers fail to remedy the relevant failure in all material respects within ten Business Days of receiving said notice); or any Loan Party contests in writing the validity or enforceability of any provision of any Collateral Document, any Guaranty, the Intercompany Subordination Agreement, the Intercreditor Agreement or any other intercreditor agreement required to be entered into pursuant to the terms of this Agreement; or any Loan Party denies in writing that it has any or further liability or obligation under any Loan Document (other than as a result of repayment in full of the Obligations (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) and termination of the Aggregate Commitments), or purports in writing to revoke or rescind any Loan Document or the perfected second priority Liens created thereby (except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement or the Collateral Documents); or

(k) Change of Control . There occurs any Change of Control.

Section 8.02 Remedies upon Event of Default . If any Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Administrative Agent shall, at the request of, or may, with the consent of, the Required Lenders take any or all of the following actions:

(a) declare the commitment of each Lender to make Loans to be terminated, whereupon such commitments and obligation shall be terminated;

 

-135-


(b) declare the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans, all interest accrued and unpaid thereon, and all other amounts owing or payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document to be immediately due and payable, without presentment, demand, protest or other notice of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Borrowers;

(c) [Reserved]; and

(d) exercise on behalf of itself and the Lenders all rights and remedies available to it and the Lenders under the Loan Documents, under any document evidencing Indebtedness in respect of which the Facility has been designated as “Designated Senior Debt” (or any comparable term) and/or under applicable Law;

provided , however , that upon the occurrence of an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to any Loan Party under any Debtor Relief Law, the obligation of each Lender to make Loans shall automatically terminate, the unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Loans and all interest and other amounts as aforesaid shall automatically become due and payable, in each case without further act of the Administrative Agent or any Lender.

Section 8.03 [Reserved] .

Section 8.04 Application of Funds . After the exercise of remedies provided for in Section  8.02 (or after an actual or deemed entry of an order for relief with respect to one or more of the Borrowers under any Debtor Relief Law), any amounts received on account of the Obligations shall, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, the provisions of Section  2.17 be applied by the Administrative Agent in the following order:

(a) first , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities, expenses and other amounts (including fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel payable under Section  10.04 and amounts payable under Article III and amounts owing in respect of (x) the preservation of Collateral or the Collateral Agent’s security interest in the Collateral or (y) with respect to enforcing the rights of the Secured Parties under the Loan Documents) payable to the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent in their respective capacity as such;

(b) second , to payment in full of Unfunded Advances/Participations;

(c) third , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting fees, indemnities, expenses and other amounts (other than principal and interest) payable to the Lenders (including fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel payable under Sections 10.04 and 10.05 ) arising under the Loan Documents and amounts payable under Article III , ratably among them in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (c) held by them;

(d) fourth , to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting accrued and unpaid interest on the Loans, ratably among the Lenders in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (d) held by them;

(e) fifth , (i) to payment of that portion of the Obligations constituting unpaid principal of the Loans, ratably among the Lenders in proportion to the respective amounts described in this clause (e) held by them;

(f) sixth , to the payment of all other Obligations of the Loan Parties owing under or in respect of the Loan Documents that are then due and payable to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties, ratably based upon the respective aggregate amounts of all such Obligations then owing to the Administrative Agent and the other Secured Parties; and

 

-136-


(g) last , after all of the Obligations have been paid in full (other than contingent indemnification obligations not yet due and owing), to the Borrowers or as otherwise required by Law or the Intercreditor Agreement.

It is understood and agreed by each Loan Party and each Secured Party that the Administrative Agent and Collateral Agent shall have no liability for any determinations made by it in this Section  8.04 , in each case except to the extent resulting from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent, as applicable (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable decision). Each Loan Party and each Secured Party also agrees that the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent may (but shall not be required to), at any time and in its sole discretion, and with no liability resulting therefrom, petition a court of competent jurisdiction regarding any application of Collateral in accordance with the requirements hereof, and the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent shall be entitled to wait for, and may conclusively rely on, any such determination.

ARTICLE IX

Administrative Agent and Other Agents

Section 9.01 Appointment and Authorization of Agents .

(a) Each Lender hereby irrevocably appoints Royal Bank to act on its behalf as Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, and designates and authorizes the Administrative Agent to take such actions on its behalf under the provisions of this Agreement and each other Loan Document and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to the Administrative Agent by the terms of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, together with such actions and powers as are reasonably incidental thereto. Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary contained elsewhere herein or in any other Loan Document no Agent shall have any duties or responsibilities, except those expressly set forth herein, nor shall any Agent have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with any Lender or participant, and no implied covenants, functions, responsibilities, duties, obligations or liabilities shall be read into this Agreement or any other Loan Document or otherwise exist against any Agent. Regardless of whether a Default has occurred and is continuing and without limiting the generality of the foregoing sentence, the use of the term “agent” herein and in the other Loan Documents with reference to any Agent is not intended to connote any fiduciary or other implied (or express) obligations arising under agency doctrine of any applicable Law. Instead, such term is used merely as a matter of market custom, and is intended to create or reflect only an administrative relationship between independent contracting parties.

(b) [Reserved].

(c) The Administrative Agent shall also act as the Collateral Agent under the Loan Documents, and each of the Secured Parties hereby irrevocably appoints and authorizes the Administrative Agent to act as the agent of (and in its capacity as Collateral Agent to hold the benefit of any security interest created by the Collateral Documents and/or any asset and proceeds of any asset paid to, held by or received or recovered by it under or in connection with the Loan Documents on trust for itself and the other Secured Parties according to its and their respective interests and upon the terms and conditions set out in the relevant Loan Documents) such Secured Party for purposes of acquiring, holding and enforcing any and all Liens on Collateral granted by any of the Loan Parties to secure any of the Secured Obligations, together with such powers and discretion as are reasonably incidental thereto. In

 

-137-


this connection, the Administrative Agent as Collateral Agent (and any co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact appointed by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  9.02 for purposes of holding or enforcing any Lien on the Collateral (or any portion thereof) granted under the Collateral Documents, or for exercising any rights and remedies thereunder at the direction of the Administrative Agent), shall be entitled to the benefits of all provisions of this Article IX (including Section  9.07 , as though such co-agents, sub-agents and attorneys-in-fact were the Collateral Agent under the Loan Documents) and Section  10.04 as if set forth in full herein with respect thereto and all references to Administrative Agent in this Article IX shall, where applicable, be read as including a reference to the Collateral Agent. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Lenders hereby expressly authorize the Administrative Agent as Collateral Agent to execute any and all documents (including releases) with respect to the Collateral and the rights of the Secured Parties with respect thereto, as contemplated by and in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement and the Collateral Documents and acknowledge and agree that any such action by any Agent shall bind the Secured Parties.

Section 9.02 Delegation of Duties . The Administrative Agent may execute any of its duties and exercise its rights and powers under this Agreement or any other Loan Document (including for purposes of holding or enforcing any Lien on the Collateral (or any portion thereof) granted under the Collateral Documents or of exercising any rights and remedies thereunder) by or through agents, employees or attorneys-in-fact and shall be entitled to advice of counsel and other consultants or experts concerning all matters pertaining to such duties. The Administrative Agent and any such sub agent may perform any and all of its duties and exercise its rights and powers by or through their respective Agent-Related Persons. The Administrative Agent shall not be responsible for the negligence or misconduct of any agent or attorney-in-fact that it selects in the absence of gross negligence or willful misconduct by the Administrative Agent, as determined by a final non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction. The exculpatory provisions of this Article IX shall apply to any such sub agent and to the Agent-Related Persons of the Administrative Agent and any such sub agent, and shall apply to their respective activities in connection with the syndication of the credit facilities provided for herein as well as activities as Administrative Agent.

Section 9.03 Liability of Agents .

(a) No Agent-Related Person shall be (i) liable for any action taken or omitted to be taken by any of them under or in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan Document or the transactions contemplated hereby (except for its own gross negligence or willful misconduct in connection with its duties expressly set forth herein, to the extent determined in a final, non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction), (ii) liable for any action taken or not taken by it (A) with the consent or at the request of the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be necessary, or as the Administrative Agent shall believe in good faith shall be necessary, under the circumstances as provided in Sections 10.01 and 8.02 ) or (B) in the absence of its own gross negligence or willful misconduct as determined by the final, non-appealable judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction, in connection with its duties expressly set forth herein, (iii) responsible in any manner to any Lender or participant for any recital, statement, representation or warranty made by any Loan Party or any officer thereof, contained herein or in any other Loan Document, or in any certificate, report, statement or other document referred to or provided for in, or received by the Administrative Agent under or in connection with, this Agreement or any other Loan Document, (iv) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the validity, effectiveness, genuineness, enforceability or sufficiency of this Agreement or any other Loan Document or any other agreement, instrument or document, or the creation, perfection or priority of any Lien, or security interest created or purported to be created under the Collateral Documents, or for any failure of any Loan Party or any other party to any Loan Document to perform its obligations hereunder, (v) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the value or the sufficiency of any Collateral or (vi) responsible for or have any duty to ascertain or inquire into the

 

-138-


satisfaction of any condition set forth in Article IV or elsewhere herein, other than to confirm receipt of items expressly required to be delivered to the Administrative Agent. No Agent-Related Person shall be under any obligation to any Lender or participant to ascertain or to inquire as to the observance or performance of any of the agreements contained in, or conditions of, this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or to inspect the properties, books or records of any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof.

(b) The Administrative Agent shall not have any duty to (i) take any discretionary action or exercise any discretionary powers, except discretionary rights and powers expressly contemplated hereby or by the other Loan Documents that such Agent is required to exercise as directed in writing by the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be expressly provided for herein or in the other Loan Documents); provided that no Agent shall be required to take any action that, in its opinion or the opinion of its counsel, may expose such Agent to liability or that is contrary to any Loan Document or applicable Law; and (ii) to disclose, except as expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents, and shall not be liable for the failure to disclose, any information relating to the Borrowers or any of their Affiliates that is communicated to or obtained by any Person serving as an Agent or any of its Affiliates in any capacity.

(c) Any assignor of a Loan or seller of a participation hereunder shall be entitled to rely conclusively on a representation of the assignee Lender or Participant in the relevant Assignment and Assumption or participation agreement, as applicable, that such assignee or purchaser is not a Disqualified Institution. No Agent shall have any responsibility or liability for monitoring the list or identities of, or enforcing provisions relating to, Disqualified Institutions.

Section 9.04 Reliance by Agents .

(a) Each Agent shall be entitled to rely, and shall be fully protected in relying, upon any writing, communication, signature, resolution, representation, notice, request, consent, certificate, instrument, affidavit, letter, telegram, facsimile, telex or telephone message, electronic mail message, Internet or intranet website posting or other distribution statement or other document or conversation believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed, sent or made by the proper Person or Persons. Each Agent also may rely upon any statement made to it orally or by telephone and believed by it to have been made by the proper Person, and shall not incur any liability for relying thereon. In determining compliance with any condition hereunder to the making of a Loan that by its terms must be fulfilled to the satisfaction of a Lender, the Administrative Agent may presume that such condition is satisfactory to such Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice to the contrary from such Lender prior to the making of such Loan. Each Agent may consult with, and rely upon (and be fully protected in relying upon), advice and statements of legal counsel (including counsel to any Loan Party), independent accountants and other experts selected by such Agent. Each Agent shall be fully justified in failing or refusing to take any action under any Loan Document unless it shall first receive such advice or concurrence of the Required Lenders (or such greater number of Lenders as may be expressly required hereby in any instance) as it deems appropriate and, if it so requests, it shall first be indemnified to its satisfaction by the Lenders against any and all liability and expense that may be incurred by it by reason of taking or continuing to take any such action. Each Agent shall in all cases be fully protected in acting, or in refraining from acting, under this Agreement or any other Loan Document in accordance with a request or consent of the Required Lenders (or such greater number of Lenders as may be expressly required hereby in any instance) and such request and any action taken or failure to act pursuant thereto shall be binding upon all the Lenders.

(b) For purposes of determining compliance with the conditions specified in Sections 4.01 , each Lender that has signed this Agreement shall be deemed to have consented to, approved or accepted or to be satisfied with, each document or other matter required thereunder to be consented to or approved by or acceptable or satisfactory to a Lender unless the Administrative Agent shall have received notice from such Lender prior to the proposed Closing Date, specifying its objection thereto.

 

-139-


Section 9.05 Notice of Default . The Administrative Agent shall not be deemed to have knowledge or notice of the occurrence of any Default, except with respect to defaults in the payment of principal, interest and fees required to be paid to the Administrative Agent for the account of the Lenders, unless the Administrative Agent shall have received written notice from a Lender or the Borrowers referring to this Agreement, describing such Default and stating that such notice is a “notice of default.” The Administrative Agent will notify the Lenders of its receipt of any such notice. The Administrative Agent shall take such action with respect to any Event of Default as may be directed by the Required Lenders in accordance with Article VIII ; provided , however , that unless and until the Administrative Agent has received any such direction, the Administrative Agent may (but shall not be obligated to) take such action, or refrain from taking such action, with respect to such Event of Default as it shall deem advisable or in the best interest of the Lenders.

Section 9.06 Credit Decision ; Disclosure of Information by Agents . Each Lender acknowledges that no Agent-Related Person has made any representation or warranty to it, and that no act by any Agent hereafter taken, including any consent to and acceptance of any assignment or review of the affairs of any Loan Party or any Affiliate thereof, shall be deemed to constitute any representation or warranty by any Agent-Related Person to any Lender as to any matter, including whether Agent-Related Persons have disclosed material information in their possession. Each Lender represents to each Agent that it has, independently and without reliance upon any Agent-Related Person and based on such documents and information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own appraisal of, and investigation into, the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition and creditworthiness of the Loan Parties and their respective Subsidiaries, and all applicable bank or other regulatory Laws relating to the transactions contemplated hereby, and made its own decision to enter into this Agreement and to extend credit to the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties hereunder. Each Lender also represents that it will, independently and without reliance upon any Agent-Related Person and based on such documents and information as it shall deem appropriate at the time, continue to make its own credit analysis, appraisals and decisions in taking or not taking action under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and to make such investigations as it deems necessary to inform itself as to the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition and creditworthiness of the Borrowers and the other Loan Parties. Except for notices, reports and other documents expressly required to be furnished to the Lenders by any Agent herein, such Agent shall not have any duty or responsibility to provide any Lender with any credit or other information concerning the business, prospects, operations, property, financial and other condition or creditworthiness of any of the Loan Parties or any of their respective Affiliates which may come into the possession of any Agent-Related Person.

Section 9.07 Indemnification of Agents . Whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby are consummated, each Lender shall, on a ratable basis based on such Lender’s Pro Rata Share of all the Facility, indemnify upon demand each Agent-Related Person (to the extent not reimbursed by or on behalf of any Loan Party and without limiting the obligation of any Loan Party to do so), and hold harmless each Agent-Related Person in each case from and against any and all Indemnified Liabilities incurred by such Agent-Related Person; provided , however , that no Lender shall be liable for any Indemnified Liabilities incurred by an Agent-Related Person to the extent such Indemnified Liabilities are determined in a final, non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction to have resulted from such Agent-Related Person’s own gross negligence or willful misconduct; provided , however , that no action taken in accordance with the directions of the Required Lenders (or such other number or percentage of the Lenders as shall be required by the Loan Documents) shall be deemed to constitute gross negligence or willful misconduct for purposes of this Section  9.07 . In the case of any investigation, litigation or proceeding giving rise to any Indemnified Liabilities, this Section  9.07 shall apply whether or

 

-140-


not any such investigation, litigation or proceeding is brought by any Lender or any other Person. Without limiting the foregoing, each Lender shall reimburse the Administrative Agent upon demand for its Pro Rata Share of any costs or out-of-pocket expenses (including the fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel) incurred by the Administrative Agent in connection with the preparation, execution, delivery, administration, modification, amendment or enforcement (whether through negotiations, legal proceedings or otherwise) of, or legal advice in respect of rights or responsibilities under, this Agreement, any other Loan Document, or any document contemplated by or referred to herein, to the extent that the Administrative Agent is not reimbursed for such expenses by or on behalf of the Borrowers; provided that such reimbursement by the Lenders shall not affect the Borrowers’ continuing reimbursement obligations with respect thereto; provided , further , that failure of any Lender to indemnify or reimburse the Administrative Agent shall not relieve any other Lender of its obligation in respect thereof. The undertaking in this Section  9.07 shall survive termination of the Aggregate Commitments, the payment of all other Obligations and the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent.

Section 9.08 Agents in Their Individual Capacities . Any Agent and its Affiliates may make loans to, issue letters of credit for the account of, accept deposits from, acquire Equity Interests in and generally engage in any kind of banking, trust, financial advisory, underwriting or other business with each of the Loan Parties and their respective Affiliates as though it were not an Agent hereunder and without notice to or consent of the Lenders. The Lenders acknowledge that, pursuant to such activities, an Agent or its Affiliates may receive information regarding any Loan Party or its Affiliates (including information that may be subject to confidentiality obligations in favor of such Loan Party or such Affiliate) and acknowledge that such Agent shall be under no obligation to provide such information to them. With respect to its Loans, such Agent shall have the same rights and powers under this Agreement as any other Lender and may exercise such rights and powers as though it were not an Agent, and the terms “Lender” and “Lenders” include such Agent in its individual capacity (unless otherwise expressly indicated or unless the context otherwise requires).

Section 9.09 Successor Agents .

The Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent may resign as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, upon 30 days’ written notice to the Borrowers and the Lenders. If the Administrative Agent or a Controlling Affiliate of the Administrative Agent is subject to an Agent-Related Distress Event, the Borrowers may remove the Administrative Agent from such role upon ten (10) days’ written notice to the Lenders. Upon receipt of any such notice of resignation or removal, the Required Lenders shall appoint from among the Lenders a successor agent for the Lenders, which successor agent shall be consented to by the Borrowers at all times other than during the existence of an Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) , or (g) (which consent of the Borrowers shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed). If no successor agent is appointed prior to the effective date of the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, may appoint, after consulting with the Lenders and the Borrowers, a successor agent from among the Lenders, which shall not be incorporated or acting through an office situated in a Non-Cooperative Jurisdiction. Upon the acceptance of its appointment as successor agent hereunder, the Person acting as such successor agent shall succeed to all the rights, powers and duties of the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, and the term “Administrative Agent” or “Collateral Agent,” as applicable, shall mean such successor administrative agent or such successor collateral agent, as applicable, and the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s appointment, powers and duties as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be terminated. After the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s resignation or removal hereunder as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, the provisions of this Article  IX and Sections 10.04 and 10.05 shall continue in effect for its benefit as to any actions taken or omitted to be taken by it while it was the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under this Agreement.

 

-141-


If no successor agent has accepted appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent by the date which is 30 days following the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s removal or notice of resignation, the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s resignation or removal shall nevertheless thereupon become effective and (i) the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder and under the other Loan Documents (except that in the case of any collateral security held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent on behalf of the Lenders under any of the Loan Documents, the retiring Agent shall continue to hold such collateral security as bailee, trustee or other applicable capacity until such time as a successor of such Agent is appointed), (ii) all payments, communications and determinations provided to or be made by, to or through the Administrative Agent shall instead be made by or to each Lender directly, until such time as the Required Lenders appoint a successor Administrative Agent as provided for above in this Section  9.09 and (iii) the Lenders shall perform all of the duties of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, hereunder until such time, if any, as the Required Lenders appoint a successor agent as provided for above. Upon the acceptance of any appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder by a successor and upon the execution and filing or recording of such financing statements, or amendments thereto, and such amendments or supplements to the Mortgages, and such other instruments or notices, as may be necessary or desirable, or as the Required Lenders may request, in order to continue the perfection of the Liens granted or purported to be granted by the Collateral Documents, the successor Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall thereupon succeed to and become vested with all the rights, powers, discretion, privileges, and duties of the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent. Upon the acceptance of any appointment as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder by a successor or upon the expiration of the 30-day period following the retiring Administrative Agent’s or Collateral Agent’s removal or notice of resignation without a successor agent having been appointed, the retiring Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder and under the other Loan Documents but the provisions of this Article IX and Sections 10.04 and 10.05 shall continue in effect for the benefit of such retiring Agent, its sub-agents and their respective Agent-Related Persons in respect of any actions taken or omitted to be taken by any of them solely in respect of the Loan Documents or Obligations, as applicable, while the retiring Agent was acting as Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable. At any time the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent is a Defaulting Lender pursuant to clause (d) of the definition thereof, the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent may be removed as the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent hereunder at the request of the Borrowers and the Required Lenders.

Section 9.10 Administrative Agent May File Proofs of Claim . In case of the pendency of any receivership, administrative receivership, judicial management, insolvency, liquidation, bankruptcy, reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), arrangement, adjustment, composition or other judicial proceeding relative to any Loan Party, the Administrative Agent (irrespective of whether the principal of any Loan shall then be due and payable as herein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and irrespective of whether the Administrative Agent shall have made any demand on the Borrowers) shall be entitled and empowered, by intervention in such proceeding or otherwise:

(a) to file and prove a claim for the whole amount of the principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the Loans and all other Obligations that are owing and unpaid and to file such other documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Lenders and the Administrative Agent (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Lenders and the Administrative Agent and their respective agents and counsel and all other amounts due the Lenders and the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.09 and 10.04 ) allowed in such judicial proceeding; and

 

-142-


(b) to collect and receive any monies or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute the same;

and any administrator, administrative receiver, custodian, receiver, assignee, trustee, judicial manager, liquidator, sequestrator or other similar official in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Lender to make such payments to the Administrative Agent and, in the event that the Administrative Agent shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Lenders, to pay to the Administrative Agent any amount due for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Agents and their respective agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Administrative Agent under Sections 2.09 and 10.04 .

Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to authorize the Administrative Agent to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Lender any plan of reorganization (by way of voluntary arrangement, schemes of arrangement or otherwise), arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Obligations or the rights of any Lender or to authorize the Administrative Agent to vote in respect of the claim of any Lender in any such proceeding.

Section 9.11 Collateral and Guaranty Matters . Each of the Lenders irrevocably authorizes the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent, and each of the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent shall to the extent requested by the Borrowers or, solely in the case of clause (d) below, to the extent provided for under this Agreement,

(a) release any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under any Loan Document (i) upon termination of the Aggregate Commitments and payment in full of all Obligations (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted), (ii) that is sold, disposed of or distributed or to be sold, disposed of or distributed as part of or in connection with any transaction permitted hereunder or under any other Loan Document, in each case to a Person that is not a Loan Party, (iii) subject to Section  10.01 , if approved, authorized or ratified in writing by the Required Lenders, (iv) that constitutes Excluded Property as a result of an occurrence not prohibited hereunder or (v) owned by a Subsidiary Guarantor upon release of such Subsidiary Guarantor from its obligations under its Guaranty pursuant to clause (c) below;

(b) release or subordinate any Lien on any property granted to or held by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent under any Loan Document to the holder of any Lien on such property that is permitted by Section  7.01(e) (other than with respect to self-insurance arrangements), (f) , (i) , (m) , (p)(A) , (s) , (u) , (w) , (z) , (aa) , (bb) , (dd) , (ee) , (hh) , (kk) and (pp) ;

(c) release any Guarantor from its obligations under the applicable Guaranty if in the case of any Subsidiary, such Person ceases to be a Restricted Subsidiary or otherwise becomes an Excluded Subsidiary as a result of a transaction or designation permitted hereunder; provided that no such release shall occur if such Guarantor continues to be a guarantor in respect of the First Lien Facility Indebtedness, any Specified Refinancing Debt, any Refinancing Notes, any New Incremental Notes and, to the extent incurred by a Loan Party, any Permitted Ratio Debt of any Loan Party or any Permitted Refinancing of any of the foregoing (or successive Permitted Refinancings thereof), in each case, with an aggregate outstanding principal amount in excess of the Threshold Amount; and

(d) to enter into the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor arrangements as contemplated by this Agreement, including pursuant to Section  7.01(a)(ii) and to release any Lien on any property to the extent required by the terms thereby and comply with all other applicable provisions thereunder.

 

-143-


Upon request by the Administrative Agent at any time, the Required Lenders will confirm in writing the Collateral Agent’s authority to release or subordinate its interest in particular types or items of property, or to release any Guarantor from its obligations under the Guaranty pursuant to this Section  9.11 . In each case as specified in this Section  9.11 , the applicable Agent will (and each Lender irrevocably authorizes the applicable Agent to), at the Borrowers’ expense, execute and deliver to the applicable Loan Party such documents as such Loan Party may reasonably request to evidence the release or subordination of such item of Collateral from the assignment and security interest granted under the Collateral Documents, or to evidence the release of such Guarantor from its obligations under the Guaranty, in each case in accordance with the terms of the Loan Documents and this Section  9.11 ; provided that the Borrowers shall have delivered to the Administrative Agent a certificate of a Responsible Officer of the Borrowers certifying that any such transaction has been consummated in compliance with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 9.12 Certain Rights of the Administrative Agent . If the Administrative Agent requests instructions from the Required Lenders with respect to any act or action (including failure to act) in connection with this Agreement or any other Loan Document, the Administrative Agent shall be entitled to refrain from such act or taking such action unless and until the Administrative Agent shall have received instructions from the Required Lenders; and the Administrative Agent shall not incur liability to any Lender by reason of so refraining. Without limiting the foregoing, neither any Lender nor the holder of any Note shall have any right of action whatsoever against the Administrative Agent as a result of the Administrative Agent acting or refraining from acting hereunder or under any other Loan Document in accordance with the instructions of the Required Lenders.

Section 9.13 Holders . The Administrative Agent may deem and treat the payee of any Note as the owner thereof for all purposes hereof unless and until a written notice of the assignment, transfer or endorsement thereof, as the case may be, shall have been filed with the Administrative Agent and recorded in the Register in accordance with Section  10.07(c) . Any request, authority or consent of any Person who, at the time of making such request or giving such authority or consent, is the holder of any Note shall be conclusive and binding on any subsequent holder, transferee, assignee or endorsee, as the case may be, of such Note or of any Note or Notes issued in exchange therefor.

Section 9.14 Other Agents; Arranger and Managers . None of the Lenders or other Persons identified on the facing page or signature pages of this Agreement as a “syndication agent,” “co-documentation agent,” “joint lead arranger,” “joint bookrunner” or “co-manager” shall have any right, power, obligation, liability, responsibility or duty under this Agreement other than those applicable to all Lenders as such. Without limiting the foregoing, none of the Lenders or other Persons so identified shall have or be deemed to have any fiduciary relationship with any Lender. Each Lender acknowledges that it has not relied, and will not rely, on any of the Lenders or other Persons so identified in deciding to enter into this Agreement or in taking or not taking action hereunder.

Section 9.15 [Reserved] .

Section 9.16 Appointment of Supplemental Agents .

(a) It is the purpose of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents that there shall be no violation of any Law of any jurisdiction denying or restricting the right of banking corporations or associations to transact business as agent or trustee in such jurisdiction. It is recognized that in case of litigation under this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents, and in particular in case of the

 

-144-


enforcement of any of the Loan Documents, or in case the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent deems that by reason of any present or future Law of any jurisdiction it may not exercise any of the rights, powers or remedies granted herein or in any of the other Loan Documents or take any other action that may be desirable or necessary in connection therewith, the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent are hereby authorized to appoint an additional individual or institution selected by them in their sole discretion as a separate trustee, co-trustee, administrative agent, collateral agent, administrative sub-agent or administrative co-agent, as applicable (any such additional individual or institution being referred to herein individually as a “ Supplemental Agent ” and collectively as “ Supplemental Agents ”).

(b) In the event that the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent appoints a Supplemental Agent with respect to any Collateral, (i) each and every right, power, privilege or duty expressed or intended by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents to be exercised by or vested in or conveyed to the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent with respect to such Collateral shall be exercisable by and vest in such Supplemental Agent to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to enable such Supplemental Agent to exercise such rights, powers and privileges with respect to such Collateral and to perform such duties with respect to such Collateral, and every covenant and obligation contained in the Loan Documents and necessary to the exercise or performance thereof by such Supplemental Agent shall run to and be enforceable by either the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent or such Supplemental Agent, and (ii) the provisions of this Article IX and of Sections 10.04 and 10.05 (obligating the Borrowers to pay the Administrative Agent’s and the Collateral Agent’s expenses and to indemnify the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent) that refer to the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent shall inure to the benefit of such Supplemental Agent and all references therein to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent shall be deemed to be references to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent and/or such Supplemental Agent, as the context may require.

(c) Should any instrument in writing from a Borrower, Holdings or any other Loan Party be required by any Supplemental Agent so appointed by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent for more fully and certainly vesting in and confirming to him or it such rights, powers, privileges and duties, the Borrowers or Holdings, as applicable, shall, or shall cause such Loan Party to, execute, acknowledge and deliver any and all such instruments promptly upon request by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent. In case any Supplemental Agent, or a successor thereto, shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all the rights, powers, privileges and duties of such Supplemental Agent, to the extent permitted by Law, shall vest in and be exercised by the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent, as applicable, until the appointment of a new Supplemental Agent.

Section 9.17 Intercreditor Agreement . The Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent are authorized by the Lenders and other Secured Parties to, to the extent required by the terms of the Loan Documents, enter into (i) the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement, (ii) any Collateral Document, (iii) or make or consent to any filings or take any other actions in connection therewith (and any amendments, amendments and restatements, restatements or waivers of or supplements to or other modifications to, such agreements in connection with the incurrence by any Loan Party of any Indebtedness of such Loan Party that is permitted to be secured pursuant to Sections  7.01 and 7.03 of this Agreement, in order to permit such Indebtedness to be secured by a valid, perfected lien on the Collateral (with such priority as may be designated by such Loan Party, to the extent such priority is permitted by the Loan Documents)), and the parties hereto acknowledge that any intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement, Collateral Document, consent, filing or other action will be binding upon them. Each Lender and each other Secured Party (a) understands, acknowledges and agrees that Liens will be created on the Collateral pursuant to the First Lien Facility Documentation, which Liens shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Intercreditor Agreement hereby agrees that it will be bound by and will take no actions contrary to the provisions of any

 

-145-


intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement (if entered into) and (b) hereby authorizes and instructs the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent to enter into the Intercreditor Agreement and any other intercreditor agreement contemplated by this Agreement or Collateral Document (and any amendments, amendments and restatements, restatements or waivers of or supplements to or other modifications to, such agreements in connection with the incurrence by any Loan Party of any Indebtedness of such Loan Party that is permitted to be secured pursuant to Sections  7.01 and 7.03 of this Agreement, in order to permit such Indebtedness to be secured by a valid, perfected lien on the Collateral (with such priority as may be designated by such Loan Party, to the extent such priority is permitted by the Loan Documents)), and to subject the Liens on the Collateral securing the Obligations to the provisions thereof.

Section 9.18 Withholding Tax . To the extent required by any applicable Laws, the Administrative Agent may withhold from any payment to any Lender an amount equivalent to any withholding tax applicable to such payment. If the IRS or any other Governmental Authority asserts a claim that the Administrative Agent did not properly withhold tax from amounts paid to or for the account of any Lender for any reason, or the Administrative Agent has paid over to the IRS or other Governmental Authority applicable withholding tax relating to a payment to a Lender but no deduction has been made from such payment, such Lender shall indemnify the Administrative Agent fully for all amounts paid, directly or indirectly, by the Administrative Agent as Tax or otherwise, including any penalties, additions to tax or interest and together with any and all expenses incurred, unless such amounts have been indemnified by the Borrowers or other Loan Party. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to any Lender by the Administrative Agent shall be conclusive absent manifest error. Each Lender hereby authorizes the Administrative Agent to set off and apply any and all amounts at any time owing to such Lender under this Agreement or any other Loan Document against any amount due the Administrative Agent under this Section  9.18 . The agreements in this Section  9.18 shall survive the resignation and/or replacement of the Administrative Agent, any assignment of rights by, or the replacement of, a Lender, the termination of the Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all other Obligations.

Section 9.19 Appointment of Incremental Arrangers and Specified Refinancing Agents . In the event that the Borrowers appoint or designate any Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent pursuant to Section  2.14 or Section  2 . 18 , as applicable, (i) each and every right, power, privilege or duty expressed or intended by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents to be exercised by or vested in or conveyed to an agent or arranger with respect to the establishment of New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing Debt, as applicable shall be exercisable by and vest in such Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to enable such Incremental Arranger or Specified Refinancing Agent to establish the New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing Debt , as applicable , and to perform such duties with respect to such New Loan Commitments or Specified Refinancing Debt, and every covenant and obligation contained in the Loan Documents and necessary to the establishment thereof by such Incremental Arranger shall run to and be enforceable by either the Administrative Agent , such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent and (ii) the provisions of this Article IX and of Sections 10.04 and 10.05 (obligating the Borrowers to pay the Administrative Agent’s and the Collateral Agent’s expenses and to indemnify the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent) that refer to the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent shall also inure to the benefit of such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent and all references therein to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent shall be deemed to be references to the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent and/or such Incremental Arranger and/or such Specified Refinancing Agent, as the context may require. Each Lender hereby irrevocably appoints any Incremental Arranger and/or such Specified Refinancing Agent to act on its behalf hereunder pursuant to Sections 2.14 and 2.18 and designates and authorizes such Incremental Arranger to take such actions on its behalf under the provisions of this Agreement and to exercise such powers and perform such duties as are expressly delegated to such Incremental Arranger or such Specified Refinancing Agent by the terms of this Agreement, together with such actions and powers as are reasonably incidental thereto.

 

-146-


ARTICLE X

Miscellaneous

Section 10.01 Amendments, Etc . Except as otherwise expressly set forth in this Agreement, no amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, and no consent to any departure by the Borrowers or any other Loan Party therefrom, shall be effective unless in writing signed by the Required Lenders and the Borrowers or the applicable Loan Party, as the case may be, and acknowledged by the Administrative Agent to the extent the Administrative Agent is not a Defaulting Lender, and each such amendment, waiver or consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the specific purpose for which given; provided , however , that no such amendment, waiver or consent shall:

(a) extend or increase the Commitment of any Lender, or reinstate the Commitment of any Lender after the termination of such Commitment pursuant to Section  8.02 , in each case without the written consent of such Lender (it being understood that a waiver of any condition precedent set forth in Section  4.02 or the waiver of (or amendment to the terms of) any Default or Event of Default, mandatory prepayment or mandatory reduction of the Commitments shall not constitute an extension or increase of any Commitment of any Lender);

(b) postpone any date scheduled for, or reduce the amount of, any payment of principal of, or interest on, any Loan or any fees or other amounts payable hereunder, without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby (and subject to such further requirements as may be applicable thereto under the last paragraph of this Section  10.01 ), it being understood that the waiver of any obligation to pay interest at the Default Rate, the amendment or waiver and any mandatory prepayment of Loans under the Facility shall not constitute a postponement of any date scheduled for the payment of principal, interest or fees;

(c) reduce the principal of, or the rate of interest specified herein on, any Loan (it being understood that a waiver of any Default or Event of Default or mandatory prepayment shall not constitute a reduction or forgiveness of principal), or (subject to clause (iii) of the proviso following clause (i) below) any fees or other amounts payable hereunder or under any other Loan Document without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby; provided , however , that only the consent of the Required Lenders shall be necessary to amend the definition of “Default Rate” or to waive any obligation of the Borrowers to pay interest at the Default Rate;

(d) modify Section  2.13 or 8.04 without the written consent of each Lender directly and adversely affected thereby;

(e) change (i) any provision of this Section  10.01 (other than the last paragraph of this Section  10.01 ), or the definition of “Required Lenders”, or any other provision hereof specifying the number or percentage of Lenders or portion of the Loans or Commitments required to amend, waive or otherwise modify any rights hereunder or make any determination or grant any consent hereunder (other than modifications in connection with repurchases of Loans, amendments with respect to New Loan Commitments and amendments with respect to extensions of maturity), without the written consent of each Lender;

 

-147-


(f) other than in a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05 , release all or substantially all of the Collateral in any transaction or series of related transactions, without the written consent of each Lender;

(g) other than in a transaction permitted under Section  7.04 or 7.05 , release all or substantially all of the aggregate value of the Guaranty, or all or substantially all of the Guarantors, without the written consent of each Lender;

(h) [Reserved]; or

(i) change the currency in which any Loan or Commitment is denominated or required to be made without the written consent of the Lender holding such Loans or Commitment, as applicable;

provided , further , that (i) [reserved]; (ii) [reserved]; (iii) unless in writing and signed by the Administrative Agent, in its capacity as such, in addition to the Borrowers and the Lenders required above, affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; (iv)  Section  10.07(g) may not be amended, waived or otherwise modified without the consent of each Granting Lender all or any part of whose Loans are being funded by an SPC at the time of such amendment, waiver or other modification; and (v) the Fee Letter may be amended, or rights or privileges thereunder waived, in a writing executed only by the parties thereto. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any amendment, modification, waiver or other action which by its terms requires the consent of all Lenders or each affected Lender may be effected with the consent of the applicable Lenders other than Defaulting Lenders or Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates), except that (x) no amendment, waiver or consent relating to Section  10.01(a) , (b) or (c)  may be effected, in each case without the consent of such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender and (y) any amendment, modification, waiver or other action that by its terms adversely affects any Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender in its capacity as a Lender in a manner that differs in any material respect from, and is more adverse to such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender than it is to, other affected Lenders shall require the consent of such Defaulting Lender or Affiliate Lender. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any waiver, amendment, modification or consent in respect of this Agreement or any other Loan Document that by its terms affects the rights or duties under this Agreement or any other Loan Document of Lenders holding Loans or Commitments of a particular Tranche (but not the Lenders holding Loans or Commitments of any other Tranche) may be effected by an agreement or agreements in writing entered into by the Borrowers and the requisite percentage in interest of the Lenders with respect to such Tranche that would be required to consent thereto under this Section  10.01 if such Lenders were the only Lenders hereunder at the time.

Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement or the other Loan Documents to the contrary, each Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate) hereby agrees that, if a proceeding under the United States Bankruptcy Code or any other Federal, state or foreign bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or similar law shall be commenced by or against the Borrowers or any other Loan Party at a time when such Lender is an Affiliate Lender, such Affiliate Lender irrevocably authorizes and empowers the Administrative Agent to vote on behalf of such Affiliate Lender with respect to the Loans held by such Affiliate Lender in any manner in the Administrative Agent’s sole discretion, unless the Administrative Agent instructs such Affiliate Lender to vote, in which case such Affiliate Lender shall vote with respect to the Loans held by it as the Administrative Agent directs; provided that such Affiliate Lender shall be entitled to vote in accordance with its sole discretion (and not in accordance with the direction of the Administrative Agent) in connection with any plan of reorganization to the extent any such plan of reorganization proposes to treat any such Affiliate Lender or the Obligations held by it in a manner that is less favorable in any material respect to such Affiliate Lender than the proposed treatment of similar Lenders and the Obligations held by them that are not Affiliates of a Borrower.

 

-148-


This Section  10.01 shall be subject to any contrary provision of Sections 2.14 or 2.18 ; provided that in no event shall any amendment pursuant to Section  2.14 or 2.18 affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent without the written consent of the Administrative Agent. In addition, notwithstanding anything else to the contrary contained in this Section  10.01 , (a) if the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall have jointly identified an obvious error or any error or omission of a technical nature, in each case, in any provision of the Loan Documents, then the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend such provision without any further action or consent of any other party if the same is not objected to in writing by the Required Lenders to the Administrative Agent within 5 Business Days following receipt of notice thereof, (b) the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend any provision of any Collateral Document or the Guaranty, or enter into any new agreement or instrument, to better implement the intentions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents or as required by local law to give effect to any guaranty, or to give effect to or to protect any security interest for the benefit of the Secured Parties, in any property so that the security interests comply with applicable Law, (c) the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend the schedules to this Agreement and any Collateral Document prior to the Closing Date and (d) to the extent the Borrowers elect to change accounting standards from GAAP to IFRS, the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers shall be permitted to amend the Loan Documents to effectuate such changes, and in each case, such amendments, documents and agreements shall become effective without any further action or consent of any other party to any Loan Document and if, in the case of amendments contemplated by clause (a), the same is not objected to in writing by the Required Lenders within 5 Business Days following receipt of notice thereof.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, in connection with any amendment, modification, waiver or other action requiring the consent or approval of Required Lenders, Lenders that are Debt Fund Affiliates shall not be permitted, in the aggregate, to account for more than 49.9% of the amounts actually included in determining whether the threshold in the definition of “ Required Lenders ” has been satisfied. The voting power of each Lender that is a Debt Fund Affiliate shall be reduced, pro rata, to the extent necessary in order to comply with the immediately preceding sentence.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, at any time and from time to time, upon notice to the Administrative Agent (who shall promptly notify the applicable Lenders) specifying in reasonable detail the proposed terms thereof, the Borrowers may make one or more loan modification offers to all the Lenders of the Facility that would, if and to the extent accepted by any such Lender, (a) extend the scheduled Maturity Date of the Loans and Commitments under the Facility and/or change the Applicable Rate and/or fees payable with respect to the Loans and Commitments under the Facility (in each case solely with respect to the Loans and Commitments of accepting Lenders in respect of which an acceptance is delivered) and (b) treat the Loans and Commitments so modified as a new “Facility” for all purposes under this Agreement; provided that (i) such loan modification offer is made to each Lender under the Facility on the same terms and subject to the same procedures as are applicable to all other Lenders under the Facility (which procedures in any case shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Administrative Agent) and (ii) no loan modification shall affect the rights or duties of, or any fees or other amounts payable to, the Administrative Agent, without its prior written consent.

In connection with any such loan modification offer, the Borrowers and each accepting Lender shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent such agreements and other documentation as the Administrative Agent shall reasonably specify to evidence the acceptance of the applicable loan modification offer and the terms and conditions thereof, and this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall be amended in a writing (which may be executed and delivered by the Borrowers and

 

-149-


the Administrative Agent and shall be effective only with respect to the applicable Loans and Commitments of Lenders that shall have accepted the relevant loan modification offer (and only with respect to Loans and Commitments as to which any such Lender has accepted the loan modification offer)) to the extent necessary or appropriate, in the judgment of the Administrative Agent, to reflect the existence of, and to give effect to the terms and conditions of, the applicable loan modification (including the addition of such modified Loans and/or Commitments as a “Facility” hereunder). No Lender shall have any obligation whatsoever to accept any loan modification offer, and may reject any such offer in its sole discretion. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no modification referred to above shall become effective unless the Administrative Agent, to the extent reasonably requested by the Administrative Agent, shall have received legal opinions, board resolutions, officers’ certificates and/or reaffirmation agreements consistent with those delivered on the Closing Date under Section  4.01 or delivered from time to time pursuant to Section  6.12 and/or Section  6.16 with respect to Holdings, the Borrowers and each other Subsidiary Guarantor.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Section  10.01 , (i) the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent may, without the input or consent of the Lenders, effect amendments to this Agreement and the other Loan Documents as may be necessary or appropriate in the opinion of the Administrative Agent to effect the provisions of Sections 2.14 or 2.18 ; (ii) the Fee Letter may be amended, or rights or privileges thereunder waived, in a writing executed only by the parties thereto; (iii) the Administrative Agent is hereby authorized by the Lenders to approve the forms of Collateral Documents as contemplated herein, and to enter into any Loan Documents in such forms as approved by it on or prior to the Closing Date (and thereafter as contemplated by the provisions of this Agreement); (iv) the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent may, without the input or consent of the Lenders, effect amendments to the Collateral Documents to effect such customary changes as may be requested by any Person acting as trustee or collateral trustee in respect of any Permitted Refinancing thereof in the form of debt securities and (v) guarantees, collateral security documents and related documents executed by any Person in connection with this Agreement may be in a form reasonably determined by the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent and may be, together with this Agreement, amended, supplemented and waived with the consent of the Administrative Agent or Collateral Agent, as applicable, at the request of the Borrowers without the need to obtain the consent of any other Lender if such amendment, supplement or waiver is delivered in order (a) to comply with or reflect customary practices under local Law or advice of local counsel, (b) to cure ambiguities, omissions, mistakes or defects or (c) to cause such guarantee, collateral security document or other document to be consistent with this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

Section 10.02 Notices; Electronic Communications .

(a) General . Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, all notices and other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and shall be delivered by hand or overnight courier service, mailed by certified or registered mail or sent by telecopier as follows, and all notices and other communications expressly permitted hereunder to be given by telephone shall be made to the applicable telephone number, as follows:

(i) if to Holdings, the Borrowers, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent to the address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified for such Person on Schedule 10.02 or to such other address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number as shall be designated by such party in a notice to the other parties hereto, as provided in Section  10.02(d) ; and

(ii) if to any other Lender, to the address, telecopier number, electronic mail address or telephone number specified in its Administrative Questionnaire.

 

-150-


Notices and other communications sent by hand or overnight courier service, or mailed by certified or registered mail, shall be deemed to have been given when received; notices and other communications sent by telecopier shall be deemed to have been given when sent (except that, if not given during normal business hours for the recipient, shall be deemed to have been given at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient). Notices and other communications delivered through electronic communications to the extent provided in clause (b) below shall be effective as provided in such clause (b).

(b) Electronic Communications . Notices and other communications to the Lenders hereunder may be delivered or furnished by electronic communication (including e-mail and Internet or intranet websites) pursuant to procedures approved by the Administrative Agent; provided that the foregoing shall not apply to notices to any Lender pursuant to Article  II if such Lender has notified the Administrative Agent that it is incapable of receiving, or is unwilling to receive, notices under Article  II by electronic communication. The Administrative Agent or the Borrowers may, in its discretion, agree to accept notices and other communications to it hereunder by electronic communications pursuant to procedures approved by it; provided that approval of such procedures may be limited to particular notices or communications.

Unless the Administrative Agent otherwise prescribes (with the Borrowers’ consent), (i) notices and other communications sent to an e-mail address shall be deemed received upon the sender’s receipt of an acknowledgment from the intended recipient (such as by the “return receipt requested” function, as available, return e-mail or other written acknowledgement); provided that if such notice or other communication is not sent during the normal business hours of the recipient, such notice or communication shall be deemed to have been sent at the opening of business on the next Business Day for the recipient, and (ii) notices or communications posted to an Internet or intranet website shall be deemed received upon the deemed receipt by the intended recipient at its e-mail address as described in the foregoing clause (i) of notification that such notice or communication is available and identifying the website address therefor.

(c) The Platform . THE PLATFORM IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE.” THE AGENT-RELATED PERSONS DO NOT WARRANT THE ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE ADEQUACY OF THE PLATFORM, AND EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM LIABILITY FOR ERRORS IN OR OMISSIONS FROM THE BORROWER MATERIALS. NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR FREEDOM FROM VIRUSES OR OTHER CODE DEFECTS, IS MADE BY ANY AGENT-RELATED PERSON IN CONNECTION WITH THE BORROWER MATERIALS OR THE PLATFORM. In no event shall any Agent-Related Person have any liability to any Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries, any Lender or any other Person for losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses of any kind (whether in tort, contract or otherwise) arising out of the Borrowers’ or the Administrative Agent’s transmission of Borrower Materials through the Internet, except to the extent that such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction by a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Agent-Related Person; provided , however , that in no event shall any Agent-Related Person have any liability to any Loan Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries, any Lender or any other Person for indirect, special, incidental, consequential or punitive damages (as opposed to direct or actual damages).

(d) Change of Address, Etc . Each of Holdings, the Borrowers, the Guarantors, the Administrative Agent and the Collateral Agent may change its address, telecopier, telephone number or electronic mail address for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the other parties

 

-151-


hereto. Each other Lender may change its address, telecopier, telephone number or electronic mail address for notices and other communications hereunder by notice to the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent. In addition, each Lender agrees to notify the Administrative Agent from time to time to ensure that the Administrative Agent has on record (i) an effective address, contact name, telephone number, telecopier number and electronic mail address to which notices and other communications may be sent and (ii) accurate wire instructions for such Lender. Furthermore, each Public Lender agrees to cause at least one individual at or on behalf of such Public Lender to at all times have selected the “Private Side Information” or similar designation on the content declaration screen of the Platform in order to enable such Public Lender or its delegate, in accordance with such Public Lender’s compliance procedures and applicable Law, including United States federal and state securities Laws, to make reference to Borrower Materials that are not made available through the “Public Side Information” portion of the Platform and that may contain material non-public information with respect to the Borrowers or their securities for purposes of United States federal or state securities laws.

(e) Reliance by Administrative Agent, Collateral Agent and Lenders . The Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent and the Lenders shall be entitled to rely and act upon any notices (including telephonic Committed Loan Notices) purportedly given by or on behalf of a Borrower even if (i) such notices were not made in a manner specified herein, were incomplete or were not preceded or followed by any other form of notice specified herein, or (ii) the terms thereof, as understood by the recipient, varied from any confirmation thereof. The Borrowers shall indemnify the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent, each Lender and the Related Parties of each of them from all losses, costs, expenses and liabilities resulting from the reliance by such Person on each notice purportedly given by or on behalf of the Borrowers to the extent required by Section  10.05 . All telephonic notices to and other telephonic communications with the Administrative Agent may be recorded by the Administrative Agent, and each of the parties hereto hereby consents to such recording.

Section 10.03 No Waiver ; Cumulative Remedies ; Enforcement .

(a) No failure by any Lender, the Administrative Agent or the Collateral Agent to exercise, and no delay by any such Person in exercising, any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder or under any other Loan Document shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or privilege. The rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided hereunder and under each other Loan Document, are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided by Law.

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein or in any other Loan Document, the authority to enforce rights and remedies hereunder and under the other Loan Documents against the Loan Parties or any of them shall be vested exclusively in, and all actions and proceedings at law in connection with such enforcement shall be instituted and maintained exclusively by, the Administrative Agent and/or Collateral Agent in accordance with Section  8.02 and the other Loan Documents for the benefit of all the Lenders; provided , however , that the foregoing shall not prohibit (a) the Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent from exercising on its own behalf the rights and remedies that inure to its benefit (solely in its capacity as Administrative Agent and/or the Collateral Agent) hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, (b) any Lender from exercising setoff rights in accordance with Section  10.09 (subject to the terms of Section  2.13 ), or (c) any Lender from filing proofs of claim or appearing and filing pleadings on its own behalf during the pendency of a proceeding relative to any Loan Party under any Debtor Relief Law; provided , further , that if at any time there is no Person acting as Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Loan Documents, then (i) the Required Lenders shall have the rights otherwise ascribed to the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  8.02 and (ii) in addition to the matters set forth in clauses (b) and (c) of the preceding proviso and subject to

 

-152-


Section  2.13 , any Lender may, with the consent of the Required Lenders, enforce any rights and remedies available to it and as authorized by the Required Lenders. In the event of a foreclosure by the Collateral Agent on any of the Collateral pursuant to a public or private sale, the Administrative Agent, the Collateral Agent or any Lender (or any person nominated by them) may be the purchaser of any or all of such Collateral at any such sale and the Administrative Agent, as agent for and representative of the Lenders (but not any Lender or Lenders in its or their respective individual capacities unless the Required Lenders shall otherwise agree in writing), shall be entitled, for the purpose of bidding and making settlement or payment of the purchase price for all or any portion of the Collateral sold in any such public sale, to use and apply any of the Obligations as a credit on account of the purchase price for any Collateral payable by the Administrative Agent at such sale.

Section 10.04 Expenses and Taxes . The Borrowers jointly and severally agree (a) if the Closing Date occurs, to pay or reimburse the Administrative Agent and the other Agents for all reasonable and out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred in connection with the preparation, negotiation, syndication and execution of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents (including reasonable expenses incurred in connection with due diligence and travel, courier, reproduction, printing and delivery expenses), and any amendment, waiver, consent or other modification of the provisions hereof and thereof (whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby are consummated), and the consummation and administration of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, including the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel (limited to the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of one primary counsel to the Agents and, if necessary, one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions) and special counsel for each relevant specialty, and (b) from and after the Closing Date, to pay or reimburse the Administrative Agent, the other Agents and each Lender for all reasonable documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred in connection with the enforcement of any rights or remedies under this Agreement or the other Loan Documents (including all such costs and expenses incurred during any legal proceeding, including, without duplication of Indemnified Taxes or Other Taxes paid or indemnified pursuant to Sections 3.01 and 3.03 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, not including any Taxes that are Excluded Taxes under this Agreement or under any other Loan Document), any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or in connection with any workout or restructuring and all documentary taxes associated with the Facility), including the fees, disbursements and other charges of counsel (limited to the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of one counsel to the Administrative Agent, the other Agents and the Lenders taken as a whole, and, if necessary, of one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions) and of special counsel for each relevant specialty and, in the event of any actual or potential conflict of interest, one additional counsel in each relevant jurisdiction for each Lender or group of Lenders or Agents subject to such conflict), in each case without duplication for any amounts paid (or indemnified) under Section  3.01 . The foregoing costs and expenses shall include, without duplication of Indemnified Taxes or Other Taxes paid or indemnified pursuant to Sections 3.01 and 3.03 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, not including any Taxes that are Excluded Taxes under this Agreement or under any other Loan Document), all reasonable search, filing, recording, title insurance and appraisal charges and fees and taxes related thereto, and other out-of-pocket expenses incurred by any Agent. All amounts due under this Section  10.04 shall be paid within 30 days after invoiced or demand therefor (with a reasonably detailed invoice with respect thereto) (except for any such costs and expenses incurred prior to the Closing Date, which shall be paid on the Closing Date to the extent invoiced at least 3 Business Days prior to the Closing Date). The agreements in this Section  10.04 shall survive the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and repayment of all other Obligations. If any Loan Party fails to pay when due any costs, expenses or other amounts payable by it hereunder or under any Loan Document, such amount may be paid on behalf of such Loan Party by the Administrative Agent after any applicable grace periods have expired, in its sole discretion and the Borrowers shall immediately reimburse the Administrative Agent, as applicable.

 

-153-


Section 10.05 Indemnification by the Borrowers . The Borrowers shall indemnify and hold harmless each Arranger, each Agent-Related Person, each Lender, each of their respective Affiliates and each partner, controlling person, director, officer, employee, counsel, agent and representative of the foregoing and, in the case of any funds, trustees and advisors and attorneys-in-fact (collectively, the “ Indemnitees ”) from and against (and will reimburse each Indemnitee, as and when incurred, for) any and all liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, claims, demands, actions, judgments, suits, costs (including settlement costs), disbursements, and reasonable and documented or invoiced out-of-pocket fees and expenses (including the fees, disbursements and other charges of (i) one counsel to the Indemnitees taken as a whole, (ii) in the case of an actual or perceived conflict of interest, where the Indemnitee affected by such conflict informs the Borrower Representative of such conflict and thereafter retains its own counsel, of another firm of counsel for each such affected Indemnitee in each relevant jurisdiction material to the interests of the Indemnitees, and (iii) if necessary, one local counsel in each relevant jurisdiction (which may include a single special counsel acting in multiple jurisdictions and, solely in the event of an actual or perceived conflict of interest, one additional counsel in each applicable jurisdiction material to the interests of the affected Persons (or each group of affected Persons) taken as a whole) and special counsel for each relevant specialty) of any kind or nature whatsoever which may at any time be imposed on, incurred by or asserted or awarded against any such Indemnitee in any way relating to or arising out of or in connection with or by reason of (x) any actual or prospective claim, litigation, investigation or proceeding in any way relating to, arising out of, in connection with or by reason of any of the following, whether based on contract, tort or any other theory (including any investigation of, preparation for, or defense of any pending or threatened claim, investigation, litigation or proceeding): (a) the execution, delivery, enforcement, performance or administration of any Loan Document or any other agreement, letter or instrument delivered in connection with the transactions contemplated thereby or the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby or (b) any Commitment or Loan or the use or proposed use of the proceeds therefrom; provided that such indemnity shall not, as to any Indemnitee, be available to the extent that such liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, claims, demands, actions, judgments, suits, costs, disbursements, fees or expenses are determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from (A) the bad faith, gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee or any of its Affiliates or controlling persons or any of the officers, directors, employees, agents, advisors, or members of any of the foregoing or (B) any dispute that is among Indemnitees (other than any dispute involving claims against the Administrative Agent, any Arranger or any other Agent, in each case in their respective capacities as such, or any Initial Lender solely in connection with its syndication activities as contemplated under the Commitment Letter) that a court of competent jurisdiction has determined in a final and non-appealable judgment did not involve actions or omissions of any direct or indirect parent or controlling person of a Borrower or its Subsidiaries; or (y) any actual or alleged presence or release of Hazardous Materials on or from any property currently or formerly owned or operated by Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Environmental Liability related in any way to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, ((x) and (y), collectively, the “ Indemnified Liabilities ”) in all cases, whether or not caused by or arising, in whole or in part, out of the negligence of the Indemnitee and regardless of whether such Indemnitee is a party thereto, and whether or not such proceedings are brought by a Borrower, its equity holders, its Affiliates, creditors or any other third person. No Indemnitee shall be liable for any damages arising from the use by others of any information or other materials obtained through the Platform or other information transmission systems (including electronic telecommunications) in connection with this Agreement unless determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment to have resulted from the gross negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct of such Indemnitee, nor shall any Indemnitee or any Loan Party have any liability for any special, punitive, indirect or consequential damages relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document or arising out of its activities in connection herewith or therewith (whether before or after the Closing Date); provided that such waiver of special, punitive, indirect or consequential damages shall not limit the indemnification obligations of the Loan Parties under this Section 10.05 . In the case of an investigation, litigation or other proceeding to

 

-154-


which the indemnity in this Section  10.05 applies, such indemnity shall be effective whether or not such investigation, litigation or proceeding is brought by any Loan Party, its directors, shareholders or creditors or an Indemnitee or any other Person, and whether or not any Indemnitee is otherwise a party thereto. Should any investigation, litigation or proceeding be settled, or if there is a judgment against an Indemnitee in any such investigation, litigation or proceeding, the Borrowers shall indemnify and hold harmless each Indemnitee in the manner set forth above; provided that the Borrowers shall not be liable for any settlement effected without the Borrowers’ prior written consent (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned). All amounts due under this Section  10.05 shall be payable within 30 days after demand therefor. The agreements in this Section  10.05 shall survive the resignation or removal of the Administrative Agent, the replacement of any Lender, the termination of the Aggregate Commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all the other Obligations. This Section  10.05 shall not apply to any claims with respect to Taxes (other than any Taxes imposed on payments received pursuant to this Section  10.05 ).

Section 10.06 Payments Set Aside . To the extent that any payment by or on behalf of the Borrowers is made to any Agent or any Lender, or any Agent or any Lender exercises its right of setoff, and such payment or the proceeds of such setoff or any part thereof is subsequently invalidated, declared to be fraudulent or preferential, set aside or required (including pursuant to any settlement entered into by such Agent or such Lender in its discretion) to be repaid to a trustee, receiver or any other party, in connection with any proceeding under any Debtor Relief Law or otherwise, then (a) to the extent of such recovery, the obligation or part thereof originally intended to be satisfied shall be revived and continued in full force and effect as if such payment had not been made or such setoff had not occurred, and (b) each Lender severally agrees to pay to the Administrative Agent upon demand its applicable share (without duplication) of any amount so recovered from or repaid by any Agent, plus interest thereon from the date of such demand to the date such payment is made at a rate per annum equal to the relevant Eurocurrency Rate from time to time in effect in the applicable currency of such recovery or payment. The obligations of the Lenders under clause (b) of the preceding sentence shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

Section 10.07 Successors and Assigns .

(a) The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, except that the Borrowers may not assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder without the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent and each Lender (and any other attempted assignment or transfer by any party hereto shall be null and void) and no Lender may assign or otherwise transfer any of its rights or obligations hereunder except (i) to an Eligible Assignee (other than to any Disqualified Institution, to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available (and is permitted to be shared) as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions) in accordance with the provisions of Section  10.07(b) , (ii) by way of participation in accordance with the provisions of Section  10.07(d) , (iii) by way of pledge or assignment of a security interest subject to the restrictions of Section  10.07(f) or (iv) to an SPC in accordance with the provisions of Section  10.07(g) . Nothing in this Agreement, expressed or implied, shall be construed to confer upon any Person (other than the parties hereto, their respective successors and assigns permitted hereby, Participants to the extent provided in Section  10.07(d) and, to the extent expressly contemplated hereby, the Indemnitees) any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or by reason of this Agreement.

 

-155-


(b) Any Lender may at any time assign to one or more assignees all or a portion of its rights and obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment(s) and the Loans at the time owing to it); provided that:

(i) (A) in the case of an assignment of the entire remaining amount of the assigning Lender’s Commitment under the Facility and the Loans at the time owing to it under the Facility, no minimum amount shall need be assigned, and (B) in any case not described in clause (b)(i)(A) of this Section  10.07 , the aggregate amount of the Commitment (which for this purpose includes Loans outstanding thereunder) or, if the applicable Commitment is not then in effect, the outstanding principal balance of the Loans of the assigning Lender subject to each such assignment, determined as of the date the Assignment and Assumption with respect to such assignment is delivered to the Administrative Agent or, if “Trade Date” is specified in the Assignment and Assumption, as of the Trade Date, shall not be less than the applicable Threshold Amount (or such lesser amount as is acceptable to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers), in each case unless each of the Administrative Agent and, so long as no Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  has occurred and is continuing, the Borrowers otherwise consent (each such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed; provided , however , that concurrent assignments to members of an Assignee Group and concurrent assignments from members of an Assignee Group to a single Eligible Assignee (or to an Eligible Assignee and members of its Assignee Group)) will be treated as a single assignment for purposes of determining whether such minimum amount has been met;

(ii) each partial assignment shall be made as an assignment of a proportionate part of all the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement with respect to the Loans or the Commitment assigned, except that this clause (ii) shall not prohibit any Lender from assigning all or a portion of its rights and obligations among separate Facilities on a non-pro rata basis;

(iii) no consent shall be required for any assignment except to the extent required by clause (b)(i)(B) of this Section  10.07 and, in addition (A) the consent of the Borrowers (from and after the Closing Date, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) shall be required for any assignment unless (1) an Event of Default under Section  8.01(a) , (f) or (g)  has occurred and is continuing at the time of such assignment or (2) such assignment is to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund (other than any Disqualified Institution); provided that (1) the Borrowers shall be deemed to have consented to any assignment unless they object thereto by written notice to the Administrative Agent within ten Business Days after having received notice thereof and (2) during the forty-five (45) day period (or such longer period reasonably acceptable to the Arrangers and the Borrowers) following the Closing Date, the Borrowers shall be deemed to have consented to an assignment to any Lender if such Lender was previously identified and approved in the initial allocations of the Loans provided by the Arrangers to the Borrowers and (B) the consent of the Administrative Agent (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) shall be required for any assignment unless (1) such assignment is to a Lender, an Affiliate of a Lender or an Approved Fund or (2) such assignment is in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility and is to a Revolving Credit Lender, an Affiliate of a Revolving Credit Lender or an Approved Fund related thereto (other than any Disqualified Institution);

(iv) the parties to each assignment shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent an Assignment and Assumption manually, together with a processing and recordation fee of $3,500 (except, (x) in the case of assignments by any of the Initial Lenders or any of their Affiliates, only a single processing and recording fee shall be payable for assignments as a part of the primary syndication of the Initial Loans and (y) the Administrative Agent, in its sole discretion, may elect to waive such processing and recording fee in the case of any assignment). Each Eligible Assignee that is not an existing Lender shall deliver to the Administrative Agent an Administrative Questionnaire;

 

-156-


(v) no such assignment shall be made (A) to any Defaulting Lender or any of its Subsidiaries, or any Person who, upon becoming a Lender hereunder, would constitute any of the foregoing Persons described in this clause (A), (B) to any natural person, (C) to any Disqualified Institution (to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available (and is permitted to be shared) as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions), (D) to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries except as permitted under clause (j) below or (E) to any Affiliate Lender except as permitted under Section  10.07(i) ;

(vi) [Reserved];

(vii) the assigning Lender shall deliver any Notes or, in lieu thereof, a lost note affidavit and indemnity reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers evidencing such Loans to the Borrowers or the Administrative Agent;

(viii) in connection with any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder, no such assignment shall be effective unless and until, in addition to the other conditions thereto set forth herein, the parties to the assignment shall make such additional payments to the Administrative Agent in an aggregate amount sufficient, upon distribution thereof as appropriate (which may be outright payment, purchases by the assignee of participations or subparticipations, or other compensating actions, including funding, with the consent of the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent, the applicable Pro Rata Share of Loans previously requested but not funded by the Defaulting Lender, to each of which the applicable assignee and assignor hereby irrevocably consent), to (x) pay and satisfy in full all payment liabilities then owed by such Defaulting Lender to the Administrative Agent or any Lender hereunder (and interest accrued thereon) and (y) acquire (and fund as appropriate) its full Pro Rata Share of all Loans; provided that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that any assignment of rights and obligations of any Defaulting Lender hereunder shall become effective under applicable Law without compliance with the provisions of this paragraph, then the assignee of such interest shall be deemed to be a Defaulting Lender for all purposes of this Agreement until such compliance occurs.

Subject to acceptance and recording thereof by the Administrative Agent pursuant to Section  10.07(c) , from and after the effective date specified in each Assignment and Assumption, the Eligible Assignee thereunder shall be a party to this Agreement and, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, have the rights and obligations of a Lender under this Agreement, and the assigning Lender thereunder shall, to the extent of the interest assigned by such Assignment and Assumption, be released from its obligations under this Agreement (and, in the case of an Assignment and Assumption covering all of the assigning Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement, such Lender shall cease to be a party hereto but shall continue to be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 , 3.04 , 10.04 and 10.05 with respect to facts and circumstances occurring prior to the effective date of such assignment, and subject to the obligations set forth in Section  10.08 ). Upon request, and the surrender by the assigning Lender of its Note, the Borrowers (at their expense) shall execute and deliver a Note to the assignee Lender. Any assignment or transfer by a Lender of rights or obligations under this Agreement (other than any purported assignment or transfer to a Disqualified Institution) that does not comply with this clause (b) shall be treated for purposes of this Agreement as a sale by such Lender of a participation in such rights and obligations in accordance with Section 10.07(d) .

(c) The Administrative Agent, acting solely for this purpose as an agent of the Borrowers (and such agency being solely for tax purposes), shall maintain at the Administrative Agent’s Office a copy of each Assignment and Assumption delivered to it and a register for the recordation of the names and addresses of the Lenders, and the Commitments of, and principal amounts (and related interest

 

-157-


amounts) of the Loans, owing to each Lender pursuant to the terms hereof from time to time (the “ Register ”). Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Documents, the entries in the Register shall be conclusive, absent manifest error, and the Borrowers, the Agents and the Lenders shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Register pursuant to the terms hereof as a Lender hereunder for all purposes of this Agreement, notwithstanding notice to the contrary. In addition, the Administrative Agent shall maintain on the Register information regarding the designation, and revocation of designation, of any Lender as Defaulting Lender. The Register shall be available for inspection by the Borrowers, any Agent and any Lender (with respect to itself), at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice. This Section  10.07(c) and Section  2.11 shall be construed so that all Loans are at all times maintained in “registered form” within the meaning of Sections 163(f), 871(h)(2) and 881(c)(2) of the Code and any related Treasury regulations (or any other relevant or successor provisions of the Code or of such Treasury regulations). Upon receipt of a duly completed Assignment and Assumption executed by the assigning Lender and the assignee Lender, the processing fee referred to in clause (b)(iv) of this Section  10.07 , if applicable, and any written consent to such assignment required by clause (b) of this Section  10.07 , the Administrative Agent shall accept such Assignment and Assumption and record the information contained therein in the Register. No assignment shall be effective for purposes of this Section  10.07 unless it has been recorded in the Register as provided in this Section 10.07(c) .

(d) Any Lender may at any time, without the consent of, or notice to, the Borrowers, the Administrative Agent, sell participations to any Person (other than a natural person, an Affiliate Lender (other than a Debt Fund Affiliate), a Person that the Administrative Agent has identified in a notice to the Lenders as a Defaulting Lender or a Disqualified Institution (to the extent that the list of Disqualified Institutions has been made available to all Lenders as set forth in the definition of Disqualified Institutions) (each, a “ Participant ”) in all or a portion of such Lender’s rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (including all or a portion of its Commitment and/or the Loans owing to it); provided that (i) such Lender’s obligations under this Agreement shall remain unchanged, (ii) such Lender shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the performance of such obligations and (iii) the Borrowers, the Agents and the other Lenders shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Lender in connection with such Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement. Any agreement or instrument pursuant to which a Lender sells such a participation shall provide that such Lender shall retain the sole right to enforce this Agreement and the other Loan Documents and to approve any amendment, modification or waiver of any provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document; provided that such agreement or instrument may provide that such Lender will not, without the consent of the Participant, agree to any amendment, waiver or other modification described in the first proviso to Section  10.01 that directly affects such Participant. Subject to Section  10.07(e) , the Borrowers agree that each Participant shall be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 and 3.04 (subject to the requirements and the limitations of such Sections and Section  3.07 ) to the same extent as if it were a Lender and had acquired its interest by assignment pursuant to Section  10.07(b) . To the extent permitted by law, each Participant also shall be entitled to the benefits of Section  10.09 as though it were a Lender; provided , such Participant agrees to be subject to Section  2.13 as though it were a Lender.

(e) A Participant shall not be entitled to receive any greater payment under Section  3.01 , 3.03 or 3.04 than the applicable Lender would have been entitled to receive with respect to the participation sold to such Participant, except to the extent that a Participant’s right to a greater payment results from a change in any Law after the Participant becomes a Participant.

(f) Any Lender may at any time pledge or assign a security interest in all or any portion of its rights under this Agreement (including under its Note, if any) (other than to a Disqualified Institution or a natural person) to secure obligations of such Lender, including any pledge or assignment to secure obligations to a Federal Reserve Bank or any central bank having jurisdiction over such Lender; provided that no such pledge or assignment, and no foreclosure or other enforcement action in respect thereof, shall release such Lender from any of its obligations hereunder or substitute any such pledgee or assignee for such Lender as a party hereto.

 

-158-


(g) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender (a “ Granting Lender ”) may grant to a special purpose funding vehicle identified as such in writing from time to time by the Granting Lender to the Administrative Agent and the Borrowers (an “ SPC ”) the option to provide all or any part of any Loan that such Granting Lender would otherwise be obligated to make pursuant to this Agreement; provided that (i) nothing herein shall constitute a commitment by any SPC to fund any Loan, and (ii) if an SPC elects not to exercise such option or otherwise fails to make all or any part of such Loan, the Granting Lender shall be obligated to make such Loan pursuant to the terms hereof or, if it fails to do so, to make such payment to the Administrative Agent as is required under Section  2.12(b) . Each party hereto hereby agrees that an SPC shall be entitled to the benefits of Sections 3.01 , 3.03 and 3.04 (subject to the requirements and the limitations of such Sections and Section  3.07 ); provided that neither the grant to any SPC nor the exercise by any SPC of such option shall increase the costs or expenses or otherwise increase or change the obligations of the Borrowers under this Agreement (including under Section  3.01 , 3.03 or 3.04 ), except to the extent that the SPC’s right to a greater payment results from a change in any Law after the grant to the SPC takes place. Each party hereto further agrees that (i) no SPC shall be liable for any indemnity or similar payment obligation under this Agreement for which a Lender would be liable, and (ii) the Granting Lender shall for all purposes, including the approval of any amendment, waiver or other modification of any provision of any Loan Document, remain the Lender of record hereunder. Other than as expressly provided in this Section  10.07(g) , (A) such Granting Lender’s obligations under this Agreement shall remain unchanged, (B) such Granting Lender shall remain solely responsible to the other parties hereto for the performance of such obligations and (C) the Borrowers, the Agents and the other Lenders shall continue to deal solely and directly with such Granting Lender in connection with such Granting Lender’s rights and obligations under this Agreement. The making of a Loan by an SPC hereunder shall utilize the Commitment of the Granting Lender to the same extent, and as if, such Loan were made by such Granting Lender. In furtherance of the foregoing, each party hereto hereby agrees (which agreement shall survive the termination of this Agreement) that, prior to the date that is one year and one day after the payment in full of all outstanding commercial paper or other senior debt of any SPC, it will not, other than in respect of matters unrelated to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby, institute against, or join any other Person in instituting against, such SPC any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency, or liquidation proceeding under the laws of the United States or any State thereof. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, any SPC may (i) with notice to, but without prior consent of the Borrowers and the Administrative Agent and with the payment of a processing fee of $3,500 assign all or any portion of its rights hereunder with respect to any Loan to the Granting Lender and (ii) subject to Section  10.08 , disclose on a confidential basis any non-public information relating to its funding of Loans to any rating agency, commercial paper dealer or provider of any surety or Guarantee or credit or liquidity enhancement to such SPC.

(h) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender that is a Fund may create a security interest in all or any portion of the Loans owing to it and the Note, if any, held by it to the trustee for holders of obligations owed, or securities issued, by such Fund as security for such obligations or securities; provided that unless and until such trustee actually becomes a Lender in compliance with the other provisions of this Section  10.07 , (i) no such pledge shall release the pledging Lender from any of its obligations under the Loan Documents, and (ii) such trustee shall not be entitled to exercise any of the rights of a Lender under the Loan Documents even though such trustee may have acquired ownership rights with respect to the pledged interest through foreclosure or otherwise.

 

-159-


(i) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender may assign all or any portion of its Loans, Specified Refinancing Loans and New Loans hereunder to any Other Affiliate (including any Debt Fund Affiliate), but only if:

(i) the assigning Lender and Other Affiliate purchasing such Lender’s Loans, Specified Refinancing Loans or New Loans, as applicable, shall execute and deliver to the Administrative Agent an assignment agreement substantially in the form of Exhibit  E-2 hereto (an “ Affiliate Lender Assignment and Assumption ”) in lieu of an Assignment and Assumption;

(ii) after giving effect to such assignment, Other Affiliates (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not, in the aggregate, own or hold Loans, Specified Refinancing Loans and New Loans with an aggregate principal amount in excess of 25% of the principal amount of all Loans then outstanding (calculated as of the date of such purchase); and

(iii) such Other Affiliate (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall (A) at the time of such assignment affirm the No Undisclosed Information Statement and (B) all times thereafter be subject to the voting restrictions specified in Section  10.01 .

In connection with each assignment pursuant to this Section  10.07(i) , each Lender acknowledges and agrees that in connection therewith, if the representation set forth in the definition of “No Undisclosed Information Statement” cannot be made pursuant to clause (ii) thereof (1) the Other Affiliates may have, and later may come into possession of, information regarding the Borrowers, the Sponsor, their respective affiliates not known to such Lender and that may be material to a decision by such Lender to participate in such prepayment (including material non-public information) (“ Excluded Information ”), (2) such Lender, independently and, without reliance on the Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates, has made its own analysis and determination to participate in such prepayment notwithstanding such Lender’s lack of knowledge of the Excluded Information and (3) none of the Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates shall have any liability to such Lender, and such Lender hereby waives and releases, to the extent permitted by law, any claims such Lender may have against Other Affiliates, Holdings, any of its Subsidiaries, the Administrative Agent or any of their respective Affiliates, under applicable laws or otherwise, with respect to the nondisclosure of the Excluded Information.

(j) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, any Lender may assign all or any portion of its Loans, Specified Refinancing Loans and New Loans hereunder to Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, but only if:

(i) (A) such assignment is made pursuant to a Dutch Auction open to all Lenders, Specified Refinancing Loan lenders or New Loan lenders on a pro rata basis or (B) such assignment is made as an open market purchase;

(ii) Holdings or its Subsidiary, as applicable, shall at the time of such assignment affirm the No Undisclosed Information Statement;

(iii) any such Loans shall be automatically and permanently cancelled immediately upon acquisition thereof by Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries; and

(iv) Holdings and its Subsidiaries do not use the proceeds of the revolving credit facility under the First Lien Facility (whether or not such revolving credit facility has been increased or refinanced pursuant to the terms thereof) to acquire such Loans.

(k) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, (i) Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not have any right to attend (including by telephone) any meeting or discussions (or portion thereof) among the Administrative Agent or any other Lender to which representatives of the Borrowers are not then present, (ii) Affiliate Lenders (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) shall not have any

 

-160-


right to receive any information or material prepared by the Administrative Agent or any other Lender or any communication by or among the Administrative Agent and one or more other Lenders, except to the extent such information or materials have been made available to the Borrowers or their representatives and (iii) neither the Sponsor nor any Affiliate of the Sponsor (other than Debt Fund Affiliates) may be entitled to receive advice of counsel to the Agents or other Lenders and none of them shall challenge any assertion of attorney-client privilege by any Agent or other Lender.

(l) [Reserved].

(m) The applicable Lender, acting solely for this purpose as a non-fiduciary agent of the Borrowers (solely for tax purposes), shall maintain a register on which it enters the name and address of (i) each SPC (other than any SPC that is treated as a disregarded entity of the Granting Lender for U.S. federal income tax purposes) that has exercised its option pursuant to Section  10.07(g) and (ii) each Participant, and the amount of (including the principal amount and stated interest of) each such SPC’s and Participant’s interest in such Lender’s rights and/or obligations under this Agreement for purposes of complying with the requirements of Sections 163(f), 871(h) and 881(c)(2) of the Code and the United States Treasury Regulations (the “ Participant Register ”); provided that no Lender shall have any obligation to disclose all or any portion of the Participant Register (including the identity of any Participant or any information relating to a Participant’s interest in any commitments, loans or its other obligations under any Loan Document) to any Person except to the extent that such disclosure is necessary to establish that such commitment, loan, letter of credit or other obligation is in registered form under Section 5f.103-1(c) of the United States Treasury Regulations. The entries in the Participant Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and the Borrowers and such Lender shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Participant Register as the owner of the applicable rights and/or obligations of such Lender under this Agreement, notwithstanding notice to the contrary.

(n) In the event that a transfer by any of the Secured Parties of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (and/or any relevant Loan Document) occurred or was deemed to occur by way of novation, the Borrowers and any other Loan Parties explicitly agree that all securities and guarantees created under any Loan Documents shall be preserved for the benefit of the new Lender and the other Secured Parties.

Section 10.08 Confidentiality . Each of the Agents and the Lenders agrees to maintain the confidentiality of the Information, except that Information may be disclosed (a) to its Affiliates and to its and its Affiliate’s respective partners, directors, officers, employees, trustees, representatives and agents, including accountants, legal counsel and other advisors and numbering administration and settlement service providers on a need to know basis, it being understood that the Persons to whom such disclosure is made will be informed of the confidential nature of such Information and instructed to keep such Information confidential in accordance with customary practices; (b) to the extent requested by any regulatory authority having jurisdiction over such Agent, Lender or its respective Affiliates or in connection with any pledge or assignment permitted under Section  10.07(f) ; (c) in any legal, judicial, administrative proceeding or other compulsory process or otherwise as required by applicable Laws or regulations or by any subpoena or similar legal process, in each case based upon the reasonable advice of the disclosing Agent’s or Lender’s legal counsel (in which case the disclosing Agent or Lender, as applicable, agrees (except with respect to any audit or examination conducted by bank accountants or any governmental bank regulatory authority exercising examination or regulatory authority), to the extent practicable and not prohibited by applicable Law, to promptly notify the Borrower Representative after disclosure); (d) to any other party to this Agreement; (e) in connection with the exercise of any remedies hereunder or under any other Loan Document or any action or proceeding relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document or the enforcement of rights hereunder or thereunder; (f) subject to an agreement containing provisions substantially the same (or at least as restrictive) as those of this Section

 

-161-


10.08 (or as may otherwise be reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers), to any Eligible Assignee of or Participant in, or any prospective Eligible Assignee of or Participant in, any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement; provided that no such disclosure shall be made by such Lender or such Agent or any of their respective Affiliates to any such Person that is a Disqualified Institution (to the extent the list thereof has been provided to all Lenders) (and is permitted to be shared); (g) with the written consent of Holdings; (h) to the extent such Information becomes publicly available other than as a result of a breach of this Section  10.08 ; (i) to any state, federal or foreign authority or examiner (including the National Association of Insurance Commissioners or any other similar organization) regulating any Lender; (j) to any rating agency when required by it (it being understood that, prior to any such disclosure, such rating agency shall undertake to preserve the confidentiality of any Information relating to the Loan Parties received by it from such Lender); or (k) to any national or international numbering service provider appointed by such Agent or Lender to provide identification numbering services in respect of this Agreement, the Facility and/or one or more Loan Parties. In addition, the Agents and the Lenders may disclose the existence of this Agreement and information about this Agreement to market data collectors, similar service providers to the lending industry, and service providers to the Agents and the Lenders in connection with the administration and management of this Agreement, the other Loan Documents, the Commitments, and the Credit Extensions; provided that such Person is advised and agrees to be bound by the provisions of this Section  10.08 .

For the purposes of this Section  10.08 , “ Information ” means all information received from any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof relating to any Loan Party or any Subsidiary thereof or their respective businesses, other than any such information that is publicly available to any Agent or any Lender prior to disclosure by any Loan Party other than as a result of a breach of this Section  10.08 by such Lender or Agent. Any Person required to maintain the confidentiality of Information as provided in this Section  10.08 shall be considered to have complied with its obligation to do so if such Person has exercised the same degree of care to maintain the confidentiality of such Information as such Person would accord to its own confidential information.

Each of the Administrative Agent and the Lenders acknowledges that (i) the Information may include material non-public information concerning Holdings or any of its Subsidiaries, (ii) it has developed compliance procedures regarding the use of material non-public information and (iii) it will handle such material non-public information in accordance with applicable Law, including United States federal and state securities Laws.

Section 10.09 Setoff . In addition to any rights and remedies of the Lenders provided by Law, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, each Secured Party is authorized at any time and from time to time, after obtaining the prior written consent of the Administrative Agent, without prior notice to any Borrower or any other Loan Party, any such notice being waived by the Borrowers (each, on its own behalf and on behalf of each Loan Party) to the fullest extent permitted by Law, to set off and apply any and all deposits (general or special, time or demand, provisional or final, in any currency), other than deposits in fiduciary accounts as to which a Loan Party is acting as fiduciary for another Person who is not a Loan Party, at any time held by, and other Indebtedness (in any currency) at any time owing by, such Lender to or for the credit or the account of the respective Loan Parties against any and all Obligations owing to such Secured Party hereunder or under any other Loan Document (or other Secured Agreement (as defined in the Security Agreement)), now or hereafter existing, irrespective of whether or not such Agent or such Lender shall have made demand under this Agreement or any other Loan Document (or other Secured Agreement (as defined in the Security Agreement)) and although such Obligations may be contingent or unmatured or denominated in a currency different from that of the applicable deposit or Indebtedness or are owed to a branch or office of such Lender different from the branch or office holding such deposit or obligated on such Indebtedness; provided that in the event that any Defaulting Lender shall exercise any such right of setoff,

 

-162-


(x) all amounts so set off shall be paid over immediately to the Administrative Agent for further application in accordance with the provisions of Section  2.17 and, pending such payment, shall be segregated by such Defaulting Lender from its other funds and deemed held in trust for the benefit of the Administrative Agent and the Lenders, and (y) the Defaulting Lender shall provide promptly to the Administrative Agent a statement describing in reasonable detail the Obligations owing to such Defaulting Lender as to which it exercised such right of setoff. Each Secured Party agrees promptly to notify the Borrower Representative and the Administrative Agent after any such set-off and application made by such Secured Party; provided , however , that the failure to give such notice shall not affect the validity of such setoff and application. The rights of the Administrative Agent and each Secured Party under this Section  10.09 are in addition to other rights and remedies (including other rights of setoff) that the Administrative Agent and such Secured Party may have. Notwithstanding anything herein or in any other Loan Document to the contrary, in no event shall the assets of any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO constitute security, or shall the proceeds of such assets be available for, payment of the Obligations, it being understood that (a) the Equity Interests of any Controlled Foreign Subsidiary or FSHCO that are directly owned by any U.S. Loan Party may be pledged, to the extent set forth in Section  6.12 (and, for the avoidance of doubt, only to the extent not constituting Excluded Property) and (b) the provisions hereof shall not limit, reduce or otherwise diminish in any respect the Borrowers’ obligations to make any mandatory prepayment pursuant to Section 2.05(b)(ii) .

Section 10.10 Interest Rate Limitation . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Document, the interest paid or agreed to be paid under the Loan Documents shall not exceed the maximum rate of non-usurious interest permitted by applicable Law (the “ Maximum Rate ”). If any Agent or any Lender shall receive interest in an amount that exceeds the Maximum Rate, the excess interest shall be applied to the principal of the Loans or, if it exceeds such unpaid principal, refunded to the Borrowers. In determining whether the interest contracted for, charged, or received by an Agent or a Lender exceeds the Maximum Rate, such Person may, to the extent permitted by applicable Law, (a) characterize any payment that is not principal as an expense, fee, or premium rather than interest, (b) exclude voluntary prepayments and the effects thereof and (c) amortize, prorate, allocate, and spread in equal or unequal parts the total amount of interest throughout the contemplated term of the Obligations hereunder.

Section 10.11 Counterparts . This Agreement and each other Loan Document may be executed in one or more counterparts (and by different parties hereto in different counterparts), each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument. Delivery by telecopier or other electronic transmission of an executed counterpart of a signature page to this Agreement and each other Loan Document shall be effective as delivery of an original executed counterpart of this Agreement and such other Loan Document. The Agents may also require that any such documents and signatures delivered by telecopier or other electronic transmission be confirmed by a manually-signed original thereof; provided that the failure to request or deliver the same shall not limit the effectiveness of any document or signature delivered by telecopier or other electronic transmission.

Section 10.12 Integration ; Effectiveness . This Agreement and the other Loan Documents (in addition to the Fee Letter) constitute the entire contract among the parties relating to the subject matter hereof and supersede any and all previous agreements and understandings, oral or written, relating to the subject matter hereof. It is expressly agreed and confirmed by the parties hereto that the provisions of the Fee Letter shall survive the execution and delivery of this Agreement, the occurrence of the Closing Date, and shall continue in effect thereafter in accordance with their terms. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and those of any other Loan Document, the provisions of this Agreement shall control; provided that the inclusion of supplemental rights or remedies in favor of the Agents or the Lenders in any other Loan Document shall not be deemed a conflict with this Agreement. Each Loan Document was drafted with the joint participation of the respective parties thereto and shall be construed neither against nor in favor of any party, but rather in accordance with the fair meaning thereof. This Agreement shall become effective in accordance with Section  4.01 .

 

-163-


Section 10.13 Survival of Representations and Warranties . All representations and warranties made hereunder and in any other Loan Document or other document delivered pursuant hereto or thereto or in connection herewith or therewith shall survive the execution and delivery hereof and thereof. Such representations and warranties have been or will be relied upon by each Agent and each Lender, regardless of any investigation made by any Agent or any Lender or on their behalf and notwithstanding that any Agent or any Lender may have had notice or knowledge of any Default at the time of any Credit Extension, and shall continue in full force and effect as long as any Loan or any other Obligation (other than contingent indemnification) hereunder shall remain unpaid or unsatisfied.

Section 10.14 Severability . If any provision of this Agreement or the other Loan Documents is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable, (a) the legality, validity and enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall not be affected or impaired thereby and (b) the parties shall endeavor in good faith negotiations to replace the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provisions. The invalidity of a provision in a particular jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction. Without limiting the foregoing provisions of this Section  10.14 , if and to the extent that the enforceability of any provisions in this Agreement relating to Defaulting Lenders shall be limited by Debtor Relief Laws then such provisions shall be deemed to be in effect only to the extent not so limited.

Section 10.15 Governing Law ; Jurisdiction ; Etc .

(a) GOVERNING LAW . THIS AGREEMENT AND EACH OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (OTHER THAN WITH RESPECT TO ANY COLLATERAL DOCUMENTS TO THE EXTENT EXPRESSLY PROVIDED OTHERWISE THEREIN) SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

(b) SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY SUBMITS, FOR ITSELF AND ITS PROPERTY, TO THE EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION OF THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SITTING IN NEW YORK CITY IN THE BOROUGH OF MANHATTAN AND OF THE UNITED STATES DISTRICT COURT FOR THE SOUTHERN DISTRICT OF NEW YORK SITTING IN THE BOROUGH OF MANHATTAN, AND ANY APPELLATE COURT FROM ANY THEREOF, IN ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT (OTHER THAN WITH RESPECT TO ANY COLLATERAL DOCUMENT TO THE EXTENT EXPRESSLY PROVIDED OTHERWISE THEREIN), OR FOR RECOGNITION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY JUDGMENT, AND EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY AGREES THAT ALL CLAIMS IN RESPECT OF ANY SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING MAY BE HEARD AND DETERMINED IN SUCH NEW YORK STATE COURT OR, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN SUCH FEDERAL COURT. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREES THAT A FINAL JUDGMENT IN ANY SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING SHALL BE CONCLUSIVE AND MAY BE ENFORCED IN OTHER JURISDICTIONS BY SUIT ON THE JUDGMENT OR IN ANY OTHER MANNER PROVIDED BY LAW. NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT OR IN ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT SHALL AFFECT ANY RIGHT WITH RESPECT TO THE COLLATERAL THAT THE ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, THE COLLATERAL AGENT, ANY LENDER MAY OTHERWISE HAVE TO BRING ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT OR THE RECOGNITION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY JUDGMENT AGAINST ANY LOAN PARTY OR ITS PROPERTIES IN THE COURTS OF ANY JURISDICTION.

 

-164-


(c) WAIVER OF VENUE . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY OBJECTION THAT IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE TO THE LAYING OF VENUE OF ANY ACTION OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT IN ANY COURT REFERRED TO IN CLAUSE (b) OF THIS SECTION  10.15 . EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, THE DEFENSE OF AN INCONVENIENT FORUM TO THE MAINTENANCE OF SUCH ACTION OR PROCEEDING IN ANY SUCH COURT.

Section 10.16 SERVICE OF PROCESS . EACH PARTY HERETO IRREVOCABLY CONSENTS TO SERVICE OF PROCESS IN THE MANNER PROVIDED FOR NOTICES IN SECTION  10.02 . NOTHING IN THIS AGREEMENT WILL AFFECT THE RIGHT OF ANY PARTY HERETO TO SERVE PROCESS IN ANY OTHER MANNER PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.

Section 10.17 WAIVER OF RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY . EACH PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT HEREBY EXPRESSLY WAIVES ANY RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY OF ANY CLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION ARISING UNDER ANY LOAN DOCUMENT OR IN ANY WAY CONNECTED WITH OR RELATED OR INCIDENTAL TO THE DEALINGS OF THE PARTIES HERETO OR ANY OF THEM WITH RESPECT TO ANY LOAN DOCUMENT, OR THE TRANSACTIONS RELATED THERETO, IN EACH CASE WHETHER NOW EXISTING OR HEREAFTER ARISING, AND WHETHER FOUNDED IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR OTHERWISE; AND EACH PARTY HEREBY AGREES AND CONSENTS THAT ANY SUCH CLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION SHALL BE DECIDED BY COURT TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY, AND THAT ANY PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY FILE AN ORIGINAL COUNTERPART OR A COPY OF THIS SECTION 10.17 WITH ANY COURT AS WRITTEN EVIDENCE OF THE CONSENT OF THE SIGNATORIES HERETO TO THE WAIVER OF THEIR RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY.

Section 10.18 Binding Effect . When this Agreement shall have become effective in accordance with Section  10.12 , it shall thereafter shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Borrowers, each Agent and each Lender and their respective successors and permitted assigns, except that the Borrowers shall not have the right to assign its rights hereunder or any interest herein without the prior written consent of the Lenders except as permitted by Section  7.04 .

Section 10.19 No Advisory or Fiduciary Responsibility . In connection with all aspects of each transaction contemplated hereby (including in connection with any amendment, waiver or other modification hereof or of any other Loan Document), the Borrowers and Holdings acknowledge and agree, and each of them acknowledges and agrees that it has informed its other Affiliates, that: (i) (A) no fiduciary, advisory or agency relationship between any of Holdings and its Subsidiaries and any Agent or any Arranger is intended to be or has been created in respect of any of the transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents, irrespective of whether any Agent or any Arranger has advised or is advising Holdings and its Subsidiaries on other matters, (B) the arranging and other services regarding this Agreement provided by the Agents and the Arrangers are arm’s-length commercial transactions between Holdings and its Subsidiaries, on the one hand, and the Agents and the Arrangers, on the other hand, (C) the Borrowers and Holdings have consulted their own legal, accounting, regulatory and tax advisors to the extent it has deemed appropriate, and (D) the Borrowers and Holdings are capable of evaluating, and understands and accepts, the terms, risks and conditions of the transactions

 

-165-


contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents; (ii) (A) each Agent and Arranger is and has been acting solely as a principal and, except as may otherwise be expressly agreed in writing by the relevant parties, has not been, is not, and will not be acting as an advisor, agent or fiduciary for Holdings or any of its Affiliates, or any other Person and (B) neither any Agent nor any Arranger has any obligation to Holdings or any of its Affiliates with respect to the transactions contemplated hereby except those obligations expressly set forth herein and in the other Loan Documents; and (iii) the Agents and the Arrangers and their respective Affiliates may be engaged in a broad range of transactions that involve interests that differ from those of Holdings, the Borrowers and their respective Affiliates, and neither any Agent nor any Arranger has any obligation to disclose any of such interests and transactions to Holdings, the Borrowers or their respective Affiliates. To the fullest extent permitted by law, Holdings and the Borrowers hereby (i) agree not to assert any claims that they may have against the Agents, the Arrangers, and the Lenders with respect to any breach or alleged breach of agency and (ii) agree not to assert that any fiduciary or similar duty is owed by the Agents, the Arrangers or the Lenders, in each case, in connection with any aspect of any transaction contemplated hereby.

Section 10.20 Affiliate Activities . The Borrowers and Holdings acknowledge that each Agent and each Arranger (and their respective Affiliates) is a full service securities firm engaged, either directly or through affiliates, in various activities, including securities trading, investment banking and financial advisory, investment management, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities and financial planning and benefits counseling for both companies and individuals. In the ordinary course of these activities, any of them may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and/or financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of customers and may at any time hold long and short positions in such securities and/or instruments. Such investment and other activities may involve securities and instruments of Holdings and its Affiliates, as well as of other entities and persons and their Affiliates which may (i) be involved in transactions arising from or relating to the engagement contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents, (ii) be customers or competitors of Holdings and its Affiliates or (iii) have other relationships with Holdings and its Affiliates. In addition, it may provide investment banking, underwriting and financial advisory services to such other entities and persons. It may also co-invest with, make direct investments in, and invest or co-invest client monies in or with funds or other investment vehicles managed by other parties, and such funds or other investment vehicles may trade or make investments in securities of Holdings and its Affiliates or such other entities. The transactions contemplated hereby and by the other Loan Documents may have a direct or indirect impact on the investments, securities or instruments referred to in this Section  10.20 .

Section 10.21 Electronic Execution of Assignments and Certain Other Documents . The words “execution,” “signed,” “signature,” and words of like import in any Assignment and Assumption or in any amendment or other modification hereof (including waivers and consents) shall be deemed to include electronic signatures or the keeping of records in electronic form, each of which shall be of the same legal effect, validity or enforceability as a manually executed signature or the use of a paper-based recordkeeping system, as the case may be, to the extent and as provided for in any applicable Law, including the Federal Electronic Signatures in Global and National Commerce Act, the New York State Electronic Signatures and Records Act, or any other similar state laws based on the Uniform Electronic Transactions Act.

Section 10.22 USA PATRIOT ACT . Each Lender that is subject to the PATRIOT Act and the Administrative Agent (for itself and not on behalf of any Lender) hereby notifies each Borrower that pursuant to the requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act (Title III of Pub. L. 107-56 (signed into law October 26, 2001, as amended from time to time)) (the “ PATRIOT Act ”), it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies each Loan Party, which information includes the name and address of each Loan Party and other information that will allow such Lender or the Administrative Agent, as

 

-166-


applicable, to identify each Loan Party in accordance with the PATRIOT Act. The Borrowers shall, promptly following a request by the Administrative Agent or any Lender, provide all documentation and other information that the Administrative Agent or such Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the PATRIOT Act.

Section 10.23 Acknowledgement and Consent to Bail-In of EEA Financial Institutions . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Loan Document or in any other agreement, arrangement or understanding among any such parties, each party hereto acknowledges that any liability of any EEA Financial Institution arising under any Loan Document, to the extent such liability is unsecured, may be subject to the write-down and conversion powers of an EEA Resolution Authority and agrees and consents to, and acknowledges and agrees to be bound by: (a) the application of any Write-Down and Conversion Powers by an EEA Resolution Authority to any such liabilities arising hereunder which may be payable to it by any party hereto that is an EEA Financial Institution; and (b) the effects of any Bail-In Action on any such liability, including, if applicable: (i) a reduction in full or in part or cancellation of any such liability; (ii) a conversion of all, or a portion of, such liability into shares or other instruments of ownership in such EEA Financial Institution, its parent entity, or a bridge institution that may be issued to it or otherwise conferred on it, and that such shares or other instruments of ownership will be accepted by it in lieu of any rights with respect to any such liability under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; or (iii) the variation of the terms of such liability in connection with the exercise of the write-down and conversion powers of any EEA Resolution Authority.

[REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

-167-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Credit Agreement to be duly executed as of the date first written above.

 

LD INTERMEDIATE HOLDINGS, INC., as a
Borrower
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer

 

LD LOWER HOLDINGS, INC., as a Borrower
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer:

 

LD TOPCO, INC., as Holdings
By:  

/s/ Douglas S. Strahan

Name:   Douglas S. Strahan
Title:   Secretary and Treasurer

 

[Signature Page to First Lien Credit Agreement]


ROYAL BANK OF CANADA, as Administrative
Agent
By:  

/s/ Rodica Dutka

Name:   Rodica Dutka
Title:   Manager, Agency

 

[Signature Page to First Lien Credit Agreement]


ROYAL BANK OF CANADA, as Lender, L/C
Issuer and Swing Line Lender
By:  

/s/ Kamran Khan

Name:   Kamran Khan
Title:   Authorized Signatory

 

[Signature Page to First Lien Credit Agreement]


THE TORONTO-DOMINION BANK, NEW YORK
BRANCH, as Lender
By:  

/s/ ALICE MARE

Name:   ALICE MARE
Title:   AUTHORIZED SIGNATORY

 

[Signature Page to First Lien Credit Agreement]

Exhibit 23.1

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption “Experts” and to the use of our report dated June 19, 2019, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of LD Topco, Inc. and Subsidiaries included in the Proxy Statement of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. that is made a part of the Registration Statement (Form S-4) and Prospectus of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. for the registration of 37,000,000 shares of its common stock.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Tysons, Virginia

June 19, 2019

Exhibit 23.2

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM’S CONSENT

We consent to the inclusion in this Registration Statement of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. on Form S-4 of our report dated April 1, 2019, with respect to our audit of the financial statements of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. as of December 31, 2018 and for the period from August 2, 2018 (inception) through December 31, 2018, which report appears in the Proxy Statement/Prospectus, which is part of this Registration Statement. We also consent to the reference to our Firm under the heading “Experts” in such Proxy Statement/Prospectus.

/s/ Marcum LLP

Marcum LLP

New York, NY

June 20, 2019

Exhibit 99.2

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ Daniel F. Akerson

 

Signature

Exhibit 99.3

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ William Darman

 

Signature

Exhibit 99.4

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ Donna Morea

 

Signature

Exhibit 99.5

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ Evan Morgan

 

Signature

Exhibit 99.6

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ Christopher J. Weiler

 

Signature

Exhibit 99.7

Consent to be Named as a Director

In connection with the filing by Pivotal Acquisition Corp. of the Registration Statement on Form S-4 with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), I hereby consent, pursuant to Rule 438 of the Securities Act, to being named in the Registration Statement and any and all amendments and supplements thereto as a member of the board of directors of Pivotal Acquisition Corp. following the consummation of the business combination. I also consent to the filing of this consent as an exhibit to such Registration Statement and any amendments thereto.

Dated: June 20, 2019

 

By:

 

/s/ Richard J. Williams

 

Signature